Vous êtes sur la page 1sur 7884

S I E M E N S

D 9 0 0
Mobile Communication System

Task Manual
TML Version SR10.0 - Innovation
Configuration: 2G MSC
APS-ID: UMRCBK1V.3510
Volume 1 - 10

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619

BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB
Siemens Aktiengesellschaft
Issued by Bereich Oeffentliche Vermittlungssysteme
Hofmannstrasse 51, D-81359 Muenchen

The reproduction, transmission or use of this


document or its contents is not permitted without
express written authority. Offenders will be liable
for damages. All rights, including rights created by
patent grant or registration of a utility model or
design, are reserved. Specifications are subject to
change without notice.

Subject to technical alterations without notice.

Copyright (c) SIEMENS AG 2002

& T M L D 9 0 0 : Administration Section


ADMIN-2 & P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
GKKKKKKKKKKKKKK9
8 ADMIN 8
FKKKKKKKKKKKKKK:

This document requires 10 50 mm binder


Order No. A30808-X3000-X500-*-99

and the accessories package for TML


Order No. P30305-V6000-A866-*-7692

Hints for interpreting the change designations:

The designations mean:

A ] Alternation, changed

N ] New, no previous chapter

0 ] Chapter removed, no replacement

This document comprises a total of 6473 pages.

Index of Issue: Issue: Pages:

ADMINISTRATION SECTION 01 ADMIN -1... 3


LIST OF CONTENTS 01 CONT -1... 28
INTRODUCTION CML/OML 01 IN -1... 9
COMMANDS 01 -1...6214
REFERENCE LIST COMMAND - MASKS 01 TAB -1... 219

T M L D 9 0 0 : Administration Section
P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ADMIN-3
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

DISPLAY A4 TESTPATTERN VALUE 2034.00 1 DISP_A4TPVAL -1... 1


ENTER A4 TESTPATTERN VALUE 2036.00 1 ENTR_A4TPVAL -1... 1
RECORD AUTHENTICATION CENTRE DATA 1927.18 1 REC_AC -1... 4
DIAGNOSE AC ALGORITHMS 1952.03 1 DIAG_ACALGOR -1... 1
TEST AC ALGORITHMS 1953.03 1 TEST_ACALGOR -1... 1
CANCEL AUTOMATIC CONGESTION CONTROL 3664.47 1 CAN_ACC -1... 1
DISPLAY AUTOMATIC CONGESTION CONTROL 3665.47 1 DISP_ACC -1... 1
ENTER AUTOMATIC CONGESTION CONTROL 3663.48 1 ENTR_ACC -1... 3
DISP. STATUS OF AUTOM. CONGEST. CONTROL 3666.47 1 STAT_ACC -1... 1
Display Access Control Configuration 1.00 1 DISP_ACCFG -1... 1
Modify Access Control Configuration 1.00 1 MOD_ACCFG -1... 2
CANCEL AUTOM. CONGEST. CONTROL TRAF. 3661.47 1 CAN_ACCTRAF -1... 1
DISPLAY AUTOM. CONGEST. CONTROL TRAF. 3662.47 1 DISP_ACCTRAF -1... 1
ENTER AUTOM. CONGEST. CONTROL TRAF. 3660.48 1 ENTR_ACCTRAF -1... 3
Activate Accounting Upgrade 1.00 1 ACT_ACCUPG -1... 1
DISPLAY GENERAL ALARM CALL DATA 1589.00 1 DISP_ACDATA -1... 1
ENTER ALARM CALL DATA 1590.04 1 ENTR_ACDATA -1... 3
CANCEL AUTHENTICATION CENTER HLR ID 1935.02 1 CAN_ACHLRID -1... 1
CREATE AUTHENTICATION CENTER HLR ID 1937.03 1 CR_ACHLRID -1... 1
DISPLAY AUTHENTICATION CENTER HLR ID 1939.00 1 DISP_ACHLRID -1... 1
Cancel Access Control Initiator Group 1.00 1 CAN_ACINIGRP -1... 1
Create Access Control Initiator Group 1.00 1 CR_ACINIGRP -1... 1
Display Access Control Initiator Group 1.00 1 DISP_ACINIGRP -1... 1
Modify Access Control Initiator Group 1.00 1 MOD_ACINIGRP -1... 1
CANCEL AUTHENTICATION CENTRE MOBILE SUB 1936.06 1 CAN_ACMSUB -1... 1
CREATE AUTHENTICATION CENTRE MOBILE SUB 1938.08 1 CR_ACMSUB -1... 4
DISPLAY AUTHENTICATION CENTRE MOBILE SUB 1940.17 1 DISP_ACMSUB -1... 1
Cancel Application Context Name 1.00 1 CAN_ACN -1... 1
Create Application Context Name 1.00 1 CR_ACN -1... 1
Display Application Context Name 1.00 1 DISP_ACN -1... 1
Modify Application Context Name 1.00 1 MOD_ACN -1... 1
CANCEL COMFORT ALARM CALL ORDER LIMITS 3825.01 1 CAN_ACOLIM -1... 1
DISPLAY COMFORT ALARM CALL ORDER LIMITS 3824.01 1 DISP_ACOLIM -1... 1
ENTER COMFORT ALARM CALL ORDER LIMITS 3823.01 1 ENTR_ACOLIM -1... 2
CANCEL ALARM CALL ORDER 1587.06 1 CAN_ACORD -1... 2
ENTER ALARM CALL ORDER 1585.07 1 ENTR_ACORD -1... 4
SELECT ALARM CALL ORDER 1586.03 1 SEL_ACORD -1... 1
Cancel Access Control Rule 1.00 1 CAN_ACRULE -1... 1
Create Access Control Rule 1.00 1 CR_ACRULE -1... 3
Display Access Control Rule 1.00 1 DISP_ACRULE -1... 2
Modify Access Control Rule 1.00 1 MOD_ACRULE -1... 3
DISPLAY ALARM CALL STATISTICS 1588.00 1 DISP_ACSTAT -1... 1
Cancel Access Control Target Group 1.00 1 CAN_ACTARGRP -1... 1
Create Access Control Target Group 1.00 1 CR_ACTARGRP -1... 2
Display Access Control Target Group 1.00 1 DISP_ACTARGRP -1... 1
Modify Access Control Target Group 1.00 1 MOD_ACTARGRP -1... 2
DISPLAY ARCHIVE FILE ENTRY 1518.03 1 DISP_AENTRY -1... 1
SELECT ARCHIVE FILE ENTRY 1519.08 1 SEL_AENTRY -1... 4
CANCEL ARCHIVE FILE 1515.01 1 CAN_AFILE -1... 1
CREATE ARCHIVE FILE 1514.03 1 CR_AFILE -1... 3
DISPLAY ARCHIVE FILE ATTRIBUTES 1517.00 1 DISP_AFILE -1... 1
MODIFY ARCHIVE FILE ATTRIBUTES 1516.02 1 MOD_AFILE -1... 3
DISPLAY ALARM STATUS 1483.02 1 DISP_ALARM -1... 2
SEARCH ALARM MESSAGE 1486.04 1 SRCH_ALARM -1... 2
Display Alarm Balance Monitor 1.00 1 DISP_ALBALMON -1... 1
ACTIVATE ALARM DISPLAY 2017.01 1 ACT_ALDISP -1... 1
DEACTIVATE ALARM DISPLAY 2019.01 1 DACT_ALDISP -1... 2
DISPLAY ALARM DISPLAY 2020.00 1 DISP_ALDISP -1... 1
Display Alarm Interface 1.00 1 DISP_ALI -1... 1
Modify Alarm Interface 1.00 1 MOD_ALI -1... 1
CANCEL ALIAS NAME 3079.00 1 CAN_ALIAS -1... 1
DISPLAY ALIAS FILE NAMES 3075.00 1 DISP_ALIAS -1... 1
ENTER ALIAS FILE NAME 3076.00 1 ENTR_ALIAS -1... 1
MODIFY ALIAS NAME 3077.00 1 MOD_ALIAS -1... 1
Cancel Alarm Input Interface 1.00 1 CAN_ALINIF -1... 1
Create Alarm Input Interface 1.00 1 CR_ALINIF -1... 3
Display Alarm Input Interface 1.00 1 DISP_ALINIF -1... 1
Modify Alarm Input Interface 1.00 1 MOD_ALINIF -1... 1
Display Alarm Output Interface 1.00 1 DISP_ALOUTIF -1... 1
CANCEL ALARM PRIORITY 2922.00 1 CAN_ALPRIO -1... 2
DISPLAY ALARM PRIORITY 769.13 1 DISP_ALPRIO -1... 4
ENTER ALARM PRIORITY 768.13 1 ENTR_ALPRIO -1... 5
DISPLAY ALARM PROFILE 3174.00 1 DISP_ALPROF -1... 1
Display Alarm Profile MP 1.00 1 DISP_ALPROFMP -1... 1

CONT-1 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

Create Alarm Relais 1.00 1 CR_ALRELAIS -1... 1


Reset Alarm Relais 1.00 1 RSET_ALRELAIS -1... 1
Reset Alarm SSNC Recovery 1.00 1 RSET_ALSSNCR -1... 1
SET ALARM STATUS 1485.04 1 SET_ALSTAT -1... 1
CANCEL ALARM TEXT 946.02 1 CAN_ALTEXT -1... 1
DISPLAY ALARM TEXT 947.01 1 DISP_ALTEXT -1... 1
ENTER ALARM TEXT 943.01 1 ENTR_ALTEXT -1... 1
CANCEL ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3162.00 1 CAN_AMP -1... 1
COMMUTE ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3166.00 1 COM_AMP -1... 1
CONFIGURE ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3155.00 1 CONF_AMP -1... 1
CREATE ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3156.00 1 CR_AMP -1... 1
DIAGNOSE ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3159.00 1 DIAG_AMP -1... 2
DISPLAY ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3160.00 1 DISP_AMP -1... 1
TEST ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3163.00 1 TEST_AMP -1... 1
Cancel ATM Multiplexer 1.00 1 CAN_AMX -1... 1
Configure ATM Multiplexer 1.00 1 CONF_AMX -1... 1
Create ATM Multiplexer 1.00 1 CR_AMX -1... 3
Diagnose ATM Multiplexer 1.00 1 DIAG_AMX -1... 1
Display ATM Multiplexer 1.00 1 DISP_AMX -1... 1
Modify ATM Multiplexer 1.00 1 MOD_AMX -1... 2
Recover ATM Multiplexer 1.00 1 RECOV_AMX -1... 1
Display Status of ATM Multiplexer 1.00 1 STAT_AMX -1... 1
Display ATM Multiplexer Clock 1.00 1 DISP_AMXCLK -1... 1
Display ATM Multiplexer Port 1.00 1 DISP_AMXPORT -1... 1
CANCEL ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT 2888.04 1 CAN_ANELEM -1... 5
CREATE ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT 4098.01 1 CR_ANELEM -1... 11
DISPLAY ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT 2890.04 1 DISP_ANELEM -1... 6
MODIFY ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT 4099.01 1 MOD_ANELEM -1... 10
CANCEL ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP COS 216.06 1 CAN_ANGCOS -1... 1
ENTER ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP COS 215.06 1 ENTR_ANGCOS -1... 7
CANCEL ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP 214.03 1 CAN_ANGRP -1... 1
CREATE ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP 213.82 1 CR_ANGRP -1... 9
DISPLAY ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP 222.03 1 DISP_ANGRP -1... 1
RECORD ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP DATA 2876.30 1 REC_ANGRP -1... 4
CANCEL ANNOUNCEMENT LINE COS 220.05 1 CAN_ANLCOS -1... 1
ENTER ANNOUNCEMENT LINE COS 219.05 1 ENTR_ANLCOS -1... 1
CANCEL ANNOUNCEMENT LINE 218.03 1 CAN_ANLN -1... 1
CREATE ANNOUNCEMENT LINE 217.79 1 CR_ANLN -1... 3
DISPLAY ANNOUNCEMENT LINE 221.03 1 DISP_ANLN -1... 1
DISPLAY STATUS OF ANNOUNCEMENT LINE 847.69 1 STAT_ANLN -1... 2
CANCEL ANNOUNCEMENT TEXT 2902.01 1 CAN_ANTXT -1... 1
CREATE ANNOUNCEMENT TEXT 2903.01 1 CR_ANTXT -1... 2
DISPLAY ANNOUNCEMENT TEXT 2891.01 1 DISP_ANTXT -1... 1
MODIFY ANNOUNCEMENT TEXT 2904.01 1 MOD_ANTXT -1... 2
CANCEL APPLICATION 1767.00 1 CAN_APPL -1... 1
CREATE APPLICATION 1769.08 1 CR_APPL -1... 7
DISPLAY APPLICATION 1771.01 1 DISP_APPL -1... 1
MODIFY APPLICATION 1774.09 1 MOD_APPL -1... 7
ENTER APS NAME 321.01 1 ENTR_APSNAME -1... 1
INCREMENT APS VERSION NUMBER 322.01 1 INCR_APSVN -1... 1
MODIFY ARCHIVE FILE 4131.00 1 MOD_ARCHIVE -1... 3
CANCEL LOCAL AREA CODE 1052.46 1 CAN_AREACODE -1... 1
DISPLAY LOCAL AREA CODE DATA 311.46 1 DISP_AREACODE -1... 1
ENTER LOCAL AREA CODE 310.46 1 ENTR_AREACODE -1... 2
MODIFY LOCAL AREA CODE 1051.46 1 MOD_AREACODE -1... 2
Cancel ATM Switching Network 1.00 1 CAN_ASN -1... 1
Configure ATM Switching Network 1.00 1 CONF_ASN -1... 1
Create ATM Switching Network 1.00 1 CR_ASN -1... 2
Diagnose ATM Switching Network 1.00 1 DIAG_ASN -1... 1
Display ATM Switching Network 1.00 1 DISP_ASN -1... 1
Modify ATM Switching Network 1.00 1 MOD_ASN -1... 2
Recover ATM Switching Network 1.00 1 RECOV_ASN -1... 1
Display Status of ATM Switching Network 1.00 1 STAT_ASN -1... 1
Display ATM Switching Network Port 1.00 1 DISP_ASNPORT -1... 1
Cancel ATM Bridge 1.00 1 CAN_ATMB -1... 1
Configure ATM Bridge 1.00 1 CONF_ATMB -1... 1
Create ATM Bridge 1.00 1 CR_ATMB -1... 2
Display ATM Bridge 1.00 1 DISP_ATMB -1... 1
Modify ATM Bridge 1.00 1 MOD_ATMB -1... 2
Display Status of ATM Bridge 1.00 1 STAT_ATMB -1... 1
ALLOW AUDIT 242.79 1 ALLOW_AUDIT -1... 2
DISPLAY AUDIT 240.70 1 DISP_AUDIT -1... 1
INHIBIT AUDIT 241.79 1 INHIB_AUDIT -1... 2
START AUDIT 239.79 1 START_AUDIT -1... 3

CONT-2 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

Activate Audit Main Processor 1.00 1 ACT_AUDITMP -1... 1


Deactivate Audit Main Processor 1.00 1 DACT_AUDITMP -1... 1
Display Audit Main Processor 1.00 1 DISP_AUDITMP -1... 1
CANCEL AUTHORIZATION 897.01 1 CAN_AUT -1... 1
DISPLAY AUTHORIZATION 898.01 1 DISP_AUT -1... 1
ENTER AUTHORIZATION 896.01 1 ENTR_AUT -1... 1
CANCEL AUTHORIZATION CLASS 894.01 1 CAN_AUTCL -1... 1
DISPLAY AUTHORIZATION CLASS 895.01 1 DISP_AUTCL -1... 1
ENTER AUTHORIZATION CLASS 893.01 1 ENTR_AUTCL -1... 1
Display Authentication Defaults 1.00 1 DISP_AUTHDEF -1... 1
Modify Authentication Defaults 1.00 1 MOD_AUTHDEF -1... 1
DISPLAY CALL DATA OF BASIC ACCESS 1592.04 1 STAT_BA -1... 2
DISPLAY BASIC ACCESS FAULT 1818.09 1 DISP_BAFAULT -1... 3
COMMUTE BASE PROCESSORS 1099.00 1 COM_BAP -1... 1
CONFIGURE BASE PROCESSOR 1089.00 1 CONF_BAP -1... 1
DIAGNOSE BASE PROCESSOR 1109.00 1 DIAG_BAP -1... 2
TEST BASE PROCESSOR 1128.00 1 TEST_BAP -1... 1
CONFIGURE BUS TO COMMON MEMORY 1101.00 1 CONF_BCMY -1... 1
DIAGNOSE BUS TO COMMON MEMORY 1112.00 1 DIAG_BCMY -1... 1
TEST BUS TO COMMON MEMORY 1130.01 1 TEST_BCMY -1... 1
ACT BIT ERROR MEASUREMENT 3242.03 1 ACT_BERM -1... 2
DISPLAY BIT ERROR RATE MEASUREMENT 3183.16 1 DISP_BERM -1... 1
ACTIVATE BILLING RECORD 3426.35 1 ACT_BILLREC -1... 5
TRANSFER INDIV. CALL DATA BUFFER TO DISK 593.18 1 TRANS_BUFFER -1... 1
CANCEL CCS7 LSET IN RT.SET OF RT AREA 1714.01 1 CAN_C7LSETRA -1... 1
DISP.FOR A GIVEN CCS7 LSET ALL RT.AREA’S 1716.01 1 DISP_C7LSETRA -1... 1
ENTER CCS7 LSET IN ROUTE DESC.OF RT AREA 1710.01 1 ENTR_C7LSETRA -1... 1
CANCEL CCS7 ROUTING AREA 1352.02 1 CAN_C7RTAREA -1... 1
CONFIGURE CCS7 ROUTING AREA 1356.02 1 CONF_C7RTAREA -1... 1
CREATE CCS7 ROUTING AREA 1351.02 1 CR_C7RTAREA -1... 1
DISPLAY CCS7 ROUTING AREA 1353.03 1 DISP_C7RTAREA -1... 1
MODIFY CCS7 ROUTING AREA 1713.03 1 MOD_C7RTAREA -1... 2
CANCEL CCS7 TRUNK GROUP RELATION 1758.00 1 CAN_C7TGREL -1... 1
DISPLAY CCS7 TRUNK GROUP RELATION 1759.26 1 DISP_C7TGREL -1... 3
ENTER CCS7 TRUNK GROUP RELATION 1757.25 1 ENTR_C7TGREL -1... 2
TEST CCS7 TRUNK STATUS 3492.26 1 TEST_C7TRSTAT -1... 4
TEST CCS7 TRUNK 854.25 1 TEST_C7TRUNK -1... 4
TEST CCS7 TRUNK VALIDATION 3628.26 1 TEST_C7TRVAL -1... 4
CANCEL CCS7 USER ASSOCIATION 1684.26 1 CAN_C7USER -1... 2
CREATE CCS7 USER ASSOCIATION 1685.26 1 CR_C7USER -1... 2
DISPLAY CCS7 USER ASSOCIATION 1695.26 1 DISP_C7USER -1... 2
CREATE CARRIER ACCESS CODE 2444.52 1 CR_CAC -1... 1
DISPLAY CARRIER ACCESS CODE 2447.52 1 DISP_CAC -1... 1
MODIFY CARRIER ACCESS CODE 2446.54 1 MOD_CAC -1... 1
CANCEL CARRIER ACCESS CODE CODE POINT 4032.52 1 CAN_CACCPT -1... 1
CREATE CARRIER ACCESS CODE CODE POINT 4031.56 1 CR_CACCPT -1... 3
DISPLAY CARRIER ACCESS CODE CODEPOINT 4034.52 1 DISP_CACCPT -1... 2
MODIFY CARRIER ACCESS CODE CODEPOINT 4033.52 1 MOD_CACCPT -1... 4
CANCEL CARRIER ACCESS CODE LIST 4040.52 1 CAN_CACLST -1... 1
CREATE CARRIER ACCESS CODE LIST 4037.52 1 CR_CACLST -1... 1
DISPLAY CARRIER ACCESS CODE LIST 4039.52 1 DISP_CACLST -1... 1
MODIFY CARRIER ACCESS CODE LIST 4038.52 1 MOD_CACLST -1... 1
CANCEL MALICIOUS CALL ID REC. CENTER 4019.13 1 CAN_CALIDREC -1... 1
CREATE MALICIOUS CALL ID REC. CENTER 4016.13 1 CR_CALIDREC -1... 2
DISPLAY MALICIOUS CALL ID REC. CENTER 4018.13 1 DISP_CALIDREC -1... 1
MODIFY MALICIOUS CALL ID REC. CENTER 4017.13 1 MOD_CALIDREC -1... 2
CANCEL CALLBACK SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES 3297.96 1 CAN_CALLBACK -1... 3
ENTER CALLBACK SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES 3301.96 1 ENTR_CALLBACK -1... 4
DISPLAY CALL PROCESSING DATA 639.79 1 DISP_CALLDAT -1... 7
DISPLAY CALL PROCESSING OPTIONS 1945.07 1 DISP_CALLPOPT -1... 2
MODIFY CALL PROCESSING OPTIONS 1950.30 1 MOD_CALLPOPT -1... 32
CANCEL CALL TYPE DATA 3387.05 1 CAN_CALLTYPE -1... 1
CREATE CALL TYPE DATA 2395.06 1 CR_CALLTYPE -1... 12
DISPLAY CALL TYPE DATA 3386.06 1 DISP_CALLTYPE -1... 4
MODIFY CALL TYPE DATA 2396.06 1 MOD_CALLTYPE -1... 16
CANCEL CALL PROCESSOR 3165.00 1 CAN_CAP -1... 1
CONFIGURE CALL PROCESSOR 1090.00 1 CONF_CAP -1... 1
CREATE CALL PROCESSOR 3157.00 1 CR_CAP -1... 1
DIAGNOSE CALL PROCESSOR 1110.00 1 DIAG_CAP -1... 2
DISPLAY CALL PROCESSOR 3161.00 1 DISP_CAP -1... 1
TEST CALL PROCESSOR 1129.01 1 TEST_CAP -1... 1
ACTIVATE CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP 3025.02 1 ACT_CBPGRP -1... 1
CANCEL CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP 3026.03 1 CAN_CBPGRP -1... 1
CREATE CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP 3027.04 1 CR_CBPGRP -1... 2

CONT-3 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

DEACTIVATE CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP 3028.02 1 DACT_CBPGRP -1... 1


DISPLAY CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP 3029.02 1 DISP_CBPGRP -1... 1
MODIFY CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP 3030.04 1 MOD_CBPGRP -1... 2
CANCEL CODE BLOCK POINT 328.85 1 CAN_CBPT -1... 2
CREATE CODE BLOCK POINT 326.86 1 CR_CBPT -1... 4
DISPLAY CODE BLOCK POINT 329.84 1 DISP_CBPT -1... 2
MODIFY CODE BLOCK POINT 327.85 1 MOD_CBPT -1... 3
CANCEL CALL BARRING SERVICE 2963.96 1 CAN_CBSERV -1... 3
ENTER CALL BARRING SERVICE 2974.96 1 ENTR_CBSERV -1... 5
CONFIGURE CENTRAL CLOCK GENERATOR 928.60 1 CONF_CCG -1... 1
DISPLAY CENTRAL CLOCK GENERATOR 921.10 1 DISP_CCG -1... 1
DISPLAY STATUS OF CCG 143.80 1 STAT_CCG -1... 1
DISPLAY CCG-PARAMETER 1549.10 1 DISP_CCGPAR -1... 3
MODIFY CCG-PARAMETER 1548.10 1 MOD_CCGPAR -1... 3
ACTIVATE A CDS TIME PROGRAM DATA 3858.00 1 ACT_CDSPROG -1... 1
CANCEL CDS TIME PROGRAM DATA 3856.00 1 CAN_CDSPROG -1... 2
DEACTIVATE A CDS TIME PROGRAM DATA 3859.01 1 DACT_CDSPROG -1... 1
DISPLAY CDS TIME PROGRAM DATA 3857.01 1 DISP_CDSPROG -1... 6
ENTER CDS TIME PROGRAM DATA 3855.01 1 ENTR_CDSPROG -1... 4
CANCEL CDS PROGRAM TIME DATA 3851.00 1 CAN_CDSPRTIM -1... 2
CREATE CDS PROGRAM TIME DATA 3850.00 1 CR_CDSPRTIM -1... 2
DISPLAY CDS PROGRAM TIME DATA 3853.00 1 DISP_CDSPRTIM -1... 2
MODIFY CDS PROGRAM TIME DATA 3852.00 1 MOD_CDSPRTIM -1... 2
CANCEL CALL DATA TREATMENT DATA 2791.09 1 CAN_CDTDAT -1... 3
DISPLAY CALL DATA TREATMENT DATA 2796.02 1 DISP_CDTDAT -1... 1
ENTER CALL DATA TREATMENT DATA 2799.09 1 ENTR_CDTDAT -1... 9
RESET COMMAND FILE OPTIONS 952.00 1 RESET_CFOPT -1... 1
SET COMMAND FILE OPTIONS 951.01 1 SET_CFOPT -1... 2
CANCEL CALL FORWARDING SERVICES 2964.17 1 CAN_CFSERV -1... 4
ENTER CALL FORWARDING SERVICE 2975.39 1 ENTR_CFSERV -1... 8
DISPLAY CALL FAILURE TREATMENT 1208.00 1 DISP_CFT -1... 1
ENTER CALL FAILURE TREATMENT 1207.00 1 ENTR_CFT -1... 1
DISPLAY COMMAND FILE TIME JOB 648.01 1 DISP_CFTJOB -1... 1
DISPLAY CHARGING DATA RECORDS 3819.02 1 DISP_CHAREC -1... 27
DISPLAY CIRCUIT POOL PREFERENCES 4078.18 1 DISP_CIRPPREF -1... 1
MODIFY CIRCUIT POOL PREFERENCES 4079.39 1 MOD_CIRPPREF -1... 4
CANCEL CIRCUIT POOL RELATION 4064.18 1 CAN_CIRPREL -1... 1
DISPLAY CIRCUIT POOL RELATION 4065.39 1 DISP_CIRPREL -1... 5
ENTER CIRCUIT POOL RELATION 4063.39 1 ENTR_CIRPREL -1... 3
Display Clock Reference 1.00 1 DISP_CLKREF -1... 1
Cancel Clock Source 1.00 1 CAN_CLKSRC -1... 1
Create Clock Source 1.00 1 CR_CLKSRC -1... 1
Display Clock Source 1.00 1 DISP_CLKSRC -1... 1
SKIP COMMAND 1.00 1 SKIP_CMD -1... 1
EXECUTE COMMAND FILE 671.75 1 EXEC_CMDFILE -1... 3
CONFIGURE COMMON MEMORY 1102.00 1 CONF_CMY -1... 1
DIAGNOSE COMMON MEMORY 1113.00 1 DIAG_CMY -1... 1
TEST COMMON MEMORY 1131.01 1 TEST_CMY -1... 1
LOAD CMY FIRMWARE 4198.00 1 LOAD_CMYFW -1... 1
DUMP CCNC MEMORY IMMEDIATE DUMP 3897.00 1 DMP_CNIMDMP -1... 3
ACTIVATE CCNC PERMANENT PATCH 3899.00 1 ACT_CNPRPCH -1... 1
CANCEL CCNC PERMANENT PATCH 3902.00 1 CAN_CNPRPCH -1... 1
DEACTIVATE CCNC PERMANENT PATCH 3900.00 1 DACT_CNPRPCH -1... 1
DISPLAY CCNC PERMANENT PATCH 3903.01 1 DISP_CNPRPCH -1... 4
ENTER CCNC PERMANENT PATCH 3898.00 1 ENTR_CNPRPCH -1... 4
UPDATE CCNC PERMANENT PATCH 3901.00 1 UPD_CNPRPCH -1... 1
ACTIVATE CCNC TRANSIENT PATCH 3905.00 1 ACT_CNTRPCH -1... 1
CANCEL CCNC TRANSIENT PATCH 3907.00 1 CAN_CNTRPCH -1... 1
DEACTIVATE CCNC TRANSIENT PATCH 3906.00 1 DACT_CNTRPCH -1... 1
DISPLAY CCNC TRANSIENT PATCH 3908.01 1 DISP_CNTRPCH -1... 4
ENTER CCNC TRANSIENT PATCH 3904.00 1 ENTR_CNTRPCH -1... 2
CANCEL COUNTRY CODE 2450.44 1 CAN_CNTRYCOD -1... 1
DISPLAY COUNTRY CODE 2451.46 1 DISP_CNTRYCOD -1... 1
ENTER COUNTRY CODE 2449.46 1 ENTR_CNTRYCOD -1... 1
Repair Code File on MP 1.00 1 REP_CODEFILE -1... 2
DISPLAY LARGE CONFERENCE 3508.07 1 DISP_CONFL -1... 2
MODIFY LARGE CONFERENCE 3507.07 1 MOD_CONFL -1... 1
CANCEL CONFERENCE 1932.07 1 CAN_CONFRNC -1... 1
CREATE CONFERENCE 1933.07 1 CR_CONFRNC -1... 1
DISPLAY CONFERENCE 1934.07 1 DISP_CONFRNC -1... 1
DISPLAY CONNECTIONS 1652.11 1 DISP_CONN -1... 5
RELEASE CONNECTION 1581.52 1 REL_CONN -1... 5
ACTIVATE CONNECTION TRACE 2013.17 1 ACT_CONNTRAC -1... 13
CANCEL CONNECTION TRACE PARAMETER SET 2057.16 1 CAN_CONNTRAC -1... 1

CONT-4 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

DEACTIVATE CONNECTION TRACE 2014.16 1 DACT_CONNTRAC -1... 1


DISPLAY CONNECTION TRACE PARAMETER SET 2058.16 1 DISP_CONNTRAC -1... 1
DUMP CONNECTION TRACE 2015.17 1 DMP_CONNTRAC -1... 3
ENTER CONNECTION TRACE PARAMETER SET 2059.17 1 ENTR_CONNTRAC -1... 8
MODIFY CONNECTION TRACE PARAMETER SET 2060.17 1 MOD_CONNTRAC -1... 5
Cancel Continuity Monitor 1.00 1 CAN_CONTMON -1... 1
Create Continuity Monitor 1.00 1 CR_CONTMON -1... 2
Display Continuity Monitor 1.00 1 DISP_CONTMON -1... 2
Modify Continuity Monitor 1.00 1 MOD_CONTMON -1... 2
CONFIGURATE CONFERENCE UNIT 1492.18 1 CONF_COU -1... 1
DIAGNOSE CONFERENCE UNIT 1491.08 1 DIAG_COU -1... 1
DISPLAY STATUS OF CONFERENCE UNIT 1490.88 1 STAT_COU -1... 1
RECORD COORDINATION PROCESSOR 277.39 1 REC_CP -1... 4
ACTIVATE CP DUMP CONDITIONS 1066.20 1 ACT_CPDMPC -1... 2
DEACTIVATE CONDITIONAL CPDUMP 1068.02 1 DACT_CPDMPC -1... 1
DISPLAY CONDITIONAL CPDUMP 1067.00 1 DISP_CPDMPC -1... 1
DUMP CP MEMORY IMMEDIATE DUMP 3605.00 1 DMP_CPIMDMP -1... 3
ACTIVATE CP PERMANENT PATCH 3593.00 1 ACT_CPPRPCH -1... 2
CANCEL CP PERMANENT PATCH 3596.00 1 CAN_CPPRPCH -1... 1
DEACTIVATE CP PERMANENT PATCH 3594.00 1 DACT_CPPRPCH -1... 2
DISPLAY CP PERMANENT PATCH 3597.02 1 DISP_CPPRPCH -1... 4
ENTER CP PERMANENT PATCH 3592.00 1 ENTR_CPPRPCH -1... 4
UPDATE CP PERMANENT PATCH 3595.00 1 UPD_CPPRPCH -1... 1
CANCEL CODE POINT 21.49 1 CAN_CPT -1... 3
CREATE CODE POINT 19.60 1 CR_CPT -1... 13
DISPLAY CODE POINT 197.60 1 DISP_CPT -1... 4
MERGE CODE POINT 387.60 1 MERGE_CPT -1... 4
MODIFY CODE POINT 314.60 1 MOD_CPT -1... 10
SPLIT CODE POINT 385.60 1 SPLIT_CPT -1... 5
ACTIVATE CP TRANSIENT PATCH 3599.00 1 ACT_CPTRPCH -1... 2
CANCEL CP TRANSIENT PATCH 3601.00 1 CAN_CPTRPCH -1... 2
DEACTIVATE CP TRANSIENT PATCH 3600.00 1 DACT_CPTRPCH -1... 2
DISPLAY CP TRANSIENT PATCH 3602.02 1 DISP_CPTRPCH -1... 4
ENTER CP TRANSIENT PATCH 3598.00 1 ENTR_CPTRPCH -1... 2
ENTER CARRIER QUOTA DATA 1805.02 1 ENTR_CQDAT -1... 4
MODIFY CARRIER QUOTA DATA 1807.05 1 MOD_CQDAT -1... 9
CAN CARRIER QUOTA GROUP 1800.01 1 CAN_CQGRP -1... 1
CREATE CARRIER QUOTA GROUP 1802.03 1 CR_CQGRP -1... 2
DISPLAY CARRIER QUOTA GROUP 1804.02 1 DISP_CQGRP -1... 1
MODIFY CARRIER QUOTA GROUP 1808.02 1 MOD_CQGRP -1... 1
CONFIGURE CODE RECEIVER 383.78 1 CONF_CR -1... 2
DIAGNOSE CODE RECEIVER 996.18 1 DIAG_CR -1... 1
DISPLAY STATUS OF CODE RECEIVER 384.88 1 STAT_CR -1... 3
CANCEL CODE RECEIVER MODULE 186.73 1 CAN_CRMOD -1... 1
CREATE CODE RECEIVER MODULE 166.81 1 CR_CRMOD -1... 2
DISPLAY CODE RECEIVER MODULE 176.75 1 DISP_CRMOD -1... 1
DUMP CSC-TRACE DATA 1075.01 1 DMP_CSCTRAC -1... 1
START CSWD PROCESSES 280.10 1 START_CSWD -1... 1
CANCEL CLOSED USER GROUP 2764.04 1 CAN_CUG -1... 2
DISPLAY CLOSED USER GROUP DATA 2766.02 1 DISP_CUG -1... 2
ENTER CLOSED USER GROUP 2768.06 1 ENTR_CUG -1... 3
MODIFY CLOSED USER GROUP AUTHORIZATION 2770.02 1 MOD_CUGAUTH -1... 2
CANCEL CLOSED USER GROUP SERVICE 3285.95 1 CAN_CUGSERV -1... 4
ENTER CLOSED USER GROUP SERVICE 3286.95 1 ENTR_CUGSERV -1... 4
RELEASE CYCLIC FILE 410.03 1 REL_CYCFILE -1... 1
Dump Disk Allocation 1.00 1 DMP_DALLOC -1... 1
Repair Data Files on MP 1.00 1 REP_DATFILES -1... 1
START DATA BASE 3568.00 1 START_DB -1... 1
Display Database Content 1.00 1 DISP_DBCONT -1... 1
Dump Disk Block 1.00 1 DMP_DBLOCK -1... 1
Patch Disk Block 1.00 1 PATCH_DBLOCK -1... 1
ACTIVATE DATABASE QUERY 4009.13 1 ACT_DBQUERY -1... 1
DISPLAY DATA BASE DESCRIPTION 1251.04 1 DISP_DBSIZE -1... 1
MODIFY DB-SIZE 1079.04 1 MOD_DBSIZE -1... 1
DIAGNOSE DIGITAL CODE RECEIVER 998.08 1 DIAG_DCR -1... 1
Cancel Disk Dir from Master and Slave 1.00 1 CAN_DDIR -1... 1
Repair Double Disk Outage on MP 1.00 1 REP_DDISKOUT -1... 1
DIAGNOSE DIGITAL ECHO SUPPRESSOR 997.08 1 DIAG_DES -1... 1
ACTIVATE DESTINATION 1799.01 1 ACT_DEST -1... 1
CANCEL DESTINATION 5.02 1 CAN_DEST -1... 1
CREATE DESTINATION 25.87 1 CR_DEST -1... 7
DEACTIVATE DESTINATION 1803.01 1 DACT_DEST -1... 1
DISPLAY DESTINATION 193.07 1 DISP_DEST -1... 2
MODIFY DESTINATION 412.88 1 MOD_DEST -1... 8

CONT-5 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

RECORD DESTINATION 261.39 1 REC_DEST -1... 5


CANCEL DESTINATION CONTROL DATA 2957.01 1 CAN_DESTCNTL -1... 2
ENTER DESTINATION CONTROL DATA 2958.01 1 ENTR_DESTCNTL -1... 2
CANCEL DESTINATION DATA 1801.03 1 CAN_DESTDAT -1... 1
ENTER DESTINATION DATA 1806.06 1 ENTR_DESTDAT -1... 3
MODIFY DESTINATION DATA 1809.05 1 MOD_DESTDAT -1... 3
DISPLAY DEVICE AUTHORIZATION 900.01 1 DISP_DEVAUT -1... 1
MODIFY DEVICE AUTHORIZATION 899.02 1 MOD_DEVAUT -1... 1
Cancel Disk File from Master and Slave 1.00 1 CAN_DFILE -1... 1
Catalog Disk File on Master and Slave 1.00 1 CAT_DFILE -1... 1
Display Disk Files on Master or Slave 1.00 1 DISP_DFILE -1... 2
Dump Disk File 1.00 1 DMP_DFILE -1... 1
Patch Disk File 1.00 1 PATCH_DFILE -1... 1
Cancel Disk File FS 1.00 1 CAN_DFILEFS -1... 1
DISPLAY DIAGNOSIS STATISTICS 1118.00 1 DISP_DIAGSTAT -1... 1
DISPLAY DIGITS CP 2162.49 1 DISP_DIGITCP -1... 1
CANCEL DIGITS GP 915.01 1 CAN_DIGITGP -1... 1
CREATE DIGITS GP 992.52 1 CR_DIGITGP -1... 1
DISPLAY DIGITS GP 913.46 1 DISP_DIGITGP -1... 1
MODIFY DIGITS GP 1926.49 1 MOD_DIGITGP -1... 3
Dump Disk File Inode 1.00 1 DMP_DINODE -1... 1
Patch Disk File Inode 1.00 1 PATCH_DINODE -1... 1
STOP DISPLAY 379.70 1 STOP_DISP -1... 1
CONFIGURE DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT 393.88 1 CONF_DIU -1... 1
DIAGNOSE DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT 995.08 1 DIAG_DIU -1... 1
DISPLAY STATUS OF DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT 356.88 1 STAT_DIU -1... 1
CANCEL DIGITAL LINE UNIT 655.05 1 CAN_DLU -1... 1
CONFIGURE DIGITAL LINE UNIT 667.50 1 CONF_DLU -1... 2
CREATE DIGITAL LINE UNIT 652.81 1 CR_DLU -1... 5
DIAGNOSIS OF THE DIGITAL LINE UNIT 1020.50 1 DIAG_DLU -1... 1
DISPLAY DIGITAL LINE UNIT 649.03 1 DISP_DLU -1... 1
EXTEND DIGITAL LINE UNIT 657.07 1 EXT_DLU -1... 4
MODIFY DIGITAL LINE UNIT 4097.01 1 MOD_DLU -1... 2
RECORD DIGITAL LINE UNIT 1056.30 1 REC_DLU -1... 4
REDUCE DIGITAL LINE UNIT 656.05 1 RED_DLU -1... 2
STATUS DISPLAY OF DLU SYSTEMS 663.50 1 STAT_DLU -1... 1
CANCEL DIGITAL LINE UNIT EQUIPMENT 4102.01 1 CAN_DLUEQ -1... 1
CONFIGURE DLU EQUIPMENT 670.50 1 CONF_DLUEQ -1... 3
CREATE DIGITAL LINE UNIT EQUIPMENT 4100.01 1 CR_DLUEQ -1... 2
DIAGNOSIS OF DLU-EQUIPMENT 1022.50 1 DIAG_DLUEQ -1... 2
DISPLAY DIGITAL LINE UNIT EQUIPMENT 4103.01 1 DISP_DLUEQ -1... 2
MODIFY DIGITAL LINE UNIT EQUIPMENT 4101.01 1 MOD_DLUEQ -1... 2
DISPLAY OST OF DLU EQUIPMENT 665.50 1 STAT_DLUEQ -1... 3
TEST DLU LINE CIRCUIT 676.15 1 TEST_DLULC -1... 6
CANCEL DLU MODULE 654.11 1 CAN_DLUMOD -1... 2
CONFIGURE DLU MODULE 668.50 1 CONF_DLUMOD -1... 2
CREATE DIGITAL LINE UNIT MODULE 653.03 1 CR_DLUMOD -1... 12
DIAGNOSIS OF DLU-MODULES 1021.50 1 DIAG_DLUMOD -1... 1
DISPLAY DLU MODULE 651.09 1 DISP_DLUMOD -1... 2
MODIFY DIGITAL LINE UNIT MODULE 1041.11 1 MOD_DLUMOD -1... 3
STATUS DISPLAY OF DLU MODULES 664.50 1 STAT_DLUMOD -1... 2
DISPLAY TRANSIENT DLU PATH DATA 849.03 1 DISP_DLUPD -1... 1
CONFIGURE DLU PORTS 669.10 1 CONF_DLUPORT -1... 2
DISPLAY DIGITAL LINE UNIT PORT 661.13 1 DISP_DLUPORT -1... 2
SELECTIVE DISPLAY OF DLU PORT 650.03 1 SEL_DLUPORT -1... 2
DISPLAY STATUS OF DLU PORTS 666.07 1 STAT_DLUPORT -1... 2
ACT DUMP OF SAFEGUARDING MESSAGES 1942.00 1 ACT_DMPSGMSG -1... 1
DACT DUMP OF SAFEGUARDING MESSAGES 1944.00 1 DACT_DMPSGMSG -1... 1
DISP DUMP OF SAFEGUARDING MESSAGES 1946.00 1 DISP_DMPSGMSG -1... 1
CANCEL DIRECTORY NUMBER 990.84 1 CAN_DN -1... 1
CREATE DIRECTORY NUMBER 988.86 1 CR_DN -1... 2
DISPLAY DIRECTORY NUMBER DATA 192.83 1 DISP_DN -1... 3
EXTEND DIRECTORY NUMBER 2276.03 1 EXT_DN -1... 1
MODIFY DIRECTORY NUMBER 989.86 1 MOD_DN -1... 3
RECORD DIRECTORY NUMBERS 2924.03 1 REC_DN -1... 10
REDUCE DIRECTORY NUMBER 2277.04 1 RED_DN -1... 1
DISPLAY DIRECTORY NUMBER ATTRIBUTE 1050.46 1 DISP_DNATT -1... 1
ENTER DIRECTORY NUMBER ATTRIBUTE 1049.54 1 ENTR_DNATT -1... 2
CANCEL DIRECTORY NUMBER OBSERVATION JOB 2960.04 1 CAN_DNOBS -1... 1
DISPLAY DIRECTORY NUMBER OBSERVATION JOB 2961.03 1 DISP_DNOBS -1... 1
ENTER DIRECTORY NUMBER OBSERVATION JOB 2962.04 1 ENTR_DNOBS -1... 4
DISPLAY DESTINATION NUMBER POINTS 454.13 1 DISP_DNP -1... 1
CANCEL DPFC ACTION 2483.00 1 CAN_DPFCACT -1... 1
CREATE DPFC ACTION 2482.35 1 CR_DPFCACT -1... 8

CONT-6 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

DISPLAY DPFC ACTION 2484.00 1 DISP_DPFCACT -1... 1


CANCEL DPFC EVALUATION DATA 2486.35 1 CAN_DPFCDAT -1... 3
CREATE DPFC EVALUATION DATA 2485.35 1 CR_DPFCDAT -1... 6
DISPLAY DPFC EVALUATION DATA 2487.35 1 DISP_DPFCDAT -1... 2
CANCEL DPFC ACTION EXCLUSION 2489.00 1 CAN_DPFCEXCL -1... 1
DISPLAY DPFC ACTION EXCLUSION 2490.00 1 DISP_DPFCEXCL -1... 1
ENTER DPFC ACTION EXCLUSION 2488.00 1 ENTR_DPFCEXCL -1... 1
CANCEL DEVICE GROUP 1791.01 1 CAN_DVGRP -1... 1
CREATE DEVICEGROUP 1793.01 1 CR_DVGRP -1... 2
SELECT DEVICE GROUP 1798.01 1 SEL_DVGRP -1... 1
DISP DEVICE GROUP LINK 1794.00 1 DISP_DVGRPLNK -1... 1
MODIFY DEVICE GROUP LINK 1796.02 1 MOD_DVGRPLNK -1... 2
CANCEL EXTERNAL ALARM LINE 1016.02 1 CAN_EAL -1... 1
CREATE EXTERNAL ALARM LINE 1015.03 1 CR_EAL -1... 1
DISPLAY EXTERNAL ALARM LINE 1017.01 1 DISP_EAL -1... 1
CREATE EAL LEVEL 1019.02 1 CR_EALLVL -1... 1
DISPLAY EAL LEVEL 1018.01 1 DISP_EALLVL -1... 1
Cancel EADAS Signaling Link Measurement 1.00 1 CAN_EASIGLME -1... 1
Create EADAS Signaling Link Measurement 1.00 1 CR_EASIGLME -1... 2
Display EADAS Signaling Link Measurement 1.00 1 DISP_EASIGLME -1... 1
Cancel EADAS Signaling Linkset Meas. 1.00 1 CAN_EASIGLSME -1... 1
Create EADAS Signaling Linkset Meas. 1.00 1 CR_EASIGLSME -1... 2
Display EADAS Signaling Linkset Meas. 1.00 1 DISP_EASIGLSME -1... 1
Cancel EADAS Sign. Network El. Meas. 1.00 1 CAN_EASIGNEME -1... 1
Create EADAS Sign. Network El. Meas. 1.00 1 CR_EASIGNEME -1... 2
Display EADAS Sign. Network El. Meas. 1.00 1 DISP_EASIGNEME -1... 1
EXECUTE EDT SYSTEM 8 270.00 1 EXEC_EDTS8 -1... 4
RECORD EQUIPMENT IDENTITY REGISTER 3062.18 1 REC_EIR -1... 4
CANCEL ELEMENTARY MESSAGE 2338.00 1 CAN_ELMSG -1... 1
CREATE ELEMENTARY MESSAGE 2334.02 1 CR_ELMSG -1... 6
DISPLAY ELEMENTARY MESSAGE 2339.01 1 DISP_ELMSG -1... 2
MODIFY ELEMENTARY MESSAGE 2335.02 1 MOD_ELMSG -1... 6
CANCEL ELEMENTARY MESSAGE ERROR 2341.00 1 CAN_ELMSGERR -1... 1
CREATE ELEMENTARY MESSAGE ERROR 2336.01 1 CR_ELMSGERR -1... 1
DISPLAY ELEMENTARY MESSAGE ERROR 2342.00 1 DISP_ELMSGERR -1... 1
MODIFY ELEMENTARY MESSAGE ERROR 2340.01 1 MOD_ELMSGERR -1... 1
RESET EMERGENCY OPERATION 647.01 1 RESET_EMERGOP -1... 1
Dump Error Notebook 1.00 1 DMP_ENB -1... 2
DISPLAY ENTITY OPTIONS 2969.17 1 DISP_ENTOPT -1... 1
MODIFY ENTITY OPTIONS 2977.30 1 MOD_ENTOPT -1... 3
MODIFY EQUIPMENT NUMBER 1860.18 1 MOD_EQN -1... 3
ACTIVATE EQUIPMENT TRAP 345.30 1 ACT_EQTRAP -1... 18
CANCEL EQUIPMENT TRAP 348.30 1 CAN_EQTRAP -1... 6
DISPLAY ERROR STATISTIC DATA 2815.06 1 DISP_ERRSTDAT -1... 10
Create Error Tracer Log 1.00 1 CR_ERRTRCLOG -1... 1
Cancel Error Tracer Records 1.00 1 CAN_ERRTRCREC -1... 1
Display Error Tracer Records to File 1.00 1 DISP_ERRTRCRECF -1... 1
Cancel Event Destination 1.00 1 CAN_EVDEST -1... 1
Create Event Destination 1.00 1 CR_EVDEST -1... 3
Disp Event Destination 1.00 1 DISP_EVDEST -1... 1
Modify Event Destination 1.00 1 MOD_EVDEST -1... 2
Cancel Event Log 1.00 1 CAN_EVLOG -1... 1
Create Event Log 1.00 1 CR_EVLOG -1... 3
Display Event Log 1.00 1 DISP_EVLOG -1... 1
Modify Event Log 1.00 1 MOD_EVLOG -1... 2
Cancel Event Log Records 1.00 1 CAN_EVREC -1... 1
Display Event Log Records Into File 1.00 1 DISP_EVRECF -1... 2
RECORD EXCHANGE DATA 290.06 1 REC_EXCH -1... 4
INTERFACE DCP TO SSP 940.01 1 STAT_EXCH -1... 1
ENTER EXCHANGE IDENTIFICATION 309.04 1 ENTR_EXCHID -1... 2
DISPLAY EXCHANGE DESCRIPTION DATA 1030.07 1 DISP_EXDDAT -1... 1
ENTER EXCHANGE DESCRIPTION DATA 1029.07 1 ENTR_EXDDAT -1... 3
CANCEL EXTERNAL LOCATION AREA CODE 2965.35 1 CAN_EXTLAC -1... 1
CREATE EXTERNAL LOCATION AREA CODE 2967.35 1 CR_EXTLAC -1... 1
DISPLAY EXTERNAL LOCATION AREA CODE 2970.94 1 DISP_EXTLAC -1... 1
MODIFY EXTERNAL LOCATION AREA CODE 2978.35 1 MOD_EXTLAC -1... 2
START FILE CONTROL PROCESSING 279.10 1 START_FCP -1... 1
DISPLAY FCS COUNTERS 1231.03 1 DISP_FCS -1... 2
CANCEL FILE GROUP 1879.02 1 CAN_FGRP -1... 1
CREATE FILE GROUP 1880.04 1 CR_FGRP -1... 2
DISPLAY FILE GROUPS 1876.02 1 DISP_FGRP -1... 1
MODIFY FILE GROUP 2328.00 1 MOD_FGRP -1... 1
DISPLAY FILE GROUP ATTRIBUTES 1507.02 1 DISP_FGRPATT -1... 1
RESET FILE GROUP ATTRIBUTES 1878.01 1 RSET_FGRPATT -1... 1

CONT-7 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

SET FILE GROUP ATTRIBUTES 1506.06 1 SET_FGRPATT -1... 3


CANCEL FILE GROUP PASSWORD 3410.00 1 CAN_FGRPPW -1... 1
RSET FILE GROUP PASSWORD 1886.01 1 RSET_FGRPPW -1... 1
SET FILE GROUP PASSWORD 1887.02 1 SET_FGRPPW -1... 2
Cancel NE Files 1.00 1 CAN_FILE -1... 1
CATALOG FILE 245.03 1 CAT_FILE -1... 2
CREATE FILE 237.06 1 CR_FILE -1... 1
DELETE FILE 235.04 1 DEL_FILE -1... 2
DISPLAY FILE 959.07 1 DISP_FILE -1... 2
List NE Files 1.00 1 LIST_FILE -1... 1
Receive File from NE 1.00 1 RCV_FILE -1... 2
Send File to NE 1.00 1 SEND_FILE -1... 3
TRANSFER FILE 939.08 1 TRANS_FILE -1... 9
MODIFY FILE AUTHORIZATION 966.02 1 MOD_FILEAUT -1... 1
ACTIVATE FILE FEATURES 2382.00 1 ACT_FILEFEAT -1... 1
CANCEL FILE FEATURES 2381.00 1 CAN_FILEFEAT -1... 1
DEACTIVATE FILE FEATURES 2383.00 1 DACT_FILEFEAT -1... 1
DISPLAY FILE FEATURES 2384.00 1 DISP_FILEFEAT -1... 1
ENTER FILE FEATURES 2380.16 1 ENTR_FILEFEAT -1... 2
ENTER FILE PASSWORD 1891.00 1 ENTR_FILEPSW -1... 1
DISPLAY FILE SECURITY METHOD 3896.00 1 DISP_FILESEC -1... 1
SET FILE SECURITY METHOD 3895.00 1 SET_FILESEC -1... 1
DISPLAY FILETEXT 2837.00 1 DISP_FILETEXT -1... 1
CANCEL FILE TRANSFERS 3246.00 1 CAN_FILETRF -1... 1
DISPLAY FILE TRANSFERS 2870.01 1 DISP_FILETRF -1... 1
STOP FILE TRANSFERS 3245.00 1 STOP_FILETRF -1... 1
CANCEL FILTER COMMAND 4262.00 1 CAN_FILTER -1... 1
CREATE FILTER COMMAND 4261.00 1 CR_FILTER -1... 6
DISPLAY FILTER COMMAND 4263.00 1 DISP_FILTER -1... 1
ACTIVATE FIXPOINT 2683.01 1 ACT_FIXPOINT -1... 2
DEACTIVATE FIXPOINT 2691.00 1 DACT_FIXPOINT -1... 1
DISPLAY FIXPOINT 2693.01 1 DISP_FIXPOINT -1... 1
ACTIVATE FILE NAME SEGMENT 958.02 1 ACT_FNS -1... 1
CANCEL FILE NAME SEGMENT 968.02 1 CAN_FNS -1... 1
DEACTIVATE FILE NAME SEGMENT 1508.00 1 DACT_FNS -1... 1
DISPLAY FILE NAME SEGMENT 956.01 1 DISP_FNS -1... 1
ENTER FILE NAME SEGMENT 967.02 1 ENTR_FNS -1... 1
Display Following Files 1.00 1 DISP_FOLLOW -1... 1
Activate Fast Process Trace 1.00 1 ACT_FPTRC -1... 1
Deactivate Fast Process Trace 1.00 1 DACT_FPTRC -1... 1
Display Fast Process Trace 1.00 1 DISP_FPTRC -1... 1
Dump Data of Fast Process Trace 1.00 1 DMP_FPTRC -1... 1
Display File Security Configuration 1.00 1 DISP_FSCFG -1... 1
Modify File Security Configuration 1.00 1 MOD_FSCFG -1... 1
Cancel File Security File Group 1.00 1 CAN_FSFGRP -1... 1
Create File Security File Group 1.00 1 CR_FSFGRP -1... 3
Display File Security File Group 1.00 1 DISP_FSFGRP -1... 2
Modify File Security File Group 1.00 1 MOD_FSFGRP -1... 3
Modify File Security File Group Password 1.00 1 MOD_FSFGRPPW -1... 2
Reset File Security File Group Password 1.00 1 RSET_FSFGRPPW -1... 2
Cancel File Security Initiator Group 1.00 1 CAN_FSINIGRP -1... 1
Create File Security Initiator Group 1.00 1 CR_FSINIGRP -1... 1
Display File Security Initiator Group 1.00 1 DISP_FSINIGRP -1... 1
Modify File Security Initiator Group 1.00 1 MOD_FSINIGRP -1... 1
Cancel File Security Rule 1.00 1 CAN_FSRULE -1... 1
Create File Security Rule 1.00 1 CR_FSRULE -1... 3
Display File Security Rule 1.00 1 DISP_FSRULE -1... 2
Modify File Security Rule 1.00 1 MOD_FSRULE -1... 2
Test Free Input of FSYS OT Commands 1.00 1 TEST_FSYS -1... 1
Cancel File Transfer Initiator 1.00 1 CAN_FTINI -1... 1
Create File Transfer Initiator 1.00 1 CR_FTINI -1... 3
Display File Transfer Initiator 1.00 1 DISP_FTINI -1... 1
Modify File Transfer Initiator 1.00 1 MOD_FTINI -1... 3
CANCEL FUNCTIONAL O&M TERMINAL 1510.01 1 CAN_FUOMT -1... 1
CREATE FUNCTIONAL O&M TERMINAL 1509.01 1 CR_FUOMT -1... 1
SELECT FUNCTIONAL O&M TERMINALS 1511.01 1 SEL_FUOMT -1... 1
DISPLAY FUNCTIONAL O&M TERMINAL LINKS 1512.00 1 DISP_FUOMTLNK -1... 1
MODIFY FUNCTIONAL O&M TERMINAL LINKS 1513.01 1 MOD_FUOMTLNK -1... 1
CANCEL GENERAL CALL SERVICES 3001.35 1 CAN_GCSERV -1... 3
ENTER GENERAL CALL SERVICES 2976.35 1 ENTR_GCSERV -1... 5
Modify GCS on MP 1.00 1 MOD_GCSMP -1... 1
ACTIVATE GENERATION 1204.03 1 ACT_GEN -1... 1
CANCEL GENERATION 1299.01 1 CAN_GEN -1... 1
COPY GENERATION 1302.06 1 COPY_GEN -1... 6

CONT-8 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

DISPLAY GENERATION 1298.02 1 DISP_GEN -1... 1


ENTER GENERATION 1081.03 1 ENTR_GEN -1... 3
MERGE GENERATION 2698.00 1 MERGE_GEN -1... 2
MODIFY GENERATION 2699.02 1 MOD_GEN -1... 2
UPDATE GENERATION 1202.00 1 UPD_GEN -1... 1
Cancel Generation on Coupled CP and MP 1.00 1 CAN_GENCPMP -1... 2
Copy Generation on Coupled CP and MP 1.00 1 COPY_GENCPMP -1... 2
Display Generation on Coupled CP and MP 1.00 1 DISP_GENCPMP -1... 2
Modify Generation on Coupled CP and MP 1.00 1 MOD_GENCPMP -1... 2
Build Generation First Install on MP 1.00 1 BLD_GENINSMP -1... 1
Cancel Generation on MP 1.00 1 CAN_GENMP -1... 1
Copy Generation on MP 1.00 1 COPY_GENMP -1... 2
Create Generation on MP 1.00 1 CR_GENMP -1... 1
Display Generation on MP 1.00 1 DISP_GENMP -1... 2
Install Delivered Generation on MP 1.00 1 INST_GENMP -1... 1
Merge Generations on MP 1.00 1 MERGE_GENMP -1... 2
Modify Generation on MP 1.00 1 MOD_GENMP -1... 2
Remove Generations on MP 1.00 1 REM_GENMP -1... 1
Restore Generation on MP 1.00 1 REST_GENMP -1... 1
Utilize Installed Generation on MP 1.00 1 UTIL_GENMP -1... 1
Validate Delivered Generation on MP 1.00 1 VAL_GENMP -1... 1
Build Generation During Upgrade on MP 1.00 1 BLD_GENUPGMP -1... 1
RECORD GRADE OF SERVICE 692.03 1 REC_GOS -1... 4
RECORD GROUP PROCESSOR 276.30 1 REC_GP -1... 4
CANCEL GENERAL PACKET RADIO SERVICE 4073.00 1 CAN_GPRSERV -1... 1
ENTER GENERAL PACKET RADIO SERVICE 4072.35 1 ENTR_GPRSERV -1... 2
CAN GSM BEARER CAPABILITY INFO ELEMENT 3002.39 1 CAN_GSMBCIE -1... 1
CR GSM BEARER CAPABILITY INFO ELEMENT 3004.39 1 CR_GSMBCIE -1... 3
DISP GSM BEARER CAPABILITY INFO ELEMENT 3006.39 1 DISP_GSMBCIE -1... 1
MOD GSM BEARER CAPABILITY INFO ELEMENT 3008.39 1 MOD_GSMBCIE -1... 3
CAN GTT CALLING PARTY ADDR. CONV. DATA 2834.30 1 CAN_GTCGPACD -1... 1
DISP GTT CALLING PARTY ADDR. CONV. DATA 2835.30 1 DISP_GTCGPACD -1... 1
ENTER GTT CALLING PARTY ADDR. CONV. DATA 2836.41 1 ENTR_GTCGPACD -1... 3
CANCEL GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. CODE POINT 2617.30 1 CAN_GTCPT -1... 1
CREATE GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. CODE POINT 1970.41 1 CR_GTCPT -1... 3
DISPLAY GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. CODE POINT 2641.50 1 DISP_GTCPT -1... 1
MERGE GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. CODE POINT 3122.41 1 MERGE_GTCPT -1... 22
MODIFY GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. CODE POINT 1998.41 1 MOD_GTCPT -1... 3
SPLIT GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. CODE POINT 3123.50 1 SPLIT_GTCPT -1... 2
CANCEL GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. DESTINATION 2618.30 1 CAN_GTDEST -1... 1
CREATE GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. DESTINATION 1971.41 1 CR_GTDEST -1... 14
DISPLAY GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. DESTINATION 2642.50 1 DISP_GTDEST -1... 1
MODIFY GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. DESTINATION 1999.41 1 MOD_GTDEST -1... 15
RECORD HOME LOCATION REGISTER DATA 1928.18 1 REC_HLR -1... 4
ACTIVATE HLR CHECKPOINT 4147.00 1 ACT_HLRCHP -1... 1
DEACTIVATE HLR CHECKPOINT 4148.00 1 DACT_HLRCHP -1... 1
DISPLAY HLR CHECKPOINT 4146.00 1 DISP_HLRCHP -1... 1
CANCEL HLR IDENTIFICATION 1960.94 1 CAN_HLRID -1... 1
CREATE HLR IDENTIFICATION 1973.94 1 CR_HLRID -1... 1
DISPLAY HLR IDENTIFICATION 1985.94 1 DISP_HLRID -1... 1
ACTIVATE HOME LOCATION REGISTER UPDATE 3333.18 1 ACT_HLRUPD -1... 1
DISPLAY HOME LOCATION REGISTER UPDATE 3334.18 1 DISP_HLRUPD -1... 1
DISPLAY HEAP MANAGEMENT STATISTICS 375.00 1 DISP_HMSTAT -1... 1
START HEAP MANAGEMENT STATISTICS 374.00 1 START_HMSTAT -1... 1
STOP HEAP MANAGEMENT STATISTICS 373.00 1 STOP_HMSTAT -1... 1
CANCEL HOLIDAY 55.39 1 CAN_HOLIDAY -1... 1
DISPLAY HOLIDAY 53.39 1 DISP_HOLIDAY -1... 1
ENTER HOLIDAY 54.39 1 ENTR_HOLIDAY -1... 2
Cancel Hop Feature for IP 1.00 1 CAN_HOPFEATIP -1... 1
Create Hop Feature for IP 1.00 1 CR_HOPFEATIP -1... 4
Display Hop Feature for IP 1.00 1 DISP_HOPFEATIP -1... 1
Modify Hop Feature for IP 1.00 1 MOD_HOPFEATIP -1... 2
Define Hardware Code Tracepoint 1.00 1 DEF_HWTPCOD -1... 1
Define Hardware Data Tracepoint 1.00 1 DEF_HWTPDATA -1... 1
Continue HW Upgrade on MP 1.00 1 CONT_HWUPGMP -1... 1
CANCEL IACHASTA OBJECT 2386.04 1 CAN_IACOBJ -1... 8
CREATE IACHASTA OBJECT 2385.04 1 CR_IACOBJ -1... 8
DISPLAY IACHASTA OBJECT 2387.04 1 DISP_IACOBJ -1... 9
ACTIVATE IACHASTA REGISTRATION 2397.04 1 ACT_IACRG -1... 4
DEACTIVATE IACHASTA REGISTRATION 2398.02 1 DACT_IACRG -1... 2
DISPLAY IACHASTA REGISTRATION 2399.02 1 DISP_IACRG -1... 1
CANCEL IACHASTA REGISTRATION POINT 2389.04 1 CAN_IACRGPT -1... 2
CREATE IACHASTA REGISTRATION POINT 2388.05 1 CR_IACRGPT -1... 7
DISPLAY IACHASTA REGISTRATION POINT 2391.04 1 DISP_IACRGPT -1... 4

CONT-9 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

MODIFY IACHASTA REGISTRATION POINT 2390.05 1 MOD_IACRGPT -1... 4


DISPLAY IACHASTA SCHEDULE 2441.02 1 DISP_IACSCHED -1... 1
MODIFY IACHASTA SCHEDULE 2440.02 1 MOD_IACSCHED -1... 2
DISPLAY IACHASTA SETTINGS 2364.02 1 DISP_IACSET -1... 1
ENTER IACHASTA SETTINGS 2363.04 1 ENTR_IACSET -1... 1
DISPLAY IACHASTA TRAFFIC DISTINCTION 2453.02 1 DISP_IACTRADI -1... 1
MODIFY IACHASTA TRAFFIC DISTINCTION 2438.04 1 MOD_IACTRADI -1... 6
ACTIVATE INDIVIDUAL CALL DATA FEATURE 835.19 1 ACT_IAFEAT -1... 13
CANCEL INDIVIDUAL CALL DATA FEATURE 836.18 1 CAN_IAFEAT -1... 1
DISPLAY INDIVIDUAL CALL DATA FEATURES 833.18 1 DISP_IAFEAT -1... 1
MODIFY INDIVIDUAL CALL DATA FEATURE 3946.18 1 MOD_IAFEAT -1... 1
ACTIVATE INDIV. CALL DATA ADMIN. OPTIONS 831.01 1 ACT_IAOPT -1... 1
CANCEL INDIV. CALL DATA ADMIN. OPTIONS 832.01 1 CAN_IAOPT -1... 1
DISPLAY INDIV. CALL DATA ADMIN. OPTIONS 834.01 1 DISP_IAOPT -1... 1
COPY IARACCOUNT 718.00 1 COPY_IARACCT -1... 1
CANCEL IARSTAT CONNEC.GROUP ASSIGNMENTS 2783.01 1 CAN_IARCON -1... 2
DISPLAY IARSTAT CONNEC.GROUP ASSIGNMENTS 2785.00 1 DISP_IARCON -1... 1
ENTER IARSTAT CONNEC.GROUP ASSIGNMENTS 2788.01 1 ENTR_IARCON -1... 2
DISPLAY IARA STATISTICS DATA 541.01 1 DISP_IARDAT -1... 2
MODIFY IARA STATISTICS DATA 540.70 1 MOD_IARDAT -1... 2
DISPLAY IARA MEASUREMENT FILE 3142.16 1 DISP_IARFILE -1... 1
CANCEL IARSTAT CONNECTION GROUPS 2787.00 1 CAN_IARGRP -1... 1
CREATE IARSTAT CONNECTION GROUPS 2784.00 1 CR_IARGRP -1... 1
DISPLAY IARSTAT CONNECTION GROUPS 2786.00 1 DISP_IARGRP -1... 1
DISPLAY IARA STATISTICS JOB 636.00 1 DISP_IARJOB -1... 1
CANCEL IARSTAT MATRIX POINT 716.03 1 CAN_IARMPT -1... 2
CREATE IARSTAT MATRIX POINT 1000.03 1 CR_IARMPT -1... 3
DISPLAY IARSTAT MATRIX POINT 715.03 1 DISP_IARMPT -1... 3
CANCEL IARA STATISTICS NAME 704.05 1 CAN_IARNAME -1... 10
DISPLAY IARA STATISTICS NAME 542.05 1 DISP_IARNAME -1... 5
ENTER IARA STATISTICS NAME 703.05 1 ENTR_IARNAME -1... 10
MODIFY IARA STATISTICS NAME 705.05 1 MOD_IARNAME -1... 10
CANCEL IARSTAT SAVING DATE 1290.00 1 CAN_IARSAVDA -1... 1
DISPLAY IARSTAT SAVING DATE 1289.00 1 DISP_IARSAVDA -1... 1
ENTER IARSTAT SAVING DATE 1288.00 1 ENTR_IARSAVDA -1... 1
DISPLAY IARA STATISTICS 539.71 1 DISP_IARSTAT -1... 2
RECORD IARA STATISTICS 538.72 1 REC_IARSTAT -1... 2
CANCEL IARSTAT TIME PERIOD 339.75 1 CAN_IARTMPD -1... 2
CREATE IARSTAT TIME PERIOD 337.75 1 CR_IARTMPD -1... 2
DISPLAY IARA TIME PERIOD 334.71 1 DISP_IARTMPD -1... 1
MODIFY IARSTAT TIME PERIOD 338.75 1 MOD_IARTMPD -1... 2
CANCEL IARA STATISTICS ZONE 545.71 1 CAN_IARZONE -1... 2
DISPLAY IARA STATISTICS ZONE 546.00 1 DISP_IARZONE -1... 2
ENTER IARA STATISTICS ZONE 543.71 1 ENTR_IARZONE -1... 2
MODIFY IARA STATISTICS ZONE 544.71 1 MOD_IARZONE -1... 2
ACTIVATE INITIATOR BASED FILE SECURITY 3913.00 1 ACT_IBFS -1... 1
DEACTIVATE INITIATOR BASED FILE SECURITY 3914.00 1 DACT_IBFS -1... 1
DISPLAY INITIATOR BASED FILE SEC. STATUS 3915.00 1 DISP_IBFS -1... 1
DISPLAY STATUS OF LAYER 1 FOR ISDN PORTS 1591.01 1 STAT_ILAYER1 -1... 2
CANCEL INTERNAT. MOBILE EQUIPMENT ID. 3136.34 1 CAN_IMEI -1... 2
CREATE INTERNAT. MOBILE EQUIPMENT ID. 3137.34 1 CR_IMEI -1... 5
DISPLAY INTERNAT. MOBILE EQUIPMENT ID. 3139.34 1 DISP_IMEI -1... 6
ACTIVATE IMSI TRACING 3287.94 1 ACT_IMSITRAC -1... 1
DEACTIVATE IMSI TRACING 3288.94 1 DACT_IMSITRAC -1... 1
CANCEL IN AUTHORIZATION 3804.02 1 CAN_INAUTH -1... 1
CREATE IN AUTHORIZATION 3803.02 1 CR_INAUTH -1... 2
DISPLAY IN AUTHORIZATION 3806.02 1 DISP_INAUTH -1... 2
MODIFY IN AUTHORIZATION 3805.02 1 MOD_INAUTH -1... 3
CANCEL INTERCEPT 82.40 1 CAN_INC -1... 5
CREATE INTERCEPT 81.40 1 CR_INC -1... 41
DISPLAY INTERCEPT 194.40 1 DISP_INC -1... 7
DISPLAY INDICATION STATUS 1487.03 1 DISP_INDIC -1... 1
DISP INTELL.NETWORK EXCHANGE DATA 3244.04 1 DISP_INEXDATA -1... 1
ENTR INTELL.NETWORK EXCHANGE DATA 3243.04 1 ENTR_INEXDATA -1... 1
Cancel Initiator 1.00 1 CAN_INI -1... 1
Create Initiator 1.00 1 CR_INI -1... 3
Display Initiator 1.00 1 DISP_INI -1... 2
Modify Initiator 1.00 1 MOD_INI -1... 3
CANCEL IN OVERLOAD CONTROL DATA 3169.08 1 CAN_INOVLCO -1... 2
DISPLAY IN OVERLOAD CONTROL DATA 3167.08 1 DISP_INOVLCO -1... 2
ENTER IN OVERLOAD CONTROL DATA 3168.30 1 ENTR_INOVLCO -1... 3
Reset Input Log Function 1.00 1 RSET_INPLOG -1... 1
Set Input Log Function 1.00 1 SET_INPLOG -1... 1
Display Status of Input Log Function 1.00 1 STAT_INPLOG -1... 1

CONT-10 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

Activate Input Log Execution 1.00 1 ACT_INPLOGEX -1... 2


Deactivate Input Log Execution 1.00 1 DACT_INPLOGEX -1... 1
Display Status of Input Log Execution 1.00 1 STAT_INPLOGEX -1... 1
Cancel Input Log File 1.00 1 CAN_INPLOGFILE -1... 2
Copy Input Log File 1.00 1 COPY_INPLOGFILE -1... 2
Modify Input Log Files 1.00 1 MOD_INPLOGFILE -1... 1
CAN IN SERVICE CLASS MARK 2413.03 1 CAN_INSCM -1... 1
CREATE IN SERVICE CLASS MARK 2411.03 1 CR_INSCM -1... 25
DISP IN SERVICE CLASS MARK 2414.03 1 DISP_INSCM -1... 2
MODIFY IN SERVICE CLASS MARK 2412.03 1 MOD_INSCM -1... 27
ACTIVATE IN SERVICE CLASS MARK REFERENCE 3673.02 1 ACT_INSCMREF -1... 9
CANCEL IN SERVICE CLASS MARK REFERENCE 2417.03 1 CAN_INSCMREF -1... 7
CREATE IN SERVICE CLASS MARK REFERENCE 2415.03 1 CR_INSCMREF -1... 10
DEACTIVATE IN SERVICE CLASS MARK REF. 3674.02 1 DACT_INSCMREF -1... 8
DISPLAY IN SERVICE CLASS MARK REFERENCE 2418.03 1 DISP_INSCMREF -1... 7
MODIFY IN SERVICE CLASS MARK REFERENCE 2416.03 1 MOD_INSCMREF -1... 8
ACT INTELL.NETWORK SERVICE LOGIC DATA 2818.08 1 ACT_INSLDAT -1... 1
CAN INTELL.NETWORK SERVICE LOGIC DATA 2820.08 1 CAN_INSLDAT -1... 1
DACT INTELL.NETWORK SERVICE LOGIC DATA 2831.08 1 DACT_INSLDAT -1... 1
DISP INTELL.NETWORK SERVICE LOGIC DATA 2825.08 1 DISP_INSLDAT -1... 2
ENTR INTELL.NETWORK SERVICE LOGIC DATA 2816.08 1 ENTR_INSLDAT -1... 9
END INSTALLATION RECOVERY 296.10 1 END_INSTALL -1... 1
RECORD INTELLIGENT NETWORK STATISTIC 3170.04 1 REC_INSTAT -1... 3
ENTER INSTALLATION GENERATION 1214.02 1 ENTR_INSTGEN -1... 2
CANCEL INTERNAL CELL 1962.94 1 CAN_INTCELL -1... 1
CREATE INTERNAL CELL 1975.35 1 CR_INTCELL -1... 2
DISPLAY INTERNAL CELL 1987.34 1 DISP_INTCELL -1... 4
MODIFY INTERNAL CELL 2002.35 1 MOD_INTCELL -1... 2
RECORD INTERNAL CELL 3063.18 1 REC_INTCELL -1... 4
ACT INTELL.NETWORK TRIGGER PROFILE 2819.30 1 ACT_INTRIG -1... 1
CAN INTELL.NETWORK TRIGGER PROFILE 2821.30 1 CAN_INTRIG -1... 1
CR INTELL.NETWORK TRIGGER PROFILE 2823.35 1 CR_INTRIG -1... 31
DACT INTELL.NETWORK TRIGGER PROFILE 2824.05 1 DACT_INTRIG -1... 1
DISP INTELL.NETWORK TRIGGER PROFILE 2826.35 1 DISP_INTRIG -1... 2
MOD INTELL.NETWORK TRIGGER PROFILE 2828.35 1 MOD_INTRIG -1... 39
TEST INPUT/OUTPUT SYSTEM 1133.00 1 TEST_IO -1... 1
CANCEL INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER 3154.00 1 CAN_IOC -1... 1
CONFIGURE INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER 1100.00 1 CONF_IOC -1... 1
CREATE INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER 3158.00 1 CR_IOC -1... 1
DIAGNOSE INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER 1111.00 1 DIAG_IOC -1... 2
DISPLAY INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER 1119.00 1 DISP_IOC -1... 1
TEST INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER 1132.01 1 TEST_IOC -1... 1
CANCEL INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR 1092.06 1 CAN_IOP -1... 1
CONFIGURE INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR 1091.06 1 CONF_IOP -1... 1
CREATE INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR 1105.10 1 CR_IOP -1... 6
DIAGNOSE INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR 1114.06 1 DIAG_IOP -1... 3
DISPLAY INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR 1120.06 1 DISP_IOP -1... 1
TEST INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR 1134.07 1 TEST_IOP -1... 1
CONFIGURE IOP GROUP 1411.01 1 CONF_IOPG -1... 1
DIAGNOSE IOP GROUP 1410.01 1 DIAG_IOPG -1... 1
TEST IOP GROUP 1409.01 1 TEST_IOPG -1... 1
DUMP IOP MEMORY IMMEDIATE DUMP 3604.00 1 DMP_IOPIMDMP -1... 3
ACTIVATE IOP PERMANENT PATCH 3582.00 1 ACT_IOPPRPCH -1... 1
CANCEL IOP PERMANENT PATCH 3585.00 1 CAN_IOPPRPCH -1... 1
DEACTIVATE IOP PERMANENT PATCH 3583.00 1 DACT_IOPPRPCH -1... 1
DISPLAY IOP PERMANENT PATCH 3586.02 1 DISP_IOPPRPCH -1... 4
ENTER IOP PERMANENT PATCH 3581.00 1 ENTR_IOPPRPCH -1... 4
UPDATE IOP PERMANENT PATCH 3584.00 1 UPD_IOPPRPCH -1... 1
ACTIVATE IOP TRANSIENT PATCH 3588.00 1 ACT_IOPTRPCH -1... 1
CANCEL IOP TRANSIENT PATCH 3590.00 1 CAN_IOPTRPCH -1... 1
DEACTIVATE IOP TRANSIENT PATCH 3589.00 1 DACT_IOPTRPCH -1... 1
DISPLAY IOP TRANSIENT PATCH 3591.02 1 DISP_IOPTRPCH -1... 4
ENTER IOP TRANSIENT PATCH 3587.00 1 ENTR_IOPTRPCH -1... 2
CANCEL AN IP-ADDRESS 3794.00 1 CAN_IPADR -1... 1
CREATE AN IP-ADDRESS 3792.01 1 CR_IPADR -1... 1
DISPLAY IP-ADDRESSES 3795.00 1 DISP_IPADR -1... 1
MODIFY IP-ADDRESS 3793.01 1 MOD_IPADR -1... 2
CANCEL INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT 2845.95 1 CAN_IWE -1... 1
CREATE INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT 2846.30 1 CR_IWE -1... 4
DISPLAY INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT 2847.18 1 DISP_IWE -1... 2
MODIFY INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT 2848.18 1 MOD_IWE -1... 4
RECORD INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT FUNCTION 3064.18 1 REC_IWE -1... 4
DISPLAY STATUS OF INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT 2849.95 1 STAT_IWE -1... 2
Cancel Interworking Point for SS7 1.00 1 CAN_IWPSS7 -1... 1

CONT-11 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

Create Interworking Point for SS7 1.00 1 CR_IWPSS7 -1... 3


Display Interworking Point for SS7 1.00 1 DISP_IWPSS7 -1... 2
Modify Interworking Point for SS7 1.00 1 MOD_IWPSS7 -1... 2
CANCEL JOB 115.00 1 CAN_JOB -1... 1
CONTINUE JOB 116.01 1 CONT_JOB -1... 1
DISPLAY JOB 34.02 1 DISP_JOB -1... 1
STOP JOB 113.00 1 STOP_JOB -1... 1
DISPLAY JOSIT DATA 1904.00 1 DISP_JOSITDAT -1... 1
Display OSI Tracer State MP 1.00 1 DISP_JOSITDATMP -1... 1
CANCEL KEYWORD 818.14 1 CAN_KEYWORD -1... 4
DISPLAY KEYWORD 819.14 1 DISP_KEYWORD -1... 4
ENTER KEYWORD 817.99 1 ENTR_KEYWORD -1... 6
Activate L1 Link Upgrade 1.00 1 ACT_L1LNKUPG -1... 1
CONFIGURE LINK ADAPTION UNIT 1858.00 1 CONF_LAU -1... 1
DIAGNOSE LINK ADAPTION UNIT 1859.00 1 DIAG_LAU -1... 2
TEST LINK ADAPTION UNIT 1862.00 1 TEST_LAU -1... 1
CANCEL LOCATION SERVICES 4244.35 1 CAN_LCS -1... 3
CREATE LOCATION SERVICES 4242.35 1 CR_LCS -1... 4
DISPLAY LOCATION SERVICES 4245.35 1 DISP_LCS -1... 1
MODIFY LOCATION SERVICES 4243.35 1 MOD_LCS -1... 4
Cancel Line Interface Card 1.00 1 CAN_LIC -1... 1
Configure Line Interface Card 1.00 1 CONF_LIC -1... 1
Create Line Interface Card 1.00 1 CR_LIC -1... 3
Diagnose Line Interface Card 1.00 1 DIAG_LIC -1... 1
Display Line Interface Card 1.00 1 DISP_LIC -1... 1
Modify Line Interface Card 1.00 1 MOD_LIC -1... 2
Recover Line Interface Card 1.00 1 RECOV_LIC -1... 1
STAT Line Interface Card 1.00 1 STAT_LIC -1... 1
Cancel LIC Port of Type DS1 1.00 1 CAN_LICPRTDS1 -1... 1
Create LIC Port of Type DS1 1.00 1 CR_LICPRTDS1 -1... 3
Display LIC Port of Type DS1 1.00 1 DISP_LICPRTDS1 -1... 2
Modify LIC Port of Type DS1 1.00 1 MOD_LICPRTDS1 -1... 3
Cancel LIC Port of Type E1 1.00 1 CAN_LICPRTE1 -1... 1
Create LIC Port of Type E1 1.00 1 CR_LICPRTE1 -1... 3
Display LIC Port of Type E1 1.00 1 DISP_LICPRTE1 -1... 2
Modify LIC Port of Type E1 1.00 1 MOD_LICPRTE1 -1... 2
Cancel Line Interface Card Red. Group 1.00 1 CAN_LICREDG -1... 1
Create Line Interface Card Red. Group 1.00 1 CR_LICREDG -1... 1
Display Line Interface Card Red. Group 1.00 1 DISP_LICREDG -1... 1
DISPLAY ENHANCED STATUS OF SUB AND PBXLN 2983.06 1 STAT_LINE -1... 4
DISPLAY LINE DATA 3712.14 1 DISP_LINEDATA -1... 5
DISP LINE THRESHOLDS 1888.00 1 DISP_LINETHR -1... 1
ENTER LINE THRESHOLDS 2547.00 1 ENTR_LINETHR -1... 1
DISPLAY LISTENER TO ANNOUNCEMENT 843.01 1 DISP_LISTTOAN -1... 1
CANCEL LINE MAINTENANCE BLOCKING 2557.15 1 CAN_LMBLK -1... 8
ENTER LINE MAINTENANCE BLOCKING 2558.15 1 ENTR_LMBLK -1... 8
DISPLAY LOCATION MARK NUMBER 2610.94 1 DISP_LMN -1... 1
MODIFY LOCATION MARK NUMBER 1955.94 1 MOD_LMN -1... 2
DISPLAY LINE LOCKOUT 359.15 1 DISP_LNLCKOUT -1... 3
CANCEL LOCAL NUMBER PORTABILITY DATA 3865.00 1 CAN_LNPDAT -1... 1
DISPLAY LOCAL NUMBER PORTABILITY DATA 3866.00 1 DISP_LNPDAT -1... 1
ENTER LOCAL NUMBER PORTABILITY DATA 3867.00 1 ENTR_LNPDAT -1... 1
MODIFY LOCAL NUMBER PORTABILITY DATA 3868.00 1 MOD_LNPDAT -1... 1
CANCEL LNP TRIGGER CODE POINT 3893.49 1 CAN_LNPTCPT -1... 1
CREATE LNP TRIGGER CODE POINT 3891.49 1 CR_LNPTCPT -1... 2
DISPLAY LNP TRIGGER CODE POINT 3894.49 1 DISP_LNPTCPT -1... 1
MODIFY LNP TRIGGER CODE POINT 3892.49 1 MOD_LNPTCPT -1... 1
ACTIVATE LNP TRIGGER PROFILE 3887.49 1 ACT_LNPTPROF -1... 1
CANCEL LNP TRIGGER PROFILE 3889.49 1 CAN_LNPTPROF -1... 1
CREATE LNP TRIGGER PROFILE 3885.52 1 CR_LNPTPROF -1... 2
DEACTIVATE LNP TRIGGER PROFILE 3888.49 1 DACT_LNPTPROF -1... 1
DISPLAY LNP TRIGGER PROFILE 3890.52 1 DISP_LNPTPROF -1... 2
MODIFY LNP TRIGGER PROFILE 3886.52 1 MOD_LNPTPROF -1... 3
ACTIVATE LNP TRIGGER TYPE 3882.49 1 ACT_LNPTTYP -1... 2
DEACTIVATE LNP TRIGGER TYPE 3883.49 1 DACT_LNPTTYP -1... 1
DISPLAY STATUS OF LNP TRIGGER TYPE 3884.49 1 DISP_LNPTTYP -1... 1
Install New LoadType on PCP 1.00 1 INST_LOADTYPE -1... 1
RECORD LOCATION AREA 3065.18 1 REC_LOCAREA -1... 4
DISPLAY LOCAL DIALLING FORMAT 1034.00 1 DISP_LOCDIAL -1... 1
ENTER LOCAL DIALLING FORMAT 1033.00 1 ENTR_LOCDIAL -1... 1
CANCEL LOCKING RESTRICTION 3080.00 1 CAN_LOCKRST -1... 1
DISPLAY LOCKING RESTRICTION 3082.00 1 DISP_LOCKRST -1... 1
ENTER LOCKING RESTRICTION 3085.00 1 ENTR_LOCKRST -1... 1
RESET LOG FUNCTION 1920.00 1 RSET_LOG -1... 1

CONT-12 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

SET LOG FUNCTION 366.03 1 SET_LOG -1... 2


DISPLAY STATUS OF LOG 368.00 1 STAT_LOG -1... 1
DISPLAY LOG ATTRIBUTES 741.00 1 DISP_LOGATT -1... 1
CANCEL LOGGING EVENTS 3081.01 1 CAN_LOGEVENT -1... 1
DISPLAY LOGGING EVENT 3083.00 1 DISP_LOGEVENT -1... 1
ENTER LOGGING EVENTS 3086.01 1 ENTR_LOGEVENT -1... 1
COPY LOG FILE 2688.02 1 COPY_LOGFILE -1... 2
MODIFY LOG FILE 1919.01 1 MOD_LOGFILE -1... 3
CANCEL LOGGING-RESTRICTION OBJECT 3088.00 1 CAN_LOGOBJ -1... 1
DISPLAY LOGGING-RESTRICTION OBJECT 3089.00 1 DISP_LOGOBJ -1... 1
ENTER LOGGING-RESTRICTION OBJECT 3090.00 1 ENTR_LOGOBJ -1... 2
LOOPBACK TEST OF ISDN BA SUBSCRIBER 1228.07 1 TEST_LOOPBA -1... 4
CANCEL LRN FOR NUMBER PORTABILITY 3917.00 1 CAN_LRNNP -1... 1
CREATE LRN FOR NUMBER PORTABILITY 3916.00 1 CR_LRNNP -1... 1
DISPLAY LRN FOR NUMBER PORTABILITY 3918.00 1 DISP_LRNNP -1... 1
CANCEL LTG 181.73 1 CAN_LTG -1... 1
CONFIGURE LINE TRUNK GROUP 929.17 1 CONF_LTG -1... 2
CREATE LINE TRUNK GROUP 163.93 1 CR_LTG -1... 1
DIAGNOSE LTG 980.03 1 DIAG_LTG -1... 1
DISPLAY LTG 175.73 1 DISP_LTG -1... 1
MODIFY LINE TRUNK GROUP 182.91 1 MOD_LTG -1... 1
RECORD LINE TRUNK GROUP 275.30 1 REC_LTG -1... 5
DISPLAY STATE OF LTG 917.17 1 STAT_LTG -1... 1
ALLOW LTG FAULT REPORT 922.17 1 ALLOW_LTGFRPT -1... 1
DUMP LTG MEMORY IMMEDIATE DUMP 3603.01 1 DMP_LTGIMDMP -1... 3
ACTIVATE LTG PERMANENT PATCH 3571.01 1 ACT_LTGPRPCH -1... 1
CANCEL LTG PERMANENT PATCH 3574.00 1 CAN_LTGPRPCH -1... 1
DEACTIVATE LTG PERMANENT PATCH 3572.01 1 DACT_LTGPRPCH -1... 1
DISPLAY LTG PERMANENT PATCH 3575.03 1 DISP_LTGPRPCH -1... 4
ENTER LTG PERMANENT PATCH 3570.00 1 ENTR_LTGPRPCH -1... 4
UPDATE LTG PERMANENT PATCH 3573.00 1 UPD_LTGPRPCH -1... 1
DISPLAY LTG RESOURCES 2947.03 1 DISP_LTGRES -1... 1
ACTIVATE LTG TRANSIENT PATCH 3577.01 1 ACT_LTGTRPCH -1... 1
CANCEL LTG TRANSIENT PATCH 3579.01 1 CAN_LTGTRPCH -1... 1
DEACTIVATE LTG TRANSIENT PATCH 3578.01 1 DACT_LTGTRPCH -1... 1
DISPLAY LTG TRANSIENT PATCH 3580.03 1 DISP_LTGTRPCH -1... 4
ENTER LTG TRANSIENT PATCH 3576.01 1 ENTR_LTGTRPCH -1... 2
CANCEL LINE TRUNK UNIT 184.77 1 CAN_LTU -1... 1
CREATE LINE TRUNK UNIT 164.97 1 CR_LTU -1... 5
DISPLAY LINE TRUNK UNIT 199.73 1 DISP_LTU -1... 1
EXTEND LINE TRUNK UNIT 195.81 1 EXT_LTU -1... 2
REDUCE LINE TRUNK UNIT 196.81 1 RED_LTU -1... 2
ACTIVATE MOBILE A-INTERFACE TRACER 3381.00 1 ACT_MATRAC -1... 7
DEACTIVATE A-INTERFACE TRACER 3382.00 1 DACT_MATRAC -1... 1
DISPLAY A-INTERFACE TRACER STATUS 3383.00 1 DISP_MATRAC -1... 1
CONFIGURE MB 923.60 1 CONF_MB -1... 1
DIAGNOSE MESSAGE BUFFER 977.00 1 DIAG_MB -1... 1
DISPLAY MESSAGE BUFFER 330.00 1 DISP_MB -1... 1
MODIFY MESSAGE BUFFER 3929.00 1 MOD_MB -1... 2
DISPLAY STATUS OF MESSAGE BUFFER 919.10 1 STAT_MB -1... 1
CONFIGURE MB ATM INTERFACE 3880.00 1 CONF_MBIA -1... 2
DIAGNOSE MESSAGE BUFFER ATM INTERFACE 3879.00 1 DIAG_MBIA -1... 1
CONFIGURE MB HDLC INTERFACE 3881.00 1 CONF_MBIH -1... 2
DIAGNOSE MESSAGE BUFFER HDLC INTERFACE 3878.00 1 DIAG_MBIH -1... 1
CONFIGURE MB UNIT LTG 924.60 1 CONF_MBUL -1... 1
DIAGNOSE MB UNIT FOR LINE TRUNK GROUP 978.00 1 DIAG_MBUL -1... 1
CONFIGURE MB UNIT SPACE GROUP CONTROL 925.60 1 CONF_MBUS -1... 2
DIAGNOSE UNIT SWITCH GROUP CONTROL 979.00 1 DIAG_MBUS -1... 1
DISPLAY MOBILE CALL RECORDS 2329.95 1 DISP_MCR -1... 4
CONFIGURE MID CALL TRIGGER RECEIVERS 3807.10 1 CONF_MCT -1... 1
DIAGNOSE MID CALL TRIGGER RECEIVERS 3809.08 1 DIAG_MCT -1... 1
DISP. STATUS MID CALL TRIGGER RECEIVERS 3808.08 1 STAT_MCT -1... 1
DISPLAY MAGNETIC DISK 961.01 1 DISP_MD -1... 1
INITIALIZE MAGNETIC DISK 962.01 1 INIT_MD -1... 1
CONFIGURE MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE 1093.01 1 CONF_MDD -1... 1
DIAGNOSE MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE 1115.01 1 DIAG_MDD -1... 3
TEST MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE 1137.01 1 TEST_MDD -1... 1
CONTINUE MDD-ACTIVATION 1203.00 1 CONT_MDDACT -1... 1
STOP ACTIVATION OF DISC 1215.00 1 STOP_MDDACT -1... 1
ACTIVATE MDD AUDIT 2984.00 1 ACT_MDDAUDIT -1... 1
DEACTIVATE MDD AUDIT 2985.00 1 DACT_MDDAUDIT -1... 1
DISPLAY MDD AUDIT ATTRIBUTES 2988.00 1 DISP_MDDAUDIT -1... 1
MODIFY DATA FOR ROUTINE MDD AUDIT 2992.00 1 MOD_MDDAUDIT -1... 1
Configure Magnetic Disk Device MP 1.00 1 CONF_MDDMP -1... 1

CONT-13 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

Diagnose Magnetic Disk Device MP 1.00 1 DIAG_MDDMP -1... 1


Display Magnetic Disk Device MP 1.00 1 DISP_MDDMP -1... 1
Modify Magnetic Disk Device MP 1.00 1 MOD_MDDMP -1... 2
STAT Magnetic Disk Device MP 1.00 1 STAT_MDDMP -1... 1
CANCEL MODEM TONE GENERATOR 3682.01 1 CAN_MDTOG -1... 1
CONFIGURE MODEM TONE GENERATOR 3612.10 1 CONF_MDTOG -1... 1
CREATE MODEM TONE GENERATOR 3681.01 1 CR_MDTOG -1... 1
DIAGNOSE MODEM TONE GENERATOR 3614.08 1 DIAG_MDTOG -1... 1
DISPLAY MODEM TONE GENERATOR 3683.01 1 DISP_MDTOG -1... 1
DISPLAY STATUS OF MODEM TONE GENERATOR 3613.08 1 STAT_MDTOG -1... 1
Display Managed Element 1.00 1 DISP_ME -1... 1
DISPLAY CHARGE METERS 112.78 1 DISP_MET -1... 4
EDIT CHARGE METER 517.77 1 EDIT_MET -1... 9
REGENERATE CHARGE METER 518.03 1 REG_MET -1... 1
SAVE CHARGE METER 68.76 1 SAVE_MET -1... 2
DISPLAY METER ADMINISTRATION DATA 360.03 1 DISP_METADM -1... 1
ENTER METER ADMINISTRATION DATA 1010.10 1 ENTR_METADM -1... 4
DISPLAY METER SAVE TIMES 69.01 1 DISP_METSAV -1... 1
ENTER METER SAVE TIMES 601.01 1 ENTR_METSAV -1... 1
Activate Measurement Upgrade 1.00 1 ACT_MEUPG -1... 1
CANCEL MOBILE LOCATION CENTER 4186.39 1 CAN_MLC -1... 1
CREATE MOBILE LOCATION CENTER 4184.39 1 CR_MLC -1... 1
DISPLAY MOBILE LOCATION CENTER 4187.39 1 DISP_MLC -1... 1
MODIFY MOBILE LOCATION CENTER 4185.39 1 MOD_MLC -1... 1
CANCEL MOBILE LOCATION CENTER AREA 4182.39 1 CAN_MLCAREA -1... 2
DISPLAY MOBILE LOCATION CENTER AREA 4183.39 1 DISP_MLCAREA -1... 3
ENTER MOBILE LOCATION CENTER AREA 4181.39 1 ENTR_MLCAREA -1... 1
CANCEL MOBILE NATION. ROAMING AGREEMENT 3039.00 1 CAN_MNATROAG -1... 2
CREATE MOBILE NATION. ROAMING AGREEMENT 3040.00 1 CR_MNATROAG -1... 2
DISPLAY MOBILE NATION. ROAMING AGREEMENT 3041.00 1 DISP_MNATROAG -1... 2
DISPLAY MAGNETO OPTICAL DISK 2331.00 1 DISP_MO -1... 1
INITIALIZE MAGNETO OPTICAL DISK 2332.00 1 INIT_MO -1... 2
MOUNT MAGNETO OPTICAL DISK 2330.00 1 MOUNT_MO -1... 2
RESET MAGNETO OPTICAL DISK 2333.00 1 RSET_MO -1... 1
DISPLAY MOBILE IN THRESHOLD 3948.35 1 DISP_MOBINTHR -1... 1
ACTIVATE METER OBSERVATION 71.76 1 ACT_MOBS -1... 3
CANCEL METER OBSERVATION 72.75 1 CAN_MOBS -1... 3
DISPLAY METER OBSERVATION 110.75 1 DISP_MOBS -1... 2
SELECT METER OBSERVATION 858.73 1 SEL_MOBS -1... 1
DISPLAY METER OBSERVATION DATA 993.06 1 DISP_MOBSDAT -1... 4
DISPLAY MOBILE THRESHOLD 2296.35 1 DISP_MOBTHR -1... 1
MODIFY MOBILE THRESHOLD 2295.35 1 MOD_MOBTHR -1... 2
CANCEL MAGNETO OPTICAL DISK DEVICE 2356.00 1 CAN_MOD -1... 1
CONFIGURE MAGNETO OPTICAL DISK DEVICE 2357.00 1 CONF_MOD -1... 1
CREATE MAGNETO OPTICAL DISK DEVICE 2358.00 1 CR_MOD -1... 1
DIAGNOSE MAGNETO OPTICAL DISK DEVICE 2359.00 1 DIAG_MOD -1... 2
DISPLAY MAGNETO OPTICAL DISK DEVICE 2360.00 1 DISP_MOD -1... 1
TEST MAGNETO OPTICAL DISK DEVICE 2361.00 1 TEST_MOD -1... 1
DUMP MODULE MEMORY IMMEDIATE DUMP 4137.00 1 DMP_MODIMDMP -1... 2
Cancel Magneto Optical Disk Device MP 1.00 1 CAN_MODMP -1... 1
Configure Magneto Optical Disk Device MP 1.00 1 CONF_MODMP -1... 1
Create Magneto Optical Disk Device MP 1.00 1 CR_MODMP -1... 1
Diagnose Magneto Optical Disk MP 1.00 1 DIAG_MODMP -1... 1
Display Magneto Optical Disk Device MP 1.00 1 DISP_MODMP -1... 1
Modify Magneto Optical Disk MP 1.00 1 MOD_MODMP -1... 2
STAT Magneto Optical Disk MP 1.00 1 STAT_MODMP -1... 1
Cancel Main Processor 1.00 1 CAN_MP -1... 1
Configure Main Processor 1.00 1 CONF_MP -1... 1
Create Main Processor 1.00 1 CR_MP -1... 5
Diagnose Main Processor 1.00 1 DIAG_MP -1... 1
Display Main Processor 1.00 1 DISP_MP -1... 1
Modify Main Processor 1.00 1 MOD_MP -1... 3
Recover Main Processor 1.00 1 RECOV_MP -1... 1
Display Status of Main Processor 1.00 1 STAT_MP -1... 1
Cancel MP Event Dump 1.00 1 CAN_MPEVDMP -1... 1
Display MP Event Dump 1.00 1 DISP_MPEVDMP -1... 1
Dump MP Event Dump 1.00 1 DMP_MPEVDMP -1... 1
Enter MP Event Dump 1.00 1 ENTR_MPEVDMP -1... 3
Dump MP Memory Immediate Dump 1.00 1 DMP_MPIMDMP -1... 2
Cancel MP Load Measurement Logfile 1.00 1 CAN_MPLDLOG -1... 1
Create MP Load Measurement Logfile 1.00 1 CR_MPLDLOG -1... 1
Display MP Load Measurement Logfile Info 1.00 1 DISP_MPLDLOG -1... 1
Cancel MP Load Measurement 1.00 1 CAN_MPLDME -1... 1
Create MP Load Measurement 1.00 1 CR_MPLDME -1... 1

CONT-14 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

Display MP Load Measurement 1.00 1 DISP_MPLDME -1... 1


Cancel MP Load Measurement Reporting 1.00 1 CAN_MPLDRPT -1... 1
Create MP Load Measurement Reporting 1.00 1 CR_MPLDRPT -1... 1
Display MP Load Measurement Reporting 1.00 1 DISP_MPLDRPT -1... 1
Modify MP Load Measurement Reporting 1.00 1 MOD_MPLDRPT -1... 1
Activate MP Permanent Patch 1.00 1 ACT_MPPRPCH -1... 1
Cancel MP Permanent Patch 1.00 1 CAN_MPPRPCH -1... 1
Deactivate MP Permanent Patch 1.00 1 DACT_MPPRPCH -1... 1
Display MP Permanent Patch 1.00 1 DISP_MPPRPCH -1... 2
Enter MP Permanent Patch 1.00 1 ENTR_MPPRPCH -1... 3
Update MP Permanent Patch 1.00 1 UPD_MPPRPCH -1... 1
DISPLAY MOBILE PROJECT DESCRIPTION DATA 3406.96 1 DISP_MPRDDAT -1... 1
ENTER MOBILE PROJECT DESCRIPTION DATA 3396.35 1 ENTR_MPRDDAT -1... 17
Activate MP Transient Patch 1.00 1 ACT_MPTRPCH -1... 1
Cancel MP Transient Patch 1.00 1 CAN_MPTRPCH -1... 1
Deactivate MP Transient Patch 1.00 1 DACT_MPTRPCH -1... 1
Display MP Transient Patch 1.00 1 DISP_MPTRPCH -1... 2
Enter MP Transient Patch 1.00 1 ENTR_MPTRPCH -1... 2
Activate MTP Route Verification Test 1.00 1 ACT_MRVT -1... 3
Cancel MTP Route Verification Test 1.00 1 CAN_MRVT -1... 1
Create MTP Route Verification Test 1.00 1 CR_MRVT -1... 1
Display MTP Route Verification Test 1.00 1 DISP_MRVT -1... 3
Modify MTP Route Verification Test State 1.00 1 MOD_MRVTST -1... 1
RECORD MOBILE SWITCHING CENTRE DATA 1929.18 1 REC_MSC -1... 4
DISPLAY MOBILE SECURITY HANDLING 3411.01 1 DISP_MSECHAND -1... 1
MODIFY MOBILE SECURITY HANDLING 3412.18 1 MOD_MSECHAND -1... 3
DISPLAY MOBILE SERVICE OPTIONS 3009.35 1 DISP_MSERVOPT -1... 11
MODIFY MOBILE SERVICE OPTIONS 3010.35 1 MOD_MSERVOPT -1... 15
SELECT MESSAGE 1533.02 1 SEL_MSG -1... 1
DISPLAY MESSAGE LINK 1527.01 1 DISP_MSGLNK -1... 2
RESET MESSAGE LINK 1526.02 1 RSET_MSGLNK -1... 2
SET MESSAGE LINK 1525.03 1 SET_MSGLNK -1... 2
CANCEL MESSAGE GROUP 1531.02 1 CAN_MSGRP -1... 1
CREATE MESSAGE GROUP 1530.03 1 CR_MSGRP -1... 2
SELECT MESSAGE GROUP 1532.02 1 SEL_MSGRP -1... 1
DISPLAY MESSAGE GROUP LINK 1529.01 1 DISP_MSGRPLNK -1... 1
SET MESSAGE GROUP LINK 1537.05 1 SET_MSGRPLNK -1... 2
CAN MOBILE STATION ROUTING NUMBER BLOCK 1963.94 1 CAN_MSRNB -1... 1
CR MOBILE STATION ROUTING NUMBER BLOCK 1976.35 1 CR_MSRNB -1... 4
DISP MOBILE STATION ROUTING NUMBER BLOCK 2648.94 1 DISP_MSRNB -1... 1
MOD MOBILE STATION ROUTING NUMBER BLOCK 2003.35 1 MOD_MSRNB -1... 6
CANCEL MOBILE SUBSCRIBER 1371.35 1 CAN_MSUB -1... 9
CREATE MOBILE SUBSCRIBER 1369.35 1 CR_MSUB -1... 19
DISPLAY MOBILE SUBSCRIBER 1372.35 1 DISP_MSUB -1... 10
MODIFY MOBILE SUBSCRIBER 1370.35 1 MOD_MSUB -1... 16
DISPLAY MOBILE SUBSCRIBER DATABASE SIZE 2971.94 1 DISP_MSUBDBSZ -1... 1
CANCEL SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 3562.00 1 CAN_MSUBFT -1... 1
ENTER SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 3561.00 1 ENTR_MSUBFT -1... 1
CANCEL LINKAGE FOR MOBILE SUBSCRIBER 2966.17 1 CAN_MSUBLINK -1... 1
CREATE LINKAGE FOR MOBILE SUBSCRIBER 2968.35 1 CR_MSUBLINK -1... 1
DISPLAY LINKAGE OF MOBILE SUBSCRIBERS 2972.94 1 DISP_MSUBLINK -1... 1
DISPLAY MAGNETIC TAPE 965.01 1 DISP_MT -1... 1
INITIALIZE MAGNETIC TAPE 964.01 1 INIT_MT -1... 2
REWIND MAGNETIC TAPE 963.01 1 REWIND_MT -1... 1
CANCEL MOBILE TARIFF 3017.00 1 CAN_MTAR -1... 1
DISPLAY MOBILE TARIFF 3020.00 1 DISP_MTAR -1... 1
ENTER MOBILE TARIFF 3035.00 1 ENTR_MTAR -1... 2
MODIFY MOBILE TARIFF 3038.00 1 MOD_MTAR -1... 2
CANCEL MOBILE TARIFF CATEGORY 3018.00 1 CAN_MTARCAT -1... 1
DISPLAY MOBILE TARIFF CATEGORY 3021.00 1 DISP_MTARCAT -1... 1
CREATE MOBILE TARIFF CATEGORY 3036.01 1 ENTR_MTARCAT -1... 1
MODIFY MOBILE TARIFF CATEGORY 3022.01 1 MOD_MTARCAT -1... 2
CANCEL MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE 1096.01 1 CAN_MTD -1... 1
CONFIGURE MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE 1095.00 1 CONF_MTD -1... 1
CREATE MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE 1107.03 1 CR_MTD -1... 2
DIAGNOSE MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE 1116.00 1 DIAG_MTD -1... 2
DISPLAY MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE 2362.00 1 DISP_MTD -1... 1
TEST MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE 1136.01 1 TEST_MTD -1... 1
Cancel MTP Account. and Verific. 1.00 1 CAN_MTPAV -1... 1
Create MTP Account. and Verific. 1.00 1 CR_MTPAV -1... 3
Display MTP Account. and Verific. 1.00 1 DISP_MTPAV -1... 3
Modify MTP Account. and Verific. 1.00 1 MOD_MTPAV -1... 3
Cancel MTP Level 2 Protocol Profile 1.00 1 CAN_MTPL2PF -1... 1
Create MTP Level 2 Protocol Profile 1.00 1 CR_MTPL2PF -1... 7

CONT-15 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

Display MTP Level 2 Protocol Profile 1.00 1 DISP_MTPL2PF -1... 7


Display MTP Logical Numbers 1.00 1 DISP_MTPLOGNU -1... 1
Cancel MTP Scheduling 1.00 1 CAN_MTPSCHD -1... 1
Create MTP Scheduling 1.00 1 CR_MTPSCHD -1... 2
Display MTP Scheduling 1.00 1 DISP_MTPSCHD -1... 1
Modify MTP Scheduling 1.00 1 MOD_MTPSCHD -1... 2
CANCEL MOBILE TRAFFIC BLOCKING DATA 3769.39 1 CAN_MTRABL -1... 3
DISPLAY MOBILE TRAFFIC BLOCKING DATA 3770.17 1 DISP_MTRABL -1... 2
ENTER MOBILE TRAFFIC BLOCKING DATA 3768.39 1 ENTR_MTRABL -1... 4
ACTIVATE MOBILE TRAFFIC DATA COLLECTION 2475.18 1 ACT_MTRDCOL -1... 2
DEACTIVATE MOBILE TR. DATA COLLECTION 2476.18 1 DACT_MTRDCOL -1... 1
DISPLAY MOBILE TRAFFIC DATA COLLECTION 2477.18 1 DISP_MTRDCOL -1... 1
DISPLAY MOBILE TRAF. FILE CHARACTERISTIC 1367.18 1 DISP_MUSFICH -1... 2
ACTIVATE MOBILE USER MONITORING FUNCTION 3068.39 1 ACT_MUSMON -1... 2
CANCEL MOBILE USER MONITORING FUNCTION 2457.39 1 CAN_MUSMON -1... 1
DEACTIVATE MOBILE USER MONITOR FUNCTION 3070.39 1 DACT_MUSMON -1... 1
DISPLAY MOBILE USER MONITOR FUNCTION 3071.39 1 DISP_MUSMON -1... 1
ENTER MOBILE USER MONITORING FUNCTION 2456.39 1 ENTR_MUSMON -1... 2
DISPLAY MOBILE TRAFFIC MEASUREM. ORDERS 1366.50 1 DISP_MUSMORD -1... 1
CANCEL MAP ENTITY VERSION NEGOT. TABLE 4050.35 1 CAN_MVNENT -1... 1
DISPLAY MAP ENTITY VERSION NEGOT. TABLE 4048.35 1 DISP_MVNENT -1... 1
ENTER MAP ENTITY VERSION NEGOT. TABLE 4049.35 1 ENTR_MVNENT -1... 13
MODIFY MAP ENTITY VERSION NEGOT. TABLE 4264.00 1 MOD_MVNENT -1... 14
DISPLAY MAP VERSION NEGOTIATION TABLE 3945.35 1 DISP_MVNGENR -1... 1
MODIFY MAP VERSION NEGOTIATION TABLE 3944.35 1 MOD_MVNGENR -1... 2
CANCEL MOBILE ZONE 3044.94 1 CAN_MZONE -1... 1
CREATE MOBILE ZONE 3045.94 1 CR_MZONE -1... 2
DISPLAY MOBILE ZONE 3047.94 1 DISP_MZONE -1... 1
MODIFY MOBILE ZONE 3046.94 1 MOD_MZONE -1... 3
CANCEL MOBILE ZONE POINT 3275.16 1 CAN_MZOPT -1... 1
CREATE MOBILE ZONE POINT 3276.72 1 CR_MZOPT -1... 9
DISPLAY MOBILE ZONE POINT 3277.39 1 DISP_MZOPT -1... 6
MODIFY MOBILE ZONE POINT 3278.72 1 MOD_MZOPT -1... 10
DISPLAY NETWORK TIMER 2973.35 1 DISP_NETTIMER -1... 3
MODIFY NETWORK TIMER 2979.35 1 MOD_NETTIMER -1... 10
CANCEL NETWORK MANAGEMENT CONTROL 1909.05 1 CAN_NMCNTL -1... 1
DISPLAY NETWORK MANAGEMENT CONTROL DATA 376.93 1 DISP_NMCNTL -1... 1
ENTER NETWORK MANAGEMENT CONTROLS 325.97 1 ENTR_NMCNTL -1... 3
ACT NETWORK TRAFFIC MANAGEMENT INFO. 2806.02 1 ACT_NTMINFO -1... 1
CAN NETWORK TRAFFIC MANAGEMENT INFO. 2807.02 1 CAN_NTMINFO -1... 1
CR NETWORK TRAFFIC MANAGEMENT INFO 2808.03 1 CR_NTMINFO -1... 4
DACT NETWORK TRAFFIC MANAGEMENT INFO. 2809.01 1 DACT_NTMINFO -1... 1
DISP NETWORK TRAFFIC MANAGEMENT INFO. 2810.13 1 DISP_NTMINFO -1... 7
ENTER NETWORK TRAFFIC MANAGEMENT INFO. 2811.13 1 ENTR_NTMINFO -1... 4
MOD NETWORK TRAFFIC MANAGEMENT INFO 2812.07 1 MOD_NTMINFO -1... 2
ACTIVATE NAILED-UP CONNECTION 838.04 1 ACT_NUC -1... 4
CANCEL NAILED-UP CONNECTION 839.02 1 CAN_NUC -1... 1
CREATE NAILED-UP CONNECTION 837.16 1 CR_NUC -1... 10
DEACTIVATE NAILED-UP CONNECTION 1872.03 1 DACT_NUC -1... 3
DISPLAY NAILED-UP CONNECTION 840.13 1 DISP_NUC -1... 6
MODIFY NAILED-UP CONNECTION 841.13 1 MOD_NUC -1... 8
CONFIGURE OPERATOR CONTR. ANNOUNC. EQU. 1811.20 1 CONF_OCANEQ -1... 1
DIAGNOSE OPERATOR CONTR. ANNOUNCEM. EQU. 1825.10 1 DIAG_OCANEQ -1... 1
DISP OPERATOR CONTR. ANNOUNC. EQU. 3616.03 1 DISP_OCANEQ -1... 3
STATUS OF OPERATOR CONTR. ANNOUNC. EQU. 1826.29 1 STAT_OCANEQ -1... 1
CANCEL OCANEQ VARIANT 3050.05 1 CAN_OCAVAR -1... 1
DISPLAY OCANEQ VARIANT 2892.04 1 DISP_OCAVAR -1... 1
ENTER OCANEQ VARIANT 2894.04 1 ENTR_OCAVAR -1... 1
ACTIVATE OCT LOADER 3789.01 1 ACT_OCTLOAD -1... 3
DEACTIVATE OCT LOADER 3791.01 1 DACT_OCTLOAD -1... 2
DISPLAY OCT LOADER 3790.01 1 DISP_OCTLOAD -1... 2
ACTIVATE ODR 3671.02 1 ACT_ODR -1... 1
CANCEL ODR 3670.00 1 CAN_ODR -1... 1
CREATE ODR 3667.00 1 CR_ODR -1... 1
DEACTIVATE ODR 3672.00 1 DACT_ODR -1... 1
DISPLAY ODR 3669.01 1 DISP_ODR -1... 1
MODIFY ODR 3668.00 1 MOD_ODR -1... 2
START O&M PROCESSES 278.10 1 START_OM -1... 1
CANCEL O&M TERMINAL 1363.03 1 CAN_OMT -1... 1
CONFIGURE O&M TERMINAL 1362.02 1 CONF_OMT -1... 1
CREATE O&M TERMINAL 1361.04 1 CR_OMT -1... 1
DIAGNOSE O&M TERMINAL 1360.01 1 DIAG_OMT -1... 2
DISPLAY O&M TERMINAL 3032.02 1 DISP_OMT -1... 1
MODIFY O&M TERMINAL 3034.01 1 MOD_OMT -1... 2

CONT-16 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

TEST O&M TERMINAL 1359.02 1 TEST_OMT -1... 1


CANCEL OPERATOR SERVICE DATA 2156.35 1 CAN_OPRSERV -1... 4
ENTER OPERATOR SERVICE DATA 2155.35 1 ENTR_OPRSERV -1... 7
CANCEL ORIGINATION DATA 2374.15 1 CAN_ORIGDAT -1... 2
CREATE ORIGINATION DATA 2373.15 1 CR_ORIGDAT -1... 4
DISPLAY ORIGINATION DATA 2376.15 1 DISP_ORIGDAT -1... 4
MODIFY ORIGINATION DATA 2375.14 1 MOD_ORIGDAT -1... 1
Display all OS Events from MP 1.00 1 DISP_OSEV -1... 1
CANCEL OSI ADDRESSES 1863.00 1 CAN_OSIADR -1... 1
CREATE OSI ADDRESSES 1864.04 1 CR_OSIADR -1... 2
DISPLAY OSI ADDRESSES 1857.00 1 DISP_OSIADR -1... 1
MODIFY OSI ADDRESSES 1865.04 1 MOD_OSIADR -1... 3
DISPLAY OSITIMER 3797.00 1 DISP_OSITIMER -1... 1
ENTER OSITIMER 3796.00 1 ENTR_OSITIMER -1... 2
ACTIVATE OSI TRACER 1903.05 1 ACT_OSITRAC -1... 7
DISPLAY OSI TRACE DATA 1905.02 1 DISP_OSITRAC -1... 1
DUMP OSI TRACE DATA 1906.05 1 DMP_OSITRAC -1... 3
Cancel OSI Tracer Log 1.00 1 CAN_OSITRACLOG -1... 1
Activate OSI Tracer MP 1.00 1 ACT_OSITRACMP -1... 2
Deactivate OSI Tracer MP 1.00 1 DACT_OSITRACMP -1... 1
Dump OSI Tracer Data MP to File 1.00 1 DMP_OSITRACMPF -1... 2
Display OS and LMDH Resources from MP 1.00 1 DISP_OSLMRES -1... 2
DISPLAY OS RESOURCE DATA 3627.00 1 DISP_OSRES -1... 2
ACTIVATE OUTPUT DIVERSION 949.00 1 ACT_OUTDIV -1... 2
DEACTIVATE OUTPUT DIVERSION 950.00 1 DEC_OUTDIV -1... 1
ACTIVATE OUTPUT SUPPRESSION 1535.00 1 ACT_OUTSUP -1... 1
DEACTIVATE OUTPUT SUPPRESSION 1721.02 1 DACT_OUTSUP -1... 1
DISPLAY OUTPUT SUPPRESSION 1536.00 1 DISP_OUTSUP -1... 1
DISPLAY OVERLOAD 400.22 1 DISP_OVLD -1... 1
CANCEL PRIMARY RATE ACCESS 2720.00 1 CAN_PA -1... 1
CREATE PRIMARY RATE ACCESS 2719.00 1 CR_PA -1... 1
DISPLAY PRIMARY RATE ACCESS 2722.00 1 DISP_PA -1... 1
TEST PRIMARY RATE ACCESS 1708.01 1 TEST_PA -1... 1
DISPLAY PA CHANNEL STATUS 1910.00 1 DISP_PACHSTAT -1... 1
DISPLAY PA FAULT 1869.01 1 DISP_PAFAULT -1... 3
DISPLAY PA LINK STATISTICS 1777.00 1 DISP_PASTAT -1... 1
Cancel Profibus Device 1.00 1 CAN_PBUSDEV -1... 1
Create Profibus Device 1.00 1 CR_PBUSDEV -1... 1
Display Profibus Device 1.00 1 DISP_PBUSDEV -1... 1
Modify Profibus Device 1.00 1 MOD_PBUSDEV -1... 1
CANCEL PBX 105.85 1 CAN_PBX -1... 2
CREATE PBX 104.99 1 CR_PBX -1...193
DISPLAY PBX 170.99 1 DISP_PBX -1... 14
MODIFY PBX 551.99 1 MOD_PBX -1...229
RECORD PBX 342.39 1 REC_PBX -1... 12
CANCEL PBX DDI NUMBER 3999.02 1 CAN_PBXDDINO -1... 2
DISPLAY PBX DDI NUMBER 3998.02 1 DISP_PBXDDINO -1... 1
ENTER PBX DDI NUMBER 3997.02 1 ENTR_PBXDDINO -1... 2
CANCEL PBX LINE 77.12 1 CAN_PBXLN -1... 2
CREATE PBX LINE 76.15 1 CR_PBXLN -1...170
DISPLAY PBX LINE 168.24 1 DISP_PBXLN -1... 10
MODIFY PBX LINE 1039.20 1 MOD_PBXLN -1...100
DISPLAY STATUS OF PBX LINE 537.85 1 STAT_PBXLN -1... 4
DISPLAY PCM ALARM COUNTER 695.52 1 DISP_PCMAC -1... 1
Cancel PCP Event Dump 1.00 1 CAN_PCPEVDMP -1... 1
Display PCP Event Dump 1.00 1 DISP_PCPEVDMP -1... 1
Dump PCP Event Dump 1.00 1 DMP_PCPEVDMP -1... 1
Enter PCP Event Dump 1.00 1 ENTR_PCPEVDMP -1... 3
Dump PCP Memory Immediate Dump 1.00 1 DMP_PCPIMDMP -1... 2
Activate PCP Permanent Patch 1.00 1 ACT_PCPPRPCH -1... 1
Cancel PCP Permanent Patch 1.00 1 CAN_PCPPRPCH -1... 1
Deactivate PCP Permanent Patch 1.00 1 DACT_PCPPRPCH -1... 1
Display PCP Permanent Patch 1.00 1 DISP_PCPPRPCH -1... 2
Enter PCP Permanent Patch 1.00 1 ENTR_PCPPRPCH -1... 3
Update PCP Permanent Patch 1.00 1 UPD_PCPPRPCH -1... 1
Activate PCP Trace 1.00 1 ACT_PCPTRC -1... 1
Cancel PCP Trace 1.00 1 CAN_PCPTRC -1... 1
Deactivate PCP Trace 1.00 1 DACT_PCPTRC -1... 1
Display PCP Trace 1.00 1 DISP_PCPTRC -1... 1
Dump PCP Trace 1.00 1 DMP_PCPTRC -1... 1
Enter PCP Trace 1.00 1 ENTR_PCPTRC -1... 1
Activate PCP Transient Patch 1.00 1 ACT_PCPTRPCH -1... 1
Cancel PCP Transient Patch 1.00 1 CAN_PCPTRPCH -1... 1
Deactivate PCP Transient Patch 1.00 1 DACT_PCPTRPCH -1... 1

CONT-17 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

Display PCP Transient Patch 1.00 1 DISP_PCPTRPCH -1... 2


Enter PCP Transient Patch 1.00 1 ENTR_PCPTRPCH -1... 2
DISPLAY PDC CHARACTERISTICS 1900.09 1 DISP_PDCCHR -1... 2
ENTER PDC CHARACTERISTICS 1901.19 1 ENTR_PDCCHR -1... 16
DISPLAY PDC CONTROLS 2608.17 1 DISP_PDCCNTL -1... 2
ENTER PDC CONTROLS 2609.17 1 ENTR_PDCCNTL -1... 8
ACTIVATE PDC FEATURE 1913.00 1 ACT_PDCFEA -1... 1
DEACTIVATE PDC FEATURE 1914.00 1 DACT_PDCFEA -1... 1
DISPLAY PDC FEATURE INFORMATIONS 1915.00 1 DISP_PDCFEA -1... 1
CANCEL PRIMARY DIGITAL CARRIER LINK 3321.06 1 CAN_PDCLNK -1... 1
CREATE PRIMARY DIGITAL CARRIER LINK 3320.06 1 CR_PDCLNK -1... 2
DISPLAY PRIMARY DIGITAL CARRIER LINK 3360.06 1 DISP_PDCLNK -1... 1
DISPLAY PDC PERFORMANCE DATA 1916.14 1 DISP_PDCPERF -1... 6
DISPLAY PDC THRESHOLD CLASS VALUES 2733.08 1 DISP_PDCTHR -1... 1
RESET PDC THRESHOLD CLASS VALUES 2734.00 1 RSET_PDCTHR -1... 1
SET PDC THRESHOLD CLASS VALUES 2736.08 1 SET_PDCTHR -1... 1
Display Pitch 1.00 1 DISP_PITCH -1... 1
CANCEL PUBLIC LAND MOBILE NETWORK TARIFF 3023.00 1 CAN_PLMNTAR -1... 1
DISP PUBLIC LAND MOBILE NETWORK TARIFF 3024.00 1 DISP_PLMNTAR -1... 1
ENTER PUBLIC LAND MOBILE NETWORK TARIFF 3048.00 1 ENTR_PLMNTAR -1... 2
MODIFY PUBLIC LAND MOBILE NETWORK TARIFF 3049.00 1 MOD_PLMNTAR -1... 3
DISPLAY PBX MAINTENANCE CONTROL 1048.11 1 DISP_PMCNTL -1... 1
ENTER PBX MAINTENANCE CONTROLS 1040.11 1 ENTR_PMCNTL -1... 2
CONFIGURE PORT 807.20 1 CONF_PORT -1... 2
DISPLAY PORT 201.75 1 DISP_PORT -1... 2
SELECTIVE DISPLAY OF PORT 600.01 1 SEL_PORT -1... 4
DISPLAY STATUS OF PORT 353.88 1 STAT_PORT -1... 2
ACTIVATE PORT TRACER 2369.15 1 ACT_PORTTRAC -1... 5
DEACTIVATE PORT TRACER 2392.00 1 DACT_PORTTRAC -1... 1
DISPLAY PORT TRACER 2370.00 1 DISP_PORTTRAC -1... 1
DUMP PORT TRACER 2372.00 1 DMP_PORTTRAC -1... 1
CANCEL PROCESSOR 888.02 1 CAN_PRO -1... 1
CREATE PROCESSOR 886.07 1 CR_PRO -1... 2
DISPLAY PROCESSOR 1773.00 1 DISP_PRO -1... 1
MODIFY PROCESSOR 1776.04 1 MOD_PRO -1... 2
START PROCESS 281.10 1 START_PROCESS -1... 1
RESET PROCESSOR CONNECTION 1498.00 1 RSET_PROCON -1... 1
SET PROCESSOR CONNECTION 1497.00 1 SET_PROCON -1... 1
CANCEL PROHIBITED FORWARDED TO NUMBER 3003.96 1 CAN_PROHFTNO -1... 1
CREATE PROHIBITED FORWARDED TO NUMBER 3005.96 1 CR_PROHFTNO -1... 1
DISPLAY PROHIBITED FORWARDED TO NUMBER 3007.96 1 DISP_PROHFTNO -1... 1
CANCEL ISUP PROTOCOL TABLE 4042.13 1 CAN_PROTTAB -1... 1
CREATE ISUP PROTOCOL TABLE 4041.15 1 CR_PROTTAB -1... 2
DISPLAY ISUP PROTOCOL TABLE 4044.13 1 DISP_PROTTAB -1... 1
MODIFY ISUP PROTOCOL TABLE 4043.15 1 MOD_PROTTAB -1... 3
CANCEL SERVICE PROVIDER NAME 2993.94 1 CAN_PROVNAM -1... 1
CREATE SERVICE PROVIDER NAME 2997.16 1 CR_PROVNAM -1... 2
DISPLAY SERVICE PROVIDER NAME 2999.94 1 DISP_PROVNAM -1... 1
CANCEL SERVICE PROVIDER NUMBER 2996.94 1 CAN_PROVNO -1... 1
CREATE SERVICE PROVIDER NUMBER 2998.94 1 CR_PROVNO -1... 1
DISPLAY SERVICE PROVIDER NUMBER 3000.94 1 DISP_PROVNO -1... 1
MODIFY SERVICE PROVIDER NUMBER 2994.94 1 MOD_PROVNO -1... 2
MODIFY PASSWORD 41.01 1 MOD_PSW -1... 1
DISPLAY PASSWORD DATA 2857.00 1 DISP_PSWDAT -1... 1
MODIFY PASSWORD DATA 2859.00 1 MOD_PSWDAT -1... 1
Display Q3 Job Register 1.00 1 DISP_Q3JOBREG -1... 1
CANCEL QUALITY OF SERVICE PROFILE 4076.00 1 CAN_QOSPROF -1... 1
CREATE QUALITY OF SERVICE PROFILE 4074.34 1 CR_QOSPROF -1... 5
DISPLAY QUALITY OF SERVICE PROFILE 4077.00 1 DISP_QOSPROF -1... 1
MODIFY QUALITY OF SERVICE PROFILE 4075.34 1 MOD_QOSPROF -1... 5
Cancel Rack 1.00 1 CAN_RACK -1... 1
Create Rack 1.00 1 CR_RACK -1... 1
Display Rack 1.00 1 DISP_RACK -1... 1
Modify Rack 1.00 1 MOD_RACK -1... 1
EXECUTE REGENERATION 611.75 1 EXEC_REGEN -1... 10
ACTIVATE RE-ENCRYPTION 3272.00 1 ACT_RENCRYPT -1... 1
CANCEL ROAMING AREA 3289.95 1 CAN_ROAMAREA -1... 1
CREATE ROAMING AREA 3290.17 1 CR_ROAMAREA -1... 2
DISPLAY ROAMING AREA 3291.95 1 DISP_ROAMAREA -1... 1
MODIFY ROAMING AREA 3292.17 1 MOD_ROAMAREA -1... 2
TEST ROUTING DATA BASE 3095.11 1 TEST_ROUDB -1... 37
ACTIVATE ROUTE 32.10 1 ACT_ROUTE -1... 2
BAR ROUTE 27.11 1 BAR_ROUTE -1... 2
CANCEL ROUTE 13.79 1 CAN_ROUTE -1... 3

CONT-18 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

CREATE ROUTE 10.93 1 CR_ROUTE -1... 27


DISPLAY ROUTE 206.85 1 DISP_ROUTE -1... 4
INSERT ROUTE 30.93 1 INS_ROUTE -1... 26
MODIFY ROUTE 413.89 1 MOD_ROUTE -1... 10
TAKE OUT ROUTE 31.79 1 TAKO_ROUTE -1... 3
CANCEL ROUTE SWITCH 313.81 1 CAN_ROUTESW -1... 4
DISPLAY ROUTE SWITCH 414.05 1 DISP_ROUTESW -1... 1
ENTER ROUTE SWITCH 312.82 1 ENTR_ROUTESW -1... 4
CANCEL ROUTE THRESHOLD 1792.02 1 CAN_ROUTETHR -1... 1
DISPLAY ROUTE THRESHOLD 1790.03 1 DISP_ROUTETHR -1... 2
ENTER ROUTE THRESHOLD 1795.04 1 ENTR_ROUTETHR -1... 3
MODIFY ROUTE THRESHOLD 1797.04 1 MOD_ROUTETHR -1... 1
CANCEL REGIONAL SUBSCRIPTION SERV. DATA 2298.00 1 CAN_RSSERV -1... 1
ENTER REGIONAL SUBSCRIPTION SERVICE DATA 2297.00 1 ENTR_RSSERV -1... 1
CANCEL REGIONAL SUBSCRIPTION ZONE 2306.00 1 CAN_RSZONE -1... 1
CREATE REGIONAL SUBSCRIPTION ZONE 2305.00 1 CR_RSZONE -1... 1
DISPLAY REGIONAL SUBSCRIPTION ZONE 2307.00 1 DISP_RSZONE -1... 1
MODIFY REGIONAL SUBSCRIPTION ZONE 2308.00 1 MOD_RSZONE -1... 2
Cancel SAAL NNI Protocol Profile 1.00 1 CAN_SAALPF -1... 1
Create SAAL NNI Protocol Profile 1.00 1 CR_SAALPF -1... 8
Display SAAL NNI Protocol Profile 1.00 1 DISP_SAALPF -1... 7
Cancel SAM File Array 1.00 1 CAN_SAMAR -1... 1
Create SAM File Array 1.00 1 CR_SAMAR -1... 4
Display SAM File Array 1.00 1 DISP_SAMAR -1... 1
Modify SAM File Array 1.00 1 MOD_SAMAR -1... 3
Cancel SAMAR File Buffer 1.00 1 CAN_SAMFILBUF -1... 1
Create SAMAR File Buffer 1.00 1 CR_SAMFILBUF -1... 1
Display SAMAR File Buffer 1.00 1 DISP_SAMFILBUF -1... 1
Modify SAMAR File Buffer 1.00 1 MOD_SAMFILBUF -1... 1
CANCEL SCREENING LIST 2404.05 1 CAN_SCLST -1... 5
DISPLAY SCREENING LIST 2405.05 1 DISP_SCLST -1... 5
ENTER SCREENING LIST 2403.05 1 ENTR_SCLST -1... 12
Cancel STP Screening Table 1.00 1 CAN_SCRTAB -1... 1
Create STP Screening Table 1.00 1 CR_SCRTAB -1... 2
Display STP Screening Table 1.00 1 DISP_SCRTAB -1... 2
Modify STP Screening Table 1.00 1 MOD_SCRTAB -1... 2
Cancel STP Screening Table Line 1.00 1 CAN_SCRTABLN -1... 2
Create STP Screening Table Line 1.00 1 CR_SCRTABLN -1... 2
Display STP Screening Table Line 1.00 1 DISP_SCRTABLN -1... 2
Modify STP Screening Table Line 1.00 1 MOD_SCRTABLN -1... 2
TRANSFER SECURITY BUFFER 1941.01 1 TRANS_SCRTBUF -1... 1
RECORD SCCP AND TCAP 2940.18 1 REC_SCTC -1... 3
Display Security Alarming 1.00 1 DISP_SECAL -1... 1
Modify Security Alarming 1.00 1 MOD_SECAL -1... 2
Cancel Security Alarm Report Log 1.00 1 CAN_SECALLOG -1... 1
Create Security Alarm Report Log 1.00 1 CR_SECALLOG -1... 2
Display Security Alarm Report Log 1.00 1 DISP_SECALLOG -1... 1
Cancel Security Alarm Report Records 1.00 1 CAN_SECALREC -1... 1
Disp Sec. Alarm Report Records to File 1.00 1 DISP_SECALRECF -1... 2
Display Security Audit Trail 1.00 1 DISP_SECAT -1... 1
Modify Security Audit Trail 1.00 1 MOD_SECAT -1... 2
Cancel Security Audit Trail Log 1.00 1 CAN_SECATLOG -1... 1
Create Security Audit Trail Log 1.00 1 CR_SECATLOG -1... 1
Display Security Audit Trail Log 1.00 1 DISP_SECATLOG -1... 1
Cancel Security Audit Trail Records 1.00 1 CAN_SECATREC -1... 1
Display Sec. Audit Trail Records to File 1.00 1 DISP_SECATRECF -1... 1
UPDATE SECURITY DATA 3087.00 1 UPD_SECDATA -1... 1
DISPLAY SECURITY THRESHOLDS 3084.00 1 DISP_SECTHR -1... 1
MODIFY SECURITY THRESHOLDS 3091.00 1 MOD_SECTHR -1... 3
Display Security Tracer 1.00 1 DISP_SECTRC -1... 1
Dump Security Trace File 1.00 1 DMP_SECTRC -1... 1
Modify Security Tracer 1.00 1 MOD_SECTRC -1... 2
CANCEL SERVICE DEPENDENT CUG DATA 2765.07 1 CAN_SERVCUG -1... 2
DISPLAY SERVICE DEPENDENT CUG DATA 2767.04 1 DISP_SERVCUG -1... 2
ENTER SERVICE DEPENDENT CUG DATA 2769.06 1 ENTR_SERVCUG -1... 2
Cancel Service Profile 1.00 1 CAN_SERVPROF -1... 1
Create Service Profile 1.00 1 CR_SERVPROF -1... 2
Display Service Profile 1.00 1 DISP_SERVPROF -1... 2
Modify Service Profile 1.00 1 MOD_SERVPROF -1... 2
Cancel Service Selector 1.00 1 CAN_SERVSEL -1... 1
Create Service Selector 1.00 1 CR_SERVSEL -1... 2
Display Service Selector 1.00 1 DISP_SERVSEL -1... 2
Modify Service Selector 1.00 1 MOD_SERVSEL -1... 2
CANCEL SESSION 2855.00 1 CAN_SESSION -1... 1

CONT-19 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

DISPLAY SESSION 2858.00 1 DISP_SESSION -1... 1


END SESSION 45.00 1 END_SESSION -1... 1
START SAFEGUARDING SOFTWARE 632.10 1 START_SFGSW -1... 1
Dump Collected Safeguarding MP 1.00 1 DMP_SFGSYMPMP -1... 1
DUMP SAFEGUARDING MESSAGES 1947.00 1 DMP_SGMSG -1... 1
CANCEL SHORT CODE PROCESSING 3322.95 1 CAN_SHCODEPR -1... 1
CREATE SHORT CODE PROCESSING 3323.95 1 CR_SHCODEPR -1... 1
DISPLAY SHORT CODE PROCESSING 3324.95 1 DISP_SHCODEPR -1... 1
Cancel Shelf 1.00 1 CAN_SHELF -1... 1
Create Shelf 1.00 1 CR_SHELF -1... 1
Display Shelf 1.00 1 DISP_SHELF -1... 1
Cancel Signaling Data Link 1.00 1 CAN_SIGDL -1... 1
Display Signaling Data Link 1.00 1 DISP_SIGDL -1... 3
Create Sign. Data Link ATM High Speed 1.00 1 CR_SIGDLHS -1... 2
Display Sign. Data Link ATM High Speed 1.00 1 DISP_SIGDLHS -1... 3
Display Signaling Data Link on a HW Unit 1.00 1 DISP_SIGDLHW -1... 4
Create Signaling Data Link TDM via LIC 1.00 1 CR_SIGDLLIC -1... 2
Display Signaling Data Link TDM via LIC 1.00 1 DISP_SIGDLLIC -1... 4
Create Signaling Data Link NB via LTG 1.00 1 CR_SIGDLLTG -1... 3
Display Signaling Data Link NB via LTG 1.00 1 DISP_SIGDLLTG -1... 5
Modify Signaling Data Link Name 1.00 1 MOD_SIGDLN -1... 1
Cancel Signaling Destination Point 1.00 1 CAN_SIGDP -1... 2
Create Signaling Destination Point 1.00 1 CR_SIGDP -1... 4
Display Signaling Destination Point 1.00 1 DISP_SIGDP -1... 6
Modify Signaling Destination Point 1.00 1 MOD_SIGDP -1... 4
Cancel Sign. Dest. Point Group 1.00 1 CAN_SIGDPGRP -1... 1
Create Sign. Dest. Point Group 1.00 1 CR_SIGDPGRP -1... 2
Display Sign. Dest. Point Group 1.00 1 DISP_SIGDPGRP -1... 2
Modify Sign. Dest. Point Group 1.00 1 MOD_SIGDPGRP -1... 2
Modify Sign. Dest. Point Group Name 1.00 1 MOD_SIGDPGRPN -1... 1
Cancel Sign. Dest. Point Meas. 1.00 1 CAN_SIGDPME -1... 2
Create Sign. Dest. Point Meas. 1.00 1 CR_SIGDPME -1... 2
Display Sign. Dest. Point Meas. 1.00 1 DISP_SIGDPME -1... 2
Modify Signaling Destination Point Name 1.00 1 MOD_SIGDPN -1... 1
Create Signaling Destination Point US 1.00 1 CR_SIGDPUS -1... 4
Cancel Sign. First and Interval Meas. 1.00 1 CAN_SIGFAIME -1... 2
Create Sign. First and Interval Meas. 1.00 1 CR_SIGFAIME -1... 2
Display Sign. First and Interval Meas. 1.00 1 DISP_SIGFAIME -1... 2
Cancel Signaling Link 1.00 1 CAN_SIGLINK -1... 1
Create Signaling Link 1.00 1 CR_SIGLINK -1... 4
Display Signaling Link 1.00 1 DISP_SIGLINK -1... 7
Modify Signaling Link 1.00 1 MOD_SIGLINK -1... 4
Display Signaling Link on HW Unit 1.00 1 DISP_SIGLINKHW -1... 2
Modify Signaling Link Inhibiting State 1.00 1 MOD_SIGLINKINH -1... 2
Display Signaling Link States 1.00 1 DISP_SIGLINKST -1... 4
Modify Signaling Link Admin. State 1.00 1 MOD_SIGLINKST -1... 2
Cancel Sign. Link Meas. 1.00 1 CAN_SIGLME -1... 2
Create Sign. Link Meas. 1.00 1 CR_SIGLME -1... 5
Display Sign. Link Meas. 1.00 1 DISP_SIGLME -1... 2
Cancel Signaling Linkset 1.00 1 CAN_SIGLSET -1... 1
Create Signaling Linkset 1.00 1 CR_SIGLSET -1... 5
Display Signaling Linkset 1.00 1 DISP_SIGLSET -1... 6
Modify Signaling Linkset 1.00 1 MOD_SIGLSET -1... 4
Cancel Signaling Linkset Combined 1.00 1 CAN_SIGLSETC -1... 1
Create Signaling Linkset Combined 1.00 1 CR_SIGLSETC -1... 3
Display Signaling Linkset Combined 1.00 1 DISP_SIGLSETC -1... 4
Modify Signaling Linkset Combined 1.00 1 MOD_SIGLSETC -1... 2
Modify Signaling Linkset Combined Name 1.00 1 MOD_SIGLSETCN -1... 1
Modify Signaling Linkset Home 1.00 1 MOD_SIGLSETH -1... 2
Modify Signaling Linkset Name 1.00 1 MOD_SIGLSETN -1... 1
Modify Signaling Linkset Type 1.00 1 MOD_SIGLSETT -1... 1
Cancel Sign. Linkset Meas. 1.00 1 CAN_SIGLSME -1... 1
Create Sign. Linkset Meas. 1.00 1 CR_SIGLSME -1... 2
Display Sign. Linkset Meas. 1.00 1 DISP_SIGLSME -1... 1
Modify Signaling Linkset VMS Flag 1.00 1 MOD_SIGLSVMS -1... 1
Modify Signaling Link VMS Flag 1.00 1 MOD_SIGLVMS -1... 1
Display Signaling Monitor 1.00 1 DISP_SIGMON -1... 1
Cancel Sign. Network Element Meas. 1.00 1 CAN_SIGNEME -1... 1
Create Sign. Network Element Meas. 1.00 1 CR_SIGNEME -1... 1
Display Sign. Network Element Meas. 1.00 1 DISP_SIGNEME -1... 1
Cancel Signaling Point 1.00 1 CAN_SIGPOINT -1... 1
Create Signaling Point 1.00 1 CR_SIGPOINT -1... 7
Display Signaling Point 1.00 1 DISP_SIGPOINT -1... 9
Modify Signaling Point 1.00 1 MOD_SIGPOINT -1... 6

CONT-20 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

Modify Signaling Point Name 1.00 1 MOD_SIGPOINTN -1... 1


Modify Signaling Point Timer 1.00 1 MOD_SIGPOINTT -1... 1
Create Signaling Point for US 1.00 1 CR_SIGPOINTUS -1... 7
Modify Signaling Point for US 1.00 1 MOD_SIGPOINTUS -1... 6
Cancel Signaling Point Secondary 1.00 1 CAN_SIGPSEC -1... 1
Create Signaling Point Secondary 1.00 1 CR_SIGPSEC -1... 2
Display Signaling Point Secondary 1.00 1 DISP_SIGPSEC -1... 1
Create Sign. Point Secondary Extension 1.00 1 CR_SIGPSECE -1... 2
Display Sign. Point Secondary Extension 1.00 1 DISP_SIGPSECE -1... 2
Modify Sign. Point Secondary Extension 1.00 1 MOD_SIGPSECE -1... 1
Cancel Sign. Point Meas. 1.00 1 CAN_SIGPTME -1... 1
Create Sign. Point Meas. 1.00 1 CR_SIGPTME -1... 2
Display Sign. Point Meas. 1.00 1 DISP_SIGPTME -1... 1
Activate Signaling Point Upgrade 1.00 1 ACT_SIGPTUPG -1... 1
Cancel Signaling Route 1.00 1 CAN_SIGROUTE -1... 2
Create Signaling Route 1.00 1 CR_SIGROUTE -1... 7
Display Signaling Route 1.00 1 DISP_SIGROUTE -1... 3
Modify Signaling Route 1.00 1 MOD_SIGROUTE -1... 5
Cancel Signaling TSM 1.00 1 CAN_SIGTSM -1... 1
Display Signaling TSM Control Info 1.00 1 DISP_SIGTSM -1... 3
Create Signaling TSM Daily 1.00 1 CR_SIGTSMD -1... 3
Cancel Sign. TSM File Template 1.00 1 CAN_SIGTSMFT -1... 1
Create Sign. TSM File Template 1.00 1 CR_SIGTSMFT -1... 1
Display Sign. TSM File Template 1.00 1 DISP_SIGTSMFT -1... 1
Modify Sign. TSM File Template Name 1.00 1 MOD_SIGTSMFTN -1... 1
Modify Signaling TSM Name 1.00 1 MOD_SIGTSMN -1... 1
Modify Signaling TSM State 1.00 1 MOD_SIGTSMST -1... 1
Create Signaling TSM Timer 1.00 1 CR_SIGTSMT -1... 3
Create Signaling TSM Weekly 1.00 1 CR_SIGTSMW -1... 3
ACTIVATE SILC TRACE EVENT 3607.02 1 ACT_SILCTRC -1... 2
CANCEL SILC TRACE EVENT 3609.02 1 CAN_SILCTRC -1... 1
DEACTIVATE SILC TRACE EVENT 3608.02 1 DACT_SILCTRC -1... 2
DISPLAY SILC TRACE EVENT 3610.02 1 DISP_SILCTRC -1... 2
DUMP SILC TRACE EVENT 3611.02 1 DMP_SILCTRC -1... 2
ENTER SILC TRACE EVENT 3606.02 1 ENTR_SILCTRC -1... 2
CANCEL SIM CARD CHANGEOVER DATA 3308.94 1 CAN_SIMCCH -1... 1
DISPLAY SIM CARD CHANGEOVER DATA 3309.94 1 DISP_SIMCCH -1... 1
ENTER SIM CARD CHANGEOVER DATA 3310.35 1 ENTR_SIMCCH -1... 1
CANCEL SUBSCRIBER/LINE ACCESS 3652.04 1 CAN_SLNACC -1... 1
CREATE SUBSCRIBER/LINE ACCESS 3649.05 1 CR_SLNACC -1... 11
DISPLAY SUBSCRIBER/LINE ACCESS 3651.05 1 DISP_SLNACC -1... 4
MODIFY SUBSCRIBER/LINE ACCESS 3650.05 1 MOD_SLNACC -1... 25
MODIFY SLRAM 1080.01 1 MOD_SLRAM -1... 1
DISPLAY SUSPECT MOBILE CALL 3548.00 1 DISP_SMCALL -1... 1
RELEASE SUSPECT MOBILE CALL 3549.00 1 REL_SMCALL -1... 1
DISPLAY SUSPECT MOBILE SUBSCRIBER 3551.00 1 DISP_SMSUB -1... 1
ACTIVATE SUSPECT MSUB DETECTION 3544.00 1 ACT_SMSUBDET -1... 1
DEACTIVATE SUSPECT MSUB DETECTION 3545.00 1 DACT_SMSUBDET -1... 1
DISPLAY SUSPECT MSUB DETECTION 3546.00 1 DISP_SMSUBDET -1... 1
CONFIGURE SWITCHING NETWORK 926.17 1 CONF_SN -1... 3
DIAGNOSE SWITCHING NETWORK 974.03 1 DIAG_SN -1... 4
DISPLAY STATUS OF SN 918.10 1 STAT_SN -1... 1
TEST SPEECH PATHS THROUGH THE SN 938.00 1 TEST_SN -1... 3
DISPLAY SN BIT ERROR RATE COUNT 694.01 1 DISP_SNBERC -1... 1
START SN BIT ERROR RATE COUNT 693.02 1 START_SNBERC -1... 2
DISPLAY SN PATH DATA (TRANSIENT) 848.01 1 DISP_SNPD -1... 1
Cancel Sccp Account 1.00 1 CAN_SPACC -1... 1
Create Sccp Account 1.00 1 CR_SPACC -1... 2
Display Sccp Account 1.00 1 DISP_SPACC -1... 2
Modify Sccp Account 1.00 1 MOD_SPACC -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Access Point Local 1.00 1 CAN_SPAPLOC -1... 1
Create Sccp Access Point Local 1.00 1 CR_SPAPLOC -1... 5
Display Sccp Access Point Local 1.00 1 DISP_SPAPLOC -1... 1
Modify Sccp Access Point Local 1.00 1 MOD_SPAPLOC -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Access Point Remote 1.00 1 CAN_SPAPREM -1... 1
Configure Sccp Access Point Remote 1.00 1 CONF_SPAPREM -1... 1
Create Sccp Access Point Remote 1.00 1 CR_SPAPREM -1... 5
Display Sccp Access Point Remote 1.00 1 DISP_SPAPREM -1... 2
Modify Sccp Access Point Remote 1.00 1 MOD_SPAPREM -1... 2
Disp Status Sccp Access Point Remote 1.00 1 STAT_SPAPREM -1... 2
Modify VMZ of Sccp Access Point Local 1.00 1 MOD_SPAPVMZ -1... 1
Cancel Sccp Concerned Area 1.00 1 CAN_SPCAREA -1... 1
Create Sccp Concerned Area 1.00 1 CR_SPCAREA -1... 1
Display Sccp Concerned Area 1.00 1 DISP_SPCAREA -1... 2

CONT-21 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

Modify Sccp Concerned Area 1.00 1 MOD_SPCAREA -1... 2


Cancel Sccp Calling Party Addr.Conv. 1.00 1 CAN_SPCLGCON -1... 1
Create Sccp Calling Party Addr.Conv. 1.00 1 CR_SPCLGCON -1... 3
Display Sccp Calling Party Addr.Conv. 1.00 1 DISP_SPCLGCON -1... 1
Modify Sccp Calling Party Addr.Conv. 1.00 1 MOD_SPCLGCON -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Calling Party Address 1.00 1 CAN_SPCLGPA -1... 1
Create Sccp Calling Party Address 1.00 1 CR_SPCLGPA -1... 4
Display Sccp Calling Party Address 1.00 1 DISP_SPCLGPA -1... 1
Modify Sccp Calling Party Address 1.00 1 MOD_SPCLGPA -1... 4
Cancel Sccp End Node Ent.Set w.o. Ssn 1.00 1 CAN_SPENS -1... 1
Create Sccp End Node Ent.Set w.o. Ssn 1.00 1 CR_SPENS -1... 2
Disp. Sccp End Node Ent.Set w.o. Ssn 1.00 1 DISP_SPENS -1... 1
Mod. Sccp End Node Ent.Set w.o. Ssn 1.00 1 MOD_SPENS -1... 3
Cancel Sccp End Node Ent.Set with Ssn 1.00 1 CAN_SPENSSSN -1... 1
Create Sccp End Node Ent.Set with Ssn 1.00 1 CR_SPENSSSN -1... 2
Display Sccp End Node Ent.Set with Ssn 1.00 1 DISP_SPENSSSN -1... 1
Modify Sccp End Node Ent.Set with Ssn 1.00 1 MOD_SPENSSSN -1... 3
CANCEL SPOOLENTRY 1761.01 1 CAN_SPENTRY -1... 1
DISPLAY SPOOLENTRY 1764.00 1 DISP_SPENTRY -1... 1
MODIFY SPOOLENTRY 1766.01 1 MOD_SPENTRY -1... 1
DISPLAY SPOOLFILE 1765.00 1 DISP_SPFILE -1... 1
Cancel Sccp Global Title Conv.Rule 1.00 1 CAN_SPGTCRUL -1... 1
Create Sccp Global Title Conv.Rule 1.00 1 CR_SPGTCRUL -1... 3
Display Sccp Global Title Conv.Rule 1.00 1 DISP_SPGTCRUL -1... 1
Modify Sccp Global Title Conv.Rule 1.00 1 MOD_SPGTCRUL -1... 3
Cancel Sccp Global Title Rule 1.00 1 CAN_SPGTRUL -1... 2
Create Sccp Global Title Rule 1.00 1 CR_SPGTRUL -1... 4
Display Sccp Global Title Rule 1.00 1 DISP_SPGTRUL -1... 2
Modify Sccp Global Title Rule 1.00 1 MOD_SPGTRUL -1... 4
Cancel Sccp Global Title Translator 1.00 1 CAN_SPGTTRL -1... 1
Create Sccp Global Title Translator 1.00 1 CR_SPGTTRL -1... 2
Display Sccp Global Title Translator 1.00 1 DISP_SPGTTRL -1... 1
Modify Sccp Global Title Translator 1.00 1 MOD_SPGTTRL -1... 1
DISPLAY SPLIT OPTION 3480.00 1 DISP_SPLITOPT -1... 1
RESET SPLIT OPTION 3479.00 1 RSET_SPLITOPT -1... 1
SET SPLIT OPTION 3478.00 1 SET_SPLITOPT -1... 1
Cancel Sccp Linkage Local 1.00 1 CAN_SPLNKLOC -1... 1
Create Sccp Linkage Local 1.00 1 CR_SPLNKLOC -1... 3
Display Sccp Linkage Local 1.00 1 DISP_SPLNKLOC -1... 1
Modify Sccp Linkage Local 1.00 1 MOD_SPLNKLOC -1... 4
Cancel Sccp Linkage Remote 1.00 1 CAN_SPLNKREM -1... 1
Create Sccp Linkage Remote 1.00 1 CR_SPLNKREM -1... 3
Display Sccp Linkage Remote 1.00 1 DISP_SPLNKREM -1... 2
Modify Sccp Linkage Remote 1.00 1 MOD_SPLNKREM -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Measurements 1.00 1 CAN_SPME -1... 1
Create Sccp Measurements 1.00 1 CR_SPME -1... 1
Display Sccp Measurements 1.00 1 DISP_SPME -1... 1
Cancel Sccp Measurements All 1.00 1 CAN_SPMEALL -1... 1
Create Sccp Measurements All 1.00 1 CR_SPMEALL -1... 1
Display Sccp Measurements All 1.00 1 DISP_SPMEALL -1... 1
Cancel Sccp Meas. First And Int. 1.00 1 CAN_SPMEFAI -1... 1
Create Sccp Meas. First And Int. 1.00 1 CR_SPMEFAI -1... 1
Display Sccp Meas. First And Int. 1.00 1 DISP_SPMEFAI -1... 1
Cancel Sccp Measurements Netdep. 1.00 1 CAN_SPMEN -1... 1
Create Sccp Measurements Netdep. 1.00 1 CR_SPMEN -1... 1
Display Sccp Measurements Netdep. 1.00 1 DISP_SPMEN -1... 1
Cancel Sccp Meas.Netdep.First And Int. 1.00 1 CAN_SPMENFAI -1... 1
Create Sccp Meas.Netdep.First And Int. 1.00 1 CR_SPMENFAI -1... 1
Display Sccp Meas.Netdep.First And Int. 1.00 1 DISP_SPMENFAI -1... 1
Cancel Sccp Meas.Scheduler 1.00 1 CAN_SPMESCHD -1... 1
Create Sccp Meas.Scheduler 1.00 1 CR_SPMESCHD -1... 2
Display Sccp Meas.Scheduler 1.00 1 DISP_SPMESCHD -1... 1
Modify Sccp Meas.Scheduler 1.00 1 MOD_SPMESCHD -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Measurements per Ssn 1.00 1 CAN_SPMESSN -1... 1
Create Sccp Measurements per Ssn 1.00 1 CR_SPMESSN -1... 1
Display Sccp Measurements per Ssn 1.00 1 DISP_SPMESSN -1... 1
Cancel Scmg User Data Screening 1.00 1 CAN_SPMGUDS -1... 1
Create Scmg User Data Screening 1.00 1 CR_SPMGUDS -1... 2
Display Scmg User Data Screening 1.00 1 DISP_SPMGUDS -1... 1
Modify Scmg User Data Screening 1.00 1 MOD_SPMGUDS -1... 2
Cancel Scmg User Data Screening Element 1.00 1 CAN_SPMGUDSE -1... 2
Create Scmg User Data Screening Element 1.00 1 CR_SPMGUDSE -1... 3
Display Scmg User Data Screening Element 1.00 1 DISP_SPMGUDSE -1... 3
Modify Scmg User Data Screening Element 1.00 1 MOD_SPMGUDSE -1... 3

CONT-22 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

Cancel Sccp Relay Node Entity Set 1.00 1 CAN_SPRNS -1... 1


Create Sccp Relay Node Entity Set 1.00 1 CR_SPRNS -1... 5
Display Sccp Relay Node Entity Set 1.00 1 DISP_SPRNS -1... 1
Modify Sccp Relay Node Entity Set 1.00 1 MOD_SPRNS -1... 5
Cancel Sccp Scr. CldPA After Gt Trans. 1.00 1 CAN_SPSCLDAT -1... 1
Create Sccp Scr. CldPA After Gt Trans. 1.00 1 CR_SPSCLDAT -1... 2
Display Sccp Scr. CldPA After Gt Trans. 1.00 1 DISP_SPSCLDAT -1... 1
Modify Sccp Scr. CldPA After Gt Trans. 1.00 1 MOD_SPSCLDAT -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Scr. CldPA AfterGtTrans. El. 1.00 1 CAN_SPSCLDATE -1... 2
Create Sccp Scr. CldPA AfterGtTrans. El. 1.00 1 CR_SPSCLDATE -1... 3
Disp. Sccp Scr. CldPA AfterGtTrans. El. 1.00 1 DISP_SPSCLDATE -1... 3
Modify Sccp Scr. CldPA AfterGtTrans. El. 1.00 1 MOD_SPSCLDATE -1... 3
Cancel Sccp Scr. Called Party Address 1.00 1 CAN_SPSCLDPA -1... 1
Create Sccp Scr. Called Party Address 1.00 1 CR_SPSCLDPA -1... 2
Display Sccp Scr. Called Party Address 1.00 1 DISP_SPSCLDPA -1... 1
Modify Sccp Scr. Called Party Address 1.00 1 MOD_SPSCLDPA -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Scr. CldPA GT Digit 1.00 1 CAN_SPSCLDPAD -1... 1
Create Sccp Scr. CldPA GT Digit 1.00 1 CR_SPSCLDPAD -1... 2
Display Sccp Scr. CldPA GT Digit 1.00 1 DISP_SPSCLDPAD -1... 1
Modify Sccp Scr. CldPA GT Digit 1.00 1 MOD_SPSCLDPAD -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Scr. CldPA GT Digit Element 1.00 1 CAN_SPSCLDPADE -1... 2
Create Sccp Scr. CldPA GT Digit Element 1.00 1 CR_SPSCLDPADE -1... 2
Display Sccp Scr. CldPA GT Digit Element 1.00 1 DISP_SPSCLDPADE -1... 2
Modify Sccp Scr. CldPA GT Digit Element 1.00 1 MOD_SPSCLDPADE -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Scr. Called Party Addr. El. 1.00 1 CAN_SPSCLDPAE -1... 2
Create Sccp Scr. Called Party Addr. El. 1.00 1 CR_SPSCLDPAE -1... 4
Disp. Sccp Scr. Called Party Addr. El. 1.00 1 DISP_SPSCLDPAE -1... 3
Modify Sccp Scr. Called Party Addr. El. 1.00 1 MOD_SPSCLDPAE -1... 3
Cancel Sccp Scr. CldPA Translator 1.00 1 CAN_SPSCLDPAT -1... 1
Create Sccp Scr. CldPA Translator 1.00 1 CR_SPSCLDPAT -1... 2
Display Sccp Scr. CldPA Translator 1.00 1 DISP_SPSCLDPAT -1... 1
Modify Sccp Scr. CldPA Translator 1.00 1 MOD_SPSCLDPAT -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Scr. CldPA Translator El. 1.00 1 CAN_SPSCLDPATE -1... 2
Create Sccp Scr. CldPA Translator El. 1.00 1 CR_SPSCLDPATE -1... 3
Display Sccp Scr. CldPA Translator El. 1.00 1 DISP_SPSCLDPATE -1... 4
Modify Sccp Scr. CldPA Translator El. 1.00 1 MOD_SPSCLDPATE -1... 4
Cancel Sccp Scr. Calling Party Address 1.00 1 CAN_SPSCLGPA -1... 1
Create Sccp Scr. Calling Party Address 1.00 1 CR_SPSCLGPA -1... 2
Display Sccp Scr. Calling Party Address 1.00 1 DISP_SPSCLGPA -1... 1
Modify Sccp Scr. Calling Party Address 1.00 1 MOD_SPSCLGPA -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Scr. ClgPA GT Digit 1.00 1 CAN_SPSCLGPAD -1... 1
Create Sccp Scr. ClgPA GT Digit 1.00 1 CR_SPSCLGPAD -1... 2
Display Sccp Scr. ClgPA GT Digit 1.00 1 DISP_SPSCLGPAD -1... 1
Modify Sccp Scr. ClgPA GT Digit 1.00 1 MOD_SPSCLGPAD -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Scr. ClgPA GT Digit Element 1.00 1 CAN_SPSCLGPADE -1... 1
Create Sccp Scr. ClgPA GT Digit Element 1.00 1 CR_SPSCLGPADE -1... 2
Display Sccp Scr. ClgPA GT Digit Element 1.00 1 DISP_SPSCLGPADE -1... 2
Modify Sccp Scr. ClgPA GT Digit Element 1.00 1 MOD_SPSCLGPADE -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Scr. Calling Party Addr. El. 1.00 1 CAN_SPSCLGPAE -1... 2
Create Sccp Scr. Calling Party Addr. El. 1.00 1 CR_SPSCLGPAE -1... 3
Disp. Sccp Scr. Calling Party Addr. El. 1.00 1 DISP_SPSCLGPAE -1... 3
Modify Sccp Scr. Calling Party Addr. El. 1.00 1 MOD_SPSCLGPAE -1... 3
Cancel Sccp Scr. ClgPA Translator 1.00 1 CAN_SPSCLGPAT -1... 1
Create Sccp Scr. ClgPA Translator 1.00 1 CR_SPSCLGPAT -1... 2
Display Sccp Scr. ClgPA Translator 1.00 1 DISP_SPSCLGPAT -1... 1
Modify Sccp Scr. ClgPA Translator 1.00 1 MOD_SPSCLGPAT -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Scr. ClgPA Translator El. 1.00 1 CAN_SPSCLGPATE -1... 2
Create Sccp Scr. ClgPA Translator El. 1.00 1 CR_SPSCLGPATE -1... 3
Display Sccp Scr. ClgPA Translator El. 1.00 1 DISP_SPSCLGPATE -1... 4
Modify Sccp Scr. ClgPA Translator El. 1.00 1 MOD_SPSCLGPATE -1... 4
Cancel Sccp Screening Domain 1.00 1 CAN_SPSDOM -1... 2
Create Sccp Screening Domain 1.00 1 CR_SPSDOM -1... 3
Display Sccp Screening Domain 1.00 1 DISP_SPSDOM -1... 3
Modify Sccp Screening Domain 1.00 1 MOD_SPSDOM -1... 3
ACTIVATE SPOOLSERVICE 1760.02 1 ACT_SPSERV -1... 1
DEACTIVATE SPOOLSERVICE 1762.00 1 DACT_SPSERV -1... 1
Cancel Sccp Screening Measurements 1.00 1 CAN_SPSME -1... 1
Create Sccp Screening Measurements 1.00 1 CR_SPSME -1... 1
Display Sccp Screening Measurements 1.00 1 DISP_SPSME -1... 1
Cancel Sccp Screening Meas.FirstAndInt. 1.00 1 CAN_SPSMEFAI -1... 1
Create Sccp Screening Meas.FirstAndInt. 1.00 1 CR_SPSMEFAI -1... 1
Disp. Sccp Screening Meas.FirstAndInt. 1.00 1 DISP_SPSMEFAI -1... 1
Act. Sccp Scr. Meas. First And Int. Upg. 1.00 1 ACT_SPSMEFAIUPG -1... 1
Cancel Sccp Screening Meas. Scheduler 1.00 1 CAN_SPSMESCHD -1... 1

CONT-23 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

Create Sccp Screening Meas. Scheduler 1.00 1 CR_SPSMESCHD -1... 2


Display Sccp Screening Meas. Scheduler 1.00 1 DISP_SPSMESCHD -1... 1
Modify Sccp Screening Meas. Scheduler 1.00 1 MOD_SPSMESCHD -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Screening Message Type 1.00 1 CAN_SPSMT -1... 1
Create Sccp Screening Message Type 1.00 1 CR_SPSMT -1... 2
Display Sccp Screening Message Type 1.00 1 DISP_SPSMT -1... 1
Modify Sccp Screening Message Type 1.00 1 MOD_SPSMT -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Screening Message Type El. 1.00 1 CAN_SPSMTE -1... 1
Create Sccp Screening Message Type El. 1.00 1 CR_SPSMTE -1... 2
Display Sccp Screening Message Type El. 1.00 1 DISP_SPSMTE -1... 2
Modify Sccp Screening Message Type El. 1.00 1 MOD_SPSMTE -1... 3
Cancel Sccp Subsystem Number 1.00 1 CAN_SPSSN -1... 2
Create Sccp Subsystem Number 1.00 1 CR_SPSSN -1... 4
Display Sccp Subsystem Number 1.00 1 DISP_SPSSN -1... 2
Modify Sccp Subsystem Number 1.00 1 MOD_SPSSN -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Term.Acc.Class Accounting 1.00 1 CAN_SPTACACC -1... 1
Create Sccp Term.Acc.Class Accounting 1.00 1 CR_SPTACACC -1... 2
Disp. Sccp Term.Acc.Class Accounting 1.00 1 DISP_SPTACACC -1... 2
Mod. Sccp Term.Acc.Class Accounting 1.00 1 MOD_SPTACACC -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Term.Acc.Class Verification 1.00 1 CAN_SPTACVRF -1... 1
Create Sccp Term.Acc.Class Verification 1.00 1 CR_SPTACVRF -1... 2
Disp. Sccp Term.Acc.Class Verification 1.00 1 DISP_SPTACVRF -1... 2
Mod. Sccp Term.Acc.Class Verification 1.00 1 MOD_SPTACVRF -1... 2
Display Sccp Timers 1.00 1 DISP_SPTIMER -1... 1
Modify Sccp Timers 1.00 1 MOD_SPTIMER -1... 2
Activate Special Trace 1.00 1 ACT_SPTRC -1... 3
Deactivate Special Trace 1.00 1 DACT_SPTRC -1... 1
Display Special Trace 1.00 1 DISP_SPTRC -1... 1
Dump Data of Special Trace 1.00 1 DMP_SPTRC -1... 1
Cancel Sccp Translation Type 1.00 1 CAN_SPTT -1... 2
Create Sccp Translation Type 1.00 1 CR_SPTT -1... 2
Display Sccp Translation Type 1.00 1 DISP_SPTT -1... 2
Modify Sccp Translation Type 1.00 1 MOD_SPTT -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Translation Type for Us 1.00 1 CAN_SPTTUS -1... 2
Create Sccp Translation Type for Us 1.00 1 CR_SPTTUS -1... 3
Display Sccp Translation Type for Us 1.00 1 DISP_SPTTUS -1... 2
Modify Sccp Translation Type for Us 1.00 1 MOD_SPTTUS -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Verification Rule 1.00 1 CAN_SPVRFRUL -1... 2
Create Sccp Verification Rule 1.00 1 CR_SPVRFRUL -1... 2
Display Sccp Verification Rule 1.00 1 DISP_SPVRFRUL -1... 2
Modify Sccp Verification Rule 1.00 1 MOD_SPVRFRUL -1... 2
Cancel Sccp Verification Translator 1.00 1 CAN_SPVRFTRL -1... 1
Create Sccp Verification Translator 1.00 1 CR_SPVRFTRL -1... 3
Display Sccp Verification Translator 1.00 1 DISP_SPVRFTRL -1... 4
Modify Sccp Verification Translator 1.00 1 MOD_SPVRFTRL -1... 3
Activate SS7 Basic Account. and Verific. 1.00 1 ACT_SS7BAV -1... 1
Cancel SS7 Basic Account. and Verific. 1.00 1 CAN_SS7BAV -1... 1
Create SS7 Basic Account. and Verific. 1.00 1 CR_SS7BAV -1... 1
Deact. SS7 Basic Account. and Verific. 1.00 1 DACT_SS7BAV -1... 1
Display SS7 Basic Account. and Verific. 1.00 1 DISP_SS7BAV -1... 1
Cancel SS7 Log File 1.00 1 CAN_SS7LOG -1... 1
Create SS7 Log File 1.00 1 CR_SS7LOG -1... 2
Display SS7 Log File 1.00 1 DISP_SS7LOG -1... 1
Cancel SS7 Log File additional 1.00 1 CAN_SS7LOGADD -1... 1
Create SS7 Log File additional 1.00 1 CR_SS7LOGADD -1... 1
Display SS7 Log File additional 1.00 1 DISP_SS7LOGADD -1... 1
ALLOW SYSTEM STATUS ANALYSIS 1083.00 1 ALLOW_SSA -1... 1
DISPLAY SYSTEM STATUS ANALYSIS DATA 1121.00 1 DISP_SSA -1... 1
INHIBIT SYSTEM STATUS ANALYSIS 1123.00 1 INHIB_SSA -1... 1
MODIFY SYSTEM STATUS ANALYSIS 1126.00 1 MOD_SSA -1... 1
ACTIVATE SECURE SUBSCRIBER ADM. FILE 3092.00 1 ACT_SSAFILE -1... 1
DEACTIVATE SECURE SUBSCRIBER ADM. FILE 3093.00 1 DACT_SSAFILE -1... 1
DISPLAY SECURE SUBSCRIBER ADM. FILE 3094.00 1 DISP_SSAFILE -1... 1
RECORD SUPPL. SERVICE UTILIZATION DATA 1930.18 1 REC_SSERV -1... 4
CONFIGURE SPACE STAGE GROUP 927.17 1 CONF_SSG -1... 2
DIAGNOSE SPACE STAGE GROUP 976.00 1 DIAG_SSG -1... 4
TEST SPEECH PATHS THROUGH THE SSG 971.00 1 TEST_SSG -1... 5
Recover SSNC 1.00 1 RECOV_SSNC -1... 1
Cancel SSNC Measurement Log 1.00 1 CAN_SSNCMELO -1... 1
Create SSNC Measurement Log 1.00 1 CR_SSNCMELO -1... 2
Display SSNC Measurement Log 1.00 1 DISP_SSNCMELO -1... 1
DISPLAY SSP 1654.01 1 DISP_SSP -1... 1
MERGE SSP 1125.00 1 MERGE_SSP -1... 1
RECOVER SSP 453.10 1 RECOV_SSP -1... 1

CONT-24 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

SPLIT SSP 1088.01 1 SPLIT_SSP -1... 1


SEARCH SSP 1127.01 1 SRCH_SSP -1... 1
DISPLAY STATUS OF SSP 123.71 1 STAT_SSP -1... 1
TEST SSP 121.70 1 TEST_SSP -1... 1
ALLOW ROUTINE TEST 1085.01 1 ALLOW_SSPRT -1... 1
CUT OFF ROUTINETEST 1108.00 1 CUT_SSPRT -1... 1
DISPLAY ROUTINE TEST DATA 1122.01 1 DISP_SSPRT -1... 1
INHIBIT ROUTINE TEST 1124.01 1 INHIB_SSPRT -1... 1
MODIFY ROUTINE TEST DATA 1084.03 1 MOD_SSPRT -1... 3
ACTIVATE SCCP AND TCAP MONITORING 2928.12 1 ACT_STMON -1... 7
DEACTIVATE SCCP AND TCAP MONITORING 2930.41 1 DACT_STMON -1... 7
DISPLAY SCCP AND TCAP MONITORING 2932.12 1 DISP_STMON -1... 10
ENTER SCCP AND TCAP MONITORING 2921.12 1 ENTR_STMON -1... 17
DISPLAY SCCP AND TCAP MONITORING INFO 3482.00 1 DISP_STMONINF -1... 1
ENTER SCCP AND TCAP MONITORING INFO 3481.00 1 ENTR_STMONINF -1... 1
CANCEL SUBSCRIBER 4.82 1 CAN_SUB -1... 2
CREATE SUBSCRIBER 2.15 1 CR_SUB -1...270
DISPLAY SUBSCRIBER 171.15 1 DISP_SUB -1... 16
MODIFY SUBSCRIBER 1038.20 1 MOD_SUB -1...181
DISPLAY STATUS OF SUBSCRIBER 536.78 1 STAT_SUB -1... 4
CANCEL SUBSCRIBER PROFILE ID 4011.01 1 CAN_SUBPRFID -1... 1
CREATE SUBSCRIBER PROFILE ID 4010.01 1 CR_SUBPRFID -1... 1
DISPLAY SUBSCRIBER PROFILE ID 4012.01 1 DISP_SUBPRFID -1... 1
CANCEL SUBSCRIBER RELATED SERVICE DATA 2153.35 1 CAN_SUBRSERV -1... 4
CREATE SUBSCRIBER RELATED SERVICE DATA 2151.35 1 CR_SUBRSERV -1... 52
DISPLAY SUBSCRIBER RELATED SERVICE DATA 2154.35 1 DISP_SUBRSERV -1... 4
MODIFY SUBSCRIBER RELATED SERVICE DATA 2152.35 1 MOD_SUBRSERV -1... 63
ACTIVATE SERVICE SUBSCRIBER 3815.06 1 ACT_SVSUB -1... 1
CANCEL SERVICE SUBSCRIBER 3817.06 1 CAN_SVSUB -1... 1
CREATE SERVICE SUBSCRIBER 3813.06 1 CR_SVSUB -1... 5
DEACTIVATE SERVICE SUBSCRIBER 3816.06 1 DACT_SVSUB -1... 1
DISPLAY SERVICE SUBSCRIBER 3818.06 1 DISP_SVSUB -1... 2
MODIFY SERVICE SUBSCRIBER 3814.06 1 MOD_SVSUB -1... 5
Activate SWT ID 1.00 1 ACT_SWTID -1... 1
Build SWT ID 1.00 1 BLD_SWTID -1... 1
Cancel SWT ID 1.00 1 CAN_SWTID -1... 1
Deactivate SWT ID 1.00 1 DACT_SWTID -1... 1
Dump SWT ID 1.00 1 DMP_SWTID -1... 1
Display SWT ID Definition 1.00 1 DISP_SWTIDDEF -1... 1
Build SWT ID Easy 1.00 1 BLD_SWTIDE -1... 1
Display SWT ID Hits 1.00 1 DISP_SWTIDHIT -1... 1
Display SWT ID Overview 1.00 1 DISP_SWTIDOVW -1... 1
Display SWT ID State 1.00 1 DISP_SWTIDSTA -1... 1
Cancel SWT ID Total 1.00 1 CAN_SWTIDT -1... 1
Activate SWT ID at Certain Time 1.00 1 ACT_SWTIDTM -1... 1
Deactivate SWT ID at Certain Time 1.00 1 DACT_SWTIDTM -1... 1
Cancel SWT Notifications Log 1.00 1 CAN_SWTLOG -1... 1
Create SWT Notifications Log 1.00 1 CR_SWTLOG -1... 1
Display SWT Notifications Log 1.00 1 DISP_SWTLOG -1... 1
Display SWT Notifications Log Records 1.00 1 DISP_SWTLOGRC -1... 1
Define Software Tracepoint 1.00 1 DEF_SWTP -1... 1
TRANSFER SYSTEM FILES 1002.06 1 TRANS_SYFILE -1... 6
ACTIVATE SYMMETRICAL KEY K4 4140.39 1 ACT_SYMKEY -1... 1
CANCEL SYMMETRICAL KEY K4 4139.39 1 CAN_SYMKEY -1... 2
DISPLAY SYMMETRICAL KEY K4 4141.39 1 DISP_SYMKEY -1... 1
ENTER SYMMETRICAL KEY K4 4138.39 1 ENTR_SYMKEY -1... 2
MODIFY SYMMETRICAL KEY 4222.35 1 MOD_SYMKEY -1... 2
CONFIGURE SYSTEM PANEL 930.60 1 CONF_SYP -1... 1
DISPLAY STATUS OF SYSTEM PANEL 920.10 1 STAT_SYP -1... 1
RECOVER SYSTEM 456.14 1 RECOV_SYSTEM -1... 2
Display System Time 1.00 1 DISP_SYSTIME -1... 1
Modify System Time 1.00 1 MOD_SYSTIME -1... 1
ACTIVATE SYSTEM UPGRADE 3238.00 1 ACT_SYSUPG -1... 1
DEACTIVATE SYSTEM UPGRADE 3239.00 1 DACT_SYSUPG -1... 1
START SYSTEM UPGRADE 3241.00 1 START_SYSUPG -1... 1
MOUNT TAPE 8.01 1 MOUNT_TAPE -1... 1
CANCEL TARIFF 57.06 1 CAN_TAR -1... 1
DISPLAY TARIFF 202.04 1 DISP_TAR -1... 2
ENTER TARIFF 56.09 1 ENTR_TAR -1... 4
MODIFY TARIFF 58.06 1 MOD_TAR -1... 2
CANCEL TARIFF SWITCH 60.07 1 CAN_TARSW -1... 2
DISPLAY TARIFF SWITCH 205.07 1 DISP_TARSW -1... 2
ENTER TARIFF SWITCH 59.07 1 ENTR_TARSW -1... 2
Cancel Transm. Convergence Sublayer 1.00 1 CAN_TCSUBL -1... 1

CONT-25 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

Create Transm. Convergence Sublayer 1.00 1 CR_TCSUBL -1... 3


Display Transm. Convergence Sublayer 1.00 1 DISP_TCSUBL -1... 2
Modify Transm. Convergence Sublayer 1.00 1 MOD_TCSUBL -1... 2
TRANSFER TEXT 1505.00 1 TRANS_TEXT -1... 1
CANCEL TRUNK GROUP CLUSTER 2772.01 1 CAN_TGCLU -1... 1
CREATE TRUNK GROUP CLUSTER 2771.04 1 CR_TGCLU -1... 3
DISPLAY TRUNK GROUP CLUSTER 2773.01 1 DISP_TGCLU -1... 1
MODIFY TRUNK GROUP CLUSTER 2774.04 1 MOD_TGCLU -1... 4
CANCEL TRUNK GROUP DATA 1874.30 1 CAN_TGDAT -1... 7
ENTER TRUNK GROUP DATA 1875.30 1 ENTR_TGDAT -1... 71
CANCEL TRUNK GROUP 14.39 1 CAN_TGRP -1... 1
CREATE TRUNK GROUP 11.42 1 CR_TGRP -1...103
DISPLAY TRUNK GROUP 226.42 1 DISP_TGRP -1... 9
MODIFY TRUNK GROUP 35.47 1 MOD_TGRP -1... 8
RECORD TRUNK GROUP 291.30 1 REC_TGRP -1... 5
DISPLAY TRUNK GROUP ALARM THRESHOLD 1889.30 1 DISP_TGRPTHR -1... 1
ENTER TRUNK GROUP ALARM THRESHOLDS 2548.30 1 ENTR_TGRPTHR -1... 11
DISPLAY THRESHOLD 256.01 1 DISP_THR -1... 1
ENTER THRESHOLD 255.73 1 ENTR_THR -1... 1
Cancel Ticket Distributor 1.00 1 CAN_TICKDISTR -1... 1
Create Ticket Distributor 1.00 1 CR_TICKDISTR -1... 1
Display Ticket Distributor 1.00 1 DISP_TICKDISTR -1... 1
DISPLAY TIME 50.15 1 DISP_TIME -1... 1
ENTER TIME 52.15 1 ENTR_TIME -1... 2
MODIFY TIME 4142.15 1 MOD_TIME -1... 3
DISPLAY TIMEOUT 767.13 1 DISP_TIOUT -1... 1
MODIFY TIMEOUT 850.35 1 MOD_TIOUT -1... 18
DISPLAY TIME JOB 259.01 1 DISP_TJOB -1... 1
CAN TRUNK MAINTENANCE BLOCKING STATUS 1882.07 1 CAN_TMBLK -1... 1
ENTER TRUNK MAINTENANCE BLOCKING STATUS 1883.06 1 ENTR_TMBLK -1... 1
DISPLAY TRUNK MAINTENANCE CONTROL 377.71 1 DISP_TMCNTL -1... 1
ENTER TRUNK MAINTENANCE CONTROL 324.30 1 ENTR_TMCNTL -1... 7
Cancel Time Event 1.00 1 CAN_TMEVENT -1... 1
CANCEL TRAFFIC OBSERVATION JOB 1649.01 1 CAN_TOBS -1... 1
DISPLAY TRAFFIC OBSERVATION JOBS 1542.00 1 DISP_TOBS -1... 1
ENTER TRAFFIC OBSERVATION JOB 1544.01 1 ENTR_TOBS -1... 3
DISPLAY TRAFFIC OBSERVATION RECORDS 2959.00 1 DISP_TOBSREC -1... 1
CANCEL TONE IDENTIFICATION 2344.01 1 CAN_TONEID -1... 1
CREATE TONE IDENTIFICATION 2337.02 1 CR_TONEID -1... 4
DISPLAY TONE IDENTIFICATION 2345.01 1 DISP_TONEID -1... 1
MODIFY TONE IDENTIFICATION 2343.02 1 MOD_TONEID -1... 4
CANCEL TRAFFIC RESTRICTION CLASS BLOCK 1416.52 1 CAN_TRABLOCK -1... 2
DISPLAY TRAFFIC RESTRICTION CLASS BLOCK 1415.49 1 DISP_TRABLOCK -1... 1
ENTER TRAFFIC RESTRICTION CLASS BLOCK 1417.52 1 ENTR_TRABLOCK -1... 3
DISPLAY TRAFFIC FILE CHARACTERISTIC 283.39 1 DISP_TRAFICH -1... 1
GET TRAFFIC FILE 286.34 1 GET_TRAFILE -1... 2
DISPLAY TRAFFIC MEASUREMENT ORDERS 507.04 1 DISP_TRAMORD -1... 1
Repair SYTRANSLOG File on MP 1.00 1 REP_TRANSLOG -1... 2
DISPLAY IRREGULARITY TRAPS 1058.30 1 DISP_TRAPS -1... 10
CANCEL TRAFFIC TYPE 3639.46 1 CAN_TRAT -1... 1
CREATE TRAFFIC TYPE 3637.54 1 CR_TRAT -1... 3
DISPLAY TRAFFIC TYPE 3640.46 1 DISP_TRAT -1... 1
MODIFY TRAFFIC TYPE 3638.52 1 MOD_TRAT -1... 3
CANCEL TRAFFIC TYPE CODE POINT 3643.46 1 CAN_TRATCPT -1... 1
CREATE TRAFFIC TYPE CODE POINT 3641.56 1 CR_TRATCPT -1... 2
DISPLAY TRAFFIC TYPE CODE POINT 3644.56 1 DISP_TRATCPT -1... 2
MODIFY TRAFFIC TYPE CODE POINT 3642.56 1 MOD_TRATCPT -1... 2
Display Trace Buffer 1.00 1 DISP_TRCB -1... 1
Modify Trace Buffer Layout 1.00 1 MOD_TRCB -1... 1
Define Trace Conditions 1.00 1 DEF_TRCCOND -1... 1
Define Tracedata 1.00 1 DEF_TRCDATA -1... 1
CANCEL TRUNK DATA 687.42 1 CAN_TRDAT -1... 3
ENTER TRUNK DATA 686.42 1 ENTR_TRDAT -1... 3
Define Trigger Functions 1.00 1 DEF_TRIGFUNC -1... 1
DISPLAY TRUNK METER 262.02 1 DISP_TRMET -1... 1
DISPLAY TRAFFIC OBJECTS 1575.00 1 DISP_TRO -1... 1
CANCEL TRAFFIC OBJECTS DESTINATION 1576.02 1 CAN_TRODEST -1... 1
ENTER TRAFFIC OBJECTS DESTINATION 1562.02 1 ENTR_TRODEST -1... 1
CANCEL TRAFFIC OBJECT DIGITAL LINE UNIT 1570.00 1 CAN_TRODLU -1... 1
ENTER TRAFFIC OBJECT DIGITAL LINE UNIT 1569.01 1 ENTR_TRODLU -1... 1
CANCEL TRAFFIC OBJECTS GROUP 1577.00 1 CAN_TROGRP -1... 1
CREATE TRAFFIC OBJECT GROUP 1558.04 1 CR_TROGRP -1... 1
DISPLAY TRAFFIC OBJECTS GROUPS 1574.00 1 DISP_TROGRP -1... 1
CANCEL TRAFFIC OBJ INCOM OUTGO TRUNK GRP 1573.00 1 CAN_TROICOGT -1... 1

CONT-26 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

ENTER TRAFFIC OBJ INCOM OUTGO TRUNK GRP 1559.01 1 ENTR_TROICOGT -1... 1
CANCEL TRAFFIC OBJ PRIMARY RATE ACCESS 3069.00 1 CAN_TROPA -1... 1
ENTER TRAFFIC OBJECT PRIMARY RATE ACCESS 3066.01 1 ENTR_TROPA -1... 1
CAN TRAFFIC OBJ PRIVATE BRANCH EXCHANGE 1561.01 1 CAN_TROPBX -1... 1
ENTR TRAFFIC OBJ PRIVATE BRANCH EXCHANGE 1560.03 1 ENTR_TROPBX -1... 1
CANCEL TRAFFIC OBJECT PBX LINE 1572.04 1 CAN_TROPBXLN -1... 1
ENTER TRAFFIC OBJECT PBX LINE 1571.05 1 ENTR_TROPBXLN -1... 1
CANCEL TRAFFIC OBJECTS SUBSCRIBER 1564.03 1 CAN_TROSUB -1... 1
ENTER TRAFFIC OBJECTS SUBSCRIBER 1563.04 1 ENTR_TROSUB -1... 1
CANCEL TRAFFIC OBJECT TRUNKGROUP 1566.00 1 CAN_TROTGRP -1... 1
ENTER TRAFFIC OBJECT TRUNKGROUP 1565.01 1 ENTR_TROTGRP -1... 1
CANCEL TRAFFIC OBJECT TRUNK 1568.03 1 CAN_TROTRUNK -1... 1
ENTER TRAFFIC OBJECT TRUNK 1567.04 1 ENTR_TROTRUNK -1... 1
CANCEL TRAFFIC STRUCTURE MEASUREMENT JOB 700.05 1 CAN_TRST -1... 2
DISPLAY TRAFFIC STRUCT. MEASUREMENT JOB 701.01 1 DISP_TRST -1... 1
ENTER TRAFFIC STRUCTURE MEASUREMENT JOB 2670.15 1 ENTR_TRST -1... 4
CANCEL TRUNK RESERVATION CONTROL 2026.01 1 CAN_TRSVCNTL -1... 1
DISPLAY TRUNK RESERVATION CONTROL 2028.02 1 DISP_TRSVCNTL -1... 1
ENTER TRUNK RESERVATION CONTROL 2030.08 1 ENTR_TRSVCNTL -1... 3
MODIFY TRUNK RESERVATION CONTROL 2032.07 1 MOD_TRSVCNTL -1... 2
CANCEL TRUNK RESERVATION TRAFFIC CRIT. 2027.04 1 CAN_TRSVCRIT -1... 3
DISPLAY TRUNK RESERVATION TRAFFIC CRIT. 2029.06 1 DISP_TRSVCRIT -1... 2
ENTER TRUNK RESERVATION TRAFFIC CRITERIA 2031.05 1 ENTR_TRSVCRIT -1... 4
CANCEL TRUNK RESERVATION TRAFFIC 3811.00 1 CAN_TRSVTRAF -1... 1
DISPLAY TRUNK RESERVATION TRAFFIC 3812.00 1 DISP_TRSVTRAF -1... 2
ENTER TRUNK RESERVATION TRAFFIC 3810.02 1 ENTR_TRSVTRAF -1... 5
MODIFY TRUNK RESERVATION TRAFFIC 3942.02 1 MOD_TRSVTRAF -1... 7
ACTIVATE TRUNK TRAP 346.30 1 ACT_TRTRAP -1... 18
CANCEL TRUNK TRAP 347.30 1 CAN_TRTRAP -1... 6
DISPLAY TRIPLE TEST VALUES 2035.00 1 DISP_TRTVAL -1... 1
ENTER TRIPLE TEST VALUES 2037.00 1 ENTR_TRTVAL -1... 2
CANCEL TRUNK 15.42 1 CAN_TRUNK -1... 2
CREATE TRUNK 12.42 1 CR_TRUNK -1... 12
DISPLAY TRUNK 189.42 1 DISP_TRUNK -1... 4
DISPLAY STATUS OF TRUNK 355.35 1 STAT_TRUNK -1... 6
CONFIGURE TIME STAGE GROUP 972.17 1 CONF_TSG -1... 2
DIAGNOSE TIME STAGE GROUP 975.00 1 DIAG_TSG -1... 3
TEST SPEECH PATHS THROUGH THE TSG 973.00 1 TEST_TSG -1... 5
CREATE TSM 4122.00 1 CR_TSM -1... 1
RELEASE TEST CALL 1280.15 1 REL_TSTCALL -1... 1
SET UP TEST CALL 1283.24 1 SETUP_TSTCALL -1... 24
DISPLAY TESTING JOBS 803.01 1 DISP_TSTJOB -1... 1
CHANGE TEST OBJECT 1273.24 1 CHANGE_TSTOBJ -1... 24
DISPLAY UPDATE 406.02 1 DISP_UPDATE -1... 1
Modify Mass Update on MP 1.00 1 MOD_UPDATEMP -1... 1
ACTIVATE UPDATE CHECKPOINTING 4226.10 1 ACT_UPDCHP -1... 1
Stop Upgrade on MP 1.00 1 STOP_UPGMP -1... 1
Display Upgraded Object Classes on MP 1.00 1 DISP_UPGOCMP -1... 1
CANCEL USER IDENTIFICATION 2860.01 1 CAN_USERID -1... 1
CREATE USER IDENTIFICATION 2856.39 1 CR_USERID -1... 2
DISPLAY USER IDENTIFICATION 2861.00 1 DISP_USERID -1... 1
MODIFY USER IDENTIFICATION 2862.39 1 MOD_USERID -1... 3
DISPLAY USSD TEXT 2491.00 1 DISP_USSDTXT -1... 1
MODIFY USSD TEXT 2492.39 1 MOD_USSDTXT -1... 3
Cancel Virtual Channel 1.00 1 CAN_VCHAN -1... 1
Create Virtual Channel 1.00 1 CR_VCHAN -1... 2
Display Virtual Channel 1.00 1 DISP_VCHAN -1... 2
Modify Virtual Channel 1.00 1 MOD_VCHAN -1... 1
Diagnose Virtual Channel with Loopback 1.00 1 DIAG_VCHANLPB -1... 2
CANCEL VOICE GROUP SERVICE AREA 4053.18 1 CAN_VGSAREA -1... 1
CREATE VOICE GROUP SERVICE AREA 4051.34 1 CR_VGSAREA -1... 2
DISPLAY VOICE GROUP SERVICE AREA 4054.39 1 DISP_VGSAREA -1... 3
MODIFY VOICE GROUP SERVICE AREA 4052.34 1 MOD_VGSAREA -1... 3
CANCEL VOICE GROUP SERVICE GROUP 4062.00 1 CAN_VGSGRP -1... 1
ENTER VOICE GROUP SERVICE GROUP 4060.00 1 ENTR_VGSGRP -1... 2
CANCEL VOICE GROUP SERV. CALL REFERENCE 4057.18 1 CAN_VGSREF -1... 1
CREATE VOICE GROUP SERV. CALL REFERENCE 4055.34 1 CR_VGSREF -1... 6
DISPLAY VOICE GROUP SERV. CALL REFERENCE 4058.39 1 DISP_VGSREF -1... 2
MODIFY VOICE GROUP SERV. CALL REFERENCE 4056.34 1 MOD_VGSREF -1... 6
RECORD VISITOR LOCATION REGISTER DATA 1931.18 1 REC_VLR -1... 4
CANCEL VOICE MAIL SERVICE 3298.94 1 CAN_VMS -1... 1
CREATE VOICE MAIL SERVICE 3299.94 1 CR_VMS -1... 1
DISPLAY VOICE MAIL SERVICE 3300.94 1 DISP_VMS -1... 1
MODIFY VOICE MAIL SERVICE 3302.94 1 MOD_VMS -1... 1

CONT-27 + P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
Contents and Issue Information

Command Description Number Issue Command Code Pages

CANCEL VOICE RECOGNITION 2348.00 1 CAN_VOICEREC -1... 1


CREATE VOICE RECOGNITION 2346.00 1 CR_VOICEREC -1... 1
DISPLAY VOICE RECOGNITION 2349.00 1 DISP_VOICEREC -1... 1
MODIFY VOICE RECOGNITION 2347.00 1 MOD_VOICEREC -1... 1
Cancel Virtual Path 1.00 1 CAN_VPATH -1... 1
Create Virtual Path 1.00 1 CR_VPATH -1... 2
Display Virtual Path 1.00 1 DISP_VPATH -1... 2
Modify Virtual Path 1.00 1 MOD_VPATH -1... 2
CONFIGURE VOICE PROCESSING UNIT 4143.00 1 CONF_VPU -1... 1
DIAGNOSE VOICE PROCESSING UNIT RECEIVERS 4144.00 1 DIAG_VPU -1... 1
DISP. STATUS VPU RECEIVERS 4145.00 1 STAT_VPU -1... 1
COPY VSD DATABASE BACKUP FILE 4125.15 1 COPY_VSD -1... 1
MERGE VSD 4088.28 1 MERGE_VSD -1... 1
RELINK VSD RECORDS 4127.14 1 RLINK_VSD -1... 1
UPDATE VSD BACKUP FILE 4128.14 1 UPD_VSD -1... 1
DISPLAY VSD DATABASE STATISTIC DATA 4126.15 1 DISP_VSDSTAT -1... 1
CANCEL VLR MOBILE SUBSCRIBER DATA 4225.35 1 CAN_VSUB -1... 2
DISPLAY VLR MOBILE SUBSCRIBER DATA 3349.35 1 DISP_VSUB -1... 2
DISPLAY VLR SUBSCRIBER DATABASE SIZE 4254.35 1 DISP_VSUBDBSZ -1... 1
DISPLAY VLR SUBSCRIBER ORIGINATION 4089.39 1 DISP_VSUBORIG -1... 1
DISPLAY WEEKDAY CATEGORY 685.39 1 DISP_WDCAT -1... 1
MODIFY WEEKDAY CATEGORY 725.39 1 MOD_WDCAT -1... 1
STATUS X25 DATA 3037.01 1 STAT_X25DAT -1... 2
CANCEL X25DTE 2685.00 1 CAN_X25DTE -1... 1
CREATE X25 DATA TERMINAL EQUIPMENT 2689.03 1 CR_X25DTE -1... 12
DISPLAY X25 DATA TERMINAL EQUIPMENT 2695.03 1 DISP_X25DTE -1... 3
MODIFY X25 DATA TERMINAL EQUIPMENT 2701.03 1 MOD_X25DTE -1... 3
CANCEL X25 LINK 2512.02 1 CAN_X25LINK -1... 1
CONFIGURE X25 LINK 2513.02 1 CONF_X25LINK -1... 1
CREATE X25 LINK 2509.05 1 CR_X25LINK -1... 10
DISPLAY X25 LINK 2511.02 1 DISP_X25LINK -1... 1
MODIFY X25 LINK 2510.05 1 MOD_X25LINK -1... 10
CANCEL X25PVC 2520.02 1 CAN_X25PVC -1... 1
CREATE X25PVC 2519.02 1 CR_X25PVC -1... 3
DISPLAY X25PVC 2521.04 1 DISP_X25PVC -1... 2
CANCEL X25ROUTE 2686.00 1 CAN_X25ROUTE -1... 1
CREATE X25ROUTE 2690.03 1 CR_X25ROUTE -1... 4
DISPLAY X25ROUTE 2696.01 1 DISP_X25ROUTE -1... 1
ACTIVATE X25 STATISTICS 2754.00 1 ACT_X25STC -1... 2
DEACTIVATE X25 STATISTICS 2755.00 1 DACT_X25STC -1... 1
DISPLAY X25 STATISTICS INFORMATION 2756.00 1 DISP_X25STC -1... 1
DUMP X25 STATISTICS 2581.01 1 DMP_X25STC -1... 2
ACTIVATE X25 TRACER 2501.02 1 ACT_X25TRAC -1... 9
DEACTIVATE X25 TRACER 2502.01 1 DACT_X25TRAC -1... 2
DISPLAY X25 TRACER INFORMATION 2504.00 1 DISP_X25TRAC -1... 1
DUMP X25 TRACE DATA 2503.01 1 DMP_X25TRAC -1... 3
DISPLAY ZONING INFORMATION 2869.04 1 DISP_ZOINF -1... 1
MODIFY ZONING INFORMATION 2868.04 1 MOD_ZOINF -1... 1
CANCEL ZONE POINT 29.72 1 CAN_ZOPT -1... 4
CREATE ZONE POINT 26.72 1 CR_ZOPT -1... 8
DISPLAY ZONE POINT 190.72 1 DISP_ZOPT -1... 5
MERGE ZONE POINT 388.72 1 MERGE_ZOPT -1... 7
MODIFY ZONE POINT 37.72 1 MOD_ZOPT -1... 8
SPLIT ZONE POINT 386.72 1 SPLIT_ZOPT -1... 7

CONT-28 - P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
D900 IN
IN Introduction
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

INTRODUCTION TO TML/OML

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 IN-1
IN D900
Introduction IN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

IN-2 P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
D900 IN
IN Introduction
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The Task Manual (TML) is a reference document which contains all tasks needed to
operate the system including those tasks intended only for system specialists
with special authorization.
Technological advances have led to changes in the way the switch is addressed.
Concretely this means that there are new interfaces via which communication with
the switch possible. Therefore some tasks communicate with the switch via
traditional commands, others via a slightly different input format. For the
sake of continuity all of these elements will be called tasks in future and will
be described in this document. As in the past, the reader accesses the required
information from the TML Table of Contents, or if task access is made from one
of the D900 manuals, through links in those documents.

Care has been taken to make input format representation as similar as possible.
There are however differences which the user must be aware of. For example the
output masks for traditional commands are described in an independent document
(OML). The outputs in the new form of tasks, if further clarification is required,
are described in the relevant task in this document. Another example is that the
length of the input parameters is not limited to 8 characters in the new tasks,
the parameter names may be up to 20 characters long.

Structure

The structure of the TML is as follows:

À Overview and Index of issues


À Introduction
À Cross reference lists for MML
À Task descriptions

Overview and Index of Issues

The TML overview makes up the administration section. The overview contains all
tasks in tabular order. All entries contain an issue report and, if necessary,
a change designation.

In addition it contains a list of the other TML sections, for example Introduction.
The overview contains links which allow the user to jump to the information in the
other TML section.

Introduction

The Introduction contains specific instruction for using the TML including the
differences relevant to operation between traditional commands (MML tasks) and the
newer tasks. Where the information is valid for all tasks, it appears only once.
Where there are differences it is clearly stated for which type of task the
information is intended.

Task descriptions

The task descriptions are the main part of the TML and reflect the set of tasks
relevant to a specific APS. Task descriptions include information about the syntax,
parameters, and where applicable paths and parameter values.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 IN-3
IN D900
Introduction IN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Task descriptions are structured as follows:

1. Task short and long name


2. Task helptext
3. Task syntax
4. Parameter information including general parameter information, and where
applicable, subparameter and parameter value information

Input syntax

This section provides an overview of the input format for tasks and the syntax.
The syntax is displayed in Backus-Naur Notation:

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB@BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 Graphic display of 1 Comment 1
1 parameters 1 1
ABBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBCBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB2
1 DEMO= 1 Entering the parameters is 1
1 1 mandatory. 1
ABBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBCBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB2
1 [,DEMO ] 1 Entering the parameters is 1
1 1 optional. 1
ABBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBCBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB2
1 (,DEMO1=) 1 Entering exactly one parameter 1
1 Z,DEMO2=Y 1 is mandatory. 1
1 * + 1 1
ABBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBCBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB2
1 X (,DEMO1=) = 1 Entering exactly one parameter 1
1 1 Z,DEMO2=Y 1 1 is optional. 1
1 > * + W 1 1
ABBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBCBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB2
1 [ ,DEMO1=,DEMO2= ] 1 Entering all parameter or none 1
1 1 entered. 1
ABBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBCBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB2
1 [ ,DEMO1= [ ,DEMO2= ] ] 1 Possible combinations: 1
1 1 - Enter all parameters 1
1 1 - Enter only parameter DEMO1 1
1 1 - Enter both parameters 1
1 1 (Parameter DEMO2 alone may 1
1 1 not be entered.) 1
ABBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBCBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB2
1 <,DEMO1=,DEMO2=,DEMO3= > 1 At least one parameter must 1
1 1 be entered. 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB?BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

The syntax diagrams contain links which allow direct access to the individual
parameter descriptions.

IN-4 P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
IN D900
Introduction IN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MML task specific

MML tasks which can be used for different purposes are split into different input
formats (paths). This applies particularly in cases in which the above mentioned
syntax is not able to represent all the dependencies among parameters, parameters
and parameter values, or among parameter values. An overview of the input formats
is given at the beginning of each command description.

Example: The MML task has the following paths:

1. CR TEQ - ATCL ACCESS TEST CIRCUIT SUB LINE


2. CR TEQ - ATE AUTOMATIC TEST EQUIPMENT
3. CR TEQ - ATEMAN ATE FOR TESTING AND MEASURING
4. CR TEQ - ATESELF ATE FOR SELFTEST
5. CR TEQ - TEMLE TEST MODULE LEVEL
6. CR TEQ - TESTSET TEST SET
7. CR TEQ - RBSI RING BACK SERVICE INTEGRATED
8. CR TEQ - TLFI TRANSLATION FUNCTION INTEGRAT.
9. CR TEQ - ADDATE ADDITIONAL ATE PORT

The paths also contain links which allow direct access to the individual input
descriptions.

Input parameters

The description of the input parameters explains the syntax of the individual
parameters.
In the simplest cases, parameters are described by the parameter short and long
name and the parameter value range. The parameter value range may be, e.g. a range
of decimal numbers or it may be defined by a specific character set as shown below:

Alphanumeric symbolic names: A...Z 0...9. + * % #

Alphanumeric text strings: A...Z 0...9. + * % # < ( & ! $ ) ; - / ,


_ > ? : @ ’ =
<enter> <line feed>

Text strings must be enclosed in quotation marks ("). If a quotation mark must be
included in a text string, it must be doubled (""). The maximum length of a text
string including the quotation marks is 72 characters.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 IN-5
D900 IN
IN Introduction
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Example:

PARDM1 PARAMETER DEMONSTRATION 1 =


5...8 characters from the symbolic name character set

However in certain cases, mnemonic abbreviations may be entered for a parameter.


These abbreviations are also called identifiers. Identifiers have short and long
names and may be supplemented by a help text.

Example:

PARDM2 PARAMETER DEMONSTRATION 2=


IDF1 LONGNAME IDENTIFIER NO.1
IDF2 LONGNAME IDENTIFIER NO.2

Under certain circumstances a parameter may have up to 4 subparameters.


Subparameters are also called information units; they must be separated
by a hyphen. In the Task Manual, information units are symbolized by the
lowercase letters a, b, c, and d.

Example:

PARDM3 PARAMETER DEMONSTRATION 3 =


a-b-c-d

a: FIRST INFORMATION UNIT =


0...7, range of decimal numbers

b: SECOND INFORMATION UNIT =

etc.

The so-called new and old parameters are also represented by lowercase
letters.

Example:

DIGIT DIGITS =
The parameter specifies the prefix digits for test multiple.
n/o
n/
/o
1...8 hexadecimal number where B is interchangeable with *
and C is interchangeable with #

In this case, new and old have a very general meaning.

EXAMPLE:

MOD TEQ: DIGITS=newvalue/oldvalue Changes the prefix digit


new value/old value
MOD TEQ: DIGITS=newvalue/ Enters new prefix digit
MOD TEQ: DIGITS= /oldvalue Deletes old prefix digit

IN-6 P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
IN D900
Introduction IN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Default values

If the syntax allows omission of a parameter or subparameter, the key word


"Default" in the parameter help text describes how the system will responds.
The following cases are possible:

- Default value: <value>


<value> is a parameter value within the permissible range that is
automatically used if the parameter is omitted.

- Default behavior: <value>


Values given are added to the default value.
This combination indicates that one can add other values to default values.

- Default behavior: <text>


<text> describes the behavior of the system if the parameter is
omitted. This option is selected if it is not possible to specify
a default value.

Examples:

- Optional parameter DATE


Default value: current date.
The current date is used.

- Option selection parameter for DISP and STAT commands


Default behavior: no restriction of output
Output is not restricted by omission of the parameter.

- Optional control parameter for CR, ENTR, CAN and MOD commands
Default behavior: no effect on the database
The database is not modified.

- Optional control parameter for ACT, DACT, DIAG and TEST commands
Default behavior: no effect on the process
The process is not affected by omission of the parameter.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 IN-7
D900 IN
IN Introduction
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

OML structure

The OML contains the following registers:

TAB - Cross-reference lists


MASK - Status reports

More information on these registers is provided below. All examples given are
fictitious; they may not be part of the actual software.

The OML contains the status reports and the cross-reference lists that
allow you to assign output mask numbers to report groups.

The cross-reference list is subdivided into two tables that are sorted
as follows:

- Report group, mask number, mask variant and, if necessary, the command

- Mask number, mask variant, report group and, if necessary, the command

MASK

Masks that occur in various situations are described only once.


For this reason, parameters may be listed for a mask that do not
apply in a specific case.

The explanation includes

- the reason for the report,


- remedies, and
- the meaning of the output parameters.

The output parameters are displayed in a grid.

Example:

1
1
1 2 3 i 4 5 6 7
123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890123456789012
XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
0 1 1
1 1 TEXTTEXT TEXT TEXT TEXTTEXTTEXT TEXT 1
2 1 1
3 1 PARAM2 1
4 1 BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB 1
BB§5 1 XXXXXX 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Output parameters

Position of the Meaning of the output


output in the
mask
(row, column)
BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB
5,32 PARAMETER 2 =
:
:
:
etc.

IN-8 P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619
IN D900
Introduction IN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

For a detailed explanation of the output parameters, please refer to the parameters
on the command level. These parameters can be found in the OML cross-reference
lists and in the associated basic commands in the CMD part; these are usually
setup commands.

Example:
You need a detailed explanation of the output parameter value of a report.
This information can be found by referring to the five-digit mask number that
appears in the mask header. The mask number is the number following the
forward slash, for example, 3077/00045.
By looking up the mask number in the OML cross-reference list, you can find
the command that initiated this report. For example, this could be the display
command of the object. Detailed information can then be found in the create
command for the object.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 IN-9
DISP A4TPVAL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY A4 TESTPATTERN VALUE

This is a command to administrate the reference patterns used to


test the A4 algorithm.
With this command you can display reference values for one or
all the 16 available test reference patterns.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP A4TPVAL : ELEMNO= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ELEMNO ELEMENT NUMBER

This parameter indicates the number of the test pattern, you want
to display.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP A4TPVAL- 1-


ENTR A4TPVAL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER A4 TESTPATTERN VALUE

This is a command to administrate the reference patterns used to


test the A4 algorithm.
With this command you can enter new reference values for one of
the 16 available test reference patterns.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR A4TPVAL : ELEMNO= ,A4TP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ELEMNO ELEMENT NUMBER

This parameter indicates the number of the test pattern, you want
to change.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

A4TP A4 TESTPATTERN

This parameter specifies a reference pattern for the A4 algorithm


test.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: 8 NIBBLES=
1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 NIBBLES=
1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 NIBBLES=
1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

d: 8 NIBBLES=
1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR A4TPVAL- 1-


REC AC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RECORD AUTHENTICATION CENTRE DATA

This command records the authentication center related data.

Prerequisites:
- System time must be secure when the command is entered.

Notes:
- Only 1 measurement job can be started.
- The measurement can be stopped with STOP JOB if the time
parameter values allow a continuation of the job.
- This command is only allowed for an AC.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command starts a semipermanent job. It can be canceled with CAN JOB.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REC AC : UNIT= [,BEG=] [,TER=] [,IV=] [,PER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

UNIT UNIT

This parameter specifies the output unit and the form of output.
Only one of the possible alternatives may be selected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: DEVICE
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
If this option is selected, a measurement file
is created and the received traffic data are
output to this file. After the parameter has
been accepted and at the end of the last
recording, an acknowledgement is output to
the OMT. It includes the name of the file in
which the traffic data are available for
postprocessing.
For postprocessing, the data must first be
copied to tape.

Notes:
- Identifier a covers both MDD and MOD.

This information unit specifies the output unit.

b: FILETYPE
SINGLE SINGLE FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
output to single measurement files.
DAILY DAILY FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
output to daily files. This is appropriate in
connection with continuous measurements which
start immediately and have no defined end.
To secure the required space on disk, all 7
daily files (MO...SU) are prepared and created
before the command is accepted.
Time parameters are not permissible for these
measurements.
A daily file is closed at the end of the day
and a new file for the next day is automatically
created on disk or the existing file is replaced.
In the second and subsequent weeks, the file
for the same day of the week is overwritten.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC AC- 1+


REC AC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CYCLIC CYCLIC FILE


If this option is selected, the data are
written into a cyclic measurement file.
Time parameters are not permitted for these
measurements.
If the cyclic file runs full the newest
data will be overwritten.
This occurs after a period of two days.

This information unit specifies the desired output form


(daily files or single measurement, or cyclic files).

BEG BEGINNING DATE

This parameter specifies the measurement begin time.

Notes:
- The begin date BEG and/or the termination date TER must be
specified.
Exception : time parameters may not be specified for the data output
in daily and cyclic files.
- A maximum of four BEG dates (in ascending order) may be linked
with &. In case of linked BEG dates, TER is not permissible.
- The earliest possible begin date is the day after entry.
- It is not permissible to enter the command after 23:45 hours with a
begin date on the following day.
- The first measurement may not begin later than one month after the
current day. Subsequent measurements may not begin later than one
year after the current date.

Default: current date

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the year of the begin


date.

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the month of the begin


date.

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the day of the begin


date.

TER TERMINATING DATE

This parameter specifies the measurement termination date.

Notes:
- Only one termination date may be entered per command.
The earliest possible termination date is the day after entry.
- The measurement duration may not exceed one year.
- The begin date BEG and/or the termination date TER must
be specified.
Exception: time parameters may not be specified for data output
in daily and cyclic files.

Default: the end of the measurement is determined by the single day


measurement.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC AC- 2+


REC AC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the year in which


recording is to terminate.

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the month in which


recording is to terminate.

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the day on which


recording is to terminate.

IV INTERVAL TIME

This parameter specifies the measurement interval times.

Notes:
- A maximum of 4 measurement intervals may be linked with &.
- Interval times are only permissible in connection with a
begin date (BEG).

Incompatibilities:
- Intervals covering more than one day (e.g. 23-00-01-00).
- Intervals separated by a break of less than one hour.

Default: 24-hour measurement on the specified days.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: BEGIN HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the hour at which the


measurement interval begins.

b: BEGIN MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the minutes past the hour at


which the measurement interval begins.

Notes:
- Possible values : 0, 15, 30 and 45.

c: END HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the hour at which the


measurement interval terminates.

d: END MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the minutes past the hour at


which the measurement interval terminates.

Notes:
- Possible values : 0, 15, 30 and 45.

PER PERIODICAL WEEKDAY

This parameter specifies the days of the week on which

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC AC- 3+


REC AC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

recording is to take place.

Notes:
- The input of weekdays is only permissible in connection with
a termination date (TER).

Default: daily measurement during the measurement period.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC AC- 4-


DIAG ACALGOR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSE AC ALGORITHMS

This command diagnoses the security algorithms of the authentication


center.

PREREQUISITES:
- The unit concerned must be MBL.

CAUTION:
- The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the authentication center.

This command is only permitted if an authentication center


(AC) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG ACALGOR : IOPAUC= [,TESTOP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOPAUC IOPAUC NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...43, range of decimal numbers

TESTOP TEST OPTIONS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TRIPLE TRIPLE GENERATION


ALGOR4 ALGORITHM TO CODE SECUR. PARAM
RANDOM RANDOM GENERATOR
NBSDES NAT. BUREAU DATA ENCRYP. STAN.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG ACALGOR- 1-


TEST ACALGOR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TEST AC ALGORITHMS

This command tests the security algorithms of the authentication center.

PREREQUISITES:
- The unit concerned must be ACT.

CAUTION:
- The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the authentication center.

This command is only permitted if an authentication center


(AC) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 TEST ACALGOR : IOPAUC= [,TESTOP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOPAUC IOPAUC NUMBER

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...43, range of decimal numbers

TESTOP TEST OPTIONS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TRIPLE TRIPLE GENERATION


ALGOR4 ALGORITHM TO CODE SECUR. PARAM
RANDOM RANDOM GENERATOR
NBSDES NAT. BUREAU DATA ENCRYP. STAN.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST ACALGOR- 1-


CAN ACC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL AUTOMATIC CONGESTION CONTROL

This command cancels an automatic congestion control element.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN ACC : NAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NAME ACC ELEMENT NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the automatic congestion control


element.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ACC- 1-


DISP ACC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY AUTOMATIC CONGESTION CONTROL

This command displays data for


- one automatic congestion control element,
- a maximum of two automatic congestion control elements according to the
addressed trunk group number, or
- all automatic congestion control elements.
When addressing with the trunk group number the element for
CNTRL = CANCEL is displayed before the element for CNTRL = SKIP
if both elements exist for this trunk group.
If all elements are displayed, the display can be sorted by NAME or TGNO.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1NAME=1 1
1 DISP ACC : ZTGNO=Y ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NAME ACC ELEMENT NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the automatic congestion control


element to be displayed.
If X is entered, the elements will be displayed in alphabetical order
of parameter NAME.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number to be displayed.


If X is entered, the elements will be displayed in alphabetical order
of parameter TGNO.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ACC- 1-


ENTR ACC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER AUTOMATIC CONGESTION CONTROL

This command creates or modifies an automatic congestion control element.


If an overload occurs in a succeeding exchange the responding congestion level
is sent to the preceding exchange. In the preceding exchange the reaction of
the overload has to be administrated if it is needed by the commands for
automatic congestion control traffic and automatic congestion control.
The overload is sent via a trunk of a trunk group. Therefore the indicator can
be administrated by the command CR TGRP with GCOS = SENDACCL.
The automatic congestion control element connects the relevant trunk group with
one automatic congestion control traffic element per type of CNTRL.
This means a maximum of two automatic congestion control traffic elements can be
assigned per trunk group. The assigned values for CNTRL = CANCEL
are preferred to the assigned values for CNTRL = SKIP.
The parameter INCEPT depends on parameter CNTRL:
In the case of CNTRL = CANCEL the parameter INCEPT is mandatory.
In the case of CNTRL = SKIP the parameter INCEPT is optional, i.e. only
relevant if there is an overflow in the last trunk group to a destination.
If CNTRL (i.e. = SKIP) is entered without a value for parameter INCEPT an
already existing value of parameter INCEPT is canceled.
Prerequisites: - the automatic congestion control traffic element must already
exist
- the trunk group must already exist
- only allowed for ISUP trunk groups.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR ACC : NAME= <,TGNO= ,ACCTRAF= ,BLK= ,CNTRL= ,INCEPT=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NAME ACC ELEMENT NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the automatic congestion control


element. The name must be unique.

Six control types share a naming pool:


- CR CBPT,
- ENTR TRSVCNTL,
- ENTR NMCNTL with CNTRL = SKIP,
- ENTR NMCNTL with CNTRL = CANTO,
- ENTR NMCNTL with CNTRL = CANFROM,
- ENTR ACC.
This means that each NAME may only be used by one of these
controls.
The user may specify any name not yet used in the above-mentioned
naming pool except for two specific values:
- The user must not choose a single "X" as name because this input
stands for all existing values of a display command parameter.
- The NAME "MABEZ" is reserved for the mass call control function
which is an automatic network management control.
Therefore "MABEZ" must not be entered in this command.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.


This parameter must be entered when the element is created and may not
be entered if additional data of the element are modified.
The trunk group number must already exist.
The parameter value cannot be changed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ACC- 1+


ENTR ACC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ACCTRAF ACC TRAFFIC ELEMENT NAME

This parameter specifies the automatic congestion control traffic


element for the relevant type of CNTRL.
This parameter must be entered when the element is created.
The automatic congestion control traffic element must already exist.
Redundant entry of a value is allowed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

BLK BLOCKING

This parameter specifies the blocking entered for the automatic


congestion control element.
Redundant entry of a value is allowed.
Standard Behavior: If no value is entered for this parameter
the value NONE is set at creation of
a new element. The existing value is not
changed if an existing element is modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NONE NO BLOCK
ADMIN ADMINISTRATIVE BLOCK
This blocking prevents activation of the
administrated control, even when an overload
occurs.

CNTRL NETWORK MANAGEMENT CONTROL

This parameter specifies the type of control.


Redundant entry of a value is allowed.
Standard Behavior: If no value is entered for this parameter
the value SKIP is set at creation of
a new element. The existing value is not
changed if an existing element is modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SKIP SKIP TO THE NEXT TGRP


The traffic percentages defined in the given
automatic congestion control traffic element
are rejected for this trunk group and flow over
to the next trunk group of the routing list.
In the case of modification, an existing
INCEPT-value is canceled.
CANCEL CANCEL THE CALL
The traffic percentages defined in the given
automatic congestion control traffic element
are rejected for this trunk group. Overflow to
the next trunk group is prevented.
Prerequisites: INCEPT is mandatory.

INCEPT INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the intercept, which defines the system


reaction for rejected calls.
Redundant entry of a value is allowed.
The parameter is mandatory in the case of CNTRL = CANCEL
and optional in the case of CNTRL = SKIP.
If parameter CNTRL is changed to value SKIP, an existing
INCEPT-value is canceled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NETWOMA0 NETWORK MANAGEMENT 0


NETWOMA1 NETWORK MANAGEMENT 1
NETWOMA2 NETWORK MANAGEMENT 2
NETWOMA3 NETWORK MANAGEMENT 3
NETWOMA4 NETWORK MANAGEMENT 4

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ACC- 2+


ENTR ACC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NETWOMA5 NETWORK MANAGEMENT 5


NETWOMA6 NETWORK MANAGEMENT 6

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ACC- 3-


STAT ACC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISP. STATUS OF AUTOM. CONGEST. CONTROL

This command displays the status for


- one automatic congestion control element,
- a maximum of two automatic congestion control elements according to the
addressed trunk group number, or
- all automatic congestion control elements.
When addressing with the trunk group number the element for
CNTRL = CANCEL is displayed before the element for CNTRL = SKIP
if both elements exist for one trunk group.
If all elements are displayed, the display can be sorted by NAME or TGNO.
Only elements which received a congestion level are considered.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1NAME=1 1
1 STAT ACC : ZTGNO=Y ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NAME ACC ELEMENT NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the automatic congestion control


element to be displayed.
If X is entered, the elements will be displayed in alphabetical order
of parameter NAME.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number to be displayed.


If X is entered, the elements will be displayed in alphabetical order
of parameter TGNO.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT ACC- 1-


DISP ACCFG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Access Control Configuration

This task displays the global parameters of Q3 Access Control:


’Default access’, ’Denial response’, ’Sec. administrator’ and
’Rule restriction’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ACCFG ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ACCFG- 1-


MOD ACCFG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Access Control Configuration

This task modifies the global parameters of Q3 Access Control.


It is used for an initial setup of the Access Control System and
to change the default access rights after definition of
individual Access Control ’Rules’.

!!!!! C A U T I O N !!!!!

Do not change the ’Default access’ before defining a ’Sec.


administrator’ and setting up access rights by Access Control
’Rules’. Otherwise any Q3 operation might be rejected and no
further administration would be possible.

Therefore:

1. Always set up the ’Sec. administrator’ first: assign the AET


of the NetM (user group) that is used to administrate the Q3
security data base. This will ensure that this NetM (user group)
can always access the Q3 Access Control data base, e.g. to
correct incorrect Access Control ’Rules’ or an incorrect
’Default access’. The ’Sec. administrator should be assigned
already during installation of a new network element.
2. Set up your Access Control data base and assign access rights for
Q3 operations.
3. Change the ’Default access’ - to disable unauthorized Q3 access -
only after individual access rights have been set up.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ACCFG : [Default access=] [,Denial response=] 1
1 1
1 [,Sec. administrator=] [,Rule restriction=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Default access

This parameter defines ’Default access’ rights for Q3


operations. ’Default access’ rights are applied if
there is no matching Access Control ’Rule’.
’Default access’ should be set to ’Deny’ after creating
the ’Rules’ for an individual Access Control system.

!!!!! C A U T I O N !!!!!:

’Default access’ must be changed to ’Deny’ only, after


you have assigned a ’Sec. administrator’ AET and after
you have assigned Q3 access rights by Access Control
’rules’. Otherwise any Q3 administration might be
inhibited.

Input format:
’Deny’ : Denies default access right for the Q3 operation.
’Allow’ : Grants default access right for the Q3 operation.

Select ’Default access’ for the Q3 operations M-GET,


M-SET, M-CREATE, M-DELETE and M-ACTION.

Denial response

This parameter defines the response to a Q3 request which is


rejected due to missing ’Default access’ rights.

Input format:
’Deny’ : Deny by Q3 response "Access Denied"
’Abort’ : Abort Q3 Association

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ACCFG- 1+


MOD ACCFG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Sec. administrator

This parameter defines the AET of a ’Sec. administrator’ application.


An AET represents the address of an application running on a
remote TMN-OS.
The ’Sec. administrator’ is always granted the right to access the
Access Control database.
Q3 Authentication ensures that authentication data is defined
for this AET.
The password used for authentication will not change in the event of
a generation fallback.

Make sure that the AET assigned here is the AET of the initiator
that will be used for Q3 administration in an emergency case, e.g.
after System Recovery with a generation fallback.

Prerequisite:
System access rights for this AET have been defined by Q3
Authentication. Otherwise the parameter is rejected.

Input format: 3 to 16 numbers separated by blank


(AET as "Object Identifier")

Rule restriction

This parameter may be used to restrict the supported ’Rule type’


of the Access Control ’Rules’. Such a restriction may help to make
an Access Control System less complex, and may thus help to avoid
conflicting rules. Therefore, use only ’Allow rules’ and set the
’Default access’ to ’Deny’ for all Q3 operations.

Prerequisite:
If the ’Rule restriction’ is set either to ’Deny rules’ or to
’Allow rules’ only, no Access Control ’Rule’ of the other type
may exist.

Input format:
’Deny rules’ : Only ’Rules’ of ’Type’ ’Deny’ or ’Abort’ are
supported.
’Allow rules’ : Only ’Rules’ of ’Type’ ’Allow’ are supported.
’All rules’ : All ’Rule types’ are supported.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ACCFG- 2-


CAN ACCTRAF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL AUTOM. CONGEST. CONTROL TRAF.

This command cancels an automatic congestion control traffic element.


It may not be connected to an automatic congestion control element.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN ACCTRAF : NAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NAME ACC TRAFFIC ELEMENT NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the automatic congestion control


traffic element.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ACCTRAF- 1-


DISP ACCTRAF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY AUTOM. CONGEST. CONTROL TRAF.

This command displays data for


- one automatic congestion control traffic element, or
- all automatic congestion control traffic elements (in alphabetical order).

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ACCTRAF : NAME= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NAME ACC TRAFFIC ELEMENT NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the automatic congestion control


traffic element.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ACCTRAF- 1-


ENTR ACCTRAF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER AUTOM. CONGEST. CONTROL TRAF.

This command creates or modifies an automatic congestion control traffic


element. With such an element different traffic reduction percentages for the
following congestion level - route type combinations can be administrated:

+--------------------------------------------------------+
Route type Command parameter
----------------------------------------------------------
Congestion level 1 direct route CL1DRT
Congestion level 1 alternate route CL1ART
Congestion level 2 direct route CL2DRT
Congestion level 2 alternate route CL2ART
+--------------------------------------------------------+

Additionally it is possible to administrate per congestion level whether


priority traffic is also affected by the traffic reduction or not.
An automatic congestion control traffic element can be connected to several
automatic congestion control elements (see command ENTR ACC).

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR ACCTRAF : NAME= <,CL1DRT= ,CL1ART= ,CL2DRT= ,CL2ART= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,CL1PRIOT= ,CL2PRIOT=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NAME ACC TRAFFIC ELEMENT NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the automatic congestion control


traffic element. The name must be unique.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CL1DRT CL1 DIRECT ROUTE TRAFFIC

This parameter specifies the traffic reduction for direct route


traffic and a received congestion level 1.
Redundant entry of a value is allowed.
Standard Behavior: If no value is entered for this parameter
the value UNSPEC is set at creation of
a new element. The existing value is not
changed if an existing element is modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PERC0 0 % BLOCKING
PERC12P5 12,5 % BLOCKING
PERC25 25 % BLOCKING
PERC37P5 37,5 % BLOCKING
PERC50 50 % BLOCKING
PERC62P5 62,5 % BLOCKING
PERC75 75 % BLOCKING
PERC87P5 87,5 % BLOCKING
PERC100 100 % BLOCKING
UNSPEC UNSPECIFIED BLOCKING

CL1ART CL1 ALTERNATE ROUTE TRAFFIC

This parameter specifies the traffic reduction for alternate route


traffic and a received congestion level 1.
Redundant entry of a value is allowed.
Standard Behavior: If no value is entered for this parameter

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ACCTRAF- 1+


ENTR ACCTRAF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

the value UNSPEC is set at creation of


a new element. The existing value is not
changed if an existing element is modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PERC0 0 % BLOCKING
PERC12P5 12,5 % BLOCKING
PERC25 25 % BLOCKING
PERC37P5 37,5 % BLOCKING
PERC50 50 % BLOCKING
PERC62P5 62,5 % BLOCKING
PERC75 75 % BLOCKING
PERC87P5 87,5 % BLOCKING
PERC100 100 % BLOCKING
UNSPEC UNSPECIFIED BLOCKING

CL2DRT CL2 DIRECT ROUTE TRAFFIC

This parameter specifies the traffic reduction for direct route


traffic and a received congestion level 2.
Redundant entry of a value is allowed.
Standard Behavior: If no value is entered for this parameter
the value UNSPEC is set at creation of
a new element. The existing value is not
changed if an existing element is modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PERC0 0 % BLOCKING
PERC12P5 12,5 % BLOCKING
PERC25 25 % BLOCKING
PERC37P5 37,5 % BLOCKING
PERC50 50 % BLOCKING
PERC62P5 62,5 % BLOCKING
PERC75 75 % BLOCKING
PERC87P5 87,5 % BLOCKING
PERC100 100 % BLOCKING
UNSPEC UNSPECIFIED BLOCKING

CL2ART CL2 ALTERNATE ROUTE TRAFFIC

This parameter specifies the traffic reduction for alternate route


traffic and a received congestion level 2.
Redundant entry of a value is allowed.
Standard Behavior: If no value is entered for this parameter
the value UNSPEC is set at creation of
a new element. The existing value is not
changed if an existing element is modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PERC0 0 % BLOCKING
PERC12P5 12,5 % BLOCKING
PERC25 25 % BLOCKING
PERC37P5 37,5 % BLOCKING
PERC50 50 % BLOCKING
PERC62P5 62,5 % BLOCKING
PERC75 75 % BLOCKING
PERC87P5 87,5 % BLOCKING
PERC100 100 % BLOCKING
UNSPEC UNSPECIFIED BLOCKING

CL1PRIOT CL1 PRIORITY TRAFFIC

This parameter specifies whether priority traffic is affected by the


administrated reductions for congestion level 1 or not.
Redundant entry of a value is allowed.
Standard Behavior: If no value is entered for this parameter
the value CNTRL is set at creation of
a new element. The existing value is not
changed if an existing element is modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NOCNTRL NO CONTROL OF PRIORITY TRAFFIC

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ACCTRAF- 2+


ENTR ACCTRAF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CNTRL CONTROL OF PRIORITY TRAFFIC

CL2PRIOT CL2 PRIORITY TRAFFIC

This parameter specifies whether priority traffic is affected by the


administrated reductions for congestion level 2 or not.
Redundant entry of a value is allowed.
Standard Behavior: If no value is entered for this parameter
the value CNTRL is set at creation of
a new element. The existing value is not
changed if an existing element is modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NOCNTRL NO CONTROL OF PRIORITY TRAFFIC


CNTRL CONTROL OF PRIORITY TRAFFIC

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ACCTRAF- 3-


ACT ACCUPG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Activate Accounting Upgrade

This task starts the upgrade for Accounting

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT ACCUPG ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT ACCUPG- 1-


DISP ACDATA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY GENERAL ALARM CALL DATA

This command displays the general alarm call data :


- indication whether the alarm call execution is active
- maximum number of alarm call orders in the database
- maximum number of alarm call orders per interval
- maximum number of tries per alarm call order
- number of alarm call orders present in the database
- directory number of the announcement that will be used
to execute the alarm call orders
- directory number of the alarm call trunk group
- index of the alarm call trunk group
- category of the alarm call trunk group
- maximum number of previous intervals where to an alarm
call can be advanced
- indication if an alarm call order should be searched in
the previous intervals when not found in the entered
interval.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ACDATA ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ACDATA- 1-


ENTR ACDATA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER ALARM CALL DATA

This command enters the general alarm call data.

Prerequisites:
- The necessary ports must be available in the LTG’s were the alarm
call program is running.
- At least one announcement trunk group and announcement line must be
available.
- The number of trunk ports and announcement lines must be in proportion
to the maximum number of alarm call executions within one 5 minute interval.
Formula :
2 x D x M x (W + 1) N
N = ˜˜˜˜˜˜˜˜˜˜˜˜˜˜˜˜˜˜˜˜˜˜˜ A = ˜
5 2
N = number of alarm call ports to be created
A = number of announcement lines to be created
D = average time of an alarm call connection in minutes
(ringing time + listening time)
M = number of maximum permitted alarm call orders per 5
minute interval (<= 200)
W = percentage of the alarm call orders that must be repeated

- The timers which determine ringing and listening time should have the
required values, the default values are :
ringing timer : T25 = 30 s.
listening timer : T33 = 30 s.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR ACDATA : <MAX= ,RETRY= ,ANNDN= ,TGRPDN= ,CAT= ,BLOCK= 1
1 1
1 ,ASHIFT= ,ASRCHE= ,OPRRETRY=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MAX MAX NO OF ORDERS PER INTERVAL

This parameter specifies the maximum number of alarm call orders per
5 minute interval.
If there are intervals that contain more alarm call orders than
permitted in the new maximum, the alarm call orders are nevertheless
executed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...200, range of decimal numbers

RETRY NUMBER OF RETRIES

This parameter specifies how often an unsuccessful


executed alarm call order can be re-executed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2, range of decimal numbers

ANNDN ANNOUNCEMENT DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the


announcement that will be used to execute the alarm call
orders.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ACDATA- 1+


ENTR ACDATA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TGRPDN TRUNK GROUP DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the alarm


call trunk group of which the ports will be used to set up
the alarm call.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CAT CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the category of the alarm call trunk group.
The category must be the same as the category entered when creating
the trunk group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

BLOCK BLOCK ALARM CALL EXECUTION

This parameter specifies whether the alarm call execution is active


or not.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO ALARM CALL EXEC. NOT BLOCKED


YES ALARM CALL EXECUTION BLOCKED

ASHIFT ALARM CALL SHIFT

This parameter specifies the maximum permitted number of previous


intervals where to an alarm call can be advanced when the interval,
corresponding the booking time, is full.
The shift function is only valid for orders entered by subscriber
controlled input.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

ASRCHE ALARM CALL ORDER SEARCH METHOD

This parameter indicates whether the ASHIFT-intervals must be


searched for an alarm call order that is not found in the
entered interval. This extended search has only effect for actions
by subscriber controlled input.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SINGLE SEARCH ONLY ENTERED INTERVAL


SHIFTED SEARCH ALSO SHIFT INTERVALS

OPRRETRY ADMOSS OPERATOR RETRY

This parameter indication whether there should be an extra


execution for the automatic and semi-automatic alarm calls
by means of the ADMOSS operator.

Notes:
- when this parameter is omitted there will be no
reexecution. Default value = NO.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO OPERATOR RETRY
When the execution of the automatic and
semi-automatic alarm call orders are unsuccessful
there will be no extra execution by means of the
ADMOSS operator.
YES OPERATOR RETRY
When the execution of the automatic and
semi-automatic alarm call orders are unsuccessful
there will be attempt to have an execution by

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ACDATA- 2+


ENTR ACDATA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

means of the ADMOSS operator.

This parameter specifies whether a reexecution should be


done by means of the ADMOSS operator for automatic and
semi-automatic alarm calls.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ACDATA- 3-


CAN ACHLRID

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL AUTHENTICATION CENTER HLR ID

This command cancels an authentication center home location register


identification (ACHLRID). This identification represents the HLR
(Home Location Register) code of the mobile subscriber identification
number (MSIN).

Prerequisites:
- The mobile subsribers created in the authentication center for this
HLR code must have been deleted with the command CAN ACMSUB.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if an authentication center


(AC) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN ACHLRID : ACHLRID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACHLRID HOME LOCATION REGISTER CODE

ACHLRID = a: 2 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...3 digit decimal number

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ACHLRID- 1-


CR ACHLRID

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE AUTHENTICATION CENTER HLR ID

This command creates an authentication center home location register


identification (ACHLRID). This identification represents the HLR
(Home Location Register) code of the mobile subscriber identification
number (MSIN).

This command should be executed prior to the CR ACMSUB commands.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if an authentication center


(AC) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR ACHLRID : ACHLRID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACHLRID HOME LOCATION REGISTER CODE

ACHLRID = a: 2 Digits

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...3 digit decimal number

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ACHLRID- 1-
DISP ACHLRID

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY AUTHENTICATION CENTER HLR ID

This command displays the home location register identifications that


are created in the authentication center (AC) together with the number
of mobile subsribers that are created per home location register
identification in the AC.
Also the total number of mobile subscribers that are created in the AC
is displayed.

This command is only permitted if an authentication center


(AC) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ACHLRID ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ACHLRID- 1-


CAN ACINIGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Access Control Initiator Group

This task cancels an Access Control ’Initiator group’, which defines a list of
remote initiators.

Prerequisite:
The ’Initiator group’ is no longer be referenced by any Access Control ’Rule’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN ACINIGRP : Initiator group= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Initiator group

This parameter defines a unique name for the ’Initiator


group’. This name is used by an Access Control ’Rule’
to reference the ’Initiator group’.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ACINIGRP- 1-


CR ACINIGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create Access Control Initiator Group

This task creates an Access Control ’Initiator group’ which defines a list of
remote initiators. Each initiator is defined by its AET (Application
Entity Title), which represents the address of an application running on a
remote TMN-OS.
An Access Control ’Initiator group’ is referenced by one or more Access Control
’Rules’ in order to grant or deny access rights to Q3 objects.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR ACINIGRP : Initiator group= ,AET list= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Initiator group

This parameter defines a unique name for the ’Initiator


group’. This name is used by an Access Control ’Rule’
to reference the ’Initiator group’.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

AET list

This parameter defines a list of initiators for this


Access Control ’Initiator group’. Each initiator is represented
by its AET (Application Entity Title).

Input format: Set (1..10) of AETs


One AET consists of 3 to 16 numbers separated
by blank (AET as "Object Identifier").

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ACINIGRP- 1-
DISP ACINIGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Access Control Initiator Group

This task displays one or more Access Control ’Initiator groups’, which define
a list of remote initiators. Each initiator is defined by its AET (Application
Entity Title), which represents the address of an application running on a
remote TMN-OS.

The following selections are possible:

- One single Access Control ’Initiator group’:


--> Enter the ’Initiator group’

- All Access Control ’Initiator groups’:


--> Default: Enter no selection parameter

- Selection by filter criteria:


--> Enter ’Substring’ for ’Initiator group’ name (match at any position),
--> Enter ’AET entry’ for ’AET list’ (AET is in the list).
If both criteria are entered they must both be met.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ACINIGRP : [Initiator group=] [,Substring=] [,AET entry=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Initiator group

This parameter selects one specific ’Initiator group’ by its


name.

Dependencies:
This parameter must not be entered if all ’Initiator groups’
are to be selected, or ’Substring’ or ’AET entry’ is entered
as a filter parameter.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

Substring

This parameter defines a string pattern for the ’Initiator


group’ name. The ’Initiator group’ name must contain this
pattern at any position.

Dependencies:
This parameter must not be entered if an ’Initiator group’
is entered.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

AET entry

This parameter defines an AET which must be contained in the ’AET list’.

Dependencies:
This parameter must not be entered if an ’Initiator group’
is entered.

Input format: 3 to 16 numbers separated


by blank (AET as "Object Identifier")

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ACINIGRP- 1-


MOD ACINIGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Access Control Initiator Group

This task modifies an Access Control ’Initiator group’, which defines a list of
remote initiators. Each initiator is defined by its AET (Application
Entity Title), which represents the address of an application running on a
remote TMN-OS.
The ’AET list’ of the ’Initiator group’ can be replaced or AETs may be added to
or removed from the list.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ACINIGRP : Initiator group= ,AET list= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Initiator group

This parameter defines a unique name for the ’Initiator


group’. This name is used by the Access Control ’Rule’
to reference the ’Initiator group’.

Input format: String (1-12 characters).

AET list

This parameter updates the list of initiators for this


Access Control ’Initiator group’. Each initiator is represented
by its AET (Application Entity Titles).

Input format:
Operation: ’REPLACE’: Replace ’AET list’,
’ADD’ : Add AETs in ’AET list’ to the old list,
’REMOVE’ : Remove AETs in ’AET list’ from the old
list.

’AET list’: Set (1..10) of AETs


One AET consists of 3 to 16 numbers separated
by blank (AET as "Object Identifier")

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ACINIGRP- 1-


CAN ACMSUB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL AUTHENTICATION CENTRE MOBILE SUB

This command cancels an authentication centre mobile subscriber


(ACMSUB).

Prerequisites:
- The associated subscriber in the home location register (HLR)
should be deleted first using the command CAN MSUB.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN ACMSUB : MSIN= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MOBILE SUBSCRIBER ID NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ACMSUB- 1-


CR ACMSUB
GSM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE AUTHENTICATION CENTRE MOBILE SUB

This command creates an authentication centre mobile subscriber


(ACMSUB),either for GSM, CDMA or UMTS.

Prerequisites:
- The associated authentication centre home location register
(ACHLRID) must be created using the command CR ACHLRID.
This is only valid for GSM and UMTS.
- At least two input output processors for the authentication
centre (IOP:AUC) should be activated via the command CONF IOP.
- The database can be expanded via the command MOD DBSIZE (group
ACDSD (GSM/UMTS) or ACDSD and ACDCD (CDMA)).

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR ACMSUB - GSM CREATE GSM SUBSCRIBER


2. CR ACMSUB - UMTS CREATE UMTS SUBSCRIBER

1. Input format

CREATE GSM SUBSCRIBER

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR ACMSUB : MSIN= ,A4KI= [,A38V=] [,K4ID=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MOBILE SUBSCRIBER ID NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

A4KI ENCYPHERED AUTHENTICATION KEY

This parameter specifies the authentication key (Ki) of this


authentication centre mobile subscriber (ACMSUB), encrypted
with algorithm A4.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: UNIT 1 OF A4KI=
1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: UNIT 2 OF A4KI=
1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: UNIT 3 OF A4KI=
1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

d: UNIT 4 OF A4KI=
1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ACMSUB- 1+
CR ACMSUB
GSM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

A38V ALGORITHM A3 AND A8 VERSION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: VERSION OF ALGORITHM A3=


0...F, range of hexadecimal numbers

This parameter specifies the version of the A3 algorithm for


this authentication centre mobile subscriber (ACMSUB).

Default: 0

b: VERSION OF ALGORITHM A8=


0...F, range of hexadecimal numbers

This parameter specifies the version of the A8 algorithm for


this authentication centre mobile subscriber (ACMSUB).

Default: 0

K4ID IDENTIFICATION FOR KEY K4

This parameter specifies the identification for the key K4. This
parameter consists of 2 units.
If this parameter is not filled in, the default key K4 is used.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LOGICAL NAME FOR KEY K4=


1...10 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This information unit contains the logical name of the key K4.

b: VERSION OF K4 ID=
1...2 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This information unit contains the version of the


identification of the key K4. This version is used to have
an extra check on the key value that is referenced by the
logical name of the key K4.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ACMSUB- 2+
CR ACMSUB
UMTS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

CREATE UMTS SUBSCRIBER

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR ACMSUB : MSIN= ,A4K= [,K4ID=] [,ALGVERS=] [,AMF=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,SQN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MOBILE SUBSCRIBER ID NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

A4K ENCYPHERED AUTH KEY FOR UMTS

This parameter specifies the authentication key (K) of this


authentication centre mobile subscriber (ACMSUB) used with UMTS and
encrypted with algorithm A4.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: UNIT 1 OF A4K=
1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: UNIT 2 OF A4K=
1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: UNIT 3 OF A4K=
1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

d: UNIT 4 OF A4K=
1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

K4ID IDENTIFICATION FOR KEY K4

This parameter specifies the identification for the key K4. This
parameter consists of 2 units.
If this parameter is not filled in, the default key K4 is used.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LOGICAL NAME FOR KEY K4=


1...10 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This information unit contains the logical name of the key K4.

b: VERSION OF K4 ID=
1...2 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This information unit contains the version of the


identification of the key K4. This version is used to have

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ACMSUB- 3+
CR ACMSUB
UMTS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

an extra check on the key value that is referenced by the


logical name of the key K4.

ALGVERS VERSION OF AUTH ALGORITHM

This parameter contains the version of the CDMA algorithm, as well as


the version of f1-f5/f1*/f5* algorithms for UMTS.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...255, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

AMF AUTH MANAGEMENT FIELD

The Authentication Management Field is an operator specific field.


If no value is entered, a default value will be filled in
(see DISP MPRDDAT).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...FFFF, range of hexadecimal numbers

SQN SEQUENCE NUMBER

This parameter is used to support the regeneration process. It is


not entered for the creation of a subscriber.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: UNIT 1 OF SQN=
0...7FFFF, range of hexadecimal numbers

b: UNIT 2 OF SQN=
0...1FFFFFFF, range of hexadecimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ACMSUB- 4-
DISP ACMSUB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY AUTHENTICATION CENTRE MOBILE SUB

This command displays the authentication centre mobile


subscribers (ACMSUB) which are created in the authentication
centre (AC) of the exchange.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ACMSUB : MSIN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MOBILE SUBSCRIBER ID NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...12 digit decimal number

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ACMSUB- 1-


CAN ACN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Application Context Name

This task is used to cancel an existing Application Context Name (ACN)


object for the Number Portability Service Logic.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN ACN : ACN ID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACN ID

This parameter identifies the Application Context Name object


which is to be cancelled.

Input format : String ( 1 - 16 characters )

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ACN- 1-


CR ACN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create Application Context Name

This task is used to create an Application Context Name (ACN)


object for the Number Portability Service Logic.
Each object specifies the mapping of an Application Context Name
to a particular ACN Selector. Different objects can map different
Application Context Names to the same ACN Selector.

The value of the Application Context Name parameter must be unique,


i.e. it must not occur in more than one object.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR ACN : ACN Id= ,ACN Selector= ,ACN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACN Id

This parameter identifies the Application Context Name object


which is to be created.

Input format : String ( 1 - 16 characters )

ACN Selector

This parameter specifies the Application Context Name Selector mapped


to the Application Context Name for this object.

It is used for the selection of the protocol version for the dialogue
with the SSP.

Input format : Integer ( 0 - 31 )

ACN

This parameter specifies the Application Context Name (ACN).

It represents a certain subset of functions contained in a protocol


of a particular application. For the received messages it will be
evaluated in order to determine the proper protocol to use.

The value of this parameter must be unique.

Input format : String ( 1 - 32 hexadecimal digits )

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ACN- 1-
DISP ACN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Application Context Name

This task is used to display the parameters of existing Application


Context Name (ACN) objects for the Number Portability Service Logic.

The objects to be displayed can be selected either by entering


- the identifier ACN Id of a specific object or
- the values for one or more of the parameters ACN and ACN Selector
that specify the objects.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ACN : [ACN ID=] [,ACN Selector=] [,ACN=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACN ID

This parameter identifies the Application Context Name object


which is to be displayed.

This parameter is optional.

Input format : String ( 1 - 16 characters )

ACN Selector

This parameter specifies the Application Context Name Selector of the


Application Context Name objects to be displayed.

It is used for the selection of the protocol version for the dialogue
with the SSP.

This parameter is optional.

Input format : Integer ( 0 - 31 )

ACN

This parameter specifies the Application Context Name (ACN) of the


Application Context Name objects to be displayed.

It represents a certain subset of functions contained in a protocol


of a particular application. For the received messages it will be
evaluated in order to determine the proper protocol to use.

This parameter is optional.

Input format : String ( 1 - 32 hexadecimal digits )

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ACN- 1-


MOD ACN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Application Context Name

This task is used to modify the parameters of an existing Application


Context Name (ACN) object for the Number Portability Service Logic.

At least one of the optional parameters ACN and ACN Selector must be
specified for modification.

The value of the Application Context Name parameter must be unique,


i.e. it must not occur in more than one object.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ACN : ACN ID= [,ACN Selector=] [,ACN=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACN ID

This parameter identifies the Application Context Name object


which is to be modified.

Input format : String ( 1 - 16 characters )

ACN Selector

This parameter specifies the Application Context Name Selector which


is to be modified.

It is used for the selection of the protocol version for the dialogue
with the SSP.

This parameter is optional.

Input format : Integer ( 0 - 31 )

ACN

This parameter specifies the Application Context Name (ACN) which is


to be modified.

It represents a certain subset of functions contained in a protocol


of a particular application. For the received messages it will be
evaluated in order to determine the proper protocol to use.

The value of this parameter must be unique.

This parameter is optional.

Input format : String ( 1 - 32 hexadecimal digits )

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ACN- 1-


CAN ACOLIM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL COMFORT ALARM CALL ORDER LIMITS

This command cancels a comfort alarm call limit for a specified


time period for a specified OSS common service group.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted for an operator service system (OSS).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN ACOLIM : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= [,TIME=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not divided into
several local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TIME TIME

This parameter specifies the time period for which the comfort
alarm call limit will be canceled.

Notes:
- The time can be omitted, if all comfort alarm call limits
of the specified common service group are to be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin hour.

b: MINUTE=
0,5,10,15,20,25,30,35,40,45,50,55, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin minute.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ACOLIM- 1-


DISP ACOLIM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY COMFORT ALARM CALL ORDER LIMITS

This command displays the comfort alarm call limits for a


specified OSS common service group.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted for an operator service system (OSS).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ACOLIM : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into
several local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ACOLIM- 1-


ENTR ACOLIM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER COMFORT ALARM CALL ORDER LIMITS

This command enters a comfort alarm call limit for a specified


time period for a specified OSS common service group.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted for an operator service system (OSS).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR ACOLIM : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,TIME= ,MAX= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not divided into
several local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TIME STARTTIME OF BOOKING INTERVAL

This parameter specifies the time at which the comfort


alarm call limit will become active.

Notes:
- Up to 24 time periods are allowed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin hour.

b: MINUTE=
0,5,10,15,20,25,30,35,40,45,50,55, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin minute.

MAX MAX NO OF ORDERS PER INTERVAL

This parameter specifies the maximum number of alarm calls


allowed per 5 minute interval for the specified time period.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ACOLIM- 1+


ENTR ACOLIM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

0...200, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ACOLIM- 2-


CAN ACORD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL ALARM CALL ORDER

This command cancels casual or/and daily alarm call orders.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN ACORD : DN= ,TIME= ,TYPE= [,FIRST=] [,LAC=] [,CHRGINF=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,KIND= [,DAYWK=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the subscriber line.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit decimal number

TIME TIME OF ALARM CALL

This parameter specifies the time of the alarm call.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

The entered time will be rounded to a


previous 5 minute interval.

TYPE TYPE OF ALARM CALL ORDER

This parameter specifies the alarm call type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CASUAL CASUAL ALARM CALL ORDER


One execution on the specified time.
DAILY DAILY ALARM CALL ORDER
A number of executions on consecutive days on the
specified time.
SPECIFIC SPECIFIC ALARM CALL ORDER
A number of executions on specified days on the
specified time.
X ALL TYPES OF ALARM CALL ORDERS
Casual, daily and specific alarm calls

FIRST SKIP FIRST EXECUTION

This parameter determines whether only the first execution


of a daily alarm call order must be disabled or whether the
complete order must be removed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO REMOVE ALARM CALL ORDER


YES DISABLE FIRST EXECUTION

Default: NO

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ACORD- 1+


CAN ACORD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code. It is required, if there


is more than one local network in the exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CHRGINF CHARGING INFORMATION

This parameter indicates whether the order is


canceled by an automatic operator.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

MACHINE MACHINE CONTROLLED INPUT


The alarm call is canceled by an
automatic operator.

KIND KIND OF ALARM CALL ORDER

This parameter specified the kind of alarm call order.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

AUTO AUTOMATIC ALARM CALL ORDER


Only the automatic alarm call orders will be
canceled.
SEMIAUTO SEMI-AUTOM. ALARM CALL ORDER
Only the semi-automatic alarm call orders will be
canceled.
COMFORT COMFORT ALARM CALL ORDER
Only the comfort alarm call orders will be
canceled.
X ALL KINDS OF ALARM CALL ORDERS
All automatic, semi-automatic and comfort alarm
call orders will be canceled.

This parameter specifies the kind of alarm you want


to cancel.

DAYWK DAYS OF WEEK

This parameter indicates the days of the week that should be


deleted for the alarm call.
Prerequisites:
- TYPE=SPECIFIC

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ACORD- 2-


ENTR ACORD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER ALARM CALL ORDER

This command books a casual, daily or specific alarm call.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,DAYNO= 11 1
1 ENTR ACORD : DN= ,TIME= ,TYPE= 1Z,WEEKNO=Y1 [,LAC=] 1
1 11,DATE= 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
1 [,SHIFT=] [,CHRGINF=] [,KIND=] [,NAMESUB=] 1
1 1
1 [,NOTE=] [,EXTNOTE=] [,CSGID=] [,LANGID=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,OPERATOR=] [,DAYWK=] [,EXECHOL=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the subscriber line.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TIME TIME OF ALARM CALL

This parameter specifies the time of the alarm call.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the hour of the alarm call time.

b: MINUTE=
0,5,10,15,20,25,30,35,40,45,50,55, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the minute of the alarm call time.

TYPE TYPE OF ALARM CALL

This parameter specifies the alarm call type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CASUAL CASUAL ALARM CALL ORDER


One execution on the specified time.

Notes:
- if DATE is entered the execution will be
performed on that particular day otherwise the
execution will be within the next 24 hours.
DAILY DAILY ALARM CALL ORDER
A number of executions on consecutive days on the
specified time.

Prerequisites:
- DAYNO
SPECIFIC SPECIFIC ALARM CALL ORDER
A number of executions on specified days on the
specified time.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ACORD- 1+


ENTR ACORD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Prerequisites:
- WEEKNO
- DAYWK

This parameter specifies the type of alarm call.

DAYNO NUMBER OF DAYS

This parameter specifies the number of consecutive days during


which a daily alarm call order is to be executed.
When DAYNO = 0 is entered, the alarm call order will be
executed for an unlimited number of days.
Incompatibilities:
- TYPE=CASUAL
- =SPECIFIC

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...99, range of decimal numbers

WEEKNO NUMBER OF WEEKS

This parameter specifies the number of weeks during


which a specific alarm call order is to be executed.
When WEEKNO = 0 is entered, the alarm call order will be
executed for an unlimited number of weeks.

Incompatibilities:
- TYPE=CASUAL
- =DAILY

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...52, range of decimal numbers

DATE DATE OF LAST EXECUTION

This parameter specifies the date on which the alarm call order
must be executed for the last time.
If it is entered, the following applies:
- for TYPE=CASUAL, date must be within one month
- for TYPE=DAILY, date must be within 99 days.
- for TYPE=SPECIFIC, date must be within one year.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code. It is required, if there


is more than one local network in the exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

SHIFT ALARM CALL SHIFTED

This parameter specifies whether the alarm call order should be


marked as shifted. Shifting is normally only valid for an alarm
call order entered by subscriber controlled input, but must be
available for regeneration of such orders.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ACORD- 2+


ENTR ACORD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NO ALARM CALL NOT SHIFTED


YES ALARM CALL SHIFTED

CHRGINF CHARGING INFORMATION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

MACHINE MACHINE CONTROLLED INPUT


The alarm call is booked by an
automatic operator.

KIND KIND OF ALARM CALL ORDER

This parameter specifies the kind of alarm call.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

AUTO AUTOMATIC ALARM CALL ORDER


The alarm call order is booked by the system and
will be executed by the system.
SEMIAUTO SEMI-AUTOM. ALARM CALL ORDER
The alarm call order is booked by means of the
ADMOSS operator and executed by the system. This
value is only relevant in case of regeneration of
a semi-automatic alarm call.
COMFORT COMFORT ALARM CALL ORDER
The alarm call order is booked by means of the
ADMOSS operator and executed by means of the
ADMOSS operator. This value is only relevant in
case of regeneration of a comfort alarm call.

This parameter specifies the kind of alarm call order


you want to book.

Default: AUTO

NAMESUB NAME OF THE SUBSCRIBER

This parameter specifies the name of the subscriber


that booked an alarm call.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

It is only relevant for regeneration of comfort alarm calls.

Prerequisites:
- KIND=COMFORT

NOTE NOTE FROM THE SUBSCRIBER

This parameter specifies the note the subscriber


wants to hear when executing the alarm call.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...60 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

It is only relevant for regeneration of comfort alarm calls.

Prerequisites:
- KIND=COMFORT

EXTNOTE EXTENDED NOTE FROM THE SUBSCR.

This parameter specifies the extended note the subscriber


wants to hear when executing the alarm call.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...60 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ACORD- 3+


ENTR ACORD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

It is only relevant for regeneration of comfort alarm calls.

Prerequisites:
- KIND=COMFORT

CSGID COMMON SERVICE GROUP ID

This parameter specifies the common service group ID


of the OSS operator that was responsible for the booking
of the alarm call order. This information is only relevant
for the regeneration of semi-automatic and comfort calls.

Prerequisites:
- KIND=COMFORT
- =SEMIAUTO

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10, range of decimal numbers

LANGID LANGUAGE IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the language identification of


the subscriber.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

OPERATOR NAT/INAT OPERATOR INDICATION

This parameter indicates whether a national or international


operator should be addressed. It is only relevant for the
regeneration of comfort calls.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NAT NATIONAL OPERATOR


INAT INTERNATIONAL OPERATOR

DAYWK DAY OF WEEK

This parameter indicates the days of the week on which the


alarm call should be executed.
Prerequisites:
- TYPE=SPECIFIC

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY

EXECHOL EXECUTION ON HOLIDAYS

This parameter indicates whether the alarm calls must be


executed on holidays or not.
Prerequisites:
- TYPE=DAILY
- =SPECIFIC

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

YES EXECUTIONS ON HOLIDAYS


NO NO EXECUTION ON HOLIDAYS

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ACORD- 4-


SEL ACORD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SELECT ALARM CALL ORDER

This command displays all casual and daily alarm call orders
for one or all subscribers for the specified time.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 SEL ACORD : DN= ,TIME= [,LAC=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the subscriber line.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit decimal number

TIME TIME OF ALARM CALL

This parameter specifies the time of the alarm call.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

The entered time will be rounded


to a previous 5 minute interval.

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code. It is required, if there


is more than one local network in the exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SEL ACORD- 1-


CAN ACRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Access Control Rule

This task cancels an Access Control ’Rule’, which defines the access rights
of an Access Control ’Initiator group’ on an Access Control ’Target group’
for the Q3 operations defined by ’Target group’.

Depending on the ’Rule type’ the cancel operation can remove existing
access rights (’Rule type’ = ’Allow’) or grant new access rights
(’Rule type’ = ’Deny’).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN ACRULE : Rule= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Rule

This parameter defines the name of the Access Control ’Rule’.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ACRULE- 1-


CR ACRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create Access Control Rule

This task creates an Access Control ’Rule’ which defines the access
rights of an Access Control ’Initiator group list’ on an Access Control
’Target group list’ for the Q3 operations defined by ’Target group’.

An Allow Rule (’Rule type’ = ’Allow’) will allow execution of the


Q3 operation as long as no matching Deny Rule exists. A Deny Rule
will reject the Q3 operation (’Rule type’ = ’Deny’) or abort the
association (’Rule type’ = ’Abort’) in any case.

A Global Rule references no ’Target group’. It defines the access


rights for the referenced ’Initiator group’ globally, i.e. it
includes all Q3 object classes and all Q3 operations.

A Common Rule references no ’Initiator group’. It defines the common


access rights to the referenced ’Target group’, i.e. it is valid for
all initiators (AETs).

Optional time dependencies may be defined by scheduling parameters.


The validity of the Access Control ’Rule’ can be restricted by:

- Duration: a ’Start time’ and ’Stop time’) and/or


- Daily scheduling: time intervals for all days of the week or
- Weekly scheduling: time intervals per day of the week

The parameter ’Availability status’ indicates if a ’Rule’ with


scheduling parameters is active (’On’) or not (’Off’). This parameter
is only for output. " " indicates that no scheduling parameter was
entered.

Prerequisite:
- The referenced Access Control ’Initiator groups’ and Access Control
’Target groups’ must have been created by ’CR ACINIGRP’ and
’CR ACTARGRP’.

- The supported ’Rule type’ may have been restricted by the parameter
’Rule restriction’ in ’MOD ACCFG’. In this case only Allow Rules or
only Deny Rules can be created.

Note:
- The parameters ’Daily intervals’ and ’Weekly intervals’ exclude one
another.

- The scheduling parameters must be selected when the Access Control


’Rule’ is created. It is not possible to add scheduling parameters by
’MOD ACRULE’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR ACRULE : Rule= ,Rule type= ,Initiator group list= 1
1 1
1 ,Target group list= [,Start time=] [,Stop time=] 1
1 1
1 [,Daily intervals=] [,Weekly intervals=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Rule

This parameter defines the name of the Access Control ’Rule’.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

Rule type

Defines the ’Rule type’, i.e. the action performed


when the ’Rule’ matches.
The supported values can be restricted by ’MOD ACCFG’.

Input format:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ACRULE- 1+
CR ACRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

’Allow’ Allow access (if no other deny rule exists)


’Deny’ Deny access by "Access Denied"
’Abort’ Deny access and abort the association

Initiator group list

This parameter references a list of Access Control


’Initiator groups’. The rule is applied to all Initiators
(AETs) of all ’Initiator Groups’ in this list.
Enter an empty ’Initiator group list’ to create a Common
Rule, which is valid for all initiators (AETs).
The referenced ’Initiator groups’ must have been created by
’CR ACINIGRP’.

Input format: Set (0..10) of ’Initiator groups’


One ’Initiator group’ is identified by its
name (1-12 characters).

Target group list

This parameter references a list of Access Control


’Target groups’, each member defines an object class list
and a set of Q3 operations.
Enter an empty list (size=0) to create a Global Rule,
which defines global access rights (to all object classes
and for all Q3 operations) for the referenced ’Initiator groups’.
The referenced ’Target groups’ in the list must have been created
by ’CR ACTARGRP’.

Input format: Set (0..10) of ’Target groups’


One ’Target group’ is identified by its
name (1-12 characters).

Start time

This parameter defines the ’Start time’ at which the rule


becomes active.
If only the ’Start time’ is set the ’Stop time’ will be set
automatically to ’Continuous’.
The time value is rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes or
10 minutes (EWSD classic).

Input format: standard date and time values

Default value: actual system time


will be set if this parameter is omitted but
’Stop time’ is set.

Stop time

This parameter defines the Stop time at which the rule becomes
inactive.
If only the ’Stop time’ is set the ’Start time’ will be set
automatically to the actual system time of the switch.
The time value is rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes or
10 minutes (EWSD classic).

Input format: option ’Continuous’


option ’Specific’ : standard date and
time values
Default value: option ’Continuous’
will be set if this parameter is omitted but
’Start time’ is set.

Daily intervals

This parameter selects daily scheduling. Up to 6 time


intervals can be specified within which the rule is active.
If this parameter is entered the parameter for weekly
scheduling must not be entered.
The time value is rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes or
10 minutes (EWSD classic).
Overlapping intervals are combined to one interval.

Input format : hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ACRULE- 2+
CR ACRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

Default: whole day

Weekly intervals

This parameter selects weekly scheduling. Up to 6 time


intervals can be defined for each day of the week.
The rule will be inactive on days of the week not
selected and on days with 0 intervals set. At least
one day with one interval must be selected.
If this parameter is entered the parameter for daily
scheduling must not be entered.
The time value is rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes or
10 minutes (EWSD classic).
Overlapping intervals are combined to one interval.

Input format: hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval for one day)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use "00:00-00:00" to select the whole day

Default: selects all days of the week without any time


restriction. Inactive days must be disabled
from the default value.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ACRULE- 3-
DISP ACRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Access Control Rule

This task displays one or more Access Control ’Rules’, which define
the access rights of Access Control ’Initiator groups’ on Access Control
’Target groups’ for the Q3 operations.

The following selections are possible:

- One single Access Control ’Rule’:


--> Enter ’Rule’

- All Access Control ’Rules’:


--> Default: Enter no selection parameter

- Selection by filter criteria:


--> Enter ’Substring’ for ’Rule’ name (match at any position),
--> Enter ’Rule type’ (equality)
--> Enter ’Initiator group’ (member in ’Initiator group list’).
--> Enter ’Target group’ (member in ’Target group list’).
More than one selection criteria are combined by logical AND.

Different output formats are supported for the display of a single Access
control ’Rule’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ACRULE : [Rule=] ,Output format= [,Substring=] [,Rule type=] 1
1 1
1 [,Initiator group=] [,Target group=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Rule

This parameter selects one specific Access Control ’Rule’.

Dependencies:
This parameter must not be entered if all Access Control
’Rules’ are to be selected or one of the following filter
parameters is entered.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

Output format

This parameter defines the ’Output format’ of the displayed Access


Control ’Rules’. Format ’Compact’ must be used if parameter ’Rule’
is not specified.

Input format:
’Compact’ displays Access Control ’Rule’ parameters without
scheduling parameters.
’Complete’ displays all Access Control ’Rule’ parameters.
’Extended’ displays all Access Control ’Rule’ parameters plus
the referenced ’Initiator group’ and ’Target group’.

Default: ’Compact’

Substring

This parameter defines a pattern for the ’Rule’ name. The ’Rule’
name must contain this pattern at any position.

Dependencies:
This parameter must not be entered if ’Rule’ was entered.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

Rule type

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ACRULE- 1+


DISP ACRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter selects the ’Rule type’ of the ’Rules’ to display.

Input format:
’Allow’ Select Allow Rules
’Deny’ Select Deny Rules
’Abort’ Select Deny Rules with Abort

Initiator group

This parameter selects the referenced ’Initiator group list’ of


the ’Rules’ to display.
If a value is entered, the ’Initiator group list’ must
contain the value;
if "" is entered, only common rules are selected.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters) for ’Initiator group’ name
"" (empty string) selects Common Rules (with no ’Initiator
group’).

Target group

This parameter selects the referenced ’Target group list’


of the ’Rules’ to display.
If a value is entered, the ’Target group list’ must contain
the entered value;
if "" is entered, only global rules are selected.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters) for ’Target group’ name
"" (empty string) selects Global Rules (with no ’Target
group’).

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ACRULE- 2-


MOD ACRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Access Control Rule

This task modifies the parameters of an Access Control ’Rule’,


which defines the access rights of Access Control
’Initiator groups’ on an Access Control ’Target groups’ for Q3
operations.

Depending on the parameters entered, the ’Rule type’, the


referenced ’Target group list’ or ’Initiator group list’ is changed.

Scheduling parameters can be modified as follows:

- Duration: replace ’Start time’ and/or ’Stop time’.


- Daily scheduling: replace ’Daily intervals’.
- Weekly Scheduling: replace time intervals of single days of the
week.

Note:
- It is not possible to change a Common Rule (empty
’Initiator group list’) to a non Common Rule or to change a non
Common Rule to a Common Rule. Thus it is only possible to modify
a ’Initiator group list’, which is not empty.

- It is not possible to change a Global Rule (no ’Target group’) to


a non Global Rule or to change a non Global Rule to a Global Rule.
Thus it is only possible to modify a ’Target group list’, which
is not empty.

- It is not possible to change an Allow Rule to a Deny Rule or a


Deny Rule to an Allow Rule respectively. Thus it is only possible
to change the ’Rule Type’ from ’Deny’ to ’Abort’ or vice versa.

- Only scheduling parameters selected by ’CR ACRULE’ can be modified.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ACRULE : Rule= [,Rule type=] [,Initiator group list=] 1
1 1
1 [,Target group list=] [,Start time=] [,Stop time=] 1
1 1
1 [,Daily intervals=] [,Weekly intervals=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Rule

This parameter defines the name of the Access Control ’Rule’.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

Rule type

This parameter replaces the ’Rule type’, i.e. the action performed
when the ’Rule’ matches.

Note: It is not possible to change an Allow Rule to a Deny Rule, or


a Deny Rule to an Allow Rule.

Input format:
’Deny’ Deny access by "Access Denied"
’Abort’ Deny access and abort the association

Initiator group list

This parameter modifies the Access Control ’Initiator group list’,


which defines the ’Initiator groups’ the ’Rule’ is applied to.

Note: It is not possible to set up an ’Initiator group list’ for


a Common Rule (empty ’Initiator group list’) or to change a

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ACRULE- 1+


MOD ACRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

non Common Rule to a Common Rule (remove all


’Initiator groups’.

Input format:
Operation: ’REPLACE’: Replace ’Initiator group list’,
’ADD’ : Add ’Initiator groups’ to the old list,
’REMOVE’ : Remove ’Initiator groups’ from the old
list.

’Group list’: Set (1..10) of ’Initiator groups’


One ’Initiator group’ is identified by its
name (1-12 characters).

Target group list

This parameter modifies the Access Control ’Target group list’;


each member defines an object classes list and a set ofQ3
operations.

Note: It is not possible to set up a ’Target group list’ for a


Global Rule (empty ’Target group list’) or to change a
non Global Rule to a Global Rule (remove all ’Target Groups’.

Input format:
Operation: ’REPLACE’: Replace ’Target group list’,
’ADD’ : Add ’Target groups’ to the old list,
’REMOVE’ : Remove ’Target groups’ from the old list.

’Group list’: Set (1..10) of ’Target groups’


One ’Target group’ is identified by its
name (1-12 characters).

Start time

This parameter replaces the ’Start time’ at which the rule


becomes active.
The parameter can be replaced only if a ’Start time’ or
’Stop time’ was entered when the ’Rule’ was created.

Input format: standard date and time values

Stop time

This parameter replaces the ’Stop time’ at which the rule


becomes inactive.
The parameter can be replaced only if a ’Start time’ or
’Stop time’ was entered when the ’Rule’ was created.

Input format: option ’Continuous’


option ’Specific’ : standard date and
time values

Default value: option ’Continuous’

Daily intervals

This parameter replaces ’Daily intervals’ (up to 6) within which


the rule is active. The parameter can be entered only if ’Daily
intervals’ were entered when the ’Rule’ was created. The
time values are rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.
Overlapping intervals are combined to one interval.

Input format : hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

Weekly intervals

This parameter replaces ’Weekly intervals’ within which the


rule is active.
Only days of the week selected in the parameter are replaced.
The intervals of the days not selected will not be changed.
Enter 0 intervals to disable the whole day.
At least one day with one interval must be active in the
resultant ’Weekly intervals’; otherwise the parameter is
rejected.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ACRULE- 2+


MOD ACRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Input format : hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval for one day)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ACRULE- 3-


DISP ACSTAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ALARM CALL STATISTICS

This command displays the alarm call statistics.


Following data are displayed :
- number of refused orders; the number of input attempts, entered
between the last but one and the last activation of the interval,
which were refused
- number of accepted orders; the number of alarm call orders in the
interval at the moment of the last activation of the interval.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ACSTAT ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ACSTAT- 1-


CAN ACTARGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Access Control Target Group

This task cancels an Access Control ’Target group’ which defines a set
of Q3 object classes (OCs) and the Q3 operations on these object classes.

Prerequisite:
The ’Target group’ is not canceled if it is referenced by an Access Control ’Rule’

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN ACTARGRP : Target group= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Target group

This parameter defines the unique name of the ’Target group’.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ACTARGRP- 1-


CR ACTARGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create Access Control Target Group

This task creates an Access Control ’Target group’ which defines a set
of Q3 object classes (OCs) and the Q3 operations on these object classes.
A ’Target group’ is referenced by one or more Access Control ’Rules’ in order
to grant or deny access rights for the Q3 operations on the OCs.

The set of OCs is defined by an ’Object class list’ and a ’Scope’ parameter.
The ’Scope’ parameter selects a subtree for the OCs in the ’Object class list’.
Thus the Target Group contains the sum of all "scopes" of the OCs in the
’Object class list’.

The optional parameter ’Ref. target group’ allows an already defined set
of OCs to be reused. If defined, the ’Object class list’ and ’Scope’ are copied
from the ’Ref. target group’.

Note:
- The scope of each OC in the ’Object class list’ must not be empty, i.e. it must
contain at least 1 OC.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR ACTARGRP : Target group= [,Ref. target group=] 1
1 1
1 [,Object class list=] [,Scope=] ,Operations list= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Target group

This parameter defines the name of the ’Target group’.


This name is used by an Access Control ’Rule’ to reference
the ’Target group’.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

Ref. target group

This parameter defines an optional reference ’Target group’.


If entered, the parameters ’Object class list’ and ’Scope’
may be omitted. Their values are then copied from the reference
’Target group’.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

Object class list

This parameter defines a list of Q3 object classes (OCs).


This parameter may be omitted only if a ’Ref. target group’
is entered. In this case the ’Object class list’ is copied
from the ’Ref. target group’.
See also ’Scope’ parameter

Input format: Set (1..10) of Q3 object classes


Select object classes from list

Scope

This parameter defines the ’Scope’ of all object classes in


’Object class list’ according to the Q3 "Name Binding" relation.
This parameter may be omitted only if a ’Ref. target group’
is entered. In this case the ’Scope’ is copied from the
’Ref. target group’.

Input format:
’Standard’:
’Base object’ Base OC only
’First level’ 1st level subordinate base OC
’Whole subtree’ Base OC and all subordinate OCs

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ACTARGRP- 1+
CR ACTARGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

’Level’: n nth level subordinate base OC

’Base to level’: n Base OC and all OCs down to level n

Default Value: ’Whole subtree’

Operations list

This parameter selects the Q3 Operations that are defined for this
’Target group’.

Input format:
’Enabled’: Q3 operation is included
’Disabled’: Q3 operation is not included

Select value for all Q3 operations:


M-GET, M-SET, M-CREATE, M-DELETE and M-ACTION.

Default value: All Q3 operations are selected.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ACTARGRP- 2-
DISP ACTARGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Access Control Target Group

This task displays one or more Access Control ’Target groups’, which define
a set of Q3 object classes (OCs) and the Q3 operations on these object classes.

The following selections are possible:

- One single Access Control ’Target group’:


--> Enter the ’Target group’

- All Access Control ’Target groups’:


--> Default: Enter no selection parameter

- Selection by filter criteria


--> Enter ’Substring’ for ’Target group’ name (match at any position),
--> Enter ’Object class’ for ’Object class list’ (’Object class’ is in the list)
If both criteria are entered they must both be met.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ACTARGRP : [Target group=] [,Substring=] [,Object class=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Target group

This parameter selects one specific ’Target group’ by its name.

Dependencies:
This parameter must not be entered if all ’Target groups’
are to be selected, or if ’Substring’ or ’Object class’ is
entered as a filter parameter.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

Substring

This parameter defines a name pattern for the ’Target group’ name.
The ’Target group’ name must contain this pattern at any one position.

Dependencies:
This parameter must not be entered if ’Target group’ was entered.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

Object class

This parameter defines an ’Object class’ which must be contained in


the ’Object class list’.

Note:
The task will evaluate the ’Object class list’ but not
the ’Scope’.

Dependencies:
This parameter must not be entered if a ’Target group’
was entered.

Input format: Select ’Object class’ from list

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ACTARGRP- 1-


MOD ACTARGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Access Control Target Group

This task modifies an Access Control ’Target group’, which defines a list
of Q3 object classes (OCs) and the Q3 operations on these object classes.

The set of OCs defined by the ’Target group’ is affected by modification


of the ’Object class list’ and/or the ’Scope’ parameter.

Note:
- The modification of the ’Object class list’ or ’Scope’ parameter must not
produce empty scopes, i.e. the scope of each OC in the ’Object class list’
must contain at least 1 OC.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ACTARGRP : Target group= [,Object class list=] [,Scope=] 1
1 1
1 [,Operations list=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Target group

This parameter defines the name of the ’Target group’.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

Object class list

This parameter updates the ’Object class list’ of the ’Target group’.

Input format:
Operation: ’REPLACE’: Replace ’Object class list’.
’ADD’ : Add OCs in ’Object class list’ to the
old list.
’REMOVE’ : Remove OCs in ’Object class list’ from the
old list.

’Object class list’: Set (1..10) of Q3 object classes


Select Object classes from list.

Scope

This parameter replaces the ’Scope’ for the object classes in


’Object class list’ according to the Q3 "Name Binding" relation.

Input format:
’Std’:
’Base object’ OC only
’Whole subtree’ OC and all subordinate OCs
’First level’ 1st level subordinate OC

’Level’: n nth level subordinate OC

’Base to level’: n OC itself and all OCs down to level


n

Operations list

This parameter replaces the Q3 operations that are defined for this
’Target group’.

Input format:
’Enabled’ : Q3 operation is included.
’Disabled’: Q3 operation is not included.

Select Value for all Q3 operations:


M-GET, M-SET, M-CREATE, M-DELETE and M-ACTION.

Default value: All Q3 operations are selected.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ACTARGRP- 1+


MOD ACTARGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ACTARGRP- 2-


DISP AENTRY

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ARCHIVE FILE ENTRY

This command displays the contents of archive files.


The messages can be specified either in their entirety or as
a list containing general information (table of contents) for the
selected message entries. The amount of messages can be restricted by
specifying the entry numbers.

Prerequisite:
- The file must exist and have the attributes of an archive file.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP AENTRY : AFILE= [,AENTRY=] [,TOC=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AFILE ARCHIVE FILE NAME

This parameter designates an archive file.

Notes:
- The first character may not be a period, the last character
may be neither a period nor an asterisk, and two periods may
not appear consecutively in the filename.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

AENTRY ARCHIVE FILE ENTRY

This parameter specifies the entry number assigned by the FCP to


incoming messages for an archive file. When displaying archive files, a
list of ranges (intervals) of these numbers can be specified as limits.

Notes:
- A maximum of two intervals can be linked with &.
- If 99999 is entered, the most recently entered message is displayed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...99999, range of decimal numbers

TOC TABLE OF CONTENTS

This parameter specifies whether only message headers or whole messages


are displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO TABLE OF CONTENTS
YES TABLE OF CONTENTS

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP AENTRY- 1-


SEL AENTRY

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SELECT ARCHIVE FILE ENTRY

This command displays data from an archive file. These data are
restricted via parameter entry.
of records from an archive file to the output device. The search
direction can be set either to ascending or descending. As long as the
individual conditions from the combination of named possibilities do not
contradict themselves, they are linked to form an overall condition.
The following can be selected:
- messages with a certain job number
- messages which are determined by context and
format number or only by context
- alarm messages, limited to alarms with a certain priority
- messages which have been entered within a specified period of time
- If neither DATE nor TIME are specified, the search covers
the entire file.
- If only DATE is specified, the search covers all entries within
the specified DATE interval.
- If only TIME is specified, the current date is implied for DATE.
- If DATE and TIME are specified, the search covers all entries in
each of the specified TIME intervals on every day included in the
specified DATE intervals.

Prerequisite:
- The specified file must exist and must be created with the attributes
of an archive file.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 SEL AENTRY : AFILE= [,TIME=] [,DATE=] [,JN=] [,MSG=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,ALPRIO=] [,DIR=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AFILE ARCHIVE FILE NAME

This parameter designates an archive file.

Note:
- The first character may not be a period, the last character
may be neither a period nor an asterisk, and two periods may
not appear consecutively in the filename.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TIME TIME

This parameter specifies the time as one of the search


criteria for selecting records from an archive file.

Note:
- Seconds are ignored during conversion to an internal format.
- A maximum of two intervals can be linked with &.

- If selective output of archive entries is desired, where the


intended time interval contains a date change, it is not
possible to achieve the result with one time interval.

- For example,

SEL AENTRY AFILE = MY.AFILE, TIME = 23-00-00&&01-00-00

will not work, since without a specified date, always the


current day is assumed. A date change is not considered.

The mentioned example will produce entries between

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SEL AENTRY- 1+


SEL AENTRY

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1h and 23h of the same day.

The desired result can be achieved as follows, working


with the DATE parameter:

- if for ONE time interval the entries are to be selected,


2 commands are needed:

SEL AENTRY AFILE = MY.AFILE, DATE = 98-10-05,


TIME = 23-00-00 && 23-59-59
SEL AENTRY AFILE = MY.AFILE, DATE = 98-10-06,
TIME = 00-00-00 && 01-00-00

- if cyclically (i.e. on each day), entries are to be


displayed, the TIME interval must be split in two:

SEL AENTRY AFILE = MY.AFILE, DATE = 98-09-01&&98-12-31,


TIME = 23-00-00&&23-59-59 & 00-00-00&&01-00-00.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

a-b-c

a: HOURS=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: MINUTES=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

c: SECONDS=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

DATE DATE

This parameter specifies the date as one of the search criteria.

Note:
- A maximum of two intervals can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

JN JOB NUMBER

This parameter specifies job number as one of the search criteria.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...9999, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SEL AENTRY- 2+


SEL AENTRY

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MSG MESSAGE

This parameter specifies a message.

Note:
- There are two kinds of messages: command response messages and
system messages.
- system context for system messages with the following
possible values:
SPT spontaneous message which is not an alarm
Alarm contexts:
SYOP SYSTEM OPERATOR CALL
SYPUPD SYSTEM PANEL UPDATE
SYPCHNG SYSTEM PANEL CHANGE
ADMINAL ADMINISTRATION ALARM
TIMINSEC TIME INSECURE ALARM
CALLID CALL IDENTIFICATION
CAT1 CAT LEVEL 1
CAT2 CAT LEVEL 2
MAL MAINTENANCE ALARM
SAL SERVICE ALARM
CU CENTRAL UNIT ALARM
CLOCK CENTRAL CLOCK GENERATOR ALARM
MB MESSAGE BUFFER ALARM
SN SWITCHING NETWORK ALARM
CCS COMMON CHANNEL SIGNALING ALARM
LNMAIN LINE MAINTENANCE ALARM
LNLNCKOUT LINE LOCKOUT ALARM
SIGLINK SIGNALING LINK ALARM
TRMAIN TRUNK MAINTENANCE ALARM
TGBL TRUNKGROUP BLOCKED
TGAL TRUNKGROUP ALARM
LTG LTG ALARM
DLU DLU ALARM
SYP SYSTEM PANEL ALARM
EALEXCH EXTERNAL EXCHANGE ALARM
EALDLU EXTERNAL DLU ALARM
NLMPAL NO LAMP ALARM
OVLD OVERLOAD ALARM
RECOV RECOVERY ALARM
DIU DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT
SERV SERVICE CIRCUITS
TAXUP CCS7 TAXATION USER PART
TIMESYNC EXTERNAL TIME SYNCHRONIZATION
ATMF ATM FABRIC
- project-specific some of the values may be unused.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: CONTEXT=
1...12 characters from the
symbolic name character set

Corresponds to the command code in a


command response message or the
system context in a system message.

The following characters are not permitted:


.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: FORMAT=
0...99999, range of decimal numbers

ALPRIO ALARM PRIORITY

This parameter specifies the priority of an alarm output message


as a search criteria.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SEL AENTRY- 3+


SEL AENTRY

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MINOR MINOR ALARM


MAJOR MAJOR ALARM
CRITICAL CRITICAL ALARM

DIR DIRECTION

This parameter specifies the read direction when archive file records
are searched.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FORW FORWARD SEARCH DIRECTION


BACKW BACKWARD SEARCH DIRECTION

Default: FORW

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SEL AENTRY- 4-


CAN AFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL ARCHIVE FILE

This command cancels an archive file.

Prerequisite:
- the archive file must exist
- the archive file may not be assigned to any device group
- If output suppression is deactivated, the AFILE may not
be the output device.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN AFILE : AFILE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AFILE ARCHIVE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies an archive file.

Note:
- The first character may not be a period, the last character
may be neither a period nor an asterisk, and two periods may
not appear consecutively in the file name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN AFILE- 1-


CR AFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE ARCHIVE FILE

This command creates an archive file to act as a functional device,


its static attributes (size and type) and the variable attributes
(threshold limits and alarm) which can be set by administration .

Notes:
A threshold triple consists of THRU, THRD and THRF.
If the occupancy level of the archive file exceeds the threshold value
set in THRU,
- a system panel alarm is output if the corresponding THRF value
is set to ALARM
- an INFO system message is sent if the corresponding THRF value
is set to NOALARM.
These alarm indications are not canceled until the occupancy level of the
archive file is less than the value set in THRD.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR AFILE : AFILE= ,SIZE= ,TYPE= [,THRU=] [,THRD=] [,THRF=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AFILE ARCHIVE FILE NAME

This parameter designates an archive file.

Note:
- The first character may not be a period, the last character
may be neither a period nor an asterisk, and two periods may
not appear consecutively in the filename.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SIZE SIZE OF AN ARCHIVE FILE

This parameter specifies the size of an archive file in 2 KB blocks.

Notes:
- The theoretical upper limit is dependent on the hardware.
- The command is rejected if the specified memory requirement is
too big or too small.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

35...8388607, range of decimal numbers

TYPE TYPE

This parameter specifies whether an archive file is to be created


as a single file or a double file.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SINGLE SINGLE
DOUBLE DOUBLE

THRU THRESHOLD UPGRADE

This parameter specifies the occupancy level of an archive file


at which the alarm condition should commence.

Notes:
- The occupancy level is expressed as a percentage.
- An upper threshold value must be higher than the associated

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR AFILE- 1+
CR AFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

lower threshold value, i.e. THRU=0, THRD>0 is not allowed.


- If no THRU value has been set, the corresponding THRF should
not be set to ALARM.
- The THRU values entered must be different.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: THRESHOLD UPGRADE LIMIT LOW=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

b: THRESHOLD UPGRADE LIMIT MEDIUM=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

c: THRESHOLD UPGRADE LIMIT HIGH=


0...100, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

THRD THRESHOLD DOWNGRADE

This parameter specifies the occupancy level at which the alarm


condition (which was activated due to an exceeded occupancy level of
an archive file), is to be reset.

Note:
- The occupancy level is expressed as a percentage.
- An upper threshold value must not be less than the associated
lower threshold value, i.e. THRU=0, THRD>0 is not allowed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: THRESHOLD DOWNGRADE LIMIT LOW=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

b: THRESHOLD DOWNGRADE LIMIT MEDIUM=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

c: THRESHOLD DOWNGRADE LIMIT HIGH=


0...100, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

THRF THRESHOLD FEATURES

This parameter specifies whether the alarm which was activated by


the excessive occupancy level of an archive file is to be displayed
on the system panel.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: THRESHOLD FEATURE FOR UPGRADE LIMIT LOW


ALARM SYSTEM PANEL ALARM MESSAGES
NOALARM OUTPUT MESSAGE ONLY ON PRINTER

Default: NOALARM

b: THRESHOLD FEATURE FOR UPGRADE LIMIT MEDIUM

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR AFILE- 2+
CR AFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ALARM SYSTEM PANEL ALARM MESSAGE


NOALARM OUTPUT MESSAGE ONLY ON PRINTER

Default: NOALARM

c: THRESHOLD FEATURE FOR UPGRADE LIMIT HIGH


ALARM SYSTEM PANEL ALARM MESSAGE
NOALARM OUTPUT MESSAGE ONLY ON PRINTER

Default: NOALARM

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR AFILE- 3-
DISP AFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ARCHIVE FILE ATTRIBUTES

This command displays a table of archive files and their respective


attributes. The information can be displayed for individual archive
files or for all archive files.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP AFILE : AFILE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AFILE ARCHIVE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies an archive file. It can be input


in partially qualified form. Up to five parameter values can
be linked with &.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP AFILE- 1-


MOD AFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY ARCHIVE FILE ATTRIBUTES

This command modifies the threshold values and threshold value


characteristics of an archive file.
Threshold values THRU and THRD, together with the threshold value
characteristic THRF, make up a threshold value triple
(THRU,THRD,THRF).
A maximum of three threshold value triples can be assigned to an archive
file. However, they must have different THRU components.
While THRU, THRD and THRF must be entered in the input form of
a-b-c, the user can use dummy value 0 for THRU, THRD and dummy value
NOALARM for THRF, if necessary.

The following operations are possible:


- Adding up to three threshold value triples:
The components THRU,THRD and THRF must be entered like a-b-c/
- Switching between up to three threshold value triples:
Independent of modification the old THRU parameter a-b-c must be
specified for identification.
The components THRU THRD and THRF will be changed by entering
d-e-f/a-b-c with d-e-f as new and a-b-c as old input parameters.
- Canceling up to three threshold value triples:
The threshold value triple (THRU,THRD,THRF), that will be
canceled, must be changed to the triple (0,0,NOALARM).

Prerequisite:
- The available threshold value triples are known and can be displayed
using command DISP AFILE.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD AFILE : AFILE= [,THRU=] [,THRD=] [,THRF=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AFILE ARCHIVE FILE NAME

This parameter designates an archive file.

Notes:
- The first character may not be a period, the last character
may be neither a period nor an asterisk, and two periods may
not appear consecutively in the file name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

THRU THRESHOLD UPGRADE

This parameter specifies the occupancy level at which an alarm


message (which was activated due to an exceeded occupancy level
of an archive file), is to be initiated.

Notes:
- The occupancy level is expressed as a percentage.
- An upper threshold value must be higher than the associated
lower threshold value, i.e. THRU=0, THRD>0 is not allowed.
- If no THRU value has been set, the corresponding THRF should
not be set to ALARM.
- The THRU values entered must be different.

n/o
n/
/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD AFILE- 1+


MOD AFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a-b-c

a: THRESHOLD UPGRADE LIMIT LOW=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

b: THRESHOLD UPGRADE LIMIT MEDIUM=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

c: THRESHOLD UPGRADE LIMIT HIGH=


0...100, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

THRD THRESHOLD DOWNGRADE

This parameter specifies the occupancy level at which the alarm


message (which was activated due to an exceeded occupancy level
of an archive file), is to be reset.

Notes:
- The occupancy level is expressed as a percentage.
- The command is rejected if an upper threshold value is below the
associated lower threshold value THRU=0, THRD>0.

n/o
n/
/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

a-b-c

a: THRESHOLD DOWNGRADE LIMIT LOW=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

b: THRESHOLD DOWNGRADE LIMIT MEDIUM=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

c: THRESHOLD DOWNGRADE LIMIT HIGH=


0...100, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

THRF THRESHOLD FEATURES

This parameter specifies whether the alarm which was activated by


the excessive occupancy level of an archive file is to be displayed
on the system panel.

n/o
n/
/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

a-b-c

a: THRESHOLD FEATURE FOR UPGRADE LIMIT LOW


ALARM SYSTEM PANEL ALARM MESSAGE
NOALARM OUTPUT MESSAGE ONLY ON PRINTER

Default: NOALARM

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD AFILE- 2+


MOD AFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: THRESHOLD FEATURE FOR UPGRADE LIMIT MEDIUM


ALARM SYSTEM PANEL ALARM MESSAGE
NOALARM OUTPUT MESSAGE ONLY ON PRINTER

Default: NOALARM

c: THRESHOLD FEATURE FOR UPGRADE LIMIT HIGH


ALARM SYSTEM PANEL ALARM MESSAGE
NOALARM OUTPUT MESSAGE ONLY ON PRINTER

Default: NOALARM

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD AFILE- 3-


DISP ALARM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ALARM STATUS

This command displays the current alarm status of objects.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ALARM : [OBJECT=] [,ALSTAT=] [,ALPRIO=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJECT ALARM OBJECT

This parameter specifies the alarm object.

Note:
- If one parameter is omitted, all its values will be taken
into consideration.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP


DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT
SN SWITCHING NETWORK
MB MESSAGE BUFFER
CLOCK CENTRAL CLOCK GENERATOR
SYP SYSTEM PANEL
CCS COMMON CHANNEL SIGNALING
SIGLINK SIGNALING LINK
CU CENTRAL UNITS
LNLCKOUT LINE LOCKOUT
MAL MAINTENANCE ALARM
SAL SERVICE ALARM
TGAL TRUNK GROUP ALARM
TIMINSEC TIME INSECURE
SYOP CALL FOR SYSTEM OPERATOR
EALEXCH EXTERNAL EXCHANGE ALARM
EALDLU EXTERNAL DLU ALARM
OVLD OVERLOAD ALARM
RECOV RECOVERY ALARM
ADMINAL ADMINISTRATION ALARM
ATMF ATM FABRIC

ALSTAT ALARM STATUS

This parameter describes the fault clearance status of an


alarm condition. The processing code is a part of the alarm
file entry.

Note:
- If one parameter is omitted, all its values will be taken
into consideration.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

NP NOT PROCESSED
D DEFERRED
IP IN PROCESS
UR UNDER REPAIR

ALPRIO ALARM PRIORITY

This parameter specifies the alarm priority.

Note:
- If one parameter is omitted, all its values will be taken
into consideration.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ALARM- 1+


DISP ALARM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MINOR MINOR ALARM


MAJOR MAJOR ALARM
CRITICAL CRITICAL ALARM

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ALARM- 2-


SRCH ALARM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SEARCH ALARM MESSAGE

This command displays the alarm message. The information output is


organized according to the time at which the alarm occurred. Current
messages are displayed first.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 SRCH ALARM : <OBJECT= ,ALSTAT= ,ALPRIO= ,MSGNO=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJECT ALARM OBJECT

This parameter specifies the alarm object.

Note:
- If one parameter is omitted, all its values will be taken
into consideration.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP


DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT
SN SWITCHING NETWORK
MB MESSAGE BUFFER
CLOCK CENTRAL CLOCK GENERATOR
SYP SYSTEM PANEL
CCS COMMON CHANNEL SIGNALING
SIGLINK SIGNALING LINK
CU CENTRAL UNITS
LNLCKOUT LINE LOCKOUT
MAL MAINTENANCE ALARM
SAL SERVICE ALARM
TGAL TRUNK GROUP ALARM
TIMINSEC TIME INSECURE
SYOP CALL FOR SYSTEM OPERATOR
EALEXCH EXTERNAL EXCHANGE ALARM
EALDLU EXTERNAL DLU ALARM
OVLD OVERLOAD ALARM
RECOV RECOVERY ALARM
ADMINAL ADMINISTRATION ALARM
ATMF ATM FABRIC

ALSTAT ALARM STATUS

This parameter describes the fault clearance status of an


alarm condition. The processing code is a part of the alarm
file entry.

Note:
- If one parameter is omitted, all its values will be taken
into consideration.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

NC NOT CLEARED
All alarms with NP, D, IP and UR
are displayed.
NP NOT PROCESSED
D DEFERRED
IP IN PROCESS
UR UNDER REPAIR

ALPRIO ALARM PRIORITY

This parameter specifies the target priority for alarm signaling.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SRCH ALARM- 1+


SRCH ALARM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MINOR MINOR ALARM


MAJOR MAJOR ALARM
CRITICAL CRITICAL ALARM

MSGNO MESSAGE NUMBER

This parameter specifies a 5-digit message number, which


corresponds to the entry number used in the alarm file
AM.ALARM.

Note:
- There is no relation to the entry numbers of the history
file HF.ARCHIVE !

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...99999, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SRCH ALARM- 2-


DISP ALBALMON

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Alarm Balance Monitor

This task displays an ]Alarm Balance Monitor]. According to the


input parameters the followong output is supported:
- No ]Alarm balance monitor] is specified:
A list of all ]Alarm Balance Monitors] created in the system is
displayed including all their parameters.
- An ]Alarm balance monitor] is specified:
The specified ]Alarm Balance Monitor] is displayed including
all its parameters.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ALBALMON : [Alarm balance monitor=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Alarm balance monitor

This parameter specifies an ]Alarm Balance Monitor]


created in the system. The following input values are valid:
1) No input value is given, then a list of all ]Alarm Balance Monitors]
created in the system is displayed including all their parameters.
2) A string is given with a length of 1...8 characters of the character
set specifying the ]Alarm balance monitor] created
in the system. Then all parameters of the specified ]Alarm Balance
Monitor]
are displayed.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ALBALMON- 1-


ACT ALDISP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE ALARM DISPLAY

This command cancels the present entries of the alarm display suppression
and sets the default values.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT ALDISP : WDCAT= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

WDCAT WEEKDAY CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the weekday category for the alarm display
suppression.

The following values are possible:

- WO for workday.

- EH for half weekend day.


This means a portion of a day with the half weekend
day category ( any value between 1 to 24 hours ).

- EF for full weekend day.


This means the full day with 24 hours and with the full
weekend day category.

- HH for half holiday international. It means a day


with the half holiday category, which contains only a
portion of a day ( any value between 1 to 24 hours ).

- HO for full holiday international. It means a day


with the full holiday category, which has 24 hours.

- HN for full holiday national. It means a day with


the full holiday category, which has 24 hours.

International holidays are applicable for all countries.


National holidays are applicable only for one country.

The priority assignment for the individual weekday


categories is as follows:

HN > HO > HH > EF > EH > WO

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

WO WORKDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL
EH HALF WEEKEND DAY
EF FULL WEEKEND DAY

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT ALDISP- 1-


DACT ALDISP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE ALARM DISPLAY

This command sets the parameters for the alarm display suppression.

Prerequisite:
- The command is rejected, if an entry already exists for
the specified weekday category.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT ALDISP : ALPRIO= ,WDCAT= ,BEGTIM= ,ENDTIM= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ALPRIO ALARM PRIORITY

This parameter specifies the priorities for the alarm display


suppression.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

MINOR MINOR ALARM


display of minor alarms are suppressed
MAJOR MAJOR ALARM
display of minor and major alarms are suppressed

WDCAT WEEKDAY CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the weekday category for the alarm display
suppression.

The following values are possible:

- WO for workday.

- EH for half weekend day.


This means a portion of a day with the half weekend
day category ( any value between 1 to 24 hours ).

- EF for full weekend day.


This means the full day with 24 hours and with the full
weekend day category.

- HH for half holiday international. It means a day


with the half holiday category, which contains only a
portion of a day ( any value between 1 to 24 hours ).

- HO for full holiday international. It means a day


with the full holiday category, which has 24 hours.

- HN for full holiday national. It means a day with


the full holiday category, which has 24 hours.

International holidays are applicable for all countries.


National holidays are applicable only for one country.

The priority assignment for the individual weekday


categories is as follows:

HN > HO > HH > EF > EH > WO

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

WO WORKDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL
EH HALF WEEKEND DAY

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT ALDISP- 1+


DACT ALDISP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

EF FULL WEEKEND DAY

BEGTIM BEGIN TIME

This parameter specifies the start time of the alarm display


suppression.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...24, range of decimal numbers

ENDTIM END TIME

This parameter specifies the end time of the alarm display


suppression.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...24, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT ALDISP- 2-


DISP ALDISP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ALARM DISPLAY

This command lists the parameters of alarm display suppression.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ALDISP ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ALDISP- 1-


DISP ALI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Alarm Interface

This task displays the ]ALI].

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ALI ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ALI- 1-


MOD ALI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Alarm Interface

This task changes the ]Alarm profile MP] of the ]ALI].

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ALI : Alarm profile MP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Alarm profile MP

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ to the managed


unit to control its alarming behavior.

The ’Alarm Profile MP’ is used to determine the priority of


an alarm, depending on its ’Probable cause’ (see Q3-standards
X.721, M.3100 etc.) and the detected service impact.

Input format:
Selection from:
generally applicable ’Alarm Profile MPs’ available on MP:
- ’ALSUPP’: Alarm suppression
Alarm is negligible and therefore suppressed.
No alarm processing will be performed.
- ’WARNING’: Warning
Alarm constitutes a situation to which attention
is drawn. For all ’Probable cause’ values the
alarm priority ’Warning’ will be used.
- ’MINNOESC’: Minor with no escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MINESC’: Minor with escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’MAJNOESC’: Major with no escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MAJESC’: Major with escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’CRITICAL’: Critical
Alarm indicates a critical system condition.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Critical’ will be used.
or a user-defined one:
- ’own name’, Input: 1...8 characters from printable character set
Use task ’DISP ALPROFMP’ to get an overview of the
existing ’Alarm Profile MPs’.

Standard behavior:
If no ’Alarm Profile MP’ is specified in a create task, a reasonable
default value, depending on the managed object class, is selected by
the system.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ALI- 1-


CAN ALIAS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL ALIAS NAME

This command has two functions:


- Cancel an alias name from the alias name table.
- Start the garbage treatment.

Which function has to be performed is indicated by the parameter given.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1ALIAS= 1 1
1 CAN ALIAS : ZGARBAGE=Y ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ALIAS ALIAS FILE NAME

This parameter indicates that an alias name of a file shall be


cancelled.
The value of the parameter specifies the alias name to be cancelled.
After the execution of this command this file can just be accessed with
the file name.

Prerequisites:
- The alias name must exist.
- The file must not be in use by using the alias name.

Notes:
- The alias name has to be entered fully qualified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GARBAGE GARBAGE TREATMENT

This parameter indicates that the user wants to start the garbage
treatment.
This command starts the garbage treatment to check the shadow catalog
whether there are existing alias names to files, that are not existing
anymore.
As long as the garbage treatment is running no other command to modify
the alias name table will be accepted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y START GARBAGE TREATMENT


YES START GARBAGE TREATMENT

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ALIAS- 1-


DISP ALIAS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ALIAS FILE NAMES

This command displays a list of all existing alias names or a specified


subset of them.
The list contains the alias names and the file names which they are
related to.

Notes:
- If no parameter is given all alias names are displayed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11ALIAS=11 1
1 DISP ALIAS : 1ZFILE= Y1 ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ALIAS ALIAS FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the alias name(s) that should be displayed.


The output list will be displayed sorted by the alias names.

Notes:
- If the parameter is not given or supplied with X, all existing alias
names with their relation to the file names are displayed.

- If the parameter is supplied with a partly qualified alias name


(indicated by a ’.’ as the last character) all matching alias names
with their relation to the file names are displayed.

- If the parameter is supplied with a fully qualified alias name then


the relation of this name to the original file name will be
displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the file name(s) with related alias names,
that should be displayed.
The output list will be displayed sorted by the file names.

Notes:
- If the parameter is supplied with X, all file names with their
related alias names are displayed (so far there are related alias
names).

- If the parameter is supplied with a partly qualified file name


(indicated by a ’.’ as the last character) all matching file names
with their related alias names are displayed.

- If the parameter is supplied with a fully qualified file name then


the related alias name to the original file name will be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ALIAS- 1-


ENTR ALIAS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER ALIAS FILE NAME

This command creates an alias name to an existing disk file.


Afterwards this file can be accessed either with the original file name or the
alias name.

Prerequisites:
- The file must exist.
- The file must not be a generation file.
- The alias name must not exist (neither as a file name nor as an alias name).
- The file must not yet have an alias name.
- The alias name must not be file name protected.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR ALIAS : FILE= ,ALIAS= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of an existing file.

Notes:
- The file name has to be entered fully qualified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ALIAS ALIAS FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the alias name for the file.

Notes:
- The alias name has to be entered fully qualified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ALIAS- 1-


MOD ALIAS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY ALIAS NAME

This command renames the alias name of disk files.


After the execution of this command the old alias name is no longer valid.
The file can only be accessed by using the original file name or the new
alias name.

Prerequisites:
- The old alias name must exist.
- The new alias name must not exist (neither as a file name nor as an alias
name).
- The new alias name must not be file name protected.
- The file must not be in use by using the old alias name.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ALIAS : ALIAS= ,NEWALIAS= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ALIAS OLD ALIAS FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the old alias name that shall be renamed.

Notes:
- The old alias name has to be entered fully qualified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NEWALIAS NEW ALIAS FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the new alias name.

Notes:
- The new alias name has to be entered fully qualified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ALIAS- 1-


CAN ALINIF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Alarm Input Interface

This task cancels an ]Alarm Input Interface] serving the


administration of system external alarms.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN ALINIF : Alarm input interface= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Alarm input interface

This parameter specifies the ]Alarm Input Interface] that shall


be canceled. Valid input parameters are 1...8 characters from
the character set.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ALINIF- 1-


CR ALINIF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create Alarm Input Interface

This task creates an ]Alarm Input Interface]. This interface is


used to administer the system external alarms. The system external alarms
are connected to the system by an ]Alarm line].

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR ALINIF : Alarm input interface= ,Alarm line= ,Alarm level= 1
1 1
1 ,Alarm profile MP= ,Probable cause= ,Device type= 1
1 1
1 [,Profibus address=] [,Additional text=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Alarm input interface

This parameter specifies the ]Alarm Input Interface].


A valid input value is a string with a length of 1...8 characters from
the
character set.

Alarm line

This parameter specifies the ]Alarm line], the


]Alarm Input Interface] is assigned to.
Valid input values are: 0...31, range of decimal numbers.

Alarm level

This parameter specifies the level activating the external alarm line.
Valid input values are: High, Low. The value Low behaves reverse to
High.

Alarm profile MP

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’


on the MP to a unit.
The ’Alarm Profile MP’ contains the Probable cause
values. For each Probable cause an alarm priority is assigned.
On the MP the following standardised ’Alarm Profile MP’s
are available:

ALSUPP:
The alarm priority of all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is suppressed.

WARNING:
This is no alarm, but a warning. The alarm priority of all
Probable cause values indicates a warning.

MINNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is of minor importance and will not escalate.

MINESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is minor,
if the service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
In case the service is affected the priority will escalate to
critical.

MAJNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable causeindicates that the
alarm is of major importance but will not escalate.

MAJESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is major,
if the service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
If service is affected, the priority will escalate to critical.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ALINIF- 1+
CR ALINIF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CRITICAL:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is critical,
i.e. service is affected.

Probable cause

This parameter defines the ]Probable cause]. It is


specifying the error reason within an emitted alarm in case a failure
occurs at the ]Alarm Input Interface]. Valid input values
for the ]Probable cause] are:
]Air compressor failure],
]Air conditioning failure],
]Air dryer failure],
]Battery discharging],
]Battery failure],
]Commercial power failure],
]Cooling fan failure],
]Enclosure door open],
]Engine failure],
]Excessive vibration],
]Explosive gas],
]Fire detected],
]Fire detector failure],
]Flood detected],
]Fuse failure],
]Generator failure],
]Heating, ventilation or cooling system problem],
]High humidity],
]High temperature],
]High wind],
]Humidity unacceptable],
]Ice build up],
]Indeterminate],
]Intrusion detection],
]Leak detected],
]Low battery threshold],
]Low cable pressure],
]Low fuel],
]Low humidity],
]Low temperature],
]Low water],
]Material supply exhausted],
]Power problem],
]Pressure unacceptable],
]Pump failure],
]Rectifier failure],
]Rectifier high voltage],
]Rectifier low F Voltage],
]Smoke detected],
]Temperature unacceptable],
]Toxic gas],
]Toxic leak detected],
]Ventilations system failure]

Device type

The parameter ’Device type’ represents


either an
- Alarm Line Interface (ALI) or
- Profibus Device (PBUSDEV),
where the alarm line is connected to.
For each ’Device type’ the ’Alarm line’
must be unambiguous.
Valid input values are: ALI, PBUSDEV.

Profibus address

This parameter corresponds to the bus address adjusted at the


]Profibus Device]. The input of this parameter is
mandatory for device type ]Profibus Device]. Valid
input values are: 16...19, range of decimal numbers.

Additional text

This parameter specifies the error situation of the external alarm


assigned at the ]external alarm line]. Valid input value

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ALINIF- 2+
CR ALINIF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

is a text string of 0...80 characters from the character set. If no alarm


text is specified a text string containing a blank value is used as
default.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ALINIF- 3-
DISP ALINIF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Alarm Input Interface

This task displays an ]Alarm Input Interface]. Dependent on the


input parameters the following output is supported:
- No ]Alarm input interface] is specified:
A list of all ]Alarm Input Interfaces] created in the system is
displayed without any parameters.
- An ]Alarm input interface] is specified:
The specified ]Alarm Input Interface] is displayed including
all its parameters.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ALINIF : [Alarm input interface=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Alarm input interface

This parameter specifies the ]Alarm Input Interface].


The following input values are valid:
1) No input value is given, then a list of all ]Alarm Input Interfaces]
existing in the system is displayed without any parameters.
2) 1...8 characters from the character set are given as input value,
specifying an ]Alarm input interface] created in the
system. Then all parameters of the specified ]Alarm Input Interface]
are displayed.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ALINIF- 1-


MOD ALINIF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Alarm Input Interface

This task modifies the parameter ]Alarm profile MP]


of an ]Alarm Input Interface].

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ALINIF : Alarm input interface= ,Alarm profile MP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Alarm input interface

This parameter specifies the ]Alarm Input Interface]. A valid


input value is a string with a length of 1...8 characters from the
character set specifying an ]Alarm input interface]
created in the system.

Alarm profile MP

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’


on the MP to a unit.
The ’Alarm Profile MP’ contains the Probable cause
values. For each Probable cause an alarm priority is assigned.
On the MP the following standardised ’Alarm Profile MP’s
are available:

ALSUPP:
The alarm priority of all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is suppressed.

WARNING:
This is no alarm, but a warning. The alarm priority of all
Probable cause values indicates a warning.

MINNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is of minor importance and will not escalate.

MINESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is minor,
if the service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
In case the service is affected the priority will escalate to
critical.

MAJNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable causeindicates that the
alarm is of major importance but will not escalate.

MAJESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is major,
if the service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
If service is affected, the priority will escalate to critical.

CRITICAL:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is critical,
i.e. service is affected.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ALINIF- 1-


DISP ALOUTIF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Alarm Output Interface

This task displays all parameters of ]Alarm Output Interface].


Dependent on the input parameters the following output is supported:
- No ]Alarm output interface] is specified:
A list of all ]Alarm Output Interfaces] created in the system
is displayed including all their parameters.
- An ]Alarm output interface] is specified:
The ]Alarm Output Interface] is displayed including all its
parameters.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ALOUTIF : [Alarm output interface=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Alarm output interface

This parameter specifies an ]Alarm Output Interface].


The following input values are valid:
1) No input value is given, then a list of all ]Alarm Output Interfaces]
created in the system is displayed including all their parameters.
2) A string is given with a length of 1...8 characters of the character
set specifying an ]Alarm output interface] created in
the system. Then all parameters of the spaecified ]Alarm Output
Interface]
are displayed.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ALOUTIF- 1-


CAN ALPRIO
DLU
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL ALARM PRIORITY

This command cancels the individual priorities of a specified alarm unit.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CAN ALPRIO - DLU DLU INDIVIDUAL PRIORITIES


2. CAN ALPRIO - LSNAM LSNAM INDIVIDUAL PRIORITIES

1. Input format

DLU INDIVIDUAL PRIORITIES

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN ALPRIO : ALUNIT= ,DLU= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ALUNIT ALARM UNIT

This parameter specifies the alarm units with alarm unit individual
priorities.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DLUC DIGITAL LINE UNIT CONTROL

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

Here the number of the affected DLU with individual alarm priorities
is specified in the three high-order positions (value range 1 to 255 ).
The lowest-order position must always be 0.
For a DLU Controller (DLUC) of a DLUG the alarm priority cannot be
administered by this command. Please use the commands:
MOD DLU or
MOD DLUEQ or
MOD DLUMOD
to administer the alarm profile.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...2550, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ALPRIO- 1+


CAN ALPRIO
LSNAM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

LSNAM INDIVIDUAL PRIORITIES

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN ALPRIO : ALUNIT= ,LSNAM= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ALUNIT ALARM UNIT

This parameter specifies the alarm units with alarm unit individual
priorities.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CCSLS COMMON CHANNEL SIGN. LINK SET

LSNAM LINK SET NAME

This parameter specifies the affected linkset name with individual


alarm priority.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ALPRIO- 2-


DISP ALPRIO
DLU
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ALARM PRIORITY

This command displays the priorities for alarm signaling which are
currently set in the system. All alarm priorities can be displayed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP ALPRIO - DLU DLU INDIVIDUAL PRIORITIES


2. DISP ALPRIO - GENERAL GENERAL PRIORITIES
3. DISP ALPRIO - LSNAM LSNAM INDIVIDUAL PRIORITIES

1. Input format

DLU INDIVIDUAL PRIORITIES

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ALPRIO : ALUNIT= ,DLU= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ALUNIT ALARM UNIT

This parameter specifies the alarm units for alarm signaling.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DLUC DIGITAL LINE UNIT CONTROL

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

Here the number of the affected DLU with individual alarm priorities
is specified in the three high-order positions (value range 1 to 255 ).
The lowest-order position must always be 0.
For a DLU Controller (DLUC) of a DLUG the alarm priority cannot be
administered by this command. Please use the commands:
DISP DLU or
DISP DLUEQ or
DISP DLUMOD
to administer the alarm profile.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...2550, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ALPRIO- 1+


DISP ALPRIO
GENERAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

GENERAL PRIORITIES

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ALPRIO : [ALUNIT=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ALUNIT ALARM UNIT

This parameter specifies the alarm units for alarm signaling.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACTGENDE DOUBLE ERROR ACTUAL GENERATION


ACTGENSE SINGLE ERROR ACTUAL GENERATION
ADMFIL1 ADMINISTRATION FILE ALARM 1
ADMFIL2 ADMINISTRATION FILE ALARM 2
ADMFIL3 ADMINISTRATION FILE ALARM 3
AIC AIR CIRCULATOR
AMP ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR
ANNAL REC. ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP ALARM
BAP BASE PROCESSOR
BCMY BUS TO COMMON MEMORY
CALLID1 CALL IDENTIFICATION 1
CALLID2 CALL IDENTIFICATION 2
CALLID3 CALL IDENTIFICATION 3
CALLID4 CALL IDENTIFICATION 4
CAP CALL PROCESSOR
CCG CENTRAL CLOCK GENERATOR
CCNCCD CCNC CODE OR DATA
CCNCTD CCNC TRUNK DATA
CCNP COMMON CHANNEL NETW. PROCESSOR
CCNPLOLD CCNP LOCAL OVERLOAD
CCNPPAF PARTIAL FAILURE CCNP
CCSCOLS CCS COMMBINED LINK SET
CCSL COMMON CHANNEL SIGNALING LINK
CCSLNAC CCS LINK NAC
CCSLS CCS LINK SET
CCSLSNAC CCS LINK SET NAC
CCSLSNEX CCS LINK SET NAC EXCEPTION
CCSTGAL CCS TRUNK GROUP ALARM
CDBUS CD-BUS FAILURE
CITERA COMMAND INTERFACE FOR TERADYNE
CMY COMMON MEMORY
CPACC UNAUTHORIZED CP-ACCESS
CR CODE RECEIVER
CSC CENTRAL SERVICE CHANNEL
CYCFIL1 CYCLIC FILE ALARM 1
CYCFIL2 CYCLIC FILE ALARM 2
CYCFIL3 CYCLIC FILE ALARM 3
DCC DIRECT CURRENT CONVERTER
DFILFAIL DOUBLE FILE FAILURE
DIU DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT
DLUC DIGITAL LINE UNIT CONTROL
ECSL EMERGENCY CALL STATION LINE
ECSM EMERGENCY CALL STATION MODULE
FISPARES NO SPARE SECT. FOR DOUBLE FILE
ICHAN INTERNET CHANNEL
IOC INPUT OUTPUT CONTROL
IOPAUC IOP AUTHENTICATION CENTER
IOPLAU IOP LINK ADAPTION UNIT
IOPMB IOP MESSAGE BUFFER
IOPMDD IOP MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
IOPMTD IOP MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE
IOPSCDV IOP SERIAL DATA COMMUN. DEV. V
IOPSCDX IOP SERIAL DATA COMMUN. DEV. X
IOPTA IOP TIME/ALARM
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES
ISTART CP INITIAL START RECOVERY
ISTART2G CP ISTART + FALLBACK OLD. GEN.
LAU LINK ADAPTION UNIT

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ALPRIO- 2+


DISP ALPRIO
GENERAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP


LTGCEN LTG CENTRAL FAILURE
LTGLOLD LTG LOCAL OVERLOAD
LTGPAF LTG PARTIAL FAILURE
MB MESSAGE BUFFER
This parameter is only valid for DE3.
MBUL MESSAGE BUFFER UNIT LTG
This parameter is only valid for DE4 and DE5.
MBUS MESSAGE BUFFER UNIT SGC
This parameter is only valid for DE4 and DE5.
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
MOD MAGNETO OPTICAL DISK DEVICE
MTACC METALLIC TEST ACCESS ERROR
MTD MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE
MUXM MULTIPLEXER
MUXMFAIL MULTIPLEXER FAILURE
NODEISO LOCAL NODE ISOLATION
NSTART CP NEW START RECOVERY
OMT OPERATION/MAINTENANCE TERMINAL
PBX PRIVATE BRANCH EXCHANGE
PCHANNUC P-CHANNEL NUC FAILURE
PCHANS P-CHANNEL SWITCHED FAILURE
PCMMAL PCM MAINTENANCE ALARM
PCMSAL PCM SERVICE ALARM
RAE RECORDED ANNOUNCEMENT EQUIPM.
RCI RADIO CLOCK INTERFACE
RCULINK REMOTE CONTROL UNIT LINK
RGMG RING-/METER GENERATOR FOR DLU
SAVGENE SAVE GENERATION ERROR
SCGROUP SOFTWARE CARRIER GROUP ALARM
SIDAT SYSTEM INDEPEND. DATA TRANSFER
SILT SIGNALING DATA LINK TERMINAL
SILTC SILT CONTROL
SLM SUBSCRIBER LINE MODULE
SN SWITCHING NETWORK
This parameter is only valid for DE3 and DE4.
SSG SPACE STAGE GROUP
This parameter is only valid for DE5.
SUB SUBSCRIBER
SYPC SYSTEM PANEL CONTROL
SYSOP SYSTEM OPERATOR
SYSOVLD SYSTEM OVERLOAD
TGAL TRUNK GROUP ALARM
TIMINCOR TIME INCORRECT
TIMINSEC TIME INSECURE
TRUNKHD TRUNK HELD
TSG TIME STAGE GROUP
This parameter is only valid for DE5.
UNSPARES NO SPARE SECT. F. UNUSED SPACE
VOCAFAIL VOLUME/CATALOG FAILURE
X25LINK BX.25 LINK

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ALPRIO- 3+


DISP ALPRIO
LSNAM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

LSNAM INDIVIDUAL PRIORITIES

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ALPRIO : ALUNIT= ,LSNAM= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ALUNIT ALARM UNIT

This parameter specifies the alarm units for alarm signaling.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CCSLS CCS LINK SET

LSNAM LINK SET NAME

This parameter specifies the affected linkset name with individual


alarm priority.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ALPRIO- 4-


ENTR ALPRIO
DLU
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER ALARM PRIORITY

This command modifies the priorities for alarm signaling which are
currently set in the system.

- Units which are in MBL or CBL are displayed on the system panel
by a HARDWARE UNITS lamp.
This display cannot be changed with this command.
Nor can the displays for the advisory messages CAT1, CAT2, TGBL,
SIGLBL and ALDSUP be changed with this command.

- Procedures to determine an operational restriction are implemented


for some alarm units. If one of these procedures finds an operational
restriction for the unit with alarm condition, the alarm priority is
raised to CRITICAL. This alarm priority cannot be changed with this
command.

- DLU failures are displayed on the system panel with the double LED
for the line/trunk group. The lamp for remote equipment (under the
the line/trunk group lamp) also lights up. The lamp display for
remote equipment cannot be changed with this command.

- System panel failures trigger an alarm on the double LED. The alarm
priority for this lamp (at present CRITICAL) is determined in the
system panel firmware. However, the priority for this alarm can be
changed for other alarm units (system status displays, output messages,
critical indicator channel to SCC) with this command.

Prerequisite:
- The priorities for external exchange alarms are part of the SYPC firm-
ware.

- If the system panel has only one LED for a particular alarm, ALPRIO
cannot be set to CRITICAL because this requires 2 LEDs.

- The use of the command only makes sense, if there is no active alarm
of the specified ALUNIT, because different priorities of active alarm
and new alarm with modified alarm priority lead to different alarm
signaling.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ENTR ALPRIO - DLU DLU INDIVIDUAL PRIORITIES


2. ENTR ALPRIO - GENERAL GENERAL PRIORITIES
3. ENTR ALPRIO - LSNAM LSNAM INDIVIDUAL PRIORITIES

1. Input format

DLU INDIVIDUAL PRIORITIES

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR ALPRIO : ALUNIT= ,DLU= ,ALPRIO= [,SDG=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ALUNIT ALARM UNIT

This parameter specifies the alarm units for alarm signaling.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DLUC DIGITAL LINE UNIT CONTROL

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

Here the number of the affected DLU with individual alarm priorities
is specified in the three high-order positions (value range 1 to 255 ).
The lowest-order position must always be 0.
For a DLU Controller (DLUC) of a DLUG the alarm priority cannot be

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ALPRIO- 1+


ENTR ALPRIO
DLU
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

administered by this command. Please use the commands:


CR DLU/MOD DLU or
CR DLUEQ/MOD DLUEQ or
CR DLUMOD/MOD DLUMOD
to administer the alarm profile.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...2550, range of decimal numbers

ALPRIO ALARM PRIORITY

This parameter specifies the target priority for alarm signaling.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CRITICAL CRITICAL ALARM


MAJOR MAJOR ALARM
MINOR MINOR ALARM

SDG SERVICE DEGRADATION

This parameter defines the check of service degradation condition.

Default: no affect on database

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO SERVICE DEGRADATION DESIRED


YES SERVICE DEGRADATION DESIRED

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ALPRIO- 2+


ENTR ALPRIO
GENERAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

GENERAL PRIORITIES

Prerequisite:
The command is rejected if no service degradation condition is defined
for the specified ALUNIT.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR ALPRIO : ALUNIT= ,ALPRIO= [,SDG=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ALUNIT ALARM UNIT

This parameter specifies the alarm units for alarm signaling.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACTGENDE DOUBLE ERROR ACTUAL GENERATION


ACTGENSE SINGLE ERROR ACTUAL GENERATION
ADMFIL1 ADMINISTRATION FILE ALARM 1
ADMFIL2 ADMINISTRATION FILE ALARM 2
ADMFIL3 ADMINISTRATION FILE ALARM 3
AIC AIR CIRCULATOR
AMP ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR
ANNAL REC. ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP ALARM
BAP BASE PROCESSOR
BCMY BUS TO COMMON MEMORY
CALLID1 CALL IDENTIFICATION 1
CALLID2 CALL IDENTIFICATION 2
CALLID3 CALL IDENTIFICATION 3
CALLID4 CALL IDENTIFICATION 4
CAP CALL PROCESSOR
CCG CENTRAL CLOCK GENERATOR
CCNCCD CCNC CODE OR DATA
CCNCTD CCNC TRUNK DATA
CCNP COMMON CHANNEL NETW. PROCESSOR
CCNPLOLD CCNP LOCAL OVERLOAD
CCNPPAF PARTIAL FAILURE CCNP
CCSCOLS CCS COMMBINED LINK SET
CCSL COMMON CHANNEL SIGNALING LINK
CCSLNAC CCS LINK NAC
CCSLS CCS LINK SET
CCSLSNAC CCS LINK SET NAC
CCSLSNEX CCS LINK SET NAC EXCEPTION
CCSTGAL CCS TRUNK GROUP ALARM
CDBUS CD-BUS FAILURE
CITERA COMMAND INTERFACE FOR TERADYNE
CMY COMMON MEMORY
CPACC UNAUTHORIZED CP-ACCESS
CR CODE RECEIVER
CSC CENTRAL SERVICE CHANNEL
CYCFIL1 CYCLIC FILE ALARM 1
CYCFIL2 CYCLIC FILE ALARM 2
CYCFIL3 CYCLIC FILE ALARM 3
DCC DIRECT CURRENT CONVERTER
DFILFAIL DOUBLE FILE FAILURE
DIU DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT
DLUC DIGITAL LINE UNIT CONTROL
ECSL EMERGENCY CALL STATION LINE
ECSM EMERGENCY CALL STATION MODULE
FISPARES NO SPARE SECT. FOR DOUBLE FILE
ICHAN INTERNET CHANNEL
IOC INPUT OUTPUT CONTROL
IOPAUC IOP AUTHENTICATION CENTER
IOPLAU IOP LINK ADAPTION UNIT
IOPMB IOP MESSAGE BUFFER
IOPMDD IOP MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
IOPMTD IOP MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE
IOPSCDV IOP SERIAL DATA COMMUN. DEV. V
IOPSCDX IOP SERIAL DATA COMMUN. DEV. X
IOPTA IOP TIME/ALARM
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ALPRIO- 3+


ENTR ALPRIO
GENERAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ISTART CP INITIAL START RECOVERY


ISTART2G CP ISTART + FALLBACK OLD. GEN.
LAU LINK ADAPTION UNIT
LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP
LTGCEN LTG CENTRAL FAILURE
LTGLOLD LTG LOCAL OVERLOAD
LTGPAF LTG PARTIAL FAILURE
MB MESSAGE BUFFER
This parameter is only valid for DE3.
MBUL MESSAGE BUFFER UNIT LTG
This parameter is only valid for DE4 and DE5.
MBUS MESSAGE BUFFER UNIT SGC
This parameter is only valid for DE4 and DE5.
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
MOD MAGNETO OPTICAL DISK DEVICE
MTACC METALLIC TEST ACCESS ERROR
MTD MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE
MUXM MULTIPLEXER
MUXMFAIL MULTIPLEXER FAILURE
NODEISO LOCAL NODE ISOLATION
NSTART CP NEW START RECOVERY
OMT OPERATION/MAINTENANCE TERMINAL
PBX PRIVATE BRANCH EXCHANGE
PCHANNUC P-CHANNEL NUC FAILURE
PCHANS P-CHANNEL SWITCHED FAILURE
PCMMAL PCM MAINTENANCE ALARM
PCMSAL PCM SERVICE ALARM
RAE RECORDED ANNOUNCEMENT EQUIPM.
RCI RADIO CLOCK INTERFACE
RCULINK REMOTE CONTROL UNIT LINK
RGMG RING-/METER GENERATOR FOR DLU
SAVGENE SAVE GENERATION ERROR
SCGROUP SOFTWARE CARRIER GROUP ALARM
SIDAT SYSTEM INDEPEND. DATA TRANSFER
SILT SIGNALING DATA LINK TERMINAL
SILTC SILT CONTROL
SLM SUBSCRIBER LINE MODULE
SN SWITCHING NETWORK
This parameter is only valid for DE3 and DE4.
SSG SPACE STAGE GROUP
This parameter is only valid for DE5.
SUB SUBSCRIBER
SYPC SYSTEM PANEL CONTROL
SYSOP SYSTEM OPERATOR
SYSOVLD SYSTEM OVERLOAD
TGAL TRUNK GROUP ALARM
TIMINCOR TIME INCORRECT
TIMINSEC TIME INSECURE
TRUNKHD TRUNK HELD
TSG TIME STAGE GROUP
This parameter is only valid for DE5.
UNSPARES NO SPARE SECT. F. UNUSED SPACE
VOCAFAIL VOLUME/CATALOG FAILURE
X25LINK BX.25 LINK

ALPRIO ALARM PRIORITY

This parameter specifies the target priority for alarm signaling.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CRITICAL CRITICAL ALARM


MAJOR MAJOR ALARM
MINOR MINOR ALARM

SDG SERVICE DEGRADATION

This parameter defines the check of service degradation condition.

Default: no affect on database

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO SERVICE DEGRADATION DESIRED


YES SERVICE DEGRADATION DESIRED

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ALPRIO- 4+


ENTR ALPRIO
LSNAM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

LSNAM INDIVIDUAL PRIORITIES

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR ALPRIO : ALUNIT= ,LSNAM= ,ALPRIO= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ALUNIT ALARM UNIT

This parameter specifies the alarm units for alarm signaling.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CCSLS CCS LINK SET

LSNAM LINK SET NAME

This parameter specifies the affected linkset name with individual


alarm priority.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ALPRIO ALARM PRIORITY

This parameter specifies the target priority for alarm signaling.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CRITICAL CRITICAL ALARM


MAJOR MAJOR ALARM
MINOR MINOR ALARM

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ALPRIO- 5-


DISP ALPROF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ALARM PROFILE

This command displays


- all alarm profiles for alarm signaling which are currently set in the
system;
- the assignment of alarm priorities ( non-degrading and degrading ) to
the existing probable causes for a specified alarm profile identifica-
tion.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ALPROF : ALPROF= [,FORMAT=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ALPROF ALARM PROFILE IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the alarm profile identification for


alarm signaling.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FORMAT FORMAT OF OUTPUT

This parameter specifies the output format.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CONTENTS CONTENTS OF ALARM PROFILE


SUMMARY SUMMARY OF EXISTING PROFILES

Default: SUMMARY

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ALPROF- 1-


DISP ALPROFMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Alarm Profile MP

This task displays an ]Alarm Profile MP].


Dependent on the input parameters the following output is supported:
- No ]Alarm profile MP] is specified:
A list of all ]Alarm Profile MPs] created in the
system is displayed without their parameters.
- An ]Alarm profile MP] is specified:
The specified ]Alarm Profile MP] is displayed
including all its parameters.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ALPROFMP : [Alarm profile MP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Alarm profile MP

This parameter specifies the Alarm Profile created on the MP.


The following input values are valid:
1) No input value is given, then a list of all ]Alarm Profile MPs]
created in the system is displayed.
2) A string is given with a length of 1...8 characters of the character
set specifying an ]Alarm profile MP] created in the system.
Then all parameters of the specified ]Alarm Profile MP]
are displayed.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ALPROFMP- 1-


CR ALRELAIS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create Alarm Relais

This script installs an alarm relais to provide alarm forwarding for all alarms
with Alarm priority Minor, Major, Critical and all PCM alarms in the system.
Therefore the following units are created:
1) Alarm forwarding of alarms with Alarm priority Critical:
Creates an ]Alarm Output Interface] called CRITICAL, that serves
as alarm forwarding relais for all alarms with Alarm priority Critical in the
system by referencing the Standard ]Alarm Balance Monitor]
(STALBAMO).
2) Alarm forwarding of alarms with Alarm priority Major:
Creates an ]Alarm Output Interface] called MAJOR, that serves
as alarm forwarding relais for all alarms with Alarm priority Major in the
system by referencing the Standard ]Alarm Balance Monitor]
(STALBAMO).
3) Alarm forwarding of alarms with Alarm priority Minor:
Creates an ]Alarm Output Interface] called MINOR, that serves
as alarm forwarding relais for all alarms with Alarm priority Minor in the
system by referencing the Standard ]Alarm Balance Monitor]
(STALBAMO).
4) Alarm forwarding of PCM alarms:
a) Creates an ]Alarm Balance Monitor] called PCM collecting
the balance information of the CP alarm object SAL and MAL.
b) Creates an ]Alarm Output Interface] called PCM that serves
as alarm forwarding relais for PCM alarms with Alarm priority Major.
It references the ]Alarm Balance Monitor] PCM.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR ALRELAIS ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ALRELAIS- 1-
RSET ALRELAIS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Reset Alarm Relais

This script resets the alarm relais that provide alarm forwarding for
all alarms with Alarm priority Minor, Major, Critical and Major PCM
alarms in the system.
Therefore the following alarm balance monitors are confirmed:
1) Action Confirm Alarm Balance for the Standard ’Alarm Balance Monitor’
(STALBAMO), to reset relais for alarm forwarding of alarms with alarm
priority Minor, Major, Critical.
2) Action Confirm Alarm Balance for the PCM ’Alarm Balance Monitor’
(PCM) collecting the balance information of the CP alarm objects
SAL and MAL.
If a new alarm occurs after executing this script, the appropriate
alarm forwarding is reactivated.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 RSET ALRELAIS ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RSET ALRELAIS- 1-


RSET ALSSNCR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Reset Alarm SSNC Recovery

This task is used to clear the alarm after a LOADREC3 Recovery of SSNC.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 RSET ALSSNCR ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RSET ALSSNCR- 1-


SET ALSTAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SET ALARM STATUS

This command sets the processing code which describes the current status
of fault clearance in the alarm file stored for each alarm.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 SET ALSTAT : MSGNO= ,ALSTAT= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSGNO MESSAGE NUMBER

This parameter specifies a 5-digit message number, which


corresponds to the entry number used in the alarm file
AM.ALARM.

Note:
- There is no relation to the entry numbers of the history
file HF.ARCHIVE !

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...99999, range of decimal numbers

ALSTAT ALARM STATUS

This parameter describes the fault clearance status of an


alarm condition. The processing code is a part of the alarm
file entry.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

D DEFERRED
The command is rejected, if the corres-
ponding object instance is UR.
IP IN PROCESS
The command is rejected, if the corres-
ponding object instance is UR.
C CLEARED
This value applies for
- System operator alarms (SYOP)
- Administration alarms (ADMINAL)
Exception: Alarms with alarm class THRES
- Recovery alarms (RECOV )
- Time insecure alarms (TIMINSEC)
with alarm unit/class TIMINCOR.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SET ALSTAT- 1-


CAN ALTEXT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL ALARM TEXT

This command cancels an existing alarm text.

Prerequisite:
- The cancellation job is only executed if the alarm text in
question is not assigned to an external alarm circuit.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN ALTEXT : TEXTNO= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TEXTNO TEXT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the number assigned to an alarm text.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...40, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ALTEXT- 1-


DISP ALTEXT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ALARM TEXT

This command displays the alarm texts assigned to a number.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ALTEXT : TEXTNO= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TEXTNO TEXT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the alarm text number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...40, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ALTEXT- 1-


ENTR ALTEXT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER ALARM TEXT

This command enters an alarm text and assigns a text number to it.

Prerequisite:
- The command is rejected, if a text already exists under
this number.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR ALTEXT : TEXTNO= ,TEXT= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TEXTNO TEXT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the alarm text number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...40, range of decimal numbers

TEXT TEXT

This parameter consists of a text (freely definable).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...30 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ALTEXT- 1-


CAN AMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR

This command cancels a pair of ATM bridge processors.


Prerequisites:
- Both ATM bridge processors must be PLA. Note that the configuration
of the last AMP of a pair from ACT to MBL is only executed when
the redundant AMP is already PLA.
- The ATM bridge must be cancelled first.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN AMP : AMP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AMP ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies one of the ATM bridge processors to be


cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...5, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN AMP- 1-


COM AMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

COMMUTE ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR

This command commutes the working states (working / spare) of one or


more pairs of ATM bridge processors.

Possible Effects:
- During the execution of this command simultaneously to high
traffic-load a minimal loss of messages is possible.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 COM AMP : AMP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AMP ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the pairs of ATM bridge processors whoes


working state have to be commuted.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

0...5, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 COM AMP- 1-


CONF AMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR

This command configures an ATM bridge processor.

Possible Effects:
- During the execution of this command simultaneously to high
traffic-load a minimal loss of messages is possible.

Notes:
- The configuration from ACT to MBL and the configuration from
MBL or UNA to ACT is considered dangerous.
A dialog mask is output. The operating personal determines by
entering ’+’ or ’-’ whether the command is to be executed.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF AMP : AMP= ,OST= [,DIAG=] [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AMP ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the ATM bridge processor to be configured.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...5, range of decimal numbers

OST OPERATING STATE

This parameter specifies the target operating state.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED
PLA PLANNED

DIAG DIAGNOSIS

This parameter allows diagnosis before configuration to ACT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N CONFIGURE WITHOUT DIAGNOSIS


NO CONFIGURE WITHOUT DIAGNOSIS
Y CONFIGURE WITH DIAGNOSIS
YES CONFIGURE WITH DIAGNOSIS

Default: YES

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF AMP- 1-


CR AMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR

This command creates a pair of ATM bridge processors (AMP-0/1, AMP-2/3


or AMP-4/5). The created ATM bridge processors are in the operating
state PLA after the command is executed.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR AMP : AMP= ,PBI= ,AMPR= ,PBIR= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AMP ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the ATM bridge processor to be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...5, range of decimal numbers

PBI PHYSICAL BUS INTERFACE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the physical bus interface number of the


ATM bridge processor.
Notes:
- The physical bus interface number depends on the mounting location
of the ATM bridge processor specified by parameter AMP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...15, range of decimal numbers

AMPR REDUNDANT ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the redundant ATM bridge processor to be


created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...5, range of decimal numbers

PBIR PBI OF REDUNDANT AMP

This parameter specifies the physical bus interface number of the


redundant ATM bridge processor.
Notes:
- The physical bus interface number depends on the mounting location
of the redundant ATM bridge processor specified by parameter AMPR.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...15, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR AMP- 1-
DIAG AMP
DIAG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSE ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR

This command initiates single, repeated or permanent diagnostic runs


for an ATM bridge processor.

Prerequisites:
- The ATM bridge processor must be MBL.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DIAG AMP - DIAG SINGLE DIAGNOSIS


2. DIAG AMP - REPDIAG REPEATED DIAGNOSIS

1. Input format

SINGLE DIAGNOSIS

This input initiates a single diagnosis for an ATM bridge processor.


The diagnosis includes a BCMY interface test.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG AMP : AMP= [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AMP ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the ATM bridge processor to be diagnosed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...5, range of decimal numbers

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG AMP- 1+


DIAG AMP
REPDIAG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

REPEATED DIAGNOSIS

This input initiates a repeated or permanent diagnosis for an ATM bridge


processor. The diagnosis does not include a BCMY interface test.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG AMP : AMP= ,REP= [,INT=] [,STATCS=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AMP ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the ATM bridge processor to be diagnosed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...5, range of decimal numbers

REP REPEAT

This parameter specifies the number of diagnostic runs.


Valid values are :
2...65535 for repeated diagnosis
PERM for permanent diagnosis with unlimited number
of runs (termination with command STOP JOB)

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

INT INTERRUPT DIAGNOSTIC CYCLE

This parameter specifies that a repeated or permanent diagnosis is


interrupted as soon as a fault is detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N CONTINUE IN CASE OF FAULT


NO CONTINUE IN CASE OF FAULT
Y TERMINATE IN CASE OF FAULT
YES TERMINATE IN CASE OF FAULT

Default: NO

STATCS OUTPUT OF STATISTICS

This parameter specifies the interval between statistic outputs


in minutes.

Notes:
- Statistic output can also be requested with the DISP DIAGSTAT
command.

Standard Behavior: no statistic output

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...60, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG AMP- 2-


DISP AMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR

This command displays all ATM bridge processors with their physical bus
interface number and working state (working / spare).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP AMP ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP AMP- 1-


TEST AMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TEST ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR

This command tests an ATM bridge processor.

Prerequisites:
- The AMP and the redundant AMP must be ACT.

Possible Effects:
- During the execution of this command simultaneously to high
traffic-load a minimal loss of messages is possible.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 TEST AMP : [AMP=] [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AMP ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the ATM bridge processor to be tested.

Standard Behavior: all active ATM bridge processors are tested

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...5, range of decimal numbers

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST AMP- 1-


CAN AMX

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel ATM Multiplexer

This task deletes an ATM Multiplexer. The input is the identifier of the ]ACCG].

Prerequisites:
- The ]AMX] is the last unit in a shelf.
- The ]ACCG] with identifier 1 must not be deleted.
- The ]ACCG] with identifier 2 is not allowed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN AMX : ACCG= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 3...64.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN AMX- 1-


CONF AMX

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Configure ATM Multiplexer

This task configures an ]ACCG] or an ]AMX].


There is a choice between the states ]Locked], ]Unlocked], ]Reserved] and
]Under repair]. If the input of ]Admin. state] is ]Locked]
then ]Hazard check] can be performed. Performing
the ]Hazard check] means that in case a hazard is
detected, the configuration will not be executed and detected hazards are
displayed in the output table as Hazards. Not performing the
]Hazard check] means that the configuration will
be executed always and detected hazards are displayed in the output table
as Actual effects.
If there is no input for the ]AMX], then
the ]ACCG] will be configured else the given
]AMX] will be configured.

Prerequisite:
- The ]ACCG] with number 2 is not allowed.

Notes:
- If ]Admin. state] is not ]Locked] the inputparameter
]Hazard check] is not used.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF AMX : Side= ,ACCG= [,AMX=] ,Admin. state= ,Hazard check= 1
1 1
1 [,Load information=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG].


The allowed ranges of decimal numbers are 1, 3...64.

AMX

This parameter is the number of an existing ]AMX].


The only allowed value is 1.

Admin. state

This parameter is used to select the kind of configuration.

Hazard check

If this parameter is ]Yes], ]Hazard check]


is started at the deactivation of a unit.

Load information

This parameter specifies if the code portion should be loaded by force


or only if necessary.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF AMX- 1-


CR AMX

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create ATM Multiplexer

This task creates the ATM Multiplexer.

Prerequisites:
- A ]Shelf] must exist.
- The ]AMX] with ]ACCG] 1 and the ]ACCG] 2
of the ]ASN] are already in the system.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR AMX : ACCG= ,Rack= ,AMX shelf= ,Conn. of AMX to ASN= 1
1 1
1 [,Conn. of AMX to ACCG=] ,Incoming connected port= 1
1 1
1 ,Outgoing connected port= ,SYS CLK connection= 1
1 1
1 ,SYS CLK connected port= ,ACCG Alarm profile= 1
1 1
1 ,AMX Alarm profile= [,AUB MP=] [,Line sync. connection=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACCG

This parameter is the number of the ]ACCG].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 3...64.

Rack

This parameter is the name of an existing ]Rack].


Allowed values are symbolic names of exactly 8 characters.

AMX shelf

This parameter is the number of an existing ]Shelf].

Conn. of AMX to ASN

This parameter is the number of the connected ]ASN].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...9.

Conn. of AMX to ACCG

This parameter is the number of the connected ]ACCG].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...32767.
Default value is 2.

Incoming connected port

This parameter specifies the incoming port of an ]ASN].

Outgoing connected port

This parameter specifies the outgoing port of an ]ASN].

SYS CLK connection

This parameter is the number of the ]ACCG] of ]SYS CLK connection].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...64.

SYS CLK connected port

This parameter specifies the port of the ]SYS CLK connection]. The
allowed range of decimal numbers is 0...3 for an ]ACCG] of ]AMX]
and 0...19 for an ]ACCG] of ]ASN].

ACCG Alarm profile

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ of ACCG to the managed


unit to control its alarming behavior.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR AMX- 1+
CR AMX

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The ’Alarm Profile MP’ is used to determine the priority of


an alarm, depending on its ’Probable cause’ (see Q3-standards
X.721, M.3100 etc.) and the detected service impact.

Input format:
Selection from:
generally applicable ’Alarm Profile MPs’ available on MP:
- ’ALSUPP’: Alarm suppression
Alarm is negligible and therefore suppressed.
No alarm processing will be performed.
- ’WARNING’: Warning
Alarm constitutes a situation to which attention
is drawn. For all ’Probable cause’ values the
alarm priority ’Warning’ will be used.
- ’MINNOESC’: Minor with no escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MINESC’: Minor with escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’MAJNOESC’: Major with no escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MAJESC’: Major with escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’CRITICAL’: Critical
Alarm indicates a critical system condition.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Critical’ will be used.
or a user-defined one:
- ’own name’, Input: 1...8 characters from printable character set
Use task ’DISP ALPROFMP’ to get an overview of the
existing ’Alarm Profile MPs’.

Standard behavior:
If no ’Alarm Profile MP’ is specified in a create task, a reasonable
default value, depending on the managed object class, is selected by
the system.

AMX Alarm profile

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ of AMX to the managed


unit to control its alarming behavior.

The ’Alarm Profile MP’ is used to determine the priority of


an alarm, depending on its ’Probable cause’ (see Q3-standards
X.721, M.3100 etc.) and the detected service impact.

Input format:
Selection from:
generally applicable ’Alarm Profile MPs’ available on MP:
- ’ALSUPP’: Alarm suppression
Alarm is negligible and therefore suppressed.
No alarm processing will be performed.
- ’WARNING’: Warning
Alarm constitutes a situation to which attention
is drawn. For all ’Probable cause’ values the
alarm priority ’Warning’ will be used.
- ’MINNOESC’: Minor with no escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MINESC’: Minor with escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR AMX- 2+
CR AMX

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

’Minor’ will be used if no service impact is


detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’MAJNOESC’: Major with no escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MAJESC’: Major with escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’CRITICAL’: Critical
Alarm indicates a critical system condition.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Critical’ will be used.
or a user-defined one:
- ’own name’, Input: 1...8 characters from printable character set
Use task ’DISP ALPROFMP’ to get an overview of the
existing ’Alarm Profile MPs’.

Standard behavior:
If no ’Alarm Profile MP’ is specified in a create task, a reasonable
default value, depending on the managed object class, is selected by
the system.

AUB MP

This parameter specifies an MP with RHS functionality which


administers and controls the resources on each LIC belonging
to the AUB. The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...128.
if not assigned, default value 1 will be used.

Line sync. connection

This parameter specifies the connected port of the ]Actual CLK master]
if the ’CLK src.’ is ’Line timed’.
+---------------+-------------------------+
! ASN type ! `Line sync. connection` !
+---------------+-------------------------+
! ASN5 ! 0,2,4,6,8 !
! ASN20, ASN40 ! 0,2,4,6,8,10,12,14 !
+---------------+-------------------------+

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR AMX- 3-
DIAG AMX

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Diagnose ATM Multiplexer

This task starts a diagnostics test of an ]ACCG] or an ]AMX]


on demand. If there is no input for ]AMX], the
]ACCG] is diagnosed.

Prerequisite:
- The ]ACCG] with identifier 2 is not allowed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG AMX : Side= ,ACCG= [,AMX=] ,Kind of diagnosis= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG].


The allowed ranges of decimal numbers are 1, 3...64.

AMX

This parameter is the number of an existing ]AMX].


The only allowed value is 1.

Kind of diagnosis

This parameter specifies the kind of diagnosis.


Following values are allowed:

]Self diagnosis]:
Base test for the unit.
It checks the availability and the workability of
the components .
Resets unit and becomes ]Self diagnosis].
No further tests are performed.

]Quick diagnosis]:
Performs a more comprehensive test than ]Self
diagnosis].
It includes all diagnosis tests without long
running
tests.
It must include testing of those hardware parts
which
are tested during normal operation.

]Complete diagnosis]:
This option performs full testing of all the
object functions, including tests which take a
long time
to complete such as memory tests.

]Cable diagnosis]:
This value is only allowed for ]AMX]:
It verifies correct plugging of cables (Yb Ports
only).

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG AMX- 1-


DISP AMX

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display ATM Multiplexer

This task displays one or all ]AMXs] and ]ACCGs].


Following combinations are allowed:

+-----------------------------------------------------------------------------+
! INPUT | OUTPUT !
+-----------------------------------------------------------------------------+
! - | all ]ACCGs] and all ]AMXs] are displayed !
!]Side] | one ]ACCG] and one ]AMX] of one ]Side] are displayed !
!]Side], ]ACCG] | one ]ACCG] of one ]Side] is displayed !
!]Side], ]ACCG], ]AMX]| one ]AMX] of one ]Side] is displayed !
+-----------------------------------------------------------------------------+

Prerequisite:
- The ]ACCG] with number 2 is not allowed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP AMX : [Side=] [,ACCG=] [,AMX=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG].


The allowed ranges of decimal numbers are 1, 3...64.

AMX

This parameter is the number of an existing ]AMX].


The only allowed value is 1.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP AMX- 1-


MOD AMX

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify ATM Multiplexer

This script changes the value of the ]Alarm profile MP]


of ]AMX] or ]ACCG] of both ]Sides].
Also the ]Board type] of ACCG can be changed.

Allowed Combinations of input parameters:


+--------------------------------------------+
! Input parameter !
+------------------+------+-----+------------------+------------+
! action type ! ACCG ! AMX ! Alarm profile MP ! Board type !
+------------------+------+-----+------------------+------------+
! change ! ! ! ! !
! Alarm profile MP ! YES ! YES ! YES ! NO !
! of AMX ! ! ! ! !
+------------------+------+-----+------------------+------------+
! change ! ! ! ! !
! Alarm profile MP ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO !
! of ACCG ! ! ! ! !
+------------------+------+-----+------------------+------------+
! change ! ! ! ! !
! Board type ! YES ! NO ! NO ! YES !
! of ACCG ! * ! ! ! !
+------------------+------+-----+------------------+------------+

* Action supporten only in case of ASN5 configuration.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD AMX : ACCG= [,AMX=] [,Alarm profile MP=] [,Board type=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG].


The allowed ranges of decimal numbers are 1...64.

AMX

This parameter is the number of an existing ]AMX].


The only allowed value is 1.

Alarm profile MP

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ to the managed


unit to control its alarming behavior.

The ’Alarm Profile MP’ is used to determine the priority of


an alarm, depending on its ’Probable cause’ (see Q3-standards
X.721, M.3100 etc.) and the detected service impact.

Input format:
Selection from:
generally applicable ’Alarm Profile MPs’ available on MP:
- ’ALSUPP’: Alarm suppression
Alarm is negligible and therefore suppressed.
No alarm processing will be performed.
- ’WARNING’: Warning
Alarm constitutes a situation to which attention
is drawn. For all ’Probable cause’ values the
alarm priority ’Warning’ will be used.
- ’MINNOESC’: Minor with no escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MINESC’: Minor with escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD AMX- 1+


MOD AMX

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

priority will escalate to ’Critical’.


- ’MAJNOESC’: Major with no escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MAJESC’: Major with escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’CRITICAL’: Critical
Alarm indicates a critical system condition.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Critical’ will be used.
or a user-defined one:
- ’own name’, Input: 1...8 characters from printable character set
Use task ’DISP ALPROFMP’ to get an overview of the
existing ’Alarm Profile MPs’.

Standard behavior:
If no ’Alarm Profile MP’ is specified in a create task, a reasonable
default value, depending on the managed object class, is selected by
the system.

Board type

Attribute to specify the board (hardware) of a unit.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD AMX- 2-


RECOV AMX

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Recover ATM Multiplexer

This task is used to recover an ]AMX].


Allowed parameters for recovery of ]AMX] are:

+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
! ]Scope] ]Depth] ]Measures] !
+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
!LOADREC2 ]Platform] ]Cold start] ]Loading of code and data] !
+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 RECOV AMX : Side= ,ACCG= ,Scope= ,Depth= ,Measures= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG].


The allowed ranges of decimal numbers are 1, 3...64.

Scope

This parameter specifies that only the addressed ]Platform] is recovered.

Depth

This parameter specifies that the recovery shall be a ]Cold start]


recovery.

Measures

This parameter specifies that code and data are reloaded.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RECOV AMX- 1-


STAT AMX

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Status of ATM Multiplexer

This task displays the states of ]AMX] and


]ACCG]. Following combinations are allowed:

+-----------------------------------------------------------------------------+
! INPUT | OUTPUT !
+-----------------------------------------------------------------------------+
! - | states of all ]ACCGs] and of all ]AMXs] are displayed !
!]Side] | states of one ]ACCG] and of one ]AMX] of one ]Side] !
! | are displayed !
!]Side], ]ACCG] | state of one ]ACCG] of one ]Side] is displayed !
!]Side], ]ACCG], ]AMX]| state of one ]AMX] of one ]Side] is displayed !
+-----------------------------------------------------------------------------+

Prerequisite:
- The ]ACCG] with number 2 is not allowed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT AMX : [Side=] [,ACCG=] [,AMX=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG].


The allowed ranges of decimal numbers are 1, 3...64.

AMX

This parameter is the number of an existing ]AMX].


The only allowed value is 1.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT AMX- 1-


DISP AMXCLK

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display ATM Multiplexer Clock

This task is used to display the ]Clock connection list] of ]ACCG] of an ]AMX].

Prerequisite:
- The ]ACCG] with number 2 is not allowed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP AMXCLK : Side= ,ACCG= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG].


The allowed ranges of decimal numbers are 1, 3...64.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP AMXCLK- 1-


DISP AMXPORT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display ATM Multiplexer Port

This task displays the AMX ports of ]AMX].

Prerequisite:
- The ]ACCG] with number 2 is not allowed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP AMXPORT : Side= ,ACCG= ,AMX= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG].


The allowed ranges of decimal numbers are 1, 3...64.

AMX

This parameter is the number of an existing ]AMX].


The only allowed value is 1.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP AMXPORT- 1-


CAN ANELEM
ANELEMPA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This command cancels announcement elements of the types


INDAS phrase, INDAS word, INDAS standard announcement, and INDAS pause.

Prerequisites:
- The INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant must be available.

Notes:
- The cancelation of announcement elements is considered
dangerous because this request may remove announcements for
call processing.
A dialog mask is output. The operating personnel is requested
to determine whether the command is to be executed or not by
entering ’+’ or ’-’.
- If the last announcement element for the specified OCANEQ variant
is canceled, the OCANEQ variant will be removed implicitly,
provided that the related UI database is empty and no LTG
exists for which this OCANEQ variant is entered.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CAN ANELEM - ANELEMPA ANELEM INDAS PAUSE


2. CAN ANELEM - ANELEMPH ANELEM INDAS PHRASE
3. CAN ANELEM - ANELEMST ANELEM INDAS STD. ANN.
4. CAN ANELEM - ANELEMWO ANELEM INDAS WORD

1. Input format

ANELEM INDAS PAUSE

This input format cancels the links between


INDAS pauses and OCANEQ text fragment numbers.

Up to 4 INDAS pauses can be linked.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN ANELEM : OCAVAR= ,ANELEM= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant. It is used to identify


the content of text fragments stored in OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the subsequent characters must
be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANELEM ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

PAUSEALL ANELEM ALL INDAS PAUSE


All INDAS pauses.
This value is not allowed to be linked
with other values.
PAUSEEND ANELEM INDAS PAUSE END
Pause after the end of each announcement cycle.
PAUSELA ANELEM INDAS PAUSE LANGUAGE
Pause between two different languages of
an announcement.
PAUSEPH ANELEM INDAS PAUSE PHRASE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ANELEM- 1+


CAN ANELEM
ANELEMPA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Pause between two phrases of an announcement.


PAUSEST ANELEM INDAS PAUSE START
Pause before the start of each announcement
cycle.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ANELEM- 2+


CAN ANELEM
ANELEMPH
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

ANELEM INDAS PHRASE

This input format cancels the links between


INDAS phrase and INDAS phrase definition.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN ANELEM : OCAVAR= ,ANELEM= ,LANGUAGE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant. It is used to identify


the content of text fragments stored in OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the subsequent characters must
be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANELEM ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: TYPE OF ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT


PHRASE ANELEM INDAS PHRASE

b: ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT NUMBER=


1-1023, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the number range of


the announcement elements to be canceled.
The number range follows from the INDAS
document related to the OCANEQ variant.

LANGUAGE RELATIVE LANGUAGE OF ANN.ELEM.

This parameter specifies one of up to four official languages


for the announcement elements.

Notes :
- The reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN1 FIRST OFFICIAL LANGUAGE


LAN2 SECOND OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN3 THIRD OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN4 FOURTH OFFICIAL LANGUAGE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ANELEM- 3+


CAN ANELEM
ANELEMST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

ANELEM INDAS STD. ANN.

This input format cancels the links between


INDAS standard announcement and INDAS standard
announcement definition.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN ANELEM : OCAVAR= ,ANELEM= ,LANGUAGE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant. It is used to identify


the content of text fragments stored in OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the subsequent characters must
be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANELEM ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: TYPE OF ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT


STDANN ANELEM INDAS STD. ANN.

b: ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT NUMBER=


1-2500, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the number range of


the announcement elements to be canceled.
The number range follows from the INDAS
document related to the OCANEQ variant.

LANGUAGE RELATIVE LANGUAGE OF ANN.ELEM.

This parameter specifies one of up to four official languages


for the announcement elements.

Notes :
- The reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN1 FIRST OFFICIAL LANGUAGE


LAN2 SECOND OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN3 THIRD OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN4 FOURTH OFFICIAL LANGUAGE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ANELEM- 4+


CAN ANELEM
ANELEMWO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

ANELEM INDAS WORD

This input format cancels the links between


INDAS word numbers and OCANEQ text fragment numbers.

Up to 32 INDAS word numbers and/or intervals


can be linked.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN ANELEM : OCAVAR= ,ANELEM= ,LANGUAGE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant. It is used to identify


the content of text fragments stored in OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the subsequent characters must
be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANELEM ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

a-b

a: TYPE OF ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT


WORD ANELEM INDAS WORD

b: ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT NUMBER=


1...4094, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the number range of


the announcement elements to be canceled.
The number range follows from the INDAS
document related to the OCANEQ variant.

LANGUAGE RELATIVE LANGUAGE OF ANN.ELEM.

This parameter specifies one of up to four official languages


for the announcement elements.

Notes :
- The reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN1 FIRST OFFICIAL LANGUAGE


LAN2 SECOND OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN3 THIRD OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN4 FOURTH OFFICIAL LANGUAGE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ANELEM- 5-


CR ANELEM
ANELEMPA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This command creates announcement elements of the types


INDAS phrase, INDAS word, INDAS standard announcement, and INDAS pause.

It allows announcements, which are played by INDAS with OCANEQ, to be


composed from sets of text fragments stored in the OCANEQ.
A text fragment is the smallest physical speech unit and can be addressed
by its text fragment number.
A text fragment consists of one or more spoken words or is a pause or
a tone burst.
Text fragments can be put together in any sequence desired.

There are two types of announcements:


- Individual announcements:
Each individual announcement is logically addressed by one or more
announcement elements of the type "INDAS phrase".
An INDAS phrase consists of several fixed text parts and several variable
parts (e.g. directory number, hour, minute, week-day) determined by
INDAS parameters which use groups of logical announcement elements of the
type "INDAS word" that can be addressed.
- Standard announcements:
Each standard announcement is logically addressed by an announcement
element of the type "INDAS standard announcement" and consists only of
fixed text parts.
No variable parts are included.

Within the system, each announcement element created by INDAS is immediately


active and can be accessed by call processing.

Prerequisites:
- The INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant must be available.
- Memory space for the OCANEQ variant data must be provided in the
database (for expandable groups OC1/OC2, see MOD DBSIZE).

Notes:
- If the OCANEQ variant has not yet been registered by either ENTR OCAVAR
or CR ANELEM or through User Interaction database administration,
a new element in the OCANEQ variant specific data structure will be used.
- The command will be rejected with an error message saying that the database
list has been exceeded, and specifying the parameter name OCAVAR if the
maximum number of 10 OCANEQ variants have already been registered in the
system (see also ENTR OCAVAR).
- If the command is rejected with the above error message and the specified
parameter names are OCAVAR and LANGUAGE, the database area for group OC1
has to be expanded (use MOD DBSIZE).
- If the command is rejected with the above error message and the specified
parameter name is PHDEFIN or STDADEF, the database area for group OC2
has to be expanded (use MOD DBSIZE).
- The available text fragments and the associated text fragment numbers are
to be taken from the INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant.
- The command should only be used for LANGUAGE values identified by the
INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant.
MOD CALLPOPT will adapt the way in which announcements are played in these
identified languages or in a specific language sequence, dependent upon the
exchange location.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR ANELEM - ANELEMPA ANELEM INDAS PAUSE


2. CR ANELEM - ANELEMPH ANELEM INDAS PHRASE
3. CR ANELEM - ANELEMST ANELEM INDAS STD. ANN.
4. CR ANELEM - ANELEMWO ANELEM INDAS WORD

1. Input format

ANELEM INDAS PAUSE

This input format is used to create an announcement element "INDAS


pause" by assigning a pause type to a text fragment.

INDAS pause specifies all pauses defined by INDAS which are inserted
according to attribute if an announcement is to be played. They are

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANELEM- 1+
CR ANELEM
ANELEMPA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

used separately from an INDAS phrase or INDAS standard announcement


definition.
An INDAS pause consists of just one text fragment.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR ANELEM : OCAVAR= ,ANELEM= ,PAUSE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant. It is used to identify


the content of text fragments stored in OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the subsequent characters must
be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANELEM ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PAUSE ANELEM INDAS PAUSE

PAUSE ANELEM INDAS PAUSE

Notes:
- Up to 4 INDAS pauses can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: TYPE OF ANN. ELEM. INDAS PAUSE


PAUSEEND ANELEM INDAS PAUSE END
A pause is inserted at the end of each
announcement cycle.
PAUSELA ANELEM INDAS PAUSE LANGUAGE
A pause is inserted between two different
languages if the announcement is to be
played in more than one language.
PAUSEPH ANELEM INDAS PAUSE PHRASE
A pause is inserted between two phrases
if the individual announcement consists
of more than one INDAS phrase.
PAUSEST ANELEM INDAS PAUSE START
A pause is inserted at the start of each
announcement cycle.

b: OCANEQ FRAGMENT NUMBER=


0...65279, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANELEM- 2+
CR ANELEM
ANELEMPH
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

ANELEM INDAS PHRASE

This input format is used to create an announcement element "INDAS


phrase" by entering its phrase definition.

An INDAS phrase consists of several fixed text parts defined by one


or more text fragments, and several variable parts defined by text
fragments which are determined by INDAS parameters using groups of
INDAS words.

Notes:
- INDAS functions are used to identify individual announcements in the
system.
Only INDAS phrases selected by INDAS functions are allowed.
The allowed number range is to be taken from the INDAS document
related to the OCANEQ variant.
The parameter numbers and the specific meaning assigned to an INDAS
phrase are also described.
INDAS phrases applied by User Interaction must have phrase numbers
between 1 and 900.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR ANELEM : OCAVAR= ,ANELEM= ,PHDEFIN= ,LANGUAGE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant. It is used to identify


the content of text fragments stored in OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the subsequent characters must
be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANELEM ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: TYPE OF ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT


PHRASE ANELEM INDAS PHRASE

b: ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT NUMBER=


1-1023, range of decimal numbers

PHDEFIN INDAS PHRASE DEFINITION

This parameter specifies an INDAS phrase definition.


The phrase definition for an INDAS phrase describes the various
modifications of an announcement text for an individual
announcement as a function of the actual INDAS parameter values
and takes the foreign-language requirements into account.
It specifies the sequence in which fixed text fragments are to be
arranged and locates the positions where the text fragments
determined by the INDAS parameter values must be inserted. An
INDAS parameter is represented by a fixed parameter number assigned.
As a result, the phrase definition controls the combination of text
fragments which form an announcement.
For each one of the allowed INDAS phrases and each valid language,
the phrase definition in its application form is part of the INDAS
document related to the OCANEQ variant.

To produce such a phrase definition, a formal definition language


similar to a programming language is used.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANELEM- 3+
CR ANELEM
ANELEMPH
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Syntax of INDAS phrase definition components:

The following INDAS phrase definition components are specified


and completed by the permissible combination of the required units:

- "Insert fragment definition":

Statement to insert a text fragment,


e.g.: compose the fixed text part of an announcement.

INFRAGM-<fragment no>

input values:
<fragment no> = 0 .. 65279, range of decimal numbers

- "Insert parameter definition":

Statement to insert an INDAS parameter:


Fit in the text fragment determined by the parameter value by
using the corresponding INDAS word.

INPAR-<parameter no>
INPAR-<parameter no>-MODNONE
INPAR-<parameter no>-MLVNONE
(MLVNONE: only for INDAS parameters
which may have more than one value)

input values:
<parameter no> = 1 .. 63, range of decimal numbers

Statement to insert an INDAS parameter:


Fit in the text fragment determined by the parameter value by
using the corresponding INDAS word modified plus or minus by a
specified INDAS word offset. This corresponds with a change to
an alternative group of text fragments.
This statement may be used
- for modification to lower voice
(e.g.: the INDAS parameter is the final part of an announcement),
- for the several interpretations of the INDAS parameter "number"
(e.g.: applied as year, as part of a price),
- for a different representation of an INDAS parameter in the same
context
(e.g.: insert the INDAS parameter "month" by its name ("January")
or alternatively by its ordinal number ("first")).

INPAR-<parameter no>-MODPLUS-<word offset>


INPAR-<parameter no>-MODMINUS-<word offset>
INPAR-<parameter no>-MLVPLUS-<word offset>
(MLVPLUS: only for INDAS parameters
which may have more than one value)
INPAR-<parameter no>-MLVMINUS-<word offset>
(MLVMINUS: only for INDAS parameters
which may have more than one value)

input values:
<parameter no> = 1 .. 63, range of decimal numbers
<word offset> = 1 .. 4094, range of decimal numbers

- "Parameter block definition":

Statement to process an INDAS parameter which may have more than


one value,
e.g.: the INDAS parameter "directory number".

PARDO-<parameter no>

input values:
<parameter no> = 1 .. 63, range of decimal numbers

- "IF condition block definition":

An "Insert fragment definition" or "Insert parameter definition"


is to be dependent of the value(s) of one INDAS parameter or
several INDAS parameters correlated to each other,
e.g.: insert the INDAS parameter "minute" unless it is a full hour.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANELEM- 4+
CR ANELEM
ANELEMPH
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

A single condition will be initiated by IFPAR. The parameter


value must be specified by its INDAS word.

Several conditions can be combined by ANDIFPAR ("and" relation,


i.e. all conditions must be true) or ORIFPAR ("or" relation, i.e.
one of the conditions must be true).

ELSIFPAR corresponds to a nested "IF condition definition" in


the form of ELSE IFPAR ... ENDIF.

If the condition(s) stated by IFPAR / ELSIFPAR / ANDIFPAR /


ORIFPAR is(are) true the definition statement(s) following will
be executed. If the condition(s) is(are) false, the definition
statement(s) following ELSE (if existent) or ENDIF will be
executed.

IFPAR-<parameter no>-<condition>-<word no>


ELSIFPAR-<parameter no>-<condition>-<word no>
ANDIFPAR-<parameter no>-<condition>-<word no>
ORIFPAR-<parameter no>-<condition>-<word no>

input values:
<parameter no> = 1 .. 63, range of decimal numbers
<word no> = 1 .. 4094, range of decimal numbers
<condition> = EQUAL
NOTEQUAL
LESS
GREATER

or
IFPAR-<parameter no>-<condition>
ELSIFPAR-<parameter no>-<condition>
ANDIFPAR-<parameter no>-<condition>
ORIFPAR-<parameter no>-<condition>

input values:
<parameter no> = 1 .. 63, range of decimal numbers
<condition> = FRSTWORD
NOTFRSTW
LASTWORD
NOTLASTW
SELECTED

The conditions FRSTWORD, NOTFRSTW, LASTWORD, NOTLASTW


are only valid for an INDAS parameter which may have more than
one value.
The condition SELECTED is true if the INDAS parameter has
at least one value.

or
ELSE

- "End definition" :

Statement to terminate a block definition or phrase definition.

ENDDO
ENDIF
END

There are the following requirements for an INDAS phrase definition:


- A "definition block" must consist of one
"Insert fragment definition" or
"Insert parameter definition" or
"Parameter block definition" or
"IF condition block definition".
- A "Parameter block definition" is mandatory if an INDAS parameter
which may have more than one value is to be processed.
This "Parameter block definition" for an INDAS parameter must be
specified before an "IF condition block definition" or "Insert
parameter definition" of that parameter is entered.
There are however the following exceptions:
- The "IF condition block definition" can be entered prior to the
"Parameter block definition" if the condition(s) of an
"IF condition block definition" has(have) been formed using

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANELEM- 5+
CR ANELEM
ANELEMPH
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SELECTED.
- Mandatory input of a "Parameter block definition" is excluded
if no "IF condition block definition" has been specified for
the INDAS parameter and
- only the last value of that parameter has to be modified
exclusively and the corresponding "Insert parameter definition"
is formed with MLVPLUS, MLVMINUS,
- none of the INDAS parameter values has to be modified and the
corresponding "Insert parameter definition" is formed with
MLVNONE.
- The body of a "Parameter block definition" must contain at least
one "definition block" and must be terminated with ENDDO.
- The "IF condition block definition" must contain at least one
statement initiated by IFPAR and must be terminated with ENDIF.
- For each case of "IF condition block definition" initiated by
IFPAR / ELSIFPAR / ELSE the body must contain at least one
"definition block".
- Nested "IF condition block definitions" and/or "Parameter block
definitions" may be used up to the maximum nested level = 10.
- Nested "Parameter block definitions" for the same parameter
number are not allowed.
- The body of an INDAS phrase definition must contain at least one
"definition block" and must be terminated with END.

Notes:
- Within an INDAS phrase, INDAS parameters may be rearranged from
the original order indicated by the parameter numbers.
The parameter number retains the meaning of the INDAS parameter.
- The length of an INDAS phrase definition is only restricted by
the maximum number of permissible characters for an MML command.
As a result, the number of INDAS phrase definition components that
can be linked with &, must follow this restriction.
- The correct order of the INDAS phrase definition components must be
observed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: ACTION CODE
ANDIFPAR AND IF PARAMETER CONDITION
ELSE ELSE CONDITION
ELSIFPAR ELSE IF PARAMETER CONDITION
END END OF PHRASE DEFINITION
ENDDO END OF PARAMETER DO LOOP
ENDIF END OF IF CONDITION
IFPAR IF PARAMETER CONDITION
INFRAGM INSERT FRAGMENT
INPAR INSERT PARAMETER
ORIFPAR OR IF PARAMETER CONDITION
PARDO FOR ALL PARAMETER VALUES DO

b: FRAGMENT- OR INDAS PARAM- NO.=


0...65279, range of decimal numbers

c: MODIFY ACTION OR CONDITION


XEQUAL = EQUAL
1FRSTWORD1 FIRST WORD
1GREATER 1 GREATER
1LASTWORD1 LAST WORD
1LESS 1 LESS
1MLVMINUS1 MOD. LAST PARAM VALUE: DECRE.
1MLVNONE 1 MOD. LAST PARAM VALUE: NOT
1MLVPLUS 1 MOD. LAST PARAM VALUE: INCRE.
1MODMINUS1 MOD. PARAM VALUE: DECREMENT
1MODNONE 1 MOD. PARAM VALUE: NOT
1MODPLUS 1 MOD. PARAM VALUE: INCREMENT
1NOTEQUAL1 NOT EQUAL
1NOTFRSTW1 NOT FIRST WORD
1NOTLASTW1 NOT LAST WORD
>SELECTEDW SELECTED

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANELEM- 6+
CR ANELEM
ANELEMPH
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

d: OFFSET=
1...4094, range of decimal numbers

LANGUAGE RELATIVE LANGUAGE OF ANN.ELEM.

This parameter indicates one of up to four official languages


commonly used in an exchange.

Notes:
- The reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN1 FIRST OFFICIAL LANGUAGE


LAN2 SECOND OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN3 THIRD OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN4 FOURTH OFFICIAL LANGUAGE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANELEM- 7+
CR ANELEM
ANELEMST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

ANELEM INDAS STD. ANN.

This input format is used to create an announcement element "INDAS


standard announcement" by entering its standard announcement definition.

Notes:
- The standard announcement number specified here must be used as the
STANNO for CR ANGRP if the assignment of an announcement to an
announcement group leading to OCANEQ is defined as definite (fixed).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR ANELEM : OCAVAR= ,ANELEM= ,STDADEF= ,LANGUAGE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant. It is used to identify


the content of text fragments stored in OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the subsequent characters must
be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANELEM ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: TYPE OF ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT


STDANN ANELEM INDAS STD. ANN.

b: ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT NUMBER=


1-2500, range of decimal numbers

STDADEF INDAS STD. ANN. DEFINITION

This parameter specifies an INDAS standard announcement


definition.
The standard announcement definition for each INDAS standard
announcement describes the way in which text fragments are
sequenced and takes foreign-language requirements into account.
As a result, the standard announcement definition controls the
combination of text fragments which form an announcement.
For each one of the allowed INDAS standard announcements and
each valid language, the standard announcement definition in
its application form is part of the INDAS document related to
the OCANEQ variant.

To produce such a standard announcement definition, a formal


definition language similar to a programming language is used.

Syntax of INDAS standard announcement definition components:

- "Insert fragment definition":

Statement to insert a text fragment.

INFRAGM-<fragment no>

input values:
<fragment no> = 0 .. 65279, range of decimal numbers

- "End definition" :

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANELEM- 8+
CR ANELEM
ANELEMST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Statement to terminate a standard announcement definition.

END

There are the following requirements for an INDAS standard


announcement definition:
- The body of an INDAS standard announcement definition must
contain at least one "Insert fragment definition" and must be
terminated with END.

Notes:
- The length of an INDAS standard announcement definition is only
restricted by the maximum number of permissible characters for
an MML command.
As a result, the number of INDAS standard announcement definition
components that can be linked with &, must follow this restriction.
- The correct order of the INDAS standard announcement definition
components must be observed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: ACTION CODE
END END OF STD. ANN. DEFINITION
INFRAGM INSERT FRAGMENT

b: FRAGMENT-NO.=
0...65279, range of decimal numbers

LANGUAGE RELATIVE LANGUAGE OF ANN.ELEM.

This parameter indicates one of up to four official languages


commonly used in an exchange.

Notes:
- The reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN1 FIRST OFFICIAL LANGUAGE


LAN2 SECOND OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN3 THIRD OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN4 FOURTH OFFICIAL LANGUAGE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANELEM- 9+
CR ANELEM
ANELEMWO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

ANELEM INDAS WORD

This input format is used to create an announcement element "INDAS


word" by entering its allocation to a text fragment.

An INDAS word is the smallest logical speech unit and is addressable by its
INDAS word number. A group of INDAS words represents an INDAS parameter
with its definite meaning. An INDAS parameter is a variable part of an
INDAS phrase. Each INDAS word consists of just one text fragment.

Notes:
- The meaning of the defined INDAS words and the associated INDAS word
numbers are to be taken from the INDAS document related to the OCANEQ
variant.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR ANELEM : OCAVAR= ,ANELEM= ,WORD= ,LANGUAGE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant. It is used to identify


the content of text fragments stored in OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the subsequent characters must
be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANELEM ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

WORD ANELEM INDAS WORD

WORD ANELEM INDAS WORD

Notes:
- Up to 32 INDAS words and/or ranges can be linked with &.
- Input of an INDAS word range is only allowed if the resulting
number of INDAS words equals those of text fragments (implicit
increment one by one for both), or exactly one and the same
text fragment is assigned to all INDAS words of a given range.
- An INDAS word number may not be entered twice with different
text fragment numbers.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

a-b

a: INDAS WORD NUMBER=


1...4094, range of decimal numbers

b: OCANEQ FRAGMENT NUMBER=


0...65279, range of decimal numbers

LANGUAGE RELATIVE LANGUAGE OF ANN.ELEM.

This parameter indicates one of up to four official languages


commonly used in an exchange.

Notes:
- The reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANELEM- 10+


CR ANELEM
ANELEMWO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN1 FIRST OFFICIAL LANGUAGE


LAN2 SECOND OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN3 THIRD OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN4 FOURTH OFFICIAL LANGUAGE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANELEM- 11-


DISP ANELEM
ANELEMPA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This command displays announcement elements of the types


INDAS phrase, INDAS word, INDAS standard announcement, and INDAS pause.

Prerequisites:
- The INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant must be available.
- Only those announcement elements will be displayed which are
previously created.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP ANELEM - ANELEMPA ANELEM INDAS PAUSE


2. DISP ANELEM - ANELEMPH ANELEM INDAS PHRASE
3. DISP ANELEM - ANELEMST ANELEM INDAS STD. ANN.
4. DISP ANELEM - ANELEMWO ANELEM INDAS WORD

1. Input format

ANELEM INDAS PAUSE

This input format displays the links between


INDAS pauses and OCANEQ text fragment numbers.

Up to 4 INDAS pauses can be linked.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ANELEM : OCAVAR= ,ANELEM= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant. It is used to identify


the content of text fragments stored in OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the subsequent characters must
be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

Notes :
- If the entered OCANEQ variant is unknown there are no data to
display.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANELEM ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

PAUSEALL ANELEM ALL INDAS PAUSE


All INDAS pauses.
This value is not allowed to be linked
with other values.
PAUSEEND ANELEM INDAS PAUSE END
Pause after the end of each announcement cycle.
PAUSELA ANELEM INDAS PAUSE LANGUAGE
Pause between two different languages of
an announcement.
PAUSEPH ANELEM INDAS PAUSE PHRASE
Pause between two phrases of an announcement.
PAUSEST ANELEM INDAS PAUSE START
Pause before the start of each announcement
cycle.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ANELEM- 1+


DISP ANELEM
ANELEMPH
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

ANELEM INDAS PHRASE

This input format displays the components of an


INDAS phrase definition.
Each component may consist of up to 4 units:
ACTION CODE
FRAGMENT- OR INDAS PARAM- NO.
MODIFY ACTION OR CONDITION
OFFSET

The phrase definition controls the combination of text


fragments which form an announcement.

Up to 32 INDAS phrase numbers and/or intervals


can be linked.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ANELEM : OCAVAR= ,ANELEM= [,LANGUAGE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant. It is used to identify


the content of text fragments stored in OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the subsequent characters must
be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

Notes :
- If the entered OCANEQ variant is unknown there are no data to
display.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANELEM ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

a-b

a: TYPE OF ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT


PHRASE ANELEM INDAS PHRASE

b: ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT NUMBER=


1-1023, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the number range of


the announcement elements to be displayed.
The number range follows from the INDAS
document related to the OCANEQ variant.

LANGUAGE RELATIVE LANGUAGE OF ANN.ELEM.

This parameter specifies one of up to four official languages


for the announcement elements.
If X is specified, the announcement elements are
displayed for all the languages for which they are defined.

Notes :
- The reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN1 FIRST OFFICIAL LANGUAGE


LAN2 SECOND OFFICIAL LANGUAGE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ANELEM- 2+


DISP ANELEM
ANELEMPH
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

LAN3 THIRD OFFICIAL LANGUAGE


LAN4 FOURTH OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
X ALL OFFICIAL LANGUAGES

Default: X

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ANELEM- 3+


DISP ANELEM
ANELEMST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

ANELEM INDAS STD. ANN.

This input format displays the components of an


INDAS standard announcement definition.
Each component may consist of up to 2 units:
ACTION CODE
FRAGMENT-NO.

The standard announcement definition controls the


combination of text fragments which form an announcement.

Up to 32 INDAS standard announcement numbers and/or


intervals can be linked.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ANELEM : OCAVAR= ,ANELEM= [,LANGUAGE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant. It is used to identify


the content of text fragments stored in OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the subsequent characters must
be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

Notes :
- If the entered OCANEQ variant is unknown there are no data to
display.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANELEM ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

a-b

a: TYPE OF ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT


STDANN ANELEM INDAS STD. ANN.

b: ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT NUMBER=


1-2500, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the number range of


the announcement elements to be displayed.
The number range follows from the INDAS
document related to the OCANEQ variant.

LANGUAGE RELATIVE LANGUAGE OF ANN.ELEM.

This parameter specifies one of up to four official languages


for the announcement elements.
If X is specified, the announcement elements are
displayed for all the languages for which they are defined.

Notes :
- The reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN1 FIRST OFFICIAL LANGUAGE


LAN2 SECOND OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN3 THIRD OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN4 FOURTH OFFICIAL LANGUAGE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ANELEM- 4+


DISP ANELEM
ANELEMST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

X ALL OFFICIAL LANGUAGES

Default: X

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ANELEM- 5+


DISP ANELEM
ANELEMWO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

ANELEM INDAS WORD

This input format displays the links between


INDAS word numbers and OCANEQ text fragment numbers.

Up to 32 INDAS word numbers and/or intervals


can be linked.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ANELEM : OCAVAR= ,ANELEM= [,LANGUAGE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant. It is used to identify


the content of text fragments stored in OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the subsequent characters must
be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

Notes :
- If the entered OCANEQ variant is unknown there are no data to
display.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANELEM ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

a-b

a: TYPE OF ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT


WORD ANELEM INDAS WORD

b: ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT NUMBER=


1...4094, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the number range of


the announcement elements to be displayed.
The number range follows from the INDAS
document related to the OCANEQ variant.

LANGUAGE RELATIVE LANGUAGE OF ANN.ELEM.

This parameter specifies one of up to four official languages


for the announcement elements.
If X is specified, the announcement elements are
displayed for all the languages for which they are defined.

Notes :
- The reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN1 FIRST OFFICIAL LANGUAGE


LAN2 SECOND OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN3 THIRD OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN4 FOURTH OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
X ALL OFFICIAL LANGUAGES

Default: X

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ANELEM- 6-


MOD ANELEM
ANELEMPA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This command modifies announcement elements of the types


INDAS phrase, INDAS word, INDAS standard announcement, and INDAS pause.

Prerequisites:
- The INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant must be available.
- Only the announcement elements previously created by CR ANELEM
can be modified.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD ANELEM - ANELEMPA ANELEM INDAS PAUSE


2. MOD ANELEM - ANELEMPH ANELEM INDAS PHRASE
3. MOD ANELEM - ANELEMST ANELEM INDAS STD. ANN.
4. MOD ANELEM - ANELEMWO ANELEM INDAS WORD

1. Input format

ANELEM INDAS PAUSE

This input format is used to modify the text fragment allocated


to each type of the announcement element "INDAS pause".

INDAS pause specifies all pauses defined by INDAS which are inserted
according to attribute if an announcement is to be played. They are
used separately from an INDAS phrase or INDAS standard announcement
definition.
An INDAS pause consists of just one text fragment.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD ANELEM : OCAVAR= ,ANELEM= ,PAUSE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant. It is used to identify


the content of text fragments stored in OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the subsequent characters must
be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANELEM ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PAUSE ANELEM INDAS PAUSE

PAUSE ANELEM INDAS PAUSE

Notes:
- Up to 4 INDAS pauses can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: TYPE OF ANN. ELEM. INDAS PAUSE


PAUSEEND ANELEM INDAS PAUSE END
A pause is inserted at the end of each
announcement cycle.
PAUSELA ANELEM INDAS PAUSE LANGUAGE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ANELEM- 1+


MOD ANELEM
ANELEMPA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

A pause is inserted between two different


languages if the announcement is to be
played in more than one language.
PAUSEPH ANELEM INDAS PAUSE PHRASE
A pause is inserted between two phrases
if the individual announcement consists
of more than one INDAS phrase.
PAUSEST ANELEM INDAS PAUSE START
A pause is inserted at the start of each
announcement cycle.

b: OCANEQ FRAGMENT NUMBER=


0...65279, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ANELEM- 2+


MOD ANELEM
ANELEMPH
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

ANELEM INDAS PHRASE

This input format is used to modify the phrase definition of


an announcement element "INDAS phrase".

Notes:
- The modified phrase definition must be entered completely.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD ANELEM : OCAVAR= ,ANELEM= ,PHDEFIN= ,LANGUAGE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant. It is used to identify


the content of text fragments stored in OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the subsequent characters must
be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANELEM ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: TYPE OF ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT


PHRASE ANELEM INDAS PHRASE

b: ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT NUMBER=


1-1023, range of decimal numbers

PHDEFIN INDAS PHRASE DEFINITION

This parameter specifies an INDAS phrase definition.


The phrase definition for an INDAS phrase describes the various
modifications of an announcement text for an individual
announcement as a function of the actual INDAS parameter values
and takes the foreign-language requirements into account.
It specifies the sequence in which fixed text fragments are to be
arranged and locates the positions where the text fragments
determined by the INDAS parameter values must be inserted. An
INDAS parameter is represented by a fixed parameter number assigned.
As a result, the phrase definition controls the combination of text
fragments which form an announcement.
For each one of the allowed INDAS phrases and each valid language,
the phrase definition in its application form is part of the INDAS
document related to the OCANEQ variant.

To produce such a phrase definition, a formal definition language


similar to a programming language is used.

Syntax of INDAS phrase definition components:

The following INDAS phrase definition components are specified


and completed by the permissible combination of the required units:

- "Insert fragment definition":

Statement to insert a text fragment,


e.g.: compose the fixed text part of an announcement.

INFRAGM-<fragment no>

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ANELEM- 3+


MOD ANELEM
ANELEMPH
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

input values:
<fragment no> = 0 .. 65279, range of decimal numbers

- "Insert parameter definition":

Statement to insert an INDAS parameter:


Fit in the text fragment determined by the parameter value by
using the corresponding INDAS word.

INPAR-<parameter no>
INPAR-<parameter no>-MODNONE
INPAR-<parameter no>-MLVNONE
(MLVNONE: only for INDAS parameters
which may have more than one value)

input values:
<parameter no> = 1 .. 63, range of decimal numbers

Statement to insert an INDAS parameter:


Fit in the text fragment determined by the parameter value by
using the corresponding INDAS word modified plus or minus by a
specified INDAS word offset. This corresponds with a change to
an alternative group of text fragments.
This statement may be used
- for modification to lower voice
(e.g.: the INDAS parameter is the final part of an announcement),
- for the several interpretations of the INDAS parameter "number"
(e.g.: applied as year, as part of a price),
- for a different representation of an INDAS parameter in the same
context
(e.g.: insert the INDAS parameter "month" by its name ("January")
or alternatively by its ordinal number ("first")).

INPAR-<parameter no>-MODPLUS-<word offset>


INPAR-<parameter no>-MODMINUS-<word offset>
INPAR-<parameter no>-MLVPLUS-<word offset>
(MLVPLUS: only for INDAS parameters
which may have more than one value)
INPAR-<parameter no>-MLVMINUS-<word offset>
(MLVMINUS: only for INDAS parameters
which may have more than one value)

input values:
<parameter no> = 1 .. 63, range of decimal numbers
<word offset> = 1 .. 4094, range of decimal numbers

- "Parameter block definition":

Statement to process an INDAS parameter which may have more than


one value,
e.g.: the INDAS parameter "directory number".

PARDO-<parameter no>

input values:
<parameter no> = 1 .. 63, range of decimal numbers

- "IF condition block definition":

An "Insert fragment definition" or "Insert parameter definition"


is to be dependent of the value(s) of one INDAS parameter or
several INDAS parameters correlated to each other,
e.g.: insert the INDAS parameter "minute" unless it is a full hour.

A single condition will be initiated by IFPAR. The parameter


value must be specified by its INDAS word.

Several conditions can be combined by ANDIFPAR ("and" relation,


i.e. all conditions must be true) or ORIFPAR ("or" relation, i.e.
one of the conditions must be true).

ELSIFPAR corresponds to a nested "IF condition definition" in


the form of ELSE IFPAR ... ENDIF.

If the condition(s) stated by IFPAR / ELSIFPAR / ANDIFPAR /


ORIFPAR is(are) true the definition statement(s) following will

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ANELEM- 4+


MOD ANELEM
ANELEMPH
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

be executed. If the condition(s) is(are) false, the definition


statement(s) following ELSE (if existent) or ENDIF will be
executed.

IFPAR-<parameter no>-<condition>-<word no>


ELSIFPAR-<parameter no>-<condition>-<word no>
ANDIFPAR-<parameter no>-<condition>-<word no>
ORIFPAR-<parameter no>-<condition>-<word no>

input values:
<parameter no> = 1 .. 63, range of decimal numbers
<word no> = 1 .. 4094, range of decimal numbers
<condition> = EQUAL
NOTEQUAL
LESS
GREATER

or
IFPAR-<parameter no>-<condition>
ELSIFPAR-<parameter no>-<condition>
ANDIFPAR-<parameter no>-<condition>
ORIFPAR-<parameter no>-<condition>

input values:
<parameter no> = 1 .. 63, range of decimal numbers
<condition> = FRSTWORD
NOTFRSTW
LASTWORD
NOTLASTW
SELECTED

The conditions FRSTWORD, NOTFRSTW, LASTWORD, NOTLASTW


are only valid for an INDAS parameter which may have more than
one value.
The condition SELECTED is true if the INDAS parameter has
at least one value.

or
ELSE

- "End definition" :

Statement to terminate a block definition or phrase definition.

ENDDO
ENDIF
END

There are the following requirements for an INDAS phrase definition:


- A "definition block" must consist of one
"Insert fragment definition" or
"Insert parameter definition" or
"Parameter block definition" or
"IF condition block definition".
- A "Parameter block definition" is mandatory if an INDAS parameter
which may have more than one value is to be processed.
This "Parameter block definition" for an INDAS parameter must be
specified before an "IF condition block definition" or "Insert
parameter definition" of that parameter is entered.
There are however the following exceptions:
- The "IF condition block definition" can be entered prior to the
"Parameter block definition" if the condition(s) of an
"IF condition block definition" has(have) been formed using
SELECTED.
- Mandatory input of a "Parameter block definition" is excluded
if no "IF condition block definition" has been specified for
the INDAS parameter and
- only the last value of that parameter has to be modified
exclusively and the corresponding "Insert parameter definition"
is formed with MLVPLUS, MLVMINUS,
- none of the INDAS parameter values has to be modified and the
corresponding "Insert parameter definition" is formed with
MLVNONE.
- The body of a "Parameter block definition" must contain at least
one "definition block" and must be terminated with ENDDO.
- The "IF condition block definition" must contain at least one

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ANELEM- 5+


MOD ANELEM
ANELEMPH
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

statement initiated by IFPAR and must be terminated with ENDIF.


- For each case of "IF condition block definition" initiated by
IFPAR / ELSIFPAR / ELSE the body must contain at least one
"definition block".
- Nested "IF condition block definitions" and/or "Parameter block
definitions" may be used up to the maximum nested level = 10.
- Nested "Parameter block definitions" for the same parameter
number are not allowed.
- The body of an INDAS phrase definition must contain at least one
"definition block" and must be terminated with END.

Notes:
- Within an INDAS phrase, INDAS parameters may be rearranged from
the original order indicated by the parameter numbers.
The parameter number retains the meaning of the INDAS parameter.
- The length of an INDAS phrase definition is only restricted by
the maximum number of permissible characters for an MML command.
As a result, the number of INDAS phrase definition components that
can be linked with &, must follow this restriction.
- The correct order of the INDAS phrase definition components must be
observed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: ACTION CODE
ANDIFPAR AND IF PARAMETER CONDITION
ELSE ELSE CONDITION
ELSIFPAR ELSE IF PARAMETER CONDITION
END END OF PHRASE DEFINITION
ENDDO END OF PARAMETER DO LOOP
ENDIF END OF IF CONDITION
IFPAR IF PARAMETER CONDITION
INFRAGM INSERT FRAGMENT
INPAR INSERT PARAMETER
ORIFPAR OR IF PARAMETER CONDITION
PARDO FOR ALL PARAMETER VALUES DO

b: FRAGMENT- OR INDAS PARAM- NO.=


0...65279, range of decimal numbers

c: MODIFY ACTION OR CONDITION


XEQUAL = EQUAL
1FRSTWORD1 FIRST WORD
1GREATER 1 GREATER
1LASTWORD1 LAST WORD
1LESS 1 LESS
1MLVMINUS1 MOD. LAST PARAM VALUE: DECRE.
1MLVNONE 1 MOD. LAST PARAM VALUE: NOT
1MLVPLUS 1 MOD. LAST PARAM VALUE: INCRE.
1MODMINUS1 MOD. PARAM VALUE: DECREMENT
1MODNONE 1 MOD. PARAM VALUE: NOT
1MODPLUS 1 MOD. PARAM VALUE: INCREMENT
1NOTEQUAL1 NOT EQUAL
1NOTFRSTW1 NOT FIRST WORD
1NOTLASTW1 NOT LAST WORD
>SELECTEDW SELECTED

d: OFFSET=
1...4094, range of decimal numbers

LANGUAGE RELATIVE LANGUAGE OF ANN.ELEM.

This parameter indicates one of up to four official languages


commonly used in an exchange.

Notes:
- The reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ANELEM- 6+


MOD ANELEM
ANELEMPH
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

LAN1 FIRST OFFICIAL LANGUAGE


LAN2 SECOND OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN3 THIRD OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN4 FOURTH OFFICIAL LANGUAGE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ANELEM- 7+


MOD ANELEM
ANELEMST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

ANELEM INDAS STD. ANN.

This input format is used to modify the standard announcement definition


of an announcement element "INDAS standard announcement".

Notes:
- The modified standard announcement definition must be entered completely.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD ANELEM : OCAVAR= ,ANELEM= ,STDADEF= ,LANGUAGE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant. It is used to identify


the content of text fragments stored in OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the subsequent characters must
be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANELEM ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: TYPE OF ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT


STDANN ANELEM INDAS STD. ANN.

b: ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT NUMBER=


1-2500, range of decimal numbers

STDADEF INDAS STD. ANN. DEFINITION

This parameter specifies an INDAS standard announcement


definition.
The standard announcement definition for each INDAS standard
announcement describes the way in which text fragments are
sequenced and takes foreign-language requirements into account.
As a result, the standard announcement definition controls the
combination of text fragments which form an announcement.
For each one of the allowed INDAS standard announcements and
each valid language, the standard announcement definition in
its application form is part of the INDAS document related to
the OCANEQ variant.

To produce such a standard announcement definition, a formal


definition language similar to a programming language is used.

Syntax of INDAS standard announcement definition components:

- "Insert fragment definition":

Statement to insert a text fragment.

INFRAGM-<fragment no>

input values:
<fragment no> = 0 .. 65279, range of decimal numbers

- "End definition" :

Statement to terminate a standard announcement definition.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ANELEM- 8+


MOD ANELEM
ANELEMST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

END

There are the following requirements for an INDAS standard


announcement definition:
- The body of an INDAS standard announcement definition must
contain at least one "Insert fragment definition" and must be
terminated with END.

Notes:
- The length of an INDAS standard announcement definition is only
restricted by the maximum number of permissible characters for
an MML command.
As a result, the number of INDAS standard announcement definition
components that can be linked with &, must follow this restriction.
- The correct order of the INDAS standard announcement definition
components must be observed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: ACTION CODE
END END OF STD. ANN. DEFINITION
INFRAGM INSERT FRAGMENT

b: FRAGMENT-NO.=
0...65279, range of decimal numbers

LANGUAGE RELATIVE LANGUAGE OF ANN.ELEM.

This parameter indicates one of up to four official languages


commonly used in an exchange.

Notes:
- The reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN1 FIRST OFFICIAL LANGUAGE


LAN2 SECOND OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN3 THIRD OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN4 FOURTH OFFICIAL LANGUAGE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ANELEM- 9+


MOD ANELEM
ANELEMWO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

ANELEM INDAS WORD

This input format is used to modify the text fragment allocated


to an announcement element "INDAS word".

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD ANELEM : OCAVAR= ,ANELEM= ,WORD= ,LANGUAGE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant. It is used to identify


the content of text fragments stored in OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the subsequent characters must
be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANELEM ANNOUNCEMENT ELEMENT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

WORD ANELEM INDAS WORD

WORD ANELEM INDAS WORD

Notes:
- Up to 32 INDAS words and/or ranges can be linked with &.
- Input of an INDAS word range is only allowed if the resulting
number of INDAS words equals those of text fragments (implicit
increment one by one for both), or exactly one and the same
text fragment is assigned to all INDAS words of a given range.
- An INDAS word number may not be entered twice with different
text fragment numbers.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

a-b

a: INDAS WORD NUMBER=


1...4094, range of decimal numbers

b: OCANEQ FRAGMENT NUMBER=


0...65279, range of decimal numbers

LANGUAGE RELATIVE LANGUAGE OF ANN.ELEM.

This parameter indicates one of up to four official languages


commonly used in an exchange.

Notes:
- The reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the INDAS document related to the OCANEQ variant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN1 FIRST OFFICIAL LANGUAGE


LAN2 SECOND OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN3 THIRD OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN4 FOURTH OFFICIAL LANGUAGE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ANELEM- 10-


CAN ANGCOS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP COS

This command cancels the given announcement group data for the specified
announcement group.

Prerequisites:
- The specified announcement group must already exist.
- The given announcement group data to be canceled must already exist.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN ANGCOS : TGNO= <,GCOS= ,BLK=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number of the announcement


group to be addressed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GCOS GROUP CLASSES OF SERVICE

This parameter defines classes of service for all announcement lines


of the announcement group. The specified data will be canceled in the
announcement group table.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CHARGABL CHARGEABLE
Calls to this announcement group will be charged.
DATEANN DATE ANNOUNCEMENT
This value indicates a date announcement in
addition to the time announcement.
It is only allowed for time announcement groups
(GCOS=OCANEQ&TIMEANN).

BLK BLOCKING

This parameter specifies the blocking of the announcement group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ADMIN ADMINISTRATIVE BLOCK


This announcement group is administratively
blocked.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ANGCOS- 1-


ENTR ANGCOS
OCINDANN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP COS

This command enters the given announcement group data for the specified
announcement group.

Prerequisites:
- The specified announcement group must already exist.
- The given announcement group data (parameters GCOS and BLK) to be entered
must not already exist.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ENTR ANGCOS - OCINDANN OCANEQ INDIVIDUAL AND UI ANNOUNCEMENTS


2. ENTR ANGCOS - OCSTDANN OCANEQ STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT
3. ENTR ANGCOS - OCTIMANN OCANEQ TIME ANNOUNCEMENT
4. ENTR ANGCOS - STANDANN STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT

1. Input format

OCANEQ INDIVIDUAL AND UI ANNOUNCEMENTS

This input format enters the given announcement group data for the specified
individual or user interactive (UI) announcement group leading to OCANEQ.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR ANGCOS : TGNO= <,GCOS= ,BLK=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number of the announcement


group to be addressed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GCOS GROUP CLASSES OF SERVICE

This parameter defines classes of service for all announcement lines


of the announcement group. The specified data will be entered in the
announcement group table.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CHARGABL CHARGEABLE
Calls to this announcement group will be charged.

BLK BLOCKING

This parameter specifies the blocking of the announcement group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ADMIN ADMINISTRATIVE BLOCK


This announcement group is administratively
blocked.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ANGCOS- 1+


ENTR ANGCOS
OCSTDANN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

OCANEQ STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT

This input format enters the given announcement group data for the specified
standard announcement group leading to OCANEQ.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR ANGCOS : TGNO= <,GCOS= ,BLK= ,STANNO= ,NUMCYC= ,SIT= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,OCALSEQ=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number of the announcement


group to be addressed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GCOS GROUP CLASSES OF SERVICE

This parameter defines classes of service for all announcement lines


of the announcement group. The specified data will be entered in the
announcement group table.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

<CHARGABL> CHARGEABLE
Calls to this announcement group will be charged.

BLK BLOCKING

This parameter specifies the blocking of the announcement group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ADMIN ADMINISTRATIVE BLOCK


This announcement group is administratively
blocked.

STANNO STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the standard announcement number for the


announcement group.
It is evaluated only in input format OCSTDANN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1-2500, range of decimal numbers

NUMCYC NUMBER OF ANNOUNCEMENT CYCLES

This parameter specifies the number of announcement cycles.


Value 0 indicates an endless-loop announcement.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...7, range of decimal numbers

SIT SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE

This parameter specifies the use of the special information tone.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(N ) NO SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ANGCOS- 2+


ENTR ANGCOS
OCSTDANN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ZNO Y NO SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE


1Y 1 SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE
*YES + SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE

OCALSEQ OCANEQ KIND & SEQ OF LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the languages of the announcements and the


sequences of these languages for OCANEQ. Input of up to 4 languages
for one sequence is possible.
Value NONE indicates the use of the switch-specific value entered by
the command MOD CALLPOPT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(L1 )
1L1L2 1
1L1L2L3 1
1L1L2L3L41
1L1L2L4 1
1L1L2L4L31
1L1L3 1
1L1L3L2 1
1L1L3L2L41
1L1L3L4 1
1L1L3L4L21
1L1L4 1
1L1L4L2 1
1L1L4L2L31
1L1L4L3 1
1L1L4L3L21
1L2 1
1L2L1 1
1L2L1L3 1
1L2L1L3L41
1L2L1L4 1
1L2L1L4L31
1L2L3 1
1L2L3L1 1
1L2L3L1L41
1L2L3L4 1
1L2L3L4L11
1L2L4 1
1L2L4L1 1
1L2L4L1L31
1L2L4L3 1
ZL2L4L3L1Y
1L3 1
1L3L1 1
1L3L1L2 1
1L3L1L2L41
1L3L1L4 1
1L3L1L4L21
1L3L2 1
1L3L2L1 1
1L3L2L1L41
1L3L2L4 1
1L3L2L4L11
1L3L4 1
1L3L4L1 1
1L3L4L1L21
1L3L4L2 1
1L3L4L2L11
1L4 1
1L4L1 1
1L4L1L2 1
1L4L1L2L31
1L4L1L3 1
1L4L1L3L21
1L4L2 1
1L4L2L1 1
1L4L2L1L31
1L4L2L3 1
1L4L2L3L11
1L4L3 1
1L4L3L1 1
1L4L3L1L21
1L4L3L2 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ANGCOS- 3+


ENTR ANGCOS
OCSTDANN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1L4L3L2L11
*NONE +

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ANGCOS- 4+


ENTR ANGCOS
OCTIMANN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

OCANEQ TIME ANNOUNCEMENT

This input format enters the given announcement group data for the specified
time announcement group leading to OCANEQ.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR ANGCOS : TGNO= <,GCOS= ,BLK= ,TIMINT= ,OCALSEQ=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number of the announcement


group to be addressed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GCOS GROUP CLASSES OF SERVICE

This parameter defines classes of service for all announcement lines


of the announcement group. The specified data will be entered in the
announcement group table.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

<CHARGABL> CHARGEABLE
< > Calls to this announcement group will be charged.
<DATEANN > DATE ANNOUNCEMENT
This value indicates a date announcement in
addition to the time announcement.

BLK BLOCKING

This parameter specifies the blocking of the announcement group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ADMIN ADMINISTRATIVE BLOCK


This announcement group is administratively
blocked.

TIMINT PERIODIC TIME INTERVAL

This parameter specifies the time interval (in seconds) for


time announcements.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,15,20,30,60, range of decimal numbers

OCALSEQ OCANEQ KIND & SEQ OF LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the languages of the announcements and the


sequences of these languages for OCANEQ. Input of up to 4 languages
for one sequence is possible.
Value NONE indicates the use of the switch-specific value entered by
the command MOD CALLPOPT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(L1 )
1L1L2 1
1L1L2L3 1
1L1L2L3L41
1L1L2L4 1
1L1L2L4L31

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ANGCOS- 5+


ENTR ANGCOS
OCTIMANN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1L1L3 1
1L1L3L2 1
1L1L3L2L41
1L1L3L4 1
1L1L3L4L21
1L1L4 1
1L1L4L2 1
1L1L4L2L31
1L1L4L3 1
1L1L4L3L21
1L2 1
1L2L1 1
1L2L1L3 1
1L2L1L3L41
1L2L1L4 1
1L2L1L4L31
1L2L3 1
1L2L3L1 1
1L2L3L1L41
1L2L3L4 1
1L2L3L4L11
1L2L4 1
1L2L4L1 1
1L2L4L1L31
1L2L4L3 1
ZL2L4L3L1Y
1L3 1
1L3L1 1
1L3L1L2 1
1L3L1L2L41
1L3L1L4 1
1L3L1L4L21
1L3L2 1
1L3L2L1 1
1L3L2L1L41
1L3L2L4 1
1L3L2L4L11
1L3L4 1
1L3L4L1 1
1L3L4L1L21
1L3L4L2 1
1L3L4L2L11
1L4 1
1L4L1 1
1L4L1L2 1
1L4L1L2L31
1L4L1L3 1
1L4L1L3L21
1L4L2 1
1L4L2L1 1
1L4L2L1L31
1L4L2L3 1
1L4L2L3L11
1L4L3 1
1L4L3L1 1
1L4L3L1L21
1L4L3L2 1
1L4L3L2L11
*NONE +

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ANGCOS- 6+


ENTR ANGCOS
STANDANN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT

This input format enters the given announcement group data for the specified
standard announcement group that is not applied via OCANEQ.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR ANGCOS : TGNO= <,GCOS= ,BLK= ,STANNO= ,NUMCYC=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number of the announcement


group to be addressed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GCOS GROUP CLASSES OF SERVICE

This parameter defines classes of service for all announcement lines


of the announcement group. The specified data will be entered in the
announcement group table.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

<CHARGABL> CHARGEABLE
Calls to this announcement group will be charged.

BLK BLOCKING

This parameter specifies the blocking of the announcement group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ADMIN ADMINISTRATIVE BLOCK


This announcement group is administratively
blocked.

STANNO STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the standard announcement number for the


announcement group.
It is evaluated only in input format OCSTDANN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2500, range of decimal numbers

NUMCYC NUMBER OF ANNOUNCEMENT CYCLES

This parameter specifies the number of announcement cycles.


Value 0 indicates an endless-loop announcement.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...7, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ANGCOS- 7-


CAN ANGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP

This command cancels an existing announcement group.

Prerequisites:
- The announcement group must not contain any announcement lines.
- No route may exist to this announcement group.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN ANGRP : TGNO= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number of the announcement


group to be addressed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ANGRP- 1-


CR ANGRP
OCINDANN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP

This command creates an announcement group with the specified trunk group
number. All specified data will be entered in the announcement group table.

Prerequisite:
- The specified trunk group number must not exist within the exchange.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR ANGRP - OCINDANN OCANEQ INDIVIDUAL AND UI ANNOUNCEMENTS


2. CR ANGRP - OCSTDANN OCANEQ STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT
3. CR ANGRP - OCTIMANN OCANEQ TIME ANNOUNCEMENT
4. CR ANGRP - STANDANN STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT

1. Input format

OCANEQ INDIVIDUAL AND UI ANNOUNCEMENTS

This input format creates an announcement group for individual or user


interactive (UI) announcements leading to OCANEQ.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR ANGRP : TGNO= ,GCOS= [,BLK=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number. Any number can be
selected by the system operator provided it is clearly identifiable
within the exchange.

It is used for:
- addressing the announcement group, if commands are entered which are
related to the announcement group.
- identifying the announcement group in system outputs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GCOS GROUP CLASSES OF SERVICE

This parameter defines classes of service for all announcement lines


of the announcement group. The specified data will be entered in the
announcement group table.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

OCANEQ OPERATOR CONTR. ANNOUNC. EQU.


This announcement group leads to OCANEQ.

[CHARGABL] CHARGEABLE
Calls to this announcement group will be charged.

BLK BLOCKING

This parameter specifies the blocking of the announcement group.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

<ADMIN > ADMINISTRATIVE BLOCK


< > This announcement group is administratively
< > blocked.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANGRP- 1+
CR ANGRP
OCINDANN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

<MAINT > MAINTENANCE BLOCK


This announcement group is blocked for maintenance
purposes.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANGRP- 2+
CR ANGRP
OCSTDANN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

OCANEQ STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT

This input format creates an announcement group for standard announcements


leading to OCANEQ.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR ANGRP : TGNO= ,GCOS= ,STANNO= [,BLK=] [,NUMCYC=] [,SIT=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,OCALSEQ=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number. Any number can be
selected by the system operator provided it is clearly identifiable
within the exchange.

It is used for:
- addressing the announcement group, if commands are entered which are
related to the announcement group.
- identifying the announcement group in system outputs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GCOS GROUP CLASSES OF SERVICE

This parameter defines classes of service for all announcement lines


of the announcement group. The specified data will be entered in the
announcement group table.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

OCANEQ OPERATOR CONTR. ANNOUNC. EQU.


This announcement group leads to OCANEQ.

[NONBARGE] NON BARGE-IN ANNOUNCEMENT


This value indicates an announcement group for
non barge-in announcements.

XCHARGABL= CHARGEABLE
1 1 Calls to this announcement group will be charged.
>STAGGER W TIME STAGGER FOR NONBARGE
If this value is entered, time-staggering for the
announcement lines of this announcement group will
be activated.
Compatibilities: Only allowed for GCOS=NONBARGE.

STANNO STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the standard announcement number for the


announcement group.
It is evaluated only in input format OCSTDANN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1-2500, range of decimal numbers

BLK BLOCKING

This parameter specifies the blocking of the announcement group.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

<ADMIN > ADMINISTRATIVE BLOCK

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANGRP- 3+
CR ANGRP
OCSTDANN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

< > This announcement group is administratively


< > blocked.
<MAINT > MAINTENANCE BLOCK
This announcement group is blocked for maintenance
purposes.

NUMCYC NUMBER OF ANNOUNCEMENT CYCLES

This parameter specifies the number of announcement cycles.


Value 0 indicates an endless-loop announcement.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...7, range of decimal numbers

Default: 2

SIT SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE

This parameter specifies the use of the special information tone.

Standard Behavior: If no value is entered and GCOS=NONBARGE, then SIT


will be set to NO, otherwise it will be set to YES.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(N ) NO SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE


ZNO Y NO SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE
1Y 1 SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE
*YES + SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE

OCALSEQ OCANEQ KIND & SEQ OF LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the languages of the announcements and the


sequences of these languages for OCANEQ. Input of up to 4 languages
for one sequence is possible.
Value NONE indicates the use of the switch-specific value entered by
the command MOD CALLPOPT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(L1 )
1L1L2 1
1L1L2L3 1
1L1L2L3L41
1L1L2L4 1
1L1L2L4L31
1L1L3 1
1L1L3L2 1
1L1L3L2L41
1L1L3L4 1
1L1L3L4L21
1L1L4 1
1L1L4L2 1
1L1L4L2L31
1L1L4L3 1
1L1L4L3L21
1L2 1
1L2L1 1
1L2L1L3 1
1L2L1L3L41
1L2L1L4 1
1L2L1L4L31
1L2L3 1
1L2L3L1 1
1L2L3L1L41
1L2L3L4 1
1L2L3L4L11
1L2L4 1
1L2L4L1 1
1L2L4L1L31
1L2L4L3 1
ZL2L4L3L1Y
1L3 1
1L3L1 1
1L3L1L2 1
1L3L1L2L41

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANGRP- 4+
CR ANGRP
OCSTDANN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1L3L1L4 1
1L3L1L4L21
1L3L2 1
1L3L2L1 1
1L3L2L1L41
1L3L2L4 1
1L3L2L4L11
1L3L4 1
1L3L4L1 1
1L3L4L1L21
1L3L4L2 1
1L3L4L2L11
1L4 1
1L4L1 1
1L4L1L2 1
1L4L1L2L31
1L4L1L3 1
1L4L1L3L21
1L4L2 1
1L4L2L1 1
1L4L2L1L31
1L4L2L3 1
1L4L2L3L11
1L4L3 1
1L4L3L1 1
1L4L3L1L21
1L4L3L2 1
1L4L3L2L11
*NONE +

Default: NONE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANGRP- 5+
CR ANGRP
OCTIMANN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

OCANEQ TIME ANNOUNCEMENT

This input format creates an announcement group for time announcements


leading to OCANEQ.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR ANGRP : TGNO= ,GCOS= ,TIMINT= [,BLK=] [,OCALSEQ=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number. Any number can be
selected by the system operator provided it is clearly identifiable
within the exchange.

It is used for:
- addressing the announcement group, if commands are entered which are
related to the announcement group.
- identifying the announcement group in system outputs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GCOS GROUP CLASSES OF SERVICE

This parameter defines classes of service for all announcement lines


of the announcement group. The specified data will be entered in the
announcement group table.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

OCANEQ OPERATOR CONTR. ANNOUNC. EQU.


This announcement group leads to OCANEQ.
TIMEANN TIME ANNOUNCEMENT
This value indicates an announcement group for
time announcements.

XCHARGABL= CHARGEABLE
1 1 Calls to this announcement group will be charged.
>DATEANN W DATE ANNOUNCEMENT
This value indicates a date announcement in
addition to the time announcement.

TIMINT PERIODIC TIME INTERVAL

This parameter specifies the time interval (in seconds) for


time announcements.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,15,20,30,60, range of decimal numbers

BLK BLOCKING

This parameter specifies the blocking of the announcement group.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

<ADMIN > ADMINISTRATIVE BLOCK


< > This announcement group is administratively
< > blocked.
<MAINT > MAINTENANCE BLOCK
This announcement group is blocked for maintenance
purposes.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANGRP- 6+
CR ANGRP
OCTIMANN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

OCALSEQ OCANEQ KIND & SEQ OF LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the languages of the announcements and the


sequences of these languages for OCANEQ. Input of up to 4 languages
for one sequence is possible.
Value NONE indicates the use of the switch-specific value entered by
the command MOD CALLPOPT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(L1 )
1L1L2 1
1L1L2L3 1
1L1L2L3L41
1L1L2L4 1
1L1L2L4L31
1L1L3 1
1L1L3L2 1
1L1L3L2L41
1L1L3L4 1
1L1L3L4L21
1L1L4 1
1L1L4L2 1
1L1L4L2L31
1L1L4L3 1
1L1L4L3L21
1L2 1
1L2L1 1
1L2L1L3 1
1L2L1L3L41
1L2L1L4 1
1L2L1L4L31
1L2L3 1
1L2L3L1 1
1L2L3L1L41
1L2L3L4 1
1L2L3L4L11
1L2L4 1
1L2L4L1 1
1L2L4L1L31
1L2L4L3 1
ZL2L4L3L1Y
1L3 1
1L3L1 1
1L3L1L2 1
1L3L1L2L41
1L3L1L4 1
1L3L1L4L21
1L3L2 1
1L3L2L1 1
1L3L2L1L41
1L3L2L4 1
1L3L2L4L11
1L3L4 1
1L3L4L1 1
1L3L4L1L21
1L3L4L2 1
1L3L4L2L11
1L4 1
1L4L1 1
1L4L1L2 1
1L4L1L2L31
1L4L1L3 1
1L4L1L3L21
1L4L2 1
1L4L2L1 1
1L4L2L1L31
1L4L2L3 1
1L4L2L3L11
1L4L3 1
1L4L3L1 1
1L4L3L1L21
1L4L3L2 1
1L4L3L2L11
*NONE +

Default: NONE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANGRP- 7+
CR ANGRP
STANDANN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT

This input format creates an announcement group for standard announcements


that are not applied via OCANEQ.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR ANGRP : TGNO= [,GCOS=] [,BLK=] [,STANNO=] [,NUMCYC=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number. Any number can be
selected by the system operator provided it is clearly identifiable
within the exchange.

It is used for:
- addressing the announcement group, if commands are entered which are
related to the announcement group.
- identifying the announcement group in system outputs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GCOS GROUP CLASSES OF SERVICE

This parameter defines classes of service for all announcement lines


of the announcement group. The specified data will be entered in the
announcement group table.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

[NONBARGE] NON BARGE-IN ANNOUNCEMENT


This value indicates an announcement group for
non barge-in announcements.

XCHARGABL= CHARGEABLE
1 1 Calls to this announcement group will be charged.
>STAGGER W TIME STAGGER FOR NONBARGE
If this value is entered, time-staggering for the
announcement lines of this announcement group will
be activated.
Compatibilities: Only allowed for GCOS=NONBARGE.

BLK BLOCKING

This parameter specifies the blocking of the announcement group.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

<ADMIN > ADMINISTRATIVE BLOCK


< > This announcement group is administratively
< > blocked.
<MAINT > MAINTENANCE BLOCK
This announcement group is blocked for maintenance
purposes.

STANNO STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the standard announcement number for the


announcement group.
It is evaluated only in input format OCSTDANN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2500, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANGRP- 8+
CR ANGRP
STANDANN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Default: 0

NUMCYC NUMBER OF ANNOUNCEMENT CYCLES

This parameter specifies the number of announcement cycles.


Value 0 indicates an endless-loop announcement.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...7, range of decimal numbers

Default: 2

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANGRP- 9-
DISP ANGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP

This command displays the announcement group specific data.

Prerequisite:
- The specified announcement group(s) must already exist.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ANGRP : TGNO= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number(s) of the announcement


group(s) to be addressed.

Up to 34 trunk group numbers may be linked.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ANGRP- 1-


REC ANGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RECORD ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP DATA

This command enables announcement trunk group data


to be recorded.

Prerequisites:
- System time must be secure when the command is accepted.

Notes:
- 8 measurement jobs can be started.
- The same measurement object may not be specified in more than one job at
any one time.
- Traffic data are output to OMT or MDD file every 15 minutes.
- The measurement job can be stopped by STOP JOB if it is not a
daily and not a cyclic measurement job and if the time parameter
values allow a continuation of the job.
- A STOP JOB command during the last or the only measurement interval
results automatically in job termination.

This command starts a semipermanent job. It can be canceled with CAN JOB.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REC ANGRP : TGNO= ,UNIT= [,BEG=] [,TER=] [,IV=] [,PER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the announcement trunk groups


for which traffic data are to be recorded.
Allowed parameter values are:
- X, means: measurement of all created announcement
trunk groups,
or
- up to 16 specified announcement group numbers
(separated by &).

Prerequisites:
- The measurement of all announcement trunk groups (TGNO=X)
is only allowed if the data output will be to the magnetic
disk device (single or daily or cyclic measurement file).

Notes:
- Only the names of existing announcement trunk groups may be
specified.
Up to 16 trunk groups may be linked with &.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

UNIT OUTPUT UNIT AND MODE

This parameter specifies the output unit and the form of


output.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: OUTPUT UNIT
OMT OPERATION AND MAIN.TERMINAL
If this option is selected, data will be output to
OMT every 15 minutes throughout the specified
measurement period.
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
If this option is selected, a measurement file

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC ANGRP- 1+


REC ANGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

is created and the received traffic data are


output every 15 minutes to this file.
After the parameter has been accepted and at
the end of the last recording, an acknowledgement
is output to the OMT. It includes the name of the
file in which the traffic data are available for
postprocessing.

This information unit specifies the output unit.

b: OUTPUT MODE
SINGLE SINGLE TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data will be
output to single measurement files.
If a file is destroyed or cannot be extended, a
message appears at OMT.
DAILY DAILY TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data will be
output to daily files.
Additional time parameters are not allowed.
This type of measurement is appropriate to
continuous measurements which start immediately
and have no defined end.
They can only be cancelled by the command
CAN JOB.

To secure the required space on disk, all 7 daily


files (MO...SU) are prepared and created during
command acceptance.
The first data output after command acceptance
will be at the second 15-minute stroke.

A daily file is closed at the end of the day and


the new file for the next day is automatically
opened or created.
Existing files are replaced.
In the second and subsequent weeks, the file for
the same day of the week before will be
overwritten.
CYCLIC CYCLIC TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are written
into a cyclic measurement file. Time parameters
are not permitted for these measurements.
If a cyclic file runs full the newest data will
be lost. This occurs after a period of two days.

This information unit specifies the desired output form


(daily or single or cyclic measurement file).
It is only permissible in connection with output unit = MDD.

BEG BEGIN DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement begin time.

Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER must be
specified.
Exception: Time parameters may not be specified for the data output
in daily or cyclic files.
- A maximum of four BEG dates may be linked with &. In case of
linked BEG dates, TER is not permissible.

Default: current date

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC ANGRP- 2+


REC ANGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

TER TERMINATION DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement termination date.

Notes:
- Only one termination date may be entered per command.
The earliest possible termination date is the day after command
entry.
- The measurement duration may not exceed one year.
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER must be
specified.
Exception: Time parameters may not be specified for the data output
in daily or cyclic files.

Default: If no termination date is entered, single day measurement


takes place.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF TERMINATION DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

IV INTERVAL TIME

This parameter reduces the daily data delivery by defining


measurement interval times.

Notes:
- A maximum of 4 measurement intervals may be linked with &.
- Interval times are only permissible in connection with a begin date
(BEG).

Default: 24-hour measurement on the specified days

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: BEGIN HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: BEGIN MINUTE=
0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

c: TERMINATION HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

d: TERMINATION MINUTE=
0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

PER PERIODIC WEEKDAY

This parameter specifies the weekdays on which data


are to be recorded.

Notes:
- The input of weekdays is only permissible in
connection with a termination date (TER).
- Up to 6 of the values may be linked with &, except

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC ANGRP- 3+


REC ANGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

the values NO, WO and HO which are not


linkable with other values.

Default: measurement every day during the measurement


period

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

NO NO SPECIFIED PERIOD
Measurement every day
MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY
Days which are full working days
HO HOLIDAY
Full national and international holidays are
included.
The full weekend day (the day marked EF
in the DISP WDCAT output mask) is included.
Half holidays are not included.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC ANGRP- 4-


CAN ANLCOS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL ANNOUNCEMENT LINE COS

This command cancels the given announcement line data for the specified
announcement line.

Prerequisites:
- The specified announcement line must already exist.
- The given data to be canceled must already exist.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN ANLCOS : TGNO= ,LNO= ,BLK= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number of the announcement


group to be addressed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number of the announcement line.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...1000, range of decimal numbers

BLK BLOCKING

This parameter specifies the blocking of the announcement line.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ADMIN ADMINISTRATIVE BLOCK


This announcement line is administratively
blocked.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ANLCOS- 1-


ENTR ANLCOS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER ANNOUNCEMENT LINE COS

This command enters the given announcement line data for the specified
announcement line.

Prerequisites:
- The specified announcement line must already exist.
- The given data to be entered must not already exist.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR ANLCOS : TGNO= ,LNO= <,BLK= ,SEIZMX=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number of the announcement


group to be addressed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number of the announcement line.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...1000, range of decimal numbers

BLK BLOCKING

This parameter specifies the blocking of the announcement line.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ADMIN ADMINISTRATIVE BLOCK


This announcement line is administratively
blocked.

SEIZMX SEIZURE COUNTER MAXIMUM VALUE

This parameter specifies the maximum number of subscribers that can


simultaneously be connected to the announcement line.

- For individual announcements only value 1 is allowed.

- For time announcements or when GCOS=NONBARGE is entered for the


announcement group, value 1 is not allowed.

- When GCOS=NONBARGE is not entered for the announcement group and


when value greater than 1 is entered (broadcast), the entered value
of parameter NUMCYC is not relevant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR ANLCOS- 1-


CAN ANLN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL ANNOUNCEMENT LINE

This command cancels an existing announcement line.

Prerequisites:
- The announcement line must be administrativly blocked.
- The announcement line is no longer seized for call processing.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN ANLN : TGNO= [,LNO=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number of the announcement


group to be addressed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number of the announcement line to be


canceled.

Standard Behavior: If no value is entered, the line with the highest


existing number available in the announcement group
will be deleted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...1000, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ANLN- 1-


CR ANLN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE ANNOUNCEMENT LINE

This command creates an announcement line with the specified data.

Prerequisites:
- The specified announcement group must already exist.
- The specified equipment number must exist and has to be free.

Announcement lines may be created on the following port construction types:

TCB800CA
TCO305
DIUPORT
DIURAPRT
INDASPRT Prerequisite: GCOS=OCANEQ is entered for the announcement group.
INDAS0PT Prerequisite: GCOS=OCANEQ is entered for the announcement group.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR ANLN : TGNO= ,EQN= [,LNO=] [,LCOS=] [,BLK=] [,SEIZMX=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number of the announcement


group to be addressed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER

In the case of a time announcement the following conditions apply:

- It is necessary to combine two adjacent ports to get one "logical"


port. This port pair must always be completed before another pair
is created.

- The ports of a coupled pair must belong to the same announcement


group.

- The ports of a coupled pair must have successive port numbers,


whereby the lower number always has to be odd and the higher even.

- The total number of created announcement lines for a time


announcement belonging to the same LTU:OCANEQ must not exceed 6
lines (3 pairs).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: TIME SWITCH GROUP=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP=


1...63, range of decimal numbers

c: LINE TRUNK UNIT=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANLN- 1+
CR ANLN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

d: CHANNEL=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number of the announcement line to be


created.

Standard Behavior: If no value is entered, the line will be given


the highest existing number available in the
announcement group plus 1. When the first line
is created, the value is set to 1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...1000, range of decimal numbers

LCOS LINE CLASSES OF SERVICE

This parameter specifies the signaling type when creating an


announcement line, or changes the port construction type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UIPRT USER INTERACTION PORT


This value indicates a port for user interaction.
It is only possible on port construction type
INDASPRT (ports 1..31 of LTU:OCANEQ). The
announcement group must have been created with
input format OCINDANN. The port construction type
will be changed to UIPRT.
DIGSIG16 DIGITAL SIGNALING 16
LT = 46, DIR = OG/IC, Sig. = BASIS-LIP F-SIG.
DIGSIG17 DIGITAL SIGNALING 17
LT = 46, DIR = BW/OG/IC, Sig. = E&M IMPULS
DIGSIG18 DIGITAL SIGNALING 18
Only possible on port construction type
DIUPORT.
DIGSIG19 DIGITAL SIGNALING 19
Only possible on port construction type
DIUPORT.
DIGSIG20 DIGITAL SIGNALING 20
Only possible on port construction type
DIUPORT.
DIGSIG21 DIGITAL SIGNALING 21
Only possible on port construction type
DIUPORT.
DIGSIG22 DIGITAL SIGNALING 22
Only possible on port construction type
DIUPORT.
DIGSIG23 DIGITAL SIGNALING 23
LT = 46, DIR = BW/OG/IC, Sig. = MIC Loop ISUP
DIGSIG1 DIGITAL SIGNALING 01
Only possible on port construction type
DIUPORT.
DIGSIG2 DIGITAL SIGNALING 02
LT = 46, DIR = OG/IN, Sig. = SW Loop
DIGSIG3 DIGITAL SIGNALING 03
LT = 46, DIR = BW/OG/IC, Sig. = Loop + MFC:R2D
DIGSIG4 DIGITAL SIGNALING 04
LT = 41, DIR = BW, Sig. = BSSAP

LT = 46, DIR = BW/OG/IC, Sig. = E&M MFC:R2A


DIGSIG5 DIGITAL SIGNALING 05
LT = 46, DIR = BW/IC, Sig. = Monitoring Loop
DIGSIG6 DIGITAL SIGNALING 06
LT = 46, DIR = OG/IC, Sig. = MIC-Loop TUP
DIGSIG7 DIGITAL SIGNALING 07
LT = 46, DIR = BW , Sig. = PABX-Loop TUP
DIGSIG8 DIGITAL SIGNALING 08
LT = 41, DIR = BW/OG/IC, Sig. = MUX CCS #7

LT = 46, DIR = BW/OG/IC, Sig. = MUX CCS #7


DIGSIG9 DIGITAL SIGNALING 09
LT = 46, DIR = BW/OG/IC, Sig. = Basic CAS / PABX
DIGSIG10 DIGITAL SIGNALING 10
Only possible on port construction type

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANLN- 2+
CR ANLN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIUPORT.
DIGSIG11 DIGITAL SIGNALING 11
LT = 41, DIR = BW/IC, Sig. = IN: Leg Control

LT = 46, DIR = BW/IC, Sig. = IN: Leg Control


DIGSIG12 DIGITAL SIGNALING 12
LT = 46, DIR = BW/IC, Sig. = ISUP
DIGSIG13 DIGITAL SIGNALING 13
LT = 46, DIR = OG/IC, Sig. = Pool Echo
DIGSIG14 DIGITAL SIGNALING 14
LT = 46, DIR = BW Sig. = TUP
DIGSIG15 DIGITAL SIGNALING 15
Only possible on port construction type
DIUPORT.
DIGSIG24 DIGITAL SIGNALING 24
LT = 46, DIR = BW, Sig. = PBX LOOP ISUP
DIGSIG25 DIGITAL SIGNALING 25
Only possible on port construction type
DIUPORT.
DIGSIG26 DIGITAL SIGNALING 26
Only possible on port construction type
DIUPORT.
DIGSIG27 DIGITAL SIGNALING 27
Only possible on port construction type
DIUPORT.
DIGSIG28 DIGITAL SIGNALING 28
LT = 46, DIR = IC, Sig. = Monitoring Trunk
DIGSIG29 DIGITAL SIGNALING 29
Only possible on port construction type
DIUPORT.
DIGSIG30 DIGITAL SIGNALING 30
Only possible on port construction type
DIUPORT.
DIGSIG31 DIGITAL SIGNALING 31
Only possible on port construction type
DIUPORT.

BLK BLOCKING

This parameter specifies the blocking of the announcement line.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ADMIN ADMINISTRATIVE BLOCK


This announcement line is administratively
blocked.
MAINT MAINTENANCE BLOCK
This announcement line is blocked for maintenance
purposes.

SEIZMX SEIZURE COUNTER MAXIMUM VALUE

This parameter specifies the maximum number of subscribers that can


simultaneously be connected to the announcement line.

- For individual announcements only value 1 is allowed.

- For time announcements or when GCOS=NONBARGE is entered for the


announcement group, value 1 is not allowed.

- When GCOS=NONBARGE is not entered for the announcement group and


when value greater than 1 is entered (broadcast), the entered value
of parameter NUMCYC is not relevant.

Standard Behavior: If no value is entered, in the case of individual


announcements the default value will be set to 1,
otherwise the default value will be set to 16.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANLN- 3-
DISP ANLN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ANNOUNCEMENT LINE

This command displays the announcement line specific data.

Prerequisite:
- The specified announcement group(s) must already exist.

All combinations of linked trunk group numbers and linked line numbers or a
range of line numbers are possible.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ANLN : TGNO= [,LNO=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number(s) of the announcement


group(s) to be addressed.

Up to 34 trunk group numbers may be linked.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number(s) of the announcement line(s)


to be displayed.

Up to 34 line numbers or ranges of line numbers may be linked.

Standard Behavior: If this parameter is not entered, all announcement


lines within the specified announcement group(s)
will be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...1000, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ANLN- 1-


STAT ANLN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY STATUS OF ANNOUNCEMENT LINE

This command displays the transient states and the seizure counters for one
or more or all lines of one or all announcement trunk groups.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT ANLN : TGNO= [,LNO=] [,STATUS= [,MODE=]] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.

Notes:
- The administration assigns trunk group numbers for recorded
announcement groups, trunk groups and test equipment groups.
- The trunk group number is used in the sequence as a search criterion
for a specific group in the system.
- Only alphanumeric characters are permitted for this parameter.
- All trunk group numbers can be assigned with X.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number of the recorded announcement


group.

Notes:
- Up to 32 LNO parameter values can be chained as input.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...16383, range of decimal numbers

STATUS TRANSIENT RCA TRUNK STATE

This parameter specifies the status of a recorded announcement group.


The default value of this parameter is X.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

OUT BUSY OUTGOING


INT BUSY INTERNAL
PBMS PORT BLOCKED BY MANUAL SWITCH
BBAC BLOCK BACKWARD
BPRM BLOCK PERMANENT
BMNT BLOCK MAINTENANCE
BADM BLOCK ADMINISTRATIVE
CADM CAMPED ON ADMINISTRATION
NLTG NOT ACCESSIBLE LTG
NDIU NOT ACCESSIBLE DIU
NPRT NOT ACCESSIBLE PORT
NCAR NOT ACCESSIBLE CARRIER
NMNT NOT ACCESSIBLE MAINTENANCE
NMNI NAC MAINTENANCE INDICATION
AUD AUDIT
MLTG MAINTENANCE BLOCKED LTG
MDIU MAINTENANCE BLOCKED DIU

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT ANLN- 1+


STAT ANLN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MPRT MAINTENANCE BLOCKED PORT


CLTG CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED LTG
CDIU CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED DIU
CPRT CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED PORT
IDLE IDLE STATUS
GBAD GROUP BLOCKED ADMIN
GBMT GROUP BLOCKED MAINT
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES
BSTC TRANSMISSION CHANNEL BLOCKED

MODE SEARCH MODE

This parameter specifies the search mode.


This parameter can be set up only together with the STATUS parameter.
With this parameter announcement lines with special status values can
be restricted.
The default value is ANY.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ANY ANY MATCH


ALL ALL MATCHES
ONLY EXACT STATUS MATCH
SUBSET SUBSET OF RESPECTIVE STATE SET

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT ANLN- 2-


CAN ANTXT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL ANNOUNCEMENT TEXT

This command cancels a definition of an announcement text of OCANEQ


(Operationally Controlled Equipment for Announcement).
When the definitions of all official languages are canceled, the
textnumber and its data (use if the special information tone,
number of announcement cycles) is canceled too.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN ANTXT : TXTNO= [,LANGUAGE=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TXTNO TEXT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the number of the selected announcement


text.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

LANGUAGE LANGUAGE OF ANNOUCEMENT TEXT

This parameter specifies one of up to four official languages


for the announcement text.

Default: Announcement text is canceled for all official


languages.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN1 FIRST OFFICIAL LANGUAGE


LAN2 SECOND OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN3 THIRD OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN4 FOURTH OFFICIAL LANGUAGE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ANTXT- 1-


CR ANTXT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE ANNOUNCEMENT TEXT

This command creates definitions of an announcement text (in up


to four languages) by combining numbers of text parts that are
available on OCANEQ (Operationally Controlled Equipment for
Announcement).

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR ANTXT : TXTNO= <,TXTLAN1= ,TXTLAN2= ,TXTLAN3= ,TXTLAN4=> 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,SIT=] [,NUMCYC=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TXTNO TEXT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the number of the selected announcement


text.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

TXTLAN1 TEXT DATA OF FIRST LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the components of an


announcement text for the first official language:
- Numbers of the elements (words or phrases) on OCANEQ
- Digit strings (e.g. telephone numbers) which are
converted to their corresponding text element numbers
automatically. They start with ’#’.
These components are connected by ’+’.
Example: TXTLAN1 = "4+16+#73154+50".
The maximum number of text elements is 50.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

TXTLAN2 TEXT DATA OF SECOND LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the components of an


announcement text for the second official language:
- Numbers of the elements (words or phrases) on OCANEQ
- Digit strings (e.g. telephone numbers) which are
converted to their corresponding text element numbers
automatically. They start with ’#’.
These components are connected by ’+’.
Example: TXTLAN2 = "4+16+#73154+50".
The maximum number of text elements is 50.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

TXTLAN3 TEXT DATA OF THIRD LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the components of an


announcement text for the third official language:
- Numbers of the elements (words or phrases) on OCANEQ
- Digit strings (e.g. telephone numbers) which are
converted to their corresponding text element numbers
automatically. They start with ’#’.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANTXT- 1+
CR ANTXT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

These components are connected by ’+’.


Example: TXTLAN3 = "4+16+#73154+50".
The maximum number of text elements is 50.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

TXTLAN4 TEXT DATA OF FOURTH LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the components of an


announcement text for the fourth official language:
- Numbers of the elements (words or phrases) on OCANEQ
- Digit strings (e.g. telephone numbers) which are
converted to their corresponding text element numbers
automatically. They start with ’#’.
These components are connected by ’+’.
Example: TXTLAN4 = "4+16+#73154+50".
The maximum number of text elements is 50.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

SIT SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE

This parameter determines whether the announcement text in every


language has to start with the special information tone or not.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE


N NO SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE
YES YES SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE
Y YES SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE

Default: NO

NUMCYC NUMBER OF ANNOUNCEMENT CYCLES

This parameter specifies the number of announcement cycles for an


individual announcement.

Notes:
NUMCYC = 0 results in announcement running until the listener hangs up.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...127, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ANTXT- 2-
DISP ANTXT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ANNOUNCEMENT TEXT

This command displays the definitions of announcement texts of OCANEQ


(Operationally Controlled Equipment of Announcement).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ANTXT : [TXTNO=] [,LANGUAGE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TXTNO TEXT NUMBER

This parameter specifies those numbers of the announcement texts


that shall be displayed.

Up to 10 parameter values can be linked by ’&’.

Default: All announcement texts

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

LANGUAGE LANGUAGE OF ANNOUCEMENT TEXT

This parameter specifies one of up to four official languages


for the annoucement texts.

Default: The announcement texts are displayed for all the


languages for which they are defined.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN1 FIRST OFFICIAL LANGUAGE


LAN2 SECOND OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN3 THIRD OFFICIAL LANGUAGE
LAN4 FOURTH OFFICIAL LANGUAGE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ANTXT- 1-


MOD ANTXT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY ANNOUNCEMENT TEXT

This command modifies a definition of an announcement text (in up


to four languages) by combining numbers of text parts that are
available on OCANEQ (Operationally Controlled Equipment for
Announcement).
Modifications of the number of announcement cycles and the use of
the special information tone are valid for all languages.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ANTXT : TXTNO= <,TXTLAN1= ,TXTLAN2= ,TXTLAN3= ,TXTLAN4= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,SIT= ,NUMCYC=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TXTNO TEXT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the number of the selected announcement


text.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

TXTLAN1 TEXT DATA OF FIRST LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the components of an


announcement text for the first official language:
- Numbers of the elements (words or phrases) on OCANEQ
- Digit strings (e.g. telephone numbers) which are
converted to their corresponding text element numbers
automatically. They start with ’#’.
These components are connected by ’+’.
Example: TXTLAN1 = "4+16+#73154+50".
The maximum number of text elements is 50.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

TXTLAN2 TEXT DATA OF SECOND LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the components of an


announcement text for the second official language:
- Numbers of the elements (words or phrases) on OCANEQ
- Digit strings (e.g. telephone numbers) which are
converted to their corresponding text element numbers
automatically. They start with ’#’.
These components are connected by ’+’.
Example: TXTLAN2 = "4+16+#73154+50".
The maximum number of text elements is 50.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

TXTLAN3 TEXT DATA OF THIRD LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the components of an


announcement text for the third official language:
- Numbers of the elements (words or phrases) on OCANEQ
- Digit strings (e.g. telephone numbers) which are

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ANTXT- 1+


MOD ANTXT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

converted to their corresponding text element numbers


automatically. They start with ’#’.
These components are connected by ’+’.
Example: TXTLAN3 = "4+16+#73154+50".
The maximum number of text elements is 50.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

TXTLAN4 TEXT DATA OF FOURTH LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the components of an


announcement text for the fourth official language:
- Numbers of the elements (words or phrases) on OCANEQ
- Digit strings (e.g. telephone numbers) which are
converted to their corresponding text element numbers
automatically. They start with ’#’.
These components are connected by ’+’.
Example: TXTLAN4 = "4+16+#73154+50".
The maximum number of text elements is 50.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

SIT SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE

This parameter determines whether the announcement text in every


language has to start with the special information tone or not.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE


N NO SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE
YES YES SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE
Y YES SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE

NUMCYC NUMBER OF ANNOUNCEMENT CYCLES

This parameter specifies the number of announcement cycles for an


individual announcement.

Notes:
NUMCYC = 0 results in announcement running until the listener hangs up.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...127, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ANTXT- 2-


CAN APPL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL APPLICATION

This command cancels all information concerning the specified application.


Notes:
- NEATT data network:
When this command is entered, the server concerned is sent a message
informing it of the modification to the database (providing that it is
registered). If the server acknowledges this modification negatively,
the command will not be executed.
- OSI data network:
If this command is entered for remote applications, the local application
concerned (providing it is registered) is sent a message informing
it of the modification to the database. If the local application
acknowledges this modification negatively, the command will not be
executed.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN APPL : APPLID= ,PRONAM= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

APPLID APPLICATION IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the identification of the application in


an OSS
OMTA
OMTS
ANSI
SSP
and CPE
processor type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRONAM PROCESSOR NAME

This parameter specifies the symbolic processor name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN APPL- 1-


CR APPL
CRNEAAPL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE APPLICATION

This command is used to create applications in processors.


- NEATT data network:
When this command is entered, a message is sent to the server concerned,
informing it of the database modification (providing the server is
registered). If the server acknowledges this modification negatively,
the command will not be executed.
- OSI and IP data network:
If this command is entered for remote applications, a message is sent to
the local application concerned, informing it of the database modification
(providing the local application is registered). If the local application
acknowledges this modification negatively, the command will not be
executed.
The servers are the local partners from remote applications in the NEATT
data network. They only report in a special table of the databases.The
difference between servers and local applications is that local applications
must be additionally created via command CR APPL. Local applications
are only used in data networks with OSI or IP addressing.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR APPL - CRNEAAPL CREATE NEA APPLICATIONS


2. CR APPL - CROSIAPL CREATE OSI APPLICATIONS

1. Input format

CREATE NEA APPLICATIONS

Input format for NEA applications.


When this command is entered, a message is sent to the server concerned,
informing it of the database modification (providing the server is
registered). If the server acknowledges this modification negatively,
the command will not be executed.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR APPL : APPLID= ,PRONAM= ,ADRNAM= [,SSID=] [,PSID=] 1
1 1
1 [,SERVID=] [,AUT=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

APPLID APPLICATION IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the application


in an OSS
OMTA
OMTS
ANSI
SSP
and CPE
processor type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRONAM PROCESSOR NAME

This parameter specifies the symbolic processor name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

ADRNAM ADDRESS NAME

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR APPL- 1+
CR APPL
CRNEAAPL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Notes:
- The first three characters of the name must be ’NEA’ or ’OSI’
or ’IPA’.
- Any characters can be chosen for the rest of the name.
- In the OSI data network a maximum of sixteen addresses can be
specified.
- If the entered address is an IP-address only one address is
allowed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSID SESSION SERVICE IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the name of the session layer for


file transfer jobs (layer 5 in the ISO reference model).

Notes:
- Default: "FJAM" (only valid for PROTYP=
SSP
DCPSR
DCPDR
PDCPSR
PDCPDR
DCPXSR
DCPXDR
BS2
MVS
OMTD
OMTX
for all NEAB applications).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

PSID PRESENTATION PROCESSOR ID

This parameter specifies the name of the presentation layer for


file transfer jobs (layer 6 in the ISO reference model).

Notes:
- Default: "NDMS" (only valid for PROTYP=
SSP
DCPSR
DCPDR
PDCPSR
PDCPDR
DCPXSR
DCPXDR
BS2
MVS
OMTD
OMTX
for all NEAB applications).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

SERVID SERVER IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the name of the server responsible for


the applications which have been entered.

Notes:
- Only those servers already registered in the CLS database can
be assigned to the applications ( not to be used with
OSI-addresses).
- The parameter SERVID specifies the service identification
associated with the application. The local application is to
be taken from the software module specific documentation.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR APPL- 2+
CR APPL
CRNEAAPL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

AUT AUTHORIZATION

This parameter specifies the authorization name for an external


application.

Prerequisites:
- The authorization name must previously be created using the
command ENTR AUT.

Notes:
- The authorization must be specified for dialog applications.
- This parameter can be entered only for remote applications.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

Default: 0

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR APPL- 3+
CR APPL
CROSIAPL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

CREATE OSI APPLICATIONS

Input format for OSI applications.


If the command is entered for remote applications, a message is sent to
the local application concerned, informing it of the database modification
(providing the local application is registered). If the local application
acknowledges this modification negatively, the command will not be
executed.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR APPL : APPLID= ,PRONAM= ,ADRNAM= [,LOCAPL=] [,PORTNR=] 1
1 1
1 [,SPROCESS=] [,AUT=] [,TSEL=] [,SSEL=] [,PSEL=] 1
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,AET=11 1
1 [,MUX=] 1Z,APQ=Y1 [,AEQ=] [,APPLC=] ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

APPLID APPLICATION IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the application


in an OSS
OMTA
OMTS
ANSI
SSP
and CPE
processor type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRONAM PROCESSOR NAME

This parameter specifies the symbolic processor name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

ADRNAM ADDRESS NAME

Notes:
- The first three characters of the name must be ’NEA’ or ’OSI’
or ’IPA’.
- Any characters can be chosen for the rest of the name.
- In the OSI data network a maximum of sixteen addresses can be
specified.
- If the entered address is an IP-address only one address is
allowed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LOCAPL LOCAL APPLICATION

This parameter specifies the name of the corresponding


local application.

Notes:
- This parameter can be entered only for remote

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR APPL- 4+
CR APPL
CROSIAPL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

applications connected via TCP/IP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PORTNR PORTNUMBER

This parameter specifies application specific portnumbers.

Notes:
- The parameter can be entered only for remote applications
connected via TCP/IP.
- If the parameter is not entered the default value 102 will
be administrated.
- The value of the portnumber can be an integer value from
0 to 32767.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...32767, range of decimal numbers

Default: 102

SPROCESS SERVER PROCESS

This parameter specifies the name of the server process


which supports the entered application.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

AUT AUTHORIZATION

This parameter specifies the authorization name for an external


application.

Prerequisites:
- The authorization name must previously be created using the
command ENTR AUT.

Notes:
- The authorization must be specified for dialog applications.
- This parameter can be entered only for remote applications.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

Default: 0

TSEL TRANSPORT SELECTOR

This parameter specifies the Transport Layer Entity.


In case of OSI applications that do not allow the use of selectors
this parameter can not be entered.

Notes:
-Only hexadecimal values (numbers from 0 to 9 and characters
from A to F) are allowed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...64 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSEL SESSION SELECTOR

This parameter specifies the Session Layer Entity.


In case of OSI applications that do not allow the use of selectors
this parameter can not be entered.

Notes:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR APPL- 5+
CR APPL
CROSIAPL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

-Only hexadecimal values (numbers from 0 to 9 and characters


from A to F) are allowed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PSEL PRESENTATION SELECTOR

This parameter specifies the Presentation Layer Entity.


In case of OSI applications that do not allow the use of selectors
this parameter can not be entered.

Notes:
-Only hexadecimal values (numbers from 0 to 9 and characters
from A to F) are allowed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

MUX MULTIPLEX SIGN

This parameter specifies if a remote application can be multiplexed


or not.
If this parameter is not entered the value is set to NO. This means
that the application cannot be multiplexed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y MULTIPLEX ALLOWED
YES MULTIPLEX ALLOWED

AET APPLICATION ENTITY TITLE

This parameter is an additional identification of the


application.
A maximum of 16 parameter values can be linked with &.

Notes:
- For the first component only the values 0, 1 and
2 are allowed.
- For the second component only a value from 0 to
39 is allowed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

APQ APPLICATION PROCESS QUALIFIER

The application process qualifier is a part of the


application entity title and specifies the application
on a specific processor.

Notes:
-The parameter APQ can only be entered for applications
with a server process on a processor with system title.
-The maximum length of APQ is 14 components.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

AEQ APPLICATION ENTITY QUALIFIER

This parameter is a part of the application entity title.

Notes:
-This parameter can only be entered if the parameter
APQ has been entered, too.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR APPL- 6+
CR APPL
CROSIAPL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

0...2147483646, range of decimal numbers

APPLC APPLICATION CONTEXT

This parameter specifies the application context.


A maximum of 16 parameter values can be linked with &.

Notes:
- The parameter can only be entered for local Q3-application.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR APPL- 7-
DISP APPL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY APPLICATION

This command displays information about:


- one application in a processor, or
- all applications in a processor, or
- all known applications.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP APPL : APPLID= [,PRONAM=] [,ALL=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

APPLID APPLICATION IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the identification of the application in all


processors.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRONAM PROCESSOR NAME

This parameter specifies the symbolic processor name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

ALL ALL INFORMATION

This parameter specifies if only short information (NO)


or all information (YES) about the application will be
displayed.
If the parameter is not entered, the short information
will be displayed.
YES can only be entered for a specified application.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y DISPLAY ALL INFORMATION


YES DISPLAY ALL INFORMATION
N DISPLAY SHORT INFORMATION
NO DISPLAY SHORT INFORMATION

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP APPL- 1-


MOD APPL
MDNEAAPL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY APPLICATION

This command modifies information concerning applications which have


been entered.
- NEATT data network:
If no default application is present, a message is sent to the
server concerned, informing it of the database modification
(providing the server is registered). If the server acknowledges
this modification negatively, the command will not be executed.
- OSI and IP data network:
If this command is entered for remote applications, a message
is sent to the local application concerned, informing it of the
database modification (providing the local application is
registered). If the local application acknowledges this modification
negatively, the command will not be executed.
- The authorization (parameter AUT) can also be modified in the
case of default applications.
- The names of the message and data description levels (parameters
SSID and PSID) can also be modified in the case of default
applications.
- In case of default applications, the address name cannot be
modified by the MOD APPL command. The MOD PRO command has to be
used.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD APPL - MDNEAAPL MODIFY NEA APPLICATIONS


2. MOD APPL - MDOSIAPL MODIFY OSI APPLICATIONS

1. Input format

MODIFY NEA APPLICATIONS

Input format for NEA applications.


If no default application is present, a message is sent to the
server concerned, informing it of the database modification
(providing the server is registered). If the server acknowledges
this modification negatively, the command will not be executed.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD APPL : APPLID= ,PRONAM= [,ADRNAM=] [,AUT=] [,SSID=] 1
1 1
1 [,PSID=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

APPLID APPLICATION IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the application


in an OSS
OMTA
OMTS
ANSI
SSP
and CPE
processor type.

n
n/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD APPL- 1+


MOD APPL
MDNEAAPL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PRONAM PROCESSOR NAME

This parameter specifies the symbolic processor name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

ADRNAM ADDRESS NAME

Notes:
- The first three characters of the name must be ’NEA’ or ’OSI’
or ’IPA’.
Any characters can be chosen for the rest of the name.
- Only in OSI data network can a maximum of sixteen addresses be
specified.
- If the entered address is an IP-address only one address is
allowed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

AUT AUTHORIZATION

This parameter specifies the authorization name for an external


application.

Prerequisites:
- The authorization name must be created previously.

Notes:
- This parameter can be entered only for remote applications.

n/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSID SESSION SERVICE IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the name of the session layer for


file transfer jobs (layer 5 in the ISO reference model).

Notes:
- Default: "FJAM" (only valid for PROTYP=
SSP
DCPSR
DCPDR
PDCPSR
PDCPDR
DCPXSR
DCPXDR
BS2
MVS
OMTD
OMTX
for all NEAB applications).

n/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

1...8 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

PSID PRESENTATION PROCESSOR ID

This parameter specifies the name of the presentation layer for


file transfer jobs (layer 6 in the ISO reference model).

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD APPL- 2+


MOD APPL
MDNEAAPL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Notes:
- Default: "NDMS" (only valid for PROTYP=
SSP
DCPSR
DCPDR
PDCPSR
PDCPDR
DCPXSR
DCPXDR
BS2
MVS
OMTD
OMTX
for all NEAB applications).

n/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

1...8 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD APPL- 3+


MOD APPL
MDOSIAPL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

MODIFY OSI APPLICATIONS

Input format for OSI applications.


If the command is entered for remote applications, a message is
sent to the local application concerned, informing it of the
database modification (providing the local application is
registered). If the application acknowledges this modification
negatively, the command will not be executed.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD APPL : APPLID= ,PRONAM= [,ADRNAM=] [,AUT=] [,OTSEL=] 1
1 1
1 [,OSSEL=] [,OPSEL=] [,NTSEL=] [,NSSEL=] [,NPSEL=] 1
1 1
1 [,MUX=] [,OAET=] [,NAET=] [,OAPQ=] [,NAPQ=] 1
1 1
1 [,OAEQ=] [,NAEQ=] [,OAPPLC=] [,NAPPLC=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

APPLID APPLICATION IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the application


in an OSS
OMTA
OMTS
ANSI
SSP
and CPE
processor type.

n
n/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRONAM PROCESSOR NAME

This parameter specifies the symbolic processor name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

ADRNAM ADDRESS NAME

Notes:
- The first three characters of the name must be ’NEA’ or ’OSI’
or ’IPA’.
Any characters can be chosen for the rest of the name.
- Only in OSI data network can a maximum of sixteen addresses be
specified.
- If the entered address is an IP-address only one address is
allowed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

AUT AUTHORIZATION

This parameter specifies the authorization name for an external


application.

Prerequisites:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD APPL- 4+


MOD APPL
MDOSIAPL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- The authorization name must be created previously.

Notes:
- This parameter can be entered only for remote applications.

n/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OTSEL OLD TRANSPORT SELECTOR

This parameter specifies the old value assigned to the Transport


Layer Entity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...64 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OSSEL OLD SESSION SELECTOR

This parameter specifies the old value assigned to the Session Layer
Entity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OPSEL OLD PRESENTATION SELECTOR

This parameter specifies the old value assigned to the Presentation


Layer Entity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NTSEL NEW TRANSPORT SELECTOR

This value specifies the new value of the Transport Layer Entity.
If Transport Layer Entity already has an old value the user must
enter the OTSEL parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...64 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NSSEL NEW SESSION SELECTOR

This parameter specifies the new value of the Session Layer Entity.
If Session Layer Entity already has an old value, the user must
enter the OSSEL parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NPSEL NEW PRESENTATION SELECTOR

This parameter specifies the new value of the Presentation Layer


Entity.
If the Presentation Layer Entity already has an old value the user
must enter the OPSEL parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD APPL- 5+


MOD APPL
MDOSIAPL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MUX MULTIPLEX SIGN

This parameter specifies if a remote application can be multiplexed


or not.
If this parameter is not entered the value is set to NO. This means
that the application cannot be multiplexed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y MULTIPLEX ALLOWED
YES MULTIPLEX ALLOWED

OAET OLD APPLICATION ENTITY TITLE

This parameter is an additional identification of the


application. It specifies the old value of the identification.
A maximum of 16 parameter values can be linked with &.

Notes:
- For the first component only the values 0, 1 and
2 are allowed.
- For the second component only a value from 0 to
39 is allowed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

NAET NEW APPLICATION ENTITY TITLE

This parameter is an additional identification of the


application. It specifies the new value of the application
entity title.
A maximum of 16 parameter values can be linked with &.

Notes:
- For the first component only the values 0, 1 and
2 are allowed.
- For the second component only a value from 0 to
39 is allowed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

OAPQ OLD APPL. PROCESS QUALIFIER

This parameter specifies the old value of the application


process qualifier.
A maximum of 14 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

NAPQ NEW APPL. PROCESS QUALIFIER

This parameter specifies the new value for the


application process qualifier.
A maximum of 14 parameter values can be linked with &

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

OAEQ OLD APPL. ENTITY QUALIFIER

This parameter specifies the old value for the


application entity qualifier.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483646, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD APPL- 6+


MOD APPL
MDOSIAPL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NAEQ NEW APPL. ENTITY QUALIFIER

This parameter specifies the new value for the


application entity qualifier.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483646, range of decimal numbers

OAPPLC OLD APPLICATION CONTEXT

This parameter specifies the old application context.


A maximum of 16 parameter values can be linked with &.

Notes:
- The parameter can only be entered for a local Q3-application.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

NAPPLC NEW APPLICATION CONTEXT

This parameter specifies the new application context.


A maximum of 16 parameter values can be linked with &.

Notes:
- The parameter can only be entered for a local Q3-application.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD APPL- 7-


ENTR APSNAME

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER APS NAME

This command enters the name and version number of an APS.


The name and version number of an APS appear in the 1st header line
of every output.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR APSNAME : NAME= [,VN=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the name segment in the APS version.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

VN VERSION NUMBER

This parameter specifies the version number of an APS.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR APSNAME- 1-


INCR APSVN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

INCREMENT APS VERSION NUMBER

This command increments the APS version number by 1.


The version number appears in the 1st header line of every output.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 INCR APSVN ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 INCR APSVN- 1-


MOD ARCHIVE
COMPRESS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY ARCHIVE FILE

This command comprises two functions:


- Compress one or more files and combine these files to an
archive file.
- Extract all files from an existing archive.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD ARCHIVE - COMPRESS ENTRY FOR COMPRESSING FILES


2. MOD ARCHIVE - EXTRACT ENTRY FOR EXTRACTING FILES

1. Input format

ENTRY FOR COMPRESSING FILES

This command compresses the files listed in FILE and stores


them in the ARCHIVE file.

Prerequisite:
The archive file must not exist.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ARCHIVE : OPTION= ,ARCHIVE= ,FILE= [,GEN=] [,SSWF=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OPTION COMPRESSING OPTION

This parameter specifies which function of the command


has to be performed.

Note:
Valid values are:
- COMPRESS
- EXTRACT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

COMPRESS COMPRESS FILE

ARCHIVE ARCHIVE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the archive file.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FILE FILE LIST

This parameter specifies a list of up to 10 file names


that will be compressed and combined to the archive
file.
Each file name can specify either a fully qualified
file name or a partly qualified file name with a dot
at the end of the file name.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GEN GENERATION NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the generation the files


belong to.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ARCHIVE- 1+


MOD ARCHIVE
COMPRESS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Default:
Files of actual generation and non-generation files.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSWF SUPPORT SOFTWARE FORMAT

This parameter specifies if an SSWF header will be


added to each of the specified files when a new
archive file is created or if an SSWF header exists
for the files in an archive.

Default:
- a

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO SSWF HEADER TREATMENT


YES INCLUDE SSWF HEADER

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ARCHIVE- 2+


MOD ARCHIVE
EXTRACT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

ENTRY FOR EXTRACTING FILES

This command extracts all files stored in the specified archive.


The extracted files are not added to a generation.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ARCHIVE : OPTION= ,ARCHIVE= [,SSWF=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OPTION COMPRESSING OPTION

This parameter specifies which function of the command


has to be performed.

Note:
Valid values are:
- COMPRESS
- EXTRACT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

EXTRACT EXTRACT FILE

ARCHIVE ARCHIVE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the archive file.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSWF SUPPORT SOFTWARE FORMAT

This parameter specifies if an SSWF header will be


added to each of the specified files when a new
archive file is created or if an SSWF header exists
for the files in an archive.

Default:
- a

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO SSWF HEADER TREATMENT


YES INCLUDE SSWF HEADER

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ARCHIVE- 3-


CAN AREACODE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL LOCAL AREA CODE

This command cancels the local area code (as well as existing
blocks in the digit destination translator)
or the local area code originating from the local area code table.

Prerequisites:
- No linkages from the entered local area code to directory numbers,
code points, bothway trunk groups or test equipments exist.
- No linkages from the entered local area code originating to digit zone
translators, bothway trunk groups or iarstat data exist.
Attention:
- Before canceling the local area code:
- verify that no traffic measurement to the old local area code is
running since traffic measurements may be performed for code belonging
to this local area code,
- verify that no traffic type code point beginning with the same digit
string like the old local area code still exists.
- If a DLU is entered, only the linkage between the local area code and
the DLU will be canceled, not the local area code itself.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1LAC= 1 (;) 1
1 CAN AREACODE : ZLACOR=Y [,DLU=] Z Y 1
1 1 1 *!+ 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.


It consists of the national prefix code
and the local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

LACOR LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING

This parameter specifies the local area code originating.


It usually consists of the national prefix code and the
local area code originating.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the external DLU number.

Notes:
- Up to 32 DLUs can be linked.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

10...2550, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN AREACODE- 1-


DISP AREACODE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY LOCAL AREA CODE DATA

This command displays the local area code(s) with their appropriate DLUs
and the LACEXT value.
Furthermore it displays the local area codes originating.
It is possible to define one, several or all local area codes for display.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP AREACODE : <LAC= ,LACOR=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.


It usually consists of the national prefix code and the
local area code.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 digit decimal number

LACOR LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING

This parameter specifies the local area code originating.


It usually consists of the national prefix code and the
local area code originating.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 digit decimal number

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP AREACODE- 1-


ENTR AREACODE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER LOCAL AREA CODE

This command creates a local area code or a local area code originating,
i.e. an entry in the table of local area codes.
DLUs and LACEXT can be assigned to the local area code with the
same command.
(Depending on the number of digits entered and EVLAC was preset
or the DNVOL is multiple (see MML command ENTR DNATT),
the blocks are seized in the digit-destination translator and
linked together.)
The entire digit combination of the local area code (i.e. with national
prefix code) and the area code table are transmitted to the
GP (group processor).
The entire digit combination of the local area code originating are
transmitted to the GP (group processor), too.

Prerequisites:
- Before a local area code will be created, the directory number attribute
must be entered (see MML command ENTR DNATT).
- The local area code to be created may be a part of another shorter local
area code.
- The local area code to be created may not be part of another digit chain.
- The number of digits in the local area code must be greater or equal as
the national prefix code length.
- The specified DLU must have been created before.
It isn’t possible to assign a DLU to a local area code if this DLU
was assigned to another local area code before.
- The local area code originating to be created may not be part of another
local area code or local area code originating.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1LAC= 1 (;) 1
1 ENTR AREACODE : ZLACOR=Y [,DLU=] [,LACEXT=] Z Y 1
1 1 1 *!+ 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.


It usually consists of the national prefix code and the
local area code.

Notes:
- Up to 50 local area codes can be set up in an exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

LACOR LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING

This parameter specifies the local area code originating.


It usually consists of the national prefix code and the
local area code originating.

Notes:
- Up to 48 local area codes originating can be set up in an exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the external DLU number.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR AREACODE- 1+


ENTR AREACODE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Notes:
- Up to 32 DLUs can be linked.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

LACEXT EXTENTION OF LAC FOR ACC.REC.

This parameter specifies the completion digit for a 3-digit area code
or a changed 3-digit area code for building the area code part in the
account record.
The local area code in the account record has no national prefix
code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO COMPLETION DIGIT
NO NO COMPLETION DIGIT
Y COMPLETION DIGIT ’0’ OR ’1’
YES COMPLETION DIGIT ’0’ OR ’1’
’3-digit area code’ will be completed with 1 to
XXX1 and ’changed 3-digit area code’ will be
completed with 0 to XXX0.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR AREACODE- 2-


MOD AREACODE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY LOCAL AREA CODE

This command modifies the local area code whereby the DLU allocation
remains unchanged.
The LACEXT value for the new local area code can be modified also.
Alternatively it is possible to modify the local area code originating.
Before command execution, a check is made to see whether the old local
area code (originating also) exists and whether the new one is available.

Prerequisites:
- The number of digits of the local area code has to be greater or equal
than that of the national prefix code.
Attention:
- Before modifying the local area code to a new local area code:
- verify that no traffic measurement to the old area code is running,
since traffic measurements may be performed for code belonging to the
old local area code,
- verify that no traffic type code point beginning with the same digit
string like the old local area code still exists.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1LAC= 1 (;) 1
1 MOD AREACODE : ZLACOR=Y [,NEWLAC=] [,LACEXT=] [,NLACOR=] Z Y 1
1 1 1 *!+ 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.


It usually consists of the national prefix code
and the local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

LACOR LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING

This parameter specifies the local area code originating.


It usually consists of the national prefix code and the
local area code originating.

Notes:
- Up to 48 local area codes originating can be set up in an exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

NEWLAC NEW LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the new local area code. It has the same
attributes as the old local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

LACEXT EXTENTION OF LAC FOR ACC.REC.

This parameter specifies the completion digit for a 3-digit area code
or a changed 3-digit area code for building the area code part in the
account record.
The local area code in the account record has no national prefix
code.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD AREACODE- 1+


MOD AREACODE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO COMPLETION DIGIT
NO NO COMPLETION DIGIT
Y COMPLETION DIGIT ’0’ OR ’1’
YES COMPLETION DIGIT ’0’ OR ’1’
’3-digit area code’ will be completed with 1 to
XXX1 and ’changed 3-digit area code’ will be
completed with 0 to XXX0.

NLACOR NEW LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATG.

This parameter specifies the new local area code originating.


It has the same attributes as the old local area code originating.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD AREACODE- 2-


CAN ASN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel ATM Switching Network

This task deletes an ]ASN].

Prerequisite:
- The ]ASNs] with number 1 or 2 must not be deleted.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN ASN : ASN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ASN

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ASN].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 3...9.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ASN- 1-


CONF ASN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Configure ATM Switching Network

This task configures an ]ACCG] or an ]ASN].


There is a choice between the states ]Locked], ]Unlocked], ]Reserved] and
]Under repair]. If the input of ]Admin. state] is ]Locked]
then ]Hazard check] can be performed. Performing
the ]Hazard check] means that in case a hazard is
detected, the configuration will not be executed and detected hazards are
displayed in the output table as Hazards. Not performing the
]Hazard check] means that the configuration will
be executed always and detected hazards are displayed in the output table
as Actual effects.
If there is no input for ]ASN], then
the ]ACCG] will be configured, else the given
]ASN] will be configured.

Prerequisite:
- Only the ]ACCG] with number 2 is allowed.

Notes:
- If ]Admin. state] is not ]Locked] the inputparameter
]Hazard check] is not used.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF ASN : Side= ,ACCG= [,ASN=] ,Admin. state= ,Hazard check= 1
1 1
1 [,Load information=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG].


The only allowed value is 2.

ASN

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ASN].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...9.

Admin. state

This parameter is used to select the kind of configuration.

Hazard check

If this parameter is ]Yes], ]Hazard check]


is started at the deactivation of a unit.

Load information

This parameter specifies if the code portion should be loaded by force


or only if necessary.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF ASN- 1-


CR ASN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create ATM Switching Network

This task creates an ]ASN].

Prerequisites:
- One ]ASN] with number 2 exists in the system.
- One ]ASMG] with number 1 exists in the system.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR ASN : ASN= ,Rack= ,Shelf= ,Pitch= ,Alarm profile MP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ASN

This parameter is the number of an ]ASN].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 3...9.

Rack

This parameter is the name of an existing ]Rack].


Allowed values are symbolic names of exactly 8 characters.

Shelf

This parameter is the number of an existing ]Shelf].

Pitch

This parameter is the number of an existing ]Pitch].

Alarm profile MP

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ to the managed


unit to control its alarming behavior.

The ’Alarm Profile MP’ is used to determine the priority of


an alarm, depending on its ’Probable cause’ (see Q3-standards
X.721, M.3100 etc.) and the detected service impact.

Input format:
Selection from:
generally applicable ’Alarm Profile MPs’ available on MP:
- ’ALSUPP’: Alarm suppression
Alarm is negligible and therefore suppressed.
No alarm processing will be performed.
- ’WARNING’: Warning
Alarm constitutes a situation to which attention
is drawn. For all ’Probable cause’ values the
alarm priority ’Warning’ will be used.
- ’MINNOESC’: Minor with no escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MINESC’: Minor with escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’MAJNOESC’: Major with no escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MAJESC’: Major with escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ASN- 1+
CR ASN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

priority will escalate to ’Critical’.


- ’CRITICAL’: Critical
Alarm indicates a critical system condition.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Critical’ will be used.
or a user-defined one:
- ’own name’, Input: 1...8 characters from printable character set
Use task ’DISP ALPROFMP’ to get an overview of the
existing ’Alarm Profile MPs’.

Standard behavior:
If no ’Alarm Profile MP’ is specified in a create task, a reasonable
default value, depending on the managed object class, is selected by
the system.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ASN- 2-
DIAG ASN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Diagnose ATM Switching Network

This task starts diagnoses of an ]ACCG] or an ]ASN].


If there is no input for ]ASN], then the ]ACCG] is diagnosed.

Prerequisite:
- Only the ]ACCG] with number 2 is allowed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG ASN : Side= ,ACCG= [,ASN=] ,Kind of diagnosis= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG].


The only allowed value is 2.

ASN

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ASN].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...9.

Kind of diagnosis

This parameter specifies the kind of diagnosis.


Following values are allowed:

]Self diagnosis]:
Base test for the unit.
It checks the availability and the workability of
the components .
Resets unit and becomes ]Self diagnosis].
No further tests are performed.

]Quick diagnosis]:
Performs a more comprehensive test than ]Self
diagnosis].
It includes all diagnosis tests without long
running
tests.
It must include testing of those hardware parts
which
are tested during normal operation.

]Complete diagnosis]:
This option performs full testing of all the
object functions, including tests which take a
long time
to complete such as memory tests.

]Cable diagnosis]:
This value is only allowed for ]ASN]:
It verifies correct plugging of cables (Yb Ports
only).

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG ASN- 1-


DISP ASN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display ATM Switching Network

This task displays one or all ]ASNs] and ]ACCGs].


Following combinations are allowed:

+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
! INPUT | OUTPUT !
+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
! - | all ]ACCGs] and all ]ASNs] with ]ASNTYPE] are displayed !
!]Side] | one ]ACCG] and one ]ASN] of one ]Side] are displayed !
!]Side], ]ACCG] | one ]ACCG] of one ]Side] is displayed !
!]Side], ]ACCG], ]ASN]| one ]ASN] of one ]Side] is displayed. !
+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------+

Prerequisite:
- Only the ]ACCG] with number 2 is allowed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ASN : [Side=] [,ACCG=] [,ASN=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG].


The only allowed value is 2.

ASN

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ASN].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...9.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ASN- 1-


MOD ASN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify ATM Switching Network

This task changes the value of the ]Alarm profile MP]


of ]ASN] or ]ACCG] of both ]Sides].
If there is no input for ]Side] the
]Alarm profile MP] of ]ACCG]
is changed. Also the ]Board type] of ]ACCG] can be changed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ASN : ACCG= [,Side=] [,ASN Switching Board=] 1
1 1
1 [,ASN Switching Module=] [,Alarm profile MP=] 1
1 1
1 [,Board type=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG].

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

ASN Switching Board

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ASN Switching Board].


If ’Board Type’ is ASMG16-16 or ASMG8-8 ’ASN Switching Board’ must be 1.

ASN Switching Module

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ASN Switching Module].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...9.

Alarm profile MP

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ to the managed


unit to control its alarming behavior.

The ’Alarm Profile MP’ is used to determine the priority of


an alarm, depending on its ’Probable cause’ (see Q3-standards
X.721, M.3100 etc.) and the detected service impact.

Input format:
Selection from:
generally applicable ’Alarm Profile MPs’ available on MP:
- ’ALSUPP’: Alarm suppression
Alarm is negligible and therefore suppressed.
No alarm processing will be performed.
- ’WARNING’: Warning
Alarm constitutes a situation to which attention
is drawn. For all ’Probable cause’ values the
alarm priority ’Warning’ will be used.
- ’MINNOESC’: Minor with no escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MINESC’: Minor with escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’MAJNOESC’: Major with no escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MAJESC’: Major with escalation

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ASN- 1+


MOD ASN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Alarm is of major importance, with escalation.


For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’CRITICAL’: Critical
Alarm indicates a critical system condition.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Critical’ will be used.
or a user-defined one:
- ’own name’, Input: 1...8 characters from printable character set
Use task ’DISP ALPROFMP’ to get an overview of the
existing ’Alarm Profile MPs’.

Standard behavior:
If no ’Alarm Profile MP’ is specified in a create task, a reasonable
default value, depending on the managed object class, is selected by
the system.

Board type

Attribute to specify the board (hardware) of a unit.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ASN- 2-


RECOV ASN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Recover ATM Switching Network

This task is used to recover an ]ASN].


Allowed parameters for recovery of ]ASN] are:

+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
! ]Scope] ]Depth] ]Measures] !
+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
!LOADREC2 ]Platform] ]Cold start] ]Loading of code and data] !
+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 RECOV ASN : Side= ,ACCG= ,Scope= ,Depth= ,Measures= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG].


The only allowed value is 2.
This is the ]ACCG] of the ]ASN].

Scope

This parameter specifies that only the addressed ]Platform] is recovered.

Depth

This parameter specifies that the recovery shall be a ]Cold start]


recovery.

Measures

This parameter specifies that code and data are reloaded.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RECOV ASN- 1-


STAT ASN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Status of ATM Switching Network

This task displays the state of ]ASN] and ]ACCG].

+-----------------------------------------------------------------------------+
! INPUT | OUTPUT !
+-----------------------------------------------------------------------------+
! - | states of all ]ACCGs] and of all ]ASNs] are displayed !
!]Side] | states of one ]ACCG] and of one ]ASN] of one ]Side] !
! | are displayed !
!]Side], ]ACCG] | state of one ]ACCG] of one ]Side] is displayed !
!]Side], ]ACCG], ]ASN]| state of one ]ASN] of one ]Side] is displayed !
+-----------------------------------------------------------------------------+

Prerequisite:
- Only the ]ACCG] with number 2 is allowed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT ASN : [Side=] [,ACCG=] [,ASN=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG].


The only allowed value is 2.

ASN

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ASN].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...9.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT ASN- 1-


DISP ASNPORT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display ATM Switching Network Port

This task displays the ASN ports of one ]ASN].

Prerequisite:
- Only the ]ACCG] with number 2 is allowed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ASNPORT : Side= ,ACCG= ,ASN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG].


The only allowed value is 2.

ASN

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ASN].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...9.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ASNPORT- 1-


CAN ATMB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel ATM Bridge

This task deletes an ]ATMB].


Prerequisite:
- It is not allowed to delete the ]ATMBs] with number 1, 2 or 3.
- Only the ]ATMB] with the highest ID can be deleted.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN ATMB : ATMB= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ATMB

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ATMB].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 4...11.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ATMB- 1-


CONF ATMB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Configure ATM Bridge

This task configures an ]ATMB].


There is a choice between the ]Admin. state] ]Locked], ]Unlocked]
and ]Reserved].
If the input of ]Admin. state] is ]Locked], then ]Hazard check] can
be performed. Performing the ]Hazard check] means, that in case a hazard
is detected, the configuration will not be executed and detected hazards are
displayed in the output table as Hazards. Not performing the ]Hazard check]
means, that the configuration will be executed always and detected hazards are
displayed in the output table as Actual effects.
If there is an input for the parameter ]Side], then only one
side (0 or 1) will be configured.
For one side it is not allowed to use the ]Admin. state] ]Reserved].
Notes:
If ]Admin. state] is not ]Locked], the input parameter ]Hazard check]
is not used.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF ATMB : ATMB= [,Side=] ,Admin. state= ,Hazard check= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ATMB

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ATMB].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...11.

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

Admin. state

This parameter is used to select the kind of configuration.

Hazard check

If this parameter is ]Yes], ]Hazard check]


is started at the deactivation of a unit.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF ATMB- 1-


CR ATMB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create ATM Bridge

This task creates the ]ATMB].


Only ]ATMBs] of ]ATMB type] Message Buffer (]ATMBM]) are created.

Prerequisite:
- An ]AMX] must exist.
- The ]AMX] is connected with less than two ]ATMBs].
- The ]ATMBs] with the numbers 1, 2 and 3 already exist in the system.
- There must not be any gaps in the ]ATMB] values.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR ATMB : ATMB= ,ACCG= ,Alarm profile MP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ATMB

This parameter is the number of an ]ATMB].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 4...11.

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ACCG] of an ]AMX].


The values 1 or 2 are not allowed.

Alarm profile MP

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ to the managed


unit to control its alarming behavior.

The ’Alarm Profile MP’ is used to determine the priority of


an alarm, depending on its ’Probable cause’ (see Q3-standards
X.721, M.3100 etc.) and the detected service impact.

Input format:
Selection from:
generally applicable ’Alarm Profile MPs’ available on MP:
- ’ALSUPP’: Alarm suppression
Alarm is negligible and therefore suppressed.
No alarm processing will be performed.
- ’WARNING’: Warning
Alarm constitutes a situation to which attention
is drawn. For all ’Probable cause’ values the
alarm priority ’Warning’ will be used.
- ’MINNOESC’: Minor with no escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MINESC’: Minor with escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’MAJNOESC’: Major with no escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MAJESC’: Major with escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’CRITICAL’: Critical
Alarm indicates a critical system condition.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Critical’ will be used.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ATMB- 1+
CR ATMB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

or a user-defined one:
- ’own name’, Input: 1...8 characters from printable character set
Use task ’DISP ALPROFMP’ to get an overview of the
existing ’Alarm Profile MPs’.

Standard behavior:
If no ’Alarm Profile MP’ is specified in a create task, a reasonable
default value, depending on the managed object class, is selected by
the system.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ATMB- 2-
DISP ATMB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display ATM Bridge

This task displays an ]ATMB].


Following combinations are allowed:

+---------------------------------------------------------+
! INPUT | OUTPUT !
+---------------------------------------------------------+
! - | each ]Side] of all ]ATMBs] is displayed !
! ]ATMB] | each ]Side] of one ]ATMB] is displayed !
!]ATMB], ]Side] | one ]Side] of one ]ATMB] is displayed !
+---------------------------------------------------------+

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ATMB : [ATMB=] [,Side=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ATMB

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ATMB].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...11.

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ATMB- 1-


MOD ATMB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify ATM Bridge

This task changes the value of the ]Alarm profile MP] of both sides
of the ]ATMB].

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ATMB : ATMB= ,Alarm profile MP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ATMB

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ATMB].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...11.

Alarm profile MP

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ to the managed


unit to control its alarming behavior.

The ’Alarm Profile MP’ is used to determine the priority of


an alarm, depending on its ’Probable cause’ (see Q3-standards
X.721, M.3100 etc.) and the detected service impact.

Input format:
Selection from:
generally applicable ’Alarm Profile MPs’ available on MP:
- ’ALSUPP’: Alarm suppression
Alarm is negligible and therefore suppressed.
No alarm processing will be performed.
- ’WARNING’: Warning
Alarm constitutes a situation to which attention
is drawn. For all ’Probable cause’ values the
alarm priority ’Warning’ will be used.
- ’MINNOESC’: Minor with no escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MINESC’: Minor with escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’MAJNOESC’: Major with no escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MAJESC’: Major with escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’CRITICAL’: Critical
Alarm indicates a critical system condition.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Critical’ will be used.
or a user-defined one:
- ’own name’, Input: 1...8 characters from printable character set
Use task ’DISP ALPROFMP’ to get an overview of the
existing ’Alarm Profile MPs’.

Standard behavior:
If no ’Alarm Profile MP’ is specified in a create task, a reasonable
default value, depending on the managed object class, is selected by
the system.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ATMB- 1+


MOD ATMB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ATMB- 2-


STAT ATMB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Status of ATM Bridge

This task displays the state of ]ATMB].


Following combinations are allowed:

+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
! INPUT | OUTPUT !
+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
! - | states of all ]ATMBs] and of each side of all ]ATMBs] are !
! | displayed !
! ]ATMB] | states of one ]ATMB] and of each side of one ]ATMBs] are !
! | displayed !
!]ATMB], ]Side] | state of one ]Side] of one ]ATMB] is displayed !
+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT ATMB : [ATMB=] [,Side=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ATMB

This parameter is the number of an existing ]ATMB].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...11.

Side

This parameter is the number of one side. Allowed values are 0 or 1.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT ATMB- 1-


ALLOW AUDIT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ALLOW AUDIT

This command allows an audit to be started that was previously inhibited by


the command INHIB AUDIT.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ALLOW AUDIT : NAME= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the audit. The names of all audits known to
the system can be called up with the command DISP AUDIT.
The names of the common audits are:
ABILREG Billing Register Audit
The idle band linkage of all free billing
registers or the billing register to
channel register linkage of all active
billing registers is tested.
CHANREG Channel Register Audit
The 127 channel registers are checked for each LTG:
- call status
. highest value
. validity
- call status in the channel register as compared
with associated channel register data
- call status in the channel register as compared
with the status of the port involved in this
connection (channel).
Exception: DSB ports (OSS).
- Busy status of the relevant channel in the
GS table in the CP (module PASDA)
- Specific channel register contents (CTE_ACTIVE,
PATH_DATA)
- Announcement table contents for a busy
announcement line and speech channel as compared
with the channel register contents on the A-side.
- specific channel register contents (OCCUPIED_BY
ISDN, CALL_DIVERSION_FOR_ISDN_PBX, OCCUPIED_BY
B_SIDE, IARSTAT_ACTIVE)
To clear a channel register inconsistency, the
interprocessor message MSG_ABORT_CHANNEL is sent to
the Call Processing Process.
CHKSUMVA Interprocessor checksums audit.
The CALL PROCESSING checksum and the LTG checksum
are compared. Errors are corrected.
CPBUFFER Call Processing Buffer Audit
The idle band linkage of all free call processing
buffers is checked, or the call processing buffer
to channel register linkage of all active call
processing buffers.
EQSTA Equipment Status Audit
A check is made to determine whether the
transient operating states of the peripheral
units are valid and whether the transient
and semipermanent operating states are identical.
In the case of DE5 the SW operating states
are compared with the HW operating states.
IPCHASTA Interprocessor Channel Register Audit
The speech channel states in the GP and CP
are checked for consistency, i.e. the channel
states in the GP should be identical with
those in the CP.
IPTRUSTA Interprocessor Trunk Status Audit
The transient states of ports in the CP
are checked for consistency:
- port states are compared
- port states in the GP are compared with port
states in the CP.
The GP supplies blocking states and busy states

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ALLOW AUDIT- 1+


ALLOW AUDIT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

to the IPTRUSTA as "summation bits".


To clear a port inconsistency the interprocessor
message MSG_ABORT_LINE is sent to the call processing
process.
IDLLSTAU Idle List Audit
The idle band linkage of trunk groups,
announcement groups and PBX groups is checked.
NWCONF Switching network configuration audit.
The TSG and SSG data are checked for consistency
with the relevant administration and safeguarding
data. Errors are corrected.
NWMAP Switching Network Map Audit.
The consistency between path data and switching
network busy states is checked. Errors are
corrected.
IPPRTSTA Interprocessor Port Status Audit
The transient port states of DLU-Ports and
V5IF-Ports are checked:
- CP port states are compared
- GP port states are compared with CP port states
The GP supplies blocking states and busy states
to the IPPRTSTA as "summation bits".
To clear a port inconsistency, the inter-
processor message MSG_ABORT_LINE is sent to
the call processing process.
CCS7AU Common Channel Signaling No.7 Audit
The port states of TUP and ISUP trunks lines
are checked:
Blocks which have been set or cancelled
(NAC_SYNCHRO and NUC_SEIZED), are compared
with DPC blocking.
To clear a port inconsistency, the inter-
processor message MSG_ABORT_CCS7_PORT
is sent to the call processing process.
OCHANREG OSS Channel Register Audit
The 127 channel registers of an OSS LTGB are
checked with respect to the port state of an
associated DSB port.
OCPBUFF OSS Call Processing Buffer Audit
The CPBs in the OSS-specific states
CPB_QUEUED and CPB_TRUNK_QUEUEING, and their
associated data, are checked.
COPRTSTA Conference Port Audit
The conference port data within the CP are checked.
NUCAUDIT Nailed Up Connection Audit
The active nailed-up connections (NUC) are checked for
their connection status during operation. In the event
of an error, the faulty NUC is through-connected
again. The NUC database data serve as a reference
for this purpose.
MMBUAUD MSB/MAC output buffer audit:
The buffers used to store the systems responses to
administration requests originated via MSB/MAC are
tested, if the linkage to the job registers is valid.
Buffers with invalid linkage are initialized and
inserted in the list of free buffers.
CDRSUTR RSU Trunk and Channel Register Audit
The consistency between the transient RSU trunk data
and the Channel Register data for trunk indices is
checked. In the event of an error, the RSU trunk is
idled and placed back into the trunk idle list.
RSUTRKST RSU Trunk Status Audit
The consistency between the transient RSU trunk data
and the CP Safeguarding data for high-speed links
is checked against the RSUC high-speed link data.
In the event of an error, the transient RSU trunk
data and the CP Safeguarding data will be
updated by Communication Maintenance.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ALLOW AUDIT- 2-


DISP AUDIT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY AUDIT

This command displays the state of currently running audits and the names
of inhibited audits. All audits known to the system are displayed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP AUDIT ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP AUDIT- 1-


INHIB AUDIT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

INHIBIT AUDIT

This command inhibits audits thereby preventing their execution.

Prerequisites:
- The audit name must be known to the system.
- The audit must not already be inhibited.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 INHIB AUDIT : NAME= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the audit. The names of all audits known to
the system can be called up with the command DISP AUDIT.
The names of the common audits are:
ABILREG Billing Register Audit
The idle band linkage of all free billing
registers or the billing register to
channel register linkage of all active
billing registers is tested.
CHANREG Channel Register Audit
The 127 channel registers are checked for each LTG:
- call status
. highest value
. validity
- call status in the channel register as compared
with associated channel register data
- call status in the channel register as compared
with the status of the port involved in this
connection (channel).
Exception: DSB ports (OSS).
- Busy status of the relevant channel in the
GS table in the CP (module PASDA)
- Specific channel register contents (CTE_ACTIVE,
PATH_DATA)
- Announcement table contents for a busy
announcement line and speech channel as compared
with the channel register contents on the A-side.
- specific channel register contents (OCCUPIED_BY
ISDN, CALL_DIVERSION_FOR_ISDN_PBX, OCCUPIED_BY
B_SIDE, IARSTAT_ACTIVE)
To clear a channel register inconsistency, the
interprocessor message MSG_ABORT_CHANNEL is sent to
the Call Processing Process.
CHKSUMVA Interprocessor checksums audit.
The CALL PROCESSING checksum and the LTG checksum
are compared. Errors are corrected.
CPBUFFER Call Processing Buffer Audit
The idle band linkage of all free call processing
buffers is checked, or the call processing buffer
to channel register linkage of all active call
processing buffers.
EQSTA Equipment Status Audit
A check is made to determine whether the
transient operating states of the peripheral
units are valid and whether the transient
and semipermanent operating states are identical.
In the case of DE5 the SW operating states
are compared with the HW operating states.
IPCHASTA Interprocessor Channel Register Audit
The speech channel states in the GP and CP
are checked for consistency, i.e. the channel
states in the GP should be identical with
those in the CP.
IPTRUSTA Interprocessor Trunk Status Audit
The transient states of ports in the CP
are checked for consistency:
- port states are compared

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 INHIB AUDIT- 1+


INHIB AUDIT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- port states in the GP are compared with port


states in the CP.
The GP supplies blocking states and busy states
to the IPTRUSTA as "summation bits".
To clear a port inconsistency the interprocessor
message MSG_ABORT_LINE is sent to the call processing
process.
IDLLSTAU Idle List Audit
The idle band linkage of trunk groups,
announcement groups and PBX groups is checked.
NWCONF Switching network configuration audit.
The TSG and SSG data are checked for consistency
with the relevant administration and safeguarding
data. Errors are corrected.
NWMAP Switching Network Map Audit.
The consistency between path data and switching
network busy states is checked. Errors are
corrected.
IPPRTSTA Interprocessor Port Status Audit
The transient port states of DLU-Ports and
V5IF-Ports are checked:
- CP port states are compared
- GP port states are compared with CP port states
The GP supplies blocking states and busy states
to the IPPRTSTA as "summation bits".
To clear a port inconsistency, the inter-
processor message MSG_ABORT_LINE is sent to
the call processing process.
CCS7AU Common Channel Signaling No.7 Audit
The port states of TUP and ISUP trunks lines
are checked:
Blocks which have been set or cancelled
(NAC_SYNCHRO and NUC_SEIZED), are compared
with DPC blocking.
To clear a port inconsistency, the inter-
processor message MSG_ABORT_CCS7_PORT
is sent to the call processing process.
OCHANREG OSS Channel Register Audit
The 127 channel registers of an OSS LTGB are
checked with respect to the port state of an
associated DSB port.
OCPBUFF OSS Call Processing Buffer Audit
The CPBs in the OSS-specific states
CPB_QUEUED and CPB_TRUNK_QUEUEING, and their
associated data, are checked.
COPRTSTA Conference Port Audit
The conference port data within the CP are checked.
NUCAUDIT Nailed Up Connection Audit
The active nailed-up connections (NUC) are checked for
their connection status during operation. In the event
of an error, the faulty NUC is through-connected
again. The NUC database data serve as a reference
for this purpose.
MMBUAUD MSB/MAC output buffer audit:
The buffers used to store the systems responses to
administration requests originated via MSB/MAC are
tested, if the linkage to the job registers is valid.
Buffers with invalid linkage are initialized and
inserted in the list of free buffers.
CDRSUTR RSU Trunk and Channel Register Audit
The consistency between the transient RSU trunk data
and the Channel Register data for trunk indices is
checked. In the event of an error, the RSU trunk is
idled and placed back into the trunk idle list.
RSUTRKST RSU Trunk Status Audit
The consistency between the transient RSU trunk data
and the CP Safeguarding data for high-speed links
is checked against the RSUC high-speed link data.
In the event of an error, the transient RSU trunk
data and the CP Safeguarding data will be
updated by Communication Maintenance.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 INHIB AUDIT- 2-


START AUDIT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

START AUDIT

This command starts an audit. Audits are programs with a low priority which
run periodically to check whether the code and data areas are correct.
Detected errors are corrected automatically. The audits IPTRUSTA and
IPPRTSTA stop correcting if they detect that previous corrections have
been unsuccessful.

Prerequisites:
- The name of the audit must be known to the system.
- The audit must not be inhibited.
- The audit must have a demand attribute.
- The audit state table must not be dynamically expanded during
execution of the command.
- The audit must not already be running.
- The requested processor must not be seized by an audit or a
fault detection.
- Only one project-specific audit may run at one time.
- Only five demand audits (audits that can be demanded via MML command
or via a user process) may run at one time.
- Sufficient resources must be available to allow the audit to be
started dynamically.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 START AUDIT : NAME= [,UNIT=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the audit. The names of all audits known to
the system can be called up with the command DISP AUDIT.
The names of the common audits are:
ABILREG Billing Register Audit
The idle band linkage of all free billing
registers or the billing register to
channel register linkage of all active
billing registers is tested.
CHANREG Channel Register Audit
The 127 channel registers are checked for each LTG:
- call status
. highest value
. validity
- call status in the channel register as compared
with associated channel register data
- call status in the channel register as compared
with the status of the port involved in this
connection (channel).
Exception: DSB ports (OSS).
- Busy status of the relevant channel in the
GS table in the CP (module PASDA)
- Specific channel register contents (CTE_ACTIVE,
PATH_DATA)
- Announcement table contents for a busy
announcement line and speech channel as compared
with the channel register contents on the A-side.
- specific channel register contents (OCCUPIED_BY
ISDN, CALL_DIVERSION_FOR_ISDN_PBX, OCCUPIED_BY
B_SIDE, IARSTAT_ACTIVE)
To clear a channel register inconsistency, the
interprocessor message MSG_ABORT_CHANNEL is sent to
the Call Processing Process.
CHKSUMVA Interprocessor checksums audit.
The CALL PROCESSING checksum and the LTG checksum
are compared. Errors are corrected.
CPBUFFER Call Processing Buffer Audit
The idle band linkage of all free call processing
buffers is checked, or the call processing buffer

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 START AUDIT- 1+


START AUDIT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

to channel register linkage of all active call


processing buffers.
EQSTA Equipment Status Audit
A check is made to determine whether the
transient operating states of the peripheral
units are valid and whether the transient
and semipermanent operating states are identical.
In the case of DE5 the SW operating states
are compared with the HW operating states.
IPCHASTA Interprocessor Channel Register Audit
The speech channel states in the GP and CP
are checked for consistency, i.e. the channel
states in the GP should be identical with
those in the CP.
IPTRUSTA Interprocessor Trunk Status Audit
The transient states of ports in the CP
are checked for consistency:
- port states are compared
- port states in the GP are compared with port
states in the CP.
The GP supplies blocking states and busy states
to the IPTRUSTA as "summation bits".
To clear a port inconsistency the interprocessor
message MSG_ABORT_LINE is sent to the call processing
process.
IDLLSTAU Idle List Audit
The idle band linkage of trunk groups,
announcement groups and PBX groups is checked.
NWCONF Switching network configuration audit.
The TSG and SSG data are checked for consistency
with the relevant administration and safeguarding
data. Errors are corrected.
NWMAP Switching Network Map Audit.
The consistency between path data and switching
network busy states is checked. Errors are
corrected.
IPPRTSTA Interprocessor Port Status Audit
The transient port states of DLU-Ports and
V5IF-Ports are checked:
- CP port states are compared
- GP port states are compared with CP port states
The GP supplies blocking states and busy states
to the IPPRTSTA as "summation bits".
To clear a port inconsistency, the inter-
processor message MSG_ABORT_LINE is sent to
the call processing process.
CCS7AU Common Channel Signaling No.7 Audit
The port states of TUP and ISUP trunks lines
are checked:
Blocks which have been set or cancelled
(NAC_SYNCHRO and NUC_SEIZED), are compared
with DPC blocking.
To clear a port inconsistency, the inter-
processor message MSG_ABORT_CCS7_PORT
is sent to the call processing process.
OCHANREG OSS Channel Register Audit
The 127 channel registers of an OSS LTGB are
checked with respect to the port state of an
associated DSB port.
OCPBUFF OSS Call Processing Buffer Audit
The CPBs in the OSS-specific states
CPB_QUEUED and CPB_TRUNK_QUEUEING, and their
associated data, are checked.
COPRTSTA Conference Port Audit
The conference port data within the CP are checked.
NUCAUDIT Nailed Up Connection Audit
The active nailed-up connections (NUC) are checked for
their connection status during operation. In the event
of an error, the faulty NUC is through-connected
again. The NUC database data serve as a reference
for this purpose.
MMBUAUD MSB/MAC output buffer audit:
The buffers used to store the systems responses to
administration requests originated via MSB/MAC are
tested, if the linkage to the job registers is valid.
Buffers with invalid linkage are initialized and
inserted in the list of free buffers.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 START AUDIT- 2+


START AUDIT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CDRSUTR RSU Trunk and Channel Register Audit


The consistency between the transient RSU trunk data
and the Channel Register data for trunk indices is
checked. In the event of an error, the RSU trunk is
idled and placed back into the trunk idle list.
RSUTRKST RSU Trunk Status Audit
The consistency between the transient RSU trunk data
and the CP Safeguarding data for high-speed links
is checked against the RSUC high-speed link data.
In the event of an error, the transient RSU trunk
data and the CP Safeguarding data will be
updated by Communication Maintenance.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

UNIT UNIT

This parameter specifies the equipment unit where the audit is to


be performed.

Compatibilities:
- If NAME=CHANREG, then entry of the parameter UNIT is mandatory.
- If NAME=CDRSUTS, then entry of the parameter UNIT is mandatory.
- If NAME=ABILREG, CPBUFFER, EQUSTA, NWCONF, NWMAP, or IPTRUSTA,
parameter UNIT is illegal.
- If NAME=CHKSUMVA, IPCHASTA, or IPTRUSTA, then LTG must be entered
for parameter value a in parameter UNIT.
- If a= LTG, then units b and c refer to:

b: TSG number =
0 for DE3 and DE4
0, 1 for DE5/1
0...3 for DE5/2
0...7 for DE5/4

c: LTG number =
1...15 for DE3
1...63 for DE4,DE5/1,DE5/2,DE5/4

- If a= MBUL, then units b and c refer to:

b: System side =
0,1

c: MBUL number =
0 for DE3 and DE4
0, 1 for DE5/1
0...3 for DE5/2
0...7 for DE5/4

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b[-c]

a: EQUIPMENT UNIT
MBUL MESSAGE BUFFER UNIT : LTG
LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

b: TIME STAGE GROUP NUMBER / SYSTEM SIDE / RSU NUMBER=


0...286, range of decimal numbers

c: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER / MBUL NUMBER=


0...63, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 START AUDIT- 3-


ACT AUDITMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Activate Audit Main Processor

This task is used to activate the execution of ]Audit MP].


One input is the number of ]MP] and the other one is ]Audit MP],
which is optional.
If there is no input for ]Audit MP] then all ]Audit MPs] of one
]MP] are activated.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT AUDITMP : MP= [,Audit MP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MP

This parameter is the number of an existing ’MP’.


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...63.

Audit MP

This parameter is the name of an existing ]Audit MP].


Allowed values are symbolic names of exactly 8 characters.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT AUDITMP- 1-


DACT AUDITMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Deactivate Audit Main Processor

This task deactivates ]Audit MP] thereby preventing their execution of one or
all ]Audit MPs] of one ]MP].
One input is the number of ]MP] and the other one is ]Audit MP].
If there is no input for the ]Audit MP] then all ]Audit MPs] of one
]MP] are deactivated.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT AUDITMP : MP= [,Audit MP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MP

This parameter is the number of an existing ’MP’.


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...63.

Audit MP

This parameter is the name of an existing ]Audit MP].


Allowed values are symbolic names of exactly 8 characters.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT AUDITMP- 1-


DISP AUDITMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Audit Main Processor

This task displays one or all ]Audit MPs] of ]MP].


One input is the number of ]MP] and the other one is ]Audit MP].
If there is no input for the ]Audit MP] then all ]Audit MPs] of one ]MP]
are displayed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP AUDITMP : MP= [,Audit MP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MP

This parameter is the number of an existing ’MP’.


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...63.

Audit MP

This parameter is the name of an existing ]Audit MP].


Allowed values are symbolic names of exactly 8 characters.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP AUDITMP- 1-


CAN AUT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL AUTHORIZATION

This command cancels authorization classes from an authorization and


cancels entire authorizations from the authorization table.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN AUT : AUT= [,AUTCL=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AUT CP AUTHORIZATION

This parameter specifies an authorization.


An authorization contains a number of authorization classes.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

AUTCL AUTHORIZATION CLASS

This parameter specifies an authorization class.


An authorization class contains a number of command authorizations.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...50, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN AUT- 1-


DISP AUT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY AUTHORIZATION

This command displays the authorization classes associated with


the authorizations on the terminal.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP AUT : AUT= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AUT CP AUTHORIZATION

This parameter specifies an authorization.


An authorization contains a number of authorization classes.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP AUT- 1-


ENTR AUT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER AUTHORIZATION

This command enters new authorizations with their associated


authorization classes and allows authorization classes to be
entered in an existing authorization.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR AUT : AUT= ,AUTCL= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AUT CP AUTHORIZATION

This parameter specifies an authorization.


An authorization contains a number of authorization classes.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

AUTCL AUTHORIZATION CLASS

This parameter specifies an authorization class.


An authorization class contains a number of command authorizations.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...50, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR AUT- 1-


CAN AUTCL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL AUTHORIZATION CLASS

This command cancels command authorizations for MML commands from a


particular authorization class.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN AUTCL : AUTCL= ,CMDCOD= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AUTCL AUTHORIZATION CLASS

This parameter specifies an authorization class.


An authorization class contains a number of command authorizations.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...49, range of decimal numbers

CMDCOD COMMAND CODE

This parameter specifies command to be entered into or deleted


from an authorization class. CMDCOD must be a valid command name.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN AUTCL- 1-


DISP AUTCL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY AUTHORIZATION CLASS

This command displays the command authorizations defined


in single or in all authorization classes.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP AUTCL : AUTCL= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AUTCL AUTHORIZATION CLASS

This parameter specifies an authorization class.


An authorization class contains a number of command authorizations.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...50, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP AUTCL- 1-


ENTR AUTCL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER AUTHORIZATION CLASS

This command enters a desired authorization class for the MML command
authorizations.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR AUTCL : AUTCL= ,CMDCOD= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

AUTCL AUTHORIZATION CLASS

This parameter specifies an authorization class.


An authorization class contains a number of command authorizations.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...49, range of decimal numbers

CMDCOD COMMAND CODE

This parameter specifies command to be entered into or deleted


from an authorization class. CMDCOD must be a valid command name.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR AUTCL- 1-


DISP AUTHDEF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Authentication Defaults

This task displays the global parameters of Q3 Authentication:


’Default authent.’ and ’Denial response’.

Note: These settings are only relevant for system access via Q3-interface.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP AUTHDEF ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP AUTHDEF- 1-


MOD AUTHDEF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Authentication Defaults

This task modifies the global parameters of Q3 Authentication.


It is used to change the default authentication access and to specify the
response which shall be returned for unauthorized authentication attempts.

Note: The settings are only relevant for system access via Q3-interface. For file
transfer there is no default access possible.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD AUTHDEF : [defaultAuth=] [,denialResp=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

defaultAuth

This parameter specifies the default authentication access


for initiators, which are not known at the authentication
domain:

Input values:

’allow’ : System access allowed.


’abortAssociation’ : abort Q3 association request.
’denyWithResponse’ : reject Q3 association request.

denialResp

This parameter defines the response to be returned for


identified initiators if the authentication check
should fail.

Input values:

’abortAssociation’ : abort Q3 association request.


’denyWithResponse’ : reject Q3 association request.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD AUTHDEF- 1-


STAT BA
DN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CALL DATA OF BASIC ACCESS

This command displays all current call-related data for the specified
basic access.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing ISDN.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. STAT BA - DN DN ORIENTED
2. STAT BA - EQN EQN ORIENTED

1. Input format

DN ORIENTED

Input format for directory-number-oriented output.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT BA : [LAC=] ,DN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code if there is more


than one local network connected to an exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the subscriber.


Up to ten parameters can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT BA- 1+


STAT BA
EQN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

EQN ORIENTED

Input format for equipment-number-oriented output.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT BA : EQN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the equipment number of the port connected to


the subscriber or PBX line to be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c[-d]

a: DIGITAL LINE UNIT / V5INTERFACE=


10...8999, range of decimal numbers

- DLU number (10,20,30...2550 for a DLU port)


- V5IF number (6000,6001,..8999 for a V5 port)

b: SHELF=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

- Shelf number (0..7 for a DLU port, 0 for a V5 port)

c: MODULE=
0...20, range of decimal numbers

- Module number (0..15 for a DLU port, 0..20 for a V5 port)

d: CIRCUIT / V5PORT=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

- Circuit number (0..7 for a DLU8 port,


0..15 for a DLU16 port,
0..99 for a V5 port)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT BA- 2-


DISP BAFAULT
DN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY BASIC ACCESS FAULT

This command displays the last occured ISDN basic access faults.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP BAFAULT - DN DIRECTORY NUMBER


2. DISP BAFAULT - EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER

1. Input format

DIRECTORY NUMBER

Path input format for display basic access fault, directory number oriented.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP BAFAULT : DN= ,TYPE= [,LAC=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the


subscriber or PBX line.
Maximum 12 digits in the range 1...9,A...F hexadecimal
value is specified.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TYPE TYPE OF FAULT

This parameter specifies the last occurred basic access line fault.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BER BIT ERROR RATE


Bit error frequency of transmission
(10exp-3/10exp-6).
LAY1 LAYER 1 FAULT
LAY2 LAYER 2 FAULT
Loss or deactivation of Layer2 of lines with
lineattribut "Lay2hold".

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code in an exchange.


Maximum 6 digits in the range 1...9 value is specified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP BAFAULT- 1+


DISP BAFAULT
EQN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

EQUIPMENT NUMBER

Path input format for display basic access fault, digital line unit
number oriented.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP BAFAULT : EQN= ,TYPE= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the equipment number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: EQUIPMENT NUMBER FOR DLU/V5=


10...8999, range of decimal numbers

For DLU port: a DLU number in the range 10...2550


(in steps of 10)
For V51IF port: a V5IF number in the range 6000...8999
For V52IF port: a V5IF number in the range 6000...8999

b: EQUIPMENT NUMBER FOR SHELF=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

For DLU port: a shelf in the range 0...7


For V51IF port: 0
For V52IF port: 0

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

c: EQUIPMENT NUMBER FOR MODULE/TH V52 PORT=


0...20, range of decimal numbers

For DLU port: a module number in the range 0...15


For V51IF port: 0
For V52IF port: THv5port number in the range 00...20

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

d: EQUIP. NUMBER FOR CIRCUIT/V5PORT=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

For DLU port: a circuit number in the range 0...7 for DLU8
0...15 for DLU16
For V51IF port: a v5port number in the range 0...31
For V52IF port: TUv5port number in the range 00...99

Note: v52port is limited to the number 2047.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

TYPE TYPE OF FAULT

This parameter specifies the last occurred basic access line fault.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BER BIT ERROR RATE


Bit error frequency of transmission
(10exp-3/10exp-6).
LAY1 LAYER 1 FAULT

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP BAFAULT- 2+


DISP BAFAULT
EQN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

LAY2 LAYER 2 FAULT


Loss or deactivation of Layer2 of lines with
lineattribut "Lay2hold".

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP BAFAULT- 3-


COM BAP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

COMMUTE BASE PROCESSORS

This command initiates a master-spare commutation. Prior to command


execution, the base processor spare (which will be the future base
processor master) is tested.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 COM BAP ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 COM BAP- 1-


CONF BAP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE BASE PROCESSOR

This command configures the BAP spare.


A configuration attempt of the BAP master to MBL is rejected.

Notes:
- The configuration from SPR to MBL and the configuration from
MBL or UNA to SPR is considered dangerous.
A dialog mask is output. The operating personnel must decide by
entering ’+’ or ’-’ whether the command should be executed.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF BAP : [BAP=] ,OST= [,DIAG=] [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

BAP BASE PROCESSOR NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

OST OPERATING STATE

This parameter specifies the target operating state.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
SPR ACTIVE SPARE
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED

DIAG DIAGNOSIS

This parameter allows the base processor to be diagnosed before


configuring it from MBL or UNA to ACT.

Notes:
- Interim diagnostic messages are displayed if SUP=NO and
DIAG=YES is entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N CONFIGURE WITHOUT DIAGNOSIS


NO CONFIGURE WITHOUT DIAGNOSIS
Y CONFIGURE WITH DIAGNOSIS
YES CONFIGURE WITH DIAGNOSIS

Default: YES

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF BAP- 1-


DIAG BAP
DIAG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSE BASE PROCESSOR

This command initiates single, repeated or permanent diagnostic runs


for a base processor.

Prerequisites:
- The base processor must be MBL.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DIAG BAP - DIAG SINGLE DIAGNOSIS


2. DIAG BAP - REPDIAG REPEATED DIAGNOSIS

1. Input format

SINGLE DIAGNOSIS

This input initiates a single diagnosis for a base processor.


The diagnosis includes a BCMY interface test.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG BAP : [BAP=] [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

BAP BASE PROCESSOR NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG BAP- 1+


DIAG BAP
REPDIAG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

REPEATED DIAGNOSIS

This input initiates a repeated or permanent diagnosis for a base


processor. The diagnosis does not include a BCMY interface test.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG BAP : [BAP=] ,REP= [,INT=] [,STATCS=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

BAP BASE PROCESSOR NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

REP REPEAT

Valid values are :


2...65535 for repeated diagnosis
PERM for permanent diagnosis with unlimited number
of runs (termination with command STOP JOB)

This parameter specifies the number of diagnostic runs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

INT INTERRUPT DIAGNOSTIC CYCLE

This parameter specifies that a repeated or permanent diagnosis is


interrupted as soon as a fault is detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N CONTINUE IN CASE OF FAULT


NO CONTINUE IN CASE OF FAULT
Y TERMINATE IN CASE OF FAULT
YES TERMINATE IN CASE OF FAULT

Default: NO

STATCS OUTPUT OF STATISTICS

This parameter specifies the interval between statistic outputs


in minutes.

Notes:
- Statistic output can also be requested with the DISP DIAGSTAT
command.

Standard Behavior: no statistic output

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...60, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG BAP- 2-


TEST BAP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TEST BASE PROCESSOR

This command tests the BAP spare.

Prerequisites:
- The base processor must be SPR.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 TEST BAP : [BAP=] [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

BAP BASE PROCESSOR NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST BAP- 1-


CONF BCMY

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE BUS TO COMMON MEMORY

This command configures a bus to common memory.

Notes:
- The configuration from ACT to MBL and the configuration from
MBL or UNA to ACT is considered dangerous.
A dialog mask is output. The operating personnel must decide by
entering ’+’ or ’-’ whether the command should be executed.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF BCMY : [BCMY=] ,OST= [,DIAG=] [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

BCMY BUS FOR COMMON MEMORY

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

OST OPERATING STATE

This parameter specifies the target operating state.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED

DIAG DIAGNOSIS

This parameter allows diagnosis before configuration to ACT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N CONFIGURE WITHOUT DIAGNOSIS


NO CONFIGURE WITHOUT DIAGNOSIS
Y CONFIGURE WITH DIAGNOSIS
YES CONFIGURE WITH DIAGNOSIS

Default: YES

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF BCMY- 1-


DIAG BCMY

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSE BUS TO COMMON MEMORY

This command initiates a diagnosis for a bus to common memory.


The diagnosis includes interface tests of the active processors and the
common memory. Repeated diagnosis is not possible.

Prerequisites:
- The bus to common memory must be MBL.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG BCMY : [BCMY=] [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

BCMY BUS FOR COMMON MEMORY

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG BCMY- 1-


TEST BCMY

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TEST BUS TO COMMON MEMORY

This command tests a bus to common memory.

Prerequisites:
- Both B:CMYs must be ACT.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 TEST BCMY : [BCMY=] [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

BCMY BUS FOR COMMON MEMORY

Notes:
- If the optional unit parameter is omitted, both B:CMYs are tested.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST BCMY- 1-


ACT BERM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACT BIT ERROR MEASUREMENT

This command starts a Bit Error Rate Measurement, the purpose of BERM
is to provide limits for bringing into service, and limits for
maintenance of digital paths, sections, and line sections in order
to achieve the performance objective given for series G recommendations.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command starts a semipermanent job. It can be canceled with CAN JOB.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT BERM : RSPDN= ,MEASTYP= ,LTG= ,LC= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RSPDN RESPONDER DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the Responder directory number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

MEASTYP MEASUREMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of Measurement.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

M1 MEASUREMENT TYPE 1
Type of measurement:
End to End unidirectional.
M2 MEASUREMENT TYPE 2
Type of measurement:
End to End bidirectional.
M3 MEASUREMENT TYPE 3
Type of measurement:
Digital Loopback.

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...127, range of decimal numbers

Dependent on the Switching Network Hardware this


unit represents the Time Stage Group (TSG for SNB)
or the Switching Network MULTIPLEXER (SNMUX for SND
and upper ones).

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


1...63, range of decimal numbers

LC LINE CONNECTION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK UNIT NUMBER=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT BERM- 1+


ACT BERM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: PORT NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT BERM- 2-


DISP BERM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY BIT ERROR RATE MEASUREMENT

This command displays bit error rate data for 64kb/s paths.
Specifying the incoming trunk under measurement and date limits the
operator get the following counters:
SES, ES, MT, EFS, BS, LS, BLER, BER, AS and UAS.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP BERM : LTG= ,LC= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LTG

This parameter specifies the LTG number of the incoming trunk


under measurement.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LTG SET=
0...127, range of decimal numbers

Corresponds to <LTG SET no>

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

Corresponds to <LTG no>

LC LINE CHANNEL

This parameter specifies the LC of the incoming trunk


under measurement.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LTU NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

Corresponds to <LTU no>

b: CHANNEL=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

Corresponds to <CHANNEL no>

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP BERM- 1-


ACT BILLREC
ACTIVATE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE BILLING RECORD

This command activates the following possibilities:


- it activates new billing, IMSI trace or IN record layouts.
- it determines the record format of the billing, IMSI trace
or IN records,
the record size of the client records destination file and
the fillers to be used in the destination file.
- it activates a selective transfer of billing or IMSI trace records.

Prerequisites:
- The activation of a new layout must not happen during the formatting
of a hot billing, emergency call trace or IMSI trace, nor during the
formattting and transfer of the contents of the IA.ICMCR, IA.ICITR
or IA.ICINA file.

Possible Effects:
- During the last transfer of records from the IA.ICMCR file or the
IA.ICITR file, always the entire file contents will be transferred.
So possible restrictive selection criteria will then be ignored.
- The contents of the selective transfer parameters can be lost after
a system recovery.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ACT BILLREC - ACTIVATE ACTIVATE RECORD LAYOUTS


2. ACT BILLREC - RECATTR ACT BILLREC RECORD ATTRIBUTES
3. ACT BILLREC - SELTRANS ACT BILLREC SEL FILE TRANSFER

1. Input format

ACTIVATE RECORD LAYOUTS

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT BILLREC ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT BILLREC- 1+


ACT BILLREC
RECATTR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

ACT BILLREC RECORD ATTRIBUTES

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT BILLREC : FILE= ,RECFORM= ,RECSIZE= [,FILLER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE FILE FOR SELECTIVE TRANSFER

This parameter specifies the file on which the selective transfer of


records must be applied or the file for whose destination file new
record attributes are defined.

Possible values:
- IA.ICMCR : cyclic file for billing records.
- IA.ICITR : cyclic file for IMSI trace records.
- IA.ICINA : cyclic file for IN records.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

RECFORM RECORD FORMAT

This parameter specifies the logical record format of the billing,


IMSI trace or IN records destination file.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FIX FIXED LOGICAL RECORD


VAR VARIABLE LOGICAL RECORD

RECSIZE RECORD SIZE

This parameter specifies the physical/logical record size (in bytes)


of the billing, IMSI trace or IN records destination file.

Incompatibilities:
- The logical record size may only be specified in case of
FIXED logical records (RECFORM = FIX).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: PHYSICAL RECORD SIZE=


3...16384, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the physical record size


of the billing records destination file.

Incompatibilities:
- This parameter must be >= logical record size.
- This parameter must be <= SET FGRPATT in command COPATT.

b: LOGICAL RECORD SIZE=


3...2048, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the logical record size


of the billing records destination file.

Incompatibilities:
- This parameter must be <= physical record size.
- This parameter must be >= maximum billing record length.

FILLER FILLER VALUE

This parameter specifies the fillers at the end of a physical/logical


record, used to obtain the fixed physical/logical record size.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT BILLREC- 2+


ACT BILLREC
RECATTR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Incompatibilities:
- The logical record filler may only be specified in case of
FIXED logical records (RECFORM = FIX).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: PHYSICAL RECORD FILLER=


0...255, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the fillers at the end of


a physical record.

Default: 255

b: LOGICAL RECORD FILLER=


0...255, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the fillers at the end of


a logical record.

Default: 255

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT BILLREC- 3+


ACT BILLREC
SELTRANS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

ACT BILLREC SEL FILE TRANSFER

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT BILLREC : FILE= [,RECLAY=] [,SEL=] [,SSV=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE FILE FOR SELECTIVE TRANSFER

This parameter specifies the file on which the selective transfer of


records must be applied or the file for whose destination file new
record attributes are defined.

Possible values:
- IA.ICMCR : cyclic file for billing records.
- IA.ICITR : cyclic file for IMSI trace records.
- IA.ICINA : cyclic file for IN records.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

RECLAY RECORD LAYOUT

This parameter specifies the selective transfer of billing records or


IMSI trace records based on the record layout.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CFC CALL FORWARDING CONDITIONAL


CFCATT CALL FORW COND ATTEMPT
CFU CALL FORWARDING UNCONDITIONAL
CFUATT CALL FORW UNCOND ATTEMPT
ECT EMERGENCY CALL TRACE
EMY EMERGENCY CALL
EMYATT EMERGENCY CALL ATTEMPT
MOC MOBILE ORIGINATING CALL
MOCATT MOBILE ORIG CALL ATTEMPT
MOCTRAC MOBILE ORIG CALL TRACE
MTC MOBILE TERMINATING CALL
MTCATT MOBILE TERM CALL ATTEMPT
MTCTRAC MOBILE TERM CALL TRACE
PABXIC PABX INCOMING CALL
PABXOG PABX OUTGOING CALL
PABXSCI PABX SUB CONTR INPUT OPERATION
RECLAY1 RECORD LAYOUT 1
ROA ROAMING TICKET
SCI SUBSCRIBER CONTROLLED INPUT
SMSMO SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE ORIGINAT
SMSMT SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE TERMINAT
SMSOTRAC SHORT MESS SERV ORIG TRACE
SMSTTRAC SHORT MESS SERV TERM TRACE
TRANSIT TRANSIT CALL

Default: ECT

SEL SELECTIVE TRANSFER

This parameter specifies the selective transfer of billing records or


IMSI trace records based on whether the hot transfer of these records
to the OS over the hot operation link or the hot trace link succeeded
or not.

Prerequisites:
- This parameter is only applicable for the features ’hot billing’,
’emergency call trace’ and ’IMSI tracing’.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT BILLREC- 4+


ACT BILLREC
SELTRANS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

FAILED FAILED TICKETS


GOOD GOOD TICKETS
X ALL TICKETS

Default: X

SSV SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICE

This parameter specifies the selective transfer of billing records


based on the supplementary service ’hot billing’.

Prerequisites:
- This parameter is only applicable for the feature ’hot billing’.

Incompatibilities:
- This parameter may only be specified for the billing records file
(FILE = IA.ICMCR) and not for the IMSI trace records file.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

HB TICKETS WITH SS HOT BILLING


NOHB TICKETS WITHOUT SS HOT BILLING
X ALL TICKETS

Default: X

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT BILLREC- 5-


TRANS BUFFER

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TRANSFER INDIV. CALL DATA BUFFER TO DISK

This command initiates the immediate transfer of the contents of the


(not necessarily full) data buffer for the specified feature type
from the CP memory to the corresponding disk file.

Prerequisites :
- The specified feature type must be active (advisory and command
rejection).
- The corresponding file is not full (advisory and command rejection).
- The CP memory data buffer is not in overflow (advisory and command
rejection).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 TRANS BUFFER : TYPE= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE INDIV. CALL DATA FEATURE TYPE

This parameter specifies the individual call data feature type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING


MCR MOBILE SUBSC. CALL RECORDING
IARA INTERADMIN. REVENUE ACCOUNTING
INA INTELLIGENT NETWORK AMA
CDR CALL DETAIL RECORDING
UAM US AUTOMATIC MSG ACCOUNTING
ITR IMSI TRACE RECORD BUFFER
LIR LAWFUL INTERCEPT RECORDING
MOB METER OBSERVATION
PMOB PREVENTIVE METER OBSERVATION
MAL MALICIOUS CALL TRACING
OME OBSERVED MOB. EQUIPM. BUFFER
FIR FACILITY INPUT RECORDING
DNOB DIRECTORY NUMBER OBSERVATION
TOB TRAFFIC OBSERVATION
TST TRAFFIC STRUCT. MEASUREMENT
ERS ERROR STATISTICS

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TRANS BUFFER- 1-


CAN C7LSETRA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CCS7 LSET IN RT.SET OF RT AREA

This command cancels a link set in the route set of a routing area. If
the link set is the last in the route set, the command will be rejected.

Possible effects:
- If execution of this command is aborted by recovery, the command
must be re-entered to prevent data base inconsistency.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange with common channel signaling
according to signaling system No.7 (CCS7).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN C7LSETRA : RANAM= ,LSNAM= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RANAM CCS7 ROUTING AREA NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LSNAM LINK SET NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN C7LSETRA- 1-


DISP C7LSETRA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISP.FOR A GIVEN CCS7 LSET ALL RT.AREA’S

This command displays the following data:


- the name of the link set
- the network indicator to which the link set belongs
- the destination point code of the signaling point at the far
end of the link set (adjacent destination point)

In addition, the display shows the following data for routing


areas which have the specified link set as possible route
direction:
- the routing area name itself
- the operating (semipermanent) state of the routing area
- the effective (transient) state of the routing area
- an indication whether this link set is the current route to the
routing area
- an indication whether this routing area is reachable
exclusively (ONLYAV) via the specified link set or not.

Notes:
- If the parameter value YES is input for the (optional) parameter
ONLYAV, only these routing areas are displayed which are
exclusively reachable via the specified link set. If the parameter
value NO is input or if the parameter is omitted, all routing
areas are displayed which have the specified link set as possible
route direction.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1LSNAM=1 1
1 DISP C7LSETRA : ZLSNO= Y [,ONLYAV=] ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LSNAM LINK SET NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LSNO LINK SET NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...255, range of decimal numbers

ONLYAV ONLY AVAIL.LINK SET TO DESTINA

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO DEST.NOT ONLY AVAIL. BY LSET


YES DEST.ONLY AVAIL.BY LSET

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP C7LSETRA- 1-


ENTR C7LSETRA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CCS7 LSET IN ROUTE DESC.OF RT AREA

This command inserts one new route direction (link set) at a specific
priority order in the route set for the routing area. A route set may
contain one to eight link sets. If there is already a link set with the
same priority as entered, this command will decrement the priority of this and
the following route directions (link sets) (lower priority means higher number).

Possible effects:
- If execution of this command is aborted by recovery, the command
must be re-entered to prevent data base inconsistency.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange with common channel signaling
according to signaling system No.7 (CCS7).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR C7LSETRA : RANAM= ,LSNAM= ,LSPRIO= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RANAM CCS7 ROUTING AREA NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LSNAM LINK SET NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LSPRIO PRIORITY OF ENTERED LINK SET

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR C7LSETRA- 1-


CAN C7RTAREA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CCS7 ROUTING AREA

This command cancels a routing area.

Prerequisites :
- The routing area must not contain any destination points.
- The routing area must be configured to the operating state
administrative blocked (ABL).

Possible effects:
- If execution of this command is aborted by recovery, the command
must be re-entered to prevent data base inconsistency.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange with common channel signaling
according to signaling system No.7 (CCS7).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN C7RTAREA : RANAM= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RANAM CCS7 ROUTING AREA NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN C7RTAREA- 1-


CONF C7RTAREA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE CCS7 ROUTING AREA

This command configures a routing area to one


of the operating states: active (ACT) or administrative blocked
(ABL). When a routing area is created, it is automatically
configured to the operating state administrative blocked
(ABL).

Possible effects:
- If execution of this command is aborted by recovery, the command
must be re-entered to prevent data base inconsistency.

Notes:
- The configuring of a routing area to operating state ABL
prevents message signal units (MSU’s) being transmitted to the
routing area by the users. It does not automatically prevent
MSU’s being transmitted from the routing area. Bi-directional
message flow can only be terminated when both signaling points at
the end of the route set (routing area and own signaling point)
are mutually configured to ABL.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF C7RTAREA : RANAM= ,OST= [,UNCOND=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RANAM CCS7 ROUTING AREA NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OST OPERATING STATE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
ABL ADMINISTRATIVE BLOCKED

UNCOND UNCONDITIONAL

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DO NOT CONFIG. UNCONDITIONALLY


NO DO NOT CONFIG. UNCONDITIONALLY
Y CONFIGURE UNCONDITIONALLY
YES CONFIGURE UNCONDITIONALLY

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF C7RTAREA- 1-


CR C7RTAREA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE CCS7 ROUTING AREA

This command creates a routing area, which is a group of destination points


in the foreign area that can be reached via the same route set.The route
set may be created with one to eight possible route directions (link
sets). The first route direction in this set will be assigned the highest
priority.
The operating state of the routing area is initially administrative
blocked (ABL).
The route set still will not carry signaling traffic until it has
been activated using the command CONF C7RTAREA.

Prerequisites :
- The link set of the route set must be created.

Possible effects:
- If execution of this command is aborted by recovery, the command
must be re-entered to prevent data base inconsistency.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange with common channel signaling
according to signaling system No.7 (CCS7).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR C7RTAREA : RANAM= ,NETIND= ,PRD= ,LSK= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RANAM CCS7 ROUTING AREA NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NET 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NET 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NET 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NET 1

PRD POSSIBLE ROUTE DIRECTION

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LSK LOAD SHARING KEY FOR RT DIRECT

This parameter specifies the loadsharing key of the route set.


It indicates a method used to determine whether the load is
distributed to one (LSK = 0) or two (LSK > 0) signaling
link sets.
If distributed to two signaling link sets the LSK = 1,2,3 or 4
additionally defines which load portions are distributed to which one
of the two signaling link sets.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...4, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR C7RTAREA- 1-
DISP C7RTAREA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CCS7 ROUTING AREA

This command displays the following data of created routing areas:


- the name of the routing area
- the network indicator of this routing area
- the destination point codes (or ranges of destination point
codes) that belong to this routing area

If a specific routing area is requested, the following additional data


is displayed:
- the load sharing key for the route direction
- the operating state (semipermanent) of the routing area
- the effective state (transient) of the routing area
- the name of the link sets which lead to this routing area
- the current priority of each link set
- an indication if the link set is the current route to the routing area
- an indication if the link set is inhibited or not inhibited
- the effective state (transient) of the link set

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1RANAM= 1 1
1 DISP C7RTAREA : ZNETIND=Y ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RANAM CCS7 ROUTING AREA

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NET 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NET 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NET 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NET 1

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP C7RTAREA- 1-


MOD C7RTAREA
LSK
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY CCS7 ROUTING AREA

This command either interchanges the priorities of the two link sets
LSNAM1 and LSNAM2 in the route set of a routing area or modifies
the loadsharing key of the route set.

Possible effects:
- If execution of this command is aborted by recovery, the command
must be reentered to prevent data base inconsistency.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange with common channel signaling
according to signaling system No.7 (CCS7).

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD C7RTAREA - LSK CHANGE LOADSHARING KEY


2. MOD C7RTAREA - PRIORITY CHANGE PRIORITY OF TWO LINK SETS

1. Input format

CHANGE LOADSHARING KEY

Change of the loadsharing key:


The loadsharing key is used to define the traffic distribution
between the current routes.
The loadsharing key must have a value between zero and four.
If the loadsharing key has the value zero, no loadsharing will
be carried out between the routes and the possible route direction
with highest priority will be used.
If the loadsharing key has a value between one and four, loadsharing
will be carried out between the two available possible route
directions with highest priority. The different values effect the
distribution of the traffic within the route directions.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD C7RTAREA : RANAM= ,LSK= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RANAM CCS7 ROUTING AREA NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LSK LOADSHARING KEY FOR RT DIRECT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...4, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD C7RTAREA- 1+


MOD C7RTAREA
PRIORITY
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

CHANGE PRIORITY OF TWO LINK SETS

Interchange of the priorities


The new priority of LSNAM1 must be specified explicitely
by LSPRI1.
The highest priority is one, the lowest is eight.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD C7RTAREA : RANAM= ,LSNAM1= ,LSNAM2= ,LSPRI1= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RANAM CCS7 ROUTING AREA NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LSNAM1 FIRST LINK SET TO BE SWAPPED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LSNAM2 SECOND LINK SET TO BE SWAPPED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LSPRI1 PRIO.OF 1ST ENTERED LINK SET

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD C7RTAREA- 2-


CAN C7TGREL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CCS7 TRUNK GROUP RELATION

This command cancels the relation between a destination point (including


the associated user part) and a trunk group with common channel signaling.

Prerequisites:
- All trunks belonging to the specified trunk group must be cancelled.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange with common channel signaling
according to signaling system No.7 (CCS7).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN C7TGREL : TGNO= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN C7TGREL- 1-


DISP C7TGREL
DPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CCS7 TRUNK GROUP RELATION

This command displays the relation between a destination point (including


the associated user part) and trunk groups with common channel signaling.
The display can also be selective.

This command is only permitted for an exchange with common channel signaling
according to signaling system No.7 (CCS7).

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP C7TGREL - DPC DESTINATION POINT CODE


2. DISP C7TGREL - TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

1. Input format

DESTINATION POINT CODE

Input format for the destination point code identifier


option

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,NETIND= 11 1
1 DISP C7TGREL : DPC= [,OSPC=] 1Z,NETNAME=Y1 [,USNAME=] ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DPC DESTINATION POINT CODE

Network Indicator = NAT0 Units = 4-3-4-3


Network Indicator = INAT0 Units = 3-8-3
Network Indicator = NAT1 Units = 4-3-4-3
Network Indicator = INAT1 Units = 3-8-3

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: DPC-UNIT1=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

b: DPC-UNIT2=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: DPC-UNIT3=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: DPC-UNIT4=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

OSPC OWN SIGNALLING POINT CODE

The allowable entries are defined by individual PTTs on a project


specific basis.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: OSPC-UNIT1=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

b: OSPC-UNIT2=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP C7TGREL- 1+


DISP C7TGREL
DPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

c: OSPC-UNIT3=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: OSPC-UNIT4=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter identifies the ITU network where the destination


point is located.
The value corresponding to this indicator is used in the network
indicator field of the message signalling units sent between two
exchanges.
In the world market, NETIND is mandatory for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.
In U.S. Releases, NETIND is optional for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.
The default value for NETIND is NAT0.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

NETNAME NETWORK NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

USNAME USER NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ISUP ISDN USER PART


SCCP SIGN. CONNECTION CONTROL PART
TUP TELEPHONE USER PART

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP C7TGREL- 2+


DISP C7TGREL
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

Input format for the trunk group number option

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP C7TGREL : TGNO= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP C7TGREL- 3-


ENTR C7TGREL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CCS7 TRUNK GROUP RELATION

This command enters a relation between a destination point (including the


associated user part) and a trunk group with common channel signaling.
A maximum of 64 trunk groups with common channel signaling may lead to a
a destination point and each of its associated user parts.

Prerequisites:
- The destination point must be created.
- The trunk group with common channel signaling must be created.
- The dialing procedure of the trunk group with common channel signaling must
correspond to one of the created user parts for the destination point.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange with common channel signaling
according to signaling system No.7 (CCS7).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,NETIND= 11 1
1 ENTR C7TGREL : TGNO= ,DPC= 1Z,NETNAME=Y1 ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DPC DESTINATION POINT CODE

Network Indicator = NAT0 Units = 4-3-4-3


Network Indicator = INAT0 Units = 3-8-3
Network Indicator = NAT1 Units = 4-3-4-3
Network Indicator = INAT1 Units = 3-8-3

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: DPC-UNIT1=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

b: DPC-UNIT2=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: DPC-UNIT3=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: DPC-UNIT4=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter identifies the ITU network where the destination


point is located.
The value corresponding to this indicator is used in the network
indicator field of the message signalling units sent between two
exchanges.
In the world market, NETIND is mandatory for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.
In U.S. Releases, NETIND is optional for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR C7TGREL- 1+


ENTR C7TGREL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The default value for NETIND is NAT0.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

NETNAME NETWORK NAME

This parameter identifies the signalling network where


the destination point is located by its name ( cf. SIEMENS
Q-MTP-E-STANDARD FOR V13 ). This parameter is mandatory if the
feature "multiple networks" is activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR C7TGREL- 2-


TEST C7TRSTAT
ONDEMAND
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TEST CCS7 TRUNK STATUS

This command starts the circuit group query test for ISUP/BICC trunks.
This test examines if the ISUP/BICC trunk states at the own exchange and
at the partner exchange do match. If any discrepancies are detected,
the trunk states are automatically corrected.
If the parameter SCHED is omitted, the test is started immediately,
otherwise it is started at the scheduled time.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is only permitted for an exchange with common channel signaling
according to signaling system No.7 (CCS7).

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. TEST C7TRSTAT- ONDEMAND ON DEMAND (IMMEDIATELY)


2. TEST C7TRSTAT- SCHED SCHEDULED START (ROUTINE-TEST)

1. Input format

ON DEMAND (IMMEDIATELY)

Input format for starting the circuit group query test on demand
(immediately).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11NETIND= 11 1
1 TEST C7TRSTAT : 1ZNETNAME=Y1 ,DPC= ,USNAME= ,CIC= ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter identifies the ITU network where the destination


point is located.
The value corresponding to this indicator is used in the network
indicator field of the message signalling units sent between two
exchanges.
In the world market, NETIND is mandatory for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.
In U.S. Releases, NETIND is optional for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.
The default value for NETIND is NAT0.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NAT0 NATIONAL NET 0


NAT1 NATIONAL NET 1

NETNAME NETWORK NAME

This parameter identifies the signalling network where


the destination point is located by its name ( cf. SIEMENS
Q-MTP-E-STANDARD). This parameter is mandatory if the
feature "multiple networks" is activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DPC DESTINATION POINT CODE

Network Indicator = NAT0 Units = 4-3-4-3


Network Indicator = INAT0 Units = 3-8-3
Network Indicator = NAT1 Units = 4-3-4-3
Network Indicator = INAT1 Units = 3-8-3

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST C7TRSTAT- 1+


TEST C7TRSTAT
ONDEMAND
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: DPC-UNIT1=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

b: DPC-UNIT2=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: DPC-UNIT3=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: DPC-UNIT4=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

USNAME USER NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ISUP ISDN USER PART

CIC CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE

This parameter specifies the circuit identification code


of the user ISUP.
Wildcard input is allowed as X-X and a-X.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

a-b

a: DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT NUMBER=


0...681, range of decimal numbers

Possible input values:


Within an ANSI or ITU network which support a 12-bit CIC:
- 0...127, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30
- 0...169, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24

Within an ANSI network which supports a 14-bit CIC value:

- 0...511, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30


- 0...681, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: CHANNEL NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

Possible input values:


0...31, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30.
0...23, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST C7TRSTAT- 2+


TEST C7TRSTAT
SCHED
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

SCHEDULED START (ROUTINE-TEST)

Input format for starting the circuit group query test by scheduler
(routine test).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11NETIND= 11 1
1 TEST C7TRSTAT : 1ZNETNAME=Y1 ,DPC= ,USNAME= ,CIC= ,SCHED= ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter identifies the ITU network where the destination


point is located.
The value corresponding to this indicator is used in the network
indicator field of the message signalling units sent between two
exchanges.
In the world market, NETIND is mandatory for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.
In U.S. Releases, NETIND is optional for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.
The default value for NETIND is NAT0.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NAT0 NATIONAL NET 0


NAT1 NATIONAL NET 1

NETNAME NETWORK NAME

This parameter identifies the signalling network where


the destination point is located by its name ( cf. SIEMENS
Q-MTP-E-STANDARD). This parameter is mandatory if the
feature "multiple networks" is activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DPC DESTINATION POINT CODE

Network Indicator = NAT0 Units = 4-3-4-3


Network Indicator = INAT0 Units = 3-8-3
Network Indicator = NAT1 Units = 4-3-4-3
Network Indicator = INAT1 Units = 3-8-3

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: DPC-UNIT1=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: DPC-UNIT2=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: DPC-UNIT3=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: DPC-UNIT4=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST C7TRSTAT- 3+


TEST C7TRSTAT
SCHED
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

USNAME USER NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ISUP ISDN USER PART

CIC CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE

This parameter specifies the circuit identification code


of the user ISUP.
Wildcard input is allowed as X-X and a-X.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

a-b

a: DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT NUMBER=


0...681, range of decimal numbers

Possible input values:


Within an ANSI or ITU network which support a 12-bit CIC:
- 0...127, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30
- 0...169, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24

Within an ANSI network which supports a 14-bit CIC value:

- 0...511, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30


- 0...681, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: CHANNEL NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

Possible input values:


0...31, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30.
0...23, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

SCHED SCHEDULE NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...255, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST C7TRSTAT- 4-


TEST C7TRUNK
DPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TEST CCS7 TRUNK

This command tests the specified circuit to determine if the circuit


identification code in the home exchange matches the circuit
identification in the partner exchange. The test is performed for up
to 31 circuits specified by the optional parameter TRRANGE.
The maximal value for TRRANGE is 24 if the trunks are connected to
a DIU24.
The test result is displayed on the OMT.

Prerequisite:
- The specified circuit must be blocked for maintenance.

Attention:
- The test result "not ok" usually indicates a circuit identification
code allocation mismatch between two exchanges. As an exception,
the result "not ok" is caused by a mismatch between the trunk
parameter LCOS and the created user. The trunk parameter LCOS
can be checked by using the command DISP TRUNK.

- If the test is cancelled by time control, wait for 30 seconds


before repeating the test.

This command is only permitted for an exchange with common channel signaling
according to signaling system No.7 (CCS7).

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. TEST C7TRUNK - DPC


2. TEST C7TRUNK - TGNAM

1. Input format

This input format starts a CIC allocation test. The circuit is


defined by the signaling point to which the associated trunk group
leads, the network indicator, the user part and the circuit identification
code (CIC). The parameter trunk range (TRRANGE) is optional and defines
the number of circuits to be tested by one command. The CIC defines the
first circuit of the circuit group if the parameter TRRANGE is entered.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,NETIND= 11 1
1 TEST C7TRUNK : DPC= ,CIC= 1Z,NETNAME=Y1 ,USNAME= [,TRRANGE=] ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DPC DESTINATION POINT CODE

Network Indicator = NAT0 Units = 4-3-4-3


Network Indicator = INAT0 Units = 3-8-3
Network Indicator = NAT1 Units = 4-3-4-3
Network Indicator = INAT1 Units = 3-8-3

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: DPC-UNIT1=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

b: DPC-UNIT2=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: DPC-UNIT3=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST C7TRUNK- 1+


TEST C7TRUNK
DPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

d: DPC-UNIT4=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

CIC CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE

This parameter specifies the circuit identification code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT NUMBER=


0...681, range of decimal numbers

Possible input values:


Within an ANSI or ITU network which support a 12-bit CIC:
- 0...127, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30
- 0...169, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24

Within an ANSI network which supports a 14-bit CIC value:


- 0...511, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30
- 0...681, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24

b: CHANNEL NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

Possible input values:

0...31, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30.


0...23, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24.

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter identifies the ITU network where the destination


point is located.
The value corresponding to this indicator is used in the network
indicator field of the message signalling units sent between two
exchanges.
In the world market, NETIND is mandatory for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.
In U.S. Releases, NETIND is optional for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.
The default value for NETIND is NAT0.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

NETNAME NETWORK NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

USNAME USER NAME

This parameter specifies the user part.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ISUP ISDN USER PART


SCCP SIGN. CONNECTION CONTROL PART
TUP TELEPHONE USER PART

TRRANGE TRUNK RANGE

This parameter specifies the number of trunks to be tested by


one command. If this parameter is not entered, only the
specified trunk is tested.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST C7TRUNK- 2+


TEST C7TRUNK
DPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST C7TRUNK- 3+


TEST C7TRUNK
TGNAM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

This input format starts a CIC allocation test. The circuit is


specified by the parameters trunk group number (TGNO) and the circuit
identification code (CIC) or the line number (LNO). The parameter trunk
range (TRRANGE) is optional and specifies the number of circuits to be
tested by one command. The parameter CIC or LNO specifies the first circuit
of the circuit group if the parameter TRRANGE is entered.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,CIC=1 1
1 TEST C7TRUNK : TGNO= Z,LNO=Y [,TRRANGE=] ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CIC CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE

This parameter specifies the circuit identification code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT NUMBER=


0...681, range of decimal numbers

Possible input values:


Within an ANSI or ITU network which support a 12-bit CIC:
- 0...127, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30
- 0...169, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24

Within an ANSI network which supports a 14-bit CIC value:


- 0...511, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30
- 0...681, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24

b: CHANNEL NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

Possible input values:

0...31, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30.


0...23, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24.

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16383, range of decimal numbers

TRRANGE TRUNK RANGE

This parameter specifies the number of trunks to be tested by


one command. If this parameter is not entered, only the
specified trunk is tested.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST C7TRUNK- 4-


TEST C7TRVAL
DPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TEST CCS7 TRUNK VALIDATION

This command tests the specified circuit to determine if the circuit


group characteristics in the home exchange match the circuit
group characteristics in the partner exchange. The test is performed
for up to 31 circuits specified by the optional parameter TRRANGE.
The maximal value for TRRANGE is 24 if the trunks are connected to
a DIU24.
The test result is displayed on the OMT.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. TEST C7TRVAL - DPC


2. TEST C7TRVAL - TGNAM

1. Input format

This input format starts a circuit validation test. The circuit is


defined by the signaling point to which the associated trunk group
leads, the network indicator, the user part and the circuit identification
code (CIC). The parameter trunk range (TRRANGE) is optional and defines
the number of circuits to be tested by one command. The CIC defines the
first circuit of the circuit group if the parameter TRRANGE is entered.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,NETIND= 11 1
1 TEST C7TRVAL : DPC= [,CIC=] 1Z,NETNAME=Y1 ,USNAME= 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
1 [,TRRANGE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DPC DESTINATION POINT CODE

Network Indicator = NAT0 Units = 4-3-4-3


Network Indicator = INAT0 Units = 3-8-3
Network Indicator = NAT1 Units = 4-3-4-3
Network Indicator = INAT1 Units = 3-8-3

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: DPC-UNIT1=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: DPC-UNIT2=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: DPC-UNIT3=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: DPC-UNIT4=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

CIC CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE

This parameter specifies the circuit identification code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST C7TRVAL- 1+


TEST C7TRVAL
DPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a-b

a: DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT NUMBER=


0...681, range of decimal numbers

Possible input values:


Within an ANSI or ITU network which support a 12-bit CIC:
- 0...127, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30
- 0...169, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24

Within an ANSI network which supports a 14-bit CIC value:

- 0...511, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30


- 0...681, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24

b: CHANNEL NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

Possible input values:

0..31, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30.


0..23, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24.

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter identifies the ITU network where the destination


point is located.
The value corresponding to this indicator is used in the network
indicator field of the message signalling units sent between two
exchanges.
In the world market, NETIND is mandatory for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.
In U.S. Releases, NETIND is optional for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.
The default value for NETIND is NAT0.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

NETNAME NETWORK NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

USNAME USER NAME

This parameter specifies the user part.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ISUP ISDN USER PART

TRRANGE TRUNK RANGE

This parameter specifies the number of trunks to be tested by


one command. If this parameter is not entered, only the
specified trunk is tested.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31, range of decimal numbers

Default: 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST C7TRVAL- 2+


TEST C7TRVAL
TGNAM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

This input format starts a circuit validation test. The circuit is


specified by the parameters trunk group number (TGNO) and the circuit
identification code (CIC) or the line number (LNO). The parameter trunk
range (TRRANGE) is optional and specifies the number of circuits to be
tested by one command. The parameter CIC or LNO specifies the first circuit
of the circuit group if the parameter TRRANGE is entered.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,CIC=11 1
1 TEST C7TRVAL : TGNO= 1Z,LNO=Y1 [,TRRANGE=] ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CIC CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE

This parameter specifies the circuit identification code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT NUMBER=


0...681, range of decimal numbers

Possible input values:


Within an ANSI or ITU network which support a 12-bit CIC:
- 0...127, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30
- 0...169, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24

Within an ANSI network which supports a 14-bit CIC value:

- 0...511, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30


- 0...681, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24

b: CHANNEL NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

Possible input values:

0..31, if the trunk is connected to a DIU30.


0..23, if the trunk is connected to a DIU24.

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16383, range of decimal numbers

TRRANGE TRUNK RANGE

This parameter specifies the number of trunks to be tested by


one command. If this parameter is not entered, only the
specified trunk is tested.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST C7TRVAL- 3+


TEST C7TRVAL
TGNAM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31, range of decimal numbers

Default: 1

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST C7TRVAL- 4-


CAN C7USER

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CCS7 USER ASSOCIATION

This command cancels an association between a user part and a destination


point.

Prerequisites:
- All trunk group relations must have been cancelled if the user part is
circuit related
- All SCCP relations must have been cancelled if the user part SCCP is
to be cancelled. Possible SCCP relations are: global title translation
destinations, SCCP subsystems or translator service groups.

Possible effects:
- If the execution of this command is aborted by recovery, the command must
be entered again to prevent data inconsistency.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange with common channel signaling
according to signaling system No.7 (CCS7).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,NETIND= 11 1
1 CAN C7USER : USNAME= ,DPC= [,OSPC=] 1Z,NETNAME=Y1 ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

USNAME USER NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SCCP SIGN. CONNECTION CONTROL PART


TUP TELEPHONE USER PART
ISUP ISDN USER PART

DPC DESTINATION POINT CODE

Network Indicator = NAT0 Units = 4-3-4-3


Network Indicator = INAT0 Units = 3-8-3
Network Indicator = NAT1 Units = 4-3-4-3
Network Indicator = INAT1 Units = 3-8-3

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: DPC-UNIT1=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

b: DPC-UNIT2=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

c: DPC-UNIT3=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

d: DPC-UNIT4=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN C7USER- 1+


CAN C7USER

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

OSPC OWN SIGNALLING POINT CODE

The allowable entries are defined by individual PTTs on a project


specific basis.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: OSPC-UNIT1=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

b: OSPC-UNIT2=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: OSPC-UNIT3=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: OSPC-UNIT4=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter identifies the ITU network where the destination


point is located.
The value corresponding to this indicator is used in the network
indicator field of the message signalling units sent between two
exchanges.
In the world market, NETIND is mandatory for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.
In U.S. Releases, NETIND is optional for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.
The default value for NETIND is NAT0.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NET 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NET 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NET 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NET 1

NETNAME NETWORK NAME

This parameter identifies the signalling network where


the destination point is located by its name ( cf. SIEMENS
Q-MTP-E-STANDARD). This parameter is mandatory if the
feature "multiple networks" is activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN C7USER- 2-


CR C7USER

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE CCS7 USER ASSOCIATION

This command creates an association between a user part and a destination


point.

Prerequisites:
- The destination point must have been created.

Possible effects:
- If the execution of this command is aborted by recovery, the command must
be entered again to prevent data inconsistency.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange with common channel signaling
according to signaling system No.7 (CCS7).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,NETIND= 11 1
1 CR C7USER : USNAME= ,DPC= 1Z,NETNAME=Y1 [,PCMTYP=] 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
1 [,CICSIZE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

USNAME USER NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SCCP SIGN. CONNECTION CONTROL PART


Compatibilities:
-INAT0
-INAT1
-NAT0
-NAT1
TUP TELEPHONE USER PART
Compatibilities:
-INAT0
-INAT1
-NAT0
-NAT1
ISUP ISDN USER PART
Compatibilities:
-INAT0
-INAT1
-NAT0
-NAT1

DPC DESTINATION POINT CODE

Network Indicator = NAT0 Units = 4-3-4-3


Network Indicator = INAT0 Units = 3-8-3
Network Indicator = NAT1 Units = 4-3-4-3
Network Indicator = INAT1 Units = 3-8-3

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: DPC-UNIT1=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

b: DPC-UNIT2=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR C7USER- 1+
CR C7USER

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

c: DPC-UNIT3=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

d: DPC-UNIT4=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter identifies the ITU network where the destination


point is located by its indicator .
The value corresponding to this indicator is used in the network
indicator field of the message signalling units sent between two
exchanges.
In the world market, NETIND is mandatory for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.
In U.S. Releases, NETIND is optional. The default value for NETIND
is NAT0.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NET 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NET 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NET 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NET 1

NETNAME NETWORK NAME

This parameter identifies the signalling network where


the destination point is located by its name ( cf. SIEMENS
Q-MTP-E-STANDARD). This parameter is mandatory for
SSNC configuration if the feature "multiple networks" is
activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PCMTYP PCM TYPE

This parameter specifies the used PCM type.


For USNAME=SCCP the parameter is allowed only for mobile switches.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DIU24 DIU 24
DIU30 DIU 30

CICSIZE CIC SIZE

This parameter specifies the size of the CIC (circuit identification


code).
In the world market CICSIZE is optional and only valid for user ISUP
in SSNC configuration.
Possible values:
CIC12 : CIC size 12 Bit
CIC13 : CIC size 13 Bit
CIC14 : CIC size 14 Bit.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CIC12 CIC SIZE 12 BITS


CIC13 CIC SIZE 13 BITS
CIC14 CIC SIZE 14 BITS

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR C7USER- 2-
DISP C7USER

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CCS7 USER ASSOCIATION

This command displays user-related data.

This command is only permitted for an exchange with common channel signaling
according to signaling system No.7 (CCS7).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,NETIND= 11 1
1 DISP C7USER : DPC= [,OSPC=] 1Z,NETNAME=Y1 [,USNAME=] [,CIC=] ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DPC DESTINATION POINT CODE

Network Indicator = NAT0 Units = 4-3-4-3


Network Indicator = INAT0 Units = 3-8-3
Network Indicator = NAT1 Units = 4-3-4-3
Network Indicator = INAT1 Units = 3-8-3

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: DPC-UNIT1=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

b: DPC-UNIT2=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

c: DPC-UNIT3=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

d: DPC-UNIT4=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

OSPC OWN SIGNALLING POINT CODE

The allowable entries are defined by individual PTTs on a project


specific basis.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: OSPC-UNIT1=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

b: OSPC-UNIT2=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: OSPC-UNIT3=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: OSPC-UNIT4=
0...16383, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP C7USER- 1+


DISP C7USER

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter identifies the ITU network where the destination


point is located.
The value corresponding to this indicator is used in the network
indicator field of the message signalling units sent between two
exchanges.
In the world market, NETIND is mandatory for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.
In U.S. Releases, NETIND is optional for CCNC configuration and
SSNC configuration with the "multiple networks" feature not activated.
The default value for NETIND is NAT0.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NET 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NET 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NET 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NET 1

NETNAME NETWORK NAME

This parameter identifies the signalling network where


the destination point is located by its name ( cf. SIEMENS
Q-MTP-E-STANDARD). This parameter is mandatory if the
feature multiple networks is activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

USNAME USER NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SCCP SIGN. CONNECTION CONTROL PART


TUP TELEPHONE USER PART
ISUP ISDN USER PART

CIC CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE=


0...681, range of decimal numbers

b: CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP C7USER- 2-


CR CAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE CARRIER ACCESS CODE

This command creates the carrier access code data.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR CAC [ROWNCAC=] [,EXCCAC1=] [,EXCCAC2=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ROWNCAC REMOVE OWN CARRIER ACCESS CODE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y OWN CAC IS REMOVED


YES OWN CAC IS REMOVED
N OWN CAC IS NOT REMOVED
NO OWN CAC IS NOT REMOVED

Default: YES

EXCCAC1 EXCHANGE CARRIER ACCESS CODE 1

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y CAC IS EXCHANGE CAC 1


YES CAC IS EXCHANGE CAC 1
N CAC IS NOT EXCHANGE CAC 1
NO CAC IS NOT EXCHANGE CAC 1

Default: NO

EXCCAC2 EXCHANGE CARRIER ACCESS CODE 2

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y CAC IS EXCHANGE CAC 2


YES CAC IS EXCHANGE CAC 2
N CAC IS NOT EXCHANGE CAC 2
NO CAC IS NOT EXCHANGE CAC 2

Default: NO

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CAC- 1-
DISP CAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CARRIER ACCESS CODE

The optional paramters reduce the amount of displayed data if they are entered.
All parameters are logically linked with AND, i.e. only those data are displayed
which meet all the entered restrictions.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP CAC : <EXCCAC1= ,EXCCAC2=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

EXCCAC1 EXCHANGE CARRIER ACCESS CODE 1

This parameter specifies that the display is restricted


to those carrierr access codes, which have the selected
value assigned to.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y CAC IS EXCHANGE CAC


YES CAC IS EXCHANGE CAC
N CAC IS NOT EXCHANGE CAC
NO CAC IS NOT EXCHANGE CAC

EXCCAC2 EXCHANGE CARRIER ACCESS CODE 2

This parameter specifies that the display is restricted


to those carrierr access codes, which have the selected
value assigned to.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y CAC IS EXCHANGE CAC


YES CAC IS EXCHANGE CAC
N CAC IS NOT EXCHANGE CAC
NO CAC IS NOT EXCHANGE CAC

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CAC- 1-


MOD CAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY CARRIER ACCESS CODE

This command modifies the carrier access code data.


All parameters can be modified, including the
carrier access code itself.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD CAC <ROWNCAC= ,EXCCAC1= ,EXCCAC2=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ROWNCAC REMOVE OWN CARRIER ACCESS CODE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y OWN CAC IS REMOVED


YES OWN CAC IS REMOVED
N OWN CAC IS NOT REMOVED
NO OWN CAC IS NOT REMOVED

Default: YES

EXCCAC1 EXCHANGE CARRIER ACCESS CODE 1

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y CAC IS EXCHANGE CAC 1


YES CAC IS EXCHANGE CAC 1
N CAC IS NOT EXCHANGE CAC 1
NO CAC IS NOT EXCHANGE CAC 1

EXCCAC2 EXCHANGE CARRIER ACCESS CODE 2

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y CAC IS EXCHANGE CAC 2


YES CAC IS EXCHANGE CAC 2
N CAC IS NOT EXCHANGE CAC 2
NO CAC IS NOT EXCHANGE CAC 2

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CAC- 1-


CAN CACCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CARRIER ACCESS CODE CODE POINT

This command cancels a codepoint for which special handling of carrier


access codes was performed or for which a default carrier access code
was assigned.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,LACOR=11 (;) 1
1 CAN CACCPT : CODE= 1Z,ORIG1=Y1 Z Y 1
1 11 11 *!+ 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE CODE

This parameter specifies a code combination which identifies the called


party (B-side).

The code combination has to be part of the code point of an existing


carrier access code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...18 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LACOR LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING

This parameter specifies an originating local area code which partly


identifies the calling party (A-side).

The local area code originating has to be part of the code point of
an existing carrier access code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies an originating mark which identifies the


calling party (A-side).

The originating mark has to be part of the code point of an existing


carrier access code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3839, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CACCPT- 1-


CR CACCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE CARRIER ACCESS CODE CODE POINT

This command creates an object for which a special handling of carrier access
codes has to be performed and/or which is connected to one of the possible
default carriers.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,LACOR=11 1
1 CR CACCPT : CODE= 1Z,ORIG1=Y1 <,DEFCAC= ,CACSHUC= ,CACSHDI= 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,CACSHPS= ,CACGHUC= ,CACGHDI= ,CACGHPS=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE CODE

This parameter specifies a code combination which identifies the


destination number or a part of it.
The destination number can be a subscriber number (including local area
code), a service number, a national significant number, an
international number or a routing number.

Prerequisites:
- This code combination must be different from all carrier access
codes which were entered with CR CAC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...18 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LACOR LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING

This parameter specifies an originating local area code which partly


identifies the calling party (A-side).

Any local area code which is administered via ENTR AREACODE


can be specified. This applies to all LAC values and to all
LACOR values in the same manner.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies an originating mark which identifies the


calling party (A-side).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3839, range of decimal numbers

DEFCAC DEFAULT CARRIER ACCESS CODE

This parameter specifies which default carrier access code is to be


selected when applicable.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CAC1 CARRIER ACCESS CODE 1


CAC2 CARRIER ACCESS CODE 2

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CACCPT- 1+
CR CACCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CACSHUC CAC SEL. HANDLING. UNCOND.

This parameter specifies a list of carrier access codes for which


special handling of carrier access codes has to be performed.
The handling is applied on a per carrier access code basis.
Dialed and preselected carrier access codes are affected equally.

Notes:
- This parameter makes the input easier for the operator if dialed and
preselected carrier access codes are to be treated in the same
manner.
Any value entered in this parameter is stored, displayed and
regenerated with identical values in the parameters CACSHDI and
CACSHPS.

Prerequisites:
- The specified list must already be created with CR CACLST.

Incompatibilities:
- CACSHDI CACSHPS
- CACGHUC
- CACGHDI CACGHPS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CACSHDI CAC SEL. HANDLING. DIALLED.

This parameter specifies a list of carrier access codes for which


special handling of carrier access codes has to be performed.
This handling is applied on a per carrier access code basis.
Dialed carrier access codes only are affected.

Prerequisites:
- The specified list must already be created with CR CACLST.

Incompatibilities:
- CACSHUC
- CACGHUC
- CACGHDI

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CACSHPS CAC SEL. HANDLING. PRESELEC.

This parameter specifies a list of carrier access codes for which


special handling of carrier access codes has to be performed.
This special handling is applied on a per carrier access code basis.
Preselected carrier access codes only are affected.

Prerequisites:
- The specified list must already be created with CR CACLST.

Incompatibilities:
- CACSHUC
- CACGHUC
- CACGHPS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CACGHUC CAC GLOBAL HANDLING. UNCOND.

This parameter specifies which special handling of carrier access codes


has to be performed. The special handling is applied for all carrier
access codes equally.
Dialed and preselected carrier access codes are affected equally.

Notes:
- This parameter makes the input easier for the operator if dialed and

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CACCPT- 2+
CR CACCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

preselected carrier access codes are to be treated in the same


manner.
Any value entered in this parameter is stored, displayed and
regenerated with identical values in the parameters CACGHDI and
CACGHPS.

Incompatibilities:
- CACSHUC
- CACSHDI CACSHPS
- CACGHDI CACGHPS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IGNORE IGNORE CAC FOR ROUTING


INCEPT INTERCEPT CAC
ROUTE CAC HAS TO BE ROUTED

CACGHDI CAC GLOBAL HANDLING. DIALLED.

This parameter specifies which special handling of carrier access codes


has to be performed. The special handling is applied for all carrier
access codes equally.
Dialed carrier access codes only are affected.

Incompatibilities:
- CACSHUC
- CACSHDI
- CACGHUC

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IGNORE IGNORE CAC FOR ROUTING


INCEPT INTERCEPT CAC
ROUTE CAC HAS TO BE ROUTED

CACGHPS CAC GLOBAL HANDLING. PRESELEC.

This parameter specifies which special handling of carrier access codes


has to be performed. The special handling is applied for all carrier
access codes equally.
Preselected carrier access codes only are affected.

Incompatibilities:
- CACSHUC
- CACSHPS
- CACGHUC

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IGNORE IGNORE CAC FOR ROUTING


INCEPT INTERCEPT CAC
ROUTE CAC HAS TO BE ROUTED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CACCPT- 3-
DISP CACCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CARRIER ACCESS CODE CODEPOINT

This command displays some or all carrier access code points.

An extended display format allows to display additionally carrier access codes.

All entries are displayed if CODE = X is entered.

The optional paramters reduce the amount of displayed data if they are entered.
All parameters are logically linked with AND, i.e. only those data are displayed
which meet all the entered restrictions.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,LACOR=11 (;) 1
1 DISP CACCPT : CODE= 1Z,ORIG1=Y1 [,CACLST=] [,FORMAT=] Z Y 1
1 11 11 *!+ 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE CODE

This parameter specifies the code combination(s) to be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...18 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LACOR LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING

This parameter specifies that the display is restricted to those


carrier access code points which refer to the originating local
area code.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies that the display is restricted to those


carrier access code points which refer to the originating mark.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3839, range of decimal numbers

CACLST CARRIER ACCESS CODE LIST NAME

This parameter specifies that the display is restricted to those


carrier access code points which refer to the carrier access code
list name.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FORMAT OUTPUT FORMAT

This parameter specifies the amount of data displayed.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CACCPT- 1+


DISP CACCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

STD STANDARD DATA


This value specifies that the display contains
carrier access code points (created with
CR CACCPT) only.
WITHCAC WITH CAC
This value specifies that the display contains
carrier access code points
(created with CR CACCPT) and
carrier access codes
(created with CR CAC).

Default: STD

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CACCPT- 2-


MOD CACCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY CARRIER ACCESS CODE CODEPOINT

This command modifies data for a codepoint to a destination for which special
handling of carrier access codes has to be performed and/or which is
connected to one of the possible default carriers.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,LACOR=11 1
1 MOD CACCPT : CODE= 1Z,ORIG1=Y1 <,DEFCAC= ,CACSHUC= ,CACSHDI= 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,CACSHPS= ,CACGHUC= ,CACGHDI= ,CACGHPS= ,CFUNC=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE CODE

This parameter specifies a code combination which identifies the called


party (B-side).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...18 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LACOR LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING

This parameter specifies the local area code of the calling


party (A-side).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the origin of the calling


party (A-side).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3839, range of decimal numbers

DEFCAC DEFAULT CARRIER ACCESS CODE

This parameter specifies which default carrier access code is to be


selected when applicable.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CAC1 CARRIER ACCESS CODE 1


CAC2 CARRIER ACCESS CODE 2

CACSHUC CAC SEL. HANDLING. UNCOND.

This parameter specifies a list of carrier access codes for which


special handling of carrier access codes has to be performed.
The handling is applied on a per carrier access code basis.
Dialed and preselected carrier access codes are affected equally.

Notes:
- This parameter makes the input easier for the operator if dialed and
preselected carrier access codes are to be treated in the same
manner.
Any value entered in this parameter is stored, displayed and

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CACCPT- 1+


MOD CACCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

regenerated with identical values in the parameters CACSHDI and


CACSHPS. It replaces any existing value in those two parameters.

Prerequisites:
- The specified list must already be created with CR CACLST.

Incompatibilities:
- CACSHDI CACSHPS
- CACGHUC
- CACGHDI CACGHPS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CACSHDI CAC SEL. HANDLING. DIALLED.

This parameter specifies a list of carrier access codes for which


special handling of carrier access codes has to be performed.
This handling is applied on a per carrier access code basis.
Dialed carrier access codes only are affected.

Notes:
- Any value entered in this parameter replaces any existing
value of parameter CACGHDI.

Prerequisites:
- The specified list must already be created with CR CACLST.

Incompatibilities:
- CACSHUC
- CACGHUC
- CACGHDI

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CACSHPS CAC SEL. HANDLING. PRESELEC.

This parameter specifies a list of carrier access codes for which


special handling of carrier access codes has to be performed.
This special handling is applied on a per carrier access code basis.
Preselected carrier access codes only are affected.

Notes:
- Any value entered in this parameter replaces any existing
value of parameter CACGHPS.

Prerequisites:
- The specified list must already be created with CR CACLST.

Incompatibilities:
- CACSHUC
- CACGHUC
- CACGHPS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CACGHUC CAC GLOBAL HANDLING. UNCOND.

This parameter specifies which special handling of carrier access codes


has to be performed. The special handling is applied for all carrier
access codes equally.
Dialed and preselected carrier access codes are affected equally.

Notes:
- This parameter makes the input easier for the operator if dialed and
preselected carrier access codes are to be treated in the same
manner.
Any value entered in this parameter is stored, displayed and
regenerated with identical values in the parameters CACGHDI and

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CACCPT- 2+


MOD CACCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CACGHPS.It replaces any existing value in those two parameters.

Incompatibilities:
- CACSHUC
- CACSHDI CACSHPS
- CACGHDI CACGHPS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IGNORE IGNORE CAC FOR ROUTING


INCEPT INTERCEPT CAC
ROUTE CAC HAS TO BE ROUTED

CACGHDI CAC GLOBAL HANDLING. DIALLED.

This parameter specifies which special handling of carrier access codes


has to be performed. The special handling is applied for all carrier
access codes equally.
Dialed carrier access codes only are affected.

Notes:
- Any value entered in this parameter replaces any existing
value of parameter CACSHDI.

Incompatibilities:
- CACSHUC
- CACSHDI
- CACGHUC

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IGNORE IGNORE CAC FOR ROUTING


INCEPT INTERCEPT CAC
ROUTE CAC HAS TO BE ROUTED

CACGHPS CAC GLOBAL HANDLING. PRESELEC.

This parameter specifies which special handling of carrier access codes


has to be performed. The special handling is applied for all carrier
access codes equally.
Preselected carrier access codes only are affected.

Notes:
- Any value entered in this parameter replaces any existing
value of parameter CACSHPS.

Incompatibilities:
- CACSHUC
- CACSHPS
- CACGHUC

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IGNORE IGNORE CAC FOR ROUTING


INCEPT INTERCEPT CAC
ROUTE CAC HAS TO BE ROUTED

CFUNC CANCEL FUNCTION

This parameter specifies a parameter which is to be removed from the


carrier access code point being modified.

Notes:
- At least one parameter has to remain in the code point after the
command has been executed, i.e. empty code points are not allowed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DEFCAC DEFAULT CAC


CACSHUC CAC SEL. HANDLING UNCOND.
CACSHDI CAC SEL. HANDLING DIALLED.
CACSHPS CAC SEL. HANDLING PRESELEC.
CACGHUC CAC GLOBAL HANDLING UNCOND.
CACGHDI CAC GLOBAL HANDLING DIALLED.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CACCPT- 3+


MOD CACCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CACGHPS CAC GLOBAL HANDLING PRESELEC.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CACCPT- 4-


CAN CACLST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CARRIER ACCESS CODE LIST

This command cancels a carrier access code list for which


special carrier routing was performed.

Prerequisites:
- The list is not referred to by a carrier codepoint.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CACLST : NAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the list name to be canceled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CACLST- 1-


CR CACLST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE CARRIER ACCESS CODE LIST

This command creates a list with a new listname and inserts up to 32 carrier
access codes to destinations for which special carrier routing is performed.
The same action is valid for all codes, entered with the create command.
More codes as well as codes with a different ACTION can be entered
with MOD CACLST.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR CACLST : NAME= ,CAC= ,ACTION= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the list name with carrier access codes.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CAC CARRIER ACCESS CODE

This parameter specifies carrier access codes for which special


carrier routing is performed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ACTION ACTION FOR CAC HANDLING

This parameter specifies the action for carrier routing.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IGNORE IGNORE CAC FOR ROUTING


INCEPT INTERCEPT CAC
ROUTE CAC HAS TO BE ROUTED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CACLST- 1-
DISP CACLST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CARRIER ACCESS CODE LIST

This command displays some or all carrier access code lists.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP CACLST : NAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the list name(s) to be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CACLST- 1-


MOD CACLST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY CARRIER ACCESS CODE LIST

This command modifies a carrier access code list.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD CACLST : NAME= [,CAC= ,ACTION=] [,CCAC=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the list being modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CAC CARRIER ACCESS CODE

This parameter specifies carrier access code(s)


to be added to the list.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ACTION ACTION FOR CAC HANDLING

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IGNORE IGNORE CAC FOR ROUTING


INCEPT INTERCEPT CAC
ROUTE CAC HAS TO BE ROUTED

CCAC CANCEL CARRIER ACCESS CODE

This parameter specifies carrier access code(s) to be


removed from the list.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CACLST- 1-


CAN CALIDREC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL MALICIOUS CALL ID REC. CENTER

This command cancels the recording center specified with the entered recording
center identification number.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CALIDREC : CALIDREC= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CALIDREC MALICIOUS CALL ID REC. CENTER

This parameter identifies the recording center to be canceled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CALIDREC- 1-


CR CALIDREC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE MALICIOUS CALL ID REC. CENTER

This command creates the data for a malicious call recording center.
The entered data specifies the recorder identification number,
the recording center directory number and, if needed, certain
features.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR CALIDREC : CALIDREC= ,DNREC= [,CUGILC=] [,CUGDNIC=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,SINGCON=] [,COLPREQ=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CALIDREC MALICIOUS CALL ID REC. CENTER

This parameter identifies the recording center to be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5, range of decimal numbers

DNREC DN OF RECORDING CENTER

This parameter specifies the national significant directory number of


the recording center.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CUGILC CUG INTERLOCK CODE

This parameter specifies the national closed user group interlock code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...65535, range of decimal numbers

CUGDNIC CUG DATA NETWORK IDENT. CODE

This parameter specifies the international closed user group


identification code.
Notes:
- This parameter is only allowed if CUGILC value is also specified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

SINGCON SINGLE CONNECTION CALL CONTENT

This parameter specifies wether call content data is transmitted


via one single 64 kb connection to the recording center as the sum
of information of A and B sides (value YES) or whether the A and B
sides information is separately transmitted via two 64 kb connections
(value NO).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DOUBLE CONNECTION CALL CONTENT


NO DOUBLE CONNECTION CALL CONTENT
Y SINGLE CONNECTION CALL CONTENT
YES SINGLE CONNECTION CALL CONTENT

Default: NO

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CALIDREC- 1+
CR CALIDREC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

COLPREQ CONNECTED LINE PRESENT.REQUEST

This parameter specifies whether the call content connection has to be


protected by using the COLP feature.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO COLP REQUEST
NO NO COLP REQUEST
Y COLP REQUEST
YES COLP REQUEST

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CALIDREC- 2-
DISP CALIDREC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY MALICIOUS CALL ID REC. CENTER

This command displays data of one recording center specified with the entered
malicious call recording center identification number or the data of all
created centers.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP CALIDREC : CALIDREC= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CALIDREC MALICIOUS CALL ID REC. CENTER

This parameter identifies the recording center to be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CALIDREC- 1-


MOD CALIDREC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY MALICIOUS CALL ID REC. CENTER

This command modifies the data of a malicious call recording center.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD CALIDREC : CALIDREC= <,NDNREC= ,NCUGILC= ,CCUGILC= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,NCUGDNIC= ,CCUGDNIC= ,SINGCON= ,COLPREQ=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CALIDREC MALICIOUS CALL ID REC. CENTER

This parameter identifies the recording center to be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5, range of decimal numbers

NDNREC NEW DN OF RECORDING CENTER

This parameter specifies the new national significant directory number


of the recording center.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NCUGILC NEW CUG INTERLOCK CODE

This parameter specifies the new international closed user group


identification code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...65535, range of decimal numbers

CCUGILC CANCEL CUG INTERLOCK CODE

This parameter specifies the international closed user group


identification code to be canceled.
Notes:
- This parameter is only allowed if no CUGDNIC is present in the
database or if CCUGDNIC is also specified.
- This parameter is incompatible with NCUGILC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...65535, range of decimal numbers

NCUGDNIC NEW CUG NETWORK IDENT.CODE

This parameter specifies the new national closed user group interlock
code.
Notes:
- This parameter is only allowed if a CUGILC is present in the
database or if NCUGILC is also specified.
- This parameter is incompatible with CCUGILC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

CCUGDNIC CANCEL CUG NETWORK IDENT.CODE

This parameter specifies the national closed user group interlock

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALIDREC- 1+


MOD CALIDREC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

code to be canceled.
Notes:
- This parameter is incompatible with NCUGDNIC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

SINGCON SINGLE CONNECTION CALL CONTENT

This parameter specifies wether call content data is transmitted


via one single 64 kb connection to the recording center as the sum
of information of A and B sides (value YES) or whether the A and B
sides information is separately transmitted via two 64 kb connections
(value NO).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DOUBLE CONNECTION CALL CONTENT


NO DOUBLE CONNECTION CALL CONTENT
Y SINGLE CONNECTION CALL CONTENT
YES SINGLE CONNECTION CALL CONTENT

Default: NO

COLPREQ CONNECTED LINE PRESENT.REQUEST

This parameter specifies whether the call content connection has to be


protected by using the COLP feature.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO COLP REQUEST
NO NO COLP REQUEST
Y COLP REQUEST
YES COLP REQUEST

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALIDREC- 2-


CAN CALLBACK
DEACT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CALLBACK SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES

This command withdraws, erases or deactivates call back service


to the given MSIN.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CAN CALLBACK - DEACT DEACTIVATION


2. CAN CALLBACK - ERASE ERASURE
3. CAN CALLBACK - WITHDRAW WITHDRAWAL

1. Input format

DEACTIVATION

Input format for deactivation of call back services.


Deactivation is an action to prevent execution of call back call
diversion service.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CALLBACK : MSIN= ,SHRTCD= ,STATUS= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

SHRTCD SHORT CODE OF VOICE MAIL SERV.

This parameter indentifies a Voice Mail Service.


It is stored in the Voice Mail Service Table of the HLR and is used as
index to this table.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...3 digit decimal number

STATUS STATUS

This parameter specifies if erasure or deactivation of the call


back service is requested.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVATION

Default: REG

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CALLBACK- 1+


CAN CALLBACK
ERASE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

ERASURE

Input format of erasure of call back services.


Erasure is an action to delete data registered in the network for
call back call diversion service.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CALLBACK : MSIN= ,SHRTCD= [,STATUS=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

SHRTCD SHORT CODE OF VOICE MAIL SERV.

This parameter indentifies a Voice Mail Service.


It is stored in the Voice Mail Service Table of the HLR and is used as
index to this table.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...3 digit decimal number

STATUS STATUS

This parameter specifies if erasure or deactivation of the call


back service is requested.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

REG REGISTRATION

Default: REG

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CALLBACK- 2+


CAN CALLBACK
WITHDRAW
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

WITHDRAWAL

Input format for withdrawal of call back services.


Withdrawal is an action to remove the call back service from the
subscriber’s access.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CALLBACK : MSIN= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CALLBACK- 3-


ENTR CALLBACK
ACTIVATE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CALLBACK SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES

This command provides, registers or activates call back service


to the given MSIN.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ENTR CALLBACK- ACTIVATE ACTIVATION


2. ENTR CALLBACK- PROVIDE PROVISION
3. ENTR CALLBACK- REGISTER REGISTRATION

1. Input format

ACTIVATION

Input format for activation of call back services.


Activation is an action which enables execution of call back call
diversion service.

Notes:
- To activate Call Back the parameter SHRTCD has to be
entered if the actual state is provisioned. If the status is
registered, it is possible to enter the command without the
parameter SHRTCD.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CALLBACK : MSIN= [,SHRTCD=] ,STATUS= [,RCTIM=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

SHRTCD SHORT CODE OF VOICE MAIL SERV.

This parameter identifies a Voice Mail Service.


It is stored in the Voice Mail Service Table of the HLR and is used as
index to this table.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...3 digit decimal number

STATUS STATUS

This parameter specifies whether registration or activation of the


call back service is requested.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVATION

RCTIM NO REPLY CONDITION TIMER

This parameter specifies the no reply condition timer for call back.
The default is project dependent.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CALLBACK- 1+


ENTR CALLBACK
ACTIVATE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

5,10,15,20,25,30, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CALLBACK- 2+


ENTR CALLBACK
PROVIDE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

PROVISION

Input format for provision of call back services.


Provision is an action to provide call back service to the mobile
subscriber.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CALLBACK : MSIN= [,RCTIM=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

RCTIM NO REPLY CONDITION TIMER

This parameter specifies the no reply condition timer for call back.
The default is project dependent.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

5,10,15,20,25,30, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CALLBACK- 3+


ENTR CALLBACK
REGISTER
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

REGISTRATION

Input format for registration of call back services.


Registration is an action to store data needed for call back call
diversion operations in the network.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CALLBACK : MSIN= ,SHRTCD= [,RCTIM=] [,STATUS=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

SHRTCD SHORT CODE OF VOICE MAIL SERV.

This parameter identifies a Voice Mail Service.


It is stored in the Voice Mail Service Table of the HLR and is used as
index to this table.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...3 digit decimal number

RCTIM NO REPLY CONDITION TIMER

This parameter specifies the no reply condition timer for call back.
The default is project dependent.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

5,10,15,20,25,30, range of decimal numbers

STATUS STATUS

This parameter specifies whether registration or activation of the


call back service is requested.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

REG REGISTRATION

Default: REG

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CALLBACK- 4-


DISP CALLDAT
EQN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CALL PROCESSING DATA

This command displays a snapshot of the contents of the transient CP and GP


resources for one or more ports. The resources must have a state which is
not idle.
The command displays the CP resources CHR, CPB, BOR, BKR, CQI,
CRL and TCB, as well as the GP resources CALLREG, LST, and DPS.

One or more ports can be specified by the equipment number.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP CALLDAT - EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER


2. DISP CALLDAT - LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

1. Input format

EQUIPMENT NUMBER

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CALLDAT : EQN= [,FORMAT=] [,TYPE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER

This parameter defines the equipment number.

Notes:
- The following qualifications of the port are allowed:

LTG: EQN = a-b-c-d one specific port


EQN = a-b-X all ports of an LTG
EQN = a-b-c all ports of an LTU
EQN = a-b-X-d one specific port in each LTU

DLU: EQN = a-b-c-d one specific DLU port


EQN = a-b-X all DLU ports of a shelf
EQN = a-b-c all DLU ports of a module
EQN = a-b-X-d one specific DLU port in each module

V5IF: EQN = a-b-c-d one specific V5IF port

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c[-d]

a: TSG / DLU OR V5IF NUMBER=


0...8999, range of decimal numbers

For LTG port: a TSG number in the range 0...7


For DLU port: a DLU number in the range 10...2550
(in steps of 10)
For V5IF port: a V5IF number in the range 6000...8999

b: LTG / SHELF=
0...63, range of decimal numbers

For LTG port: an LTG number in the range 1...63


For DLU port: a shelf in the range 0...7
For V5IF port: 0

c: LTU / MODULE OR V5IF PORT NUMBER=


0...20, range of decimal numbers

For LTG port: an LTU number in the range 0...7

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CALLDAT- 1+


DISP CALLDAT
EQN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

For DLU port: a module number in the range 0...15


For V51IF port: 0
For V52IF port: a V52IF port number in the range 0...20

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

d: CHANNEL / CIRCUIT OR V5IF PORT NUMBER=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

For LTG port: a channel number in the range 0...31


For DLU port: a circuit number in the range
0...7 for SLM with 8 ports
0...15 for SLM with 16 ports
0...32 for SLM with 32 ports
For V51IF port: a V51IF port number in the range 0...31
For V52IF port: a V52IF port number in the range 0...99

FORMAT OUTPUT FORMAT

This parameter specifies the display format.

Notes:
- The format parameter values DATA and BOTH are allowed only if
the parameter TYPE is unsupplied or if it is supplied with CHR.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(BOTH ) DISPLAY IN HEX AND STRUCTURED


1 1 Only for CHR (channel register).
1 1 For the equipment number range, the
1 1 channel registers found are displayed first
1 1 in structured format, followed by
1 1 an output of the channel registers in
1 1 hexadecimal format.
1 1 To identify a channel register in the structured
1 1 list and in the hexadecimal list,
Z Y the processor number and the speech channel number
1 1 are also displayed in both output formats.
1 1 Since the tailing zeros are suppressed in the
1 1 hexadecimal output, the channel register may
1 1 be displayed with different length.
1BYTE 1 DISPLAY IN HEXADECIMAL FORMAT
1 1 This is the standard output format for all types
1 1 of resources.
1 1 Tailing zeros are suppressed in the output of
1 1 each resource. As a result, the displays may show
1 1 the resource with different lengths.
*DATA + DISPLAY IN STRUCTURED FORMAT
Only for CHR (channel register).
For the equipment number range, the
channel registers found are displayed
in structured format.

Default: BYTE

TYPE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the resource to be displayed.

Note:
- If the TYPE and FORMAT parameters are omitted, the
searching for data of the equipment number includes all supported
CP and GP resources. This has as condition that there is a channel
register not idle linked to this equipment number.

- If a GP resource is specifically requested, a display is attempted


regardless of the state of the channel register in CP.

Output formats dependent on input


+---------------------------------+----------------------------------+
! Input: ! Output format: !
! ! !
! TYPE= !FORMAT= ! hexadecimal structured !
! ! +---------------------+------------+
! a b c d e f g h i k ! ! a b c d e f g h i k !Channel reg.!

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CALLDAT- 2+


DISP CALLDAT
EQN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

+---------------------+-----------+---------------------+------------+
! - - - - - - - - - - ! - ! x x x x x x x x x x ! - !
! - - - - - - - - - - ! Y ! x x x x x x x x x x ! - !
! - - - - - - - - - - ! D ! - - - - - - - - - - ! x !
! - - - - - - - - - - ! B ! x - - - - - - - - - ! x !
! x - - - - - - - - - ! - ! x - - - - - - - - - ! - !
! - x - - - - - - - - ! - ! - x - - - - - - - - ! - !
! - - x - - - - - - - ! - ! - - x - - - - - - - ! - !
! - - - x - - - - - - ! - ! - - - x - - - - - - ! - !
! - - - - x - - - - - ! - ! - - - - x - - - - - ! - !
! - - - - - x - - - - ! - ! - - - - - x - - - - ! - !
! - - - - - - x - - - ! - ! - - - - - - x - - - ! - !
! - - - - - - - x - - ! - ! - - - - - - - x - - ! - !
! - - - - - - - - x - ! - ! - - - - - - - - x - ! - !
! - - - - - - - - - x ! - ! - - - - - - - - - x ! - !
! x - - - - - - - - - ! Y ! x - - - - - - - - - ! - !
! - x - - - - - - - - ! Y ! - x - - - - - - - - ! - !
! - - x - - - - - - - ! Y ! - - x - - - - - - - ! - !
! - - - x - - - - - - ! Y ! - - - x - - - - - - ! - !
! - - - - x - - - - - ! Y ! - - - - x - - - - - ! - !
! - - - - - x - - - - ! Y ! - - - - - x - - - - ! - !
! - - - - - - x - - - ! Y ! - - - - - - x - - - ! - !
! - - - - - - - x - - ! Y ! - - - - - - - x - - ! - !
! - - - - - - - - x - ! Y ! - - - - - - - - x - ! - !
! - - - - - - - - - x ! Y ! - - - - - - - - - x ! - !
! x - - - - - - - - - ! D ! - - - - - - - - - - ! x !
! - x - - - - - - - - ! D ! ) !
! - - x - - - - - - - ! D ! ! !
! - - - x - - - - - - ! D ! ! !
! - - - - x - - - - - ! D ! ! This combination results !
! - - - - - x - - - - ! D ! > in an error message !
! - - - - - - x - - - ! D ! ! !
! - - - - - - - x - - ! D ! ! !
! - - - - - - - - x - ! D ! ) !
! - - - - - - - - - x ! D ! ) !
! x - - - - - - - - - ! B ! x - - - - - - - - - ! x !
! - x - - - - - - - - ! B ! ) !
! - - x - - - - - - - ! B ! ! !
! - - - x - - - - - - ! B ! ! !
! - - - - x - - - - - ! B ! ! This combination results !
! - - - - - x - - - - ! B ! > in an error message !
! - - - - - - x - - - ! B ! ! !
! - - - - - - - x - - ! B ! ! !
! - - - - - - - - x - ! B ! ) !
! - - - - - - - - - x ! B ! ) !
+---------------------+-----------+----------------------------------+
TYPE=TYPE, FORMAT=FORMAT,
Y=BYTE,
D=DATA,
B=BOTH

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(BKR ) BOOKING REGISTER


1 1 Resource in CP
1 1 Table number: d = booking register
1BOR 1 OPERATOR BILLING REGISTER
1 1 Resource in CP
1 1 Table number: c = operator billing register
1CALLREG 1 CALL REGISTER
1 1 Resource in GP
1 1 Table number: h = call register
1CHR 1 CHANNEL REGISTER
1 1 Resource in CP
Z Y Table number: a = channel register
1CPB 1 CALL PROCESSING BUFFER
1 1 Resource in CP
1 1 Table number: b = call processing buffer
1CQI 1 COMMON QUEUEING INDEX TABLE
1 1 Resource in CP
1 1 Table number: e = common queueing index table
1DPS 1 DLU PORT STATUS TABLE
1 1 Resource in GP
1 1 Table number: k = DLU port status table
1LST 1 LINE STATUS TABLE
1 1 Resource in GP
1 1 Table number: i = line status table

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CALLDAT- 3+


DISP CALLDAT
EQN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

*TCB + TRANSACTION CONTROL BLOCK


Resource in CP
Table number: f = transaction control block

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CALLDAT- 4+


DISP CALLDAT
LTG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

LINE TRUNK GROUP

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CALLDAT : LTG= [,LC=] [,FORMAT=] [,TYPE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNG GROUP

This parameter specifies the line trunk group of the set of objects to
be traced.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

LTGSET : 0..31

Dependent on the Switching Network Hardware this unit


represents the Time Stage Group (TSG for SNB) or the
Switching Network MULTIPLEXER (SNMUX for SND
and upper ones)

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


0...63, range of decimal numbers

LTG : 1..63

LC LINE CONNECTION

This parameter specifies the line connection of a LTG.

Notes:
- The input of this parameter is only valid in combination
with the LTG parameter.

- The following input is allowed:

LC = X
LC = a
LC = a-b

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: LTU NO.OF A LTG=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

LTU : 0..7

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: CHANNEL OF A LTG PORT=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

Channel : 0..31

FORMAT OUTPUT FORMAT

This parameter specifies the display format.

Notes:
- The format parameter values DATA and BOTH are allowed only if
the parameter TYPE is unsupplied or if it is supplied with CHR.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CALLDAT- 5+


DISP CALLDAT
LTG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(BOTH ) DISPLAY IN HEX AND STRUCTURED


1 1 Only for CHR (channel register).
1 1 For the equipment number range, the
1 1 channel registers found are displayed first
1 1 in structured format, followed by
1 1 an output of the channel registers in
1 1 hexadecimal format.
1 1 To identify a channel register in the structured
1 1 list and in the hexadecimal list,
Z Y the processor number and the speech channel number
1 1 are also displayed in both output formats.
1 1 Since the tailing zeros are suppressed in the
1 1 hexadecimal output, the channel register may
1 1 be displayed with different length.
1BYTE 1 DISPLAY IN HEXADECIMAL FORMAT
1 1 This is the standard output format for all types
1 1 of resources.
1 1 Tailing zeros are suppressed in the output of
1 1 each resource. As a result, the displays may show
1 1 the resource with different lengths.
*DATA + DISPLAY IN STRUCTURED FORMAT
Only for CHR (channel register).
For the equipment number range, the
channel registers found are displayed
in structured format.

Default: BYTE

TYPE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the resource to be displayed.

Note:
- If the TYPE and FORMAT parameters are omitted, the
searching for data of the equipment number includes all supported
CP and GP resources. This has as condition that there is a channel
register not idle linked to this equipment number.

- If a GP resource is specifically requested, a display is attempted


regardless of the state of the channel register in CP.

Output formats dependent on input


+---------------------------------+----------------------------------+
! Input: ! Output format: !
! ! !
! TYPE= !FORMAT= ! hexadecimal structured !
! ! +---------------------+------------+
! a b c d e f g h i k ! ! a b c d e f g h i k !Channel reg.!
+---------------------+-----------+---------------------+------------+
! - - - - - - - - - - ! - ! x x x x x x x x x x ! - !
! - - - - - - - - - - ! Y ! x x x x x x x x x x ! - !
! - - - - - - - - - - ! D ! - - - - - - - - - - ! x !
! - - - - - - - - - - ! B ! x - - - - - - - - - ! x !
! x - - - - - - - - - ! - ! x - - - - - - - - - ! - !
! - x - - - - - - - - ! - ! - x - - - - - - - - ! - !
! - - x - - - - - - - ! - ! - - x - - - - - - - ! - !
! - - - x - - - - - - ! - ! - - - x - - - - - - ! - !
! - - - - x - - - - - ! - ! - - - - x - - - - - ! - !
! - - - - - x - - - - ! - ! - - - - - x - - - - ! - !
! - - - - - - x - - - ! - ! - - - - - - x - - - ! - !
! - - - - - - - x - - ! - ! - - - - - - - x - - ! - !
! - - - - - - - - x - ! - ! - - - - - - - - x - ! - !
! - - - - - - - - - x ! - ! - - - - - - - - - x ! - !
! x - - - - - - - - - ! Y ! x - - - - - - - - - ! - !
! - x - - - - - - - - ! Y ! - x - - - - - - - - ! - !
! - - x - - - - - - - ! Y ! - - x - - - - - - - ! - !
! - - - x - - - - - - ! Y ! - - - x - - - - - - ! - !
! - - - - x - - - - - ! Y ! - - - - x - - - - - ! - !
! - - - - - x - - - - ! Y ! - - - - - x - - - - ! - !
! - - - - - - x - - - ! Y ! - - - - - - x - - - ! - !
! - - - - - - - x - - ! Y ! - - - - - - - x - - ! - !
! - - - - - - - - x - ! Y ! - - - - - - - - x - ! - !
! - - - - - - - - - x ! Y ! - - - - - - - - - x ! - !
! x - - - - - - - - - ! D ! - - - - - - - - - - ! x !

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CALLDAT- 6+


DISP CALLDAT
LTG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

! - x - - - - - - - - ! D ! ) !
! - - x - - - - - - - ! D ! ! !
! - - - x - - - - - - ! D ! ! !
! - - - - x - - - - - ! D ! ! This combination results !
! - - - - - x - - - - ! D ! > in an error message !
! - - - - - - x - - - ! D ! ! !
! - - - - - - - x - - ! D ! ! !
! - - - - - - - - x - ! D ! ) !
! - - - - - - - - - x ! D ! ) !
! x - - - - - - - - - ! B ! x - - - - - - - - - ! x !
! - x - - - - - - - - ! B ! ) !
! - - x - - - - - - - ! B ! ! !
! - - - x - - - - - - ! B ! ! !
! - - - - x - - - - - ! B ! ! This combination results !
! - - - - - x - - - - ! B ! > in an error message !
! - - - - - - x - - - ! B ! ! !
! - - - - - - - x - - ! B ! ! !
! - - - - - - - - x - ! B ! ) !
! - - - - - - - - - x ! B ! ) !
+---------------------+-----------+----------------------------------+
TYPE=TYPE, FORMAT=FORMAT,
Y=BYTE,
D=DATA,
B=BOTH

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(BKR ) BOOKING REGISTER


1 1 Resource in CP
1 1 Table number: d = booking register
1BOR 1 OPERATOR BILLING REGISTER
1 1 Resource in CP
1 1 Table number: c = operator billing register
1CALLREG 1 CALL REGISTER
1 1 Resource in GP
1 1 Table number: h = call register
1CHR 1 CHANNEL REGISTER
1 1 Resource in CP
Z Y Table number: a = channel register
1CPB 1 CALL PROCESSING BUFFER
1 1 Resource in CP
1 1 Table number: b = call processing buffer
1CQI 1 COMMON QUEUEING INDEX TABLE
1 1 Resource in CP
1 1 Table number: e = common queueing index table
1DPS 1 DLU PORT STATUS TABLE
1 1 Resource in GP
1 1 Table number: k = DLU port status table
1LST 1 LINE STATUS TABLE
1 1 Resource in GP
1 1 Table number: i = line status table
*TCB + TRANSACTION CONTROL BLOCK
Resource in CP
Table number: f = transaction control block

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CALLDAT- 7-


DISP CALLPOPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CALL PROCESSING OPTIONS

This command displays exchange parameters related to call processing.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CALLPOPT : <FORMAT= ,SERV= ,ADMSERV=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FORMAT OUTPUT MASK FORM

This parameter is for displaying a table with the values of exchange


parameters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

OPTIONS CALL PROCESSING OPTIONS

SERV INTERNAL SERVICE COMPATIBILITY

This parameter is for displaying a table containing


service types and all compatible services for one or
more internal services.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

TANALOG TRAFFIC ANALOG MODE


TCMSPEEC TRAFFIC CIRCUIT MODE SPEECH
TCMUNRST TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE UNRESTR.
TCMAUDIO TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE 3.1KHZ AUDIO
TCMAUDI7 TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE 7KHZ AUDIO
TCMSERV6 TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE SERVICE 06
TCMSERV7 TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE SERVICE 07
TUNKNOWN TRAFFIC UNKNOWN BEARER SERV.
TPMBCHAN TRAFFIC PACKET MODE B-CHANNEL
TPMDCHAN TRAFFIC PACKET MODE D-CHANNEL
TPMBDCHA TRAFFIC PACKET MODE BD-CHANNEL
TTEL3K TRAFFIC TELEPHONY ISDN 3.1KHZ
TTEL7K TRAFFIC TELEPHONY ISDN 7KHZ
TFAX3 TRAFFIC TELEFAX GROUP 2/3
TFAX4 TRAFFIC TELEFAX GROUP 4
TTTX64K TRAFFIC TELETEX 64 KBIT/S
TVIDEOTX TRAFFIC VIDEOTEXT
TVIDEOTL TRAFFIC VIDEOTELEPHONY
TSERV19 TRAFFIC SERVICE 19
TSERV20 TRAFFIC SERVICE 20
TSERV21 TRAFFIC SERVICE 21
TSERV22 TRAFFIC SERVICE 22
TSERV23 TRAFFIC SERVICE 23
TSERV24 TRAFFIC SERVICE 24
TSERV25 TRAFFIC SERVICE 25
TSERV26 TRAFFIC SERVICE 26
TSERV27 TRAFFIC SERVICE 27
TSPCONN TRAFFIC SEMIPERM. CONNECTION
TSERV29 TRAFFIC SERVICE 29
TSERV30 TRAFFIC SERVICE 30
TSERV31 TRAFFIC SERVICE 31
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

ADMSERV ADMIN. SERVICE COMPATIBILITY

This parameter is for displaying a table containing


service types and all compatible services for one or
more administrative services.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ANALOG ANALOG MODE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CALLPOPT- 1+


DISP CALLPOPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CMSPEECH CIRCUIT MODE SPEECH


CMUNRST CM UNRESTRICTED DIGITAL INFO.
CMAUDIO CIRCUIT MODE 3.1KHZ AUDIO
CMAUDI7K CIRCUIT MODE 7KHZ AUDIO
CMSERV6 CIRCUIT MODE SERVICE 06
CMSERV7 CIRCUIT MODE SERVICE 07
UNKNOWN UNKNOWN BEARER SERVICE
PMBCHANN PACKET MODE B-CHANNEL
PMDCHANN PACKET MODE D-CHANNEL
PMBDCHAN PACKET MODE BD-CHANNEL
TEL3K TELEPHONY ISDN 3.1KHZ
TEL7K TELEPHONY ISDN 7KHZ
FAX3 TELEFAX GROUP 2/3
FAX4 TELEFAX GROUP 4
TTX64K TELETEX 64 KBIT/S
VIDEOTEX VIDEOTEXT
VIDEOTEL VIDEOTELEPHONY
SERV19 SERVICE 19
SERV20 SERVICE 20
SERV21 SERVICE 21
SERV22 SERVICE 22
SERV23 SERVICE 23
SERV24 SERVICE 24
SERV25 SERVICE 25
SERV26 SERVICE 26
SERV27 SERVICE 27
SPCONN SEMIPERMANENT CONNECTION
NONVCGRP NONVOICE SERVICES GROUP
VOICEGRP VOICE SERVICES GROUP
ALLGRP ALL SERVICES GROUP
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CALLPOPT- 2-


MOD CALLPOPT
ADMSERV
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY CALL PROCESSING OPTIONS

This command modifies the exchange parameters and the services related to
Call Processing.
In the following a description is given for
- modification of administrative services
- input of exchange parameters
- modification of internal services for one service
- modification of internal services for several services.
Note: The input of exchange parameters is always possible with the
input for modification of internal and administrative services.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD CALLPOPT - ADMSERV MODIFIC. ADMINISTRATIVE SERVICES


2. MOD CALLPOPT - OPTIONS OPTIONS
3. MOD CALLPOPT - SERV MODIFIC. ONE INTERNAL SERVICE
4. MOD CALLPOPT - SERVTYPE MODIFIC. SEVERAL INTERNAL SERVICES

1. Input format

MODIFIC. ADMINISTRATIVE SERVICES

This input format modifies the powersets of services (exept the powerset of
internal services) for one or more administrative services.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD CALLPOPT : ADMSERV= <,TYPE= ,CTYPE=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ADMSERV ADMINISTRATIVE SERVICE

This parameter specifies the administrative service that has values to


be modified.

Notes:
- This parameter must always be entered with at least one
of the parameters TYPE, CTYPE.
- The values of parameter ADMSERV are verified against the
powersets of administrative services.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ALLGRP ALL SERVICES GROUP


ANALOG ANALOG MODE
CMAUDIO CIRC.MODE 3.1KHZ AUDIO
CMAUDI7K CIRC.MODE 7KHZ AUDIO
CMSERV6 CIRC.MODE SERVICE 06
CMSERV7 CIRC.MODE SERVICE 07
CMSPEECH CIRC.MODE SPEECH
CMUNRST CIRC.MODE UNRESTR.DIGITAL INFO
FAX3 TELEFAX GROUP 2/3
FAX4 TELEFAX GROUP 4
NONVCGRP NONVOICE SERVICES GROUP
PMBCHANN PACKET MODE B-CHANNEL
PMBDCHAN PACKET MODE BD-CHANNEL
PMDCHANN PACKET MODE D-CHANNEL
SERV19 SERVICE 19
SERV20 SERVICE 20
SERV21 SERVICE 21
SERV22 SERVICE 22
SERV23 SERVICE 23
SERV24 SERVICE 24
SERV25 SERVICE 25
SERV26 SERVICE 26

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 1+


MOD CALLPOPT
ADMSERV
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SERV27 SERVICE 27
SPCONN SEMIPERMANENT CONNECTION
TEL3K TELEPHONY ISDN 3.1KHZ
TEL7K TELEPHONY ISDN 7KHZ
TTX64K TELETEX 64 KBIT/S
UNKNOWN UNKNOWN BEARER SERVICE
VIDEOTEL VIDEOTELEPHONY
VIDEOTEX VIDEOTEXT
VOICEGRP VOICE SERVICES GROUP

TYPE SERVICE TYPE

This parameter specifies the set of services where the entered


service shall be added.

Notes:
- This parameter must always be entered with parameter
SERV or ADMSERV.
- The TRAFFIC ,VOICE services can only be
modified using parameter SERV.
- All other service types are administrative services and can
only be modified using parameter ADMSERV.
- All VOICE services must also be contained in the powerset of
TRAFFIC services.
- All SCIVOICE services must also be contained in the powerset of
VOICE services except for ADMSERV is VOICEGRP and ALLGRP.
In case of ADMSERV is NONVCGRP SCIVOICE is not possible.
- All standard services must also be contained in the powerset of
the corresponding administrative service.
- The following parameter values are only allowed during Installation
Recovery : TRAFFIC, (only for internal services)
VOICE, (only for internal services)
SCIVOICE, (only for administrative services)
ADMIN, (only for adminstrative services)
SUB, (only for adminstrative services)
SUB1TR6, (only for adminstrative services)
PHI, (only for adminstrative services)
FH, (only for adminstrative services)
QSIG, (only for adminstrative services)

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ADMIN ADMINISTRATIVE SERVICE


CONFL LARGE CONFERENCE
FH FRAME HANDLER SERVICE
FHSTD FRAME HANDLER SERVICE STANDARD
IDSB ISDN-DSB SERVICE
PHI PACKET HANDLER INTERFACE SERV.
PHISTD PHI SERVICE STANDARD
QSIG Q-SIGNALLING SERVICE
QSIGSTD Q-SIGNALLING SERVICE STANDARD
SCIVOICE SCI VOICE SERVICE
SUB SUBSCRIBER SERVICE
SUBSTD SUBSCRIBER SERVICE STANDARD
SUB1TR6 1TR6-SUBSCRIBER SERVICE
SUB1TR6S 1TR6-SUBSCR. SERVICE STANDARD

CTYPE CANCEL SERVICE TYPE

This parameter specifies the set of services from which the entered
service shall be deleted.

Notes:
- This parameter must always be entered with parameter
SERV or ADMSERV.
- The TRAFFIC,VOICE services can only be
modified using parameter SERV.
- All other service types are administrative services and can
only be modified using parameter ADMSERV.
- In the case of CTYPE = TRAFFIC the complete sequence of
administrative services for the addressed TRAFFIC service in
the compatibility tables will be deleted automatically.
- In the case of CTYPE = VOICE the complete sequence
of administrative services for the addressed VOICE
service and SCIVOICE service in the compatibility-
tables will be deleted automatically.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 2+


MOD CALLPOPT
ADMSERV
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- In the case of CTYPE = ADMIN it is verified that the addressed


service is not used in the compatibility tables.
- The following parameter values are only allowed during Installation
Recovery : TRAFFIC, (only for internal services)
VOICE, (only for internal services)
SCIVOICE, (only for administrative services)
ADMIN, (only for adminstrative services)
SUB, (only for adminstrative services)
SUB1TR6, (only for adminstrative services)
PHI, (only for adminstrative services)
FH, (only for adminstrative services)
QSIG, (only for adminstrative services)

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ADMIN ADMINISTRATIVE SERVICE


CONFL LARGE CONFERENCE
FH FRAME HANDLER SERVICE
FHSTD FRAME HANDLER SERVICE STANDARD
IDSB ISDN-DSBSERVICE
PHI PACKET HANDLER INTERFACE SERV.
PHISTD PHI SERVICE STANDARD
QSIG Q-SIGNALLING SERVICE
QSIGSTD Q-SIGNALLING SERVICE STANDARD
SCIVOICE SCI VOICE SERVICE
SUB SUBSCRIBER SERVICE
SUBSTD SUBSCRIBER SERVICE STANDARD
SUB1TR6 1TR6-SUBSCRIBER SERVICE
SUB1TR6S 1TR6-SUBSCR. SERVICE STANDARD

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 3+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

OPTIONS

This input format modifies the exchange parameters.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD CALLPOPT : <OCALSEQ= ,OOSOPT= ,COOSOPT= ,CCQUEL= 1
1 1
1 ,CFWTIMER= ,CTXTIMER= ,ANITX= ,CFWMAX= 1
1 1
1 ,FACFRM= ,VOIREC= ,CTXNAME= ,NUISWRH= 1
1 1
1 ,TELCOCNT= ,MSNMAX= ,ABB= ,MLDIVNO= ,RELFEA= 1
1 1
1 ,TRIVKW= ,CTRIVKW= ,RBSIN= ,CRBSIN= ,PHDN= 1
1 1
1 ,CPHDN= ,GENPROT= ,MDMSN= ,DESTMAXL= ,DLUEM= 1
1 1
1 ,SLANAPRT= ,SYSREA= ,CFWNOT= ,ANNFCFW= 1
1 1
1 ,CFWFIX= ,SATMAX= ,HOPCO= ,ISDNPROT= 1
1 1
1 ,COURTESY= ,PROPDELY= ,TMSLRES= ,SPCHRES= 1
1 1
1 ,SWAPORIG= ,LOADS4LS= ,CFACSUOR= ,CFRQSUOR= 1
1 1
1 ,MWIA= ,MWIFIMM= ,MWISTI= ,SCLSTNAE= 1
1 1
1 ,ISSCODEP= ,SCF= ,KEY= ,INTKEY= ,INTKEYLN= 1
1 1
1 ,SECWORD= ,DNMAXL= ,TRCLMAX= ,TRCLMIN= 1
1 1
1 ,CONFLMAX= ,KEYMAX= ,ANNARDN= ,KEYWREQ= 1
1 1
1 ,REDUDACT= ,IGFEAMCI= ,IMPLDACT= ,ANSCIPBX= 1
1 1
1 ,PINLNGTH= ,SCLSTCAT= ,POPDN= ,CPOPDN= ,IWUDN= 1
1 1
1 ,CIWUDN= ,IWUILC= ,IWUDNIC= ,PRSAUTH= ,TMFEAT= 1
1 1
1 ,CTMFEAT= ,ERN= ,CERN= ,NRN= ,CNRN= 1
1 1
1 ,DNDTIMER= ,OPRASST= ,COPRASST= ,TRRMINA= 1
1 1
1 ,TRRMINB= ,TRRNOMA= ,TRRNOMB= ,BASEPOS= 1
1 1
1 ,DN2ADM= ,CTDN= ,DOMSTD= ,NETISTD= ,REDIRMAX= 1
1 1
1 ,CACOVRTR= ,FPTHRS= ,FPTIMLIM= ,FPOMT= ,FPACT= 1
1 1
1 ,BIERIP= ,BCHDLDN= ,TMUOCAC=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCALSEQ OCANEQ KIND & SEQ OF LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the languages and the sequences of these


languages for the OCANEQ (Operationally Controlled ANnouncement
Equipment) within the exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

L1
L1L2
L1L2L3
L1L2L3L4
L1L2L4
L1L2L4L3
L1L3
L1L3L2
L1L3L2L4
L1L3L4
L1L3L4L2

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 4+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

L1L4
L1L4L2
L1L4L2L3
L1L4L3
L1L4L3L2
L2
L2L1
L2L1L3
L2L1L3L4
L2L1L4
L2L1L4L3
L2L3
L2L3L1
L2L3L1L4
L2L3L4
L2L3L4L1
L2L4
L2L4L1
L2L4L1L3
L2L4L3
L2L4L3L1
L3
L3L1
L3L1L2
L3L1L2L4
L3L1L4
L3L1L4L2
L3L2
L3L2L1
L3L2L1L4
L3L2L4
L3L2L4L1
L3L4
L3L4L1
L3L4L1L2
L3L4L2
L3L4L2L1
L4
L4L1
L4L1L2
L4L1L2L3
L4L1L3
L4L1L3L2
L4L2
L4L2L1
L4L2L1L3
L4L2L3
L4L2L3L1
L4L3
L4L3L1
L4L3L1L2
L4L3L2
L4L3L2L1

OOSOPT OUT OF SERVICE OPTION

This parameter specifies the reason for automatic remove of


trunks from service.

Notes:
- This parameter is not allowed with parameter COOSOPT.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

HOLD OOS WITH SINGLE HOLDING


KILL OOS FOR KILLER TRUNK
MDII OOS FOR EXCESSIVE MDII

COOSOPT CANCEL OUT OF SERVICE OPTION

This parameter cancels reason for automatic trunk removal from


service.

Notes:
- This parameter is not allowed with parameter OOSOPT.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 5+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

HOLD OOS WITH CONNECTION HOLDING


KILL OOS FOR KILLER TRUNKS
MDII OOS FOR EXCESSIVE MDII

CCQUEL CCBS QUEUE LENGTH

Notes:
- This parameter is allowed only during Installation Recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...5, range of decimal numbers

CFWTIMER CALL FORWARDING TIMER

Defines a default value for individual


call forwarding timers.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

5...60, range of decimal numbers

CTXTIMER CTX CALL FORWARDING TIMER

This parameter specifies a default value for CENTREX


call forwarding timers

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

5...60, range of decimal numbers

ANITX A-NUMB.IDENT. IN TRANSIT EXCH.

This parameter specifies whether A-number identification in


international and transit exchanges is active (YES)
or inactive (NO).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N ANITX NOT ACTIVE


NO ANITX NOT ACTIVE
Y ANITX ACTIVE
YES ANITX ACTIVE

CFWMAX CALL FORWARD (MAXIMUM)

This parameter specifies the maximum number of call forwards allowed


in the exchange.
This parameter only accepts a single value entry.
1..5 range of decimal numbers.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5, range of decimal numbers

FACFRM FACILITY FORMAT

This parameter specifies the type of procedure for subscriber dialed


inputs of the exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CEPT CEPT FORMAT


EWSA EWSA FORMAT

VOIREC VOICE RECOGNITION

This parameter specifies whether voice recognition is disabled


or enabled in the exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DISABLE VOICEREC.DISABLED
ENABLE VOICEREC.ENABLED

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 6+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CTXNAME CENTREXNAME

This parameter specifies whether the centrexname recognition


is disabled or enabled in the exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DISABLE CTXNAME DISABLED


ENABLE CTXNAME ENABLED

NUISWRH PROMPT F. FEATURE

enabling resp. disabling the possibility to prompt for a new


feature input without replacing the handset.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DISABLE PROMPT DISABLED


ENABLE PROMPT ENABLED

TELCOCNT TELECOMMUNICATION CENTER NO.

This parameter specifies the telecommunication centre number.


It is used in traffic measurement.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

MSNMAX MULTIPLE SUBSCR. NO. MAXIMUM

This parameter specifies the maximum number of multiple subscriber


numbers allowed in the exchange during one access.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...255, range of decimal numbers

ABB ABBREVIATED DIALING DATA

This parameter specifies the short number lower limits for abbreviated
dialing.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: SHORT NUMBER TYPE


SLPLIM SCREENING LIST PLACE LIMIT
SNOLIM1 SHORT NUM. LIMIT ONE DIGIT
SNOLIM2 SHORT NUM. LIMIT TWO DIGITS

This parameter unit specifies whether the short number list of


one digit and/or the short number list of two digits is valid.

b: SHORT NUMBER LIMIT VALUE=


0...90, range of decimal numbers

In case of SNOLIM1 this parameter unit can take the values


0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 .
In case of SNOLIM2 this parameter unit can take the values
0, 10, 20 . . . 90 .
In case of SLPLIM this parameter unit can take the values
0, 1.

MLDIVNO MAX. LENGTH OF DIVERSION NO.

This parameter specifies the maximum length of diversion numbers


allowed in the exchange.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 7+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a-b

a: DIVERSION
DIVBY DIVERSION BUSY
DIVDA DIVERSION NOT ANSWERED
DIVI DIVERSION IMMEDIATELY

This parameter specifies whether call forwarding


immediately, call forwarding no reply or call forwarding busy
is valid.

b: MAX. LENGTH OF DIVERSION NUMBER=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

RELFEA RELEASED FEATURES

This parameter specifies the released features for the exchange.


This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CENTREX CENTREX ALLOWED


OSS OSS ALLOWED
PRIOQUE PRIORITY QUEUING ALLOWED

TRIVKW TRIVIAL KEYWORD

This parameter specifies the whether the keyword digits are


equal, in ascending order or in descending order. More than
one value connected with & may be entered.
This parameter may not be used together with the cancelling
operation.
This parameter can be used during normal operation.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ASCEDIG DIGITS IN ASCENDING ORDER


digits of keyword in ascending order
DESCDIG DIGITS IN DESCENDING ORDER
digits of keyword in descending order
EQUALDIG EQUAL DIGITS IN KEYWORD
only equal digits in keyword

CTRIVKW CANCEL TRIVIAL KEYWORD

This parameter specifies, which allowed form of the trivial


keyword has to get cancelled. It is not allowed to enter this
parameter together with the parameter to set the trivial
keyword.
This parameter can be used during normal operation.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ASCEDIG DIGITS IN ASCENDING ORDER


DESCDIG DIGITS IN DESCENDING ORDER
EQUALDIG EQUAL DIGITS IN KEYWORD

RBSIN RING BACK SERVICE ID. NO.

This parameter specifies the ring back service identification number.

Notes:
- This parameter is not allowed with parameter CRBSIN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CRBSIN CANCEL RING BACK SERV. ID. NO.

This parameter cancels the ring back service identification number.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 8+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Notes:
- This parameter is not allowed with parameter RBSIN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PHDN PACKET HANDLER DIR. NO.

This parameter specifies the packet handler directory number.

Notes:
- This parameter is not allowed with parameter CPHDN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CPHDN CANCEL PACKET HANDLER DIR. NO.

This parameter cancels the packet handler directory number.

Notes:
- This parameter is not allowed with parameter PHDN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

GENPROT GENERIC PROTOCOL

This parameter specifies which protocol, functional and/or stimulus,


is applied.
A value for GLOBAL always has to be entered.
If GLOBAL-STIPROT or GLOBAL-FCTPROT is entered no other
value is allowed.
In case of GLOBAL-BOTH all of the other parameters
(OUTPUT, REQUEST, OUTAOC) have to be entered.
Notes:
- This parameter is allowed only during Installation Recovery.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: GENERIC PROTOCOL
GLOBAL ALLOWED PROTOCOL
OUTAOC OUTPUT ADVICE OF CHARGE
output advice of charge default protocol
OUTPUT DEFAULT PROTOCOL FOR OUTPUT
REQUEST DEFAULT PROTOCOL FOR REQUEST

This parameter unit specifies whether the global parameter or


the subscription option ( request or output ) is valid.

b: PROTOCOL TYPE
BOTH BOTH PROTOCOLS
FCTPROT FUNCTIONAL PROTOCOL
STIPROT STIMULUS PROTOCOL

MDMSN DEFAULT MULTIPLE SUBSCR. NO.

This parameter specifies whether the marking of a multiple subscriber


number as default multiple subscriber number is mandatory or optional.

Notes:
- This parameter is allowed only during Installation Recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

MANDAT MANDATORY
OPTIONAL OPTIONAL

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 9+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DESTMAXL MAX. LENGTH OF DEST. NAME

This parameter specifies the maximum length allowed for the destination
name in the exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LONG LONG NAME: 12 CHARACTERS


SHORT SHORT NAME: 6 CHARACTERS

DLUEM DLU EMERGENCY ALLOWED

This parameter specifies whether the complete DLU emergency operation


can be activated in this exchange or only a reduced mode.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PARTLY PARTLY ALLOWED

SLANAPRT SUB LINE ANALOG PORT FAILURE

This parameter specifies whether a subscriber line


port failure is printed out or not.
This parameter can only be used during Installation
Recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PRTNO SUBSCRIBER PRINTOUT NO


PRTYES SUBSCRIBER PRINTOUT YES

SYSREA SYSTEM REACTION

This parameter specifies whether or not a specific


system reaction is required in call processing.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SPECIAL SPECIAL REACTION


STANDARD STANDARD REACTION

CFWNOT CFW NOTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the kind of call forwarding notification


at the calling users side.
This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO NOTIFICATION
WITH NOTIFICATION WITH NUMBER
WITHOUT NOTIFICATION WITHOUT NUMBER

ANNFCFW ANNOUNCEMENT FOR CALL FORWARD

This parameter specifies whether an announcement must be


applied to a calling subscriber, when his call was
forwarded.
- This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DO NOT APPLY ANNOUNCEMENT


NO DO NOT APPLY ANNOUNCEMENT
Y DO APPLY ANNOUNCEMENT
YES DO APPLY ANNOUNCEMENT

CFWFIX CALL FORWARDING IS FIX

This parameter specifies whether fixed call forwarding


to voice mail service is activated.
This parameter can only be used during Installation
Recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 10+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

N CALL FORWARDING IS NOT FIX


NO CALL FORWARDING IS NOT FIX
Y CALL FORWARDING IS FIX
YES CALL FORWARDING IS FIX

SATMAX MAX NUMBER OF SATELLITE LINKS

This parameter specifies the maximum number of satellite links


within one connection.
- This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

HOPCO HOPCOUNTER

This parameter specifies the value of the hopcounter used to


limit of consecutive transit connections (caused by incorrect
routing data) to a certain level (1..31).
After reaching the put in value the call is released.
- This parameter can be used during normal operation.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...31, range of decimal numbers

ISDNPROT ISDN PROTOCOL

This parameter specifies the type of ISDN D1 - PROTOCOL, that is


used in the exchange.
The parameter may only be entered at installation.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BOTH BOTH 1TR6 AND EDSS1 PROTOCOL


EDSS1 EDSS1:DIG.SUB.SIGNAL.1(BLUEB.)
ISDN1TR6 1TR6:TECHN.RICHTL.(REDB.)

COURTESY COURTESY CALL

This parameter specifies whether a courtesy call attempt


to the forward-to party must be performed after subscriber
controlled input of call forwarding.
- This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DO NOT ACTIVATE COURTESY CALL


NO DO NOT ACTIVATE COURTESY CALL
Y DO ACTIVATE COURTESY CALL
YES DO ACTIVATE COURTESY CALL

PROPDELY PROPAGATION DELAY COUNTER

This parameter specifies the maximum value of the propagation


delay counter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...999, range of decimal numbers

TMSLRES MAX. RESERVED TIMESLOTS

This parameter specifies the maximum value of reserved timeslots


for the BEV-condition in GP.
- This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...127, range of decimal numbers

SPCHRES MAX. RESERVED SPEECHCHANNELS

This parameter specifies the maximum value of reserved speech-


channels for the BEV-condition in GP.
- This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 11+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...127, range of decimal numbers

SWAPORIG SWAP ORIGINATING MARKS

- This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DO NOT SWAP ORIGINATING MARKS


NO DO NOT SWAP ORIGINATING MARKS
Y DO SWAP ORIGINATING MARKS
YES DO SWAP ORIGINATING MARKS

LOADS4LS LOADSHARING 4 LINK SETS

This parameter specifies whether the loadsharing via two or


four linksets is applied in the switch.
The parameter may only be entered at installation.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N LOADSHARING VIA MAX 2 LINKSETS


NO LOADSHARING VIA MAX 2 LINKSETS
Y LOADSHARING VIA MAX 4 LINKSETS
YES LOADSHARING VIA MAX 4 LINKSETS

CFACSUOR CFW. ACCOUNT SUSPENSION ORIG.

In order to choose a required interworking between enhancement call


forwarding and accountsuspension originating an action can be entered.
The parameter may only be entered at installation.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CFW CALL FORWARDING IS PERFORMED


CONNECT CALL CONNECTED TO B1 SUB
The call is connected to the B1 subscriber.
REJECT REJECTION(DEFAULT VALUE)
RING CALLING SUB.REC.RINGING TONE
The calling subscriber receives ringing tone.

CFRQSUOR CFW. REQ.SUSP.ORIG.

In order to choose a required interworking between


enhancement call forwarding and requested suspension
originating an action can be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CFW CALL FORWARDING IS PERFORMED


CONNECT CALLING CONNECTED TO B1 SUB.
The call is connected to the B1 subscriber.
REJECT DEFAULT VALUE
RING CALLING SUB.REC.RINGING TONE
The calling subscriber receives ringing tone.

MWIA MESSAGE WAIT. INDIC. ANALOG

This parameter specifies the maximum number of controlling users for


message waiting indication analog.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2, range of decimal numbers

MWIFIMM MESSAGE WAIT.IND.FUNC.IMM.

This parameter specifies the maximum number of controlling users for


message waiting indication functional immediately.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...10, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 12+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MWISTI MESSAGE WAIT. INDIC. STIMULUS

This parameter specifies the maximum number of controlling users for


message waiting indication stimulus.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2, range of decimal numbers

SCLSTNAE SCREENLIST NOT ACT WHEN EMPTY

This parameter specifies whether an empty screening list


is allowed to be active or not.
- This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N EMPTY SCREENING LST MAY BE ACT


Empty screening lists may be active.
NO EMPTY SCREENING LST MAY BE ACT
Empty screening lists may be active.
Y EMPTY SCR. LST MAY NOT BE ACT
Empty screening lists must not be active.
YES EMPTY SCR. LST MAY NOT BE ACT
Empty screening lists must not be active.

ISSCODEP ISDN SUPLEM. SERV. CODE PROC.

This parameter specifies whether the called party number


should be used from the global title header or from
the Call Completion Busy Subscriber component to
determine the B-side user.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DO NOT USE ISS CODE PROCESSING


NO DO NOT USE ISS CODE PROCESSING
Y DO USE ISS CODE PROCESSING
YES DO USE ISS CODE PROCESSING

SCF SELECTIVE CALL FORWARDING.

This parameter specifies whether selective call forwar-


ding takes precedence over non-selective call forwarding
or vice versa.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N PRECEDENCE FOR NON SEL CFW


Precedence for non selective call forwarding.
NO PRECEDENCE FOR NON SEL CFW
Precedence for non selective call forwarding.
Y PRECEDENCE FOR SELECTIVE CFW
Precedence for selective call forwarding.
YES PRECEDENCE FOR SELECTIVE CFW
Precedence for selective call forwarding.

KEY KEYWORD

This parameter specifies the default keyword for subscriber


controlled inputs.
The length of this parameter must be the minimum value of
PINLNGTH.
- This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...12 digit decimal number

INTKEY DEFAUL INTERNET PW

This parameter specifies the default internet password.


The parameter may only be entered at installation.
The length of this parameter must be the minimum value
of the parameter INTKEYLN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 13+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

INTKEYLN INTKEY MIN/MAX VALUE

This parameter specifies the maximum and minimum pinlength for the
internet password. It has to be entered in the form min-max:
min....minimum keylength (between 4 and 12)
max....maximum keylength (between 4 and 12)
min has to be equal max or lower.
With this parameter the parameter INTKEY has to be entered as well.
This parameter can just be entered at installation.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: MINIMUM INTKEY LENGTH=


4...12, range of decimal numbers

b: MAXIMUM INTKEY LENGTH=


4...12, range of decimal numbers

SECWORD SECRET WORD

This parameter specifies a secret password.


The parameter may be entered at normal
operation but is displayed only at installation.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DNMAXL MAX. DIRECTORY NUMBER LENGTH

This parameter specifies the maximum length of directory numbers


that are allowed in an exchange.
- This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12, range of decimal numbers

TRCLMAX MAX. TRAFFIC CLASSES

This parameter specifies the maximum number of traffic classes


that are allowed in an exchange.
- This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...255, range of decimal numbers

TRCLMIN TRAFFIC CLASSES MINIMUM

This parameter specifies the minimum value of traffic classes


that is allowed in an exchange.
Notes:
- This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...255, range of decimal numbers

CONFLMAX MAX. CONFERENCE PARTICIPANTS

This parameter specifies the maximum number of participants in


a large conference.
- This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...32, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 14+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

KEYMAX MAX. KEYWORD MISUSES

This parameter specifies the maximum number of keyword misuses.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

3...5, range of decimal numbers

ANNARDN AUTOM. REC. (1 NUMB. STORED)

This Parameter specifies, whether an announcement with the


calling party number currently stored is fed in (YES) or
not (NO), if the subscriber put in the appropriate access
code for AR with announcement.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N ANNARDN NOT ACTIVATED


NO ANNARDN NOT ACTIVATED
Y ANNARDN ACTIVATED
YES ANNARDN ACTIVATED

KEYWREQ KEYWORD REQUEST

This parameter specifies whether the necessity of a keyword is


defined on feature-office-base or on subscribed base.
The parameter may only be entered at installation
recovery

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FEATURE FEATURE BASE


SUBSCR SUBSCR. BASE

REDUDACT REDUNTANT ACTIVATION CFW

This Parameter specifies, whether a redundant


deactivation of CFW can be done (YES) or
is rejected (NO).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N REDUNDANT ACTIVATIOND REJEC.


NO REDUNDANT ACTIVATIOND REJEC.
Y REDUNDANT ACT. NOT REJ.
YES REDUNDANT ACT. NOT REJ.

IGFEAMCI IGN. FEAT. WHEN MAL. CALL ID.

This Parameter specifies, whether features are


ignored in case of malicious call identification
(YES) or not (NO).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N FEATURES NOT IGNORED.


NO FEATURES NOT IGNORED.
Y FEATURES IGNORED.
YES FEATURES IGNORED.

IMPLDACT IMPLICIT ACTIVATION CFW

This Parameter specifies, whether a implicit


deactivation of CFW can be done (YES) or
is rejected (NO).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N IMPLICIT ACTIVATIOND REJEC.


NO IMPLICIT ACTIVATIOND REJEC.
Y IMPLICIT ACT. NOT REJ.
YES IMPLICIT ACT. NOT REJ.

ANSCIPBX ANALOG SCI ON PBX-LEVEL

This Parameter specifies, whether an analog

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 15+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SCI on PBX-Level can be done (YES) or


not (NO).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO ANALOG SCI ON PBX-LEVEL


NO NO ANALOG SCI ON PBX-LEVEL
Y ANALOG SCI ON PBX-LEVEL
YES ANALOG SCI ON PBX-LEVEL

PINLNGTH PINLENGTH MIN/MAX VALUE

This parameter specifies the maximum and minimum pinlength for sub-
scriber controlled input. It has to be entered in the form min-max:
min....minimum pinlength (between 4 and 12)
max....maximum pinlength (between 4 and 12)
min may be equal max or lower.
With this parameter the parameter KEY has to be entered as well.
This parameter can only be entered at installation.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: MINIMUM PINLENGTH=
4...12, range of decimal numbers

b: MAXIMUM PINLENGTH=
4...12, range of decimal numbers

SCLSTCAT SCREENING LIST CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the symbolic digit strings attached to


screening list categories

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: CATEGORY
CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15
COINB COIN BOX
DATAINAT DATA TRANSMIS. INTERNAT.
DATRANS DATA TRANSMISSION NATIONAL
OPOS OPERATORS POSITION
OPOSINAT OPERATORS POS. INTERNAT.
SUBINAT SUBSCRIBER INTERNATIONAL
SUBMFC SUB. CATEG. REQUESTED BY MFC
Subscriber category requested by MFC
SUBORD SUBSCRIBER
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUBSCR. INTERNAT.
SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT

This parameter unit specifies which screening list


category the symbolic digit string is attached to.

b: SYMBOLIC DIGIT STRING=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

A value between 0 and 99 may be entered.


In case of omission of part b the digit
string is removed.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 16+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

POPDN POINT OF PRESENCE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the point of presence number


Notes:
- This parameter is not allowed with parameter CPOPDN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...20 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CPOPDN CANCEL POINT OF PRESENCE NO.

This parameter cancels the point of presence number.

Notes:
- This parameter is not allowed with parameter POPDN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...20 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

IWUDN INTERWORKING UNIT DIR.NUMBER

This parameter specifies the interworking unit number


Notes:
- This parameter is not allowed with parameter CIWUDN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...20 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CIWUDN CAN. INTERWORKING UNIT DIR.NO.

This parameter cancels the interworking unit number.

Notes:
- This parameter is not allowed with parameter IWUDN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...20 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

IWUILC INT.WORK UNIT INTERLOCK CODE

This parameter specifies the interworking unit interlock code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...65535, range of decimal numbers

IWUDNIC IWU DATANETWORK IDENT. CODE

This parameter specifies the interworking unit datanetwork


identification code. The value may be between 0 and 9999

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...9999, range of decimal numbers

PRSAUTH PROTOCOL SPEC. AUTHORISATIONS

This parameter specifies whether protocol specific


authorisation is set.
It may only be entered at installation.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO PROTOCOL SPEC. AUTH.


NO NO PROTOCOL SPEC. AUTH.
Y PROTOCOL SPECIFIC AUTH.
YES PROTOCOL SPECIFIC AUTH.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 17+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TMFEAT TRAF.MEAS.-FEATURES

This parameter specifies the features for which


traffic measurement can be started.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ABBD ABBREVIATED DIALLING


allowed for Analog and EDSS1
ACCEPTCW ACCEPTED CALL WAITINGS USE
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
ACO ALARM CALL ORDER
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
ACREJ ANONYMOUS CALL REJECTION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
AFS AUTOMATIC FEATURE SUBSCRIPT.
automatic feature subscription
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
AGRU ANS. GEAEND. RUFNR. (TELEKOM)
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
AOC ADVICE OF CHARGE ON REQUEST
allowed for EDSS1
AR AUTOMATIC RECALL
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
ARNO ACCOUNT RECORD NUMBER
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CC COMPLETION OF CALLS
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CCIBI CALL COMP.INTERN.BUSY IMMID.
call completion internet busy immediate,
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CCIBU CALL COMP.INTERN.BUSY USER
call completion internet busy user,
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CCIBVOIP CALL CMP.INT.BUSY VOICE O.IP
call completion international
busy voice over internet,
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CCSSVI COLL.CALL SCR.FILT.INT.SERV.
collect call screening filtered
interception service.
Allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CLIR CALLING LINE IDENT RESTR
calling line identification restriction,
allowed for Analog
CLIRR CALLING LINE IDENT RESTR REQU
allowed for EDSS1
CLIRS CALLING LINE IDENT RESTR SUSP
allowed for EDSS1
COLRR CONNECT LINE IDENT RESTR REQU
allowed for EDSS1
COLRS CONNECT LINE IDENT TESTR SUSP
allowed for EDSS1
CONFL LARGE CONFERENCE
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CONF3 3WAY CONFERENCE
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
CT CALL TRANSFER (A-SIDE, B-SIDE)
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CTD CLICK TO DIAL
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CW CALL WAITING
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
CWD CALL WAITING DE LUXE
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CWDA CALL WAITING DELUXE ACCEPTED
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CWDC CALL WAITING DELUXE CONF.
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CWDF CALL WAITING DELUXE FORWARDED
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CWIB CALL WAITING INTERN. BUSY
call waiting internet busy
DEBNC DETAILLED BILLING NEXT CALL
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVA FIXED ANNOUNCEMENT DIVERSION

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 18+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

allowed for Analog and EDSS1


DIVBRVMS BUSY ROUTE DIVERSION TO VMS
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVBY BUSY LINE DIVERSION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVBYVMS BUSY LINE DIVERSION TO VMS
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVCD CONDITIONAL DIVERSION
allowed for 1TR6
DIVCDE DIVERSION ON CALL DEFLECTION
allowed for EDSS1
DIVDA DON’T ANSWER DIVERSION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVDAVMS DON’T ANSWER DIVERSION TO VMS
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVI IMMEDIATE DIVERSION
allowed for 1TR6
DIVIA INDIVID. ANNOUNC. DIVERSION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVIP CFW UNCONDITIONAL PARALLEL
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVIVMS IMMEDIATE DIVERSION TO VMS
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVND DON’T DISTURB DIVERSION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
DIVOP OPERATOR DIVERSION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
DIVOPD DELAYED DIVERSION TO OPERATOR
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVUCD UNCONDITIONAL DIVERSION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
EECT ENHANCED EXPLICIT CALL TR.
enhanced explicit call transfer
FSK FREQUENCY SHIFT KEYING
allowed for Analog
HOTLDEL HOTLINE DELAYED
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
HOTLIMM HOTLINE IMMEDIATE
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
ISCI INTERN.SUB.CONTR.INPUT
internet subscriber controlled input
KEYWORD KEYWORD MODIFICATION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
MCII MALICIOUS CALL ID IMMED
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
MCIR MALICIOUS CALL ID REQU
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
PR PARTIAL REROUTING (EDSS1-PBX)
allowed for EDSS1
RCCS REVERSE CHARGE CALL SECURITY
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
RCREQS REVERSED CHARGE AT SET UP TIME
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
REJDIV CALL FORWARDING REJCTION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
REQSTDA REQUEST STATUS/FEATDATA
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
RSCI REMOTE SUBS. CONTROLLED INPUT
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
SCA SELECTIVE CALL ACCEPTANCE
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
SCD SELECTIVE CALL DIVERSION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
SCIR SUBS. CONTROLLED INPUT RESTR.
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
SCLIM SUPERVISION OF CREDIT LIMIT
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
SCLST SCREENING LIST
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
SCLSTKO SCREENING LIST KICK OUT
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
SCO SELECTIV CALL ORIGINATION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
SCR SELECTIV CALL REJECTION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
SCW SELECTIV CALL WAITING
allowed for Analog and EDSS1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 19+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SERVC SERVICE CHANGE


allowed for 1TR6
SPCONN SEMIPERMANENT CONNECTION
allowed for 1TR6
SR SELECTIVE RINGING
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
STH STOP HUNT
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
SUBADDR SUBADDRESSING
allowed for EDSS1
TRARSDN CALL RESTRICTION DN/PRT
allowed for 1TR6
TRARSS TRAFFIC RESTRICTION SUB
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
TRARSTR TRAFFIC RESTRICTION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
TRARSTRT TRAFFIC RESTRICTION TERM
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
TRARSUSP BLUEBOOK OUTGOING CALL SUSP.
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
TWC THREE WAY CALL (INQUIRY)
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
UISCI USER INTERACTIVE SCI
User interactive subscriber controlled input.
allowed for Analog and ISDN
UUS1 USER-TO-USER-SIGNALLING 1
allowed for EDSS1
UUS3 USER-TO-USER-SIGNALLING 3
allowed for EDSS1
VACNC VERB ANN CHARGES FOR NEXT CALL
allowed for Analog
VMSRETR VMS MESSAGE RETRIEVAL
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
VOI VOICE OVER INTERNET
allowed for Analog and EDSS1

CTMFEAT CANCEL TRAF.MEAS.-FEATURES

This parameter is used to cancel features for which


traffic measurement can be started.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ABBD ABBREVIATED DIALLING


allowed for Analog and EDSS1
ACCEPTCW ACCEPTED CALL WAITINGS USE
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
ACO ALARM CALL ORDER
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
ACREJ ANONYMOUS CALL REJECTION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
AFS AUTOMATIC FEATURE SUBSCRIPT.
automatic feature subscription
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
AGRU ANS. GEAEND. RUFNR. (TELEKOM)
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
AOC ADVICE OF CHARGE ON REQUEST
allowed for EDSS1
AR AUTOMATIC RECALL
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
ARNO ACCOUNT RECORD NUMBER
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CC COMPLETION OF CALLS
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CCIBI CALL COMP.INTERN.BUSY IMMID.
call completion internet busy immediate,
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CCIBU CALL COMP.INTERN.BUSY USER
call completion internet busy user,
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CCIBVOIP CALL COMP.INT.BUSY VOICE O.IP
call completion international
busy voice over internet,
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CCSSVI COLL.CALL SCR.FILT.INT.SERV.
collect call screening filtered

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 20+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

interception service,
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CLIR CALLING LINE IDENT RESTR
allowed for Analog
CLIRR CALLING LINE IDENT RESTR REQU
allowed for EDSS1
CLIRS CALLING LINE IDENT RESTR SUSP
allowed for EDSS1
COLRR CONNECT LINE IDENT RESTR REQU
allowed for EDSS1
COLRS CONNECT LINE IDENT TESTR SUSP
allowed for EDSS1
CONFL LARGE CONFERENCE
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CONF3 3WAY CONFERENCE
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
CT CALL TRANSFER (A-SIDE, B-SIDE)
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CTD CLICK TO DIAL
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CW CALL WAITING
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
CWD CALL WAITING DE LUXE
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CWDA CALL WAITING DELUXE ACCEPTED
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CWDC CALL WAITING DELUXE CONF.
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CWDF CALL WAITING DELUXE FORWARDED
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
CWIB CALL WAITING INTERN. BUSY
call waiting internet busy
DEBNC DETAILLED BILLING NEXT CALL
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVA FIXED ANNOUNCEMENT DIVERSION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVBRVMS BUSY ROUTE DIVERSION TO VMS
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVBY BUSY LINE DIVERSION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVBYVMS BUSY LINE DIVERSION TO VMS
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVCD CONDITIONAL DIVERSION
allowed for 1TR6
DIVCDE DIVERSION ON CALL DEFLECTION
allowed for EDSS1
DIVDA DON’T ANSWER DIVERSION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVDAVMS DON’T ANSWER DIVERSION TO VMS
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVI IMMEDIATE DIVERSION
allowed for 1TR6
DIVIA INDIVID. ANNOUNC. DIVERSION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVIP CFW UNCONDITIONAL PARALLEL
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVIVMS IMMEDIATE DIVERSION TO VMS
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVND DON’T DISTURB DIVERSION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
DIVOP OPERATOR DIVERSION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
DIVOPD DELAYED DIVERSION TO OPERATOR
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
DIVUCD UNCONDITIONAL DIVERSION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
EECT ENHANCED EXPLICIT CALL TR.
enhanced explicit call transfer
FSK FREQUENCY SHIFT KEYING
allowed for Analog
HOTLDEL HOTLINE DELAYED
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
HOTLIMM HOTLINE IMMEDIATE
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
ISCI INTERN.SUB.CONTR.INPUT
internet subscriber controlled input
KEYWORD KEYWORD MODIFICATION

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 21+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

allowed for Analog and EDSS1


MCII MALICIOUS CALL ID IMMED
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
MCIR MALICIOUS CALL ID REQU
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
PR PARTIAL REROUTING (EDSS1-PBX)
allowed for EDSS1
RCCS REVERSE CHARGE CALL SECURITY
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
RCREQS REVERSED CHARGE AT SET UP TIME
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
REJDIV CALL FORWARDING REJCTION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
REQSTDA REQUEST STATUS/FEATDATA
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
RSCI REMOTE SUBS. CONTROLLED INPUT
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
SCA SELECTIVE CALL ACCEPTANCE
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
SCD SELECTIVE CALL DIVERSION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
SCIR SUBS. CONTROLLED INPUT RESTR.
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
SCLIM SUPERVISION OF CREDIT LIMIT
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
SCLST SCREENING LIST
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
SCLSTKO SCREENING LIST KICK OUT
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
SCO SELECTIVE CALL ORIGINATION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
SCR SELECTIVE CALL REJECTION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
SCW SELECTIVE CALL WAITING
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
SERVC SERVICE CHANGE
allowed for 1TR6
SPCONN SEMIPERMANENT CONNECTION
allowed for 1TR6
SR SELECTIVE RINGING
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
STH STOP HUNT
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
SUBADDR SUBADDRESSING
allowed for EDSS1
TRARSDN CALL RESTRICTION DN/PRT
allowed for 1TR6
TRARSS TRAFFIC RESTRICTION SUB
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
TRARSTR TRAFFIC RESTRICTION
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
TRARSTRT TRAFFIC RESTRICTION TERM
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
TRARSUSP TRAFFIC RESTR. SUSPENDED
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
TWC THREE WAY CALL (INQUIRY)
allowed for Analog and EDSS1 and 1TR6
UISCI USER INTERACTIVE SCI
User interactive subscriber controlled input.
allowed for Analog and ISDN
UUS1 USER-TO-USER-SIGNALLING 1
allowed for EDSS1
UUS3 USER-TO-USER-SIGNALLING 3
allowed for EDSS1
VACNC VERB ANN CHARGES FOR NEXT CALL
allowed for Analog
VMSRETR VMS MESSAGE RETRIEVAL
allowed for Analog and EDSS1
VOI VOICE OVER INTERNET
allowed for Analog and EDSS1

ERN EXCHANGE ROUTING NO.

This parameter specifies the exchange routing number

Notes:
- This parameter is not allowed with parameter CERN.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 22+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CERN CANCEL EXCHANGE ROUTING NO.

This parameter cancels the exchange routing number.

Notes:
- This parameter is not allowed with parameter ERN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NRN NETWORK ROUTING NO.

This parameter specifies the network routing number

Notes:
- This parameter is not allowed with parameter CNRN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CNRN CANCEL NETWORK ROUTING NO.

This parameter cancels the network routing number.

Notes:
- This parameter is not allowed with parameter NRN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DNDTIMER DO NOT DISTURB TIMER

This parameter specifies the time in hours after which the feature
do not disturb of a subscriber is automatically deactivated.
An input of zero means that no deactivation takes place.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...48, range of decimal numbers

OPRASST OPERATOR ASSIST NO.

This parameter specifies the operator assist number


for malicious call tracing
Notes:
- This parameter is not allowed with parameter COPRASST.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

COPRASST CANCEL OPERATOR ASSIST NO.

This parameter cancels the operator assist number.

Notes:
- This parameter is not allowed with parameter OPRASST.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 23+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TRRMINA TRANSFER RATE MINIMUM A

This parameter specifies the minimum


transfer rate for SLMI:SDA.
Notes:
-The value of it must not be larger
than TRRNOMA.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0,6,12, range of decimal numbers

TRRMINB TRANSFER RATE MINIMUM B

This parameter specifies the minimum


transfer rate for SLMI:SDB/SCC/SDD.

Notes:
-The value of it must not be larger
than TRRNOMB.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0,6,12,13,14,15,16,17,18,19,20,21,22,23,24,25,26,27,28,29,
30,31,32, range of decimal numbers

TRRNOMA TRANSFER RATE NOMINAL A

This parameter specifies nominal transfer rate


for SLMI:SDA.

Notes:
-The value of it must not be smaller
than TRRMINA.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0,6,12, range of decimal numbers

TRRNOMB TRANSFER RATE NOMINAL B

This parameter specifies the nominal


transfer rate for SLMI:SDB/SCC/SDD.

Notes:
-The value of it must not be smaller
than TRRMINB.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0,6,12,13,14,15,16,17,18,19,20,21,22,23,24,25,26,27,28,29,
30,31,32, range of decimal numbers

BASEPOS BASIC SERVICE POSSIBLE

This Parameter specifies, whether the SDSL line card will


try to set up with 160kbit/sec as a last possibility
independently of the administrated bandwidth(YES) or
not (NO).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N BASEPOS NOT ACTIVATED


NO BASEPOS NOT ACTIVATED
Y BASEPOS ACTIVATED
YES BASEPOS ACTIVATED

DN2ADM DN2 POSSIBLE

This Parameter specifies whether a second directory


number may be entered while modifying a subscriber(YES)
or not (NO). This parameter may only be entered at
installation operation.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DN2ADM NOT ACTIVATED

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 24+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NO DN2ADM NOT ACTIVATED


Y DN2ADM ACTIVATED
YES DN2ADM ACTIVATED

CTDN CLICK TO DIAL NO.

This parameter specifies the click to dial number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DOMSTD DOMAIN STANDARD

This parameter specifies standard domain for MLPP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...16777215, range of decimal numbers

NETISTD NETWORK ID STANDARD

This parameter specifies the default network identification


code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

REDIRMAX REDIRECTION (MAXIMUM)

This parameter specifies the maximum number of redirections allowed


in the exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...8, range of decimal numbers

CACOVRTR CAC OVERRIDES TRAFFIC RESTR

This parameter specifies whether carrier access code


overrides traffic restrictions.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO OVERRIDE
NO NO OVERRIDE
Y OVERRIDE
YES OVERRIDE

FPTHRS FRAUD PREV THRESHHOLD

This parameter specifies the fraud prevention


threshhold.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

3...10, range of decimal numbers

FPTIMLIM FRAUD PREV TIMELIMIT

This parameter specifies the fraud prevention


timelimit.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...168, range of decimal numbers

FPOMT FRAUD PREV OUTPUT ON OMT

This parameter specifies whether fraud prevention is


output on operation and maintenance terminal (YES)
or not (NO).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 25+


MOD CALLPOPT
OPTIONS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

N NO OUTPUT ON OMT
NO NO OUTPUT ON OMT
Y OUTPUT ON OMT
YES OUTPUT ON OMT

FPACT FRAUD PREVENTION ACTIVE

This parameter specifies, whether the fraud prevention


is active (YES) or not (NO).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N FRAUD PREVENTION NOT ACTIVATED


NO FRAUD PREVENTION NOT ACTIVATED
Y FRAUD PREVENTION ACTIVATED
YES FRAUD PREVENTION ACTIVATED

BIERIP BASIC INTERN. EXCH. RES.

This parameter specifies a basic internode


exchange resource IP.

Notes:
It is of the form a.b.c.d where a/b/c/d are
integers in the range 0..255.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 characters from the


symbolic name character set

BCHDLDN B-CHANNEL DATA LINK DN

This parameter specifies the b-channel data link directory


number.
Notes:
- This parameter is cancelled by entering zero.
- Up to 24 digits between 0 and 9 may be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit decimal number

TMUOCAC TRAFFIC MEASURE. USE OWN CAC

This Parameter specifies, whether, for traffic


measurement, if the carrier access code is not dialed,
the own carrier access code has to be used (YES), or
not(NO).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DO NOT USE OWN CAC


NO DO NOT USE OWN CAC
Y USE OWN CAC
YES USE OWN CAC

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 26+


MOD CALLPOPT
SERV
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

MODIFIC. ONE INTERNAL SERVICE

This input format modifies the powersets of services and the service
compatibility tables for one service.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD CALLPOPT : SERV= <,TYPE= ,CTYPE= ,COMPORIG= ,COMPTERM= 1
1 1
1 ,BSIGN=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SERV INTERNAL SERVICE

This parameter specifies which internal service has parameters


to be modified.

Notes:
- This parameter must always be entered with at least one of the
parameters TYPE, CTYPE, COMPORIG, COMPTERM or BSIGN.
- The values of parameter SERV are verified against the
powerset of TRAFFIC services.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TANALOG TRAFFIC ANALOG MODE


TCMAUDIO TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE 3.1KHZ AUDIO
TCMAUDI7 TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE 7KHZ AUDIO
TCMSERV6 TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE SERVICE 06
TCMSERV7 TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE SERVICE 07
TCMSPEEC TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE SPEECH
TCMUNRST TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE UNRESTR.
TFAX3 TRAFFIC TELEFAX GROUP 2/3
TFAX4 TRAFFIC TELEFAX GROUP 4
TPMBCHAN TRAFFIC PACKET MODE B-CHANNEL
TPMBDCHA TRAFFIC PACKET MODE BD-CHANNEL
TPMDCHAN TRAFFIC PACKET MODE D-CHANNEL
TSERV19 TRAFFIC SERVICE 19
TSERV20 TRAFFIC SERVICE 20
TSERV21 TRAFFIC SERVICE 21
TSERV22 TRAFFIC SERVICE 22
TSERV23 TRAFFIC SERVICE 23
TSERV24 TRAFFIC SERVICE 24
TSERV25 TRAFFIC SERVICE 25
TSERV26 TRAFFIC SERVICE 26
TSERV27 TRAFFIC SERVICE 27
TSERV29 TRAFFIC SERVICE 29
TSERV30 TRAFFIC SERVICE 30
TSERV31 TRAFFIC SERVICE 31
TSPCONN TRAFFIC SEMIPERM. CONNECTION
TTEL3K TRAFFIC TELEPHONY ISDN 3.1KHZ
TTEL7K TRAFFIC TELEPHONY ISDN 7KHZ
TTTX64K TRAFFIC TELETEX 64 KBIT/S
TUNKNOWN TRAFFIC UNKNOWN BEARER SERV.
TVIDEOTL TRAFFIC VIDEOTELEPHONY
TVIDEOTX TRAFFIC VIDEOTEXT

TYPE SERVICE TYPE

This parameter specifies the set of services where the entered


service shall be added.

Notes:
- This parameter must always be entered with parameter
SERV or ADMSERV.
- The TRAFFIC ,VOICE services can only be
modified using parameter SERV.
- All other service types are administrative services and can
only be modified using parameter ADMSERV.
- All VOICE services must also be contained in the powerset of
TRAFFIC services.
- All SCIVOICE services must also be contained in the powerset of

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 27+


MOD CALLPOPT
SERV
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

VOICE services except for ADMSERV is VOICEGRP and ALLGRP.


In case of ADMSERV is NONVCGRP SCIVOICE is not possible.
- All standard services must also be contained in the powerset of
the corresponding administrative service.
- The following parameter values are only allowed during Installation
Recovery : TRAFFIC, (only for internal services)
VOICE, (only for internal services)
SCIVOICE, (only for administrative services)
ADMIN, (only for adminstrative services)
SUB, (only for adminstrative services)
SUB1TR6, (only for adminstrative services)
PHI, (only for adminstrative services)
FH, (only for adminstrative services)
QSIG, (only for adminstrative services)

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

TRAFFIC INTERNAL SERVICE


VOICE VOICE SERVICE

CTYPE CANCEL SERVICE TYPE

This parameter specifies the set of services from which the entered
service shall be deleted.

Notes:
- This parameter must always be entered with parameter
SERV or ADMSERV.
- The TRAFFIC,VOICE services can only be
modified using parameter SERV.
- All other service types are administrative services and can
only be modified using parameter ADMSERV.
- In the case of CTYPE = TRAFFIC the complete sequence of
administrative services for the addressed TRAFFIC service in
the compatibility tables will be deleted automatically.
- In the case of CTYPE = VOICE the complete sequence
of administrative services for the addressed VOICE
service and SCIVOICE service in the compatibility-
tables will be deleted automatically.
- In the case of CTYPE = ADMIN it is verified that the addressed
service is not used in the compatibility tables.
- The following parameter values are only allowed during Installation
Recovery : TRAFFIC, (only for internal services)
VOICE, (only for internal services)
SCIVOICE, (only for administrative services)
ADMIN, (only for adminstrative services)
SUB, (only for adminstrative services)
SUB1TR6, (only for adminstrative services)
PHI, (only for adminstrative services)
FH, (only for adminstrative services)
QSIG, (only for adminstrative services)

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

TRAFFIC INTERNAL SERVICE


VOICE VOICE SERVICE

COMPORIG COMPAT. SERVICE (ORIG.TRAFFIC)

This parameter specifies the sequence of administrative services


associated with one internal service for originating traffic.
This internal service is specified by the parameter SERV.

Notes:
- First administrative service in the sequence has the highest
priority, with a maximum of 8 elements in the sequence.
- A service may not be entered twice.
- Administrative service must be allowed in this exchange.
- This parameter must always be entered with parameter
SERV.
- The entered value(s) of administrative service must match
the protocol of the internal service specified by SERV.
- This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 28+


MOD CALLPOPT
SERV
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

of multiple values linked with &.

ALLGRP ALL SERVICES GROUP


ANALOG ANALOG MODE
CMAUDIO CIRC.MODE 3.1KHZ AUDIO
CMAUDI7K CIRC.MODE 7KHZ AUDIO
CMSERV6 CIRC.MODE SERVICE 06
CMSERV7 CIRC.MODE SERVICE 07
CMSPEECH CIRC.MODE SPEECH
CMUNRST CIRC.MODE UNRESTR.DIGITAL INFO
FAX3 TELEFAX GROUP 2/3
FAX4 TELEFAX GROUP 4
NONVCGRP NONVOICE SERVICES GROUP
PMBCHANN PACKET MODE B-CHANNEL
PMBDCHAN PACKET MODE BD-CHANNEL
PMDCHANN PACKET MODE D-CHANNEL
SERV19 SERVICE 19
SERV20 SERVICE 20
SERV21 SERVICE 21
SERV22 SERVICE 22
SERV23 SERVICE 23
SERV24 SERVICE 24
SERV25 SERVICE 25
SERV26 SERVICE 26
SERV27 SERVICE 27
SPCONN SEMIPERMANENT CONNECTION
TEL3K TELEPHONY ISDN 3.1KHZ
TEL7K TELEPHONY ISDN 7KHZ
TTX64K TELETEX 64 KBIT/S
UNKNOWN UNKNOWN BEARER SERVICE
VIDEOTEL VIDEOTELEPHONY
VIDEOTEX VIDEOTEXT
VOICEGRP VOICE SERVICES GROUP

COMPTERM COMPAT. SERVICE (TERM.TRAFFIC)

This parameter specifies the sequence of administrative services


associated with one internal service for terminating traffic.
This internal service is specified by the parameter SERV.

Notes:
- First administrative service in the sequence has the highest
priority, with a maximum of 16 elements in the sequence.
- A service may not be entered twice.
- Administrative service must be allowed in this exchange.
- This parameter must always be entered with parameter
SERV.
- The entered value(s) of administrative service must match
the protocol of the internal service specified by SERV.
- This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ALLGRP ALL SERVICES GROUP


ANALOG ANALOG MODE
CMAUDIO CIRC.MODE 3.1KHZ AUDIO
CMAUDI7K CIRC.MODE 7KHZ AUDIO
CMSERV6 CIRC.MODE SERVICE 06
CMSERV7 CIRC.MODE SERVICE 07
CMSPEECH CIRC.MODE SPEECH
CMUNRST CIRC.MODE UNRESTR.DIGITAL INFO
FAX3 TELEFAX GROUP 2/3
FAX4 TELEFAX GROUP 4
NONVCGRP NONVOICE SERVICES GROUP
PMBCHANN PACKET MODE B-CHANNEL
PMBDCHAN PACKET MODE BD-CHANNEL
PMDCHANN PACKET MODE D-CHANNEL
SERV19 SERVICE 19
SERV20 SERVICE 20
SERV21 SERVICE 21
SERV22 SERVICE 22
SERV23 SERVICE 23
SERV24 SERVICE 24
SERV25 SERVICE 25
SERV26 SERVICE 26
SERV27 SERVICE 27

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 29+


MOD CALLPOPT
SERV
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SPCONN SEMIPERMANENT CONNECTION


TEL3K TELEPHONY ISDN 3.1KHZ
TEL7K TELEPHONY ISDN 7KHZ
TTX64K TELETEX 64 KBIT/S
UNKNOWN UNKNOWN BEARER SERVICE
VIDEOTEL VIDEOTELEPHONY
VIDEOTEX VIDEOTEXT
VOICEGRP VOICE SERVICES GROUP

BSIGN B-SIDE SIGNALLING COMPAT.

This parameter specifies the basic signalling services


associated with one internal service.
This internal service is specified by the parameter SERV.

Notes:
- A basic signalling service parameter should not be entered twice.
- This parameter must always be entered with parameter
SERV.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: KIND OF PROTOCOL
ANALOG ANALOG SERVICES
EDSS1 EDSS1:DIG.SUB.SIGNAL.1(BLUEB.)
ISDN1TR6 1TR6:TECHN.RICHTL.(REDB.)

This unit specifies the type of signalling protocol of the


terminating side of the call.
This parameter can only be used during Installation Recovery.

b: INTERNAL SERVICE OF B-SIDE


TANALOG TRAFFIC ANALOG MODE
TCMAUDIO TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE 3.1KHZ AUDIO
TCMAUDI7 TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE 7KHZ AUDIO
TCMSERV6 TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE SERVICE 06
TCMSERV7 TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE SERVICE 07
TCMSPEEC TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE SPEECH
TCMUNRST TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE UNRESTR.
TFAX3 TRAFFIC TELEFAX GROUP 2/3
TFAX4 TRAFFIC TELEFAX GROUP 4
TNOSERV TRAFFIC NO SERVICE
TPMBCHAN TRAFFIC PACKET MODE B-CHANNEL
TPMBDCHA TRAFFIC PACKET MODE BD-CHANNEL
TPMDCHAN TRAFFIC PACKET MODE D-CHANNEL
TSERV19 TRAFFIC SERVICE 19
TSERV20 TRAFFIC SERVICE 20
TSERV21 TRAFFIC SERVICE 21
TSERV22 TRAFFIC SERVICE 22
TSERV23 TRAFFIC SERVICE 23
TSERV24 TRAFFIC SERVICE 24
TSERV25 TRAFFIC SERVICE 25
TSERV26 TRAFFIC SERVICE 26
TSERV27 TRAFFIC SERVICE 27
TSERV29 TRAFFIC SERVICE 29
TSERV30 TRAFFIC SERVICE 30
TSERV31 TRAFFIC SERVICE 31
TSPCONN TRAFFIC SEMIPERM. CONNECTION
TTEL3K TRAFFIC TELEPHONY ISDN 3.1KHZ
TTEL7K TRAFFIC TELEPHONY ISDN 7KHZ
TTTX64K TRAFFIC TELETEX 64 KBIT/S
TUNKNOWN TRAFFIC UNKNOWN BEARER SERV.
TVIDEOTL TRAFFIC VIDEOTELEPHONY
TVIDEOTX TRAFFIC VIDEOTEXT

This unit specifies the internal service, that is associated


to the type of signalling protocol of the terminating
side of the call.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 30+


MOD CALLPOPT
SERVTYPE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

MODIFIC. SEVERAL INTERNAL SERVICES

This input format modifies the powersets of services for one or more services.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD CALLPOPT : SERV= <,TYPE= ,CTYPE=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SERV INTERNAL SERVICE

This parameter specifies which internal service has parameters


to be modified.

Notes:
- This parameter must always be entered with at least one of the
parameters TYPE, CTYPE, COMPORIG, COMPTERM or BSIGN.
- The values of parameter SERV are verified against the
powerset of TRAFFIC services.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

TANALOG TRAFFIC ANALOG MODE


TCMAUDIO TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE 3.1KHZ AUDIO
TCMAUDI7 TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE 7KHZ AUDIO
TCMSERV6 TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE SERVICE 06
TCMSERV7 TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE SERVICE 07
TCMSPEEC TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE SPEECH
TCMUNRST TRAFFIC CIRC.MODE UNRESTR.
TFAX3 TRAFFIC TELEFAX GROUP 2/3
TFAX4 TRAFFIC TELEFAX GROUP 4
TPMBCHAN TRAFFIC PACKET MODE B-CHANNEL
TPMBDCHA TRAFFIC PACKET MODE BD-CHANNEL
TPMDCHAN TRAFFIC PACKET MODE D-CHANNEL
TSERV19 TRAFFIC SERVICE 19
TSERV20 TRAFFIC SERVICE 20
TSERV21 TRAFFIC SERVICE 21
TSERV22 TRAFFIC SERVICE 22
TSERV23 TRAFFIC SERVICE 23
TSERV24 TRAFFIC SERVICE 24
TSERV25 TRAFFIC SERVICE 25
TSERV26 TRAFFIC SERVICE 26
TSERV27 TRAFFIC SERVICE 27
TSERV29 TRAFFIC SERVICE 29
TSERV30 TRAFFIC SERVICE 30
TSERV31 TRAFFIC SERVICE 31
TSPCONN TRAFFIC SEMIPERM. CONNECTION
TTEL3K TRAFFIC TELEPHONY ISDN 3.1KHZ
TTEL7K TRAFFIC TELEPHONY ISDN 7KHZ
TTTX64K TRAFFIC TELETEX 64 KBIT/S
TUNKNOWN TRAFFIC UNKNOWN BEARER SERV.
TVIDEOTL TRAFFIC VIDEOTELEPHONY
TVIDEOTX TRAFFIC VIDEOTEXT

TYPE SERVICE TYPE

This parameter specifies the set of services where the entered


service shall be added.

Notes:
- This parameter must always be entered with parameter
SERV or ADMSERV.
- The TRAFFIC ,VOICE services can only be
modified using parameter SERV.
- All other service types are administrative services and can
only be modified using parameter ADMSERV.
- All VOICE services must also be contained in the powerset of
TRAFFIC services.
- All SCIVOICE services must also be contained in the powerset of
VOICE services except for ADMSERV is VOICEGRP and ALLGRP.
In case of ADMSERV is NONVCGRP SCIVOICE is not possible.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 31+


MOD CALLPOPT
SERVTYPE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- All standard services must also be contained in the powerset of


the corresponding administrative service.
- The following parameter values are only allowed during Installation
Recovery : TRAFFIC, (only for internal services)
VOICE, (only for internal services)
SCIVOICE, (only for administrative services)
ADMIN, (only for adminstrative services)
SUB, (only for adminstrative services)
SUB1TR6, (only for adminstrative services)
PHI, (only for adminstrative services)
FH, (only for adminstrative services)
QSIG, (only for adminstrative services)

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

TRAFFIC INTERNAL SERVICE


VOICE VOICE SERVICE

CTYPE CANCEL SERVICE TYPE

This parameter specifies the set of services from which the entered
service shall be deleted.

Notes:
- This parameter must always be entered with parameter
SERV or ADMSERV.
- The TRAFFIC,VOICE services can only be
modified using parameter SERV.
- All other service types are administrative services and can
only be modified using parameter ADMSERV.
- In the case of CTYPE = TRAFFIC the complete sequence of
administrative services for the addressed TRAFFIC service in
the compatibility tables will be deleted automatically.
- In the case of CTYPE = VOICE the complete sequence
of administrative services for the addressed VOICE
service and SCIVOICE service in the compatibility-
tables will be deleted automatically.
- In the case of CTYPE = ADMIN it is verified that the addressed
service is not used in the compatibility tables.
- The following parameter values are only allowed during Installation
Recovery : TRAFFIC, (only for internal services)
VOICE, (only for internal services)
SCIVOICE, (only for administrative services)
ADMIN, (only for adminstrative services)
SUB, (only for adminstrative services)
SUB1TR6, (only for adminstrative services)
PHI, (only for adminstrative services)
FH, (only for adminstrative services)
QSIG, (only for adminstrative services)

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

TRAFFIC INTERNAL SERVICE


VOICE VOICE SERVICE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLPOPT- 32-


CAN CALLTYPE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CALL TYPE DATA

This command cancels an ADMOSS or CENTREX call type


for common CDS.

Compatibilities:
- If the ADMOSS call type is assigned to a task group or if it is referenced
in the common service subscriber database, or in the common service
group specific intercept datebase or in the route database, or in the
virtual operator service database it can not be canceled.
- If the CENTREX call type is assigned to a task group or if it is referenced
in the common service subscriber database, it can not be canceled.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This input format is used to cancel an ADMOSS or CENTREX


call type.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CALLTYPE : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,CTYP= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into
several local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CTYP CALL TYPE

This parameter specifies the ADMOSS or CENTREX


call type name.

Prerequisites:
- The call type name must exist.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CALLTYPE- 1-


CR CALLTYPE
CRCCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE CALL TYPE DATA

This command creates an ADMOSS or CENTREX call type


for common CDS.

Prerequisites:
- A call type can only be entered if the common service group is already
existing.
- The call type name must be unique in a common service group.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR CALLTYPE - CRCCTYP CREATE CENTREX CALL TYPE


2. CR CALLTYPE - CRHDCTYP CREATE HIGH PERF.DL.CALL TYPE
3. CR CALLTYPE - CROCTYP CREATE ADMOSS CALL TYPE

1. Input format

CREATE CENTREX CALL TYPE

This input format is used to create a CENTREX call type.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR CALLTYPE : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,CTYP= [,LAC=] [,DN=] 1
1 1
1 [,CTYPFEA=] [,INCEPT=] [,GOS=] [,APPLID=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,OCALSEQ=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into
several local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CTYP CALL TYPE

This parameter specifies the ADMOSS or CENTREX call type name.

Prerequisites:
- The call type name must not exist in the common service group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CALLTYPE- 1+
CR CALLTYPE
CRCCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code of the call type.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the call type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CTYPFEA CALL TYPE FEATURE

This parameter specifies the feature of the call type.

Following inputs are allowed:


SPECOP
AUTOCB
AUTOTC
AUTOGR
SCREENLT
NATDNA
INATDNA
NATDNAR
INATDNAR
RNATDNA
RINATDNA
RCSROPR
RCSRANN
RCSRLS
VOPRSVP
CTLIST
ACDMON
ROUTING
ENHROUT
INETSERV
FEA1
FEA2
FEA3

Following inputs are incompatible for one Calltype:

SPECOP & RCSROPR


SPECOP & RCSRANN
SPECOP & RCSRLS
SPECOP & CTLIST

AUTOCB & RCSROPR


AUTOCB & RCSRANN
AUTOCB & RCSRLS

AUTOTC & RCSROPR


AUTOTC & RCSRANN
AUTOTC & RCSRLS
AUTOTC & CTLIST

RCSROPR & RCSRANN


RCSROPR & RCSRLS
RCSRANN & RCSRLS

ACDMON & ROUTING


ACDMON & ENHROUT
ROUTING & ENHROUT
INETSERV & SPECOP
INETSERV & AUTOCB
INETSERV & AUTOTC
INETSERV & AUTOGR

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CALLTYPE- 2+
CR CALLTYPE
CRCCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

INETSERV & SCREENLT


INETSERV & NATDNA
INETSERV & INATDNA
INETSERV & NATDNAR
INETSERV & INATDNAR
INETSERV & RNATDNA
INETSERV & RINATDNA
INETSERV & RCSROPR
INETSERV & RCSRANN
INETSERV & RCSRLS
INETSERV & VOPRSVP
INETSERV & CTLIST
INETSERV & ACDMON
INETSERV & ROUTING
INETSERV & ENHROUT
INETSERV & FEA1
INETSERV & FEA2
INETSERV & FEA3

Following Call Type Feature are only once allowed in a


Common Service Group:

SPECOP
AUTOCB
AUTOTC

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ACDMON ACTIVATES CDS MONITORING


ENHROUT ENHANCED ROUTING
FEA1 FEATURE 1
FEA2 FEATURE 2
FEA3 FEATURE 3
ROUTING ROUTING

INCEPT INTERCEPT

This parameter specifies the intercept for a calltype.

For following intercepts only the fix Part is allowed:


QPOS
QWAIT

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: INTERCEPT WITH DATA


GREET SERV.GREETING ANNOUNCEMENT
OPRQ OPERATOR QUEUE
OPRQFULL OPERATOR QUEUE FULL
QPOS QUEUE POSITION ANNOUNCEMENT
QWAIT QUEUE WAITING ANNOUNCEMENT
ROUTFAIL ROUTING FAILED
TAGUNMAN TASKGROUP UNMANNED

b: NAME=
1...8 characters from the
symbolic name character set

GOS GRADE OF SERVICE

This parameter specifies the grade of service for a calltype.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: GOS WITH DATA


HOLD HOLDING
QABANDC QUEUEING TIME ABANDONED CALLS
QPRESC QUEUEING TIME PRESENTED CALLS

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CALLTYPE- 3+
CR CALLTYPE
CRCCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: TIME1=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

c: TIME2=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

d: TIME3=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

APPLID APPLICATION IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the Application Identification.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...255, range of decimal numbers

OCALSEQ OCANEQ KIND & SEQ OF LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the languages of the announcements and the


sequences of these languages for QPOS and QWAIT. Input of up to
4 languages for one sequence is possible.
Value NONE indicates the use of the switch-specific value entered by
the command MOD CALLPOPT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(L1 )
1L1L2 1
1L1L2L3 1
1L1L2L3L41
1L1L2L4 1
1L1L2L4L31
1L1L3 1
1L1L3L2 1
1L1L3L2L41
1L1L3L4 1
1L1L3L4L21
1L1L4 1
1L1L4L2 1
1L1L4L2L31
1L1L4L3 1
1L1L4L3L21
1L2 1
1L2L1 1
1L2L1L3 1
1L2L1L3L41
1L2L1L4 1
1L2L1L4L31
1L2L3 1
1L2L3L1 1
1L2L3L1L41
1L2L3L4 1
1L2L3L4L11
1L2L4 1
1L2L4L1 1
1L2L4L1L31
1L2L4L3 1
ZL2L4L3L1Y
1L3 1
1L3L1 1
1L3L1L2 1
1L3L1L2L41
1L3L1L4 1
1L3L1L4L21
1L3L2 1
1L3L2L1 1
1L3L2L1L41
1L3L2L4 1
1L3L2L4L11
1L3L4 1
1L3L4L1 1
1L3L4L1L21
1L3L4L2 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CALLTYPE- 4+
CR CALLTYPE
CRCCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1L3L4L2L11
1L4 1
1L4L1 1
1L4L1L2 1
1L4L1L2L31
1L4L1L3 1
1L4L1L3L21
1L4L2 1
1L4L2L1 1
1L4L2L1L31
1L4L2L3 1
1L4L2L3L11
1L4L3 1
1L4L3L1 1
1L4L3L1L21
1L4L3L2 1
1L4L3L2L11
*NONE +

Default: NONE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CALLTYPE- 5+
CR CALLTYPE
CRHDCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

CREATE HIGH PERF.DL.CALL TYPE

This input format is used to create an ADMOSS call type


for high Performance Datalink

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR CALLTYPE : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,CTYP= [,VOPSERV=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into
several local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CTYP CALL TYPE

This parameter specifies the ADMOSS or CENTREX call type name.

Prerequisites:
- The call type name must not exist in the common service group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

VOPSERV VIRTUAL OPERATOR SERVICE

This parameter assignes one virtual operator service to an


ADMOSS call type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BCHDL B-CHANNEL DATALINK

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CALLTYPE- 6+
CR CALLTYPE
CROCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

CREATE ADMOSS CALL TYPE

This input format is used to create an ADMOSS call type.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR CALLTYPE : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,CTYP= [,LAC=] [,DN=] 1
1 1
1 [,CTYPFEA=] [,CTYPR=] [,DICON=] [,INCEPT=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,GOS=] [,APPLID=] [,VOPSERV=] [,OCALSEQ=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into
several local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CTYP CALL TYPE

This parameter specifies the ADMOSS or CENTREX call type name.

Prerequisites:
- The call type name must not exist in the common service group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code of the call type.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the call type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CALLTYPE- 7+
CR CALLTYPE
CROCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CTYPFEA CALL TYPE FEATURE

This parameter specifies the feature of the call type.

Following inputs are allowed:


SPECOP
AUTOCB
AUTOTC
AUTOGR
SCREENLT
NATDNA
INATDNA
NATDNAR
INATDNAR
RNATDNA
RINATDNA
RCSROPR
RCSRANN
RCSRLS
VOPRSVP
CTLIST
ACDMON
ROUTING
ENHROUT
INETSERV
FEA1
FEA2
FEA3

Following inputs are incompatible for one Calltype:

SPECOP & RCSROPR


SPECOP & RCSRANN
SPECOP & RCSRLS
SPECOP & CTLIST

AUTOCB & RCSROPR


AUTOCB & RCSRANN
AUTOCB & RCSRLS

AUTOTC & RCSROPR


AUTOTC & RCSRANN
AUTOTC & RCSRLS
AUTOTC & CTLIST

RCSROPR & RCSRANN


RCSROPR & RCSRLS
RCSRANN & RCSRLS

ACDMON & ROUTING


ACDMON & ENHROUT
ROUTING & ENHROUT
INETSERV & SPECOP
INETSERV & AUTOCB
INETSERV & AUTOTC
INETSERV & AUTOGR
INETSERV & SCREENLT
INETSERV & NATDNA
INETSERV & INATDNA
INETSERV & NATDNAR
INETSERV & INATDNAR
INETSERV & RNATDNA
INETSERV & RINATDNA
INETSERV & RCSROPR
INETSERV & RCSRANN
INETSERV & RCSRLS
INETSERV & VOPRSVP
INETSERV & CTLIST
INETSERV & ACDMON
INETSERV & ROUTING
INETSERV & ENHROUT
INETSERV & FEA1
INETSERV & FEA2
INETSERV & FEA3

Following Call Type Feature are only once allowed in a


Common Service Group:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CALLTYPE- 8+
CR CALLTYPE
CROCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SPECOP
AUTOCB
AUTOTC

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ACDMON ACTIVATES CDS MONITORING


AUTOCB AUTOMATIC CALL BACK
AUTOGR AUTOMATIC GREETING
AUTOTC AUTOMATIC TIME & CHARGE
CTLIST CALL TRANSFER LIST
ENHROUT ENHANCED ROUTING
FEA1 FEATURE 1
FEA2 FEATURE 2
FEA3 FEATURE 3
INATDNA INAT.DN ASSISTANCE
INATDNAR INAT.DN ASSIST.WITH RECON.POS.
INETSERV INTERNET SERVICE
NATDNA NAT.DN ASSISTANCE
NATDNAR NAT.DN ASSIST.WITH RECON.POSS.
RCSRANN RCS RECONNECT TO ANNOUNCEMENT
RCSRLS RCS RELEASE CALL
RCSROPR RCS RECONNECT TO OPERATOR
RINATDNA RECONNECT FROM INAT.DN ASSIST.
RNATDNA RECONNECT FROM NAT.DN ASSIST.
ROUTING ROUTING
SCREENLT SCREENING LIST
SPECOP SPECIFIC OPERATOR
VOPRSVP VIRT.OPR.SERVICE POSSIBLE

CTYPR CALL TYPE RECONNECTED

This parameter specifies the reconnected call type for ADMOSS.

Prerequisites:
- The call type name must exist in the common service group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DICON DIGIT CONVERTING CODE

This parameter specifies the digit converting code.


It is only entered, if the call type should be created for
quasiautomatic calls, to modify the existing dial information.

The following modifications can be made:


- removal of digits
- insertion of digits
- replacement of digits

Valid input characters:


0-9, A-F, #, +, ., X

The control characters have the following significance:


X : The character of the old code remains as it is.
. : The character of the old code is deleted.
+ : The character following this character, up to the
next control character, are inserted or added at the
appropriate place.

Example:
a = 123XX. specifies that the first 3 digits of the existing
dial information are replaced by 123, the next 2 digits remain
and the 6th digits is omitted.
The existing dial information 7944583 is changed to 123453.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CALLTYPE- 9+
CR CALLTYPE
CROCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

INCEPT INTERCEPT

This parameter specifies the intercept for a calltype.

For following intercepts only the fix Part is allowed:


QPOS
QWAIT

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: INTERCEPT WITH DATA


GREET SERV.GREETING ANNOUNCEMENT
OPRQ OPERATOR QUEUE
OPRQFULL OPERATOR QUEUE FULL
QPOS QUEUE POSITION ANNOUNCEMENT
QWAIT QUEUE WAITING ANNOUNCEMENT
ROUTFAIL ROUTING FAILED
TAGUNMAN TASKGROUP UNMANNED

b: NAME=
1...8 characters from the
symbolic name character set

GOS GRADE OF SERVICE

This parameter specifies the grade of service for a calltype.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: GOS WITH DATA


HOLD HOLDING
QABANDC QUEUEING TIME ABANDONED CALLS
QPRESC QUEUEING TIME PRESENTED CALLS

b: TIME1=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

c: TIME2=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

d: TIME3=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

APPLID APPLICATION IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the Application Identification.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...255, range of decimal numbers

VOPSERV VIRTUAL OPERATOR SERVICE

This parameter assignes one virtual operator service to an


ADMOSS call type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC AUTOMATIC CALL COMPLETION


BCHDL B-CHANNEL DATALINK
NOSERV NO SERVICE
ONAA ONE NUMBER AGENT ACCESS
SEMADA SEMI AUTOMATIC DIR.ASSISTANCE
VOPS01 VIRT.OPERATOR SERVICE 1
VOPS02 VIRT.OPERATOR SERVICE 2
VOPS03 VIRT.OPERATOR SERVICE 3
VOPS04 VIRT.OPERATOR SERVICE 4

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CALLTYPE- 10+


CR CALLTYPE
CROCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

VOPS05 VIRT.OPERATOR SERVICE 5


VOPS06 VIRT.OPERATOR SERVICE 6
VOPS07 VIRT.OPERATOR SERVICE 7
VOPS08 VIRT.OPERATOR SERVICE 8
VOPS09 VIRT.OPERATOR SERVICE 9
VOPS10 VIRT.OPERATOR SERVICE 10

OCALSEQ OCANEQ KIND & SEQ OF LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the languages of the announcements and the


sequences of these languages for QPOS and QWAIT. Input of up to
4 languages for one sequence is possible.
Value NONE indicates the use of the switch-specific value entered by
the command MOD CALLPOPT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(L1 )
1L1L2 1
1L1L2L3 1
1L1L2L3L41
1L1L2L4 1
1L1L2L4L31
1L1L3 1
1L1L3L2 1
1L1L3L2L41
1L1L3L4 1
1L1L3L4L21
1L1L4 1
1L1L4L2 1
1L1L4L2L31
1L1L4L3 1
1L1L4L3L21
1L2 1
1L2L1 1
1L2L1L3 1
1L2L1L3L41
1L2L1L4 1
1L2L1L4L31
1L2L3 1
1L2L3L1 1
1L2L3L1L41
1L2L3L4 1
1L2L3L4L11
1L2L4 1
1L2L4L1 1
1L2L4L1L31
1L2L4L3 1
ZL2L4L3L1Y
1L3 1
1L3L1 1
1L3L1L2 1
1L3L1L2L41
1L3L1L4 1
1L3L1L4L21
1L3L2 1
1L3L2L1 1
1L3L2L1L41
1L3L2L4 1
1L3L2L4L11
1L3L4 1
1L3L4L1 1
1L3L4L1L21
1L3L4L2 1
1L3L4L2L11
1L4 1
1L4L1 1
1L4L1L2 1
1L4L1L2L31
1L4L1L3 1
1L4L1L3L21
1L4L2 1
1L4L2L1 1
1L4L2L1L31
1L4L2L3 1
1L4L2L3L11
1L4L3 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CALLTYPE- 11+


CR CALLTYPE
CROCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1L4L3L1 1
1L4L3L1L21
1L4L3L2 1
1L4L3L2L11
*NONE +

Default: NONE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CALLTYPE- 12-


DISP CALLTYPE
DICTCSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CALL TYPE DATA

This command displays ADMOSS or CENTREX call type data


for common CDS.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command allows multiple starts.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP CALLTYPE- DICTCSG DISP.CALL TYPE FOR CSG


2. DISP CALLTYPE- DICTDN DISP.CALL TYPE FOR DN
3. DISP CALLTYPE- DICTOCSG DISP.CALL TYPE ONE CSG

1. Input format

DISP.CALL TYPE FOR CSG

This input format is used to display call type


data of a specific common service group or
to get an overview of several common service
groups.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CALLTYPE : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CALLTYPE- 1+


DISP CALLTYPE
DICTDN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

DISP.CALL TYPE FOR DN

This input format is used to display call types


that are connected with a directory number.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CALLTYPE : [LAC=] ,DN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code of the ADMOSS


or CENTREX call type.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the ADMOSS


or CENTREX call type.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CALLTYPE- 2+


DISP CALLTYPE
DICTOCSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

DISP.CALL TYPE ONE CSG

This input format is used to display call type


data of a specific common service group.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CALLTYPE : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= [,CTYP=] [,CTYPFEA=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CTYP CALL TYPE

This parameter specifies the ADMOSS or CENTREX


call type name.

Notes:
- If X is entered for CSGLAC and/or CSGDN this
parameter is not allowed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CTYPFEA CALL TYPE FEATURE

This parameter specifies the feature of the call type.

Notes:
- If X is entered for CSGLAC and/or CSGDN this
parameter is not allowed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ACDMON ACTIVATES CDS MONITORING


AUTOCB AUTOMATIC CALL BACK
AUTOGR AUTOMATIC GREETING
AUTOTC AUTOMATIC TIME & CHARGE
CTLIST CALL TRANSFER LIST
ENHROUT ENHANCED ROUTING
FEA1 FEATURE 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CALLTYPE- 3+


DISP CALLTYPE
DICTOCSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

FEA2 FEATURE 2
FEA3 FEATURE 3
INATDNA INAT.DN ASSISTANCE
INATDNAR INAT.DN ASSIST.WITH RECON.POS.
INETSER INTERNET SERVICE
NATDNA NAT.DN ASSISTANCE
NATDNAR NAT.DN ASSIST.WITH RECON.POSS.
RCSRANN RCS RECONNECT TO ANNOUNCEMENT
RCSRLS RCS RELEASE CALL
RCSROPR RCS RECONNECT TO OPERATOR
RINATDNA RECONNECT FROM INAT.DN ASSIST.
RNATDNA RECONNECT FROM NAT.DN ASSIST.
ROUTING ROUTING
SCREENLT SCREENING LIST
SPECOP SPECIFIC OPERATOR
VOPRSVP VIRTUAL OPR.SERVICE POSSIBLE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CALLTYPE- 4-


MOD CALLTYPE
MOCCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY CALL TYPE DATA

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD CALLTYPE - MOCCTYP MODIFY CENTREX CALL TYPE


2. MOD CALLTYPE - MOHDCTYP MODIFY HIGH PERF.DL.CALL TYPE
3. MOD CALLTYPE - MOOCTYP MODIFY ADMOSS CALL TYPE

1. Input format

MODIFY CENTREX CALL TYPE

This input format is used to modify a CENTEX call type.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD CALLTYPE : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,CTYP= <,NCTYP= ,LAC= ,DN= 1
1 1
1 ,CLAC= ,CDN= ,CXCTYP= ,CTYPFEA= ,CCTYPFEA= 1
1 1
1 ,INCEPT= ,CINCEPT= ,GOS= ,CGOS= ,APPLID= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,OCALSEQ=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into
several local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CTYP CALL TYPE

This parameter specifies the ADMOSS or CENTREX call type name.

Prerequisites:
- The call type name must exist.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NCTYP NEW CALL TYPE

This parameter specifies the new name of the ADMOSS or


CENTREX call type.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLTYPE- 1+


MOD CALLTYPE
MOCCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Prerequisites:
- The new name must not exist in the common service group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code of the call type.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the call type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLAC CANCEL LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the cancel local area code of the call
type.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CDN CANCEL DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the cancel directory number of the


call type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CXCTYP FIX CENTREX CALL TYPE

This parameter specifies the fixed CENTREX call type.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ATATGR ATTN. TO ATTN. GROUP CALL


ATNCO ATTN. RECALL FROM CAMP-ON
ATNGR DIAL ATTENDANT GROUP CALL
ATNIC ATTENDANT INTERCEPT INCOMING
ATNOG ATTENDANT INTERCEPT OUTGOING
CRLFCD CALL REDIRECTED TO LFCD NUMBER
CRNS CALL REDIRECTED TO NS NUMBER
CSHRATN CALL TO SHARED ATTENDANT
DIVBY BUSY LINE DIVERSION
DIVDA DO NOT ANSWER DIVERSION
DIVI IMMEDIATE DIVERSION
DTAC DIAL THROUGH ATTN. CALL
HOTATN HOTLINE CALL TO ATTN.
ILPDNAG INAT.CALL TO LPDN OF ATTN.GRP.
NLPDNAG NAT.CALL TO LPDN OF ATTN.GRP.
NOWORK CALL TO NON-WORKING NUMBER
OAWIID OPR.ASSIST.WITH IDENTIFICATION
OAWOID OPR.ASSIST.WITHOUT IDENT.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLTYPE- 2+


MOD CALLTYPE
MOCCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RESECATN REROUTE TO SERIAL CALL ATTN.


REST RESTRICTED CALL TO ATTENDANT
SPECL SPECIAL (E.G. NIGHT SERVICE)
TOLDIV TOLL DIVERSION TO ATTENDANT
TRANS TRANSFERRED CALL

CTYPFEA CALL TYPE FEATURE

This parameter specifies the feature of the call type.

Following inputs are allowed:


SPECOP
AUTOCB
AUTOTC
AUTOGR
SCREENLT
NATDNA
INATDNA
NATDNAR
INATDNAR
RNATDNA
RINATDNA
RCSROPR
RCSRANN
RCSRLS
VOPRSVP
CTLIST
ACDMON
ROUTING
ENHROUT
INETSERV
FEA1
FEA2
FEA3

Following inputs are incompatible for one Calltype:

SPECOP & RCSROPR


SPECOP & RCSRANN
SPECOP & RCSRLS
SPECOP & CTLIST

AUTOCB & RCSROPR


AUTOCB & RCSRANN
AUTOCB & RCSRLS

AUTOTC & RCSROPR


AUTOTC & RCSRANN
AUTOTC & RCSRLS
AUTOTC & CTLIST

RCSROPR & RCSRANN


RCSROPR & RCSRLS
RCSRANN & RCSRLS

ACDMON & ROUTING


ACDMON & ENHROUT
ROUTING & ENHROUT

INETSERV & SPECOP


INETSERV & AUTOCB
INETSERV & AUTOTC
INETSERV & AUTOGR
INETSERV & SCREENLT
INETSERV & NATDNA
INETSERV & INATDNA
INETSERV & NATDNAR
INETSERV & INATDNAR
INETSERV & RNATDNA
INETSERV & RINATDNA
INETSERV & RCSROPR
INETSERV & RCSRANN
INETSERV & RCSRLS
INETSERV & VOPRSVP
INETSERV & CTLIST
INETSERV & ACDMON
INETSERV & ROUTING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLTYPE- 3+


MOD CALLTYPE
MOCCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

INETSERV & ENHROUT


INETSERV & FEA1
INETSERV & FEA2
INETSERV & FEA3

Following Call Type Feature are only once allowed in a


Common Service Group:

SPECOP
AUTOCB
AUTOTC

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ACDMON ACTIVATES CDS MONITORING


ENHROUT ENHANCED ROUTING
FEA1 FEATURE 1
FEA2 FEATURE 2
FEA3 FEATURE 3
ROUTING ROUTING

CCTYPFEA CANCEL CALL TYPE FEATURE

This parameter specifies the cancel call type features.

Following inputs are allowed:


SPECOP
AUTOCB
AUTOTC
AUTOGR
SCREENLT
NATDNA
INATDNA
NATDNAR
INATDNAR
RNATDNA
RINATDNA
RCSROPR
RCSRANN
RCSRLS
VOPRSVP
CTLIST
ACDMON
ROUTING
ENHROUT
INETSERV
FEA1
FEA2
FEA3

Following inputs are incompatible for one Calltype:

SPECOP & RCSROPR


SPECOP & RCSRANN
SPECOP & RCSRLS
SPECOP & CTLIST

AUTOCB & RCSROPR


AUTOCB & RCSRANN
AUTOCB & RCSRLS

AUTOTC & RCSROPR


AUTOTC & RCSRANN
AUTOTC & RCSRLS
AUTOTC & CTLIST

RCSROPR & RCSRANN


RCSROPR & RCSRLS
RCSRANN & RCSRLS

ACDMON & ROUTING


ACDMON & ENHROUT
ROUTING & ENHROUT

INETSERV & SPECOP


INETSERV & AUTOCB

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLTYPE- 4+


MOD CALLTYPE
MOCCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

INETSERV & AUTOTC


INETSERV & AUTOGR
INETSERV & SCREENLT
INETSERV & NATDNA
INETSERV & INATDNA
INETSERV & NATDNAR
INETSERV & INATDNAR
INETSERV & RNATDNA
INETSERV & RINATDNA
INETSERV & RCSROPR
INETSERV & RCSRANN
INETSERV & RCSRLS
INETSERV & VOPRSVP
INETSERV & CTLIST
INETSERV & ACDMON
INETSERV & ROUTING
INETSERV & ENHROUT
INETSERV & FEA1
INETSERV & FEA2
INETSERV & FEA3

Following Call Type Feature are only once allowed in a


Common Service Group:

SPECOP
AUTOCB
AUTOTC

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ACDMON ACTIVATES CDS MONITORING


ENHROUT ENHANCED ROUTING
FEA1 FEATURE 1
FEA2 FEATURE 2
FEA3 FEATURE 3
ROUTING ROUTING

INCEPT INTERCEPT

This parameter specifies the intercept for a calltype.

For following intercepts only the fix Part is allowed:


QPOS
QWAIT

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: INTERCEPT WITH DATA


GREET SERV.GREETING ANNOUNCEMENT
OPRQ OPERATOR QUEUE
OPRQFULL OPERATOR QUEUE FULL
QPOS QUEUE POSITION ANNOUNCEMENT
QWAIT QUEUE WAITING ANNOUNCEMENT
ROUTFAIL ROUTING FAILED
TAGUNMAN TASKGROUP UNMANNED

b: NAME=
1...8 characters from the
symbolic name character set

CINCEPT CANCEL INTERCEPT

This parameter cancels the intercept for a calltype.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

GREET SERV.GREETING ANNOUNCEMENT


OPRQ OPERATOR QUEUE
OPRQFULL OPERATOR QUEUE FULL
QPOS QUEUE POSITION ANNOUNCEMENT
QWAIT QUEUE WAITING ANNOUNCEMENT

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLTYPE- 5+


MOD CALLTYPE
MOCCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ROUTFAIL ROUTING FAILED


TAGUNMAN TASKGROUP UNMANNED

GOS GRADE OF SERVICE

This parameter specifies the grade of service for a calltype.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: GOS WITH DATA


HOLD HOLDING
QABANDC QUEUEING TIME ABANDONED CALLS
QPRESC QUEUEING TIME PRESENTED CALLS

b: TIME1=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

c: TIME2=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

d: TIME3=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

CGOS CANCEL GRADE OF SERVICE

This parameter cancels the grade of service for a calltype.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

HOLD HOLDING
QABANDC QUEUEING TIME ABANDONED CALLS
QPRESC QUEUEING TIME PRESENTED CALLS

APPLID APPLICATION

This parameter specifies the Application Identification.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...255, range of decimal numbers

OCALSEQ OCANEQ KIND & SEQ OF LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the languages of the announcements and the


sequences of these languages for QPOS and QWAIT. Input of up to
4 languages for one sequence is possible.
Value NONE indicates the use of the switch-specific value entered by
the command MOD CALLPOPT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

L1
L1L2
L1L2L3
L1L2L3L4
L1L2L4
L1L2L4L3
L1L3
L1L3L2
L1L3L2L4
L1L3L4
L1L3L4L2
L1L4
L1L4L2
L1L4L2L3
L1L4L3
L1L4L3L2
L2
L2L1
L2L1L3

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLTYPE- 6+


MOD CALLTYPE
MOCCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

L2L1L3L4
L2L1L4
L2L1L4L3
L2L3
L2L3L1
L2L3L1L4
L2L3L4
L2L3L4L1
L2L4
L2L4L1
L2L4L1L3
L2L4L3
L2L4L3L1
L3
L3L1
L3L1L2
L3L1L2L4
L3L1L4
L3L1L4L2
L3L2
L3L2L1
L3L2L1L4
L3L2L4
L3L2L4L1
L3L4
L3L4L1
L3L4L1L2
L3L4L2
L3L4L2L1
L4
L4L1
L4L1L2
L4L1L2L3
L4L1L3
L4L1L3L2
L4L2
L4L2L1
L4L2L1L3
L4L2L3
L4L2L3L1
L4L3
L4L3L1
L4L3L1L2
L4L3L2
L4L3L2L1
NONE

Default: NONE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLTYPE- 7+


MOD CALLTYPE
MOHDCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

MODIFY HIGH PERF.DL.CALL TYPE

This input format is used to modify an ADMOSS call type


for high Performance Datalink

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD CALLTYPE : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,CTYP= [,VOPSERV=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into
several local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CTYP CALL TYPE

This parameter specifies the ADMOSS or CENTREX call type name.

Prerequisites:
- The call type name must exist.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

VOPSERV VIRTUAL OPERATOR SERVICE

This parameter assignes one virtual operator service to an


ADMOSS call type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BCHDL B-CHANNEL DATALINK

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLTYPE- 8+


MOD CALLTYPE
MOOCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

MODIFY ADMOSS CALL TYPE

This input format is used to modify an ADMOSS call type.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD CALLTYPE : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,CTYP= <,NCTYP= ,LAC= ,DN= 1
1 1
1 ,CLAC= ,CDN= ,CTYPFEA= ,CCTYPFEA= ,CTYPR= 1
1 1
1 ,CCTYPR= ,DICON= ,CDICON= ,INCEPT= ,CINCEPT= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,GOS= ,CGOS= ,APPLID= ,VOPSERV= ,OCALSEQ=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into
several local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CTYP CALL TYPE

This parameter specifies the ADMOSS or CENTREX call type name.

Prerequisites:
- The call type name must exist.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NCTYP NEW CALL TYPE

This parameter specifies the new name of the ADMOSS or


CENTREX call type.

Prerequisites:
- The new name must not exist in the common service group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code of the call type.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLTYPE- 9+


MOD CALLTYPE
MOOCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the call type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLAC CANCEL LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the cancel local area code of the call
type.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CDN CANCEL DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the cancel directory number of the


call type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CTYPFEA CALL TYPE FEATURE

This parameter specifies the feature of the call type.

Following inputs are allowed:


SPECOP
AUTOCB
AUTOTC
AUTOGR
SCREENLT
NATDNA
INATDNA
NATDNAR
INATDNAR
RNATDNA
RINATDNA
RCSROPR
RCSRANN
RCSRLS
VOPRSVP
CTLIST
ACDMON
ROUTING
ENHROUT
INETSERV
FEA1
FEA2
FEA3

Following inputs are incompatible for one Calltype:

SPECOP & RCSROPR


SPECOP & RCSRANN
SPECOP & RCSRLS
SPECOP & CTLIST

AUTOCB & RCSROPR


AUTOCB & RCSRANN
AUTOCB & RCSRLS

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLTYPE- 10+


MOD CALLTYPE
MOOCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

AUTOTC & RCSROPR


AUTOTC & RCSRANN
AUTOTC & RCSRLS
AUTOTC & CTLIST

RCSROPR & RCSRANN


RCSROPR & RCSRLS
RCSRANN & RCSRLS

ACDMON & ROUTING


ACDMON & ENHROUT
ROUTING & ENHROUT

INETSERV & SPECOP


INETSERV & AUTOCB
INETSERV & AUTOTC
INETSERV & AUTOGR
INETSERV & SCREENLT
INETSERV & NATDNA
INETSERV & INATDNA
INETSERV & NATDNAR
INETSERV & INATDNAR
INETSERV & RNATDNA
INETSERV & RINATDNA
INETSERV & RCSROPR
INETSERV & RCSRANN
INETSERV & RCSRLS
INETSERV & VOPRSVP
INETSERV & CTLIST
INETSERV & ACDMON
INETSERV & ROUTING
INETSERV & ENHROUT
INETSERV & FEA1
INETSERV & FEA2
INETSERV & FEA3

Following Call Type Feature are only once allowed in a


Common Service Group:

SPECOP
AUTOCB
AUTOTC

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ACDMON ACTIVATES CDS MONITORING


AUTOCB AUTOMATIC CALL BACK
AUTOGR AUTOMATIC GREETING
AUTOTC AUTOMATIC TIME & CHARGE
CTLIST CALL TRANSFER LIST
ENHROUT ENHANCED ROUTING
FEA1 FEATURE 1
FEA2 FEATURE 2
FEA3 FEATURE 3
INATDNA INAT.DN ASSISTANCE
INATDNAR INAT.DN ASSIST.WITH RECON.POS.
NATDNA NAT.DN ASSISTANCE
NATDNAR NAT.DN ASSIST.WITH RECON.POSS.
RCSRANN RCS RECONNECT TO ANNOUNCEMENT
RCSRLS RCS RELEASE CALL
RCSROPR RCS RECONNECT TO OPERATOR
RINATDNA RECONNECT FROM INAT.DN ASSIST.
RNATDNA RECONNECT FROM NAT.DN ASSIST.
ROUTING ROUTING
SCREENLT SCREENING LIST
SPECOP SPECIFIC OPERATOR
VOPRSVP VIRT.OPR.SERVICE POSSIBLE

CCTYPFEA CANCEL CALL TYPE FEATURE

This parameter specifies the cancel call type features.

Following inputs are allowed:


SPECOP
AUTOCB
AUTOTC

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLTYPE- 11+


MOD CALLTYPE
MOOCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

AUTOGR
SCREENLT
NATDNA
INATDNA
NATDNAR
INATDNAR
RNATDNA
RINATDNA
RCSROPR
RCSRANN
RCSRLS
VOPRSVP
CTLIST
ACDMON
ROUTING
ENHROUT
INETSERV
FEA1
FEA2
FEA3

Following inputs are incompatible for one Calltype:

SPECOP & RCSROPR


SPECOP & RCSRANN
SPECOP & RCSRLS
SPECOP & CTLIST

AUTOCB & RCSROPR


AUTOCB & RCSRANN
AUTOCB & RCSRLS

AUTOTC & RCSROPR


AUTOTC & RCSRANN
AUTOTC & RCSRLS
AUTOTC & CTLIST

RCSROPR & RCSRANN


RCSROPR & RCSRLS
RCSRANN & RCSRLS

ACDMON & ROUTING


ACDMON & ENHROUT
ROUTING & ENHROUT

INETSERV & SPECOP


INETSERV & AUTOCB
INETSERV & AUTOTC
INETSERV & AUTOGR
INETSERV & SCREENLT
INETSERV & NATDNA
INETSERV & INATDNA
INETSERV & NATDNAR
INETSERV & INATDNAR
INETSERV & RNATDNA
INETSERV & RINATDNA
INETSERV & RCSROPR
INETSERV & RCSRANN
INETSERV & RCSRLS
INETSERV & VOPRSVP
INETSERV & CTLIST
INETSERV & ACDMON
INETSERV & ROUTING
INETSERV & ENHROUT
INETSERV & FEA1
INETSERV & FEA2
INETSERV & FEA3

Following Call Type Feature are only once allowed in a


Common Service Group:

SPECOP
AUTOCB
AUTOTC

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLTYPE- 12+


MOD CALLTYPE
MOOCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACDMON ACTIVATES CDS MONITORING


AUTOCB AUTOMATIC CALL BACK
AUTOGR AUTOMATIC GREETING
AUTOTC AUTOMATIC TIME & CHARGE
CTLIST CALL TRANSFER LIST
ENHROUT ENHANCED ROUTING
FEA1 FEATURE 1
FEA2 FEATURE 2
FEA3 FEATURE 3
INATDNA INAT.DN ASSISTANCE
INATDNAR INAT.DN ASSIST.WITH RECON.POS.
NATDNA NAT.DN ASSISTANCE
NATDNAR NAT.DN ASSIST.WITH RECON.POSS.
RCSRANN RCS RECONNECT TO ANNOUNCEMENT
RCSRLS RCS RELEASE CALL
RCSROPR RCS RECONNECT TO OPERATOR
RINATDNA RECONNECT FROM INAT.DN ASSIST.
RNATDNA RECONNECT FROM NAT.DN ASSIST.
ROUTING ROUTING
SCREENLT SCREENING LIST
SPECOP SPECIFIC OPERATOR
VOPRSVP VIRT.OPR.SERVICE POSSIBLE

CTYPR CALL TYPE RECONNECTED

This parameter specifies the ADMOSS reconnected call type.

Prerequisites:
- The call type name must exist in the common service group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CCTYPR CANCEL CALL TYPE RECONNECTED

This parameter cancel the ADMOSS reconnected call type.

Prerequisites:
- The call type name must exist in the common service group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DICON DIGIT CONVERTING CODE

This parameter specifies the digit converting code.


It is entered to modify the existing dial information.

The following modifications can be made:


- removal of digits
- insertion of digits
- replacement of digits

Valid input characters:


0-9, A-F, #, +, ., X

The control characters have the following significance:


X : The character of the old code remains as it is.
. : The character of the old code is deleted.
+ : The character following this character, up to the
next control character, are inserted or added at the
appropriate place.

Example:
a = 123XX. specifies that the first 3 digits of the existing
dial information are replaced by 123, the next 2 digits remain
and the 6th digits is omitted.
The existing dial information 7944583 is changed to 123453.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 characters from the

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLTYPE- 13+


MOD CALLTYPE
MOOCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

symbolic name character set

CDICON CANCEL DIGIT CONVERTING CODE

This parameter specifies the cancel digit converting code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 characters from the


symbolic name character set

INCEPT INTERCEPT

This parameter specifies the intercept for a calltype.

For following intercepts only the fix Part is allowed:


QPOS
QWAIT

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: INTERCEPT WITH DATA


GREET SERV.GREETING ANNOUNCEMENT
OPRQ OPERATOR QUEUE
OPRQFULL OPERATOR QUEUE FULL
QPOS QUEUE POSITION ANNOUNCEMENT
QWAIT QUEUE WAITING ANNOUNCEMENT
ROUTFAIL ROUTING FAILED
TAGUNMAN TASKGROUP UNMANNED

b: NAME=
1...8 characters from the
symbolic name character set

CINCEPT CANCEL INTERCEPT

This parameter cancels the intercept for a calltype.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

GREET SERV.GREETING ANNOUNCEMENT


OPRQ OPERATOR QUEUE
OPRQFULL OPERATOR QUEUE FULL
QPOS QUEUE POSITION ANNOUNCEMENT
QWAIT QUEUE WAITING ANNOUNCEMENT
ROUTFAIL ROUTING FAILED
TAGUNMAN TASKGROUP UNMANNED

GOS GRADE OF SERVICE

This parameter specifies the grade of service for a calltype.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: GOS WITH DATA


HOLD HOLDING
QABANDC QUEUEING TIME ABANDONED CALLS
QPRESC QUEUEING TIME PRESENTED CALLS

b: TIME1=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

c: TIME2=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLTYPE- 14+


MOD CALLTYPE
MOOCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

d: TIME3=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

CGOS CANCEL GRADE OF SERVICE

This parameter cancels the grade of service for a calltype.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

HOLD HOLDING
QABANDC QUEUEING TIME ABANDONED CALLS
QPRESC QUEUEING TIME PRESENTED CALLS

APPLID APPLICATION

This parameter specifies the Application Identification.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...255, range of decimal numbers

VOPSERV VIRTUAL OPERATOR SERVICE

This parameter assignes one virtual operator service to an


ADMOSS call type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC AUTOMATIC CALL COMPLETION


BCHDL B-CHANNEL DATALINK
NOSERV NO SERVICE
ONAA ONE NUMBER AGENT ACCESS
SEMADA SEMI AUTOMATIC DIR.ASSISTANCE
VOPS01 VIRTUAL OPERATOR SERVICE 1
VOPS02 VIRTUAL OPERATOR SERVICE 2
VOPS03 VIRTUAL OPERATOR SERVICE 3
VOPS04 VIRTUAL OPERATOR SERVICE 4
VOPS05 VIRTUAL OPERATOR SERVICE 5
VOPS06 VIRTUAL OPERATOR SERVICE 6
VOPS07 VIRTUAL OPERATOR SERVICE 7
VOPS08 VIRTUAL OPERATOR SERVICE 8
VOPS09 VIRTUAL OPERATOR SERVICE 9
VOPS10 VIRTUAL OPERATOR SERVICE 10

OCALSEQ OCANEQ KIND & SEQ OF LANGUAGE

This parameter specifies the languages of the announcements and the


sequences of these languages for QPOS and QWAIT. Input of up to
4 languages for one sequence is possible.
Value NONE indicates the use of the switch-specific value entered by
the command MOD CALLPOPT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

L1
L1L2
L1L2L3
L1L2L3L4
L1L2L4
L1L2L4L3
L1L3
L1L3L2
L1L3L2L4
L1L3L4
L1L3L4L2
L1L4
L1L4L2
L1L4L2L3
L1L4L3
L1L4L3L2
L2
L2L1
L2L1L3
L2L1L3L4
L2L1L4
L2L1L4L3

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLTYPE- 15+


MOD CALLTYPE
MOOCTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

L2L3
L2L3L1
L2L3L1L4
L2L3L4
L2L3L4L1
L2L4
L2L4L1
L2L4L1L3
L2L4L3
L2L4L3L1
L3
L3L1
L3L1L2
L3L1L2L4
L3L1L4
L3L1L4L2
L3L2
L3L2L1
L3L2L1L4
L3L2L4
L3L2L4L1
L3L4
L3L4L1
L3L4L1L2
L3L4L2
L3L4L2L1
L4
L4L1
L4L1L2
L4L1L2L3
L4L1L3
L4L1L3L2
L4L2
L4L2L1
L4L2L1L3
L4L2L3
L4L2L3L1
L4L3
L4L3L1
L4L3L1L2
L4L3L2
L4L3L2L1
NONE

Default: NONE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CALLTYPE- 16-


CAN CAP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CALL PROCESSOR

This command cancels a call processor.


Prerequisites:
- The call processor must be PLA.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN CAP : CAP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CAP CALL PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the call processor to be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...9, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CAP- 1-


CONF CAP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE CALL PROCESSOR

This command configures a call processor.

Notes:
- The configuration from ACT to MBL and the configuration from
MBL or UNA to ACT is considered dangerous.
A dialog mask is output. The operating personnel must decide by
entering ’+’ or ’-’ whether the command should be executed.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF CAP : CAP= ,OST= [,DIAG=] [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CAP CALL PROCESSOR NUMBER

This parameter specifies the call processor to be configured.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...9, range of decimal numbers

OST OPERATING STATE

This parameter specifies the target operating state.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED
PLA PLANNED

DIAG DIAGNOSIS

This parameter allows diagnosis before configuration to ACT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N CONFIGURE WITHOUT DIAGNOSIS


NO CONFIGURE WITHOUT DIAGNOSIS
Y CONFIGURE WITH DIAGNOSIS
YES CONFIGURE WITH DIAGNOSIS

Default: YES

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF CAP- 1-


CR CAP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE CALL PROCESSOR

This command creates a call processor.


The created call processor is in the operating state PLA after the
command has been executed.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR CAP : CAP= ,PBI= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CAP CALL PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the call processor to be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...9, range of decimal numbers

PBI PHYSICAL BUS INTERFACE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the physical bus interface number.


Notes:
- The physical bus interface number depends on the mounting location
of the call processor.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...15, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CAP- 1-
DIAG CAP
DIAG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSE CALL PROCESSOR

This command initiates single, repeated or permanent diagnostic runs


for a call processor.

Prerequisites:
- The call processor must be MBL.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DIAG CAP - DIAG SINGLE DIAGNOSIS


2. DIAG CAP - REPDIAG REPEATED DIAGNOSIS

1. Input format

SINGLE DIAGNOSIS

This input initiates a single diagnosis for a call processor.


The diagnosis includes a BCMY interface test.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG CAP : CAP= [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CAP CALL PROCESSOR NUMBER

This parameter specifies the call processor to be diagnosed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...9, range of decimal numbers

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG CAP- 1+


DIAG CAP
REPDIAG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

REPEATED DIAGNOSIS

This input initiates a repeated or permanent diagnosis for a call


processor. The diagnosis does not include a BCMY interface test.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG CAP : CAP= ,REP= [,INT=] [,STATCS=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CAP CALL PROCESSOR NUMBER

This parameter specifies the call processor to be diagnosed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...9, range of decimal numbers

REP REPEAT

Valid values are :


2...65535 for repeated diagnosis
PERM for permanent diagnosis with unlimited number
of runs (termination with command STOP JOB)

This parameter specifies the number of diagnostic runs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

INT INTERRUPT DIAGNOSTIC CYCLE

This parameter specifies that a repeated or permanent diagnosis is


interrupted as soon as a fault is detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N CONTINUE IN CASE OF FAULT


NO CONTINUE IN CASE OF FAULT
Y TERMINATE IN CASE OF FAULT
YES TERMINATE IN CASE OF FAULT

Default: NO

STATCS OUTPUT OF STATISTICS

This parameter specifies the interval between statistic outputs


in minutes.

Notes:
- Statistic output can also be requested with the DISP DIAGSTAT
command.

Standard Behavior: no statistic output

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...60, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG CAP- 2-


DISP CAP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CALL PROCESSOR

This command displays all call processors with their physical bus
interface numbers.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CAP ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CAP- 1-


TEST CAP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TEST CALL PROCESSOR

This command tests a call processor.

Prerequisites:
- The call processor must be ACT.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 TEST CAP : [CAP=] [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CAP CALL PROCESSOR NUMBER

This parameter specifies the call processor to be tested.

Notes:
- If the optional unit parameter is omitted, all active call processors
are tested.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...9, range of decimal numbers

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST CAP- 1-


ACT CBPGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP

This command activates either a single or all code block point groups.

It is not possible to activate the code block point group named


"MABEZ",because this group is internally used for traffic monitoring
of mass call destinations (MABEZ destinations).
Activation of all code block point groups does not include the
code block point group "MABEZ".

Prerequisites:
- The given code block point group must exist.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT CBPGRP : CBPGRP= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CBPGRP CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP

This parameter specifies the name of an existing code block point


group.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CBPGRP- 1-


CAN CBPGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP

This command cancels a code block point group.


It is not possible to cancel the code block point group named
"MABEZ", because this group is used for traffic monitoring of
mass call destinations (MABEZ destinations) and is therefore
internally created and cancelled.

Prerequisites:
- No code block point is assigned to this group.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CBPGRP : CBPGRP= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CBPGRP CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP

This parameter specifies the name of the existing code block


point group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CBPGRP- 1-


CR CBPGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP

This command creates a code block point group for the control
function Leaky Bucket. A number of code points may be assigned to
a code block point group with the MML command CR CBPT.
The Leaky Bucket control function limits the number of call attempts
to the code block points of the group to a predefined call attempt
rate. Reduction is active if the defined threshold of call attempts
per second is exceeded.
This results in the rejection of all call attempts to this group
which exceed the predefined limit (parameter LBUCLCR).

Notes:
- It is not possible to create a code block point group named
"MABEZ", because this group is internally used for traffic
monitoring of mass call destinations (MABEZ destinations).
- The number of code block point groups within an exchange is
limited to 500.
- The administered leaky bucket threshold may not be less than
the administered leaky bucket limit call rate.
- The maximum number of code block points assigned to one CBPGRP
is 64.
- The CBPGRP has to be activated by the command ACT CBPGRP,
in order to start traffic control.
- The network management function Leaky Bucket may be activated
(parameter PRIVTRAF=CNTRL, standard value) or deactivated
(parameter PRIVTRAF=NOCNTRL) for a privileged subscriber
(i.e. BEV subscriber).

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR CBPGRP : CBPGRP= ,LBUCLCR= [,LBTHR=] [,PRIVTRAF=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CBPGRP CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP

This parameter specifies the name of a code block point group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LBUCLCR LEAKY BUCKET LIMIT CALL RATE

This parameter specifies the limit of call attempts for the Leaky
Bucket function.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LCPS0P05 LIMIT 0.05 CALLS PER SECOND


LCPS0P1 LIMIT 0.1 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P15 LIMIT 0.15 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P2 LIMIT 0.2 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P25 LIMIT 0.25 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P3 LIMIT 0.3 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P35 LIMIT 0.35 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P4 LIMIT 0.4 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P45 LIMIT 0.45 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P5 LIMIT 0.5 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P55 LIMIT 0.55 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P6 LIMIT 0.6 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P65 LIMIT 0.65 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P7 LIMIT 0.7 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P75 LIMIT 0.75 CALLS PER SECOND

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CBPGRP- 1+
CR CBPGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

LCPS0P8 LIMIT 0.8 CALLS PER SECOND


LCPS0P85 LIMIT 0.85 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P9 LIMIT 0.9 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P95 LIMIT 0.95 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS1P0 LIMIT 1.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS1P2 LIMIT 1.2 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS1P4 LIMIT 1.4 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS1P6 LIMIT 1.6 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS1P8 LIMIT 1.8 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS2P0 LIMIT 2.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS2P2 LIMIT 2.2 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS2P4 LIMIT 2.4 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS2P6 LIMIT 2.6 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS2P8 LIMIT 2.8 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS3P0 LIMIT 3.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS3P2 LIMIT 3.2 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS3P4 LIMIT 3.4 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS3P6 LIMIT 3.6 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS3P8 LIMIT 3.8 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS4P0 LIMIT 4.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS4P2 LIMIT 4.2 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS4P4 LIMIT 4.4 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS4P6 LIMIT 4.6 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS4P8 LIMIT 4.8 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS5P0 LIMIT 5.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS5P5 LIMIT 5.5 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS6P0 LIMIT 6.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS6P5 LIMIT 6.5 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS7P0 LIMIT 7.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS7P5 LIMIT 7.5 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS8P0 LIMIT 8.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS8P5 LIMIT 8.5 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS9P0 LIMIT 9.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS9P5 LIMIT 9.5 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS10P0 LIMIT 10.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS12P0 LIMIT 12.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS14P0 LIMIT 14.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS16P0 LIMIT 16.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS18P0 LIMIT 18.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS20P0 LIMIT 20.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS22P0 LIMIT 22.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS24P0 LIMIT 24.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS26P0 LIMIT 26.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS28P0 LIMIT 28.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS30P0 LIMIT 30.0 CALLS PER SECOND

LBTHR LEAKY BUCKET THRESHOLD

This parameter specifies the maximum number of call


attempts per second which are not controlled by
Leaky Bucket.
Standard value of this parameter is 30 calls.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...256, range of decimal numbers

PRIVTRAF PRIVILEGED TRAFFIC

This parameter specifies the privileged traffic,


i.e. traffic initiated by a BEV subscriber.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NOCNTRL NO_CONTROL
This parameter value specifies that privileged
traffic is not subject to the blocking function
Leaky Bucket.
CNTRL CONTROL
This parameter value specifies that privileged
traffic is subject to the blocking function
Leaky Bucket.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CBPGRP- 2-
DACT CBPGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP

This command deactivates either a single or all code block point groups.
Code block points connected to this code block point group will thus
no longer be blocked via the code block point translator.

It is not possible to deactivate the code block point group named


"MABEZ" because this group is used internally for traffic monitoring
of mass call destinations (MABEZ destinations).
Deactivation of all code block point groups does not include the
code block point group "MABEZ".

The deactivation of a code block point group has no effect on the


related code block points. Call Processing always has to process all
digits of the code block points before the activity status of the
code block point group can be evaluated.

Prerequisites:
- The given code block point group must exist.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DACT CBPGRP : CBPGRP= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CBPGRP CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP

This parameter specifies the name of an existing code block point


group.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT CBPGRP- 1-


DISP CBPGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP

This command displays a single, all or a list of code block point


groups with their specified limit call rate and the indicator for
privileged traffic.
The data of the code block point group "MABEZ" will be displayed,
although this code block point group is not created by the command
CR CBPGRP.
This code block point group is created internally after activation
of mass call event recognition, detection of a mass call event and
start of rate reduction for the relevant code.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP CBPGRP : CBPGRP= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CBPGRP CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP

This parameter specifies the name of an existing code block point


group.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CBPGRP- 1-


MOD CBPGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP

This command changes the limit call rate, leaky bucket threshold
and the indicator for privileged traffic for the specified CBPGRP.

Notes:
- The limit call rate can be changed at any time, i.e. even when
the controlling network function is in use.
- It is not possible to modify the code block point group named
"MABEZ" because this group is used internally for traffic
monitoring of mass call destinations (MABEZ destinations).

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD CBPGRP : CBPGRP= <,LBUCLCR= ,LBTHR= ,PRIVTRAF=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CBPGRP CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP

This parameter specifies the name of an existing code block


point group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LBUCLCR LEAKY BUCKET LIMIT CALL RATE

This parameter specifies the limit of call attempts for the Leaky
Bucket function.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LCPS0P05 LIMIT 0.05 CALLS PER SECOND


LCPS0P1 LIMIT 0.1 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P15 LIMIT 0.15 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P2 LIMIT 0.2 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P25 LIMIT 0.25 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P3 LIMIT 0.3 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P35 LIMIT 0.35 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P4 LIMIT 0.4 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P45 LIMIT 0.45 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P5 LIMIT 0.5 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P55 LIMIT 0.55 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P6 LIMIT 0.6 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P65 LIMIT 0.65 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P7 LIMIT 0.7 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P75 LIMIT 0.75 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P8 LIMIT 0.8 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P85 LIMIT 0.85 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P9 LIMIT 0.9 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS0P95 LIMIT 0.95 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS1P0 LIMIT 1.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS1P2 LIMIT 1.2 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS1P4 LIMIT 1.4 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS1P6 LIMIT 1.6 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS1P8 LIMIT 1.8 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS2P0 LIMIT 2.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS2P2 LIMIT 2.2 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS2P4 LIMIT 2.4 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS2P6 LIMIT 2.6 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS2P8 LIMIT 2.8 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS3P0 LIMIT 3.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS3P2 LIMIT 3.2 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS3P4 LIMIT 3.4 CALLS PER SECOND

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CBPGRP- 1+


MOD CBPGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

LCPS3P6 LIMIT 3.6 CALLS PER SECOND


LCPS3P8 LIMIT 3.8 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS4P0 LIMIT 4.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS4P2 LIMIT 4.2 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS4P4 LIMIT 4.4 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS4P6 LIMIT 4.6 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS4P8 LIMIT 4.8 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS5P0 LIMIT 5.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS5P5 LIMIT 5.5 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS6P0 LIMIT 6.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS6P5 LIMIT 6.5 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS7P0 LIMIT 7.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS7P5 LIMIT 7.5 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS8P0 LIMIT 8.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS8P5 LIMIT 8.5 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS9P0 LIMIT 9.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS9P5 LIMIT 9.5 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS10P0 LIMIT 10.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS12P0 LIMIT 12.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS14P0 LIMIT 14.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS16P0 LIMIT 16.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS18P0 LIMIT 18.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS20P0 LIMIT 20.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS22P0 LIMIT 22.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS24P0 LIMIT 24.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS26P0 LIMIT 26.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS28P0 LIMIT 28.0 CALLS PER SECOND
LCPS30P0 LIMIT 30.0 CALLS PER SECOND

LBTHR LEAKY BUCKET THRESHOLD

This parameter specifies the maximum number of call


attempts per second which are not controlled
by Leaky Bucket.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...256, range of decimal numbers

PRIVTRAF PRIVILEGED TRAFFIC

This parameter specifies the privileged traffic,


i.e. traffic initiated by a BEV subscriber.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NOCNTRL NO_CONTROL
This parameter value specifies that privileged
traffic is not subject to the blocking function
Leaky Bucket.
CNTRL CONTROL
This parameter value specifies that privileged
traffic is subject to the blocking function
Leaky Bucket.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CBPGRP- 2-


CAN CBPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CODE BLOCK POINT

This command cancels a code block point.

The code block point is either defined by NAME or by the


combination of CODE, ORIGDC or CAT.

Prerequisite:
- The code block point already exists.

Notes:
- It is not possible to cancel code block points belonging to
the code block point group "MABEZ", because they are used
internally to reduce traffic to mass call destinations
(MABEZ destinations).

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1CODE=1 (;) 1
1 CAN CBPT : ZNAME=Y [,ORIGDC=] [,CAT=] Z Y 1
1 1 1 *!+ 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION CODE

This parameter specifies the digit combination (i.e. the destination)


where traffic is blocked.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NAME CODE BLOCK POINT OBJECT NAME

This parameter specifies the code block point object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ORIGDC ORIG FOR DESTINATION CONTROLS

This parameter specifies the originating mark of the code block point.
ORIGDC serves as a criterion for selective blocking of traffic to
the entered digit combination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3839, range of decimal numbers

CAT CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the category of the code block point.


CAT serves as a criterion for selective blocking of traffic
to the entered digit combination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER


SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT
COINB COIN BOX
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CBPT- 1+


CAN CBPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL


DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
OPOSINAT OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CBPT- 2-


CR CBPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE CODE BLOCK POINT

This command creates a code block point, i.e. a network traffic


management control is defined for the specified digit combination.

The parameter NAME specifies the code block point object.

The type of network traffic management control is defined by the


parameters PERC, CGAP or CBPGRP.

The destination code to be controlled by code blocking may be national


or international telephone numbers, service codes, local area codes,
carrier codes, country codes, etc. or suitable concatenations of these.
All code block points have to be preceded by the international or, if
applicable, the national prefix.

Example: Within the local area 089 of an exchange a subscriber number


4711 exists.
- The code block point 0894711 blocks traffic to the given subscriber.
- The code block point 089 blocks traffic to the local area 089.
- If there is another local area 088 within the exchange, the code block
point 08 blocks the traffic to 088 and 089.

Code block points consist of digit combinations together with parameters


ORIGDC und CAT. Because the digit translator is not checked
to ensure that a code point exists for this digit combination, only code
block points should be created which refer to existing code points in
the digit translator.

This command facilitates


- the blocking of a certain percentage of traffic (see parameter PERC).
Thus it is possible to block a certain percentage of call attempts
for a given code block point.
- the blocking of call attempts for a certain time interval
(see parameter CGAP).
After each successful call attempt to a given code block point, it is
possible to block further call attempts for a certain time interval.
The first call after creation of the code block point or after recovery
is never blocked by call gapping.
- the assignment of code block points to a code block point group for
the Leaky Bucket control function (see parameter CBPGRP).
A total of 64 code block points may be assigned to a code block point
group.

Notes:
- The number of code block points within an exchange is limited to 10000.
- Each code block point can be marked with parameter TRAMEA=YES to be
controlled by traffic measurement (TRAMEA=NO, standard value).
In this case the assigned traffic measurement index is displayed
together with the command execution message.
- It is not possible to create a code block point for the code block point
group "MABEZ", because this group contains only code block points which
are used internally to reduce traffic to mass call destinations
(MABEZ destinations).

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,PERC= 1 1
1 CR CBPT : CODE= [,NAME=] [,ORIGDC=] [,CAT=] Z,CGAP= Y 1
1 1,CBPGRP=1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,INCEPT= [,TRAMEA=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CBPT- 1+
CR CBPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION CODE

This parameter specifies the digit combination (i.e. the destination)


where traffic is blocked.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NAME CODE BLOCK POINT OBJECT NAME

This parameter specifies a unique name for a code block point object.
This name is the key that identifies the code block point and must not
be changed.

Six control types share a naming pool:


- CR CBPT,
- ENTR TRSVCNTL,
- ENTR NMCNTL with CNTRL = SKIP,
- ENTR NMCNTL with CNTRL = CANTO,
- ENTR NMCNTL with CNTRL = CANFROM,
- ENTR ACC.
This means that each NAME may only be used by one of these
controls.
The user may specify any name not yet used in the above-mentioned
naming pool except for two specific values:
- The user must not choose a single "X" as name because this input
stands for all existing values of a display command parameter.
- The NAME "MABEZ" is reserved for the mass call control function
which is an automatic network management control.
Therefore "MABEZ" must not be entered in this command.

Automatic instance naming is performed if this parameter is not


entered, i.e. the system itself assigns a name to the code block
point object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ORIGDC ORIG FOR DESTINATION CONTROLS

This parameter specifies the originating mark of the code block point.
ORIGDC serves as a criterion for selective blocking of traffic to
the entered destination depending on the origin of the call.

Using the parameter ORIGDC the following points must be considered:

- Value ’0’ is used as subscriber origin. All subscribers are


implicitly assigned this value. Assigning this value to trunk groups
is not possible.
- If a code block point is created without ORIGDC, the specified
control is independent of the origin of the call. If, in addition,
a code block point with the same code and a specific ORIGDC-value
is created, all calls with this origin are controlled in the specified
way. Calls with any other ORIGDC-value are controlled by the code
block point created without origin.

Example:
A code block point 1234 is created without ORIGDC, and specifying
PERC=PERC100. The same code is created with ORIGDC=1, and
specifying PERC=PERC50. All calls with ORIGDC unequal 1 are then
blocked with 100%. Calls with ORIGDC=1 are blocked with 50%.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3839, range of decimal numbers

CAT CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the category of the code block point.


CAT serves as a criterion for selective blocking of traffic
to the entered digit combination.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CBPT- 2+
CR CBPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER


SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT
COINB COIN BOX
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
OPOSINAT OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15

PERC PERCENTAGE OF BLOCKING

This parameter specifies the percentage of traffic to the


code block point which has to be blocked.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PERC0 0 % BLOCKING
PERC12P5 12.5 % BLOCKING
PERC25 25 % BLOCKING
PERC37P5 37.5 % BLOCKING
PERC50 50 % BLOCKING
PERC62P5 62.5 % BLOCKING
PERC75 75 % BLOCKING
PERC87P5 87.5 % BLOCKING
PERC100 100 % BLOCKING

CGAP CALL GAPPING TIME INTERVAL

This parameter specifies the time interval when the traffic to


the code block point is blocked.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SEC0 0 SECONDS CALL GAP


SEC0P1 0.1 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC0P25 0.25 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC0P5 0.5 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC1 1 SECOND CALL GAP
SEC2 2 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC5 5 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC10 10 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC15 15 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC30 30 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC60 60 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC120 120 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC300 300 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC600 600 SECONDS CALL GAP
INF INFINITE CALL GAP

CBPGRP CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP

This parameter specifies the name of a code block point group


for the network management function Leaky Bucket.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

INCEPT INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the intercept code (e.g. an announcement)


where the blocked traffic will be diverted if blocking is valid.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CBPT- 3+
CR CBPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NETWOMA0 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 0


NETWOMA1 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 1
NETWOMA2 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 2
NETWOMA3 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 3
NETWOMA4 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 4
NETWOMA5 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 5
COINNEAR INTERNATIONAL NEAR CONGESTION
CONANEAR NATIONAL NEAR CONGESTION
NETWOMA6 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 6

TRAMEA TRAFFIC MEASUREMENT

This parameter indicates whether traffic measurement has


to be activated or deactivated for the code block point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO
NO NO
Y YES
YES YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CBPT- 4-
DISP CBPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CODE BLOCK POINT

This command displays the code block points and their blocking
functions. One or more of the parameters CODE, NAME, PERC,
CGAP, CBPGRP, TRAMEA or INCEPT may be entered.
The code block point belonging to the code block point group "MABEZ"
will also be displayed although it is not created by the command
CR CBPT.
This code block point group is created internally after activation of
mass call recognition, detection of a mass call event and start of
rate reduction for the relevant code.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) X( )= 1
1 1CODE=1 11,PERC= 11 1
1 DISP CBPT : ZNAME=Y 1Z,CGAP= Y1 [,TRAMEA=] [,INCEPT=] ; 1
1 1 1 11,CBPGRP=11 1
1 * + >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION CODE

This parameter specifies the digit combination of the code


block point(s) to be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NAME CODE BLOCK POINT OBJECT NAME

This parameter specifies the code block point object.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PERC PERCENTAGE OF BLOCKING

This parameter specifies the percentage of traffic to the code


block point which has to be blocked.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

PERC0 0 % BLOCKING
PERC12P5 12.5 % BLOCKING
PERC25 25 % BLOCKING
PERC37P5 37.5 % BLOCKING
PERC50 50 % BLOCKING
PERC62P5 62.5 % BLOCKING
PERC75 75 % BLOCKING
PERC87P5 87.5 % BLOCKING
PERC100 100 % BLOCKING
X ALL PERC VALUES

CGAP CALL GAPPING TIME INTERVAL

This parameter specifies the time interval when the traffic to


the code block point is blocked.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CBPT- 1+


DISP CBPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SEC0 0 SECONDS CALL GAP


SEC0P1 0.1 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC0P25 0.25 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC0P5 0.5 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC1 1 SECOND CALL GAP
SEC2 2 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC5 5 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC10 10 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC15 15 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC30 30 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC60 60 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC120 120 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC300 300 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC600 600 SECONDS CALL GAP
INF INFINITE CALL GAP
X ALL GAP VALUES

CBPGRP CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP

This parameter specifies the name of a code block point group


for the network management function Leaky Bucket.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TRAMEA TRAFFIC MEASUREMENT

This parameter indicates whether traffic measurement is


activated or deactivated for the code block point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO
NO NO
Y YES
YES YES
INDEP INDEPENDENT

INCEPT INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the intercept for the code block point(s)
to be displayed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

NETWOMA0 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 0


NETWOMA1 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 1
NETWOMA2 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 2
NETWOMA3 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 3
NETWOMA4 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 4
NETWOMA5 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 5
COINNEAR INTERNATIONAL NEAR CONGESTION
CONANEAR NATIONAL NEAR CONGESTION
NETWOMA6 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 6

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CBPT- 2-


MOD CBPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY CODE BLOCK POINT

This command modifies the percentage, time interval or code block


point group of a particular code block point according to the values
entered for the parameters PERC, CGAP or CBPGRP.
The blocking function may not be changed (e.g. from code blocking
to call gapping).
The modification of INCEPT and the activation or deactivation
of traffic measurement for the code block point by parameter
TRAMEA are also possible.

The code block point is either defined by NAME or by the combination


of CODE, ORIGDC or CAT.

Prerequisite:
- The code block point already exists.

Note:
- It is not possible to modify a code block point belonging to, or so
that it subsequently belongs to, the code block point group "MABEZ".
The code block points belonging to this group are used internally
to reduce traffic to mass call destinations (MABEZ destinations).

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) X( )= 1
1 1CODE=1 11,PERC= 11 1
1 MOD CBPT : ZNAME=Y [,ORIGDC=] [,CAT=] 1Z,CGAP= Y1 [,INCEPT=] 1
1 1 1 11,CBPGRP=11 1
1 * + >* +W 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,TRAMEA=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION CODE

This parameter specifies the digit combination (i.e. the destination)


where traffic is blocked.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NAME CODE BLOCK POINT OBJECT NAME

This parameter specifies the code block point object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ORIGDC ORIG FOR DESTINATION CONTROLS

This parameter specifies the originating mark of the code block point.
ORIGDC serves as a criterion for selective blocking of traffic to
the entered digit combination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3839, range of decimal numbers

CAT CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the category of the code block point.


CAT serves as a criterion for selective blocking of traffic

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CBPT- 1+


MOD CBPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

to the entered digit combination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER


SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT
COINB COIN BOX
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
OPOSINAT OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15

PERC PERCENTAGE OF BLOCKING

This parameter specifies the (new) percentage of traffic to the


code block point which has to be blocked.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PERC0 0 % BLOCKING
PERC12P5 12.5 % BLOCKING
PERC25 25 % BLOCKING
PERC37P5 37.5 % BLOCKING
PERC50 50 % BLOCKING
PERC62P5 62.5 % BLOCKING
PERC75 75 % BLOCKING
PERC87P5 87.5 % BLOCKING
PERC100 100 % BLOCKING

CGAP CALL GAPPING TIME INTERVAL

This parameter specifies the (new) time interval when the


traffic to the code block point is blocked.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SEC0 0 SECONDS CALL GAP


SEC0P1 0.1 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC0P25 0.25 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC0P5 0.5 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC1 1 SECOND CALL GAP
SEC2 2 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC5 5 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC10 10 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC15 15 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC30 30 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC60 60 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC120 120 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC300 300 SECONDS CALL GAP
SEC600 600 SECONDS CALL GAP
INF INFINITE CALL GAP

CBPGRP CODE BLOCK POINT GROUP

This parameter specifies the (new) name of a code block point


group for the network management function Leaky Bucket.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

INCEPT INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the (new) intercept code (e.g. an announce-


ment) where the blocked traffic will be diverted if blocking is

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CBPT- 2+


MOD CBPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

valid.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NETWOMA0 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 0


NETWOMA1 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 1
NETWOMA2 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 2
NETWOMA3 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 3
NETWOMA4 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 4
NETWOMA5 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 5
COINNEAR INTERNATIONAL NEAR CONGESTION
CONANEAR NATIONAL NEAR CONGESTION
NETWOMA6 NETWORK MANAGEMENT INTERCEPT 6

TRAMEA TRAFFIC MEASUREMENT

This parameter indicates whether traffic measurement has


to be activated or deactivated for the code block point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO
NO NO
Y YES
YES YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CBPT- 3-


CAN CBSERV
DEACT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CALL BARRING SERVICE

This command withdraws or deactivates call barring services.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CAN CBSERV - DEACT DEACTIVATION


2. CAN CBSERV - WITHDRAW WITHDRAWAL

1. Input format

DEACTIVATION

Input format for deactivation of call barring services.


Deactivation of a call barring service applies to one or
more groups of basic services.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CBSERV : MSIN= ,CBSERV= ,BSVG= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

CBSERV CALL BARRING SERVICE

This parameter specifies a call barring service to be withdrawn or


deactivated.

Notes:
- If the last call barring service is withdrawn the following values
are deleted. In case of a new provision they are reset to their
defaults.
CCB
PW

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALLCB ALL CALL BARRING SERVICES


CBI CB OF INCOMING CALLS
CBIC CB OF ALL INCOMING CALLS
CBICROUT CBIC ROAMING OUTSIDE HOME PLMN
CBO CB OF OUTGOING CALLS
CBOC CB OF ALL OUTGOING CALLS
CBOIC CB OF ALL OUTGOING INT CALLS
CBOICEXH CBOIC EXCEPT TO HPLMN COUNTRY

BSVG BASIC SERVICE GROUP CODE

This parameter specifies a basic service group code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALLBS ALL BEARER SERVICES


ALLBSV ALL BASIC SERVICES

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CBSERV- 1+


CAN CBSERV
DEACT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ALLTS ALL TELESERVICES


BS20 DATA CIRCUIT DUPLEX ASYN SERV
BS30 DATA CIRCUIT SYN. SERVICES
BS40 PAD ACCESS SERVICES
TELEPHON TELEPHONY
TS20 SHORT MESSAGE SERVICES
TS60 FACSIMILE SERVICES

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CBSERV- 2+


CAN CBSERV
WITHDRAW
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

WITHDRAWAL

Input format for withdrawal of call barring services.


Withdrawal of a call barring service applies to all basic
services the mobile subscriber subscribed to.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CBSERV : MSIN= ,CBSERV= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

CBSERV CALL BARRING SERVICE

This parameter specifies a call barring service to be withdrawn or


deactivated.

Notes:
- If the last call barring service is withdrawn the following values
are deleted. In case of a new provision they are reset to their
defaults.
CCB
PW

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALLCB ALL CALL BARRING SERVICES


CBI CB OF INCOMING CALLS
CBIC CB OF ALL INCOMING CALLS
CBICROUT CBIC ROAMING OUTSIDE HOME PLMN
CBO CB OF OUTGOING CALLS
CBOC CB OF ALL OUTGOING CALLS
CBOIC CB OF ALL OUTGOING INT CALLS
CBOICEXH CBOIC EXCEPT TO HPLMN COUNTRY

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CBSERV- 3-


ENTR CBSERV
ACT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CALL BARRING SERVICE

This command provides call barring services or activates basic


service related call barring services.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ENTR CBSERV - ACT ACTIVATION


2. ENTR CBSERV - PROV PROVISION
3. ENTR CBSERV - PWOPT PASSWORD OPTION

1. Input format

ACTIVATION

Input format for activation of call barring services.


Activation of a call barring service applies to one or more groups
of basic services.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CBSERV : MSIN= ,CBSERV= ,BSVG= [,CCB=] [,PW=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

CBSERV CALL BARRING SERVICE

This parameter specifies a call barring service to be provided or


activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CBIC CB OF ALL INCOMING CALLS


CBICROUT CBIC ROAMING OUTSIDE HOME PLMN
CBOC CB OF ALL OUTGOING CALLS
CBOIC CB OF ALL OUTGOING INT CALLS
CBOICEXH CBOIC EXCEPT TO HPLMN COUNTRY

BSVG BASIC SERVICE GROUP CODE

This parameter specifies a basic service group code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALLBS ALL BEARER SERVICES


ALLBSV ALL BASIC SERVICES
ALLTS ALL TELESERVICES
BS20 DATA CIRCUIT DUPLEX ASYN SERV
BS30 DATA CIRCUIT SYN. SERVICES
BS40 PAD ACCESS SERVICES
TELEPHON TELEPHONY
TS20 SHORT MESSAGE SERVICES
TS60 FACSIMILE SERVICES

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CBSERV- 1+


ENTR CBSERV
ACT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CCB CONTROL OF CALL BARRING

This parameter specifies the control of call barring supplementary


service.

Prerequisites:
- Provision of at least one call barring service.
The provision can be entered with the same or a prior command.

Notes:
- If there is no provision of call barring service and a new
provision is entered and CCB is omitted, control of call barring
is reset to its default.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

OPR OPERATOR
SUB SUBSCRIBER

PW PASSWORD

This parameter specifies the password in case of subscriber controlled


call barring. Only one password per mobile subscriber for all call
barring services is possible.

Prerequisites:
- Provision of at least one call barring service.
The provision can be entered with the same or a prior command.

Notes:
- If there is no provision of call barring service at all and a new
provision is entered, the password is reset to its default.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CBSERV- 2+


ENTR CBSERV
PROV
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

PROVISION

Input format for provision of call barring services.


Provision of a call barring service applies to all basic services
the mobile subscriber subscribed to.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CBSERV : MSIN= ,CBSERV= [,CCB=] [,PW=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

CBSERV CALL BARRING SERVICE

This parameter specifies a call barring service to be provided or


activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALLCB ALL CALL BARRING SERVICES


CBI CB OF INCOMING CALLS
CBIC CB OF ALL INCOMING CALLS
CBICROUT CBIC ROAMING OUTSIDE HOME PLMN
CBO CB OF OUTGOING CALLS
CBOC CB OF ALL OUTGOING CALLS
CBOIC CB OF ALL OUTGOING INT CALLS
CBOICEXH CBOIC EXCEPT TO HPLMN COUNTRY

CCB CONTROL OF CALL BARRING

This parameter specifies the control of call barring supplementary


service.

Prerequisites:
- Provision of at least one call barring service.
The provision can be entered with the same or a prior command.

Notes:
- If there is no provision of call barring service and a new
provision is entered and CCB is omitted, control of call barring
is reset to its default.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

OPR OPERATOR
SUB SUBSCRIBER

PW PASSWORD

This parameter specifies the password in case of subscriber controlled


call barring. Only one password per mobile subscriber for all call
barring services is possible.

Prerequisites:
- Provision of at least one call barring service.
The provision can be entered with the same or a prior command.

Notes:
- If there is no provision of call barring service at all and a new
provision is entered, the password is reset to its default.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CBSERV- 3+


ENTR CBSERV
PROV
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...4 digit decimal number

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CBSERV- 4+


ENTR CBSERV
PWOPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

PASSWORD OPTION

Input format for password option.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CBSERV : MSIN= <,CCB= ,PW=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

CCB CONTROL OF CALL BARRING

This parameter specifies the control of call barring supplementary


service.

Prerequisites:
- Provision of at least one call barring service.
The provision can be entered with the same or a prior command.

Notes:
- If there is no provision of call barring service and a new
provision is entered and CCB is omitted, control of call barring
is reset to its default.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

OPR OPERATOR
SUB SUBSCRIBER

PW PASSWORD

This parameter specifies the password in case of subscriber controlled


call barring. Only one password per mobile subscriber for all call
barring services is possible.

Prerequisites:
- Provision of at least one call barring service.
The provision can be entered with the same or a prior command.

Notes:
- If there is no provision of call barring service at all and a new
provision is entered, the password is reset to its default.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CBSERV- 5-


CONF CCG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE CENTRAL CLOCK GENERATOR

This command configures a central clock generator side to the requested


operating state.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF CCG : CCG= ,OST= [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CCG CENTRAL CLOCK GENERATOR

This parameter specifies the side of CCG.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

OST OPERATING STATUS

This parameter specifies the target operational states.


The following table shows which operational state transitions
are permitted.

Compatibilities:
+------------+---------------------+
! from / to ! ACT STB MBL !
+------------+---------------------+
! ACT ! - 1 !! !
! STB ! - - + !
! MBL ! - + - !
! NAC ! - - + !
! UNA ! - + + !
+------------+---------------------+

+ : legal state transition


- : illegal state transition
1 : legal state transition, if the redundant CCG
is in the operational state STB.
!!: dangerous configuration: may cause system failure or loss of
calls. This operational state transition is permitted, if the
redundant CCG is in the operational state STB.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

STB STANDBY
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

If parameter SUP=Y is specified, messages from the periphery are


suppressed during command execution.

N NO
NO
Y YES
YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF CCG- 1-


DISP CCG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CENTRAL CLOCK GENERATOR

This command displays the state and error registers for the central
clock generator CCG.

Notes:
- Reference frequencies which are not set are evaluated as GOOD in the
associated output mask.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CCG ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CCG- 1-


STAT CCG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY STATUS OF CCG

This command displays the CCG operating state.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT CCG ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT CCG- 1-


DISP CCGPAR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CCG-PARAMETER

This command displays the internal CCG(A) parameters.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CCGPAR : CCG= ,DATA0= ,DATA1= ,DATA2= ,DATA3= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CCG CENTRAL CLOCK GENERATOR

This parameter specifies the central clock generator side.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

DATA0 SPECIFIC CCG DATA0

This parameter specifies the contents of the byte to be sent to the


CCG(A).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...FF, range of hexadecimal numbers

DATA1 SPECIFIC CCG DATA1

This parameter specifies the contents of the byte to be sent to the


CCG(A).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...FF, range of hexadecimal numbers

DATA2 SPECIFIC CCG DATA2

This parameter specifies the contents of the byte to be sent to the


CCG(A).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...FF, range of hexadecimal numbers

DATA3 SPECIFIC CCG DATA3

This parameter specifies the contents of the byte to be sent to the


CCG(A).

The following combinations of DATA0 .. DATA3 are possible:


----------------------------------------------------------

a) REQMOD: SPECIFIC CCG DATA0 = 01


SPECIFIC CCG DATA1 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA2 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA3 = 00

This byte combination interrogates the modifications made by


PRIOFR, DISFS and DISCONF.

Expected acknowledgement: REQMODACK


and output of
CCG-INFORMATION: H’ 01 xx yy zz

with: xx see xx for PRIOACK - MOD CCGPAR b)


= 00 = Reference frequencies have HW priority
= 01 = Reference frequency 1 has priority
= 02 = Reference frequency 2 has priority

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CCGPAR- 1+


DISP CCGPAR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

yy see xx for DISFSACK - MOD CCGPAR c)


= 00 = Reference frequencies are supervised
= 01 = Reference frequency supervision disabled

zz see xx for DISCOACK - MOD CCGPAR d)


= 00 = All reference frequencies are enabled
01 = Reference 0 disabled
02 = Reference 1 disabled
03 = Reference 0 and reference 1 disabled
04 = Partner reference disabled
05 = Partner reference and reference 0 disabled
06 = Partner reference and reference 1 disabled
07 = Partner reference and
references 0 and 1 disabled

b) PDACT: SPECIFIC CCG DATA0 = 02


SPECIFIC CCG DATA1 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA2 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA3 = 00

This byte combination interrogates the current PD value. An


evaluation is only useful in conjunction with the current phase
offset (Acknowledgement to the command OFFSET).

Expected acknowledgement: PDACK


and output of
CCG-INFORMATION: H’ 02 xx yy zz

with: xx = Byte after point in PD contents


yy = 1st byte before point in PD contents
zz = 2nd byte before point in PD contents (MSB)

c) OFFSET: SPECIFIC CCG DATA0 = 03


SPECIFIC CCG DATA1 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA2 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA3 = 00

This byte combination interrogates the present phase offset, which


is a result of the previous phase corrections.

Expected acknowledgement: OFFACK


and output of
CCG-INFORMATION: H’ 03 xx yy zz

with: xx = Byte after point in offset contents


yy = 1st byte before point in offset contents
zz = 2nd byte before point in offset contents (MSB)

d) SIREG: SPECIFIC CCG DATA0 = 04


SPECIFIC CCG DATA1 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA2 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA3 = 00

This byte combination interrogates the original contents of the


integration register stored in the ANMOD.

Expected acknowledgement: SIACK


and output of
CCG-INFORMATION: H’ 04 xx yy zz

with: xx = Byte after point in safeguarding IR


yy = 1st byte before point in safeguarding IR
zz = 2nd byte before point in safeguarding IR (MSB)

e) IREG: SPECIFIC CCG DATA0 = 05


SPECIFIC CCG DATA1 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA2 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA3 = 00

This byte combination interrogates the current contents of the


integration register.

Expected acknowledgement: IACK


and output of
CCG-INFORMATION: H’ 05 xx yy zz

with: xx = Byte after point in integration register

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CCGPAR- 2+


DISP CCGPAR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

yy = 1st byte before point in integration register


zz = 2nd byte before point in integration register (MSB)

f) DAC: SPECIFIC CCG DATA0 = 06


SPECIFIC CCG DATA1 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA2 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA3 = 00

This byte combination interrogates the current DAC value.

Expected acknowledgement: DACACK


and output of
CCG-INFORMATION: H’ 06 xx yy zz

with: xx = Byte after point in DAC value


yy = 1st byte before point in DAC value
zz = 2nd byte before point in DAC value (MSB)

g) PREG: SPECIFIC CCG DATA0 = 07


SPECIFIC CCG DATA1 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA2 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA3 = 00

This byte combination interrogates the current contents of the


proportional register.

Expected acknowledgement: PACK


and output of
CCG-INFORMATION: H’ 07 xx yy zz

with: xx = Byte after point in the proportional register


yy = 1st byte before point in proportional register
zz = 2nd byte before point in proportional register (MSB)

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...FF, range of hexadecimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CCGPAR- 3-


MOD CCGPAR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY CCG-PARAMETER

This command modifies the CCG(A) control parameters. The command is


only valid for the digital CCG(A) or CCGR. The analog CCG does not
execute the command.
This command is a dangerous command because it may destroy the
network synchronism.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD CCGPAR : CCG= ,DATA0= ,DATA1= ,DATA2= ,DATA3= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CCG CENTRAL CLOCK GENERATOR

This parameter specifies the central clock generator side.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

DATA0 SPECIFIC CCG DATA0

This parameter specifies the contents of the byte to be sent to the


CCG(A).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...FF, range of hexadecimal numbers

DATA1 SPECIFIC CCG DATA1

This parameter specifies the contents of the byte to be sent to the


CCG(A).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...FF, range of hexadecimal numbers

DATA2 SPECIFIC CCG DATA2

This parameter specifies the contents of the byte to be sent to the


CCG(A).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...FF, range of hexadecimal numbers

DATA3 SPECIFIC CCG DATA3

This parameter specifies the contents of the byte to be sent to the


CCG(A).

The following modifications of DATA0 .. DATA3 are possible :


------------------------------------------------------------

a) RESET: SPECIFIC CCG DATA0 = 01


SPECIFIC CCG DATA1 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA2 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA3 = 00

With this byte combination the CCG(A)/CCGR is reset, i.e. start in


mode A, if a reference frequency is available (without heating
the VCO).

Expected acknowledgement: MSTSY


and output of

CCG-PARAMETER: H’ 01 00 00 00

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CCGPAR- 1+


MOD CCGPAR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b) PRIOFR: SPECIFIC CCG DATA0 = 02,


SPECIFIC CCG DATA1 = 00 = Restoration of HW priority
= 01 = Reference frequency 1 now has priority
= 02 = Reference frequency 2 now has priority
SPECIFIC CCG DATA2 = SPECIFIC CCG DATA3 = 00

This byte combination changes the hardware priority of the


reference frequencies. If the frequency given in the command is
available, a switchover is made correspondingly.

Expected acknowledgement: PRIOACK


and output of
CCG-PARAMETER: H’ 02 xx 00 00

with: xx = 00 = HW priority restored


= 01 = Reference frequency 1 has priority
= 02 = Reference frequency 2 has priority

c) DISFS: SPECIFIC CCG DATA0 = 03


SPECIFIC CCG DATA1 = 00 = Switch off disable
= 01 = Switch on disable
SPECIFIC CCG DATA2 = SPECIFIC CCG DATA3 = 00

This byte combination disables or reactivates the supervision of


the reference frequency (frequencies) being applied.

Expected acknowledgement: DISFSACK


and output of
CCG-PARAMETER: H’ 03 xx 00 00

with: xx = 00 = Disable switched off (supervision)


= 01 = Disable switched on (no supervision)

d) DISCONF: SPECIFIC CCG DATA0 = 04


SPECIFIC CCG DATA1 = 00 = Switch off disable
= 01 = Disable reference 0
= 02 = Disable reference 1
= 03 = Disable reference 0 and reference 1
= 04 = Disable partner reference
= 05 = Disable partner reference and reference 0
= 06 = Disable partner reference and reference 1
= 07 = Disable partner reference and
references 0 and 1
SPECIFIC CCG DATA2 = SPECIFIC CCG DATA3 = 00

This byte combination disables or reactivates the reference


frequencies being applied at the CCG(A)/CCGR. Any combination of
the two external reference frequencies (reference 0 and
reference 1) and of the reference frequency of the partner
CCG(A)/CCGR (partner reference) can be disabled.
SPECIFIC CCG DATA1 = 07 puts the CCG(A)/CCGR in HOLDOVER mode.

Expected acknowledgement: DISCOACK


and output of
CCG-PARAMETER: H’ 04 xx 00 00

with: xx = 00 = All disables switched off


01 = Reference 0 disabled
02 = Reference 1 disabled
03 = Reference 0 and reference 1 disabled
04 = Partner reference disabled
05 = Partner reference and reference 0 disabled
06 = Partner reference and reference 1 disabled
07 = Partner reference and
references 0 and 1 disabled

e) UIREG: SPECIFIC CCG DATA0 = 15


SPECIFIC CCG DATA1 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA2 = 00
SPECIFIC CCG DATA3 = 00

This byte combination saves the contents of the integration


register on disk.

Expected acknowledgement: SADIR


and output of

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CCGPAR- 2+


MOD CCGPAR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CCG-PARAMETER: H’ 15 00 00 00

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...FF, range of hexadecimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CCGPAR- 3-


ACT CDSPROG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE A CDS TIME PROGRAM DATA

This command activates a certain CDS time program.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT CDSPROG : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,PROG= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not divided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

PROG CDS TIME PROGRAM

This parameter specifies the kind of time program.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CDSCONF CDS CONFIGURATION


TGASSIGN TASK GROUP ASSIGNMENT

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CDSPROG- 1-


CAN CDSPROG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CDS TIME PROGRAM DATA

This command cancels one or several common service subscribers from a


certain program time for the program TGASSIGN.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN CDSPROG : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,PROG= ,TIME= ,TASKGRP= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,CSSUBID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

PROG CDS TIME PROGRAM

This parameter specifies the time program TGASSIGN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CDSCONF CDS CONFIGURATION


TGASSIGN TASK GROUP ASSIGNMENT

TIME CDS PROGRAM TIME

This parameter specifies the program time, that shall be


administred.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: DAY
MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CDSPROG- 1+


CAN CDSPROG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

EH HALF WEEKEND DAY


EF FULL WEEKEND DAY
ALL EVERY DAY

This parameter specifies the begin day of program time.

b: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin hour of program time.

c: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin minute of program time.

TASKGRP TASK GROUP

This parameter specifies the name of the task group.

Prerequisites:
- The task group must exist in the common service group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CSSUBID COMMON SERVICE SUBSCRIBER ID

This parameter specifies the number of the common service


subscriber.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CDSPROG- 2-


DACT CDSPROG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE A CDS TIME PROGRAM DATA

This command deactivates a certain CDS time program.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT CDSPROG : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,PROG= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not divided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

PROG CDS TIME PROGRAM

This parameter specifies the kind of time program.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CDSCONF CDS CONFIGURATION


TGASSIGN TASK GROUP ASSIGNMENT

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT CDSPROG- 1-


DISP CDSPROG
DCDSCONF
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CDS TIME PROGRAM DATA

This command displays a CDS time program data for a specified time program.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP CDSPROG - DCDSCONF DISPLAY CDSCONF DATA


2. DISP CDSPROG - DSUBTOTG DISPLAY CSSUB TO TASKGROUP DATA
3. DISP CDSPROG - DTGTOSUB DISPLAY TASKGROUP TO CSSUB

1. Input format

DISPLAY CDSCONF DATA

This input format is used to display a CDS-Configuration


for a certain or all created program times for the program
CDSCONF.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CDSPROG : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,PROG= [,TIME=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

PROG CDS TIME PROGRAM

This parameter specifies the kind of time program.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CDSCONF CDS CONFIGURATION


TGASSIGN TASK GROUP ASSIGNMENT

TIME CDS PROGRAM TIME

This parameter specifies the program time, that shall be


administred.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: DAY
ALL EVERY DAY

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CDSPROG- 1+


DISP CDSPROG
DCDSCONF
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

EF FULL WEEKEND DAY


EH HALF WEEKEND DAY
FR FRIDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
MO MONDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
TH THURSDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
WO WORKDAY

This parameter specifies the begin day of program time.

b: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin hour of program time.

c: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin minute of program time.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CDSPROG- 2+


DISP CDSPROG
DSUBTOTG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

DISPLAY CSSUB TO TASKGROUP DATA

This input format is used to display the CSSUBs for a certain


or all task groups for a certain or all program times for the
program TGASSIGN.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CDSPROG : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,PROG= [,TIME=] [,TASKGRP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

PROG CDS TIME PROGRAM

This parameter specifies the kind of time program.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CDSCONF CDS CONFIGURATION


TGASSIGN TASK GROUP ASSIGNMENT

TIME CDS PROGRAM TIME

This parameter specifies the program time, that shall be


administred.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: DAY
ALL EVERY DAY
EF FULL WEEKEND DAY
EH HALF WEEKEND DAY
FR FRIDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
MO MONDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
TH THURSDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
WO WORKDAY

This parameter specifies the begin day of program time.

b: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CDSPROG- 3+


DISP CDSPROG
DSUBTOTG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter specifies the begin hour of program time.

c: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin minute of program time.

TASKGRP TASK GROUP

This parameter specifies the name of the task group.

Prerequisites:
- The task group have to exist in the common service group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CDSPROG- 4+


DISP CDSPROG
DTGTOSUB
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

DISPLAY TASKGROUP TO CSSUB

This input format is used to display all task groups for a


certain CSSUB for a certain or all program times for the
program TGASSIGN.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CDSPROG : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,PROG= [,TIME=] ,CSSUBID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

PROG CDS TIME PROGRAM

This parameter specifies the kind of time program.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CDSCONF CDS CONFIGURATION


TGASSIGN TASK GROUP ASSIGNMENT

TIME CDS PROGRAM TIME

This parameter specifies the program time, that shall be


administred.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: DAY
ALL EVERY DAY
EF FULL WEEKEND DAY
EH HALF WEEKEND DAY
FR FRIDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
MO MONDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
TH THURSDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
WO WORKDAY

This parameter specifies the begin day of program time.

b: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CDSPROG- 5+


DISP CDSPROG
DTGTOSUB
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter specifies the begin hour of program time.

c: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin minute of program time.

CSSUBID COMMON SERVICE SUBSCRIBER ID

This parameter specifies the number of the common service


subscriber.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CDSPROG- 6-


ENTR CDSPROG
ECDSCONF
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CDS TIME PROGRAM DATA

This command enters a new CDS time program for a specified program time.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ENTR CDSPROG - ECDSCONF ENTER CDSCONF DATA


2. ENTR CDSPROG - ETGASSGN ENTER TGASSIGN DATA

1. Input format

ENTER CDSCONF DATA

This input format is used to enter a CDS-Configuration


for a certain program time for the program CDSCONF.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CDSPROG : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,PROG= ,TIME= ,CONF= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

PROG CDS TIME PROGRAM

This parameter specifies the kind of time program.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CDSCONF CDS CONFIGURATION


TGASSIGN TASK GROUP ASSIGNMENT

TIME CDS PROGRAM TIME

This parameter specifies the program time, that shall be


administred.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: DAY
ALL EVERY DAY
EF FULL WEEKEND DAY
EH HALF WEEKEND DAY
FR FRIDAY

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CDSPROG- 1+


ENTR CDSPROG
ECDSCONF
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL


HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
MO MONDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
TH THURSDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
WO WORKDAY

This parameter specifies the begin day of program time.

b: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin hour of program time.

c: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin minute of program time.

CONF CONFIGURATION

This parameter specifies the call distribution system configuration.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CDSPROG- 2+


ENTR CDSPROG
ETGASSGN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

ENTER TGASSIGN DATA

This input format is used to enter one or several CSSUBs to a


certain task group for a certain program time for the program
TGASSIGN.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR CDSPROG : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,PROG= ,TIME= ,TASKGRP= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,CSSUBID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

PROG CDS TIME PROGRAM

This parameter specifies the kind of time program.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CDSCONF CDS CONFIGURATION


TGASSIGN TASK GROUP ASSIGNMENT

TIME CDS PROGRAM TIME

This parameter specifies the program time, that shall be


administred.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: DAY
ALL EVERY DAY
EF FULL WEEKEND DAY
EH HALF WEEKEND DAY
FR FRIDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
MO MONDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
TH THURSDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
WO WORKDAY

This parameter specifies the begin day of program time.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CDSPROG- 3+


ENTR CDSPROG
ETGASSGN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin hour of program time.

c: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin minute of program time.

TASKGRP TASK GROUP

This parameter specifies the name of the task group.

Prerequisites:
- The task group have to exist in the common service group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CSSUBID COMMON SERVICE SUBSCRIBER ID

This parameter specifies the number of the common service


subscriber.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CDSPROG- 4-


CAN CDSPRTIM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CDS PROGRAM TIME DATA

This command cancels a CDS program time for a specified time program.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CDSPRTIM : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,PROG= ,TIME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

PROG CDS TIME PROGRAM

This parameter specifies the kind of time program.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CDSCONF CDS CONFIGURATION


TGASSIGN TASK GROUP ASSIGNMENT

TIME CDS PROGRAM TIME

This parameter specifies the program time, that shall be


administred.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: DAY
MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL
EH HALF WEEKEND DAY
EF FULL WEEKEND DAY
ALL EVERY DAY

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CDSPRTIM- 1+


CAN CDSPRTIM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter specifies the begin day of program time.

b: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin hour of program time.

c: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin minute of program time.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CDSPRTIM- 2-


CR CDSPRTIM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE CDS PROGRAM TIME DATA

This command creates a new CDS program time for a specified time program.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR CDSPRTIM : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,PROG= ,TIME= [,INIT=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

PROG CDS TIME PROGRAM

This parameter specifies the kind of time program.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CDSCONF CDS CONFIGURATION


TGASSIGN TASK GROUP ASSIGNMENT

TIME CDS PROGRAM TIME

This parameter specifies the program time, that shall be


administred.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: DAY
MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL
EH HALF WEEKEND DAY
EF FULL WEEKEND DAY
ALL EVERY DAY

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CDSPRTIM- 1+
CR CDSPRTIM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter specifies the begin day of program time.

b: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin hour of program time.

c: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin minute of program time.

INIT INITIAL CONFIGURATION

Initial value of the assignments at the time of


creating a program time.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DEFAULT DEFAULT
SET SET
RESET RESET

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CDSPRTIM- 2-
DISP CDSPRTIM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CDS PROGRAM TIME DATA

This command displays a CDS program time for a specified time program.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP CDSPRTIM : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,PROG= [,TIME=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

PROG CDS TIME PROGRAM

This parameter specifies the kind of time program.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CDSCONF CDS CONFIGURATION


TGASSIGN TASK GROUP ASSIGNMENT

TIME CDS PROGRAM TIME

This parameter specifies the program time, that shall be


administred.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: DAY
MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CDSPRTIM- 1+


DISP CDSPRTIM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

EH HALF WEEKEND DAY


EF FULL WEEKEND DAY
ALL EVERY DAY

This parameter specifies the begin day of program time.

b: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin hour of program time.

c: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin minute of program time.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CDSPRTIM- 2-


MOD CDSPRTIM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY CDS PROGRAM TIME DATA

This command modifies a CDS program time for a specified time program.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD CDSPRTIM : [CSGLAC=] ,CSGDN= ,PROG= ,TIME= ,NTIME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSGLAC COMMON SERVICE GROUP LAC

This parameter specifies the local area code of the common service
group.

Notes:
- If the exchange directory number volume is not devided into several
local area codes, this parameter can be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

CSGDN COMMON SERVICE GROUP DN

This parameter specifies the directory number of the common service


group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

PROG CDS TIME PROGRAM

This parameter specifies the kind of time program.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CDSCONF CDS CONFIGURATION


TGASSIGN TASK GROUP ASSIGNMENT

TIME CDS PROGRAM TIME

This parameter specifies the program time, that shall be


administred.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: DAY
MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL
EH HALF WEEKEND DAY
EF FULL WEEKEND DAY
ALL EVERY DAY

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CDSPRTIM- 1+


MOD CDSPRTIM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter specifies the begin day of program time.

b: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin hour of program time.

c: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin minute of program time.

NTIME NEW CDS PROGRAM TIME

This parameter specifies the new program time, that shall be


administred.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: DAY
MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL
EH HALF WEEKEND DAY
EF FULL WEEKEND DAY
ALL EVERY DAY

This parameter specifies the begin day of program time.

b: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin hour of program time.

c: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the begin minute of program time.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CDSPRTIM- 2-


CAN CDTDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CALL DATA TREATMENT DATA

This command cancels:


- control flags for call data treatment;
- non standard (extra and alternative) data for several recording types;
- activation of preventive meter observation.
This command resets:
- preventive meter observation thresholds, category and traffic type
dependent.
- the record version identification, recording type dependent.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN CDTDAT : [REC=] <,EXTNSD= ,ALTNSD= ,MARKS= ,VERSID= 1
1 1
1 ,PMOBS=> [,TYPE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

REC RECORDING TYPE

This parameter specifies for which recording type the extra


data no longer has to be recorded for a call by the
EWSD-switching system, and/or for which recording type
the specified version identification is no longer valid.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

METSUB SUBSCRIBER METERING


AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING
MOBORIG METER OBSERVATION ORIGINATING
MOBTERM METER OBSERVATION TERMINATING
PMOB PREVENTIVE METER OBSERVATION
IARSTAT INTER ADMINISTR. REVENUE STAT.
MDR MESSAGE DATA RECORDING
INAMA INTELIGENT NETWORK AMA
OPERAMA AMA FOR OPERATOR INPUT
IACAMA IACHASTA WITH AMA
IACMET IACHASTA WITH METERING

EXTNSD EXTRA NON STANDARD DATA

This parameter specifies which extra data no longer have


to be recorded for a call by the EWSD-switching system.

If no recording is specified, the entered extra data items


are reset for each relevant recording.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CHARGES CALL CHARGES


RECTRID RECORD TRUNK IDENTIFICATION
BMETPULS B SIDE METER PULSES
OCLGDN ORIGINATING CALLING PARTY DN
DURBANS DURATION BEFORE ANSWER
THRDPRTY THIRD PARTY NUMBER
CLDRCVD RECEIVED CALLED PARTY NUMBER
NEWDEST NEW DESTINATION
BGID BUSSINES GROUP IDENTIFICATION
CTXNO CENTREX NUMBERS
SEQUENCE SEQUENCE NUMBER
CHECKSUM CHECKSUM
CALLIND ADDITIONAL CALL INDICATORS
CALLTAR CALL TARIFF
GCR GLOBAL CHARGE REFERENCE
CONNID CONNECTION IDENTIFICATION
FAUPRTNR FAU BY PARTNER

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CDTDAT- 1+


CAN CDTDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TRAFQUAL TRAFFIC QUALITY DATA


CAC CARRIER ACCESS CODE
ADVCUMCH ADVISED CUMULATED CHARGES
ADDCLGDN ADDITIONAL CALLING PARTY DN
DEFMSN DEFAULT MULTIPLE SUBSCR. NO.
CLDSENT SENT CALLED PARTY NUMBER
CLDTOSCP CALLED PARTY DN SENT TO SCP
SCPRDGDN PROVIDED REDIRECTING DN BY SCP
RECOWNER RECORD OWNER DN
PFXNATIN NATIONAL/INTERNATIONAL PREFIX
EXCHNAME EXCHANGE IDENTIFICATION NAME
VERSID RECORD VERSION IDENTIFICATION
ADDTAR ADD-ON TARIFF DATA
PBXOPN PBX OPERATOR NUMBER
RELIND RELEASE INDICATOR
INSERVK IN SERVICE KEY
MLPP M LEVEL PRECEDENCE/PREEMPTION
REFINDUR REFINED DURATION
CLGSENT SENT CALLING PARTY NUMBER
REDSENT SENT REDIRECTING NUMBER
CATSENT SENT CALLING PARTY CATEGORY
CATRCVD RECEIVED CALLING PARTY CATEG.
SERVINFO SERVICE INFO
MAPCREF MAP CALL REFERENCE
IMSI IMSI NUMBER
SPC SIGNALLING POINT CODE

ALTNSD ALTERNATIVE NON STANDARD DATA

This parameter specifies which alternative data no longer


has to be recorded for a call by the EWSD-switching system.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

TGNA TRUNK GROUP NAME


CACTYPE CAC TYPE
OWNCAC OWN CAC
EXCHIDNO EXCHANGE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
RANSWTIM RECORD ANSWER TIME
EXTBDIG EXTENDED B DIGITS
RECTRCIC RECORD TRUNK IDENT. WITH CIC
TGN2 SECOND TRUNK GROUP NO. IDENT.

MARKS MARKS

This parameter specifies which specific control data are disabled.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

AMASFAI AMA IMM.OUTP.FOR SUB.FAC.INPUT


UCALLAMA UNANSWERED CALLS WITH AMA
DEBFA DEB FOR FACILITY INPUT/USAGE
UCALLIAC UNSUCCESS. CALLS WITH IACHASTA
AMAFAIID AMA F.SUB.FAC.INP.IMPL. DEACT.
CXSFAICH CENTREX STATION FAC.INP.CHARG.
CTXFAU CENTREX FAU CHARGING
UCALMOBT UNANSW. CALLS FOR MOBTERM.
PMOBIO PREVENT.MOB IMMEDIATE OUTPUT
ATTNOCHA RECORD CHRG.FREE CALL ATTEMPT
UCALLINA INAMA FOR UNSUCCESSFUL CALLS

VERSID RECORD VERSION IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the record version identification


value which is to be reset. This value refers to the APS software
version.
A recording type (parameter REC) must also be specified when
previously the record version identification was entered with
a specified recording type.

Prerequisite:
This value can only be reset when this value is not requested
as EXTNSD data by any recording type (parameter REC).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CDTDAT- 2+


CAN CDTDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...99, range of decimal numbers

PMOBS CANCEL ACTIVATION OF PMOBS

This parameter specifies that the activation of the PMOBS feature is


canceled (with reset of the threshold value).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT CANCEL ACTIVATION OF PMOBS

TYPE PMOB TYPE

This parameter specifies for which category and traffic type


combination the PMOB threshold is no longer valid.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: CATEGORY
COINB COINBOX
SUB SUBSCRIBER

b: TRAFFIC TYPE
NAT NATIONAL
INAT INTERNATIONAL

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CDTDAT- 3-


DISP CDTDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CALL DATA TREATMENT DATA

This command displays


- the extra and/or alternative data items.
- the activated call data treatment control flags
- non standard (extra and alternative) data for several recording types
- the status and the threshold value for preventive meter observation.

This command is only permitted for a local exchange.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CDTDAT ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CDTDAT- 1-


ENTR CDTDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CALL DATA TREATMENT DATA

This command enters:


- control flags for call data treatment
- non standard (extra and alternative) data items for several recording types
- charging counter for facility input and facility usage
- activation and threshold value (charge limit) for preventive meter
observation (can be entered per category and traffic type)
- the record version identification value (per recording).

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR CDTDAT : [REC=] <,EXTNSD= ,ALTNSD= ,MARKS= ,FAICNTR= 1
1 1
1 ,FAUCNTR= ,VERSID= ,PMOBS=> [,TYPE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

REC RECORDING TYPE

This parameter specifies for which recording type the extra


data has to be recorded for a call by the EWSD-switching
system, and/or for which recording type the version identification
is valid.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

METSUB SUBSCRIBER METERING


This identifier allows to enter extra
non standard data items to be
recorded for a subscriber metering
registration.
AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING
This identifier allows to enter extra
non standard data items to be recorded
with AMA registration.
MOBORIG METER OBSERVATION ORIGINATING
This identifier allows to enter extra
non standard data items to be recorded
with meter observation at the
originating side.
MOBTERM METER OBSERVATION TERMINATING
This identifier allows to enter extra
non standard data items to be recorded
with meter observation at the
terminating side.
PMOB PREVENTIVE METER OBSERVATION
This identifier allows to enter extra
non standard data items to be
recorded for an active PMOB
registration.
MDR MESSAGE DATA RECORDING
This identifier allows to enter extra
non standard data items to be recorded
for CENTREX subscriber charging with
MDR registration.
INAMA INTELLIGENT NETWORK AMA
This identifier allows to enter extra
non standard data items to be
recorded for an active IN AMA
registration.
OPERAMA OPERATOR AMA
This identifier allows to enter extra
non standard data items to be
recorded for AMA registration
for an operator input.
IACAMA IACHASTA WITH AMA
This identifier allows to enter extra
non standard data items to record with

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CDTDAT- 1+


ENTR CDTDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

AMA at active IACHASTA registration.


IACMET IACHASTA WITH METERING
This identifier allows to enter extra
non standard data items to
record for an active
IACHASTA metering registration.

EXTNSD EXTRA NON STANDARD DATA

This parameter specifies which extra data items must be


recorded by the EWSD switching system for a call.
For a specific recording type, the amount of data to be
collected per recording type consists of:
- basic data items, which are always collected (i.e. fixed)
- extra data items, which are collected if entered via this
parameter (i.e. administrable).

Notes:
1. In case no recording type (see parameter REC) is specified,
the extra data items entered are set for all relevant
recordings (see next overview).
2. The Extra Non Standard Data Items CONNID, FAUPRTNR,
TRAFQUAL, CAC and SERVINFO are default set for the relevant
recordings. They can be removed with the CAN CDTDAT
command.

The following overview shows which extra data items can be


administered for which recording types by entering the respective
parameter value(s):

METSUB
PFXNATIN: National/International prefix digit(s).

DEB
CHARGES : Charge units for connection, charge units for
facility usage, zone and charge band.
RECTRID : Trunk Identification incoming/outgoing.
BMETPULS: B-side meter pulses.
OCLGDN : Originating calling party directory number.
DURBANS : Duration before answer.
THRDPRTY: Third party number.
CLDRCVD : Received called party number.
NEWDEST : New destination.
BGID : Business group identification.
CTXNO : CENTREX numbers.
SEQUENCE: Sequence number.
CHECKSUM: Checksum.
CALLIND : Additional call indicators.
CALLTAR : Call tariff.
GCR : Global Charge reference.
CONNID : Connection Identification.
FAUPRTNR: Facility Usage by Partner.
TRAFQUAL: Traffic Quality Data.
CAC : Carrier Access Code.
ADVCUMCH: Advised Cumulated Charges.
ADDCLGDN: Additional calling party directory number.
DEFMSN : Default multiple subscriber number.
CLDSENT : Sent called party number.
RECOWNER: Record owner directory number.
PFXNATIN: National/International prefix digit(s).
EXCHNAME: Exchange name.
VERSID : Record version identification.
ADDTAR : Add-on tariff data.
PBXOPN : PBX operator number.
RELIND : Release indicator.
INSERVK : IN service key.
MLPP : MLPP level.
REFINDUR: Refined duration.
CLGSENT : Sent calling party number.
REDSENT : Sent redirecting number.
CATSENT : Sent calling party category.
CATRCVD : Received calling party category.
SERVINFO: Service info.
SPC : Signalling point code.

RECTRID : Trunk Identification incoming/outgoing.


BMETPULS: B-side meter pulses.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CDTDAT- 2+


ENTR CDTDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

OCLGDN : Originating calling party directory number.


DURBANS : Duration before answer.
THRDPRTY: Third party number.
CLDRCVD : Received called party number.
NEWDEST : New destination.
BGID : Business group identification.
CTXNO : CENTREX numbers.
CALLIND : Additional call indicators.
CALLTAR : Call tariff.
CONNID : Connection Identification.
FAUPRTNR: Facility Usage by Partner.
TRAFQUAL: Traffic Quality Data.
CAC : Carrier Access Code.
ADVCUMCH: Advised Cumulated Charges.
ADDCLGDN: Additional calling party directory number.
DEFMSN : Default multiple subscriber number.
CLDSENT : Sent called party number.
EXCHNAME: Exchange name.
VERSID : Record version identification.
ADDTAR : Add-on tariff data.
PBXOPN : PBX operator number.
RELIND : Release indicator.
INSERVK : IN service key.
MLPP : MLPP level.
REFINDUR: Refined duration.
CLGSENT : Sent calling party number.
REDSENT : Sent redirecting number.
CATSENT : Sent calling party category.
CATRCVD : Received calling party category.
SERVINFO: Service info.
SPC : Signalling point code.

OCLGDN : Originating calling party directory number.


BGID : Business group identification.
CTXNO : CENTREX numbers.
CALLIND : Additional call indicators.
CONNID : Connection Identification.
TRAFQUAL: Traffic Quality Data.
ADDCLGDN: Additional calling party directory number.
DEFMSN : Default multiple subscriber number.
EXCHNAME: Exchange name.
VERSID : Record version identification.
PBXOPN : PBX operator number.
RELIND : Release indicator.
REFINDUR: Refined duration.
SERVINFO: Service info.

IACHASTA: IACAMA
CHARGES : Charge units for connection.
BMETPULS: B-side meter pulses.
OCLGDN : Originating calling party directory number.
THRDPRTY: Third party number.
CLDRCVD : Received called party number.
NEWDEST : New destination.
SEQUENCE: Sequence number.
CHECKSUM: Checksum.
CALLIND : Additional call indicators.
CALLTAR : Call tariff.
GCR : Global Charge reference.
CONNID : Connection Identification.
TRAFQUAL: Traffic Quality Data.
CAC : Carrier Access Code.
ADVCUMCH: Advised Cumulated Charges.
ADDCLGDN: Additional calling party directory number.
DEFMSN : Default multiple subscriber number.
CLDSENT : Sent called party number.
RECOWNER: Record owner directory number.
PFXNATIN: National/International prefix digit(s).
EXCHNAME: Exchange name.
VERSID : Record version identification.
ADDTAR : Add-on tariff data.
PBXOPN : PBX operator number.
RELIND : Release indicator.
INSERVK : IN service key.
MLPP : MLPP level.
REFINDUR: Refined duration.
CLGSENT : Sent calling party number.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CDTDAT- 3+


ENTR CDTDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

REDSENT : Sent redirecting number.


CATSENT : Sent calling party category.
CATRCVD : Received calling party category.
SERVINFO: Service info.
SPC : Signalling point code.

IACHASTA: IACMET
CHARGES : Charge units for connection.
BMETPULS: B-side meter pulses.
VERSID : Record version identification.

CHARGES : Charge units for connection.


OCLGDN : Originating calling party directory number.
DURBANS : Duration before answer.
THRDPRTY: Third party number.
BGID : Business group identification.
CALLIND : Additional call indicators.
CALLTAR : Call tariff.
CONNID : Connection Identification.
FAUPRTNR: Facility Usage by Partner.
TRAFQUAL: Traffic Quality Data.
CAC : Carrier Access Code.
ADVCUMCH: Advised Cumulated Charges.
EXCHNAME: Exchange name.
VERSID : Record version identification.
ADDTAR : Add-on tariff data.
INSERVK : IN service key.
REFINDUR: Refined duration.
SERVINFO: Service info.

INAMA
RECTRID : Trunk Identification incoming/outgoing.
OCLGDN : Originating calling party directory number.
CLDRCVD : Received called party number.
SEQUENCE: Sequence number.
CHECKSUM: Checksum.
CALLTAR : Call tariff.
GCR : Global Charge reference.
CONNID : Connection Identification.
TRAFQUAL: Traffic Quality Data.
CAC : Carrier Access Code.
ADDCLGDN: Additional calling party directory number.
DEFMSN : Default multiple subscriber number.
CLDSENT : Sent called party number.
CLDTOSCP: Called party number sent to SCP.
SCPRDGDN: SCP redirecting number.
RECOWNER: Record owner directory number.
PFXNATIN: National/International prefix digit(s).
EXCHNAME: Exchange name.
VERSID : Record version identification.
ADDTAR : Add-on tariff data.
PBXOPN : PBX operator number.
INSERVK : IN service key.
REFINDUR: Refined duration.
CLGSENT : Sent calling party number.
REDSENT : Sent redirecting number.
SERVINFO: Service info.
MAPCREF : MAP call reference.
IMSI : IMSI number.
SPC : Signalling point code.

PMOB
CONNID : Connection Identification.
TRAFQUAL: Traffic Quality Data.
RECOWNER: Record owner directory number.
PFXNATIN: National/International prefix digit(s).
EXCHNAME: Exchange name.
VERSID : Record version identification.
REFINDUR: Refined duration.
SERVINFO: Service info.

OPERAMA
SEQUENCE: Sequence number.
CHECKSUM: Checksum.
DEFMSN : Default multiple subscriber number.
RECOWNER: Record owner directory number.
PFXNATIN: National/International prefix digit(s).

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CDTDAT- 4+


ENTR CDTDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

EXCHNAME: Exchange name.


VERSID : Record version identification.
PBXOPN : PBX operator number.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CHARGES CALL CHARGES


This identifier allows to record charge units,
zone and charge band.
RECTRID RECORD TRUNK IDENTIFICATION
This identifier allows the recording of the trunk
identification.

The trunk identification can be recorded in the


following form:
- trunk group number + line number
or
- trunk group number + CIC identification
(see parameter ALTNSD).
BMETPULS B SIDE METER PULSES
This identifier allows to collect the B side
meter pulses for an IACHASTA registration.
OCLGDN ORIGINATING CALLING PARTY DN
This identifier allows to record the originating
calling party number within several recording type
records.
In case of PBX with DDI, this is the signalled
and screened directory number.
In case of CAMA and IACAMA this is the
inter-office signalled directory number.
DURBANS DURATION BEFORE ANSWER
This identifier allows to record the
call duration before answer.
THRDPRTY THIRD PARTY NUMBER
This identifier allows to provide the
third party number of a call transfer or
call forwarding within the tickets.
E.g. in case of serial call forwarding
the AMA records of all the call legs
contain the original calling party.
CLDRCVD RECEIVED CALLED PARTY NUMBER
This identifier allows to provide the
received called party number within the tickets.
NEWDEST NEW DESTINATION
This identifier allows to provide the
new destination number within the
tickets.
BGID BUSINESS GROUP IDENTIFICATION
This identifier allows to provide the
CENTREX business group identifier within
the tickets.
CTXNO CENTREX NUMBERS
This identifier allows to provide the
CENTREX numbers within the tickets.
SEQUENCE SEQUENCE NUMBER
This identifier allows to provide the
sequence number within the tickets.
CHECKSUM CHECKSUM
This identifier allows to provide the
checksum within the tickets.
CALLIND ADDITIONAL CALL INDICATORS
This identifier allows to provide the
additional call indicators within the tickets.
CALLTAR CALL TARIFF
This identifier allows to provide the
call tariff within the tickets.
GCR GLOBAL CHARGE REFERENCE
This identifier allows to record the
global charge reference .
Because this is an extension of the local
charge reference (controlable with the
identifier CONNID) the connection
identification will no longer be available
in the charging ticket when the global
charge reference is requested.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CDTDAT- 5+


ENTR CDTDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONNID CONNECTION IDENTIFICATION


This identifier allows to record the
connection identification.
FAUPRTNR FAU BY PARTNER
This identifier allows to record the
facility usage by the partner.
TRAFQUAL TRAFFIC QUALITY DATA
This identifier allows to record the
traffic quality data.
CAC CARRIER ACCESS CODE
This identifier allows to record the
carrier access code.
ADVCUMCH ADVISED CUMULATED CHARGES
This identifier allows to record the
advised cumulated charges.
ADDCLGDN ADDITIONAL CALLING PARTY DN
This identifier allows to record the
additional calling party number.
DEFMSN DEFAULT MULTIPLE SUBSCR. NO.
This identifier allows to record the
default multiple subscriber number.
CLDSENT SENT CALLED PARTY NUMBER
This identifier allows to record the
sent called party number.
CLDTOSCP CALLED PARTY DN SENT TO SCP
This identifier allows to record the
called party number sent to the SCP.
SCPRDGDN PROVIDED REDIRECTING DN BY SCP
This identifier allows to record the
SCP provided redirecting number.
RECOWNER RECORD OWNER DN
This identifier allows to record the
record owner directory number.
PFXNATIN NATIONAL/INTERNATIONAL PREFIX
This identifier allows to have the
national and/or international prefix
included in the directory numbers.
EXCHNAME EXCHANGE IDENTIFICATION NAME
This identifier allows to record the
exchange identification name.
VERSID RECORD VERSION IDENTIFICATION
This identifier allows to record the
record version identification.

Prerequisite:
A record version identification value
(see parameter VERSID) must either
have been entered before or is entered
in the same command.
ADDTAR ADD-ON TARIFF DATA
This identifier allows to record the
add-on tariff data.
PBXOPN PBX OPERATOR NUMBER
This identifier allows to record the
PBX operator number.
RELIND RELEASE INDICATOR
This identifier allows to record the
release indicator.
INSERVK IN SERVICE KEY
This identifier allows to record the
IN service key.
MLPP M LEVEL PRECEDENCE/PREEMPTION
This identifier allows to record the
MLPP precedence level.
REFINDUR REFINED DURATION
This identifier allows recording of the
refined duration.
CLGSENT SENT CALLING PARTY NUMBER
This identifier allows recording of the
sent calling party number.
REDSENT SENT REDIRECTING NUMBER
This identifier allows recording of the
sent redirecting number.
CATSENT SENT CALLING PARTY CATEGORY
This identifier allows recording of the
sent calling party category.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CDTDAT- 6+


ENTR CDTDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CATRCVD RECEIVED CALLING PARTY CATEG.


This identifier allows recording of the
received calling party category.
SERVINFO SERVICE INFO
This identifier allows recording of the
service info.
MAPCREF MAP CALL REFERENCE
This identifier allows recording of the
MAP call reference.
IMSI IMSI NUMBER
This identifier allows recording of the
IMSI number.
SPC SIGNALLING POINT CODE
This identifier allows recording of the
signalling point code.

ALTNSD ALTERNATIVE NON STANDARD DATA

This parameter specifies which alternative data items must be


recorded for a call by the EWSD-switching system.
The possibility exists to collect alternative data items instead of
the standard data items for some recording types.

The alternative data items are administered independent from


the recording type. This means that when an alternative data item
is entered, it is valid for all recording types for which it is
relevant.

Following overview shows for which recording types, which


alternative data items are relevant:

DEB
EXCHIDNO: Exchange identification number instead of name.
RANSWTIM: Recording of begin time instead of end time.
EXTBDIG : More than 18 B-digits can be registered (only
relevant for old ticket layout of V4.X).
RECTRCIC: Trunk identification with CIC instead of
the line number.
TGN2 : Special representation of the trunk group number.
CACTYPE : CAC type.
OWNCAC : Own CAC.
TGNA : Trunk group name.

IACHASTA: IACAMA
EXCHIDNO: Exchange identification number instead of name.
RANSWTIM: Recording of begin time instead of end time.
RECTRCIC: Trunk identification with CIC instead of
the line number.
TGN2 : Special representation of the trunk group number.
CACTYPE : CAC type.
OWNCAC : Own CAC.
TGNA : Trunk group name.

MOBORIG
INAMA
EXCHIDNO: Exchange identification number instead of name.
RANSWTIM: Recording of begin time instead of end time.
RECTRCIC: Trunk identification with CIC instead of
the line number.
TGN2 : Special representation of the trunk group number.
CACTYPE : CAC type.
OWNCAC : Own CAC.
TGNA : Trunk group name.

OPERAMA:
EXCHIDNO: Exchange identification number instead of name.
RANSWTIM: Recording of begin time instead of end time.

PMOB:
EXCHIDNO: Exchange identification number instead of name.

RANSWTIM: Recording of begin time instead of end time.


CACTYPE : CAC type.
OWNCAC : Own CAC.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CDTDAT- 7+


ENTR CDTDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TGNA TRUNK GROUP NAME


This identifier allows to record a trunk group
in form of the trunk group name instead of the
standard trunk group number (parameter TGNA
in command CR TGRP).
Incompatibilities: ALTNSD=TGN2.
CACTYPE CAC TYPE
This identifier allows to record the
CAC type instead of the MCE type.
OWNCAC OWN CAC
This identifier allows to record the
own carrier access code.
EXCHIDNO EXCHANGE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
This identifier allows to record the
exchange identification number instead
of the exchange identification name.
RANSWTIM RECORD ANSWER TIME
This identifier allows to record the
begin date/time of the call instead
of the end date/time.
EXTBDIG EXTENDED B DIGITS
RECTRCIC RECORD TRUNK IDENT. WITH CIC
This identifier allows to record a trunk in form
of circuit identification code instead of line
number for Signaling System No. 7 trunk groups.
This alternative data item only becomes active
if the extra data item RECTRID is set.
TGN2 SECOND TRUNK GROUP NO. IDENT.
This identifier allows to record a trunk group in
form of the second trunk group number instead of
the standard trunk group number (parameter TGN2
in command CR TGRP).
Incompatibilities: ALTNSD=TGNA.

MARKS MARKS

This parameter specifies the control flags that can be used


to control specific functions of call data treatment.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

AMASFAI AMA IMM.OUTP.FOR SUB.FAC.INPUT


UCALLAMA AMA FOR UNSUCCESSFUL CALLS
DEBFA DEB FOR FACILITY INPUT/USAGE
If this flag is set, DEB records are also
generated for facility input/usage by the
subscriber if the DEB feature is activated
for this subscriber.
UCALLIAC IACHASTA FOR UNSUCCESS. CALLS
AMAFAIID AMA FOR IMPLICIT DEACTIVATION
CXSFAICH CENTREX STATION FAC.INP.CHARG.
CTXFAU CENTREX FAU CHARGING
UCALMOBT UNANSW. CALLS FOR MOBTERM.
PMOBIO PREVENT.MOB IMMEDIATE OUTPUT
ATTNOCHA RECORD CHRG.FREE CALL ATTEMPT
UCALLINA INAMA FOR UNSUCCESSFUL CALLS
If this flag is set, IN AMA tickets are generated
for unsuccessful calls. These are calls that have
not been answered but IN AMA must be performed
nevertheless for that call, e.g. because of the
zoning result or 1st dialed digit (project
specific GP implementation).

FAICNTR FACILITY INPUT CHARGE COUNTER

This parameter specifies on which counter the charge units for


facility input have to be accumulated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CNTR1 COUNTER 1
CNTR3 COUNTER 3
CNTR2 COUNTER 2
CNTR4 COUNTER 4

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CDTDAT- 8+


ENTR CDTDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CNTR5 COUNTER 5

FAUCNTR FACILITY USAGE CHARGE COUNTER

This parameter specifies on which counter the charge units for


facility usage have to be accumulated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CNTR1 COUNTER 1
CNTR3 COUNTER 3
CNTR2 COUNTER 2
CNTR4 COUNTER 4
CNTR5 COUNTER 5

VERSID RECORD VERSION IDENT. VALUE

This parameter specifies the record version identification


value per recording.
If no recording type (parameter REC) is specified, the
entered record version identification value is set for all
relevant recordings, i.e. for those recordings for which
the EXTNSD value VERSID can be set.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...99, range of decimal numbers

PMOBS PREVENTIVE METER OBSERVATION

This parameter allows the PMOB feature to be activated together with


entering the PMOB threshold value.
PMOB tickets are generated for calls whose charges have reached
or exceeded the threshold specified in the command.

The generated PMOB tickets can be displayed with DISP CHAREC.


The PMOB threshold can be displayed with DISP CDTDAT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: ACTIVATION OF PMOBS
ACT ACTIVATE PMOBS

b: PMOBS THRESHOLD VALUE=


1...65534, range of decimal numbers

TYPE PMOB TYPE

This parameter specifies for which category and traffic type


combination the PMOB threshold becomes valid.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: CATEGORY
COINB COINBOX
SUB SUBSCRIBER

b: TRAFFIC TYPE
NAT NATIONAL
INAT INTERNATIONAL

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CDTDAT- 9-


RESET CFOPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RESET COMMAND FILE OPTIONS

This command resets the command file options to their defaults in the
session level. If it forms part of a command file, this command sets the
command file options to the values of the next higher level.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 RESET CFOPT ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RESET CFOPT- 1-


SET CFOPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SET COMMAND FILE OPTIONS

This command sets the command file options. In dialog, the parameters
defined with this command remain in effect until the command is entered
again or until the command is input from a command file with parameter
SCOPE=GLOBAL or until the defaults are set with the appropriate
command.
If the command SET CFOPT is entered from a command file, the
following is valid:
- It remains in effect until the command is entered again or until
RESET CFOPT is entered from the command file.
- In a command file addressed from this command file (lower level)
it remains in effect until the command SET CFOPT/RESET CFOPT is
entered from the lower level command file.
When the higher level command file is re-entered, the last
SET CFOPT/RESET CFOPT entered there is valid.
- Otherwise the command is valid up to the end of the command file.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 SET CFOPT : <ACKCFS= ,ON= ,OFF= ,DANCMD= ,ACKREQ=> 1
1 1
1 [,SCOPE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACKCFS EXTEND OF CMD ACKNOWLEDGEMENT

This parameter defines to what extent commands from command files


are to be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALL ALL
CMDERR COMMAND ACKNOWLEDGE + ERROR
ERROR ERROR ACKNOWLEDGE

Default: ERROR

ON SWITCH ON

This parameter specifies which of the switches are set to ON.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

OFF SWITCH OFF

This parameter specifies which of the switches are set to OFF.

Default value: X

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

DANCMD EXECUTION OF DANGEROUS COMMAND

This parameter specifies whether commands in the command file


with the attribute ’Dangerous command’ are to be executed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SET CFOPT- 1+


SET CFOPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

EXEC EXECUTION
NOEXEC NO EXECUTION

Default: NOEXEC

ACKREQ ACKNOWLEDGE OF READ REQUEST

This parameter specifies whether acknowledgement requests


arising due to command input are to be answered positively
or negatively.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

POS POSITIVE ACKNOWLEDGE


NEG NEGATIVE ACKNOWLEDGE

Default: NEG

SCOPE RANGE OF VALIDITY

This parameter specifies the range of validity of the other


parameters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LOCAL ONLY FOR ACTUAL NESTING LEVEL


GLOBAL GLOBAL VALIDITY FOR ALL LEVELS

Default: LOCAL

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SET CFOPT- 2-


CAN CFSERV
DEACT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CALL FORWARDING SERVICES

This command withdraws or deregistrates or deactivates


call forwarding services.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CAN CFSERV - DEACT DEACTIVATE


2. CAN CFSERV - ERASURE ERASURE
3. CAN CFSERV - WITHDRAW WITHDRAWAL

1. Input format

DEACTIVATE

Input format for deactivate of call forwarding services.


Deactivation of a call forwarding service applies to one or
more groups of basic services.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CFSERV : MSIN= ,CFSERV= ,BSVG= ,STATUS= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

CFSERV CALL FORWARDING SERVICE

This parameter specifies a call forwarding service to be withdrawn or


erased or deactivated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALLCF ALL CALL FORWARDING SERVICES


ALLCFCON ALL CF CONDITIONAL
CFBUSY CF ON MSUB BUSY
CFNREACH CF ON MSUB NOT REACHABLE
CFNREPLY CF ON NO REPLY
Notes:
- If this call forwarding service is withdrawn
the value of RCTIM is deleted. In case of a
new provision it is reset to its default.
CFU CF UNCONDITIONAL

BSVG BASIC SERVICE GROUP CODE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALLBS ALL BEARER SERVICES


ALLBSV ALL BASIC SERVICES
ALLTS ALL TELESERVICES
BS20 DATA CIRCUIT DUPLEX ASYN SERV
BS30 DATA CIRCUIT SYN. SERVICES
TELEPHON TELEPHONY
TS60 FACSIMILE SERVICES

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CFSERV- 1+


CAN CFSERV
DEACT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

STATUS STATUS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVATION

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CFSERV- 2+


CAN CFSERV
ERASURE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

ERASURE

Input format for erasure of call forwarding services.


Erasure of a call forwarding service applies to one or
more groups of basic services.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CFSERV : MSIN= ,CFSERV= ,BSVG= [,STATUS=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

CFSERV CALL FORWARDING SERVICE

This parameter specifies a call forwarding service to be withdrawn or


erased or deactivated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALLCF ALL CALL FORWARDING SERVICES


ALLCFCON ALL CF CONDITIONAL
CFBUSY CF ON MSUB BUSY
CFNREACH CF ON MSUB NOT REACHABLE
CFNREPLY CF ON NO REPLY
Notes:
- If this call forwarding service is withdrawn
the value of RCTIM is deleted. In case of a
new provision it is reset to its default.
CFU CF UNCONDITIONAL

BSVG BASIC SERVICE GROUP CODE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALLBS ALL BEARER SERVICES


ALLBSV ALL BASIC SERVICES
ALLTS ALL TELESERVICES
BS20 DATA CIRCUIT DUPLEX ASYN SERV
BS30 DATA CIRCUIT SYN. SERVICES
TELEPHON TELEPHONY
TS60 FACSIMILE SERVICES

STATUS STATUS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

REG REGISTRATION

Default: REG

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CFSERV- 3+


CAN CFSERV
WITHDRAW
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

WITHDRAWAL

Input format for withdrawal of call forwarding services.


Withdrawal of a call forwarding service applies to all
basic services the mobile subscriber subscribed to.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CFSERV : MSIN= ,CFSERV= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

CFSERV CALL FORWARDING SERVICE

This parameter specifies a call forwarding service to be withdrawn or


erased or deactivated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALLCF ALL CALL FORWARDING SERVICES


ALLCFCON ALL CF CONDITIONAL
CFBUSY CF ON MSUB BUSY
CFD CF DEFAULT
CFNREACH CF ON MSUB NOT REACHABLE
CFNREPLY CF ON NO REPLY
Notes:
- If this call forwarding service is withdrawn
the value of RCTIM is deleted. In case of a
new provision it is reset to its default.
CFU CF UNCONDITIONAL

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CFSERV- 4-


ENTR CFSERV
ACT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CALL FORWARDING SERVICE

This command provides or registrates or activates


call forwarding services.
It is also possible to overwrite the subscriber related RCTIM.

Notes:
- If CFNREPLY is withdrawn the value of RCTIM is deleted.
In case of a new provision of this service the timer is
reset to its default.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ENTR CFSERV - ACT ACTIVATE


2. ENTR CFSERV - PROV PROVISION
3. ENTR CFSERV - REG REGISTRATION
4. ENTR CFSERV - TIMER NO REPLY CONDITION TIMER

1. Input format

ACTIVATE

Input format for activation of call forwarding services.


Activation of a call forwarding service applies to one or
more groups of basic services.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR CFSERV : MSIN= ,CFSERV= ,BSFTNO= [,REPCF=] [,SERVAV=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,RCTIM=] [,NCS=] [,NFS=] [,STATUS=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

CFSERV CALL FORWARDING SERVICE

This parameter specifies a call forwarding service to be provided or


registered or activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALLCF ALL CALL FORWARDING SERVICES


Compatibilities:
- In case of activation of a provisioned
"forwarded to number" or in case of
registration the value ALLCF can only
be entered together with a "forwarded
to number".
ALLCFCON ALL CF CONDITIONAL
CFBUSY CF ON MSUB BUSY
CFD CF DEFAULT
CFNREACH CF ON MSUB NOT REACHABLE
CFNREPLY CF ON NO REPLY
CFU CF UNCONDITIONAL

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CFSERV- 1+


ENTR CFSERV
ACT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

BSFTNO BASIC SERVICE GROUP AND FTNO

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: BASIC SERVICE GROUP CODE


ALLBS ALL BEARER SERVICES
ALLBSV ALL BASIC SERVICES
ALLTS ALL TELESERVICES
BS20 DATA CIRCUIT DUPLEX ASYN SERV
BS30 DATA CIRCUIT SYN. SERVICES
TELEPHON TELEPHONY
TS60 FACSIMILE SERVICES

b: FORWARDED TO NUMBER=
1...17 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: NUMBERTYPE OF FTNO
INTNO FTNO IN INTERNATIONAL FORMAT
UNKNOWN FTNO IN UNKNOWN FORMAT

Default: INTNO

REPCF REPLACEMENT OF CF SERVICE

This parameter specifies the forwarding conditions for which CFD


is to be applied.

Default: CFBUSY + CFNREPLY + CRNREACH

Compatibilities:
- If REPCF is entered, parameter value of CFSERV must be CFD.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CFBUSY CF ON MSUB BUSY


CFNREACH CF ON MSUB NOT REACHABLE
CFNREPLY CF ON NO REPLY

SERVAV SERVICE AVAILABILITY

This parameter specifies the availability of a "call forwarding


by default" service.

Compatibilities:
- If SERVAV is entered, parameter value of CFSERV must be CFD.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALLPLMN ALL PUBLIC LAND MOBILE NETWORK


HPLMN HOME PLMN ONLY

Default: ALLPLMN

RCTIM NO REPLY CONDITION TIMER

This parameter specifies the no reply condition timer.

Compatibilities:
- CFSERV=CFNREPLY

Notes:
- Each new provision of CFNREPLY resets the timer to
its default.
- If the no reply condition timer is changed and
CFSERV=CFD is active, then - depending on
the project - no VLR update is performed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

5,10,15,20,25,30, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CFSERV- 2+


ENTR CFSERV
ACT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NCS NOTIFICATION TO CALLING SUB

This parameter specifies whether the calling subscriber is notified


or not.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO NOTIFICATION
NO NO NOTIFICATION
Y NOTIFICATION
YES NOTIFICATION

NFS NOTIFICATION TO FORWARDING SUB

This parameter specifies whether the forwarding subscriber is notified


or not.

Compatibilities:
- CFSERV=CFBUSY
- CFSERV=CFNREPLY
- CFSERV=ALLCF , but has only effect on CFBUSY and CFNREPLY
- CFSERV=ALLCFCON, but has only effect on CFBUSY and CFNREPLY

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO NOTIFICATION
NO NO NOTIFICATION
Y NOTIFICATION
YES NOTIFICATION

STATUS STATUS

Notes:
- In case of activation of a provisioned "forwarded to number" or
in case of registration a "forwarded to number" has to be
entered too.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVATION

Default: ACT

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CFSERV- 3+


ENTR CFSERV
PROV
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

PROVISION

Input format for provision of call forwarding services.


Provision of a call forwarding service applies to all basic services
the mobile subscriber subscribed to.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CFSERV : MSIN= ,CFSERV= [,NCS=] [,NFS=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

CFSERV CALL FORWARDING SERVICE

This parameter specifies a call forwarding service to be provided or


registered or activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALLCF ALL CALL FORWARDING SERVICES


Compatibilities:
- In case of activation of a provisioned
"forwarded to number" or in case of
registration the value ALLCF can only
be entered together with a "forwarded
to number".
ALLCFCON ALL CF CONDITIONAL
CFBUSY CF ON MSUB BUSY
CFNREACH CF ON MSUB NOT REACHABLE
CFNREPLY CF ON NO REPLY
CFU CF UNCONDITIONAL

NCS NOTIFICATION TO CALLING SUB

This parameter specifies whether the calling subscriber is notified


or not.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO NOTIFICATION
NO NO NOTIFICATION
Y NOTIFICATION
YES NOTIFICATION

Default: NO, NO

NFS NOTIFICATION TO FORWARDING SUB

This parameter specifies whether the forwarding subscriber is notified


or not.

Compatibilities:
- CFSERV=CFBUSY
- CFSERV=CFNREPLY
- CFSERV=ALLCF , but has only effect on CFBUSY and CFNREPLY
- CFSERV=ALLCFCON, but has only effect on CFBUSY and CFNREPLY

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO NOTIFICATION
NO NO NOTIFICATION
Y NOTIFICATION
YES NOTIFICATION

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CFSERV- 4+


ENTR CFSERV
PROV
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Default: NO, NO

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CFSERV- 5+


ENTR CFSERV
REG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

REGISTRATION

Input format for registration of call forwarding services.


Registration of a call forwarding service applies to one or
more groups of basic services.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR CFSERV : MSIN= ,CFSERV= ,BSFTNO= ,STATUS= [,RCTIM=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,NCS=] [,NFS=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

CFSERV CALL FORWARDING SERVICE

This parameter specifies a call forwarding service to be provided or


registered or activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALLCF ALL CALL FORWARDING SERVICES


Compatibilities:
- In case of activation of a provisioned
"forwarded to number" or in case of
registration the value ALLCF can only
be entered together with a "forwarded
to number".
ALLCFCON ALL CF CONDITIONAL
CFBUSY CF ON MSUB BUSY
CFNREACH CF ON MSUB NOT REACHABLE
CFNREPLY CF ON NO REPLY
CFU CF UNCONDITIONAL

BSFTNO BASIC SERVICE GROUP AND FTNO

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b[-c]

a: BASIC SERVICE GROUP CODE


ALLBS ALL BEARER SERVICES
ALLBSV ALL BASIC SERVICES
ALLTS ALL TELESERVICES
BS20 DATA CIRCUIT DUPLEX ASYN SERV
BS30 DATA CIRCUIT SYN. SERVICES
TELEPHON TELEPHONY
TS60 FACSIMILE SERVICES

b: FORWARDED TO NUMBER=
1...17 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: NUMBERTYPE OF FTNO
INTNO FTNO IN INTERNATIONAL FORMAT
UNKNOWN FTNO IN UNKNOWN FORMAT

Default: INTNO

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CFSERV- 6+


ENTR CFSERV
REG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

STATUS STATUS

Notes:
- In case of activation of a provisioned "forwarded to number" or
in case of registration a "forwarded to number" has to be
entered too.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

REG REGISTRATION

RCTIM NO REPLY CONDITION TIMER

This parameter specifies the no reply condition timer.

Compatibilities:
- CFSERV=CFNREPLY

Notes:
- Each new provision of CFNREPLY resets the timer to
its default.
- If the no reply condition timer is changed and
CFSERV=CFD is active, then - depending on
the project - no VLR update is performed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

5,10,15,20,25,30, range of decimal numbers

NCS NOTIFICATION TO CALLING SUB

This parameter specifies whether the calling subscriber is notified


or not.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO NOTIFICATION
NO NO NOTIFICATION
Y NOTIFICATION
YES NOTIFICATION

NFS NOTIFICATION TO FORWARDING SUB

This parameter specifies whether the forwarding subscriber is notified


or not.

Compatibilities:
- CFSERV=CFBUSY
- CFSERV=CFNREPLY
- CFSERV=ALLCF , but has only effect on CFBUSY and CFNREPLY
- CFSERV=ALLCFCON, but has only effect on CFBUSY and CFNREPLY

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO NOTIFICATION
NO NO NOTIFICATION
Y NOTIFICATION
YES NOTIFICATION

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CFSERV- 7+


ENTR CFSERV
TIMER
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

NO REPLY CONDITION TIMER

Input format for changing the no reply condition timer.

Prerequisites:
- Activation or registration for call forwarding on no reply.

Incompatibilities:
CFSERV=CFD

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CFSERV : MSIN= ,BSFTNO= ,RCTIM= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

BSFTNO BASIC SERVICE GROUP AND FTNO

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALLBS ALL BEARER SERVICES


ALLBSV ALL BASIC SERVICES
ALLTS ALL TELESERVICES
BS20 DATA CIRCUIT DUPLEX ASYN SERV
BS30 DATA CIRCUIT SYN. SERVICES
TELEPHON TELEPHONY
TS60 FACSIMILE SERVICES

RCTIM NO REPLY CONDITION TIMER

This parameter specifies the no reply condition timer.

Compatibilities:
- CFSERV=CFNREPLY

Notes:
- Each new provision of CFNREPLY resets the timer to
its default.
- If the no reply condition timer is changed and
CFSERV=CFD is active, then - depending on
the project - no VLR update is performed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

5,10,15,20,25,30, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CFSERV- 8-


DISP CFT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CALL FAILURE TREATMENT

This command prints out the entire RCF table (call failure treatment table).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CFT ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CFT- 1-


ENTR CFT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CALL FAILURE TREATMENT

This command can allocate or remove a table for a certain type of program.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR CFT : PRTYPE= ,CFTTAB= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PRTYPE PROGRAM TYPE

This parameter specifies the user program.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8, range of decimal numbers

CFTTAB CALL FAILURE TREATMENT TABLE

This parameter specifies the call failure handling table that


defines the response to specific call failures. Its values are:
0 Initial value
1...15 Table number

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CFT- 1-


DISP CFTJOB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY COMMAND FILE TIME JOB

This command displays the significant data for timed command file-jobs.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP CFTJOB : [JN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

JN JOB NUMBER

This parameter specifies the job number. If this parameter


is omitted, all existing scheduled command file-jobs are
displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...9999, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CFTJOB- 1-


DISP CHAREC
AMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CHARGING DATA RECORDS

This command displays EWSD charging data records, i.e. call detail
records and administrative records that are used for charging purposes
or for charging observation purposes.
The charging data records to be displayed may be stored on the following
locations:
- the EWSD CP (Central Processor) disk
- the EWSD MP (Main Processor) disk
- a tape or magneto optical disk.
Following types of charging data records exist and can be displayed:
- for charging purposes:
AMA records: To charge a PSTN subscriber or a TFS subscriber.
If feature type AMA is activated these records are
stored in the default file IA.ICAMA , otherwise if
feature type CDR is activated these records are
stored in the default file IA.ICCDR or the two files
IA.ICCDR1 and IA.ICCDR2.
INAMA records: To charge an IN service subscriber.
These records are stored in the default file
IA.ICINA.
IACAMA records: To perform inter-operator charging.
If feature type IARA is activated these records are
stored in the default file IA.ICIAR or the two files
IA.ICIAR1 and IA.ICIAR2, otherwise if feature type
CDR is activated these records are stored in the
default file IA.ICCDR or the two files IA.ICCDR1 and
IA.ICCDR2.
- for observation purposes:
MOB records: To observe charges of a PSTN/TFS subscriber.
These records are stored in the default file
IA.ICMOB.
PMOB records: To observe expensive calls (calls for which the
charges exceed a certain limit) for PSTN subscribers.
These records are stored in the default file
IA.ICPMB.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP CHAREC - AMA DISPLAY AMA RECORDS


2. DISP CHAREC - CDR DISPLAY CDR RECORDS
3. DISP CHAREC - CHN DISPLAY AMA/INA RECORDS FOR PROJ. CHINA
4. DISP CHAREC - IACAMA DISPLAY IACAMA RECORDS
5. DISP CHAREC - INAMA DISPLAY INAMA RECORDS
6. DISP CHAREC - MOB DISPLAY MOB RECORDS
7. DISP CHAREC - PMOB DISPLAY PMOB RECORDS

1. Input format

DISPLAY AMA RECORDS

This input format is used to display the AMA records.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CHAREC : TYPE= [,OWNERDN=] [,CLGDN=] [,CLDDN=] 1
1 1
1 [,NEWDEST=] [,ADDNO=] [,ICTGNO=] [,OGTGNO=] 1
1 1
1 [,BEGDATE=] [,BEGTIME=] [,ENDDATE=] [,ENDTIME=] 1
1 1
1 [,FILE=] [,FILEAR=] [,VSN=] [,ALL=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE TYPE OF CHARGING RECORD

This parameter specifies the type of the charging


data record.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 1+


DISP CHAREC
AMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING

OWNERDN OWNER DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the "Owner Directory Number" of the


relevant charging records :
AMA,
IACAMA,
MOB,
PMOB.
The parameter must be entered with local area code and without
discriminating digits.
The "Owner Directory Number" in the charging data records can
be stored in different fields :
* In the field "Record-Owner" if this field is available.
* In the data package mentioned in the field "Record Owner Type".
The Record Owner Type refers to either:
- the data package "Calling Party Number" ,
- the data package "Redirecting Number" ,
- the data package "System Provided Number" ,
- the data package "Connected Party Number" ,
- the data package "Called Party Number" or
- the data package "Service Subscriber Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGDN CALLING DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the digits as stored in the data package


"Calling Party Number" of the relevant charging records :
- AMA,
- INAMA,
- IACAMA,
- MOB.
The national or international prefix digits (e.g. "0" for national
and "00" for international) are never present in the data package
"Calling Party Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLDDN CALLED DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the called party directory number.


This directory number can be stored either in the data package
"Partner Directory Number" or in the data package
"Called Party Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NEWDEST NEW DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the new destination digits


stored in the data package "New Destination"

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ADDNO ADDITIONAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies one of the additional numbers


stored in the data package "Additional Numbers".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 2+


DISP CHAREC
AMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ICTGNO INCOMING TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the incoming trunk group of the


call for which the charging record was generated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OGTGNO OUTGOING TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the outgoing trunk group of the


call for which the charging record was generated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

BEGDATE BEGIN DATE

This parameter specifies the begin date of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

BEGTIME BEGIN TIME

This parameter specifies the begin time of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOURS OF BEGIN TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTES OF BEGIN TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECONDS OF BEGIN TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

ENDDATE END DATE

This parameter specifies the end date of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF END DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 3+


DISP CHAREC
AMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: MONTH OF END DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF END DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

ENDTIME END TIME

This parameter specifies the end time of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOURS OF END TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTES OF END TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECONDS OF END TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file on tape or


magneto optical disk or the name of the file on the EWSD CP disk
or on the EWSD MP disk.
Notes:
The EWSD MP disk file name is only allowed for the record types
AMA,
IACAMA,
INAMA.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FILEAR FILE NAME OF THE SAMAR FILE

This parameter specifies the name of the SAMAR (SAMAR = array


of SAM files which logically belong together) stored on the
EWSD MP disk.
Notes:
This parameter can be used in combination with parameter FILE.
The following table gives an overview of the location where
the charging data records are searched:

FILE FILEAR SEARCH ON


- - the default file on EWSD CP disk
- x all the SAM files of the SAMAR on EWSD
MP disk
x - the indicated file on EWSD CP disk or
on tape/magneto optical disk
x x the indicated SAM file of the SAMAR on
the EWSD MP disk

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...25 characters from the


symbolic name character set

VSN VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the volume serial number of the


tape/magneto optical disk.
Notes:
If this parameter is not entered, the file is assumed to be on disk.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 4+


DISP CHAREC
AMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

symbolic name character set

ALL DISPLAY ALL INFORMATION

This parameter specifies whether all information,


i.e. the total record content, must be displayed
or not.

N DON’T PRINT ALL INFORMATION


NO DON’T PRINT ALL INFORMATION
Y PRINT ALL INFORMATION
YES PRINT ALL INFORMATION

Default: N

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 5+


DISP CHAREC
CDR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

DISPLAY CDR RECORDS

This input format is used to display the IACAMA and the AMA records
stored in the CDR file IA.ICCDR.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CHAREC : TYPE= [,OWNERDN=] [,CLGDN=] [,CLDDN=] 1
1 1
1 [,NEWDEST=] [,ADDNO=] [,ICTGNO=] [,OGTGNO=] 1
1 1
1 [,BEGDATE=] [,BEGTIME=] [,ENDDATE=] [,ENDTIME=] 1
1 1
1 [,FILE=] [,FILEAR=] [,VSN=] [,ALL=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE TYPE OF CHARGING RECORD

This parameter specifies the type of the charging


data record.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CDR COMMON DATA RECORD

OWNERDN OWNER DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the "Owner Directory Number" of the


relevant charging records :
AMA,
IACAMA,
MOB,
PMOB.
The parameter must be entered with local area code and without
discriminating digits.
The "Owner Directory Number" in the charging data records can
be stored in different fields :
* In the field "Record-Owner" if this field is available.
* In the data package mentioned in the field "Record Owner Type".
The Record Owner Type refers to either:
- the data package "Calling Party Number" ,
- the data package "Redirecting Number" ,
- the data package "System Provided Number" ,
- the data package "Connected Party Number" ,
- the data package "Called Party Number" or
- the data package "Service Subscriber Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGDN CALLING DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the digits as stored in the data package


"Calling Party Number" of the relevant charging records :
- AMA,
- INAMA,
- IACAMA,
- MOB.
The national or international prefix digits (e.g. "0" for national
and "00" for international) are never present in the data package
"Calling Party Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLDDN CALLED DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the called party directory number.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 6+


DISP CHAREC
CDR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This directory number can be stored either in the data package


"Partner Directory Number" or in the data package
"Called Party Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NEWDEST NEW DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the new destination digits


stored in the data package "New Destination"

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ADDNO ADDITIONAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies one of the additional numbers


stored in the data package "Additional Numbers".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ICTGNO INCOMING TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the incoming trunk group of the


call for which the charging record was generated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OGTGNO OUTGOING TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the outgoing trunk group of the


call for which the charging record was generated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

BEGDATE BEGIN DATE

This parameter specifies the begin date of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

BEGTIME BEGIN TIME

This parameter specifies the begin time of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 7+


DISP CHAREC
CDR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a-b-c

a: HOURS OF BEGIN TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTES OF BEGIN TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECONDS OF BEGIN TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

ENDDATE END DATE

This parameter specifies the end date of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF END DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF END DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF END DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

ENDTIME END TIME

This parameter specifies the end time of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOURS OF END TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTES OF END TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECONDS OF END TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file on tape or


magneto optical disk or the name of the file on the EWSD CP disk
or on the EWSD MP disk.
Notes:
The EWSD MP disk file name is only allowed for the record types
AMA,
IACAMA,
INAMA.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FILEAR FILE NAME OF THE SAMAR FILE

This parameter specifies the name of the SAMAR (SAMAR = array


of SAM files which logically belong together) stored on the
EWSD MP disk.
Notes:
This parameter can be used in combination with parameter FILE.
The following table gives an overview of the location where

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 8+


DISP CHAREC
CDR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

the charging data records are searched:

FILE FILEAR SEARCH ON


- - the default file on EWSD CP disk
- x all the SAM files of the SAMAR on EWSD
MP disk
x - the indicated file on EWSD CP disk or
on tape/magneto optical disk
x x the indicated SAM file of the SAMAR on
the EWSD MP disk

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...25 characters from the


symbolic name character set

VSN VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the volume serial number of the


tape/magneto optical disk.
Notes:
If this parameter is not entered, the file is assumed to be on disk.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ALL DISPLAY ALL INFORMATION

This parameter specifies whether all information,


i.e. the total record content, must be displayed
or not.

N DON’T PRINT ALL INFORMATION


NO DON’T PRINT ALL INFORMATION
Y PRINT ALL INFORMATION
YES PRINT ALL INFORMATION

Default: N

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 9+


DISP CHAREC
CHN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

DISPLAY AMA/INA RECORDS FOR PROJ. CHINA

This input format is used to display the AMA/INA records


for Project China.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CHAREC : TYPE= [,CLGDN=] [,CLDDN=] [,BEGDATE=] 1
1 1
1 [,BEGTIME=] [,ENDDATE=] [,ENDTIME=] [,FILE=] 1
1 1
1 [,VSN=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE TYPE OF CHARGING RECORD

This parameter specifies the type of the charging


data record.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING


INAMA INTELLIGENT NETWORK WITH AMA

CLGDN CALLING DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the digits as stored in the data package


"Calling Party Number" of the relevant charging records :
- AMA,
- INAMA,
- IACAMA,
- MOB.
The national or international prefix digits (e.g. "0" for national
and "00" for international) are never present in the data package
"Calling Party Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLDDN CALLED DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the called party directory number.


This directory number can be stored either in the data package
"Partner Directory Number" or in the data package
"Called Party Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

BEGDATE BEGIN DATE

This parameter specifies the begin date of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 10+


DISP CHAREC
CHN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

BEGTIME BEGIN TIME

This parameter specifies the begin time of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOURS OF BEGIN TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTES OF BEGIN TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECONDS OF BEGIN TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

ENDDATE END DATE

This parameter specifies the end date of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF END DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF END DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF END DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

ENDTIME END TIME

This parameter specifies the end time of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOURS OF END TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTES OF END TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECONDS OF END TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file on tape or


magneto optical disk or the name of the file on the EWSD CP disk
or on the EWSD MP disk.
Notes:
The EWSD MP disk file name is only allowed for the record types
AMA,
IACAMA,
INAMA.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 11+


DISP CHAREC
CHN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

VSN VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the volume serial number of the


tape/magneto optical disk.
Notes:
If this parameter is not entered, the file is assumed to be on disk.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 12+


DISP CHAREC
IACAMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

DISPLAY IACAMA RECORDS

This input format is used to display the IACAMA records.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CHAREC : TYPE= [,OWNERDN=] [,CLGDN=] [,CLDDN=] 1
1 1
1 [,NEWDEST=] [,ADDNO=] [,ICTGNO=] [,OGTGNO=] 1
1 1
1 [,BEGDATE=] [,BEGTIME=] [,ENDDATE=] [,ENDTIME=] 1
1 1
1 [,FILE=] [,FILEAR=] [,VSN=] [,ALL=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE TYPE OF CHARGING RECORD

This parameter specifies the type of the charging


data record.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IACAMA INTERADMIN. CHARGING VIA AMA

OWNERDN OWNER DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the "Owner Directory Number" of the


relevant charging records :
AMA,
IACAMA,
MOB,
PMOB.
The parameter must be entered with local area code and without
discriminating digits.
The "Owner Directory Number" in the charging data records can
be stored in different fields :
* In the field "Record-Owner" if this field is available.
* In the data package mentioned in the field "Record Owner Type".
The Record Owner Type refers to either:
- the data package "Calling Party Number" ,
- the data package "Redirecting Number" ,
- the data package "System Provided Number" ,
- the data package "Connected Party Number" ,
- the data package "Called Party Number" or
- the data package "Service Subscriber Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGDN CALLING DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the digits as stored in the data package


"Calling Party Number" of the relevant charging records :
- AMA,
- INAMA,
- IACAMA,
- MOB.
The national or international prefix digits (e.g. "0" for national
and "00" for international) are never present in the data package
"Calling Party Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLDDN CALLED DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the called party directory number.


This directory number can be stored either in the data package

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 13+


DISP CHAREC
IACAMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

"Partner Directory Number" or in the data package


"Called Party Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NEWDEST NEW DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the new destination digits


stored in the data package "New Destination"

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ADDNO ADDITIONAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies one of the additional numbers


stored in the data package "Additional Numbers".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ICTGNO INCOMING TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the incoming trunk group of the


call for which the charging record was generated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OGTGNO OUTGOING TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the outgoing trunk group of the


call for which the charging record was generated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

BEGDATE BEGIN DATE

This parameter specifies the begin date of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

BEGTIME BEGIN TIME

This parameter specifies the begin time of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 14+


DISP CHAREC
IACAMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a: HOURS OF BEGIN TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTES OF BEGIN TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECONDS OF BEGIN TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

ENDDATE END DATE

This parameter specifies the end date of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF END DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF END DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF END DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

ENDTIME END TIME

This parameter specifies the end time of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOURS OF END TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTES OF END TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECONDS OF END TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file on tape or


magneto optical disk or the name of the file on the EWSD CP disk
or on the EWSD MP disk.
Notes:
The EWSD MP disk file name is only allowed for the record types
AMA,
IACAMA,
INAMA.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FILEAR FILE NAME OF THE SAMAR FILE

This parameter specifies the name of the SAMAR (SAMAR = array


of SAM files which logically belong together) stored on the
EWSD MP disk.
Notes:
This parameter can be used in combination with parameter FILE.
The following table gives an overview of the location where
the charging data records are searched:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 15+


DISP CHAREC
IACAMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

FILE FILEAR SEARCH ON


- - the default file on EWSD CP disk
- x all the SAM files of the SAMAR on EWSD
MP disk
x - the indicated file on EWSD CP disk or
on tape/magneto optical disk
x x the indicated SAM file of the SAMAR on
the EWSD MP disk

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...25 characters from the


symbolic name character set

VSN VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the volume serial number of the


tape/magneto optical disk.
Notes:
If this parameter is not entered, the file is assumed to be on disk.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ALL DISPLAY ALL INFORMATION

This parameter specifies whether all information,


i.e. the total record content, must be displayed
or not.

N DON’T PRINT ALL INFORMATION


NO DON’T PRINT ALL INFORMATION
Y PRINT ALL INFORMATION
YES PRINT ALL INFORMATION

Default: N

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 16+


DISP CHAREC
INAMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

DISPLAY INAMA RECORDS

This input format is used to display the INA records.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CHAREC : TYPE= [,CLI=] [,CLGDN=] [,CLDDN=] [,NEWDEST=] 1
1 1
1 [,ADDNO=] [,ICTGNO=] [,OGTGNO=] [,BEGDATE=] 1
1 1
1 [,BEGTIME=] [,ENDDATE=] [,ENDTIME=] [,FILE=] 1
1 1
1 [,FILEAR=] [,VSN=] [,ALL=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE TYPE OF CHARGING RECORD

This parameter specifies the type of the charging


data record.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAMA INTELLIGENT NETWORK WITH AMA

CLI CALLING LINE IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the directory number as stored in the


data package "Calling Line Id" for the relevant charging record
INAMA.
The parameter must be entered with local area code, and, depending
on the project, with or without discrimination digit.
The "Calling Line Id" data package contains the signalled calling
party number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGDN CALLING DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the digits as stored in the data package


"Calling Party Number" of the relevant charging records :
- AMA,
- INAMA,
- IACAMA,
- MOB.
The national or international prefix digits (e.g. "0" for national
and "00" for international) are never present in the data package
"Calling Party Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLDDN CALLED DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the called party directory number.


This directory number can be stored either in the data package
"Partner Directory Number" or in the data package
"Called Party Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NEWDEST NEW DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the new destination digits


stored in the data package "New Destination"

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 17+


DISP CHAREC
INAMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ADDNO ADDITIONAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies one of the additional numbers


stored in the data package "Additional Numbers".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ICTGNO INCOMING TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the incoming trunk group of the


call for which the charging record was generated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OGTGNO OUTGOING TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the outgoing trunk group of the


call for which the charging record was generated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

BEGDATE BEGIN DATE

This parameter specifies the begin date of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

BEGTIME BEGIN TIME

This parameter specifies the begin time of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOURS OF BEGIN TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTES OF BEGIN TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECONDS OF BEGIN TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 18+


DISP CHAREC
INAMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENDDATE END DATE

This parameter specifies the end date of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF END DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF END DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF END DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

ENDTIME END TIME

This parameter specifies the end time of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOURS OF END TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTES OF END TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECONDS OF END TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file on tape or


magneto optical disk or the name of the file on the EWSD CP disk
or on the EWSD MP disk.
Notes:
The EWSD MP disk file name is only allowed for the record types
AMA,
IACAMA,
INAMA.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FILEAR FILE NAME OF THE SAMAR FILE

This parameter specifies the name of the SAMAR (SAMAR = array


of SAM files which logically belong together) stored on the
EWSD MP disk.
Notes:
This parameter can be used in combination with parameter FILE.
The following table gives an overview of the location where
the charging data records are searched:

FILE FILEAR SEARCH ON


- - the default file on EWSD CP disk
- x all the SAM files of the SAMAR on EWSD
MP disk
x - the indicated file on EWSD CP disk or
on tape/magneto optical disk
x x the indicated SAM file of the SAMAR on
the EWSD MP disk

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 19+


DISP CHAREC
INAMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...25 characters from the


symbolic name character set

VSN VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the volume serial number of the


tape/magneto optical disk.
Notes:
If this parameter is not entered, the file is assumed to be on disk.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ALL DISPLAY ALL INFORMATION

This parameter specifies whether all information,


i.e. the total record content, must be displayed
or not.

N DON’T PRINT ALL INFORMATION


NO DON’T PRINT ALL INFORMATION
Y PRINT ALL INFORMATION
YES PRINT ALL INFORMATION

Default: N

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 20+


DISP CHAREC
MOB
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

6. Input format

DISPLAY MOB RECORDS

This input format is used to display the MOB records.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CHAREC : TYPE= [,OWNERDN=] [,CLGDN=] [,CLDDN=] 1
1 1
1 [,OGTGNO=] [,NEWDEST=] [,ADDNO=] [,BEGDATE=] 1
1 1
1 [,BEGTIME=] [,ENDDATE=] [,ENDTIME=] [,FILE=] 1
1 1
1 [,VSN=] [,ALL=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE TYPE OF CHARGING RECORD

This parameter specifies the type of the charging


data record.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

MOB METER OBSERVATION

OWNERDN OWNER DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the "Owner Directory Number" of the


relevant charging records :
AMA,
IACAMA,
MOB,
PMOB.
The parameter must be entered with local area code and without
discriminating digits.
The "Owner Directory Number" in the charging data records can
be stored in different fields :
* In the field "Record-Owner" if this field is available.
* In the data package mentioned in the field "Record Owner Type".
The Record Owner Type refers to either:
- the data package "Calling Party Number" ,
- the data package "Redirecting Number" ,
- the data package "System Provided Number" ,
- the data package "Connected Party Number" ,
- the data package "Called Party Number" or
- the data package "Service Subscriber Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGDN CALLING DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the digits as stored in the data package


"Calling Party Number" of the relevant charging records :
- AMA,
- INAMA,
- IACAMA,
- MOB.
The national or international prefix digits (e.g. "0" for national
and "00" for international) are never present in the data package
"Calling Party Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLDDN CALLED DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the called party directory number.


This directory number can be stored either in the data package

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 21+


DISP CHAREC
MOB
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

"Partner Directory Number" or in the data package


"Called Party Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

OGTGNO OUTGOING TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the outgoing trunk group of the


call for which the charging record was generated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NEWDEST NEW DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the new destination digits


stored in the data package "New Destination"

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ADDNO ADDITIONAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies one of the additional numbers


stored in the data package "Additional Numbers".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

BEGDATE BEGIN DATE

This parameter specifies the begin date of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

BEGTIME BEGIN TIME

This parameter specifies the begin time of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOURS OF BEGIN TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTES OF BEGIN TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECONDS OF BEGIN TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 22+


DISP CHAREC
MOB
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENDDATE END DATE

This parameter specifies the end date of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF END DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF END DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF END DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

ENDTIME END TIME

This parameter specifies the end time of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOURS OF END TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTES OF END TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECONDS OF END TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file on tape or


magneto optical disk or the name of the file on the EWSD CP disk
or on the EWSD MP disk.
Notes:
The EWSD MP disk file name is only allowed for the record types
AMA,
IACAMA,
INAMA.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 characters from the


symbolic name character set

Default: IA.ICMOB

VSN VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the volume serial number of the


tape/magneto optical disk.
Notes:
If this parameter is not entered, the file is assumed to be on disk.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ALL DISPLAY ALL INFORMATION

This parameter specifies whether all information,


i.e. the total record content, must be displayed
or not.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 23+


DISP CHAREC
MOB
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

N DON’T PRINT ALL INFORMATION


NO DON’T PRINT ALL INFORMATION
Y PRINT ALL INFORMATION
YES PRINT ALL INFORMATION

Default: N

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 24+


DISP CHAREC
PMOB
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

7. Input format

DISPLAY PMOB RECORDS

This input format is used to display the PMOB records.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CHAREC : TYPE= [,OWNERDN=] [,CLDDN=] [,BEGDATE=] 1
1 1
1 [,BEGTIME=] [,ENDDATE=] [,ENDTIME=] [,FILE=] 1
1 1
1 [,VSN=] [,ALL=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE TYPE OF CHARGING RECORD

This parameter specifies the type of the charging


data record.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PMOB PREVENTIVE METER OBSERVATION

OWNERDN OWNER DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the "Owner Directory Number" of the


relevant charging records :
AMA,
IACAMA,
MOB,
PMOB.
The parameter must be entered with local area code and without
discriminating digits.
The "Owner Directory Number" in the charging data records can
be stored in different fields :
* In the field "Record-Owner" if this field is available.
* In the data package mentioned in the field "Record Owner Type".
The Record Owner Type refers to either:
- the data package "Calling Party Number" ,
- the data package "Redirecting Number" ,
- the data package "System Provided Number" ,
- the data package "Connected Party Number" ,
- the data package "Called Party Number" or
- the data package "Service Subscriber Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLDDN CALLED DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the called party directory number.


This directory number can be stored either in the data package
"Partner Directory Number" or in the data package
"Called Party Number".

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

BEGDATE BEGIN DATE

This parameter specifies the begin date of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 25+


DISP CHAREC
PMOB
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

BEGTIME BEGIN TIME

This parameter specifies the begin time of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOURS OF BEGIN TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTES OF BEGIN TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECONDS OF BEGIN TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

ENDDATE END DATE

This parameter specifies the end date of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF END DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF END DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF END DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

ENDTIME END TIME

This parameter specifies the end time of the display interval.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOURS OF END TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTES OF END TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECONDS OF END TIME=


0...59, range of decimal numbers

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file on tape or


magneto optical disk or the name of the file on the EWSD CP disk
or on the EWSD MP disk.
Notes:
The EWSD MP disk file name is only allowed for the record types
AMA,

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 26+


DISP CHAREC
PMOB
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

IACAMA,
INAMA.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 characters from the


symbolic name character set

Default: IA.ICPMB

VSN VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the volume serial number of the


tape/magneto optical disk.
Notes:
If this parameter is not entered, the file is assumed to be on disk.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ALL DISPLAY ALL INFORMATION

This parameter specifies whether all information,


i.e. the total record content, must be displayed
or not.

N DON’T PRINT ALL INFORMATION


NO DON’T PRINT ALL INFORMATION
Y PRINT ALL INFORMATION
YES PRINT ALL INFORMATION

Default: N

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CHAREC- 27-


DISP CIRPPREF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CIRCUIT POOL PREFERENCES

This command displays the circuit pool preferences:


- Standard circuit pool.
- Alternative circuit pool.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CIRPPREF ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CIRPPREF- 1-


MOD CIRPPREF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY CIRCUIT POOL PREFERENCES

This command defines the STANDARD CIRCUIT POOL and the


ALTERNATIVE CIRCUIT POOL.
Initial values : SCIRPNO=POOL1,ACIRPNO=NOPOOL

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD CIRPPREF : SCIRPNO= ,ACIRPNO= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCIRPNO STANDARD CIRCUIT POOL NO

This parameter specifies the ’Standard circuit pool’ number

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

POOL1 CIRCUIT POOL NO 1


Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL2 CIRCUIT POOL NO 2
Not supported
POOL3 CIRCUIT POOL NO 3
Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
Half Rate speech channel
Half Rate data channel (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL4 CIRCUIT POOL NO 4
Not supported
POOL5 CIRCUIT POOL NO 5
Full Rate speech channel
Enhanced Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL6 CIRCUIT POOL NO 6
Not supported
POOL7 CIRCUIT POOL NO 7
Full Rate speech channel
Enhanced Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
Half Rate speech channel
Half Rate data channel (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL8 CIRCUIT POOL NO 8
Not supported
POOL9 CIRCUIT POOL NO 9
Not allowed as standard or alternative pool
POOL10 CIRCUIT POOL NO 10
Not allowed as standard or alternative pool
POOL11 CIRCUIT POOL NO 11
Not supported
POOL12 CIRCUIT POOL NO 12
Not supported
POOL13 CIRCUIT POOL NO 13
Not supported
POOL14 CIRCUIT POOL NO 14
Not supported
POOL15 CIRCUIT POOL NO 15
Not supported
POOL16 CIRCUIT POOL NO 16
Not supported
POOL17 CIRCUIT POOL NO 17
Not supported
POOL18 CIRCUIT POOL NO 18
Not allowed as standard or alternative pool
POOL19 CIRCUIT POOL NO 19
Not supported

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CIRPPREF- 1+


MOD CIRPPREF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

POOL20 CIRCUIT POOL NO 20


Full Rate speech channel
Enhanced Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
Half Rate speech channel
Half Rate data channel (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL21 CIRCUIT POOL NO 21
Not allowed as standard or alternative pool
POOL22 CIRCUIT POOL NO 22
Not supported
POOL23 CIRCUIT POOL NO 23
Adaptative Multi-rate Full Rate speech channel
Adaptative Multi-rate Half Rate speech channel
POOL24 CIRCUIT POOL NO 24
Adaptative Multi-rate Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
Adaptative Multi-rate Half Rate speech channel
POOL25 CIRCUIT POOL NO 25
Full Rate speech channel
Enhanced Full Rate speech channel
Adaptative Multi-rate Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
Adaptative Multi-rate Half Rate speech channel
POOL26 CIRCUIT POOL NO 26
Full Rate speech channel
Enhanced Full Rate speech channel
Adaptative Multi-rate Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
Adaptative Multi-rate Half Rate speech channel
POOL27 CIRCUIT POOL NO 27
Full Rate speech channel
Enhanced Full Rate speech channel
Adaptative Multi-rate Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
Half Rate speech channel
Adaptative Multi-rate Half Rate speech channel
Half Rate data channel (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL28 CIRCUIT POOL NO 28
Full Rate speech channel
Enhanced Full Rate speech channel
Adaptative Multi-rate Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
Half Rate speech channel
Adaptative Multi-rate Half Rate speech channel
Half Rate data channel (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL29 CIRCUIT POOL NO 29
Not allowed as standard or alternative pool
POOL30 CIRCUIT POOL NO 30
Not allowed as standard or alternative pool
POOL31 CIRCUIT POOL NO 31
Not supported
POOL32 CIRCUIT POOL NO 32
Not supported

ACIRPNO ALTERNATIVE CIRCUIT POOL NO

This parameter specifies the ’Alternative circuit pool’ number

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NOPOOL NO ALTERNATIVE CIRCUIT POOL


POOL1 CIRCUIT POOL NO 1
Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL2 CIRCUIT POOL NO 2
Not supported
POOL3 CIRCUIT POOL NO 3
Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
Half Rate speech channel
Half Rate data channel (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL4 CIRCUIT POOL NO 4
Not supported
POOL5 CIRCUIT POOL NO 5
Full Rate speech channel
Enhanced Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CIRPPREF- 2+


MOD CIRPPREF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

POOL6 CIRCUIT POOL NO 6


Not supported
POOL7 CIRCUIT POOL NO 7
Full Rate speech channel
Enhanced Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
Half Rate speech channel
Half Rate data channel (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL8 CIRCUIT POOL NO 8
Not supported
POOL9 CIRCUIT POOL NO 9
Not allowed as standard or alternative pool
POOL10 CIRCUIT POOL NO 10
Not allowed as standard or alternative pool
POOL11 CIRCUIT POOL NO 11
Not supported
POOL12 CIRCUIT POOL NO 12
Not supported
POOL13 CIRCUIT POOL NO 13
Not supported
POOL14 CIRCUIT POOL NO 14
Not supported
POOL15 CIRCUIT POOL NO 15
Not supported
POOL16 CIRCUIT POOL NO 16
Not supported
POOL17 CIRCUIT POOL NO 17
Not supported
POOL18 CIRCUIT POOL NO 18
Not allowed as standard or alternative pool
POOL19 CIRCUIT POOL NO 19
Not supported
POOL20 CIRCUIT POOL NO 20
Full Rate speech channel
Enhanced Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
Half Rate speech channel
Half Rate data channel (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL21 CIRCUIT POOL NO 21
Not allowed as standard or alternative pool
POOL22 CIRCUIT POOL NO 22
Not supported
POOL23 CIRCUIT POOL NO 23
Adaptative Multi-rate Full Rate speech channel
Adaptative Multi-rate Half Rate speech channel
POOL24 CIRCUIT POOL NO 24
Adaptative Multi-rate Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
Adaptative Multi-rate Half Rate speech channel
POOL25 CIRCUIT POOL NO 25
Full Rate speech channel
Enhanced Full Rate speech channel
Adaptative Multi-rate Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
Adaptative Multi-rate Half Rate speech channel
POOL26 CIRCUIT POOL NO 26
Full Rate speech channel
Enhanced Full Rate speech channel
Adaptative Multi-rate Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
Adaptative Multi-rate Half Rate speech channel
POOL27 CIRCUIT POOL NO 27
Full Rate speech channel
Enhanced Full Rate speech channel
Adaptative Multi-rate Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
Half Rate speech channel
Adaptative Multi-rate Half Rate speech channel
Half Rate data channel (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL28 CIRCUIT POOL NO 28
Full Rate speech channel
Enhanced Full Rate speech channel
Adaptative Multi-rate Full Rate speech channel
Full Rate data channel (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
Half Rate speech channel
Adaptative Multi-rate Half Rate speech channel
Half Rate data channel (6, 3.6 kbit/s)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CIRPPREF- 3+


MOD CIRPPREF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

POOL29 CIRCUIT POOL NO 29


Not allowed as standard or alternative pool
POOL30 CIRCUIT POOL NO 30
Not allowed as standard or alternative pool
POOL31 CIRCUIT POOL NO 31
Not supported
POOL32 CIRCUIT POOL NO 32
Not supported

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CIRPPREF- 4-


CAN CIRPREL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CIRCUIT POOL RELATION

This command cancels a circuit pool characteristic related to a BSSAP trunk


group.
Notes:
- The circuit pool characteristic related to the specified BSSAP trunk group
will be set to the default value NOPOOL.
Prerequisites:
- All BSSAP trunk groups assigned to the same BSC destination as the specified
BSSAP trunk group must have related circuit pool characteristic different from
the default value NOPOOL.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CIRPREL : TGNO= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CIRPREL- 1-


DISP CIRPREL
BSCAREA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CIRCUIT POOL RELATION

This command displays data of created circuit pool relation between a BSSAP
trunk group and a circuit pool number.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP CIRPREL - BSCAREA BSC AREA


2. DISP CIRPREL - CIRPNO CIRCUIT POOL NUMBER
3. DISP CIRPREL - TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

1. Input format

BSC AREA

This input format displays all BSSAP trunk groups, together with the
related circuit pool number, that are assigned to the specified
base station controller signaling point code.
Notes:
- If a BSSAP trunk group is not related to the circuit pool number,
the default value NOPOOL will be displayed.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CIRPREL : BSCSPC= ,NETIND= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

BSCSPC BASE STATION CONTROLLER SPC

BSCSPC a: = 1..15
b: = 1..7
c: = 1..15
d: = 1..7

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: SIGNALING POINT CODE UNIT1=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

b: SIGNALING POINT CODE UNIT2=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: SIGNALING POINT CODE UNIT3=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: SIGNALING POINT CODE UNIT4=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CIRPREL- 1+


DISP CIRPREL
CIRPNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

CIRCUIT POOL NUMBER

This input format displays all BSSAP trunk groups related to the specified
circuit pool number, together with the base station controller signaling
point code and network indicator.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CIRPREL : CIRPNO= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CIRPNO CIRCUIT POOL NUMBER

This parameter specifies a group of circuits supporting the same


channel types.
Notes:
- Some of the circuit pools are not allowed, because they are reserved
for future usage.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NOPOOL NO CIRCUIT POOL ASSIGNMENT


POOL1 CIRCUIT POOL NO 1
FR speech version 1
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL10 CIRCUIT POOL NO 10
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 2*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL11 CIRCUIT POOL NO 11
HSCSD max. 4*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL12 CIRCUIT POOL NO 12
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 4*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL13 CIRCUIT POOL NO 13
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 4*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL14 CIRCUIT POOL NO 14
HSCSD max. 6*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL15 CIRCUIT POOL NO 15
FR data (14.5 kbit/s)
POOL16 CIRCUIT POOL NO 16
HSCSD max. 2*FR data (14.5 kbit/s)
POOL17 CIRCUIT POOL NO 17
HSCSD max. 4*FR data (14.5 kbit/s)
POOL18 CIRCUIT POOL NO 18
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 2*FR data (14.5, 12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL19 CIRCUIT POOL NO 19
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 4*FR data (14.5, 12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL2 CIRCUIT POOL NO 2
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL20 CIRCUIT POOL NO 20
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL21 CIRCUIT POOL NO 21

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CIRPREL- 2+


DISP CIRPREL
CIRPNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 2*FR data (14.5, 12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL22 CIRCUIT POOL NO 22
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 4*FR data (14.5, 12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL23 CIRCUIT POOL NO 23
FR speech version 3
HR speech version 3
POOL24 CIRCUIT POOL NO 24
FR speech version 3
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 3
POOL25 CIRCUIT POOL NO 25
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR speech version 3
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 3
POOL26 CIRCUIT POOL NO 26
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR speech version 3
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 3
POOL27 CIRCUIT POOL NO 27
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR speech version 3
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR speech version 3
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL28 CIRCUIT POOL NO 28
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR speech version 3
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR speech version 3
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL29 CIRCUIT POOL NO 29
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR speech version 3
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR speech version 3
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 2*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL3 CIRCUIT POOL NO 3
FR speech version 1
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL30 CIRCUIT POOL NO 30
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR speech version 3
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR speech version 3
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 2*FR data (14.5, 12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL31 CIRCUIT POOL NO 31
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR speech version 3
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CIRPREL- 3+


DISP CIRPREL
CIRPNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

HR speech version 3
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 4*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL32 CIRCUIT POOL NO 32
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR speech version 3
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR speech version 3
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 4*FR data (14.5, 12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL4 CIRCUIT POOL NO 4
FR speech version 2
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL5 CIRCUIT POOL NO 5
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL6 CIRCUIT POOL NO 6
FR speech version 2
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL7 CIRCUIT POOL NO 7
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL8 CIRCUIT POOL NO 8
HSCSD max. 2*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL9 CIRCUIT POOL NO 9
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 2*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CIRPREL- 4+


DISP CIRPREL
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This input format displays information of a specified BSSAP trunk group.


Notes:
- If a BSSAP trunk group is not related to the circuit pool number,
the default value NOPOOL will be displayed.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CIRPREL : TGNO= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CIRPREL- 5-


ENTR CIRPREL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CIRCUIT POOL RELATION

This command enters a circuit pool characteristic related to a BSSAP trunk


group.
Prerequisites:
- The BSSAP trunk group must be created (CR TGRP).
- The BSSAP trunk group must be assigned to a BSC destination
(ENTR C7TGREL).
- At least one BSSAP trunk group must have a circuit pool characteristic equal
to the standard pool or equal to the alternative pool, in order not to
interrupt the traffic to the BSC destination. Standard/alternative pool can be
displayed by DISP CIRPPREF.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CIRPREL : TGNO= ,CIRPNO= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CIRPNO CIRCUIT POOL NUMBER

This parameter specifies a group of circuits supporting the same


channel types.
Notes:
- Each CIRPNO is allowed only once per BSC destination.
- Some of the circuit pools are not allowed, because they are reserved
for future usage.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

POOL1 CIRCUIT POOL NO 1


FR speech version 1
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL2 CIRCUIT POOL NO 2
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL3 CIRCUIT POOL NO 3
FR speech version 1
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL4 CIRCUIT POOL NO 4
FR speech version 2
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL5 CIRCUIT POOL NO 5
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL6 CIRCUIT POOL NO 6
FR speech version 2
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL7 CIRCUIT POOL NO 7
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CIRPREL- 1+


ENTR CIRPREL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)


HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL8 CIRCUIT POOL NO 8
HSCSD max. 2*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL9 CIRCUIT POOL NO 9
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 2*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL10 CIRCUIT POOL NO 10
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 2*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL11 CIRCUIT POOL NO 11
HSCSD max. 4*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL12 CIRCUIT POOL NO 12
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 4*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL13 CIRCUIT POOL NO 13
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 4*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL14 CIRCUIT POOL NO 14
HSCSD max. 6*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL15 CIRCUIT POOL NO 15
FR data (14.5 kbit/s)
POOL16 CIRCUIT POOL NO 16
HSCSD max. 2*FR data (14.5 kbit/s)
POOL17 CIRCUIT POOL NO 17
HSCSD max. 4*FR data (14.5 kbit/s)
POOL18 CIRCUIT POOL NO 18
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 2*FR data (14.5, 12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL19 CIRCUIT POOL NO 19
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 4*FR data (14.5, 12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL20 CIRCUIT POOL NO 20
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL21 CIRCUIT POOL NO 21
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 2*FR data (14.5, 12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL22 CIRCUIT POOL NO 22
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 4*FR data (14.5, 12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL23 CIRCUIT POOL NO 23
FR speech version 3
HR speech version 3
POOL24 CIRCUIT POOL NO 24
FR speech version 3
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 3
POOL25 CIRCUIT POOL NO 25
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR speech version 3
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CIRPREL- 2+


ENTR CIRPREL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

HR speech version 3
POOL26 CIRCUIT POOL NO 26
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR speech version 3
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 3
POOL27 CIRCUIT POOL NO 27
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR speech version 3
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR speech version 3
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL28 CIRCUIT POOL NO 28
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR speech version 3
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR speech version 3
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
POOL29 CIRCUIT POOL NO 29
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR speech version 3
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR speech version 3
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 2*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL30 CIRCUIT POOL NO 30
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR speech version 3
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR speech version 3
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 2*FR data (14.5, 12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL31 CIRCUIT POOL NO 31
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR speech version 3
FR data (12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR speech version 3
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 4*FR data (12, 6 kbit/s)
POOL32 CIRCUIT POOL NO 32
FR speech version 1
FR speech version 2
FR speech version 3
FR data (14.5, 12, 6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HR speech version 1
HR speech version 3
HR data (6, 3.6 kbit/s)
HSCSD max. 4*FR data (14.5, 12, 6 kbit/s)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CIRPREL- 3-


DISP CLKREF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Clock Reference

This task displays the actual ]CLK reference].

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CLKREF ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CLKREF- 1-


CAN CLKSRC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Clock Source

This task deletes the ’CLK src.’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN CLKSRC : Priority= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Priority

This parameter is the number of an existing ]CLK src.].


Allowed values are a range of 1...10 of decimal numbers.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CLKSRC- 1-


CR CLKSRC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create Clock Source

This task creates a ]CLK src.]. It can be ]Line timed] with input parameters
of ]LIC] and ]LIC port] or ’External timed’ timed with input parameters
’ACCG’ and ’ACCG port’.
Prerequisites:
- If it is ’Line timed’ then a ’LIC’ with a ’LIC port’
must exist and the ’AMX’ connected directly to the ’LIC’ must
have a ’Line sync. connection’.
- If there is ’Protection type’ then the redundant ’LIC’ must also have
a ’Line sync. connection’.
- If it is ’External timed’ the ’ACCG’ must exist.
- At most 2 ’Line timed’ and 2 ’External timed’
’CLK src.s’ can be created.
- The ’Quality’ of a ’CLK src.’ must not be set to a value less than the
minimum required clock ’Quality’.
The value 1 is the highest ’Quality’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR CLKSRC : Priority= ,Quality= [,LIC=] [,LIC port=] [,ACCG=] 1
1 1
1 [,ACCG port=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Priority

This parameter specifies the ’Priority’ of the ]CLK src.’.


Allowed values are a range of 1...10 of decimal numbers.

Quality

This parameter describes the ’Quality’ of the ]CLK src.].


Allowed values are a range of 1...4 of decimal numbers.

LIC

This parameter is the number of an existing ’LIC’ if the ’CLK src.’


is ’Line timed’.
Allowed values are a range of 1...32767 of decimal numbers.

LIC port

This parameter is the number of an existing ]LIC port] of the ]LIC] if


the ’CLK src.’ is ’Line timed’.
Allowed values are a range of 1...8 of decimal numbers.

ACCG

This parameter is the number of an existing ’ACCG’, if the ’CLK src.’ is


’External timed’.
Allowed values are a range of 1...64 of decimal numbers.

ACCG port

This parameter is the number of an existing ’ACCG port’ of the ’ACCG’, if


the ’CLK src.’ is ’External timed’.
Allowed values are 0, 1 of decimal numbers.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CLKSRC- 1-
DISP CLKSRC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Clock Source

This task displays one or all ]CLK src.s].


If no value is specified, all ]CLK src.s] are displayed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CLKSRC : [Priority=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Priority

This parameter is the number of an existing ]CLK src.].


Allowed values are a range of 1...10 of decimal numbers.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CLKSRC- 1-


SKIP CMD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SKIP COMMAND

This command skips a command sequence which is dependent on the


control switches. They are set with ON or OFF .
The command labeled with LABEL = <NAME> is processed next.
This command is only legal in a command file, and cannot be entered
from the terminal.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 SKIP CMD : LABEL= [,ON=] [,OFF=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LABEL LABEL OF TARGET COMMAND

This parameter identifies the label of the target command.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ON SWITCH ON

This parameter lists the control switches which must be set to


ON for the command to be executed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...32, range of decimal numbers

OFF SWITCH OFF

This parameter lists the control switches which must be set to


OFF for the command to be executed.

Notes:
- OFF overrides ON.
- 32 is the error switch.
- Command SET CFOPT sets the switches (1...16) for use in the
command file.
- Only forward skips are legal.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...32, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SKIP CMD- 1-


EXEC CMDFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

EXECUTE COMMAND FILE

This command starts the execution of a command file. The file can
execute on a specified date and/or time, but will execute immediately
if no future time or date is specified. Command files can also be
scheduled to execute periodically.
Timer jobs with an insecure start time are accepted, but not started,
either at the specified start time or retrospectively.
At 23.50 the time administration sets the weekday and the weekday
category.
Timer jobs which are started at 23.50 and 23.55 are only executed at
the desired time if the operator takes the characteristics of the time
administration into consideration when he enters a timer job (e.g.
non-recurring timer jobs must be predated).
Commands may also exist in the command file through which a nested call
of command files is possible. The nesting depth for command files is
three. After the internal command file finishes processing, the
processing of the external file is continued.
Notes:
- In the case of tape / optical disk files, only one file can be open
at a time, i.e., tape / optical disk files may not be nested in one
another, and during a COFIP run, one tape / optical disk file can be
accessed from a disk file and must be processed and closed before a
second tape / optical disk file may be opened. Tape / optical disk
files must have ASCII text format with variable record size.
- It is possible to read MML commands from the O&M terminal. The input
of an asterisk (’*’) for the file name causes the display of a
number sign (’#’) on the O&M terminal, which marks the input
request of an MML command. This feature allows the execution of a
command file which is situated on a PC if the PC is capable of
reading MML commands from a PC file. Nested files are not allowed in
this case.
It is possible to store 120 timer jobs but only 10 timer jobs can be
started at the same time. Timer jobs are illegal in command files.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command starts a semipermanent job. It can be canceled with CAN JOB.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 EXEC CMDFILE : FILE= [,STEP=] [,VSN=] [,CHOL=] [,TIME= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,PER= [,WDCAT=]]] [,DATE=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the command file name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

STEP STEP COMMAND

This parameter specifies that, after errors have occurred in the


execution of a command, a branch is made to the next STEP command
or if this next STEP command does not exist, a branch is made to
the end of the file.
If the parameter is omitted, the STEP command will be ignored.

N NO
NO NO

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 EXEC CMDFILE- 1+


EXEC CMDFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Y YES
YES YES

VSN VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the volume serial number of a


tape / optical disk or disk. It is mandatory for tape /
optical disk files.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CHOL CHECK ONLY

This parameter checks MML commands for syntax errors.


The only command which is executed is EXEC CMDFILE.
It is rejected if the commands are located in nested command
files. For nested command files only the parameter value of the
outermost file is valid.

N NO
NO NO
Y YES
YES YES

TIME TIME

This parameter specifies when the command file is to be executed.


Immediate start is the default. This parameter is illegal in
nested command files.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

Corresponds to <Hour>

b: MINUTE=
0,5,10...55, range of decimal numbers

Corresponds to <Minutes>

PER PERIODICAL WEEKDAY

This parameter indicates a periodic timer job. Workdays, international


half holidays, international full holidays, national holidays, half
weekend, full weekend, all the days of the week, or a non-periodic
job can be identified. This parameter is illegal in nested command
files.

Notes:
- Weekdays MO, TU, ... SU: execution on the respective
weekday (irrespective of the entered category, i.e. SU
means: execution on every Sunday)
- The combination of several weekdays with & corresponds to a
logical OR, i.e. execution on all the days entered
- Categories WO, EH, EF, HO, HH, HN: execution
in the respective category
- The combination of several categories with & corresponds to
a logical OR, i.e. execution in all categories specified
- The combination of category and weekday, in PER is not
possible. However it is possible to enter a weekday in
PER and a category in WDCAT. This corresponds to a
logical AND, i.e. both parameters must be entered

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 EXEC CMDFILE- 2+


EXEC CMDFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NO NOT A PERIODIC JOB


MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAYS
HH HOLIDAY HALF (INTERNATIONAL)
HO HOLIDAY FULL (INTERNATIONAL)
HN HOLIDAY NATIONAL
EH HALF WEEKEND DAY
EF FULL WEEKEND DAY
YES EVERY DAY OF THE WEEK

WDCAT WEEKDAY CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the weekday category, which must be


valid at job execution time. This parameter is illegal in nested
command files.
Compatibilities:
- WDCAT is only allowed if parameter PER is not NO.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

WO WORKDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF (INTERNATIONAL)
HO HOLIDAY FULL (INTERNATIONAL)
HN HOLIDAY NATIONAL
EH HALF WEEKEND DAY
EF FULL WEEKEND DAY

DATE DATE

This parameter specifies the date when command processing is to


start. The current date is the default. This parameter is illegal
in nested command files.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

Corresponds to <Year>

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

Corresponds to <Month>

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

Corresponds to <Day>

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 EXEC CMDFILE- 3-


CONF CMY

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE COMMON MEMORY

This command configures a common memory.

Notes:
- The configuration from ACT to MBL and the configuration from
MBL or UNA to ACT is considered dangerous.
A dialog mask is output. The operating personnel must decide by
entering ’+’ or ’-’ whether the command should be executed.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF CMY : [CMY=] ,OST= [,DIAG=] [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CMY COMMON MEMORY

This parameter specifies the common memory to be configured.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

OST OPERATING STATE

This parameter specifies the target operating state.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED

DIAG DIAGNOSIS

This parameter allows diagnosis before configuration to ACT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N CONFIGURE WITHOUT DIAGNOSIS


NO CONFIGURE WITHOUT DIAGNOSIS
Y CONFIGURE WITH DIAGNOSIS
YES CONFIGURE WITH DIAGNOSIS

Default: YES

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF CMY- 1-


DIAG CMY

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSE COMMON MEMORY

This command initiates a diagnosis for a common memory. The diagnosis


includes a BCMY interface test. Repeated diagnosis is not possible.

Prerequisites:
- The common memory must be MBL.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG CMY : [CMY=] [,SUP=] [,ONEBIT=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CMY COMMON MEMORY

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

ONEBIT ONE BIT FAILURE TREATMENT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO ONE BIT FAILURE TREATMENT


NO NO ONE BIT FAILURE TREATMENT
Y ONE BIT FAILURE TREATMENT
YES ONE BIT FAILURE TREATMENT

Default: NO

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG CMY- 1-


TEST CMY

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TEST COMMON MEMORY

This command tests a common memory.

Prerequisites:
- Both CMYs must be ACT.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 TEST CMY : [CMY=] [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CMY COMMON MEMORY

This parameter specifies the common memory to be tested.

Notes:
- If the optional unit parameter is omitted, both CMYs are tested.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST CMY- 1-


LOAD CMYFW

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

LOAD CMY FIRMWARE

This command loads the firmware for the common memory.


The firmware is loaded from file FW.CMYE to the
APS-part image of the firmware which is linked in the
APS. This APS part is used to update the FEPROM of the common
memory.

Notes:
- The flash update of the FEPROM is executed when the CMY is
configured to active.
- The firmware versions of APS part and base part can be
displayed with the DISP SSP command.
- The command is only executed on the CP113E.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 LOAD CMYFW : FWVAR= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FWVAR FIRMWARE VARIANT

This parameter specifies the firmware variant to be loaded.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...99, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 LOAD CMYFW- 1-


DMP CNIMDMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DUMP CCNC MEMORY IMMEDIATE DUMP

This command supplies a consistent display of memory contents of CCNC


platforms or of the corresponding load library on system disk.

If UNIT = DISK is entered, the specified address range to be


dumped will be read from load library.
To dump contents of a platform’s memory, select the appropriate
platform using parameter PLF.

You can specify up to five different address ranges to be dumped.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1PLF= 1 1
1 DMP CNIMDMP : ZUNIT=Y ,ADDR= [,LENGTH=] [,FORMAT=] ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the CCNC platform.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
CPI CP INTERFACE OF CCNC
SIMP SIGNALING MANAGEMENT PROCESSOR
SIPA SIGNALING PERIPHERY ADAPTER
SILTC SIGNALING LINK TERMINAL CTRL
SILT SIGNALING LINK TERMINAL

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: PROCESSOR NUMBER=
0...255, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the processor number.

UNIT SYSTEM UNIT

This parameter specifies the system unit.


If disk is selected a linear dump of the content of the CCNC loadlib
at the specified address range will be performed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DISK REQUEST READ FROM DISK

ADDR LIST OF ADDRESS RANGES

This parameter defines the address (range) of the memory


content to be dumped.
For dumping a linear memory content, 2 ways of specifying
the address limits of the dump can be used:
either an address range is entered with ADDR,
or, if only the start address is given, you have to specify
the length of the dump using parameter LENGTH.

Following inputs are possible:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP CNIMDMP- 1+


DMP CNIMDMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- Address is specified relative to a module begin, i.e load


module name (can be repeated or not) and module name are
entered (8 characters each), plus a distance within the
module

e.g.: ADDR="LOADNAME.LOADNAME.MODULE0C_0006" or
ADDR="LOADNAME.LOADNAME.MODULE0C_0006+H’23F"

or rather:

ADDR="LOADNAME.MODULE0C_0006" or
ADDR="LOADNAME.MODULE0C_0006+H’23F"

Offsets are hexadecimal numbers preceded by the letter "H" and a


single quote.
The module version number (underline and 4 digits) may be
omitted.

- A symbolic address can be specified by using a symbol name (i.e.


the name of a granted object, length 8 characters):
e.g.: ADDR="LOADNAME.MODULE0C_0006.SYMBOLA0+H’12A4"

- Address ranges must be specified by entering the start address


and the upper limit, separated by "&&".
e.g.: ADDR="LOADNAME.MODULE0C.SYMBOLA0"&&
"MODULE0C.SYMBOLA0+H’F4"

The load module name has to be entered with the start address only
and must be omitted with the upper limit of the address range.

The upper limit of an address range may be specified in


relation to the lower limit in the following way:
e.g.: ADDR="LOADNAME.MODULE0C+H’AF"&&"+H’21"
shorthand for
ADDR="LOADNAME.MODULE0C+H’AF"&&
"MODULE0C+H’CF"
The second address is interpreted as number of bytes to be dumped if
it begins with the character plus ("+").

- Symbolic addresses can be specified by using labels. A label is


preceded by the letter "L" and a single quote:
e.g.: ADDR="LOADNAME.L’LABELBEG+H’476EBF"

- Symbolic address by using the value of an exported symbol (8


characters) as an additional offset:

e.g.: ADDR="LOADNAME.MODULE1C_2401.SYMBOLA0
+MODULE2P_0101.CONST000" or
ADDR="LOADNAME.MODULE1C
+MODULE2P.CONST000+H’0FF4"

If both module names are identical, the second one may be


omitted.
e.g.: ADDR="LOADNAME.MODULE1C_2401.SYMBOLA0+.CONST000"
instead of
ADDR="LOADNAME.MODULE1C_2401.SYMBOL
+MODULE1C_2401.CONST000".

- Absolute address within a load module in hexadecimal form:


e.g.: ADDR="LOADNAME+H’2A476EBF"&&"+H’28"

Up to 5 different address ranges may be entered, concatenated by "&".

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

LENGTH LENGTH OF DUMP ELEMENT

This parameter provides the length of a single chained


element of a linked list, or, in case of a linear dump,
the number of bytes which shall be dumped if only a start

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP CNIMDMP- 2+


DMP CNIMDMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

address is entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

FORMAT FORMAT OF OUTPUT

This parameter specifies the format type of the output.


If HEX is chosen an output in hexadecimal form will be
produced, in case of ASCII the output will contain ASCII
characters additionally to the hex output.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

HEX HEXADECIMAL OUTPUT


SYMBOL SYMBOLIC OUTPUT
ASCII ASCII OUTPUT

Default: ASCII

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP CNIMDMP- 3-


ACT CNPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE CCNC PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can activate one or more Permanent


Patches in the memory of those platforms indicated under parameter
PLF. Successful execution of the command results in execution
of the atomic action AM (Activate in Memory) in
parallel on all respective platforms in operation.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT CNPRPCH : ID= [,PLF=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
load module name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="loadname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

PLF LIST OF PLATFORMS

This parameter specifies the CCNC platform where a Permanent


Patch is to be processed.
If the parameter is omitted the command concerns all
platforms in operation.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
CPI CP INTERFACE OF CCNC
SIMP SIGNALING MANAGEMENT PROCESSOR

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: PROCESSOR NUMBER=
0...255, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the processor number.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CNPRPCH- 1-


CAN CNPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CCNC PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can cancel one or more Permanent


Patches on disk implicitly deactivating them in the memory on all
platforms in operation. Successful execution of the command
results in execution of the atomic actions DUD
(Deupdate on Disk), DAM (Deactivate in Memory) and CD (Cancel
on Disk).

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN CNPRPCH : ID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
load module name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="loadname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CNPRPCH- 1-


DACT CNPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE CCNC PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can deactivate one or more Permanent


Patches in the memory of those platforms indicated under parameter
PLF. Successful execution of the command results in execution
of the atomic actions DUD (Deupdate on Disk) and
DAM (Deactivate in Memory) in parallel on all respective
platforms in operation.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT CNPRPCH : ID= [,PLF=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
load module name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="loadname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

PLF LIST OF PLATFORMS

This parameter specifies the CCNC platform where a Permanent


Patch is to be processed.
If the parameter is omitted the command concerns all
platforms in operation.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
CPI CP INTERFACE OF CCNC
SIMP SIGNALING MANAGEMENT PROCESSOR

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: PROCESSOR NUMBER=
0...255, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the processor number.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT CNPRPCH- 1-


DISP CNPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CCNC PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can display patch data kept in the
patch administration on disk and patch states concerning
Permanent Patches for all platform(s) in operation specified
by parameter PLF.
The patch selection can be performed either by patch identifier(s)
using parameter ID or by logical address ranges affected by
the patches, using parameter ADDR.
In case of using parameter ADDR, the filling levels of the
Patch Area and the Patch Administration are displayed
additionally.
If ID = X is entered, parameter LIB is also required.
To limit the list of patch IDs, it is possible to specify
combinations of following parameters:
BEGDATE, BEGTIME, ENDDATE, ENDTIME and PATSTATE

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1ID= 1 1
1 DISP CNPRPCH : ZADDR=Y [,PLF=] [,LIB=] [,BEGDATE=] 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 [,BEGTIME=] [,ENDDATE=] [,ENDTIME=] [,PATSTATE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
load module name and a patch name.
It is also possible to use wildcard signs (*) or (?) as part
of the patchname. In this case all patches found within the
specified load module and fulfilling the wildcard criteria will
be displayed.

e.g.: ID="loadname.patchname" or
ID="loadname.*" or
ID="loadname.A?CD*EF"

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

10...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

ADDR LIST OF ADDRESS RANGES

This parameter represents an interval in which the search


for patches will be performed. An address can be specified
either in hexadecimal form as an offset from load module
begin or symbolically.

e.g.: ADDR="loadname.address"&&"address" or
ADDR="loadname.address"&&"+distance"

where address may have one of the following


structures:

"loadname.modname+offset+distance", or
"loadname.modname.symbol+offset+distance", or

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CNPRPCH- 1+


DISP CNPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

"label+offset+distance", or
"offset+distance", where

loadname <text string> = 8 char.,


label L’<text string> = 8 char.,
modname <text string> = 8 char. (or 13 if the
version is included),
symbol <text string> <= 8 char.,
offset <hexadecimal string> <= 8 hex signs,
distance disitem+disitem ..+disitem..,
disitem loadname.modname.symbol or offset

The end address of an interval may be omitted. If it is


omitted in the case of load module or module the entire address
range of the unit is scanned. If it is omitted in the case of
symbol or offset the search range is that byte only.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

PLF LIST OF PLATFORMS

This parameter specifies the CCNC platform where a Permanent


Patch is to be processed.
If the parameter is omitted the command concerns all
platforms in operation.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
CPI CP INTERFACE OF CCNC
SIMP SIGNALING MANAGEMENT PROCESSOR

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: PROCESSOR NUMBER=
0...255, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the processor number.

LIB LIBRARY NAME

This parameter represents the name of the library associated


with the platform to be patched.
If the parameter is omitted, the library specified via
parameter ID is taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

BEGDATE BEGIN DATE

This parameter specifies the begin date of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGTIME,
ENDDATE and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter BEGDATE: 2000:01:01

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CNPRPCH- 2+


DISP CNPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

BEGTIME BEGIN TIME

This parameter specifies the begin time of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
ENDDATE and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter BEGTIME: 00:00:00

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECOND=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

ENDDATE END DATE

This parameter specifies the end date of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
BEGTIME and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter ENDDATE: actual date

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

ENDTIME END TIME

This parameter specifies the end time of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
BEGTIME and ENDDATE.
Default value of parameter ENDTIME: 23:59:59

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CNPRPCH- 3+


DISP CNPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

c: SECOND=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

PATSTATE PATCH STATE

This parameter is used to limit the list of patch IDs


displayed to those patches having the entered PATSTATE.
If this parameter is omitted, every patch will be displayed
regardless of its state in the system.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NOTENTER NEITHER ENTERING NOR ENTERED


HIT HIT
ENTRG ENTERING
ENTRD ENTERED
NOTUPD OTHER THAN UPDATED
PARTACT PARTLY ACTIVE
ACT ACTIVE
UPD UPDATED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CNPRPCH- 4-


ENTR CNPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CCNC PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can enter a Permanent Patch into the
patch administration on disk. Successful execution of the
command results in execution of the atomic action ED (Enter on
Disk).
With each ENTR CNPRPCH command one of the four different
subpatch types can be entered:

- Insert Rucksack Subpatches using parameter INSRADDR


- Replace Subpatches using parameter REPADDR
- Insert Procedure Subpatches using parameter INSPREF
- Insert Variable Subpatches using parameter INSVREF

The subpatch types can be entered in the form of subpatches


belonging to a specified Patch ID. Under one specified Patch ID
subpatches of different types can be inserted into the
system.
For each subpatch of a patch a new ENTR CNPRPCH command is
necessary.
The completeness of the subpatches is indicated by means of
parameter SUBPCHNO.
All Subpatches with the exception of Insert Variable can be
entered in subpatch parts for each part using an individual
ENTR CNPRPCH command. All subpatch parts except Insert
Procedure Subpatches are referred to the same patch address.
The concatenation of those subpatch parts is supported by
means of parameter SUBPPART.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,INSRADDR=1 1
1 1,REPADDR= 1 1
1 ENTR CNPRPCH : ID= Z,INSPREF= Y [,SUBPPART=] [,NEWCNT= 1
1 1,INSVREF= 1 1
1 1,SUBPCHNO=1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 [,OLDCNT=]] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID PATCH IDENTIFIER

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
load module name and a patch name. Whenever a subpatch or
subpatch part is entered for a certain patch the identifier
must be identical.

e.g.: ID="loadname.patchname"

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

INSRADDR INSERT RUCKSACK SUBPATCH ADDR.

This parameter provides the insert rucksack subpatch


address. The address format is an interval within the
module boundaries in the form of begin address and end
address (linked by &&) whereby the latter may be given as a
distance relative to the begin address. At the begin address
the instruction is replaced by a branch instruction for jumping
to the respective rucksack. The end address serves as
continuation address from which the program will continue
after the rucksack code has been executed.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CNPRPCH- 1+


ENTR CNPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The old instruction (6 Byte), overwritten by the branch


instruction, is at user’s own risk to add to the rucksack
or not.
An address can be specified either in hexadecimal form as an
offset from load module begin or symbolically.

e.g.: INSRADDR="loadname.modname.symbol+distance" or
INSRADDR="offset+distance" or
INSRADDR="label+distance",

&&"loadname.modname.symbol+distance" or
&&"label+distance" or
&&"+offset" ,where

label L’<text string> = 8 char.,


loadname <text string> = 8 char.,
modname <text string> = 8 char. (or 13 if the
version is included),
symbol <text string> <= 8 char.,
offset H’<hexadecimal string> <= 8 hex signs,
distance disitem+disitem ..+disitem..,
disitem loadname.modname.symbol or offset

The given address is valid for the load module denoted within
parameter ID.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

REPADDR REPLACE SUBPATCH ADDRESS

This parameter provides the replace subpatch address. The


address format is a replacement address, where address can
be specified in the same way as described for the first part
of INSRADDR.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

INSPREF INSERT PROCED. SUBPATCH REFER.

This parameter provides the insert procedure subpatch


reference as a mnemonic including the number <n> of the
insert procedure.
The inserted procedure is only visible within the defining
patch. The number <n> serves to address the inserted
procedure within other subpatches of the defining patch.

e.g.: INSPREF="IP’5"

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...6 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

INSVREF INSERT VARIAB. SUBPATCH REFER.

This parameter provides the insert variable subpatch


reference as a mnemonic including the number <n> of the
insert variable and the length of the variable in bytes.
The inserted variable is only visible within the defining
patch.

e.g.: INSVREF="IV’5"-50

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: "INSERT VARIABLE" SUBPATCH REFERENCE=


4...6 characters from the
text string character set, enclosed in "

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CNPRPCH- 2+


ENTR CNPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This unit serves to address the inserted variable


within other subpatches of the defining patch.

b: LENGTH OF INSERT VARIABLE IN BYTES=


1...4096, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the length of the variable to be


declared.

SUBPCHNO TOTAL NUMBER OF SUBPATCHES

This parameter represents the total number of subpatches


belonging to a Patch ID. A patch must be closed by a final
ENTR CNPRPCH command with the parameters ID and
SUBPCHNO, whereby the latter one corresponds to the number
of patches, entered under the same ID.
This command causes the transition of the patch state from
ENTRG to ENTRD.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...20, range of decimal numbers

SUBPPART ACTUAL NUMBER OF SUBPATCH PART

This parameter characterizes a part of a subpatch. A subpatch


of a Permanent Patch may, for some reason, have more than one
part in the case of Insert Rucksack Subpatch, Permanent
Replace Subpatch, or Insert Procedure Subpatch.

e.g.: SUBPPART="partcounter-lastsign"

The partcounter denotes the subpatch part sequence number


and serves as concatenation controller.
The lastsign denotes either the last or not last part of a
subpatch.

If SUBPPART is omitted, e.g., typical proceeding in case


of a short subpatch consisting of only one part, the default
value 1-LAST is assumed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: ACTUAL NUMBER OF SUBPATCH PART TO BE ENTERED=


1...999, range of decimal numbers

This unit denotes the subpatch part sequence number.

b: INDICATOR THAT LAST PART OF SUBPATCH IS ENTERED


NOTLAST NOT LAST SUBPATCH PART
LAST LAST SUBPATCH PART

This unit denotes either last or not last part.

NEWCNT NEW CONTENT OF SUBPATCH

This parameter represents the new instruction code to be


executed instead of the old instruction code which may be
represented by parameter OLDCNT.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

OLDCNT OLD CONTENT AT SUBPATCH LOCAT.

This parameter represents the old instruction code to be


checked for security reasons.
Must not be used for Insert Variable or Insert Procedure
subpatches.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CNPRPCH- 3+


ENTR CNPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CNPRPCH- 4-


UPD CNPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

UPDATE CCNC PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can update one or more Permanent


Patches on disk, whereby they are implicitly activated in
memory on all active platforms. Successful execution of the
command results in execution of the atomic actions
AM (Activate in Memory) and UD (Update on Disk).

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 UPD CNPRPCH : ID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
load module name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="loadname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 UPD CNPRPCH- 1-


ACT CNTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE CCNC TRANSIENT PATCH

With this command you can activate one or more Transient


Patches in the memory on one platform. Successful execution of
the command results in execution of the atomic action
AM (Activate in Memory) on the respective platform in
operation.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT CNTRPCH : PLF= ,ID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the CCNC platform where a Transient


Patch is to be processed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
CPI CP INTERFACE OF CCNC
SIMP SIGNALING MANAGEMENT PROCESSOR

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: PROCESSOR NUMBER=
0...255, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the processor number.

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
load module name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="loadname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CNTRPCH- 1-


CAN CNTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CCNC TRANSIENT PATCH

With this command you can cancel one or more Transient


Patches in the memory on one platform by implicitly
deactivating them in the memory on this platform.
Successful execution of the command results in execution of
the atomic actions DAM (Deactivate in Memory) and CM (Cancel
in Memory) on the respective platform in operation.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN CNTRPCH : PLF= ,ID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the CCNC platform where a Transient


Patch is to be processed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
CPI CP INTERFACE OF CCNC
SIMP SIGNALING MANAGEMENT PROCESSOR

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: PROCESSOR NUMBER=
0...255, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the processor number.

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
load module name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="loadname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CNTRPCH- 1-


DACT CNTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE CCNC TRANSIENT PATCH

With this command you can deactivate one or more Transient


Patches in the memory on one platform. Successful execution of
the command results in execution of the atomic action
DAM (Deactivate in Memory) on the respective platform in
operation.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT CNTRPCH : PLF= ,ID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the CCNC platform where a Transient


Patch is to be processed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
CPI CP INTERFACE OF CCNC
SIMP SIGNALING MANAGEMENT PROCESSOR

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: PROCESSOR NUMBER=
0...255, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the processor number.

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
load module name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="loadname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT CNTRPCH- 1-


DISP CNTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CCNC TRANSIENT PATCH

With this command you can display patch data kept in the
patch administration on the individual platform and patch
states concerning Transient Patches for a specified platform in
operation.
The patch selection can be performed either by patch identifier(s)
using parameter ID or by logical address ranges affected by
the patches, using parameter ADDR.
In case of using parameter ADDR, the filling levels of the
Patch Area and the Patch Administration are displayed
additionally.
If ID = X is entered, parameter LIB is also required.
To limit the list of patch IDs, it is possible to specify
combinations of following parameters:
BEGDATE, BEGTIME, ENDDATE, ENDTIME and PATSTATE

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,ID= 1 1
1 DISP CNTRPCH : PLF= Z,ADDR=Y [,LIB=] [,BEGDATE=] [,BEGTIME=] 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 [,ENDDATE=] [,ENDTIME=] [,PATSTATE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the CCNC platform where a Transient


Patch is to be processed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
CPI CP INTERFACE OF CCNC
SIMP SIGNALING MANAGEMENT PROCESSOR

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: PROCESSOR NUMBER=
0...255, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the processor number.

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
load module name and a patch name.
It is also possible to use wildcard signs (*) or (?) as part
of the patchname. In this case all patches found within the
specified load module and fulfilling the wildcard criteria will
be displayed.

e.g.: ID="loadname.patchname" or
ID="loadname.*" or
ID="loadname.A?CD*EF"

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CNTRPCH- 1+


DISP CNTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

10...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

ADDR LIST OF ADDRESS RANGES

This parameter represents an interval in which the search


for patches will be performed. An address can be specified
either in hexadecimal form as an offset from load module
begin or symbolically.

e.g.: ADDR="loadname.address"&&"address" or
ADDR="loadname.address"&&"+distance"

where address may have one of the following


structures:

"loadname.modname+offset+distance", or
"loadname.modname.symbol+offset+distance", or
"label+offset+distance", or
"offset+distance", where

loadname <text string> = 8 char.,


label L’<text string> = 8 char.,
modname <text string> = 8 char. (or 13 if the
version is included),
symbol <text string> <= 8 char.,
offset <hexadecimal string> <= 8 hex signs,
distance disitem+disitem ..+disitem..,
disitem loadname.modname.symbol or offset

The end address of an interval may be omitted. If it is


omitted in the case of load module or module the entire address
range of the unit is scanned. If it is omitted in the case of
symbol or offset the search range is that byte only.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

LIB LIBRARY NAME

This parameter represents the name of the library associated


with the platform to be patched.
If the parameter is omitted, the library specified via
parameter ID is taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

BEGDATE BEGIN DATE

This parameter specifies the begin date of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGTIME,
ENDDATE and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter BEGDATE: 2000:01:01

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CNTRPCH- 2+


DISP CNTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

BEGTIME BEGIN TIME

This parameter specifies the begin time of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
ENDDATE and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter BEGTIME: 00:00:00

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECOND=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

ENDDATE END DATE

This parameter specifies the end date of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
BEGTIME and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter ENDDATE: actual date

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

ENDTIME END TIME

This parameter specifies the end time of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
BEGTIME and ENDDATE.
Default value of parameter ENDTIME: 23:59:59

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECOND=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CNTRPCH- 3+


DISP CNTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PATSTATE PATCH STATE

This parameter is used to limit the list of patch IDs


displayed to those patches having the entered PATSTATE.
If this parameter is omitted, every patch will be displayed
regardless of its state in the system.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ENTRG ENTERING
ENTRD ENTERED
ACT ACTIVE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CNTRPCH- 4-


ENTR CNTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CCNC TRANSIENT PATCH

With this command you can enter a Transient Patch into the
patch administration on a platform.
Successful execution of the command results in execution
of the atomic action EM (Enter into Memory) on the
respective platform in operation.
With each ENTR CNTRPCH command the subpatch type Replace
Subpatch can be entered by using parameter REPADDR.

The completeness of the subpatches is indicated by means of


parameter SUBPCHNO. For each subpatch of a patch a new
ENTR CNTRPCH command is necessary.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,REPADDR= 1 1
1 ENTR CNTRPCH : PLF= ,ID= Z,SUBPCHNO=Y [,NEWCNT= [,OLDCNT=]] ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the CCNC platform where a Transient


Patch is to be processed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
CPI CP INTERFACE OF CCNC
SIMP SIGNALING MANAGEMENT PROCESSOR

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: PROCESSOR NUMBER=
0...255, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the processor number.

ID PATCH IDENTIFIER

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
load module name and a patch name. Whenever a subpatch is
entered for a certain patch the identifier must be
identical.

e.g.: ID="loadname.patchname"

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

REPADDR REPLACE SUBPATCH ADDRESS

This parameter provides the replace subpatch address. The


address format is a replacement address.

e.g.: REPADDR="loadname.modname.symbol+distance" or
REPADDR="offset+distance" or
REPADDR="label+distance",

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CNTRPCH- 1+


ENTR CNTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

label L’<text string> = 8 char.,


loadname <text string> = 8 char.,
modname <text string> = 8 char. (or 13 if the
version is included),
symbol <text string> <= 8 char.,
offset H’<hexadecimal string> <= 8 hex signs,
distance disitem+disitem ..+disitem..,
disitem loadname.modname.symbol or offset

The given address is valid for the load module denoted within
parameter ID.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

SUBPCHNO TOTAL NUMBER OF SUBPATCHES

This parameter represents the total number of subpatches


belonging to a Patch ID. A patch must be closed by a final
ENTR CNTRPCH command with the parameters ID and
SUBPCHNO, whereby the latter one corresponds to the number
of patches, entered under the same ID.
This command causes the transition of the patch state from
ENTRG to ENTRD.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7, range of decimal numbers

NEWCNT NEW CONTENT OF SUBPATCH

This parameter represents the new instruction code to be


executed instead of the old instruction code which may be
represented by parameter OLDCNT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

OLDCNT OLD CONTENT AT SUBPATCH LOCAT.

This parameter represents the old instruction code to be


checked for security reasons.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CNTRPCH- 2-


CAN CNTRYCOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL COUNTRY CODE

This command cancels one country code from country code table.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CNTRYCOD : CC= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CC COUNTRY CODE

This parameter determines the country code to be canceled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...3 digit decimal number

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CNTRYCOD- 1-


DISP CNTRYCOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY COUNTRY CODE

This command displays:

- the country code,


- the country name,
- whether or not the country code is belonging
to this exchange.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CNTRYCOD ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CNTRYCOD- 1-


ENTR CNTRYCOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER COUNTRY CODE

This command enters the country code data.


It determines:
- the country code,
- the name of the dependend country,
- whether the entered country code is the country code
belonging to this exchange.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CNTRYCOD : CC= ,CNTRY= [,OWNCC=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CC COUNTRY CODE

This parameter determines the country code.

Notes:
- Up to 1000 country codes can be set up in an exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...3 digit decimal number

CNTRY COUNTRY

This parameter specifies the country name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OWNCC OWN COUNTRY CODE

This parameter specifies whether or not the entered country code


is the country code belonging to this exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

YES OWN COUNTRY CODE


NO NOT OWN COUNTRY CODE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CNTRYCOD- 1-


REP CODEFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Repair Code File on MP

This task repairs a ’Code’ file of the


loaded, disabled ’Generation’ on the
system disk of the MP. If the loaded
’Generation’ is corrupted due to a
defective ’Code’ file there is the
possibility to repair this ’Generation’ by
a restore of a single ’Code’ file from
a fallback ’Generation’ on the system disk
or an archive ’Generation’ on the
magneto-optical disk device (MOD).
The current corrupted ’Code’ file is
deleted and replaced by the file which is restored.
The system runs in diskless operation mode because of the
disabled loaded ’Generation’; therefore a
data snapshot into the loaded ’Generation’
is performed, which ends the diskless operation.

Notes:
- The task is possible only if the loaded
’Generation’ is defective and the
’Operational state’ attribute equals ’Disabled’.
- This is a long-running task. The NE issues following
event reports:
Data Snapshot Report,
begin-, progress- and end event reports

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REP CODEFILE : Device Name= ,Code generation= ,Code file= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Device Name

This parameter specifies the source of


the code generation, which is either
system disk or magneto-optical disk
device.
Input values: MDD, MOD0, MOD1

Code generation

This parameter specifies the name of


’Generation’ which is
the source of the
’Code’ file to be
copied.
Input format: 1...8 characters from
the character set
without space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

Code file

This parameter specifies the name of


the ’Code’ file to
be copied.
Input format: 1...30 characters from
the character set
without space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REP CODEFILE- 1+


REP CODEFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REP CODEFILE- 2-


DISP CONFL
CONFDATA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY LARGE CONFERENCE

This command displays the conference data for


large conferences.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is only permitted for a local exchange.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP CONFL - CONFDATA CONFERENCE DATA FORMAT


2. DISP CONFL - MAXDATA MAXIMAL NUMBER FORMAT

1. Input format

CONFERENCE DATA FORMAT

This input format displays the conference IDs,


and the port specific data for large conferences.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CONFL : FORMAT= ,LTG= [,COU=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FORMAT FORMAT OF OUTPUT MASK

This parameter specifies the output format.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CONFLST CONFERENCE ID LIST

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

COU CONFERENCE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the number of the conference unit.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CONFL- 1+


DISP CONFL
MAXDATA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

MAXIMAL NUMBER FORMAT

This input format is used to display all existing values


of the max. no. of conferees for a large conference,
originated by an analog/ISDN-subscriber or by an
OSS-operator.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CONFL : FORMAT= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FORMAT FORMAT OF OUTPUT MASK

This parameter specifies the output format.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

MAXNUM MAXIMAL NUMBERS

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CONFL- 2-


MOD CONFL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY LARGE CONFERENCE

This command modifies the max. no.


of conferees in a large conference.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for a local exchange.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD CONFL : <MAXSUB= ,MAXOSS= ,DEFSUB=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MAXSUB MAX. NO. OF SUB. CONFEREES

This parameter specifies the max. no. of conference


subscribers for a large conference originated by an
analog or ISDN-subscriber.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...32, range of decimal numbers

MAXOSS MAX. NO. OF OSS CONFEREES

This parameter specifies the max. no. of conference


subscribers for a large conference originated by an
OSS-operator.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...32, range of decimal numbers

DEFSUB DEFAULT NO. OF SUB. CONFEREES

This parameter specifies the default value of the max.


no. of conferees for a large conference originated by
an ISDN-subscriber, in case of no value is given for
this no. by the subscriber.

Notes :
- The value of this parameter should not exceed
the value of MAXSUB-parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...32, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CONFL- 1-


CAN CONFRNC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CONFERENCE

This command cancels the 32 conference ports belonging to a conference


unit (CONFERENCE UNIT).

Prerequisites :
- The conference unit must be in safeguarding status planned.
- None of the CONFERENCE UNIT conference circuits
is allocated to a telephone meeting group.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for a local exchange.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN CONFRNC : LTG= ,COU= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

COU CONFERENCE UNIT

This parameter specifies the number of the conference unit.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CONFRNC- 1-


CR CONFRNC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE CONFERENCE

This command creates the 32 conference ports belonging to a conference unit


(CONFERENCE UNIT) for a specified service feature application.

Prerequisites :
- The LTU must have previously been created with the appropriate type for
conference units.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for a local exchange.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR CONFRNC : LTG= ,COU= ,COUTYP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

COU CONFERENCE UNIT

This parameter specifies the number of the conference unit.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

COUTYP CONFERENCE UNIT TYPE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CONFL LARGE CONFERENCE


The application of this CONFERENCE UNIT is the
service feature large conference.
MEETME MEET ME
The service feature meet me is not
implemented in this version and is
not usable for CONFERENCE UNIT!
PHONMEET TELEPHONE MEETING
The application of this CONFERENCE UNIT is the
service feature telephone meeting.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CONFRNC- 1-
DISP CONFRNC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CONFERENCE

This command displays the application of one or all CONFERENCE UNITs


within a specified range (interval) of LTGs.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is only permitted for a local exchange.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CONFRNC : LTG= [,COU=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

COU CONFERENCE UNIT

This parameter specifies the number of the conference unit.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CONFRNC- 1-


DISP CONN
DN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CONNECTIONS

This command displays the port address, processor number, speech


channel, and, if possible, the directory number or the trunk group
number and line number of ports seized by a call in progress.
The display is a snapshot of the situation at the time of the command.
The scope of data displayed can be specified by equipment number,
directory number or trunk group.
If there are several local networks a subscriber in a specific
local network can be specified.

Notes:
- The command only displays complete data for connections which are
occupying two channel registers.
Therefore, the output mask displays either NO MORE DATA or a
series of stars (*) in the SIDE column for connections to recorded
announcements, for incomplete connections or for SULIM connections.
Recorded announcements can be displayed by the command
DISP LISTTOAN.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP CONN - DN DN FOR ANALOG OR ISDN SUBSCRIBER


2. DISP CONN - DNPBX DN FOR ANY PBX LINE
3. DISP CONN - EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER
4. DISP CONN - LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP
5. DISP CONN - TGNO TGNO FOR TRUNK GROUP OR TRUNK

1. Input format

DN FOR ANALOG OR ISDN SUBSCRIBER

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CONN : [LAC=] ,DN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of a subscriber


or PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CONN- 1+


DISP CONN
DNPBX
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

DN FOR ANY PBX LINE

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CONN : [LAC=] ,DN= ,LNO= ,OPMODE= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of a subscriber


or PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number in a PBX group or


trunk group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16383, range of decimal numbers

OPMODE OPERATION MODE

This parameter specifies a subset of PBX lines, referring to the


operation mode of these lines.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

XABW = HUNT GROUP: ANALOG BOTHWAY


1AIC 1 HUNT GROUP: ANALOG INCOMING
1AOG 1 HUNT GROUP: ANALOG OUTGOING
1IBW 1 HUNT GROUP: ISDN BOTHWAY
1IBW1TR6 1 HUNT GROUP: ISDN BOTHWAY 1TR6
1IIC 1 HUNT GROUP: ISDN INCOMING
1IIC1TR6 1 HUNT GROUP: ISDN INCOMING 1TR6
1IOG 1 HUNT GROUP: ISDN OUTGOING
1IOG1TR6 1 HUNT GROUP: ISDN OUTGOING 1TR6
>MBW W HUNT GROUP: MIXED BOTHWAY

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CONN- 2+


DISP CONN
EQN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

EQUIPMENT NUMBER

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CONN : EQN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER

This parameter defines the equipment number.

Notes:
- The following port qualifications are allowed:

LTG: EQN = a-b-c-d one specific port


EQN = a-b-X all ports of an LTG
EQN = a-b-c all ports of an LTU
EQN = a-b-X-d one specific port in each LTU

DLU: EQN = a-b-c-d one specific DLU port


EQN = a-b-X all DLU ports of a shelf
EQN = a-b-c all DLU ports of a module
EQN = a-b-X-d one specific DLU port in each module

V5IF: EQN = a-b-c-d one specific V5IF port

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c[-d]

a: TSG / DLU OR V5IF NUMBER=


0...8999, range of decimal numbers

For LTG port: a TSG number in the range 0...7


For DLU port: a DLU number in the range 10...2550
(in steps of 10)
For V5IF port: a V5IF number in the range 6000...8999

b: LTG / SHELF=
0...63, range of decimal numbers

For LTG port: an LTG number in the range 1...63


For DLU port: a shelf in the range 0...7
For V5IF port: 0

c: LTU / MODULE OR V5IF PORT NUMBER=


0...20, range of decimal numbers

For LTG port: an LTU number in the range 0...7


For DLU port: a module number in the range 0...15
For V51IF port: 0
For V52IF port: a V52IF port number in the range 0...20

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

d: CHANNEL / CIRCUIT OR V5IF PORT NUMBER=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

For LTG port: a channel number in the range 0...31


For DLU port: a circuit number in the range 0...7 for DLU8
0...15 for DLU16
0...31 for DLUG
For V51IF port: a V51IF port number in the range 0...31
For V52IF port: a V52IF port number in the range 0...99

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CONN- 3+


DISP CONN
LTG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

LINE TRUNK GROUP

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CONN : LTG= [,LC=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNG GROUP

This parameter specifies the line trunk group of the set of objects to
be traced.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

LTGSET : 0..31

Dependent on the Switching Network Hardware this unit


represents the Time Stage Group (TSG for SNB) or the
Switching Network MULTIPLEXER (SNMUX for SND
and upper ones)

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


0...63, range of decimal numbers

LTG : 1..63

LC LINE CONNECTION

This parameter specifies the line connection of a LTG.

Notes:
- The input of this parameter is only valid in combination
with the LTG parameter.

- The following input is allowed:

LC = X
LC = a
LC = a-b

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: LTU NO.OF A LTG=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

LTU : 0..7

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: CHANNEL OF A LTG PORT=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

Channel : 0..31

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CONN- 4+


DISP CONN
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

TGNO FOR TRUNK GROUP OR TRUNK

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,LNO=11 1
1 DISP CONN : TGNO= 1Z,CIC=Y1 ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number in a PBX group or


trunk group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16383, range of decimal numbers

CIC CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE

This parameter specifies the circuit identification code of CCS7 lines.

Prerequisites:
- Input of a trunk group specified by the parameter TGNO

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: PCM LINK NUMBER=


0...681, range of decimal numbers

For DIU 30 the input 0...511 is possible.


For DIU 24 the input 0...681 is possible.

b: CHANNEL NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

For DIU 30 the input 0...31 is possible.


For DIU 24 the input 0...23 is possible.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CONN- 5-


REL CONN
DNPATH1
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RELEASE CONNECTION

This command sends an appropriate message to the CP call


processing programs for connections to ordinary subscribers and
to the relevant LTGs for connections to ISDN PA.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. REL CONN - DNPATH1 RELEASE BY DIRECTORY NUMBER


2. REL CONN - DNPATH2 RELEASE BY DIRECTORY NUMBER
3. REL CONN - EQNPATH RELEASE BY EQUIPMENT NUMBER
4. REL CONN - LTGPATH RELEASE BY LINE TRUNK GROUP
5. REL CONN - TGNOPA RELEASE BY TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

1. Input format

RELEASE BY DIRECTORY NUMBER

This input format should be used if there is only


one OPMODE for each LNO.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REL CONN : DN= [,LAC=] [,LNO=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of a subscriber, an


analog or ISDN PBX line (pilot DN or line service number) or test
phone control.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter must be specified if several local area codes


have been created within an exchange. If there is only one
local area code for each exchange, this parameter need not
be specified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number of a trunk in a trunk group


or a line of an analog or ISDN PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16383, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REL CONN- 1+


REL CONN
DNPATH2
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

RELEASE BY DIRECTORY NUMBER

This input format should be used if there are


several OPMODE for each LNO.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REL CONN : DN= [,LAC=] [,LNO=] [,OPMODE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of a subscriber, an


analog or ISDN PBX line (pilot DN or line service number) or test
phone control.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter must be specified if several local area codes


have been created within an exchange. If there is only one
local area code for each exchange, this parameter need not
be specified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number of a trunk in a trunk group


or a line of an analog or ISDN PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16383, range of decimal numbers

OPMODE OPERATION MODE

The operating mode must be specified if the PBX is created with two or
more operating modes.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ABW ANALOG BOTHWAY


AIC ANALOG INCOMING
AOG ANALOG OUTGOING
DEF DEFAULT VALUE (NOT INPUT)
IBW ISDN BOTHWAY EDSS1 PROTOCOL
IBW1TR6 ISDN BOTHWAY 1TR6 PROTOCOL
IIC ISDN INCOMING EDSS1 PROTOCOL
IIC1TR6 ISDN INCOMING 1TR6 PROTOCOL
IOG ISDN OUTGOING EDSS1 PROTOCOL
IOG1TR6 ISDN OUTGOING 1TR6 PROTOCOL

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REL CONN- 2+


REL CONN
EQNPATH
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

RELEASE BY EQUIPMENT NUMBER

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REL CONN : EQN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the equipment number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: TIME STAGE GROUP / DIGITAL LINE UNIT/V5 INTERFACE=


0...9999, range of decimal numbers

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP / SHELF NUMBER=


0...63, range of decimal numbers

c: LINE TRUNK UNIT / MODULE NUMBE=


0...96, range of decimal numbers

d: CHANNEL NUMBER / CIRCUIT NUMBER/V5IF PORT NUMBER=


0...96, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REL CONN- 3+


REL CONN
LTGPATH
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

RELEASE BY LINE TRUNK GROUP

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REL CONN : LTG= ,LC= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

When LTG and LC are entered, a check is made as


to whether the corresponding connection has been set up
and the specified connection group is type A. Tasks
executed by the call processing programs cannot be
monitored.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: TIME STAGE GROUP=


0...127, range of decimal numbers

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP=


1...63, range of decimal numbers

LC LINE CHANNEL

The line circuit number must be entered in connection with the


LTG number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LTU NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

b: CHANNEL=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REL CONN- 4+


REL CONN
TGNOPA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

RELEASE BY TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,CIC=1 1
1 REL CONN : TGNO= Z,LNO=Y ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number of a trunk group or a


recorded announcement group. It must be input in connection with LNO
or CIC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CIC CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE

This parameter specifies the circuit identification code for CCS7


trunks.
CIC can only be input in conjunction with TGNO.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE=


0...681, range of decimal numbers

b: CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION CODE=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number of a trunk in a trunk group


or a line of an analog or ISDN PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16383, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REL CONN- 5-


ACT CONNTRAC
IM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE CONNECTION TRACE

This command activates the connection trace facility of call processing.

The tracer will stay active until

.It is deactivated by DACT CONNTRAC


.The tracebuffer on CP is completely filled and MODE=SEQU was
entered
.If the parameter TDUR was entered and the trace duration timer
has expired
.If the parameter EEVENT was entered and one of the trigger
event has occured
.If a recovery with a level greater than the level of the parameter
RECLEV occures.

The tracebuffer is ODAGEN expandable with command MOD DBSIZE.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is a test command only permitted for use by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel for NM-test purposes.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ACT CONNTRAC - IM IMMEDIATELY


2. ACT CONNTRAC - SDEL START DELAY
3. ACT CONNTRAC - SEVENT START EVENT

1. Input format

IMMEDIATELY

Input format for activating connection trace facility immediately.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,TDUR= 11 1
1 ACT CONNTRAC : PARSET= [,MODE=] 1Z,EEVENT=Y1 [,RECLEV=] 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
1 [,GPSEND=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PARSET TRACE PARAMETER SET

This parameter specifies the trace parameter sets to be


activated . CONNTRAC is activated on all processors
(CP and GPs) defined in the entered parameter sets.

Notes:
- It is not allowed to activate together parameter sets
containing the definition of the same processors. In such
a case only the first activation of each processor will be
performed and an error message will be displayed, which
shows the parsets, which are not activated (OBJECT ALREADY
ACTIVE).

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10, range of decimal numbers

MODE BUFFER WRITE MODUS

This parameter describes the way of writing the trace data

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CONNTRAC- 1+


ACT CONNTRAC
IM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

into the CONNTRAC trace buffer on the CP.

Incompatibilities:
- SEQU and CYCLIC are not allowed simultaneously.
- NEW and CONTINUE are not allowed simultaneously.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CONTINUE CONTINUE
CYCLIC CYCLIC
NEW NEW
SEQU SEQUENTIAL

Default: CYCLIC, NEW

TDUR TRACE DURATION

This parameter specifies the trace duration in mm-ss-ms after


entering the MML command ACT CONNTRAC. This can be:
.If a start delay is entered, tracing is started after the
start delay has expired.
.If start events are entered, tracing is started after the
one of the start events has occured.
.If no start delay and no start trigger event are entered,
tracing is started immediately after activation of the
tracer per MML.

After expiration of the trace duration, tracing is stopped.

Restrictions:
- This parameter has to be omitted if an END TRIGGER EVENT is
specified.
- For this parameter a value of at least 50 ms has to
be specified.

Notes:
- If this parameter is omitted, the tracer is tracing until
an end trigger condition occured or the user stops the trace
due to a MML command.
- If this parameter is entered it might be necessary in some
special cases to terminate the tracer by DACT CONNTRAC.
For example this has to be done if a LTG has been specified,
which is not active or for which the tracer does not support
the loadtype.

Default: No trace duration, tracer runs until deactivation


by the user.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: TIME IN MINUTES=
0...1439, range of decimal numbers

b: TIME IN SECONDS=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: TIME IN MILLISECONDS=
0...999, range of decimal numbers

EEVENT END TRIGGER EVENT

This parameter specifies the events, which are able to stop


the trace on all processors which are mentioned in the PARSETs.

Restrictions:
- A maximum of 6 LTG’s can be deactivated simultaneously by
a trigger event.
- This parameter has to be omitted if a TRACE DURATION is specified.

Notes:
- Up to 4 trigger events can be entered.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CONNTRAC- 2+


ACT CONNTRAC
IM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c]]

a: EVENT TYPE
AUDIT AUDIT TRIGGER EVENT
CMD CP/GP COMMAND
COLEV GP COLLECTIVE EVENT
COMEV GP COMMON EVENT
COMUEV GP COMMUNICATION EVENT
CPMSG CP MESSAGE
CPTIMEV CP TIMER EVENT
DLU GP DLU EVENT
GPMSG GP MESSAGE
GPTIMEV GP TIMER EVENT
GSEV GP GROUP SWITCH EVENT
PEREV GP PERIPHERAL EVENT
PRIVATE PRIVATE TRIGGER EVENT
RCF REASON FOR CALL FAILURE
RCT REASON FOR CALL TERMINATION
REP GP REPORT
SWSG SWSG TRIGGER EVENT

b: EVENT DESCRIPTION PART ONE=


1...8 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This unit has various meanings, dependent on EEVENT

EEVENT: MEANING:

GPMSG JC1 ... JOBCODE 1


CMD JC1 ... JOBCODE 1
REP JC1 ... JOBCODE 1
CPMSG SRC ... SOURCE
PEREV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
GPTIMEV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
COMEV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
COLEV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
GSEV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
DLU OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
COMUEV EV_GRP ... EVENT GROUP
SWSG MODULE NAME
RCT RCT NUMBER
RCF RCF NUMBER
AUDIT AUDIT NAME

Compatibilities:
- Module/Audit name = ’XXXXXXXX’
matches to all modules/audits.
- SOURCE IOCP, TIMER, USER, IOMES
- JC1 is a HEX value
- OT_ID is a HEX value
- EV_GRP is a HEX value
- RCT and RCF is the INT value of the defining set value.
There must not be an input for c.
- AUDIT NAME is the identifier from the defining set
without the prefix ’AUD_’.

c: EVENT DESCRIPTION PART TWO=


1...3 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This unit has various meanings, dependent on EEVENT

EEVENT: MEANING:

GPMSG JC2 ... JOBCODE 2


CMD JC2 ... JOBCODE 2
REP JC2 ... JOBCODE 2
CPMSG JC2 ... JOBCODE 2
PEREV OT_EV ... OPERATION TABLE EVENT
GPTIMEV OT_EV ... OPERATION TABLE EVENT
COMEV EV_NO ... EVENT NUMBER

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CONNTRAC- 3+


ACT CONNTRAC
IM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

COLEV EV_NO ... EVENT NUMBER


GSEV OT_EV ... OPERATION TABLE EVENT
DLU OT_EV ... OPERATION TABLE EVENT
COMUEV EV_NO ... EVENT NUMBER
CPTIMEV TIM_OP ... TIMER OPERATION
SWSG SWSG NUMBER
AUDIT AUDIT NUMBER

Notes:
- All values have to be entered in hexadecimal format.
Except SWSG NUMBER and AUDIT NUMBER which have
to be entered in decimal format.
For the latter the entire range of parameter values is
taken if c is not entered.
- On the GP it is possible to use wildcards for parameter b
and c. Such a wildcard applies to all possible values.
To enter a wildcard, enter a hex value of H’FF.

RECLEV RECOVERY LEVEL

This parameter specifies the recovery level which the tracer survives.

Notes :
- Recovery level on CP correspondes to on GP:
NSTART0 ... Local recovery
NSTART1 ... Level 1
NSTART2 ... Level 1.1
NSTART3 ... Level 1.2
ISTART1 ... Level 2.1

Default Values:
- If PRC = CP : RECLEV = NONE
- If PRC = GP : RECLEV = NSTART1 (Rec. level 1 on GP)

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ISTART1 INITIAL START1


NONE NO RECOVERY LEVEL
NSTART0 NEW START0
NSTART1 NEW START1
NSTART2 NEW START2
NSTART3 NEW START3

GPSEND GP DATA SEND MODE

This parameter specifies if the traced GP data should


be sent to the CP during trace or after the end
of trace.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CONT SEND CONTINUOUSLY


In this case the traced data is sent to the
CP immediately, respectively continuously
during trace.
END SEND BY END
In this case the traced data on GP is buffered
without sending to CP, until the end of trace is
reached. If there is more trace data than GP
buffer capacity, the oldest trace data will be
overwritten.
After end of tracing, the whole GP tracebuffer
contents are sent to the CP.

Default: CONT

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CONNTRAC- 4+


ACT CONNTRAC
SDEL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

START DELAY

Input format for activating connection trace facility with a delay.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,TDUR= 11 1
1 ACT CONNTRAC : PARSET= [,MODE=] ,SDEL= 1Z,EEVENT=Y1 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
1 [,RECLEV=] [,GPSEND=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PARSET TRACE PARAMETER SET

This parameter specifies the trace parameter sets to be


activated . CONNTRAC is activated on all processors
(CP and GPs) defined in the entered parameter sets.

Notes:
- It is not allowed to activate together parameter sets
containing the definition of the same processors. In such
a case only the first activation of each processor will be
performed and an error message will be displayed, which
shows the parsets, which are not activated (OBJECT ALREADY
ACTIVE).

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10, range of decimal numbers

MODE BUFFER WRITE MODUS

This parameter describes the way of writing the trace data


into the CONNTRAC trace buffer on the CP.

Incompatibilities:
- SEQU and CYCLIC are not allowed simultaneously.
- NEW and CONTINUE are not allowed simultaneously.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CONTINUE CONTINUE
CYCLIC CYCLIC
NEW NEW
SEQU SEQUENTIAL

Default: CYCLIC, NEW

SDEL START DELAY

This parameter specifies the start delay in mm-ss-ms after


entering the MML command ACT CONNTRAC. The start delay is the
time between entering the command ACT CONNTRAC and the actual
start of tracing.

Restrictions:
- This parameter has to be omitted if a START TRIGGER EVENT is
specified.
- For this parameter a value of at least 50 ms has to
be specified.

Notes:
- If this parameter is omitted, the tracer starts tracing
immediately or after a specified start trigger condition.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CONNTRAC- 5+


ACT CONNTRAC
SDEL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: TIME IN MINUTES=
0...1439, range of decimal numbers

b: TIME IN SECONDS=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: TIME IN MILLISECONDS=
0...999, range of decimal numbers

TDUR TRACE DURATION

This parameter specifies the trace duration in mm-ss-ms after


entering the MML command ACT CONNTRAC. This can be:
.If a start delay is entered, tracing is started after the
start delay has expired.
.If start events are entered, tracing is started after the
one of the start events has occured.
.If no start delay and no start trigger event are entered,
tracing is started immediately after activation of the
tracer per MML.

After expiration of the trace duration, tracing is stopped.

Restrictions:
- This parameter has to be omitted if an END TRIGGER EVENT is
specified.
- For this parameter a value of at least 50 ms has to
be specified.

Notes:
- If this parameter is omitted, the tracer is tracing until
an end trigger condition occured or the user stops the trace
due to a MML command.
- If this parameter is entered it might be necessary in some
special cases to terminate the tracer by DACT CONNTRAC.
For example this has to be done if a LTG has been specified,
which is not active or for which the tracer does not support
the loadtype.

Default: No trace duration, tracer runs until deactivation


by the user.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: TIME IN MINUTES=
0...1439, range of decimal numbers

b: TIME IN SECONDS=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: TIME IN MILLISECONDS=
0...999, range of decimal numbers

EEVENT END TRIGGER EVENT

This parameter specifies the events, which are able to stop


the trace on all processors which are mentioned in the PARSETs.

Restrictions:
- A maximum of 6 LTG’s can be deactivated simultaneously by
a trigger event.
- This parameter has to be omitted if a TRACE DURATION is specified.

Notes:
- Up to 4 trigger events can be entered.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CONNTRAC- 6+


ACT CONNTRAC
SDEL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c]]

a: EVENT TYPE
AUDIT AUDIT TRIGGER EVENT
CMD CP/GP COMMAND
COLEV GP COLLECTIVE EVENT
COMEV GP COMMON EVENT
COMUEV GP COMMUNICATION EVENT
CPMSG CP MESSAGE
CPTIMEV CP TIMER EVENT
DLU GP DLU EVENT
GPMSG GP MESSAGE
GPTIMEV GP TIMER EVENT
GSEV GP GROUP SWITCH EVENT
PEREV GP PERIPHERAL EVENT
PRIVATE PRIVATE TRIGGER EVENT
RCF REASON FOR CALL FAILURE
RCT REASON FOR CALL TERMINATION
REP GP REPORT
SWSG SWSG TRIGGER EVENT

b: EVENT DESCRIPTION PART ONE=


1...8 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This unit has various meanings, dependent on EEVENT

EEVENT: MEANING:

GPMSG JC1 ... JOBCODE 1


CMD JC1 ... JOBCODE 1
REP JC1 ... JOBCODE 1
CPMSG SRC ... SOURCE
PEREV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
GPTIMEV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
COMEV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
COLEV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
GSEV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
DLU OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
COMUEV EV_GRP ... EVENT GROUP
SWSG MODULE NAME
RCT RCT NUMBER
RCF RCF NUMBER
AUDIT AUDIT NAME

Compatibilities:
- Module/Audit name = ’XXXXXXXX’
matches to all modules/audits.
- SOURCE IOCP, TIMER, USER, IOMES
- JC1 is a HEX value
- OT_ID is a HEX value
- EV_GRP is a HEX value
- RCT and RCF is the INT value of the defining set value.
There must not be an input for c.
- AUDIT NAME is the identifier from the defining set
without the prefix ’AUD_’.

c: EVENT DESCRIPTION PART TWO=


1...3 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This unit has various meanings, dependent on EEVENT

EEVENT: MEANING:

GPMSG JC2 ... JOBCODE 2


CMD JC2 ... JOBCODE 2
REP JC2 ... JOBCODE 2
CPMSG JC2 ... JOBCODE 2
PEREV OT_EV ... OPERATION TABLE EVENT
GPTIMEV OT_EV ... OPERATION TABLE EVENT
COMEV EV_NO ... EVENT NUMBER
COLEV EV_NO ... EVENT NUMBER

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CONNTRAC- 7+


ACT CONNTRAC
SDEL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

GSEV OT_EV ... OPERATION TABLE EVENT


DLU OT_EV ... OPERATION TABLE EVENT
COMUEV EV_NO ... EVENT NUMBER
CPTIMEV TIM_OP ... TIMER OPERATION
SWSG SWSG NUMBER
AUDIT AUDIT NUMBER

Notes:
- All values have to be entered in hexadecimal format.
Except SWSG NUMBER and AUDIT NUMBER which have
to be entered in decimal format.
For the latter the entire range of parameter values is
taken if c is not entered.
- On the GP it is possible to use wildcards for parameter b
and c. Such a wildcard applies to all possible values.
To enter a wildcard, enter a hex value of H’FF.

RECLEV RECOVERY LEVEL

This parameter specifies the recovery level which the tracer survives.

Notes :
- Recovery level on CP correspondes to on GP:
NSTART0 ... Local recovery
NSTART1 ... Level 1
NSTART2 ... Level 1.1
NSTART3 ... Level 1.2
ISTART1 ... Level 2.1

Default Values:
- If PRC = CP : RECLEV = NONE
- If PRC = GP : RECLEV = NSTART1 (Rec. level 1 on GP)

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ISTART1 INITIAL START1


NONE NO RECOVERY LEVEL
NSTART0 NEW START0
NSTART1 NEW START1
NSTART2 NEW START2
NSTART3 NEW START3

GPSEND GP DATA SEND MODE

This parameter specifies if the traced GP data should


be sent to the CP during trace or after the end
of trace.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CONT SEND CONTINUOUSLY


In this case the traced data is sent to the
CP immediately, respectively continuously
during trace.
END SEND BY END
In this case the traced data on GP is buffered
without sending to CP, until the end of trace is
reached. If there is more trace data than GP
buffer capacity, the oldest trace data will be
overwritten.
After end of tracing, the whole GP tracebuffer
contents are sent to the CP.

Default: CONT

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CONNTRAC- 8+


ACT CONNTRAC
SEVENT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

START EVENT

Input format for activating connection trace facility by a


start trigger event.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,TDUR= 11 1
1 ACT CONNTRAC : PARSET= [,MODE=] ,SEVENT= 1Z,EEVENT=Y1 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
1 [,RECLEV=] [,GPSEND=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PARSET TRACE PARAMETER SET

This parameter specifies the trace parameter sets to be


activated . CONNTRAC is activated on all processors
(CP and GPs) defined in the entered parameter sets.

Notes:
- It is not allowed to activate together parameter sets
containing the definition of the same processors. In such
a case only the first activation of each processor will be
performed and an error message will be displayed, which
shows the parsets, which are not activated (OBJECT ALREADY
ACTIVE).

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10, range of decimal numbers

MODE BUFFER WRITE MODUS

This parameter describes the way of writing the trace data


into the CONNTRAC trace buffer on the CP.

Incompatibilities:
- SEQU and CYCLIC are not allowed simultaneously.
- NEW and CONTINUE are not allowed simultaneously.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CONTINUE CONTINUE
CYCLIC CYCLIC
NEW NEW
SEQU SEQUENTIAL

Default: CYCLIC, NEW

SEVENT START TRIGGER EVENT

This parameter specifies the events, which are able to start


the trace on all processors which are mentioned in the PARSETs.

Restrictions:
- A maximum of 6 LTG’s can be activated simultaneously by
a trigger event.
- This parameter has to be omitted if a START DELAY is specified.
- This parameter has to be omitted if DIRECTORY NUMBERs have been
specified for the corresponding PARSETs.

Notes:
- Up to 4 trigger events can be entered.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CONNTRAC- 9+


ACT CONNTRAC
SEVENT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c]]

a: EVENT TYPE
CMD CP/GP COMMAND
COLEV GP COLLECTIVE EVENT
COMEV GP COMMON EVENT
COMUEV GP COMMUNICATION EVENT
CPMSG CP MESSAGE
CPTIMEV CP TIMER EVENT
DLU GP DLU EVENT
GPMSG GP MESSAGE
GPTIMEV GP TIMER EVENT
GSEV GP GROUP SWITCH EVENT
PEREV GP PERIPHERAL EVENT
PRIVATE PRIVATE TRIGGER EVENT
REP GP REPORT

b: EVENT DESCRIPTION PART ONE=


1...5 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This unit has various meanings, dependent on SEVENT

SEVENT: MEANING:

GPMSG JC1 ... JOBCODE 1


CMD JC1 ... JOBCODE 1
REP JC1 ... JOBCODE 1
CPMSG SRC ... SOURCE
PEREV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
GPTIMEV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
COMEV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
COLEV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
GSEV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
DLU OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
COMUEV EV_GRP ... EVENT GROUP

Compatibilities:
- SOURCE IOCP, TIMER, USER, IOMES
- JC1 is a HEX value
- OT_ID is a HEX value
- EV_GRP is a HEX value

c: EVENT DESCRIPTION PART TWO=


0...FF, range of hexadecimal numbers

This unit has various meanings, dependent on SEVENT

EVENT TYPE: MEANING:

GPMSG JC2 ... JOBCODE 2


CMD JC2 ... JOBCODE 2
REP JC2 ... JOBCODE 2
CPMSG JC2 ... JOBCODE 2
PEREV OT_EV ... OPERATION TABLE EVENT
GPTIMEV OT_EV ... OPERATION TABLE EVENT
COMEV EV_NO ... EVENT NUMBER
COLEV EV_NO ... EVENT NUMBER
GSEV OT_EV ... OPERATION TABLE EVENT
DLU OT_EV ... OPERATION TABLE EVENT
COMUEV EV_NO ... EVENT NUMBER
CPTIMEV TIM_OP ... TIMER OPERATION

Notes:
- All values have to be entered in hexadecimal format.
- On the GP it is possible to use wildcards for parameter b
and c. Such a wildcard applies to all possible values. To
enter a wildcard, enter a hex value of H’FF.

TDUR TRACE DURATION

This parameter specifies the trace duration in mm-ss-ms after


entering the MML command ACT CONNTRAC. This can be:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CONNTRAC- 10+


ACT CONNTRAC
SEVENT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

.If a start delay is entered, tracing is started after the


start delay has expired.
.If start events are entered, tracing is started after the
one of the start events has occured.
.If no start delay and no start trigger event are entered,
tracing is started immediately after activation of the
tracer per MML.

After expiration of the trace duration, tracing is stopped.

Restrictions:
- This parameter has to be omitted if an END TRIGGER EVENT is
specified.
- For this parameter a value of at least 50 ms has to
be specified.

Notes:
- If this parameter is omitted, the tracer is tracing until
an end trigger condition occured or the user stops the trace
due to a MML command.
- If this parameter is entered it might be necessary in some
special cases to terminate the tracer by DACT CONNTRAC.
For example this has to be done if a LTG has been specified,
which is not active or for which the tracer does not support
the loadtype.

Default: No trace duration, tracer runs until deactivation


by the user.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: TIME IN MINUTES=
0...1439, range of decimal numbers

b: TIME IN SECONDS=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: TIME IN MILLISECONDS=
0...999, range of decimal numbers

EEVENT END TRIGGER EVENT

This parameter specifies the events, which are able to stop


the trace on all processors which are mentioned in the PARSETs.

Restrictions:
- A maximum of 6 LTG’s can be deactivated simultaneously by
a trigger event.
- This parameter has to be omitted if a TRACE DURATION is specified.

Notes:
- Up to 4 trigger events can be entered.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c]]

a: EVENT TYPE
AUDIT AUDIT TRIGGER EVENT
CMD CP/GP COMMAND
COLEV GP COLLECTIVE EVENT
COMEV GP COMMON EVENT
COMUEV GP COMMUNICATION EVENT
CPMSG CP MESSAGE
CPTIMEV CP TIMER EVENT
DLU GP DLU EVENT
GPMSG GP MESSAGE
GPTIMEV GP TIMER EVENT
GSEV GP GROUP SWITCH EVENT
PEREV GP PERIPHERAL EVENT
PRIVATE PRIVATE TRIGGER EVENT
RCF REASON FOR CALL FAILURE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CONNTRAC- 11+


ACT CONNTRAC
SEVENT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RCT REASON FOR CALL TERMINATION


REP GP REPORT
SWSG SWSG TRIGGER EVENT

b: EVENT DESCRIPTION PART ONE=


1...8 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This unit has various meanings, dependent on EEVENT

EEVENT: MEANING:

GPMSG JC1 ... JOBCODE 1


CMD JC1 ... JOBCODE 1
REP JC1 ... JOBCODE 1
CPMSG SRC ... SOURCE
PEREV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
GPTIMEV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
COMEV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
COLEV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
GSEV OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
DLU OT_ID ... OPERATION TABLE ID
COMUEV EV_GRP ... EVENT GROUP
SWSG MODULE NAME
RCT RCT NUMBER
RCF RCF NUMBER
AUDIT AUDIT NAME

Compatibilities:
- Module/Audit name = ’XXXXXXXX’
matches to all modules/audits.
- SOURCE IOCP, TIMER, USER, IOMES
- JC1 is a HEX value
- OT_ID is a HEX value
- EV_GRP is a HEX value
- RCT and RCF is the INT value of the defining set value.
There must not be an input for c.
- AUDIT NAME is the identifier from the defining set
without the prefix ’AUD_’.

c: EVENT DESCRIPTION PART TWO=


1...3 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This unit has various meanings, dependent on EEVENT

EEVENT: MEANING:

GPMSG JC2 ... JOBCODE 2


CMD JC2 ... JOBCODE 2
REP JC2 ... JOBCODE 2
CPMSG JC2 ... JOBCODE 2
PEREV OT_EV ... OPERATION TABLE EVENT
GPTIMEV OT_EV ... OPERATION TABLE EVENT
COMEV EV_NO ... EVENT NUMBER
COLEV EV_NO ... EVENT NUMBER
GSEV OT_EV ... OPERATION TABLE EVENT
DLU OT_EV ... OPERATION TABLE EVENT
COMUEV EV_NO ... EVENT NUMBER
CPTIMEV TIM_OP ... TIMER OPERATION
SWSG SWSG NUMBER
AUDIT AUDIT NUMBER

Notes:
- All values have to be entered in hexadecimal format.
Except SWSG NUMBER and AUDIT NUMBER which have
to be entered in decimal format.
For the latter the entire range of parameter values is
taken if c is not entered.
- On the GP it is possible to use wildcards for parameter b
and c. Such a wildcard applies to all possible values.
To enter a wildcard, enter a hex value of H’FF.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CONNTRAC- 12+


ACT CONNTRAC
SEVENT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RECLEV RECOVERY LEVEL

This parameter specifies the recovery level which the tracer survives.

Notes :
- Recovery level on CP correspondes to on GP:
NSTART0 ... Local recovery
NSTART1 ... Level 1
NSTART2 ... Level 1.1
NSTART3 ... Level 1.2
ISTART1 ... Level 2.1

Default Values:
- If PRC = CP : RECLEV = NONE
- If PRC = GP : RECLEV = NSTART1 (Rec. level 1 on GP)

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ISTART1 INITIAL START1


NONE NO RECOVERY LEVEL
NSTART0 NEW START0
NSTART1 NEW START1
NSTART2 NEW START2
NSTART3 NEW START3

GPSEND GP DATA SEND MODE

This parameter specifies if the traced GP data should


be sent to the CP during trace or after the end
of trace.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CONT SEND CONTINUOUSLY


In this case the traced data is sent to the
CP immediately, respectively continuously
during trace.
END SEND BY END
In this case the traced data on GP is buffered
without sending to CP, until the end of trace is
reached. If there is more trace data than GP
buffer capacity, the oldest trace data will be
overwritten.
After end of tracing, the whole GP tracebuffer
contents are sent to the CP.

Default: CONT

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CONNTRAC- 13-


CAN CONNTRAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CONNECTION TRACE PARAMETER SET

This command allows to cancel one or more trace parameter sets, if


this parameter sets are not active.
If a parameter set has been canceled, it is undefined and cannot be
used for activation or modification.

This command is a test command only permitted for use by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel for NM-test purposes.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN CONNTRAC : PARSET= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PARSET TRACE PARAMETER SET

This parameter specifies the trace parameter sets to be canceled.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CONNTRAC- 1-


DACT CONNTRAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE CONNECTION TRACE

This commmand deactivates the connection trace facility of call


processing.

This command is a test command only permitted for use by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel for NM-test purposes.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT CONNTRAC : [PARSET=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PARSET TRACE PARAMETER SET

This parameter specifies the trace parameter sets to be deactivated.


If this parameter is entered, CONNTRAC is deactivated on all processors
(CP and GPs), which are defined in the entered parameter sets.
If the parameter PARSET is entered, CONNTRAC stops tracing on
CP and all activated GPs.
CONNTRAC waits until all trace data from the local tracebuffers
of the LTGs have arrived.
The execution of the MML-command DACT CONNTRAC is terminated
after 10 seconds, but data collection still goes on. When the
MML-command DMP CONNTRAC is entered, the tracebuffer will be
closed and collecting of GP-tracedata is ended.
If this parameter is omitted, CONNTRAC is deactivated immediately on
all processors where it is active. Tracedata in the local
tracebuffers of the LTGS are lost.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT CONNTRAC- 1-


DISP CONNTRAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CONNECTION TRACE PARAMETER SET

This command allows to display parameter sets and to find out whether
the tracer is active or not.

This command is a test command only permitted for use by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel for NM-test purposes.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CONNTRAC : [PARSET=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PARSET TRACE PARAMETER SET

This parameter specifies the numbers of the trace parameter sets to be


displayed.
If the parameter is omitted, the state of CONNTRAC at CP and a list of
the active LTGs is displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CONNTRAC- 1-


DMP CONNTRAC
FILE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DUMP CONNECTION TRACE

This command dumps the connection trace buffer of call processing out
onto the maintenance terminal or copies the trace buffer to or from
disk. Before a dump command can be handled, the connection tracer
must be deactivated.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is a test command only permitted for use by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel for NM-test purposes.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DMP CONNTRAC - FILE FILE OPERATIONS


2. DMP CONNTRAC - TERM TERMINAL OPERATIONS

1. Input format

FILE OPERATIONS

This input form is used to store the contents of the trace buffer
on disk.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11FROMFILE=11 1
1 DMP CONNTRAC : 1ZTOFILE= Y1 ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FROMFILE FILENAME ON DISK

This parameter specifies the file name (including the prefix


’CT.’) on disc, where from the trace buffer contents are
copied. The chosen filename has to begin always with the
prefix ’CT.’, which is a mandatory prefix for a valid
filename.
If this parameter is entered, all other parameters
are insignificant.

Default: No filename, tracedata will be dumped onto maintenance


terminal

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...11 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TOFILE FILENAME ON DISK

This parameter specifies the file name (including the prefix


’CT.’) on disc, where to the trace buffer contents are
copied. The chosen filename has to begin always with the
prefix ’CT.’, which is a mandatory prefix for a valid
filename.
If this parameter is entered, all other parameters
are insignificant.

Default: No filename, tracedata will be dumped onto maintenance


terminal

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...11 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP CONNTRAC- 1+


DMP CONNTRAC
TERM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

TERMINAL OPERATIONS

This input form is used to dump the connection trace buffer on the
O&M-Terminal.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DMP CONNTRAC : [PARSET=] [,FORM=] [,EVNO=] [,MODE=] [,DATA=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PARSET TRACE PARAMETER SET

This parameter specifies the trace parameter sets which should be


dumped.
If this parameter is omitted, all trace parameter sets which were
active while tracing are specified.

Default: PARSET = X (all parsets, which were active while tracing)

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10, range of decimal numbers

FORM FORM OF DUMP

This parameter specifies the format of dumping.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DIR DIRECTORY OF THE STORED EVENTS


HEX HEXADECIMAL DUMP
LONG LONG DUMP

Default: DIR

EVNO EVENT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the event number. When dumping events, an


event index is assigned to each event by the CONNTRAC.
If this parameter is specified, only events with indices within the
defined range are dumped.

Default: No EVNO (no selection by event number)

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

MODE DUMP ORDER MODE

This parameter specifies the dump order mode.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NEW NEW DUMP


REVERSE REVERSE DUMP

Default: NEW

DATA DATA TO BE DUMPED

This parameter specifies the data (messages and resources) to be


dumped.
Default: All DATA (no selection by data)

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP CONNTRAC- 2+


DMP CONNTRAC
TERM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ASN1DERR CP/GP ASN1 DECODE ERROR


ATD ADDITIONAL TRANSACTION DATA
BAR CP BILLING APPLICATION REG.
BDU CP BSSAP DATA UNIT
CAPDT GP CALL PROCESSING USER DATA
CDU CP/GP COMPONENT DATA UNIT
CHR CP CHANNEL REGISTER
CMD CP/GP COMMAND DATA
COLEV GP COLLECTIVE EVENT DATA
COMEV GP COMMON EVENT DATA
COMUEV GP COMMUNICATION EVENT DATA
CPB CP CALL PROCESSING BUFFER
CR GP CALL REGISTER
CRALL ALL GP CALL REGISTERS
CRCHA CHARGING CALL REGISTER
CRCTX CENTREX CALL REGISTER
CRIN IN CALL REGISTER
CRMOB MOBILE CALL REGISTER
CRPRJ PROJECT SPECIFIC CALL REGISTER
CRUSR USER CALL REGISTER
DLU GP DLU EVENT DATA
DPS GP DLU PORT STATUS TABLE
EDU CP EXTERNAL DATA UNIT
GSEV GP GROUP SWITCH EVENT DATA
INTEV CP/GP INTERNAL EVENT DATA
IWF GP INTERWORKING FUNCTION DATA
LST GP LINE STATUS TABLE
MSG CP/GP MESSAGE DATA
ORD CP/GP ORDER DATA
PDU CP PROTOCOL DATA UNIT
PEREV GP PERIPHERAL EVENT DATA
RCB CP RESOURCE CONFIG BUFFER
REP GP REPORT DATA
TCB CP/GP TRANSACTION CONTROL BLK.
TIMEV CP/GP TIMER EVENT DATA
TMM CP TRAFFIC MEASUREMENT MODULE
TR CP TRANSACTION REGISTER
USER GP USER DATA
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP CONNTRAC- 3-


ENTR CONNTRAC
CP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CONNECTION TRACE PARAMETER SET

This command enters a connection trace parameter set.

This command is a test command only permitted for use by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel for NM-test purposes.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ENTR CONNTRAC- CP CP PARSET


2. ENTR CONNTRAC- GP GP PARSET

1. Input format

CP PARSET

This input form is used for entering a CP trace parameter set.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR CONNTRAC : PARSET= [,PRC=] [,EQN=] [,EVENT=] [,DATA=] 1
1 1
1 [,DN=] [,LAYER=] [,C7ADDR=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PARSET TRACE PARAMETER SET

This parameter specifies the number of the trace parameter set to


be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10, range of decimal numbers

PRC PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the processor, where the tracing is


performed.
For specification of the LTG’s use the parameter EQN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CP COORDINATION PROCESSOR

EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the equipment numbers to be traced.


If PRC = GP, EQN defines the LTGs where the tracing is done.
If PRC = CP, only the connections with the specified LTGs
are traced. No selection of ports is done.

Compatibilities:
- a - b specifies a LTG
For PRC = GP also available:
- a specifies all ports of a DLU or V5IF
- a - b - c specifies a LTG pseudoport
- a - b - c - d specifies a LTG port or a DLU port or a V5.1 port

Notes:
- This parameter is mandatory if PRC = GP.
- If no LTG port or DLU port are selected, all ports are
traced.
- A parameter interval is allowed only between values of the
same EQN type. If the EQN type is a DLU or a DLU port, only
ranges within the same DLU are allowed.

- Up to 10 EQN-numbers or up to 5 ranges of EQN-numbers


can be entered.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CONNTRAC- 1+


ENTR CONNTRAC
CP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a[-b]

a: TSG/DLU NUMBER=
0...8999, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies a TSG number in the range 0...7 if


the equipment number refers to LTG or a LTG port;
with reference to a DLU or a DLU port a DLU number in the
range 10...2550 (in steps of 10) and with reference to a
V5.1 or V5.1 port a V5IF in the range of 6000...8999 is
specified.

b: LTG/SHELF NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies a LTG number in the range 1...63 if the


equipment number refers to a LTG or a LTG port; with
reference to a DLU port a frame in the range of 0...7 is
specified. For a V5.1 port it will be equal zero.
This unit is omitted if the EQN refers to all ports of a DLU.

EVENT EVENT

This parameter specifies the events, where the tracer will


trace data.

Notes:
- If the user wants to specify a great amount of parameter
values, the input EVENT=X should be chosen and modified
by the command MOD using MODE = SUB.
(Normally the identifier X of parameter EVENT is blocked.
For compound test phase it is possible to unblock the
identifier X by patch.)

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ASN1DERR CP/GP ASN1 DECODE ERROR


CMD CP/GP COMMANDS
INTEV CP/GP INTERNAL EVENTS
MSG CP/GP MESSAGES
NONE NO EVENTS
ORD CP/GP ORDERS
TIMEV CP/GP TIMER EVENTS
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

Default: ORD

DATA DATA TO BE TRACED

This parameter specifies the data (messages and resources)


to be traced.

Notes:
- If the user wants to specify a great amount of parameter
values, the input DATA=X should be chosen and modified
by the command MOD using MODE = SUB.
(Normally the identifier X of parameter DATA is blocked.
For compound test phase it is possible to unblock the
identifier X by patch.)

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ASN1DERR CP/GP ASN1 DECODE ERROR


ATD ADDITIONAL TRANSACTION DATA
BAR CP BILLING APPLICATION REG.
BDU CP BSSAP DATA UNIT
CDU CP/GP COMPONENT DATA UNIT
CHR CP CHANNEL REGISTER
CMD CP/GP COMMAND DATA
CPB CP CALL PROCESSING BUFFER
EDU CP EXTERNAL DATA UNIT
INTEV CP/GP INTERNAL EVENT DATA
MSG CP/GP MESSAGE DATA

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CONNTRAC- 2+


ENTR CONNTRAC
CP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ORD CP/GP ORDER DATA


PDU CP PROTOCOL DATA UNIT
RCB CP RESOURCE CONFIG BUFFER
TCB CP/GP TRANSACTION CONTROL BLK.
TIMEV CP/GP TIMER EVENT DATA
TMM CP TRAFFIC MEASUREMENT MODULE
TR CP TRANSACTION REGISTER
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

Default: ORD

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the identifications of the subscriber


or the mobile station to be traced. It is only available if
PRC = CP.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b[-c]

a: TYPE OF SUBSCRIBER IDENTIFICATION


HO HANDOVER MSC B-PART
IMEI INT. MOBILE EQUIPM. IDENTITY
IMSI INT. MOBILE SUBSCR. IDENTITY
MINESN MOBILE IDENTIFICATION CDMA
MSISDN MOBILE STATION ISDN NUMBER
PSTNDN PSTN DIRECTORY NUMBER

b: IDENTIFICATION=
1...24 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This unit has various meanings, dependent on


DN

DN: MEANING:

PSTNDN PSTN DIRECTORY NUMBER


IMSI INT. MOBILE SUBSCR. IDENTITY
IMEI INT. MOBILE EQUIPM. IDENTITY
MSISDN MOBILE STATION ISDN NUMBER
HO HANDOVER MSC B-PART
MINESN MOBILE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

Compatibilities:
- If PSTNDN, IMSI, IMEI, MSISDN or HO is entered there
must not be an input for c.
- If MINESN is entered there must be an input (ESN) for c.
- The total number of digits of a MOBILE IDENTIFICATION
NUMBER must be 10.

c: ELECTRONIC SERIAL NUMBER=


8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LAYER LAYER

This parameter specifies the protocol layers. The message flow


concerning these protocol layers will be traced.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

C7SIGN ISUP AND TUP


C7USER USERS OF SCCP AND TCAP
GENERIC GENERIC C AND GENERIC M
SCCP SIGNALING CONN. CONTROL PART
TCAP TRANSACTION CAPAB. APPL. PART
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

Default: X

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CONNTRAC- 3+


ENTR CONNTRAC
CP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

C7ADDR CCS7 ADDRESS

This parameter specifies a CCS7 address.

Notes: - Each type of address may only be given once. If more than one
value is specified, an event is traced only if all values
are matching.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: TYPE OF CCS7 ADDRESS


GT GLOBAL TITLE
Compatibilities:
- ADDRESS = 1..24 decimal digits
NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR
Compatibilities:
- ADDRESS =
SPC SIGNALING POINT CODE
Compatibilities:
- ADDRESS = 2^24-1 (=16777215), range of decimal
numbers
SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFICATION
Compatibilities:
- ADDRESS =
BSSAPINT BSSAP INTERNAL

b: ADDRESS=
1...24 characters from the
symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CONNTRAC- 4+


ENTR CONNTRAC
GP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

GP PARSET

This input form is used for entering a GP trace parameter set.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR CONNTRAC : PARSET= ,PRC= ,EQN= [,EVENT=] [,DATA=] 1
1 1
1 [,LAYER=] [,SUBL=] [,C7ADDR=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PARSET TRACE PARAMETER SET

This parameter specifies the number of the trace parameter set to


be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10, range of decimal numbers

PRC PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the processor, where the tracing is


performed.
For specification of the LTG’s use the parameter EQN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

GP GROUP PROCESSOR

EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the equipment numbers to be traced.


If PRC = GP, EQN defines the LTGs where the tracing is done.
If PRC = CP, only the connections with the specified LTGs
are traced. No selection of ports is done.

Compatibilities:
- a - b specifies a LTG
For PRC = GP also available:
- a specifies all ports of a DLU or V5IF
- a - b - c specifies a LTG pseudoport
- a - b - c - d specifies a LTG port or a DLU port or a V5.1 port

Notes:
- This parameter is mandatory if PRC = GP.
- If no LTG port or DLU port are selected, all ports are
traced.
- A parameter interval is allowed only between values of the
same EQN type. If the EQN type is a DLU or a DLU port, only
ranges within the same DLU are allowed.

- Up to 10 EQN-numbers or up to 5 ranges of EQN-numbers


can be entered.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: TSG/DLU NUMBER=
0...8999, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies a TSG number in the range 0...7 if


the equipment number refers to LTG or a LTG port;
with reference to a DLU or a DLU port a DLU number in the
range 10...2550 (in steps of 10) and with reference to a
V5.1 or V5.1 port a V5IF in the range of 6000...8999 is
specified.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CONNTRAC- 5+


ENTR CONNTRAC
GP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: LTG/SHELF NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies a LTG number in the range 1...63 if the


equipment number refers to a LTG or a LTG port; with
reference to a DLU port a frame in the range of 0...7 is
specified. For a V5.1 port it will be equal zero.
This unit is omitted if the EQN refers to all ports of a DLU.

c: PSEUDOPORT/LTU/MODULE NUMBER=
0...450, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies a LTU number in the range 0...7 if the


equipment number refers to a LTG port; with reference to a
DLU port a module in the range 0...15 is specified.
If the equipment number refers to a LTG pseudoport this unit
specifies the pseudoport in the range 0...450.
For a V5.1 port this unit will be equal zero.
This unit is omitted if the EQN refers to all ports of a LTG
or a DLU.

d: CHANNEL/CIRCUIT NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies a channel number in the range 0..31 if the


equipment number refers to a LTG or a V5.1 port; with
reference to a DLU8 (DLU16) a circuit number in the range 0...7
(0...15) is specified. This unit is omitted if the EQN
refers to all ports of a LTG, DLU or a LTG pseudoport.

EVENT EVENT

This parameter specifies the events, where the tracer will


trace data.

Notes:
- If the user wants to specify a great amount of parameter
values, the input EVENT=X should be chosen and modified
by the command MOD using MODE = SUB.
(Normally the identifier X of parameter EVENT is blocked.
For compound test phase it is possible to unblock the
identifier X by patch.)

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ASN1DERR CP/GP ASN1 DECODE ERROR


CAPDT GP CALL PROCESSING USER EVENTS
CMD CP/GP COMMANDS
COLEV GP COLLECTIVE EVENTS
COMEV GP COMMON EVENTS
COMUEV GP COMMUNICATION EVENTS
DLU GP DLU EVENTS
GSEV GP GROUP SWITCH EVENTS
INTEV CP/GP INTERNAL EVENTS
IWF GP INTERWORKING FUNCTION EV.
MSG CP/GP MESSAGES
NONE NO EVENTS
ORD CP/GP ORDERS
PEREV GP PERIPHERAL EVENTS
REP GP REPORTS
TIMEV CP/GP TIMER EVENTS
USER GP USER
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

Default: ORD

DATA DATA TO BE TRACED

This parameter specifies the data (messages and resources)


to be traced.

Notes:
- If the user wants to specify a great amount of parameter

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CONNTRAC- 6+


ENTR CONNTRAC
GP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

values, the input DATA=X should be chosen and modified


by the command MOD using MODE = SUB.
(Normally the identifier X of parameter DATA is blocked.
For compound test phase it is possible to unblock the
identifier X by patch.)

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ASN1DERR CP/GP ASN1 DECODE ERROR


CAPDT GP CALL PROCESSING USER DATA
CDU CP/GP COMPONENT DATA UNIT
CMD CP/GP COMMAND DATA
COLEV GP COLLECTIVE EVENT DATA
COMEV GP COMMON EVENT DATA
COMUEV GP COMMUNICATION EVENT DATA
CR GP CALL REGISTER
CRALL ALL GP CALL REGISTERS
CRCHA CHARGING CALL REGISTER
CRCTX CENTREX CALL REGISTER
CRIN IN CALL REGISTER
CRMOB MOBILE CALL REGISTER
CRPRJ PROJECT SPECIFIC CALL REGISTER
CRUSR USER CALL REGISTER
DLU GP DLU EVENT DATA
DPS GP DLU PORT STATUS TABLE
GSEV GP GROUP SWITCH EVENT DATA
INTEV CP/GP INTERNAL EVENT DATA
IWF GP INTERWORKING FUNCTION DATA
LST GP LINE STATUS TABLE
MSG CP/GP MESSAGE DATA
ORD CP/GP ORDER DATA
PEREV GP PERIPHERAL EVENT DATA
REP GP REPORT DATA
TCB CP/GP TRANSACTION CONTROL BLK.
TIMEV CP/GP TIMER EVENT DATA
USER GP USER DATA
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

Default: ORD

LAYER LAYER

This parameter specifies the protocol layers. The message flow


concerning these protocol layers will be traced.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

C7SIGN ISUP AND TUP


C7USER USERS OF SCCP AND TCAP
GENERIC GENERIC C AND GENERIC M
SCCP SIGNALING CONN. CONTROL PART
TCAP TRANSACTION CAPAB. APPL. PART
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

Default: X

SUBL BSSAP SUBLAYER

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CC CALL CONTROL
MM MOBILITY MANAGEMENT
RR RADIO RESOURCE MANAGEMENT
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
SS NON CALL RELATED SUPPL. SERV.
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

Default: X

C7ADDR CCS7 ADDRESS

This parameter specifies a CCS7 address.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CONNTRAC- 7+


ENTR CONNTRAC
GP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Notes: - Each type of address may only be given once. If more than one
value is specified, an event is traced only if all values
are matching.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: TYPE OF CCS7 ADDRESS


GT GLOBAL TITLE
Compatibilities:
- ADDRESS = 1..24 decimal digits
NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR
Compatibilities:
- ADDRESS =
SPC SIGNALING POINT CODE
Compatibilities:
- ADDRESS = 2^24-1 (=16777215), range of decimal
numbers
SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFICATION
Compatibilities:
- ADDRESS =
BSSAPINT BSSAP INTERNAL

b: ADDRESS=
1...24 characters from the
symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CONNTRAC- 8-


MOD CONNTRAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY CONNECTION TRACE PARAMETER SET

This command modifies a connection trace parameter set.

This command is a test command only permitted for use by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel for NM-test purposes.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD CONNTRAC : PARSET= [,PRC=] [,EQN=] [,EVENT=] [,DATA=] 1
1 1
1 [,DN=] [,LAYER=] [,SUBL=] [,C7ADDR=] [,MODE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PARSET TRACE PARAMETER SET

This parameter specifies the number of the trace parameter set to


be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10, range of decimal numbers

PRC PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the processor, where the tracing is


performed.
For specification of the LTG’s use the parameter EQN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CP COORDINATION PROCESSOR
GP GROUP PROCESSOR

Default: CP

EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the equipment numbers to be traced.


If PRC = GP, EQN defines the LTGs where the tracing is done.
If PRC = CP, only the connections with the specified LTGs
are traced. No selection of ports is done.

Compatibilities:
- a - b specifies a LTG
For PRC = GP also available:
- a specifies all ports of a DLU or a V5IF
- a - b - c specifies a LTG pseudoport
- a - b - c - d specifies a LTG port or a DLU port or V5.1 port

Notes:
- Up to 10 EQN-numbers or up to 5 ranges of EQN-numbers
can be entered.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: TSG/DLU NUMBER=
0...8999, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies a TSG number in the range 0...7 if


the equipment number refers to LTG or a LTG port;
with reference to a DLU or a DLU port a DLU number in the
range 10...2550 (in steps of 10) and with reference to a
V5.1 or V5.1 port a V5IF in the range of 6000...8999 is
specified.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CONNTRAC- 1+


MOD CONNTRAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: LTG/SHELF NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies a LTG number in the range 1...63 if the


equipment number refers to a LTG or a LTG port; with
reference to a DLU port a frame in the range of 0...7 is
specified. For a V5.1 port this unit wiil be equal zero.
This unit is omitted if the EQN refers to all ports of
a DLU.

c: PSEUDOPORT/LTU/MODULE NUMBER=
0...450, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies a LTU number in the range 0...7 if the


equipment number refers to a LTG port; with reference to a
DLU port a module in the range 0...15 is specified.
If the equipment number refers to a LTG pseudoport this unit
specifies the pseudoport in the range 0...450.
For a V5.1 port this unit will be equal zero.
This unit is omitted if the EQN refers to all ports of a LTG
or a DLU.

d: CHANNEL/CIRCUIT NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies a channel number in the range 0..31 if the


equipment number refers to a LTG or a V5.1 port; with reference
to a DLU8 (DLU16) a circuit number in the range 0...7
(0...15) is specified. This unit is omitted if the EQN
refers to all ports of a LTG, DLU or a LTG pseudoport.

EVENT EVENT

This parameter specifies the events, where the tracer will


trace data.

Notes:
- If the user wants to specify a great amount of parameter
values, the input EVENT=X should be chosen.
(Normally the identifier X of parameter EVENT is blocked.
For compound test phase it is possible to unblock the
identifier X by patch.)

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

USER GP USER
MSG CP/GP MESSAGES
CMD CP/GP COMMANDS
ORD CP/GP ORDERS
REP GP REPORTS
PEREV GP PERIPHERAL EVENTS
INTEV CP/GP INTERNAL EVENTS
TIMEV CP/GP TIMER EVENTS
COMEV GP COMMON EVENTS
COMUEV GP COMMUNICATION EVENTS
COLEV GP COLLECTIVE EVENTS
GSEV GP GROUP SWITCH EVENTS
ASN1DERR CP/GP ASN1 DECODE ERROR
IWF GP INTERWORKING FUNCTION EV.
DLU GP DLU EVENTS
CAPDT GP CALL PROCESSING USER EVENTS
NONE NO EVENTS
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

Default: ORD

DATA DATA TO BE TRACED

This parameter specifies the data (messages and resources)


to be traced.

Notes:
- If the user wants to specify a great amount of parameter

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CONNTRAC- 2+


MOD CONNTRAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

values, the input DATA=X should be chosen.


(Normally the identifier X of parameter DATA is blocked.
For compound test phase it is possible to unblock the
identifier X by patch.)

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ASN1DERR CP/GP ASN1 DECODE ERROR


ATD ADDITIONAL TRANSACTION DATA
BAR CP BILLING APPLICATION REG.
BDU CP BSSAP DATA UNIT
CAPDT GP CALL PROCESSING USER DATA
CDU CP/GP COMPONENT DATA UNIT
CHR CP CHANNEL REGISTER
CMD CP/GP COMMAND DATA
COLEV GP COLLECTIVE EVENT DATA
COMEV GP COMMON EVENT DATA
COMUEV GP COMMUNICATION EVENT DATA
CPB CP CALL PROCESSING BUFFER
CR GP CALL REGISTER
CRALL ALL GP CALL REGISTERS
CRCHA CHARGING CALL REGISTER
CRCTX CENTREX CALL REGISTER
CRIN IN CALL REGISTER
CRMOB MOBILE CALL REGISTER
CRPRJ PROJECT SPECIFIC CALL REGISTER
CRUSR USER CALL REGISTER
DLU GP DLU EVENT DATA
DPS GP DLU PORT STATUS TABLE
EDU CP EXTERNAL DATA UNIT
GSEV GP GROUP SWITCH EVENT DATA
INTEV CP/GP INTERNAL EVENT DATA
IWF GP INTERWORKING FUNCTION DATA
LST GP LINE STATUS TABLE
MSG CP/GP MESSAGE DATA
ORD CP/GP ORDER DATA
PDU CP PROTOCOL DATA UNIT
PEREV GP PERIPHERAL EVENT DATA
RCB CP RESOURCE CONFIG BUFFER
REP GP REPORT DATA
TCB CP/GP TRANSACTION CONTROL BLK.
TIMEV CP/GP TIMER EVENT DATA
TMM CP TRAFFIC MEASUREMENT MODULE
TR CP TRANSACTION REGISTER
USER GP USER DATA
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

Default: ORD

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the identifications of the subscriber


or the mobile station to be traced.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b[-c]

a: TYPE OF SUBSCRIBER IDENTIFICATION


PSTNDN PSTN DIRECTORY NUMBER
IMSI INT. MOBILE SUBSCR. IDENTITY
IMEI INT. MOBILE EQUIPM. IDENTITY
MSISDN MOBILE STATION ISDN NUMBER
HO HANDOVER MSC B-PART
MINESN MOBILE IDENTIFICATION CDMA

b: IDENTIFICATION=
1...24 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This unit has various meanings, dependent on


DN

DN: MEANING:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CONNTRAC- 3+


MOD CONNTRAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PSTNDN PSTN DIRECTORY NUMBER


IMSI INT. MOBILE SUBSCR. IDENTITY
IMEI INT. MOBILE EQUIPM. IDENTITY
MSISDN MOBILE STATION ISDN NUMBER
HO HANDOVER MSC B-PART
MINESN MOBILE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

Compatibilities:
- If PSTNDN, IMSI, IMEI, MSISDN or HO is entered there
must not be an input for c.
- If MINESN is entered there must be an input (ESN) for c.
- The total number of digits for the MOBILE IDENTIFICATION
NUMBER must be 10.

c: ELECTRONIC SERIAL NUMBER=


8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LAYER LAYER

This parameter specifies the protocol layers. The message flow


concerning these protocol layers will be traced.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

SCCP SIGNALING CONN. CONTROL PART


TCAP TRANSACTION CAPAB. APPL. PART
C7USER USERS OF SCCP AND TCAP
GENERIC GENERIC C AND GENERIC M
C7SIGN ISUP AND TUP
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

Default: X

SUBL BSSAP SUBLAYER

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

RR RADIO RESOURCE MANAGEMENT


MM MOBILITY MANAGEMENT
CC CALL CONTROL
SS NON CALL RELATED SUPPL. SERV.
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

Default: X

C7ADDR CCS7 ADDRESS

This parameter specifies a CCS7 address.

Notes:
- Each type of address may only be given once. If more than one
value is specified, an event is traced only if all values
are matching.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: TYPE OF CCS7 ADDRESS


NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR
Compatibilities:
- ADDRESS =
SPC SIGNALING POINT CODE
Compatibilities:
- ADDRESS = 2^24-1 (=16777215)
GT GLOBAL TITLE
Compatibilities:
- ADDRESS = 1..24 decimal digits

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CONNTRAC- 4+


MOD CONNTRAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFICATION


Compatibilities:
- ADDRESS =
BSSAPINT BSSAP INTERNAL

b: ADDRESS=
1...24 characters from the
symbolic name character set

MODE MODE FOR ALTERING PARAMETERS

This parameter specifies the modus for altering the trace parameter
set.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ADD ADD PARAMETERS


SUB SUBSTRACT PARAMETERS
NEW NEW PARAMETERS

Default: NEW

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CONNTRAC- 5-


CAN CONTMON

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Continuity Monitor

This task cancels a Continuity monitor.

Inputparameter:
- TCS ID
This parameter identifies the transmission convergence sublayer (TCS).
- VPI
This parameter identifies the virtual path (VP). It is the VPI value present in
the header
of the corresponding ATM cells.
- VCI
This parameter identifies the virtual channel (VC). It is the VCI value present
in the header
of the corresponding ATM cells.
- Flow Direction
The flowDirection attribute indicate in which direction the
monitoring is made, in relation to the TP by which the monitor object
is named. The value outOfSwitch means that the monitored flow extends
from TP toward the network. The value inToSwitch means that monitored
flow extends from TP into the cross-connect.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN CONTMON : TCS ID= ,VPI= ,VCI= ,Flow Direction= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TCS ID

This parameter identifies the transmission convergence sublayer (TCS).

VPI

This parameter identifies the virtual path (VP). It is the VPI value
present in the header
of the corresponding ATM cells.

Input format:
0...4095, range of decimal numbers

VCI

This parameter identifies the virtual channel (VC). It is the VCI value
present in the header
of the corresponding ATM cells.

Input format:
0...65535, range of decimal numbers

Flow Direction

The flowDirection attribute indicate in which direction the


monitoring is made, in relation to the TP by which the monitor object
is named. The value outOfSwitch means that the monitored flow extends
from TP toward the network. The value inToSwitch means that monitored
flow extends from TP into the cross-connect.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CONTMON- 1-


CR CONTMON

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create Continuity Monitor

This task creates a Continuity monitor for VC.

The Continuity monitor models a Continuity Check (CC) OAM flow.


It represents the termination of a VC segment OAM flow.

The Continuity monitor provides a source mechanism


and a sink mechanism which can be activated separately by setting the parameters
Source active respectively Sink active to ’TRUE’.
To monitor a VC segment, a continuity monitor must be present on each segment
endpoint.

When the parameter Sink active is ’TRUE’ and the VC


is detected as disrupted, a communications alarm with the probable cause
set to ’Communications subsystem failure’ is issued.

The Continuity monitors shall be automatically deleted when the


superior VC is deleted.

Prerequistes:
- VC must exist
- VCs Admin. state must be Unlocked
- VCs Operational state must be Enabled

Inputparameters:
- TCS ID
This parameter identifies the transmission convergence sublayer (TCS).
- VPI
This parameter identifies the virtual path (VP). It is the VPI value present in
the header
of the corresponding ATM cells.
- VCI
This parameter identifies the virtual channel (VC). It is the VCI value present
in the header
of the corresponding ATM cells.
- Source active
This parameter indicates whether the generation of the continuity check OAM
flow is active.
- Sink active
This parameter indicates whether the processing of the continuity check OAM
flow is active.
- Flow Direction
The flowDirection attribute indicate in which direction the
monitoring is made, in relation to the TP by which the monitor object
is named. The value outOfSwitch means that the monitored flow extends
from TP toward the network. The value inToSwitch means that monitored
flow extends from TP into the cross-connect.If both flows (inToSwitch
and outOfSwitch) need to be monitored, then two monitor objects should
be created.

Outputparameters:
- TCS ID
- VPI
- VCI
- Source active
- Sink active
- Operational state
This parameter describes the operability of a resource.
It is read-only and can have one of the following values:
’Disabled’ The resource is totally inoperable and unable to provide
service to the user(s).
’Enabled’ The resource is partially or fully operable and
available for use.
- Alarm status
The parameter ’Alarm status’ can indicate the occurrence of:
1. an alarm condition, which will be notified and will be included into the
balance of the ’Alarm Balance Monitor’.
2. a pending alarm condition which will neither be notified
nor included into the balance of the ’Alarm Balance Monitor’. ’.
3. the highest alarm priority of active alarm conditions,
if more than one alarm condition is active for a unit.
The order of alarm priority from highest to lowest is:
- critical,
- major,
- minor,
- indeterminate,

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CONTMON- 1+
CR CONTMON

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- warning,
- active pending,
- cleared.
- Current problem list

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR CONTMON : TCS ID= ,VPI= ,VCI= ,Flow Direction= 1
1 1
1 ,Source active= ,Sink active= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TCS ID

This parameter identifies the transmission convergence sublayer (TCS).

VPI

This parameter identifies the virtual path (VP). It is the VPI value
present in the header
of the corresponding ATM cells.

Input format:
0...4095, range of decimal numbers

VCI

This parameter identifies the virtual channel (VC). It is the VCI value
present in the header
of the corresponding ATM cells.

Input format:
0...65535, range of decimal numbers

Flow Direction

The flowDirection attribute indicate in which direction the


monitoring is made, in relation to the TP by which the monitor object
is named. The value outOfSwitch means that the monitored flow extends
from TP toward the network. The value inToSwitch means that monitored
flow extends from TP into the cross-connect.If both flows (inToSwitch
and outOfSwitch) need to be monitored, then two monitor objects should
be created.

Source active

This parameter indicates whether the generation of the continuity check


OAM
flow is active.

Sink active

This parameter indicates whether the processing of the continuity check


OAM
flow is active.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CONTMON- 2-
DISP CONTMON

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Continuity Monitor

This task displays a Continuity monitor.

The Continuity monitor models a Continuity Check (CC) OAM flow.


It represents the termination of a VC segment OAM flow.

The Continuity monitor provides a source mechanism


and a sink mechanism which can be activated separately by setting the parameters
Source active respectively Sink active to ’TRUE’.
To monitor a VC segment, a continuity monitor must be present on each segment
endpoint.

When the parameter Sink active is ’TRUE’ and the VC


is detected as disrupted, a communications alarm with the probable cause
set to ’Communications subsystem failure’ is issued.

Inputparameters:
- TCS ID
This parameter identifies the transmission convergence sublayer (TCS).
- VPI
This parameter identifies the virtual path (VP). It is the VPI value present in
the header
of the corresponding ATM cells.
- VCI
This parameter identifies the virtual channel (VC). It is the VCI value present
in the header
of the corresponding ATM cells.
- VP TTP ID
This parameter identifies the virtual path (VP) within the network element (NE).
This parameter is given in alarm notifications.

Outputparameters:
- TCS ID
- VPI
- VCI
- Source active
- Sink active
- Operational state
This parameter describes the operability of a resource.
It is read-only and can have one of the following values:
’Disabled’ The resource is totally inoperable and unable to provide
service to the user(s).
’Enabled’ The resource is partially or fully operable and
available for use.
- Alarm status
The parameter ’Alarm status’ can indicate the
occurrence of:
1. an alarm condition, which will be notified and will be included into the
balance of the ’Alarm Balance Monitor’.
2. a pending alarm condition which will neither be notified
nor included into the balance of the ’Alarm Balance Monitor’. ’.
3. the highest alarm priority of active alarm conditions,
if more than one alarm condition is active for a unit.
The order of alarm priority from highest to lowest is:
- critical,
- major,
- minor,
- indeterminate,
- warning,
- active pending,
- cleared.
- Current problem list

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CONTMON : [TCS ID=] [,VPI=] [,VP TTP ID=] [,VCI=] 1
1 1
1 [,Flow Direction=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CONTMON- 1+


DISP CONTMON

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TCS ID

This parameter identifies the transmission convergence sublayer (TCS).

VPI

This parameter identifies the virtual path (VP). It is the VPI value
present in the header
of the corresponding ATM cells.
If this parameter is entered, parameter ’TCS ID’ is mandatory.

Input format:
0...4095, range of decimal numbers

VP TTP ID

This parameter identifies the virtual path (VP) within the network
element (NE).
It can be used only if VPI is assigned
This parameter is given in alarm notifications.
If this parameter is entered, parameter ’TCS ID’ is mandatory.

VCI

This parameter identifies the virtual channel (VC). It is the VCI value
present in the header
of the corresponding ATM cells.
If this parameter is entered, parameter ’TCS ID’ is mandatory.

Input format:
0...65535, range of decimal numbers

Flow Direction

The flowDirection attribute indicate in which direction the


monitoring is made, in relation to the TP by which the monitor object
is named. The value outOfSwitch means that the monitored flow extends
from TP toward the network. The value inToSwitch means that monitored
flow extends from TP into the cross-connect.
If this parameter is entered, parameter ’TCS ID’ is mandatory.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CONTMON- 2-


MOD CONTMON

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Continuity Monitor

This task modifies a Continuity monitor.

The Continuity monitor models a Continuity Check (CC) OAM flow.


It represents the termination of a VC segment OAM flow.

The Continuity monitor provides a source mechanism


and a sink mechanism which can be activated separately by setting the parameters
Source active respectively Sink active to ’TRUE’.
To monitor a VC segment, a continuity monitor must be present on each segment
endpoint.

When the parameter Sink active is ’TRUE’ and the VC


is detected as disrupted, a communications alarm with the probable cause
set to ’Communications subsystem failure’ is issued.

Prerequistes:
To activate the source mechanism or the sink mechanism, the
- VCs Admin. state must be Unlocked
- VCs Operational state must be Enabled

Inputparameter:
- TCS ID
This parameter identifies the transmission convergence sublayer (TCS).
- VPI
This parameter identifies the virtual path (VP). It is the VPI value present in
the header
of the corresponding ATM cells.
- VCI
This parameter identifies the virtual channel (VC). It is the VCI value present
in the header
of the corresponding ATM cells.
- Flow Direction
The flowDirection attribute indicate in which direction the
monitoring is made, in relation to the TP by which the monitor object
is named. The value outOfSwitch means that the monitored flow extends
from TP toward the network. The value inToSwitch means that monitored
flow extends from TP into the cross-connect.
- Source active
This parameter indicates whether the generation of the continuity check OAM
flow is active.
It may be set to TRUE only if the current value is FALSE and vice versa.
- Sink active
This parameter indicates whether the processing of the continuity check OAM
flow is active.
It may be set to TRUE only if the current value is FALSE and vice versa.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD CONTMON : TCS ID= ,VPI= ,VCI= ,Flow Direction= 1
1 1
1 [,Source active=] [,Sink active=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TCS ID

This parameter identifies the transmission convergence sublayer (TCS).

VPI

This parameter identifies the virtual path (VP). It is the VPI value
present in the header
of the corresponding ATM cells.

Input format:
0...4095, range of decimal numbers

VCI

This parameter identifies the virtual channel (VC). It is the VCI value

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CONTMON- 1+


MOD CONTMON

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

present in the header


of the corresponding ATM cells.

Input format:
0...65535, range of decimal numbers

Flow Direction

The flowDirection attribute indicate in which direction the


monitoring is made, in relation to the TP by which the monitor object
is named. The value outOfSwitch means that the monitored flow extends
from TP toward the network. The value inToSwitch means that monitored
flow extends from TP into the cross-connect.

Source active

This parameter indicates whether the generation of the continuity check


OAM
flow is active.
It may be set to TRUE only if the current value is FALSE and vice versa.

Sink active

This parameter indicates whether the processing of the continuity check


OAM
flow is active.
It may be set to TRUE only if the current value is FALSE and vice versa.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CONTMON- 2-


CONF COU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURATE CONFERENCE UNIT

This command configures a conference unit to one of the states


PLA, MBL, ACT or CBL.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF COU : LTG= ,COU= ,OST= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LTG NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LTGSET NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

COU CONFERENCE UNIT

This parameter specifies the unit number in an LTG.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

OST OPERATING STATUS

This parameter specifies the target operating state.


The following state transitions are permitted:

MBL <-> PLA


MBL --> ACT
MBL <-- ACT (when the LTG is not active)
ACT <-> CBL
UNA --> ACT, MBL, CBL

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CBL CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED


ACT ACTIVE
PLA PLANNED
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF COU- 1-


DIAG COU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSE CONFERENCE UNIT

This command starts diagnosis of a conference unit in an LTG.


Precondition: the LTG must be in the operating status
ACT or CBL and the associated COU must be in the
operating status MBL.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG COU : LTG= ,COU= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LTG NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LTGSET NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

COU CONFERENCE UNIT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG COU- 1-


STAT COU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY STATUS OF CONFERENCE UNIT

This command displays the operating status of


- one COU in a certain LTG
- one COU in all LTGs
- all COUs in a particular LTG
- all COUs in all LTGs
- all COUs in a particular operating status in a particular
LTG
- all COUs in a particular operating status in all LTGs
For the parameter LTG a value or X must always be entered.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT COU : LTG= [,COU=] [,OST=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LTG NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: LTGSET NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

COU CONFERENCE UNIT

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

OST OPERATING STATUS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
CBL CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED
UNA UNAVAILABLE
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED
PLA PLANNED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT COU- 1-


REC CP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RECORD COORDINATION PROCESSOR

This command initiates recording of CP traffic data (total load and


callprocessing load).

Prerequisites:
- System time must be secure when the command is entered.

Notes:
- The name of the measurement file is displayed on the OMT
if disk output of traffic data is requested.
- Only one measurement job can be started.
- The traffic data are output every 15 minutes within the
selected measurement intervals.
At least 15 minutes elapse before the first data are output
with immediate start.
- The measurement can be stopped with STOP JOB, except
jobs with UNIT=MDD-DAILY OR CYCLIC.

This command starts a semipermanent job. It can be canceled with CAN JOB.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REC CP : [INTTIM=] ,UNIT= [,BEG=] [,TER=] [,IV=] [,PER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

INTTIM INTEGRATION TIME

This parameter specifies the time over which the load values are
to be averaged (integrated).
If output is to the OMT, it is not permissible to enter SEC4.

Default: MIN3

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SEC4 4 SECONDS
SEC36 36 SECONDS
MIN1 1 MINUTE
MIN3 3 MINUTES
MIN5 5 MINUTES
MIN15 15 MINUTES

UNIT OUTPUT UNIT AND MODE

This parameter specifies the output unit and the mode of


output.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: OUTPUT UNIT
OMT OPERATION AND MAIN.TERMINAL
If this option is selected, data are output
to the OMT.
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
If this option is selected, a measurement file
is created and the traffic data are output to
this file. The start and the finish message
include the name of the file in which the
traffic data are available for postprocessing.

Notes :
- If a file is destroyed or cannot be extended,
an advisory is sent to the OMT.

This information unit specifies the output unit.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC CP- 1+


REC CP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: OUTPUT MODE
SINGLE SINGLE TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are output
to a single measurement file.
DAILY DAILY TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are output
to daily files. The measurement starts
immediately and has no defined end. Time
parameters are not permitted.
To secure the required space on disk, all 7
daily files are prepared and created at the
start of measurement.
A daily file is closed at the end of the day
and a new file for the next day is
automatically created, or the existing file is
replaced.
Daily files will be overwritten in the
following week on the same weekday.
CYCLIC CYCLIC TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
written into a cyclic measurement file.
Time parameters are not permitted for
these measurements.
If the cyclic file runs full, the newest
data will be lost. This occurs
after a period of two days.

This information unit specifies the desired output


mode (daily or single or cyclic measurement file).
It is only permissible in connection with output
UNIT=MDD.

BEG BEGIN DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement begin date.

Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER
must be specified.
Exception: Time parameters cannot be specified for data
output in daily or cyclic files.
- A maximum of four BEG dates in chronological order may
be linked with &. In the case of linked BEG dates, TER
is not permitted.
If no TER is selected, the measurement is active on the
specified BEG days only.
- The earliest possible begin date BEG is the day after
command input.
- The first BEG date must be within an interval of one
month starting from the current date.
- The other BEG dates must be within an interval of
one year starting from the current date.
- The measurement on the actual BEG day can be stopped
with STOP JOB. If the measurement is stopped on the
last BEG day, it will be finished.

Default: the begin of measurement is the current date.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

TER TERMINATION DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement termination date.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC CP- 2+


REC CP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER
must be specified.
Exception: Time parameters may not be specified for data
output in daily or cyclic files.
- Only one termination date may be entered.
The earliest possible termination date is the day after
command input.
- The measurement duration must not exceed one year.
- If no BEG parameter is entered, recording starts
immediately.

Default: the end of measurement is determined by the last


single day (BEG).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF TERMINATION DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

IV INTERVAL TIME

This parameter indicates interval times of the measurement.

Notes:
- Interval times IV are only permitted if at least one
begin date BEG is selected.
- A maximum of 4 measurement intervals in chronological
order may be linked with &. Linked intervals have to be
at least 30 minutes apart except for measurements over
midnight.
- An interval may not include midnight, e.g. IV =
23-00-01-00 is not permitted.
A measurement over midnight requires the input of two
interval times, e.g. IV = 00-00-01-00&23-00-00-00.
- The measurement is active during the specified interval
times only.
- The measurement can be stopped during the actual interval
IV with STOP JOB. If the measurement is stopped
during the last interval IV, it will be finished.

Default: 24-hour measurement on the specified days

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: BEGIN HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: BEGIN MINUTE=
0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

c: TERMINATION HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

d: TERMINATION MINUTE=
0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

PER PERIODIC WEEKDAY

This parameter specifies the weekdays on which data

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC CP- 3+


REC CP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

have to be recorded.

Notes:
- Input of weekdays is only permissible in
connection with a termination date (TER).
- Up to 6 of the values may be linked with &, except
the values NO, WO and HO which cannot be
linked with other values.

Default: measurement every day during the measurement


period

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

NO NO SPECIFIED PERIOD
Measurement every day
MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY
Days which are full working days
HO HOLIDAY
Full national and international holidays are
included.
The full weekend day (the day marked EF
in the DISP WDCAT output mask) is included.
Half holidays are not included.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC CP- 4-


ACT CPDMPC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE CP DUMP CONDITIONS

This command activates a dump condition with specification of CP core storage


address range. The CP dump conditions are activated upon command entry.

This command is normally logged.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1RADDR=1 1
1 ACT CPDMPC : ZAADDR=Y [,SWSG=] [,UNIT=] [,MODULE=] [,COUNT=] 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 [,LEVEL=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RADDR RELATIVE ADDRESS

Only 5 address ranges are allowed

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

a-b

a: MODULE NAME=
8 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This information unit allows only alphanumeric characters.

b: OFFSET=
0...7FFFFF, range of hexadecimal numbers

AADDR ABSOLUTE ADDRESS

Only 5 address ranges are allowed

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...10 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

SWSG SWSG IDENTIFICATION

For a SWSG number less than 128


a module name must be specified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...999, range of decimal numbers

UNIT CP PROCESSOR UNIT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BAP0 BASE PROCESSOR 0


BAP1 BASE PROCESSOR 1
BAPM MASTER BASE PROCESSOR

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CPDMPC- 1+


ACT CPDMPC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

BAPS SPARE BASE PROCESSOR


CAP0 CALL PROCESSOR 0
CAP1 CALL PROCESSOR 1
CAP2 CALL PROCESSOR 2
CAP3 CALL PROCESSOR 3
CAP4 CALL PROCESSOR 4
CAP5 CALL PROCESSOR 5
CAP6 CALL PROCESSOR 6
CAP7 CALL PROCESSOR 7
CAP8 CALL PROCESSOR 8
CAP9 CALL PROCESSOR 9
AMP0 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 0
AMP1 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 1
AMP2 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 2
AMP3 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3
AMP4 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 4
AMP5 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 5

MODULE MODULE NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

COUNT TERMINATION COUNT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10, range of decimal numbers

Default: 1

LEVEL RECOVERY LEVEL

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NSTART3 NEWSTART WITH CODE LOAD


NSTART2 NEWSTART WITH SEMIDATA LOAD
NSTART1 NEWSTART OF ALL PROCESSES
SASDATS SAVING SW DATA WITH STATISTICS
SASDAT SAVING SW DATA W/O STATISTICS
NSTART0 NEWSTART NON CALLPROS. GROUP
The only non-call-processing processes
are restarted.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CPDMPC- 2-


DACT CPDMPC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE CONDITIONAL CPDUMP

This command deactivates conditions set in the dump condition list.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT CPDMPC : ID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the deactivation conditions.

Note:
- Up to 10 information units can be linked with &.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...20, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT CPDMPC- 1-


DISP CPDMPC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CONDITIONAL CPDUMP

This command displays the conditional CP dump addresses and conditions


as well as their present state.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CPDMPC ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CPDMPC- 1-


DMP CPIMDMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DUMP CP MEMORY IMMEDIATE DUMP

This command supplies a consistent display of memory contents of CP


platforms or of the corresponding load library on system disk.

If UNIT = DISK is entered, the specified address range to be


dumped will be read from load library.
To dump contents of a platform’s memory, select the appropriate
platform using parameter PLF.

You can specify up to five different address ranges to be dumped,


or, in case of a dump of memory, chained lists of data.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1PLF= 1 1
1 DMP CPIMDMP : ZUNIT=Y ,ADDR= [,LENGTH=] [,CHOFFS=] [,CHNO=] 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 [,FORMAT=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the CP platform.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BAP0 BASE PROCESSOR 0


BAP1 BASE PROCESSOR 1
CAP0 CALL PROCESSOR 0
CAP1 CALL PROCESSOR 1
CAP2 CALL PROCESSOR 2
CAP3 CALL PROCESSOR 3
CAP4 CALL PROCESSOR 4
CAP5 CALL PROCESSOR 5
CAP6 CALL PROCESSOR 6
CAP7 CALL PROCESSOR 7
CAP8 CALL PROCESSOR 8
CAP9 CALL PROCESSOR 9
AMP0 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 0
AMP1 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 1
AMP2 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 2
AMP3 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3
AMP4 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 4
AMP5 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 5
BAPM BASE PROCESSOR MASTER
BAPS BASE PROCESSOR SPARE

This unit specifies the platform type.

UNIT SYSTEM UNIT

This parameter specifies the system unit.


If disk is selected a linear dump of the content of the CP loadlib
at the specified address range will be performed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DISK REQUEST READ FROM DISK

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP CPIMDMP- 1+


DMP CPIMDMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ADDR LIST OF ADDRESS RANGES

This parameter defines the address (range) of the memory


content to be dumped.
For dumping a linear memory content, 2 ways of specifying
the address limits of the dump can be used:
either an address range is entered with ADDR,
or, if only the start address is given, you have to specify
the length of the dump using parameter LENGTH.
In case of dumping chained elements (a linked list), only
a start address has to be specified, the length of each
chained element has to be entered via parameter LENGTH.

Following inputs are possible:

- Address is specified relative to a module begin, i.e capsule,


SPU, and module name are entered (8 characters each), plus a
distance within the module
e.g.: ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE0C_0006" or
ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE0C_0006+H’23F"
Offsets are hexadecimal numbers preceded by the letter "H" and a
single quote.
The module version number (underline and 4 digits) may be
omitted.
Notes:
module names have to be entered always in combination with
the corresponding SPU names.

- A symbolic address can be specified by using a symbol name (i.e.


the name of a granted object, length 8 characters):
e.g.: ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE0C_0006.SYMBOLA0+H’12A4"

- Address ranges must be specified by entering the start address


and the upper limit, separated by "&&".
e.g.: ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE0C.SYMBOLA0"&&
"SPU00A0A.MODULE0C.SYMBOLA0+H’F4"

The capsule name has to be entered with the start address only and
must be omitted with the upper limit of the address range.

The upper limit of an address range may be specified in


relation to the lower limit in the following way:
e.g.: ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE0C+H’AF"&&"+H’21"
shorthand for
ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE0C+H’AF"&&
"SPU00A0A.MODULE0C+H’CF"
The second address is interpreted as number of bytes to be dumped if
it begins with the character plus ("+").

- Symbolic addresses can be specified by using labels. A label is


preceded by the letter "L" and a single quote:
e.g.: ADDR="CAPSCA0A.L’LABELBEG+H’476EBF"

- Symbolic address by using the value of an exported symbol (8


characters) as an additional offset:

e.g.: ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE1C_2401.SYMBOLA0
+SPU00A0A.MODULE2P_0101.CONST000" or
ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE1C
+SPU00A0A.MODULE2P.CONST000+H’0FF4"

If both module names are identical, the second one may be


omitted.
e.g.: ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE1C_2401.SYMBOLA0+.CONST000"
instead of
ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE1C_2401.SYMBOL
+SPU00A0A.MODULE1C_2401.CONST000".

- Absolute address within capsule in hexadecimal form:


e.g.: ADDR="CAPSCA0A+H’2A476EBF"&&"+H’28"

- Absolute address within a load module in hexadecimal form:


e.g.: ADDR="LDMOD00X+H’10ED04D0"&&"+H’28"

- Indirect dump can be specified by a begin address: It contains


a pointer which indicates the real start address preceded by
the letters "IN" and a single quote:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP CPIMDMP- 2+


DMP CPIMDMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

e.g.: ADDR="IN’CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE1C+H’8"

Up to 5 different address ranges may be entered, concatenated by "&".

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

LENGTH LENGTH OF CHAINED ELEMENT

This parameter provides the length of a single chained


element of a linked list, or, in case of a linear dump,
the number of bytes which shall be dumped if only a start
address is entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

CHOFFS OFFSET OF POINTER TO NEXT ELE.

This parameter specifies the offset of the link pointer


to the next element within the chained (linked) list to
be dumped.
The memory location of this pointer is the begin address
of the current chained element plus the offset defined by
CHOFFS.

Notes:
- a dump of a linked list is specified by the corresponding
parameters LENGTH, CHOFFS, and CHNO.
- chained elements can only be dumped from CP memory and not
from system disk.
- all pointers of the chained list must have the same
offset within their corresponding chained elements.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...65535, range of decimal numbers

CHNO NUMBER OF CHAINED ELEMENTS

This parameter specifies the number of chained elements to be


dumped. If the current linked list contains less elements than
the value specified, only the current number of chained elements
will be dumped.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...50, range of decimal numbers

Default: 50

FORMAT FORMAT OF OUTPUT

This parameter specifies the format type of the output.


If HEX is chosen an output in hexadecimal form will be
produced, in case of ASCII the output will contain ASCII
characters additionally to the hex output.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

HEX HEXADECIMAL OUTPUT


SYMBOL SYMBOLIC OUTPUT
ASCII ASCII OUTPUT

Default: ASCII

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP CPIMDMP- 3-


ACT CPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE CP PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can activate one or more Permanent


Patches in the memory of those platforms indicated under parameter
PLF. Successful execution of the command results in execution
of the atomic action AM (Activate in Memory) in
parallel on all respective platforms in operation.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT CPPRPCH : ID= [,PLF=] [,LIB=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

PLF LIST OF PLATFORMS

This parameter specifies the CP platform where a Permanent


Patch is to be processed.
If the parameter is omitted the command concerns all
platforms in operation.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

BAP0 BASE PROCESSOR 0


BAP1 BASE PROCESSOR 1
CAP0 CALL PROCESSOR 0
CAP1 CALL PROCESSOR 1
CAP2 CALL PROCESSOR 2
CAP3 CALL PROCESSOR 3
CAP4 CALL PROCESSOR 4
CAP5 CALL PROCESSOR 5
CAP6 CALL PROCESSOR 6
CAP7 CALL PROCESSOR 7
CAP8 CALL PROCESSOR 8
CAP9 CALL PROCESSOR 9
AMP0 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 0
AMP1 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 1
AMP2 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 2
AMP3 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3
AMP4 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 4
AMP5 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 5
BAPM BASE PROCESSOR MASTER
BAPS BASE PROCESSOR SPARE

This unit specifies the platform type.

LIB LIBRARY NAME

This parameter represents the name of the library associated


with the platform to be patched.
If the parameter is omitted, the library specified via

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CPPRPCH- 1+


ACT CPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

parameter ID is taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CPPRPCH- 2-


CAN CPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CP PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can cancel one or more Permanent


Patches on disk implicitly deactivating them in the memory on all
platforms in operation. Successful execution of the command
results in execution of the atomic actions DUD
(Deupdate on Disk), DAM (Deactivate in Memory) and CD (Cancel
on Disk).

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN CPPRPCH : ID= [,LIB=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

LIB LIBRARY NAME

This parameter represents the name of the library associated


with the platform to be patched.
If the parameter is omitted, the library specified via
parameter ID is taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CPPRPCH- 1-


DACT CPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE CP PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can deactivate one or more Permanent


Patches in the memory of those platforms indicated under parameter
PLF. Successful execution of the command results in execution
of the atomic actions DUD (Deupdate on Disk) and
DAM (Deactivate in Memory) in parallel on all respective
platforms in operation.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT CPPRPCH : ID= [,PLF=] [,LIB=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

PLF LIST OF PLATFORMS

This parameter specifies the CP platform where a Permanent


Patch is to be processed.
If the parameter is omitted the command concerns all
platforms in operation.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

BAP0 BASE PROCESSOR 0


BAP1 BASE PROCESSOR 1
CAP0 CALL PROCESSOR 0
CAP1 CALL PROCESSOR 1
CAP2 CALL PROCESSOR 2
CAP3 CALL PROCESSOR 3
CAP4 CALL PROCESSOR 4
CAP5 CALL PROCESSOR 5
CAP6 CALL PROCESSOR 6
CAP7 CALL PROCESSOR 7
CAP8 CALL PROCESSOR 8
CAP9 CALL PROCESSOR 9
AMP0 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 0
AMP1 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 1
AMP2 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 2
AMP3 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3
AMP4 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 4
AMP5 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 5
BAPM BASE PROCESSOR MASTER
BAPS BASE PROCESSOR SPARE

This unit specifies the platform type.

LIB LIBRARY NAME

This parameter represents the name of the library associated


with the platform to be patched.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT CPPRPCH- 1+


DACT CPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

If the parameter is omitted, the library specified via


parameter ID is taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT CPPRPCH- 2-


DISP CPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CP PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can display patch data kept in the
patch administration on disk and patch states concerning
Permanent Patches for all platform(s) in operation specified
by parameter PLF.
The patch selection can be performed either by patch identifier(s)
using parameter ID or by logical address ranges affected by
the patches, using parameter ADDR.
In case of using parameter ADDR, the filling levels of the
Patch Area and the Patch Administration are displayed
additionally.
To limit the list of patch IDs, it is possible to specify
combinations of following parameters:
BEGDATE, BEGTIME, ENDDATE, ENDTIME and PATSTATE

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1ID= 1 1
1 DISP CPPRPCH : ZADDR=Y [,PLF=] [,LIB=] [,BEGDATE=] 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 [,BEGTIME=] [,ENDDATE=] [,ENDTIME=] [,PATSTATE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.
It is also possible to use wildcard signs (*) or (?) as part
of the patchname. In this case all patches found within the
specified capsule and fulfilling the wildcard criteria will
be displayed.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname" or
ID="capsname.*" or
ID="capsname.A?CD*EF"

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

10...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

ADDR LIST OF ADDRESS RANGES

This parameter represents an interval in which the search


for patches will be performed. An address can be specified
either in hexadecimal form as an offset from capsule begin or
symbolically.

e.g.: ADDR="capname.address"&&"address" or
ADDR="capname.address"&&"+distance"

where address may have one of the following


structures:

"spuname.modname+offset+distance", or
"spuname.modname.symbol+offset+distance", or
"label+offset+distance", or

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CPPRPCH- 1+


DISP CPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

"offset+distance", where

capname <text string> = 8 char.,


label L’<text string> = 8 char.,
spuname <text string> = 8 char.,
modname <text string> = 8 char. (or 13 if the
version is included),
symbol <text string> <= 8 char.,
offset <hexadecimal string> <= 8 hex signs,
distance disitem+disitem ..+disitem..,
disitem spuname.modname.symbol or offset

The end address of an interval may be omitted. If it is


omitted in the case of capsule or module the entire address
range of the unit is scanned. If it is omitted in the case of
symbol or offset the search range is that byte only.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

PLF LIST OF PLATFORMS

This parameter specifies the CP platform where a Permanent


Patch is to be processed.
If the parameter is omitted the command concerns all
platforms in operation.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

BAP0 BASE PROCESSOR 0


BAP1 BASE PROCESSOR 1
CAP0 CALL PROCESSOR 0
CAP1 CALL PROCESSOR 1
CAP2 CALL PROCESSOR 2
CAP3 CALL PROCESSOR 3
CAP4 CALL PROCESSOR 4
CAP5 CALL PROCESSOR 5
CAP6 CALL PROCESSOR 6
CAP7 CALL PROCESSOR 7
CAP8 CALL PROCESSOR 8
CAP9 CALL PROCESSOR 9
AMP0 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 0
AMP1 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 1
AMP2 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 2
AMP3 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3
AMP4 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 4
AMP5 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 5
BAPM BASE PROCESSOR MASTER
BAPS BASE PROCESSOR SPARE

This unit specifies the platform type.

LIB LIBRARY NAME

This parameter represents the name of the library associated


with the platform to be patched.
If the parameter is omitted, the library specified via
parameter ID is taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

BEGDATE BEGIN DATE

This parameter specifies the begin date of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGTIME,
ENDDATE and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter BEGDATE: 2000:01:01

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CPPRPCH- 2+


DISP CPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

BEGTIME BEGIN TIME

This parameter specifies the begin time of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
ENDDATE and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter BEGTIME: 00:00:00

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECOND=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

ENDDATE END DATE

This parameter specifies the end date of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
BEGTIME and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter ENDDATE: actual date

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

ENDTIME END TIME

This parameter specifies the end time of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
BEGTIME and ENDDATE.
Default value of parameter ENDTIME: 23:59:59

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CPPRPCH- 3+


DISP CPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECOND=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

PATSTATE PATCH STATE

This parameter is used to limit the list of patch IDs


displayed to those patches having the entered PATSTATE.
If this parameter is omitted, every patch will be displayed
regardless of its state in the system.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NOTENTER NEITHER ENTERING NOR ENTERED


HIT HIT
ENTRG ENTERING
ENTRD ENTERED
NOTUPD OTHER THAN UPDATED
PARTACT PARTLY ACTIVE
ACT ACTIVE
UPD UPDATED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CPPRPCH- 4-


ENTR CPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CP PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can enter a Permanent Patch into the
patch administration on disk. Successful execution of the
command results in execution of the atomic action ED (Enter on
Disk).
With each ENTR CPPRPCH command one of the four different
subpatch types can be entered:

- Insert Rucksack Subpatches using parameter INSRADDR


- Replace Subpatches using parameter REPADDR
- Insert Procedure Subpatches using parameter INSPREF
- Insert Variable Subpatches using parameter INSVREF

The subpatch types can be entered in the form of subpatches


belonging to a specified Patch ID. Under one specified Patch ID
subpatches of different types can be inserted into the system.
For each subpatch of a patch a new ENTR CPPRPCH command is
necessary.
The completeness of the subpatches is indicated by means of
parameter SUBPCHNO.
All Subpatches with the exception of Insert Variable can be
entered in subpatch parts for each part using an individual
ENTR CPPRPCH command. All subpatch parts except Insert
Procedure Subpatches are referred to the same patch address.
The concatenation of those subpatch parts is supported by
means of parameter SUBPPART.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,INSRADDR=1 1
1 1,REPADDR= 1 1
1 ENTR CPPRPCH : ID= Z,INSPREF= Y [,SUBPPART=] [,NEWCNT= 1
1 1,INSVREF= 1 1
1 1,SUBPCHNO=1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 [,OLDCNT=]] [,LIB=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID PATCH IDENTIFIER

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name. Whenever a subpatch or
subpatch part is entered for a certain patch the identifier
must be identical.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

INSRADDR INSERT RUCKSACK SUBPATCH ADDR.

This parameter provides the insert rucksack subpatch


address. The address format is an interval within the
module boundaries in the form of begin address and end
address (linked by &&) whereby the latter may be given as a
distance relative to the begin address. At the begin address
the instruction is replaced by a branch instruction for jumping
to the respective rucksack. The end address serves as
continuation address from which the program will continue
after the rucksack code has been executed.
The old instruction (6 Byte), overwritten by the branch

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CPPRPCH- 1+


ENTR CPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

instruction, is at user’s own risk to add to the rucksack


or not.
An address can be specified either in hexadecimal form as an
offset from capsule begin or symbolically.

e.g.: INSRADDR="spuname.modname.symbol+distance" or
INSRADDR="offset+distance" or
INSRADDR="label+distance",

&&"spuname.modname.symbol+distance" or
&&"label+distance" or
&&"+offset" ,where

label L’<text string> = 8 char.,


spuname <text string> = 8 char.,
modname <text string> = 8 char. (or 13 if the
version is included),
symbol <text string> <= 8 char.,
offset H’<hexadecimal string> <= 8 hex signs,
distance disitem+disitem ..+disitem..,
disitem spuname.modname.symbol or offset

The given address is valid for the capsule denoted within


parameter ID.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

REPADDR REPLACE SUBPATCH ADDRESS

This parameter provides the replace subpatch address. The


address format is a replacement address, where address can
be specified in the same way as described for the first part
of INSRADDR.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

INSPREF INSERT PROCED. SUBPATCH REFER.

This parameter provides the insert procedure subpatch


reference as a mnemonic including the number <n> of the
insert procedure.
The inserted procedure is only visible within the defining
patch. The number <n> serves to address the inserted
procedure within other subpatches of the defining patch.

e.g.: INSPREF="IP’5"

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...6 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

INSVREF INSERT VARIAB. SUBPATCH REFER.

This parameter provides the insert variable subpatch


reference as a mnemonic including the number <n> of the
insert variable and the length of the variable in bytes.
The inserted variable is only visible within the defining
patch.

e.g.: INSVREF="IV’5"-50

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: "INSERT VARIABLE" SUBPATCH REFERENCE=


4...6 characters from the
text string character set, enclosed in "

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CPPRPCH- 2+


ENTR CPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This unit serves to address the inserted variable


within other subpatches of the defining patch.

b: LENGTH OF INSERT VARIABLE IN BYTES=


1...4096, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the length of the variable to be


declared.

SUBPCHNO TOTAL NUMBER OF SUBPATCHES

This parameter represents the total number of subpatches


belonging to a Patch ID. A patch must be closed by a final
ENTR CPPRPCH command with the parameters ID and
SUBPCHNO, whereby the latter one corresponds to the number
of patches, entered under the same ID.
This command causes the transition of the patch state from
ENTRG to ENTRD.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...59, range of decimal numbers

SUBPPART ACTUAL NUMBER OF SUBPATCH PART

This parameter characterizes a part of a subpatch. A subpatch


of a Permanent Patch may, for some reason, have more than one
part in the case of Insert Rucksack Subpatch, Permanent
Replace Subpatch, or Insert Procedure Subpatch.

e.g.: SUBPPART="partcounter-lastsign"

The partcounter denotes the subpatch part sequence number


and serves as concatenation controller.
The lastsign denotes either the last or not last part of a
subpatch.

If SUBPPART is omitted, e.g., typical proceeding in case


of a short subpatch consisting of only one part, the default
value 1-LAST is assumed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: ACTUAL NUMBER OF SUBPATCH PART TO BE ENTERED=


1...999, range of decimal numbers

This unit denotes the subpatch part sequence number.

b: INDICATOR THAT LAST PART OF SUBPATCH IS ENTERED


NOTLAST NOT LAST SUBPATCH PART
LAST LAST SUBPATCH PART

This unit denotes either last or not last part.

NEWCNT NEW CONTENT OF SUBPATCH

This parameter represents the new instruction code to be


executed instead of the old instruction code which may be
represented by parameter OLDCNT.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

OLDCNT OLD CONTENT AT SUBPATCH LOCAT.

This parameter represents the old instruction code to be


checked for security reasons.
Must not be used for Insert Variable or Insert Procedure
subpatches.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CPPRPCH- 3+


ENTR CPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

LIB LIBRARY NAME

This parameter represents the name of the library associated


with the platform to be patched.
If the parameter is omitted, the library specified via
parameter ID is taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CPPRPCH- 4-


UPD CPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

UPDATE CP PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can update one or more Permanent


Patches on disk, whereby they are implicitly activated in
memory on all active platforms. Successful execution of the
command results in execution of the atomic actions
AM (Activate in Memory) and UD (Update on Disk).

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 UPD CPPRPCH : ID= [,LIB=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

LIB LIBRARY NAME

This parameter represents the name of the library associated


with the platform to be patched.
If the parameter is omitted, the library specified via
parameter ID is taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 UPD CPPRPCH- 1-


CAN CPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CODE POINT

This command cancels the specified code point. Call attempts to the canceled
code point will be diverted to the specified intercept code.

Prerequisites :
- If the code point was created with special codes
MFCAT (MFC CATEGORY),
ZDIG (LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT),
ROUTYP (ROUTE TYPE),
ORIG1 (ORIGINATING MARK 1) or
LAC (LOCAL AREA CODE)
these without their positions within the digit combination must be
specified when the code point is to be canceled.
- Any code blocking (CR CBPT), trunk reservation (ENTR TRSVCRIT),
destination (REC DEST) or code measurement (ENTR NTMINFO) that is
existing for the code point, or part of the code point to be canceled,
should be canceled first, because no checks are done.

An indication of whether other code points or test points use the


destination area of the canceled code point is output.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN CPT : CODE= [,INCEPT=] [,LAC=] [,ORIG1=] [,MFCAT=] 1
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,ANNDIG=11 (;) 1
1 [,ZDIG=] [,ROUTYP=] 1Z,TXTNO= Y1 Z Y 1
1 11 11 *!+ 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter specifies the digit combination of the code point to be


canceled. If the code point was created with special codes then these
have to be entered to define the code point uniquely.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

INCEPT INTERCEPT

This parameter determines the intercept code to which call attempts


will be diverted. If the intercept UNOBDE0 is entered, the code
point will be deleted completely. If no value is entered, the value
UNOBDE0 is used by default.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION
UNOBDE0 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 00
UNOBDE1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 01
UNOBDE2 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 02
UNOBDE3 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 03
UNOBDE4 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 04
UNOBDE5 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 05
UNOBDE6 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 06
UNOBDE7 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 07
UNOBDE8 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 08
UNOBDE9 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 09
UNOBDE10 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 10
UNOBDE11 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 11

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CPT- 1+


CAN CPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

UNALLROU UNALLOCATED ROUTE


ILLDEST ILLEGAL DESTINATION
UNOBDE12 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 12
UNOBDE13 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 13
CHCPTIND CHANGED CODE POINT IND. ANN.
RESANN RESERVE USER ANNOUNCEMENT
Unit b must be specified.

b: RESERVE USER ANNOUNCEMENT NUMBER=


0...9, range of decimal numbers

This parameter determines the number of the reserve


user announcement intercept.

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code for which


the destination is addressed. Only decimal numbers,
range 0..3839, and the hexadecimal number ’DEF’ may be
entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: ORIGINATING MARK=
1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: POSITION OF ORIGINATING MARK=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit is not evaluated and exists only


to be compatible to the syntax of older
EWSD-versions.

MFCAT MFC CATEGORY

This parameter specifies branch categories.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: CATEGORY
SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT
COINB COIN BOX
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
OPOSINAT OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15

b: POSITION OF CATEGORY=
1...24, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CPT- 2+


CAN CPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This unit is not evaluated and exists only


to be compatible to the syntax of older
EWSD-versions.

ZDIG LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT

This parameter specifies up to 16 different digital switchboards.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT=


1 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: POSITION OF LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit is not evaluated and exists only


to be compatible to the syntax of older
EWSD-versions.

ROUTYP ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the route type for ISDN traffic.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ROUTYP0 ROUTE TYPE 00


ROUTYP1 ROUTE TYPE 01
ROUTYP2 ROUTE TYPE 02
ROUTYP3 ROUTE TYPE 03
ROUTYP4 ROUTE TYPE 04
ROUTYP5 ROUTE TYPE 05
ROUTYP6 ROUTE TYPE 06
ROUTYP7 ROUTE TYPE 07
ROUTYP8 ROUTE TYPE 08
ROUTYP9 ROUTE TYPE 09
ROUTYP10 ROUTE TYPE 10
ROUTYP11 ROUTE TYPE 11
ROUTYP12 ROUTE TYPE 12
ROUTYP13 ROUTE TYPE 13
ROUTYP14 ROUTE TYPE 14
ROUTYP15 ROUTE TYPE 15

ANNDIG INDIVIDUAL ANNOUNCEMENT DIGITS

This parameter specifies the digits to be announced.


This parameter may only be entered if INCEPT = CHCPTIND.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TXTNO TEXT NUMBER OF ANNOUNCEMENT

This parameter specifies the number of the text to be announced.


This parameter may only be entered if INCEPT = RESANN-X.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CPT- 3-


CR CPT
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE CODE POINT

This command creates a code point, i.e. a destination is defined for the
specified digit combination. All digit combinations that are not created
as code points, test points or as subscriber controlled input access codes
are diverted to the UNOBDE0 intercept code.

According to the entered code and the special codes


LAC (LOCAL AREA CODE),
ORIG1 (ORIGINATING MARK 1),
MFCAT (MFC CATEGORY),
ZDIG (LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT) or
ROUTYP (ROUTE TYPE)
the blocks are seized in the digit-destination translator. If no position is
input, the special code is attached at the end of the code or, if there is
already such a special code existing for the desired code, the existing position
is used. However, it is possible to determine the positions of the special codes
freely within the digit combination. The last block in the digit chain contains
the reference to the destination.

It is possible to create a code point for a ported directory number


by extending an existing digit chain. For example:
CR CPT:CODE=1234, DEST=A;
CR CPT:CODE=12345, LAC=089, TRATYP=CPTDN;

Using the special code ORIG1 the following must be considered:

- Creating a code point with ORIG1=DEF has the same effect for call
processing as entering up to 3840 code points with ORIG1=0 through to
ORIG1=3839. So a code point with ORIG1=DEF stands for all code points
(with the same CODE) which are not explicitly created with a specific
ORIG1-value.

Example: CODE=12345, split by origination as follows:


For the origination value 10 the digit translation shall lead to
destination A, for value 200 to destination B, for all other values
to destination C.

CR CPT:CODE=12345, ORIG1=10, DEST=A;


CR CPT:CODE=12345, ORIG1=200, DEST=B;
CR CPT:CODE=12345, ORIG1=DEF, DEST=C;

These commands may be entered in any sequence. Instead of 3840


commands now only 3 commands are needed.

Using ORIG1=DEF, the position of this special code should be at the end of
the code. All ’exceptional’ code points must be entered, specially those,
which shall lead to an intercept.

Compatibilities:
- The parameter LAC is only allowed if the DN-attribute (see ENTR DNATT) is
multiple or if the code point indicates a directory number block
(i.e. TRATYP=CPTDN).

- Before entering code points beginning with a carrier access code,


the carrier access code must be defined first (see CR CAC).
These code points may only lead to a destination or an intercept.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR CPT - DEST CPT TO DESTINATION AREA


2. CR CPT - INCEPT CPT TO INTERCEPT CODE
3. CR CPT - TRATYP CPT WITH TRAFFIC TYPE

1. Input format

CPT TO DESTINATION AREA

If the code point to the specified destination area should be non barrable
NBARCPT must be entered for the parameter TRATYP.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CPT- 1+
CR CPT
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Additional prerequisites :
- The destination area must already exist in the destination area table
(see CR DEST).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR CPT : CODE= ,DEST= [,LAC=] [,ORIG1=] [,MFCAT=] [,ZDIG=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,ROUTYP=] <,TRATYP=> [,SYMCON=] [,AMA=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

The parameter CODE determines the digits for which the code point
is created. In addition to the selected digits, special codes can also
be entered in order to determine the destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the destination area selected by the digit


combination. The specified destination area must exist with at least
one route or be created with a new code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.


Input is only permitted if the directory number attribute of the
exchange is multiple or if the code point indicates a directory number
block. The use of this parameter may affect the value of the parameter
MINMAX (see CR DEST). The operator has to take care for a
correct value of the parameter MINMAX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: LOCAL AREA CODE=


1...6 digit decimal number

b: POSITION OF LOCAL AREA CODE=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the local area code


in the digit combination.

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code for which


the destination is addressed. Only decimal numbers,
range 0..3839, and the hexadecimal number ’DEF’ may be
entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: ORIGINATING MARK=
1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CPT- 2+
CR CPT
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: POSITION OF ORIGINATING MARK=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the origin code


in the digit combination.

MFCAT MFC CATEGORY

This parameter specifies branch categories.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: CATEGORY
(CAT11 ) CATEGORY 11
1 1 own mobile subscriber
1CAT12 1 CATEGORY 12
1 1 foreign mobile subscriber
1CAT13 1 CATEGORY 13
1 1 fixed mobile subscriber
1CAT14 1 CATEGORY 14
1CAT15 1 CATEGORY 15
ZCOINB Y COIN BOX
1DATAINAT1 DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
1DATRANS 1 DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
1OPOS 1 OPERATOR’S POSITION
1OPOSINAT1 OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
1SUBINAT 1 ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
1SUBORD 1 ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
1SUBPINAT1 PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
1SUBPRIOR1 PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
*TESTEQ + TEST EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the category for which the destination is


addressed.

b: POSITION OF CATEGORY=
1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the category in the digit


combination.

ZDIG LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT

This parameter specifies up to 16 different digital switchboards.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT=


1 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: POSITION OF LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the language digit


in the digit combination.

ROUTYP ROUTE TYPE

This parameter indicates the route type for the ISDN traffic.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: ROUTE TYPE
(ROUTYP0 ) ROUTE TYPE 00
1 1 The origin of the call is an actual trunk which
1 1 does not benefit from transition into ISDN. The
1 1 call should be held by conventional means.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CPT- 3+
CR CPT
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1ROUTYP1 1 ROUTE TYPE 01


1ROUTYP101 ROUTE TYPE 10
1ROUTYP111 ROUTE TYPE 11
1ROUTYP121 ROUTE TYPE 12
1ROUTYP131 ROUTE TYPE 13
1ROUTYP141 ROUTE TYPE 14
1ROUTYP151 ROUTE TYPE 15
1ROUTYP2 1 ROUTE TYPE 02
1ROUTYP3 1 ROUTE TYPE 03
1 1 A call of an ISDN subscriber for which a
1 1 transition into the analog network is permitted
Z Y (on the telephone service). These calls should as
1 1 far as possible be held in ISDN to guarantee a
1 1 defined handling of service features. A transition
1 1 to a conventional line is only advisable if no
1 1 ISDN line exists for the selected direction.
1ROUTYP4 1 ROUTE TYPE 04
1 1 A call of an ISDN subscriber for which a
1 1 transition into the analog network is not
1 1 permitted (in the non-telephone service). These
1 1 calls must be held in ISDN as they cannot be
1 1 handled in the analog network. The corresponding
1 1 destination may therefore only contain ISDN
1 1 routes.
1ROUTYP5 1 ROUTE TYPE 05
1ROUTYP6 1 ROUTE TYPE 06
1ROUTYP7 1 ROUTE TYPE 07
1ROUTYP8 1 ROUTE TYPE 08
*ROUTYP9 + ROUTE TYPE 09

b: POSITION OF ROUTE TYPE=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the ROUTE TYPE


in the digit combination.

TRATYP TRAFFIC TYPE

This parameter indicates the traffic type for the code point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(ASCITERM) ASCI TERMINATING


1ITGW 1 INTERNET GATEWAY
1 1 This parameter value indicates that the code
1 1 point leads to an access point for internet
1 1 telephony. It can only be entered in addition
1 1 to the parameter DEST.
1MOBBOTH 1 MOBILE BOTH
1MOBHAND 1 MOBILE HANDOVER
ZMOBINTERY MOBILE INTERROGATION
1MOBPHA 1 MOBILE PACKET A
1MOBPHB 1 MOBILE PACKET B
1MOBTERM 1 MOBILE TERMINATING
1NBARCPT 1 NON-BARRABLE CODE POINT
1SELCWROU1 SELECTIVE CALL WITH ROUTING
1 1 Code point for selective call with routing.
1 1 The outgoing trunk within the trunk group is
1 1 determined by the digit combination selected.
1VBS 1 VOICE BROADCAST SERVICE
*VGCS + VOICE GROUP CALL SERVICE

SYMCON SYMMETRIC CONNECTION

This parameter indicates whether the connection is symmetric or


not.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(N ) NO SYMMETRIC CONNECTION
ZNO Y NO SYMMETRIC CONNECTION
1Y 1 YES SYMMETRIC CONNECTION
*YES + YES SYMMETRIC CONNECTION

Default: NO

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CPT- 4+
CR CPT
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING

This parameter specifies if charging data will be collected


at the specified code point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

XN = NO AMA RECORD IS GENERATED


1NO 1 NO AMA RECORD IS GENERATED
1Y 1 AMA RECORD IS GENERATED
>YES W AMA RECORD IS GENERATED

Default: N

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CPT- 5+
CR CPT
INCEPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

CPT TO INTERCEPT CODE

The call requests for the specified code are diverted to the intercept code.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR CPT : CODE= ,INCEPT= [,LAC=] [,ORIG1=] [,MFCAT=] 1
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,ANNDIG=11 (;) 1
1 [,ZDIG=] [,ROUTYP=] 1Z,TXTNO= Y1 Z Y 1
1 11 11 *!+ 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

The parameter CODE determines the digits for which the code point
is created. In addition to the selected digits, special codes can also
be entered in order to determine the destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

INCEPT INTERCEPT

This parameter specifies the intercept code selected by the code point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION
(CHCPTIND) CHANGED CODE POINT IND. ANN.
1ILLDEST 1 ILLEGAL DESTINATION
1RESANN 1 RESERVE USER ANNOUNCEMENT
1 1 Unit b must be specified.
1UNALLROU1 UNALLOCATED ROUTE
1UNOBDE1 1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 01
1UNOBDE101 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 10
1UNOBDE111 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 11
ZUNOBDE12Y UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 12
1UNOBDE131 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 13
1UNOBDE2 1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 02
1UNOBDE3 1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 03
1UNOBDE4 1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 04
1UNOBDE5 1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 05
1UNOBDE6 1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 06
1UNOBDE7 1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 07
1UNOBDE8 1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 08
*UNOBDE9 + UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 09

b: RESERVE USER ANNOUNCEMENT NUMBER=


0...9, range of decimal numbers

This parameter determines the number of the reserve


user announcement intercept.

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.


Input is only permitted if the directory number attribute of the
exchange is multiple or if the code point indicates a directory number
block. The use of this parameter may affect the value of the parameter
MINMAX (see CR DEST). The operator has to take care for a
correct value of the parameter MINMAX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CPT- 6+
CR CPT
INCEPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a[-b]

a: LOCAL AREA CODE=


1...6 digit decimal number

b: POSITION OF LOCAL AREA CODE=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the local area code


in the digit combination.

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code for which


the destination is addressed. Only decimal numbers,
range 0..3839, and the hexadecimal number ’DEF’ may be
entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: ORIGINATING MARK=
1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: POSITION OF ORIGINATING MARK=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the origin code


in the digit combination.

MFCAT MFC CATEGORY

This parameter specifies branch categories.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: CATEGORY
(CAT11 ) CATEGORY 11
1 1 own mobile subscriber
1CAT12 1 CATEGORY 12
1 1 foreign mobile subscriber
1CAT13 1 CATEGORY 13
1 1 fixed mobile subscriber
1CAT14 1 CATEGORY 14
1CAT15 1 CATEGORY 15
ZCOINB Y COIN BOX
1DATAINAT1 DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
1DATRANS 1 DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
1OPOS 1 OPERATOR’S POSITION
1OPOSINAT1 OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
1SUBINAT 1 ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
1SUBORD 1 ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
1SUBPINAT1 PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
1SUBPRIOR1 PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
*TESTEQ + TEST EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the category for which the destination is


addressed.

b: POSITION OF CATEGORY=
1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the category in the digit


combination.

ZDIG LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT

This parameter specifies up to 16 different digital switchboards.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CPT- 7+
CR CPT
INCEPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a[-b]

a: LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT=


1 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: POSITION OF LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the language digit


in the digit combination.

ROUTYP ROUTE TYPE

This parameter indicates the route type for the ISDN traffic.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: ROUTE TYPE
(ROUTYP0 ) ROUTE TYPE 00
1 1 The origin of the call is an actual trunk which
1 1 does not benefit from transition into ISDN. The
1 1 call should be held by conventional means.
1ROUTYP1 1 ROUTE TYPE 01
1ROUTYP101 ROUTE TYPE 10
1ROUTYP111 ROUTE TYPE 11
1ROUTYP121 ROUTE TYPE 12
1ROUTYP131 ROUTE TYPE 13
1ROUTYP141 ROUTE TYPE 14
1ROUTYP151 ROUTE TYPE 15
1ROUTYP2 1 ROUTE TYPE 02
1ROUTYP3 1 ROUTE TYPE 03
1 1 A call of an ISDN subscriber for which a
1 1 transition into the analog network is permitted
Z Y (on the telephone service). These calls should as
1 1 far as possible be held in ISDN to guarantee a
1 1 defined handling of service features. A transition
1 1 to a conventional line is only advisable if no
1 1 ISDN line exists for the selected direction.
1ROUTYP4 1 ROUTE TYPE 04
1 1 A call of an ISDN subscriber for which a
1 1 transition into the analog network is not
1 1 permitted (in the non-telephone service). These
1 1 calls must be held in ISDN as they cannot be
1 1 handled in the analog network. The corresponding
1 1 destination may therefore only contain ISDN
1 1 routes.
1ROUTYP5 1 ROUTE TYPE 05
1ROUTYP6 1 ROUTE TYPE 06
1ROUTYP7 1 ROUTE TYPE 07
1ROUTYP8 1 ROUTE TYPE 08
*ROUTYP9 + ROUTE TYPE 09

b: POSITION OF ROUTE TYPE=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the ROUTE TYPE


in the digit combination.

ANNDIG INDIVIDUAL ANNOUNCEMENT DIGITS

This parameter specifies the digits to be announced.


This parameter may only be entered if INCEPT = CHCPTIND.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TXTNO TEXT NUMBER OF ANNOUNCEMENT

This parameter specifies the number of the text to be announced.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CPT- 8+
CR CPT
INCEPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter may only be entered if INCEPT = RESANN-X.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CPT- 9+
CR CPT
TRATYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

CPT WITH TRAFFIC TYPE

These code points must be entered first.

Additional prerequisites :
- If the code point refers to a directory number block, this must exist
(see CR DN).
- If the code point refers to an intelligent network service, this
service trigger table must exist (see CR INTRIG).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR CPT : CODE= ,TRATYP= [,LAC=] [,ORIG1=] [,MFCAT=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,ZDIG=] [,ROUTYP=] [,PROVNAM=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

The parameter CODE determines the digits for which the code point
is created. In addition to the selected digits, special codes can also
be entered in order to determine the destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TRATYP TRAFFIC TYPE

This parameter indicates the traffic type for the code point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: TRAFFIC TYPE A
(CLOCKTST) CLOCK TEST
1CPTDN 1 CODE POINT -> DIRECTORY NUMBER
1 1 Code point to a directory number.
1IACBPROC1 INTERNAT. AUTOM. CALL BACK
1IN 1 INTELLIGENT NETWORK SERVICE
1 1 Code point for intelligent network service.
1 1 Units b and c must be specified.
1MOBPROV 1 MOBILE SERVICE PROVIDER
1 1 Parameter PROVNAM must be specified.
ZPHONMEETY PHONE MEETING
1 1 Unit b must be specified.
1RADIOSUB1 RADIO SUBSCRIBER
1SELCWORO1 SELECTIVE CALL WITHOUT ROUTING
1 1 Code point for selective call without routing.
1 1 The outgoing trunk is determined directly by the
1 1 digit combination selected.
1TOLLFRNO1 TOLL FREE NUMBER
1 1 Code point for tollfree service. Unit b must be
1 1 specified.
*TWOPARTY+ TWO PARTY LINE

b: TRAFFIC TYPE B=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

Possible input values:


Unit a = TOLLFRNO: 0-9
Length of the tollfree service directory number.
Unit a = PHONMEET: 0-99
Telephone meeting group number.
Unit a = IN: 0-15
Length of the IN subscriber number.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CPT- 10+


CR CPT
TRATYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Unit a = IACBPROC: 0-15


Length of the call back service directory number.

c: TRAFFIC TYPE C=
1...6 characters from the
text string character set, enclosed in "

Possible input values:


Unit a = IN: Name of the IN service.
The name of the IN service specified in the command
CR INTRIG (parameter PRID) must be entered.

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.


Input is only permitted if the directory number attribute of the
exchange is multiple or if the code point indicates a directory number
block. The use of this parameter may affect the value of the parameter
MINMAX (see CR DEST). The operator has to take care for a
correct value of the parameter MINMAX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: LOCAL AREA CODE=


1...6 digit decimal number

b: POSITION OF LOCAL AREA CODE=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the local area code


in the digit combination.

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code for which


the destination is addressed. Only decimal numbers,
range 0..3839, and the hexadecimal number ’DEF’ may be
entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: ORIGINATING MARK=
1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: POSITION OF ORIGINATING MARK=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the origin code


in the digit combination.

MFCAT MFC CATEGORY

This parameter specifies branch categories.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: CATEGORY
(CAT11 ) CATEGORY 11
1 1 own mobile subscriber
1CAT12 1 CATEGORY 12
1 1 foreign mobile subscriber
1CAT13 1 CATEGORY 13
1 1 fixed mobile subscriber
1CAT14 1 CATEGORY 14
1CAT15 1 CATEGORY 15
ZCOINB Y COIN BOX
1DATAINAT1 DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CPT- 11+


CR CPT
TRATYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1DATRANS 1 DATA XMISSION NATIONAL


1OPOS 1 OPERATOR’S POSITION
1OPOSINAT1 OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
1SUBINAT 1 ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
1SUBORD 1 ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
1SUBPINAT1 PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
1SUBPRIOR1 PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
*TESTEQ + TEST EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the category for which the destination is


addressed.

b: POSITION OF CATEGORY=
1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the category in the digit


combination.

ZDIG LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT

This parameter specifies up to 16 different digital switchboards.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT=


1 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: POSITION OF LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the language digit


in the digit combination.

ROUTYP ROUTE TYPE

This parameter indicates the route type for the ISDN traffic.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: ROUTE TYPE
(ROUTYP0 ) ROUTE TYPE 00
1 1 The origin of the call is an actual trunk which
1 1 does not benefit from transition into ISDN. The
1 1 call should be held by conventional means.
1ROUTYP1 1 ROUTE TYPE 01
1ROUTYP101 ROUTE TYPE 10
1ROUTYP111 ROUTE TYPE 11
1ROUTYP121 ROUTE TYPE 12
1ROUTYP131 ROUTE TYPE 13
1ROUTYP141 ROUTE TYPE 14
1ROUTYP151 ROUTE TYPE 15
1ROUTYP2 1 ROUTE TYPE 02
1ROUTYP3 1 ROUTE TYPE 03
1 1 A call of an ISDN subscriber for which a
1 1 transition into the analog network is permitted
Z Y (on the telephone service). These calls should as
1 1 far as possible be held in ISDN to guarantee a
1 1 defined handling of service features. A transition
1 1 to a conventional line is only advisable if no
1 1 ISDN line exists for the selected direction.
1ROUTYP4 1 ROUTE TYPE 04
1 1 A call of an ISDN subscriber for which a
1 1 transition into the analog network is not
1 1 permitted (in the non-telephone service). These
1 1 calls must be held in ISDN as they cannot be
1 1 handled in the analog network. The corresponding
1 1 destination may therefore only contain ISDN
1 1 routes.
1ROUTYP5 1 ROUTE TYPE 05
1ROUTYP6 1 ROUTE TYPE 06

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CPT- 12+


CR CPT
TRATYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1ROUTYP7 1 ROUTE TYPE 07


1ROUTYP8 1 ROUTE TYPE 08
*ROUTYP9 + ROUTE TYPE 09

b: POSITION OF ROUTE TYPE=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the ROUTE TYPE


in the digit combination.

PROVNAM SERVICE PROVIDER NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the service provider. It may


only be entered if TRATYP = MOBPROV.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CPT- 13-


DISP CPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CODE POINT

This command displays the data related to the specified code point(s).

The displayed data may be restricted to certain code points by specifying


parameters CODE, ORIG1, MFCAT, ZDIG, ROUTYP or LAC.

Examples: DISP CPT: CODE=X; (show all masks)


DISP CPT: DEST=X,CODE=12; (code and type restricted)
DISP CPT: DEST=MUNICH; (destination restricted)
DISP CPT: PROVNAM=ABCDEF; (provider name restricted)

If ’X’ is entered for ORIG1, MFCAT, ZDIG, ROUTYP or LAC, only


those objects are displayed that have a valid value for this parameter.
The parameters DEST, TRATYP, INCEPT and PROVNAM may be specified
at the same time, then all related masks will be displayed. If none of these
parameters is entered, all data will be displayed.
After successful execution of the command, the command text is repeated
and all data is output within a table.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CPT : [CODE=] [,DEST=] [,INCEPT=] [,TRATYP=] [,PROVNAM=] 1
1 1
1 [,ORIG1=] [,MFCAT=] [,ZDIG=] [,ROUTYP=] [,LAC=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter restricts the code points to be displayed. Only code


points that begin with the entered digits will be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the destination area.


Only objects matching this destination will be displayed.

Compatibilities:
- If destination area is specified together with parameter
CODE, then DEST=X must be entered.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

INCEPT INTERCEPT

This parameter specifies the intercept code.


Only objects matching this intercept code will be displayed.
Compatibilities:
- If intercept code is specified together with parameter
CODE then INCEPT=X must be entered.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CPT- 1+


DISP CPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

UNOBDE1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 01


UNOBDE2 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 02
UNOBDE3 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 03
UNOBDE4 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 04
UNOBDE5 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 05
UNOBDE6 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 06
UNOBDE7 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 07
UNOBDE8 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 08
UNOBDE9 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 09
UNOBDE10 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 10
UNOBDE11 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 11
UNALLROU UNALLOCATED ROUTE
ILLDEST ILLEGAL DESTINATION
UNOBDE12 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 12
UNOBDE13 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 13
CHCPTIND CHANGED CODE POINT IND. ANN.
RESANN RESERVE USER ANNOUNCEMENT
X ALL VALUES

b: RESERVE USER ANNOUNCEMENT NUMBER=


0...9, range of decimal numbers

This parameter determines the number of the reserve user


announcement intercept. If this parameter is not entered
all reserve user announcement intercepts are output.

TRATYP TRAFFIC TYPE

This parameter specifies the traffic type.


Only objects matching this traffic type will be displayed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c]]

a: TRAFFIC TYPE A
X ALL VALUES
NBARCPT NON-BARRABLE CODE POINT
TOLLFRNO TOLL FREE NUMBER
SELCWROU SELECTIVE CALL WITH ROUTING
SELCWORO SELECTIVE CALL WITHOUT ROUTING
MOBBOTH MOBILE BOTH
RADIOSUB RADIO SUBSCRIBER
MOBPROV MOBILE PROVIDER
CLOCKTST CLOCK TEST
PHONMEET PHONE MEETING
TWOPARTY TWO PARTY LINE
CPTDN CODE POINT -> DIRECTORY NUMBER
MOBINTER MOBILE INTERROGATION
MOBTERM MOBILE TERMINATING
MOBHAND MOBILE HANDOVER
IN INTELLIGENT NETWORK SERVICE
MOBPHA MOBILE PACKET A
MOBPHB MOBILE PACKET B
IACBPROC INTERNAT. AUTOM. CALL BACK
ITGW INTERNET GATEWAY
VGCS VOICE GROUP CALL SERVICE
VBS VOICE BROADCAST SERVICE
ASCITERM ASCI TERMINATING

b: TRAFFIC TYPE B=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

Possible input values:


Unit a = PHONMEET : 0-99
Phone meeting group number.
Unit a = IN : 0-15
Length of the IN subscriber number.

c: TRAFFIC TYPE C=
1...6 characters from the
text string character set, enclosed in "

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CPT- 2+


DISP CPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Possible input values:


Unit a = IN : Name of the IN service.
The name of the IN service specified in the command
CR INTRIG (parameter PRID).

PROVNAM PROVIDER NAME

This parameter specifies the provider name.

Compatibilities:
- If provider name is specified together with parameter
CODE, then PROVNAM=X must be entered.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code for which


the destination is addressed. Only decimal numbers,
range 0..3839, and the hexadecimal number ’DEF’ may be
entered. Only objects matching this parameter value may
be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

MFCAT MFC CATEGORY

This parameter specifies branch categories.


Only objects matching this parameter value may
be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER


SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT
COINB COIN BOX
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
OPOSINAT OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15
X ALL VALUES

This unit specifies the category for which the destination is


addressed.

ZDIG LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT

This parameter specifies up to 16 different digital switchboards.


Only objects matching this parameter value may be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1 digit hexadecimal number where B is

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CPT- 3+


DISP CPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTYP ROUTE TYPE

This parameter indicates the route type for the ISDN traffic.
Only objects matching this parameter value may be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ROUTYP0 ROUTE TYPE 00


ROUTYP1 ROUTE TYPE 01
ROUTYP2 ROUTE TYPE 02
ROUTYP3 ROUTE TYPE 03
ROUTYP4 ROUTE TYPE 04
ROUTYP5 ROUTE TYPE 05
ROUTYP6 ROUTE TYPE 06
ROUTYP7 ROUTE TYPE 07
ROUTYP8 ROUTE TYPE 08
ROUTYP9 ROUTE TYPE 09
ROUTYP10 ROUTE TYPE 10
ROUTYP11 ROUTE TYPE 11
ROUTYP12 ROUTE TYPE 12
ROUTYP13 ROUTE TYPE 13
ROUTYP14 ROUTE TYPE 14
ROUTYP15 ROUTE TYPE 15
X ALL VALUES

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.


Only objects matching this parameter value may be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CPT- 4-


MERGE CPT
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MERGE CODE POINT

This command merges parallel code points. The existing code points and their
destinations are cancelled and a new code point is created with the specified
destination (destination area, intercept code).
Parallel code points are code points whose last digits differ or code points
which have one of the following special codes at the end of the digit string:
ORIG1, (ORIGINATING MARK 1),
MFCAT (MFC CATEGORY),
ZDIG (LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT),
ROUTYP (ROUTE TYPE).

Prerequisites:
- At least two code points to be merged must refer to a destination or
intercept code other than UNOBDE0.
- When merging by a digit, the entered code must be one digit shorter than
the code points to be merged.
- When merging by a special code, the entire code must be entered.
- Before using this command, the operator has to verify that no traffic
measurement job is running for the digit combination to be merged.

An indication of whether other code points or test points still use the
destination areas of the merged code points is output.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MERGE CPT - DEST MERGE CPT WITH DEST


2. MERGE CPT - INCEPT MERGE CPT WITH INCEPT

1. Input format

MERGE CPT WITH DEST

This input format describes the merging of code points with DEST.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MERGE CPT : CODE= ,DEST= [,LAC=] [,ORIG1=] [,MFCAT=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,ZDIG=] [,ROUTYP=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter specifies the digit combination of the code point to be


merged.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the destination area selected by the digit


combination. The specified destination area must exist with at
least one route or be created with a new code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE CPT- 1+


MERGE CPT
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code of the code


points to be merged. only decimal numbers, range 0..3839,
and the hexadecimal number ’DEF’ may be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

MFCAT MFC CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the branching category of the code


points to be merged.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15
COINB COIN BOX
DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
OPOSINAT INTERNATIONAL OPERATOR’S POS.
SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT

ZDIG LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT

This parameter specifies the language digit of the code


points to be merged.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTYP ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the route type for ISDN traffic of the code
points to be merged.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ROUTYP0 ROUTE TYPE 00


ROUTYP1 ROUTE TYPE 01
ROUTYP10 ROUTE TYPE 10
ROUTYP11 ROUTE TYPE 11
ROUTYP12 ROUTE TYPE 12
ROUTYP13 ROUTE TYPE 13
ROUTYP14 ROUTE TYPE 14
ROUTYP15 ROUTE TYPE 15
ROUTYP2 ROUTE TYPE 02
ROUTYP3 ROUTE TYPE 03
ROUTYP4 ROUTE TYPE 04
ROUTYP5 ROUTE TYPE 05
ROUTYP6 ROUTE TYPE 06
ROUTYP7 ROUTE TYPE 07
ROUTYP8 ROUTE TYPE 08
ROUTYP9 ROUTE TYPE 09

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE CPT- 2+


MERGE CPT
INCEPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

MERGE CPT WITH INCEPT

This input format describes merging of code points with INCEPT.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MERGE CPT : CODE= ,INCEPT= [,LAC=] [,ORIG1=] [,MFCAT=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,ZDIG=] [,ROUTYP=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter specifies the digit combination of the code point to be


merged.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

INCEPT INTERCEPT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ILLDEST ILLEGAL DESTINATION


UNALLROU UNALLOCATED ROUTE
UNOBDE1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 01
UNOBDE10 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 10
UNOBDE11 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 11
UNOBDE12 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 12
UNOBDE13 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 13
UNOBDE2 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 02
UNOBDE3 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 03
UNOBDE4 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 04
UNOBDE5 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 05
UNOBDE6 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 06
UNOBDE7 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 07
UNOBDE8 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 08
UNOBDE9 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 09

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code of the code


points to be merged. only decimal numbers, range 0..3839,
and the hexadecimal number ’DEF’ may be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

MFCAT MFC CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the branching category of the code


points to be merged.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE CPT- 3+


MERGE CPT
INCEPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

foreign mobile subscriber


CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15
COINB COIN BOX
DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
OPOSINAT INTERNATIONAL OPERATOR’S POS.
SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT

ZDIG LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT

This parameter specifies the language digit of the code


points to be merged.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTYP ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the route type for ISDN traffic of the code
points to be merged.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ROUTYP0 ROUTE TYPE 00


ROUTYP1 ROUTE TYPE 01
ROUTYP10 ROUTE TYPE 10
ROUTYP11 ROUTE TYPE 11
ROUTYP12 ROUTE TYPE 12
ROUTYP13 ROUTE TYPE 13
ROUTYP14 ROUTE TYPE 14
ROUTYP15 ROUTE TYPE 15
ROUTYP2 ROUTE TYPE 02
ROUTYP3 ROUTE TYPE 03
ROUTYP4 ROUTE TYPE 04
ROUTYP5 ROUTE TYPE 05
ROUTYP6 ROUTE TYPE 06
ROUTYP7 ROUTE TYPE 07
ROUTYP8 ROUTE TYPE 08
ROUTYP9 ROUTE TYPE 09

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE CPT- 4-


MOD CPT
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY CODE POINT

This command modifies the destination for the specified code point. If the code
point is created with special codes
ORIG1 (ORIGINATING MARK 1),
MFCAT (MFC CATEGORY),
ZDIG (LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT) or
ROUTYP (ROUTE TYPE)
then the special codes must also be specified in order to define the particular
point uniquely.
If the code point is created for a particular local network, the local area code
(LAC) must be specified.
An indication of whether other code points or test points use the old
destination area of the modified code point is output.

Prerequisites:
- The code point specified by the digit combination must exist.

Compatibilities:

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD CPT - DEST CPT TO DESTINATION AREA


2. MOD CPT - INCEPT CPT TO INTERCEPT CODE
3. MOD CPT - TRATYP CPT WITH TRAFFIC TYPE

1. Input format

CPT TO DESTINATION AREA

The destination of the code point is modified to specified destination


area, or the data for specific destination area is modified.

Additional prerequisites :
- The code point to the old destination area specified by the digit
combination must exist.
- The new destination area must already exist in the destination
area table (see CR DEST).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD CPT : CODE= ,DEST= [,LAC=] [,ORIG1=] [,MFCAT=] [,ZDIG=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,ROUTYP=] <,TRATYP=> [,SYMCON=] [,AMA=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter specifies the digit combination of the code point to be


modified. Special codes have to be entered to define the code point
uniquely.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the new destination area selected by the


digit combination. The specified destination area must exist with at
least one route or must be created with a new code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CPT- 1+


MOD CPT
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code for which the destination
is addressed. Only decimal numbers, range 0..3839, and the hexadecimal
number ’DEF’ may be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: ORIGINATING MARK=
1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: POSITION OF ORIGINATING MARK=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit is not evaluated and exists only


to be compatible to the syntax of older
EWSD-versions.

MFCAT MFC CATEGORY

This parameter specifies branch categories.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: CATEGORY
(CAT11 ) CATEGORY 11
1 1 own mobile subscriber
1CAT12 1 CATEGORY 12
1 1 foreign mobile subscriber
1CAT13 1 CATEGORY 13
1 1 fixed mobile subscriber
1CAT14 1 CATEGORY 14
1CAT15 1 CATEGORY 15
ZCOINB Y COIN BOX
1DATAINAT1 DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
1DATRANS 1 DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
1OPOS 1 OPERATOR’S POSITION
1OPOSINAT1 OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
1SUBINAT 1 ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
1SUBORD 1 ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
1SUBPINAT1 PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
1SUBPRIOR1 PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
*TESTEQ + TEST EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the category for which the destination


is addressed.

b: POSITION OF CATEGORY=
1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit is not evaluated and exists only


to be compatible to the syntax of older
EWSD-versions.

ZDIG LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT

This parameter specifies up to 16 different digital switchboards.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CPT- 2+


MOD CPT
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a[-b]

a: LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT=


1 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: POSITION OF LANGUAGE OR DISCRIM. Z-DIGIT=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit is not evaluated and exists only


to be compatible to the syntax of older
EWSD-versions.

ROUTYP ROUTE TYPE

The parameter indicates the route type for the ISDN traffic.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(ROUTYP0 ) ROUTE TYPE 00


1ROUTYP1 1 ROUTE TYPE 01
1ROUTYP101 ROUTE TYPE 10
1ROUTYP111 ROUTE TYPE 11
1ROUTYP121 ROUTE TYPE 12
1ROUTYP131 ROUTE TYPE 13
1ROUTYP141 ROUTE TYPE 14
ZROUTYP15Y ROUTE TYPE 15
1ROUTYP2 1 ROUTE TYPE 02
1ROUTYP3 1 ROUTE TYPE 03
1ROUTYP4 1 ROUTE TYPE 04
1ROUTYP5 1 ROUTE TYPE 05
1ROUTYP6 1 ROUTE TYPE 06
1ROUTYP7 1 ROUTE TYPE 07
1ROUTYP8 1 ROUTE TYPE 08
*ROUTYP9 + ROUTE TYPE 09

TRATYP TRAFFIC TYPE

This parameter indicates the traffic type for the code point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(ASCITERM) ASCI TERMINATING


1ITGW 1 INTERNET GATEWAY
1 1 This parameter value indicates that the code
1 1 point leads to an access point for internet
1 1 telephony. It can only be entered in addition
1 1 to the parameter DEST.
1MOBBOTH 1 MOBILE BOTH
1MOBHAND 1 MOBILE HANDOVER
ZMOBINTERY MOBILE INTERROGATION
1MOBPHA 1 MOBILE PACKET A
1MOBPHB 1 MOBILE PACKET B
1MOBTERM 1 MOBILE TERMINATING
1NBARCPT 1 NON-BARRABLE CODE POINT
1SELCWROU1 SELECTIVE CALL WITH ROUTING
1 1 Code point for selective call with routing.
1 1 The outgoing trunk within the trunk group is
1 1 determined by the digit combination selected.
1VBS 1 VOICE BROADCAST SERVICE
*VGCS + VOICE GROUP CALL SERVICE

SYMCON SYMMETRIC CONNECTION

This parameter indicates whether the connection is symmetric or


not.

Standard Behavior:
- If type of destination is modified, the connection will
not be symmetric.
- If only data for a type of destination is modified, then
there is no affect on database.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(N ) NO SYMMETRIC CONNECTION

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CPT- 3+


MOD CPT
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ZNO Y NO SYMMETRIC CONNECTION


1Y 1 YES SYMMETRIC CONNECTION
*YES + YES SYMMETRIC CONNECTION

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING

This parameter specifies if charging data will be collected


at the specified code point.

Standard Behavior:
- If type of destination is modified, no AMA record is
generated.
- If only data for a type of destination is modified, then
there is no affect on database.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

XN = NO AMA RECORD IS GENERATED


1NO 1 NO AMA RECORD IS GENERATED
1Y 1 AMA RECORD IS GENERATED
>YES W AMA RECORD IS GENERATED

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CPT- 4+


MOD CPT
INCEPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

CPT TO INTERCEPT CODE

The old intercept value is changed to another intercept value.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD CPT : CODE= ,INCEPT= [,LAC=] [,ORIG1=] [,MFCAT=] 1
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,ANNDIG=11 (;) 1
1 [,ZDIG=] [,ROUTYP=] 1Z,TXTNO= Y1 Z Y 1
1 11 11 *!+ 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter specifies the digit combination of the code point to be


modified. Special codes have to be entered to define the code point
uniquely.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

INCEPT INTERCEPT

This parameter specifies the new intercept code selected by the


code point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION
(CHCPTIND) CHANGED CODE POINT IND. ANN.
1ILLDEST 1 ILLEGAL DESTINATION
1RESANN 1 RESERVE USER ANNOUNCEMENT
1 1 Unit b must be specified.
1UNALLROU1 UNALLOCATED ROUTE
1UNOBDE1 1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 01
1UNOBDE101 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 10
1UNOBDE111 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 11
ZUNOBDE12Y UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 12
1UNOBDE131 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 13
1UNOBDE2 1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 02
1UNOBDE3 1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 03
1UNOBDE4 1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 04
1UNOBDE5 1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 05
1UNOBDE6 1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 06
1UNOBDE7 1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 07
1UNOBDE8 1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 08
*UNOBDE9 + UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 09

b: RESERVE USER ANNOUNCEMENT NUMBER=


0...9, range of decimal numbers

This parameter determines the number of the reserve


user announcement intercept.

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CPT- 5+


MOD CPT
INCEPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code for which the destination
is addressed. Only decimal numbers, range 0..3839, and the hexadecimal
number ’DEF’ may be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: ORIGINATING MARK=
1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: POSITION OF ORIGINATING MARK=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit is not evaluated and exists only


to be compatible to the syntax of older
EWSD-versions.

MFCAT MFC CATEGORY

This parameter specifies branch categories.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: CATEGORY
(CAT11 ) CATEGORY 11
1 1 own mobile subscriber
1CAT12 1 CATEGORY 12
1 1 foreign mobile subscriber
1CAT13 1 CATEGORY 13
1 1 fixed mobile subscriber
1CAT14 1 CATEGORY 14
1CAT15 1 CATEGORY 15
ZCOINB Y COIN BOX
1DATAINAT1 DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
1DATRANS 1 DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
1OPOS 1 OPERATOR’S POSITION
1OPOSINAT1 OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
1SUBINAT 1 ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
1SUBORD 1 ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
1SUBPINAT1 PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
1SUBPRIOR1 PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
*TESTEQ + TEST EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the category for which the destination


is addressed.

b: POSITION OF CATEGORY=
1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit is not evaluated and exists only


to be compatible to the syntax of older
EWSD-versions.

ZDIG LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT

This parameter specifies up to 16 different digital switchboards.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT=


1 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: POSITION OF LANGUAGE OR DISCRIM. Z-DIGIT=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CPT- 6+


MOD CPT
INCEPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This unit is not evaluated and exists only


to be compatible to the syntax of older
EWSD-versions.

ROUTYP ROUTE TYPE

The parameter indicates the route type for the ISDN traffic.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(ROUTYP0 ) ROUTE TYPE 00


1ROUTYP1 1 ROUTE TYPE 01
1ROUTYP101 ROUTE TYPE 10
1ROUTYP111 ROUTE TYPE 11
1ROUTYP121 ROUTE TYPE 12
1ROUTYP131 ROUTE TYPE 13
1ROUTYP141 ROUTE TYPE 14
ZROUTYP15Y ROUTE TYPE 15
1ROUTYP2 1 ROUTE TYPE 02
1ROUTYP3 1 ROUTE TYPE 03
1ROUTYP4 1 ROUTE TYPE 04
1ROUTYP5 1 ROUTE TYPE 05
1ROUTYP6 1 ROUTE TYPE 06
1ROUTYP7 1 ROUTE TYPE 07
1ROUTYP8 1 ROUTE TYPE 08
*ROUTYP9 + ROUTE TYPE 09

ANNDIG INDIVIDUAL ANNOUNCEMENT DIGITS

This parameter specifies the digits to be announced.


This parameter may only be entered
if INCEPT = CHCPTIND.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TXTNO TEXT NUMBER OF ANNOUNCEMENT

This parameter specifies the number of the text


to be announced.
This parameter may only be entered if INCEPT =
RESANN-X

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CPT- 7+


MOD CPT
TRATYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

CPT WITH TRAFFIC TYPE

The destination of the code point is modified to specified traffic type,


or the data for specific traffic type is modified.

Additional prerequisites :
- If the code point refers to an intelligent network service, this service
trigger table must exist (see CR INTRIG).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD CPT : CODE= ,TRATYP= [,LAC=] [,ORIG1=] [,MFCAT=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,ZDIG=] [,ROUTYP=] [,PROVNAM=] [,NPROVNAM=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter specifies the digit combination of the code point to be


modified. Special codes have to be entered to define the code point
uniquely.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TRATYP TRAFFIC TYPE

This parameter indicates the traffic type for the code point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: TRAFFIC TYPE A
(CLOCKTST) CLOCK TEST
1CPTDN 1 CODE POINT -> DIRECTORY NUMBER
1 1 Code point to a directory number.
1IACBPROC1 INTERNAT. AUTOM. CALL BACK
1IN 1 INTELLIGENT NETWORK SERVICE
1 1 Code point for intelligent network service.
1 1 Units b and c must be specified.
1MOBPROV 1 MOBILE SERVICE PROVIDER
1 1 Parameter PROVNAM must be specified.
ZPHONMEETY PHONE MEETING
1 1 Unit b must be specified.
1RADIOSUB1 RADIO SUBSCRIBER
1SELCWORO1 SELECTIVE CALL WITHOUT ROUTING
1 1 Code point for selective call without routing.
1 1 The outgoing trunk is determined directly by the
1 1 digit combination selected.
1TOLLFRNO1 TOLL FREE NUMBER
1 1 Code point for tollfree service. Unit b must be
1 1 specified.
*TWOPARTY+ TWO PARTY LINE

b: TRAFFIC TYPE B=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

Possible input values:


Unit a = TOLLFRNO: 0-9
Length of the tollfree service directory number.
Unit a = PHONMEET: 0-99
Telephone meeting group number.
Unit a = IN: 0-15
Length of the IN subscriber number.
Unit a = IACBPROC: 0-15
Length of the call back service directory number.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CPT- 8+


MOD CPT
TRATYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

c: TRAFFIC TYPE C=
1...6 characters from the
text string character set, enclosed in "

Possible input values:


Unit a = IN: Name of the IN service.
The name of the IN service specified in the command
CR INTRIG (parameter PRID) must be entered.

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code for which the destination
is addressed. Only decimal numbers, range 0..3839, and the hexadecimal
number ’DEF’ may be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: ORIGINATING MARK=
1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: POSITION OF ORIGINATING MARK=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit is not evaluated and exists only


to be compatible to the syntax of older
EWSD-versions.

MFCAT MFC CATEGORY

This parameter specifies branch categories.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: CATEGORY
(CAT11 ) CATEGORY 11
1 1 own mobile subscriber
1CAT12 1 CATEGORY 12
1 1 foreign mobile subscriber
1CAT13 1 CATEGORY 13
1 1 fixed mobile subscriber
1CAT14 1 CATEGORY 14
1CAT15 1 CATEGORY 15
ZCOINB Y COIN BOX
1DATAINAT1 DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
1DATRANS 1 DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
1OPOS 1 OPERATOR’S POSITION
1OPOSINAT1 OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
1SUBINAT 1 ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
1SUBORD 1 ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
1SUBPINAT1 PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
1SUBPRIOR1 PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
*TESTEQ + TEST EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the category for which the destination


is addressed.

b: POSITION OF CATEGORY=
1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit is not evaluated and exists only

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CPT- 9+


MOD CPT
TRATYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

to be compatible to the syntax of older


EWSD-versions.

ZDIG LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT

This parameter specifies up to 16 different digital switchboards.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT=


1 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: POSITION OF LANGUAGE OR DISCRIM. Z-DIGIT=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

This unit is not evaluated and exists only


to be compatible to the syntax of older
EWSD-versions.

ROUTYP ROUTE TYPE

The parameter indicates the route type for the ISDN traffic.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(ROUTYP0 ) ROUTE TYPE 00


1ROUTYP1 1 ROUTE TYPE 01
1ROUTYP101 ROUTE TYPE 10
1ROUTYP111 ROUTE TYPE 11
1ROUTYP121 ROUTE TYPE 12
1ROUTYP131 ROUTE TYPE 13
1ROUTYP141 ROUTE TYPE 14
ZROUTYP15Y ROUTE TYPE 15
1ROUTYP2 1 ROUTE TYPE 02
1ROUTYP3 1 ROUTE TYPE 03
1ROUTYP4 1 ROUTE TYPE 04
1ROUTYP5 1 ROUTE TYPE 05
1ROUTYP6 1 ROUTE TYPE 06
1ROUTYP7 1 ROUTE TYPE 07
1ROUTYP8 1 ROUTE TYPE 08
*ROUTYP9 + ROUTE TYPE 09

PROVNAM OLD SERVICE PROVIDER NAME

This parameter specifies the old name of the service provider.


It may only be entered if TRATYP = MOBPROV.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NPROVNAM NEW SERVICE PROVIDER NAME

This parameter specifies the new name of the service provider.


It may only be entered if TRATYP = MOBPROV.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CPT- 10-


SPLIT CPT
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SPLIT CODE POINT

This command splits an existing code point into 16 new code points. The option
of specifying 16 new destinations for that code point is created (by using
MOD CPT).
A code point can be split by a digit or by a special code
ORIG1 (ORIGINATING MARK 1),
MFCAT (MFC CATEGORY),
ZDIG (LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT) or
ROUTYP (ROUTE TYPE).
Only the code point specified by the parameter SPLITBY, ORIG1, MFCAT, ZDIG or
ROUTYP in the command receives the new destination. The other newly-created
code points retain the destination of the old code point. If the code point is
split by digit, the entered code must have one digit more than the code point
to be split.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. SPLIT CPT - DEST SPLIT CPT WITH DEST


2. SPLIT CPT - INCEPT SPLIT CPT WITH INCEPT

1. Input format

SPLIT CPT WITH DEST

This input format describes the splitting of code points with DEST.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 SPLIT CPT : CODE= ,DEST= ,SPLITBY= [,LAC=] [,ORIG1=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,MFCAT=] [,ZDIG=] [,ROUTYP=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter specifies the digit combination of the code point to be


split.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the new destination area for the code point
specified by the parameter ORIG1, MFCAT, ZDIG or ROUTYP.
The specified destination area must exist with at least one route or
must be created with a new code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SPLITBY DETERMINE KIND OF SPLIT

This parameter specifies the kind of special code for which the split
shall be done.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DIGIT SPLIT BY DIGIT


MFCAT SPLIT BY BRANCHING CATEGORY
ORIG1 SPLIT BY ORIG1
ROUTYP SPLIT BY ROUTE TYPE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SPLIT CPT- 1+


SPLIT CPT
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ZDIG SPLIT BY LANGUAGE DIGIT

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code for which


the destination is addressed. Only decimal numbers,
range 0..3839, and the hexadecimal number ’DEF’ may be
entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

MFCAT MFC CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the branching category of the new code


point that receives the specified new destination area or
intercept code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15
COINB COIN BOX
DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
OPOSINAT INTERNATIONAL OPERATOR’S POS.
SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT

ZDIG LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT

This parameter specifies the language digit of the new code


point that receives the specified new destination area or
intercept code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTYP ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the route type for ISDN traffic of the
new code point that receives the specified new destination area or
intercept code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ROUTYP0 ROUTE TYPE 00


ROUTYP1 ROUTE TYPE 01
ROUTYP10 ROUTE TYPE 10
ROUTYP11 ROUTE TYPE 11
ROUTYP12 ROUTE TYPE 12
ROUTYP13 ROUTE TYPE 13
ROUTYP14 ROUTE TYPE 14
ROUTYP15 ROUTE TYPE 15
ROUTYP2 ROUTE TYPE 02

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SPLIT CPT- 2+


SPLIT CPT
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ROUTYP3 ROUTE TYPE 03


ROUTYP4 ROUTE TYPE 04
ROUTYP5 ROUTE TYPE 05
ROUTYP6 ROUTE TYPE 06
ROUTYP7 ROUTE TYPE 07
ROUTYP8 ROUTE TYPE 08
ROUTYP9 ROUTE TYPE 09

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SPLIT CPT- 3+


SPLIT CPT
INCEPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

SPLIT CPT WITH INCEPT

This input format describes splitting of code points with INCEPT.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 SPLIT CPT : CODE= ,INCEPT= ,SPLITBY= [,LAC=] [,ORIG1=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,MFCAT=] [,ZDIG=] [,ROUTYP=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter specifies the digit combination of the code point to be


split.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

INCEPT INTERCEPT

This parameter specifies the new intercept code for the code point
specified by the parameter ORIG1, MFCAT, ZDIG or ROUTYP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ILLDEST ILLEGAL DESTINATION


UNALLROU UNALLOCATED ROUTE
UNOBDE1 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 01
UNOBDE10 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 10
UNOBDE11 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 11
UNOBDE12 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 12
UNOBDE13 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 13
UNOBDE2 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 02
UNOBDE3 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 03
UNOBDE4 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 04
UNOBDE5 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 05
UNOBDE6 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 06
UNOBDE7 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 07
UNOBDE8 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 08
UNOBDE9 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 09

SPLITBY DETERMINE KIND OF SPLIT

This parameter specifies the kind of special code for which the split
shall be done.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DIGIT SPLIT BY DIGIT


MFCAT SPLIT BY BRANCHING CATEGORY
ORIG1 SPLIT BY ORIG1
ROUTYP SPLIT BY ROUTE TYPE
ZDIG SPLIT BY LANGUAGE DIGIT

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code for which


the destination is addressed. Only decimal numbers,
range 0..3839, and the hexadecimal number ’DEF’ may be

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SPLIT CPT- 4+


SPLIT CPT
INCEPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

MFCAT MFC CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the branching category of the new code


point that receives the specified new destination area or
intercept code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15
COINB COIN BOX
DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
OPOSINAT INTERNATIONAL OPERATOR’S POS.
SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT

ZDIG LANGUAGE OR DISCRIMIN. Z-DIGIT

This parameter specifies the language digit of the new code


point that receives the specified new destination area or
intercept code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTYP ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the route type for ISDN traffic of the
new code point that receives the specified new destination area or
intercept code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ROUTYP0 ROUTE TYPE 00


ROUTYP1 ROUTE TYPE 01
ROUTYP10 ROUTE TYPE 10
ROUTYP11 ROUTE TYPE 11
ROUTYP12 ROUTE TYPE 12
ROUTYP13 ROUTE TYPE 13
ROUTYP14 ROUTE TYPE 14
ROUTYP15 ROUTE TYPE 15
ROUTYP2 ROUTE TYPE 02
ROUTYP3 ROUTE TYPE 03
ROUTYP4 ROUTE TYPE 04
ROUTYP5 ROUTE TYPE 05
ROUTYP6 ROUTE TYPE 06
ROUTYP7 ROUTE TYPE 07
ROUTYP8 ROUTE TYPE 08
ROUTYP9 ROUTE TYPE 09

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SPLIT CPT- 5-


ACT CPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE CP TRANSIENT PATCH

With this command you can activate one or more Transient


Patches in the memory on one platform. Successful execution of
the command results in execution of the atomic action
AM (Activate in Memory) on the respective platform in
operation.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT CPTRPCH : PLF= ,ID= [,LIB=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the CP platform where a Transient


Patch is to be processed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BAP0 BASE PROCESSOR 0


BAP1 BASE PROCESSOR 1
CAP0 CALL PROCESSOR 0
CAP1 CALL PROCESSOR 1
CAP2 CALL PROCESSOR 2
CAP3 CALL PROCESSOR 3
CAP4 CALL PROCESSOR 4
CAP5 CALL PROCESSOR 5
CAP6 CALL PROCESSOR 6
CAP7 CALL PROCESSOR 7
CAP8 CALL PROCESSOR 8
CAP9 CALL PROCESSOR 9
AMP0 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 0
AMP1 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 1
AMP2 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 2
AMP3 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3
AMP4 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 4
AMP5 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 5
BAPM BASE PROCESSOR MASTER
BAPS BASE PROCESSOR SPARE

This unit specifies the platform type.

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

LIB LIBRARY NAME

This parameter represents the name of the library associated


with the platform to be patched.
If the parameter is omitted, the library specified via
parameter ID is taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CPTRPCH- 1+


ACT CPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT CPTRPCH- 2-


CAN CPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CP TRANSIENT PATCH

With this command you can cancel one or more Transient


Patches in the memory on one platform by implicitly
deactivating them in the memory on this platform.
Successful execution of the command results in execution of
the atomic actions DAM (Deactivate in Memory) and CM (Cancel
in Memory) on the respective platform in operation.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN CPTRPCH : PLF= ,ID= [,LIB=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the CP platform where a Transient


Patch is to be processed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BAP0 BASE PROCESSOR 0


BAP1 BASE PROCESSOR 1
CAP0 CALL PROCESSOR 0
CAP1 CALL PROCESSOR 1
CAP2 CALL PROCESSOR 2
CAP3 CALL PROCESSOR 3
CAP4 CALL PROCESSOR 4
CAP5 CALL PROCESSOR 5
CAP6 CALL PROCESSOR 6
CAP7 CALL PROCESSOR 7
CAP8 CALL PROCESSOR 8
CAP9 CALL PROCESSOR 9
AMP0 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 0
AMP1 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 1
AMP2 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 2
AMP3 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3
AMP4 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 4
AMP5 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 5
BAPM BASE PROCESSOR MASTER
BAPS BASE PROCESSOR SPARE

This unit specifies the platform type.

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

LIB LIBRARY NAME

This parameter represents the name of the library associated


with the platform to be patched.
If the parameter is omitted, the library specified via
parameter ID is taken.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CPTRPCH- 1+


CAN CPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CPTRPCH- 2-


DACT CPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE CP TRANSIENT PATCH

With this command you can deactivate one or more Transient


Patches in the memory on one platform. Successful execution of
the command results in execution of the atomic action
DAM (Deactivate in Memory) on the respective platform in
operation.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT CPTRPCH : PLF= ,ID= [,LIB=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the CP platform where a Transient


Patch is to be processed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BAP0 BASE PROCESSOR 0


BAP1 BASE PROCESSOR 1
CAP0 CALL PROCESSOR 0
CAP1 CALL PROCESSOR 1
CAP2 CALL PROCESSOR 2
CAP3 CALL PROCESSOR 3
CAP4 CALL PROCESSOR 4
CAP5 CALL PROCESSOR 5
CAP6 CALL PROCESSOR 6
CAP7 CALL PROCESSOR 7
CAP8 CALL PROCESSOR 8
CAP9 CALL PROCESSOR 9
AMP0 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 0
AMP1 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 1
AMP2 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 2
AMP3 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3
AMP4 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 4
AMP5 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 5
BAPM BASE PROCESSOR MASTER
BAPS BASE PROCESSOR SPARE

This unit specifies the platform type.

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

LIB LIBRARY NAME

This parameter represents the name of the library associated


with the platform to be patched.
If the parameter is omitted, the library specified via
parameter ID is taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT CPTRPCH- 1+


DACT CPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT CPTRPCH- 2-


DISP CPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CP TRANSIENT PATCH

With this command you can display patch data kept in the
patch administration on the individual platform and patch
states concerning Transient Patches for a specified platform in
operation.
The patch selection can be performed either by patch identifier(s)
using parameter ID or by logical address ranges affected by
the patches, using parameter ADDR.
In case of using parameter ADDR, the filling levels of the
Patch Area and the Patch Administration are displayed
additionally.
To limit the list of patch IDs, it is possible to specify
combinations of following parameters:
BEGDATE, BEGTIME, ENDDATE, ENDTIME and PATSTATE

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,ID= 1 1
1 DISP CPTRPCH : PLF= Z,ADDR=Y [,LIB=] [,BEGDATE=] [,BEGTIME=] 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 [,ENDDATE=] [,ENDTIME=] [,PATSTATE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the CP platform where a Transient


Patch is to be processed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BAP0 BASE PROCESSOR 0


BAP1 BASE PROCESSOR 1
CAP0 CALL PROCESSOR 0
CAP1 CALL PROCESSOR 1
CAP2 CALL PROCESSOR 2
CAP3 CALL PROCESSOR 3
CAP4 CALL PROCESSOR 4
CAP5 CALL PROCESSOR 5
CAP6 CALL PROCESSOR 6
CAP7 CALL PROCESSOR 7
CAP8 CALL PROCESSOR 8
CAP9 CALL PROCESSOR 9
AMP0 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 0
AMP1 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 1
AMP2 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 2
AMP3 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3
AMP4 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 4
AMP5 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 5
BAPM BASE PROCESSOR MASTER
BAPS BASE PROCESSOR SPARE

This unit specifies the platform type.

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.
It is also possible to use wildcard signs (*) or (?) as part
of the patchname. In this case all patches found within the
specified capsule and fulfilling the wildcard criteria will

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CPTRPCH- 1+


DISP CPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

be displayed.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname" or
ID="capsname.*" or
ID="capsname.A?CD*EF"

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

10...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

ADDR LIST OF ADDRESS RANGES

This parameter represents an interval in which the search


for patches will be performed. An address can be specified
either in hexadecimal form as an offset from capsule begin or
symbolically.

e.g.: ADDR="capname.address"&&"address" or
ADDR="capname.address"&&"+distance"

where address may have one of the following


structures:

"spuname.modname+offset+distance", or
"spuname.modname.symbol+offset+distance", or
"label+offset+distance", or
"offset+distance", where

capname <text string> = 8 char.,


label L’<text string> = 8 char.,
spuname <text string> = 8 char.,
modname <text string> = 8 char. (or 13 if the
version is included),
symbol <text string> <= 8 char.,
offset <hexadecimal string> <= 8 hex signs,
distance disitem+disitem ..+disitem..,
disitem spuname.modname.symbol or offset

The end address of an interval may be omitted. If it is


omitted in the case of capsule or module the entire address
range of the unit is scanned. If it is omitted in the case of
symbol or offset the search range is that byte only.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

LIB LIBRARY NAME

This parameter represents the name of the library associated


with the platform to be patched.
If the parameter is omitted, the library specified via
parameter ID is taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

BEGDATE BEGIN DATE

This parameter specifies the begin date of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGTIME,
ENDDATE and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter BEGDATE: 2000:01:01

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CPTRPCH- 2+


DISP CPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

BEGTIME BEGIN TIME

This parameter specifies the begin time of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
ENDDATE and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter BEGTIME: 00:00:00

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECOND=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

ENDDATE END DATE

This parameter specifies the end date of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
BEGTIME and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter ENDDATE: actual date

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

ENDTIME END TIME

This parameter specifies the end time of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
BEGTIME and ENDDATE.
Default value of parameter ENDTIME: 23:59:59

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CPTRPCH- 3+


DISP CPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECOND=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

PATSTATE PATCH STATE

This parameter is used to limit the list of patch IDs


displayed to those patches having the entered PATSTATE.
If this parameter is omitted, every patch will be displayed
regardless of its state in the system.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ENTRG ENTERING
ENTRD ENTERED
ACT ACTIVE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CPTRPCH- 4-


ENTR CPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CP TRANSIENT PATCH

With this command you can enter a Transient Patch into the
patch administration on a platform.
Successful execution of the command results in execution
of the atomic action EM (Enter into Memory) on the
respective platform in operation.
With each ENTR CPTRPCH command the subpatch type Replace
Subpatch can be entered by using parameter REPADDR.

The completeness of the subpatches is indicated by means of


parameter SUBPCHNO. For each subpatch of a patch a new
ENTR CPTRPCH command is necessary.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,REPADDR= 1 1
1 ENTR CPTRPCH : PLF= ,ID= Z,SUBPCHNO=Y [,NEWCNT= [,OLDCNT=]] 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 [,LIB=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the CP platform where a Transient


Patch is to be processed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BAP0 BASE PROCESSOR 0


BAP1 BASE PROCESSOR 1
CAP0 CALL PROCESSOR 0
CAP1 CALL PROCESSOR 1
CAP2 CALL PROCESSOR 2
CAP3 CALL PROCESSOR 3
CAP4 CALL PROCESSOR 4
CAP5 CALL PROCESSOR 5
CAP6 CALL PROCESSOR 6
CAP7 CALL PROCESSOR 7
CAP8 CALL PROCESSOR 8
CAP9 CALL PROCESSOR 9
AMP0 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 0
AMP1 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 1
AMP2 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 2
AMP3 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 3
AMP4 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 4
AMP5 ATM BRIDGE PROCESSOR 5
BAPM BASE PROCESSOR MASTER
BAPS BASE PROCESSOR SPARE

This unit specifies the platform type.

ID PATCH IDENTIFIER

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name. Whenever a subpatch is
entered for a certain patch the identifier must be
identical.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

11...25 characters from the

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CPTRPCH- 1+


ENTR CPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

text string character set, enclosed in "

REPADDR REPLACE SUBPATCH ADDRESS

This parameter provides the replace subpatch address. The


address format is a replacement address.

e.g.: REPADDR="spuname.modname.symbol+distance" or
REPADDR="offset+distance" or
REPADDR="label+distance",

label L’<text string> = 8 char.,


spuname <text string> = 8 char.,
modname <text string> = 8 char. (or 13 if the
version is included),
symbol <text string> <= 8 char.,
offset H’<hexadecimal string> <= 8 hex signs,
distance disitem+disitem ..+disitem..,
disitem spuname.modname.symbol or offset

The given address is valid for the capsule denoted within


parameter ID.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

SUBPCHNO TOTAL NUMBER OF SUBPATCHES

This parameter represents the total number of subpatches


belonging to a Patch ID. A patch must be closed by a final
ENTR CPTRPCH command with the parameters ID and
SUBPCHNO, whereby the latter one corresponds to the number
of patches, entered under the same ID.
This command causes the transition of the patch state from
ENTRG to ENTRD.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...118, range of decimal numbers

NEWCNT NEW CONTENT OF SUBPATCH

This parameter represents the new instruction code to be


executed instead of the old instruction code which may be
represented by parameter OLDCNT.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

OLDCNT OLD CONTENT AT SUBPATCH LOCAT.

This parameter represents the old instruction code to be


checked for security reasons.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

LIB LIBRARY NAME

This parameter represents the name of the library associated


with the platform to be patched.
If the parameter is omitted, the library specified via
parameter ID is taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CPTRPCH- 2-


ENTR CQDAT
MEASIC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CARRIER QUOTA DATA

This command assigns data to one carrier of a quota group. These data may
be either trunk group sizes or quotas and possibly a list of trunk groups
to be measured. The type of required data depends on the quota procedure,
which is valid for the specified carrier quota group.

The carrier quota group is activated as soon as correct quota data are
assigned to all carriers of that group. The craft will be notified of the
activation with the display of all quota data of that carrier quota group.
For this purpose the same output mask is used as for the command
DISP CQGRP, but no trunk groups to be measured will be displayed in this
case regardless of their existence.

The data which were entered with this command may be displayed with
DISP CQGRP. These data may be cancelled either completely with the
command CAN CQGRP or selectively with MOD CQDAT.

Prerequisites:
- The carrier quota group and the carrier are already created.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ENTR CQDAT - MEASIC MEASUREMENT INCOMING CALLS


2. ENTR CQDAT - STAQUO STATIC QUOTAS
3. ENTR CQDAT - TGSIZE TRUNK GROUP SIZE

1. Input format

MEASUREMENT INCOMING CALLS

This input format is entered for carrier data belonging to a quota group
with quota procedure MEASIC.

For the quota procedure MEASIC it is necessary to provide a quota to


start with as well as a list of trunk groups to be measured for each
carrier.

Notes:
- The quotas to start with are valid until the first actualization took
place, depending on the measured incoming call duration time. The
actually valid quotas may be displayed with the command DISP CQGRP.

Prerequisites:
- The sum of quotas for all carriers equals exactly 100 %.
- Each TGNO to be measured already exists as an incoming or bothway
trunk group.
- None of the trunk groups to be measured is already part of another list
of trunk groups to be measured, neither for the same quota group nor for
another.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CQDAT : CQGRP= ,CARR= ,TGNO= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CARR CARRIER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CQDAT- 1+


ENTR CQDAT
MEASIC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a-b

a: NAME OF CARRIER=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

b: VALUE OF QUOTA OR VALUE OF TRUNK GROUP SIZE SUM=


0,1,2...100, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the quota of outgoing calls to


be assigned to the specified carrier after activation
of the carrier selection destination. If 0 is entered,
the carrier is deactivated until the operator enters a
different value.

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the names of the trunk groups for which
the times for incoming calls are to be summed up.

Up to 48 parameter values can be specified.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CQDAT- 2+


ENTR CQDAT
STAQUO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

STATIC QUOTAS

This input format is entered for carrier data belonging to a quota group
with quota procedure STAQUO.

For the quota procedure STAQUO it is necessary to specify a percentage


quota for each carrier of that quota group.

Prerequisites:
- The sum of quotas for all carriers equals exactly 100%.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CQDAT : CQGRP= ,CARR= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CARR CARRIER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: NAME OF CARRIER=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

b: VALUE OF QUOTA OR VALUE OF TRUNK GROUP SIZE SUM=


0,1,2...100, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the quota of outgoing calls to


be assigned to the specified carrier after activation
of the carrier selection destination. If 0 is entered,
the carrier is deactivated until the operator enters a
different value.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CQDAT- 3+


ENTR CQDAT
TGSIZE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

TRUNK GROUP SIZE

This input format is entered for carrier data belonging to a quota group
with quota procedure TGSIZE.

The quota procedure TGSIZE requires the specification of trunk group


sizes.
Those sizes result in calculated percentages for each carrier of the quota
group. The result of this calculation may be displayed with the command
DISP CQGRP.

The trunk group sizes to be entered in this command refer to the sum of
numbers of trunks in all outgoing trunk groups in the own switch, which are
operated by that carrier. No internal check is executed if the craft’s
input matches the trunk group data in the call processing data base.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CQDAT : CQGRP= ,CARR= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CARR CARRIER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: NAME OF CARRIER=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

b: VALUE OF QUOTA OR VALUE OF TRUNK GROUP SIZE SUM=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

This parameter specifies the quota of outgoing calls to


be assigned to the specified carrier after activation
of the carrier selection destination. If 0 is entered,
the carrier is deactivated until the operator enters a
different value.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CQDAT- 4-


MOD CQDAT
ATGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY CARRIER QUOTA DATA

This command modifies quota data for one or more carriers of a quota group.
Up to 20 carriers can be specified.
Depending on the actual status of the data the following actions are
possible:

- add trunk groups to an existing list,


- modify name of a carrier,
- cancel trunk groups from an existing list,
- modify the quota value of a single or all carriers,
- modify the trunk group size of a single or all carriers,
- modify the quota procedure.

Prerequisites:
- The value of at least one parameter is input to be changed.
- All entered objects exist already.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD CQDAT - ATGNO ADDITIONAL TRUNK GROUP


2. MOD CQDAT - CARR CARRIER
3. MOD CQDAT - CTGNO CANCEL TRUNK GROUP
4. MOD CQDAT - QUOPRO QUOTA PROCEDURE
5. MOD CQDAT - QUOTAIND QUOTA INDIVIDUAL CARR
6. MOD CQDAT - QUOTALL QUOTA ALL CARR
7. MOD CQDAT - TGSIZE TRUNK GROUP SIZE

1. Input format

ADDITIONAL TRUNK GROUP

This input format is entered to add trunk groups to an already existing


list of incoming/bothway trunk groups to be measured. Each trunk group
specified in this input format occupies an element in a pool (group
index list). This pool is not expandable and comprises 1000 elements.

Additional prerequisites:
- A list of trunk groups to be measured already exists for the entered
carrier (refer to ENTR CQDAT for creation of such a list).
- The number of trunk groups already entered and of those being added does
not exceed 48.
- None of the trunk groups to be measured is a member of another list,
neither in the same nor in another quota group.
- Each TGNO to be measured already exists as an incoming or bothway
trunk group.
- There are enough free elements available in the group index list.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD CQDAT : CQGRP= ,CARR= ,ATGNO= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CARR CARRIER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CQDAT- 1+


MOD CQDAT
ATGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ATGNO ADDITIONAL TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

Up to 47 parameter values can be specified.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CQDAT- 2+


MOD CQDAT
CARR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

CARRIER

This input format is entered to modify the name of a carrier.

Additional prerequisites:
- The new name has not been assigned to any carrier within the same carrier
quota group.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD CQDAT : CQGRP= ,CARR= ,NCARR= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CARR CARRIER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NCARR NEW CARRIER NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CQDAT- 3+


MOD CQDAT
CTGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

CANCEL TRUNK GROUP

This input format is entered to remove trunk group numbers from the list of
trunk groups to be measured.
It is possible to remove trunk group numbers from a list of trunk groups to
be measured, and to cancel completely a list that was created provisio-
nally.

Additional prerequisites:
- At least one trunk group number is left in the list of trunk groups to be
measured, if QUOPRO=MEASIC is active for the specified carrier quota
group .

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD CQDAT : CQGRP= ,CARR= ,CTGNO= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CARR CARRIER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CTGNO CANCELLED TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

Up to 48 parameter values can be specified.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CQDAT- 4+


MOD CQDAT
QUOPRO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

QUOTA PROCEDURE

This entry is made to modify the quota procedure for a carrier


quota group.
But it is not permissible to change the kind of quota procedure
to or from CDD.

The existing lists of trunk groups to be measured are kept if the quota
procedure MEASIC was active before the execution of this command. A
similar status as for prepared lists is achieved. These lists may be
deleted if not needed any longer after the modification of the quota
procedure with this command using the parameter CTGNO (see above).

Additional prerequisites:
- The quota group is active.
- Each carrier name of the group is entered, possibly with a trunk group size
of 0 or a quota of 0 % . Up to 20 carriers can be specified.
- At least one trunk group to be measured is assigned to each carrier of
the group if MEASIC is entered as new quota procedure.
- The sum of the quotas of all carriers is exactly 100 %, if a new quota
procedure is entered which requires quota values (STAQUO or MEASIC).

If the execution of this command results in previously deactivated carriers


being activated (i.e. instead of a quota of 0 % now a non-zero quota comes
into effect) then the following prerequisites need to be fulfilled for
successful command execution in addition to the standard prerequisites:
- All destinations for carrier selection which belong to this quota group
have a carrier destination assigned to the carrier being activated.
- Each of these carrier destinations has at least one route.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD CQDAT : CQGRP= ,CARR= ,QUOPRO= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CARR CARRIER

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: NAME OF CARRIER=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

b: VALUE OF QUOTA OR VALUE OF TRUNK GROUP SIZE SUM=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

This parameter unit specifies quota data of the carrier.


Depending on the specified quota procedure, the numerical
value entered represents either a quota (percentage) or a
trunk group size (to be specified as a number of trunks).

QUOPRO QUOTA PROCEDURE

This parameter specifies the quota procedure used to distribute the


call processing load to the carriers in the carrier quota group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

MEASIC MEASUREMENT INCOMING CALLS

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CQDAT- 5+


MOD CQDAT
QUOPRO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The outgoing calls are distributed to the


carriers initially in accordance with the
specified start quotas and later in the ratio
of the total call times measured in the incoming
direction. The quotas are updated whenever
an incoming call time of at least 9000 seconds
is measured for all carriers of the carrier
quota group at a full quarter-hour.

Notes:
Arrangements with the corresponding exchanges must
be taken to ensure that this quota procedure is
only used at one end of the connection. Otherwise,
after a certain time, a stable quota distribution
would result whereby one carrier would be assigned
100% of the load and all other carriers would have
no load.
STAQUO STATIC QUOTAS
The outgoing calls are distributed according to
the specified quotas.
TGSIZE TRUNK GROUP SIZES SUM
The outgoing calls are distributed in the ratio of
the trunk group sizes entered.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CQDAT- 6+


MOD CQDAT
QUOTAIND
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

QUOTA INDIVIDUAL CARR

This input format is entered to modify the quota of a single carrier


belonging to one quota group.

Additional prerequisites:
- The carrier quota group is not active.
- The sum of the quotas of all carriers, including the value to be entered,
is not greater than 100%.
- Only one carrier is specified.
- Prior to command execution a value was specified with
ENTR CQDAT.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD CQDAT : CQGRP= ,CARR= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CARR CARRIER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: NAME OF CARRIER=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

b: VALUE OF QUOTA OR VALUE OF TRUNK GROUP SIZE SUM=


0-100, range of decimal numbers

This parameter unit specifies quota data of the carrier.


Depending on the specified quota procedure, the numerical
value entered represents either a quota (percentage) or a
trunk group size (to be specified as a number of trunks).

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CQDAT- 7+


MOD CQDAT
QUOTALL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

6. Input format

QUOTA ALL CARR

This input format is entered to modify the quotas of all carriers in a


group. Up to 20 carriers can be specified.

Additional prerequisites:
- The quota group is active.
- Each carrier in the quota group is named, possibly with a new quota of 0%
(deactivation of the carrier).
- The sum of the quotas of all carriers is exactly 100% .

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD CQDAT : CQGRP= ,CARR= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CARR CARRIER

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: NAME OF CARRIER=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

b: VALUE OF QUOTA OR VALUE OF TRUNK GROUP SIZE SUM=


0-100, range of decimal numbers

This parameter unit specifies quota data of the carrier.


Depending on the specified quota procedure, the numerical
value entered represents either a quota (percentage) or a
trunk group size (to be specified as a number of trunks).

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CQDAT- 8+


MOD CQDAT
TGSIZE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

7. Input format

TRUNK GROUP SIZE

This input format is entered to modify trunk group sizes.

Additional prerequisites:
- It is only permissible to specify one carrier or all carriers of the carrier
quota group.
- The carrier quota group was created before with QUOPRO=TGSIZE.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD CQDAT : CQGRP= ,CARR= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CARR CARRIER

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: NAME OF CARRIER=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

b: VALUE OF QUOTA OR VALUE OF TRUNK GROUP SIZE SUM=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

This parameter unit specifies quota data of the carrier.


Depending on the specified quota procedure, the numerical
value entered represents either a quota (percentage) or a
trunk group size (to be specified as a number of trunks).

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CQDAT- 9-


CAN CQGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CAN CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This command cancels the specified carrier quota group.

If lists of trunk groups to be measured exist for carriers of the quota


group to be cancelled, then those entries are deleted.

If all carriers of the group being deleted have more than 48 measured
trunk groups assigned in total, then either those lists have to be
cancelled first (MOD CQDAT, parameter CTGNO) or the carriers have to be
deleted individually (MOD CQGRP, parameter CCARR).

Prerequisites:
- No carrier selection destination refers to the quota group that is to be
cancelled.
- The trunk group lists of all carriers do not contain more than 48 trunk
groups.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CQGRP : CQGRP= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CQGRP- 1-


CR CQGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This command creates a carrier quota group, which is a prerequisite for


routing with load sharing. The following data are assigned to the carrier
quota group.

- the name by which the carrier quota group is addressed


- the quota procedure used
- the names of the carriers belonging to the carrier quota group.

All destinations for carrier selection assigned to a quota group are


subject to joint quota assignment. Destinations for carrier selection must
be assigned to quota groups in such a way that each carrier involved can
serve all subscriber directory numbers or lines within the area represented
by the sum of all destination area groups.

Prerequisites:
- The quota group name does not yet exist.
- No carrier name occurs more than once in the quota group that is to be
created.

To enable a quota group to be activated, it is necessary to assign the


quota data for each carrier with the command ENTR CQDAT.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR CQGRP : CQGRP= ,QUOPRO= ,CARR= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This parameter specifies the name of the carrier quota group.


The name is user specifiable, it is not permissible to specify
a single X.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

QUOPRO QUOTA PROCEDURE

This parameter specifies the quota procedure used to distribute the


call processing load to the carriers in the carrier quota group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TGSIZE TRUNK GROUP SIZES SUM


The outgoing calls are distributed
in the ratio of the trunk group
sizes entered.
STAQUO STATIC QUOTAS
The outgoing calls are distributed
according to the specified quotas.
MEASIC MEASUREMENT INCOMING CALLS
The outgoing calls are distributed to the
carriers initially in accordance with the
specified start quotas and later according to the
total call times measured in the incoming
direction. The quotas are updated whenever an
incoming call time of at least 9000 seconds is
measured for all carriers of the carrier quota
group at a full quarter-hour.

Notes:
- Arrangements must be made with the
corresponding exchanges to ensure that this

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CQGRP- 1+
CR CQGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

quota procedure is only used at one end of the


connection. Otherwise, after a certain time, a
stable quota distribution would result whereby
one carrier would be assigned 100% of the load
and all other carriers would have no load.
CDD CARRIER DIVERGENCE DESTINATION
A call is routed to a new directory number, which
is selected on a cyclic basis in order to
guarantee equal distribution.
The new directory numbers can be allocated to the
carrier destinations used in this quota procedure,
by means of the parameter FOVCODE.

CARR CARRIER NAME

Up to 20 parameter values can be specified.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CQGRP- 2-
DISP CQGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This command displays the data of all or selected carrier quota groups.
The display of all quota group data is achieved by input of CQGRP = X.
The amount of display may be reduced by entering additional parameters:
Only those quota groups out of all existing groups are displayed which have
the specified carrier name (CARR) or quota procedure (QUOPRO).

If several parameters are entered only those quota groups are displayed
which fulfill all conditions at the same time.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CQGRP : CQGRP= [,CARR=] [,QUOPRO=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

Up to 32 parameter values can be specified.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CARR CARRIER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

QUOPRO QUOTA PROCEDURE

This parameter specifies the quota procedure used to distribute the


call processing load to the carriers of the carrier group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TGSIZE TRUNK GROUP SIZE


STAQUO STATIC QUOTAS
MEASIC MEASUREMENT INCOMING CALLS
CDD CARRIER DIVERGENCE DESTINATION

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CQGRP- 1-


MOD CQGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This command modifies data of a quota group. The name of the group may be
changed as well as the amount of assigned carriers.

It is required to modify each destination for carrier selection which is


assigned to the quota group in an identical manner, in order to maintain
consistent data (MOD DESTDAT).

Prerequisite:
- The value of at least one parameter is changed.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD CQGRP : CQGRP= <,NCQGRP= ,CARR= ,CCARR=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This parameter specifies the carrier quota group for which data
are to be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NCQGRP NEW CARRIER QUOTA GROUP NAME

This parameter specifies the new name for the


carrier quota group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CARR ADDITIONAL CARRIER

This parameter specifies the carrier to be assigned


to the carrier quota group. Up to 19 parameter
values can be specified.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CCARR CANCELLED CARRIER

This parameter specifies the carrier to be deleted


from the carrier quota group. Up to 19 parameter
values can be specified.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CQGRP- 1-


CONF CR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE CODE RECEIVER

With this command one or all codereceiver of a module can be


configured to one of the states MBL, ACT or PLA.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,LCPOS=1 1
1 CONF CR : LTG= Z,CRPOS=Y ,OST= ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LTG NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LTGSET NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

LCPOS LINE CIRCUIT POSITION

This parameter specifies the position of a codereceiver in


the line trunk unit.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b[-c]

a: LINE TRUNK UNIT=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...6, range of decimal numbers

c: CIRCUIT NUMBER=
0-7, range of decimal numbers

If this unit is omitted, all possible unit values are


affected.

CRPOS CODE RECEIVER POSITION

This parameter specifies the position of a codereceiver in


a signaling unit SU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: MODULE NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the module.

Compatibilities:
0-2 for LTGB
0-7 for LTGC
0 for LTGD

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF CR- 1+


CONF CR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: CODE RECEIVER NUMBER=


0-3, range of decimal numbers

If this unit is omitted, all possible unit values


are affected.

OST OPERATING STATUS

This parameter specifies the destination operating status.


The following status transitions are permitted:

ACT <-> MBL


MBL <-> PLA
UNA --> ACT or MBL

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
PLA PLANNED
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF CR- 2-


DIAG CR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSE CODE RECEIVER

This command starts diagnosis for one or more code receivers on a


module.
Prerequisites:
- A diagnosis is only possible module by module.
- The code receiver to be diagnosed must be MAINTENANCE BLOCKED
- The LTG control unit must be ACTIVE or CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED.
- The code receiver must be MAINTENANCE BLOCKED.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,CRPOS=1 1
1 DIAG CR : LTG= Z,LCPOS=Y ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LTG NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LTGSET NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

CRPOS CODE RECEIVER POSITION

This parameter specifies the position of a code receiver in the


signaling unit.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the position of the CR module.


The following value ranges are permissible:
0-3 for LTGB
0-7 for LTGC
0 for LTGD

LCPOS LINE CIRCUIT POSITION

This parameter specifies the position of a code receiver in the


line trunk unit.
The mounting locations are to be determined from the exchange-
specific documentation.These documents must be kept current.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LTU NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...6, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG CR- 1-


STAT CR
CR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY STATUS OF CODE RECEIVER

This command displays the operating state(s) of


- a particular code receiver module in a particular LTG
- a particular code receiver module in all LTGs
- all code receiver in a particular LTG
- all code receiver in all LTGs
- all code receiver in a particular operating state in a particular LTG
- all code receiver in a particular operating state in all LTGs
For the parameter LTG a value or X must always be entered.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. STAT CR - CR CODE RECEIVER


2. STAT CR - OST OPERATIONAL STATUS

1. Input format

CODE RECEIVER

Input format for displaying the CR operating states.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,LCPOS=11 1
1 STAT CR : LTG= 1Z,CRPOS=Y1 ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LTG NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: LTGSET NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

LCPOS LINE CIRCUIT POSITION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LTU NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...6, range of decimal numbers

CRPOS CODE RECEIVER POSITION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: MODULE NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT CR- 1+


STAT CR
CR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This unit specifies the position of the module.


Compatibilities:
0-2 for LTGB
0-7 for LTGC
0 for LTGD

b: CODE RECEIVER NUMBER=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

If this unit is omitted, all possible unit values are affected.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT CR- 2+


STAT CR
OST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

OPERATIONAL STATUS

Input format for determining code receivers in a particular operating


state.
Notes:
- If the parameter LTG NUMBER is omitted, all possible values are affected.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT CR : LTG= ,OST= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LTG NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: LTGSET NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

OST OPERATING STATUS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED
PLA PLANNED
STB STANDBY
UNA UNAVAILABLE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT CR- 3-


CAN CRMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CODE RECEIVER MODULE

This command cancels a code receiver module in the signaling


unit of an LTG.

Prerequisites:
- The code receiver module must be PLA.
- The ports of the code receiver must not be in service.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CRMOD : LTG= ,CRMOD= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter specifies the LTG.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTGSET number.

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


1...63, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTG number.

CRMOD CODE RECEIVER MODULE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the number of the code receiver module


to be cancelled.
For the signaling unit LTG type LTGB only the code receiver
modules 0, 1 or 2 may be specified. For the signaling unit of
LTG type LTGD only the code receiver modules 0 may be specified.

Notes:
If, in spite of the LTG being operational, the port data cannot
be sent to the GP, it is possible to configure the associated
LTG to MBL. If it is configured from this state to
ACT, the LTG receives the data stored in the CP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...7, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CRMOD- 1-


CR CRMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE CODE RECEIVER MODULE

This command creates a code receiver module in the signaling unit


of an LTG.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR CRMOD : LTG= ,CRMOD= ,TYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter specifies the LTG.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTGSET number.

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


1...63, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTG number.

CRMOD CODE RECEIVER MODULE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the number of the code receiver module.


For the signaling unit of LTG type LTGB only the code receiver
modules 0, 1 or 2 may be specified. For the signaling unit of
LTG type LTGD only the code receiver module 0 may be specified.
For the LTG types and LTGH no code receiver modules may be
specified.

The configuration data for the four ports of a code receiver


module depend on the code receiver type.

The ports are assigned to the code receiver modules as follows:

LTG type LTGB:

+------------+----------------+
! Port no.: ! CR module no.: !
+------------+----------------+
! 256 - 259 ! 0 !
! 260 - 263 ! 1 !
! 264 - 267 ! 2 !
+------------+----------------+

LTG type LTGC:

+--------------+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
! CR module no.! 0 ! 1 ! 2 ! 3 ! 4 ! 5 ! 6 ! 7 !
+--------------+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
! Port no. ! 160 ! 161 ! 162 ! 163 ! 164 ! 165 ! 166 ! 167 !
! ! 168 ! 169 ! 170 ! 171 ! 172 ! 173 ! 174 ! 175 !
! ! 176 ! 177 ! 178 ! 179 ! 180 ! 181 ! 182 ! 183 !
! ! 184 ! 185 ! 186 ! 187 ! 188 ! 189 ! 190 ! 191 !
+--------------+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+

LTG type LTGD:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CRMOD- 1+
CR CRMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

+------------+----------------+
! Port no.: ! CR module no.: !
+------------+----------------+
! 256 - 259 ! 0 !
+------------+----------------+

LTG type LTGG, LTGM or LTGN operated as LTGB:

+------------+----------------+
! Port no.: ! CR module no.: !
+------------+----------------+
! 256 - 259 ! 0 !
! 260 - 263 ! 1 !
+------------+----------------+

Code receiver module 0 and 1 must be created with


the same code receiver module type.
RMCTC may only be specified for code receiver module 0;
in this case module 1 is unused.

LTG type LTGG, LTGM or LTGN operated as LTGC:

+--------------+-----+-----+-----+-----+
! CR module no.! 0 ! 1 ! 4 ! 5 !
+--------------+-----+-----+-----+-----+
! Port no. ! 160 ! 161 ! 164 ! 165 !
! ! 168 ! 169 ! 172 ! 173 !
! ! 176 ! 177 ! 180 ! 181 !
! ! 184 ! 185 ! 188 ! 189 !
+--------------+-----+-----+-----+-----+

Code receiver module 0 and 1, respectively 4 and 5, must


be created with the same code receive module type.
RMCTC may only be specified for code receiver module 0;
in this case module 1 is unused.

Note:
If, in spite of the LTG being operational, the port data
cannot be sent to the GP, it is advisable to cancel the job
with the command CAN CRMOD and to recreate the code receiver
module. Alternatively, the associated LTG can be configured to
MBL. If the LTG is configured from this state to ACT, it
receives the data stored in the CP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...7, range of decimal numbers

TYPE CODE RECEIVER TYPE

This parameter specifies the code receiver module type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CRPC CODE RECEIVER PUSHBUTTON CEPT


CRMR2 CODE RECEIVER MFC R2 SIGNALING
RMCTC CODE RECEIVER RMCTC
This module type may only be specified for
code receiver type 0.
CRMR1 CODE RECEIVER MFC R1 SIGNALING
CRMSC CODE RECEIVER MSC SIGNALING

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR CRMOD- 2-
DISP CRMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CODE RECEIVER MODULE

This command displays the code receiver module data for one, several or
all the LTGs in an exchange.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP CRMOD : LTG= [,CRMOD=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter specifies the LTG. Depending on the value entered


the following options are possible:

1. <ltgset> - <ltg>
All objects for the specified LTG are displayed.
Only in this case is it permissable to specify parameter
CRMOD.
2. <ltgset> - <ltg> && <ltgset> - <ltg>
All objects for the specified range of LTGs are displayed.
The first limit must be lower than the second limit.
3. <ltgset> - X
The objects of all LTGs for the specified LTGSET are displayed.
4. X - X
The objects for all LTGs and LTGSETs are displayed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTGSET number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


1...63, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTG number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

CRMOD CODE RECEIVER MODULE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the number of the code receiver module.


For the signaling unit LTG type LTGB the code receiver
modules 0, 1 or 2 may be specified. For the signaling unit of
LTG type LTGD only code receiver module 0 may be specified.
For the LTG type LTGH no code receiver modules may be specified.

Default: All code receivers in the specified LTGs are displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...7, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CRMOD- 1-


DMP CSCTRAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DUMP CSC-TRACE DATA

This command dumps data in the trace memory. The trace function is
stopped by this command. The last event stored is printed first.
If the command is entered several times, the trace memory can be
output to the end (oldest frame).

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DMP CSCTRAC : CSC= [,BLKCO=] [,BLKLEN=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CSC CENTRAL SERVICE CHANNEL

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...99, range of decimal numbers

BLKCO BLOCK COUNT

This parameter specifies the number of data blocks


to be printed out.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...9999, range of decimal numbers

Default: 9999

BLKLEN BLOCK LENGTH

This parameter specifies how many bytes per block are to be


printed out.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...5200, range of decimal numbers

Default: 5200

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP CSCTRAC- 1-


START CSWD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

START CSWD PROCESSES

This command starts the control and switching device processes which handle the
configuration of peripheral units.
Start of functions for activating the call processing(classic) periphery (LTG,
MB, SN, DLU) and start of CALLP.

Notes:
This command is only allowed during the installation phase (installation
recovery).

This command is only permitted when an exchange is first being put into service.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 START CSWD ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 START CSWD- 1-


CAN CUG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CLOSED USER GROUP

This command cancels


- the existing membership of a subscriber/PBX in one closed user
group,
- the membership of one or several services in a closed user group,
- the traffic restriction within the closed user group for the
subscriber/PBX.

Notes:
- If the last closed user group of a subscriber/PBX or of a service
is canceled, then also the network authorizations and the prefe-
rential closed group are canceled.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CUG : [LAC=] ,DN= ,CUGID= [,SERV=] [,CUGBLK=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple directory number
volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the subscriber or


the PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CUGID CUG IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the closed user group identification, which


is specific per subscriber/PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...99, range of decimal numbers

SERV SERVICE

This parameter specifies the services of the subscriber/PBX


for which the closed user group is to be canceled.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ANALOG ANALOG PART OF MIXED PBX


CMSPEECH CIR. MODE SPEECH BEARER SRV
CMUNRST CIR. M. 64KBIT/S UNR. BEA. SRV
CMAUDIO CIR. MODE 3.1KHZ AUD. BEA. SRV
CMAUDI7K CIR. MODE 7KHZ AUD. BEA. SRV
CMSERV06 CM SERVICE 06
CMSERV07 CM SERVICE 07
UNKNOWN UNKNOWN BEARER SERVICE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CUG- 1+


CAN CUG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PMDCHANN PACKET MODE D-CHANNEL


PMBDCHAN PACKET MODE SWITCHED BD-CHAN.
TEL3K TELEPHONY 3.1KHZ
TEL7K TELEPHONY 7KHZ
FAX3 TELEFAX GROUP 2/3
FAX4 TELEFAX GROUP 4
TTX64K TELETEXT 64KBIT/S
VIDEOTEX VIDEO TEXT
VIDEOTEL VIDEO TELEPHONY
SERV19 SERVICE 19
SERV20 SERVICE 20
SERV21 SERVICE 21
SERV22 SERVICE 22
SERV23 SERVICE 23
SERV24 SERVICE 24
SERV25 SERVICE 25
SERV26 SERVICE 26
SERV27 SERVICE 27
NONVCGRP NONVOICE SERVICE GROUP
VOICEGRP VOICE SERVICE GROUP
ALLGRP ALL SERVICE GROUP

CUGBLK CUG BLOCKING

This parameter specifies a restriction on the communication with


other members within the same closed user group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TERM TERM. CALLS BLOCKED WITHIN CUG


ORIG ORIG. CALLS BLOCKED WITHIN CUG

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CUG- 2-


DISP CUG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY CLOSED USER GROUP DATA

This command displays closed user group data for


- a specified subscriber or PBX,
- all subscribers and PBX in a directory number interval,
- all subscribers and PBX of a specified local area code or
- all subscribers and PBX in the exchange.

A selection can be made on


- the closed user group identification or
- the interlock code or
- the interlock code and the data network identification code.

Notes:
- If desired, also the service dependant closed user group data of
ISDN-subscribers, ISDN- and mixed PBX can be displayed.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,CUGID=11 (;) 1
1 DISP CUG : [LAC=] ,DN= 1Z,ILC= Y1 [,DNIC=] [,FORMAT=] Z Y 1
1 11 11 *!+ 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple directory number
volume.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number or directory number


interval. The directory number or, if an interval is entered, the
directory number boundaries, must be numbers of a created directory
number interval. Only one interval can be entered.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

1...12 digit decimal number

CUGID CUG IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the closed user group identification, which


is specific per subscriber/PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...99, range of decimal numbers

ILC INTERLOCK CODE

This parameter specifies the interlock code, which is the national


identification of the closed user group.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CUG- 1+


DISP CUG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...65535, range of decimal numbers

DNIC DATA NETWORK IDENTIFICAT. CODE

This parameter specifies the data network identification code, which


is the international identification of the closed user group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

FORMAT OUTPUT FORMAT

This parameter specifies whether, for ISDN subscribers and ISDN or


mixed PBX, only the subscriber/PBX specific closed user group data are
displayed or additionally the service specific closed user group data.

Notes:
- If the parameter is omitted, then only the subscriber/PBX specific
closed user group data are displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CUG OUTPUT OF CUG DATA


Only subscriber/PBX specific closed user group
data are displayed.
ALL OUTPUT OF CUG AND SERVCUG DATA
Subscriber/PBX specific and service specific
closed group data are displayed.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP CUG- 2-


ENTR CUG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CLOSED USER GROUP

This command
- assigns a subscriber (analog mainstation or ISDN) or PBX (analog,
mixed or ISDN) to a closed user group,
- enters data for the closed user group of a subscriber/PBX.

With the first assignment of a subscriber/PBX to a closed user group,


the closed user group is implicitly created in the public network.
A closed user group is identified by the international identi-
fication ’data network identification code’ DNIC and the national
identification ’interlock code’ ILC.
The different closed user groups of a subscriber/PBX are identified
by the closed user group identification CUGID.
A subscriber/PBX can be a member of 100 different closed user groups.

The services which a subscriber/PBX can use within the closed user
group can be entered. For a mixed PBX, the analog part must expli-
citly be administered with the parameter SERV=ANALOG.
ISDN1TR6 services can only be a member in one closed user group,
which will automatically be set as preferential closed user group for
the service.

With the assignment of the first closed user group to a service, the
protocol types for the service are adopted from the office data. The
office data can be determined with the command DISP CALLPOPT.

For an ISDN-DSS1 or analog subscriber/PBX the traffic restrictions


within the closed user group can be entered. The traffic within a
closed user group may be restricted either to only receiving calls or
to only originating calls within the specified closed user group.

Notes:

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR CUG : [LAC=] ,DN= ,CUGID= [,DNIC=] <,ILC= ,SERV= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,CUGBLK=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple directory number
volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the subscriber or


the PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CUGID CUG IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the closed user group identification, which


is specific per subscriber/PBX.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CUG- 1+


ENTR CUG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...99, range of decimal numbers

DNIC DATA NETWORK IDENTIFICAT. CODE

This parameter specifies the data network identification code, which is


the international identification of the closed user group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

ILC INTERLOCK CODE

This parameter specifies the interlock code, which is the national


identification of the closed user group.

Notes:
- When entering a new closed user group, this parameter is
obligatory.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...65535, range of decimal numbers

SERV SERVICE

This parameter specifies the existing services of the subscriber/PBX


for which the closed user group is to be entered.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ANALOG ANALOG PART OF MIXED PBX


CMSPEECH CIR. MODE SPEECH BEARER SRV
CMUNRST CIR. M. 64KBIT/S UNR. BEA. SRV
CMAUDIO CIR. MODE 3.1KHZ AUD. BEA. SRV
CMAUDI7K CIR. MODE 7KHZ AUD. BEA. SRV
CMSERV06 CM SERVICE 06
CMSERV07 CM SERVICE 07
UNKNOWN UNKNOWN BEARER SERVICE
PMDCHANN PACKET MODE D-CHANNEL
PMBDCHAN PACKET MODE SWITCHED BD-CHAN.
TEL3K TELEPHONY 3.1KHZ
TEL7K TELEPHONY 7KHZ
FAX3 TELEFAX GROUP 2/3
FAX4 TELEFAX GROUP 4
TTX64K TELETEXT 64KBIT/S
VIDEOTEX VIDEO TEXT
VIDEOTEL VIDEO TELEPHONY
SERV19 SERVICE 19
SERV20 SERVICE 20
SERV21 SERVICE 21
SERV22 SERVICE 22
SERV23 SERVICE 23
SERV24 SERVICE 24
SERV25 SERVICE 25
SERV26 SERVICE 26
SERV27 SERVICE 27
NONVCGRP NONVOICE SERVICE GROUP
VOICEGRP VOICE SERVICE GROUP
ALLGRP ALL SERVICE GROUP

CUGBLK CUG BLOCKING

This parameter specifies a restriction on the communication with


other members within the same closed user group.

Notes:
- This parameter is only relevant for ISDN-DSS1 and analog
subscribers/PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CUG- 2+


ENTR CUG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TERM TERM. CALLS BLOCKED WITHIN CUG


ORIG ORIG. CALLS BLOCKED WITHIN CUG

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CUG- 3-


MOD CUGAUTH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY CLOSED USER GROUP AUTHORIZATION

This command modifies closed user group data of a subscriber/PBX The closed user
group data that can be modified are
- the authorizations for the traffic to/from the public network,
- the preferential closed user group.

These closed user group data are valid if no service-specific data are assigned
with the command ENTR SERVCUG.

Notes:
- At least one of the parameters NETAUTH, CNETAUTH, PCUGID and CPCUGID
must be entered.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD CUGAUTH : [LAC=] ,DN= [,NETAUTH=] [,CNETAUTH=] 1
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,PCUGID= 11 (;) 1
1 1Z,CPCUGID=Y1 Z Y 1
1 11 11 *!+ 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple directory number
volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the subscriber or


the PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NETAUTH NETWORK AUTHORIZATION

This parameter enters authorizations for the traffic to/from the


public network.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ICTRAF I/C TRAFFIC FROM PUBLIC NETW.


Incoming traffic from the public network

Notes:
- the incoming traffic is only relevant for
ISDN-DSS1 and analog subscribers/PBX.

OGTRREQ O/G TRAF. TO PUB. NET. ON REQ.


Outgoing traffic to the public network on
explicit request

CNETAUTH CANCEL NETWORK AUTHORIZATION

This parameter cancels existing authorizations for the traffic to/from

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CUGAUTH- 1+


MOD CUGAUTH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

the public network.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ICTRAF I/C TRAFFIC FROM PUBLIC NETW.


Incoming traffic from the public network
OGTRREQ O/G TRAF. TO PUB. NET. ON REQ.
Outgoing traffic to the public network on
explicit request

PCUGID PREFERENTIAL CUG IDENTIFICAT.

This parameter enters the preferential closed user group of the


subscriber/PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...99, range of decimal numbers

CPCUGID CANCEL PREF. CUG IDENTIFICAT.

This parameter cancels the preferential closed user group of the


subscriber/PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...99, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD CUGAUTH- 2-


CAN CUGSERV
ALLCUG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL CLOSED USER GROUP SERVICE

This command deletes an entry in the CUG table.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CAN CUGSERV - ALLCUG DELETE ALL CUGS


2. CAN CUGSERV - BSVG DELETE BSVG OF A CUG
3. CAN CUGSERV - CUG DELETE ONE CUG
4. CAN CUGSERV - PCUG DELETE PCUG ENTRY

1. Input format

DELETE ALL CUGS

This input format deletes all CUG entries of a subscriber.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CUGSERV : MSIN= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CUGSERV- 1+


CAN CUGSERV
BSVG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

DELETE BSVG OF A CUG

This input format deletes BSVG


within a CUG of a subscriber.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CUGSERV : MSIN= ,CUG= ,BSVG= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

CUG CLOSED USER GROUP

This parameter specifies the closed user group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...32767, range of decimal numbers

BSVG BASIC SERVICE GROUP CODES

This parameter specifies basic service group codes.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ALLBS ALL BEARER SERVICES


ALLBSV ALL BASIC SERVICES
ALLTS ALL TELESERVICES
BS20 DATA CIRCUIT DUPLEX ASYN SERV
BS30 DATA CIRCUIT SYN. SERVICES
TELEPHON TELEPHONY
TS60 FACSIMILE SERVICES

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CUGSERV- 2+


CAN CUGSERV
CUG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

DELETE ONE CUG

This input format deletes a CUG entry of a subscriber.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CUGSERV : MSIN= ,CUG= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

CUG CLOSED USER GROUP

This parameter specifies the closed user group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...32767, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CUGSERV- 3+


CAN CUGSERV
PCUG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

DELETE PCUG ENTRY

This input format resets the PCUG entry.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN CUGSERV : MSIN= ,PCUG= ,BSVG= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

PCUG PREFERENTIAL CUG

This parameter specifies the preferential closed user group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...32767, range of decimal numbers

BSVG BASIC SERVICE GROUP CODES

This parameter specifies basic service group codes.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ALLBS ALL BEARER SERVICES


ALLBSV ALL BASIC SERVICES
ALLTS ALL TELESERVICES
BS20 DATA CIRCUIT DUPLEX ASYN SERV
BS30 DATA CIRCUIT SYN. SERVICES
TELEPHON TELEPHONY
TS60 FACSIMILE SERVICES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN CUGSERV- 4-


ENTR CUGSERV
CUG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER CLOSED USER GROUP SERVICE

This command provides closed user group services and activates


the service.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ENTR CUGSERV - CUG CLOSED USER GROUP


2. ENTR CUGSERV - SERVDATA CLOSED USER GROUP SERVICE DATA
3. ENTR CUGSERV - SERVICES CLOSED USER GROUP SERVICES

1. Input format

CLOSED USER GROUP

This input format creates a new CUG.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CUGSERV : MSIN= ,CUG= ,DNIC= ,ILC= ,BSVG= [,INTRACR=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

CUG CLOSED USER GROUP

This parameter specifies the closed user group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...32767, range of decimal numbers

DNIC DATA NETWORK IDENTITY CODE

This parameter specifies the data network identification code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

ILC INTERLOCK CODE

This parameter specifies the interlock code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...65535, range of decimal numbers

BSVG BASIC SERVICE GROUP CODES

This parameter specifies basic service group codes.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ALLBS ALL BEARER SERVICES


ALLBSV ALL BASIC SERVICES

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CUGSERV- 1+


ENTR CUGSERV
CUG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ALLTS ALL TELESERVICES


BS20 DATA CIRCUIT DUPLEX ASYN SERV
BS30 DATA CIRCUIT SYN. SERVICES
TELEPHON TELEPHONY
TS60 FACSIMILE SERVICES

INTRACR INTRA CUG RESTRICTION

This parameter specifies the intra cug restrictions.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ICB INCOMING CALLS BARRED


NONE NONE
OCB OUTGOING CALLS BARRED

Default: NONE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CUGSERV- 2+


ENTR CUGSERV
SERVDATA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

CLOSED USER GROUP SERVICE DATA

This input format modifies basic service specific CUG data.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CUGSERV : MSIN= ,BSVG= <,PCUG= ,INTERCA=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

BSVG BASIC SERVICE GROUP CODES

This parameter specifies basic service group codes.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ALLBS ALL BEARER SERVICES


ALLBSV ALL BASIC SERVICES
ALLTS ALL TELESERVICES
BS20 DATA CIRCUIT DUPLEX ASYN SERV
BS30 DATA CIRCUIT SYN. SERVICES
TELEPHON TELEPHONY
TS60 FACSIMILE SERVICES

PCUG PREFERENTIAL CUG

This parameter specifies the preferential closed user group.

Prerequisites:
- The CUG has to be created first.

Incompatibilities:
- INTRA CUG RESTRICTION = OUTGOING CALLS BARRED
is not allowed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...32767, range of decimal numbers

INTERCA INTER CUG ACCESSIBILITY

This parameter specifies the inter closed user group


accessibility.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IA INCOMING ACCESS
IOA INCOMING AND OUTGOING ACCESS
NONE NONE
OA OUTGOING ACCESS

Default: NONE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CUGSERV- 3+


ENTR CUGSERV
SERVICES
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

CLOSED USER GROUP SERVICES

This input format modifies an existing CUG.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR CUGSERV : MSIN= ,CUG= <,BSVG= ,INTRACR=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

CUG CLOSED USER GROUP

This parameter specifies the closed user group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...32767, range of decimal numbers

BSVG BASIC SERVICE GROUP CODES

This parameter specifies basic service group codes.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ALLBS ALL BEARER SERVICES


ALLBSV ALL BASIC SERVICES
ALLTS ALL TELESERVICES
BS20 DATA CIRCUIT DUPLEX ASYN SERV
BS30 DATA CIRCUIT SYN. SERVICES
TELEPHON TELEPHONY
TS60 FACSIMILE SERVICES

INTRACR INTRA CUG RESTRICTION

This parameter specifies the intra cug restrictions.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ICB INCOMING CALLS BARRED


NONE NONE
OCB OUTGOING CALLS BARRED

Default: NONE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR CUGSERV- 4-


REL CYCFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RELEASE CYCLIC FILE

This command releases the last saved data in the specified cyclic file
for overwriting. In addition, an entry is made in the administrative
part of the file stating that the next save is to be started from the
oldest record that has not yet been saved.

Prerequisite:
- The file must exist.
- The file must not be in the process of being saved.
- The file must be a cyclic file.
- The file must have been saved at least once before.

Notes:
- If no data to be released exist (file was not copied at least once),
or if the copied part of the file was already overwritten, it is
possible that command execution is reported (EXECUTED) but that the
occupancy level of the file does not change.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REL CYCFILE : FILE= [,UNCOND=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the disk file.


The following characters must not be used:
- A succession of periods (...)
- A single period, or a combination ending in a period.
- A single asterisk, or a combination ending in an asterisk.
- A single X.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


+,%,#

UNCOND UNCONDITIONAL

This parameter allows files to be deleted if they have been


transferred at least once to an external data carrier, even
if backup copies are missing.

N CHECK EXECUTED COPIES


NO CHECK EXECUTED COPIES
Y CHECK FILE TRANSFERRED ONCE
YES CHECK FILE TRANSFERRED ONCE

Default: N

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REL CYCFILE- 1-


DMP DALLOC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Dump Disk Allocation

This task displays a disk allocation (FBSU/FBMUs) using a DUMP utilitity.


The dump will always be displayed symbolic.Symbolic means the logical
structure of the displayed data.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DMP DALLOC : SCSI= [,MP_ID=] ,Side= ,Number= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCSI

Specifies the disk SCSI address.


In the current EWSD version the possible values are hard-coded:
SYS: scsi = 0, side = 0&1
MOD0: scsi = 1, side = 0
MOD1: scsi = 1, side = 1

MP_ID

Specifies the Identifier of MP.

Side

Specifies the mpu side.

Number

Specifies the number of disk blocks.


Can be obtained by the dump boot sector.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP DALLOC- 1-


REP DATFILES

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Repair Data Files on MP

This task repairs the ’Data’ files of the


loaded, disabled ’Generation’ on the
system disk of the MP. If the loaded
’Generation’ is corrupted due to defective
’Data’ files there is the possibility to
repair this ’Generation’ by performing a
so called data snapshot from memory into the loaded and
disabled ’Generation’ on system disk.
The system runs in diskless operation mode because of the
disabled loaded ’Generation’; therefore a
data snapshot into the loaded ’Generation’
is performed, which ends the diskless operation.

Notes:
- The task is possible only if the loaded
’Generation’ is defective and the
’Operational State’ attribute equals ’Disabled’.
- This is a long-running task. The NE issues following
event reports:
Data Snapshot Report,
begin-, progress- and end event reports

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REP DATFILES ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REP DATFILES- 1-


START DB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

START DATA BASE

This command starts processes necessary to create and populate the Data Base.

Notes:
This command is only allowed during the installation phase (installation
recovery).

This command is only permitted when an exchange is first being put into service.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 START DB ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 START DB- 1-


DISP DBCONT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Database Content

This task retrieves the Database Content. The retrieval of a


selected functional area of the Database Content can be specified
by the parameter ’Functional Area’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP DBCONT : Functional Area= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Functional Area

Enter this parameter to specify which functional area of the


Database Content must be retrieved.

Input format: selection of


- NodeBasics
- Log
- Alarming
- EFD
- GPRS/UMTS
- MTP
- SCCP
- SCCP Screening
- ATM
- AccesControl
- FileSecurity
- Authentication
- TrunkLineMaintenance
- Measurements
- MeasurementJob
- SoftwareManagement
- Trace&Debug
- LogRecords
- MTP,SCCP and SCCPScreening
- MTP, SCCP, SCCPScreening and EFD
- All Areas except LogRecords

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DBCONT- 1-


DMP DBLOCK

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Dump Disk Block

This task dumps a disk block using a DUMP utilitity.


The dump can be displayed either binary (hexadecimal + ASCII) or symbolic (see
help for input field SYMB).
If the block number is not specified, the block 0 will be displayed (boot sector
/ boot area).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DMP DBLOCK : SCSI= [,MP_ID=] ,Side= ,Block= ,Offset= ,Length= 1
1 1
1 ,Symb= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCSI

Specifies the disk SCSI address.


In the current EWSD version the possible values are hard-coded:
SYS: scsi = 0, side = 0&1
MOD0: scsi = 1, side = 0
MOD1: scsi = 1, side = 1

MP_ID

Specifies the Identifier of MP.

Side

Specifies the mpu side.

Block

Specifies the disk block number.


Default value is 0 (boot sector / boot area).

Offset

Specifies the offset of displayed data within the block.


Negative value means offset from the block end.
Default value is 0 (from the block beginning).

Length

Specifies the length of displayed data.


Default value is 0 (whole block).

Symb

Specifies if the output will be displayed symbolic.


Symbolic means the logical structure of the blocks.
Allowed values are NO (the blocks are displayed in hex + ASCII Dump),
SHORT (the blocks are displayed symbolic) and LONG (the blocks and all
connected blocks are displayed symbolic). If the value of the parameter
SYMB is unequal NO, the parameters OFFSET and LENGTH will be ignored.
Default value is LONG.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP DBLOCK- 1-


PATCH DBLOCK

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Patch Disk Block

This task patches a disk block using a PATCH utilitity.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 PATCH DBLOCK : SCSI= [,MP_ID=] ,Side= ,Block= ,Offset= ,Comp= 1
1 1
1 ,Data= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCSI

Specifies the disk SCSI address.


In the current EWSD version the possible values are hard-coded:
SYS: scsi = 0, side = 0&1
MOD0: scsi = 1, side = 0
MOD1: scsi = 1, side = 1

MP_ID

Specifies the Identifier of MP.

Side

Specifies the mpu side.

Block

Specifies the disk block number.

Offset

Specifies the offset of patched data within the block.


Negative value means offset from the block end.
Default value is 0 (from the block beginning).

Comp

Specifies the compare data.


Syntax: value [ & value ] ...
value: [ - ] decimal | $ hexadecimal | ’ string ’

Data

Specifies the patch data.


Syntax: value [ & value ] ...
value: [ - ] decimal | $ hexadecimal | ’ string ’

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 PATCH DBLOCK- 1-


ACT DBQUERY

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE DATABASE QUERY

This command activates a database query to create a file on disc with


data related to unconnected ports or with connected and unconnected ports.
The query can be performed on :
- all hardware created on the local exchange,
- a single DLU,
- a single LTG,
- a single V5IF.

Prerequisites:
- No file for the same query (FREE/ALL) may exist.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,DLU= 11 1
1 ACT DBQUERY : QUERY= 1Z,LTG= Y1 ; 1
1 11,V5IF=11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

QUERY QUERY TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of query to be activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FREE FREE PORTS


ALL ALL PORTS

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: TIME STAGE GROUP NUMBER=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


1...63, range of decimal numbers

V5IF V5 INTERFACE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the V5 interface.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

6000...8999, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT DBQUERY- 1-


DISP DBSIZE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DATA BASE DESCRIPTION

This command enables the display of information about the expandable


part of database. Parameters can be input in continuation mode.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP DBSIZE : [DPUSED=] [,GROUP=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DPUSED DISPLAY PERCENT USED

This parameter specifies the displayed information.


Default is NO.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

YES PERCENT USED DISPLAY


Input of YES or Y includes the display of
filling levels of the expandable data arrays
specified by the group parameter.
Y PERCENT USED DISPLAY
See YES.
NO NO PERCENT USED DISPLAY
Input of NO or N or no input excludes the
display of filling levels of the expandable data
arrays specified by group parameter.
N NO PERCENT USED DISPLAY
See NO.

GROUP NAME OF EXPANDABLE GROUP

Input of group names (three to five characters) in continuation mode


restricts the display of information to those groups. If the
parameter is omitted, all group information is displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

3...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DBSIZE- 1-


MOD DBSIZE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY DB-SIZE

This command expands the areas of database. This command is part of


the file generation concept of CP113. The command always creates a new
file generation with modified SY.TASKLIB and SY.SEMILIB by expanding
the database. The files SY.SIMP and SY.LOADLIB.LA will be copied
from the current generation. All other files will be connected from
the current generation without any change.
Depending on the system state the new generation will be
- set valid and introduced into the system immediately by
Recovery .
- set blocked.
It is possible to repeat the parameters of this command up to
100 times.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD DBSIZE : GROUP= ,SIZE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

GROUP NAME OF EXPANDABLE GROUP

This parameter specifies a group of modules with expandable


structures of data to be expanded together.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

3...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#,0,1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8,9

SIZE WANTED SIZE OF EXP. GROUP

This parameter specifies the desired number of elements of an


expandable structure of data. The given value has to be greater than
the actual number of elements and less then or equal to the maximum
number of elements.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...65535, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DBSIZE- 1-


DIAG DCR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSE DIGITAL CODE RECEIVER

This command initiates LTG digital code receiver diagnosis.


Precondition: the LTG must be in the operating status
ACT or CBL and the associated DIU must be in the
operating status MBL.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG DCR : LTG= ,DCR= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LTG NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LTGSET NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

DCR DIGITAL CODE RECEIVER

This parameter specifies the position of the DCR within


the LTG. A DCR is allocated to the DIU with the same
number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...7, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG DCR- 1-


CAN DDIR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Disk Dir from Master and Slave

This task removes a directory from both master and slave disk using an
FCS-Testprocess.
Warning: With the directory the whole content will be removed too.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN DDIR : [MP_ID=] ,Dir= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MP_ID

Specifies the Identifier of MP.

Dir

Specifies the directory name (with full path).

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DDIR- 1-


REP DDISKOUT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Repair Double Disk Outage on MP

This task repairs a double disk outage when building the


loaded ’Generation’ on the system disk of
the MP. The system runs in diskless operation mode.
The ’Code’ portion of the
’Generation’ is selected from any archive
’Generation’ on any MOD.
The ’Data’ portion of the
’Generation’ is selected from the loaded
’Generation’, whose name is determined
within the task. The ’Data’ portion is added
by a data snapshot.
If the task is succesfully completed, the newly built
’Generation’ has to be provided with a
matching SY.NETCONFIG file.

In an EWSD Innovation system the


’Generation compatibility sign (GCS)’ has to be supplied
with a reasonable value by means of task ’MOD GCSMP’.

Prerequisites:
- The system disk must be empty, i.e. labelled.

Notes:
- This is a long-running task. The NE issues the
following event reports:
Data Snapshot Report,
begin-, progress- and end event report

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REP DDISKOUT : Code Generation= ,MOD name= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Code Generation

This parameter is the name of the


’Code’ portion
source ’Generation’.
Input format: 1...8 characters from
the character set
without space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

MOD name

This parameter is the device name of


the magneto-optical disk device MOD,
from which the
’Code’ portion
source ’Generation’ is
taken.
Input values: MOD0 or MOD1

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REP DDISKOUT- 1-


DIAG DES

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSE DIGITAL ECHO SUPPRESSOR

This command is necessary to diagnose a digital echo


suppressor in an LTG.
Precondition: the LTG must be in the operating status
ACT or CBL and the associated DIU must be in the
operating status MBL.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG DES : LTG= ,DES= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LTG NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LTGSET NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

DES DIGITAL ECHO SUPPRESSOR

This parameter specifies the position of the DES within


the LTG. A DES is allocated to the DIU with the same
number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...4, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG DES- 1-


ACT DEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE DESTINATION

This command activates the specified destination for carrier selection.


This destination may be either a newly created destination for carrier
selection (ENTR DESTDAT) or an already used destination for carrier
selection, which was expanded beforehand (MOD DESTDAT).

The necessity for another activation of an already earlier activated


destination for carrier selection may result from the change of quotas or
trunk group sizes within an active carrier quota group (MOD CQDAT).

Prerequisites:
- The destination is created.
- It is a destination for carrier selection.
- Each assigned carrier specific destination has at least one route, except
for the case, that the specified carrier is deactivated within the quota
group.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT DEST : DEST= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT DEST- 1-


CAN DEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL DESTINATION

This command cancels a standard destination or a destination with new code.

Carrier destinations may be cancelled automatically, if the assignment to


the superior destination of carrier selection was removed with the help of
a MOD DESTDAT or CAN DESTDAT command. If they have been transformed
into standard destinations, they may be cancelled with CAN DEST.

Destinations for carrier selection may only be cancelled, if they were


deactivated first with the help of the command DACT DEST and afterwards
transformed into standard destinations with the help of the command
CAN DESTDAT.

Prerequisites:
- There must be no code point or test point in existence (created) that refers
to this destination.
- There must be no code point group in existence referring to this destination.
- There must be no operator position point in existence referring to this
destination.
- There must be no centrex code point in existence referring to this
destination.
- There must be no centrex directory number in existence referring to this
destination.
- There must be no directory number destination in existence referring to this
destination.
- There must be no network management traffic data in existence referring to
this destination.
- There must be no route in existence to this destination.
- There must be no carrier data referring to this destination.
- There must be no intercept code data referring to this destination.
- There must be no call booking limit referring to this destination.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN DEST : DEST= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DEST- 1-


CR DEST
RETRANS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE DESTINATION

This command creates a destination. A destination is normally accessed via


code points. A distinction is made between different types of
destinations, depending on the further treatment of call requests:

- Standard Destinations
These access routes are for trunk group clusters, trunk groups, trunk work
station groups, test equipment, announcement trunk groups, call types and
digit conversion masks addressing PBXµs.

- Destinations with new code translation


These are used to access another destination with aid of repeated digit
translation (Call Processing).
These destinations cannot be linked to an optimized dynamic routing
(ODR)-list.

- Destinations for carrier selection and carrier destinations


These are required for conditional alternative routing. Destinations for
carrier selection are initially created as standard destinations
(ENTR DESTDAT).
These destinations cannot be linked to an optimized dynamic routing
(ODR)-list.

Prerequisites:
- The destination does not yet exist.
- If more than 6 digits are to be entered in the destination
area name, the range of values must be extended with the
command MOD CALLPOPT : DESTMAXL = LONG.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR DEST - RETRANS DESTINATION WITH RETRANSLATION


2. CR DEST - STANDARD STANDARD DESTINATION

1. Input format

DESTINATION WITH RETRANSLATION

This input format is entered for destinations with retranslation.

Destinations with new code replace the originally dialed digit combination
with a new digit combination specified in the parameter NEWCODE. This
happens independently of the digit combination which led to the destination
with new code, i.e. many code points may refer to the same destination.
Immediately after the code replacement a new digit translation process
is started in the own switch.

Destinations with NEWCAC replaces the existing carrier access code or


define a new carrier access code.
Immediately after the carrier access code replacement a new digit
translation is started in the own switch.

Destinations with NEWORIG1 replaces the existing originating mark 1 or


define an originating mark 1.
Immediately after the originating mark 1 replacement a new digit
translation is started in the own switch.

A destination that has a digit conversion assigned allows another


destination to be accessed thanks to the new digit translation.
The CONVCODE, NEWCODE, NEWCAC and NEWORIG1 parameters perform a
similar function (i.e. starting a new digit translation).
CONVCODE refers to the dialed digits, i.e. it permits modification of
digits that have not yet been translated (B - DN), but leaves any dialed
area code unchanged that is administered as a LAC in the own switch.
NEWCODE performs a complete replacement of the codepoint, i.e. it allows
the LAC to be replaced, but leaves the B - DN unchanged.
NEWCAC performs a replacement of the carrier access code.
NEWORIG1 performs a replacement of the originating mark 1.
Note:
Combination of NEWCODE with NEWCAC and NEWORIG1 and CONVCODE with
NEWCAC and NEWORIG1 are possible.
Combination of NEWCODE and CONVCODE is not allowed.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DEST- 1+
CR DEST
RETRANS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR DEST : DEST= <,NEWCODE= ,NEWCAC= ,NEWORIG1= ,CONVCODE=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the destination name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NEWCODE NEW CODE

This parameter specifies the new code with which the


originally dialed code is replaced.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NEWCAC NEW CARRIER ACCESS CODE

This parameter specifies the code which replaces an existing


carrier access code or which defines a new carrier access
code if none exists.
Note:
- The existence of this parameter is not checked
in the carrier database.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NEWORIG1 NEW ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code which replaces


an existing originating code or which defines a new
originating code if none exists.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3839, range of decimal numbers

CONVCODE CONVERTED CODE

This parameter specifies a conversion mask which is used


to modify the originally dialed code.
Any dialed area code which is administered as a local
area code in the own switch remains unchanged.
The modified code is immediately retranslated.

Valid input characteres:


0-9, A-F, #, *, +, ., X

The modifications are specified in the form of a mask


consisting of control characters and digits.

Thecontrol characters have the following significance:


X :The digit of the old code is left as it is.
. :The digit of the old code is deleted.
+ :The digits following this character, up to the next
control character, are inserted.
: Digits without a preceeding "+" replace the old code.

Input is subject to the following conditions:


- At least one modification in the code is done.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DEST- 2+
CR DEST
RETRANS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- Not more than two modifications may be made.


- Per modification, a maximum of 15 digits can be affected
but the total of both modifications is restricted to 24.

Example:
CONVCODE = 123xx. specifies that the first 3 digits of the
existing dial information are replaced by 1 2 3, the next
2 digits remain and the 6th digit is omitted.
The existing dial information 7944583 is changed to 123453.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DEST- 3+
CR DEST
STANDARD
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

STANDARD DESTINATION

This input format is entered for standard destinations.

Standard destinations refer to up to 16 routes, which are used for the


selection of a trunk group in order to route a call to the outside of the
switch.

The trunk group is selected with a fixed alternative or an optimized


routing scheme, i.e. the routes are checked in ascending hunting sequence
if the addressed trunk group has at least one idle trunk.
If the ODR algorithm is used the routes of the ODR-list are checked
cyclically after the fixed alternate route at the position LINK has failed.
If the route is not allowed to seize the last idle trunk, then a check must
be made to determins whether the addressed trunk group has at least two idle
trunks. The first route in the hunting sequence which fulfills this condition
is seized for the call being set up.

The rerouting feature deviates from the fixed alternative routing scheme.
Rerouting means that in case of an unsuccessful attempt to get through
(i.e. successful seizure of a trunk in the own switch but congestion in a
transit switch), an attempt is made to establish the connection using a route
belonging to another rerouting group, i.e. the congested transit switches
are not addressed again.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR DEST : DEST= [,FOVCODE=] [,MINMAX=] [,TLIM=] [,DEFEAT=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,ODR= ,LINK=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the destination name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FOVCODE FINAL OVERFLOW CODE

This parameter specifies the new code as the final alternate


route. This code is used for retranslation after all routes
of the overflow sequence have been checked without success.
It will not be used if ODR routes have been checked.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

MINMAX MIN/MAX NUMBER OF DIGITS

This parameter specifies that the end-of-selection is determined


by an abbreviated timeout if the minimum number of digits is present.
If the maximum number of digits is present, selection is considered
to be ended.

Note:
- The number of digits of the LAC (known in the own exchange)
associated with the CPT which points to the destination, must not
be considered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DEST- 4+
CR DEST
STANDARD
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a: MINIMUM NUMBER OF DIGITS=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

Default: 1

b: MAXIMUM NUMBER OF DIGITS=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

Default: 24

TLIM TIME LIMIT

This parameter specifies the time limits which are to be activated or


deactivated for the destination. The project-specific time values
of the specified timers can be output using the command DISP TIOUT.
The following time limit groups are possible:
Group 1:
The parameter values in this group determine the EOS supervision
for the destination. If this is activated, dialing is considered
to be ended when the relevant timer has timed out.
Group 2:
The parameter values in this group determine the ring time limit
for the destination. If this is activated, the ring time is limited
to the value specified in the relevant timer.
Group 3:
The parameter values in this group determine the clearback signal
supervision for the destination. If this is activated, the connection
is released when the relevant timer has timed out and the clearback
signal has been received from the called end.
Group 4:
The parameter values in this group determine the call time supervision
for the destination. If this is activated, the connection is released
when the relevant timer has timed out.
Group 5:
The parameter values in this group determine the release delay for
the destination. If this is activated, the connection is released when
the relevant timer has timed out after the calling party has replaced
the receiver.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

X(DIALTM1 )= DIAL TIME 1


11 11 Corresponds to timer 07 for trunks.
1ZDIALTM2 Y1 DIAL TIME 2
11 11 Corresponds to timer 08 for trunks.
11DIALTM3 11 DIAL TIME 3
11 11 Corresponds to timer 09 for trunks.
>*OFFDIA +W SWITCH OFF DIAL CONTROL
Switches off the EOS supervision.

X(RINGTM0 )= RING TIME LIMIT 0


11 11 Switches off the ring time limit. This is a
11 11 mandatory input if TRACA=ORIG is to be
11 11 specified for one of the routes.
11RINGTM1 11 RING TIME LIMIT 1
11 11 Corresponds to timer 19.
11RINGTM2 11 RING TIME LIMIT 2
1Z Y1 Corresponds to timer 20.
11RINGTM3 11 RING TIME LIMIT 3
11 11 Corresponds to timer 21.
11RINGTM4 11 RING TIME LIMIT 4
11 11 Corresponds to timer 22.
11RINGTM5 11 RING TIME LIMIT 5
11 11 Corresponds to timer 23.
11RINGTM6 11 RING TIME LIMIT 6
11 11 Corresponds to timer 24.
>*RINGTM7 +W RING TIME LIMIT 7
Corresponds to timer 25.

X(CLEATM1 )= CLEAR BACK TIME 1


11 11 Corresponds to timer 34.
11CLEATM2 11 CLEAR BACK TIME 2
11 11 Corresponds to timer 35.
11CLEATM3 11 CLEAR BACK TIME 3
11 11 Corresponds to timer 36.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DEST- 5+
CR DEST
STANDARD
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

11CLEATM4 11 CLEAR BACK TIME 4


1Z Y1 Corresponds to timer 37.
11CLEATM5 11 CLEAR BACK TIME 5
11 11 Corresponds to timer 38.
11CLEATM6 11 CLEAR BACK TIME 6
11 11 Corresponds to timer 39.
11OFFEND 11 SWITCH OFF END CONTROL
11 11 Supervision of the called party clearback signal
11 11 is switched off (e.g. to avoid premature release).
>*RELCLEA +W RELEASE CLEAR BACK
Release takes place as soon as the clearback
signal is received from the called end.

X(CONVTM1 )= CONVERSATION TIME LIMIT 1


11 11 Corresponds to timer 27.
11CONVTM2 11 CONVERSATION TIME LIMIT 2
11 11 Corresponds to timer 28.
11CONVTM3 11 CONVERSATION TIME LIMIT 3
11 11 Corresponds to timer 29.
1ZCONVTM4 Y1 CONVERSATION TIME LIMIT 4
11 11 Corresponds to timer 30.
11CONVTM5 11 CONVERSATION TIME LIMIT 5
11 11 Corresponds to timer 31.
11CONVTM6 11 CONVERSATION TIME LIMIT 6
11 11 Corresponds to timer 32.
11CONVTM7 11 CONVERSATION TIME LIMIT 7
11 11 Corresponds to timer 33.
>*OFFCALL +W NO CONVERSATION TIME LIMIT
Switches off the conversation time limit.

X(RELTM0 )= RELEASE TIME A-SIDE 0


11 11 Specifies that the connection is held until
11 11 released by an operator.
1ZRELTM1 Y1 RELEASE TIME A-SIDE 1
11 11 Specifies that the connection is released as soon
11 11 as the dialing party has replaced the receiver.
11RELTM2 11 RELEASE TIME A-SIDE 2
11 11 Corresponds to timer 42.
>*RELTM3 +W RELEASE TIME A-SIDE 3
This parameter value corresponds to timer 43.

Default: DIALTM1, RINGTM1, CLEATM1, OFFCALL, RELTM3

DEFEAT DESTINATION FEATURES

This parameter value specifies particular call processing


destination characteristics.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

AUTOINFO AUTOMATIC INFORMATION SERVICE


Suffix dialing of digits is possible via the
speech path after the connection has been
established.
FEATCHCK FEATURE CHECK
This value marks a destination for the
protocol check to check a number of
parameters.
FIRSTACT FIRST ACTIVE ROUTE AS PRIMARY
This value assigns the network traffic status
’primary traffic’ to the first active route,
i.e. to the lowest route number in the
overflow sequence to the destination that is
not blocked. Omitting this value assigns the
network traffic status ’primary traffic’ to
route number ’1’ to the destination even if
that route has been deactivated.
INDIDEN INDIVIDUAL IDENTIFICATION
This value marks a destination as one
requiring individual identification of an
originating CR PBX.
QUITON QUIET TONE
After dialing of all digits, a project specific
confirmation tone will be sent to the calling
party.
RCALLBAC RECALL BACKWARD ALLOWED

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DEST- 6+
CR DEST
STANDARD
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The calling party can recall the operator who


set up the connection.

ODR OPTIMIZED DYNAMIC ROUTING LIST

This parameter specifies the ODR-list which has to be linked


to the destination and is used to find an idle route by the
ODR algorithm.
This is only allowed for standard destinations.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LINK LINKAGE TO ODR LIST

This parameter specifies the position in the ascending hunting


sequence of the fixed alternate route where the routing
algorithm changes to ODR and the routes of the ODR list
are checked.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...16, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DEST- 7-
DACT DEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE DESTINATION

This command deactivates a destination for carrier selection. A standby


carrier destination is specified for the entire traffic volume assigned to
the destination for carrier selection.

Prerequisites:
- The destination has been created.
- A destination is a destination for carrier selection.
- The specified standby carrier destination belongs to the
destination for carrier selection that is to be deactivated.
- The specified standby carrier destination has at least one route.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DACT DEST : DEST= ,SCDEST= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SCDEST STANDBY CARRIER DESTINATION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT DEST- 1-


DISP DEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DESTINATION

This command displays the data of all or some specified destinations.

To display all parameters the different types of destinations require


three different output masks, which will be displayed successively.

The amount of display may be reduced by specifying the parameter FORMAT .

The amount of display may be reduced further by specifying additional


parameters.

When specifying several parameters at the same time, only those


destinations will be displayed that fulfill all requirements at the same
time.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP DEST : DEST= [,FORMAT=] [,CQGRP=] [,CARR=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the destination.

The display of all existing destinations will be performed if


parameter DEST= X is specified.

Up to 32 parameter values can be linked with &.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FORMAT OUTPUT FORMAT

This parameter is used to control the amount of information


displayed.
Notes:
There are three identifier groups:
- The first group displays all data of all specified
destinations with ALL.
- The second group specifies which destination data
will be displayed. The possible values are:
NEWCODE,STD,CARRSEL,TMRIPI and LINK.
- The third group specifies in which order the destinations
will be displayed. The display can be in alphabetical
(SORT) or in nonalphabetical (NOSORT) order of the
destinations.
Only one identifier of a group can be linked with an
identifier of another group.
The default values are: ALL and SORT.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ALL DISPLAY ALL DESTINATIONS


All data for all specified
destinations are output.
NEWCODE SELECT NEW CODE DESTINATIONS
Only the data of destinations with
digit retranslation are output.
STD SELECT STANDARD DESTINATIONS
Only the data of standard destinations,
carrier destinations and destinations
for carrier selection are output.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DEST- 1+


DISP DEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CARRSEL SELECT CARRIER SELECTION DESTS


Only the data of carrier destinations
and destinations for carrier selection
are output.
SORT SORTED IN ALPHABETICAL ORDER
All destinations will be displayed in
alphabetical order ifparameter
FORMAT=SORT is specified.
The carrier destinations belonging to one
destination for carrier selection will not be
displayed in an alphabetical order, because
they are related to the corresponding
carriers of the quota group.
NOSORT NOT SORTED IN ALPHA. ORDER
TMRIPI SELECT TMRIPI SELECTION DESTS
Only the data of destinations for TMR/IPI
selection are output.
LINK LINKAGE TO ODR LIST
The linkage between the destinations and
the ODR lists are displayed.

Default: ALL, SORT

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This parameter specifies the carrier quota group.


Data output is limited to the destinations for carrier selection
that belong to the specified carrier quota group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CARR CARRIER

This parameter specifies the carrier.


Data output is limited to the destinations for carrier selection
that contain the specified carrier.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DEST- 2-


MOD DEST
DESTDATA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY DESTINATION

This command modifies one of the following destination data:


- the name of any destination,
- the data of a standard destination,
- the data of a destination for carrier selection and automatically all the
assigned carrier destinations,
- the destination link to an optimized dynamic routing (ODR) list,
- it creates or cancels the link from a destination to an ODR-list.

Notes:
- This command is not intended for changing a standard destination into
a destination with retranslation. Nor is it intended for changing
a destination in the reverse direction. Such modifications have to be
performed using the commands CAN DEST and CR DEST.
- It is possible to modify a destination with NEWCODE into a
destination with CONVCODE and vice versa.
- It is possible to modify a destination with NEWCODE or CONVCODE by
extending the destination with NEWCODE or NEWCODE.

Prerequisites:
- The destination exists already.
- The specified ODR-list exists.
- The specified new value does not yet exist.
- The specified old value is equal to the existing data.
- If more than 6 digits are to be entered in the destination
area name, the range of values must have been extended with
the command MOD CALLPOPT : DESTMAXL = LONG.

Compatibilities:
- The parameters FOVCODE and CFOVCODE are only allowed in case of
standard or carrier-selection destinations.
Exception: The parameter FOVCODE is also allowed for carrier destinations
which are used for CDD to administrate the code for call
divergence.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD DEST - DESTDATA MODIFY DESTINATION DATA


2. MOD DEST - DESTNAME MODIFY DESTINATION NAME
3. MOD DEST - RETRANS MODIFY DESTINATION WITH RETRANSLATION

1. Input format

MODIFY DESTINATION DATA

This input format is entered in order to modify:


- data of standard destinations,
- data of destinations for carrier selection or
- linkage of a standard destination to an ODR-list.

The change of a parameter for a destination for carrier selection results


in an identical change of that value within all assigned carrier specific
destinations.

The following prerequisites must be fulfilled for successful command


execution in addition to the standard prerequisites, if one ofthe parameters
DEFEAT, MINMAX or TLIM is changed:

- The name of a standard or carrier specific destination (DEST) is


specified.
- New and old value of the parameter TLIM refers to the same time limit.

Note if changing the parameter DEFEAT:


- Each command input permits the addition of new values (using parameter
DEFEAT) and/or cancellation of existing values (using parameter CDEFEAT);
unspecified values remain unchanged in the database.

Note if changing the parameter TLIM:


- Each command input allows the value of a single time limit to be changed;
the unspecified values of other time limits remain unchanged in the
database.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DEST- 1+


MOD DEST
DESTDATA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD DEST : DEST= <,FOVCODE= ,CFOVCODE= ,MINMAX= ,TLIM= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,DEFEAT= ,CDEFEAT=> [,ODR=] <,LINK=> [,CODR=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FOVCODE FINAL OVERFLOW CODE

This parameter specifies the new code as the final


alternate route. This code is used for retranslation
after all routes of the overflow sequence have been
checked without success.
This parameter is also allowed for carrier destinations
which are used for CDD to administrate the code for
call divergence.
It will not be used if ODR routes have been checked.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CFOVCODE CANCELLED FINAL OVERFLOW CODE

This parameter specifies the new code as the final


alternative route that has to be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

MINMAX NEW MIN/MAX NUMBER OF DIGITS

This parameter specifies that the end-of-selection is determined by


an abbreviated timeout if the minimum number of digits is present.
If the maximum number of digits is present, selection is considered
to be ended.

Notes:
- The number of digits of the LAC (known in the exchange)
associated with the CPT which points to the destination,
must not be considered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: MINIMUM NUMBER OF DIGITS=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

b: MAXIMUM NUMBER OF DIGITS=


1...24, range of decimal numbers

TLIM NEW TIME LIMIT

This parameter specifies the time limits which are to be activated or


deactivated for the destination. An entry can only be made to change
the existing values; if no value was entered for the parameter TLIM
the values created with the command CR DEST remain in the database.
The project-specific time values of the specified timers can
be displayed using the command DISP TIOUT.
The following time limit groups are possible:
Group 1:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DEST- 2+


MOD DEST
DESTDATA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The parameter values in this group determine the EOS


supervision for the destination. If this is activated,
dialing is considered to be complete when the relevant timer
has timed out.
Group 2:
The parameter values in this group determine the ring time limit
for the destination. If this is activated, the ring time is limited
to the value specified in the relevant timer.
Group 3:
The parameter values in this group determine the clearback signal
supervision for the destination. If this is activated, the connection
is released when the relevant timer has timed out and the clearback
signal has been received from the called end.
Group 4:
The parameter values in this group determine the call time supervision
for the destination. If this is activated, the connection is released
when the relevant timer has timed out.
Group 5:
The parameter values in this group determine the release delay for
the destination. If this is activated, the connection is released when
the relevant timer has timed out after the calling party has replaced
the receiver.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

X(DIALTM1 )= DIAL TIME 1


11 11 Corresponds to timer 07 for trunks.
1ZDIALTM2 Y1 DIAL TIME 2
11 11 Corresponds to timer 08 for trunks.
11DIALTM3 11 DIAL TIME 3
11 11 Corresponds to timer 09 for trunks.
>*OFFDIA +W SWITCH OFF DIAL CONTROL
Switches off the EOS supervision.

X(RINGTM0 )= RING TIME LIMIT 0


11 11 Switches off the ring time limit.
11 11 This is a mandatory input if TRACA=ORIG
11 11 is to be specified for one of the routes.
11RINGTM1 11 RING TIME LIMIT 1
1Z Y1 Default for ring time supervision.
11RINGTM2 11 RING TIME LIMIT 2
11RINGTM3 11 RING TIME LIMIT 3
11RINGTM4 11 RING TIME LIMIT 4
11RINGTM5 11 RING TIME LIMIT 5
11RINGTM6 11 RING TIME LIMIT 6
>*RINGTM7 +W RING TIME LIMIT 7

X(CLEATM1 )= CLEAR BACK TIME 1


11 11 Default for supervision of the clearback
11 11 signal.
11CLEATM2 11 CLEAR BACK TIME 2
11CLEATM3 11 CLEAR BACK TIME 3
1ZCLEATM4 Y1 CLEAR BACK TIME 4
11CLEATM5 11 CLEAR BACK TIME 5
11CLEATM6 11 CLEAR BACK TIME 6
11OFFEND 11 SWITCH OFF END CONTROL
11 11 Supervision of the called party clearback signal
11 11 is switched off (e.g. to avoid premature release).
>*RELCLEA +W RELEASE CLEAR BACK
Release takes place as soon as the clearback
signal is received.

X(CONVTM1 )= CONVERSATION TIME LIMIT 1


11 11 Corresponds to timer 27.
11CONVTM2 11 CONVERSATION TIME LIMIT 2
11 11 Corresponds to timer 28.
11CONVTM3 11 CONVERSATION TIME LIMIT 3
11 11 Corresponds to timer 29.
1ZCONVTM4 Y1 CONVERSATION TIME LIMIT 4
11 11 Corresponds to timer 30.
11CONVTM5 11 CONVERSATION TIME LIMIT 5
11 11 Corresponds to timer 31.
11CONVTM6 11 CONVERSATION TIME LIMIT 6
11 11 Corresponds to timer 32.
11CONVTM7 11 CONVERSATION TIME LIMIT 7
11 11 Corresponds to timer 33.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DEST- 3+


MOD DEST
DESTDATA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

>*OFFCALL +W NO CONVERSATION TIME LIMIT


Switches off the call time limit.

X(RELTM0 )= RELEASE TIME A-SIDE 0


11 11 Specifies that the connection is held until it
11 11 is released by an operator.
11RELTM1 11 RELEASE TIME A-SIDE 1
1Z Y1 Specifies that the connection is released as
11 11 soon as the called party has replaced the
11 11 receiver.
11RELTM2 11 RELEASE TIME A-SIDE 2
11 11 Corresponds to timer 42.
>*RELTM3 +W RELEASE TIME A-SIDE 3
Corresponds to timer 43.

DEFEAT NEW DESTINATION FEATURES

This parameter specifies particular call-processing


destination characteristics.

Default: No value

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

XAUTOINFO= AUTOMATIC INFORMATION SERVICE


1 1 Suffix dialing of digits is possible via the
1 1 speech path after the connection has been
1 1 established.
1FEATCHCK1 FEATURE CHECK
1 1 This value marks a destination for the
1 1 protocol check to check a number of
1 1 parameters.
1FIRSTACT1 FIRST ACTIVE ROUTE AS PRIMARY
1 1 This value assigns the network traffic status
1 1 ’primary traffic’ to the first active route,
1 1 i.e. to the lowest route number in the
1 1 overflow sequence to the destination that is
1 1 not blocked. Omitting this value assigns the
1 1 network traffic status ’primary traffic’ to
1 1 route number ’1’ to the destination even if
1 1 that route is deactive.
1INDIDEN 1 INDIVIDUAL IDENTIFICATION
1 1 This value marks a destination as one
1 1 requiring individual identification of an
1 1 originating CR PBX.
1QUITON 1 QUIET TONE
1 1 After dialing of all digits, a project specific
1 1 confirmation tone will be sent to the calling
1 1 party.
>RCALLBACW RECALL BACKWARD ALLOWED
The calling party can recall the operator who
set up the connection.

CDEFEAT CANCELED DESTINATION FEATURES

This parameter specifies particular call-processing


destination characteristics to be canceled.

Default: No value

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

XAUTOINFO= AUTOMATIC INFORMATION SERVICE


1 1 Suffix dialing of digits is possible via the
1 1 speech path after the connection has been
1 1 established.
1FEATCHCK1 FEATURE CHECK
1 1 This value marks a destination for the
1 1 protocol check to check a number of
1 1 parameters.
1FIRSTACT1 FIRST ACTIVE ROUTE FLAG
1 1 The first active route to the destination has
1 1 the network traffic status primary traffic.
1INDIDEN 1 INDIVIDUAL IDENTIFICATION
1 1 This value marks a destination as one

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DEST- 4+


MOD DEST
DESTDATA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1 1 requiring individual identification of an


1 1 originating CR PBX.
1QUITON 1 QUIET TONE
1 1 After dialing of all digits, a project specific
1 1 confirmation tone will be sent to the calling
1 1 party.
>RCALLBACW RECALL BACKWARD ALLOWED
The calling party can recall the operator who
set up the connection.

ODR OPTIMIZED DYNAMIC ROUTING LIST

This parameter specifies the ODR-list which has to be linked


to the destination and is used to find an idle route by the
ODR algorithm.
This is only allowed for standard destinations, which are
not already linked to an ODR-list.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LINK LINKAGE TO ODR LIST

This parameter specifies the position in the ascending hunting


sequence of the fixed alternate routes where the routing
algorithm changes to ODR and the routes of the ODR-list
are scanned.
Note:
This parameter must be entered in combination with ODR or
can be entered when ODR already exists.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...16, range of decimal numbers

CODR CANCEL LINKAGE TO ODR LIST

This parameter specifies the ODR-list which should no longer


be linked from the destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DEST- 5+


MOD DEST
DESTNAME
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

MODIFY DESTINATION NAME

This input format is to modify a destination name.

The name of a destination can be modified independently of the type, i.e:


- the names of standard and carrier specific destinations can be changed
as well as the names of destinations for carrier selection and
destinations with new code.

Prerequisite:
- The new name is not in use for another destination.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD DEST : DEST= ,NDEST= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NDEST NEW DESTINATION NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DEST- 6+


MOD DEST
RETRANS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

MODIFY DESTINATION WITH RETRANSLATION

This input format is to modify destination data for destinations with


retranslation.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,NEWCODE= 1 1
1 1,NEWCAC= 1 (;) 1
1 MOD DEST : DEST= Z,NEWORIG1=Y Z Y 1
1 1,CONVCODE=1 *!+ 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NEWCODE NEW NEWCODE

This parameter specifies the new code with which the


originally dialed code is replaced.
This parameter is removed by canceling the whole destination
and creating the destination together with the other
parameters.
For your convenience the following shortcut is provided by
this command:
- Reenter the existing value of this parameter again
and it will be canceled.
This only works as long as at least one code processing
parameter remains for this destination.
Caution:
- If you want to enter a new value for this parameter,
please check that it not exists, using the display
command.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NEWCAC NEW CARRIER ACCESS CODE

This parameter specifies the code which replaces an existing


carrier access code or which defines a new carrier access
code if none exists.
This parameter is removed by canceling the whole destination
and creating the destination together with the other
parameters.
For your convenience the following shortcut is provided by
this command:
- Reenter the existing value of this parameter again
and it will be canceled.
This only works as long as at least one code processing
parameter remains for this destination.
Caution:
- If you want to enter a new value for this parameter,
please check that it not exists, using the display
command.
Note:
- The existence of this parameter is not checked
in the carrier database.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DEST- 7+


MOD DEST
RETRANS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NEWORIG1 NEW ORIGINATION MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code which replaces


an existing originating code or which defines a new
originating code if none exists.
This parameter is removed by canceling the whole destination
and creating the destination together with the other
parameters.
For your convenience the following shortcut is provided by
this command:
- Reenter the existing value of this parameter again
and it will be canceled.
This only works as long as at least one code processing
parameter remains for this destination.
Caution:
- If you want to enter a new value for this parameter,
please check that it not exists, using the display
command.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3839, range of decimal numbers

CONVCODE CONVERTED CODE

This parameter specifies a conversion mask which is used


to modify the originally dialed code.
Any dialed area code which is administered as a local
area code in the own switch remains unchanged.
The modified code is immediately retranslated.

Valid input characteres:


0-9, A-F, #, *, +, ., X

The modifications are specified in the form of a mask


consisting of control characters and digits.

The control characters have the following significance:


X : The digit of the old code is left as it is.
. : The digit of the old code is deleted.
+ : The digits following this character, up to the next
control character, are inserted.
: Digits without a preceeding "+" replace the old code.

Input is subject to the following conditions:


- At least one modification in the code is made.
- Not more than two modifications may be made.
- For each modification, a maximum of 15 digits can be
affected but the total of both modifications is limited
to 24.

Example:
CONVCODE = 123xx. specifies that the first 3 digits of the
existing dial information are replaced by 1 2 3, the next
2 digits remain and the 6th digit is omitted.
The existing dial information 7944583 is changed to 123453.

This parameter is removed by canceling the whole destination


and creating the destination together with the other
parameters.
For your convenience the following shortcut is provided by
this command:
- Reenter the existing value of this parameter again
and it will be canceled.
This only works as long as at least one code processing
parameter remains for this destination.
Caution:
- If you want to enter a new value for this parameter,
please check that it not exists, using the display
command.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...31 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DEST- 8-


REC DEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RECORD DESTINATION

This command initiates recording of destination load data.

Prerequisites:
- System time must be secure when the command is entered.

Notes:
- The name of the measurement file is displayed on the OMT
if disk output of traffic data is requested.
- A maximum of 8 jobs of this type with a sum of 512 destinations
(specified via group or destination origin code) may be entered
at the same time.
- The same measurement object may not be specified in more
than one job.
- The traffic data are output every 15 minutes within the
selected measurement intervals.
At least 15 minutes elapse before the first data are output
with immediate start.
- The measurement can be stopped with STOP JOB, except
jobs with UNIT=MDD-DAILY OR CYCLIC.
- In case of high system load it is possible that not all
measurement data can be displayed on OMT or written into
the file within a 15 minute interval.
The data record remains incomplete.

This command starts a semipermanent job. It can be canceled with CAN JOB.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,GRP= 1 1
1 REC DEST : UNIT= Z,DOCODE=Y [,FORMAT=] [,BEG=] [,TER=] 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 [,IV=] [,PER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

UNIT OUTPUT UNIT AND MODE

This parameter specifies the output unit and the mode of


output.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: OUTPUT UNIT
OMT OPERATION AND MAIN.TERMINAL
If this option is selected, data are output
to the OMT.
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
If this option is selected, a measurement file
is created and the traffic data are output to
this file. The start and the finish message
include the name of the file in which the
traffic data are available for postprocessing.

Notes :
- If a file is destroyed or cannot be extended,
an advisory is sent to the OMT.

This information unit specifies the output unit.

b: OUTPUT MODE
SINGLE SINGLE TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are output
to a single measurement file.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DEST- 1+


REC DEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DAILY DAILY TRAFFIC FILE


If this option is selected, the data are output
to daily files. The measurement starts
immediately and has no defined end. Time
parameters are not permitted.
To secure the required space on disk, all 7
daily files are prepared and created at the
start of measurement.
A daily file is closed at the end of the day
and a new file for the next day is
automatically created, or the existing file is
replaced.
Daily files will be overwritten in the
following week on the same weekday.
CYCLIC CYCLIC TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
written into a cyclic measurement file.
Time parameters are not permitted for
these measurements.
If the cyclic file runs full, the newest
data will be lost. This occurs
after a period of two days.

This information unit specifies the desired output


mode (daily or single or cyclic measurement file).
It is only permissible in connection with output
UNIT=MDD.

GRP TRAFFIC OBJECT GROUP NAME

This parameter specifies the name of a group (containing a


maximum of 512 destinations). One of the two measurement objects
(group or single destination) must be specified; a combination is
not permitted. If a group is specified, output is only possible
to disk. Only valid group names may be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DOCODE DESTINATION ORIGIN CODE

This parameter specifies the destination originating code.

Up to 16 destination origin codes may be linked with &.

One of the two measurement parameters (destination origin code or


group) must be specified; a combination is not permitted.

The destinations for which measurement is to be carried out may


lie inside or outside the home exchange.

The destination codes have to be specified including the


traffic discrimination digit(s) and the local area code.

In the destination code part it is possible to specify any digit


combination (up to 18 digits per code). No checks are performed
during command acceptance whether the digit combinations lead
to an existing destination.

The operator must be carefull not to put invalid code under


measurement.

If a code to be measured is too long and not valid (e.g. 089 722 05),
the calls to the smaller and valid digit combination (e.g. 089 722 0)
cannot be performed.

Measurement of subdestinations is possible (e.g. 09 & 098 & 0987 &...),


but not in combination with different origin or language code values.

A maximum of 18 subdestinations can be measured at the same time.

Multiple measurement of identical measurement objects (same digit


combination) is not permitted.

However, identical destinations can be distinguished by providing

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DEST- 2+


REC DEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

different carrier access codes at part of the destination codes.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c]]

a: DESTINATION CODE=
1...18 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

This information unit specifies the destination.

b: ORIGIN CODE=
0...3839, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the origin.


The origin code corresponds to the originating mark 1
used for routing purposes.

c: LANGUAGE CODE=
0...F, range of hexadecimal numbers

This information unit specifies the language digit.

FORMAT OUTPUT FORMAT

This parameter determines the output format to the output medium.


The identifiers ALL (output of all traffic data counters) or
VOL (output of the following traffic data counters: calls carried,
calls carried with answer, traffic volume and traffic volume
with answer) are permitted.

Default: ALL

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALL ALL DATA


VOL VOLUME DATA

BEG BEGIN DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement begin date.

Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER
must be specified.
Exception: Time parameters cannot be specified for data
output in daily or cyclic files.
- A maximum of four BEG dates in chronological order may
be linked with &. In the case of linked BEG dates, TER
is not permitted.
If no TER is selected, the measurement is active on the
specified BEG days only.
- The earliest possible begin date BEG is the day after
command input.
- The first BEG date must be within an interval of one
month starting from the current date.
- The other BEG dates must be within an interval of
one year starting from the current date.
- The measurement on the actual BEG day can be stopped
with STOP JOB. If the measurement is stopped on the
last BEG day, it will be finished.

Default: the begin of measurement is the current date.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DEST- 3+


REC DEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

TER TERMINATION DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement termination date.

Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER
must be specified.
Exception: Time parameters may not be specified for data
output in daily or cyclic files.
- Only one termination date may be entered.
The earliest possible termination date is the day after
command input.
- The measurement duration must not exceed one year.
- If no BEG parameter is entered, recording starts
immediately.

Default: the end of measurement is determined by the last


single day (BEG).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF TERMINATION DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

IV INTERVAL TIME

This parameter indicates interval times of the measurement.

Notes:
- Interval times IV are only permitted if at least one
begin date BEG is selected.
- A maximum of 4 measurement intervals in chronological
order may be linked with &. Linked intervals have to be
at least 30 minutes apart except for measurements over
midnight.
- An interval may not include midnight, e.g. IV =
23-00-01-00 is not permitted.
A measurement over midnight requires the input of two
interval times, e.g. IV = 00-00-01-00&23-00-00-00.
- The measurement is active during the specified interval
times only.
- The measurement can be stopped during the actual interval
IV with STOP JOB. If the measurement is stopped
during the last interval IV, it will be finished.

Default: 24-hour measurement on the specified days

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: BEGIN HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: BEGIN MINUTE=
0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DEST- 4+


REC DEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

c: TERMINATION HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

d: TERMINATION MINUTE=
0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

PER PERIODIC WEEKDAY

This parameter specifies the weekdays on which data


have to be recorded.

Notes:
- Input of weekdays is only permissible in
connection with a termination date (TER).
- Up to 6 of the values may be linked with &, except
the values NO, WO and HO which cannot be
linked with other values.

Default: measurement every day during the measurement


period

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

NO DEFAULT
Measurement every day
MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY
Days which are full working days
HO HOLIDAY
Full national and international holidays are
included.
The full weekend day (the day marked EF
in the DISP WDCAT output mask) is included.
Half holidays are not included.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DEST- 5-


CAN DESTCNTL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL DESTINATION CONTROL DATA

This command cancels from the existing TMRIPI combination the specified call
history data or the relation of all TIRDEST’s to their DEST (and in addition
this destination itself).

To re-assign an intercept to a pure TMRIPI combination, the operator has to


enter the parameter TMRIPI with only two info units. After entering this
command the actual assignment to this TMRIPI combination will be cancelled,
modifying it into an assignment of an intercept.

To cancel the call history data, the operator has to enter the parameter
TMRIPI with all three info units. After entering this command, the call
history data of this specific TMRIPI combination will not be evaluated for an
incoming call anymore. If call processing comes with all three values
(transmission requirement, ISUP preference indicator, call history data), the
call can be routed over a TIRDEST to be specified belonging to the specific
TMRIPI combination, ignoring the given call history data.

In case that the operator only entered the parameter DEST, it will be
assumed, that he wants to cancel the whole TMRIPI constellation. Therefore
after entering this command, the destination for TMRIPI selection will be
deleted. The corresponding TIRDEST elements will always be kept.

Prerequisites:
- There must be no code point or test point (created) that refers to this
destination.
- There must be no code point group that refers to this destination.
- There must be no operator position point that refers to this destination.
- There must be no centrex code point that refers to this destination.
- There must be no centrex directory number that refers to this destination.
- There must be no directory number destination that refers to this destination.
- There must be no network management traffic data that refers to this
destination.
- There must be no route to this destination.
- There must be no carrier data that refers to this destination.
- There must be no intercept code data that refers to this destination.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN DESTCNTL : DEST= [,TMRIPI=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the name of destination for


TMRIPI selection.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TMRIPI TMR/IPI COMBINATION

This parameter specifies the valid combinations and consists


of three information units, one for the transmission
requirement, a second for the ISUP preference indicator and
the third info unit for special call history data.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b[-c]

a: TRANSMISSION MEDIUM REQUIREMENT

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DESTCNTL- 1+


CAN DESTCNTL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

A3KHZ1 3.1 KHZ AUDIO


SPEECH SPEECH
KBIT64 64 KBIT/S UNRESTRICTED
KBIT64FB 64 KBIT/S UNRES. FALLBACK CAP.

b: ISDN-UP PREFERENCE INDICATOR


NOTREQ NOT REQUIRED
PREF PREFERRED
REQ REQUIRED

c: CALL HISTORY DATA


ICTUPP INCOMING TUP+
NOGTUPP SERVICE NO OUTGOING TUP+
ORIGMOB ORIGINATING MOBILE SUBSCRIBER
ICR2ECHO IC MFC R2 WITH HALF ECHO SUPPR
ASUBDLU ORIGINATING ANALOG SUB AT DLU
ISDNANCA ISDN ORIGIN WITH ANALOGUE CALL

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DESTCNTL- 2-


ENTR DESTCNTL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER DESTINATION CONTROL DATA

This command creates a new type of destination, called destination for TMRIPI
selection (DEST).
This destination is used to route a call depending on its incoming
characteristics.
These characteristics are defined with the parameter TMRIPI.
Depending on the valid TMRIPI combinations, a certain destination (TIRDEST)
will be choosen to route the traffic.
This means, that the code point points to the destination for TMRIPI
selection, and depending on the TMRIPI value (coming from the LTG incoming
side) the call will be routed over a certain TMRIPI routing destination
(TIRDEST).

If the specified destination for TMRIPI selection (DEST) does not yet
exist, a new element will be occupied in the datatable, having the new
destination type (destination for TMRIPI selection). In case that the
destination exists already, and it is of the correct type, it is assumed
that the operator wants to:
- enter additional data
- change data

If the parameter TIRDEST is entered:


- an additional TMRIPI combination may be entered for an already
existing destination, as well as for a new destination;
- a change may be made from intercept or destination (TIRDEST) to
a new destination.

If the parameter TIRDEST is not entered:


- a call history value may be brought into the administered state
(i.e. the call history value will be evaluated by Call Processing)
and be assigned to intercept handling;
- a call history value already administered may be reassigned from a
TIRDEST to intercept handling.

Prerequisites:
- If more than 6 digits are to be entered in the destination area name, the
range of values must have been extended with the command MOD CALLPOPT :
DESTMAXL = LONG.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR DESTCNTL : DEST= ,TMRIPI= [,TIRDEST=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the name of destination for TMRIPI


selection.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TMRIPI TMR/IPI COMBINATION

This parameter specifies the valid combinations and consists of three


information units, one for the transmission requirement, a second for
the ISUP preference indicator and the third info unit for special call
history data.

Valid input combinations for this parameter:

KBIT64FB-REQ
-PREF
-NOTREQ

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR DESTCNTL- 1+


ENTR DESTCNTL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

KBIT64-REQ
-PREF
-NOTREQ
SPEECH-REQ
-PREF
-NOTREQ
A3KHZ1-REQ
-PREF
-NOTREQ
KBIT64-REQ-ICTUPP
-PREF-ICTUPP
-NOTREQ-ICTUPP
SPEECH-REQ-ICTUPP
-PREF-ICTUPP
-NOTREQ-ICTUPP
A3KHZ1-REQ-ICTUPP
-PREF-ICTUPP
-NOTREQ-ICTUPP
KBIT64-REQ-NOGTUPP
-PREF-NOGTUPP
-NOTREQ-NOGTUPP
SPEECH-PREF-ORIGMOB
-PREF-ISDNANCA
-NOTREQ-ORIGMOB
-NOTREQ-ICR2ECHO
-NOTREQ-ASUBDLU
A3KHZ1-PREF-ORIGMOB
-PREF-ISDNANCA
-NOTREQ-ORIGMOB
-NOTREQ-ICR2ECHO
-NOTREQ-ASUBDLU

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b[-c]

a: TRANSMISSION MEDIUM REQUIREMENT


A3KHZ1 3.1 KHZ AUDIO
SPEECH SPEECH
KBIT64 64 KBIT/S UNRESTRICTED
KBIT64FB 64 KBIT/S UNR. FALLBACK CAPAB.

b: ISDN-UP PREFERENCE INDICATOR


NOTREQ NOT REQUIRED
PREF PREFERRED
REQ REQUIRED

c: CALL HISTORY DATA


ICTUPP INCOMING TUP+
NOGTUPP SERVICE NO OUTGOING TUP+
ORIGMOB ORIGINATING MOBILE SUBSCRIBER
ICR2ECHO IC MFC R2 WITH HALF ECHO SUPPR
ASUBDLU ORIGINATING ANALOG SUB AT DLU
ISDNANCA ISDN ORIGIN WITH ANALOGUE CALL

TIRDEST TMR/IPI ROUTING DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the name of a destination, which will be


referable via a destination for TMRIPI selection (DEST).
The destination may be reached with a code combination directly, or
indirectly via a destination for TMRIPI selection (DEST).

Prerequisites:
- The destination specified for parameter TIRDEST has to be
created as standard or newcode destination, or as a destination
for carrier selection, with help of the command CR DEST or
ENTR DESTDAT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR DESTCNTL- 2-


CAN DESTDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL DESTINATION DATA

This command converts a destination for carrier selection into a standard


destination. The assignment to a carrier quota group is cancelled. With
the command CAN DESTDAT all routes created for the standby destination
are transferred to the former destination for carrier selection. As a
result, this destination becomes a standard destination again. The former
standby carrier destination is then cancelled.

The other carrier destinations are converted into standard destinations


if one of the following conditions is fulfilled:
- a test point exists for the carrier destination
- a route exists for the carrier destination.
Carrier destinations for which neither of these conditions is fulfilled
are cancelled.

Prerequisites:
- The destination has been created.
- It is a destination for carrier selection.
- The destination for carrier selection has already been deactivated.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN DESTDAT : DEST= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DESTDAT- 1-


ENTR DESTDAT
NOROUTE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER DESTINATION DATA

This command modifies a standard destination to form a destination for


carrier selection. This applies even if calls are already processed via
the standard destination.

Note:
The modification is not allowed for destinations with optimized
dynamic routing (CR ODR) reference.

Prerequisites:
- The standard destination to be modified to form a destination
for carrier selection is created.
- If one of the carrier destinations has already been created
as standard destination, no code points refer to this destination.
- The carrier quota group has been created and is active.
- A carrier destination is specified for each active carrier of the
carrier quota group.
- If more than 6 digits are to be entered in the destination area
name, the range of values must have been extended with the command
MOD CALLPOPT : DESTMAXL = LONG.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ENTR DESTDAT - NOROUTE


2. ENTR DESTDAT - ROUTE

1. Input format

Input format to be used if the destination to be expanded has no routes

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR DESTDAT : DEST= ,CQGRP= ,CDEST= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the name of the standard destination


which is being converted into a carrier selection destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This parameter specifies the name of the carrier quota group


which is assigned to the carrier selection destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CDEST CARRIER DESTINATION

Up to 20 parameter values may be specified.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR DESTDAT- 1+


ENTR DESTDAT
NOROUTE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a: CARRIER DESTINATION NAME=


1...12 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This parameter unit specifies the name of a carrier destination


which can be assigned to the carrier selection destination.

b: CARRIER NAME=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This parameter unit specifies the name of the carrier to


which the carrier destination will be assigned.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR DESTDAT- 2+


ENTR DESTDAT
ROUTE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

Input format to be used if the destination to be expanded has routes.


The routes of the standard destination are transferred to the specified
standby carrier destination.

Additional prerequisites:
- The standby carrier destination must be specified in the list of
carrier destinations.
- No routes may have been created for the standby carrier destination.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR DESTDAT : DEST= ,CQGRP= ,CDEST= ,SCDEST= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the name of the standard destination


which is being converted into a carrier selection destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CQGRP CARRIER QUOTA GROUP

This parameter specifies the name of the carrier quota group


which is assigned to the carrier selection destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CDEST CARRIER DESTINATION

Up to 20 parameter values may be specified.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: CARRIER DESTINATION NAME=


1...12 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This parameter unit specifies the name of a carrier destination


which can be assigned to the carrier selection destination.

b: CARRIER NAME=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This parameter unit specifies the name of the carrier to


which the carrier destination will be assigned.

SCDEST STANDBY CARRIER DESTINATION

This parameter specifies to which carrier destination the routes


which are assigned to the standard destination, being converted
into carrier selection destination, are to be transferred.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR DESTDAT- 3-


MOD DESTDAT
ACDEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY DESTINATION DATA

This command modifies the assignment of carrier destination to a carrier


selection area.

It is possible to
- assign further carrier destinations to a destination for carrier
selection or
- cancel the assignment of carrier destinations to a destination for
carrier selection.

Prerequisites:
- If more than 6 digits are to be entered in the destination area
name, the range of values must have been extended with the command
MOD CALLPOPT : DESTMAXL = LONG.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD DESTDAT - ACDEST ADDITIONAL CARRIER DESTINATION


2. MOD DESTDAT - CCDEST CANCELLED CARRIER DESTINATION

1. Input format

ADDITIONAL CARRIER DESTINATION

This input format is used to modify the extension for a destination for
carrier selection (add carrier destinations).

All destinations for carrier selection need to be expanded after the


addition of one or more carriers to a quota group (MOD CQGRP) in order to
bring the additional carriers into effect for the load sharing scheme.

The expansion of destinations for carrier selection is also necessary, if


no carrier destinations were assigned during the initial ENTR DESTDAT to
carriers with a quota of zero, and if the carriers shall be activated now.

All added carrier destinations with already assigned routes are activated
automatically, if the destination for carrier selection is already active
(ACT DEST).

Prerequisites:
- The name of the additional carrier destination is not yet used.
- The additional carrier destination already exists as a standard
destination without any code points using this destination.
- The carrier name already exists in that quota group used by the specified
destination for carrier selection.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD DESTDAT : ACDEST= ,DEST= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACDEST ADDITIONAL CARRIER DESTINATION

Up to 19 parameter values can be entered.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: CARRIER DESTINATION NAME=


1...12 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This parameter unit specifies the name of the carrier


destination which can be assigned to the carrier selection

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DESTDAT- 1+


MOD DESTDAT
ACDEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

destination.

b: CARRIER NAME=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This parameter unit specifies the name of the carrier to


which the carrier destination will be assigned.

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the name of the carrier selection area.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DESTDAT- 2+


MOD DESTDAT
CCDEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

CANCELLED CARRIER DESTINATION

This input format is entered to modify the extension of destination for


carrier selection (cancel carrier destination).

All carrier destinations assigned to a deactivated carrier (MOD CQDAT)


need to be deleted from the destination for carrier selection before the
carrier can be removed from the quota group (MOD CQGRP).

Additionally, a table is displayed which shows if the cancelled carrier


destinations have been deleted or if they were kept as standard
destinations.

Prerequisites:
- The carrier, which the carrier destination being cancelled is assigned
to, is deactive within the quota group.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD DESTDAT : CCDEST= ,DEST= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CCDEST CANCELLED CARRIER DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the carrier destination for which the


assignment to the carrier selection area should be cancelled.
Up to 19 parameter values can be cancelled.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the name of the carrier selection area.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DESTDAT- 3-


DISP DEVAUT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DEVICE AUTHORIZATION

This command displays authorizations assigned to devices.


A table is displayed showing the authorizations of individual
or all devices.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP DEVAUT : [DEV=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEV OUTPUT DEVICE

This parameter specifies the device for which the basic or maximum
authorization is to be modified, or which devices authorizations are
to be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: DEVICE TYPE
OMT O&M TERMINAL
WST WORKSTATION

This information unit specifies the device type.

b: DEVICE NUMBER=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the device number.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DEVAUT- 1-


MOD DEVAUT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY DEVICE AUTHORIZATION

This command modifies the input device authorization.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD DEVAUT : DEV= ,AUT= ,OAUT= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEV OUTPUT DEVICE

This parameter specifies the device for which the authorization must
be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: DEVICE IDENTIFIER
OMT O&M TERMINAL
WST WORKSTATION

b: DEVICE IDENTIFIER=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

AUT NEW AUTHORIZATION

This parameter specifies the new device authorization.


An authorization contains a number of authorization classes.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OAUT OLD AUTHORIZATION

This parameter specifies the old device authorization.


An authorization contains a number of authorization classes.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DEVAUT- 1-


CAN DFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Disk File from Master and Slave

This task deletes a file from both master and slave disk using an FCS-Testprocess.
This task should be used only if it is not possible to delete a file using
CAN DFILEFS task.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN DFILE : [MP_ID=] ,File= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MP_ID

Specifies the Identifier of MP.

File

Specifies the file name (with full path).

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DFILE- 1-


CAT DFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Catalog Disk File on Master and Slave

This task renames a file on both master and slave disk using an FCS-Testprocess.
It is not possible to change the directory, only the file member name.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAT DFILE : [MP_ID=] ,New file= ,Old file= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MP_ID

Specifies the Identifier of MP.

New file

Specifies the new file name (with full path).

Old file

Specifies the old file name (with full path).

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAT DFILE- 1-


DISP DFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Disk Files on Master or Slave

This task queries files on master and/or slave disk using an FCS-Testprocess.
It is possible to specify, which disk should be queried (master or slave).
Either the base directory only or the whole base directory tree will be returned.
As a default, all objects except of object with the category system or unsynch
will be returned. In order to see those objects too it is possible to enter
the specific category as a filter. In this case only objects with the specified
category will be displayed.
The output can be either short (only names) or long (names and attributes).
If the output has been truncated (indicate the value of the output parameter
LAST),
use DISP FOLLOW to see following files.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP DFILE : [SCSI=] [,MP_ID=] [,Side=] ,Dir= ,Categ= ,Attr= 1
1 1
1 ,Whole= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCSI

Specifies the disk SCSI address.


In the current EWSD version the possible values are hard-coded:
SYS: scsi = 0, side = 0&1
MOD0: scsi = 1, side = 0
MOD1: scsi = 1, side = 1
If the side is not entered, the scsi is ignored as well.
If the side is entered and this value is not entered the scsi
default value will be the SYS disk.

MP_ID

Specifies the Identifier of MP.

Side

Specifies the mpu side.


If not entered the query is not disk specific.

Dir

Specifies the base directory name (with full path).

Categ

Specifies the file category. Empty for no categ filter (all files).
Possibilities: DBMS, LOAD, LOG, TEMP, SYSTEM, DIR, UNSYNC, SAMAR
Remark: The files with the category = SYSTEM and UNSYNC will not
be displayed if no categ filter is required. In order to display
these files the file category filter must be used.

Attr

Specifies inquire type.


ONLY NAME = only names (default),
NAME ATTR = names with attributes.

Whole

Specifies scope.
BASE = base directory only,
WHOLE = whole tree (default).

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DFILE- 1+


DISP DFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DFILE- 2-


DMP DFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Dump Disk File

This task dumps a disk file / directory using a DUMP utilitity.


The dump can be displayed either binary (hexadecimal + ASCII)
or symbolic (see help for input field SYMB).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DMP DFILE : SCSI= [,MP_ID=] ,Side= ,File= ,Offset= ,Length= 1
1 1
1 ,Symb= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCSI

Specifies the disk SCSI address.


In the current EWSD versions the possible values are hard-coded:
SYS: scsi = 0, side = 0&1
MOD0: scsi = 1, side = 0
MOD1: scsi = 1, side = 1

MP_ID

Specifies the Identifier of MP.

Side

Specifies the mpu side.

File

Specifies the file / directory name (with full path).

Offset

Specifies the offset of displayed data within the file / directory.


Negative value means offset from the file / direcory end.
Default value is 0 (from the file / directory beginning).

Length

Specifies the length of displayed data.


Length equals -1 means dump until file end.
Default value is 2048 (one block = 2048 Bytes).

Symb

Specifies if the output will be displayed symbolic.


Symbolic means the logical structure of the object.
Allowed values are NO (the object is displayed in hex + ASCII Dump),
SHORT (only the important fields are displayed symbolic) and LONG
(all fields are displayed symbolic). Only objects of categories DIR
or LOG can be displayed symbolic. If the value of parameter SYMB is
unequal NO, the parameters OFFSET and LENGTH will be ignored.
Default value is NO.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP DFILE- 1-


PATCH DFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Patch Disk File

This task patches a disk file / directory using a PATCH utilitity.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 PATCH DFILE : SCSI= [,MP_ID=] ,Side= ,File= ,Offset= ,Comp= 1
1 1
1 ,Data= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCSI

Specifies the disk SCSI address.


In the current EWSD version the possible values are hard-coded:
SYS: scsi = 0, side = 0&1
MOD0: scsi = 1, side = 0
MOD1: scsi = 1, side = 1

MP_ID

Specifies the Identifier of MP.

Side

Specifies the mpu side.

File

Specifies the file / directory name (with full path).

Offset

Specifies the offset of patched data within the file / directory.


Negative value means offset from the file / directory end.
Default value is 0 (from the file / directory beginning).

Comp

Specifies the compare data.


Syntax: value [ & value ] ...
value: [ - ] decimal | $ hexadecimal | ’ string ’

Data

Specifies the patch data.


Syntax: value [ & value ] ...
value: [ - ] decimal | $ hexadecimal | ’ string ’

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 PATCH DFILE- 1-


CAN DFILEFS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Disk File FS

This task deletes a file from both master and slave disk using an FS-Testprocess.
If it is not possible to delete a file using this task, a CAN DFILE can be used.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN DFILEFS : [MP_ID=] ,File= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MP_ID

Specifies the Identifier of MP.

File

Specifies the file name (with full path).

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DFILEFS- 1-


DISP DIAGSTAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DIAGNOSIS STATISTICS

This command displays interim results of the active permanent


diagnosis. The number of cyclic runs, the number of faults found,
information on different faults, and the basic information on
the last fault are displayed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP DIAGSTAT ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DIAGSTAT- 1-


DISP DIGITCP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DIGITS CP

This command displays the digit translator data related to the


specified digit combination.

The displayed data may be restricted to certain digit combinations


specifying parameters CODE and ORIG1.

Examples: DISP DIGITCP; (no restrictions)


DISP DIGITCP: CODE=X; (no restrictions)
DISP DIGITCP: CODE=12; (code restricted)
DISP DIGITCP: ORIG1=DEF; (origination mark 1 restricted).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP DIGITCP : [CODE=] [,ORIG1=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter restricts the digit translation data to be displayed:


Only digit translation data that begin with the entered digits will
be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter restricts the digit translation data to be displayed:


Only digit translation data that contain the entered originating
mark will be displayed. Only decimal numbers, range 0..3839, and
the hexadecimal number ’DEF’ may be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DIGITCP- 1-


CAN DIGITGP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL DIGITS GP

This command cancels the control record for the GP according to the digit
combination entered in the command CR DIGITGP.

The appropriate digit combinations will then be pretranslated according to


the standard values.

Prerequisites :
- The appropriate digit combinations in the digit translator must first be
cancelled if the number of digits for pretranslation is to be changed.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN DIGITGP : CODE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter specifies the digit combination for the control record
for the GP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...3 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DIGITGP- 1-


CR DIGITGP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE DIGITS GP

This command creates the control record for the GP. Based on this record, the
number of digits to be pretranslated in the GP is determined.
The record consists of two units. The first unit specifies the code for pre-
translation. The second unit determines the number of digits to be evaluated
by the GP. Codes that don’t appear in the control record are handled by using
default values.
(These default values are:
Subscriber Controlled Input - 6 digits,
Code points with TRATYP=TOLLFRNO - 24 digits,
Code points with TRATYP=CLOCKTST - 24 digits,
Code points with TRATYP=NBARCPT - 24 digits,
Code points with TRATYP=ITGW - 24 digits,
Local areacodes - 6 digits.)

Since the pretranslator receives its data from the commands that create the
digit translator, the described command must be entered first.

Prerequisites :
- The entered control record must not already exist.
- The command must be entered before the digit translator is created.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR DIGITGP : CODE= ,DIGITS= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter determines the digit combination for the control record
for the GP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...3 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DIGITS DIGITS

This parameter specifies the number of digits to be evaluated


in the GP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DIGITGP- 1-
DISP DIGITGP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DIGITS GP

This command displays the digit control data for the GP and also the digit
pretranslation table.

If the parameters are omitted or standard list format is selected, all digit
sequences for which the digit pretranslation differs from the standard setup
(evaluation of a maximum of 4 digits in the GP), are displayed.

If extended list format is selected, the complete digit pretranslation data is


displayed for all digit sequences specified by the parameter CODE.
If all data of digit preanalysis table is selected, the data of the not used
elements (i.e. elements of the digit preanalysis table with initial values)
will be displayed too.

If utilization list format is selected, the rate of capacity utilization of the


digit pretranslation table is displayed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP DIGITGP : [CODE=] [,FORMAT=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter specifies the digit sequence for which data is to be


displayed.
The parameter is mandatory if FORMAT = EXT or
FORMAT = ALL.

Incompatibilities:
- FORMAT = STD
- FORMAT = USE

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

FORMAT OUTPUT FORMAT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

STD STANDARD LIST FORMAT


EXT EXTENDED LIST FORMAT
ALL ALL DATA OF PREANALYSIS TABLE
USE USE OF PREANALYSIS TABLE

Default: STD

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DIGITGP- 1-


MOD DIGITGP
COLDIG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY DIGITS GP

This command modifies the number of digits which are to be collected after the
digit pretranslation in the GP. (Prerequisite for this command is a good working
knowledge of the system.) The call is not passed on to the CP until the GP has
received the required number of digits.

The number of GP-CP messages (M:DIGIT_BLOCK_C - C:COME_AGAIN_C cycles) is


reduced if more digits are collected in the GP. This affects the time for
setting up a call as well as the used processor time, but only if the called
party digits are received with an "overlap" protocol. Otherwise a single
GP-CP message M:DIGIT_BLOCK_C is used to send all digits at once to the CP.

The GP uses a subtree of the CP digit translation tree to perform the digit
pretranslation. This subtree, in the standard configuration, comprises four
digits, i.e. the root of the digit tree plus three additional nodes of the digit
tree.

It is also possible to increase the number of digits that are collected in the
GP for specific digit combinations.
The parameters CODE and possibly LAC define the digit combination.
Parameter COLDIG defines how many digits still have to be collected after
the digit pretranslation is finished.
This optimisation does not affect the number of allocated nodes in the GP digit
tree. It is additional data for a pretranslation result.
Note:
This number of additionally collected digits is reset whenever one of the above
listed commands is entered for a digit combination that completely includes
LAC (if present) and CODE. The COLDIG value has to be
re-entered if it still applies.

Caution:
The length of LAC (if present) and CODE plus the value of
COLDIG may not exceed the total length of the shortest called party number
starting with LAC (if present) and CODE.
Entering a COLDIG value that does not comply with this rule REMOVES short
called party numbers beginning with LAC (if present) and CODE the
service!
The called party numbers concerned are not recognized as completely dialed.
The calls are released after a time-out.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD DIGITGP - COLDIG INDIVIDUAL COLLECTION OF DIGITS


2. MOD DIGITGP - DIGITS DEFAULT LENGTH OF PRETRANSLATION TREE

1. Input format

INDIVIDUAL COLLECTION OF DIGITS

This path is used to modify the code individual amount of additionally collected
digits.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD DIGITGP : CODE= [,LAC=] ,COLDIG= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter specifies the control record digit combination for


the GP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DIGITGP- 1+


MOD DIGITGP
COLDIG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code if multiple directory


number volumes exist in the exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

COLDIG COLLECT DIGITS

This parameter specifies the number of digits which are to be collected


in the GP after the digit pretranslation.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...24, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DIGITGP- 2+


MOD DIGITGP
DIGITS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

DEFAULT LENGTH OF PRETRANSLATION TREE

This path is used to modify the global standard length of the digit combinations
that are stored in the GP pretranslator.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD DIGITGP : DIGITS= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DIGITS PRETRANSLATED DIGITS (DEFAULT)

This parameter specifies the default value for the number of digits
which are stored in the GP digit pretranslator und used for the digit
pretranslation.
Digit combinations with a length lower or equal to the value of this
parameter may be stored completely in the GP. Longer digit combinations
are cut off at the specified length and partially stored in the GP.

The GP handles a subset of the CP functions for digit translation.


Fewer digits than the specified length are stored in GP if a digit
combination uses a CP-only function.
An example for these is a CR CPT using the evalution of
ORIG1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DIGITGP- 3-


DMP DINODE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Dump Disk File Inode

This task dumps a disk file inode using a DUMP utilitity.


The dump can be displayed either binary (hexadecimal + ASCII)
or symbolic (see help for input field SYMB).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DMP DINODE : SCSI= [,MP_ID=] ,Side= ,File= ,Offset= ,Length= 1
1 1
1 ,Symb= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCSI

Specifies the disk SCSI address.


In the current EWSD version the possible values are hard-coded:
SYS: scsi = 0, side = 0&1
MOD0: scsi = 1, side = 0
MOD1: scsi = 1, side = 1

MP_ID

Specifies the Identifier of MP.

Side

Specifies the mpu side.

File

Specifies the file / directory name (with full path).

Offset

Specifies the offset of displayed data within the inode.


Negative value means offset from the inode end.
Default value is 0 (from the inode beginning).

Length

Specifies the length of displayed data.


Default value is 0 (whole inode).

Symb

Specifies if the output will be displayed symbolic.


Symbolic means the logical structure of the inode.
Allowed values are NO (the inode and secondary
extent table are displayed in hex + ASCII Dump),
SHORT (the inode and secondary extent table are displayed symbolic)
and LONG (the inode and all connected blocks are displayed symbolic).
If the value of the parameter SYMB is unequal NO, the parameters
OFFSET and LENGTH will be ignored.
Default value is LONG.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP DINODE- 1-


PATCH DINODE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Patch Disk File Inode

This task patches a disk file inode using a PATCH utilitity.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 PATCH DINODE : SCSI= [,MP_ID=] ,Side= ,File= ,Offset= ,Comp= 1
1 1
1 ,Data= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCSI

Specifies the disk SCSI address.


In the current EWSD version the possible values are hard-coded:
SYS: scsi = 0, side = 0&1
MOD0: scsi = 1, side = 0
MOD1: scsi = 1, side = 1

MP_ID

Specifies the Identifier of MP.

Side

Specifies the mpu side.

File

Specifies the file / directory name (with full path).

Offset

Specifies the offset of patched data within the inode.


Negative value means offset from the inode end.
Default value is 0 (from the inode beginning).

Comp

Specifies the compare data.


Syntax: value [ & value ] ...
value: [ - ] decimal | $ hexadecimal | ’ string ’

Data

Specifies the patch data.


Syntax: value [ & value ] ...
value: [ - ] decimal | $ hexadecimal | ’ string ’

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 PATCH DINODE- 1-


STOP DISP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

STOP DISPLAY

This command stops the display being output on the O&M terminal.
The command is only effective if the display was started with a command
that performs a display function (e.g. DISP, SEL, STAT commands).

Notes:
- The command must be entered on the same terminal as the command which
causes the output that should be stopped.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STOP DISP : JN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

JN JOB NUMBER

This parameter specifies the job number assigned to a display job.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...9999, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STOP DISP- 1-


CONF DIU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT

With this command a digital interface unit can be configured


to one of the states MBL, ACT, CBL or PLA.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF DIU : LTG= ,DIU= ,OST= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LTG NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LTGSET NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

DIU DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...4, range of decimal numbers

OST OPERATING STATUS

This parameter specifies the destination operating status.


The following status transitions are permitted:

PLA <-> MBL


MBL --> ACT
ACT --> MBL (when the LTG is not active)
MBL <-> CBL
UNA --> MBL or CBL or ACT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CBL CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED


ACT ACTIVE
PLA PLANNED
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF DIU- 1-


DIAG DIU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSE DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT

This command diagnoses a DIU of the type DIU24 or DIU30 in


an LTG.
Precondition: the LTG must be in the operating status
ACT or CBL and the associated DIU must be in the
operating status MBL.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG DIU : LTG= ,DIU= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LTG NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LTGSET NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

DIU DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...4, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG DIU- 1-


STAT DIU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY STATUS OF DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT

This command displays the operating status of


- one DIU in a particular LTG
- one DIU in all LTGs
- all DIUs in a particular LTG
- all DIUs in all LTGs
- all DIUs with a particular operating status in a
particular LTG
- all DIUs with a particular operating status in all LTGs
For the parameter LTG a value or X must always be entered.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT DIU : LTG= [,DIU=] [,OST=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LTG NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: LTGSET NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

DIU DIGITAL INTERFACE UNIT NUMBER

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...4, range of decimal numbers

OST OPERATING STATUS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
CBL CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED
UNA UNAVAILABLE
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED
PLA PLANNED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT DIU- 1-


CAN DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This command cancels a DLU.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU must exist.
- The existing DLU systems must be PLA.
- The DIUs in the LTGs the DLU is connected
to must be PLA.
- No nailed up connection must exist for this DLU.
- If the DLU is of the type DLUG, no
administerable DLU equipment must exist in
this DLU.
- No administerable DLU modules must exist in
this DLU.
- The DLU must not be object to IACHASTA (see
MML command CR IACOBJ.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN DLU : DLU= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DLU- 1-


CONF DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This command configures a DLU system to the desired operating status.

If a DLU system of any DLU type except DLUG is configured, then the
connected DIUs on the LTG will be configured automatically together
with the DLU system.

If a DLU system of a DLUG is configured, then the connected DIUs on


the LTG are not configured automatically together with the DLU system.
The command CONF DIU must be used to configure the DIUs of a
connected DLUG.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,DLUC0=1 1
1 CONF DLU : DLU= Z,DLUC1=Y ,OST= ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

DLUC0 DIGITAL LINE UNIT CONTROL 0

N NO
NO
Y YES
YES

DLUC1 DIGITAL LINE UNIT CONTROL 1

N NO
NO
Y YES
YES

OST OPERATING STATUS

This parameter specifies the desired operating status.

Compatibilities:
+--------------------------+-------------------+
! ! ! New state !
! Old ! Access- +----+----+----+----+
! state ! Degrading ! CBL! ACT! PLA! MBL!
+==========================+====+====+====+====+
! UNA ! * ! + ! + ! ! + !
+--------------------------+----+----+----+----+
! MBL ! * ! + ! + ! + ! !
+--------------------------+----+----+----+----+
! PLA ! * ! ! ! ! + !
+--------------------------+----+----+----+----+
! CBL ! * ! ! + ! ! + !

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF DLU- 1+


CONF DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

+--------------------------+----+----+----+----+
! ACT ! accessible ! + ! ! ! !
! ACT ! not accessible ! + ! ! ! + !
+--------------------------+----+----+----+----+

+: legal transition
*: not relevant

Notes:
- During installation recovery there are no restrictions for state
transitions and the compatibility table is not relevant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
PLA PLANNED
CBL CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF DLU- 2-


CR DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This command creates a DLU.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU must not yet exist.
- All LTGs connected to the DLU must be
of the same type.
- All LTGs connected to the DLU must have
the same load type.
- All LTUs connected to the DLU must be
of the same type and not be connected to
another DLU. Allowed types are:
D24
D30
- Enough memory must be provided in the CP
database (see command MODIFY DB-SIZE),

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR DLU : DLU= ,TYPE= <,DLUC0= ,DLUC1=> [,PORTGRID=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,CCSWIDTH=] [,ALEXF=] [,ALPROF=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU must not yet exist.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

TYPE DLU TYPE

This parameter specifies the DLU type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DLUA DLU TYPE A


DLUB DLU TYPE B
DLUK DLU TYPE K
DLUO DLU TYPE O
DLUD DLU TYPE D
DLUV DLU TYPE V
DLUX DLU TYPE X
DLUI DLU TYPE I
DLUG DLU TYPE G

DLUC0 DIGITAL LINE UNIT CONTROLLER 0

This parameter specifies the connection of


DLU controller 0 to LTUs in up to two LTGs.

Compatibilities:
- The specified LTGs and LTUs must exist.
- The specified LTGs must be of the
type LTGB.
- The type of these LTUs must be one of the
following:
D24
D30
- The PCM links of all DLU controllers of

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLU- 1+
CR DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

the DLU must be connected to LTUs of the


same type.
- If the type of the LTUs is D30, only the
LTUs 0 to 3 may be used for connecting
the DLU.
- The specified DIUs must not yet be connected
to another DLU.
- CCS links must be connected to DIUs with the
following applications:
CCSDLU
CCSLDI
- Extension links must be connected to DIUs
with the following applications:
EXTDLU
EXTLDI
- All CCS links of a DLU controller must be
connected to DIUs with the same application.
- To each LTG connected to the DLU there must
be exactly one CCS link.
- The CCS links of DLU controller 0 must be
connected to different LTGs than the CCS links
of DLU controller 1.
- If a CCS link of a DLU controller is
connected to a DIU with the application
CCSDLU, all extension links of this DLU
controller must be connected to DIUs with the
application EXTDLU.
- If a CCS link of a DLU controller is
connected to a DIU with the application
CCSLDI, all extension links of this DLU
controller must be connected to DIUs with the
application EXTLDI.
- The CCS link connected to the port CCS0 of
the DLU controller must lead to a different
LTG than the CCS link connected to port CCS1.
- All PCM links connected to the ports CCS0,
EXT0, EXT1, EXT2 and EXT3 of a DLU
controller must be connected to the same LTG.
- All PCM links connected to the ports CCS1,
EXT4, EXT5, EXT6 and EXT7 of a DLU
controller must be connected to the same LTG.
- The ports EXT3 and EXT7 of the DLU
controller can only be used if they are
connected to LTUs of the type D24.
- For all DLU types except DLUG, only the
ports CCS0 and EXT0 of the DLU controller
can be used for LTG connections.
- If the CCS link of a DLU of the type DLUV
is connected to a DIU with the application
CCSDLU, no extension link may be created.

At maximum 10 values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: LTG SET=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTG set.

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTG number.

c: LINE TRUNK UNIT NUMBER=


0...4, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the DIU to which


the DLU controller 0 is connected via
a PCM link.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLU- 2+
CR DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

d: DLUC PORT
CCS0 DLUC PORT FOR CCS 0
EXT0 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 0
EXT1 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 1
EXT2 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 2
EXT3 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 3
CCS1 DLUC PORT FOR CCS 1
EXT4 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 4
EXT5 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 5
EXT6 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 6
EXT7 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 7

This unit specifies the PCM port on the


DLU controller 0 to which the PCM is
connected.

DLUC1 DIGITAL LINE UNIT CONTROLLER 1

This parameter specifies the connection of


DLU controller 1 to LTUs in up to two LTGs.

Compatibilities:
- The specified LTGs and LTUs must exist.
- The specified LTGs must be of the
type LTGB.
- The type of these LTUs must be one of the
following:
D24
D30
- The PCM links of all DLU controllers of
the DLU must be connected to LTUs of the
same type.
- If the type of the LTUs is D30, only the
LTUs 0 to 3 may be used for connecting
the DLU.
- The specified DIUs must not yet be connected
to another DLU.
- CCS links must be connected to DIUs with the
following applications:
CCSDLU
CCSLDI
- Extension links must be connected to DIUs
with the following applications:
EXTDLU
EXTLDI
- All CCS links of a DLU controller must be
connected to DIUs with the same application.
- To each LTG connected to the DLU there must
be exactly one CCS link.
- The CCS links of DLU controller 0 must be
connected to different LTGs than the CCS links
of DLU controller 1.
- If a CCS link of a DLU controller is
connected to a DIU with the application
CCSDLU, all extension links of this DLU
controller must be connected to DIUs with the
application EXTDLU.
- If a CCS link of a DLU controller is
connected to a DIU with the application
CCSLDI, all extension links of this DLU
controller must be connected to DIUs with the
application EXTLDI.
- The CCS link connected to the port CCS0 of
the DLU controller must lead to a different
LTG than the CCS link connected to port CCS1.
- All PCM links connected to the ports CCS0,
EXT0, EXT1, EXT2 and EXT3 of a DLU
controller must be connected to the same LTG.
- All PCM links connected to the ports CCS1,
EXT4, EXT5, EXT6 and EXT7 of a DLU
controller must be connected to the same LTG.
- The ports EXT3 and EXT7 of the DLU
controller can only be used if they are
connected to LTUs of the type D24.
- For all DLU types except DLUG, only the

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLU- 3+
CR DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ports CCS0 and EXT0 of the DLU controller


can be used for LTG connections.
- If the CCS link of a DLU of the type DLUV
is connected to a DIU with the application
CCSDLU, no extension link may be created.

At maximum 10 values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: LTG SET=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTG set.

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTG number.

c: LINE TRUNK UNIT NUMBER=


0...4, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the DIU to which


the DLU controller 1 is connected via
a PCM link.

d: DLUC PORT
CCS0 DLUC PORT FOR CCS 0
EXT0 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 0
EXT1 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 1
EXT2 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 2
EXT3 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 3
CCS1 DLUC PORT FOR CCS 1
EXT4 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 4
EXT5 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 5
EXT6 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 6
EXT7 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 7

This unit specifies the PCM port on the


DLU controller 1 to which the PCM is
connected.

PORTGRID PORT GRID OF THE DLU

This parameter specifies how many ports are


assigned to each DLU module is this DLU.

Compatibilities:
- This parameter may only be entered for a
DLU of the type DLUG.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

16,32, range of decimal numbers

CCSWIDTH CCS WIDTH

This parameter specifies how many timeslots


on each CCS link of the DLU are used as
CCS channel.

Compatibilities:
- This parameter may only be entered for a
DLU of the type DLUG.

Incompatibilities:
- If the DLU is connected to LTUs of the
type D24, only values from 1 to 8 may
be entered.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLU- 4+
CR DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

ALEXF ALARM EXTERNAL FUNCTION

This parameter specifies whether the integrated


ALEX function of the DLU controllers are used.

Compatibilities:
- This parameter may only be entered for a
DLU of the type DLUG.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO ALEX FUNCTION
NO NO ALEX FUNCTION
Y ALEX FUNCTION
YES ALEX FUNCTION

ALPROF ALARM PROFILE

This parameter specifies the alarm profile.

Valid profiles are:


MAJESC major with escalation
MINESC minor with escalation
MAJNOESC major no escalation
MINNOESC minor no escalation
CRITICAL critical

If this parameter is omitted for a DLU of


the type DLUG, the alarm profile MAJESC
will be used by default.

Prerequisites:
- The specified alarm profile must exist.

Compatibilities:
- This parameter may only be entered for a
DLU of the type DLUG.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLU- 5-
DIAG DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSIS OF THE DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This command starts the diagnosis of a digital line unit or a specific


DLU system.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU system(s) to be diagnosed must have been created.
- No other diagnosis may run on this DLU.
- The pre-switched units (LTG and DIU(CCS)) must be in the operating states
ACT or CBL.
- The DLU system(s) to be diagnosed must be in the operating state(s) MBL.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,DLUC0=11 1
1 DIAG DLU : DLU= 1Z,DLUC1=Y1 ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

DLUC0 DIGITAL LINE UNIT CONTROL 0

This parameter specifies whether DLUC0 is to be diagnosed.

Default: 1.) Y if neither DLUC0=Y nor DLUC1=Y is specified or


2.) N if DLUC1=Y is specified.

N NO
NO
Y YES
YES

Default: Y

DLUC1 DIGITAL LINE UNIT CONTROL 1

This parameter specifies whether DLUC1 is to be diagnosed.

Default: 1.) Y if neither DLUC1=Y nor DLUC0=Y is specified or


2.) N if DLUC0=Y is specified.

N NO
NO
Y YES
YES

Default: Y

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG DLU- 1-


DISP DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This command displays data of one DLU, a range of DLUs or


all DLUs.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP DLU : DLU= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DLU- 1-


EXT DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

EXTEND DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This command creates news PCM connections from a DLU


to currently unconnected LTUs.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU to be extended must exist.
- The LTUs of the type D30 or D24 to which
the additional PCMs are to be connected must not
be connected to another DLU.
- If a new CCS link is to be created and there are
any modules created in the DLU, the corresponding
LTG must be PLA or MBL.
- If the DLU type is not DLUG, the specified DLU
controller must be PLA.
- The maximum amount of created DLU ports managed
by each affected LTG must not exceed 2048.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 EXT DLU : DLU= <,DLUC0= ,DLUC1=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU must exist.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

DLUC0 DIGITAL LINE UNIT CONTROLLER 0

This parameter specifies the connection of


DLU controller 0 to LTUs in up to two LTGs.

Compatibilities:
- The specified LTGs and LTUs must exist.
- The specified LTGs must be of the
type LTGB.
- The type of these LTUs must be one of the
following:
D24
D30
- The PCM links of all DLU controllers of
the DLU must be connected to LTUs of the
same type.
- If the type of the LTUs is D30, only the
LTUs 0 to 3 may be used for connecting
the DLU.
- The specified DIUs must not yet be connected
to another DLU.
- CCS links must be connected to DIUs with the
following applications:
CCSDLU
CCSLDI
- Extension links must be connected to DIUs
with the following applications:
EXTDLU
EXTLDI
- All CCS links of a DLU controller must be
connected to DIUs with the same application.
- To each LTG connected to the DLU there must
be exactly one CCS link.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 EXT DLU- 1+


EXT DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- The CCS links of DLU controller 0 must be


connected to different LTGs than the CCS links
of DLU controller 1.
- If a CCS link of a DLU controller is
connected to a DIU with the application
CCSDLU, all extension links of this DLU
controller must be connected to DIUs with the
application EXTDLU.
- If a CCS link of a DLU controller is
connected to a DIU with the application
CCSLDI, all extension links of this DLU
controller must be connected to DIUs with the
application EXTLDI.
- The CCS link connected to the port CCS0 of
the DLU controller must lead to a different
LTG than the CCS link connected to port CCS1.
- All PCM links connected to the ports CCS0,
EXT0, EXT1, EXT2 and EXT3 of a DLU
controller must be connected to the same LTG.
- All PCM links connected to the ports CCS1,
EXT4, EXT5, EXT6 and EXT7 of a DLU
controller must be connected to the same LTG.
- The ports EXT3 and EXT7 of the DLU
controller can only be used if they are
connected to LTUs of the type D24.
- The specified port of the DLU controller must
not yet be used by an already existing PCM
link.
- For all DLU types except DLUG, only the
ports CCS0 and EXT0 of the DLU controller
can be used for LTG connections.
- If the CCS link of a DLU of the type DLUV
is connected to a DIU with the application
CCSDLU, no extension link may be created.

At maximum 10 values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: LTG SET=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTG set.

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTG number.

c: LINE TRUNK UNIT NUMBER=


0...4, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the DIU to which


the DLU controller 0 is connected via
a PCM link.

d: DLUC PORT
CCS0 DLUC PORT FOR CCS 0
EXT0 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 0
EXT1 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 1
EXT2 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 2
EXT3 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 3
CCS1 DLUC PORT FOR CCS 1
EXT4 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 4
EXT5 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 5
EXT6 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 6
EXT7 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 7

This unit specifies the PCM port on the


DLU controller 0 to which the PCM is

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 EXT DLU- 2+


EXT DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

connected.

DLUC1 DIGITAL LINE UNIT CONTROLLER 1

This parameter specifies the connection of


DLU controller 1 to LTUs in up to two LTGs.

Compatibilities:
- The specified LTGs and LTUs must exist.
- The specified LTGs must be of the
type LTGB.
- The type of these LTUs must be one of the
following:
D24
D30
- The PCM links of all DLU controllers of
the DLU must be connected to LTUs of the
same type.
- If the type of the LTUs is D30, only the
LTUs 0 to 3 may be used for connecting
the DLU.
- The specified DIUs must not yet be connected
to another DLU.
- CCS links must be connected to DIUs with the
following applications:
CCSDLU
CCSLDI
- Extension links must be connected to DIUs
with the following applications:
EXTDLU
EXTLDI
- All CCS links of a DLU controller must be
connected to DIUs with the same application.
- To each LTG connected to the DLU there must
be exactly one CCS link.
- The CCS links of DLU controller 0 must be
connected to different LTGs than the CCS links
of DLU controller 1.
- If a CCS link of a DLU controller is
connected to a DIU with the application
CCSDLU, all extension links of this DLU
controller must be connected to DIUs with the
application EXTDLU.
- If a CCS link of a DLU controller is
connected to a DIU with the application
CCSLDI, all extension links of this DLU
controller must be connected to DIUs with the
application EXTLDI.
- The CCS link connected to the port CCS0 of
the DLU controller must lead to a different
LTG than the CCS link connected to port CCS1.
- All PCM links connected to the ports CCS0,
EXT0, EXT1, EXT2 and EXT3 of a DLU
controller must be connected to the same LTG.
- All PCM links connected to the ports CCS1,
EXT4, EXT5, EXT6 and EXT7 of a DLU
controller must be connected to the same LTG.
- The ports EXT3 and EXT7 of the DLU
controller can only be used if they are
connected to LTUs of the type D24.
- The specified port of the DLU controller must
not yet be used by an already existing PCM
link.
- For all DLU types except DLUG, only the
ports CCS0 and EXT0 of the DLU controller
can be used for LTG connections.
- If the CCS link of a DLU of the type DLUV
is connected to a DIU with the application
CCSDLU, no extension link may be created.

At maximum 10 values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 EXT DLU- 3+


EXT DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a-b-c-d

a: LTG SET=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTG set.

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTG number.

c: LINE TRUNK UNIT NUMBER=


0...4, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the DIU to which


the DLU controller 1 is connected via
a PCM link.

d: DLUC PORT
CCS0 DLUC PORT FOR CCS 0
EXT0 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 0
EXT1 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 1
EXT2 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 2
EXT3 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 3
CCS1 DLUC PORT FOR CCS 1
EXT4 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 4
EXT5 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 5
EXT6 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 6
EXT7 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 7

This unit specifies the PCM port on the


DLU controller 1 to which the PCM is
connected.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 EXT DLU- 4-


MOD DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This command modifies a DLU.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU must exist.
- The DLU must be of the type DLUG.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD DLU : DLU= <,CCSWIDTH= ,ALEXF= ,ALPROF=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU must exist.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

CCSWIDTH CCS WIDTH

This parameter specifies how many timeslots


on each CCS link of the DLU are used as
CCS channel.

Compatibilities:
- If the DLU is connected to LTUs of the
type D24, only values from 1 to 8 may
be entered.
- The DLU controllers of the DLU must
be PLA or MBL.
- The corresponding LTUs must be PLA
or MBL.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

ALEXF ALARM EXTERNAL FUNCTION

This parameter specifies whether the integrated


ALEX function of the DLU controllers are used.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO ALEX FUNCTION
NO NO ALEX FUNCTION
Y ALEX FUNCTION
YES ALEX FUNCTION

ALPROF ALARM PROFILE

This parameter specifies the alarm profile.

Valid profiles are:


MAJESC major with escalation
MINESC minor with escalation
MAJNOESC major no escalation
MINNOESC minor no escalation
CRITICAL critical

Prerequisites:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DLU- 1+


MOD DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- The specified alarm profile must exist.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DLU- 2-


REC DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RECORD DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This command records DLU traffic measurement data for specified DLUs
to operator terminal or to disk every 15 minutes within a given time
interval.
Prerequisites:
- System time must be secure when the command is entered.
Notes:
- The name of the measurement file is displayed on the OMT
if disk output of traffic data is requested.
- A maximum of 8 jobs of this type may be entered at the
same time.
- The traffic data are output every 15 minutes within the
selected measurement intervals.
At least 15 minutes elapse before the first data are output
with immediate start.
- The measurement can be stopped with STOP JOB, except
jobs with UNIT=MDD-DAILY OR CYCLIC.

This command starts a semipermanent job. It can be canceled with CAN JOB.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REC DLU : DLU= ,UNIT= [,FORMAT=] [,BEG=] [,TER=] [,IV=] 1
1 1
1 [,PER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the numbers of the DLUs for which data
has to be recorded.
It is possible to choose a single DLU, single DLUs linked with &,
a range of DLUs, ranges of DLUs linked with & or a combination
of these possibilities linked with & .
A maximum of 5 links is permitted.
Prerequisites:
- Measurement of all DLUs (DLU=X) is only possible if
output UNIT=MDD is specified.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

10...2550, range of decimal numbers

UNIT OUTPUT UNIT AND MODE

This parameter specifies the output unit and the mode of


output.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: OUTPUT UNIT
OMT OPERATION AND MAIN.TERMINAL
If this option is selected, data are output
to the OMT.
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
If this option is selected, a measurement file
is created and the traffic data are output to
this file. The start and the finish message
include the name of the file in which the
traffic data are available for postprocessing.
Notes :
- If a file is destroyed or cannot be extended,
an advisory is sent to the OMT.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DLU- 1+


REC DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This information unit specifies the output unit.

b: OUTPUT MODE
SINGLE SINGLE TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are output
to a single measurement file.
DAILY DAILY TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are output
to daily files. The measurement starts
immediately and has no defined end. Time
parameters are not permitted.
To secure the required space on disk, all 7
daily files are prepared and created at the
start of measurement.
A daily file is closed at the end of the day
and a new file for the next day is
automatically created, or the existing file is
replaced.
Daily files will be overwritten in the
following week on the same weekday.
CYCLIC CYCLIC TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are written
into a cyclic measurement file. Time parameters
are not permitted for these measurements.
If the cyclic file runs full, the newest data will
be lost. This occurs after a period of two days.

This information unit specifies the desired output


mode (daily, single or cyclic measurement file).
It is only permissible in connection with output
UNIT=MDD.

FORMAT OUTPUT_FORMAT

This parameter determines the output format to the output medium.


The identifiers can be concatenated, with the exception of the
following case:
SHORT together with LONG;
are not permitted.
Default: SHORT

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

SHORT SHORT FORMAT


If this option is selected, the common DLU
counters and the short format of CC counters
are recorded.
LONG LONG FORMAT
If this option is selected, the common DLU
counters and the long format of CC counters
are recorded.
TIMESLOT TIME SLOT COUNTER
If this option is selected, the common DLU
counters, the CC counters and the time slot
occupation counters are recorded.
SPEECHCH SPEECH CHANNEL COUNTER
If this option is selected, the common DLU
counters, the CC counters and the speech
channel counters are recorded.
This value is not allowed in a measurement
of all DLUs (DLU = X) .
ALLTRAFF ALL TRAFFIC DATA
If this option is selected, the common DLU
counters, the CC counters , the time slot
occupation- and the speech channel counters
are recorded.
PORT PORT DATA
Additional to the selected counters (default =
DLU) the DLU port data are collected.
In case of UNIT=OMT the port data will be
displayed at the beginning of the measurement.
In case of UNIT=MDD[-DAILY] the port data
will be written at the beginning of all files.

This information unit selects the output format.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DLU- 2+


REC DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

BEG BEGIN DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement begin date.


Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER
must be specified.
Exception: Time parameters cannot be specified for data
output in daily or cyclic files.
- A maximum of four BEG dates in chronological order may
be linked with &. In the case of linked BEG dates, TER
is not permitted.
If no TER is selected, the measurement is active on the
specified BEG days only.
- The earliest possible begin date BEG is the day after
command input.
- The first BEG date must be within an interval of one
month starting from the current date.
- The other BEG dates must be within an interval of
one year starting from the current date.
- The measurement on the actual BEG day can be stopped
with STOP JOB. If the measurement is stopped on the
last BEG day, it will be finished.
Default: the begin of measurement is the current date.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

TER TERMINATION DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement termination date.


Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER
must be specified.
Exception: Time parameters may not be specified for data
output in daily or cyclic files.
- Only one termination date may be entered.
The earliest possible termination date is the day after
command input.
- The measurement duration must not exceed one year.
- If no BEG parameter is entered, recording starts
immediately.
Default: the end of measurement is determined by the last
single day (BEG).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF TERMINATION DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

IV INTERVAL TIME

This parameter indicates interval times of the measurement.


Notes:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DLU- 3+


REC DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- Interval times IV are only permitted if at least one


begin date BEG is selected.
- A maximum of 4 measurement intervals in chronological
order may be linked with &. Linked intervals have to be
at least 30 minutes apart except for measurements over
midnight.
- An interval may not include midnight, e.g. IV =
23-00-01-00 is not permitted.
A measurement over midnight requires the input of two
interval times, e.g. IV = 00-00-01-00&23-00-00-00.
- The measurement is active during the specified interval
times only.
- The measurement can be stopped during the actual interval
IV with STOP JOB. If the measurement is stopped
during the last interval IV, it will be finished.
Default: 24-hour measurement on the specified days

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: BEGIN HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: BEGIN MINUTE=
0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

c: TERMINATION HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

d: TERMINATION MINUTE=
0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

PER PERIODIC WEEKDAY

This parameter specifies the weekdays on which data


have to be recorded.
Notes:
- Input of weekdays is only permissible in
connection with a termination date (TER).
- Up to 6 of the values may be linked with &, except
the values NO, WO and HO which cannot be
linked with other values.
Default: measurement every day during the measurement
period

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

NO NO SPECIFIED PERIOD
Measurement every day
MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY
Days which are full working days
HO HOLIDAY
Full national and international holidays are
included.
The full weekend day (the day marked EF
in the DISP WDCAT output mask) is included.
Half holidays are not included.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DLU- 4-


RED DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

REDUCE DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This command cancels existing PCM connections of a DLU.

Prerequisites:
- The specified DLU must exist.
- The specified PCM connections must exist
for this DLU.

Compatibilities:
- If a PCM link is to be removed from a DLU
which is not of the type DLUG, the corresponding
DLU controller must be PLA.
- If a CCS link is to be removed from a DLU of
the type DLUG, the corresponding
DLU controller must be PLA.
- If a CCS link is to be removed and there are any
modules created in the DLU, the corresponding
LTG must be PLA.
- If a PCM link is to be removed from a DLU of
the type DLUG, the corresponding LTUs must
be PLA.
- At least one CCS link must remain on this DLU!

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 RED DLU : DLU= <,DLUC0= ,DLUC1=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU must exist.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

DLUC0 DIGITAL LINE UNIT CONTROLLER 0

This parameter specifies the connection of


DLU controller 0 to LTUs in up to two LTGs.

Compatibilities:
- The specified PCM connection must exist
for this DLU.

At maximum 10 values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c[-d]

a: LTG SET=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTG set.

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTG number.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RED DLU- 1+


RED DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

c: LINE TRUNK UNIT NUMBER=


0...4, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the DIU to which


the DLU controller 0 is connected via
a PCM link.

d: DLUC PORT
CCS0 DLUC PORT FOR CCS 0
EXT0 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 0
EXT1 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 1
EXT2 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 2
EXT3 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 3
CCS1 DLUC PORT FOR CCS 1
EXT4 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 4
EXT5 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 5
EXT6 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 6
EXT7 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 7

This unit specifies the PCM port on the


DLU controller 0 to which the PCM is
connected.

DLUC1 DIGITAL LINE UNIT CONTROLLER 1

This parameter specifies the connection of


DLU controller 1 to LTUs in up to two LTGs.

Compatibilities:
- The specified PCM connection must exist
for this DLU.

At maximum 10 values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c[-d]

a: LTG SET=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTG set.

b: LTG NUMBER=
1...63, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the LTG number.

c: LINE TRUNK UNIT NUMBER=


0...4, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the DIU to which


the DLU controller 1 is connected via
a PCM link.

d: DLUC PORT
CCS0 DLUC PORT FOR CCS 0
EXT0 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 0
EXT1 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 1
EXT2 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 2
EXT3 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 3
CCS1 DLUC PORT FOR CCS 1
EXT4 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 4
EXT5 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 5
EXT6 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 6
EXT7 DLUC PORT FOR EXT 7

This unit specifies the PCM port on the


DLU controller 1 to which the PCM is
connected.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RED DLU- 2-


STAT DLU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

STATUS DISPLAY OF DLU SYSTEMS

This command displays the DLU system operating states of all DLUs, an
interval of DLUs or only one DLU.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT DLU : DLU= [,OST=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

OST OPERATING STATUS IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies an operating status for selective display.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
CBL CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED
DST DISTURBED
UNA UNAVAILABLE
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED
PLA PLANNED
FLT FAULTY

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT DLU- 1-


CAN DLUEQ

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL DIGITAL LINE UNIT EQUIPMENT

This command cancels DLU equipment.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU must exist.
- The DLU must be of the type DLUG.
- The specified DLU equipment must exist.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN DLUEQ : DLU= ,EQ= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU must exist.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

EQ EQUIPMENT

This parameter specifies the location of


the DLU equipment within the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b[-c]

a: LOCATION TYPE
EQG EQUIPMENT DLUG SLOT
MOD MODULE SLOT

This unit specifies the location type


of the DLU equipment.

b: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the shelf number.

c: EQUIPMENT NUMBER / MODULE NUMBER=


0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the DLU equipment


number respectively the DLU module number
associated with the DLU equipment.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DLUEQ- 1-


CONF DLUEQ

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE DLU EQUIPMENT

This command configures one or more DLU equipment to the desired


operating status.
DLUV equipment will be configured automatically together with
the DLU system. It cannot be configured by this MML command.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,DCC= 1 1
1 1,RGMG=1 1
1 CONF DLUEQ : DLU= Z,RGB= Y ,OST= ; 1
1 1,EQ= 1 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

DCC DIRECT CURRENT CONVERTER

This parameter specifies the mounting location of the direct


current converter.

The parameter DCC is valid for all DLU types except DLUG.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: DCC NUMBER=
0...3, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the DCC number within


a shelf.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

RGMG RING METER GENERATOR

This parameter specifies the ringing and metering generator.


The parameter RGMG may be entered for all DLU types except
DLUG.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF DLUEQ- 1+


CONF DLUEQ

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RGB RING GENERATOR SHELF B

This parameter specifies the ringing generator.


The parameter RGB may be entered for all DLU types except
DLUG.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

EQ EQUIPMENT

This parameter specifies the equipment of a DLUG.

Depending on the entered unit values, the following


equipment will be configured :

1. for EQG - <shelf> - <eqg_no> or


EQG - <shelf> - X or
EQG - <shelf>
the central DCC in a shelf of a DLUG

2. for EQG - X - X or
EQG - X
all central DCCs within a DLUG

3. for MOD - <shelf> - <mod>


one module located equipment

4. for MOD - <shelf> - X


all module located equipment within a shelf

5. for MOD - X - X
all module located equipment within a DLUG

6. for BD - <bd_no>
one bus distributor specified by its ID

7. for BD - X
all bus distributors within a DLUG

8. for X - X - X
all equipment within a DLUG.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b[-c]

a: EQUIPMENT ADDRESS TYPE


EQG CENTRAL DCC LOCATION
BD BUS DISTRIBUTOR
MOD MODULE LOCATED EQUIPMENT
X ALL EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the address type of the equipment.

b: EQUIPMENT UNIT 2=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

The meaning of equipment unit 2 depends on the selected


address type.

It specifies the shelf number for the address types EQG


and MOD respectively the ID of the bus distributor for
the address type BD.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

c: EQUIPMENT UNIT 3=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

The meaning of equipment unit 3 depends on the selected

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF DLUEQ- 2+


CONF DLUEQ

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

address type.

For the address type EQG the central equipment position


in a shelf of a DLUG is selected.
For the address type MOD the module position within a
shelf has to be entered.
For the address type BD the equipment unit 3 has to be
omitted.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

OST OPERATING STATUS

This parameter specifies the desired operating status.

Compatibilities for any equipment except BDs in the DLUG:


+-----------+--------------+
! ! New state !
! Old +----+----+----+
! state ! ACT! PLA! MBL!
+===========+====+====+====+
! MBL ! + ! + ! !
+-----------+----+----+----+
! PLA ! ! ! + !
+-----------+----+----+----+
! ACT ! ! ! + !
+-----------+----+----+----+

+: legal transition

Notes:
- DCC status transition from ACT to MBL in all DLU types except
DLUG are only allowed if the depending switching modules or the
supplied DLU system is in the status PLA.
- DCC status transitions in the DLUG can be executed independent
of the supplied DLU modules.

Compatibilities for BDs (bus distributors) in the DLUG:


+--------------------------+-------------------+
! ! ! New state !
! Old ! Access- +----+----+----+----+
! state ! Degrading ! CBL! ACT! PLA! MBL!
+==========================+====+====+====+====+
! MBL ! * ! + ! + ! + ! !
+--------------------------+----+----+----+----+
! PLA ! * ! ! ! ! + !
+--------------------------+----+----+----+----+
! CBL ! * ! ! + ! ! + !
+--------------------------+----+----+----+----+
! ACT ! accessible ! + ! ! ! !
! ACT ! not accessible ! + ! ! ! + !
+--------------------------+----+----+----+----+

+: legal transition
*: not relevant

During installation recovery there are no restrictions for state


transitions and the compatibility table is not relevant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
PLA PLANNED
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED
CBL CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF DLUEQ- 3-


CR DLUEQ

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE DIGITAL LINE UNIT EQUIPMENT

This command creates DLU equipment.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU must exist.
- The DLU must be of the type DLUG.
- The specified DLU equipment address
must be free.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR DLUEQ : DLU= ,TYPE= ,EQ= [,ALPROF=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU must exist.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

TYPE DLU EQUIPMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the DLU


equipment type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DCC4 DIRECT CURRENT CONVERTER 4


DCC8 DIRECT CURRENT CONVERTER 8
DCCPOOL DIRECT CURRENT CONVERTER POOL

EQ EQUIPMENT

This parameter specifies the location of


the DLU equipment within the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b[-c]

a: LOCATION TYPE
EQG EQUIPMENT DLUG SLOT
MOD MODULE SLOT

This unit specifies the location type


of the DLU equipment.

b: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the shelf number.

c: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the DLU module number


associated with the DLU equipment.
This unit may only be entered if the
location type is MOD.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLUEQ- 1+
CR DLUEQ

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ALPROF ALARM PROFILE

This parameter specifies the alarm profile.

Valid profiles are:


MAJESC major with escalation
MINESC minor with escalation
MAJNOESC major no escalation
MINNOESC minor no escalation
CRITICAL critical

If this parameter is omitted, the alarm


profile MAJNOESC will be used by default.

Prerequisites:
- The specified alarm profile must exist.

Compatibilities:
- This parameter may only be entered for a
DLU of the type DLUG.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLUEQ- 2-
DIAG DLUEQ

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSIS OF DLU-EQUIPMENT

This command starts the diagnosis of a digital line unit equipment.

Prerequisites:
- The equipment to be diagnosed must have been created.
- No other diagnosis may run on this DLU.
- The pre-switched units must be in the operating states ACT or
CBL.
- At least one equipment within the specified range must be in the
operating status MBL.
- No equipment within the specified range must be in the operating
status ACT or CBL.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,RGMG=1 1
1 DIAG DLUEQ : DLU= Z,RGB= Y ; 1
1 1,EQ= 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

RGMG RING METER GENERATOR

This parameter specifies the ringing and metering generator.


The parameter RGMG may be entered for all DLU types except
DLUG.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

RGB RING GENERATOR

This parameter specifies the ringing generator.


The parameter RGB may be entered for all DLU types except
DLUG.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

EQ EQUIPMENT

This parameter specifies the equipment of a DLUG.

Depending on the entered unit values, the following


equipment will be diagnosed :

1. for EQG - <shelf> - <eqg_no> or


EQG - <shelf> - X or
EQG - <shelf>
the central DCC in a shelf of a DLUG

2. for EQG - X - X or
EQG - X
all central DCCs within a DLUG

3. for MOD - <shelf> - <mod>

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG DLUEQ- 1+


DIAG DLUEQ

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

one module located equipment

4. for MOD - X - X
all module located equipment within a DLUG

5. for BD - <bd_no>
one bus distributor specified by its ID

6. for BD - X
all bus distributors within a DLUG

7. for X - X - X
all equipment within a DLUG.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b[-c]

a: EQUIPMENT ADDRESS TYPE


EQG CENTRAL DCC LOCATION
BD BUS DISTRIBUTOR
MOD MODULE LOCATED EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the address type of the equipment.

b: EQUIPMENT UNIT 2=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

The meaning of equipment unit 2 depends on the selected


address type.

It specifies the shelf number for the address types EQG


and MOD respectively the ID of the bus distributor for
the address type BD.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

c: EQUIPMENT UNIT 3=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

The meaning of equipment unit 3 depends on the selected


address type.

For the address type EQG the central equipment position


in a shelf of a DLUG is selected.
For the address type MOD the module position within a
shelf has to be entered.
For the address type BD the equipment unit 3 has to be
omitted.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG DLUEQ- 2-


DISP DLUEQ

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DIGITAL LINE UNIT EQUIPMENT

This command displays DLU equipment.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU must exist.
- The specified DLU equipment must
exist.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,TYPE=11 (;) 1
1 DISP DLUEQ : DLU= 1Z,EQ= Y1 Z Y 1
1 11 11 *!+ 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU must exist.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

TYPE DLU EQUIPMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the DLU


equipment type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

RGMG RINGING / METERING GENERATOR


DCC4 DIRECT CURRENT CONVERTER 4
DCC8 DIRECT CURRENT CONVERTER 8
DCCPOOL DIRECT CURRENT CONVERTER POOL
BD BUS DISTRIBUTOR

EQ EQUIPMENT

This parameter specifies the location of


the DLU equipment within the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: LOCATION TYPE
EQ EQUIPMENT (CLASSIC) SLOT
EQG EQUIPMENT DLUG SLOT
BD BUS DISTRIBUTOR
MOD MODULE SLOT
RGMG RINGING / METERING GENERATOR

This unit specifies the location type


of the DLU equipment.

b: SHELF / RGMG / BD NUMBER=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the shelf number,


the Ringing and Metering Generator number,
or the bus distributor number.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DLUEQ- 1+


DISP DLUEQ

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

c: EQUIPMENT NUMBER / MODULE NUMBER=


0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the DLU equipment


number respectively the DLU module number
associated with the DLU equipment.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DLUEQ- 2-


MOD DLUEQ

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY DIGITAL LINE UNIT EQUIPMENT

This command modifies DLU equipment.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU must exist.
- The DLU must be of the type DLUG.
- The specified DLU equipment must exist.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD DLUEQ : DLU= ,EQ= ,ALPROF= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU must exist.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

EQ EQUIPMENT

This parameter specifies the location of


the DLU equipment within the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b[-c]

a: LOCATION TYPE
EQG EQUIPMENT DLUG SLOT
BD BUS DISTRIBUTOR
MOD MODULE SLOT

This unit specifies the location type


of the DLU equipment.

b: SHELF NUMBER / BD NUMBER=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the shelf number


or the BD number.

c: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the DLU module number


associated with the DLU equipment.
This unit may only be entered if the
location type is MOD.

ALPROF ALARM PROFILE

This parameter specifies the alarm profile.

Valid profiles are:


MAJESC major with escalation
MINESC minor with escalation
MAJNOESC major no escalation
MINNOESC minor no escalation

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DLUEQ- 1+


MOD DLUEQ

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CRITICAL critical

Prerequisites:
- The specified alarm profile must exist.

Compatibilities:
- This parameter may only be entered for a
DLU of the type DLUG.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DLUEQ- 2-


STAT DLUEQ

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY OST OF DLU EQUIPMENT

This command displays the operating states of DLU equipment.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,DCC= 1 1
1 1,RGMG=1 1
1 STAT DLUEQ : DLU= Z,RGB= Y [,OST=] [,TYPE=] ; 1
1 1,EQ= 1 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

DCC DIRECT CURRENT CONV. LOCATION

This parameter specifies the mounting location of the


direct current converter.

The parameter DCC is valid for all DLU types except DLUG.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: DCC NUMBER=
0...3, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

RGMG RINGING/METERING GENER. NUMBER

This parameter specifies the ringing and metering generator.


The parameter RGMG may be entered for all DLU types except
DLUG.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

RGB RINGING GENERATOR SHELF B

This parameter specifies the ringing generator.


The parameter RGB may be entered for all DLU types except
DLUG.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...1, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT DLUEQ- 1+


STAT DLUEQ

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

EQ EQUIPMENT

This parameter specifies the equipment of a DLUG.

Depending on the entered unit values, the following


equipment will be displayed :

1. for EQG - <shelf> - <eqg_no> or


EQG - <shelf> - X or
EQG - <shelf>
the central DCC in a shelf of a DLUG

2. for EQG - X - X or
EQG - X
all central DCCs within a DLUG

3. for MOD - <shelf> - <mod>


one module located equipment

4. for MOD - <shelf> - X


all module located equipment within a shelf

5. for MOD - X - X
all module located equipment within a DLUG

6. for BD - <bd_no>
one bus distributor specified by its ID

7. for BD - X
all bus distributors within a DLUG

8. for X - X - X
all equipment within a DLUG.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b[-c]

a: EQUIPMENT ADDRESS TYPE


EQG CENTRAL DCC LOCATION
BD BUS DISTRIBUTOR
MOD MODULE LOCATED EQUIPMENT
X ALL EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the address type of the equipment.

b: EQUIPMENT UNIT 2=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

The meaning of equipment unit 2 depends on the selected


address type.

It specifies the shelf number for the address types EQG


and MOD respectively the ID of the bus distributor for
the address type BD.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

c: EQUIPMENT UNIT 3=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

The meaning of equipment unit 3 depends on the selected


address type.

For the address type EQG the central equipment position


in a shelf of a DLUG is selected.
For the address type MOD the module position within a
shelf has to be entered.
For the address type BD the equipment unit 3 has to be
omitted.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT DLUEQ- 2+


STAT DLUEQ

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

OST OPERATING STATUS IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies an operating status for selective display.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
DST DISTURBED
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED
PLA PLANNED
CBL CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED
FLT FAULTY

TYPE EQUIPMENT TYPE SELECTOR

This parameter specifies an equipment type for selective display.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

RGB RINGING GENERATOR TYPE B


RGMG RINGING/METERING GENERATOR
DCC4 CLASSIC DCC FOR 4 MODULES
DCC8 CLASSIC DCC FOR 8 MODULES
DCCPOOL POOL DCC
BD BUS DISTRIBUTOR

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT DLUEQ- 3-


TEST DLULC
MULTIPLE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TEST DLU LINE CIRCUIT

This command only tests analog subscriber line circuits


in the DLU.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command starts a job with breakpoints. After a breakpoint the job can be
continued with CONT JOB.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. TEST DLULC - MULTIPLE MULTIPLE SUBSCR. LINE CIRCUITS


2. TEST DLULC - SINGLE ONE SUBSCRIBER LINE CIRCUIT
3. TEST DLULC - UNCOND UNCONDTIONAL SLMI:FMA

1. Input format

MULTIPLE SUBSCR. LINE CIRCUITS

This command tests more than one DLU analog subscriber line circuit.
The circuits to be tested are specified by entering port-oriented
data.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 TEST DLULC : DLU= ,LC= [,TTYPE=] [,SCHED=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU number in an exchange.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...2553, range of decimal numbers

LC LINE CIRCUIT

This parameter specifies the position of one or more line


circuits in the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b[-c]

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit value corresponds to the shelf number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit value corresponds to the module number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

c: CIRCUIT NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

This unit value corresponds to the circuit number.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST DLULC- 1+


TEST DLULC
MULTIPLE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TTYPE TEST TYPE

This parameter specifies the program variant of testing analog


circuits in a DLU.

In the case of S1 the RINGING TEST for only the first port per
module is carried out.
In the case of S2 only the RINGING TEST is carried out.
In the case of S3 only if TU position 0-11-0 is specified,
TU Calibration will be executed.
In all other cases the COMPLETE CIRCUIT TEST is carried out
(as if optional parameter TTYPE had not been entered).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

S1 RINGING TST.FOR 1.CIRC.OF MOD.


S2 RINGING TST.FOR EACH SEL.CIRC.
S3 TU CALIBRATION
S4 TEST FUNCTION 4 (NORMAL TEST)
S5 TEST FUNCTION 5 (NORMAL TEST)
S6 TEST FUNCTION 6 (NORMAL TEST)
S7 TEST FUNCTION 7 (NORMAL TEST)
S8 TEST FUNCTION 8 (NORMAL TEST)
S9 TEST FUNCTION 9 (NORMAL TEST)

SCHED SCHEDULE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the schedule number which


determines the tasks.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...255, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST DLULC- 2+


TEST DLULC
SINGLE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

ONE SUBSCRIBER LINE CIRCUIT

This command tests a single DLU analog subscriber line circuit.


The circuits to be tested are specified by entering port-oriented
data.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,PERM=11 1
1 TEST DLULC : DLU= ,LC= [,TTYPE=] [,SCHED=] 1Z,STEP=Y1 ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU number in an exchange.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...2553, range of decimal numbers

LC LINE CIRCUIT

This parameter specifies the position of one or more line


circuits in the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b[-c]

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit value corresponds to the shelf number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit value corresponds to the module number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

c: CIRCUIT NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

This unit value corresponds to the circuit number.

TTYPE TEST TYPE

This parameter specifies the program variant of testing analog


circuits in a DLU.

In the case of S1 the RINGING TEST for only the first port per
module is carried out.
In the case of S2 only the RINGING TEST is carried out.
In the case of S3 only if TU position 0-11-0 is specified,
TU Calibration will be executed.
In all other cases the COMPLETE CIRCUIT TEST is carried out
(as if optional parameter TTYPE had not been entered).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST DLULC- 3+


TEST DLULC
SINGLE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

S1 RINGING TST.FOR 1.CIRC.OF MOD.


S2 RINGING TST.FOR EACH SEL.CIRC.
S3 TU CALIBRATION
S4 TEST FUNCTION 4 (NORMAL TEST)
S5 TEST FUNCTION 5 (NORMAL TEST)
S6 TEST FUNCTION 6 (NORMAL TEST)
S7 TEST FUNCTION 7 (NORMAL TEST)
S8 TEST FUNCTION 8 (NORMAL TEST)
S9 TEST FUNCTION 9 (NORMAL TEST)

SCHED SCHEDULE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the schedule number which


determines the tasks.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...255, range of decimal numbers

PERM PERMANENT TEST

This parameter specifies whether a permanent test job is to be


performed.
A permanent test is only allowed for a single line circuit.
The job runs continuously and can be stopped by the STOP JOB
command.

N DO NOT SET PERMANENT TEST


NO DO NOT SET PERMANENT TEST
Y SET PERMANENT TEST
YES SET PERMANENT TEST

STEP STEP NUMBER

This parameter specifies a breakpoint during a step test.


The test table of the test object indicates which
test steps represent a breakpoint (country-specific).
A step test is only allowed for a single test of one line circuit.
The test program runs until the defined test step and must
be continued with the command CONT JOB.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...998, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST DLULC- 4+


TEST DLULC
UNCOND
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

UNCONDTIONAL SLMI:FMA

This command tests a single DLU analog subscriber line circuit, type
SLMI:FMA, with the possibility to override the high bit rate busy
status.
The circuits to be tested are specified by entering port-oriented
data.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 TEST DLULC : DLU= ,LC= ,UNCOND= [,TTYPE=] [,PERM=] [,STEP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU number in an exchange.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...2553, range of decimal numbers

LC LINE CIRCUIT

This parameter specifies the position of one or more line


circuits in the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b[-c]

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit value corresponds to the shelf number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit value corresponds to the module number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

c: CIRCUIT NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

This unit value corresponds to the circuit number.

UNCOND UNCONDITIONAL TEST

This parameter specifies whether or not the high bit rate portion
of a subscriber is to be tested independently of the high bit rate
busy status. YES means that the high bit rate status busy is to be
overriden and the test performed. NO means that the test is to be
performed only if the high bit rate status is idle. By default the
value of this parameter is NO.

N NORMAL TESTING
NO NORMAL TESTING
Y TEST UNCONDITIONALLY
YES TEST UNCONDITIONALLY

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST DLULC- 5+


TEST DLULC
UNCOND
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TTYPE TEST TYPE

This parameter specifies the program variant of testing analog


circuits in a DLU.

In the case of S1 the RINGING TEST for only the first port per
module is carried out.
In the case of S2 only the RINGING TEST is carried out.
In the case of S3 only if TU position 0-11-0 is specified,
TU Calibration will be executed.
In all other cases the COMPLETE CIRCUIT TEST is carried out
(as if optional parameter TTYPE had not been entered).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

S1 RINGING TST.FOR 1.CIRC.OF MOD.


S2 RINGING TST.FOR EACH SEL.CIRC.
S3 TU CALIBRATION
S4 TEST FUNCTION 4 (NORMAL TEST)
S5 TEST FUNCTION 5 (NORMAL TEST)
S6 TEST FUNCTION 6 (NORMAL TEST)
S7 TEST FUNCTION 7 (NORMAL TEST)
S8 TEST FUNCTION 8 (NORMAL TEST)
S9 TEST FUNCTION 9 (NORMAL TEST)

PERM PERMANENT TEST

This parameter specifies whether a permanent test job is to be


performed.
A permanent test is only allowed for a single line circuit.
The job runs continuously and can be stopped by the STOP JOB
command.

N DO NOT SET PERMANENT TEST


NO DO NOT SET PERMANENT TEST
Y SET PERMANENT TEST
YES SET PERMANENT TEST

STEP STEP NUMBER

This parameter specifies a breakpoint during a step test.


The test table of the test object indicates which
test steps represent a breakpoint (country-specific).
A step test is only allowed for a single test of one line circuit.
The test program runs until the defined test step and must
be continued with the command CONT JOB.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...998, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST DLULC- 6-


CAN DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL DLU MODULE

This command cancels a DLU module.

Prerequisites:
- The module to be canceled must exist and must be PLA.
- The ports of the module must be PLA.
This prerequisite does not apply to modules of the
following types:
IWEA
IWEB
IWEC
IWED
IWEE
IWEF
SLMDVO16
SLMDVO8
- The module type must be administrable.
- The associated DLU ports must not be connected.
- No frame handler must be assigned to this DLU module.
- The DLU module MGB may only be canceled if no depending
DLU module exists in the DLU.
- The DLU module LTAM may only be canceled if the
inter-DLU bus it is connected to is not being used
by a test access for testing the DLU.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN DLUMOD : DLU= ,MOD= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

MOD MODULE

This parameter specifies the mounting


location of the DLU module.

Depending on the DLU type, several DLU module


positions cannot be administered, because they
are used by vital DLU hardware. These positions
are:

+----------+-----------------------------------------+
! DLU type ! Non-administerable DLU module positions !
+----------+-----------------------------------------+
! DLUA ! 0-8, 0-9, 0-10, 1-8, 1-9, 1-10 !
! DLUB ! 0-5, 0-6, 0-7, 0-8, 0-9, 0-10 !
! DLUD ! 0-7, 0-8 !
! DLUG ! 0-7, 1-7 !
! DLUK ! 0-7, 0-8 !
! DLUI ! 0-7, 0-8 !
! DLUO ! 0-8, 0-9, 0-10, 1-8, 1-9, 1-10 !
! DLUV ! 0-5, 0-6, 0-9, 0-10 !
! DLUX ! 0-7, 0-8 !
+----------+-----------------------------------------+

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DLUMOD- 1+


CAN DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the number of the DLU shelf.


For a DLU of the type DLUA values from 0
to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUB values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUD values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUG with
PORTGRID=16 values from 0 to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUG with
PORTGRID=32 values from 0 to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUI values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUK values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUO values from 0
to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUV values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUX values from 0
to 3 are valid.

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the module number in the DLU shelf.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DLUMOD- 2-


CONF DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE DLU MODULE

This command configures one or more DLU modules to the desired operating
status.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF DLUMOD : DLU= ,MOD= ,OST= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

MOD MODULE NAME

This parameter specifies the mounting location of the DLU module.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

OST OPERATING STATUS

This parameter specifies the desired operating status.

Compatibilities:
+-----------+-------------------+
! ! New state !
! Old +----+----+----+----+
! state ! CBL! ACT! PLA! MBL!
+===========+====+====+====+====+
! MBL ! + ! + ! + ! !
+-----------+----+----+----+----+
! PLA ! ! ! ! + !
+-----------+----+----+----+----+
! CBL ! ! + ! ! + !
+-----------+----+----+----+----+
! ACT ! + ! ! ! + !
+-----------+----+----+----+----+

+: legal transition

Notes:
- Status transitions to the status CBL are only allowed for
call-processing DLU modules.
- During installation recovery there are no restrictions for state
transitions and the compatibility table is not relevant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF DLUMOD- 1+


CONF DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACT ACTIVE
PLA PLANNED
CBL CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF DLUMOD- 2-


CR DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE DIGITAL LINE UNIT MODULE

This command creates a DLU module.

Prerequisites:
- The specified DLU must exist.
- The specified mounting location must be free and administrable.
- DLU type, module type and mounting location must be compatible.
- The module type and the LTG load type must be compatible.
- Memory space must be provided in the CP database.
(see MOD DBSIZE)

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR DLUMOD : DLU= ,MOD= ,TYPE= [,MEAS=] [,PACC=] [,PATHID=] 1
1 1
1 [,SLMXID=] [,IDLB=] [,PHUBMODE=] [,PARTNER=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,ALPROF=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

MOD MODULE

This parameter specifies the mounting location of


the DLU module.

It is possible to create more than 1 module by


specifying an interval. The interval must not
exceed the range of one shelf.

Compatibilities:
Depending on the DLU type, several DLU module
positions cannot be administered, because they
are used by vital DLU hardware. These positions
are:

+----------+-----------------------------------------+
! DLU type ! Non-administerable DLU module positions !
+----------+-----------------------------------------+
! DLUA ! 0-8, 0-9, 0-10, 1-8, 1-9, 1-10 !
! DLUB ! 0-5, 0-6, 0-7, 0-8, 0-9, 0-10 !
! DLUD ! 0-7, 0-8 !
! DLUG ! 0-7, 1-7 !
! DLUK ! 0-7, 0-8 !
! DLUI ! 0-7, 0-8 !
! DLUO ! 0-8, 0-9, 0-10, 1-8, 1-9, 1-10 !
! DLUV ! 0-5, 0-6, 0-9, 0-10 !
! DLUX ! 0-7, 0-8 !
+----------+-----------------------------------------+

The exact compatibilities of module type, mounting


location and shelf type are described in the
projecting handbook. The CP only checks the
compatibilities listed below.

DLU modules for a DLU of the type DLUA:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLUMOD- 1+
CR DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! module type ! valid mounting locations !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! ALEX ! 0-15 !
! ALMA ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! EMSP ! 0-14, 0-15, 1-11, 1-12 !
! FAM ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! FMTU ! 0-11 !
! FTEM ! 0-11 !
! IWEA ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! IWEB ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! IWEC ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! IWED ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! IWEE ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! IWEF ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! LCMM ! 0-12, 0-13 !
! LMEM ! 0-12, 0-13 !
! LTAM ! 1-14 !
! LVMM ! 0-12, 0-13 !
! MTAM ! 1-13 !
! NODLUMOD ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! OLMA ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! OLMAC ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SASC ! 0-2 !
! SLMA12R ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMABEL ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMAC12R ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMACCBR ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMACM16 ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMACMC ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMACMRL ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMACOS ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMACRMP ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMACSP ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMACSR ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMADID ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMADIOD ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMAFPA ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMAFPB ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMAFPC ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMAFPC8 ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMAFPS ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMAMC ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMAMCD ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMATPL ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMD ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMDA ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMDB ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMDVO8 ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMF ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMIAMA ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMIAMC ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMIFMA ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMIMSB ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMIPH1 ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMISDA ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMX ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! TBAM ! 1-15 !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+

DLU modules for a DLU of the type DLUB:

+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! module type ! valid mounting locations !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! ALEX ! 0-11 !
! EMSP ! 0-0, 0-13, 0-15 !
! FMTU ! 0-3, 0-4 !
! IWEA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! IWEB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! IWEC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! IWED ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! IWEE ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! IWEF ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! LCMM ! 0-3 !

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLUMOD- 2+
CR DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

! LTAM ! 0-13 !
! MGB ! 1-7 !
! MTAM ! 0-12 !
! NODLUMOD ! 0-0 .. 0-4, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SASC ! 0-1 !
! SLMA12R ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMABEL ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAC12R ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACCBR ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACM16 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACMRL ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACOS ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACRMP ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACSP ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACSR ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMADID ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMADIOD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPC8 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPE ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPS ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAMCD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMATPL ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDQFB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDTFB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDVO16 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDVO8 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAMA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAMB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAME ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMPB ! 0-0 .. 0-4, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMPC ! 0-0 .. 0-4, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMSA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMSB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMSC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIPH1 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMISDA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMISDB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMISDC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! SLMX ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-11 .. 3-15 !
! TBAM ! 0-14 !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+

Further compatibilities for a DLU of the type DLUB:


- The DLU modules SLMACMRL, SLMATPL, SLMAFPC and
SLMAFPC8 can only be created if the DLU module MGB
exists in the DLU.
- DLU modules of the types SLMAITF and SLMAITM must
be created as SLMAFPE.

DLU modules for a DLU of the type DLUD:

+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! module type ! valid mounting locations !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! ALEX ! 0-11, 3-15 !
! EMSP ! 0-0, 0-13, 0-15 !
! FMTU ! 0-3, 0-4 !
! IWEA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWEB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWEC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWED ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWEE ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLUMOD- 3+
CR DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

! IWEF ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !


! LCMM ! 0-3 !
! LTAM ! 0-13 !
! MGB ! 1-7 !
! MTAM ! 0-12 !
! NODLUMOD ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SASC ! 0-1 !
! SLMA12R ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMABEL ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAC12R ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACCBR ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACM16 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACMRL ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACOS ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACRMP ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACSP ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACSR ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMADID ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMADIOD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPC8 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPE ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPS ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAMCD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMATPL ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDQFB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDTFB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDVO16 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDVO8 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAMA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAMB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAME ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMPB ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMPC ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMSA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMSB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMSC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIPH1 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMISDA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMISDB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMISDC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMX ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! TBAM ! 0-14 !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+

Further compatibilities for a DLU of the type DLUD:


- The DLU modules SLMACMRL, SLMATPL, SLMAFPC and
SLMAFPC8 can only be created if the DLU module
MGB exists in the DLU.
- DLU modules of the types SLMAITF and SLMAITM must
be created as SLMAFPE.
- Only one DLU module ALEX may be created per DLU.

DLU modules for a DLU of the type DLUG:

+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! module type ! valid mounting locations !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! ALEX ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! FMTU ! 0-6 !
! LCMM ! 0-5 !
! LTAM ! 0-4 !
! MTAM ! 0-2 !

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLUMOD- 4+
CR DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

! NODLUMOD ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !


! SASCG ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 1-15 !
! SLMAITFG ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAITHG ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAITMG ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDQFB ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! SLMDQFC ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! SLMDTFB ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! SLMDTFC ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! SLMDVO16 ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! SLMDVO8 ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! SLMIAMB ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! SLMIAME ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! SLMIFMC ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! SLMIMPB ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! SLMIMPC ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! SLMIMSA ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! SLMIMSC ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! SLMIMSD ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! SLMIPH1 ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! SLMISDB ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! SLMISDC ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-8 .. 1-6, 1-8 .. 7-15 !
! TBAM ! 0-3 !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+

Further compatibilities for a DLU of the type DLUG:


- Only one DLU module ALEX may be created per DLU.
- If the DLU was created with PORTGRID=32, only
the shelves 0 to 3 are available.

DLU modules for a DLU of the type DLUI:

+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! module type ! valid mounting locations !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! ALEX ! 0-11, 3-15 !
! EMSP ! 0-0, 0-13, 0-15 !
! FMTU ! 0-3, 0-4 !
! IWEA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWEB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWEC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWED ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWEE ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWEF ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! LCMM ! 0-3 !
! LTAM ! 0-13 !
! MGB ! 1-7 !
! MTAM ! 0-12 !
! NODLUMOD ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SASC ! 0-1 !
! SLMA12R ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMABEL ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAC12R ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACCBR ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACM16 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACMRL ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACOS ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACRMP ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACSP ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACSR ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMADID ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMADIOD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPC8 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPE ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPS ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAMCD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMATPL ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDQFB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLUMOD- 5+
CR DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

! SLMDTFB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !


! SLMDVO16 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDVO8 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAMA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAMB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAME ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMPB ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMPC ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMSA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMSB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMSC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIPH1 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMISDA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMISDB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMISDC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMX ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! TBAM ! 0-14 !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+

Further compatibilities for a DLU of the type DLUI:


- The DLU modules SLMACMRL, SLMATPL, SLMAFPC and
SLMAFPC8 can only be created if the DLU module
MGB exists in the DLU.
- DLU modules of the types SLMAITF and SLMAITM must
be created as SLMAFPE.
- Only one DLU module ALEX may be created per DLU.

DLU modules for a DLU of the type DLUK:

+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! module type ! valid mounting locations !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! ALEX ! 0-11, 3-15 !
! EMSP ! 0-0, 0-13, 0-15 !
! FMTU ! 0-3, 0-4 !
! IWEA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWEB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWEC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWED ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWEE ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWEF ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! LCMM ! 0-3 !
! LTAM ! 0-13 !
! MGB ! 1-7 !
! MTAM ! 0-12 !
! NODLUMOD ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SASC ! 0-1 !
! SLMA12R ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMABEL ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAC12R ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACCBR ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACM16 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACMRL ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACOS ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACRMP ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACSP ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACSR ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMADID ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMADIOD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPC8 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPE ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPS ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAMCD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMATPL ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLUMOD- 6+
CR DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

! SLMDA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !


! SLMDB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDQFB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDTFB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDVO16 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDVO8 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAMA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAMB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAME ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMPB ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMPC ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMSA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMSB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMSC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIPH1 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMISDA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMISDB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMISDC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMX ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! TBAM ! 0-14 !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+

Further compatibilities for a DLU of the type DLUK:


- The DLU modules SLMACMRL, SLMATPL, SLMAFPC and
SLMAFPC8 can only be created if the DLU module
MGB exists in the DLU.
- DLU modules of the types SLMAITF and SLMAITM must
be created as SLMAFPE.
- Only one DLU module ALEX may be created per DLU.

DLU modules for a DLU of the type DLUO:

+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! module type ! valid mounting locations !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! ALMA ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! FMTU ! 0-11 !
! LCMM ! 0-12, 0-13 !
! LTAM ! 1-14 !
! MTAM ! 1-13 !
! OLMA ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! OLMAC ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMA12R ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMABEL ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMAC12R ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMACCBR ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMACM16 ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMACMC ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMACMRL ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMACOS ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMACRMP ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMACSP ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMACSR ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMADID ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMADIOD ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMAFPA ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMAFPB ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMAFPC ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMAFPC8 ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMAFPS ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMAMC ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMAMCD ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMATPL ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMDA ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! SLMDB ! 0-0 .. 0-7, 0-11 .. 1-7, 1-11 .. 7-15 !
! TBAM ! 1-15 !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLUMOD- 7+
CR DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DLU modules for a DLU of the type DLUV:

+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! module type ! valid mounting locations !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! ALEX ! 0-11 !
! SLMX ! 1-0 .. 1-4 !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+

DLU modules for a DLU of the type DLUX:

+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! module type ! valid mounting locations !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+
! ALEX ! 0-11, 3-15 !
! EMSP ! 0-0, 0-13, 0-15 !
! FMTU ! 0-3, 0-4 !
! IWEA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWEB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWEC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWED ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWEE ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! IWEF ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! LCMM ! 0-3 !
! LTAM ! 0-13 !
! MGB ! 1-7 !
! MTAM ! 0-12 !
! NODLUMOD ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SASC ! 0-1 !
! SLMA12R ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMABEL ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAC12R ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACCBR ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACM16 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACMRL ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACOS ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACRMP ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACSP ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMACSR ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMADID ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMADIOD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPC8 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPE ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAFPS ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMAMCD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMATPL ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDQFB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDTFB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDVO16 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMDVO8 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAMA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAMB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIAME ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIFMD ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMPB ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMPC ! 0-0 .. 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMSA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMSB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIMSC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMIPH1 ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMISDA ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMISDB ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !
! SLMISDC ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLUMOD- 8+
CR DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

! SLMX ! 0-0 .. 0-3, 0-5, 0-6, 0-9 .. 3-15 !


! TBAM ! 0-14 !
+-------------+---------------------------------------+

Further compatibilities for a DLU of the type DLUX:


- The DLU modules SLMACMRL, SLMATPL, SLMAFPC and
SLMAFPC8 can only be created if the DLU module
MGB exists in the DLU.
- DLU modules of the types SLMAITF and SLMAITM must
be created as SLMAFPE.
- Only one DLU module ALEX may be created per DLU.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the number of the DLU shelf.


For a DLU of the type DLUA values from 0
to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUB values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUD values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUG with
PORTGRID=16 values from 0 to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUG with
PORTGRID=32 values from 0 to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUI values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUK values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUO values from 0
to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUV values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUX values from 0
to 3 are valid.

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the module number in the DLU shelf.

TYPE DIGITAL LINE UNIT MODULE TYPE

This parameter specifies the DLU module type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SLMACOS SLMA DLU ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER


SLMACM16 SLMA DLU METER PULSE 16 KHZ
SLMACCBR SLMA DLU COINBOX REVERSAL
SLMACRMP SLMA DLU METER PULSE 16 REVERS
SLMD SLM DIGITAL (4 CIRCUITS)
LMEM LINE MEASURING MODULE
LVMM LEVEL MEASURING MODULE
FTEM FUNCTION TEST MODULE
ALEX ALARM EXTERN
EMSP EMERGENCY SERVICE PUSHBUTTON
SLMAC12R SLMA DLU 12 KHZ REVERSAL
SLMACMC SLMA DLU 12 KHZ C-WIRE
SLMATPL SLMA DLU TWO PARTY LINE
SLMADID SLMA DLU DIRECT INWARD DIALING
SLMACMRL SLMA DLU 16 KHZ REVERSAL
SLMF SLM FOR OPTICAL FIBRE
FAM FIBRE ACCESS MODULE
MTAM METALLIC TEST ACCESS MODULE
TBAM TEST BUS ACCESS MODULE
LTAM LOOP TEST ACCESS MODULE
SLMAFPA SLMA DLU FEATURE PROGRAMMAB. A
SLMADIOD SLMA DLU IN/OUTWARD DIALING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLUMOD- 9+
CR DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SLMAFPB SLMA DLU FEATURE PROGRAMMAB. B


SLMACSR SLMA CONC SILENT REVERSAL
SLMDA SLM DIGITAL A (8 CIRCUITS)
SLMABEL SLMA DLU BALANCED EXTENDED
SLMA12R SLMA METER PULSE 12 KHZ REVERS
SLMDB SLM DIGITAL B (8 CIRCUITS)
SLMAMCD SLMA DLU THIRD GENERATION SLIC
SLMAFPC SLMA DLU FEATURE PROGRAMMAB. C
FMTU FUNCTION TEST MODULE FOR TU
LCMM LINE AND CIRCUIT MEASURING MOD
SASC STAND ALONE SERVICE CONTROLLER
SLMAFPS SLMA DLU FEATURE PROGRAMMAB. S
IWEA INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT A
IWEB INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT B
SLMACSP SLMA DLU COINBOX SEMIPUBLICO
ALMA ANNOUNCEMENT LINE MOD ANALOG
OLMA OPERATOR LINE MODULE ANALOG
OLMAC OPERATOR LINE MODULE ANALOG C
SLMAMC SLMA METER PULSE C-WIRE
SLMAFPC8 SLMA DLU FEATURE PROG. C 8
SLMIAMA SLM INTERNET ADSL MODEM TYPE A
SLMX SUBSCRIBER LINE MULTIPLEXER
SLMIPH1 SLM INTERNET PACKET HUB TYPE 1
IWEC INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT C
IWED INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT D
IWEE INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT E
IWEF INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT F
SLMIFMA SLM INTERNET FLEX. MODEM A
SLMAFPE SLMA DLU FEATURE PROG. E
DLU modules of the types SLMAITF and
SLMAITM must be created as SLMAFPE.
MGB METERING GENERATOR DLUB
SLMDVO8 SLMD FOR VIRTUAL OPERATOR
SLMISDA SLM INTERNET SYMM. DIGITAL A
SLMIMSB SLMI MULTIPLE SERVICE TYPE B
SLMIAMC SLM INTERNET ADSL MODEM TYPE C
SLMIMSA SLMI MULTIPLE SERVICE TYPE A
SLMDQFB SLM DIGITAL QFB (16 CIRCUITS)
SLMDTFB SLM DIGITAL TFB (16 CIRCUITS)
NODLUMOD NON DLU MODULE
This DLU module type marks a DLU module slot
used by a DLU integrated external hardware.
SLMDVO16 SLMD FOR VIRTUAL OPERATOR
SLMIMPB SLM INTERNET MODEM POOL CARD B
SLMAITFG SLMA INTEGR. TEST FUNC. G
SLMAITMG SLMA INTEGR. METAL. TEST G
SLMISDB SLM INTERNET SYMM. DIGITAL B
SASCG STAND-ALONE SERV. CONTR. G
SLMISDC SLM INTERNET SYMM. DIGITAL C
SLMIAMB SLM INTERNET ADSL MODEM TYPE B
SLMIAME SLM INTERNET ADSL MODEM TYPE E
SLMIFMB SLM INTERNET FLEX. MODEM B
SLMIFMC SLM INTERNET FLEX. MODEM C
SLMIFMD SLM INTERNET FLEX. MODEM D
SLMDQFC SLM DIGITAL QFC
SLMDTFC SLM DIGITAL TFC
SLMIMPC SLM INTERNET MODEM POOL CARD C
SLMAITHG SLMA INTEGR. TEST HIGH CURR. G
SLMIMSC SLMI MULTIPLE SERVICE TYPE C
SLMIMSD SLMI MULTIPLE SERVICE TYPE D

MEAS MEASUREMENT INDEX

This parameter specifies the test data record index for a DLU
module.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

PACC ACCESS TO PACKET SWITCHING MOD

This parameter specifies the packet access authorization.

Prerequisites:
To assign the packet access authorization, one of
the following packet data connections from the

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLUMOD- 10+


CR DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DLU to the packet handler must exist for the


specified DLU:

Compatibilities:
- Packet access authorization may only be assigned to
DLU modules of the following types:
SLMD
SLMDA
SLMDB
SLMF
SLMX
SLMDQFB
SLMDQFC
SLMDTFB
SLMDTFC
SLMDVO16
SLMDVO8
SLMIAMC
SLMIAME
SLMISDA
SLMISDB
SLMISDC

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO PACKET ACCESS
YES PACKET ACCESS

PATHID PACKET DATA PATH ID

This parameter specifies the packet data path ID


for a DLU module.

Compatibilities:
- This parameter is only allowed for DLU modules
in a DLU of the type DLUG.
- This parameter is only allowed if the DLU
module has packet access authorization.
- A nailed-up connection with the specified
PATHID must exist for the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

SLMXID SLMX IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the SLMX identifier.

Compatibilities:
This parameter may only be entered for DLU modules of the type
SLMX. Its value has to be unique within the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

IDLB INTER-DLU BUS

This parameter specifies the inter-DLU bus.

Compatibilities:
This parameter may only be entered if the
DLU module is of the type LTAM and if
the country code has been set to BEL
via the command ENTR EXDDAT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...1023, range of decimal numbers

PHUBMODE PACKET HUB MODE

This parameter specifies the packet hub mode.

Compatibilities:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLUMOD- 11+


CR DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter may only be entered for DLU


modules of the type SLMIPH1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SUPERIOR SUPERIOR
SUPERRED SUPERIOR REDUNDANT
INFERIOR INFERIOR

PARTNER PACKET HUB PARTNER

This parameter specifies the packet hub partner.

Compatibilities:
This parameter may only be entered for DLU
modules of the type SLMIPH1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: PACKET HUB PARTNER SHELF=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

b: PACKET HUB PARTNER MODULE=


0...15, range of decimal numbers

ALPROF ALARM PROFILE

This parameter specifies the alarm profile


of the DLU module.

Valid profiles are:


MAJESC major with escalation
MINESC minor with escalation
MAJNOESC major no escalation
MINNOESC minor no escalation
CRITICAL critical

Prerequisites:
- The specified alarm profile must exist.

Compatibilities:
- This parameter may only be entered for a
DLU module in a DLU of the type DLUG.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DLUMOD- 12-


DIAG DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSIS OF DLU-MODULES

This command starts the diagnosis of DLU modules.

Prerequisites:
- The DLU module(s) to be diagnosed must have been created.
- No other diagnosis may run on this DLU.
- The pre-switched units must be in the operating states ACT or
CBL.
- At least one DLU module within the specified range must be in the
operating status MBL.
- No DLU module within the specified range must be in the operating
status ACT or CBL.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG DLUMOD : DLU= ,MOD= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

MOD MODULE NAME

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG DLUMOD- 1-


DISP DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DLU MODULE

This command displays the data of DLU modules.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,MOD= 11 1
1 DISP DLUMOD : DLU= 1Z,SLMXID=Y1 ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

MOD MODULE

This parameter specifies the mounting location


of the DLU module.

Prerequisites:
It may only be specified if no parameter
interval is entered for the parameter DLU.

Compatibilities:
Depending on the DLU type, several DLU module
positions cannot be administered, because they
are used by vital DLU hardware. These positions
are:

+----------+-----------------------------------------+
! DLU type ! Non-administerable DLU module positions !
+----------+-----------------------------------------+
! DLUA ! 0-8, 0-9, 0-10, 1-8, 1-9, 1-10 !
! DLUB ! 0-5, 0-6, 0-7, 0-8, 0-9, 0-10 !
! DLUD ! 0-7, 0-8 !
! DLUG ! 0-7, 1-7 !
! DLUK ! 0-7, 0-8 !
! DLUI ! 0-7, 0-8 !
! DLUO ! 0-8, 0-9, 0-10, 1-8, 1-9, 1-10 !
! DLUV ! 0-5, 0-6, 0-9, 0-10 !
! DLUX ! 0-7, 0-8 !
+----------+-----------------------------------------+

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the number of the DLU shelf.

For a DLU of the type DLUA values from 0


to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUB values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUD values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUG with
PORTGRID=16 values from 0 to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUG with

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DLUMOD- 1+


DISP DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PORTGRID=32 values from 0 to 3 are valid.


For a DLU of the type DLUI values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUK values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUO values from 0
to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUV values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUX values from 0
to 3 are valid.

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the module number


in the DLU shelf.

SLMXID SLMX IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the SLMX identifier.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DLUMOD- 2-


MOD DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY DIGITAL LINE UNIT MODULE

This command modifies the data of a DLU module.

Prerequisites:
- The specified DLU must exist.
- The DLU module to be modified must exist.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD DLUMOD : DLU= ,MOD= <,MEAS= ,PACC= ,IDLB= ,PATHID= 1
1 1
1 ,ALPROF=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

MOD MODULE

This parameter specifies the mounting location of the DLU module.

Depending on the DLU type, several DLU module


positions cannot be administered, because they
are used by vital DLU hardware. These positions
are:

+----------+-----------------------------------------+
! DLU type ! Non-administerable DLU module positions !
+----------+-----------------------------------------+
! DLUA ! 0-8, 0-9, 0-10, 1-8, 1-9, 1-10 !
! DLUB ! 0-5, 0-6, 0-7, 0-8, 0-9, 0-10 !
! DLUD ! 0-7, 0-8 !
! DLUG ! 0-7, 1-7 !
! DLUK ! 0-7, 0-8 !
! DLUI ! 0-7, 0-8 !
! DLUO ! 0-8, 0-9, 0-10, 1-8, 1-9, 1-10 !
! DLUV ! 0-5, 0-6, 0-9, 0-10 !
! DLUX ! 0-7, 0-8 !
+----------+-----------------------------------------+

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the number of the DLU shelf.

For a DLU of the type DLUA values from 0


to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUB values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUD values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUG with
PORTGRID=16 values from 0 to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUG with
PORTGRID=32 values from 0 to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUI values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUK values from 0
to 3 are valid.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DLUMOD- 1+


MOD DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

For a DLU of the type DLUO values from 0


to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUV values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUX values from 0
to 3 are valid.

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the module number in


the DLU shelf.

MEAS MEASUREMENT INDEX

This parameter specifies the test data record


index for a DLU module.

Incompatibilities:
- This parameter is not allowed for DLU modules
in a DLU of the type DLUV.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

PACC PACKET ACCESS AUTHORIZATION

This parameter specifies the packet access authorization.

Prerequisites:
To assign the packet access authorization, one of
the following packet data connections from the
DLU to the packet handler must exist for the
specified DLU:

Compatibilities:
- Packet access authorization may only be assigned to
DLU modules of the following types:
SLMD
SLMDA
SLMDB
SLMF
SLMX
SLMDQFB
SLMDQFC
SLMDTFB
SLMDTFC
SLMDVO16
SLMDVO8
SLMIAMC
SLMIAME
SLMISDA
SLMISDB
SLMISDC

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO PACKET ACCESS
YES PACKET ACCESS

IDLB INTER-DLU BUS

This parameter specifies the inter-DLU bus.

Compatibilities:
This parameter may only be entered if the
DLU module is of the type LTAM and if
the country code has been set to BEL
via the command ENTR EXDDAT.

n/o
n/
/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DLUMOD- 2+


MOD DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...1023, range of decimal numbers

If no value for new a is entered


the connection of the DLU to the
inter-DLU bus will be canceled. This
connection may only be canceled if
the inter-DLU bus is not being used by
a test access for testing the DLU.

PATHID PACKET DATA PATH ID

This parameter specifies the packet data path ID


for a DLU module.

Compatibilities:
- This parameter is only allowed for DLU modules
in a DLU of the type DLUG.
- This parameter is only allowed if the DLU
module has packet access authorization.
- A nailed-up connection with the specified
PATHID must exist for the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

ALPROF ALARM PROFILE

This parameter specifies the alarm profile


of the DLU module.

Valid profiles are:


MAJESC major with escalation
MINESC minor with escalation
MAJNOESC major no escalation
MINNOESC minor no escalation
CRITICAL critical

Prerequisites:
- The specified alarm profile must exist.

Compatibilities:
- This parameter may only be entered for a
DLU module in a DLU of the type DLUG.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DLUMOD- 3-


STAT DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

STATUS DISPLAY OF DLU MODULES

This command displays the operating states (with access


degradations), the states of packet data accesses and INTERNET
failures of all modules, an interval of modules or one module for
the specified DLU.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT DLUMOD : DLU= ,MOD= [,OST=] [,PACC=] [,INTERNET=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the digital line unit.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

MOD MODULE LOCATION

This parameter specifies the module location.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

OST OPERATING STATUS IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies an operating status for selective display.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
CBL CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED
DST DISTURBED
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED
PLA PLANNED
BLK BLOCKED
NCP NO CALL-PROCESSING

PACC PACKET DATA ACCESS STATE

This optional parameter specifies one packet access state for the
selective display.
Default: no effect on display

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO P-DATA ACC. AUTHORISATION


YES P-DATA ACCESS AUTHORISATION
AVAIL PACKET DATA ACCESS AVAILABLE
NAC PACKET DATA NOT ACCESSIBLE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT DLUMOD- 1+


STAT DLUMOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PCHAN P-CHANNEL FAILURE


CDBUS CD-BUS FAILURE

INTERNET INTERNET FAILURES

This parameter allows the selective display of DLU modules


with a specific INTERNET failure state.
Default: no effect on display

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALL ALL INTERNET MODULES


NOFAIL INTERNET MOD. WITHOUT FAILURE
INTFAIL INTERNET MOD. WITH INT. FAIL.
EXTFAIL INTERNET MOD. WITH EXT. FAIL.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT DLUMOD- 2-


DISP DLUPD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY TRANSIENT DLU PATH DATA

This command displays transient DLU path data.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP DLUPD : EQN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER

This parameter defines the equipment number.

Notes:
- Only the following port qualifications are allowed:

LTG: EQN = a-b

DLU: EQN = a

The input of an V5IF number will be rejected with an operator hint.

- If EQN is given for an LTG path data will be dispayed of this LTGB
which can be connected to 1, 2 or 4 DLUs.

- If EQN is given for a DLU path data will be dispayed of this DLU
which can be connected to 1 or 2 LTGBs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: TSG / DLU OR V5IF NUMBER=


0...8999, range of decimal numbers

For LTG : a TSG number in the range 0...7


For DLU : a DLU number in the range 10...2550
(in steps of 10)
For V5IF : a V5IF number in the range 6000...8999

Input of V5 interface will be rejected with an operator hint.

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP / SHELF NUMBER=


0...63, range of decimal numbers

For LTG : an LTG number in the range 1...63


For DLU : not allowed
For V5IF : not allowed

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DLUPD- 1-


CONF DLUPORT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE DLU PORTS

This command initiates the operating status transition of one or more


DLU ports.

Note:
The current operating status of DLU ports can be displayed by the
MML command STAT DLUPORT.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF DLUPORT : DLU= ,LC= ,OST= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

LC LINE CIRCUIT

This parameter specifies the line circuit.

Notes:

- X can be specified only for the CIRCUIT unit, simultaneously for


the MODULE and CIRCUIT unit or simultaneously for all 3 units.

- For a DLU with type DLUB (compact DLU) or DLUD only the input
of SHELF values 0..3 is allowed.

- For a DLU with type DLUA only the input of PORT values 0..7 is
allowed.

(The current DLU type can be displayed using the MML command
DISP DLU.)

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b-c

a: SHELF=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: MODULE=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

c: CIRCUIT=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF DLUPORT- 1+


CONF DLUPORT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

OST OPERATING STATUS

This parameter specifies the new operating state.

Compatibilities:
+-----------+--------------+
! ! New state !
! Old +----+----+----+
! state ! PLA! MBL! ACT!
+===========+====+====+====+
! PLA ! ! + ! !
+-----------+----+----+----+
! MBL ! + ! ! + !
+-----------+----+----+----+
! ACT ! ! + ! !
+-----------+----+----+----+

+: legal transition

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
PLA PLANNED
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF DLUPORT- 2-


DISP DLUPORT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DIGITAL LINE UNIT PORT

This command displays the port data for a specified range.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP DLUPORT : EQN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the equipment number of a port on the


DLU. Depending on the parameter entered, the following ranges are
displayed:

1. for <dluno> - <shelfno> - <modulno> - <circno>


- precisely the DLU port specified
2. for <dluno> - <shelfno> - <modulno> [ - X ]
- all DLU ports of the specified module
3. for <dluno> - <shelfno> - X [ - X ]
- the DLU ports of all DLU modules of the specified shelf
4. for <dluno> - X - X [ - X ]
- the DLU ports of all DLU modules in all shelves of the
specified DLU
5. for X - X - X [ - X ]
- the DLU ports of all created DLUs

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c[-d]

a: DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER=


10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the DLU number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the number of the DLU shelf.

For a DLU of the type DLUA values from 0


to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUB values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUD values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUG with
PORTGRID=16 values from 0 to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUG with
PORTGRID=32 values from 0 to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUI values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUK values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUO values from 0
to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUV values from 0
to 3 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUX values from 0
to 3 are valid.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DLUPORT- 1+


DISP DLUPORT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

c: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the module number


in the DLU shelf.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

d: CIRCUIT NUMBER=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the circuit number.

For a DLU of the type DLUA values from 0


to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUB values from 0
to 15 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUD values from 0
to 15 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUG with
PORTGRID=16 values from 0 to 15 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUG with
PORTGRID=32 values from 0 to 31 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUI values from 0
to 15 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUK values from 0
to 15 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUO values from 0
to 7 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUV values from 0
to 15 are valid.
For a DLU of the type DLUX values from 0
to 15 are valid.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DLUPORT- 2-


SEL DLUPORT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SELECTIVE DISPLAY OF DLU PORT

This command displays the port data of one, several or all DLUs.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 SEL DLUPORT : DLU= ,LCTYPE= [,TYPE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

LCTYPE LINE CIRCUIT TYPE

This parameter specifies the line circuit type of a DLU port.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SLCACOS SLCA DLU ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER


SLCACM16 SLCA DLU METER PULSE 16 KHZ
SLCACRMP SLCA DLU METER PULSE 16 REVERS
SLCACCBR SLCA DLU COINBOX REVERSAL
SLCAC12R SLCA DLU 12 KHZ SILENT REVERSA
SLCACMRL SLCA DLU 16 KHZ REVERSAL
SLCACMC SLCA DLU 12 KHZ C-WIRE
SLCF SLC FOR OPTICAL FIBRE
SLCD SUBSCRIBER LINE CIRCUIT DIGITA
FTEC DLU FUNCTION TEST CIRCUIT
LMEC DLU LINE MEASURING CIRCUIT
LVMC DLU LEVEL MEASURING CIRUIT
EMSP DLU EMERGENCY SERVICE EQUIPMEN
SLCADID SLCA DLU PBX LINE DID
SLCATPL SLCA DLU TWO PARTY LINE
UNUSEPRT UNUSED PORT
MTAC DLU METALLIC TEST ACCESS CIRCU
TBAC DLU TEST BUS ACCESS CIRCUIT
LTAC DLU LOOP TEST ACCESS CIRCUIT
SLCAFPA SLCA DLU FEATURE PROGRAMMAB. A
SLCADIOD SLCA DLU DIRECT IN/OUT DIALING
SLCAFPB SLCA DLU FEATURE PROGRAMMAB. B
SLCACSR SLCA DLU SILENT REVERSAL
SLCAMCD SLCA DLU THIRD GENERATION SLIC
SLCAFPC SLCA DLU FEATURE PROGRAMMAB. C
SASCL STAND ALONE SERV CONTR LINK
SLCABEL SLCA DLU BALANCED EXTENDED
SLCAMC SLCA DLU 12KHZ C WIRE
SLCAFPS SLCA DLU FEATURE PROGRAMMAB. S
ALCA ANNOUNCEMENT LC ANALOG
FCTU DLU FUNCTION TEST CIRCUIT TU
LCMC DLU LINE AND CIRCUIT MEASURING
OLCAC OPERATOR LINE CIRCUIT ANALOG C
OLCA OPERATOR LINE CIRCUIT ANALOG
SLCACCSP SLCA DLU COINBOX SEMIPUBLICO
SLCAFPE SLCA DLU FEATURE PROGRAMMAB. E
SLCX SLCX V51IF PORT
COTPRT CENTRAL OFFICE TERMINAL PORT
SLCDVO SLCD VIRTUAL OPERATOR
SLCSL SLC SDSL LOW
SLCSH SLC SDSL HIGH
SLCADSL SLC ADSL
SLCFMA SLC FLEXIBLE MODEM A

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SEL DLUPORT- 1+


SEL DLUPORT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TYPE TABLE TYPE

This parameter specifies the table type for a port.

Default value:
If no entry is made for this parameter, no table type is selected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FREE NOT CONNECTED


SUB SUBSCRIBER
ISUB ISDN SUBSCRIBER
PBXLN PBX LINE
IPBXBA ISDN PBX BASIC ACCESS
KEY MULTILINE HUNTING GROUP W. KEY
TEQ TEST EQUIPMENT
TRUNK TRUNK
CONSOLE CONSOLE
V5IF V5 INTERFACE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SEL DLUPORT- 2-


STAT DLUPORT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY STATUS OF DLU PORTS

This command is used to display the operating status of DLU ports.


A specific operating status can be entered to search for DLU ports
with given status.

Note:
The current operating status of DLU ports can be modified using
the MML command CONF DLUPORT.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT DLUPORT : DLU= ,LC= [,OST=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the DLU number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

LC LINE CIRCUIT

This parameter specifies the line circuit.

Notes:

- X can be specified only for the CIRCUIT unit, simultaneously for


the MODULE and CIRCUIT unit or simultaneously for all 3 units.

- For a DLU with type DLUB (compact DLU) or DLUD only the input
of SHELF values 0..3 is allowed.

- For a DLU with type DLUA only the input of PORT values 0..7 is
allowed.

(The current DLU type can be displayed using the MML command
DISP DLU.)

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b-c

a: SHELF=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: MODULE=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

c: CIRCUIT=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT DLUPORT- 1+


STAT DLUPORT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

OST OPERATING STATUS

This optional parameter specifies the operating state of the DLU


ports to be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
PLA PLANNED
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED
DST DISTURBED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT DLUPORT- 2-


ACT DMPSGMSG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACT DUMP OF SAFEGUARDING MESSAGES

This command activates the dump of safeguarding messages.

Prerequisites:
- The dump may not previously be active.
- Activation of the dump causes following dump initiations to be processed
but not at the same time as the activation.
- External activations must be specified with the command DMP SGMSG.
This cancels the suppression of internal initiations (internal = from the
distribution process to the dump process, as soon as 200 messages have been
collected since the initiation last processed).
- If no external initiation is specified, there is automatically an internal
initiation after 200 messages have been collected by the distribution
process. This internal initiation initiates the dump of all previously
stored messages.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT DMPSGMSG ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT DMPSGMSG- 1-


DACT DMPSGMSG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DACT DUMP OF SAFEGUARDING MESSAGES

This command deactivates the dump of stored safeguarding messages.

Notes:
- Internal initiations from the distribution process to the dump process
are suppressed.
- External initiations to dump by the command DMP SGMSG are rejected
with the appropriate output.
- One reason for the deactivation can be that SG.OPER is full. In this
case, this cyclic file would be (partially) overwritten by further dumping.
The dump can be reactivated if dumping is at first suppressed and
SG.OPER is then dumped.
- Deactivation can also be initiated before the SG.OPER is created with
more than 90 PAM pages.

Prerequisites:
- If the dump is deactivated no further messages are written to SG.OPER,
but messages to be displayed continue to be collected by the distribution
process in its memory area.
- If the memory area is full, the oldest stored messages are compulsorily
overwritten.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT DMPSGMSG ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT DMPSGMSG- 1-


DISP DMPSGMSG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISP DUMP OF SAFEGUARDING MESSAGES

This command displays the activation state for the dump of safeguarding
messages.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP DMPSGMSG ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DMPSGMSG- 1-


CAN DN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL DIRECTORY NUMBER

This command cancels a directory number interval or a single directory


number.

Prerequisites:
- The directory number interval must not be connected (command
DISP DN, TYPE=CONNECT) or accessible by the digit
translator (command DISP DN, ACT=YES).
- The directory number interval must not be activated for IACHASTA
registration (command DISP IACOBJ).
- There must not be any ported directory number (command DISP DN,
INCEPT=PORTEDDN) in the interval.
- There must not be any directory number ported by location
( command DISP DN, INCEPT=PORTEDLP) in the interval.
- There must not be any individual announcements (command DISP DN,
INCEPT=CHGDNIND) for directory numbers in the interval.
- There must not be any extended directory number (command DISP DN,
EXTDN=YES) in the interval.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for a local exchange.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN DN : [LAC=] ,DN= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple directory
number volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number interval or the single


directory number to be canceled.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DN- 1-


CR DN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE DIRECTORY NUMBER

This command creates a directory number interval or a single directory number


with or without economy.

Prerequisites:
- The local area code must be defined.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for a local exchange.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR DN : LAC= ,DN= [,PBXVOL=] [,DNGRP=] [,STMGRP=] [,ACCNO=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

Notes:
- Intervals that are used for subscribers should be decimal.
These intervals can be connected with a code point.
- Non-dialable intervals (e.g. for accounting purposes) might
be hexadecimal.
- Intervals of 1, 10, 100, 1000 directory numbers can be entered:
Intervals of 10, 100, 1000 dir.numbers with 2...12 digits
Single DN with PBX volume with 2...12 digits
Single DN without PBX volume with 1...12 digits

- Length of DN is not allowed to be longer tha specified


by DNMAXL to be displayed with DISP CALLPOPT.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PBXVOL PBX DIRECTORY NUMBER VOLUME

- For a single directory number used for a PBX, the PBX volume
indicates which directory number digits of a decade belong
to the PBX. The PBX volume must contain the last digit of the
given directory number.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

0...9, range of decimal numbers

DNGRP DIRECTORY NUMBER GROUP

This parameter specifies the allocation of the directory number


interval or the single directory number to a subgroup (e.g. for
creating an accounting file).

Notes:
- Only alphanumeric digits are possible for input.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...2 characters from the

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DN- 1+
CR DN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

symbolic name character set

STMGRP STATISTIC METER GROUP

This parameter specifies the allocation of the directory number


interval or the single directory number to counter groups.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0,1,2...15, range of decimal numbers

ACCNO MARK FOR ACCOUNT NUMBER

This parameter specifies whether the directory number interval is only


used for accounting purposes. In this case the directory number
interval cannot be connected with a code point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DN IS NOT AN ACCOUNT NUMBER


NO DN IS NOT AN ACCOUNT NUMBER
Y DN IS AN ACCOUNT NUMBER
YES DN IS AN ACCOUNT NUMBER

Default: N

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DN- 2-
DISP DN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DIRECTORY NUMBER DATA

This command displays data for either all directory numbers, the
directory numbers within an interval or a single directory number.
It displays directory numbers within a certain interval with the
specified information.
A search can be made for one of the following selection criteria:
- Accounting numbers or non-accounting numbers ACCNO
- Directory number group DNGRP
- Access from digit translator ACT
- Statistics meter group STMGRP
- Directory number type TYPE
- Intercept identifier INCEPT
- Extended directory numbers EXTDN.
If TYPE, INCEPT or EXTDN are specified each directory number with
the selected criteria will be displayed besides the data that are valid
for the whole interval.
If ACCNO, DNGRP, ACT or STMGRP are specified the directory
number interval data is displayed.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is only permitted for a local exchange.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,DNGRP= 11 1
1 11,INCEPT=11 1
1 11,ACT= 11 1
1 DISP DN : [LAC=] ,DN= 1Z,STMGRP=Y1 [,FORMAT=] ; 1
1 11,TYPE= 11 1
1 11,ACCNO= 11 1
1 11,EXTDN= 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple directory
number volume.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number range or the single


directory number to be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DNGRP DIRECTORY NUMBER GROUP

This parameter specifies the subgroup of the directory number


interval or single directory number.

Notes:
- Only alphanumeric digits are possible for input.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DN- 1+


DISP DN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...2 characters from the


symbolic name character set

INCEPT INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CHANGEDN CHANGED DIRECTORY NUMBER


UNOBDN UNOBTAINABLE DIRECTORY NUMBER
CHGDNIND CHANGED DIRECTORY NUMBER IND.
PORTEDDN NUMBER PORTABILITY
PORTEDLP LOCATION PORTABILITY

ACT ACTIVATED DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies as a selection criterion whether or not the


directory number interval or the single directory number is
accessible by the digit translator.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY NOT ACTIVATED DN ONLY


NO DISPLAY NOT ACTIVATED DN ONLY
Y DISPLAY ACTIVATED DN ONLY
YES DISPLAY ACTIVATED DN ONLY

STMGRP STATISTIC METER GROUP

This parameter specifies the allocation of the directory number


interval or the single directory number to counter groups.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

TYPE SUBSCRIBER TYPE FOR DN

This parameter specifies the directory number type of the directory


number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SUB SUBSCRIBER
PBXLN PBX LINE
PBX PBX
PBXADDNO PBX ADDITIONAL NUMBER
Additional number of PBX.
PBXDDINO PBX DIRECT DIALING NUMBER
Direct dialing number of PBX
FREE FREE LINE
Specifies that only directory numbers
with no further connections are selected.
Also directory numbers with an intercept
identification will be selected.
WST WORK STATION
MEETME MEET ME
CSGRP COMMON SERVICE GROUP
RESCSGRP RESERVED FOR COM. SERV. GROUP
CALLTYPE COMMON CDS CALLTYPE
CXGRP CENTREX GROUP
CONNECT CONNECTED DIRECTORY NUMBER
Specifies that directory numbers with
further connections are selected.
A connection can be:
-SUB
-PBXLN
-PBX
-PBXADDNO
-PBXDDINO
-WST
-MEETME
-CSGRP

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DN- 2+


DISP DN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

-RESCSGRP
-CALLTYPE
-CXGRP

ACCNO MARK FOR ACCOUNT NUMBER

This parameter specifies as a selection criterion whether or not the


directory number interval is used for accounting purposes only.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DN IS NOT AN ACCOUNT NUMBER


NO DN IS NOT AN ACCOUNT NUMBER
Y DN IS AN ACCOUNT NUMBER
YES DN IS AN ACCOUNT NUMBER

Default: NO

EXTDN MARK FOR EXTENDED DN

This parameter specifies as a selection criterion whether


extended directory numbers are to be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y DN IS EXTENDED
YES DN IS EXTENDED

FORMAT OUTPUT FORMAT

This parameter specifies the output format of the display.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTERVAL DIRECTORY NO. INTERVALS ONLY


specifies that only the data valid for the whole
interval (e.g. activation, kind of interval,
directory number group, statistic meter group,
PBX volume, extended directory number in interval
existing) will be displayed.
ALL ALL DIRECTORY NUMBERS
specifies the display of the individual data
of each directory number within the specified
directory number interval (including directory
number type, intercept identification and extended
directory number).
Furthermore the data valid for the whole
interval (e.g. activation, type of interval,
directory number group, statistic meter group
and PBX directory number volume) will be
displayed.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DN- 3-


EXT DN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

EXTEND DIRECTORY NUMBER

This command extends an existing directory number to a directory


number interval of 10 numbers. The existing directory number
must be within an interval of 10, 100 or 1000 numbers.
The new directory number interval consists of the existing
directory number followed by one digit where the lower interval
boundary must be 0 and the upper interval boundary must be 9.

Prerequisites:
- The country code is set to BRD.
(Command DISP EXDDAT).
- No extension of ported directory numbers.
- The directory number must be not connected.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for a local exchange.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 EXT DN : [LAC=] ,DN= ,NEWDN= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple
directory number volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number


to be extended. No more than DNMAXL-1 digits
are allowed. Length DNMAXL can to be displayed
with DISP CALLPOPT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...11 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NEWDN NEW DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the new directory number interval of


10 numbers.

Notes:
-Length of NEWDN is not allowed to be longer then specified
by DNMAXL to be displayed with DISP CALLPOPT.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

3...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 EXT DN- 1-


MOD DN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY DIRECTORY NUMBER

This command modifies a directory number interval or the data of a


directory number interval.
The following data can be changed:
- PBX directory number volume (PBXVOL) (for a single
directory number only)
- directory number group (DNGRP)
- statistic meter group (STMGRP)
It is also used to enter, modify and cancel the intercept identification
(INCEPT) or the intercept digits (b) of a single directory
number.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for a local exchange.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,NEWDN= 1 1
1 1,PBXVOL=1 (;) 1
1 MOD DN : [LAC=] ,DN= Z,DNGRP= Y Z Y 1
1 1,STMGRP=1 *!+ 1
1 1,INCEPT=1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple directory
number volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the existing directory number interval or an


existing single directory number.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NEWDN NEW DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the new directory number interval or a new


single directory number.

Notes:
- When connected (DISP DN, TYPE=CONNECT) or ported (MOD DN,
INCEPT=PORTEDDN) directory numbers are modified, a dangerous
command message is output. In this case care should be taken that
meter observation is stopped and traffic observation/measurement
is canceled.
- When connected directory numbers ported by location (MOD DN,
INCEPT=PORTEDLP) directory numbers are modified, a dangerous
command message is output. In this case care should be taken that
meter observation is stopped and traffic observation/measurement
is canceled.
- The mask is also output, if directory numbers are in the interval,
which are ported with location portability (INCEPT=PORTEDLP).
- The directory number interval must not be accessible by the digit
translator (command DISP DN, ACT=YES).
- If ported directory numbers are existing in the interval (to be
displayed with DISP DN), two cases can be distinguished:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DN- 1+


MOD DN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a) The ported directory numbers in the exchange, where the


concerned subscribers are located, remain the same:
After the modification of the directory number interval the
directory numbers marked with INCEPT=PORTEDDN values must
be modified (MOD DN, parameter INCEPT=UNOBDN which
means this number is not valid). Because ported subscribers
are only reachable through their original numbers it necessary
to recreate the original numbers as single directory numbers
(CR DN) and modify them (MOD DN, parameter INCEPT=
PORTEDDN-b) so the link from the original number
to the ported number is like before.
b) The ported directory numbers in these exchanges are modified
accordingly:
No further ported directory number handling after the
modification of the directory number interval is necessary.
- For the new directory number (interval) a zone point should exist.
- The size of the directory number interval cannot be changed.
- Intervals that are used for subscribers which can be dialed must
be decimal.
- Intervals that are only used for accounting purposes might be
hexadecimal.
- The PBX volume must contain the last digit of the new directory
number.
- The new directory number with PBX volume must have at least two
digits.
- If a directory number in the interval is part of an operator
number of a PBX (OPN) and the length of the directory numbers
of the interval is changed, the length of the operator number
must not exceed the maximum length of a directory number
(12 digits).
- The Start Position Digits to Send (SSDI) for direct inward
dialing PBXs in the interval has to be adapted after the
modification, if the length of the interval has changed.
- Length of NEWDN is not allowed to be longer than specified
by DNMAXL to be displayed with DISP CALLPOPT.
- If extended directory numbers (EXTDN) are existing within the
interval, the new directory number cannot be longer than
DNMAXL-1 digits.
- If in the interval a PBX pilot directory number exists and the PBX
has additional numbers (ADDNO) in other directory number
intervals, the modification is not possible.
The additional numbers in the other intervals have to be
canceled (see MOD PBX) before the execution of the command and
recreated afterwards.
- If there are additional numbers (ADDNO) of a PBX in the interval
and the pilot directory number or further additional number of the
PBX are in another intervals, then the modification is not
possible.
The additional numbers in the interval to be changed have to be
canceled (see MOD PBX) before the execution of the command and
recreated afterwards.
- If in the interval a DDI-PBX direct dialing number (PBXDDINO)
or a PBX of type PBXDDINO exists, the modification is not
possible.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PBXVOL PBX DIRECTORY NUMBER VOLUME

Notes:
- The directory number interval must not be accessible by the digit
translator (command DISP DN, ACT=YES).
- Only an already existing PBX volume can be changed.
- A new PBX volume indicating which directory number digits of a decade
belong to a PBX can be entered for single directory numbers. The PBX
volume must contain the last digit of the given directory number.
- The new PBX volume must be compatible with the operator number of
the PBX if there is one existing.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DN- 2+


MOD DN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

0...9, range of decimal numbers

DNGRP DIRECTORY NUMBER GROUP

This parameter modifies the allocation of the directory number


interval or the single directory number to a subgroup (e.g. for
creating an accounting file).

Notes:
- Only alphanumeric digits are possible for input.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...2 characters from the


symbolic name character set

STMGRP STATISTIC METER GROUP

This parameter modifies the allocation of the directory number interval


or the single directory number to counter groups.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

INCEPT INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies


- the intercept identification and if needed the
individual announcement number or
- the porting information
for the desired directory number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION
CHANGEDN CHANGED DIRECTORY NUMBER
A second unit must not be entered.
UNOBDN UNOBTAINABLE DIRECTORY NUMBER
A second unit must not be entered.
CHGDNIND CHANGED DIRECTORY NO INDIV.
A second unit must be entered.
PORTEDDN NUMBER PORTABILITY
A second unit can be entered.
PORTEDLP LOCATION PORTABILITY
The PORTEDLP defines location portability
in project Singapore. A second unit must not
be entered.

b: INTERCEPT DIGITS=
1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DN- 3-


REC DN
DLU
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RECORD DIRECTORY NUMBERS

This command records directory numbers to detect high load


connections. Up to 1000 subscribers can be measured by one
measurement. Only subscribers are measured, all other types
(e.g. PBX) are ignored.
The command will be rejected if there is no created subscriber in
the selected intervals. The measurement can only be run once at
any one time. The data of the measured records are output
exclusively to MDD.
The period of every single data collection and data output can be
varied by the command parameter SCANTIME.

If more than 1000 subscribers exist in the selected directory


number intervals, an indication follows in the "started mask".
The "started mask" contains a command repetition which confirms
the selected directory number intervals. In addition, the lowest
and highest directory numbers measured and the total number of
measured subscribers are output.
The three information units (lowest and highest measured
directory number, number of measured subscribers) appear in the
"started mask" and in the "finished mask".
Due to the information about the highest measured subscriber, the
directory number intervals in a subsequent measurement can be
selected optionally.

Which directory numbers from the selected directory number


interval are created subscribers is checked at the moment of
command receipt. The establishment of the directory numbers to be
measured is therefore a snapshot recording. This means that
subscribers created subsequently within the directory number
intervals selected in the command will be disregarded.
Selected subscribers who are deleted or modified after command
receipt will not be measured any more but they remain in the
output data.

Directory numbers can be specified by a digital line unit (DLU)


as an alternative to using intervals. The establishment of the
directory numbers is also a snapshot recording, which means that
the created subscribers at the DLU (including subscribers
connected via a V5 interface) to be measured will be
established at the moment of command receipt. If the number of
created subscribers of a selected DLU exceeds 1000, only
the first 1000 created subscribers will be measured.
With the "started mask" and the "finished mask" the user receives
information about the number of measured subscribers analogous
to the specification of directory number intervals. Information
is also output about the lowest and highest port where
subscribers are measured.
Subscribers to be measured are always selected from the port
with the lowest port number to the port with the highest port
number. A subsequent measurement can be started at the port where
the last measurement has ended by selecting command parameters
DLU and EQN. All or none of the created directory numbers
at an MSN port or connected via a V5 interface are measured.
Directory numbers in the output are not sorted in ascending
order but in the order in which they are found by searching
at the DLU.
If the number of directory numbers to be measured exceeds the
limit of 1000 and the last DLU port is an MSN port or a V5
interface is connected to this DLU port, this DLU port
cannot be measured within the running measurement job.
There could thus be a measurement whose directory number total is
less than 1000 even though the number of created subscribers at
the DLU exceeds 1000.

It is only advisable to measure REC DN for MSN ports if all


the directory numbers at an MSN port are measured in the same
measurement job.

For each subscriber to be measured the following counters are


provided:

- TC:I traffic carried (incoming)


- TC:O traffic carried (outgoing)
- CC:I number of calls carried (incoming)
- CC:O number of calls carried (outgoing)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DN- 1+


REC DN
DLU
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Disk Size:
If 1000 directory numbers are measured, 87 kbytes are required
(89 bytes per directory number) on hard disk for every output.

This command starts a semipermanent job. It can be canceled with CAN JOB.

This command is only permitted for a local exchange.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. REC DN - DLU DLU SPECIFICATION


2. REC DN - DN DN SPECIFICATION

1. Input format

DLU SPECIFICATION

This input format records directory numbers of subscribers


connected to the specified digital line unit.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REC DN : UNIT= ,DLU= [,EQN=] [,SCANTIME=] [,BEG=] [,TER=] 1
1 1
1 [,IV=] [,PER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

UNIT OUTPUT UNIT AND MODE

This parameter specifies the output unit and the mode of


output.

Notes:
- UNIT=MDD-DAILY is not allowed in combination with
BEG, TER, PER or IV.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: OUTPUT UNIT
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
If this option is selected, a measurement file
is created and the traffic data are output to
this file. The start and the finish message
include the name of the file in which the
traffic data are available for
postprocessing.

Notes :
If a file is destroyed or cannot be extended,
an advisory is sent to the OMT.

This information unit specifies the output unit.

b: OUTPUT MODE
XDAILY = DAILY TRAFFIC FILE
1 1 If this option is selected, the data are
1 1 output to daily files. The measurement starts
1 1 immediately and has no defined end. Time
1 1 parameters are not permitted.
1 1 To secure the required space on disk, all 7
1 1 daily files are prepared and created at the
1 1 start of measurement.
1 1 A daily file is closed at the end of the day and a
1 1 new file for the next day is automatically
1 1 created, or the existing file is replaced.
1 1 Daily files will be overwritten in the
1 1 following week on the same day.
>SINGLE W SINGLE TRAFFIC FILE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DN- 2+


REC DN
DLU
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

If this option is selected, the data are


output to single measurement file.

This information unit specifies the desired output mode


(daily file or single measurement file).
It is only permissible in connection with output unit = MDD.

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This parameter specifies the digital line unit.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the start port of the DLU.

Notes:
- The chosen DLU value in the parameter EQN must be equal to
the parameter DLU.

Default: EQN = DLU-0-0-0

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER=


10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

b: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

c: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

d: CIRCUIT NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

SCANTIME SCAN TIME FOR DATA OUTPUT

This parameter specifies a duration in minutes. For this duration,


counter data will be collected and output. The SCANTIME can be
selected in the range from 15 to 720 in the 15 minutes frame.

Restrictions:
If a time parameter is selected, the intervals of measurement must
be a multiple of the selected SCANTIME. In all other cases the
command will be rejected.
Therefore the following combinations between time parameters and
SCANTIME are possible:

For the combinations of time parameter


BEG,
BEG and TER,
BEG and TER and PER or
TER and PER
the default IV 00-00-24-00 is used. In this case the possible
values for the SCANTIME are 15, 30, 45, 60, 90, 120, 180, 240,
360, 480 and 720, only.

For any combination of time parameters containing the parameter


IV, the possible values of the SCANTIME depend on the duration
of the selected intervals. All selected intervals must be a
multiple of the selected SCANTIME.

The SCANTIME can be arbitrary in the range of 15 to 720 in the 15


minutes frame if TER is the only specified time parameter in the
command or if the parameter UNIT=MDD-DAILY is chosen.

Default: 15 minutes.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DN- 3+


REC DN
DLU
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

15,30,45...720, range of decimal numbers

BEG BEGIN DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement begin time.

Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER
must be specified.
Exception: Time parameter cannot be specified for the
data output in daily files.
- A maximum of four BEG dates in chronological order may
be linked with &. In case of linked BEG dates, TER
is not permitted.
If no TER is selected, the measurement is active on the
specified BEG days only.
- The earliest possible begin date BEG is the day after
command input.
- The first BEG date must be within an interval of one
month starting from the current date.
- The other BEG dates must be within an interval of
one year starting from the current date.
- The measurement on the actual BEG day can be stopped
with STOP JOB. If the measurement is stopped on the
last BEG day, it will be finished.

Default: the begin of measurement is the current date

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

TER TERMINATION DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement time termination


date.

Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER
must be specified.
Exception: Time parameters may not be epecified for
data output in daily files.
- Only one termination date may be entered.
- The earliest possible termination date is the day after the
command input.
- The measurement duration may not exceed one year.
- If no BEG parameter is enterred, recording starts
immediately.

Default: the end of measurement is determined by the last


single day (BEG).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF TERMINATION DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DN- 4+


REC DN
DLU
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

c: DAY OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

IV INTERVAL TIME

This parameter indicates interval times of the measurement.

Notes:
- Interval times IV are only permitted if at least one
begin date (BEG)is selected.
- A maximum of 4 measurement intervals in chronological
order may be linked with &. Linked intervals have to be
at least 30 minutes apart except for measurement over
midnight.
- An interval may not include midnight, e. g. IV =
23-00-01-00 is not permitted..
A measurement over midnight requires the input of two
interval times, e. g. 00-00-01-00&23-00-00-00.
- The measurement is active during the specified interval
times only.
- The measurement can be stopped during the actual interval
IV with STOP JOB. If the measurement is stopped
during the last interval IV, it will be finished.

Default: 24-hour measurement on the specified days

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: HOUR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE OF BEGIN DATE=


0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

c: HOUR OF TERMINATION DATE=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

d: MINUTE OF TERMINATION DATE=


0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

PER PERIODIC WEEKDAY

This parameter specifies the weekdays on which data


have to be recorded.

Notes:
- Input of weekdays is only permissible in
connection with a termination date (TER).
- Up to 6 of the values may be linked with &, except
the values NO, WO and HO which cannot be
linked with other values.

Default: measurement every day during the measurement


period

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

XFR = FRIDAY
1HO 1 HOLIDAY
1 1 Full national and international holidays are
1 1 included.
1 1 The full weekend day (the day marked EF
1 1 in the DISP WDCAT output mask) is included.
1 1 Half holidays are not included.
1MO 1 MONDAY
1NO 1 NO SPECIFIED PERIOD
1 1 Measurement every day
1SA 1 SATURDAY

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DN- 5+


REC DN
DLU
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1SU 1 SUNDAY
1TH 1 THURSDAY
1TU 1 TUESDAY
1WE 1 WEDNESDAY
>WO W WORKDAY
Days which are full working days

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DN- 6+


REC DN
DN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

DN SPECIFICATION

This input format records subscriber directory numbers


specified as directory number intervals.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REC DN : UNIT= [,LAC=] ,DN= [,SCANTIME=] [,BEG=] [,TER=] 1
1 1
1 [,IV=] [,PER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

UNIT OUTPUT UNIT AND MODE

This parameter specifies the output unit and the mode of


output.

Notes:
- UNIT=MDD-DAILY is not allowed in combination with
BEG, TER, PER or IV.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: OUTPUT UNIT
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
If this option is selected, a measurement file
is created and the traffic data are output to
this file. The start and the finish message
include the name of the file in which the
traffic data are available for
postprocessing.

Notes :
If a file is destroyed or cannot be extended,
an advisory is sent to the OMT.

This information unit specifies the output unit.

b: OUTPUT MODE
XDAILY = DAILY TRAFFIC FILE
1 1 If this option is selected, the data are
1 1 output to daily files. The measurement starts
1 1 immediately and has no defined end. Time
1 1 parameters are not permitted.
1 1 To secure the required space on disk, all 7
1 1 daily files are prepared and created at the
1 1 start of measurement.
1 1 A daily file is closed at the end of the day and a
1 1 new file for the next day is automatically
1 1 created, or the existing file is replaced.
1 1 Daily files will be overwritten in the
1 1 following week on the same day.
>SINGLE W SINGLE TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
output to single measurement file.

This information unit specifies the desired output mode


(daily file or single measurement file).
It is only permissible in connection with output unit = MDD.

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

Default: in exchanges with only one local network, this


parameter may be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DN- 7+


REC DN
DN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number intervals. A


maximum of 5 intervals can be linked with &.
The upper interval limit must be higher than the lower interval
limit and the directory number intervals must be disjunct.
By selecting the command parameter ’DN=X’ a maximum of 1000
created subscribers will be measured. The selection starts with
the lowest directory number in the exchange or with the
lowest directory number belonging to the selected LAC.

Restrictions:
Additional directory numbers of PBXs are rejected.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SCANTIME SCAN TIME FOR DATA OUTPUT

This parameter specifies a duration in minutes. For this duration,


counter data will be collected and output. The SCANTIME can be
selected in the range from 15 to 720 in the 15 minutes frame.

Restrictions:
If a time parameter is selected, the intervals of measurement must
be a multiple of the selected SCANTIME. In all other cases the
command will be rejected.
Therefore the following combinations between time parameters and
SCANTIME are possible:

For the combinations of time parameter


BEG,
BEG and TER,
BEG and TER and PER or
TER and PER
the default IV 00-00-24-00 is used. In this case the possible
values for the SCANTIME are 15, 30, 45, 60, 90, 120, 180, 240,
360, 480 and 720, only.

For any combination of time parameters containing the parameter


IV, the possible values of the SCANTIME depend on the duration
of the selected intervals. All selected intervals must be a
multiple of the selected SCANTIME.

The SCANTIME can be arbitrary in the range of 15 to 720 in the 15


minutes frame if TER is the only specified time parameter in the
command or if the parameter UNIT=MDD-DAILY is chosen.

Default: 15 minutes.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

15,30,45...720, range of decimal numbers

BEG BEGIN DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement begin time.

Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER
must be specified.
Exception: Time parameter cannot be specified for the
data output in daily files.
- A maximum of four BEG dates in chronological order may
be linked with &. In case of linked BEG dates, TER
is not permitted.
If no TER is selected, the measurement is active on the
specified BEG days only.
- The earliest possible begin date BEG is the day after

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DN- 8+


REC DN
DN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

command input.
- The first BEG date must be within an interval of one
month starting from the current date.
- The other BEG dates must be within an interval of
one year starting from the current date.
- The measurement on the actual BEG day can be stopped
with STOP JOB. If the measurement is stopped on the
last BEG day, it will be finished.

Default: the begin of measurement is the current date

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

TER TERMINATION DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement time termination


date.

Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER
must be specified.
Exception: Time parameters may not be epecified for
data output in daily files.
- Only one termination date may be entered.
- The earliest possible termination date is the day after the
command input.
- The measurement duration may not exceed one year.
- If no BEG parameter is enterred, recording starts
immediately.

Default: the end of measurement is determined by the last


single day (BEG).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF TERMINATION DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

IV INTERVAL TIME

This parameter indicates interval times of the measurement.

Notes:
- Interval times IV are only permitted if at least one
begin date (BEG)is selected.
- A maximum of 4 measurement intervals in chronological
order may be linked with &. Linked intervals have to be
at least 30 minutes apart except for measurement over
midnight.
- An interval may not include midnight, e. g. IV =
23-00-01-00 is not permitted..
A measurement over midnight requires the input of two
interval times, e. g. 00-00-01-00&23-00-00-00.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DN- 9+


REC DN
DN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- The measurement is active during the specified interval


times only.
- The measurement can be stopped during the actual interval
IV with STOP JOB. If the measurement is stopped
during the last interval IV, it will be finished.

Default: 24-hour measurement on the specified days

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: HOUR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE OF BEGIN DATE=


0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

c: HOUR OF TERMINATION DATE=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

d: MINUTE OF TERMINATION DATE=


0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

PER PERIODIC WEEKDAY

This parameter specifies the weekdays on which data


have to be recorded.

Notes:
- Input of weekdays is only permissible in
connection with a termination date (TER).
- Up to 6 of the values may be linked with &, except
the values NO, WO and HO which cannot be
linked with other values.

Default: measurement every day during the measurement


period

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

XFR = FRIDAY
1HO 1 HOLIDAY
1 1 Full national and international holidays are
1 1 included.
1 1 The full weekend day (the day marked EF
1 1 in the DISP WDCAT output mask) is included.
1 1 Half holidays are not included.
1MO 1 MONDAY
1NO 1 NO SPECIFIED PERIOD
1 1 Measurement every day
1SA 1 SATURDAY
1SU 1 SUNDAY
1TH 1 THURSDAY
1TU 1 TUESDAY
1WE 1 WEDNESDAY
>WO W WORKDAY
Days which are full working days

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC DN- 10-


RED DN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

REDUCE DIRECTORY NUMBER

This command reduces an extended directory number interval of


10 numbers to a single directory number.
The single directory number is equal to the directory number
of the lower interval boundary reduced by the last digit.

Prerequisites:
- The extended directory number interval must not be connected
(command DISP DN, TYPE=CONNECT).
- There must not be any ported directory number (command
DISP DN, INCEPT=PORTEDDN) in the extension interval.
- There must not be any directory numbers ported by location
(command DISP DN, INCEPT=PORTEDLP) in the extension
interval.
- There must not be any individual announcements (command
DISP DN, INCEPT=CHGDNIND) for directory numbers in the
extension interval.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for a local exchange.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 RED DN : [LAC=] ,DN= ,NEWDN= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple
directory number volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number interval of


10 numbers.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

3...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NEWDN NEW DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the single directory number to which the


interval will be reduced.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...11 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RED DN- 1-


DISP DNATT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DIRECTORY NUMBER ATTRIBUTE

This command displays :

- whether the directory number volume within the exchange


is multiple or unique,
- whether the local area codes are to be evaluated in the
digit-destination translator,
- the national prefix digits,
- the international prefix digits,
- the prefix digits for carrier access code,
- whether the local area code is part of directory number.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP DNATT ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DNATT- 1-


ENTR DNATT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER DIRECTORY NUMBER ATTRIBUTE

This command enters the directory number attributes.


It determines:
- whether the directory number volume within the exchange is
multiple or unique,
- whether the local area codes are to be evaluated in the
digit-destination translator,
- the national prefix digits,
- the international prefix digits,
- the prefix digits from carrier access code,
- whether national prefix digits or international prefix digits
or the prefix digits for carrier access code are used,
- whether the local area code is part of directory number,
- whether a not dialed LAC will be inserted before the
dialed B-number to build up a national significant number.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR DNATT : <DNVOL= ,EVLAC= ,PFXNAT= ,PFXINAT= ,PFXCAC= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,NOPFX= ,LACPNO=> [,LACINSOC=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DNVOL DIRECTORY NUMBER VOLUME

This parameter specifies whether the directory number volume


in the exchange is multiple or unique.

Notes:
- Two subscribers of the exchange may have the same directory number
but a different local area code only if directory number volume
is assigned MULTIPLE.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UNIQUE UNIQUE DIRECTORY NUMBERS


MULTIPLE MULTIPLE DIRECTORY NUMBERS

EVLAC EVALUATION OF LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies whether the local area codes are to be


evaluated.

Prerequisites:
- An evaluation of the local area codes can only be prevented within an
exchange with a unique directory number volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y EVALUATE LAC
(initial value)
YES EVALUATE LAC
N DO NOT EVALUATE LAC
NO DO NOT EVALUATE LAC

PFXNAT PREFIX NATIONAL

This parameter specifies the national prefix digits.


Attention:
- A changed national prefix could be incompatible
to existing local area codes or codepoints.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...3 digit decimal number

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR DNATT- 1+


ENTR DNATT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PFXINAT PREFIX INTERNATIONAL

This parameter specifies the international prefix digits.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...3 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PFXCAC PREFIX CARRIER ACCESS CODE

This parameter specifies the prefix digits for carrier access code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...3 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NOPFX NO PREFIX

This parameter specifies that existing national or


international prefix digits or the prefix digits
for carrier access code are canceled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NAT NATIONAL PREFIX


INAT INTERNATIONAL PREFIX
CAC CARRIER ACCESS CODE PREFIX

LACPNO LOCAL AREA CODE IS PART OF NO

This parameter specifies if the local area code is part of


of a national significant number.
The entry LACPNO = YES means that a national
significant number consists out of LAC + DN.
The DN alone is in this case only locally significant.

The entry LACPNO = NO means that the DN


alone is national significant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y LOCAL AREACODE IS PART OF NO


(initial value)
YES LOCAL AREACODE IS PART OF NO
N LOC. AREACODE ISN’T PART OF NO
NO LOC. AREACODE ISN’T PART OF NO

LACINSOC LAC INSERT. FOR OUTG. CALL

This parameter specifies whether a LAC, which was not


dialed, must be inserted before the dialled B-number
to build up a national significant number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y INSERT LAC
YES INSERT LAC
N DO NOT INSERT LAC
(initial value)
NO DO NOT INSERT LAC

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR DNATT- 2-


CAN DNOBS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL DIRECTORY NUMBER OBSERVATION JOB

This command either cancels or limits an existing directory number


observation job by cancelling certain object groups (consisting of
subscribers or private branch exchanges) or removes digit
combinations for special encoding.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN DNOBS : [GRP=] [,ENCODE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

GRP GROUP OF OBJECTS

This parameter specifies object groups of subscribers or private


branch exchanges.
Up to 10 object groups may be linked with &.
Default: all objects are cancelled

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ENCODE DIGIT STRING FOR ENCODING

This parameter specifies the digit string for special


encoding.
Up to eight digit strings may be entered linked with &.
The command with this parameter must not be entered if
a Directory Number Observation job is already started.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DNOBS- 1-


DISP DNOBS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DIRECTORY NUMBER OBSERVATION JOB

This command displays the directory number observation


data. If parameter is not entered the assumed default
for FORMAT is STATUS

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP DNOBS : [FORMAT=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FORMAT OUTPUT FORMAT

This parameter specifies the FORMAT for the output.


If STATUS is entered the directory number observation
job data is output.
If ENCODE is entered the list of digits strings
entered for special encoding is output.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

STATUS STATUS OF DN OBSERVATION


ENCODE LIST OF CODES FOR ENCODING

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DNOBS- 1-


ENTR DNOBS
DNOBS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER DIRECTORY NUMBER OBSERVATION JOB

This command may be used to enter a new/expand an existing


directory number observation job by specifying which object
groups (consisting of subscribers or private branch exchanges)
should be measured at a determined time or for input digit
strings for special encoding.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ENTR DNOBS - DNOBS PATH FOR DNOBS START


2. ENTR DNOBS - ENCODE PATH FOR ENCODE

1. Input format

PATH FOR DNOBS START

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR DNOBS : GRP= [,RREC=] [,BEG=] [,TER=] [,PER=] [,IV=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

GRP GROUP OF OBJECTS

This parameter specifies object groups of subscribers or private


branch exchanges.
Up to 10 object groups may be linked with &.
Default: no effect on process

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

RREC NUMBER OF REQUESTED RECORDS

This parameter specifies the number of requested observation


records.
The value can be changed during observation.
Default: no restriction

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...65535, range of decimal numbers

BEG BEGIN DATE

This parameter specifies the begin date, which may (as a single date)
describe the beginning of an interval of days or (as up to 4 linked
dates) up to 4 single days.
Default: no effect on process

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR DNOBS- 1+


ENTR DNOBS
DNOBS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TER TERMINATING DATE

This parameter specifies the end of an interval of days.


Default: no effect on process

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

PER PERIODIC WEEKDAY

This parameter specifies the periodic weekdays or the weekday category.


Up to 8 weekdays/categories may be linked with &, the maximum number of
weekdays being limited to 6.
Notes:
- The input of this parameter is only permissible in connection with
a terminating date (TER).
- Weekdays MO, TU, ... SU: execution on the respective
weekday
- Categories WO, HO:
WO = execution on all full working days
HO = execution on all full national and international holidays
Default: observation every day during the observation period

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

FR FRIDAY
HO HOLIDAY
MO MONDAY
NO DEFAULT VALUE
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
TH THURSDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
WO WORKDAY

IV INTERVAL TIME

This parameter specifies the time intervals during which the


directory number observation job is active each day.
Up to 4 intervals may be linked with &.
Default: no effect on process

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: BEGIN HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the hour at which the


directory number observation job should begin.

b: BEGIN MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the minutes after the


hour at which the directory number observation job should
begin.
Notes:
- Possible values are: 0, 15, 30 or 45.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR DNOBS- 2+


ENTR DNOBS
DNOBS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

c: END HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the hour at which the


directory number observation job should terminate.

d: END MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the minutes after the


hour at which the directory number observation job should
terminate.
Notes:
- Possible values are: 0, 15, 30 or 45.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR DNOBS- 3+


ENTR DNOBS
ENCODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

PATH FOR ENCODE

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR DNOBS : ENCODE= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ENCODE DIGIT STRING FOR ENCODE

This parameter specifies the digit string for encoding.


Up to eight digit strings can be entered linked with &
using a single command. Otherwise, (by multiple entry)
up to 50 encoding strings can be entered.
The database should be expanded with ODAGEN using the
GROUP OBD.
This parameter must not be entered with any other of
the command parameters.
The command entered with this parameter does not start
a Directory Number Observation job.
The command with this parameter must not be entered if
a Directory Number Observation job is already started.
Indication on parameter usage:
- If operator tries to input the digit string: 1234
and digit string 123 was entered before, the command
will be rejected ( new digit string already with
special encode).
- If operator tries to input the digit string: 1234
and digit string 12345 was entered before, the
command is rejected. Hint: Cancel the 12345 digit
string and repeat command with 1234 digit
combination.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR DNOBS- 4-


DISP DNP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DESTINATION NUMBER POINTS

This command displays destination number points which are entered in the
special digit translator for traffic measurements (with REC DEST). The
destination number points are output with their digit combination,
destination number and origin language digit.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP DNP ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DNP- 1-


CAN DPFCACT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL DPFC ACTION

This command cancels a subscriber dependent digit processing


feature control action. It deletes an action to be performed
for a subscriber dependent digit processing feature.
Prerequisites:
- This action is not assigned to an evaluation criterion.
Notes:
- If this action still excludes other actions or is excluded
by other actions the corresponding exclusion data are also
updated (the canceled action is removed from this database).

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN DPFCACT : ACTION= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACTION ACTION TO BE PERFORMED

This parameter specifies the name of an action.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DPFCACT- 1-


CR DPFCACT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE DPFC ACTION

This command creates an action for subscriber dependent


digit processing and feature control. It is also possible
to specify a dummy action (action without any parameter
except parameter action) which can be used for excluding
other actions. See more details in action exclusion.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,ZOCHA=11 1
1 CR DPFCACT : ACTION= [,PRIO=] [,ZOINF=] 1Z,ZONO= Y1 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
1 [,TKZOINF=] [,BILLING=] [,STAT=] [,MEPROC=] 1
1 1
1 [,DICON=] [,ZONDAT=] [,NPDAT=] [,POSCC=] 1
1 1
1 [,ORIG1=] [,ORIG2=] [,MFCAT=] [,FTCNTL=] [,IN=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,ZDIG=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACTION ACTION TO BE PERFORMED

This parameter specifies the name of an action.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRIO PRIORITY

This parameter is used to determine the sequence of the actions


if more than one action is to be performed for a certain call.
1 is the highest order, it will be executed at first.
255 is the lowest order, it will be executed at last.
Actions without priority will be executed after actions
with a priority.
If more actions with the same priority should be executed, the
sequence of the execution is not defined.
Notes:
- No modification command for action is existing, therefore
it is not possible to modify a action priority without
cancelling the action and all conditions. Therefore
sufficient steps of priority numbers should be used to
have the possibility to create now actions with new
priorities.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...255, range of decimal numbers

ZOINF ZONING INFORMATION

This parameter specifies if the zoning information is present.


It is only relevant, if zoning is required (incoming trunk group).
Notes:
- If zoning with dialed digits is required (see CR MZOPT) the
parameter ZOINF must have the value NO.
- If ZOINF is set to YES without an action, zoning with

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DPFCACT- 1+
CR DPFCACT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CR MZOPT Database will not be done for a call where this action
applies.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N ZONING INFO NOT SPECIFIED


NO ZONING INFO NOT SPECIFIED
Y ZONING INFO SPECIFIED
YES ZONING INFO SPECIFIED

ZOCHA ZONE CHARACTERISTIC

This parameter specifies in which exchange zoning has


to be executed.
Prerequisites:
- Parameter ZOINF has value YES.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NOPULSE NO CHARGE PULSE GENERATION


ZONINHI ZONING IN HIGHER EXCHANGE

ZONO ZONE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the zone number.


Prerequisites:
- The specified zone must have been created with the command CR MZONE.
- Parameter ZOINF has value YES.
Notes:
- This parameter will not accept 127, 255.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...511, range of decimal numbers

TKZOINF TAKE OVER ZONING INFORMATION

This parameter determines whether a take over of backward


signalled zoning information or zone information sent by SCP
is allowed or not.
Prerequisites:
- Parameter ZOINF has value YES.
- Parameter ZOCHA or Parameter ZONO must be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N TAKE OVER NOT ALLOWED


NO TAKE OVER NOT ALLOWED
Y TAKE OVER ALLOWED
YES TAKE OVER ALLOWED

BILLING REQUESTED RECORDINGS

This parameter specifies the type of requested recordings.


BILLING=AMA means a charging ticket is generated. If
this parameter is not specified there is no charging ticket
generated.
Prerequisites:
- Parameter ZOINF has value YES.
- Parameter ZOCHA or Parameter ZONO must be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING

STAT STATISTIC MEASUREMENT INDEX

This parameter specifies the meter in which the statistic data


are to be entered.
Prerequisites:
- Parameter ZOINF has value YES.
- Parameter ZOCHA or Parameter ZONO must be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...255, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DPFCACT- 2+
CR DPFCACT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MEPROC METERING PROCEDURE

This parameter specifies the metering procedure.


Prerequisites:
- Parameter ZOINF has value YES.
- Parameter ZOCHA or Parameter ZONO must be entered.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

SUPANSPU SUPPRESS ANSWER METER IMPULSE


SUP1TIPU SUPPR. 1ST VAR.TIME METER IMP.
APA AUTOMATIC PRICE ADVICE
MEPROC3 METERING PROCEDURE 3
BCINCHRG BACKWARD CALL INDIC. NO CHARGE
BCICHRG BACKWARD CALL INDICATOR CHARGE

DICON DIGIT CONVERTING CODE

This parameter specifies the digit convertion code.


The following modifications can be made:
- replacement of digits
- insertion/append of digits
- removal of digits
The modifications are specified in form of a mask
consisting of control characters and digits.
There are two types of valid input characters:
digit values: 0-9, A-F, #, * (* -> B, # -> C)
control characters: X, ., +, %, R, S, !, (symbolic name)
If digit convertion code is shorter than the evaluated number
the remained digits will be taken over.

Control characters have the following significance:


X the digit of the old code remains unchanged
R digits following this character replace the
corresponding digits in the old code
. the digit of the old code is deleted
+ digits following this character up to next
control character are inserted
% append digits or symbolic names behind old code
or already modified code (This character is only
allowed as last control character except symbolic name)
() characters between brackets are interpreted as
symbolic name
S the conversion is stopped, all digits of the old code
from the corresponding position on are deleted
(This character is only allowed as last character)
! only allowed after symbolic name ANUM to distinguish
how many digits from A-number should be inserted.
After this control character a digit must follow.

Notes:
The input string composed of
- R, +, !, % as last character
- only S as single character
- only X (one or more)
is not allowed.

A digit combination without any control character is used


to replace all original digits.

Symbolic names are replaced by actual values which are handled


in form of digit strings.

The following symbolic names are supported:


NATPREF : national prefix of PLMN (see DISP MPRDDAT)
INATPREF[-index]: international prefix of PLMN (see DISP MPRDDAT)
index: refers to INATPREF as specified in
project data
1...8, range of decimal numbers
CC : country code of PLMN (see DISP MPRDDAT)
LAC[-index] : local area code of PLMN (see DISP MPRDDAT)
index: refers to LAC as specified in project data
1...15, range of decimal numbers
NDC[-index] : national destination code of PLMN
(see DISP MPRDDAT)
index: refers to NDC as specified in project data

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DPFCACT- 3+
CR DPFCACT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...10, range of decimal numbers


NDCLAC : NDC or LAC of subscriber
This symbolic name must only be used together with
a condition, which checks if it is a own subscriber
SN : subscriber number
LACOD : if location area code is used for digit modification
always a five digit decimal code is used
CI : if cell identification is used for digit modification
always a five digit decimal code is used
MCC : mobile country code of PLMN (see DISP MPRDDAT)
MNC : mobile network code of PLMN (see DISP MPRDDAT)
SCM : service class mark
Always the unknown format of SCM is used.
NOD[-format] : number of digits
format: HEX hexadezimal
DEC decimal
If neither HEX nor DEC is declared certainly DEC
will be used.
LOCNO : location number (see CR INTCELL)
DIALNO : dialed number
ANUM : A-number
In combination with control character ! digits
of A-number could be modified.

Examples:

- DICON = XX+123 Description: First two digits remains unchanged.


dial info: 7944583 The next three digits 123 are
inserted. The last five digits
remains unchanged.
Result: 7912344583

- DICON = .+45S Description: First digit is deleted.


dial info: 7944583 The next two digits are inserted
by 45 and after S the convertion
is stopped.
Result: 45

- DICON = ..R32 Description: First two digits are deleted.


dial info: 004921 The next two digits are replaced.
And the last digits remains
unchanged.
Result: 3221

- DICON = +0049%56 Description: First four digits are inserted.


dial info: 1 Two digits are appended.

Result: 0049156

- DICON = +(ANUM)!4 Description: First four digits of A-number


dial info: 23 567890 are inserted.

Result: 567823

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...40 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

ZONDAT ZONING AFTER DATA MODIFICATION

This parameter specifies if the digits before DICON modification


or the digits after DICON modification should be used for zoning.
Prerequisites:
- This parameter is only applicable if parameter DICON
is entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N ZONE BEFORE DIGIT MODIFICATION


NO ZONE BEFORE DIGIT MODIFICATION
Y ZONE AFTER DIGIT MODIFICATION
YES ZONE AFTER DIGIT MODIFICATION

NPDAT NUM PORT AFTER DATA MODIF.

This parameter specifies which digits should be used for number

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DPFCACT- 4+
CR DPFCACT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

portability.
Notes:
- YES in combination with parameter DICON:
digits after digit modification (defined in DICON) should be
used for number portability.
- YES without parameter DICON:
all following digit modifications without parameter NPDAT
(defined in DICONs in following performed actions) should be
used for number portability.
- NO in combination with parameter DICON:
digits before digit modification should be used for number
portability.
- NO without parameter DICON:
all following digit modifications without parameter NPDAT
(defined in DICONs in following performed actions) should not
be used for number portability.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NUM PORT BEFORE DIGIT MODIF.


NO NUM PORT BEFORE DIGIT MODIF.
Y NUM PORT AFTER DIGIT MODIF.
YES NUM PORT AFTER DIGIT MODIF.

POSCC POSITION OF COUNTRY CODE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15, range of decimal numbers

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the origin mark 1 used for routing.


In case of MTC this parameter overwrites the ORIG1
for roaming and in case of CFGMSC and CFVMSC it
overwrites the ORIG1 for call forwarding.
ORIG1-Loop (ORIG1 is used for multiple SCP dialogues) is
not overwritten by this ORIG1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3839, range of decimal numbers

ORIG2 ORIGINATING MARK 2

This parameter specifies the origin mark 2 and overwrites


the existing origin mark 2 of the cell database or trunk group
database. It is used for zoning. It is only meaningful if ZOINF
has value NO.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...255, range of decimal numbers

MFCAT MFC CATEGORY

This parameter specifies a category which can be used by


digit translator (see CR CPT).

Meaning of decimal numbers:

0...subscriber category requested by MFC


1...subscriber
2...priority subscriber
3...test equipment
4...coin box
5...operator position
6...data transmission national
7...subscriber international
8...data transmission international
9...priority subscriber international
10...operator position international
11...category 11
12...category 12
13...category 13
14...category 14

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DPFCACT- 5+
CR DPFCACT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

15...category 15

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

FTCNTL FEATURE CONTROL

This parameter specifies the control of features.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: FEATURE
SREL SUBSCRIBER RELATED ROUTING
RELCALL RELEASE CALL
INCEPT INTERCEPT
RECALLDP RECALL DIGIT PROCESSING
DEFCALL DEFAULT CALL HANDLING FOR IN
TRPLOCNO TRANSPORT LOCNO VIA TUP
A prefix is cut from the called party number and
sent to the SCP in the next IN dialog. The first
digit of the called party number determines the
length of the prefix to be cut. The prefix itself
starts with the second digit.
Example:
- The called party number = 4123456789 results in
length = 4, prefix = 1234 and new called party
number = 56789.
MOCTOP1 CHRG MOC TRANSL. OTHER PARTY 1
If the dialed other party is modified (e.g. by
SDDPFC or by IN), the modified number is written
to the field "other party dialed number" of the
mobile call record for MOC.
SUPTCSI SUPPRESS T-CSI AND CFU
MTCOC CHARGING MTC TO OUTGOING CALL
If a call is routed to outgoing traffic after HLR
interrogation, the digits used for routing are
written to the field "other party translated
number" of the transit charging ticket, instead of
the MSRN.
SUPSCP SUPPRESS SCP
HOTBILRO HOT BILLING FOR ROAMERS
ANNDCS1 ANNOUNCEM. DURING CALL SETUP 1
ANNDCS2 ANNOUNCEM. DURING CALL SETUP 2
ANNDCS3 ANNOUNCEM. DURING CALL SETUP 3
ANNDCS4 ANNOUNCEM. DURING CALL SETUP 4
ANNDCS5 ANNOUNCEM. DURING CALL SETUP 5
INMDIG IN DIALOG WITH MODIFIED DIGITS
If DICON is used for digit modification the
original digits are normally sent to the SCP
during setup of a subsequent IN dialog.
With INMDIG the modified digits are sent instead
of the original digits.
DACTCLIR DEACTIVATE CLIR
ACTCLIR ACTIVATE CLIR
HALFRATE HALF RATE
PFXSCM PREFIX SERVICE CLASS MARK
ANUMEVAL A-NUMBER EVALUATION
ECTPRINT EMERGENCY CALL TRACE PRINTOUT
MOCTOP2 CHRG MOC TRANSL. OTHER PARTY 2
If the dialed other party is modified by SDDPFC,
the modified number is written to the field "other
party dialed number" of the mobile call record for
MOC.
SUPMTPY SUPPRESS MULTI PARTY
Suppress the supplementary services multi party
and call hold.
LIGMSC LAWFUL INTERCEPTION IN GMSC
SUPUSSD SUPPRESS USSD
DEBIT USSD DEBIT SUBSCRIBER
FTCNTL29 FEATURE CONTROL 29
FTCNTL30 FEATURE CONTROL 30
FTCNTL31 FEATURE CONTROL 31
FTCNTL32 FEATURE CONTROL 32

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DPFCACT- 6+
CR DPFCACT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

FTCNTL33 FEATURE CONTROL 33


FTCNTL34 FEATURE CONTROL 34
FTCNTL35 FEATURE CONTROL 35
FTCNTL36 FEATURE CONTROL 36
FTCNTL37 FEATURE CONTROL 37
FTCNTL38 FEATURE CONTROL 38
FTCNTL39 FEATURE CONTROL 39
FTCNTL40 FEATURE CONTROL 40
FTCNTL41 FEATURE CONTROL 41
FTCNTL42 FEATURE CONTROL 42
FTCNTL43 FEATURE CONTROL 43
FTCNTL44 FEATURE CONTROL 44
FTCNTL45 FEATURE CONTROL 45
FTCNTL46 FEATURE CONTROL 46
FTCNTL47 FEATURE CONTROL 47
FTCNTL48 FEATURE CONTROL 48
FTCNTL49 FEATURE CONTROL 49
FTCNTL50 FEATURE CONTROL 50
FTCNTL51 FEATURE CONTROL 51
FTCNTL52 FEATURE CONTROL 52
FTCNTL53 FEATURE CONTROL 53
FTCNTL54 FEATURE CONTROL 54
FTCNTL55 FEATURE CONTROL 55

b: AUTHORIZATION
N FEATURE NOT ALLOWED
NO FEATURE NOT ALLOWED
Y FEATURE ALLOWED
YES FEATURE ALLOWED

Compatibilities:
- a=SREL
- a=ANUMEVAL
Default Behavior:
- If this information unit is not entered the default
value is YES.

c: POSITION OF SERVICE INDICATOR=


1...15, range of decimal numbers

It is necessary to enter this parameter unit, if


subscriber related routing is permitted for foreign
subscribers and the length of the country code and
national destination code of foreign subscribers home
PLMN is different to the length of country code and
national destination code of this PLMN.
Compatibilities:
- a=SREL
- b=YES

IN INTELLIGENT NETWORK SERVICE

This parameter specifies the intelligent network service.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LENGTH OF IN SUBSCRIBER NUMBER=


0...15, range of decimal numbers

This information unit describes the minimum length


of available digits.

b: IN SERVICE=
1...6 characters from the
text string character set, enclosed in "

This information unit describes name of the IN service trigger


profile.
Prerequisites:
- The specified IN service must have been created with the
command CR INTRIG.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DPFCACT- 7+
CR DPFCACT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ZDIG LANGUAGE DIGIT

This parameter specifies the language digit which can be


evaluated by digit translator (see CR CPT).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DPFCACT- 8-
DISP DPFCACT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DPFC ACTION

This command displays subscriber dependent digit processing feature


control action data.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP DPFCACT : ACTION= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACTION ACTION TO BE PERFORMED

This parameter specifies the name of an action.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DPFCACT- 1-


CAN DPFCDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL DPFC EVALUATION DATA

This command deletes subscriber dependent digit processing feature


control depending evaluation criterion data and the assignment of
assigned actions.
It is possible to delete the assignment of assigned actions for the
feature. The feature and the remained actions are still assigned.
All evaluation parameters for the specified feature must be entered.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,IMSI= 11 1
1 CAN DPFCDAT : FEAT= ,CALLTYP= ,ACTION= 1Z,MSTYPE=Y1 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
1 [,MSISDN=] [,INCEPT=] [,SCM=] [,MSCAT=] 1
1 1
1 [,CODE=] [,NOD=] [,NPRES=] [,LOCNO=] [,ORIG1=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,SSIND=] [,SCP=] [,CRIT1=] [,CRIT2=] [,CRIT3=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FEAT FEATURE

This parameter specifies the feature name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CALLTYP CALL TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of call.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

MOC MOBILE ORIGINATING CALL


MTC MOBILE TERMINATING CALL
USSD UNSTRUCTURED SUPPL. SERV. DATA
CFGMSC CALL FORWARDING GATEWAY MSC
CFVMSC CALL FORWARDING VISITED MSC
PRETRANS PRE DIGIT TRANSLATION
NPP NUMBER PORTABILITY PROCESSING
ICALL INCOMING CALL

ACTION ACTION TO BE PERFORMED

This parameter specifies the name of an action.


Notes:
- Up to 8 actions can be assigned.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

IMSI INT. MOBILE SUBSCRIBER ID

This parameter specifies the leading digits of international


mobile subscriber identification. IMSI can be used to distinguish

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DPFCDAT- 1+


CAN DPFCDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

between subscribers from different PLMNs or between subscribers


from different HLRs. The evaluation of the full IMSI is possible.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit decimal number

MSTYPE TYPE OF MOBILE SUBSCRIBER

This parameter specifies the type of the mobile subscriber


(mobile subscriber of the own or of a foreign PLMN).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

OWN MS OF OWN PLMN


FOREIGN MS OF FOREIGN PLMN

MSISDN MOBILE SUBSCRIBER ISDN NUMBER

This parameter specifies the leading digits of mobile subscriber


ISDN number. The evaluation of the full MSISDN is possible.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit decimal number

INCEPT INTERCEPT EVALUATION

This parameter specifies if call is leading to intercept or not.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NORMAL CALL SETUP


NO NORMAL CALL SETUP
Y CALL LEADING TO INTERCEPT
YES CALL LEADING TO INTERCEPT

SCM SERVICE CLASS MARK

This parameter specifies the service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...21 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

MSCAT MOBILE SUBSCRIBER CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the mobile subscriber category


which is assigned to a subscriber.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...255, range of decimal numbers

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter specifies the digit combination to be evaluated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...20 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NOD NUMBER OF DIGITS

This parameter specifies the number of digits.


It is possible to evaluate a digit length from 1 to
maximum 32 digits. Value 32 means an evaluation of
32 and more digits.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DPFCDAT- 2+


CAN DPFCDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NPRES NUM PORT RESULT EVALUATION

This parameter specifies if number portability was successful.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UNSUC NUM PORT QUERY UNSUCCESSFUL


SUC NUM PORT QUERY SUCCESSFUL

LOCNO LOCATION NUMBER

This parameter specifies the leading digits of LOCATION NUMBER.


The evaluation of full LOCATION NUMBER is possible.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the origin mark 1


used for routing.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3839, range of decimal numbers

SSIND SUPPL. SERVICES INDICATOR

This parameter specifies a supplementary service code.


It is possible to evaluate supplementery services
which are active.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...255, range of decimal numbers

SCP SERVICE CONTROL POINT DIALOG

This parameter specifies the service control point dialog.


It allows the use of subscriber dependent digit processing
and feature control also after IN dialogs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INV DIALOG INVOLVED


NOTINV DIALOG NOT INVOLVED

CRIT1 CRITERION 1

This parameter specifies an evaluation criterion.


At present but it is not in use.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

CRIT2 CRITERION 2

This parameter specifies an evaluation criterion.


At present but it is not in use.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

CRIT3 CRITERION 3

This parameter specifies an evaluation criterion.


At present but it is not in use.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DPFCDAT- 3-


CR DPFCDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE DPFC EVALUATION DATA

This command creates subscriber dependent digit processing


feature control evaluation data and assigns up to eight actions.
If evaluation criterion for a feature is already created additional
actions can be assigned.
The maximum number of assigned actions and references to other
evaluation data is eight.
If all evaluation criteria fit exactly to data of a certain call the
assigned actions are executed.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,IMSI= 11 1
1 CR DPFCDAT : FEAT= ,CALLTYP= ,ACTION= 1Z,MSTYPE=Y1 [,MSISDN=] 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
1 [,INCEPT=] [,SCM=] [,MSCAT=] [,CODE=] [,NOD=] 1
1 1
1 [,NPRES=] [,LOCNO=] [,ORIG1=] [,SSIND=] [,SCP=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,CRIT1=] [,CRIT2=] [,CRIT3=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FEAT FEATURE

This parameter is used to identify the set of evaluation data defined


by this command. If the evaluation data will be modified also the
feature name must be changed. The action has no influence for feature
name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CALLTYP CALL TYPE

This parameter specifies at which type of call the condition


should be evaluated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

MOC MOBILE ORIGINATING CALL


MTC MOBILE TERMINATING CALL
USSD UNSTRUCTURED SUPPL. SERV. DATA
CFGMSC CALL FORWARDING GATEWAY MSC
CFVMSC CALL FORWARDING VISITED MSC
PRETRANS PRE DIGIT TRANSLATION
NPP NUMBER PORTABILITY PROCESSING
ICALL INCOMING CALL

ACTION ACTION TO BE PERFORMED

This parameter specifies the name of an action.


Prerequisites:
- The action must have been created with the command CR DPFCACT.
Notes:
- Up to 8 actions can be assigned.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DPFCDAT- 1+
CR DPFCDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

IMSI INT. MOBILE SUBSCRIBER ID

This parameter specifies the leading digits of international


mobile subscriber identification. IMSI can be used to distinguish
between subscribers from different PLMNs or between subscribers
from different HLRs. The evaluation of the full IMSI is possible.
Which IMSI is used for condition evaluation depends on the
CALLTYP:
MOC/USSD : A-subscriber IMSI
MTC : B-subscriber IMSI
CFGMSC/CFVMSC : B-subscriber IMSI (IMSI of forwarding subscriber)

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit decimal number

MSTYPE TYPE OF MOBILE SUBSCRIBER

This parameter specifies the type of the mobile subscriber


(mobile subscriber of the own or of a foreign PLMN).
Compatibilities:
- This parameter is not allowed if parameter IMSI was specified.
- Only applicable for call type MOC and USSD.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

OWN MS OF OWN PLMN


FOREIGN MS OF FOREIGN PLMN

MSISDN MOBILE SUBSCRIBER ISDN NUMBER

This parameter specifies the leading digits of mobile subscriber


ISDN number. The evaluation of the full MSISDN is possible.
Which MSISDN is used for condition evaluation depends on the
CALLTYP:
MOC/MTC/ICALL : A-subscriber MSISDN
CFGMSC/CFVMSC : B-subscriber MSISDN (MSISDN of forwarding subscriber)
PRETRANS : In ability to operation after PRETRANS.
This information is only visible during call processing
access and consists of following possibilities:
MOC/MTC/CFGMSC/CFVMSC/ICALL : see above
HANDOVER/CCBS : no evaluation will be done
NPP : not possible

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit decimal number

INCEPT INTERCEPT EVALUATION

This parameter specifies if call is leading to intercept or not.


Notes:
- If value YES : This condition is fulfilled if call is
leading to intercept.
If value NO : This condition is fulfilled if normal
call setup is done.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NORMAL CALL SETUP


NO NORMAL CALL SETUP
Y CALL LEADING TO INTERCEPT
YES CALL LEADING TO INTERCEPT

SCM SERVICE CLASS MARK

This parameter specifies the service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DPFCDAT- 2+
CR DPFCDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...21 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

MSCAT MOBILE SUBSCRIBER CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the mobile subscriber category


which is assigned to a subscriber (see CR MSUB).
Only applicable for call type MOC and CFVMSC.

Values for the following categories:

1...operator language french (OLFRENCH)


2...operator language english (OLENGLSH)
3...operator language german (OLGERMAN)
4...operator language russian (OLRUSSIA)
5...operator language spanish (OLSPANSH)
6...add. operator language 1 (OLADD1)
7...add. operator language 2 (OLADD2)
8...add. operator language 3 (OLADD3)
9...national operator (NATOPER)
10...ordinary calling subscriber (ORDINSUB)
11...priority subscriber (PRIOSUB)
13...data call (DATACALL)
14...test call (TESTCALL)
15...payphone (PAYPHONE)
224...verification subscriber (VERIFSUB)
225...priority 1 subscriber (PRIO1SUB)
226...priority 2 subscriber (PRIO2SUB)
227...priority 3 subscriber (PRIO3SUB)
228...debit subscriber without record (PPSCSUB)
229...debit subscriber with record (PPSCSUBR)
240...ORDINSUB without charging (ORDFREE)
244...PRIOSUB without charging (PRIOFREE)

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...255, range of decimal numbers

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter specifies the digit combination to be evaluated.


Evaluation depends on the following CALLTYP:
MOC/ICALL/NPP : The originally dialed digits will be
evaluated before any digit modification takes place.
Except subscriber dependent digit processing and
feature control is called twice if during the first
evaluation feature control has value RECALLDP
(see CR DPFCACT). Than the long number will be
used for evaluation.
MTC : The mobile station roaming number received from VLR
will be evaluated.
USSD : The USSD string will be evaluated. Only the feature code is
expected.
Notes:
- Characters * and # within the first three digits of the USSD
string must not be entered.
- Character * at another position of the USSD string has to be
entered as hexadecimal number B.
- Character # at another position of the USSD string has to be
entered as hexadecimal number C.
- All characters being neither decimal numbers nor * or # have
to be entered as hexadecimal number A.
- For USSD strings using a not supported alphabet the
characters DDD have to be entered.
Examples:
- Feature code = *#132# CODE = 132C
- Feature code = **23#* CODE = 23CB
- Feature code = #***657*# CODE = B657BC
- Feature code = *100 NDC262# CODE = 100AAAA262C
CFGMSC/CFVMSC : The forwarded to number will be evaluated.
The number always has to be entered in unknown format.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...20 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DPFCDAT- 3+
CR DPFCDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NOD NUMBER OF DIGITS

This parameter specifies the number of digits.


It is possible to evaluate a digit length from 1 to
maximum 32 digits. Value 32 means the condition is
fulfilled if NOD has value 32 or higher.
Evaluation depends on the following CALLTYP:
MOC/ICALL/NPP : The originally dialed digits will be
evaluated before any digit modification takes place.
Except subscriber dependent digit processing and
feature control is called twice if during the first
evaluation feature control has value RECALLDP
(see CR DPFCACT). Than the long number will be
used for evaluation.
MTC : The mobile station roaming number received from VLR
will be evaluated.
USSD : The USSD string will be evaluated. The characters # and * are
ignored within the first three characters of the USSD string.
CFGMSC/CFVMSC : The forwarded to number will be evaluated.
The number of digits always has to be entered for numbers in
unknown format.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32, range of decimal numbers

NPRES NUM PORT RESULT EVALUATION

This parameter specifies if number portability was successful.


Notes:
- If value SUC : This condition is fulfilled if number portability
was successful.
- If value UNSUC : This condition is fulfilled if number portability
was unsuccessful.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UNSUC NUM PORT QUERY UNSUCCESSFUL


SUC NUM PORT QUERY SUCCESSFUL

LOCNO LOCATION NUMBER

This parameter specifies the leading digits of LOCATION NUMBER.


The evaluation of full LOCATION NUMBER is possible.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the origin mark 1 used for routing.


Only applicable for call type MOC, MTC, CFGMSC,
CFVMSC and ICALL.
Reserved a values (e.g. a for MTC or a
for forwarded calls) are not relevant for this parameter.
If the origin mark 1 is set to a reserved value, the previous
a value is evaluated instead of the reserved value.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3839, range of decimal numbers

SSIND SUPPL. SERVICES INDICATOR

This parameter specifies a supplementary service code.


It is just possible to evaluate supplementery services
which are activated in the MSC.
Commandos for the activation status of supplementary services:
- DISP MSERVOPT
- DISP MSUB
- DISP MPRDDAT

SSIND for the GSM defined supplementary services:

16...all line identification SS

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DPFCDAT- 4+
CR DPFCDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

17...calling line identification present


18...calling line identification restriction
19...connected line identification present
20...connected line identification restriction
21...malicious call identification
32...all forwarding SS
33...call forwarding unconditional
40...all conditional forwarding SS
41...call forwarding on subscriber busy
42...call forwarding on no reply
43...call forwarding on subscriber not reachable
48...all call offering SS (includes also all call forwarding SS)
49...call transfer (CALLTRAN)
50...mobile access hunting
64...all call completion SS
65...call waiting
66...call hold
67...completion of call to busy subscriber (NATCCBS)
80...all multy party SS
81...multy party service (MPTY)
96...all community of interest SS
97...closed user group
112...all charging SS
113...advice of charge: information
114...advice of charge: charging
128...all additional info transfer SS
129...user to user signalling (USERSIG1)
144...all call restriction SS
145...barring of outgoing calls (CBO)
146...barring of all outgoing calls (CBOC)
147...barring of outgoing international calls (CBOIC)
148...barring of outgoing international calls except those
directed to HPLMN (CBOICEXH)
153...barring of all incoming calls (CBIC)
154...barring of incoming calls (CBI)
155...barring of incoming calls roaming outside HPLMN (CBICROUT)

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...255, range of decimal numbers

SCP SERVICE CONTROL POINT DIALOG

This parameter specifies the service control point dialog.


It allows the use of subscriber dependent digit processing
and feature control also after IN dialogs.
Notes:
- If value INV : The dialogue will be done. This
condition is fulfilled if subscriber
dependent digit processing and feature
control is called after a IN dialogue.
If value NOTINV : The dialogue will not be done.
This condition is fulfilled if
subscriber dependent digit processing
and feature control is done before
IN dialogue.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INV DIALOG INVOLVED


NOTINV DIALOG NOT INVOLVED

CRIT1 CRITERION 1

This parameter specifies an evaluation criterion.


At present but it is not in use.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

CRIT2 CRITERION 2

This parameter specifies an evaluation criterion.


At present but it is not in use.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DPFCDAT- 5+
CR DPFCDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

0...15, range of decimal numbers

CRIT3 CRITERION 3

This parameter specifies an evaluation criterion.


At present but it is not in use.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DPFCDAT- 6-
DISP DPFCDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DPFC EVALUATION DATA

This command displays subscriber dependent digit processing


feature control evaluation data and the assigned actions to
be performed.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1FEAT= 1 1
1 1ACTION= 1 1
1 1CODE= 1 (;) 1
1 DISP DPFCDAT : ZMSISDN= Y Z Y 1
1 1IMSI= 1 *!+ 1
1 1CALLTYP=1 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FEAT FEATURE

This parameter specifies the name of the feature.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ACTION ACTION TO BE PERFORMED

This parameter specifies the name of an action.


Prerequisites:
- The action must have been created with the command CR DPFCACT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION

This parameter specifies the digit combination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...20 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

MSISDN MOBILE SUBSCRIBER ISDN NUMBER

This parameter specifies the leading digits of mobile subscriber


ISDN number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit decimal number

IMSI INT. MOBILE SUBSCRIBER ID

This parameter specifies the leading digits of international


mobile subscriber identification.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit decimal number

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DPFCDAT- 1+


DISP DPFCDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CALLTYP CALL TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of call.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

MOC MOBILE ORIGINATING CALL


MTC MOBILE TERMINATING CALL
USSD UNSTRUCTURED SUPPL. SERV. DATA
CFGMSC CALL FORWARDING GATEWAY MSC
CFVMSC CALL FORWARDING VISITED MSC
PRETRANS PRE DIGIT TRANSLATION
NPP NUMBER PORTABILITY PROCESSING
ICALL INCOMING CALL

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DPFCDAT- 2-


CAN DPFCEXCL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL DPFC ACTION EXCLUSION

This command cancels data for subscriber dependent digit processing


feature control action exclusion.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN DPFCEXCL : ACTION= [,EXCLACT=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACTION ACTION TO BE PERFORMED

This parameter specifies the name of an action.


Prerequisites:
- The action must have been created with the command CR DPFCACT.
- It is possible to specify up to 8 excluded actions.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

EXCLACT EXCLUDED ACTION

This parameter specifies the name of excluded actions.


Default behavior:
- If this parameter is not entered all actions defined
as excluded actions for the specified action are canceled.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DPFCEXCL- 1-


DISP DPFCEXCL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY DPFC ACTION EXCLUSION

This command displays data for subscriber dependent digit processing


feature control action exclusion.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP DPFCEXCL : ACTION= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACTION ACTION TO BE PERFORMED

This parameter specifies the name of an action.


Prerequisites:
- The action must have been created with the command CR DPFCACT.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DPFCEXCL- 1-


ENTR DPFCEXCL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER DPFC ACTION EXCLUSION

This command enters data for subscriber dependent digit processing


feature control action exclusion.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR DPFCEXCL : ACTION= ,EXCLACT= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ACTION ACTION TO BE PERFORMED

This parameter specifies the name of an action.


Prerequisites:
- The action must have been created with the command CR DPFCACT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

EXCLACT EXCLUDED ACTION

This parameter specifies the name of excluded action.


Prerequisites:
- The action must have been created with the command CR DPFCACT.
Notes:
- It is possible to specify up to 8 excluded actions.
If more than 8 excluded actions have to be assigned
it is necessary to enter more commands.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR DPFCEXCL- 1-


CAN DVGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL DEVICE GROUP

This command cancels a device group.

Prerequisite:
- the device group must exist
- the device group must not be assigned to a message group.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN DVGRP : DVGRP= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DVGRP DEVICE GROUP

This parameter designates a device group of the message control.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN DVGRP- 1-


CR DVGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE DEVICEGROUP

This command creates a device group from different types of output device.
A distinction is made between local devices (archive and
functional O&M terminals), remote devices (processors with their
respective applications) and the source terminal.

Prerequisite:
- the device group must not already exist,
- the pair of processor-name applications specified in parameter REMDEV
must not be assigned to a server which cannot process print or dialog
tasks,
- the output devices must exist,
- no more than 5 output devices may be specified,
- if parameter SRC=NO is entered, either parameter
LOCDEV or parameter REMDEV must be specified.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR DVGRP : DVGRP= <,LOCDEV= ,REMDEV= ,SRC=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DVGRP DEVICE GROUP

This parameter designates a device group to the message


control.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LOCDEV LOCAL DEVICE

This parameter designates a local output device.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: LOCAL DEVICE NAME=


1...17 characters from the
symbolic name character set

b: LOCAL DEVICE TYPE


FUOMT FUNCTIONAL O&M-TERMINAL
AFILE ARCHIVE FILE

REMDEV REMOTE DEVICE

This parameter designates an output device in the network.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: PROCESSOR NAME=
1...8 characters from the
text string character set, enclosed in "

b: APPLICATION IDENTIFICATION=
1...5 characters from the
symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DVGRP- 1+
CR DVGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SRC SOURCE O&M TERMINAL

This parameter specifies whether the input terminal is to serve


as output device for a device group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO OUTPUT NOT ON SOURCE TERMINAL


YES OUTPUT ON SOURCE TERMINAL

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR DVGRP- 2-
SEL DVGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SELECT DEVICE GROUP

This command selects those device groups to which


at least one of the specified output devices is assigned.
This data is then output as a table.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 SEL DVGRP : <LOCDEV= ,REMDEV= ,SRC=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LOCDEV LOCAL DEVICE

This parameter designates a local output device.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: LOCAL DEVICE NAME=


1...17 characters from the
symbolic name character set

b: LOCAL DEVICE TYPE


FUOMT FUNCTIONAL O&M-TERMINAL
AFILE ARCHIVE FILE

REMDEV REMOTE DEVICE

This parameter designates an output device in the network.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: PROCESSOR NAME=
1...8 characters from the
text string character set, enclosed in "

b: APPLICATION IDENTIFICATION=
1...5 characters from the
symbolic name character set

SRC SOURCE O&M TERMINAL

This parameter specifies whether the input terminal is to serve


as output device for a device group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO OUTPUT NOT ON SOURCE TERMINAL


YES OUTPUT ON SOURCE TERMINAL

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SEL DVGRP- 1-


DISP DVGRPLNK

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISP DEVICE GROUP LINK

This command displays the output devices to which the device groups
specified in parameter DVGRP are assigned. The display is table.
In this way, a distinction is made between local output devices,
remote output devices and the source terminal as output device.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP DVGRPLNK : DVGRP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DVGRP DEVICE GROUP

This parameter designates a device group of the message control.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP DVGRPLNK- 1-


MOD DVGRPLNK

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY DEVICE GROUP LINK

This command modifies the assignment of a device group to the respective


output devices. With parameter SRC, it is possible to indicate whether
the source terminal is to be used as output device.

Prerequisites:
- When adding and replacing an output device, those output devices
specified in parameters LOCDEV or REMDEV must have been previously
created using command CR AFILE or CR FUOMT, if LOCDEV was entered
and CR PRO and possibly CR APPL, if REMDEV was entered.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD DVGRPLNK : DVGRP= <,LOCDEV= ,REMDEV= ,SRC=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DVGRP DEVICE GROUP

This parameter specifies a customer device group of the message


control.

Incompatibilities:
- If the DVGRP is linked to the MSGRP ’MSYP.ALARM’ or
’MSYP.REPORT’ it must consist only of output devices of
DCP type or applications which can handle binary structured
outputs.
These applications must have been created with the command
CR APPL with APPLID = SMMLB.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LOCDEV LOCAL DEVICE

This parameter specifies a local output device.

n/o
n/
/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

a-b

a: LOCAL DEVICE NAME=


1...17 characters from the
symbolic name character set

b: LOCAL DEVICE TYPE


FUOMT FUNCTIONAL O&M-TERMINAL
AFILE ARCHIVE FILE

REMDEV REMOTE DEVICE

This parameter specifies an output device in the O&M network.

n/o
n/
/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DVGRPLNK- 1+


MOD DVGRPLNK

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a-b

a: PROCESSOR NAME=
1...8 characters from the
text string character set, enclosed in "

b: APPLICATION IDENTIFICATION=
1...5 characters from the
symbolic name character set

SRC SOURCE O&M TERMINAL

This parameter specifies whether the input terminal is to serve


as output device for a device group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO OUTPUT NOT ON SOURCE TERMINAL


YES OUTPUT ON SOURCE TERMINAL

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD DVGRPLNK- 2-


CAN EAL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL EXTERNAL ALARM LINE

This command cancels the assignment of an alarm text for an external alarm
line or for a DLU external alarm line. In case of DLU it also cancels the
assignment of the alarm priority and set it to the default value "critical".

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN EAL : SITE= ,EAL= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SITE HARDWARE INSTALLATION SITE

This parameter specifies whether an exchange or a digital


line unit is involved.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

EXCH EXCHANGE
DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT

EAL EXTERNAL ALARM LINE NUMBER

Compatibilities:
1...16 for DLU
1...24 for EXCH

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN EAL- 1-


CR EAL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE EXTERNAL ALARM LINE

This command assigns an alarm text to a specified external alarm line or


for a DLU external alarm line. In case of DLU it also assigns a priority
to an external alarm line.

Prerequisite:
- The command is rejected, if an entry already exists for
the specified external alarm line.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR EAL : SITE= ,EAL= ,TEXTNO= [,ALPRIO=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SITE HARDWARE INSTALLATION SITE

This parameter specifies whether an exchange or a digital


line unit is involved.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

EXCH EXCHANGE
DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT

EAL EXTERNAL ALARM LINE NUMBER

Compatibilities:
1...16 for DLU
1...24 for EXCH

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24, range of decimal numbers

TEXTNO TEXT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the number assigned to an alarm text.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...40, range of decimal numbers

ALPRIO ALARM PRIORITY

This parameter specifies the priority of an alarm.

Prerequisites:
SITE = DLU

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

MINOR MINOR ALARM


MAJOR MAJOR ALARM
CRITICAL CRITICAL ALARM

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR EAL- 1-
DISP EAL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY EXTERNAL ALARM LINE

This command displays the assignment of a single external alarm line


or of all external alarm lines of the exchange or of the DLU.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP EAL : SITE= ,EAL= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SITE HARDWARE INSTALLATION SITE

This parameter specifies whether an exchange or a digital


line unit is involved.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

EXCH EXCHANGE
DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT

EAL EXTERNAL ALARM LINE NUMBER

Compatibilities:
1...16 for DLU
1...24 for EXCH

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP EAL- 1-


CR EALLVL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE EAL LEVEL

This command creates the "No Alarm" level for an external alarm line
of a specified DLU.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR EALLVL : DLU= ,EAL= ,LVL= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...2550, range of decimal numbers

EAL EXTERNAL ALARM LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the number of an external alarm line.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

LVL ELECTRICAL NON-ALARM LEVEL

This parameter specifies whether a high or a low signal is


to be transmitted when there is no alarm.

Default: HIGH

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

HIGH HIGH LINE LEVEL


LOW LOW LINE LEVEL

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR EALLVL- 1-
DISP EALLVL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY EAL LEVEL

This command displays the "No Alarm" level for an external alarm line
or for all external alarm lines of the specified DLU.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP EALLVL : DLU= ,EAL= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

Here the number of the affected DLU is specified in the


three high-order positions. ( Value range 1 to 255 ). The
lowest-order position must always be 0.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...2550, range of decimal numbers

EAL EXTERNAL ALARM LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the number of an external alarm line.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP EALLVL- 1-


CAN EASIGLME

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel EADAS Signaling Link Measurement

This task deletes the following measurement type for the switch:

- EADAS sign.link measurem.

Notes :
Valid parametercombinations are :
- Net ID or Net name , Link set ID, Link code
- Link set name, Link code

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN EASIGLME : [Net name=] [,Net ID=] [,Link set name=] 1
1 1
1 [,Link set ID=] ,Link code= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Net name

This parameter identifies the name of the own signaling


point within a signaling network.
Possible values: up to 12 characters
Allowed characters: all letters (no difference between
small and capital letters),
all numerals, ’+’,’#’,’*’,’%’,’.’

Net ID

This parameter identifies the ID of the own


signaling point within a signaling network.
Possible values: 1..32

Link set name

This parameter represents the name of the signaling link set.


Possible values: up to 12 characters

Link set ID

This parameter identifies the signaling link set.


Possible values: 1..1024

Link code

This parameter is used to identify a particular


Signaling link instance. The Link code at both ends of
the Signaling link must have the same value.
Possible values: 0..15

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN EASIGLME- 1-


CR EASIGLME

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create EADAS Signaling Link Measurement

This task creates the type of measurement for Signaling link:

The following types of measurement are supported :

-EADAS sign.link measurem.


This managed object class contains all EADAS signaling link
measurement data. The preferred granularity period is 30 minutes.
The parameters are read-only. For counter parameters filtering
is not possible.

The following counter attributes are supported:

- transmittedOctetsSIFSIO:
Number of SIF and SIO octets transmitted on a link basis
within the specified granularity period.
This attribute represents measurement Q.752/3.1.

- retransmittedOctets:
The L2 Message Handling counts all octets retransmitted on a
link basis within the specified granularity period
This attribute represents measurement Q.752/3.2.

- transmittedMSUs:
Countof all transmitted MSU excluding MSUs which are
retransmitted. This count is performed on a link basis within
the specified granularity period.
This attribute represents measurement Q.752/3.3.

- receivedOctetsSIFSIO:
Number of SIF and SIO octets received on a link basis
within the specified granularity period.
This attribute represents measurement Q.752/3.4.

- receivedMSUs:
Count of all MSUs received on a linkbasis within the specified
granularity period. All MSUs that are discarded at L2 are not
counted.
This attribute represents measurement Q.752/3.5.

- signUnitsReceived:
Number of signalling units in error.
Examples of these errors are the following:
- Checksum error detected for the signalling unit.
- SIF & SIO length error has exceeded more than 272 bytes.
This attribute represents measurement Q.752/1.8.

- slInServiceDuration:
The begin count of the duration of the link in service is started
when the link state is set to active. The link state is set to
active when the link is aligned and passed link test. The duration
count is restarted for each granularity period.
This attribute represents measurement Q.752/1.1

- slUnavailabilityDuration:
The begin count of the duration of the link unavailable for any
reason is started when the link state is changed to locally
inhibited, remotely inhibited , both locally and remotely
inhibited, remote processor outage or failed. The duration count
is restarted for each granularity period.
This attribute represents measurement Q.752/2.1

- slUnavailabilityDuration (INHIBIT):
The begin count of the duration of the link unavailable due to
inhibit state is started when the link state is changed to inhibit.
The duration count is halted when the link state is out of
inhibit state.
The duration count is restarted for each granularity period.

- slLocalInhibited:
The count of this measurement is the sum of all events of
link inhibited locally.

- slRemoteInhibited:
The count of this measurement is the sum of all events of
link inhibited remotely.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR EASIGLME- 1+
CR EASIGLME

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- slLocalBlocked:
The count of this measurement is th esum of all events of
link blocked locally (local processor outage).

- slRemoteBlocked:
The count of this measurement is the sum of all events of
link blocked remotely (remote processor outage).

- slFailed:
The begin count of the duration of the link failure is started
when the link state is changed to failed. The duration count is
halted when the link is out of failed state. The duration count
is restarted for each granularity period. The link state in this
phase is out of service due to MTP level 2 (NB) or SAAL (NNI)
layer is not available, or hardware failure in the SLT. No MSUs
messages can be sent on this link.
This attribute represents measurement Q.752/2.7.

Valid mandatory inputparameter combinations are :


- Net ID or Net name, Link set ID, Link code
- Link set name, Link code

- Admin. state is set to UNLOCKED


- all other attributes are set to initial values

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR EASIGLME : [Net name=] [,Net ID=] [,Link set name=] 1
1 1
1 [,Link set ID=] ,Link code= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Net name

This parameter identifies the name of the own signaling


point within a signaling network.
Possible values: up to 12 characters
Allowed characters: all letters (no difference between
small and capital letters),
all numerals, ’+’,’#’,’*’,’%’,’.’

Net ID

This parameter identifies the ID of the own


signaling point within a signaling network.
Possible values: 1..32

Link set name

This parameter represents the name of the signaling link set.


Possible values: up to 12 characters

Link set ID

This parameter identifies the signaling link set.


Possible values: 1..1024

Link code

This parameter is used to identify a particular


Signaling link instance. The Link code at both ends of
the Signaling link must have the same value.
Possible values: 0..15

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR EASIGLME- 2-
DISP EASIGLME

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display EADAS Signaling Link Measurement

This task displays the following measurement type for the switch:

- EADAS sign.link measurem.

Notes :
Valid mandatory inputparameter combinations are :
- one EADAS sign.link measurem. in one Signaling link set
- Net ID or Net name, Link set ID, Link code
- Link set name, Link code
- all EADAS sign.link measurem. of one signLinkset
- Net ID or Net name and Link set ID
- Link set name
- all EADAS sign.link measurem. of one network
- Net ID or Net name

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP EASIGLME : [Net name=] [,Net ID=] [,Link set name=] 1
1 1
1 [,Link set ID=] [,Link code=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Net name

This parameter identifies the name of the own signaling


point within a signaling network.
Possible values: up to 12 characters
Allowed characters: all letters (no difference between
small and capital letters),
all numerals, ’+’,’#’,’*’,’%’,’.’

Net ID

This parameter identifies the ID of the own


signaling point within a signaling network.
Possible values: 1..32

Link set name

This parameter represents the name of the signaling link set.


Possible values: up to 12 characters

Link set ID

This parameter identifies the signaling link set.


Possible values: 1..1024

Link code

This parameter is used to identify a particular


Signaling link instance. The Link code at both ends of
the Signaling link must have the same value.
Possible values: 0..15

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP EASIGLME- 1-


CAN EASIGLSME

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel EADAS Signaling Linkset Meas.

This task deletes the following measurement type for the switch:

- EADAS sign.link set meas.

Notes :
Valid inputparameter combinations are :
- Net ID, Link set ID
- Net name, Link set ID
- Link set name

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN EASIGLSME : [Net name=] [,Net ID=] [,Link set name=] 1
1 1
1 [,Link set ID=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Net name

This parameter identifies the name of the own signaling


point within a signaling network.
Possible values: up to 12 characters
Allowed characters: all letters (no difference between
small and capital letters),
all numerals, ’+’,’#’,’*’,’%’,’.’

Net ID

This parameter identifies the ID of the own


signaling point within a signaling network.
Possible values: 1..32

Link set name

This parameter represents the name of the signaling link set.


Possible values: up to 12 characters

Link set ID

This parameter identifies the signaling link set.


Possible values: 1..1024

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN EASIGLSME- 1-


CR EASIGLSME

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create EADAS Signaling Linkset Meas.

This task creates the measurement for Signaling link set:

- EADAS sign.link set meas.

The following measurement type is supported :

- EADAS sign.link set meas.


This managed object class contains all EADAS signaling linkset
measurement data, that do not depend on the current congestion
method. The preferred granularity period is 30 minutes.
The parameters are read-only. For counter parameters filtering
is not possible.

The following counter attributes are supported:

- transmittedOctetsSIFSIO:
Number of SIF and SIO octets transmitted on a link basis
within the specified granularity period.
This attribute represents measurement Q.752/3.1.

- retransmittedOctets:
The L2 Message Handling counts all octets retransmitted on a
link basis within the specified granularity period
This attribute represents measurement Q.752/3.2.

- transmittedMSUs:
Count of all transmitted MSU excluding MSUs which are
retransmitted. This count is performed on a link basis within
the specified granularity period.
This attribute represents measurement Q.752/3.3.

- receivedOctetsSIFSIO:
Number of SIF and SIO octets received on a link basis
within the specified granularity period.
This attribute represents measurement Q.752/3.4.

- receivedMSUs:
Count of all MSUs received on a link basis within the specified
granularity period. All MSUs that are discarded at L2 are not
counted.
This attribute represents measurement Q.752/3.5.

- discardedMSUs (buffer overflow):


Count of all dicarded MSUs due to transmission buffer overflow
received on a link basis within the specified granularity period.

- discardedMSUs (congestion L1):


Once the signalling link congestion threshold level 1 is crossed
then L3 message handling discards the outgoing MSUs and counts
the number of MSU discarded at threshold level 1 on a link basis
within the specified granularity period.
sep messages are discarded at the onset threshold and stp messages
are discarded at the discard threshold.

- discardedMSUs (congestion L2):


Once the signalling link congestion threshold level 2 is crossed
then L3 message handling discards the outgoing MSUs and counts
the number of MSU discarded at threshold level 2 on a link basis
within the specified granularity period.
sep messages are discarded at the onset threshold and stp messages
are discarded at the discard threshold.

- discardedMSUs (congestion L3):


Once the signalling link congestion threshold level 3 is crossed
then L3 message handling discards the outgoing MSUs and counts
the number of MSU discarded at threshold level 3 on a link basis
within the specified granularity period.
sep messages are discarded at the onset threshold and stp messages
are discarded at the discard threshold.

Valid mandatory inputparameter combinations are :


- Net ID or Net name and Link set ID
- Link set name

- Admin. state is set to UNLOCKED

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR EASIGLSME- 1+
CR EASIGLSME

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- all other attributes are set to initial values

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR EASIGLSME : [Net name=] [,Net ID=] [,Link set name=] 1
1 1
1 [,Link set ID=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Net name

This parameter identifies the name of the own signaling


point within a signaling network.
Possible values: up to 12 characters
Allowed characters: all letters (no difference between
small and capital letters),
all numerals, ’+’,’#’,’*’,’%’,’.’

Net ID

This parameter identifies the ID of the own


signaling point within a signaling network.
Possible values: 1..32

Link set name

This parameter represents the name of the signaling link set.


Possible values: up to 12 characters

Link set ID

This parameter identifies the signaling link set.


Possible values: 1..1024

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR EASIGLSME- 2-
DISP EASIGLSME

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display EADAS Signaling Linkset Meas.

This task displays the following measurement type for the switch:

- EADAS sign.link set meas.

Notes :
Valid mandatory inputparameter combinations are :
- one EADAS sign.link set meas. of one network
- Net ID, Link set ID
- Net name, Link set ID
- Link set name

- all EADAS sign.link set meas. of one network


- Net ID
- Net name

- all EADAS sign.link set meas.


- no input

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP EASIGLSME : [Net name=] [,Net ID=] [,Link set name=] 1
1 1
1 [,Link set ID=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Net name

This parameter identifies the name of the own signaling


point within a signaling network.
Possible values: up to 12 characters
Allowed characters: all letters (no difference between
small and capital letters),
all numerals, ’+’,’#’,’*’,’%’,’.’

Net ID

This parameter identifies the ID of the own


signaling point within a signaling network.
Possible values: 1..32

Link set name

This parameter represents the name of the signaling link set.


Possible values: up to 12 characters

Link set ID

This parameter identifies the signaling link set.


Possible values: 1..1024

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP EASIGLSME- 1-


CAN EASIGNEME

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel EADAS Sign. Network El. Meas.

This task deletes the following measurement type for the switch:

- EADAS swit. element meas.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN EASIGNEME ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN EASIGNEME- 1-


CR EASIGNEME

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create EADAS Sign. Network El. Meas.

This task creates the following measurement type for the switch :

- EADAS netw. element meas.

The following measurement types are supported :

- EADAS netw. element meas.

This object class contains some US-specific measurements concerning node


isolation, transit MSUs, and originated and terminated octets.

The following counter attributes are supported:

- numInMSU:
The L3 message handling counts all MSUs received from the
network (excluding transit MSUs) on a network basis within
the specified granularity period (30 minutes).
This attribute represents measurement 1 TR 24.7.

- numTransitMSU:
If the own signalling point supports stp functionality then
L3 message handling counts all MSUs transit in the system
on a network basis within the specified granularity period (30 minutes).
This attribute represents measurement 1 TR 24.7.

- numOutMSU:
The L3 message handling counts its own MSUs formulated for
the outgoing direction and also its own MSUs in the outgoing
direction. This measurement consists of the sum of all outgoing
MSUs originated by both L3 network management and L3 message
handling within the specified granularity period (30 minutes).
This attribute represents measurement 1 TR 24.7.

- MSUOctetsTransit:
The L3 network management counts all MSU octets SIF & SIO
originated on a switch basis within the specified
granularity period (30 minutes).

- originatedOctetsSIFSIO:
The L3 message handling counts all MSU octets SIF & SIO
originated on a switch basis within the specified
granularity period (30 minutes).

- terminatedOctetsSIFSIO:
The L3 message handling counts all MSU octets SIF & SIO
terminated on a switch basis within the specified
granularity period (30 minutes).

- nodeIsolation:
The count of this measurement is the sum of all events of
unavailability of route set of all destinations for all networks.
This attribute represents measurement Q.752/4.9.

- nodeIsolationDuration:
The count of this measurement is the sum of all durations of
node isolation for any reason (see nodeIsolation).
This attribute represents measurement Q.752/4.10.

Notes :
- Admin. state is set to UNLOCKED
- all other attributes are set to initial values

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR EASIGNEME ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR EASIGNEME- 1+
CR EASIGNEME

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR EASIGNEME- 2-
DISP EASIGNEME

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display EADAS Sign. Network El. Meas.

This task displays the following measurement type for the switch:

- EADAS netw. element meas.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP EASIGNEME ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP EASIGNEME- 1-


EXEC EDTS8

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

EXECUTE EDT SYSTEM 8

This command calls the EDTS8 file editing subroutine to process SAM files.
EDTS8 processes control inputs in interactive mode from a data terminal or
in batch mode from a SAM file on disk. These control inputs are subdivided
into:
- Commands in command mode
Command mode is activated after EDTS8 has started or after data mode has
terminated.
- Data lines in data mode
Data mode is activated when a data line is input. EDTS8 interprets
all subsequent inputs as data lines. The changeover from data mode to
command mode is initiated by
pressing the input key
entering a period
end of a SAM file (with data lines)
- Dialog responses on the data terminal (in interactive mode)

All EDTS8 outputs appear on the data terminal. Optional outputs to a


printer are:
- An EDTS8 command log
- Contents of the EDTS8 line memory (file window)

When data are written to a SAM file, the specified lines of the EDTS8
line memory are written to disk. When data are read from a SAM file, the
specified records are entered as data lines in the EDTS8 line memory.
The records of this SAM file can be up to 252 bytes long.

EDTS8 commands

AGAIN Repetition of no more than the last 5 commands except


AGAIN and HELP

A P Output (print) of the last 5 commands


n Repetition of n commands
Repetition of the last command

CHANGE Changes in text lines or columns in specific lines

CH range domain search := new text


ALL search := new text
.. search := new text
search..:= new text
domain1 := new text
domain1 op search := new text

COPY Copy whole lines or columns to a required position

C range domain TO ln STEP m CLc


ST m

DELETE Delete specific lines

D range
domain search
domain op search

END End EDTS8

FILE Define file and type of access (Write or read)

F file INPUT OUTPUT


I O

HELP Summary of the operating instructions in English

H Command
Command OPD
OPD
OPD operand

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 EXEC EDTS8- 1+


EXEC EDTS8

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

INSERT Insert text or data sections in specific lines


in the required position

I range domain := new text


domain op search := new text
domain1 .. search := new text
search .. := new text
ALL search := new text
ALL search .. := new text

LIST List specific lines on the printer

L range domain NON HEX


search N H
domain1 op search

LOG Log the next commands on the printer


Activate the logging function
OFF Deactivate the logging function

MOVE Move lines or columns to the required position


The source data are deleted

M range domain TO ln STEP m CLc


ST m

NUMBER Renumber all lines

N Standard numbering 1,2,3...


ln STEP m
ST m

PRINT Print lines and columns on the data terminal

P range domain NON HEX


search N H
domain1 op search

READ Read in SAM files in the required position

R # file
recrange FROM file
recrange domain FR file

SELECT Select particular lines by deleting lines which are not


selected

S range
range domain search
range domain op search

SPACE Delete spaces to the left up to beginning of text or to


the right after end of text up to end of line

SP range R
L

TAB Tabulator declaration for data input in tabular form and


definition of a tab mark

T t CLn1 n2 n3 ....n32
OFF

TRANSLATE Translate data to EBCDIC or ASCII code

TR range domain TO EBCDIC

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 EXEC EDTS8- 2+


EXEC EDTS8

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E
ASCII
A

VERIFY If the text is modified using the commands CHANGE, INSERT,


MOVE, COPY and SELECT, all the lines concerned are output
as a verification

V Activate verification function


OFF Deactivate verification function

WRITE Write all or part of the line memory as a SAM file to


disk

W # file
EXTEND
range TO file EXT
range domain TO file EXT

ln Line input to the line memory, line number


STEP m domain :=data <<
ST m

range Line area


ln1 :ln2

domain Column area, column number

recchange Records (lines) in a SAM file

<< Command linkage with the command character

EDTS8 word symbols

A SCII USASCII code


A GAIN Command abbreviation
CH ANGE Command abbreviation
CL Column data
C OPY Command abbreviation
D ELETE Command abbreviation
E BCDIC EBCDIC code
END End of EDTS8
EXT ENT Extend file
F ILE Command abbreviation
FR OM Direction specification "from"
H ELP Command abbreviation
H EX Hexadecimal specification
I NPUT Read file
I NSERT Command abbreviation
L Left
L IST Command abbreviation
LOG IN log
M OVE Command abbreviation
N ON Output without line number
O UTPUT Write file
OFF Switch off
OPD Operand
P RINT Command abbreviation
R Right
R EAD Command abbreviation
REC Record of a SAM file
S ELECT Command abbreviation
SP ACE Command abbreviation
ST EP Command abbreviation
T AB Command abbreviation
TO Direction specification "to"
TR ANSLATE Command abbreviation
V ERIFY Command abbreviation
W RITE Command abbreviation

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 EXEC EDTS8- 3+


EXEC EDTS8

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

EDTS8 character symbols

+ Page forward
- Page backward
<< Command link, command character
% First line in line memory
* Current line in line memory
$ Last line in line memory
? Free space after last line in line memory
& Whole line memory
: Start:End
:= Is replaced by
.. Area before or after
= Equal to
/= Not equal to
< Less than
> Greater than
’ Limit
" Text separator
. Period, end of data

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 EXEC EDTS8 ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 EXEC EDTS8- 4-


REC EIR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RECORD EQUIPMENT IDENTITY REGISTER

This command records the equipment identity register related data.

Prerequisites:
- System time must be secure when the command is entered.

Notes:
- Only 1 measurement job can be started.
- The measurement can be stopped with STOP JOB if the time
parameter values allow a continuation of the job.
- This command is only allowed for an EIR.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command starts a semipermanent job. It can be canceled with CAN JOB.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REC EIR : UNIT= [,BEG=] [,TER=] [,IV=] [,PER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

UNIT UNIT

This parameter specifies the output unit and the form of output.
Only one of the possible alternatives may be selected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: DEVICE
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
If this option is selected, a measurement file
is created and the received traffic data are
output to this file. After the parameter has
been accepted and at the end of the last
recording, an acknowledgement is output to
the OMT. It includes the name of the file in
which the traffic data are available for
postprocessing.
For postprocessing, the data must first be
copied to tape.

Notes:
- Identifier a covers both MDD and MOD.

This information unit specifies the output unit.

b: FILETYPE
SINGLE SINGLE FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
output to single measurement files.
DAILY DAILY FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
output to daily files. This is appropriate in
connection with continuous measurements which
start immediately and have no defined end.
To secure the required space on disk, all 7
daily files (MO...SU) are prepared and created
before the command is accepted.
Time parameters are not permissible for these
measurements.
A daily file is closed at the end of the day
and a new file for the next day is automatically
created on disk or the existing file is replaced.
In the second and subsequent weeks, the file
for the same day of the week is overwritten.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC EIR- 1+


REC EIR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CYCLIC CYCLIC FILE


If this option is selected, the data are
written into a cyclic measurement file.
Time parameters are not permitted for these
measurements.
If the cyclic file runs full the newest
data will be lost.
This occurs after a period of two days.

This information unit specifies the desired output form


(daily , single or cyclic measurement files).

BEG BEGINNING DATE

This parameter specifies the measurement begin time.

Notes:
- The begin date BEG and/or the termination date TER must be
specified.
Exception : time parameters may not be specified for the data output
in daily and cyclic files.
- A maximum of four BEG dates (in ascending order) may be linked
with &. In case of linked BEG dates, TER is not permissible.
- The earliest possible begin date is the day after entry.
- It is not permissible to enter the command after 23:45 hours with a
begin date on the following day.
- The first measurement may not begin later than one month after the
current date. Subsequent measurements may not begin later than one
year after the current date.

Default: current date

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the year of the begin


date.

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the month of the begin


date.

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the day of the begin


date.

TER TERMINATING DATE

This parameter specifies the measurement termination date.

Notes:
- Only one termination date may be entered per command.
The earliest possible termination date is the day after entry.
- The measurement duration may not exceed one year.
- The begin date BEG and/or the termination date TER must
be specified.
Exception: time parameters may not be specified for data output
in daily and cyclic files.

Default: the end of the measurement is determined by the single day


measurement.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC EIR- 2+


REC EIR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the year in which


recording is to terminate.

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the month in which


recording is to terminate.

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the day on which


recording is to terminate.

IV INTERVAL TIME

This parameter specifies the measurement interval times.

Notes:
- A maximum of 4 measurement intervals may be linked with &.
- Interval times are only permissible in connection with a
begin date (BEG).

Incompatibilities:
- Intervals covering more than one day (e.g. 23-00-01-00).
- Intervals separated by a break of less than one hour.

Default: 24-hour measurement on the specified days.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: BEGIN HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the hour at which the


measurement interval begins.

b: BEGIN MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the minutes past the hour at


which the measurement interval begins.

Notes:
- Possible values : 0, 15, 30 and 45.

c: END HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the hour at which the


measurement interval terminates.

d: END MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the minutes past the hour at


which the measurement interval terminates.

Notes:
- Possible values : 0, 15, 30 and 45.

PER PERIODICAL WEEKDAY

This parameter specifies the days of the week on which

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC EIR- 3+


REC EIR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

recording is to take place.

Notes:
- The input of weekdays is only permissible in connection with
a termination date (TER).

Default: daily measurement during the measurement period.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC EIR- 4-


CAN ELMSG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

This command cancels an elementary message for a given OCANEQ variant.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN ELMSG : OCAVAR= ,ELMSGID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant equivalent to the


project-specific firmware label of OCANEQ speech memory.
It is used to identify the content of text fragments stored in the
speech memory of one OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the characters remaining
must be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ELMSGID ELEMENTARY MSG IDENTIFICATION

This parameter identifies the elementary message in the SCP (Service


Control Point). The elementary message identification implicit
defines the language of the elementary message.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ELMSG- 1-


CR ELMSG
INDPHR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

This command creates an elementary message for a given OCANEQ variant and
assigns it to an elementary message identification, known by the SCP
(Service Control Point).

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR ELMSG - INDPHR ELEMENTARY MESSAGE FOR INDAS PHRASE


2. CR ELMSG - OPRASS ELMSG FOR OPERATOR ASSISTANCE
3. CR ELMSG - STAN ELEMENTARY MESSAGE FOR STD ANNOUNCEMENT

1. Input format

ELEMENTARY MESSAGE FOR INDAS PHRASE

This input format is used to assign elementary messages of message type


"INDAS phrase" to an elementary message identification.
An INDAS phrase is composed of fixed text parts and up to six different
variable parts.
The variable part is represented by parameter ELMPAR.
The indas phrases can be used for user confirmation of input information or to
announce frequently changing parts, such as directory number, date/time,...

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR ELMSG : OCAVAR= ,ELMSGID= ,ELMSG= [,ELMPAR=] ,LANELMSG= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,SUBVOC=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant equivalent to the


project-specific firmware label of OCANEQ speech memory.
It is used to identify the content of text fragments stored in the
speech memory of one OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the characters remaining
must be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ELMSGID ELEMENTARY MSG IDENTIFICATION

This parameter identifies the elementary message in the SCP (Service


Control Point). The elementary message identification implicit
defines the language of the elementary message.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

ELMSG ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

This parameter defines the contents of the elementary message.


The elementary message is identified by its message type and optionally
(only for INDPHR and STAN) its announcement number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: MESSAGE TYPE
INDPHR INDAS PHRASE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ELMSG- 1+
CR ELMSG
INDPHR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter unit is used to define the message type of the


elementary message.

b: ANNOUNCEMENT NUMBER=
1,2,3...900, range of decimal numbers

This parameter unit is used to define the announcement number.

ELMPAR ELMSG PARAMETER

This parameter builds the contents of the variable part of the INDAS
phrase. The variable part is used to announce variable information as
there are: directory numbers, date/time,....
The variable part can contain up to 6 ELMPAR values, linked with &.
The order in which the different values are given determines
the sequence of the ELMPAR values in the INDAS phrase.
The different values can be placed on any position within the INDAS
phrase. Each of the possible values can be specified more than once.
example: TIME&PRICE&TIME&DIGITS&INTEGER

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

DATE DATE
DIGITS DIGITS
INTEGER INTEGER
PRICE PRICE
TIME TIME
WEEKDAY WEEKDAY

LANELMSG LANGUAGE OF ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

For the input formats INDAS PHRASE and STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT this
parameter indicates one of the possible official languages
commonly used in exchange.
For the input format OPERATOR ASSISTANCE this parameter indicates
which operator is selected.

Notes:
- For the input formats INDAS PHRASE and STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT
the reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the project-specific INDAS document related to the
OCANEQ variant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN0 LANGUAGE 0
LAN1 LANGUAGE 1
LAN2 LANGUAGE 2
LAN3 LANGUAGE 3
LAN4 LANGUAGE 4

SUBVOC SUBVOCABULARY

This parameter is only applicable for announcements


which prompt the subscriber to give a response (e.g. acknowledge).
The parameter indicates to the voice recognition system which
subset of the recognizable words can be expected in the response
(e.g.YES and NO for an acknowledge).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SVOC0 SUBVOCABULARY 0
SVOC1 SUBVOCABULARY 1
SVOC2 SUBVOCABULARY 2
SVOC3 SUBVOCABULARY 3
SVOC4 SUBVOCABULARY 4
SVOC5 SUBVOCABULARY 5
SVOC6 SUBVOCABULARY 6
SVOC7 SUBVOCABULARY 7

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ELMSG- 2+
CR ELMSG
OPRASS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

ELMSG FOR OPERATOR ASSISTANCE

This input format is used to assign an elementary message of message type


"operator assistance" to an elementary message identification.
The different kind of operator assistances are defined by parameter OPRMODE.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR ELMSG : OCAVAR= ,ELMSGID= ,ELMSG= [,OPRMODE=] ,LANELMSG= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant equivalent to the


project-specific firmware label of OCANEQ speech memory.
It is used to identify the content of text fragments stored in the
speech memory of one OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the characters remaining
must be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ELMSGID ELEMENTARY MSG IDENTIFICATION

This parameter identifies the elementary message in the SCP (Service


Control Point). The elementary message identification implicit
defines the language of the elementary message.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

ELMSG ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

This parameter defines the contents of the elementary message.


The elementary message is identified by its message type and optionally
(only for INDPHR and STAN) its announcement number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

OPRASS OPERATOR ASSISTANCE

This parameter unit is used to define the message type of the


elementary message.

OPRMODE OPERATOR MODE

This parameter is used to define the kind of operator


assistance.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

OPRASSAP OPERATOR ASSISTANCE AFTER PIN


Operator assistance after the user has entered
the Personal Identification Number (PIN).
OPRASSBP OPERATOR ASSISTANCE BEFORE PIN
Operator assistance before the user has entered
the Personal Identification Number (PIN).
OPRASSO OPERATOR ASSISTANCE OUT
Operator assistance has to be finished.

LANELMSG LANGUAGE OF ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

For the input formats INDAS PHRASE and STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT this
parameter indicates one of the possible official languages
commonly used in exchange.
For the input format OPERATOR ASSISTANCE this parameter indicates

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ELMSG- 3+
CR ELMSG
OPRASS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

which operator is selected.

Notes:
- For the input formats INDAS PHRASE and STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT
the reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the project-specific INDAS document related to the
OCANEQ variant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN0 LANGUAGE 0
LAN1 LANGUAGE 1
LAN10 LANGUAGE 10
LAN11 LANGUAGE 11
LAN12 LANGUAGE 12
LAN13 LANGUAGE 13
LAN14 LANGUAGE 14
LAN15 LANGUAGE 15
LAN16 LANGUAGE 16
LAN17 LANGUAGE 17
LAN18 LANGUAGE 18
LAN19 LANGUAGE 19
LAN2 LANGUAGE 2
LAN20 LANGUAGE 20
LAN21 LANGUAGE 21
LAN22 LANGUAGE 22
LAN23 LANGUAGE 23
LAN24 LANGUAGE 24
LAN25 LANGUAGE 25
LAN26 LANGUAGE 26
LAN27 LANGUAGE 27
LAN28 LANGUAGE 28
LAN29 LANGUAGE 29
LAN3 LANGUAGE 3
LAN30 LANGUAGE 30
LAN31 LANGUAGE 31
LAN32 LANGUAGE 32
LAN33 LANGUAGE 33
LAN34 LANGUAGE 34
LAN35 LANGUAGE 35
LAN36 LANGUAGE 36
LAN37 LANGUAGE 37
LAN38 LANGUAGE 38
LAN39 LANGUAGE 39
LAN4 LANGUAGE 4
LAN5 LANGUAGE 5
LAN6 LANGUAGE 6
LAN7 LANGUAGE 7
LAN8 LANGUAGE 8
LAN9 LANGUAGE 9

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ELMSG- 4+
CR ELMSG
STAN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

ELEMENTARY MESSAGE FOR STD ANNOUNCEMENT

This input format is used to assign an elementary message of message type


"fixed text announcement" to an elementary message identification.
A fixed text announcement is completely represented by its announcement number.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR ELMSG : OCAVAR= ,ELMSGID= ,ELMSG= ,LANELMSG= [,SUBVOC=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant equivalent to the


project-specific firmware label of OCANEQ speech memory.
It is used to identify the content of text fragments stored in the
speech memory of one OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the characters remaining
must be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ELMSGID ELEMENTARY MSG IDENTIFICATION

This parameter identifies the elementary message in the SCP (Service


Control Point). The elementary message identification implicit
defines the language of the elementary message.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

ELMSG ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

This parameter defines the contents of the elementary message.


The elementary message is identified by its message type and optionally
(only for INDPHR and STAN) its announcement number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: MESSAGE TYPE
STAN STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT

This parameter unit is used to define the message type of the


elementary message.

b: ANNOUNCEMENT NUMBER=
1,2,3...2500, range of decimal numbers

This parameter unit is used to define the announcement number.

LANELMSG LANGUAGE OF ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

For the input formats INDAS PHRASE and STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT this
parameter indicates one of the possible official languages
commonly used in exchange.
For the input format OPERATOR ASSISTANCE this parameter indicates
which operator is selected.

Notes:
- For the input formats INDAS PHRASE and STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT
the reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the project-specific INDAS document related to the
OCANEQ variant.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ELMSG- 5+
CR ELMSG
STAN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN0 LANGUAGE 0
LAN1 LANGUAGE 1
LAN2 LANGUAGE 2
LAN3 LANGUAGE 3
LAN4 LANGUAGE 4

SUBVOC SUBVOCABULARY

This parameter is only applicable for announcements


which prompt the subscriber to give a response (e.g. acknowledge).
The parameter indicates to the voice recognition system which
subset of the recognizable words can be expected in the response
(e.g.YES and NO for an acknowledge).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SVOC0 SUBVOCABULARY 0
SVOC1 SUBVOCABULARY 1
SVOC2 SUBVOCABULARY 2
SVOC3 SUBVOCABULARY 3
SVOC4 SUBVOCABULARY 4
SVOC5 SUBVOCABULARY 5
SVOC6 SUBVOCABULARY 6
SVOC7 SUBVOCABULARY 7

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ELMSG- 6-
DISP ELMSG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

This command displays one or more elementary messages for a certain


OCANEQ variant.
A selective display can be achieved by specifying the message type of the
elementary message and (or) the language.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ELMSG : OCAVAR= ,ELMSGID= [,ELMSG=] [,LANELMSG=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant equivalent to the


project-specific firmware label of OCANEQ speech memory.
It is used to identify the content of text fragments stored in the
speech memory of one OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the characters remaining
must be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ELMSGID ELEMENTARY MSG IDENTIFICATION

This parameter identifies the elementary message in the SCP (Service


Control Point). The elementary message identification implicit
defines the language of the elementary message.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

ELMSG ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

This parameter defines the contents of the elementary message.


The elementary message is identified by its message type and optionally
(depending on the message type) its announcement number.
For display purposes, only the message function can be specified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INDPHR INDAS PHRASE


STAN STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT
OPRASS OPERATOR ASSISTANCE

This parameter unit is used to define the message type of the


elementary message.

LANELMSG LANGUAGE OF ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

This parameter indicates one of the possible official languages


commonly used in exchange.

Notes:
- The reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the project-specific INDAS document related to the
OCANEQ variant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ELMSG- 1+


DISP ELMSG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

LAN0 LANGUAGE 0
LAN1 LANGUAGE 1
LAN2 LANGUAGE 2
LAN3 LANGUAGE 3
LAN4 LANGUAGE 4
LAN5 LANGUAGE 5
LAN6 LANGUAGE 6
LAN7 LANGUAGE 7
LAN8 LANGUAGE 8
LAN9 LANGUAGE 9
LAN10 LANGUAGE 10
LAN11 LANGUAGE 11
LAN12 LANGUAGE 12
LAN13 LANGUAGE 13
LAN14 LANGUAGE 14
LAN15 LANGUAGE 15
LAN16 LANGUAGE 16
LAN17 LANGUAGE 17
LAN18 LANGUAGE 18
LAN19 LANGUAGE 19
LAN20 LANGUAGE 20
LAN21 LANGUAGE 21
LAN22 LANGUAGE 22
LAN23 LANGUAGE 23
LAN24 LANGUAGE 24
LAN25 LANGUAGE 25
LAN26 LANGUAGE 26
LAN27 LANGUAGE 27
LAN28 LANGUAGE 28
LAN29 LANGUAGE 29
LAN30 LANGUAGE 30
LAN31 LANGUAGE 31
LAN32 LANGUAGE 32
LAN33 LANGUAGE 33
LAN34 LANGUAGE 34
LAN35 LANGUAGE 35
LAN36 LANGUAGE 36
LAN37 LANGUAGE 37
LAN38 LANGUAGE 38
LAN39 LANGUAGE 39

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ELMSG- 2-


MOD ELMSG
INDPHR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

This command modifies, for a given OCANEQ variant, the contents of the
elementary message assigned to an elementary message identification.
It is also possible to change the message type (parameter ELMSG).
If the message type is changed, all parameters necessary for the new
message type must be entered in the command. No data from the old
message type is kept in this case.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD ELMSG - INDPHR ELEMENTARY MESSAGE FOR INDAS PHRASE


2. MOD ELMSG - OPRASS ELEMENTARY MSG FOR OPERATOR ASSISTANCE
3. MOD ELMSG - STAN ELEMENTARY MSG FOR STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT

1. Input format

ELEMENTARY MESSAGE FOR INDAS PHRASE

This input format is used to change the linking of an elementary message


identification assigned to a standard announcement or an operator assistance
into an elementary message identification, assigned to an INDAS phrase.

It can also be used to modify the announcement number of the INDAS phrase, the
variable part of the INDAS phrase and (or) the language, assigned to the
elementary message identification. The OCANEQ variant can not be modified.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ELMSG : OCAVAR= ,ELMSGID= <,ELMSG= ,ELMPAR= ,LANELMSG= 1
1 1
1 ,SUBVOC=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant equivalent to the


project-specific firmware label of OCANEQ speech memory.
It is used to identify the content of text fragments stored in the
speech memory of one OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the characters remaining
must be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ELMSGID ELEMENTARY MSG IDENTIFICATION

This parameter identifies the elementary message in the SCP (Service


Control Point). The elementary message identification implicit
defines the language of the elementary message.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

ELMSG ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

This parameter defines the contents of the elementary message.


The elementary message is identified by its message type and optionally
(depending on the message type) its announcement number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: MESSAGE TYPE
INDPHR INDAS PHRASE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ELMSG- 1+


MOD ELMSG
INDPHR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: ANNOUNCEMENT NUMBER=
1,2,3...900, range of decimal numbers

ELMPAR ELEMENTARY MESSAGE PARAMETER

This parameter builds the contents of the variable part of the INDAS
phrase. The variable part is used to announce variable information as
there are: directory numbers, date/time,....
The variable part can contain up to 6 ELMPAR values, linked with &.
The order in which the different values are given, determine
the sequence of the ELMPAR values in the INDAS phrase.
The different values can be placed on any position within the INDAS
phrase. Each of the possible values can be specified more than once.
example: TIME&PRICE&TIME&DIGITS&INTEGER

Note that when the announcement number the old parameters in the
are cleared. If the new INDAS phrase requires parameters, these
must be entered.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

DATE DATE
DIGITS DIGITS
INTEGER INTEGER
PRICE PRICE
TIME TIME
WEEKDAY WEEKDAY

LANELMSG LANGUAGE OF ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

For the input formats INDAS PHRASE and STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT this
parameter indicates one of the possible official languages
commonly used in exchange.
For the input format OPERATOR ASSISTANCE this parameter indicates
which operator is selected.

Notes:
- For the input formats INDAS PHRASE and STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT
the reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the project-specific INDAS document related to the
OCANEQ variant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN0 LANGUAGE 0
LAN1 LANGUAGE 1
LAN2 LANGUAGE 2
LAN3 LANGUAGE 3
LAN4 LANGUAGE 4

SUBVOC SUBVOCABULARY

This parameter is only applicable for announcements


which prompt the subscriber to give a response (e.g. acknowledge).
The parameter indicates to the voice recognition system which
subset of the recognizable words can be expected in the response
(e.g.YES and NO for an acknowledge).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SVOC0 SUBVOCABULARY 0
SVOC1 SUBVOCABULARY 1
SVOC2 SUBVOCABULARY 2
SVOC3 SUBVOCABULARY 3
SVOC4 SUBVOCABULARY 4
SVOC5 SUBVOCABULARY 5
SVOC6 SUBVOCABULARY 6
SVOC7 SUBVOCABULARY 7

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ELMSG- 2+


MOD ELMSG
OPRASS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

ELEMENTARY MSG FOR OPERATOR ASSISTANCE

This input format is used to change the linking of an elementary message


identification assigned to an INDAS phrase or a standard announcement into an
elementary message identification, assigned to an operator assistance. It can
also be used to modify the operator mode and (or) the language, assigned to the
elementary message identification.
The OCANEQ variant can not be modified.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ELMSG : OCAVAR= ,ELMSGID= <,ELMSG= ,OPRMODE= ,LANELMSG=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant equivalent to the


project-specific firmware label of OCANEQ speech memory.
It is used to identify the content of text fragments stored in the
speech memory of one OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the characters remaining
must be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ELMSGID ELEMENTARY MSG IDENTIFICATION

This parameter identifies the elementary message in the SCP (Service


Control Point). The elementary message identification implicit
defines the language of the elementary message.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

ELMSG ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

This parameter defines the contents of the elementary message.


The elementary message is identified by its message type and optionally
(depending on the message type) its announcement number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

OPRASS OPERATOR ASSISTANCE

OPRMODE OPERATOR MODE

This parameter is used to define the kind of operator


assistance.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

OPRASSAP OPERATOR ASSISTANCE AFTER PIN


OPRASSBP OPERATOR ASSISTANCE BEFORE PIN
OPRASSO OPERATOR ASSISTANCE OUT

LANELMSG LANGUAGE OF ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

For the input formats INDAS PHRASE and STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT this
parameter indicates one of the possible official languages
commonly used in exchange.
For the input format OPERATOR ASSISTANCE this parameter indicates
which operator is selected.

Notes:
- For the input formats INDAS PHRASE and STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT
the reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the project-specific INDAS document related to the
OCANEQ variant.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ELMSG- 3+


MOD ELMSG
OPRASS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN0 LANGUAGE 0
LAN1 LANGUAGE 1
LAN10 LANGUAGE 10
LAN11 LANGUAGE 11
LAN12 LANGUAGE 12
LAN13 LANGUAGE 13
LAN14 LANGUAGE 14
LAN15 LANGUAGE 15
LAN16 LANGUAGE 16
LAN17 LANGUAGE 17
LAN18 LANGUAGE 18
LAN19 LANGUAGE 19
LAN2 LANGUAGE 2
LAN20 LANGUAGE 20
LAN21 LANGUAGE 21
LAN22 LANGUAGE 22
LAN23 LANGUAGE 23
LAN24 LANGUAGE 24
LAN25 LANGUAGE 25
LAN26 LANGUAGE 26
LAN27 LANGUAGE 27
LAN28 LANGUAGE 28
LAN29 LANGUAGE 29
LAN3 LANGUAGE 3
LAN30 LANGUAGE 30
LAN31 LANGUAGE 31
LAN32 LANGUAGE 32
LAN33 LANGUAGE 33
LAN34 LANGUAGE 34
LAN35 LANGUAGE 35
LAN36 LANGUAGE 36
LAN37 LANGUAGE 37
LAN38 LANGUAGE 38
LAN39 LANGUAGE 39
LAN4 LANGUAGE 4
LAN5 LANGUAGE 5
LAN6 LANGUAGE 6
LAN7 LANGUAGE 7
LAN8 LANGUAGE 8
LAN9 LANGUAGE 9

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ELMSG- 4+


MOD ELMSG
STAN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

ELEMENTARY MSG FOR STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT

This input format is used to change the linking of an elementary message


identification assigned to an INDAS phrase or an operator assistance into an
elementary message identification, assigned to a standard announcement.
It can also be used to modify the standard announcement number and (or) the
language, assigned to the elementary message identification.
The OCANEQ variant can not be modified.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ELMSG : OCAVAR= ,ELMSGID= <,ELMSG= ,LANELMSG= ,SUBVOC=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant equivalent to the


project-specific firmware label of OCANEQ speech memory.
It is used to identify the content of text fragments stored in the
speech memory of one OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the characters remaining
must be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ELMSGID ELEMENTARY MSG IDENTIFICATION

This parameter identifies the elementary message in the SCP (Service


Control Point). The elementary message identification implicit
defines the language of the elementary message.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

ELMSG ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

This parameter defines the contents of the elementary message.


The elementary message is identified by its message type and optionally
(depending on the message type) its announcement number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: MESSAGE TYPE
STAN STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT

b: ANNOUNCEMENT NUMBER=
1,2,3...2500, range of decimal numbers

LANELMSG LANGUAGE OF ELEMENTARY MESSAGE

For the input formats INDAS PHRASE and STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT this
parameter indicates one of the possible official languages
commonly used in exchange.
For the input format OPERATOR ASSISTANCE this parameter indicates
which operator is selected.

Notes:
- For the input formats INDAS PHRASE and STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT
the reference between official language and foreign language is
specified by the project-specific INDAS document related to the
OCANEQ variant.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAN0 LANGUAGE 0

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ELMSG- 5+


MOD ELMSG
STAN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

LAN1 LANGUAGE 1
LAN2 LANGUAGE 2
LAN3 LANGUAGE 3
LAN4 LANGUAGE 4

SUBVOC SUBVOCABULARY

This parameter is only applicable for announcements


which prompt the subscriber to give a response (e.g. acknowledge).
The parameter indicates to the voice recognition system which
subset of the recognizable words can be expected in the response
(e.g.YES and NO for an acknowledge).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SVOC0 SUBVOCABULARY 0
SVOC1 SUBVOCABULARY 1
SVOC2 SUBVOCABULARY 2
SVOC3 SUBVOCABULARY 3
SVOC4 SUBVOCABULARY 4
SVOC5 SUBVOCABULARY 5
SVOC6 SUBVOCABULARY 6
SVOC7 SUBVOCABULARY 7

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ELMSG- 6-


CAN ELMSGERR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL ELEMENTARY MESSAGE ERROR

This command cancels for a given OCANEQ variant, the assignment of a fixed
text announcement to a given combination of an error code and error treatment.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN ELMSGERR : OCAVAR= ,ERRTR= ,UIERRCOD= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant equivalent to the


project-specific firmware label of OCANEQ speech memory.
It is used to identify the content of text fragments stored in the
speech memory of one OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the characters remaining
must be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ERRTR ERROR TREATMENT

This parameter defines how the detected input error of the user
interaction should be treated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SEI STANDARD ERROR AND INFORMATION


This kind of error treatment results in an
immediate release of a pending announcement or
tone, stops the digit collection and starts a
standard announcement.
HLP HELP
This kind of error treatment is used to assist the
end-user with a standard announcement.
The UI(User Interaction)-LTG waits for a corrected
input from the end-user.

UIERRCOD USER INTERACTION ERROR CODE

This parameter defines the possible


user interaction error codes.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FDT FIRST DIGIT TIMEOUT


Timeout of the first digit timer.
IDT INTER DIGIT TIMEOUT
Timeout of the inter digit timer and minimum
number of digits not yet reached.
EOR END OF REPLY
End Of Reply digit received and minimum number of
digits not yet reached.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ELMSGERR- 1-


CR ELMSGERR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE ELEMENTARY MESSAGE ERROR

This command assigns, for a given OCANEQ variant, a fixed text announcement
to a combination of an error treatment and an error code.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR ELMSGERR : OCAVAR= ,ERRTR= ,UIERRCOD= ,STANNO= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant equivalent to the


project-specific firmware label of OCANEQ speech memory.
It is used to identify the content of text fragments stored in the
speech memory of one OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the characters remaining
must be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ERRTR ERROR TREATMENT

This parameter defines how the detected input error of the user
interaction should be treated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SEI STANDARD ERROR AND INFORMATION


This kind of error treatment results in an
immediate release of a pending announcement or
tone, stops the digit collection and starts a
standard announcement.
HLP HELP
This kind of error treatment is used to assist the
end-user with a standard announcement.
The UI(User Interaction)-LTG waits for a corrected
input from the end-user.

UIERRCOD USER INTERACTION ERROR CODE

This parameter defines the possible


user interaction error codes.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FDT FIRST DIGIT TIMEOUT


Timeout of the first digit timer.
IDT INTER DIGIT TIMEOUT
Timeout of the inter digit timer and minimum
number of digits not yet reached.
EOR END OF REPLY
End Of Reply digit received and minimum number of
digits not yet reached.

STANNO STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...2500, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ELMSGERR- 1-
DISP ELMSGERR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ELEMENTARY MESSAGE ERROR

This command displays, for a given OCANEQ variant, the fixed text announcements
assigned to the different combinations of error codes and error treatments.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ELMSGERR : OCAVAR= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant equivalent to the


project-specific firmware label of OCANEQ speech memory.
It is used to identify the content of text fragments stored in the
speech memory of one OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the characters remaining
must be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ELMSGERR- 1-


MOD ELMSGERR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY ELEMENTARY MESSAGE ERROR

This command modifies, for a given OCANEQ variant, the assignment of a fixed
text announcement to a combination of error code and error treatment.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ELMSGERR : OCAVAR= ,ERRTR= ,UIERRCOD= ,STANNO= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OCAVAR OCANEQ VARIANT

This parameter specifies the OCANEQ variant equivalent to the


project-specific firmware label of OCANEQ speech memory.
It is used to identify the content of text fragments stored in the
speech memory of one OCANEQ.
The first character must be a letter, the characters remaining
must be decimal numbers in the range 0...9.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ERRTR ERROR TREATMENT

This parameter defines how the detected input error of the user
interaction should be treated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SEI STANDARD ERROR AND INFORMATION


This kind of error treatment results in an
immediate release of a pending announcement or
tone, stops the digit collection and starts a
standard announcement.
HLP HELP
This kind of error treatment is used to assist the
end-user with a standard announcement.
The UI(User Interaction)-LTG waits for a corrected
input from the end-user.

UIERRCOD USER INTERACTION ERROR CODE

This parameter defines the possible


user interaction errors.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FDT FIRST DIGIT TIMEOUT


Timeout of the first digit timer.
IDT INTER DIGIT TIMEOUT
Timeout of the inter digit timer and minimum
number of digits not yet reached.
EOR END OF REPLY
End Of Reply digit received and minimum number of
digits not yet reached.

STANNO STANDARD ANNOUNCEMENT NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...2500, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ELMSGERR- 1-


RESET EMERGOP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RESET EMERGENCY OPERATION

This command resets the emergency operation flag.


Emergency operation is caused by a hardware recovery.

Notes:
- Configuration, diagnosis and test commands for central units, IOPs and
devices can’t be executed while the CP is in emergency operation.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 RESET EMERGOP ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RESET EMERGOP- 1-


DMP ENB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Dump Error Notebook

This task activates the memory dump of the SGSN Error Note Books
and the MSC Error Note Books.
A Error Note Book is a part of memory, which contains error
symptom data belonging to occurred software errors.
The error symptom data contained in the dump result is needed
for error analysis. To get actual error symptom data the dump
should be executed as soon as possible after the problems occurred.
To ensure a good error analysis, always dump all of the
Error Note Books.

Note :
- The modules E9LCFA1S, E9LH8A1S, E9LLEA1S, E9LMBA1S and E9LS8A1S
won’t be executable in PO because the platforms are only
available in CS.
- The modules E9TLYG0S and E9TLZG0S will be partly executed in PO,
because they contain requests for platforms which are only
available in CS.
- The modules G9MCFA1S, I9CCXA1S, I9EDDA1S, G9ALEA1S, G9PXXA1S
and G9PXYA1S won’t be executable in CS because the platforms
are only available in PO.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DMP ENB : Module name= ,Dump variable part= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Module name

This parameter specifies the Error Note Book to be dumped.


See below for a complete list.

Input format:
selection of:
- E9LCFA1S (MP:AAL2),
- E9LH8A1S (MP:AAL2),
- E9LLEA1S (MP:AAL2),
- E9LMBA1S (MP:AAL2),
- E9LS8A1S (MP:AAL2),
- E9TLYG0S (MP:AAL2,SA),
- E9TLZG0S (MP:AAL2,SA,SM),
- D9ZE0A1S (MP:ACC),
- G9ACXA1S (MP:ACC),
- E9IOEA1S (MP:MM,RANAP),
- G9MCFA1S (MP:MM),
- I9CCXA1S (MP:MM),
- I9EDDA1S (MP:MM),
- G9ALEA1S (MP:PD),
- G9PXXA1S (MP:PD),
- G9PXYA1S (MP:PD),
- E9BCEA1S (MP:RANAP),
- E9R1EG0S (MP:RANAP),
- E9MAFG0S (MP:SA),
- E9MO1A1S (MP:SA),
- E9OAEG0S (MP:SA),
- E9XAAA1S (MP:SA),
- G9OAAA1S (MP:SA),
- G9OAEA1S (MP:SA),
- G9OAWA1S (MP:SA),
- G9TIAA1S (MP:SA),
- HOPEIA1S (MP:SA),
- I9UTEA1S (MP:SA),
- MUCERG0S (MP:SA),
- HIENBA1S (MP:HI).

Dump variable part

This parameter is used to decide if the variable memory part

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP ENB- 1+


DMP ENB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

will be printed after the fixed part of the selected module.

Input format:
selection of
- no
- yes

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP ENB- 2-


DISP ENTOPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ENTITY OPTIONS

This command displays the entity specific data, which are relevant
for the given type of entity.

Notes:
- This command will be rejected when :
- the specified type of entity is not installed in the exchange.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ENTOPT : ENTITY= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ENTITY ENTITY TYPE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

HLR HOME LOCATION REGISTER


VLR VISITOR LOCATION REGISTER
MSC MOBILE SERV. SWITCHING CENTER
AC AUTHENTICATION CENTER
RELNODE RELAY NODE
HLRSID HLR SENDID
VLRSID VLR SENDID
MSCSID MSC SENDID
PROTMAP PROTOCOL MAPPER

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ENTOPT- 1-


MOD ENTOPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY ENTITY OPTIONS

This command modifies predefined specific values for the following entities :
- HLR : - the HLR internal ISDN number HLRISD.
- VLR : - the VLR internal ISDN number VLRISD.
- the VLR name VLRNAME.
- AC : - the AC name ACNAME.
- the AC firmware function state ACFWFUST.
- the physical names of the communication partners.
- MSC : - the EIR Status EIR (LOCAL or REMOTE).
- the EIRISD number of the EIR which is consulted if EIR=REMOTE.
Additional predefined specific values can also be modified :
- RELNODE : - NODE is RELAY NODE in case of a HLR.
- HLRSID : - the HLR send identity number in case of a HLR for CDMA
projects.
- VLRSID : - the VLR send identity number in case of a VLR for CDMA
projects.
- MSCSID : - the MSC send identity number in case of a MSC for CDMA
projects.
Notes:
- This command will be rejected when :
- the specified parameter is related to an entity which is not configured in
the exchange.
- the combination of logical name and application which is defined in
ACCOMPAR is not valid.
- EIR = LOCAL and EIRISD has been entered.

- In integrated entities, all entities should be allocated different ISDN


numbers.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD ENTOPT : <HLRISD= ,VLRISD= ,VLRNAME= ,ACNAME= ,ACFWFUST= 1
1 1
1 ,ACCOMPAR= ,EIRISD= ,EIR= ,RELNODE= ,HLRSID= 1
1 1
1 ,VLRSID= ,MSCSID=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

HLRISD HLR INTERNAL ISDN NUMBER

This parameter specifies the internal ISDN number for the HLR which
is used in the MAP messages.
Note: ’0’ means no HLRISD value.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

VLRISD VLR INTERNAL ISDN NUMBER

This parameter specifies the internal ISDN number for the VLR which
is used in the MAP messages.
Note: ’0’ means no VLRISD value.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

VLRNAME VLR NAME

Note: ’*’ means no VLR name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...30 characters from the

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ENTOPT- 1+


MOD ENTOPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

text string character set, enclosed in "

ACNAME AC NAME

Note: ’*’ means no AC name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...30 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

ACFWFUST FIRMWARE FUNCTION STATE

This parameter limits the use of the functionality provided


by the IOP:AUC’s.

Notes:
- This command will be rejected if a is lower
than a previously entered value.
- This command will be rejected if some of the activated
IOP:AUC firmware in the exchange has a function state lower
than a.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...99, range of decimal numbers

ACCOMPAR COMP PHYS. LOG. NAME AND APPL.

This parameter specifies a combination of a physical name, a logical


name and an application.

Prerequisites:
- This command will only be executed when the combination of logical
name and application is defined, in which case the corresponding
physical name will be modified.

Notes:
- The valid combinations of logical name and application may be
obtained via the DISP ENTOPT:ENTITY=AC command.
- At most 7 parameters may be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: PHYSICAL NAME=
0...30 characters from the
text string character set, enclosed in "

Physical name of the communication partner.


This name uniquely identifies the communication partner.
Note: ’*’ means no physical name.

b: LOGICAL NAME=
0...8 characters from the
text string character set, enclosed in "

Logical name of the communication partner.


This is a name for the functionality of the
communication partner.

c: APPLICATION=
0...5 characters from the
text string character set, enclosed in "

Name of the application which is used between the AC and the


communication partner.

EIRISD EIR ISDN NUMBER

This parameter specifies the international ISDN number of the remote


EIR which is consulted by the MSC for the purpose of equipment control.
The parameter has to be entered only when the EIR status is REMOTE.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ENTOPT- 2+


MOD ENTOPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Note: ’0’ means no EIRISD value.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

EIR EIR STATUS

This parameter specifies the EIR status.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LOCAL EIR LOCAL


REMOTE EIR REMOTE

RELNODE RELAY NODE

This parameter determines if the node is a relay node.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y YES
N NO

HLRSID HLR SENDID NUMBER

This parameter specifies the send identity number for the HLR which
is used in the MAP messages.
Note: ’0’ means no HLRSID value.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit decimal number

VLRSID VLR SENDID NUMBER

This parameter specifies the send identity number for the VLR which
is used in the MAP messages.
Note: ’0’ means no VLRSID value.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit decimal number

MSCSID MSC SENDID NUMBER

This parameter specifies the send identity number for the MSC which
is used in the MAP messages.
Note: ’0’ means no MSCSID value.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit decimal number

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD ENTOPT- 3-


MOD EQN
DN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY EQUIPMENT NUMBER

This command changes the equipment number of a subscriber or a


PBX Line without changing any of the subscriber or PBX Line related
data under consideration of the following points:

- A modification is possible from DLU to DLU port and from LTG to DLU
port.
- The old equipment number is assigned to a subscriber/PBX Line.
- ISDN-subscriber and all analog subscriber categories besides
mobile stations can be handled.
- The category of the PBX Line can either be mainstation (for analog
lines) or Basic Access (for ISDN lines).
- No nailed up connection must exist for the old equipment number.
- If the object on the parallel port from the new low bit rate or
high bit rate port of an SDSL access is a subscriber/PBX line,
the moved object has to be of the same type (subscriber/PBX line).
- If the object is moved to a SDSL port the transferrate values are set
to the old values if existing or the values of object connected on
the parallelport or the office values.
- If the object is moved from a SDSL port the transferrate values are
deleted implicitly.
- the number of B-channels must be supported on the new port

Prerequisites:
- The new equipment number must previously be a free DLU port.
- The new equipment must be able to support all the subscriber/PBX Line/PBX
features that exist for the subscriber/PBX Line/PBX to be moved.
- The limitations concerning LTG resources must be fulfilled
(Command DISP LTGRES).
- Compatibility between the circuit type of the new equipment and
the category of the subscriber/PBX Line.
- Compatibility between the circuit type of the new equipment and
the operation mode of the PBX Line.
- Compatibility between the circuit type of the new equipment and
line attributes of the subscriber/PBX Line.
- Compatibility between the circuit type of the new equipment and
classes of service of the subscriber/PBX Line.
- Compatibility between the circuit type of the new equipment and
charging features of the subscriber/PBX Line.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted for a local exchange.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD EQN - DN DIRECTORY NUMBER


2. MOD EQN - EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER

1. Input format

DIRECTORY NUMBER

Input format for addressing a subscriber/PBX Line via DN.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD EQN : [LAC=] ,DN= [,OPMODE= ,LNO=] ,NEWEQN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple directory number
volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD EQN- 1+


MOD EQN
DN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the subscriber directory number or the pilot


directory number of a PBX, to which the PBX Line is assigned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

OPMODE OPERATION MODE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ABW ANALOG BOTHWAY


AIC ANALOG INCOMING
AOG ANALOG OUTGOING
IBW ISDN BOTHWAY
IBW1TR6 ISDN BOTHWAY 1TR6 PROTOCOL
IIC ISDN INCOMING
IIC1TR6 ISDN INCOMING 1TR6 PROTOCOL
IOG ISDN OUTGOING
IOG1TR6 ISDN OUTGOING 1TR6 PROTOCOL

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number of the PBX Line.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

NEWEQN NEW EQUIPMENT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the new equipment number to which the


subscriber/PBX Line will be reconnected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: DLU=
10...2550, range of decimal numbers

b: SHELF=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

c: MODULE=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

d: CIRCUIT=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD EQN- 2+


MOD EQN
EQN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

EQUIPMENT NUMBER

Input format for addressing a subscriber/PBX Line via EQN.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD EQN : EQN= ,NEWEQN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

EQN EQUIPMENT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the equipment number to which the subscriber/


PBX Line is connected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: TSG/DLU=
0...2550, range of decimal numbers

- TSG number (0..7 for a LTG port).


- DLU number (10,20,30...2550 for a DLU port).

b: LTG/SHELF=
0...63, range of decimal numbers

- LTG number (1..63 for a LTG port).


- Shelf number (0..7 for a DLU port).

c: LTU/MODULE=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

- LTU number (0..7 for a LTG port).


- DLU module number (0..15 for a DLU port).

d: CIRCUIT=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

- Circuit number (0..31 for a LTG port)


- Circuit number (0..31 for a DLU port)

NEWEQN NEW EQUIPMENT NUMBER

This parameter specifies the new equipment number to which the


subscriber/PBX Line will be reconnected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: DLU=
10...2550, range of decimal numbers

b: SHELF=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

c: MODULE=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

d: CIRCUIT=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD EQN- 3-


ACT EQTRAP
PALLHALL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE EQUIPMENT TRAP

This command activates an instant printout for each occurrence of the specified
error codes:
- on a particular port or on the ports
- in a port area of a particular line/trunk unit
- in a particular line/trunk unit
- in a line/trunk unit area of a particular line/trunk group
- in a particular line/trunk group

Incompatibilities:
- The functionality which is activated by the MML commands
ACT TRTRAP and ACT EQTRAP is not supported by the BSSAP LTG.
If either of these MML commands is entered, the correct handling
of the BSSAP protocol at the GSM A-interface cannot be guaranteed.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ACT EQTRAP - PALLHALL PRINT ALL HOLD ALL


2. ACT EQTRAP - PALLHNON PRINT ALL HOLD NONE
3. ACT EQTRAP - PALLHSPE PRINT ALL HOLD SPECIFIED
4. ACT EQTRAP - PALLHUSP PRINT ALL HOLD UNSPECIFIED
5. ACT EQTRAP - PSPEHSPE PRINT SPECIFIED HOLD SPECIFIED
6. ACT EQTRAP - PUSPHNON PRINT UNSPECIFIED HOLD NONE
7. ACT EQTRAP - PUSPHUSP PRINT UNSPECIFIED HOLD UNSPEC.

1. Input format

PRINT ALL HOLD ALL

Input format for activating a printout and the attempt to hold the
connection for the occurrence of any MDII (machine detected interoffice
irregularity).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT EQTRAP : LTG= [,LC=] ,PRINT= ,HOLD= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...127, range of decimal numbers

Dependent on the Switching Network Hardware this unit


represents the Time Stage Group (TSG for SNB) or the
Switching Network Multiplexer (SNMUX for SND and
upper ones).

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


1...63, range of decimal numbers

LC LINE CONNECTION

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a[-b]

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 1+


ACT EQTRAP
PALLHALL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a: LINE TRUNK UNIT=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: CHANNEL=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

PRINT PRINT CONDITION

This parameter specifies whether a printout is required when an error


code occurs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALL ALL ERRORCODES


Activates a printout of a port when any
MDII occurs.

HOLD HOLD CONDITION

This parameter specifies whether a connection is to be held for


a port when an error code occurs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALL ALL ERRORCODES


Holds a connection for a port when any MDII
occurs.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 2+


ACT EQTRAP
PALLHNON
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

PRINT ALL HOLD NONE

Input format for activating a printout for the occurrence of any MDII
(machine detected interoffice irregularity).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT EQTRAP : LTG= [,LC=] ,PRINT= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...127, range of decimal numbers

Dependent on the Switching Network Hardware this unit


represents the Time Stage Group (TSG for SNB) or the
Switching Network Multiplexer (SNMUX for SND and
upper ones).

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


1...63, range of decimal numbers

LC LINE CONNECTION

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a[-b]

a: LINE TRUNK UNIT=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: CHANNEL=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

PRINT PRINT CONDITION

This parameter specifies whether a printout is required when an error


code occurs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALL ALL ERRORCODES


Activates a printout of a port when any
MDII occurs.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 3+


ACT EQTRAP
PALLHSPE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

PRINT ALL HOLD SPECIFIED

Input format for activating a printout for the occurrence of all MDIIs
and the attempt to hold the connection for the occurrence of specified
MDIIs (machine detected interoffice irregularity).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT EQTRAP : LTG= [,LC=] ,PRINT= ,ERCO= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...127, range of decimal numbers

Dependent on the Switching Network Hardware this unit


represents the Time Stage Group (TSG for SNB) or the
Switching Network Multiplexer (SNMUX for SND and
upper ones).

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


1...63, range of decimal numbers

LC LINE CONNECTION

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a[-b]

a: LINE TRUNK UNIT=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: CHANNEL=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

PRINT PRINT CONDITION

This parameter specifies whether a printout is required when an error


code occurs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALL ALL ERRORCODES


Activates a printout of a port when any
MDII occurs.

ERCO ERROR CODE

This parameter specifies the MDII.


Notes:
- Only up to 6 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 4+


ACT EQTRAP
PALLHSPE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a-b

a: ERROR CODE
E1 SEIZE AND RELEASE WITHOUT DIG.

E16 NO SEIZURE RESPONSE


E17 NO PROCEED TO SEND
E18 NO KP ACKNOWLEDGE
E19 NO WINK SIGNAL RECEIVED
E20 NO WINK END RECEIVED
E32 NO FIRST DIGIT NO KP SIGNAL
E33 TRUNK OFFERING SUPERVI TIMEOUT
E34 NO END OF ADDRESS SIGNAL (ST)
E35 UNACCEPTABLE DIAL PULSE
E48 MF 2/6 ERROR NOT TWO TONES
E49 INVALID FORWD REGISTER SIGNAL
E50 CONTINUOUS FORW REGISTER SIGN
E52 UNEXPECTED FORW REGISTER SIGN
E53 LOSS OF FORW REGISTER SIGNAL
E54 CONTINUOUS BACK SIGNAL
E55 NO BACK SIGNAL
E56 UNEXPECTED BACK REGISTER SIGN
E57 INVALID BACK REGISTER SIGNAL
E58 NO PAUSE BETWEEN REGISTER SIGN
E64 INVALID DIGIT RECEIVED
E65 PERMANENT DETECTED INC
E66 PERMANENT DETECTED OUT
E67 PREMATURE ANSWER
E68 PREMATURE MCI
E69 UNEXPECTED BACKWARD LN SIGNAL
E70 NO SECONDARY SIGNAL
E71 NO END OF PRIMARY SIGNAL
E72 INVALID CHARGING INFORMATION
E73 PREMATURE METER PULSE
E74 INVALID METER PULSE
E75 NOT PERMITTED METER PULSE
E76 NO SEIZURE RESPONSE FROM DCME
E77 INVALID ISUP MESSAGE
E78 HOP COUNTER EXHAUSTION
E95 LOSS OF FORWARD MESSAGE
E96 CLF NOT RECEIVED
E97 RLG NOT RECEIVED
E98 UNEXPECTED RLG RECEIVED INC
E99 UNEXPECTED RLG RECEIVED OUT

E100 INVALID FORWARD MESSAGE


E101 UNEXPECTED FORWARD MESSAGE
E102 INVALID BACKWARD MESSAGE
E103 UNEXPECTED BACKWARD MESSAGE
E104 ANSWER REC. BEFORE CTC FINISH
E105 NO RECEIVER FOR CTC
E106 UNEXPECTED COT-MSG RECEIVED
E108 MORE THAN 2 SATELLITES IN CON.
E112 US: PARTIAL DIAL ABANDON (INC)
E113 US: PARTIAL DIAL TIMEOUT (INC)
E114 US: EXTRA DIGIT RECEIVED (INC)
E115 US: EXTRA PULSE RECEIVED (INC)
E116 US: MORE THAN ONE MF KP SIGN.
E117 US: MISPLACED ST SIGNAL (INC)
E118 US: MUTILATED DIGIT (INC)
E119 US: NO KP (INC)
E120 US: PERM. SIGNAL TIMEOUT (INC)
E121 US: DELAY DIAL STEADY OFF HOOK
E122 US: DELAY DIAL STEADY ON HOOK
E123 US: WINK START,STEADY ON HOOK
E124 US: WINK START,STEADY OFF HOOK
E125 US: NO EXPECTED STOP
E126 US: POLARITY FAILURE
E127 US: UNEXPECTED STOP
E128 US: STOP SIGNAL TOO LONG
E129 US: T/O WAIT FOR CONNECT
E130 US: T/O WAIT AFTER ANI
E131 US: T/O WAIT AFTER CARRIER ID.
E132 US: T/O WAIT FOR SECOND START
E133 US: O-H WAIT AFTER ANI
E134 US: O-H WAIT AFTER CARRIER ID.
E135 US: O-H WAIT FOR SECOND START

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 5+


ACT EQTRAP
PALLHSPE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E136 US: INVALID TCM LENGTH


E137 US: CCS, IAM SIGNALING ERROR
E138 US: CCS, RESET SIGNAL RECEIVED
E139 US: CCS, WAIT FOR CONTINUE
E140 US: CCS, INCOMPLETE ADDRESS
E141 US: CCS, SIGNALING NETW. FAIL.
E142 US: CCS, VACANT CODE
E143 US: CCS, TIME OUT WAITING
E144 US: CCS, ADDRESS INCOMPLETE
E145 US: CCS, CONTINUITY CHECK
E146 US: CCS, CONFUSION SIGNAL
E147 US: CCS, VACANT NATIONAL NUM.
E148 US: CCS, RELEASE GUARD SIGNAL
E149 US: CCS, RESET SIGNAL
E150 US: CCS, SIGNALING NETW. FAIL.
E151 US: TIMEOUT WAIT FOR EXM-SIGN.
E160 ANALOG CARRIER FAILURE
E176 HANG PROTECT TIMER EXPIRED
E200 FAULTY SELECTIVE NUMBER
E201 UNEXPECTED SIGNAL
E202 INVALID SIGNAL COMBINATION
E205 INVALID NATURE OF ADDR IND.
E216 AUTOM. ANSWER SUPERV. TIMEOUT
E220 US: SIGN. FAIL. / FXS-TRUNK
E225 EXTREME CALL DURATION TIME OUT
E227 MESSAGE WITH INCORRECT DIGITS
E228 DISCARDED ISUP MESSAGE
E229 DISCARDED ISUP PARAMETER
E230 TIME OUT WAITING FOR CLEARING

b: HOLD CONDITION
H HOLD
The connection is to be held for a port, when
a certain MDII occurs.

Specifies whether the connection is to be held for


a port when a certain error code occurs.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 6+


ACT EQTRAP
PALLHUSP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

PRINT ALL HOLD UNSPECIFIED

Input format for activating a printout for the occurrence of all MDIIs
and the attempt to hold the connection for the occurrence of all except
the specified MDIIs (machine detected interoffice irregularity).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT EQTRAP : LTG= [,LC=] ,PRINT= ,HOLD= ,ERCO= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...127, range of decimal numbers

Dependent on the Switching Network Hardware this unit


represents the Time Stage Group (TSG for SNB) or the
Switching Network Multiplexer (SNMUX for SND and
upper ones).

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


1...63, range of decimal numbers

LC LINE CONNECTION

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a[-b]

a: LINE TRUNK UNIT=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: CHANNEL=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

PRINT PRINT CONDITION

This parameter specifies whether a printout is required when an error


code occurs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALL ALL ERRORCODES


Activates a printout of a port when any
MDII occurs.

HOLD HOLD CONDITION

This parameter specifies whether a connection is to be held for


a port when an error code occurs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

COMP COMPLEMENT OF ERRORCODES


Holds a connection of a port when any other

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 7+


ACT EQTRAP
PALLHUSP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

than the specified MDIIs occurs.

ERCO ERROR CODE

This parameter specifies the MDII.


Notes:
- Only up to 6 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

E1 SEIZE AND RELEASE WITHOUT DIG.

E16 NO SEIZURE RESPONSE


E17 NO PROCEED TO SEND
E18 NO KP ACKNOWLEDGE
E19 NO WINK SIGNAL RECEIVED
E20 NO WINK END RECEIVED
E32 NO FIRST DIGIT NO KP SIGNAL
E33 TRUNK OFFERING SUPERVI TIMEOUT
E34 NO END OF ADDRESS SIGNAL (ST)
E35 UNACCEPTABLE DIAL PULSE
E48 MF 2/6 ERROR NOT TWO TONES
E49 INVALID FORWD REGISTER SIGNAL
E50 CONTINUOUS FORW REGISTER SIGN
E52 UNEXPECTED FORW REGISTER SIGN
E53 LOSS OF FORW REGISTER SIGNAL
E54 CONTINUOUS BACK SIGNAL
E55 NO BACK SIGNAL
E56 UNEXPECTED BACK REGISTER SIGN
E57 INVALID BACK REGISTER SIGNAL
E58 NO PAUSE BETWEEN REGISTER SIGN
E64 INVALID DIGIT RECEIVED
E65 PERMANENT DETECTED INC
E66 PERMANENT DETECTED OUT
E67 PREMATURE ANSWER
E68 PREMATURE MCI
E69 UNEXPECTED BACKWARD LN SIGNAL
E70 NO SECONDARY SIGNAL
E71 NO END OF PRIMARY SIGNAL
E72 INVALID CHARGING INFORMATION
E73 PREMATURE METER PULSE
E74 INVALID METER PULSE
E75 NOT PERMITTED METER PULSE
E76 NO SEIZURE RESPONSE FROM DCME
E77 INVALID ISUP MESSAGE
E78 HOP COUNTER EXHAUSTION
E95 LOSS OF FORWARD MESSAGE
E96 CLF NOT RECEIVED
E97 RLG NOT RECEIVED
E98 UNEXPECTED RLG RECEIVED INC
E99 UNEXPECTED RLG RECEIVED OUT

E100 INVALID FORWARD MESSAGE


E101 UNEXPECTED FORWARD MESSAGE
E102 INVALID BACKWARD MESSAGE
E103 UNEXPECTED BACKWARD MESSAGE
E104 ANSWER REC. BEFORE CTC FINISH
E105 NO RECEIVER FOR CTC
E106 UNEXPECTED COT-MSG RECEIVED
E108 MORE THAN 2 SATELLITES IN CON.
E112 US: PARTIAL DIAL ABANDON (INC)
E113 US: PARTIAL DIAL TIMEOUT (INC)
E114 US: EXTRA DIGIT RECEIVED (INC)
E115 US: EXTRA PULSE RECEIVED (INC)
E116 US: MORE THAN ONE MF KP SIGN.
E117 US: MISPLACED ST SIGNAL (INC)
E118 US: MUTILATED DIGIT (INC)
E119 US: NO KP (INC)
E120 US: PERM. SIGNAL TIMEOUT (INC)
E121 US: DELAY DIAL STEADY OFF HOOK
E122 US: DELAY DIAL STEADY ON HOOK
E123 US: WINK START,STEADY ON HOOK
E124 US: WINK START,STEADY OFF HOOK
E125 US: NO EXPECTED STOP
E126 US: POLARITY FAILURE
E127 US: UNEXPECTED STOP

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 8+


ACT EQTRAP
PALLHUSP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E128 US: STOP SIGNAL TOO LONG


E129 US: T/O WAIT FOR CONNECT
E130 US: T/O WAIT AFTER ANI
E131 US: T/O WAIT AFTER CARRIER ID.
E132 US: T/O WAIT FOR SECOND START
E133 US: O-H WAIT AFTER ANI
E134 US: O-H WAIT AFTER CARRIER ID.
E135 US: O-H WAIT FOR SECOND START
E136 US: INVALID TCM LENGTH
E137 US: CCS, IAM SIGNALING ERROR
E138 US: CCS, RESET SIGNAL RECEIVED
E139 US: CCS, WAIT FOR CONTINUE
E140 US: CCS, INCOMPLETE ADDRESS
E141 US: CCS, SIGNALING NETW. FAIL.
E142 US: CCS, VACANT CODE
E143 US: CCS, TIME OUT WAITING
E144 US: CCS, ADDRESS INCOMPLETE
E145 US: CCS, CONTINUITY CHECK
E146 US: CCS, CONFUSION SIGNAL
E147 US: CCS, VACANT NATIONAL NUM.
E148 US: CCS, RELEASE GUARD SIGNAL
E149 US: CCS, RESET SIGNAL
E150 US: CCS, SIGNALING NETW. FAIL.
E151 US: TIMEOUT WAIT FOR EXM-SIGN.
E160 ANALOG CARRIER FAILURE
E176 HANG PROTECT TIMER EXPIRED
E200 FAULTY SELECTIVE NUMBER
E201 UNEXPECTED SIGNAL
E202 INVALID SIGNAL COMBINATION
E205 INVALID NATURE OF ADDR IND.
E216 AUTOM. ANSWER SUPERV. TIMEOUT
E220 US: SIGN. FAIL. / FXS-TRUNK
E225 EXTREME CALL DURATION TIME OUT
E227 MESSAGE WITH INCORRECT DIGITS
E228 DISCARDED ISUP MESSAGE
E229 DISCARDED ISUP PARAMETER
E230 TIME OUT WAITING FOR CLEARING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 9+


ACT EQTRAP
PSPEHSPE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

PRINT SPECIFIED HOLD SPECIFIED

Input format for activating a printout and the attempt to hold the
connection for the occurrence of specified MDIIs (machine detected
interoffice irregularity).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT EQTRAP : LTG= [,LC=] ,ERCO= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...127, range of decimal numbers

Dependent on the Switching Network Hardware this unit


represents the Time Stage Group (TSG for SNB) or the
Switching Network Multiplexer (SNMUX for SND and
upper ones).

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


1...63, range of decimal numbers

LC LINE CONNECTION

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a[-b]

a: LINE TRUNK UNIT=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: CHANNEL=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

ERCO ERROR CODE

This parameter specifies the MDII.


Notes:
- Only up to 6 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: ERROR CODE
E1 SEIZE AND RELEASE WITHOUT DIG.

E16 NO SEIZURE RESPONSE


E17 NO PROCEED TO SEND
E18 NO KP ACKNOWLEDGE
E19 NO WINK SIGNAL RECEIVED
E20 NO WINK END RECEIVED
E32 NO FIRST DIGIT NO KP SIGNAL

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 10+


ACT EQTRAP
PSPEHSPE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E33 TRUNK OFFERING SUPERVI TIMEOUT


E34 NO END OF ADDRESS SIGNAL (ST)
E35 UNACCEPTABLE DIAL PULSE
E48 MF 2/6 ERROR NOT TWO TONES
E49 INVALID FORWD REGISTER SIGNAL
E50 CONTINUOUS FORW REGISTER SIGN
E52 UNEXPECTED FORW REGISTER SIGN
E53 LOSS OF FORW REGISTER SIGNAL
E54 CONTINUOUS BACK SIGNAL
E55 NO BACK SIGNAL
E56 UNEXPECTED BACK REGISTER SIGN
E57 INVALID BACK REGISTER SIGNAL
E58 NO PAUSE BETWEEN REGISTER SIGN
E64 INVALID DIGIT RECEIVED
E65 PERMANENT DETECTED INC
E66 PERMANENT DETECTED OUT
E67 PREMATURE ANSWER
E68 PREMATURE MCI
E69 UNEXPECTED BACKWARD LN SIGNAL
E70 NO SECONDARY SIGNAL
E71 NO END OF PRIMARY SIGNAL
E72 INVALID CHARGING INFORMATION
E73 PREMATURE METER PULSE
E74 INVALID METER PULSE
E75 NOT PERMITTED METER PULSE
E76 NO SEIZURE RESPONSE FROM DCME
E77 INVALID ISUP MESSAGE
E78 HOP COUNTER EXHAUSTION
E95 LOSS OF FORWARD MESSAGE
E96 CLF NOT RECEIVED
E97 RLG NOT RECEIVED
E98 UNEXPECTED RLG RECEIVED INC
E99 UNEXPECTED RLG RECEIVED OUT

E100 INVALID FORWARD MESSAGE


E101 UNEXPECTED FORWARD MESSAGE
E102 INVALID BACKWARD MESSAGE
E103 UNEXPECTED BACKWARD MESSAGE
E104 ANSWER REC. BEFORE CTC FINISH
E105 NO RECEIVER FOR CTC
E106 UNEXPECTED COT-MSG RECEIVED
E108 MORE THAN 2 SATELLITES IN CON.
E112 US: PARTIAL DIAL ABANDON (INC)
E113 US: PARTIAL DIAL TIMEOUT (INC)
E114 US: EXTRA DIGIT RECEIVED (INC)
E115 US: EXTRA PULSE RECEIVED (INC)
E116 US: MORE THAN ONE MF KP SIGN.
E117 US: MISPLACED ST SIGNAL (INC)
E118 US: MUTILATED DIGIT (INC)
E119 US: NO KP (INC)
E120 US: PERM. SIGNAL TIMEOUT (INC)
E121 US: DELAY DIAL STEADY OFF HOOK
E122 US: DELAY DIAL STEADY ON HOOK
E123 US: WINK START,STEADY ON HOOK
E124 US: WINK START,STEADY OFF HOOK
E125 US: NO EXPECTED STOP
E126 US: POLARITY FAILURE
E127 US: UNEXPECTED STOP
E128 US: STOP SIGNAL TOO LONG
E129 US: T/O WAIT FOR CONNECT
E130 US: T/O WAIT AFTER ANI
E131 US: T/O WAIT AFTER CARRIER ID.
E132 US: T/O WAIT FOR SECOND START
E133 US: O-H WAIT AFTER ANI
E134 US: O-H WAIT AFTER CARRIER ID.
E135 US: O-H WAIT FOR SECOND START
E136 US: INVALID TCM LENGTH
E137 US: CCS, IAM SIGNALING ERROR
E138 US: CCS, RESET SIGNAL RECEIVED
E139 US: CCS, WAIT FOR CONTINUE
E140 US: CCS, INCOMPLETE ADDRESS
E141 US: CCS, SIGNALING NETW. FAIL.
E142 US: CCS, VACANT CODE
E143 US: CCS, TIME OUT WAITING
E144 US: CCS, ADDRESS INCOMPLETE
E145 US: CCS, CONTINUITY CHECK
E146 US: CCS, CONFUSION SIGNAL

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 11+


ACT EQTRAP
PSPEHSPE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E147 US: CCS, VACANT NATIONAL NUM.


E148 US: CCS, RELEASE GUARD SIGNAL
E149 US: CCS, RESET SIGNAL
E150 US: CCS, SIGNALING NETW. FAIL.
E151 US: TIMEOUT WAIT FOR EXM-SIGN.
E160 ANALOG CARRIER FAILURE
E176 HANG PROTECT TIMER EXPIRED
E200 FAULTY SELECTIVE NUMBER
E201 UNEXPECTED SIGNAL
E202 INVALID SIGNAL COMBINATION
E205 INVALID NATURE OF ADDR IND.
E216 AUTOM. ANSWER SUPERV. TIMEOUT
E220 US: SIGN. FAIL. / FXS-TRUNK
E225 EXTREME CALL DURATION TIME OUT
E227 MESSAGE WITH INCORRECT DIGITS
E228 DISCARDED ISUP MESSAGE
E229 DISCARDED ISUP PARAMETER
E230 TIME OUT WAITING FOR CLEARING

b: HOLD CONDITION
H HOLD
The connection is to be held for a port, when
a certain MDII occurs.

Specifies whether the connection is to be held for


a port when a certain error code occurs.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 12+


ACT EQTRAP
PUSPHNON
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

6. Input format

PRINT UNSPECIFIED HOLD NONE

Input format for activating a printout for the occurrence of all except
the specified MDIIs (machine detected interoffice irregularity).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT EQTRAP : LTG= [,LC=] ,PRINT= ,ERCO= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...127, range of decimal numbers

Dependent on the Switching Network Hardware this unit


represents the Time Stage Group (TSG for SNB) or the
Switching Network Multiplexer (SNMUX for SND and
upper ones).

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


1...63, range of decimal numbers

LC LINE CONNECTION

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a[-b]

a: LINE TRUNK UNIT=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: CHANNEL=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

PRINT PRINT CONDITION

This parameter specifies whether a printout is required when an error


code occurs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

COMP COMPLEMENT OF ERRORCODES


Activates a printout of a port when any other
than the specified MDIIs occurs.

ERCO ERROR CODE

This parameter specifies the MDII.


Notes:
- Only up to 6 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

E1 SEIZE AND RELEASE WITHOUT DIG.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 13+


ACT EQTRAP
PUSPHNON
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E16 NO SEIZURE RESPONSE


E17 NO PROCEED TO SEND
E18 NO KP ACKNOWLEDGE
E19 NO WINK SIGNAL RECEIVED
E20 NO WINK END RECEIVED
E32 NO FIRST DIGIT NO KP SIGNAL
E33 TRUNK OFFERING SUPERVI TIMEOUT
E34 NO END OF ADDRESS SIGNAL (ST)
E35 UNACCEPTABLE DIAL PULSE
E48 MF 2/6 ERROR NOT TWO TONES
E49 INVALID FORWD REGISTER SIGNAL
E50 CONTINUOUS FORW REGISTER SIGN
E52 UNEXPECTED FORW REGISTER SIGN
E53 LOSS OF FORW REGISTER SIGNAL
E54 CONTINUOUS BACK SIGNAL
E55 NO BACK SIGNAL
E56 UNEXPECTED BACK REGISTER SIGN
E57 INVALID BACK REGISTER SIGNAL
E58 NO PAUSE BETWEEN REGISTER SIGN
E64 INVALID DIGIT RECEIVED
E65 PERMANENT DETECTED INC
E66 PERMANENT DETECTED OUT
E67 PREMATURE ANSWER
E68 PREMATURE MCI
E69 UNEXPECTED BACKWARD LN SIGNAL
E70 NO SECONDARY SIGNAL
E71 NO END OF PRIMARY SIGNAL
E72 INVALID CHARGING INFORMATION
E73 PREMATURE METER PULSE
E74 INVALID METER PULSE
E75 NOT PERMITTED METER PULSE
E76 NO SEIZURE RESPONSE FROM DCME
E77 INVALID ISUP MESSAGE
E78 HOP COUNTER EXHAUSTION
E95 LOSS OF FORWARD MESSAGE
E96 CLF NOT RECEIVED
E97 RLG NOT RECEIVED
E98 UNEXPECTED RLG RECEIVED INC
E99 UNEXPECTED RLG RECEIVED OUT

E100 INVALID FORWARD MESSAGE


E101 UNEXPECTED FORWARD MESSAGE
E102 INVALID BACKWARD MESSAGE
E103 UNEXPECTED BACKWARD MESSAGE
E104 ANSWER REC. BEFORE CTC FINISH
E105 NO RECEIVER FOR CTC
E106 UNEXPECTED COT-MSG RECEIVED
E108 MORE THAN 2 SATELLITES IN CON.
E112 US: PARTIAL DIAL ABANDON (INC)
E113 US: PARTIAL DIAL TIMEOUT (INC)
E114 US: EXTRA DIGIT RECEIVED (INC)
E115 US: EXTRA PULSE RECEIVED (INC)
E116 US: MORE THAN ONE MF KP SIGN.
E117 US: MISPLACED ST SIGNAL (INC)
E118 US: MUTILATED DIGIT (INC)
E119 US: NO KP (INC)
E120 US: PERM. SIGNAL TIMEOUT (INC)
E121 US: DELAY DIAL STEADY OFF HOOK
E122 US: DELAY DIAL STEADY ON HOOK
E123 US: WINK START,STEADY ON HOOK
E124 US: WINK START,STEADY OFF HOOK
E125 US: NO EXPECTED STOP
E126 US: POLARITY FAILURE
E127 US: UNEXPECTED STOP
E128 US: STOP SIGNAL TOO LONG
E129 US: T/O WAIT FOR CONNECT
E130 US: T/O WAIT AFTER ANI
E131 US: T/O WAIT AFTER CARRIER ID.
E132 US: T/O WAIT FOR SECOND START
E133 US: O-H WAIT AFTER ANI
E134 US: O-H WAIT AFTER CARRIER ID.
E135 US: O-H WAIT FOR SECOND START
E136 US: INVALID TCM LENGTH
E137 US: CCS, IAM SIGNALING ERROR
E138 US: CCS, RESET SIGNAL RECEIVED
E139 US: CCS, WAIT FOR CONTINUE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 14+


ACT EQTRAP
PUSPHNON
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E140 US: CCS, INCOMPLETE ADDRESS


E141 US: CCS, SIGNALING NETW. FAIL.
E142 US: CCS, VACANT CODE
E143 US: CCS, TIME OUT WAITING
E144 US: CCS, ADDRESS INCOMPLETE
E145 US: CCS, CONTINUITY CHECK
E146 US: CCS, CONFUSION SIGNAL
E147 US: CCS, VACANT NATIONAL NUM.
E148 US: CCS, RELEASE GUARD SIGNAL
E149 US: CCS, RESET SIGNAL
E150 US: CCS, SIGNALING NETW. FAIL.
E151 US: TIMEOUT WAIT FOR EXM-SIGN.
E160 ANALOG CARRIER FAILURE
E176 HANG PROTECT TIMER EXPIRED
E200 FAULTY SELECTIVE NUMBER
E201 UNEXPECTED SIGNAL
E202 INVALID SIGNAL COMBINATION
E205 INVALID NATURE OF ADDR IND.
E216 AUTOM. ANSWER SUPERV. TIMEOUT
E220 US: SIGN. FAIL. / FXS-TRUNK
E225 EXTREME CALL DURATION TIME OUT
E227 MESSAGE WITH INCORRECT DIGITS
E228 DISCARDED ISUP MESSAGE
E229 DISCARDED ISUP PARAMETER
E230 TIME OUT WAITING FOR CLEARING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 15+


ACT EQTRAP
PUSPHUSP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

7. Input format

PRINT UNSPECIFIED HOLD UNSPEC.

Input format for activating a printout and the attempt to hold the
connection for the occurrence of all except the specified MDIIs (machine
detected interoffice irregularity).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT EQTRAP : LTG= [,LC=] ,PRINT= ,HOLD= ,ERCO= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...127, range of decimal numbers

Dependent on the Switching Network Hardware this unit


represents the Time Stage Group (TSG for SNB) or the
Switching Network Multiplexer (SNMUX for SND and
upper ones).

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


1...63, range of decimal numbers

LC LINE CONNECTION

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a[-b]

a: LINE TRUNK UNIT=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: CHANNEL=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

PRINT PRINT CONDITION

This parameter specifies whether a printout is required when an error


code occurs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

COMP COMPLEMENT OF ERRORCODES


Activates a printout of a port when any other
than the specified MDIIs occurs.

HOLD HOLD CONDITION

This parameter specifies whether a connection is to be held for


a port when an error code occurs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

COMP COMPLEMENT OF ERRORCODES


Holds a connection of a port when any other

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 16+


ACT EQTRAP
PUSPHUSP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

than the specified MDIIs occurs.

ERCO ERROR CODE

This parameter specifies the MDII.


Notes:
- Only up to 6 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

E1 SEIZE AND RELEASE WITHOUT DIG.

E16 NO SEIZURE RESPONSE


E17 NO PROCEED TO SEND
E18 NO KP ACKNOWLEDGE
E19 NO WINK SIGNAL RECEIVED
E20 NO WINK END RECEIVED
E32 NO FIRST DIGIT NO KP SIGNAL
E33 TRUNK OFFERING SUPERVI TIMEOUT
E34 NO END OF ADDRESS SIGNAL (ST)
E35 UNACCEPTABLE DIAL PULSE
E48 MF 2/6 ERROR NOT TWO TONES
E49 INVALID FORWD REGISTER SIGNAL
E50 CONTINUOUS FORW REGISTER SIGN
E52 UNEXPECTED FORW REGISTER SIGN
E53 LOSS OF FORW REGISTER SIGNAL
E54 CONTINUOUS BACK SIGNAL
E55 NO BACK SIGNAL
E56 UNEXPECTED BACK REGISTER SIGN
E57 INVALID BACK REGISTER SIGNAL
E58 NO PAUSE BETWEEN REGISTER SIGN
E64 INVALID DIGIT RECEIVED
E65 PERMANENT DETECTED INC
E66 PERMANENT DETECTED OUT
E67 PREMATURE ANSWER
E68 PREMATURE MCI
E69 UNEXPECTED BACKWARD LN SIGNAL
E70 NO SECONDARY SIGNAL
E71 NO END OF PRIMARY SIGNAL
E72 INVALID CHARGING INFORMATION
E73 PREMATURE METER PULSE
E74 INVALID METER PULSE
E75 NOT PERMITTED METER PULSE
E76 NO SEIZURE RESPONSE FROM DCME
E77 INVALID ISUP MESSAGE
E78 HOP COUNTER EXHAUSTION
E95 LOSS OF FORWARD MESSAGE
E96 CLF NOT RECEIVED
E97 RLG NOT RECEIVED
E98 UNEXPECTED RLG RECEIVED INC
E99 UNEXPECTED RLG RECEIVED OUT

E100 INVALID FORWARD MESSAGE


E101 UNEXPECTED FORWARD MESSAGE
E102 INVALID BACKWARD MESSAGE
E103 UNEXPECTED BACKWARD MESSAGE
E104 ANSWER REC. BEFORE CTC FINISH
E105 NO RECEIVER FOR CTC
E106 UNEXPECTED COT-MSG RECEIVED
E108 MORE THAN 2 SATELLITES IN CON.
E112 US: PARTIAL DIAL ABANDON (INC)
E113 US: PARTIAL DIAL TIMEOUT (INC)
E114 US: EXTRA DIGIT RECEIVED (INC)
E115 US: EXTRA PULSE RECEIVED (INC)
E116 US: MORE THAN ONE MF KP SIGN.
E117 US: MISPLACED ST SIGNAL (INC)
E118 US: MUTILATED DIGIT (INC)
E119 US: NO KP (INC)
E120 US: PERM. SIGNAL TIMEOUT (INC)
E121 US: DELAY DIAL STEADY OFF HOOK
E122 US: DELAY DIAL STEADY ON HOOK
E123 US: WINK START,STEADY ON HOOK
E124 US: WINK START,STEADY OFF HOOK
E125 US: NO EXPECTED STOP
E126 US: POLARITY FAILURE
E127 US: UNEXPECTED STOP

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 17+


ACT EQTRAP
PUSPHUSP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E128 US: STOP SIGNAL TOO LONG


E129 US: T/O WAIT FOR CONNECT
E130 US: T/O WAIT AFTER ANI
E131 US: T/O WAIT AFTER CARRIER ID.
E132 US: T/O WAIT FOR SECOND START
E133 US: O-H WAIT AFTER ANI
E134 US: O-H WAIT AFTER CARRIER ID.
E135 US: O-H WAIT FOR SECOND START
E136 US: INVALID TCM LENGTH
E137 US: CCS, IAM SIGNALING ERROR
E138 US: CCS, RESET SIGNAL RECEIVED
E139 US: CCS, WAIT FOR CONTINUE
E140 US: CCS, INCOMPLETE ADDRESS
E141 US: CCS, SIGNALING NETW. FAIL.
E142 US: CCS, VACANT CODE
E143 US: CCS, TIME OUT WAITING
E144 US: CCS, ADDRESS INCOMPLETE
E145 US: CCS, CONTINUITY CHECK
E146 US: CCS, CONFUSION SIGNAL
E147 US: CCS, VACANT NATIONAL NUM.
E148 US: CCS, RELEASE GUARD SIGNAL
E149 US: CCS, RESET SIGNAL
E150 US: CCS, SIGNALING NETW. FAIL.
E151 US: TIMEOUT WAIT FOR EXM-SIGN.
E160 ANALOG CARRIER FAILURE
E176 HANG PROTECT TIMER EXPIRED
E200 FAULTY SELECTIVE NUMBER
E201 UNEXPECTED SIGNAL
E202 INVALID SIGNAL COMBINATION
E205 INVALID NATURE OF ADDR IND.
E216 AUTOM. ANSWER SUPERV. TIMEOUT
E220 US: SIGN. FAIL. / FXS-TRUNK
E225 EXTREME CALL DURATION TIME OUT
E227 MESSAGE WITH INCORRECT DIGITS
E228 DISCARDED ISUP MESSAGE
E229 DISCARDED ISUP PARAMETER
E230 TIME OUT WAITING FOR CLEARING

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT EQTRAP- 18-


CAN EQTRAP
ALLEQ
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL EQUIPMENT TRAP

This command deactivates the instant printout for the occurrence of the
specified or any error codes:
- on a particular port or on the ports
- in a port area of a particular line/trunk unit
- in a particular line/trunk unit
- in a line/trunk unit area of a particular line/trunk group
- in a particular line/trunk group
- in a line/trunk group area of a particular time switch group
- in a time switch group
- in the complete exchange.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CAN EQTRAP - ALLEQ ALL EQUIPMENTS


2. CAN EQTRAP - SPECEQ SPECIFIED EQUIPMENTS

1. Input format

ALL EQUIPMENTS

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN EQTRAP : [ERCO=] [,PRINT=] [,HOLD=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ERCO ERROR CODE

This parameter specifies the MDII.


Notes:
- Only up to 6 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: ERROR CODE
E0 NO ERROR
E1 SEIZE AND RELEASE WITHOUT DIG.
E100 INVALID FORWARD MESSAGE
E101 UNEXPECTED FORWARD MESSAGE
E102 INVALID BACKWARD MESSAGE
E103 UNEXPECTED BACKWARD MESSAGE
E104 ANSWER REC. BEFORE CTC FINISH
E105 NO RECEIVER FOR CTC
E106 UNEXPECTED COT-MSG RECEIVED
E108 MORE THAN 2 SATELLITES IN CON.
E112 US: PARTIAL DIAL ABANDON (INC)
E113 US: PARTIAL DIAL TIMEOUT (INC)
E114 US: EXTRA DIGIT RECEIVED (INC)
E115 US: EXTRA PULSE RECEIVED (INC)
E116 US: MORE THAN ONE MF KP SIGN.
E117 US: MISPLACED ST SIGNAL (INC)
E118 US: MUTILATED DIGIT (INC)
E119 US: NO KP (INC)
E120 US: PERM. SIGNAL TIMEOUT (INC)
E121 US: DELAY DIAL STEADY OFF HOOK
E122 US: DELAY DIAL STEADY ON HOOK
E123 US: WINK START,STEADY ON HOOK
E124 US: WINK START,STEADY OFF HOOK
E125 US: NO EXPECTED STOP
E126 US: POLARITY FAILURE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN EQTRAP- 1+


CAN EQTRAP
ALLEQ
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E127 US: UNEXPECTED STOP


E128 US: STOP SIGNAL TOO LONG
E129 US: T/O WAIT FOR CONNECT
E130 US: T/O WAIT AFTER ANI
E131 US: T/O WAIT AFTER CARRIER ID.
E132 US: T/O WAIT FOR SECOND START
E133 US: O-H WAIT AFTER ANI
E134 US: O-H WAIT AFTER CARRIER ID.
E135 US: O-H WAIT FOR SECOND START
E136 US: INVALID TCM LENGTH
E137 US: CCS, IAM SIGNALING ERROR
E138 US: CCS, RESET SIGNAL RECEIVED
E139 US: CCS, WAIT FOR CONTINUE
E140 US: CCS, INCOMPLETE ADDRESS
E141 US: CCS, SIGNALING NETW. FAIL.
E142 US: CCS, VACANT CODE
E143 US: CCS, TIME OUT WAITING
E144 US: CCS, ADDRESS INCOMPLETE
E145 US: CCS, CONTINUITY CHECK
E146 US: CCS, CONFUSION SIGNAL
E147 US: CCS, VACANT NATIONAL NUM.
E148 US: CCS, RELEASE GUARD SIGNAL
E149 US: CCS, RESET SIGNAL
E150 US: CCS, SIGNALING NETW. FAIL.
E151 US: TIMEOUT WAIT FOR EXM-SIGN.
E16 NO SEIZURE RESPONSE
E160 ANALOG CARRIER FAILURE
E17 NO PROCEED TO SEND
E176 HANG PROTECT TIMER EXPIRED
E18 NO KP ACKNOWLEDGE
E19 NO WINK SIGNAL RECEIVED
E20 NO WINK END RECEIVED
E200 FAULTY SELECTIVE NUMBER
E201 UNEXPECTED SIGNAL
E202 INVALID SIGNAL COMBINATION
E205 INVALID NATURE OF ADDR IND.
E216 AUTOM. ANSWER SUPERV. TIMEOUT
E220 US: SIGN. FAIL. / FXS-TRUNK
E225 EXTREME CALL DURATION TIME OUT
E227 MESSAGE WITH INCORRECT DIGITS
E228 DISCARDED ISUP MESSAGE
E229 DISCARDED ISUP PARAMETER
E230 TIME OUT WAITING FOR CLEARING
E32 NO FIRST DIGIT NO KP SIGNAL
E33 TRUNK OFFERING SUPERVI TIMEOUT
E34 NO END OF ADDRESS SIGNAL (ST)
E35 UNACCEPTABLE DIAL PULSE
E48 MF 2/6 ERROR NOT TWO TONES
E49 INVALID FORWD REGISTER SIGNAL
E50 CONTINUOUS FORW REGISTER SIGN
E52 UNEXPECTED FORW REGISTER SIGN
E53 LOSS OF FORW REGISTER SIGNAL
E54 CONTINUOUS BACK SIGNAL
E55 NO BACK SIGNAL
E56 UNEXPECTED BACK REGISTER SIGN
E57 INVALID BACK REGISTER SIGNAL
E58 NO PAUSE BETWEEN REGISTER SIGN
E64 INVALID DIGIT RECEIVED
E65 PERMANENT DETECTED INC
E66 PERMANENT DETECTED OUT
E67 PREMATURE ANSWER
E68 PREMATURE MCI
E69 UNEXPECTED BACKWARD LN SIGNAL
E70 NO SECONDARY SIGNAL
E71 NO END OF PRIMARY SIGNAL
E72 INVALID CHARGING INFORMATION
E73 PREMATURE METER PULSE
E74 INVALID METER PULSE
E75 NOT PERMITTED METER PULSE
E76 NO SEIZURE RESPONSE FROM DCME
E77 INVALID ISUP MESSAGE
E78 HOP COUNTER EXHAUSTION
E95 LOSS OF FORWARD MESSAGE
E96 CLF NOT RECEIVED
E97 RLG NOT RECEIVED
E98 UNEXPECTED RLG RECEIVED INC
E99 UNEXPECTED RLG RECEIVED OUT

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN EQTRAP- 2+


CAN EQTRAP
ALLEQ
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: HOLD CONDITION
H HOLD
The connection is to be held for a port, when
a certain MDII occurs.

Specifies whether the connection is to be held for


a port when a certain error code occurs.

PRINT PRINT CONDITION

This parameter defines together with the parameters HOLD and ERCO
a combination; the instant printout is deactivated on the ports on
that it was activated with this combination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALL ALL ERROR CODES


COMP COMPLEMENT OF ERROR CODES

HOLD HOLD CONDITION

This parameter defines together with the parameter PRINT and


ERCO a combination; the instant printout is deactivated on the ports
on that it was activated with this combination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALL ALL ERROR CODES


COMP COMPLEMENT OF ERROR CODES

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN EQTRAP- 3+


CAN EQTRAP
SPECEQ
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

SPECIFIED EQUIPMENTS

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN EQTRAP : [ERCO=] ,LTG= ,LC= [,PRINT=] [,HOLD=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ERCO ERROR CODE

This parameter specifies the MDII.


Notes:
- Only up to 6 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: ERROR CODE
E0 NO ERROR
E1 SEIZE AND RELEASE WITHOUT DIG.
E100 INVALID FORWARD MESSAGE
E101 UNEXPECTED FORWARD MESSAGE
E102 INVALID BACKWARD MESSAGE
E103 UNEXPECTED BACKWARD MESSAGE
E104 ANSWER REC. BEFORE CTC FINISH
E105 NO RECEIVER FOR CTC
E106 UNEXPECTED COT-MSG RECEIVED
E108 MORE THAN 2 SATELLITES IN CON.
E112 US: PARTIAL DIAL ABANDON (INC)
E113 US: PARTIAL DIAL TIMEOUT (INC)
E114 US: EXTRA DIGIT RECEIVED (INC)
E115 US: EXTRA PULSE RECEIVED (INC)
E116 US: MORE THAN ONE MF KP SIGN.
E117 US: MISPLACED ST SIGNAL (INC)
E118 US: MUTILATED DIGIT (INC)
E119 US: NO KP (INC)
E120 US: PERM. SIGNAL TIMEOUT (INC)
E121 US: DELAY DIAL STEADY OFF HOOK
E122 US: DELAY DIAL STEADY ON HOOK
E123 US: WINK START,STEADY ON HOOK
E124 US: WINK START,STEADY OFF HOOK
E125 US: NO EXPECTED STOP
E126 US: POLARITY FAILURE
E127 US: UNEXPECTED STOP
E128 US: STOP SIGNAL TOO LONG
E129 US: T/O WAIT FOR CONNECT
E130 US: T/O WAIT AFTER ANI
E131 US: T/O WAIT AFTER CARRIER ID.
E132 US: T/O WAIT FOR SECOND START
E133 US: O-H WAIT AFTER ANI
E134 US: O-H WAIT AFTER CARRIER ID.
E135 US: O-H WAIT FOR SECOND START
E136 US: INVALID TCM LENGTH
E137 US: CCS, IAM SIGNALING ERROR
E138 US: CCS, RESET SIGNAL RECEIVED
E139 US: CCS, WAIT FOR CONTINUE
E140 US: CCS, INCOMPLETE ADDRESS
E141 US: CCS, SIGNALING NETW. FAIL.
E142 US: CCS, VACANT CODE
E143 US: CCS, TIME OUT WAITING
E144 US: CCS, ADDRESS INCOMPLETE
E145 US: CCS, CONTINUITY CHECK
E146 US: CCS, CONFUSION SIGNAL
E147 US: CCS, VACANT NATIONAL NUM.
E148 US: CCS, RELEASE GUARD SIGNAL
E149 US: CCS, RESET SIGNAL
E150 US: CCS, SIGNALING NETW. FAIL.
E151 US: TIMEOUT WAIT FOR EXM-SIGN.
E16 NO SEIZURE RESPONSE
E160 ANALOG CARRIER FAILURE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN EQTRAP- 4+


CAN EQTRAP
SPECEQ
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E17 NO PROCEED TO SEND


E176 HANG PROTECT TIMER EXPIRED
E18 NO KP ACKNOWLEDGE
E19 NO WINK SIGNAL RECEIVED
E20 NO WINK END RECEIVED
E200 FAULTY SELECTIVE NUMBER
E201 UNEXPECTED SIGNAL
E202 INVALID SIGNAL COMBINATION
E205 INVALID NATURE OF ADDR IND.
E216 AUTOM. ANSWER SUPERV. TIMEOUT
E220 US: SIGN. FAIL. / FXS-TRUNK
E225 EXTREME CALL DURATION TIME OUT
E227 MESSAGE WITH INCORRECT DIGITS
E228 DISCARDED ISUP MESSAGE
E229 DISCARDED ISUP PARAMETER
E230 TIME OUT WAITING FOR CLEARING
E32 NO FIRST DIGIT NO KP SIGNAL
E33 TRUNK OFFERING SUPERVI TIMEOUT
E34 NO END OF ADDRESS SIGNAL (ST)
E35 UNACCEPTABLE DIAL PULSE
E48 MF 2/6 ERROR NOT TWO TONES
E49 INVALID FORWD REGISTER SIGNAL
E50 CONTINUOUS FORW REGISTER SIGN
E52 UNEXPECTED FORW REGISTER SIGN
E53 LOSS OF FORW REGISTER SIGNAL
E54 CONTINUOUS BACK SIGNAL
E55 NO BACK SIGNAL
E56 UNEXPECTED BACK REGISTER SIGN
E57 INVALID BACK REGISTER SIGNAL
E58 NO PAUSE BETWEEN REGISTER SIGN
E64 INVALID DIGIT RECEIVED
E65 PERMANENT DETECTED INC
E66 PERMANENT DETECTED OUT
E67 PREMATURE ANSWER
E68 PREMATURE MCI
E69 UNEXPECTED BACKWARD LN SIGNAL
E70 NO SECONDARY SIGNAL
E71 NO END OF PRIMARY SIGNAL
E72 INVALID CHARGING INFORMATION
E73 PREMATURE METER PULSE
E74 INVALID METER PULSE
E75 NOT PERMITTED METER PULSE
E76 NO SEIZURE RESPONSE FROM DCME
E77 INVALID ISUP MESSAGE
E78 HOP COUNTER EXHAUSTION
E95 LOSS OF FORWARD MESSAGE
E96 CLF NOT RECEIVED
E97 RLG NOT RECEIVED
E98 UNEXPECTED RLG RECEIVED INC
E99 UNEXPECTED RLG RECEIVED OUT

b: HOLD CONDITION
H HOLD
The connection is to be held for a port, when
a certain MDII occurs.

Specifies whether the connection is to be held for


a port when a certain error code occurs.

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a[-b]

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...127, range of decimal numbers

Dependent on the Switching Network Hardware this unit


represents the Time Stage Group (TSG for SNB) or the
Switching Network Multiplexer (SNMUX for SND and
upper ones).

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN EQTRAP- 5+


CAN EQTRAP
SPECEQ
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


1...63, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

LC LINE CONNECTION

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a[-b]

a: LINE TRUNK UNIT=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: CHANNEL=
0...31, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

PRINT PRINT CONDITION

This parameter defines together with the parameters HOLD and ERCO
a combination; the instant printout is deactivated on the ports on
that it was activated with this combination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALL ALL ERROR CODES


COMP COMPLEMENT OF ERROR CODES

HOLD HOLD CONDITION

This parameter defines together with the parameter PRINT and


ERCO a combination; the instant printout is deactivated on the ports
on that it was activated with this combination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALL ALL ERROR CODES


COMP COMPLEMENT OF ERROR CODES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN EQTRAP- 6-


DISP ERRSTDAT
AUDIT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY ERROR STATISTIC DATA

This command displays audit or SWSG (software safeguarding)


statistic tables from
- the cycle disk file IA.ERST
- a sequential statistic disk file
- a statistic tape / magneto optical disk file

Prerequisites:
--------------
- A statistic file is:
a) the cycle disk file IA.ERST
b) a sequential file generated by copying the cycle disk
file IA.ERST
(command TRANS FILE)
c) a sequential file generated by copying the sequential file
created with b)
(command TRANS FILE).

- Before copying a statistic file to tape / magneto optical disk,


the tape / magneto optical disk must be initialized
(command INIT MT).

- If data are read from the cycle disk file IA.ERST, the statistic
data available in the IA-buffer (but not yet written into IA.ERST)
are automatically displayed. This means that no transfer of the
IA-buffer to the cycle disk file IA.ERST is necessary before
displaying the statistic tables
(command TRANS BUFFER).

Possible effects:
-----------------
- If no further data applicable to the input parameter are found,
the final message is "NO (MORE) DATA FOR DISPLAY AVAILABLE".

Notes:
------
1) The following audit error tables can be provided:

a) Summary tables, i.e. how many errors were detected by audit?

. number of errors detected by each audit,


in descending order of number of occurrence
. number of errors detected for one given equipment
(DLU number, LTG number, port number)
. number of errors detected by one AUDIT
. number of errors for which an audit correction failed
. all these tables within a given date/time interval

b) Sequential tables, i.e. when were the errors detected by audit?

. all errors detected by audit


. all errors detected by one audit
. all errors detected for one given equipment
. all errors for which an audit correction failed
. all these tables, within a given date/time interval

2) The following SWSG error tables can be provided:

a) Summary tables, i.e. how many errors?

. number of SWSG errors for each module,


in descending order of number of occurrence
. number of SWSG errors for one selected module
. number of SWSG errors for a particular processor
. number of SWSG errors with a given recovery level
. all these tables within a given date/time interval

b) Sequential tables, i.e. when did the errors occur?

. all SWSG errors


. all SWSG errors reported by one selected module
. all SWSG errors with a given module name and error number
. all SWSG errors for a particular processor
. all SWSG errors with a given recovery level
. all these tables, within a given date/time interval

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ERRSTDAT- 1+


DISP ERRSTDAT
AUDIT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3) All parameter combinations are allowed in this command, but only


the parameters OBJECT and FORM determine the data to be
displayed.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP ERRSTDAT- AUDIT AUDIT TABLES


2. DISP ERRSTDAT- SWSG SOFTWARE SAFEGUARGING TABLES

1. Input format

AUDIT TABLES

This path is legal for displaying audit tables from


- the cyclic disk file IA.ERST
- a sequential statistic disk file
- a statistic tape / magneto optical disk file

The cyclic disk file IA.ERST is:


- created with ACT IAFEAT;
- written by: - IA-buffer management
(automatically when a buffer is full)
- the command TRANS BUFFER

Note:
-----
- It is possible that data already copied to tape / magneto optical
disk are displayed if addressing the cyclic disk file IA.ERST.
The command REL CYCFILE does not delete data from a cyclic
disk file but releases the data for overwriting.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ERRSTDAT : TYPE= [,FORM=] [,OBJECT=] [,ERRNO=] 1
1 1
1 [,LOADTYPE=] [,PORTTYPE=] [,LTG=] [,LC=] 1
1 1
1 [,DATE= [,TIME=]] [,MARK=] [,FILE=] [,VSN=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE TYPE OF DATA

This parameter specifies the type of the displayed data.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

AUDIT ERROR DETERMINED BY AUDIT

FORM FORMAT

This parameter specifies the format of the displayed data.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SEQ SEQUENTIAL TABLE (WHEN)


SUM SUMMARY TABLE(HOW MUCH ERRORS)

OBJECT OBJECT IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the object identification.


(audit name or module name)

1 ... 13 characters from the symbolic character set.


Exception: see prerequisites.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ERRSTDAT- 2+


DISP ERRSTDAT
AUDIT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Symbolic character set consists of:


- letter : A | B | ..... | Y | Z
- digit : 0 | 1 | ..... | 8 | 9
- special values : + | # | * | % | .

The audit name consists of:


- character 1 ... 13 = audit name e.g. ABILREG

The module name consists of:


- character 1 ... 5 = name, e.g. SIPRC
- character 6 ... 7 = variant, e.g. D2
- character 8 = type, e.g. C
- character 9 = separator,
- character 10 ... 13 = version, e.g. 0101

Prerequisites: (for module name only)


--------------
- type : C (source module) or
T (transient data module)
- separator : always dot (.)
- version : . each character must have a value between 0 and 9;
. when entering the version,
"name, variant, type and separator"
must be entered.
e.g. SIPRCD2C.0101

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...13 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ERRNO ERROR NUMBER

This parameter specifies the error number.

The errors listed in the table are reduced to the given error number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...999, range of decimal numbers

LOADTYPE LOAD TYPE OF GP

This parameter specifies the GP load type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: TYPE OF LTG
A LTG-A
B LTG-B
C LTG-C
CB LTG-CB
D LTG-D
H LTG-H

b: LOAD TYPE=
0...999, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

PORTTYPE PORT TYPE

This parameter specifies the port type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ANETW ACCESS NETWORK


ANNOU RECORDED ANNOUNCEMENT
CO CONFERENCE
CONS CONSOLE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ERRSTDAT- 3+


DISP ERRSTDAT
AUDIT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DLU DIGITAL CONCENTRATOR


DSW DIGITAL SWITCHBOARD
EQUIP EQUIPMENT
IWE INTERWORKING
KEY KEY
LINE LINE
MDN MULTIPLE DN
MPLX MULTIPLEXER
NC NOT CONNECTED
PADCF PRIMARY ACCESS D-CHANNEL FIXED
PANC PRIMARY ACCESS NOT CONNECTED
PBXLN PBX LINE
SUB SUBSCRIBER
TEQ TEST EQUIPMENT
TPC TEST PHONE CONTROL
TRUNK TRUNK

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line trunk group of the errors detected
by audit.

Possible values:
----------------

1) Equipment is DLU -> LTG = dlu, shelf

2) Equipment is LTGA/B/C -> LTG = ltgset, ltg

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: DLU OR LTGSET=
0...13020, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: SHELF OR LTG=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

LC LINE CONNECTION NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line connection number of the errors


detected by audit.

Possible values:
----------------

1) Equipment is DLU -> LC = module, circuit

2) Equipment is LTGA/B/C -> LC = ltu, channel

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: MODULE OR LTU=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: CIRCUIT OR CHANNEL=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ERRSTDAT- 4+


DISP ERRSTDAT
AUDIT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DATE DATE

This parameter specifies the date when the error occurred,


i.e. the date software error treatment was called or the date audit
detected the error.

Notes:
------
- The listed errors are reduced to those that occurred within
the given interval. If only one date is entered, the errors
are listed from the given date to the end of the addressed file.

Compatibilities:
----------------
- This parameter also displays all invalid "errors".
(=date/time insecure)
There is no comparison between insecure date/time in the file and
secure date/time which is entered by the operator.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

TIME TIME

This parameter specifies the time the error occurred,


i.e. the time software error treatment was called or the time audit
detected the error.

Notes:
------
- The listed errors are reduced to those that occurred within
the given interval. If only one time is entered, the errors
are listed from the given time to the end of the addressed file.

Compatibilities:
----------------
- This parameter also displays all invalid "errors".
(=date/time insecure)
There is no comparison between insecure date/time in the file and
secure date/time which is entered by the operator.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b-c

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECOND=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

MARK MARK OF AUDIT ERROR

This parameter specifies the mark of the error detected by audit.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

F AUDIT CORRECTION FAILED

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ERRSTDAT- 5+


DISP ERRSTDAT
AUDIT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

S AUDIT CORRECTION SUCCESSFUL

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file from which the
statistic data are read.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

Default: IA.ERST

VSN VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the volume serial number of the tape / magneto
optical disk from which the statistic data are read.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ERRSTDAT- 6+


DISP ERRSTDAT
SWSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

SOFTWARE SAFEGUARGING TABLES

This path is legal for displaying software safeguarding tables from


- the cyclic disk file IA.ERST
- a sequential statistic disk file
- a statistic tape / magneto optical disk file

The cyclic disk file IA.ERST is:


- created with ACT IAFEAT;
- written by: - IA-buffer management
(automatically when a buffer is full)
- the command TRANS BUFFER

Note:
-----
- It is possible that data already copied to tape / magneto optical
disk are displayed by adressing the cyclic disk file IA.ERST.
The command REL CYCFILE does not delete data from a cyclic
disk file but releases the data for overwriting.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ERRSTDAT : TYPE= [,FORM=] [,OBJECT=] [,ERRNO=] [,PRO=] 1
1 1
1 [,REC=] [,DATE= [,TIME=]] [,FILE=] [,VSN=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE TYPE OF DATA

This parameter specifies the type of the displayed data.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SWSG ERROR REPORTED SOFTW.SAFEGUARD

FORM FORMAT

This parameter specifies the format of the displayed data.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SEQ SEQUENTIAL TABLE (WHEN)


SUM SUMMARY TABLE(HOW MUCH ERRORS)

OBJECT OBJECT IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the object identification.


(audit name or module name)

1 ... 13 characters from the symbolic character set.


Exception: see prerequisites.

Symbolic character set consists of:


- letter : A | B | ..... | Y | Z
- digit : 0 | 1 | ..... | 8 | 9
- special values : + | # | * | % | .

The audit name consists of:


- character 1 ... 13 = audit name e.g. ABILREG

The module name consists of:


- character 1 ... 5 = name, e.g. SIPRC
- character 6 ... 7 = variant, e.g. D2
- character 8 = type, e.g. C
- character 9 = separator,
- character 10 ... 13 = version, e.g. 0101

Prerequisites: (for module name only)


--------------
- type : C (source module) or
T (transient data module)
- separator : always dot (.)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ERRSTDAT- 7+


DISP ERRSTDAT
SWSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- version : . each character must have a value between 0 and 9;


. when entering the version,
"name, variant, type and separator"
must be entered.
e.g. SIPRCD2C.0101

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...13 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ERRNO ERROR NUMBER

This parameter specifies the error number.

The errors listed in the table are reduced to the given error number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...999, range of decimal numbers

PRO PROCESSOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the processor for which the errors are to be
displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

AMP0 ATM PROCESSOR 0


AMP1 ATM PROCESSOR 1
AMP2 ATM PROCESSOR 2
AMP3 ATM PROCESSOR 3
AMP4 ATM PROCESSOR 4
AMP5 ATM PROCESSOR 5
BAPM BASE PROCESSOR / MASTER
BAPS BASE PROCESSOR / SPARE
CAP0 CALL PROCESSOR 0
CAP1 CALL PROCESSOR 1
CAP2 CALL PROCESSOR 2
CAP3 CALL PROCESSOR 3
CAP4 CALL PROCESSOR 4
CAP5 CALL PROCESSOR 5
CAP6 CALL PROCESSOR 6
CAP7 CALL PROCESSOR 7
CAP8 CALL PROCESSOR 8
CAP9 CALL PROCESSOR 9

REC PERFORMED RECOVERY LEVEL

This parameter must be entered when the error tables are to be reduced
to those which occurred with the given recovery level
(performed by SWET).

Notes:
------
- The performed recovery level is the recovery level executed by
SWET (software error treatment). The requested recovery level
is the recovery level entered by SWSG-user.
Normally, the performed recovery level corresponds to the
requested recovery level. Only in case of escalation the requested
level is increased (by SWET) to a higher recovery level (performed).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INSTAL RECOVERY DURING INSTALLATION


ISTART1 NEW LOAD OF CP, NSTART PROCESS
ISTART1B BASIC ISTART1
ISTART2 ISTART1, LOAD PERIPHERY
ISTART2E EMERGENCY RECOVERY
ISTART2F FORCE RECOVERY
ISTART2G GENERATION CHANGE
ISTART2R RELOAD RECOVERY
NSTART0 NEW START OF ALL NOT CALLP
NSTART1 NEW START OF ALL CP PROCESSES
NSTART1B BASIC NSTART1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ERRSTDAT- 8+


DISP ERRSTDAT
SWSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NSTART2 NSTART1, LOAD OF SEMIPERM.DATA


NSTART3 NSTART2, LOAD CODE
PROBRD ONE PROCESSOR BREAKDOWN
SASDAT SAVING SYMPTOM WITHOUT STATIS.
SASDATS SAVING SYMPTOM WITH STATISTIC

DATE DATE

This parameter specifies the date when the error occurred,


i.e. the date software error treatment was called or the date audit
detected the error.

Notes:
------
- The listed errors are reduced to those that occurred within
the given interval. If only one date is entered, the errors
are listed from the given date to the end of the addressed file.

Compatibilities:
----------------
- This parameter also displays all invalid "errors".
(=date/time insecure)
There is no comparison between insecure date/time in the file and
secure date/time which is entered by the operator.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

TIME TIME

This parameter specifies the time the error occurred,


i.e. the time software error treatment was called or the time audit
detected the error.

Notes:
------
- The listed errors are reduced to those that occurred within
the given interval. If only one time is entered, the errors
are listed from the given time to the end of the addressed file.

Compatibilities:
----------------
- This parameter also displays all invalid "errors".
(=date/time insecure)
There is no comparison between insecure date/time in the file and
secure date/time which is entered by the operator.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b-c

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECOND=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ERRSTDAT- 9+


DISP ERRSTDAT
SWSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file from which the
statistic data are read.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

Default: IA.ERST

VSN VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the volume serial number of the tape / magneto
optical disk from which the statistic data are read.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ERRSTDAT- 10-


CR ERRTRCLOG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create Error Tracer Log

This task creates the ’Error tracer’ log with the log ID Q3ETR.
The ’Event log size’ can be set by the operator.

Notes:
- The ’Error tracer’ log is automatically created during system startup.
Use this task only if the ’Error tracer’ log was deleted during system
operation.

Possible Effects:
- It is possible to create the ’Error tracer’ log with up to 2 Giga Bytes of
storage capacity. Note that this will reduce the available disk capacity!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR ERRTRCLOG : [Event log size=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Event log size

This parameter specifies the size (storage capacity) of the ’Error


tracer’ log in
Kilo Bytes.
It is possible to create the ’Error tracer’ log with up to 2 Giga Bytes
of
storage capacity. Note that this will reduce the available disk capacity!

Input Format: RANGE (100 .. 2 000 000)

Default: 4 000

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR ERRTRCLOG- 1-
CAN ERRTRCREC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Error Tracer Records

This task cancels ’Error tracer log records’ from the ’Error tracer’ log. It is
possible to
define a range of the ’Log record ID’ or the ’Logging time’ attribute of the
’Error tracer log
records’ to be canceled.

Possible Effects:
- Error trace data will be lost, if not saved before executing this task.
- If no input parameter is used, the whole amount of contained
’Error tracer log records’ will be canceled.

Notes:
- To display the stored ’Error tracer log records’, see task ’DISP ERRTRCREC’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN ERRTRCREC : [Record range=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Record range

This parameter allows the definition of a filter for ’Error tracer log
records’ to be canceled.
It is possible to define a ’Range’ of either the ’Logging time’
attribute or
the ’Event log record’ name itself. The first record of this range is
always
the oldest record in the ’Error tracer’ log. Therefore it is only
necessary to
define the last record of this range.

If this parameter is not used, the whole amount of contained


’Error tracer log records’ will be canceled.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN ERRTRCREC- 1-


DISP ERRTRCRECF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Error Tracer Records to File

This task returns ’Error tracer log records’ stored in the ’Error Tracer’ log
that lie
within the specified input parameter boundaries. These boundaries can be chosen as
an interval of ’Logging time’ or ’Log record ID’.

Possible Effects:
- If no input parameter is given, the whole amount of contained ’Error tracer
log records’
will be displayed. This may lead to a long running job.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP ERRTRCRECF : [Record range=] [,Destination file=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Record range

This parameter allows the definition of a filter for ’Error tracer log
records’ to be displayed.
It is possible to define a ’Range’ of either the ’Logging time’ or the
’Event log record’
name itself.
If none of both filter parameters is used, the whole amount of contained
’Error tracer log records’ will be displayed. This may lead to a long
running job.

Input Format:
Selection ’Logging time range’:
’Begin time’: standard values for date and time
’End time’: standard values for date and time

Selection ’Record range’:


’Begin record’: RANGE (-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)
’End record’: RANGE (-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)

Destination file

This parameter defines a Windows NT output file for the records


retrieved. The entered value must specify a correct file name
in the Windows NT network.

Input format : Windows NT file name in UNC (Universal Naming


Convention) format:
\\<host name>\<share name>\<file name with
relative path from share>

Default value: If this parameter is omitted, the output is displayed


on terminal.

Note: An existing Windows NT file will be overwritten.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP ERRTRCRECF- 1-


CAN EVDEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Event Destination

This Task cancels one ’Event destination’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN EVDEST : Event destination= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Event destination

This parameter defines a unique Name for an ’Event destination’.


Enter its unique name to cancel one single ’Event destination’.

Input format : RANGE(-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN EVDEST- 1-


CR EVDEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create Event Destination

This Task creates an ’Event destination’. The ’Event destination’ is


used to determine which Event Reports are forwarded to a particular
’Destination’ during specified time periods. A ’Destination’ is an
Application running on a remote OS with the capability of receiving
Event Reports. It may also be used to specify the mode (confirm or no -
confirm) an Application has to act on received Event Reports. Each
’Event destination’ may contain a scheduling capability determining the
intervals during which Event Reports are selected for forwarding. Each
’Event destination’ contains an ’Event filter’ which specifies the
characteristics an Event Report must satisfy in order to be forwarded.

There is the opportunity to create a new ’Event destination’ with an


existing ’Event destination’ as reference. All parameter values of the
referenced ’Event destination’ will be used.
Parameters that are entered will overwrite the referenced ones.

If the creation by reference is not used the following parameters are


mandatory: ’Destination’, ’Dest. with backup’ and ’Event filter’.

The ’Availability’ parameter cannot be entered. It’s values {-, On, Off}
represents the scheduling states. The value "-" means that no scheduling
parameter was entered, so scheduling has no efect whether the ’Event
destination’ is "On" or "Off".

Note:
- The parameters for daily scheduling and weekly scheduling exclude
one another.

- The parameters ’Destination’ and ’Dest. with backup’ exclude


one another.

- It is not possible to add parameters by the MOD EVDEST Task if they


were omitted in this Task.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR EVDEST : Event destination= [,Reference event dest.=] 1
1 1
1 [,Destination=] [,Dest. with backup=] [,Conf on receipt=] 1
1 1
1 [,Event filter=] [,Administrative state=] [,Start time=] 1
1 1
1 [,Stop time=] [,Daily intervals=] [,Weekly intervals=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Event destination

This parameter defines a unique Name for an ’Event destination’.

Input format : RANGE(-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)

Reference event dest.

This parameter defines a unique Name for an ’Event destination’


already created. All parameter values of this referenced
’Event destination’ will be used. Parameters that are entered
will be used instead of the referenced values.

Input format : RANGE(-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)

Destination

This parameter defines ’single’ or ’multiple’ Application


Entity Title (AET). An AET represents the address of an
application running on a remote TMN-OS. This application
receives Event Reports routed by this ’Event destination’.
An AET value entered for this parameter must be administrated
in the Layer Management too.
If this parameter is entered the parameter ’Dest. with backup’

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR EVDEST- 1+
CR EVDEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

must not be entered.


It is possible to select 2 different types of ’Destination’:
’single’ : only one AET
’multiple’ : up to 6 AET

Input format for AET: 3 Up to 16 numbers separeted by blanks


number: RANGE(0 .. +2 147 483 647)

Dest. with backup

This parameter defines one active AET and up to 5 BackUp AETs


used in case of communication failure with the active one.
An AET represents the address of an application running on a
remote TMN-OS. This application receives Event Reports routed
by this ’Event destination’. An AET value entered for this
parameter must be administrated in the Layer Management too.

Input format for AET: 3 Up to 16 numbers separeted by blanks


number: RANGE(0 .. +2 147 483 647)

Conf on receipt

This parameter defines if a confirmation on receipt is required.


The value ’Yes’ will force the receiving application to confirm
each Event Report routed by this ’Event destination’.
The value ’No’ means that the application does not confirm
each Event Report routed by this ’Event destination’.

Input format: ’Yes’ confirmation required


’No’ no confirmation required

Event filter

This parameter defines a filter for Event Reports. You may


define which Event Reports should be routed by this ’Event
destination’.
Each Event Report consists of three significant attributes.
They are ’Emitting object class’, ’Emitting object’ and
’Emitted event type’. You can enter a Set of those triplets.
Each member of the triplet is optional, but you must enter at
least one of them. The overall number of entered members must
not exceed the amount of 10.
If the three attributes of an Event Report matches those of
a triple the Event Report will be routed to the application
specified with the ’Destination’ or ’Dest. with backUp’
parameter.

Administrative state

This parameter is used to suspend and resume Event Report


routing by this ’Event destination’.

Input format: ’Unlocked’: Event Reports will be routed by


this ’Event destination’

’Locked’: Event Reports will not be routed by


this ’Event destination’

Default : ’Unlocked’

Start time

This parameter defines the ’Start time’ at which the


’Event destination’ becomes active. If only the ’Start time’
is set the ’Stop time’ will be set automatically to
’Continuous’. The time value is rounded up to a multiple of
5 minutes.

Input format: standard date and time values.

Default value: actual system time


will be set if this parameter is omitted but
’Stop time’ is set.

Stop time

This parameter defines the ’Stop time’ at which the

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR EVDEST- 2+
CR EVDEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

’Event destination’ becomes inactive. If only the ’Stop time’


is set the ’Start time’ will be set automatically to actual
system time of the switch.

Input format: option ’Continuous’


option ’Specific’ : standard date and
time values
Default value: option ’Continuous’
will be set if this parameter is omitted but
’Start time’ is set.

Daily intervals

This parameter selects daily scheduling. Up to 6 time


intervals can be specified within which the ’Event destination’
is active. If this parameter is entered the parameter for
weekly scheduling must not be entered.
The time values are rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.
Overlapping intervals are combined to one interval.

Input format : hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

Default: whole day

Weekly intervals

This parameter selects weekly scheduling. Up to 6 time


intervals can be defined for each day of the week. The
’Event destination’ will be inactive on days of the week not
selected and on days with 0 intervals selected. At least one
day with one interval must be selected.
If this parameter is entered the parameter for daily
scheduling must not be entered.
The time values are rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.
Overlapping intervals are combined to one interval.

Input format: hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval for one day)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

Default: selects all days of the week without any time


restriction. Inactive days must be disabled
from the default value.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR EVDEST- 3-
DISP EVDEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Disp Event Destination

This Task displays parameters of ’Event destination’. It is possible


to display one ’Event destination’ with all parameters or several with
a subset of parameters. The subset of parameters is:
’Event destination’, ’Event filter’, ’Administrative state’,
’Destination’, ’Destin with backUp’ and ’Availability’.

Omit all parameters to display all ’Event destination’.


Enter ’Event destination’ parameter to display one ’Event destination’
Enter ’Start id’ to display all ’Event destination’ starting with
this name.
Enter ’End id’ to display all ’Event destination’ up to this name.
Enter ’Start id’ and ’End id’ to display all ’Event destination’
between these two names.

The ’Availability’ parameter cannot be entered. It’s values {-, On, Off}
represents the scheduling states. The value "-" means that no scheduling
parameter was entered, so scheduling has no efect whether the ’Event
destination’ is "On" or "Off".

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP EVDEST : [Event destination=] [,Start id=] [,End id=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Event destination

This parameter defines a unique Name for an ’Event destination’.


Enter a unique name to display one single ’Event destination’
with all parameters.
This parameter is optional and may be omitted if all ’Event
destination’ shall be displayed with a subset of parameters.

Input format : RANGE(-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)

Start id

This parameter defines a unique Name for an ’Event destination’.


All ’Event destination’ will be displayed starting with this
name. If a value for ’End id’ is entered all ’Event destination’
between ’Start id’ and ’End id’ will be displayed.

Input format : RANGE(-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)

End id

This parameter defines a unique Name for an ’Event destination’.


All ’Event destination’ up to this name will be displayed. If a
value for ’Start id’ is entered all ’Event destination’ between
’Start id’ and ’End id’ will be displayed.

Input format : RANGE(-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP EVDEST- 1-


MOD EVDEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Event Destination

This Task modifies one ’Event destination’ with parameters given by


the user. If a value is omitted the corresponding parameter remains
unchanged.

Note:
- You cannot add parameters if they are not entered previously with
the CR EVNTDEST Task. You may execute DISP EVNTDEST Task to look up
the parameters entered before.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD EVDEST : Event destination= [,Destination=] [,Dest. with backup=] 1
1 1
1 [,Event filter=] [,Administrative state=] [,Start time=] 1
1 1
1 [,Stop time=] [,Daily intervals=] [,Weekly intervals=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Event destination

This parameter defines a unique Name for an existing


’Event destination’ that is to be modified.

Input format : RANGE(-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)

Destination

This parameter replaces ’single’ or ’multiple’ Application


Entity Title (AET). An AET represents the address of an
application running on a remote TMN-OS. This application
receives Event Reports routed by this ’Event destination’.
An AET value entered for this parameter must be administrated
in the Layer Management too.
If this parameter is entered the parameter ’Dest. with backup’
must not be entered.
It is possible to select 2 different types of ’Destination’:
’single’ : only one AET
’multiple’ : up to 6 AET

Input format for AET: 3 Up to 16 numbers separeted by blanks


number: RANGE(0 .. +2 147 483 647)

Dest. with backup

This parameter replaces one active AET and up to 5 BackUp AETs


used in case of communication failure with the active one.
An AET represents the address of an application running on a
remote TMN-OS. This application receives Event Reports routed
by this ’Event destination’. An AET value entered for this
parameter must be administrated in the Layer Management too.

Input format for AET: 3 Up to 16 numbers separeted by blanks


number: RANGE(0 .. +2 147 483 647)

Event filter

This parameter replaces a filter for Event Reports. You may


define which Event Reports should be routed by this ’Event
destination’. Each Event Report consists of three significant
attributes. They are ’Emitting object class’, ’Emitting object’
and ’Emitted event type’. You can enter a Set of those triplets.
Each member of the triplet is optional, but you must enter at
least one of them. The overall number of entered members must
not exceed the amount of 10.
If the three attributes of an Event Report matches those of a
triple the Event Report will be routed to the application
specified with the ’Destination’ or ’Dest. with backUp’
parameter.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD EVDEST- 1+


MOD EVDEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Administrative state

This parameter is used to suspend and resume Event Report


routing by this ’Event destination’.

Input format: ’Unlocked’: Event Reports will be routed by


this ’Event destination’

’Locked’: Event Reports will not be routed by


this ’Event destination’

Start time

This parameter replaces the ’Start time’ at which the ’Event


destination’ becomes active. The parameter can be replaced only
if a ’Start time’ or ’Stop time’ was entered when the ’Event
destination’ was created.

Input format: standard date and time values.

Stop time

This parameter replaces the ’Stop time’ at which the ’Event


destination’ becomes inactive. The parameter can be replaced
only if a ’Start time’ or ’Stop time’ was entered when the
’Event destination’ was created.

Input format: option ’Continuous’


option ’Specific’ : standard date and
time values

Default value: option ’Continuous’

Daily intervals

This parameter replaces ’Daily intervals’ (up to 6), at


which the ’Event destination’ is active. The parameter can be
entered only if ’Daily intervals’ were entered when the
’Event destination’ was created. The time values are rounded up
to a multiple of 5 minutes. Overlapping intervals are combined
to one interval.

Input format : hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

Weekly intervals

This parameter replaces ’Weekly intervals’, at which the


’Event destination’ is active. Only days of the week selected
in the parameter are replaced. The intervals of the days not
selected will not be changed. Enter 0 intervals to disable the
whole day. At least one day with one interval must be active
in the resultant ’Weekly intervals’; otherwise the parameter is
rejected.

Input format : hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval for one day)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD EVDEST- 2-


CAN EVLOG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Event Log

This task cancels an ’Event log’ with all ’Event log records’ contained .

Note:
Make sure that an ’Event log’ is not canceled before all
’Event log records’ have been retrieved with the DISP EVREC task.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN EVLOG : Event log= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Event log

This parameter specifies the name of the ’Event log’ to be deleted.

Input format:
’String’:
1 .. 18 characters of the following character set:
A .. Z, a .. z, 0 .. 9,
!, $, %, &, #, +, -, _,
(, ), ,, /, ;, <, =, >,
@, [, ], {, }, |

’Number’:
RANGE (-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN EVLOG- 1-


CR EVLOG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create Event Log

This task creates an ’Event log’, which is used to store Event Reports. Each
’Event log’ contains an ’Event filter’ which defines the characteristics for
an Event Report to be selected for storage. An Event Report that is selected
for storage is supplemented with additional information generated as a part
of the storage process to create so called ’Event log records’.

Possible effects:
It is possible to supply all ’Event log’ parameters without restriction.
In some cases, this may lead to high system load. For further details,
please refer to the help texts of the specific parameters.

Notes:
- The parameters for ’Daily intervals’ and ’Weekly intervals’ exclude one
another.
- Note that optional parameters must be selected when the ’Event log’ is
created. It is not possible to add opptional parameters later on by the
MOD EVLOG task.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR EVLOG : Event log= [,Log size=] [,Log full action=] 1
1 1
1 [,Capacity alarm thresholds=] ,Event filter= 1
1 1
1 [,Administrative state=] [,Start time=] [,Stop time=] 1
1 1
1 [,Daily intervals=] [,Weekly intervals=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Event log

This parameter specifies the name of the ’Event log’ to be created.


This can either be a ’String’ a ’Number’.

Input format:
’String’:
1 .. 18 characters of the following character set:
A .. Z, a .. z, 0 .. 9,
!, $, %, &, #, +, -, _,
(, ), ,, /, ;, <, =, >,
@, [, ], {, }, |

’Number’:
RANGE (-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)

Log size

This parameter specifies the size (storage capacity) of the ’Event log’
in
kilo bytes.

Input format: RANGE (100 .. 2 000 000)

Default: 10 000

Note: Is is possible to create ’Event logs’ with a storage capacity of up


to 2 giga bytes. Note however that this will considerably reduce
available
disk space!

Log full action

This paramteter defines overwrite characteristics.

Input format:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR EVLOG- 1+
CR EVLOG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

’Halt’: The ’Event log’ stops record storage when full.


’Wrap’: The oldest ’Event log records’ will be overwritten when new
’Event log records’ are stored.

Default: ’Wrap’

Capacity alarm thresholds

This parameter specifies up to five occupancy levels of an ’Event log’ at


which a ’Capacity alarm event’ should be initiated.

Input format:
Up to five RANGES (1 .. 100)

Notes:
- The occupancy level is expressed as a percentage.
- The 100% threshold for the ’Log full action’ ’Halt’ is defined
automatically.

Event filter

This parameter defines a filter for Event Reports. You may


define which Event Reports should be stored by this ’Event
log’.
Each Event Report consists of three significant attributes.
They are ’Emitting object class’, ’Emitting object’ and
’Emitted event type’. You can enter a Set of those triplets.
Each member of the triplet is optional, but you must enter at
least one of them. The overall number of entered members must
not exceed the amount of 10.
If the three attributes of an Event Report matches those of
a triple the Event Report will be stored in this ’Event log’.

Administrative state

This parameter is used to suspend and resume Event Report


storage by this ’Event log’.

Input format: ’Unlocked’: Event Reports will be stored by


this ’Event log’

’Locked’: Event Reports will not be stored by


this ’Event log’

Default : unlocked

Start time

This parameter defines the ’Start time’ the ’Event log’


becomes active. If only the ’Start time’ is set the ’Stop time’
will be set automatically to ’Continuous’. The time value is
rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.

Input format: standard date and time values.

Default value: actual system time


will be set if this parameter is omitted but
’Stop time’ is set.

Stop time

This parameter defines the ’Stop time’ the ’Event destination’


becomes inactive. If only the ’Stop time’ is set the
’Start time’ will be set automatically to actual system time
of the switch.

Input format: option ’Continuous’


option ’Specific’ : standard date and
time values
Default value: option ’Continuous’
will be set if this parameter is omitted but
’Start time’ is set.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR EVLOG- 2+
CR EVLOG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Daily intervals

This parameter selects daily scheduling. Up to 6 time


intervals can be specified, the ’Event log’ is active
within. If this parameter is entered the parameter for weekly
scheduling must not be entered.
The time values are rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.
Overlapping intervals are combined to one interval.

Input format : hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

Default: whole day

Weekly intervals

This parameter selects weekly scheduling. Up to 6 time


intervals can be defined for each day of the week. The
’Event log’ will be inactive on days of the week not
selected and on days with 0 intervals selected. At least one
day with one interval must be selected.
If this parameter is entered the parameter for daily
scheduling must not be entered.
The time values are rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.
Overlapping intervals are combined to one interval.

Input format: hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval for one day)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

Default: selects all days of the week without any time


restriction. Inactive days must be disabled
from the default value.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR EVLOG- 3-
DISP EVLOG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Event Log

This task displays status information of all ’Event logs’ for the whole system.
If the
name of a specific ’Event log’ is specified, detailed information for this ’Event
log’
will be displayed.

It is also possible to display status information for a subset of ’Event logs’


which
begin with the character string specified. For this case the parameter ’Event log
subset’
is used.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP EVLOG : [Event log=] [,Event log subset=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Event log

This parameter specifies the name of an ’Event log’ for which detailed
information
is requested. If neither the parameter ’Event log’ nor the
parameter ’Event log subset’ is used, an overview about all ’Event logs’
in the
whole system will be shown.

Input format:
’String’:
1 .. 18 characters of the following character set:
A .. Z, a .. z, 0 .. 9,
!, $, %, &, #, +, -, _,
(, ), ,, /, ;, <, =, >,
@, [, ], {, }, |

’Number’:
RANGE (-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)

Event log subset

This parameter specifies an initial string for ’Event logs’ with names in
’String’ representation. Status information will be displayed for all
’Event
logs’ beginning with this initial string. If neither the parameter
’Event log’
nor the parameter ’Event log subset’ is used, an overview about all
’Event logs’
of the whole System will be shown.

Input format:
’String’:
1 .. 18 characters of the following character set:
A .. Z, a .. z, 0 .. 9,
!, $, %, &, #, +, -, _,
(, ), ,, /, ;, <, =, >,
@, [, ], {, }, |

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP EVLOG- 1-


MOD EVLOG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Event Log

This task modifies a specific ’Event log’.


If a parameter value is omitted the corresponding parameter remains unchanged.

Note:
- Adding parameters with MOD EVLOG is not possible if they have not been entered
previously with the CR EVLOG task. Use the DISP EVLOG task to check the
parameters
entered before.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD EVLOG : Event log= [,Event filter=] [,Administrative state=] 1
1 1
1 [,Start time=] [,Stop time=] [,Daily intervals=] 1
1 1
1 [,Weekly intervals=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Event log

This parameter specifies the name of the ’Event log’ to be modified.

Input format:
’String’:
1 .. 18 characters of the following character set:
A .. Z, a .. z, 0 .. 9,
!, $, %, &, #, +, -, _,
(, ), ,, /, ;, <, =, >,
@, [, ], {, }, |

’Number’:
RANGE (-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)

Event filter

This parameter replaces a filter for Event Reports. You may


define which Event Reports should be stored by this ’Event
log’. Each Event Report consists of three significant
attributes. They are ’Emitting object class’, ’Emitting object’
and ’Emitted event type’. You can enter a Set of those triplets.
Each member of the triplet is optional, but you must enter at
least one of them. The overall number of entered members must
not exceed the amount of 10.
If the three attributes of an Event Report matches those of a
triple the Event Report will be stored in this ’Event log’.

Administrative state

This parameter is used to suspend and resume Event Report


storage by this ’Event log’.

Input format: ’Unlocked’: Event Reports will be stored by


this ’Event log’

’Locked’: Event Reports will not be stored by


this ’Event log’

Start time

This parameter replaces the ’Start time’ the ’Event


log’ becomes active. The parameter can be replaced only
if a ’Start time’ or ’Stop time’ was entered, when the ’Event
destination’ was created.

Input format: standard date and time values.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD EVLOG- 1+


MOD EVLOG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Stop time

This parameter replaces the ’Stop time’ the ’Event log’


becomes inactive. The parameter can be replaced only, if a
’Start time’ or ’Stop time’ was entered, when the ’Event
log’ was created.

Input format: option ’Continuous’


option ’Specific’ : standard date and
time values

Default value: option ’Continuous’

Daily intervals

This parameter replaces the ’Daily intervals’ (up to 6), the


’Event log’ is active within. The parameter can be
entered only, if ’Daily intervals’ were entered when the
’Event dlog’ was created. The time values are rounded up
to a multiple of 5 minutes. Overlapping intervals are combined
to one interval.

Input format : hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

Weekly intervals

This parameter replaces the ’Weekly intervals’, the ’Event


log’ is active within.
Only days of the week selected in the parameter are replaced.
The intervals of the days not selected will not be changed.
Enter 0 intervals to disable the whole day.
At least one day with one interval must be active in the
resultant ’Weekly intervals’; otherwise the parameter is
rejected.

Input format : hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval for one day)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD EVLOG- 2-


CAN EVREC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Event Log Records

This task cancels ’Event log records’ of a specific ’Event log’. It is


possible to define a ’Range’ of ’Event log records’ to be canceled.

Possible effects:
- If the parameter ’Record range’ is not used, the whole amount of stored
’Event log records’ will be canceled.

Note:
- Make sure that ’Event log records’ are not canceled before they have been
retrieved with the DISP EVREC task.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN EVREC : Event log= [,Record range=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Event log

This parameter specifies the name of the ’Event log’ from which ’Event
log records’
are to be canceled.

Input format:
’String’:
1 .. 18 characters of the following character set:
A .. Z, a .. z, 0 .. 9,
!, $, %, &, #, +, -, _,
(, ), ,, /, ;, <, =, >,
@, [, ], {, }, |

’Number’:
RANGE (-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)

Record range

This parameter allows the definition of a filter for ’Event log records’
to be canceled.
It is possible to define a ’Range’ of either the ’Logging time’
attribute or
the ’Event log record’ name itself. The first record of this range is
always the
oldest record in the ’Event log’. Therefore it is only necessary to
define
the last Record of this range.

Note:
If this parameter is not used, the whole amount of stored ’Event log
records’
will be canceled.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN EVREC- 1-


DISP EVRECF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Event Log Records Into File

This task displays ’Event log records’ of a specific ’Event log’. It is


possible to define a ’Range’ of ’Event log records’ to be displayed. Furthermore
it is possible to reduce the amount of displayed ’Event log records’ by using
a ’Detailed filter’ of several ’Event log record’ attributes.

Possible Effects:
If neither the ’Record range’ nor the ’Detailed filter’ parameter is used, the
whole amount
of contained ’Event log records’ will be displayed. This may lead to a long
running job
with a high amount of output data.

Note:
The output will be in an internal CMIS Syntax Notation format.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP EVRECF : Event log= [,Record range=] [,Detailed filter=] 1
1 1
1 [,Destination file=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Event log

This parameter specifies the name of the ’Event log’, from which ’Event
log records’
are to be displayed.

Input format:
’String’:
1 .. 18 characters of the following character set:
A .. Z, a .. z, 0 .. 9,
!, $, %, &, #, +, -, _,
(, ), ,, /, ;, <, =, >,
@, [, ], {, }, |

’Number’:
RANGE (-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)

Record range

This parameter allows the definition of a filter for the ’Event log
records’
to be displayed. It is possible to define a ’Range’ of either the
’Logging time’
attribute or the ’Event log record’ name itself.

Input Format:
Selection ’Logging time range’:
’Begin time’: standard values for date and time
’End time’: standard values for date and time

Selection ’Record range’:


’Begin record’: RANGE (-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)
’End record’: RANGE (-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)

Note:
- Searching for specific ’Event log records’ using this ’Record
range’ filter
is very fast.
- If neither the ’Record range’ nor the ’Detailed filter’ parameter
is used, the
whole amount of contained ’Event log records’ will be displayed.
This may
lead to a long running job with a high amount of output data.
- If also the ’Detailed filter’ parameter is used, both filter
conditions are

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP EVRECF- 1+


DISP EVRECF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

combined with a logical AND.

Detailed filter

This parameter allows the definition of additional filter conditions for


’Event log records’
to be displayed. Each ’Event log record’ consists of several significant
attributes.
You can enter a set of those attributes. Each member of this set is
optional, but you
must enter at least one of them. The overall number of entered members
must not exceed
the amount of 10.

If the attributes of a ’Event log record’ matches those set of attributes


the ’Event log record’ will be displayed. Members that are not entered
will always
match the according attribute in the ’Event log record’. It is possible
to define
up to 3 different sets of attributes.

Input Format:
’Emitting object class’: standard ’Object class’ selection
’Emitting object’: standard ’Object’ selection
’Emitted event type’: standard ’Event type’ selection
’Record class’: standard ’Object class’ selection
’Notification identifier’: RANGE (-2 147 483 648 .. +2 147 483 647)
’Perceived severity’: possible values:
’Indeterminate’,
’Critical’,
’Major’,
’Minor’,
’Warning’,
’Cleared’

Note:
- Searching for specific ’Event log records’ using the ’Detailed
filter’ may be
time consuming.
- If neither the ’Record range’ nor the ’Detailed filter’ parameter
is used, the
whole amount of contained ’Event log records’ will be displayed.
This may
lead to a long running job with a high amount of output data.
- If also the ’Record range’ parameter is used, both filter
conditions are
combined with a logical AND.

Destination file

This parameter defines a Windows NT output file for the records


retrieved. The entered value must specify a correct file name
in the Windows NT network.

Input format : Windows NT file name in UNC (Universal Naming


Convention) format:
\\<host name>\<share name>\<file name with
relative path from share>

Default value: If this parameter is omitted, the output is displayed


on terminal.

Note: An existing Windows NT file will be overwritten.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP EVRECF- 2-


REC EXCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RECORD EXCHANGE DATA

This command is used to record exchange load and traffic data


of calls carried and rejected due to network management and
internal protection mechanisms.
This measurement includes the following values:
- Processor load (mErl)
- Call processing load (mErl)
- Number of offered seizures
- Number of carried calls
- Number of calls rejected due to Leaky Bucket
- Number of calls rejected due to Trunk Reservation
- Number of calls rejected due to CancelTo
- Number of calls rejected due to All Trunks Busy
- Number of calls rejected due to internal protection mechanisms
- Number of calls with answer
- Congestion level indicator

Prerequisites:
- System time must be secure when the command is entered.

Notes:
- The name of the measurement file is displayed on the OMT
if disk output of traffic data is requested.
- A maximum of 1 job of this type may be entered at the
same time.
- The traffic data are output every 15 minutes within the
selected measurement intervals.
At least 15 minutes elapse before the first data are output
with immediate start.
- The measurement can be stopped with STOP JOB, except
jobs with UNIT=MDD-DAILY.

This command starts a semipermanent job. It can be canceled with CAN JOB.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REC EXCH : UNIT= [,BEG=] [,TER=] [,IV=] [,PER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

UNIT OUTPUT UNIT AND MODE

This parameter specifies the output unit and the mode of


output.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: OUTPUT UNIT
OMT OPERATION AND MAIN. TERMINAL
If this option is selected, data are output
to the OMT.
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
If this option is selected, a measurement file
is created and the traffic data are output to
this file. The start and the finish message
include the name of the file in which the
traffic data are available for postprocessing.

Notes :
- If a file is destroyed or cannot be extended,
an advisory is sent to the OMT.

This information unit specifies the output unit.

b: OUTPUT MODE
SINGLE SINGLE TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are output
to a single measurement file.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC EXCH- 1+


REC EXCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DAILY DAILY TRAFFIC FILE


If this option is selected, the data are output
to daily files. The measurement starts
immediately and has no defined end. Time
parameters are not permitted.
To secure the required space on disk, all 7
daily files are prepared and created at the
start of measurement.
A daily file is closed at the end of the day
and a new file for the next day is
automatically created, or the existing file is
replaced.
Daily files will be overwritten in the
following week on the same weekday.

This information unit specifies the desired output


mode (daily file or single measurement file).
It is only permissible in connection with output
UNIT=MDD.

BEG BEGIN DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement begin date.

Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER
must be specified.
Exception: Time parameters cannot be specified for data
output in daily files.
- A maximum of four BEG dates in chronological order may
be linked with &. In the case of linked BEG dates, TER
is not permitted.
If no TER is selected, the measurement is active on the
specified BEG days only.
- The earliest possible begin date BEG is the day after
command input.
- The first BEG date must be within an interval of one
month starting from the current date.
- The other BEG dates must be within an interval of
one year starting from the current date.
- The measurement on the actual BEG day can be stopped
with STOP JOB. If the measurement is stopped on the
last BEG day, it will be finished.

Default: the begin of measurement is the current date.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

TER TERMINATION DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement termination date.

Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER
must be specified.
Exception: Time parameters may not be specified for data
output in daily files.
- Only one termination date may be entered.
The earliest possible termination date is the day after
command input.
- The measurement duration must not exceed one year.
- If no BEG parameter is entered, recording starts
immediately.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC EXCH- 2+


REC EXCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Default: the end of measurement is determined by the last


single day (BEG).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF TERMINATION DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

IV INTERVAL TIME

This parameter indicates interval times of the measurement.

Notes:
- Interval times IV are only permitted if at least one
begin date BEG is selected.
- A maximum of 4 measurement intervals in chronological
order may be linked with &. Linked intervals have to be
at least 30 minutes apart except for measurements over
midnight.
- An interval may not include midnight, e.g. IV =
23-00-01-00 is not permitted.
A measurement over midnight requires the input of two
interval times, e.g. IV = 00-00-01-00&23-00-00-00.
- The measurement is active during the specified interval
times only.
- The measurement can be stopped during the actual interval
IV with STOP JOB. If the measurement is stopped
during the last interval IV, it will be finished.

Default: 24-hour measurement on the specified days

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: BEGIN HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: BEGIN MINUTE=
0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

c: TERMINATION HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

d: TERMINATION MINUTE=
0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

PER PERIODIC WEEKDAY

This parameter specifies the weekdays on which data


have to be recorded.

Notes:
- The input of weekdays is only permissible in
connection with a termination date (TER).
- Up to 6 of the values may be linked with &,
except the values NO, WO and HO which
cannot be linked with other values.

Default: measurement every day during the measurement


period

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC EXCH- 3+


REC EXCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

NO NO SPECIFIED PERIOD
Measurement every day
MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY
Days which are full working days
HO HOLIDAY
Full national and international holidays are
included.
The full weekend day (the day marked EF
in the DISP WDCAT output mask) is included.
Half holidays are not included.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC EXCH- 4-


STAT EXCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

INTERFACE DCP TO SSP

THIS COMMAND IS USED FOR STATUS DATA REQUEST FROM DCP.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT EXCH ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT EXCH- 1-


ENTR EXCHID

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER EXCHANGE IDENTIFICATION

This command enters the exchange identification and the


system title of the local processor.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,IDNO= 11 1
1 ENTR EXCHID : NAME= 1Z,IDNOWB=Y1 [,OSYT=] [,NSYT=] ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the exchange name. The


exchange name is the name of the local processor.

Notes:
- The name of the local processor can be seen after
entering the command DISP PRO and in the header of
each output mask.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

IDNO IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

This parameter defines the exchange identification number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...11 characters from the


symbolic name character set

IDNOWB IDENTIFICATION NO WITH BLANKS

This parameter defines the exchange identification number.


In opposition to the parameter IDNO you can enter also
blanks with this parameter (IDNO allowes only symbolic
names).

Notes:
- Only symbolic names and blanks are allowed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...11 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

OSYT OLD SYSTEM TITLE

This parameter specifies the old value of the


system title.
The system title is a part of the application
entity title. It specifies the processor specific
part.

Notes:
- The system title has to be unique in the DIB.
- The system title has a minimum of two and a
maximum of 16 components.
- For the first component only the values 0, 1 and
2 are allowed.
- For the second component only a value from 0 to
39 is allowed.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR EXCHID- 1+


ENTR EXCHID

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

NSYT NEW SYSTEM TITLE

This parameter specifies the new value of the


system title.
The system title is a part of the application
entity title. It specifies the processor specific
part.

Notes:
- The system title has to be unique in the DIB.
- The system title has a minimum of two and a
maximum of 16 components.
- For the first component only the values 0, 1 and
2 are allowed.
- For the second component only a value from 0 to
39 is allowed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR EXCHID- 2-


DISP EXDDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY EXCHANGE DESCRIPTION DATA

This command displays exchange description data such as:

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP EXDDAT ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP EXDDAT- 1-


ENTR EXDDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER EXCHANGE DESCRIPTION DATA

This command enters exchange description data, such as

Notes:
Following parameters may only be specified during installation
recovery:
- country CNTRY,
- generic type GNTYPE,
- digital exchange type DETYPE,
- entity type ENTITY,
- q3 active sign Q3ACTIVE,
- system configuration CONFIG.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR EXDDAT : <CNTRY= ,GNTYPE= ,DETYPE= ,ENTITY= ,Q3ACTIVE= 1
1 1
1 ,CMYSIZE= ,CONFIG=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CNTRY COUNTRY

This parameter specifies the code for country-specific


features.
The parameter may only be entered during installation
recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BRD GERMANY
FIN FINLAND
RSA REP. OF SOUTH AFRICA
LBY LIBYA
GRI GREECE
SWZ SWITZERLAND
OES AUSTRIA
PHI PHILIPPINES
EGY EGYPT
KOL COLUMBIA
OMA OMAN
IDS INDONESIA
ARG ARGENTINA
USA UNITED STATES OF AMERICA
IRN IRAN
BRA BRAZIL
DAN DENMARK
LUX LUXEMBOURG
PAR PARAGUAY
TAI TAIWAN
BGD BANGLADESH
BEL BELGIUM
POR PORTUGAL
SWD SWEDEN
NOR NORWAY
FRR FRANCE
KAM CAMEROON
GBR GREAT BRITAIN
ITL ITALY
SAR SAUDI ARABIA

GNTYPE GENERIC TYPE

This parameter specifies the generic type of exchange.


The parameter may only be entered during installation recovery.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR EXDDAT- 1+


ENTR EXDDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

MOBILE MOBILE TELEPHONE EXCHANGE

DETYPE DIGITAL EXCHANGE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of digital exchange (i.e.


its capacity).
The parameter may only be entered during installation recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DE3 DIGITAL EXCHANGE 3


DE4 DIGITAL EXCHANGE 4
DE51 DIGITAL EXCHANGE 5/1
DE52 DIGITAL EXCHANGE 5/2
DE54 DIGITAL EXCHANGE 5/4
DE60 DIGITAL EXCHANGE 6/0
DE61 DIGITAL EXCHANGE 6/1
DE62 DIGITAL EXCHANGE 6/2
DE63 DIGITAL EXCHANGE 6/3
DE64 DIGITAL EXCHANGE 6/4
DE65 DIGITAL EXCHANGE 6/5
DE66 DIGITAL EXCHANGE 6/6
DE67 DIGITAL EXCHANGE 6/7
DE68 DIGITAL EXCHANGE 6/8

ENTITY ENTITY CONFIGURATION

This parameter specifies the type of entity (AC,HLR,MSC,VLR,EIR).


The parameter may only be entered during installation recovery.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

AC AUTHENTICATION CENTER
HLR HOME LOCATION REGISTER
VLR VISITOR LOCATION REGISTER
MSC MOBILE SERV SWITCHING CENTER
EIR EQUIPMENT IDENTITY REGISTER

Q3ACTIVE Q3 ACTIVE

This parameter specifies if Q3 - Logging File(s) should


be created automatically (Q3ACTIVE
is YES)
or not (Q3ACTIVE
is NO).
The parameter may only be entered during installation
recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO Q3 IS NOT ACTIVE
YES Q3 IS ACTIVE

CMYSIZE COMMON MEMORY SIZE

This parameter specifies the size of the common memory


(CMY) in megabyte.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

64,80,96...2048, range of decimal numbers

Corresponds to <CMYSize>

CONFIG CONFIGURATION OF APS

This parameter specifies the configuration


of the system. (CP Stand Allone or CP and MP)
The parameter may only be entered during installation
recovery.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR EXDDAT- 2+


ENTR EXDDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CPSA COMMUNIC. PROC. STAND ALLONE


CPMP COMMUNIC. PROC. AND MAIN P.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR EXDDAT- 3-


CAN EXTLAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL EXTERNAL LOCATION AREA CODE

This command cancels an external location area code within a foreign mobile
services switching center area (MSC area).

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN EXTLAC : LACOD= [,MCC= ,MNC=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LACOD LOCATION AREA CODE

LACOD a: 0..65535

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...65535, range of decimal numbers

MCC MOBILE COUNTRY CODE

This parameter specifies the home country of the mobile subscriber


according to the CCITT Recommendation E.212.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

3 digit decimal number

MNC MOBILE NETWORK CODE

This parameter specifies the home PLMN of the mobile subscriber


according to the CCITT Recommendation E.212.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...3 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN EXTLAC- 1-


CR EXTLAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE EXTERNAL LOCATION AREA CODE

This command creates a new location area code within a foreign mobile services
switching center area (MSC area).
Notes:
- If a location area of a foreign PLMN area is to be created, both parameters
MCC and MNC must be entered.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR EXTLAC : LACOD= ,MSCID= [,VLRISD=] [,MCC= ,MNC=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LACOD LOCATION AREA CODE

LACOD a: 0..65535

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...65535, range of decimal numbers

MSCID MSC IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the identification of a mobile services


switching center within the PLMN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

6...15 digit decimal number

VLRISD VLR ISDN NUMBER

This parameter specifies the identification of a visitor location


register within the PLMN.
If this parameter is not entered, the MSCID will be used for
the VLRISD.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

6...15 digit decimal number

MCC MOBILE COUNTRY CODE

This parameter specifies the home country of the mobile subscriber


according to the CCITT Recommendation E.212.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

3 digit decimal number

MNC MOBILE NETWORK CODE

This parameter specifies the home PLMN of the mobile subscriber


according to the CCITT Recommendation E.212.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...3 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR EXTLAC- 1-
DISP EXTLAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY EXTERNAL LOCATION AREA CODE

This command displays information of foreign mobile services


switching center areas.
Note:
- If the project requires a structured LACOD only one LACOD per
MSCID will be significant. As the originally input value might be
replaced by the value which actually represents the range for this
MSC (see CR EXTLAC) the output values might be different from the
input.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP EXTLAC : MSCID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSCID MSC IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the identification of a mobile services


switching center within the PLMN.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

6...15 digit decimal number

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP EXTLAC- 1-


MOD EXTLAC
LACOD
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY EXTERNAL LOCATION AREA CODE

This command modifies assigned data of an external location area.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD EXTLAC - LACOD LOCATION AREA CODE


2. MOD EXTLAC - MSCVLRID MSC/VLR IDENTIFICATION

1. Input format

LOCATION AREA CODE

This input format modifies the location area code of a foreign


location area.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD EXTLAC : LACOD= ,NLACOD= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LACOD LOCATION AREA CODE

LACOD a: 0..65535

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...65535, range of decimal numbers

NLACOD NEW LOCATION AREA CODE

NLACOD a: 0..65535

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...65535, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD EXTLAC- 1+


MOD EXTLAC
MSCVLRID
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

MSC/VLR IDENTIFICATION

This input format modifies for an external location area either the
mobile services switching center identification or the visitor location
register ISDN number or both.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD EXTLAC : LACOD= <,NMSCID= ,NVLRISD=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LACOD LOCATION AREA CODE

LACOD a: 0..65535

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...65535, range of decimal numbers

NMSCID NEW MSC IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the new identification of a mobile services


switching center within the PLMN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

6...15 digit decimal number

NVLRISD NEW VLR ISDN NUMBER

This parameter specifies the new identification of a visitor location


register within the PLMN.
If this parameter is not entered, the NMSCID will be used for
the NVLRISD.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

6...15 digit decimal number

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD EXTLAC- 2-


START FCP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

START FILE CONTROL PROCESSING

This command starts the file control processes function so that disk and tape
files can be used.

Notes:
This command is only allowed during the installation phase (installation
recovery).

This command is only permitted when an exchange is first being put into service.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 START FCP ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 START FCP- 1-


DISP FCS
DN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY FCS COUNTERS

This command displays the counters for the specified lines.


This command is only legal for basic access.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP FCS - DN DIRECTORY NUMBER ORIENTED


2. DISP FCS - LC EQUIPMENT NUMBER ORIENTED

1. Input format

DIRECTORY NUMBER ORIENTED

Input format for directory-number-oriented output.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FCS : [LAC=] ,DN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code if multiple directory


number volumes exist in an exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the subscriber


line. Up to ten parameters can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FCS- 1+


DISP FCS
LC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

EQUIPMENT NUMBER ORIENTED

Input format for equipment-number-oriented output.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FCS : DLU= ,LC= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

LC LINE CIRCUIT

This parameter specifies the circuit position in a DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b[-c]

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

c: CIRCUIT NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FCS- 2-


CAN FGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL FILE GROUP

This command deletes file groups from the file group table. Only file
groups created by the user can be deleted.

Prerequisites:

For attribute file groups:


- All attributes must be reset with RSET FGRPATT.

For password file groups:


- All files must be detached from the file group with the
command MOD FGRP.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN FGRP : FGRP= [,TYPE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FGRP FILEGROUP

This parameter specifies the file group name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TYPE OF FILEGROUP

This parameter specifies the type of the file group


which has to be canceled.
Notes:
- If FILEATTR is entered, the file group for file
attributes is cancelled.
- If FILEPW is entered, the file group for file
passwords is cancelled.
- If this parameter is not entered, the file group
for file attributes is cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FILEATTR FILE ATTRIBUTE TYPE


FILEPW FILE PASSWORD TYPE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN FGRP- 1-


CR FGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE FILE GROUP

This command creates an element in the file group table.


It is possible to create an attribute- or a password file group.
It is possible to create an cyclic or a normal file group.

Notes:
- If the parameter TYPE is not entered, an attribute file group
is created.

- If the parameter CYCLIC is not entered, a non cyclic file


group is created. Only attribute file groups can be created
cyclic.

- The file group features for attribute file groups:


threshold upgrades,
threshold downgrades,
threshold features and
maximum copy length
can only be set for cyclic file groups (via SET FGRPATT).

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR FGRP : FGRP= [,TYPE=] [,CYCLIC=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FGRP FILEGROUP

This parameter specifies the name of the file group which is to be


created.

Notes:
- Each file group name can exist not more than twice:
As the name of an attribute file group and as the name
of a password file group.
- Password file group names can be fully or partly
qualified because the name has only symbolic meaning.
- For password file group names there is no hierarchy in
opposition to attribute file group names.
- Attribute file group names can be a subset or a superset
of the already existing file group names.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TYPE OF FILEGROUP

This parameter specifies the type of the file group


which has to be created.

Notes:
- If FILEATTR is entered, the file group is created
for file attributes.
- If FILEPW is entered, the file group is created
for file passwords.
- If this parameter is not entered, the file group is
created for file attributes.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FILEATTR FILE ATTRIBUTE TYPE


FILEPW FILE PASSWORD TYPE

CYCLIC CYCLIC SELECTION

This parameter specifies if a cyclic or a non cyclic file group is


to be created.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FGRP- 1+
CR FGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Notes:
- Only attribute file groups can be created cyclic.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO CREATE NON CYCLIC FILE GROUP


YES CREATE CYCLIC FILE GROUP

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FGRP- 2-
DISP FGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY FILE GROUPS

This command displays the file groups. The file groups were
generated automatically or were created by the user with the
command CR FGRP.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FGRP : [FGRP=] [,TYPE=] [,FILELIST=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FGRP FILEGROUP

This parameter specifies the name of the file group which


has to be displayed.

Notes:
- If X is entered or the parameter is not entered,
all filegroups of the specified type are displayed.
- A file group name can be entered only for password file
group types in combination with FILELIST = YES.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TYPE OF FILEGROUP

This parameter specifies the type of the file group


which has to be displayed.
Notes:
- If FILEATTR is entered, the file groups for file
attributes are displayed.
- If FILEPW is entered, the file groups for file
passwords are displayed.
- If ALL is entered, all types of file groups are
displayed.
- If this parameter is not entered, the file groups
for file attributes are displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FILEATTR FILE ATTRIBUTE TYPE


FILEPW FILE PASSWORD TYPE
ALL ALL FILE GROUP TYPES

FILELIST FILELIST

This parameter specifies if a list of the files of


the filegroup has to be displayed.

Notes:
- The filelist can be displayed only for password file
group types.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

Y DISPLAY FILELIST
YES DISPLAY FILELIST
N DO NOT DISPLAY FILELIST
NO DO NOT DISPLAY FILELIST

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FGRP- 1-


MOD FGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY FILE GROUP

With this command files can be attached and detached to/from


password file groups.

Prerequisites:
- The filegroup has to exist.

Notes:
- This command can be entered only by the system
administrator.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,FILE= 1 1
1 MOD FGRP : FGRP= Z,CFILE=Y ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FGRP FILEGROUP

This parameter specifies the file group name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file


which has to be attached to the password file
group.
Notes:
- The file may not yet exist.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CFILE CANCEL FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file


which has to be detached from the password file
group.
Notes:
- To detach the last file of the file group no
password may exist for this file group.
- If "X" is entered, all files are detached
from the file group.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD FGRP- 1-


DISP FGRPATT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY FILE GROUP ATTRIBUTES

This command displays all file group features of one file group.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FGRPATT : FGRP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FGRP FILE GROUP

This parameter specifies the file group for which the group features
are to be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

Default: BLANK

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FGRPATT- 1-


RSET FGRPATT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RESET FILE GROUP ATTRIBUTES

This command resets the file group features (set to default


value) of one file group.

Prerequisite:
- The file group must exist.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 RSET FGRPATT : FGRP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FGRP FILEGROUP

This parameter specifies the file group for which the group features
are to be reset.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RSET FGRPATT- 1-


SET FGRPATT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SET FILE GROUP ATTRIBUTES

This command sets file group features for one attribute


file group.
If there are files belonging to this file group, the
specified features will be changed in the file catalogs, too.

Prerequisites:
- The file group must exist.
- The copy attributes must be compatible with the already
existing attributes.
- A specified copy service process must exist.
- The cyclic attributes THRD, THRU, THRF and MAXCOPLE
cannot be changed in the file catalogs of the files
belonging to this file group if these files are empty and
opened for writing.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 SET FGRPATT : FGRP= <,RETPER= ,SAFCOP= ,COPATT= ,PRNAME= 1
1 1
1 ,THRU= ,THRD= ,THRF= ,MAXCOPLE=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FGRP FILE GROUP

This parameter specifies the file group for which the group features
are to be set.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

RETPER RETENTION PERIOD

This parameter specifies the number of days the file is retained


(protected against deleting and overwriting).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...36526, range of decimal numbers

SAFCOP SAFECOPY

This parameter specifies the number of the required


safecopies.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

COPATT COPY ATTRIBUTES

This parameter specifies the following features for copies of files


belonging to this file group: - block size
- retention period

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: BLOCK SIZE=
0...65535, range of decimal numbers

b: RETENTION PERIOD=
0...65535, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SET FGRPATT- 1+


SET FGRPATT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PRNAME PROCESS NAME

This parameter specifies the name of a copy service process.

Notes:
- Only alphanumeric characters are allowed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

THRU THRESHOLD UPGRADES

This parameter specifies the thresholds of a cyclic file group for


increasing filling capacity.
If a threshold is reached and the threshold feature was set to ALARM,
an alarm will be triggered on the System Panel.

Notes:
- The parameter can only be entered in conjunction with the
parameter THRD.
- The second threshold upgrade must be greater than the first one
and the third threshold upgrade must be greater than the second
one, with the following exception:
- The threshold upgrades can be equal if all threshold upgrades
and all threshold downgrades have the value 0.
In this case no threshold control will be performed.
- The threshold upgrades must be greater than or equal to the
threshold downgrades.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: THRESHOLD UP 1=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: THRESHOLD UP 2=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

c: THRESHOLD UP 3=
0...100, range of decimal numbers

THRD THRESHOLD DOWNGRADES

This parameter specifies the thresholds of a cyclic file group for


decreasing filling capacity.
If a threshold is reached and the threshold feature was set to ALARM,
the alarm on the System Panel will be reset.

Notes:
- The parameter can only be entered in conjunction with the
parameter THRU.
- The second threshold downgrade must be greater than the first one
and the third threshold downgrade must be greater than the second
one, with the following exception:
- The threshold downgrades can be equal if all threshold downgrades
and all threshold upgrades have the value 0.
In this case no threshold control will be performed.
- The threshold downgrades must be lower than or equal to the
threshold upgrades.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: THRESHOLD DOWN 1=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: THRESHOLD DOWN 2=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SET FGRPATT- 2+


SET FGRPATT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

c: THRESHOLD DOWN 3=
0...100, range of decimal numbers

THRF THRESHOLD FEATURES

This parameter specifies the threshold features for increasing and


decreasing filling capacities.
If a threshold is reached and the threshold feature was set to ALARM,
an alarm will be triggered or reset on the System Panel.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: THRESHOLD FEATURE 1
ALARM DISPLAY ON SYSTEM PANEL
NOALARM DON’T DISPLAY ON SYSTEM PANEL

b: THRESHOLD FEATURE 2
ALARM DISPLAY ON SYSTEM PANEL
NOALARM DON’T DISPLAY ON SYSTEM PANEL

c: THRESHOLD FEATURE 3
ALARM DISPLAY ON SYSTEM PANEL
NOALARM DON’T DISPLAY ON SYSTEM PANEL

MAXCOPLE MAXIMUM COPY LENGTH

This parameter specifies the maximum copy length


(in PAM-pages) for the cyclic files of the file
group.

Notes:
- This parameter can be entered only for cyclic
file groups.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

50...99999, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SET FGRPATT- 3-


CAN FGRPPW

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL FILE GROUP PASSWORD

This command cancels all assignments of a file group password to the


specified access types for a file group.
The password will be requested by the system and will not be displayed.
The password may have a length from one up to 40 characters.
All characters are allowed.
Upper case and lower case letters count as distinct.

Prerequisites:
- The specified file group name must exist.
- The specified file group password must exist.
- All specified file accesses must be protected by the same password.
- The file group must be entered fully qualified (e.g.: IA.ICAMA).
- Update must be activated.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN FGRPPW : FGRP= ,ACCESS= [,CRYPTPW=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FGRP FILE GROUP

This parameter specifies the file group for which the relevant
function is to be carried out.

Prerequisites:
- Only fully qualified file group names are allowed.
(e.g.: IA.ICAMA)

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ACCESS FILE ACCESSES

This parameter specifies the access(es) of which the file group


password has to be cancelled.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

DEL DELETE PROTECTED


RD READ PROTECTED
WR WRITE PROTECTED
CN CHANGE FILE NAME PROTECTED
CR CHANGE RETENTION PERIOD PROT.

CRYPTPW ENCRYPTED PASSWORD

This parameter specifies the encrypted password that shall be


cancelled.

Note:
- This parameter is only allowed when the command is started from a
command file (COFIP).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...54 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN FGRPPW- 1-


RSET FGRPPW

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RSET FILE GROUP PASSWORD

This command resets all assignments of a file group password to the


specified access types for a file group. The file group password will
be reset to a defined value that must be entered with the command.
The password will be requested by the system and will not be displayed.
The password may have a length from one up to 40 characters.
All characters are allowed.
Upper case and lower case letters count as distinct.

Prerequisites:
- The specified file group name must exist.
- The file group must be entered fully qualified (e.g.: IA.ICAMA).
- All specified accesses must be protected by the same password.
- Update must be activated.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 RSET FGRPPW : FGRP= ,ACCESS= [,NCRYPTPW=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FGRP FILE GROUP

This parameter specifies the file group for which the relevant
function has to be carried out.

Prerequisites:
- Only fully qualified file group names are allowed
(e.g.: IA.ICAMA)

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ACCESS FILE ACCESSES

This parameter specifies the access(es) of which the file group


password has to be reset.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

DEL DELETE PROTECTED


RD READ PROTECTED
WR WRITE PROTECTED
CN CHANGE FILE NAME PROTECTED
CR CHANGE RETENTION PERIOD PROT.

NCRYPTPW NEW ENCRYPTED PASSWORD

This parameter specifies the encrypted new password that shall replace
the unknown password.

Note:
- This parameter is only allowed when the command is started from a
command file (COFIP).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...54 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RSET FGRPPW- 1-


SET FGRPPW

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SET FILE GROUP PASSWORD

This command protects file accesses by a file group password.


It can also be used to rename the file group password and/or to
change the accesses, protected by a file group password.
For changing an existing password the parameter CHANGEPW =
YES has to be entered.
The password(s) will be requested by the system and will not be
displayed.
The password may have a length from one up to 40 characters.
All characters are allowed.
Upper case and lower case letters count as distinct.

Prerequisites:
- The file group must exist.
- In the case of renaming the file group password or changing
the protected accesses, the old password must be correct.
- The file group name must be entered fully qualified
(e.g.: IA.ICAMA)
- Update must be activated.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 SET FGRPPW : FGRP= ,ACCESS= [,CHANGEPW=] [,NCRYPTPW= 1
1 1
1 [,CRYPTPW=]] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FGRP FILE GROUP

This parameter specifies the file group for which the relevant
function is to be carried out.

Prerequisites:
- Only fully qualified file group names are allowed
(e.g.: IA.ICAMA)

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ACCESS FILE ACCESSES

This parameter specifies the access(es) which are to be protected


by a file group password.

Note:
- This parameter is always mandatory, even when renaming a file
group password .
This guarantees that no file group passwords of other users are
renamed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

DEL DELETE PROTECTED


RD READ PROTECTED
WR WRITE PROTECTED
CN CHANGE FILE NAME PROTECTED
CR CHANGE RETENTION PERIOD PROT.

CHANGEPW CHANGE PASSWORD

This parameter specifies whether the operator wants to enter a new


password or to change an existing password.

Note:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SET FGRPPW- 1+


SET FGRPPW

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- If a new password is to be entered, the parameter has to be entered


with the value NO.
- If an existing password is to be changed, the parameter has to be
entered with the value YES.
- If the parameter is not given, CHANGEPW=NO is assumed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N ENTER NEW PASSWORD


NO ENTER NEW PASSWORD
Y CHANGE EXISTING PASSWORD
YES CHANGE EXISTING PASSWORD

Default: NO

NCRYPTPW NEW ENCRYPTED PASSWORD

This parameter specifies the encrypted new password when the password
is to be changed.

Note:
- This parameter is only allowed when the command is started from a
command file (COFIP).
- The parameter CHANGEPW has to be entered with the value YES.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...54 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

CRYPTPW ENCRYPTED PASSWORD

This parameter specifies the encrypted password that is to be entered


or changed.

Note:
- This parameter is only allowed when the command is started from a
command file (COFIP).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...54 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SET FGRPPW- 2-


CAN FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel NE Files

DELETE FILE

This task deletes a file at the Network Element. It


uses FTP/FTAM protocol to delete the file at the
Network Element. The desired protocol and the file
to be deleted are the input parameters
for the task

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN FILE : TRANSFER TYPE= ,FILE NAME= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRANSFER TYPE

TRANSFER TYPE

The transfer type identifies the file transfer


server at the Network Element which will be the
partner for this File Transfer. This could be one
of the following values :

- FTAM
- FTP

FILE NAME

FILE NAME

This is the name of the file at the Network Element,


that has to be deleted.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN FILE- 1-


CAT FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CATALOG FILE

This command modifies the catalog entry of a disk file. The file
can be renamed and the retention period can be changed.

Prerequisites for renaming of files:


- The file must exist.
- The new filename must not already exist.
- The new filename must conform with system conventions.
- The new filename must not contain a protected name segment.
- The file must not be protected by access restrictions or
file group passwords.
- The file must not be protected by a retention period, or the
correct expiration date must be entered via parameter EXPDAT.
- The file must not belong to any generation.

Prerequisites for changing the retention period:


- The file must exist.
- The file must not be protected by access restrictions or
file group passwords.
- The retention period can not be changed if this was already
administered via the command SET FGRPATT.
Nevertheless the execution of the command will be acknowledged
with EXEC’D.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,RETPER=11 1
1 CAT FILE : FILE= 1Z,EXPDAT=Y1 ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the disk file.

Notes:
The following characters may not be used:
- A succession of periods (...)
- A single period, or a combination ending in a period.
- A single asterisk, or a combination ending in an asterisk.
- A single X.

n
n/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

RETPER RETENTION PERIOD

This parameter specifies the number of days the file


is retained (protected against overwriting).

Notes:
- If a value is entered for this parameter, a new retention
period becomes valid (and the old one becomes invalid).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...36526, range of decimal numbers

EXPDAT EXPIRATION DATE

This parameter specifies the expiration date of the file.

Notes:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAT FILE- 1+


CAT FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- This parameter can only be entered in conjunction with the


parameter FILE for renaming the file.
- The file may not be deleted before this date.
- The file can be renamed if the correct expiration date is entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAT FILE- 2-


CR FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE FILE

This command creates a file on magnetic disk.


The created file has no protection.

Prerequisites:
- The file name must conform to system conventions.
- The file name must not contain a protected stem.
- The file must not already exist.
- There must be free storage space on the magnetic disk.
- The specified disk must be available.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR FILE : FILE= ,TYPE= ,SIZE= [,VSN=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the disk file.

Notes:
The following characters must not be used:
- A succession of periods (...)
- A single period, or a combination ending in a period.
- A single asterisk, or a combination ending in an asterisk.
- A single X.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TYPE

This parameter specifies single or double file type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SINGLE SINGLE
DOUBLE DOUBLE

SIZE SIZE

This parameter specifies the amount of space to be reserved


on the data carrier.

Notes:
- The maximum amount of space must be specified, because
dynamic file expansion is not possible.
- The size is specified as a number of blocks (PAM pages of
2048 bytes each).
- The maximum value depends on the disk capacity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1,2,3...999999, range of decimal numbers

VSN VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the volume serial number of the disk.

Note:
- If TYPE = DOUBLE is entered, the parameter VSN will be
ignored and the file will be created as a double file.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

VSN000 VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER 000


VSN001 VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER 001

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FILE- 1-
DEL FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DELETE FILE

This command deletes disk files, tape / magneto optical disk


files or all files on tape / magneto optical disk.

Prerequisites:
- The file must be closed.
- The file and the data carrier must exist.
- The expiration date must be passed or entered.
- The file must not be protected by access restrictions.
- The file must not belong to any generation.

Notes:
- The command can be used also for tape / magneto optical disk files.
The specified tape / magneto optical disk file and the following
files cannot be accessed any more. (The FCP will set a section mark
before the specified file, this means that the end of the tape /
magneto optical disk is reached.)

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DEL FILE : FILE= [,VSN=] [,EXPDAT=] [,UNCOND=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE FILE NAME

In the case of disks, this parameter specifies the name of


the file.

Note:
- Full or partial qualification of the filename is mandatory.
- If a tape / magneto optical disk file is to be deleted, not
only the specified file but also all subsequent files are
deleted.
- When tape / magneto optical disk files are deleted, they
are deleted logically but not physically.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

VSN VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the volume serial number of the


disk, tape or magneto optical disk on which the file is to
be deleted.

Notes:
- If this parameter is not entered, the file will be
deleted on both disk drives.
-The parameter VSN will be ignored for disk files.
Only if parameter FILE is entered with X (erase all files)
the command will be rejected if parameter VSN wasn’t
entered or was set to VSN000 or VSN001.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

EXPDAT EXPIRATION DATE

This parameter allows files to be deleted before their


retention period has expired. This can be done on condition
that the access restrictions permit changes to the retention

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DEL FILE- 1+


DEL FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

period.

Note:
- Deletion of the file is enabled by entering the correct
expiration date, to prove that it is known.
- In the case of tape / magneto optical disk files, an entire
tape / magneto optical disk can only be deleted once the
retention period for the first section of the file expired.
- The retention period can be overwritten in this case by
entering the correct expiration date.
- When tape / magneto optical disk files are deleted, links
to continuation tapes / magneto optical disks are ignored.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

UNCOND UNCONDITIONAL

This parameter allows files to be deleted if they have been


transferred at least once to an external data carrier, even
if backup copies are missing.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N CHECK OF EXECUTED COPIES


NO CHECK OF EXECUTED COPIES
Y CHECK IF FILE COPIED ONCE
YES CHECK IF FILE COPIED ONCE

Default: N

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DEL FILE- 2-


DISP FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY FILE

This command displays disk, tape and magneto optical disk files’
attributes and comprises the functions:
- List of files on the medium (table of contents) giving the main file
attributes.
- List of all attributes of a file that can be determined from the
disk catalog or the tape / magneto optical disk labels.
- List of mutilated and invalid disk files and disk files in the
process of being copied, with brief information from the catalog.

The execution of the command (output of table of contents) can be


stopped with the STOP DISP command.

Prerequisites:
- The file must exist
- The specified volume must be accessible

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FILE : [FILE= [,ALL=]] [,GEN=] [,VSN=] [,DAM=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file for which the
attributes are to be output.

Notes:
- If X is entered here, a table of contents of the relevant
volume containing the main information on the specified
file(s) and the medium is displayed.
- X is illegal in conjunction with the parameter ALL=
YES.
- If an alias file name is entered, only a fully qualified
name is allowed (last character must not be ’.’).

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

Default: X

ALL ALL INFORMATION

This parameter specifies that all attributes of a file that can


be determined from the disk catalog or the tape / magneto optical disk
labels are output.

Notes:
- The parameter can only be entered in conjunction
with a fully qualified filename.

N DON’T LIST ALL PARAMETERS


NO DON’T LIST ALL PARAMETERS
Y LIST ALL PARAMETERS
YES LIST ALL PARAMETERS

Default: N

GEN FILE GENERATION

This parameter specifies the generation name. It must be

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FILE- 1+


DISP FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

represented by four pairs of characters which correspond


to:
- Function version
- Correction version
- ODAGEN run number
- Checkpoint serial number

Notes:
- To get all attributes of a generation file which does not belong
to the current generation, the name of this generation has to be
entered.
- If the parameter is omitted, all files with or without generation
are displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

VSN VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the volume (medium) on which the file to


be processed is located.

Notes:
- If the parameter is omitted, both disk files are accessed.
- The following character strings are reserved for disk devices:
’VSN000’ for MDD-00 and
’VSN001’ for MDD-01.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DAM DAMAGED

If this parameter is entered, an extract of the disk catalog


is output with all mutilated and invalid files and files in the
process of being copied. This output includes the associated
generation names.

Notes:
- This parameter is illegal for tape / magneto optical disk files
and in conjunction with parameter ALL.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY ALL FILES


NO DISPLAY ALL FILES
Y DISPLAY ONLY INVALID FILES
YES DISPLAY ONLY INVALID FILES

Default: N

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FILE- 2-


LIST FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

List NE Files

LIST FILES

This task displays the list of files (and their attributes)


present under a particular directory in the Network Element.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 LIST FILE : DIRECTORY NAME= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DIRECTORY NAME

DIRECTORY NAME

Identifies the directory in the remote system. The format of the


directory name
in the NE is as given below:
logical device name:\pathname -> for files on an archive device
\pathname -> for files on system device
\ -> for files in the root-directory(non-gene
where logical device name= logical name of the backup store. It must be
supplied
only for a removable disk. It can be max. 8 character
path name= Level 1 directory (=generation)It can be max. 8
characters
The attributes of the files in this directory will be listed in the
output of
the task.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 LIST FILE- 1-


RCV FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Receive File from NE

RECEIVE FILE

This task transfers a file from the Network Element to the OS. It
uses FTP/FTNEA/FTAM protocol to receive the file from the
Network Element. The desired protocol is an input parameter
of the task

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 RCV FILE : SOURCE FILE NAME= ,TRANSFER TYPE= ,COPY MODE= 1
1 1
1 ,DESTINATION FILE NAME= ,FILE WRITING MODE= 1
1 1
1 ,RECORD LENGTH= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SOURCE FILE NAME

SOURCE FILE NAME

This is the name of the source file that has to be


received from the Network Element.
logical device name:\pathname\SrcFileName -> for files on an archive
device
pathname\SrcFileName -> for files on system device
SrcFileName -> for files in the root-directory(non-gene
files)
where logical device name= logical name of the backup store. It must be
supplied
only for a removable disk. It can be max. 8 character
path name= Level 1 directory (=generation)It can be max. 8
characters
SrcFileName= Name of the Source File.

TRANSFER TYPE

TRANSFER TYPE

The transfer type specifies which protocol is


to be used for the transfer. One of the following
values is possible:

- FTNEA
- FTAM
- FTP

FTNEA is the standard value.

COPY MODE

COPY MODE

The copy mode specifies, how the file is to be


transferred to the network element. One of the
following values is possible:

- ASCII
File is transferred as text file.

- BINARY
File is transferred as binary file without record structure

- USER
is not supported

- EXTENSION

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RCV FILE- 1+


RCV FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The file is transferred transparently (binary). This


parameter is valid only for FTAM and FTNEA.

ASCII is standard value

DESTINATION FILE NAME

DESTINATION FILE NAME

Destination file name: Specifies the UNC name of the


destination file in the NT network. UNC names have
the following format:

\\<MachineName>\<ShareName>\<FileName>

Example:
\\FILESERVER1\XXXBase\UserHomeDir\User1\File.txt
(Where XXX is ENM for ENM V3.2,XXX = NetM for Version > V3.2)
It can be max. 256 characters

FILE WRITING MODE

FILE WRITING MODE

Write mode: Specifies whether, the present destination


file is to be overwritten, extended or remain unchanged.
If the destination file does not exist as yet, it is created.
Possible values are:

- OVERWRITE
If the destination file already exists, it is
overwritten. Otherwise, a new destination file is
created.

- NOOVERWRITE
A non-existing destination file is created newly. If the
destination file exists, no file transfer is executed and
an error messages is displayed in the output window.

- EXTEND
The new file is attached to the existing destination
file.

Standard value is OVERWRITE. This valus is valid


only for the file transfer types FTAM and FTNEA.

RECORD LENGTH

RECORD LENGTH

The parameter is optional and a value that is equal to


or greater than the longest record length of the file,
which is to be transferred, must be specified. When the
record length is incorrect (very small value), an error
message is displayed and no file transfer is executed.
If the field remains empty, transfer occurs automatically
with the correct record length.

Standard value is 1024.

This parameter is valid only for the file transfer types


FTAM and FTNEA.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RCV FILE- 2-


SEND FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Send File to NE

SEND FILE

This task transfers a file to the Network Element. It


uses FTP/FTNEA/FTAM protocol to transfer the file to the
Network Element. The desired protocol is an input parameter
of the task

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 SEND FILE : SOURCE FILE NAME= ,TRANSFER TYPE= ,COPY MODE= 1
1 1
1 ,DESTINATION FILE NAME= ,FILE WRITING MODE= 1
1 1
1 ,RECORD LENGTH= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SOURCE FILE NAME

SOURCE FILE NAME

Source file name: Specifies the UNC name of the


original file, which is to be sent to the network element.

UNC names have the following format:


\\<MachineName>\<ShareName>\<FileName>

Example:
\\FILESERVER1\XXXBase\UserHomeDir\User1\File.txt
(Where XXX is ENM for ENM V3.2,XXX = NetM for Version > V3.2)
It can be max. 256 characters

TRANSFER TYPE

TRANSFER TYPE

Transfer type:The transfer type specifies, which


protocol is to be used for the transfer. One of the
following values is possible.

- FTNEA
- FTAM
- FTP

FTNEA is the standard value.

COPY MODE

COPY MODE

The copy mode specifies, how the file is to be


transferred to the network element. One of the
following values is possible:

- ASCII
File is transferred as text file.

- BINARY
File is transferred as binary file without record structure

- USER
is not supported

- EXTENSION
The file is transferred transparently (binary). This
parameter is valid only for FTAM and FTNEA.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SEND FILE- 1+


SEND FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ASCII is standard value

DESTINATION FILE NAME

DESTINATION FILE NAME

Destination file name: Name of the destination file on


the network element.
logical device name:\pathname\DestFileName -> for files on an archive
device
pathname\DestFileName -> for files on system device
DestFileName -> for files in the root-directory(non-gene
files)
where logical device name= logical name of the backup store. It must be
supplied
only for a removable disk. It can be max. 8 character
path name= Level 1 directory (=generation)It can be max. 8
characters
DestFileName= Name of the Destination File
File names are allowed from symbolic character set only up to 17
characters max
Symbolic Character set :
0123456789#%+.
abcdefhghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz
.(dot) is not allowed as the last character in file name
Successive ..(more then one dot in succession) not allowed
File name as .(dot) is not allowed

FILE WRITING MODE

FILE WRITING MODE

Write mode: Specifies whether, the present destination


file is to be overwritten, extended or remain unchanged.
If the destination file does not exist as yet, it is created.
Possible values are:

- OVERWRITE
If the destination file already exists, it is
overwritten. Otherwise, a new destination file is
created.

- NOOVERWRITE
A non-existing destination file is created newly. If the
destination file exists, no file transfer is executed and
an error messages is displayed in the output window.

- EXTEND
If the destination file already exists, the new file is
attached to it. Otherwise a new destination file is
created.

Standard value is OVERWRITE. This valus is valid


only for the file transfer types FTAM and FTNEA.

RECORD LENGTH

RECORD LENGTH

The parameter is optional and a value that is equal to


or greater than the longest record length of the file,
which is to be transferred, must be specified. When the
record length is incorrect (very small value), an error
message is displayed and no file transfer is executed.
If the field remains empty, transfer occurs automatically
with the correct record length.

Standard value is 1024.

This parameter is valid only for the file transfer types


FTAM and FTNEA.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SEND FILE- 2+


SEND FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SEND FILE- 3-


TRANS FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TRANSFER FILE

This command transfers files between data carriers, i.e. hard disk,
floppy disk, optical disk, tape and cartridge. Files can be transferred
- between any local data carriers (local transfer) or
- between a local and a remote data carrier (remote transfer).

Notes:
Three file formats are defined for EWSD:
- The Post-Processing format is defined by the system conventions
for magnetic tape storage based on ISO standards. This format allows
data to be exchanged between processors of different manufacturers
and is used for customer files containing post-processing data.
- The SSW format is an EWSD-specific format. It also fulfills the
system conventions for magnetic tape storage and has an EWSD-specific
internal structure. It is used for creating save copies of EWSD-
system-files on tape/optical disk at the CP and transporting EWSD-
software from HOST to CP by tape.
- The CP format exists only on local disk. Files of data type TEXTCMP
or MMLCMPR contain compressed text data with mask numbers as editing
specification. These files are converted into Post-Processing format
producing target files containing printable text data. Source files
of data type TEXTCMP are only converted into editable files if these
target files have variable records with a maximum record length of
256 bytes. Editable files are always generated from source files of
data type MMLCMPR.

The following table shows the correlation between file format, file
type, data type and data carrier.

+-------------+-------+----------------+------------+---------------------+
! File ! File ! Possible ! Possible data carriers !
! format ! type ! data types ! local disk ! local tape/ !
! ! ! ! ! local optical disk/ !
! ! 1) ! 2) ! ! remote data carrier !
+-------------+-------+----------------+------------+---------------------+
! Post- ! SAM ! TRANSP ! X ! X !
! Processing ! ! ! ! !
! format ! ! ! ! !
! ! ! ! ! !
! " ! " ! TEXTNCMP ! X ! X !
! ! ! ! ! !
! SSW format ! SAM ! TRANSP ! ! X !
! ! ! ! ! !
! CP format ! SAM ! TEXTCMP ! X ! !
! ! ! ! ! !
! " ! PAM ! TRANSP ! X ! !
! ! ! ! ! !
! " ! CYC ! TRANSP ! X ! !
! ! ! ! ! !
! " ! " ! TEXTNCMP ! X ! !
! ! ! ! ! !
! " ! " ! TEXTCMP ! X ! !
! ! ! ! ! !
! " ! " ! MMLCMPR ! X ! !
! ! ! ! ! !
+-------------+-------+----------------+------------+---------------------+

1) see output parameter type of file of command DISP FILE


2) see output parameter data storage form of command DISP FILE

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 TRANS FILE : FILE= [,VSNS=] [,VSNR=] [,PRONAM=] [,USINF=] 1
1 1
1 [,REQPSW=] [,SIZE=] [,MODE=] [,COPMOD=] 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TRANS FILE- 1+


TRANS FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1 1
1 [,RETPER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the file to be transferred. The following


conventions must be observed:
- The new parameter value specifies the target file name, the old
parameter value specifies the source file name.
- If only a fully/partially qualified target file name or value X
is specified, the names of source and target files are identical.
- When copying from local disk to local disk, target and source
file names must neither be identical nor start with the same
partial qualification.
- Value X is only permitted for local transfers from tape/optical
disk.
- If a partially qualified name or value X is specified, all other
parameters apply to all files being copied.
- Partial qualification is only allowed for local transfers and for
remote transfers where CP is initiating and sending processor.
- By appending an * (asterisk) to the target file name, the exchange
code is appended.
- The exchange code can only be appended if the source file is on
local disk and the target file is not on local disk.
- If the target file name already ends with the exchange code, it
is not appended in duplicate.
- Input of * (asterisk) at the end of a fully qualified file name
or as fully qualified file name for local disk is not permissible.
- A . (period) is neither allowed at the end of a fully qualified
file name nor as a fully qualified file name.
- An initial . (period) and .. (successive periods) are not
allowed for files on local disk.
- Target files can only be created on local disk if their name does
not begin with a protected file name segment (see DISP FNS).

Notes:
- If a file at the remote processor is specified, the input of the
corresponding file password is requested after the command was
entered correctly. The following conventions must be observed:
- If the source file is at the remote processor, the password
which authorizes read access must be entered.
- If the target file is at the remote processor, the password
to be entered depends on the intended action.
If MODE = CR is specified, no file password is requested.
The output of the entered file password is suppressed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

n
n/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

VSNS VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER SENDER

This parameter specifies the data carrier of the source file.


The following conventions must be observed:
- To access files on data carriers other than on disk, a VSNS
must be specified.
- To access files on disk, a VSNS must be specified for the DCP
but is optional for the CP.
- For direct access to local disk MDD-00 or MDD-01, the associated
VSNS must be specified.
- At the HOST, only public disks can be accessed. If a VSNS is
specified, it is ignored.
- Tapes cannot be accessed at the HOST.
- VSN000 and VSN001 are not permitted as tape/optical disk names.

Default : local disk

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TRANS FILE- 2+


TRANS FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

VSNR VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER RECEIVER

This parameter specifies the data carrier of the target file.


The following conventions must be observed:
- To access files on data carriers other than disk, a VSNR must
be specified.
- To access files on disk, a VSNR must be specified for the DCP
but is optional for the CP.
- For direct access to local disk MDD-00 or MDD-01, the associated
VSNR must be specified.
- At the HOST, only public disks can be accessed. If a VSNR is
specified, it is ignored.
- Tapes cannot be accessed at the HOST.
- VSN000 and VSN001 are not permitted as tape/optical disk names.

Default : local disk

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: LIST 1 ELEMENT=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This information unit specifies one of up to five VSN of the


first list of data carriers of the target file. The following
conventions must be observed:
- Only one VSN is permitted for remote transfer or local
transfer to disk.
- If local transfer to tape/optical disk, at least one VSN
and up to four continuation tape/optical disks are to be
specified.

b: LIST 2 ELEMENT=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This information unit specifies one of up to five VSN of the


second list of data carriers of the target file. The following
conventions must be observed:
- This information unit must not be used for remote transfer
or local transfer to disk.
- If local transfer to tape/optical disk, at least one VSN
and up to four continuation tape/optical disks are to be
specified.

PRONAM PROCESSOR NAME

This parameter specifies the receiving and the sending processor via
its symbolic processor name. The following conventions must be
observed:
- The new parameter value specifies the receiving processor, the old
parameter value specifies the sending processor.

Default : local processor/local processor

n/o
n/
/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

1...8 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

USINF USER INFORMATION

This parameter specifies the user identification and authorization


for the remote processor. The user authorization is composed of the

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TRANS FILE- 3+


TRANS FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

user password and a user account number. The input of the user
password is requested separately after the command was entered
correctly. The output of the entered user password is suppressed.

Notes:
- The parameter may be omitted if a default identification for
file transfer exists and the file is to be processed under this
identity.
- For remote processors, which uses FTAC profiles for identification
and authorization (e.g. UNIX or Windows OS`ses), the transfer
admission of the FTAC profile must be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: USER IDENTIFICATION=
1...8 characters from the
text string character set, enclosed in "

User identification as required by remote processor.

b: USER ACCOUNT NUMBER=


1...40 characters from the
text string character set, enclosed in "

Input of a user account number if required by remote processor.

REQPSW REQUEST PASSWORDS FOR REMOTE

This parameter specifies if passwords have to be requested for remote


processor.

Notes:
- Input and therefore requests for passwords for remote processor are
not necessary, if they are already stored there (e.g. in
FTAC-Profiles at UNIX or Windows OS`ses). The parameter must be
entered with N/NO to avoid the dialog messages explicitely.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO
NO NO
Y YES
YES YES

Default: Y

SIZE SIZE OF RECEIVE FILE

This parameter specifies the size of the target file for files on disk
in PAM pages (1 PAM page = 2048 bytes). The following conventions must
be observed:
- At the CP, a target file is reduced to the actual size after
transmission if MODE = CR/CRD is entered.
- At the DCP, the size of the file on disk remains unchanged.
- If the value specified for FILE is a partial qualification or
value X, SIZE applies to every file transferred.
The input is ignored if:
- the source file is in SSW format and the target file was created
on local disk
- the target file is on tape/optical disk
- MODE = OVWR or MODE = EXT
- COPMOD = SSWF.
If no input is made for SIZE, the file transfer determines the
size of the target file, except the following case:
If the source file is in Post-Processing format on tape/optical disk
and the target file is to be created on local disk, the system
attempts to correct the preset value of SIZE as far as possible. If
the difference between actual file size and preset value is too great,
the transfer may be aborted due to lack of space. In this case, the
transfer procedure must be repeated with the correct SIZE value.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8388607, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TRANS FILE- 4+


TRANS FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Default: 100

MODE MODE TO OPEN RECEIVE FILE

This parameter specifies the opening mode of the target file.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CR CREATE
Create file before transfer.
CRD CREATE DOUBLE
Create file in duplicate before transfer
(only possible for local disk).
OVWR OVERWRITE
Existing file will be overwritten.
- If the file does not exist, it is created.
If SSW format is decomposed, the information
in the file key block applies.
- The parameter value is not valid for local tape/
optical disk.
- The parameter value is valid for the DCP tape if
the file is the last on the tape.
- If the target file is a CYC file, the parameter
value is not valid.
EXT EXTEND
Existing file will be extended.
- For tape/optical disk this parameter value is
only valid if the target file is the last on
the tape/optical disk.
- For DCP tape this parameter value is only valid
if the tape file is empty.
- The parameter value is not valid if the target
carrier is a tape/optical disk and a partial
qualification has been entered.
- The parameter value is not valid for the DCP
disk.
- The parameter value is not valid if the
target file is a PAM file/ CYC file or if
COPMOD = SSWF.
- If a file transfer with target file on local
disk is aborted due to lack of space and this
parameter value has been entered, the following
options exist:
a) use CR FILE to create a new file with
sufficient capacity,
b) use OVWR to transfer the file that was to
be extended to the newly created file,
c) use EXT to extend the newly created file.

Default: CR

COPMOD COPY MODE OF FILE

This parameter specifies the copy mode (file and/or data reformatting).

Assignment of parameter values to copy direction/default:

+-----------------------+------------------------+----------------+
! Copy from .. to .. ! Possible param. values ! Default !
+-----------------------+------------------------+----------------+
! local disk --> ! KEEP ! KEEP !
! local disk ! POST ! !
+-----------------------+------------------------+----------------+
! local disk --> ! ! !
! local optical disk / ! POST ! POST !
! local tape ! SSWF ! !
! remote data carrier ! ! !
+-----------------------+------------------------+----------------+
! local optical disk / ! ! !
! local tape --> ! ! !
! local disk / ! BIN ! BIN !
! local optical disk / ! CHAR ! !
! local tape / ! ! !
! remote data carrier ! ! !
+-----------------------+------------------------+----------------!
! remote data ! ! !

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TRANS FILE- 5+


TRANS FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

! carrier --> ! ! !
! local disk / ! BIN ! BIN
! local optical disk / ! CHAR !
! local tape ! ! !
+-----------------------+------------------------+----------------+

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BIN COPY BINARY DATA


This parameter value enables
1) a file in Post-Processing format containing
binary data to be copied 1:1 in the directions

+--------------+
! local !
! optical disk/!
! local tape/ ! --+
! remote data ! !
! carrier ! !
+--------------+ !
!
+--------------+ +--------------+ !
! ! ! local ! !
! ! ! optical disk/! !
! local disk ! <------ ! local tape/ ! <-+
! ! ! remote data !
! ! ! carrier !
+--------------+ +--------------+

- The target file attributes are determined


by the source file attributes.
- The data are not reformatted.
- If the target file is on local disk:
a) no access restrictions are set,
b) the number of requested copies is set
to 0 (zero).

2) a file in SSW format to be copied in the


directions

+--------------+ +--------------+
! ! ! local !
! ! ! optical disk/!
! local disk ! <------ ! local tape/ !
! ! ! remote data !
! ! ! carrier !
+--------------+ +--------------+

- The SSW format is decomposed.


- By decomposing the SSW format, the file which
was copied with COPMOD = SSWF is
reconstructed.
- The target file attributes are taken from the
file key block, which is output as SSW
INFORMATION in connection with DISP FILE
for the local tape/optical disk.

3) a file in SSW format to be copied in the


directions

+--------------+
! local !
! optical disk/!
! local tape/ ! --+
! remote data ! !
! carrier ! !
+--------------+ !
!
+--------------+ !
! local ! !
! optical disk/! !
! local tape/ ! <-+
! remote data !
! carrier !
+--------------+

- The SSW format is not decomposed.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TRANS FILE- 6+


TRANS FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- DISP FILE for a file on local tape/


optical disk specifies whether it has
Post-Processing format or SSW format.
CHAR COPY CHARACTER
This parameter value enables a file in
Post-Processing format containing text data to be
copied 1:1 in the directions

+--------------+
! local !
! optical disk/!
! local tape/ ! --+
! remote data ! !
! carrier ! !
+--------------+ !
!
+--------------+ +--------------+ !
! ! ! local ! !
! ! ! optical disk/! !
! local disk ! <------ ! local tape/ ! <-+
! ! ! remote data !
! ! ! carrier !
+--------------+ +--------------+

- The entry is ignored for source files in


SSW format.
- The target file attributes are determined by the
source file attributes.
- The data are recoded and stored on the target
data carrier
EBCDIC tape/
optical disk in EBCDIC.DF.03 code
ASCII tape/
optical disk in ASCII code
Disk in processor internal code.
- If the target file is on local disk:
a) no access restrictions are set,
b) the number of required copies is set
to 0 (zero).
SSWF CREATE SUPPORT SOFTWARE FORMAT
This parameter value copies a file from local disk
creating SSW format in the directions

+--------------+ +--------------+
! ! ! local !
! ! ! optical disk/!
! local disk ! ------> ! local tape/ !
! ! ! remote data !
! ! ! carrier !
+--------------+ +--------------+

- This parameter value is primarily used for


creating save copies on EBCDIC tape/optical
disks.
- This parameter value is not possible for CYC
files and generation files.
- Since the target file is created in SSW format,
the following restrictions apply to the source
file:
a) record size <= 2048 byte, if record format is
variable,
b) record size <= 2040 byte, if record format is
fix.
- The copying information is ignored as the target
file attributes are defined by SSW format.
- The number of performed copies is not increased.
- The source file attributes are stored in the
file key block of the target file, enabling the
source file to be reconstructed when the target
file is recopied to local disk.
Notes:
- EBCDIC tape/optical disks created with this
parameter value can be processed by IMON.
- File copies produced with this parameter value
can be read by the host using SYSUPD.
- Files in SSW format are structured with:
a) file type SAM,

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TRANS FILE- 7+


TRANS FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b) record format FIX,


c) data type TRANSP,
d) record size (block length) 2048 bytes.
KEEP KEEP FILE STRUCTURE
This parameter value creates a 1:1 copy in the
directions

+--------------+
! !
+-- ! local disk !
! ! !
! +--------------+
!
! +--------------+
! ! !
+-> ! local disk !
! !
+--------------+

- The parameter value is not possible for


CYC files.
- File attributes (especially file type and
data type) are retained. For exceptions see
below.
- For the target file on local disk:
a) no access restrictions are set, but the write
protection is adopted from the source file,
b) the number of required copies file is set
to default 0 (zero),
c) the service process of the source file is not
assigned to the target file.
POST CREATE POST PROCESSING FORMAT
This parameter value copies a file creating
Post-Processing format in the directions

+--------------+ +--------------+
! ! ! local !
! ! ! optical disk/!
+-- ! local disk ! ------> ! local tape/ !
! ! ! ! remote data !
! ! ! ! carrier !
! +--------------+ +--------------+
!
! +--------------+
! ! !
+-> ! local disk !
! !
+--------------+

- This parameter value is only allowed for PAM


file if a service process exists.
- The target file is a file in
Post-Processing format with non-compressed data
(SAM/TRANSP or SAM/TEXTNCMP).
- The target file attributes are derived from the
copying information of the source file (see
DISP FILE output block COPY INFORMATION).
- The copy block length determines the block
length for the local tape/optical disk, but not
for a remote tape.
- The number of copies made is incremented by 1 if
the target file is on local tape/local optical
disk/remote data carrier and the number of
requested copies is > 0 (zero).
- If the target file is on local disk, then:
a) no access restrictions are set, but the write
protection is adopted from the source file,
b) the number of requested copies is set
to 0 (zero).
- Reformatting is controlled via the data type or
is performed independently of the data type by a
service process, if one exists (see DISP FILE
output block FILEGROUP INFORMATION).
- The following table provides an overview of
reformatting controlled by data type:

+-------+-------------+--------------------------+

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TRANS FILE- 8+


TRANS FILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

!CP ! ! !
!source ! Data type ! File and/or data !
!file ! 1) ! reformatting !
!-------+-------------+--------------------------!
! SAM ! TRANSP ! No reformatting !
! ! ! (copy of binary data) !
! ! ! !
! ! TEXTNCMP ! No reformatting !
! ! ! Character conversion !
! ! ! (ASCII <--> EBCDIC.DF.03)!
! ! ! dependent on target data !
! ! ! carrier or according to !
! ! ! link protocol !
! ! ! (copy of text data) !
! ! ! !
! ! TEXTCMP ! Data edited into !
! ! ! printable characters !
! ! ! according to the !
! ! ! editing information !
! ! ! stored in the file !
! ! ! and character conversion !
! ! ! (as above) !
! ! ! !
!-------+-------------+--------------------------!
! CYC ! ! Decomposition of cyclic !
! ! ! structure for all data !
! ! ! types !
! ! ! (target file type SAM) !
! ! ! Depending on copy record !
! ! ! size, records in cyclic !
! ! ! files may also be split !
! ! ! !
! ! ! ) !
! ! TRANSP ! ! !
! ! TEXTNCMP ! > data reformatting !
! ! TEXTCMP ! ! all as above !
! ! ! ) !
! ! ! !
! ! MMLCMPR ! As for TEXTCMP but with !
! ! ! addition of conversion !
! ! ! into a format that can !
! ! ! be processed by text !
! ! ! editors !
! ! ! !
+-------+-------------+--------------------------+
1) see output parameter data storage form of
command DISP FILE

RETPER RETENTION PERIOD RECEIVE FILE

This parameter specifies the retention period of the target file


in days. The following conventions must be observed:
- If no input is made for RETPER and COPMOD = POST, the copy
retention period of the source file is adopted implicitly as
retention period of the target file.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...36525, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TRANS FILE- 9-


MOD FILEAUT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY FILE AUTHORIZATION

This command is used to modify the access restrictions and/or the


number of safe copies in a file catalog.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD FILEAUT : FILE= <,AR= ,SAFCOP=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file whose catalog is to


be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


+,*,%,#

AR ACCESS RESTRICTION

This parameter specifies the type of access restrictions.

Note:
- Any access restrictions not specified are reset
if they are set in the catalog.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

NOCN NO CATALOG NAME


NOCR NO CATALOG RETENTION PERIOD
NODEL NO DELETE
NORD NO READ
NOWR NO WRITE
NOAR NO ACCESS RESTRICTION

SAFCOP SAFECOPY

This parameter specifies the number of safe copies


that have already been made.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1,2,3...3, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD FILEAUT- 1-


ACT FILEFEAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE FILE FEATURES

This commands activates features assigned to a certain file.


Prerequisites:
If the feature was previously not entered, the command will be rejected
The target file specified in the command must exist on the system disk.
Possible effects:
The data in the target file may be lost after this command.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT FILEFEAT : FILE= ,FEAT= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE TARGET FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file for whom a feature will
be activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FEAT FEATURES

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

FLAMCOMP FLAM COMPRESSION


The data in the target file is compressed using
the FLAM algorithm in CX8 mode.
HEADER HEADER
During file transfer a header record is added.
TRAILER TRAILER
During file transfer a trailer record is added.
FORMAT ASN.1 CLIENT RECORD FORMATTING
During file transfer the data in the target file
is reformatted into a client specific format using
an external device.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT FILEFEAT- 1-


CAN FILEFEAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL FILE FEATURES

This command cancels features assigned to a file.


Prerequisites:
The feature to be canceled may not be active.
The target file must exist on the system disk.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN FILEFEAT : FILE= ,FEAT= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE TARGET FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file from which a feature will
be canceled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FEAT FEATURES

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

FLAMCOMP FLAM COMPRESSION


The data in the target file is compressed using
the FLAM algorithm in CX8 mode.
HEADER HEADER
During file transfer a header record is added.
TRAILER TRAILER
During file transfer a trailer record is added.
FORMAT ASN.1 CLIENT RECORD FORMATTING
During file transfer the data in the target file
is reformatted into a client specific format using
an external device.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN FILEFEAT- 1-


DACT FILEFEAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE FILE FEATURES

This command deactivates features assigned to a certain file.


Prerequisites:
If the feature was previously not active, the command will be rejected.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT FILEFEAT : FILE= ,FEAT= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE TARGET FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file from which a feature will
be deactivated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FEAT FEATURES

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

FLAMCOMP FLAM COMPRESSION


The data in the target file is compressed using
the FLAM algorithm in CX8 mode.
HEADER HEADER
During file transfer a header record is added.
TRAILER TRAILER
During file transfer a trailer record is added.
FORMAT ASN.1 CLIENT RECORD FORMATTING
During file transfer the data in the target file
is reformatted into a client specific format using
an external device.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT FILEFEAT- 1-


DISP FILEFEAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY FILE FEATURES

This command displays the different features assigned to a certain


file. Together with the feature and its status, the name of the file
where the results of the assigned DISP FILEFEAT is stored.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FILEFEAT : FILE= [,FEAT=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE TARGET FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file for which the assigned
DISP FILEFEAT will be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FEAT FEATURES

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

FLAMCOMP FLAM COMPRESSION


The data in the target file is compressed using
the FLAM algorithm in CX8 mode.
HEADER HEADER
During file transfer a header record is added.
TRAILER TRAILER
During file transfer a trailer record is added.
FORMAT ASN.1 CLIENT RECORD FORMATTING
During file transfer the data in the target file
is reformatted into a client specific format using
an external device.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FILEFEAT- 1-


ENTR FILEFEAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER FILE FEATURES

This command enters feature(s) and assigns these feature(s) to a


targetfile. The result is stored in another file with the same
characteristics as the target file unless otherwise specified.
The result file name cannot be specified by the operator. It is
system internal defined in following manner "TARGET FILE NAME" + ".FLAM".
Prerequisites:
The file to which a feature is assigned, must already exist.
If the file -read application- is not supported by the system ,
the command will be rejected indicating that the application is
not supported.
Following files - read applications - are supported:
- IA.ICAMA
- IA.ICMCR
- IA.ICINA (both ASN.1 format and internal format)
- IA.ICIAR
- IA.ICIAR1
- IA.ICIAR2

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR FILEFEAT : FILE= ,FEAT= [,ACTION=] [,SIZE=] [,RECF=] 1
1 1
1 [,RECSZ=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE TARGET FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the file for which a feature is
entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FEAT FEATURES

This parameter specifies the assigned features

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

FLAMCOMP FLAM COMPRESSION


The data in the target file is compressed using
the FLAM algorithm in CX8 mode.
HEADER HEADER
During file transfer a header record is added.
TRAILER TRAILER
During file transfer a trailer record is added.
FORMAT ASN.1 CLIENT RECORD FORMATTING
During file transfer the data in the target file
is reformatted into a client specific format using
an external device.

ACTION ADDITIONAL ACTIONS

This parameter specifies which additional action is done with the data
in the target file.
Possible effects can be that original data of the file is lost when the
entered feature is activated lateron.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

REL RELEASE EXISTING FILE


The data in the target file is released after
successful feature execution.
NOREL NOT RELEASE EXISTING FILE
The data in the target file is kept after
successful feature execution.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR FILEFEAT- 1+


ENTR FILEFEAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Default: REL

SIZE RESULT FILE SIZE

This parameter specifies the size of the result file. The size is
entered in number of PAM pages.
The default value is the size of the target file.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...65000, range of decimal numbers

RECF RECORD FORMAT RESULT FILE

This parameter specifies the record format of the result file.


The default value is identical to the record format of the target file.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

VAR VARIABLE FORMAT


FIX FIXED FORMAT

RECSZ RECORD SIZE RESULT FILE

This parameter specifies the record size of the result file. The record
size can be entered in bytes. The size must be minimum 80 bytes and
maximum 32768 bytes (32K).
The default value is identical to the record size of the target file

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

80...32768, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR FILEFEAT- 2-


ENTR FILEPSW

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER FILE PASSWORD

This command enters a session file password.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR FILEPSW ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR FILEPSW- 1-


DISP FILESEC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY FILE SECURITY METHOD

This command is used to show the selected File Security


method.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FILESEC ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FILESEC- 1-


SET FILESEC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SET FILE SECURITY METHOD

This command is used to switch between the two methods of File


Security.

File based File Security names the method where per file an
optional password can be administrated for each file access.
Access to files is allowed when no password is set.
This is independently of the initiator who attempts to access
the file.
Initiator based File Security names the method where for each
initiator, defined by a user id, access rights can be set for
single files or a number of files. Access to files is not
allowed for a specific initiator when nothing is administrated
for this initiator.

Note:
- With the File based File Security method passwords have to
be administrated using the commands CR FGRP and SET FGRPPW.
- With the Initiator based File Security method administration
can only be done using Q3 operations.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 SET FILESEC : FILESEC= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILESEC FILE SECURITY METHOD

This parameter is always mandatory.


The parameter specifies which File Security method shall be
selected.
The value FBFS stands for the File based File Security
method.
The value IBFS stands for the Initiator based File
Security method.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FBFS FILE BASED FILE SECURITY


IBFS INITIATOR BASED FILE SECURITY

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SET FILESEC- 1-


DISP FILETEXT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY FILETEXT

This command displays the content of a file.

Prerequisites:
- The specified file must be a sequential dataset with variable
record length.
- The records contain only ASCII characters (see note).

Notes:
- Unprintable characters are substituted by ’.’.
- Continuation lines of a record start with ’>>’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FILETEXT : FILE= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter identifies the dataset for display with its


filename.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FILETEXT- 1-


CAN FILETRF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL FILE TRANSFERS

This command cancels FTAM file transfer(s).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN FILETRF : <JN= ,JST=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

JN JOB NUMBER

This parameter specifies the job number assigned to a FTAM file


transfer.

Notes:
- If exactly one FTAM filetransfer is specified, the value entered
for JST is checked against the actual jobstate (see output
parameter jobstate of command DISP FILETRF).
- If X is entered, all FTAM file transfers are cancelled.
If JST is entered additionally, only the corresponding FTAM
jobs are cancelled.
- If no value is entered here, JST has to be specified.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...9999, range of decimal numbers

JST JOB STATE

This parameter specifies an additional selection criterion.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
INTR INTERRUPTED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN FILETRF- 1-


DISP FILETRF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY FILE TRANSFERS

This command displays data of FTAM file transfer(s) and comprises


the functions:
- list of all FTAM file transfers giving main job data.
- list of all job data for one FTAM file transfer.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FILETRF : <JN= ,JST=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

JN JOB NUMBER

This parameter specifies the job number assigned to a FTAM file


transfer.

Notes:
- If exactly one FTAM filetransfer is specified, the value entered
for JST is ignored.
- If X is entered, a list of all FTAM file transfers is displayed.
If JST is entered additionally, only the corresponding FTAM
jobs are displayed.
- If no value is entered here, JST has to be specified.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...9999, range of decimal numbers

JST JOB STATE

This parameter specifies an additional selection criterion.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
INTR INTERRUPTED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FILETRF- 1-


STOP FILETRF

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

STOP FILE TRANSFERS

This command stops FTAM file transfer(s). The jobstate changes to


interrupted (see output parameter jobstate of command DISP FILETRF).

Prerequisites:
- the interruption of the FTAM file transfer(s) must be possible
(see output parameter interrupt possible of command DISP FILETRF).
- the FTAM file transfer(s) must be activ.
(see output parameter jobstate of command DISP FILETRF)

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STOP FILETRF : JN= [,INTRPER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

JN JOB NUMBER

This parameter specifies the job number assigned to a FTAM file


transfer.

Notes:
- If X is entered, all FTAM file transfers are stopped

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...9999, range of decimal numbers

INTRPER INTERRUPT PERIOD

This parameter specifies the interrupt period for FTAM file


transfer(s) suggested by the operator. The value is entered
in the form HH-MM (H=Hour, M=Minute). As the value is
transferred in the form 2 to the power of x seconds by the
FTAM protocol, the entered value is calculated in seconds
and rounded up. Due to this exact values cannot be produced.

Default : 10 minutes

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STOP FILETRF- 1-


CAN FILTER

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL FILTER COMMAND

This command deletes the specified filter.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN FILTER : FILTER= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILTER FILTER NAME

This parameter specifies the name of a filter


to be deleted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN FILTER- 1-


CR FILTER

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE FILTER COMMAND

This command creates a new filter that can be used to select only
those mobile subscribers which match the filter criteria.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR FILTER : FILTER= <,BSV= ,SSV= ,MSUBFT= ,OPRSERV= ,MSCAT= 1
1 1
1 ,EXPIRY= ,SELECT= ,QOSPROF= ,NTF= ,PRFMSIN= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,NDC= ,LAC= ,VIEW=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILTER FILTER NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the filter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

BSV BASIC SERVICE CODE

This parameter selects mobile subscribers with the


specified basic service.
Notes:
- Up to 3 basic services can be specified.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

TELEPHON TELEPHONY
TS21 SHORT MESSAGE MT/PP
TS22 SHORT MESSAGE MO/PP
TS61 FACSIMILE GROUP 3 AND SPEECH
TS62 AUTOMATIC FACSIMILE GROUP 3
BS21 DATA C.D.A. 300B/S
BS22 DATA C.D.A. 1200B/S
BS23 DATA C.D.A. 1200-75B/S
BS24 DATA C.D.A. 2400B/S
BS25 DATA C.D.A. 4800B/S
BS26 DATA C.D.A. 9600B/S
BS41 PAD ACCESS C.D.A. 300B/S
BS42 PAD ACCESS C.D.A. 1200B/S
BS44 PAD ACCESS C.D.A. 2400B/S
BS45 PAD ACCESS C.D.A. 4800B/S
BS46 PAD ACCESS C.D.A. 9600B/S
BS31 DATA C.D.S. 1200B/S
BS32 DATA C.D.S. 2400B/S
BS33 DATA C.D.S. 4800B/S
BS34 DATA C.D.S. 9600B/S
BS61A ALTERNATE SPEECH OR DATA
BS81A SPEECH FOLLOWED BY DATA
BS20GENR GENERAL DATA C.D.A.
BS30GENR GENERAL DATA C.D.S.
BS40GENR GENERAL PAD ACCESS C.D.A.
VGCS VOICE GROUP CALL SERVICE
VBS VOICE BROADCAST SERVICE
GPRS GENERAL PACKET RADIO SERVICE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FILTER- 1+
CR FILTER

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TS21GPRS SHORT MESSAGE MT/PP FOR GPRS


TS22GPRS SHORT MESSAGE MO/PP FOR GPRS

SSV SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICE

This parameter selects mobile subscribers with the specified


supplementary service or group of supplementary services.
Notes:
- Up to 3 supplementary services can be specified.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CLIP CALLING LINE ID. PRESENTATION


CLIR CALLING LINE ID. RESTRICTION
COLP CONNECTED LINE ID PRESENTATION
COLR CONNECTED LINE ID RESTRICTION
ALLCF ALL CALL FORWARDING SERVICES
CFU CF UNCONDITIONAL
ALLCFCON ALL CF CONDITIONAL
CFBUSY CF ON MSUB BUSY
CFNREPLY CF ON NO REPLY
CFNREACH CF ON MSUB NOT REACHABLE
CALLWAIT CALL WAITING
CALLHOLD CALL HOLD
CCBSA CALL COMPLETION BUSY SUBSCR. A
CCBSB CALL COMPLETION BUSY SUBSCR. B
MPTY MULTI PARTY
CUG CLOSED USER GROUP
AOCINFO ADVICE OF CHARGE INFORMATION
AOCCHRG ADVICE OF CHARGE CHARGING
ALLCB ALL CALL BARRING SERVICES
CBO CB OF OUTGOING CALLS
CBOC CB OF ALL OUTGOING CALLS
CBOIC CB OF ALL OUTGOING INT. CALLS
CBOICEXH CBOIC EXCEPT TO HPLMN COUNTRY
CBI CB OF INCOMING CALLS
CBIC CB OF ALL INCOMING CALLS
CBICROUT CBIC ROAMING OUTSIDE HOME PLMN
EMLPP EMLPP SERVICE
ANYLCS ANY LCS PRIVACY EXCEPT. CLASS
UNIVERS UNIVERSAL CLASS
CREL CALL RELATED CLASS
CUNREL CALL UNRELATED CLASS
PLMNOPR PLMN OPERATOR CLASS
BSLC BASIC SELF LOCATION
ASLC AUTONOMOUS SELF LOCATION
HOTBILL HOT BILLING
USERSIG1 USER TO USER SIGN. SERV. 1
CALLBACK CALL BACK
NATCCBS CALL COMPL. TO BUSY SUBSCR.
CT CALL TRANSFER
FOLLOWME FOLLOW ME
FROUT FORCED ROUTING
FMSPV FOLLOW ME SUPERVISOR
NATSS01 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 01
NATSS02 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 02
NATSS03 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 03
NATSS04 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 04
NATSS05 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 05
NATSS06 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 06
NATSS07 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 07
NATSS08 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 08
NATSS09 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 09
NATSS10 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 10
NATSS11 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 11
NATSS12 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 12
NATSS13 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 13
NATSS14 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 14
NATSS15 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 15
CFD CF DEFAULT

MSUBFT SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE

This parameter selects mobile subscribers with the


specified subscriber-related feature.
Notes:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FILTER- 2+
CR FILTER

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- The meaning of the specified feature is project-dependent.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

MSUBFT01 SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 01


MSUBFT02 SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 02
MSUBFT03 SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 03
MSUBFT04 SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 04
MSUBFT05 SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 05
MSUBFT06 SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 06
MSUBFT07 SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 07
MSUBFT08 SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 08
MSUBFT09 SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 09
MSUBFT10 SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 10
MSUBFT11 SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 11
MSUBFT12 SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 12
MSUBFT13 SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 13
MSUBFT14 SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 14
MSUBFT15 SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 15
MSUBFT16 SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE 16
ANYFT ANY SUBSCRIBER RELATED FEATURE

OPRSERV OPERATOR SERVICE

This parameter selects mobile subscribers with the


specified operator service.
Notes:
- Up to 12 operator services can be specified.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: OPERATOR SERVICE TYPE


OCSI ORIGINATING CSI
TCSI TERMINATING CSI
UCSI USSD CAMEL SUBSCRIPTION INFO
SSCSI SSV CAMEL SUBSCRIPTION INFO
GPRSCSI GPRS CAMEL SUBSCRIPTION INFO
MSP MULTIPLE SUBSCRIBER PROFILE
VTCSI VISITED MSC TERMINATING CSI
SMSCSI SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE CSI
MCSI MOBILITY MANAGEMENT CSI
DCSI DIALED SERVICES CSI
TIFCSI TRANSLATION INFORM. FLAG CSI
SUBRELRO SUBSCRIBER RELATED ROUTING
INMOC IN MOBILE ORIGINATED CALL
INMTC IN MOBILE TERMINATING CALL

b: OPERATOR SERVICE NAME=


1...10 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This unit specifies the service name as a further


selection criteria.
If X is entered, service name is ignored.

c: CSI STATE
ACT ACTIVATED
DACT DEACTIVATED

This unit specifies the CAMEL subscription


information state as a further selection criteria.
Incompatibilities:
- a = MSP
- a = SUBRELRO

d: CSI NOTIFICATION
ACT ACTIVATED
DACT DEACTIVATED

This unit specifies the CAMEL subscription


information notification as a further selection criteria.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FILTER- 3+
CR FILTER

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Incompatibilities:
- a = MSP
- a = SUBRELRO

MSCAT MOBILE SUBSCRIBER CATEGORY

This parameter selects mobile subscribers with the


specified category.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ORDINSUB ORDINARY CALLING SUBSCRIBER


VERIFSUB VERIFICATION SUBSCRIBER
PRIO1SUB PRIORITY 1 SUBSCRIBER
PRIO2SUB PRIORITY 2 SUBSCRIBER
PRIO3SUB PRIORITY 3 SUBSCRIBER
PPSCSUB PREPAID SUBSCR. WITHOUT RECORD
PPSCSUBR PREPAID SUBSCR. WITH RECORD
OLFRENCH OPERATOR LANGUAGE FRENCH
OLENGLSH OPERATOR LANGUAGE ENGLISH
OLGERMAN OPERATOR LANGUAGE GERMAN
OLRUSSIA OPERATOR LANGUAGE RUSSIAN
OLSPANSH OPERATOR LANGUAGE SPANISH
OLADD1 ADD. OPERATOR LANGUAGE 1
OLADD2 ADD. OPERATOR LANGUAGE 2
OLADD3 ADD. OPERATOR LANGUAGE 3
NATOPER NATIONAL OPERATOR
PRIOSUB PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
DATACALL DATA CALL
TESTCALL TEST CALL
PAYPHONE PAYPHONE
ORDFREE ORDINSUB WITHOUT CHARGING
PRIOFREE PRIOSUB WITHOUT CHARGING

Default: ORDINSUB

EXPIRY EXPIRY DATE OF MSUB ENTRY

This parameter selects mobile subscribers with the


specified expiry date.
Only mobile subscribers whose expiry date matches the input
to this parameter are selected for display.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

SELECT SELECTION MODE

This parameter selects mobile subscribers matching


all specified selection modes.
Notes:
- The maximum number of list entries is 8.
Incompatibilities:
- Any combination of the parameter values TEMPLATE,
LMU and PROFILE is not allowed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

MSUBLINK LINKED MOBILE SUBSCRIBERS


SIMCCH MSUB WITH SIM CARD CHANGEOVER
IMSITRAC MSUB WITH IMSI TRACE
WLLSUB WLL SUBSCRIBERS

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FILTER- 4+
CR FILTER

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RSSERV REGIONAL SUBSCR. SERVICE DATA


TEMPLATE TEMPLATE FOR MOBILE SUBSCRIBER
EXPIRED EXPIRED MOBILE SUBSCRIBER
LMU LOCATION MEASUREMENT UNIT
PROFILE PROFILE FOR MOBILE SUBSCRIBER
OR OPTIMAL ROUTING

QOSPROF QOS PROFILE NAME

This parameter selects mobile subscribers with the


specified quality of service profile.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NTF NOTIFICATION TO CSE

This parameter selects mobile subscribers with the specified


notification flag. The flag indicates the necessity to notify
the CSE(Camel service environment) of the change of
subscriber data.
Notes:
- Up to 3 notification flags can be specified.
- Combination NONE with other flags is not allowed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

NONE NO NOTIFICATION FLAG


CBSERV CALL BARRING SERVICES
CFSERV CALL FORWARDING SERVICES
ODB OPERATOR DETERMINED BARRING

PRFMSIN PROFILE MSUB IDENTIF. NUMBER

This parameter selects mobile subscribers with the


specified profile MSUB identification number.
Notes:
- Up to 3 entries can be specified.
- If "X" is entered, then the type of profile is ignored.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: TYPE OF PROFILE
GPRS GPRS PROFILE
CAMEL CAMEL PROFILE
SSV SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES PROFILE
X TYPE OF PROFILE IGNORED

b: MSIN OF PROFILE=
1...12 digit decimal number

NDC NATIONAL DESTINATION CODE

This parameter selects mobile subscribers with one of the


specified national destination codes.
Notes:
- Up to 3 national destination codes can be specified.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 digit decimal number

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter selects subscribers with the


specified local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FILTER- 5+
CR FILTER

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...5 digit decimal number

VIEW VIEW ON MSUB DATA

This parameter selects the type of view on mobile


subscriber data.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NORMAL NORMAL DISPLAY


Display with references to profiles.
PRFEXP PROFILE DATA EXPLODED

Default: NORMAL

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FILTER- 6-
DISP FILTER

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY FILTER COMMAND

This command displays the filter criteria.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP FILTER : FILTER= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FILTER FILTER NAME

This parameter specifies the name of a filter to be


displayed.
Notes:
- Up to 50 filter profiles can be specified.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FILTER- 1-


ACT FIXPOINT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE FIXPOINT

This command activates the automatic creation of fixpoint generations.


The command causes a fixpoint generation to be automatically created on
disk each time a defined threshold number of MML commands with logging
attribute or, if the Q3 interface is active, Q3 requests or
Q3 responses has been entered.

The number of fixpoints simultaneously permitted on disk is limited.


When the maximum number of fixpoints on disk has been reached, the
oldest fixpoint is deleted upon generation of another fixpoint.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT FIXPOINT : [CMDTHRES=] [,Q3REQTHR=] [,Q3RESTHR=] 1
1 1
1 [,Q3OPCNT=] [,FIXNO=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CMDTHRES COMMAND THRESHOLD

This parameter specifies the number of MML commands with logging


attribute, after input of which an automatic fixpoint generation, that
is, a copy of the current semipermanent database to disk, will be made.
The default of this parameter is the value entered during the last
input of the command ACT FIXPOINT. If the command ACT FIXPOINT is
entered for the first time, this parameter must be specified. This
threshold value specifies the number of subscriber-programmed
entries.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1000...100000, range of decimal numbers

Q3REQTHR Q3 REQUEST THRESHOLD

This parameter specifies the number of Q3 Requests with logging


attribute, after input of which an automatic fixpoint generation, that
is, a copy of the current semipermanent database to disk, will be
generated.
The default of this parameter is the value entered during the last
input of the command ACT FIXPOINT. If the command ACT FIXPOINT is
entered for the first time and no value is specified, no fixpoint will
be generated in respect of Q3 Requests.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10000, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

Q3RESTHR Q3 RESPONSE THRESHOLD

This parameter specifies the number of Q3 Responses with logging


attribute, after input of which an automatic fixpoint generation, that
is, a copy of the current semipermanent database to disk, will be
generated.
The default of this parameter is the value entered during the last
input of the command ACT FIXPOINT. If the command ACT FIXPOINT is
entered for the first time and no value is specified, the value
defaults to that of CMDTHRES.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

100...100000, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT FIXPOINT- 1+


ACT FIXPOINT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Q3OPCNT Q3 OPERATION COUNTING

This parameter specifies whether Q3 entries are to be counted or not


i.e, if an automatic fixpoint is to be generated because of
Q3 Responses or Q3 Requests or not.
If the Q3 interface is not active this parameter is ignored.
Default: Q3 operations are counted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

YES Q3 OPERATION COUNTING


Y Q3 OPERATION COUNTING
NO NO Q3 OPERATION COUNTING
N NO Q3 OPERATION COUNTING

FIXNO MAXIMAL NUMBER OF FIXPOINTS

This parameter specifies the maximum number of fixpoint generations


on disk. The original generation, i.e. that with the same generation
name but with fixpoint counter = 00, and snapshot generations are not
included in this number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT FIXPOINT- 2-


DACT FIXPOINT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE FIXPOINT

This command deactivates automatic fixpoint generation. This is required


for example, prior to an APS change or REGEN run (see the command
description for EXEC REGEN). If the automatic fixpoint function is
subsequently activated again without entering parameters, the threshold
value is the same as the one before the deactivation.

For general information on the generation concept, see the command


description for COPY GEN.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT FIXPOINT ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT FIXPOINT- 1-


DISP FIXPOINT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY FIXPOINT

This command displays the following information on automatic fixpoint


creation:

- Status of the fixpoint function

- Threshold number of entered MML commands with logging


attribute, on exceeding of which a fixpoint is to be generated,

- Threshold number of entered Q3 requests with logging


attribute, on exceeding of which a fixpoint is to be generated,

- Threshold number of entered Q3 responses with logging


attribute, on exceeding of which a fixpoint is to be generated,

- Status of Q3 counting, i.e. whether Q3 counting is activated or


not

- Maximum number of fixpoint generations permitted on disk.

For general information on the generation concept, see the command


description for COPY GEN.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FIXPOINT ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FIXPOINT- 1-


ACT FNS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE FILE NAME SEGMENT

This command activates the filename segment protection


for one element or for all elements of the filename
segment table.

Prerequisite:
- The filename segment element must exist.
- The syntax of the filename segment element must be correct.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT FNS : [FNS=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FNS FILE NAME SEGMENT

This parameter specifies the name of the filename segment


for which the relevant function is to be carried out.

Note:
- Only alphanumeric characters are legal.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT FNS- 1-


CAN FNS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL FILE NAME SEGMENT

This command cancels elements of the filename segment


table which were created retrospectively.

Prerequisite:
- The filename segment element must be an external element
(created with ENTR FNS).
- The syntax of the filename segment element must be correct.
- Update must be switched on.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN FNS : FNS= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FNS FILE NAME SEGMENT

This parameter specifies the name of the filename segment


for which the relevant function is to be carried out.

Note:
- Only alphanumeric characters are legal.
- The filename segment must be entered as a fully
qualified name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN FNS- 1-


DACT FNS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE FILE NAME SEGMENT

This command deactivates the filename segment protection for


one element or all elements of the filename segment table.

Prerequisite:
- The file name segment element must exist.
- The syntax of the filename segment element must be correct.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT FNS : [FNS=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FNS FILE NAME SEGMENT

This parameter specifies the name of the file name segment.

Note:
- Only alphanumeric characters are legal.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT FNS- 1-


DISP FNS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY FILE NAME SEGMENT

This command displays one or all elements of the filename


segment table.

Prerequisite:
- The filename segment element must exist.
- The syntax of the filename segment element must be correct.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FNS : [FNS=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FNS FILE NAME SEGMENT

This parameter specifies the name of the filename segment


for which the relevant function is to be carried out.

Note:
- Only alphanumeric characters are legal.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FNS- 1-


ENTR FNS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER FILE NAME SEGMENT

This command is used to add new elements to the file name segment table.

Prerequisite:
- The filename segment must be entered as a fully
qualified name.
- The specified element may not exist.
- The table should not be full.
- The syntax of the specified element must be correct.
- Update must be switched on.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR FNS : FNS= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FNS FILE NAME SEGMENT

This parameter specifies the name of the filename segment.

Note:
- Only alphanumeric characters are legal.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR FNS- 1-


DISP FOLLOW

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Following Files

This task returns following files if the output of DISP DFILE or DISP FOLLOW
has been truncated (indicate the value of the output parameter LAST).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FOLLOW : [MP_ID=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MP_ID

Specifies the Identifier of MP.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FOLLOW- 1-


ACT FPTRC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Activate Fast Process Trace

This task activates the SPT tracer for Fast Process Switching tracing
on MP platform(s).
This activation job can only be submitted in the state of deactivation,
e.g. no active trace and no trace data dump is just running.

Note:
- If the trace buffer contains data of an previous trace which are
not dumped yet, the parameter ’Unconditional activation’ must be set
to ’Yes’.
Otherwise the trace cannot be activated again.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT FPTRC : [MP=] [,Recovery level=] [,Cyclic=] 1
1 1
1 [,Unconditional activation=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MP

This parameter is used to specify up to 10 MPs on which the


Fast Process Switch Trace should be activated.
If ’MP’ is not specified, the trace is activated on all
active platforms.

Recovery level

This parameter specifies up to which recovery level the trace


should survive.
If this parameter is omitted the trace won’t survive any recoveries.

Cyclic

This parameter specifies, whether the trace buffer will be


written cyclically - i.e. the content of trace buffer can be
overwritten - or non-cyclically.
If this parameter is omitted the trace buffer will be written
cyclically.

Unconditional activation

This parameter specifies if the acitivation is performed even if


trace data of the prevoius trace are not dumped yet.
The default value is ’No’.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT FPTRC- 1-


DACT FPTRC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Deactivate Fast Process Trace

This command deactivates the current not yet finished trace on


the MP platform(s) that was activated by the previous activation
job task.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT FPTRC ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT FPTRC- 1-


DISP FPTRC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Fast Process Trace

This task displays information about the trace status on MP platform(s).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FPTRC : [MP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MP

This parameter is used to specify up to 10 MPs whose trace


status should be displayed.
If ’MP’ is not specified, the status is displayed for all
active platforms.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FPTRC- 1-


DMP FPTRC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Dump Data of Fast Process Trace

This task displays the trace buffer of the special trace.

It can only be submitted in the state of deactivation, e.g. no


active trace and no trace data dump is just running.

The data can be displayed for all active MPs or for up to 10


specified MPs.

This task can also be used to stop a currently running output of


the trace buffer.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DMP FPTRC : Action= [,MP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Action

This parameter specifies if the trace buffer should be dumped


or if a currently running dump should be stopped.

MP

This parameter is used to specify up to 10 MPs whose trace


data should be dumped.
If ’MP’ is not specified, the trace data of all active
platforms are dumped.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP FPTRC- 1-


DISP FSCFG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display File Security Configuration

This Task displays the ’File Security Configuration’, which defines


the possible ’Rule restrictions’ and the ’Default access’ rights
provided no ’Rule’ applies.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FSCFG ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FSCFG- 1-


MOD FSCFG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify File Security Configuration

This Task modifies the ’File Security Configuration’, which defines


the possible ’Rule restrictions’ and the ’Default access’ rights
provided no ’Rule’ applies.

The ’Rule restriction’ cannot be changed if this would lead to


inconsistancies with existing ’Rules’.

At least one of the parameters ’Default access’ and ’Rule restriction’


has to be specified.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD FSCFG : [Default access=] [,Rule restriction=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Default access

This parameter specifies the ’Default access’ rights that are used for
file access check, if no File Security ’Rule’ applies.

Input format:
’Allow’ : Allows default access right for the file operation.

’Deny’ : Denies default access right for the file operation.

Select the ’Default access’ for the file operations:


’Read’, ’Write’, ’Create’, ’Delete’, ’Read attributes’

Rule restriction

This parameter can restrict the supported ’Rule type’ of the File
Security ’Rules’. Such a restriction may help to get a less complex File
Security system and therefore may help to avoid conflicting ’Rules’.

Prerequisite:
If the ’Rule restriction’ is set to ’Deny rules’ or ’Allow rules’ only,
then no File Security ’Rule’ of the other ’Rule type’ may exist.

Input format:
’Allow rules’: Only ’Rules’ of ’Rule type’ ’Deny’ are supported.

’Deny rules’ : Only ’Rules’ of ’Rule type’ ’Allow’ are supported.

’All rules’ : All ’Rule types’ are supported.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD FSCFG- 1-


CAN FSFGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel File Security File Group

This task cancels a File Security ’File group’, which defines a set of file
name patterns and the file operations on these file name patterns.

Prerequisite:
The ’File group’ is not canceled, if it is still referenced by a File
Security ’Rule’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN FSFGRP : File group= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

File group

This parameter specifies the name of the ’File group’.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

Dependencies:
The ’File group’ is not canceled, if it is referebced by a File
Security ’Rule’

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN FSFGRP- 1-


CR FSFGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create File Security File Group

This task creates a File Security ’File group’, which defines a set of file
name patterns and the file operations on these file name patterns.
A ’File group’ is referenced by one or more File Security ’Rules’ in order
to ’Allow’ or ’Deny’ access rights for the file operations on the file name
patterns.

The set of file name patterns is defined by the ’File list’.

The file operations are defined by the ’Operations list’.


Optionally to each of the file operations a ’Password’ can be entered.

The file names within the ’File list’ parameter can be fully qualified file
names or file name patterns defined by special characters.

Dependencies:
’Passwords’ are ignored at access checks if this ’File group’ is referenced
by a ’Deny’ ’Rule’.

Note:
- The response ’Operation not allowed or not possible’ can have one
of the following reasons:

- There are already too many ’File groups’ in the database.


- The maximum number of passwords (200) or file names (400)
is reached.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR FSFGRP : File group= ,File list= ,Operations list= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

File group

This parameter specifies the name of the ’File group’. This name is used
by a File Security ’Rule’ to reference the ’File group’.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

File list

This parameter specifies a list of file names and file name patterns on
which the file operations specified within ’Operations list’ will be
allowed or denied.
Selected elements of this list must not be suplied with an empty string.

Input format:
Set (1-20 elements) of file names.
One element consists of a choice:
’File on CP’: String (1-17 characters) for CP file names,
only capital letters, numbers and the special
characters "#", "%", "+", ".", "*"
and "?" are allowed.
’File on MP’: String (1-48 characters) for MP file names,
small and capital letters, numbers and the special
characters "#" "%" "+" "." "*" "!"
"$" "&" "(" ")" "," ":" "-" "/"
";" "<" ">" "=" "@" "[" "]" ""
"_" "{" "}" "?" "\" are allowed.

For files on MP the device must be specified either by the device


name or by a wildcard.

A file name pattern is defined as follows:


- "Partly qualified" file names are specified by a dot (".") at
the end of the name.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FSFGRP- 1+
CR FSFGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

A file name matches this file name pattern, if it contains this


"partly qualified" file name as a prefix including the dot.

- "Fully qualified" file names are given uniquely without any


wild cards.

- One or more question marks ("?") can be entered at any position


of the file name pattern.
A file name matches this file name pattern, if the file name and
the file name pattern are equal except the character positions
indicated by the question mark within the file name pattern.
One question mark substitutes exactly one character.

- One asterisk ("*") can be entered at any position of the file


name pattern.
A file name matches this file name pattern, if the part before the
asterisk is contained as a prefix and if the part after the asterisk
is contained as a suffix.
The asterisk substitutes none, one or more characters.

- A question mark can be used in combination with a "partly qualified"


file name and with an asterisk.

- An asterisk cannot be used in combination with a dot as the last


character of the file name pattern.

Examples for files on CP:


- "Partly qualified" file name "SY." matches to
"SY.TASKLIB", "SY.SEMILIB", etc.
"SYSTEM.FILE" does NOT match this pattern.

- The file name pattern "RG.F?.FILE" applies to


"RG.FC.FILE", "RG.FS.FILE", etc.

- The file name pattern "IA.IC*" applies to "IA.IC",


"IA.ICAMA", "IA.ICMAL", etc.

Examples for files on MP:


- The file name pattern "SYS:\ab*" applies to all files on the
system device beginning with the prefix "ab". A generation
beginning with this prefix also matches to this file name pattern.
(e.g. ab, ab0, abC, ... , \ab\systemcode, \abCd\systemfile, ... )

- The file name pattern "SYS:\\def*" applies to all files of the


actual generation on the system device, beginning with the
prefix "def".

- The file name pattern "MOD:\*" applies to all files on the


MOD device.

- The file name pattern "???:\ab*" applies to all files on any


device with 3 letters beginning with the prefix "ab".

Operations list

This parameter specifies a list of file operations that are defined for
this ’File group’.

The ’Rule’ that references this ’File group’ defines whether these file
operations are allowed or denied.

Optionally to each of this file operations a ’Password’ can be entered


for restricted file access.
The ’Password’ has to be entered twice for verification.
A ’Password’ must contain at least one alphabetic character, one
numerical
character and one special character.

Dependencies:
- Optionally entered ’Passwords’ are ignored at access checks if this
’File group’ is referenced by a ’Deny’ ’Rule’.

- For file access via FTP no password may be administrated.

Input format:
Set (1-5) of file operations
One file operation element consists of:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FSFGRP- 2+
CR FSFGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

’Operation’:
’Create’ : Create file operation
’Delete’ : Delete file operation
’Read’ : Read file operation
’Write’ : Write file operation
’Read attributes’: Read file attributes operation
’Password’:
String (3-40 characters)
’Verify password’:
String (3-40 characters)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FSFGRP- 3-
DISP FSFGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display File Security File Group

This task displays one or more File Security ’File groups’, which define a
set of file name patterns and the file operations on these file name patterns.

The following selections are possible:

- One single File Security ’File group’:


--> Enter the ’File group’

- All File Security ’File groups’:


--> Default: Enter no selection parameter

- Selection by filter criteria:


--> Enter ’Substring’ for ’File group’ name (match at any position).
--> Enter ’File entry’ for ’File list’ (’File name’ is in the list).
If more than one filter criteria are entered they must be all fulfilled.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FSFGRP : [File group=] [,Substring=] [,File location=] 1
1 1
1 [,File name=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

File group

This parameter selects one specific ’File group’ by its name.

Dependencies:
This parameter must not be entered, if all ’File groups’ shall be
selected or ’Substring’ or ’File entry’ is entered as filter parameter.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

Substring

This parameter defines a pattern for the ’File group’ name.


The ’File group’ name must contain this pattern at any position.

Dependencies:
This parameter must not be entered, if a ’File group’ is entered.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

File location

This parameter specifies where the file, specified in ’File name’,


is located.

Dependencies:
- This parameter must be entered together with the parameter ’File name’.

File name

This parameter specifies a file name which must be contained in the ’File
list’. It is only looked for exact matches of the given file name and
that
one in the ’File list’.

Dependencies:
- This parameter must be entered together with the parameter ’File
location’.
- It must not be entered, if a ’File group’ was entered.

Input format:
’File on CP’: String (1-17 characters) for CP file names

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FSFGRP- 1+


DISP FSFGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

’File on MP’: String (1-48 characters) for MP file names

For files on MP the device must be specified either by the device


name or by a wildcard.

A file name pattern is defined as follows:


- "Partly qualified" file names are specified by a dot (".") at
the end of the name.

- "Fully qualified" file names are given uniquely without any


wild cards.

- One or more question marks ("?") can be entered at any position


of the file name pattern.
A file name matches this file name pattern, if the file name and
the file name pattern are equal except the character positions
indicated by the question mark within the file name pattern.
One question mark substitutes exactly one character.

- One asterisk ("*") can be entered at any position of the file


name pattern.
A file name matches this file name pattern, if the part before the
asterisk is contained as a prefix and if the part after the asterisk
is contained as a suffix.
The asterisk substitutes none, one or more characters.

- A question mark can be used in combination with a "partly qualified"


file name and with an asterisk.

- An asterisk cannot be used in combination with a dot as the last


character of the file name pattern.

Examples for files on CP:


- "Partly qualified" file name "SY." matches to
"SY.TASKLIB", "SY.SEMILIB", etc.
"SYSTEM.FILE" does NOT match this pattern.

- The file name pattern "RG.F?.FILE" applies to


"RG.FC.FILE", "RG.FS.FILE", etc.

- The file name pattern "IA.IC*" applies to "IA.IC",


"IA.ICAMA", "IA.ICMAL", etc.

Examples for files on MP:


- The file name pattern "SYS:\ab*" applies to all files on the
system device beginning with the prefix "ab". A generation beginning
with this prefix also matches to this file name pattern.
(e.g. ab, ab0, abC, ... , \ab\systemcode,
\abCd\systemfile, ... )

- The file name pattern "SYS:\\def*" applies to all files of the


actual generation on the system device, beginning with the
prefix "def".

- The file name pattern "MOD:\*" applies to all files on the


MOD device.

- The file name pattern "???:\ab*" applies to all files on any device
with 3 letters beginning with the prefix "ab".

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FSFGRP- 2-


MOD FSFGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify File Security File Group

This task modifies a File Security ’File group’, which defines a set of file
name patterns and the file operations on these file name patterns.

’Passwords’ can be entered to an ’Operation’ or can be removed with an


’Operation’.
To remove an ’Operation’ with a ’Password’, the ’Password’ has to be
specified.
To change an existing ’Password’ without affecting the ’Operation’, the
task ’MOD FSFGRPPW’ has to be used.

Dependencies:
The parameters ’Add operations’ and ’Remove operations’ must not be
specified at the same time.

Note:
- The response ’Operation not allowed or not possible’ can have one
of the following reasons:

- There are already too many ’File groups’ in the database.


- The maximum number of passwords (200) or file names (400)
is reached.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD FSFGRP : File group= [,File list=] [,Remove operations=] 1
1 1
1 [,Add operations=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

File group

This parameter specifies the name of the ’File group’.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

File list

This parameter specifies a list of file names that will replace the
existing list of file names of the specified ’File group’.
Selected elements of this list must not be suplied with an empty string.

Input format:
Operation:
’REPLACE’: Replace ’File list’.
’ADD’ : Add file names in ’File list’ to the existing list.
’REMOVE’ : Remove file names in ’File list’ from the existing list.
’File list’ :
Set (1..20) of file names.
One list element consists of a choice:
’File on CP’: String (1-17 characters) for CP file names,
only capital letters, numbers and the special
characters "#", "%", "+", ".", "*"
and "?" are allowed.
’File on MP’: String (1-48 characters) for MP file names,
small and capital letters, numbers and the special
characters "#" "%" "+" "." "*" "!"
"$" "&" "(" ")" "," ":" "-" "/"
";" "<" ">" "=" "@" "[" "]" ""
"_" "{" "}" "?" "\" are allowed.

For files on MP the device must be specified either by the device


name or by a wildcard.

A file name pattern is defined as follows:


- "Partly qualified" file names are specified by a dot (".") at

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD FSFGRP- 1+


MOD FSFGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

the end of the name.


A file name matches this file name pattern, if it contains this
"partly qualified" file name as a prefix including the dot.

- "Fully qualified" file names are given uniquely without any


wild cards.

- One or more question marks ("?") can be entered at any position


of the file name pattern.
A file name matches this file name pattern, if the file name and
the file name pattern are equal except the character positions
indicated by the question mark within the file name pattern.
One question mark substitutes exactly one character.

- One asterisk ("*") can be entered at any position of the file


name pattern.
A file name matches this file name pattern, if the part before the
asterisk is contained as a prefix and if the part after the asterisk
is contained as a suffix.
The asterisk substitutes none, one or more characters.

- A question mark can be used in combination with a "partly qualified"


file name and with an asterisk.

- An asterisk cannot be used in combination with a dot as the last


character of the file name pattern.

Examples for files on CP:


- "Partly qualified" file name "SY." matches to
"SY.TASKLIB", "SY.SEMILIB", etc.
"SYSTEM.FILE" does NOT match this pattern.

- The file name pattern "RG.F?.FILE" applies to


"RG.FC.FILE", "RG.FS.FILE", etc.

- The file name pattern "IA.IC*" applies to "IA.IC",


"IA.ICAMA", "IA.ICMAL", etc.

Examples for files on MP:


- The file name pattern "SYS:\ab*" applies to all files on the
system device beginning with the prefix "ab". A generation
beginning with this prefix also matches to this file name pattern.
(e.g. ab, ab0, abC, ... , \ab\systemcode, \abCd\systemfile, ... )

- The file name pattern "SYS:\\def*" applies to all files of the


actual generation on the system device, beginning with the
prefix "def".

- The file name pattern "MOD:\*" applies to all files on the


MOD device.

- The file name pattern "???:\ab*" applies to all files on any


device with 3 letters beginning with the prefix "ab".

Remove operations

This parameter specifies a list of ’Operations’ that will be removed from


the existing ’Operations list’ of the specified ’File group’.

Optionally existing ’Passwords’ for the specified ’Operations’ must also


be specified.

Input format:
Set (1-5) of file operations
One file operation element consists of:
’Operation’:
’Create’ : Create file operation
’Delete’ : Delete file operation
’Read’ : Read file operation
’Write’ : Write file operation
’Read attributes’: Read file attributes operation
’Password’:
String (3-40 characters)

Add operations

This parameter specifies a list of ’Operations’ that will be added to

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD FSFGRP- 2+


MOD FSFGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

the existing ’Operations list’ the specified ’File group’.

Optionally a ’Password’ can be specified for each of the entered


’Operations’. The ’Password’ has to be entered twice for verification.
A ’Password’ must contain at least one alphabetic character, one
numerical
character and one special character.

Input format:
Set (1-5) of file operations
One file operation element consists of:
’Operation’:
’Create’ : Create file operation
’Delete’ : Delete file operation
’Read’ : Read file operation
’Write’ : Write file operation
’Read attributes’: Read file attributes operation
’Password’:
String (3-40 characters)
’Verify password’:
String (3-40 characters)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD FSFGRP- 3-


MOD FSFGRPPW

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify File Security File Group Password

This task modifies a ’Password’ of a File Security ’File group’, which


defines a set of file name patterns and the file operations on these file
name patterns.

If an existing ’Password’ is to be changed then this ’Old password’ has to


be specified.

If a ’New password’ is entered it has to be entered twice for verification.

Note:
- The response ’Operation not allowed or not possible’ can have the
following reasons:

- The maximum number of passwords (200) is reached.

- M-SET Error: Either the ’New Password’ is invalid or the ’Old Password’
is wrong or the ’Operation’ you specified is not in the ’Operations List’
of this ’File Group’.
If the passwords are correct, pleas check the ’Operations List’ of the
’File group’ with ’DISP FSFGRP’. If the ’Operation’ is not in the
’Operations List’, you can add it with ’MOD FSFGRP’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD FSFGRPPW : File group= ,Operation= [,Old password=] 1
1 1
1 [,New password=] [,Verify password=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

File group

This parameter specifies the name of the ’File group’.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

Operation

This parameter specifies the ’Operation’ for which the ’Password’ will
be changed.

Input format:
’Create’ : Create file operation
’Delete’ : Delete file operation
’Read’ : Read file operation
’Write’ : Write file operation
’Read attributes’: Read file attributes operation

Old password

This parameter specifies the ’Old password’ of the specified ’Operation’.

Input format:
String (3-40 characters)

New password

This parameter specifies the ’New password’ of the specified ’Operation’


to be set.
The ’Password’ must contain at least one alphabetic character, one
numerical character and one special character.

Dependencies:
If this parameter is specified ’Verify password’ must also be entered.

Input format:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD FSFGRPPW- 1+


MOD FSFGRPPW

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

String (3-40 characters)

Verify password

This parameter specifies the verification of the ’New password’.


The ’Passwords’ entered in ’New password’ and in ’Verify password’ must
be equal.

This parameter may only be specified, if ’New password’ is entered.

Input format:
String (3-40 characters)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD FSFGRPPW- 2-


RSET FSFGRPPW

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Reset File Security File Group Password

This task resets or cancels the ’Password’ of an ’Operation’ of a File


Security ’File group’.

If a ’New password’ is entered it has to be entered twice for verification.

Note:
- The response ’Operation not allowed or not possible’ can have the
following reasons:

- The maximum number of passwords (200) is reached.


- The given password is invalid.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 RSET FSFGRPPW : File group= ,Operation= [,New password=] 1
1 1
1 [,Verify password=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

File group

This parameter specifies the name of the ’File group’.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

Operation

This parameter specifies the ’Operation’ for which the ’Password’ will
be changed.

Input format:
’Create’ : Create file operation
’Delete’ : Delete file operation
’Read’ : Read file operation
’Write’ : Write file operation
’Read attributes’: Read file attributes operation

New password

This parameter specifies the ’New password’ of the specified ’Operation’


to be set.
The ’Password’ must contain at least one alphabetic character, one
numerical character and one special character.

If this parameter is not entered, the existing ’Password’ of the


’Operation’ will be canceled.

Dependencies:
If this parameter is specified ’Verify password’ must also be entered.

Input format:
String (3-40 characters): The ’Password’ will be reset.

Default: The ’Password’ will be canceled.

Verify password

This parameter specifies the verification to the ’New password’ of the


specified ’Operation’.

This parameter may only be specified, if ’New password’ is entered.

Input format:
String (3-40 characters)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RSET FSFGRPPW- 1+


RSET FSFGRPPW

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RSET FSFGRPPW- 2-


CAN FSINIGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel File Security Initiator Group

This task cancels a File Security ’Initiator group’, which defines a list of
’Initiators’.

Prerequisite:
The ’Initiator group’ is not canceled, if it is referenced by a File Security
’Rule’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN FSINIGRP : Initiator group= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Initiator group

This parameter specifies the name of the ’Initiator group’ to be


canceled.

Dependencies:
The ’Initiator group’ is not canceled, if it is referenced by a File
Security ’Rule’.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN FSINIGRP- 1-


CR FSINIGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create File Security Initiator Group

This task creates a File Security ’Initiator group’, which defines a


list of ’Initiators’.
A File Security ’Initiator group’ is referenced by one or more File Security
’Rules’ in order to ’Allow’ or ’Deny’ file access rights to file operations.

Note:
- The response ’Operation not allowed or not possible’ can have one
of the following reasons:

- There are already too many ’Initiator groups’ in the database.


- The maximum number of Initiators (200) is reached.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR FSINIGRP : Initiator group= ,Initiator list= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Initiator group

This parameter defines the name of the ’Initiator group’. This name is
used by a File Security ’Rule’ to reference the ’Initiator group’.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

Initiator list

This parameter defines a list of ’Initiators’ for this File Security


’Initiator group’. Each ’Initiator’ is represented by its name.
Selected elements of this list must not be suplied with an empty string.

Dependencies:
This task does not check if the ’Initiators’ exist within Authentication.

Input format:
Set (1..20) of ’Initiators’
One ’Initiator’ consists of a String (1-8 characters)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FSINIGRP- 1-
DISP FSINIGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display File Security Initiator Group

This task displays one or more File Security ’Initiator groups’, which
define a list of ’Initiators’.

The following selections are possible:

- One single File Security ’Initiator group’:


--> Enter the ’Initiator group’

- All File Security ’Initiator groups’:


--> Default: Enter no selection parameter

- Selection by filter criteria:


--> Enter ’Substring’ for ’Initiator group’ name (match at any position)
--> Enter ’Initiator entry’ for ’Initiator list’ (’Initiator’ is in the list)
If both criteria are entered they must be both fulfilled.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FSINIGRP : [Initiator group=] [,Substring=] [,Initiator entry=] ;1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Initiator group

This parameter selects one specific ’Initiator group’ by its name.

Dependencies:
This parameter must not be entered, if all ’Initiator groups’ shall
be selected or ’Substring’ or ’Initiator entry’ is entered as filter
parameter.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

Substring

This parameter defines a pattern for the ’Initiator group’ name.


The ’Initiator group’ name must contain this pattern at any position.

Dependencies:
This parameter must not be entered, if an ’Initiator group’ is entered.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

Initiator entry

This parameter specifies an ’Initiator’ which must be contained in the


’Initiator list’.

Dependencies:
- This parameter must not be entered, if an ’Initiator group’ was
entered.
- If this parameter is entered together with ’Substring’ then all
’Initiator groups’ will be displayed that reference the given
’Initiator’.
- If the given ’Initiator’ is an element of a ’Initiators list’ of some
’Initiator group’, these ’Initiator group’ will be displayed.

Input format:
String (1-8 characters)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FSINIGRP- 1-


MOD FSINIGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify File Security Initiator Group

This task modifies a File Security ’Initiator group’, which defines a list
of ’Initiators’ that have the same File Security access rights.
The ’Initiator list’ of the ’Initiator group’ can be replaced or
’Initiators’ may be added to or removed from the list.

Note:
- The response ’Operation not allowed or not possible’ can have one
of the following reasons:

- There are already too many ’Initiator groups’ in the database.


- The maximum number of Initiators (200) is reached.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD FSINIGRP : Initiator group= ,Initiator list= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Initiator group

This parameter specifes the name of the File Security ’Initiator group’.
This name is used by a File Security ’Rule’ to reference the
’Initiator group’.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

Initiator list

This parameter specifies a list of ’Initiators’ that will replace, or


will be added to or removed from the existing ’Initiator list’.
Selected elements of this list must not be suplied with an empty string.

Dependencies:
The ’Initiators’ must have been created using the Authentication
function.
This task does not check if the ’Initiators’ exist within Authentication.

Input format:
Operation
’REPLACE’: Replace ’Initiator list’.
’ADD’ : Add ’Initiators’ of ’Initiator list’ to the
existing list.
’REMOVE’ : Remove ’Initiators’ in ’Initiator list’ from the
existing list.

’Initiator list’
Set (1..20) of ’Initiators’
One ’Initiator’ consists of a String
(1-8 characters)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD FSINIGRP- 1-


CAN FSRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel File Security Rule

This task cancels a File Security ’Rule’, which defines the access
rights of a File Security ’Initiator group’ on a File Security
’File group’ for the file operations defined by ’File group’.

Depending on the ’Rule type’ the cancel operation can remove existing
access rights (’Rule type’ = ’Allow’) or grant new access rights
(’Rule type’ = ’Deny’).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN FSRULE : Rule= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Rule

This parameter specifies the name of the File Security


’Rule’.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN FSRULE- 1-


CR FSRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create File Security Rule

This task creates a ’Rule’ which defines the access rights of a File
Security ’Initiator group’ on files specified within a File Security
’File group’.

An ’Allow’ ’Rule’ (’Rule type’ = ’Allow’) allows the file access, as


long as no matching ’Deny’ ’Rule’ exists. A ’Deny’ ’Rule’ rejects the
file access (’Rule type’ = ’Deny’).

’Rules’ with an empty ’Initiator group’ parameter are ’Common rules’ and
apply to all File Security ’Initiators’.
’Rules’ with an empty ’File group’ parameter are ’Global rules’ and apply
to all files.
’Rules’ with both the ’Initiator group’ and the ’File group’ parameter
supplied apply only to the File Security ’Initiators’ listed in the
referenced ’Initiator group’ and only on the files listed in the
referenced ’File groups’.

Optional time dependencies may be defined by scheduling parameters.


The validity of the ’Rule’ can be restricted by:
- duration: a ’Start time’ and ’Stop time’ and/or
- daily scheduling: time intervals for all days (of the week) or
- weekly scheduling: time intervals per individual days of the week.
- Stop time: if ’Start time’ is given, ’Stop time’ is optional.

Prerequisite:
- The referenced File Security ’Initiator group’ and File Security
’File group’ must exist.

- The supported ’Rule restriction’ can have been restricted by the task
’MOD FSCFG’. In this case only ’Allow’ ’Rules’ or only ’Deny’ ’Rules’
can be created.
The administrated restrictions can be displayed using the task
’DISP FSCFG’.

Note:
- The parameters for daily scheduling and weekly scheduling exclude
each other.

- The scheduling parameters must be selected when the ’Rule’ is created.


It is not possible to add scheduling parameters by ’MOD FSRULE’.

- The response ’Operation not allowed or not possible’ can have one
of the following reasons:

- There are already too many Rules in the database.


- Some internal resources exceed their limits

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR FSRULE : Rule= ,Rule type= [,Initiator group list=] 1
1 1
1 [,File group list=] [,Start time=] [,Stop time=] 1
1 1
1 [,Daily intervals=] [,Weekly intervals=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Rule

This parameter specifies the name of the File Security ’Rule’.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

Rule type

This parameter specifies the desired action performed if the ’Rule’

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FSRULE- 1+
CR FSRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

applies to a file access check.


The supported values can be restricted by ’MOD FSCFG’.

Input format:
’Allow’ : Allow file access (if no other matching ’Deny’ ’Rule’
exists).
’Deny’ : Deny file access.

Default value : ’Deny’

Initiator group list

This parameter specifies a reference to a list of File Security


’Initiator groups’. The ’Rule’ applies to all ’Initiators’ in this
groups.
If no ’Initiator group’ is entered, a ’Common rule’ is generated,
which is valid for all ’Initiators’.

Prerequisite:
The referenced ’Initiator group(s)’ must have been created by ’CR
FSINIGRP’.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters) : Reference to an ’Initiator group’

no entry : ’Common rule’

Default value : "" (empty string) : ’Common rule’

File group list

This parameter specifies a reference to a list of File Security


’File groups’, which define the ’File lists’ and the File Security
’Operations’ for this ’Rule’.
If no ’File group’ is entered, a ’Global rule’ is generated, which
is valid to all files and all ’Operations’ within the system for
the referenced ’Initiator group’.

Prerequisite:
The referenced ’File group(s)’ must have been created by ’CR FSFGRP’.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters) : Reference to a ’File group’

no entry : ’Common rule’

Default value : "" (empty string) : ’Global rule’

Start time

This parameter defines the ’Start time’ at which the ’Rule’ becomes
active.
If only the ’Start time’ is set the ’Stop time’ will be set
automatically to ’Continuous’.
The time value is rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.

Input format:
standard date and time values.

Default value:
Actual system time.
Will be set if this parameter is omitted but ’Stop time’ is set.

Stop time

This parameter defines the ’Stop time’ at which the ’Rule’ becomes
inactive.
If only the ’Stop time’ is set the ’Start time’ will be set automatically
to the actual system time of the system.

Input format:
option ’Continuous’
option ’Specific’ : standard date and time values

Default value:
option ’Continuous’
Will be set if this parameter is omitted but ’Start time’ is set.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FSRULE- 2+
CR FSRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Daily intervals

This parameter defines ’Daily Intervals’ (up to 6), within which the
’Rule’ is active.
If this parameter is entered, the parameter for ’weekly intervals’ must
not be entered.
The time values are rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.
Overlapping intervals are combined to one interval.

Input format:
hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval)
hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day.

Default:
00:00-00:00 (whole day)

Weekly intervals

This parameter defines ’weekly intervals’ within which the ’Rule’ is


active. Up to 6 time intervals can be defined for each day of the week.
The ’Rule’ will be inactive on days of the week not selected and on
days with no intervals set.
At least one day with one interval must be specified.
If this parameter is entered, the parameter for ’Daily intervals’ must
not be entered.
The time values are rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.
Overlapping intervals are combined to one interval.

Input format:
hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval)
hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day.

Default:
Selects all days of the week without any time restriction.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FSRULE- 3-
DISP FSRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display File Security Rule

This task displays one or more File Security ’Rules’, which define the
access rights of a File Security ’Initiator group’ on files specified
within a File Security ’File group’.

The following selections are possible:

- One single File Security ’Rule’:


--> Enter ’Rule’

- All File Security ’Rules’:


--> Default: Enter no selection parameter

- Selection by filter criteria:


--> Enter ’Substring’ for ’Rule’ name (match at any position).
--> Enter ’Rule type’ (equality)
--> Enter ’Initiator group’ (equality)
--> Enter ’File group’ (equality)
All entered criteria must be fulfilled for the ’Rules’ displayed.

Different output formats are supported for the display of a single


File Security ’Rule’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FSRULE : [Rule=] ,Output format= [,Substring=] [,Rule type=] 1
1 1
1 [,Initiator group=] [,File group=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Rule

This parameter selects one specific File Security ’Rule’.

Dependencies:
This parameter must not be entered, if all File Security ’Rules’ shall
be selected or one of the following filter parameters is entered.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

Output format

This parameter defines the ’Output format’ of the displayed File Security
’Rules’. Format ’Compact’ must be used, if parameter ’Rule’ is not
given.

Input format:
’Compact’ displays File Security ’Rule’ parameters without
scheduling parameters.
’Complete’ displays all File Security ’Rule’ parameters.
’Expanded’ displays all File Security ’Rule’ parameters including
the referenced File Security ’Initiator group’ and
File Security ’File group’.

Default:
’Compact’

Substring

This parameter defines a pattern for the ’Rule’ name.


The ’Rule’ name must contain this pattern at any position.

Dependencies:
This parameter must not be entered, if ’Rule’ was specified.

Input format:
String (1-12) characters

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FSRULE- 1+


DISP FSRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Rule type

This parameter selects the ’Rule type’ of the ’Rules’ to display.

Dependencies:
This parameter must not be entered, if ’Rule’ was specified.

Input format:
’Allow’ Select ’Allow’ ’Rules’.
’Deny’ Select ’Deny’ ’Rules’.

Initiator group

This parameter selects the referenced ’Initiator group’ of the ’Rules’


to display.

Dependencies:
This parameter cannot be entered at the same time with the ’Rule’
parameter.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters) for ’Initiator group’ name.
"" (empty string) selects ’Common rules’ (with no
’Initiator group’).

File group

This parameter selects the referenced ’File group’ of the ’Rules’


to display.

Dependencies:
This parameter cannot be entered at the same time with the ’Rule’
parameter.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters) for ’File group’ name.
"" (empty string) selects ’Global rules’ (with no
’File group’).

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FSRULE- 2-


MOD FSRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify File Security Rule

This task modifies a File Security ’Rule’, which defines the access
rights of a File Security ’Initiator group’ on files specified within
a File Security ’File group’.

Depending on the parameters specified, the ’Rule type’, the referenced


’File group’ or ’Initiator group’ is changed.

Scheduling parameters can be modified as follows:

- Duration: replace ’Start time’ and/or ’Stop time’.


- Daily scheduling: replace ’Daily intervals’.
- Weekly scheduling: replace time intervals of single days of the week.

Note:
- It is not possible to change a ’Common rule’ (no ’Initiator group’) to
a non ’Common rule’ and vice versa.
It is only possible to replace an existing reference to an ’Initiator group’.

- It is not possible to change a ’Global rule’ (no ’File group’) to a non


’Global rule’ and vice versa.
It is only possible to replace an existing reference to a ’File group’.

- Only scheduling parameters specified by CR FSRULE can be modified.

- The response ’Operation not allowed or not possible’ can have one
of the following reasons:

- There are already too many Rules in the database.


- Some internal resources exceed their limits

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD FSRULE : Rule= [,Initiator group list=] [,File group list=] 1
1 1
1 [,Start time=] [,Stop time=] [,Daily intervals=] 1
1 1
1 [,Weekly intervals=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Rule

This parameter specifies the name of the ’Rule’.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

Initiator group list

This parameter specifies a list of File Security ’Initiator groups’


that replace the existing reference.

Note:
It is not possible to set a reference to an
’Initiator group’ for a ’Common rule’ (no
’Initiator group’), or to remove the reference to an
’Initiator group’.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

File group list

This parameter specifies a list of File Security ’File groups’


that replace the existing reference.

Note:
It is not possible to set a reference to a ’File group’ for a ’Global

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD FSRULE- 1+


MOD FSRULE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

rule’ (no ’File group’), or to remove the reference to a ’File group’.

Input format:
String (1-12 characters)

Start time

This parameter replaces the ’Start time’ at which the ’Rule’ becomes
active.
The parameter can be replaced only if a ’Start time’ or ’Stop time’
was specified, when the ’Rule’ was created.

Input format:
Standard date and time values.

Stop time

This parameter replaces the ’Stop time’ at which the ’Rule’ becomes
inactive.
The parameter can be replaced only, if a ’Start time’ or ’Stop time’
was specified, when the ’Rule’ was created.

Input format:
option ’Continuous’
option ’Specific’ : standard date and time values

Default value:
option ’Continuous’
Will be set if this parameter is omitted but ’Start time’ is set.

Daily intervals

This parameter replaces the ’Daily intervals’ (up to 6) within which


the ’Rule’ is active.
The parameter can be entered only if ’Daily intervals’ were specified,
when the ’Rule’ was created.
The time values are rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes. Overlapping
intervals are combined to one interval.

Input format:
hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval)
hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

Weekly intervals

This parameter replaces the ’Weekly intervals’ within


which the ’Rule’ is active.
Only days of the week selected in the parameter are
replaced.
The intervals of the days not selected will not be changed.
Enter 0 intervals to disable the whole day.
At least one day with one interval must be active in the
resultant ’Weekly intervals’; otherwise the parameter is
rejected.

Input format:
hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval for one day)
hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD FSRULE- 2-


TEST FSYS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Test Free Input of FSYS OT Commands

This task allows a free input of any FSYS Online Tool Command.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 TEST FSYS : Command= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Command

FSYS Online Tool Command.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST FSYS- 1-


CAN FTINI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel File Transfer Initiator

This task releases an File transfer initiator.


The required input parameters for an unique ’Initiator’ selection are:
1) ’User identity’ and
2) ’Password type’

Note:
’Cancel File Transfer Initiator’ removes the specified ’File transfer initiator’
from the authentication database and does not cancel active file transfers.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN FTINI : User identity= ,Password type= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

User identity

This mandatory parameter specifies the unique UserId of an


remote ’File transfer initiator’.

Input format: String (1-8 characters).

Password type

This mandatory parameter defines the type of password


mechanism. It specifies if the initiator should be
authenicated by a simple or by a replay-protected
password.

Input values:

’Replay protected PW’ : Initiator with a replay


protected password
’Simple PW’ : Initiator with a simple
password

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN FTINI- 1-


CR FTINI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create File Transfer Initiator

This task creates a ’FT-Initiator (File transfer initiator)’ at the


Authentication function with the specified password type.
Possible password types are the "Simple PW" and the "Replay protected PW"
for simple or replay-protected user authentication.

Each ’FT-Initiator’ must be specified by its ’User identity’. The system access
can
be restricted to specified FT-Applications (e.g. "ftp") via selection of parameter
’File transfer type’.

Further it is possible to define time dependencies and restrict the system access
of
each ’FT-Initiator’ by following scheduling parameters:
- duration: defines a ’Start Time’ and ’Stop Time’ and/or
- daily scheduling: time intervals for all days of the week or
- weekly scheduling: time intervals per individual days of the week.

The parameter ’Availability status’ indicates if a ’FT-Initiator’ with scheduling


parameters is available (’On’) or not (’Off’). The output "-" indicates that no
scheduling parameter was entered.

Note:
- The parameters for daily scheduling and weekly scheduling exclude one another.
- The scheduling paramters must be selected when the initiator is created. If not,
then it is not possible to add scheduling parameters later by ’MOD INI’.

If no scheduling parameters created then the ’FT-Initiator’ is permanent valid


and can get system access every time.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR FTINI : User identity= ,Password type= ,Password= 1
1 1
1 ,Verify password= [,ftType=] [,Accept time range=] 1
1 1
1 [,Start time=] [,Stop time=] [,Daily intervals=] 1
1 1
1 [,Weekly intervals=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

User identity

This mandatory parameter specifies the unique UserId of an


remote ’File transfer initiator’.

Input format: String (1-8 characters).

Password type

This mandatory parameter defines the type of password


mechanism. It specifies if the ’Initiator’ should
be identified without a password or if it should be
authenticated by a simple or by a replay-protected
password.

Input values:

’Replay protected PW’ : Initiator with a replay


protected password
’Simple PW’ : Initiator with a simple
password

Password

This parameter specifies the password.

Prerequisites:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FTINI- 1+
CR FTINI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The password should contain at least a letter, a digit


and a special character and the password length should
be between 4 (minimum) and 24 (maximum) characters.

Input format: String (4-24 characters).

Verify password

Please enter password string again.

Input format: String (4-24 characters).

ftType

This parameter defines a specific type of File transfer


application where the system access can be restricted to.
If no value is specified, access to all File transfer
types allowed.

Input values:

’All’ : no restrictions,
’FTP’ : access only for FTP-Applications,
’FTAM’ : access only for FTAM-Applications,
’FTNEA’ : access only for FTNEA-Applications.

Accept time range

This parameter is only used for ’Initiators’ with


’Password type’ "Replay protected PW" to specify
the ’accept time range’.
This means the maximum time interval between generating
the authentication value at the ’Initiator’ and receiving
it at the responder.
If the parameter is not specified for an "replay
protected PW" Initiator then the default value of
5 minutes will be used.

Input format: hh:mm:ss (String )


hh hour (00..23),
mm minute (00..59),
ss second (00..59).

Start time

This parameter defines the ’Start time’ at which the


’Initiator’ gets system access.
If only the ’Start time’ is set the ’Stop time’ will be
set automatically to ’Continuous’.
The time value is rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.

Input format: standard date and time values.

Default value: actual system time


will be set if this parameter is omitted
but ’Stop time’ is set.

Stop time

This parameter defines the ’Stop time’ at which the


’Initiator’ loses system access.
If only the ’Stop time’ is set the ’Start time’ will be
set automatically to the actual system time of the switch.

Input format: option ’Continuous’


option ’Specific’ : standard date and
time values
Default value: option ’Continuous’
will be set if this parameter is omitted
but ’Start time’ is set.

Daily intervals

This parameter selects daily scheduling. Up to 6 time


intervals can be specified within the ’Initiator’ gets
system access.
If this parameter is entered the parameter for weekly

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FTINI- 2+
CR FTINI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

scheduling must not be entered.


The time values are rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.
Overlapping intervals are combined to one interval.

Input format : hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

Default: whole day.

Weekly intervals

This parameter selects weekly scheduling. Up to 6 time


intervals can be defined for each day of the week.
The system access will be denied on days of the week not
selected and on days with 0 intervals set. At least one
day with one interval must be selected.
If this parameter is entered the parameter for daily
scheduling must not be entered.
The time values are rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.
Overlapping intervals are combined to one interval.

Input format: hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval for one day)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

Default: selects all days of the week without any time


restriction. Inactive days must be disabled from
the default value.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FTINI- 3-
DISP FTINI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display File Transfer Initiator

DISP FTINI is used to display the authentication parameters of one or more


’File transfer initiators’.
The following selection is possible:

- Output of one ’Initiator’:


--> Please enter 1) ’User identity’
and 2) ’Password type’.

- Output of all ’Initiators’:


--> No input necessarry.

- Individual selections:
--> You can do selection by
1) ’User identity’ or by ’User substring’
and/or
2) ’Password type’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP FTINI : [User identity=] [,User substring=] [,Password type=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

User identity

This parameter specifies the unique UserId of an remote


File transfer Initiator.
This parameter must not be entered, if ’User substring’
is specified.

Input format: String (1-8 characters)

User substring

This parameter specifies a pattern (substring) for the


’User identity’. Only ’Initiators’ which name contains
this substring at any position will be displayed.

This parameter must not be entered, if ’User identity’


is specified.

Input format: String (1-8 characters)

Password type

This parameter selects ’Initiators’ by a specific


’password type’.
If the parameter is not specified then all ’File
transfer initiators’ will be selected, otherwise only
the Initiators with the specified Password Type will
be displayed.

Input values:

’Replay protected PW’ : FT-Initiators with a replay


protected Password
’Simple PW’ : FT-Initiators with a simple
password.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FTINI- 1-


MOD FTINI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify File Transfer Initiator

This task modifies the authentication parameters of an existing ’File transfer


initiator’.

The following parameters are used for an unique ’Initiator’ selection and
can not be changed:
1) ’User indentity’ and
2) ’Password type’.

Following parameters are changeable:


- ’Password’,
- ’File transfer type’.
- ’Accept time range’
- ’Scheduling Data’

Note: A creation of new scheduling parameters is not possible. Only


scheduling paramters selected when the initiator was created can
be modified in following way:
- duration: replace ’Start Time’ and/or ’Stop Time’,
- daily scheduling: replace daily time intervals,
- weekly scheduling: replace time intervals of single days of the week.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD FTINI : User identity= ,Password type= [,Password=] 1
1 1
1 [,Verify password=] [,Ft type=] [,Accept time range=] 1
1 1
1 [,Start time=] [,Stop time=] [,Daily intervals=] 1
1 1
1 [,Weekly intervals=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

User identity

This mandatory parameter specifies the unique UserId of an


remote ’File transfer initiator’.

Input format: String (1-8 characters).

Password type

This mandatory parameter is used for an unique ’Initiator’


selection and specifies the type of password mechanism.

Input values:

’Replay protected PW’ : Initiator with a replay


protected password
’Simple PW’ : Initiator with a simple
password

Password

This parameter defines the new password value.

Prerequisites:

The password should contain at least a letter, a digit


and a special character and the password length should
be between 4 (minimum) and 24 (maximum) characters.

Input format: String (4-24 characters).

Verify password

Please enter new password string again.

Input format: String (4-24 characters).

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD FTINI- 1+


MOD FTINI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Ft type

This parameter defines a specific type of File transfer


application where the system access can be restricted to.

Input values:

’all’ : no restrictions,
’ftp’ : access only for FTP-Applications,
’ftam’ : access only for FTAM-Applications,
’ftnea’ : access only for FTNEA-Applications.

Accept time range

This parameter is only used for ’Initiators’ with


’Password type’ "Replay protected PW" to specify
the ’accept time range’.
This means the maximum time interval between generating
the authentication value at the ’Initiator’ and receiving
it at the responder.

Input format: hh:mm:ss (String )


hh hour (00..23),
mm minute (00..59),
ss second (00..59).

Start time

This parameter replaces the ’Start time’ at which the


’Initiator’ gets system access.
The parameter can be replaced only if a ’Start time’ or
’Stop time’ was entered, when the ’Initiator’ was created.

Input format: standard date and time values.

Stop time

This parameter replaces the ’Stop time’ at which the


’Initiator’ loses system access.
The parameter can be replaced only, if a ’Start time’ or
’Stop time’ was entered, when the ’Initiator’ was created.

Input format: option ’Continuous’


option ’Specific’ : standard date and
time values

Default value: option ’Continuous’

Daily intervals

This parameter replaces the ’Daily intervals’ (up to 6)


within the ’Initiator’ gets system access.
The parameter can be entered only, if ’Daily intervals’
were entered when the ’Initiator’ was created.
The time values are rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.
Overlapping intervals are combined to one interval.

Input format : hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

Weekly intervals

This parameter replaces the ’Weekly intervals’ within


the ’Initiator’ gets system access.
Only days of the week selected in the parameter are
replaced. The intervals of the days not selected will
not be changed.
Enter 0 intervals to disable the whole day. At least
one day with one interval must be active in the resultant
’Weekly intervals’; otherwise the parameter is rejected.

Input format : hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval for one day)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD FTINI- 2+


MOD FTINI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD FTINI- 3-


CAN FUOMT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL FUNCTIONAL O&M TERMINAL

This command cancels functional O&M terminals.

Prerequisites:
- the functional O&M terminal must exist.
- the functional O&M terminal must not be assigned to any device group.
- the functional O&M terminal must not be assigned as the output device
of the deactivated output suppression.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN FUOMT : FUOMT= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FUOMT FUNCTIONAL O&M TERMINAL

This parameter specifies a functional O&M terminal.

Notes:
- a maximum of five parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN FUOMT- 1-


CR FUOMT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE FUNCTIONAL O&M TERMINAL

This command creates functional O&M terminals to which a physical O&M


terminal is assigned at the same time; there is the option of assigning
a second O&M terminal as an alternative device.

Prerequisite:
- the functional device may not already exist.
- a physical device must exist.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR FUOMT : FUOMT= ,OMT= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FUOMT FUNCTIONAL O&M TERMINAL

This parameter specifies a functional O&M terminal.

Notes:
- a maximum of five parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OMT O&M TERMINAL

This parameter designates a real device or a real device and an


alternate device.

Notes:
- the primary device must not be an alternative device.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: PRIMARY OMT=
1...4 characters from the
symbolic name character set

b: ALTERNATIVE OMT=
1...4 characters from the
symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR FUOMT- 1-
SEL FUOMT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SELECT FUNCTIONAL O&M TERMINALS

This command selects a table of functional O&M terminals.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 SEL FUOMT : OMT= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OMT O&M TERMINAL

This parameter specifies a real (physical) terminal or a real


terminal and an alternative terminal.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: PRIMARY OMT=
1...4 characters from the
symbolic name character set

If parameter value a is specified, all


O&M terminals are displayed for which the
specified terminal is entered as first or
second O&M terminal.

b: ALTERNATIVE OMT=
1...4 characters from the
symbolic name character set

If parameter values a and b are specified,


the O&M terminals are displayed which are
assigned to the terminal stated in the
first information unit as first terminal
and to the terminal stated in the second
information unit as alternative terminal.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SEL FUOMT- 1-


DISP FUOMTLNK

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY FUNCTIONAL O&M TERMINAL LINKS

This command displays a table of functional O&M terminals and their


assignment to physical terminals. A selection of functional terminals or
all functional terminals can be output.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP FUOMTLNK : FUOMT= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FUOMT FUNCTIONAL O&M TERMINAL

This parameter specifies a functional O&M terminal.

Notes:
- a maximum of five parameter values can be linked with &.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP FUOMTLNK- 1-


MOD FUOMTLNK

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY FUNCTIONAL O&M TERMINAL LINKS

This command modifies the assignment of physical O&M terminals to


functional O&M terminals. It can be executed for two or more functional
terminals provided that they are assigned the same combination of real
devices.

Prerequisite:
- the functional O&M terminals must exist.
- the physical terminals must exist.
- the specified original combination of physical O&M terminals must be
assigned to the functional O&M terminal.
- the combination of O&M terminals resulting from the modification may not
be identical with the existing one.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD FUOMTLNK : FUOMT= ,OMT= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FUOMT FUNCTIONAL O&M TERMINAL

This parameter specifies a functional O&M terminal.

Note:
- a maximum of five parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OMT O&M TERMINAL

This parameter designates a real device or a real device and an


alternate device.

Note:
- the primary device must not be an alternate device.

n/o
n/
/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

a[-b]

a: PRIMARY OMT=
1...4 characters from the
symbolic name character set

b: ALTERNATIVE OMT=
1...4 characters from the
symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD FUOMTLNK- 1-


CAN GCSERV

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL GENERAL CALL SERVICES

This command cancel general call services.

Notes:
- Deactivation of a general call service:

CLIP : result of withdrawal


CLIR : result of withdrawal
COLP : result of withdrawal
COLR : result of withdrawal
CT : result of withdrawal
AOCCHRG : result of withdrawal
AOCINFO : result of withdrawal
HOTBILL : result of withdrawal
CALLHOLD : result of withdrawal
CALLWAIT : result of withdrawal or
separated per command or
per subscriber controlled procedure
MPTY : result of withdrawal
NATCCBS : result of withdrawal
USERSIG1 : result of withdrawal
NATSS01 : result of withdrawal
NATSS02 : result of withdrawal
NATSS03 : result of withdrawal
NATSS04 : result of withdrawal
NATSS05 : result of withdrawal
NATSS06 : result of withdrawal
NATSS07 : result of withdrawal
NATSS08 : result of withdrawal
NATSS09 : result of withdrawal
NATSS10 : result of withdrawal
NATSS11 : result of withdrawal
NATSS12 : result of withdrawal
NATSS13 : result of withdrawal
NATSS14 : result of withdrawal
NATSS15 : result of withdrawal
FOLLOWME : result of withdrawal
FMSPV : result of withdrawal
FROUT : result of withdrawal
EMLPP : result of withdrawal
CCBSA : result of withdrawal
CCBSB : result of withdrawal
UNIVERS : result of withdrawal
CREL : result of withdrawal
CUNREL : result of withdrawal
PLMNOPR : result of withdrawal
BSLC : result of withdrawal
ASLC : result of withdrawal

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

This input format cancel general call services for GSM

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN GCSERV : MSIN= ,GCSERV= [,FILTER=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN GCSERV- 1+


CAN GCSERV

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...12 digit decimal number

GCSERV GENERAL CALL SERVICE

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c]]

a: GENERAL CALL SERVICE


AOCCHRG ADVICE OF CHARGE: CHARGING
AOCINFO ADVICE OF CHARGE: INFORMATION
ASLC AUTONOMOUS SELF LOCATION
BSLC BASIC SELF LOCATION
CALLHOLD CALL HOLD
CALLWAIT CALL WAIT
CCBSA CALL COMPL. TO BUSY SUBSCR. A
CCBSB CALL COMPL. TO BUSY SUBSCR. B
CLIP CALLING LINE ID. PRESENTATION
CLIR CALLING LINE ID. RESTRICTION
COLP CONNECTED L. ID. PRESENTATION
COLR CONNECTED LINE ID. RESTRICTION
CREL CALL RELATED CLASS
CT CALL TRANSFER
CUNREL CALL UNRELATED CLASS
EMLPP ENH MULT LEV PREC AND PRE-EMPT
FMSPV FOLLOW ME SUPERVISOR
If FOLLOWME shall be restored, at first the
service FMSPV has to be cancelled and then service
FOLLOWME has to be entered again.
FOLLOWME FOLLOW ME
FROUT FORCED ROUTING
HOTBILL HOT BILLING
MPTY MULTI PARTY
NATCCBS CALL COMPL. TO BUSY SUBSCR.
NATSS01 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 01
NATSS02 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 02
NATSS03 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 03
NATSS04 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 04
NATSS05 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 05
NATSS06 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 06
NATSS07 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 07
NATSS08 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 08
NATSS09 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 09
NATSS10 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 10
NATSS11 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 11
NATSS12 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 12
NATSS13 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 13
NATSS14 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 14
NATSS15 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 15
PLMNOPR PLMN OPERATOR CLASS
UNIVERS UNIVERSAL CLASS
USERSIG1 USER TO USER SIGN. SERV. 1

This parameter unit specifies a general call service.

b: STATUS
ACT ACTIVATION
PROV PROVISION

This parameter unit specifies if withdrawal or deactivation or


deregistration for the general call service is requested.

Compatibilities:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN GCSERV- 2+


CAN GCSERV

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- a=CALLWAIT (Only PROV or ACT are allowed).

Default: PROV

c: BASIC SERVICE GROUP CODE


ALLBS ALL BEARER SERVICES
ALLBSV ALL BASIC SERVICES
ALLTS ALL TELESERVICES
BS20 DATA CIRCUIT DUPLEX ASYN SERV
BS30 DATA CIRCUIT SYN. SERVICES
BS40 PAD ACCESS SERVICES
TELEPHON TELEPHONY
TS20 SHORT MESSAGE SERVICES
TS60 FACSIMILE SERVICES

This parameter unit specifies if a basic service group for the


general call service is requested.

Compatibilities:
- STATUS=ACT

Incompatibilities:
- STATUS=PROV

Default: ALLBSV

FILTER FILTER NAME

This parameter defines the name of the filter, which is used for
modifying only those mobile subscribers that match predefined filter
criteria.

Notes:
- This parameter must not be used in single command mode. It may be
used only in group command mode.

Prerequisites:
- The filter must have been created (CR FILTER).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN GCSERV- 3-


ENTR GCSERV

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER GENERAL CALL SERVICES

This command provides/activates general call services.

Notes:
- Activation of a general call service:

CLIP : result of provision


CLIR : result of provision
COLP : result of provision
COLR : result of provision
CT : result of provision
AOCCHRG : result of provision
AOCINFO : result of provision
HOTBILL : result of provision
CALLHOLD : result of provision
CALLWAIT : result of provision or
separated per command or
per subscriber controlled procedure
MPTY : result of provision
NATCCBS : result of provision
USERSIG1 : result of provision
NATSS01 : result of provision
NATSS02 : result of provision
NATSS03 : result of provision
NATSS04 : result of provision
NATSS05 : result of provision
NATSS06 : result of provision
NATSS07 : result of provision
NATSS08 : result of provision
NATSS09 : result of provision
NATSS10 : result of provision
NATSS11 : result of provision
NATSS12 : result of provision
NATSS13 : result of provision
NATSS14 : result of provision
NATSS15 : result of provision
FOLLOWME : result of provision
FROUT : result of provision
EMLPP : result of provision
CCBSA : result of provision
CCBSB : result of provision
FMSPV : result of provision
UNIVERS : result of provision
CREL : result of provision
CUNREL : result of provision
PLMNOPR : result of provision
BSLC : result of provision
ASLC : result of provision

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

This input format enters general call services for GSM.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR GCSERV : MSIN= ,GCSERV= [,CLIPOVR=] [,COLPOVR=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,CLIRPRES=] [,PRIO=] [,LCS=] [,FILTER=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR GCSERV- 1+


ENTR GCSERV

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...12 digit decimal number

GCSERV GENERAL CALL SERVICE

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c]]

a: GENERAL CALL SERVICE


AOCCHRG ADVICE OF CHARGE: CHARGING
AOCINFO ADVICE OF CHARGE: INFORMATION
ASLC AUTONOMOUS SELF LOCATION
This parameter value allows the subscriber
to retrieve its own location without interaction
with the PLMN for a predetermined period of time.
BSLC BASIC SELF LOCATION
This parameter value allows the subscriber
to retrieve its own location.
CALLHOLD CALL HOLD
CALLWAIT CALL WAIT
CCBSA CALL COMPL. TO BUSY SUBSCR. A
CCBSB CALL COMPL. TO BUSY SUBSCR. B
CLIP CALLING LINE ID. PRESENTATION
Notes:
- If this value is newly entered for this
subscriber and no CLIPOVR is given,
the initial value of CLIPOVR is NO.
CLIR CALLING LINE ID. RESTRICTION
Notes:
- If this value is newly entered for this
subscriber and no CLIRPRES is given,
the initial value of CLIRPRES is PERM.
COLP CONNECTED L. ID. PRESENTATION
Notes:
- If this value is newly entered for this
subscriber and no COLPOVR is given,
the initial value of COLPOVR is NO.
COLR CONNECTED LINE ID. RESTRICTION
CREL CALL RELATED CLASS
This parameter value allows retrieval of the
current location by any value added LCS client
to which a call is established from the target MS.

Prerequisites:
- LCS is given within this command or was entered
before.
CT CALL TRANSFER
CUNREL CALL UNRELATED CLASS
This parameter value allows retrieval of the
current location by a designated external value
added LCS client.

Prerequisites:
- LCS is specified within this command or was
entered before.
EMLPP ENH MULT LEV PREC AND PRE-EMPT
FMSPV FOLLOW ME SUPERVISOR
The parameter value FMSPV specifies a supervisor
for FOLLOWME. If the service FMSPV is entered the
service FOLLOWME is replaced.
FOLLOWME FOLLOW ME
FROUT FORCED ROUTING
HOTBILL HOT BILLING
MPTY MULTI PARTY

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR GCSERV- 2+


ENTR GCSERV

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NATCCBS CALL COMPL. TO BUSY SUBSCR.


NATSS01 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 01
NATSS02 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 02
NATSS03 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 03
NATSS04 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 04
NATSS05 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 05
NATSS06 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 06
NATSS07 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 07
NATSS08 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 08
NATSS09 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 09
NATSS10 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 10
NATSS11 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 11
NATSS12 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 12
NATSS13 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 13
NATSS14 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 14
NATSS15 NATIONAL SUPPL. SERVICE 15
PLMNOPR PLMN OPERATOR CLASS
This parameter value allows to retrieve the
current location by a designated PLMN operator.
UNIVERS UNIVERSAL CLASS
This parameter value allows to retrieve the
current location by any LCS client.
USERSIG1 USER TO USER SIGN. SERV. 1

This parameter unit specifies a general call service.

b: STATUS
ACT ACTIVATION
PROV PROVISION

This parameter unit specifies whether provision or activation


for the general call service is requested.

Compatibilities:
- a=CALLWAIT
- a=UNIVERS
- a=CREL
- a=CUNREL
- a=PLMNOPR
- a=BSLC
- a=ASLC

Default: PROV

c: BASIC SERVICE GROUP CODE


ALLBS ALL BEARER SERVICES
ALLBSV ALL BASIC SERVICES
ALLTS ALL TELESERVICES
BS20 DATA CIRCUIT DUPLEX ASYN SERV
BS30 DATA CIRCUIT SYN. SERVICES
BS40 PAD ACCESS SERVICES
TELEPHON TELEPHONY
TS20 SHORT MESSAGE SERVICES
TS60 FACSIMILE SERVICES

This parameter unit specifies basic service group codes.

Compatibilities:
- STATUS=ACT

Incompatibilities:
- STATUS=PROV
- a=UNIVERS
- a=CREL
- a=CUNREL
- a=PLMNOPR
- a=BSLC
- a=ASLC

Default: ALLBSV

CLIPOVR CLIP OVERRIDE CATEGORY

Prerequisites:
- CLIP is given within this command or entered before.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR GCSERV- 3+


ENTR GCSERV

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO OVERRIDE IS NOT POSSIBLE


YES OVERRIDE IS POSSIBLE

COLPOVR COLP OVERRIDE CATEGORY

Prerequisites:
- COLP is given within this command or entered before.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO OVERRIDE IS NOT POSSIBLE


YES OVERRIDE IS POSSIBLE

CLIRPRES CLIR PRESENTATION MODE

Prerequisites:
- CLIR is given within this command or entered before.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PERM PERMANENT
TEMPNRES TEMPORARY PRES. NOT RESTRICTED
TEMPRES TEMPORARY PRES. RESTRICTED

PRIO EMLPP PRIORITY

This parameter specifies the priority of enhanced


Multi-Level Precedence and Pre-emtion (eMLPP)
service consisting of MAXIMUM and DEFAULT priority.

Notes:
- The parameter unit value DEFAULT EMLPP PRIORITY has
to be less or equal than MAXIMUM EMLPP PRIORITY.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: MAXIMUM EMLPP PRIORITY


PRIO0 HIGHEST EMLPP PRIORITY LEVEL 0
PRIO1 EMLPP PRIORITY LEVEL 1
PRIO2 EMLPP PRIORITY LEVEL 2
PRIO3 EMLPP PRIORITY LEVEL 3
PRIO4 LOWEST EMLPP PRIORITY LEVEL 4

This parameter unit indicates the highest priority level the


subscriber is allowed to apply for an outgoing call set-up.

b: DEFAULT EMLPP PRIORITY


PRIO0 HIGHEST EMLPP PRIORITY LEVEL 0
PRIO1 EMLPP PRIORITY LEVEL 1
PRIO2 EMLPP PRIORITY LEVEL 2
PRIO3 EMLPP PRIORITY LEVEL 3
PRIO4 LOWEST EMLPP PRIORITY LEVEL 4

This parameter unit defines the priority level which shall


be assigned to a call if no explicit priority is indicated
during call set-up.

LCS LOCATION SERVICES PROFILE

This parameter specifies a location services profile name.

Notes:
One profile name can be specified per location service.
Up to 3 profile names can be specified.

Compatibilities:
- a = CREL
- a = CUNREL
- a = PLMNOPR

Prerequisites:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR GCSERV- 4+


ENTR GCSERV

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- The LCS profile must have been created (CR LCS).

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FILTER FILTER NAME

This parameter defines the name of the filter, which is used for
modifying only those mobile subscribers that match predefined filter
criteria.

Notes:
- This parameter must not be used in single command mode. It may be
used only in group command mode.

Prerequisites:
- The filter must have been created (CR FILTER).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR GCSERV- 5-


MOD GCSMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify GCS on MP

This task modifies the


’Generation compatibility sign (GCS)’ of a MP software
’Generation’ on system disk or on
magneto-optical disk. This task is not available in an
SSNC stand-alone configuration.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD GCSMP : Device Name= ,Generation= ,GCS= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Device Name

This parameter specifies the


destination device name, which is
either system disk or magneto-optical
disk device.
Input values: MDD, MOD0, MOD1

Generation

This parameter specifies the name of


the modified
’Generation’.
Input format: 1...8 characters from
the character set
without space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

GCS

This parameter specifies the


generation compatibility sign. It is
used in an EWSD Innovation system to
indicate the compatibility of two part
APSes, EWSD part and SSNC part. If the
two signs are equal the two parts
belong together and are compatible.
After a new
’Generation’ is created
the signs of the two parts are
assigned an initial and not valid
value (9999). After the creation of a
new ’Generation’ the
’Generation compatibility sign (GCS)’
of both parts must therefore be
assigned a valid value.
Input format: 1...9999, range of
decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GCSMP- 1-


ACT GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE GENERATION

This command activates a blocked file generation.


The generation must have been created by command
ENTR GEN or MOD DBSIZE.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command starts a job with breakpoints. After a breakpoint the job can be
continued with CONT JOB.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT GEN : GEN= [,ACTLEVEL=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

GEN NAME OF GENERATION

This parameter specifies the file generation


to be activated

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

ACTLEVEL ACTIVATION LEVEL

This parameter specifies how to introduce the new


generation into the system.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NOACT NO ACTIVATION
The new generation will not be introduced into
the system. It will be set valid
MINACT MINIMAL ACTIVATION
The new generation will be introduced into
the system without recovery.
LOWACT LOW ACTIVATION LEVEL
The new generation will be set valid and
introduced into the system with the lowest
CP recovery level as possible. Peripheral
units have to be configurated manually
afterwards.
GLOBACT GLOBAL ACTIVATION LEVEL
The new generation will be set valid and
introduced into the system with the
recovery level needed to load all impacted
units.

Default: GLOBACT

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT GEN- 1-


CAN GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL GENERATION

With this command, file generations stored on disk are deleted logically
and physically. All files of the specified generation are marked as
being not associated with the generation and files which do not belong
to any other generation are physically deleted. Before this is done,
the generation list is specified and an acknowledgment requested.
The list of the physically deleted files is output.

A check is made whether the generation to be deleted is not identical


with the current one and whether it is not the only valid golden
generation.

Log files which belong to a generation are not deleted.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN GEN : GEN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

GEN FILE GENERATION

This parameter specifies the generation to be deleted. It is not


permissible to specify the current generation.
Structure of the generation name:

|----------|
| ffkkloii |
|----------|
Meaning:
ff - APS function version
kk - APS correction version
l - local correction version (special patch status)
o - ODAGEN sequence number
ii - fixpoint sequence number

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN GEN- 1-


COPY GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

COPY GENERATION

This command copies either all files of a generation or only the


semipermanent files to disk or tape/optical disk. Only the current
generation, i.e. the loaded generation whose phase (code and data) is
active, can be copied to disk. Non-current generations, e.g. safeguarding
generations stored on disk can only be copied to tape / optical disk.

If a generation is copied to tape/optical disk, a modified generation


list (consisting of only one entry for the generation to be saved) is
also transferred to tape/optical disk.

In the following differences/restrictions between CP-standalone (CP/SA) and


CP running with a connected MP (CP/MP) will be marked.

The type of the generation to be created (command parameters TYPE=


GOLDEN,BACKUP) can be administrated.

If all files of a generation are copied, the destination generation is


of type backup (BACKUP) or golden (GOLDEN) and is set to
CP/SA: valid (VALID)
CP/MP: blocked (BLOCKED).

When creating a new generation the generation compatibility sign (GCS) is


set to
CP/SA: 0 and can never be modified
CP/MP: 9999 and can be modified with command MOD GEN

Note:
The GCS is needed when the CP is running with a connected MP. It is
needed by startup to determine compatible generations on both the CP and the MP
(compatible generations: GCS-CP = GCS-MP).
The value GCS=0 is reserved for CP/SA.
The value GCS=9999 indicates an invalid value, which needs to be changed
with the command MOD GEN.

CP/SA: If only the semipermanent data is copied, the destination generation is


of type fixpoint (FIX) and is set to blocked (BLOCKED).
CP/MP: the creation of a generation of type fixpoint (FIX) is not possible.

A generation on tape/optical disk is assigned the same validity status it


has on disk.

The validity flag can be changed with the command MOD GEN.

COPY GEN is an essential part of the system for APS safeguarding: it can
be used to create safeguarding generations on tape/optical disk or disk.

The components of the APS safeguarding system include the MML commands
COPY LOGFILE and TRANS SYFILE which transfer the safeguarding
generations from tape/optical disk or disk to disk for restoration purposes.

For APS safeguarding, a distinction must be made between an initial


installation generation which is created with ENTR INSTGEN, and
a database extension which is performed with MOD DBSIZE. UPD GEN
belongs to the disk debugging procedures.

A generation is a consistent, self-contained subset of the EWSD system files


which are required for the operation of an EWSD switching center. One such
file can be assigned to several generations.

Each generation is assigned a generation name. This generation name is a


character string consisting of 8 digits.

All generations of a switching system are listed in a special system file,


i.e. SY.GENLIST, which is not assigned to any generation. The entries, i.e.
the generations that exist in the system, are in the sequence in which
a fallback, if any, is to take place. In general, new generations precede
elder generations. A maximum of 31 generations can be administrated.

Safeguarding generations are generations which can be created by a special


safeguarding action from the current, i.e. the loaded generation.

The following table indicates which files/file types belong to which type
of safeguarding generation:

+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 COPY GEN- 1+


COPY GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

File | Fixpoint | Snapshot | Remarks


(file type) |on disk |on tape / |on disk |on tape /|
| |opt. disk | |opt. disk|
-------------|----------|----------| ---------|---------|--------------------
SY.GENLIST | | * | | * |On tape, the SY.
| | | | |GENLIST has only
| | | | |one entry, no
| | | | |generation file
SY.INSTALL | | | | * |no generation
| | | | |file
SY.SEMILIB | * | * | * | * |
SY.SIMP | * | * | * | * |only in exchanges
| | | | |with CCNC
SY.TASKLIB | z | | * | * |Z: file is merely
SY.LOADLIB.LA| z | | * | * |assigned to safe-
SY.LOADLIB.CA| z | | * | * |guarding generation,
SY.LOADLIB.MA| z | | * | * |and not physically
SY.PSW.T<nnn>| z | | * | * |copied; it also
| | | | |belongs to
| | | | |other generations
+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+

Legend: * = physical copy of file

The following types of safeguarding generations exist:

Fixpoint : Safeguarding generation consists physically only of the


semipermanent data, i.e. of the files SY.SEMILIB and SY.SIMP;
all other files are identical with those of the current
generation and are only logically assigned to it.

Backup : Safeguarding generation consists of physical copies of all


files of an original generation;

Golden : Safeguarding generation is a backup having been tested with


startup by the operator.

A generation may have one of the validity flags BLOCKED, VALID and
’invalid’. The validity flag can be modified with the command MOD GEN,
but only from BLOCKED to VALID and vice versa. A generation on tape/
optical disk is assigned the same status it has on disk. With this command,
the type of a safeguarding generation can also be changed from BACKUP to
GOLDEN. This is useful especially in case one wants to adjust a generation
which was retransferred from tape/optical disk with TRANS SYFILE for a
specified purpose.
The validity status determines the startup capability of a generation. It
is of significance for all generation types. Only a valid generation can
be selected for the automatic fallback. A non-valid or blocked generation
is not used for automatic fallbacks.
However, a manual startup with blocked generations is always possible.

Generations which are to be copied to tape/optical disk are initially


copied to disk, if they contain the current semipermanent database
(SY.SEMILIB and SY.SIMP, if existing). Source generations having such a
property are either the current generation or generations originating from
merging a non-current generation with the current semipermanent database
("semicurrent" generation). The purpose of this procedure is to generate a
fixpoint of the semipermanent database on disk within a short period of time.
In a second step, this intermediate generation is copied to tape/optical disk.
On the other hand, source generations containing a non-current semipermanent
database are copied directly to tape/optical disk without using an
intermediate copy on disk.

In case the intermediate generation is not required to be permanent


(i.e., the source is semipermanent or OUTPUT = TAPMOD has been specified),
this intermediate generation is temporary, i.e. it appears to be an
’invalid’ fixpoint generation.
CP/MP: OUTPUT = TAPMOD is not allowed.

Type and Validity of created generation on tape/optical disk


------------------------------------------------------------
(VSN /= SYSVSN) with COPY GEN
----------------------------
+---------------------------------------------------------------------+
| | created with
Source generation | Destination generation | command parameters

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 COPY GEN- 2+


COPY GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TYPE / Actuality | TYPE / VALIDITY | OUTPUT / TYPE


--------------------|----------------------------|---------------------
NONE non-current | FIX * | FIX -
NONE non-current | BACKUP * | GEN BACKUP
| |
FIX non-current | FIX * | FIX -
| |
BACKUP non-current | BACKUP * | GEN BACKUP
| |
MERGED non-current | BACKUP * | GEN BACKUP
| |
GOLDEN non-current | GOLDEN * | GEN GOLDEN
| |
--------------------|----------------------------|---------------------
arbitrary current | BACKUP VALID | GEN/TAPMOD BACKUP
type | |
arbitrary current | GOLDEN VALID | GEN/TAPMOD GOLDEN
type | |
arbitrary current | FIX BLOCKED | FIX -
type | |
| |
+---------------------------------------------------------------------+

Legend: * = Validity of copy on tape/optical disk is taken to be the


same as that of source generation
TYPE = TYPE
BACKUP = BACKUP
GOLDEN = GOLDEN
VALIDITY = VALIDITY
VALID = VALID
BLOCKED = BLOCKED
OUTPUT = OUTPUT
GEN = GEN
TAPMOD = TAPMOD
FIX = FIX
MERGED = generated by MERGE GEN

For copy to tape, other OUTPUT/TYPE parameter combinations of the


command COPY GEN than those listed in the third column are not possible.

If the current source generation is specified for COPY GEN, and


OUTPUT = FIX or OUTPUT = GEN, then also a permanent copy on disk
is generated besides the copy on tape/optical disk.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 COPY GEN : OUTPUT= [,VSN=] [,GEN=] [,TYPE=] [,VERIFY=] 1
1 1
1 [,RETPER=] [,REWIND=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OUTPUT OUTPUT MODE OF COPYGEN

This parameter specifies whether all files of the generation or only


the semipermanent data (SY.SEMILIB and SY.SIMP) are to be copied or
the total current generation is to be copied directly to tape/optical
disk without generating a permanent copy on disk. If only the
semipermanent data are to be copied, the parameter TYPE is ignored.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FIX SAVE SEMILIB/SIMP ONLY


Copies only the semipermanent data.
GEN SAVE WHOLE GENERATION
Copies all files of the generation.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 COPY GEN- 3+


COPY GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TAPMOD SAVE GEN TO TAPE/OPT.DISK ONLY


Copies the current generation to tape/optical disk
immediately.
In contrary to the other possible methods for
creating a copy of the current generation on tape/
optical disk (OUTPUT= FIX/GEN, VSN =
Volume Serial Number of the tape/optical disk
used), no permanent copy of the current generation
on disk prior to the final copy on tape/optical
disk will be made. Only that part of the current
generation which contains its semipermanent data
is put into a temporary copy on disk.

Specification of a generation different from the


current one is not allowed. VSN is mandatory.
With OUTPUT=TAPMOD, it is not possible to
generate a fixpoint (= semipermanent data only)
on tape/optical disk.
The resulting copy on tape/optical disk of
TYPE=BACKUP/GOLDEN is set to VALID.

VSN VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER LIST

This parameter list specifies whether the generation is to be copied


on disk (VSN=SYSVSN) or tape/optical disk. Up to 5 tapes/optical
disks can be specified in the list:
VSN = <tape1> & <tape2> & <tape3> & <tape4> & <tape5>
(<tape1>...<tape5>: Volume Serial Number of tapes/optical disks).
It is not allowed to specify both VSN of tapes/optical disks and
’SYSVSN’ in the list described above (VSN list).
The specification of VSN’s of several tapes/optical disks before
starting the copy process to tape/optical disk allows COPY GEN
execution with automatic write access to continuation tapes/optical
disks. This is useful if the generation to be saved is very large.
The tapes/optical disks can be mounted on arbitrary tape/optical
disk units; not mounted tapes/optical disks will be requested by the
system. The system will also check if the initialization of the
continuation tapes/optical disks is identical with that of the first
one.
NOTE: for copy to tape/optical disk:
The copy of a generation may only occur either on tape OR on
optical disk (e.g. if copy has been started on tape then the
continuation medium must be tape!).
A compound of both mediums is not allowed!
The first tape/optical disk specified in the VSN list, must be
initialized before the copy to tape/optical disk starts. For this
action one has to use the following command:
For tape:
<INIT MT:VSN=<tape VSN>,CD=EBC,DENS=6250,MTD=<#tape device>;
For optical disk (MOD):
<INIT MO:VSN=<mod VSN>,CD=EBC,MOD=<#mod device>;

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GEN FILE GENERATION

This parameter specifies the generation to be copied. The default


value is the current generation.
Structure of the generation name:

|----------|
| ffkkloii |
|----------|

Meaning:
ff - APS function version
kk - APS correction version
l - local correction version (special patch status)
o - ODAGEN sequence number
ii - fixpoint sequence number

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 COPY GEN- 4+


COPY GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TYPE OF SAVE GENERATION

This parameter can be used (for OUTPUT = GEN or OUTPUT = TAPMOD)


to select whether a backup or golden generation is to be created. The
default value is BACKUP. For OUTPUT = FIX, the parameter TYPE is
not evaluated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BACKUP BACKUP GENERATION


Creates a backup generation.
CP/SA: If the current generation is copied with
OUTPUT = GEN and a permanent backup
generation on disk is created, all other
fixpoint and backup generations on disk are
deleted. A warning is output in this case.
In case that OUTPUT = TAPMOD was specified,
no existing fixpoints or safeguard generations
on disk are deleted.
CP/MP: no automatic deletion of older generations
will occur
GOLDEN GOLDEN GENERATION
Creates a golden generation.
CP/SA:If the current generation is copied with
OUTPUT = GEN and a permanent golden
generation on disk is created, all other
fixpoint, backup and golden generations are
deleted. A warning is output in this case.
In case that OUTPUT = TAPMOD was specified,
no existing fixpoints or safeguard generations
on disk are deleted.
CP/MP: no automatic deletion of generations
will occur.

Default: BACKUP

VERIFY VERIFY CHECKSUM

This parameter specifies whether a checksum audit is to be initiated


during COPY GEN. If a copy on disk is created with this option,
checksum audits are initiated both for the generation files to be
copied and for their copies. In this way, the copying process disk to
disk can be checked. If a copy on tape/optical disk is created,
checksum audits are initiated for the source generation files, and the
calculated checksums, together with the copies, are transferred to
tape/optical disk. When writing to tape/optical disk, the consistency
of the checksum is not checked against the tape/optical disk contents.
This is not possible until the tape/optical disk contents have been
copied back to disk with the aid of command TRANS SYFILE using its
verify function.

If the result of the checksum check is negative, COPY GEN is aborted


with an error message. If, on the one hand, checksum errors are
reported for the source generation, the latter has been found to be
faulty before the start of COPY GEN. If, on the other hand, checksum
errors are reported for the destination generation, errors within
COPY GEN have occurred.

See also the description of the command parameter VERIFY belonging


to the command TRANS SYFILE.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

YES ACTIVATE CHECKSUM


Checksum audit is initiated
Y ACTIVATE CHECKSUM
Checksum audit is initiated
NO DEACTIVATE CHECKSUM
No checksum audit is initiated
N DEACTIVATE CHECKSUM
No checksum audit is initiated

Default: YES

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 COPY GEN- 5+


COPY GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RETPER RETENTION PERIOD

This parameter specifies the retention period of the copy on tape/


optical disk in days, taken from the creation date. During this time
period the tape/optical disk copy is protected against erasure. If no
value or 0 days is given, the tape/optical disk copy is not protected
at all. If VSN is not specified or VSN = SYSVSN, i.e. if only a
copy on disk is required, this parameter is ignored.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...36525, range of decimal numbers

REWIND REWIND TAPE

This parameter specifies whether the tape/optical disk should be


rewound/reset after execution of the command COPY GEN or not. The
default value is YES.
If REWIND = YES is specified, the tape/optical disk is rewound/
reset and released after execution of the command COPY GEN. Otherwise
the tape/optical disk is only released and
- subsequent commands (e.g. TRANS FILE) are allowed to continue
writing on the tape/optical disk mounted for COPY GEN
- access of following commands to this tape/optical disk can be
specified either by the tape/optical disk VSN or by the VSN of the
first tape/optical disk used for COPY GEN (File Group Name).
Therefore one is not forced to evaluate the actual VSN for following
commands, but can always refer to the static ’File Group Name’.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

YES REWIND TAPE


Y REWIND TAPE
NO DON’T REWIND TAPE
N DON’T REWIND TAPE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 COPY GEN- 6-


DISP GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY GENERATION

This command displays file generation information for specific files or


for file generations.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP GEN : [DISPL=] [,GEN=] [,LIB=] [,VSN=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DISPL DISPLAY FUNCTION

This parameter specifies the information to be output.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

GEN GENERATION
Displays the generations with which a file given
in LIB is associated. LIB is mandatory,
GEN and VSN are ignored.
FILES FILES
Displays all files of the generation specified
in GEN. If GEN is not specified, the file
list of the currently loaded generation
is output. LIB and VSN are ignored.
LIST GENERATION LIST
Outputs the entire generation list in edited form
if GEN is not input, otherwise the desired
generation. LIB is ignored.
If VSN is specified and VSN is not identical
with SYSVSN, the information of the generation
list is output from tape/optical disk, otherwise
from disk.
Entries VSN000 and VSN001 are not permissible.

Default: LIST

GEN FILE GENERATION

This parameter specifies the generation, the information of which is to


be output.
For general information on the generation concept, see the command
description for COPY GEN.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LIB LIBRARY

This parameter specifies the library (i.e. generation file),


whose generation membership is to be output.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

VSN VOLUME SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies whether either the generation information


of the disk or the tape/optical disk is to be output.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP GEN- 1-


ENTR GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER GENERATION

This command creates a new file generation. It is part of the file


generation concept of CP113.
A file generation is a summary of all system files of an APS.
This command enables to change or introduce systemfiles. Files that
are not changed will be taken from the current generation to the new.
It is possible to exclude classic GP-files (SY.PSW.nnn).
Depending on the state of the system the new generation will be set
valid and if necessary introduced into the system by recovery
immediately. Or it will be set blocked. The recovery level necessary
for bringing up the new generation will be ascertained automatically.
It results of the changed librarys.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command starts a job with breakpoints. After a breakpoint the job can be
continued with CONT JOB.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR GEN : [LIB=] [,EXCLSMOD=] [,EXCLLMOD=] [,EXCLCPS=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,EXCLLTYP=] [,EXCLLIB=] [,ACTLEVEL=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIB LIBRARY

This parameter specifies a library which is to be taken into the new


generation. The library has to be a Core Image format. The type of
the library will be ascertained automatically. This parameter can be
linked by "&" or repeated by continuation mode. The maximal number
of inputs is dependent on the type of library:
- resident CP-SW (Tasklib) (1)
- non resident software (Loadlib.L) (1)
- non resident masks (Loadlib.M) (1)
- non resident command descriptions (Loadlib.C) (1)
- loadlib for peripheral software (20)
- GP-Load for MP (1)
- GP-Load for AMX (1)
- GP-Load for IWU (1)
Non resident CP-librarys can be delta or basis libraries.
The libraries have to be available on disk. They have to be doubled
and non generation files. Files names beginning with KS. are not
allowed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


+,*,%

EXCLSMOD EXCLUDE SEMIP. DATA MODULE

This parameter specifies a data module of the semilib.


This parameter has a connection to the tasklib that was specified
by the a-parameter.
The data of the specified T/P-module will not be copied to the new
semilib.
This parameter can be linked by "&" or repeated by continuation mode

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR GEN- 1+


ENTR GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

up to 50 times.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

EXCLLMOD EXCLUDE LOAD MODULE

This parameter specifies a load module of a CP-loadlib.


This parameter has a connection to the library that was specified by
the a-parameter.
Only allowed if the new library is a delta library.
The specified load module is not taken to the new system loadlib.
This parameter can be linked by "&" or repeated by continuation mode
for each CP-loadlib , up to 50 times.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

EXCLCPS EXCLUDE CAPSULE

This parameter specifies a capsule of actual MPULIB.


Only allowed if the new library is a delta library.
The specified capsule will not be taken into the new system
library.
This parameter can be linked by "&" or repeated by continuation mode
up to 20 times.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

EXCLLTYP EXCLUDE LOAD TYPE

This parameter specifies a loadtype of actual MPULIB.


Only allowed if the new library is a delta library.
The specified loadtype and all capsules, belonging to this loadtype
only, will not be taken into the new system library.
This parameter can be linked by "&" or repeated by continuation mode
up to 20 times.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

EXCLLIB EXCLUDE LIBRARY

This parameter specifies a PSW-Lib of the actual generation that


should not be taken into the new generation.
This parameter can be linked by "&" or repeated by continuation mode
up to 20 times.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


+,*,%

ACTLEVEL ACTIVATION LEVEL

This parameter specifies how to introduce the new


generation into the system.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR GEN- 2+


ENTR GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NOACT NO ACTIVATION
The new generation will not be introduced into
the system. It will be set blocked
MINACT MINIMAL ACTIVATION
The new generation will be introduced into
the system without recovery.
LOWACT LOW ACTIVATION LEVEL
The new generation will be set valid and
introduced into the system with the lowest
CP recovery level as possible. Peripheral
units have to be configured manually
afterwards.
GLOBACT GLOBAL ACTIVATION LEVEL
The new generation will be set valid and
introduced into the system with the
recovery level needed to load all impacted
units.

Default: GLOBACT

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR GEN- 3-


MERGE GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MERGE GENERATION

This command creates a new generation which contains the code of that
source generation specified as GENTASKL and the semipermanent data
of that one specified as GENSEMIL. The files are solely assigned to
the new generation, that is, they are not copied physically.
Subsequently, the newly created generation is set to blocked.

With command MOD GEN, such a generation can be set to VALID and from
VALID to BLOCKED subsequently.

One of the two source generations must be the loaded generation that
is in operation. The first six characters of the generation names of both
source generations must be identical.

This command can be used to save an APS from backup by (a) combining it with
a saved Semilib in the case of an APS whose Semilib is destroyed but whose
code is O.K., or (b) by combining it with code files in the case of an APS
whose code is destroyed (by patches) but whose Semilib is O.K.

For general information on the generation concept, see the command


description for COPY GEN.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MERGE GEN : GENTASKL= ,GENSEMIL= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

GENTASKL FILE GENERATION OF TASKLIB

This parameter is used to specify the generation whose code is to be


transferred into the generation to be newly created, i.e., whose
tasklib, loadlibs and PSWlibs are to be used.
Structure of the generation name:

|----------|
| ffkkloii |
|----------|
Meaning:
ff - APS function version
kk - APS correction version
l - local correction version (special patch status)
o - ODAGEN sequence number
ii - fixpoint sequence number

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GENSEMIL FILE GENERATION OF SEMILIB

This parameter is used to specify the generation whose semipermanent


data are to be transferred into the generation to be newly created,
i.e., whose files SY.SEMILIB and SY.SIMP are to be used.
Structure of the generation name:

|----------|
| ffkkloii |
|----------|
Meaning:
ff - APS function version
kk - APS correction version
l - local correction version (special patch status)
o - ODAGEN sequence number
ii - fixpoint sequence number

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GEN- 1+


MERGE GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GEN- 2-


MOD GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY GENERATION

This command changes the validity flag and the type of a generation.
The latter is possible only if the specified generation is
of type backup.
If the CP is running with a connected MP (CP/MP) then also the
generation compatibility sign (GCS) can be changed.

Fixpoints and combined (merged) generations are always blocked at the time
they are created (BLOCKED), backups and golden generations always valid
(VALID).
CP/MP: backup (BACKUP) and golden (GOLDEN) generations are always blocked
(BLOCKED) at the time they are created.
Status ’invalid’ is exclusively set by the system itself.

The valid flag defines the startup capability of a generation. It is of sig-


nificance for both current and non-current generations as well as for all
generation types. A valid generation can be selected for the automatic fall-
back. An invalid or blocked generation is not used for automatic fallbacks.
A manual startup, however, is also possible with blocked generations.

In the following cases, a required change of validity is rejected:


- The generation is neither blocked nor valid
- The generation is a valid current generation
- The generation is the initial generation
- The generation is the only valid golden generation on the disk

The change of type of generations which are of other type than of


backup is rejected.

The GCS of a generation can only be changed in CP/MP state.

For general information on the generation concept, see the command


description for COPY GEN.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD GEN : GEN= ,VALIDITY= [,TYPE=] [,GCS=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

GEN FILE GENERATION

This parameter specifies the generation whose validity flag is to be


changed. The current generation must not be specified.

Structure of the generation name:

|----------|
| ffkkloii |
|----------|
Meaning:
ff - APS function version
kk - APS correction version
l - local correction version (special patch status)
o - ODAGEN sequence number
ii - fixpoint sequence number

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

VALIDITY VALIDITY OF GENERATION

This parameter specifies whether a generation is to be set to blocked


or to valid.
Status ’invalid’ is exclusively set by the system itself.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GEN- 1+


MOD GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BLOCKED SET GENERATION BLOCKED


The generation will be set to blocked.
VALID SET GENERATION VALID
The generation will be set to valid.

TYPE NEW TYPE OF GENERATION

This parameter can be used to change the type of a generation


simultaneously with it’s validity. If no value is specified, the type
will be left unchanged.
It is only allowed to specify TYPE = GOLDEN for a generation of
initial type backup.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BACKUP BACKUP GENERATION


This parameter value is not permitted, i.e.
it is not allowed to change a generation of
TYPE = GOLDEN into BACKUP.
GOLDEN GOLDEN GENERATION
A generation of TYPE = BACKUP is changed
to GOLDEN.

GCS GENERATION COMPATIBILITY SIGN

This parameter can only be entered when the CP is running with a


connected MP.
It specifies the generation compatibility sign, i.e. the criterion
to find the compatible generation on the MP.
If this parameter is not entered the GCS will remain unchanged.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9998, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GEN- 2-


UPD GEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

UPDATE GENERATION

This command is called after a double disk failure or when the Semilib of
the current generation is defective, invalid or no longer exists, in
order to restore an executable generation on disk and to continue system
operations.

UPD GEN can be used for saving the current status of the semipermanent
data during the debugging procedures for disk failures.

If the Semilib exists on disk after a double disk failure, the Semilib is
checked for compatibility with the semipermanent main memory area and is
then overwritten with the contents of the main memory area. If SY.SEMI-
LIB does not exist, it is newly created and overwritten with the contents
of the semipermanent main memory area of the CP (mass update).

UPD GEN does not perform a reconstruction of CCNC-Semilib SY.SIMP. Before


a command is executed, a check is made whether system file SY.SIMP, which
contains semipermanent CCNC data, is compatible with the current status of
the semipermanent main memory area in the CP.

Incompatibility may occur when, after a failure of the exchange, a SY.SIMP


with an old status has been read in with the aid of TRANS SYFILE. The
status of SY.SIMP is obsolete if CCNC commands have been processed between
the dump of this file and the failure. The SY.SIMP used before the failure
thus contains more recent entries which do not exist in the SY.SIMP read
in, but are in accordance with the current status of SY.SEMILIB. The SY.SIMP
read in is then not compatible with the current SY.SEMILIB.

The compatibility check consists of a checksum comparison between the


SY.SIMP read in (old status) and the checksum of the current SY.SIMP
stored in the main memory.

After a forced termination during the reconstruction with a recovery level


higher than a newstart of the processes without code or data reloading,
restoring the SY.SEMILIB is no longer possible. In this case, a recovery
with a safeguarding generation and an off-line disk reconstruction must be
carried out.

For general information on the generation concept, see command descrip-


tion for COPY GEN.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 UPD GEN ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 UPD GEN- 1-


CAN GENCPMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Generation on Coupled CP and MP

Cancel Generation on Coupled CP and MP

This task cancels (deletes) generations on the


system disks of CP and MP in coupled CP-MP
systems.
It is possible to cancel compatible generation pairs
on CP and MP, or non-compatible generations that
exist on one side only.

Possible Effects:
- Incautious execution of this task may compromise
the regular operation of the exchange!

Notes:
- Exactly one of the three task parameters must be
specified:
’GCS’ for compatible generation pairs on CP and MP,
’CP generation’ for generations on the CP side only, or
’MP generation’ for generations on the MP side only.
- The loaded generation pair on CP and MP, and
the last GOLDEN generation on CP cannot be
cancelled.
- A confirmation is requested before the generation is
cancelled.
- Log files that belong to a generation are not
cancelled. The task CAN INPLOGFILE can be
used for this purpose.
- This task cancels generations only from the system
disks of CP and MP. The tasks CAN GEN and
CAN GENMP can be used to cancel generations on
magneto-optical disks of CP and MP, respectively.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN GENCPMP : CP generation= ,GCS= ,MP generation= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CP generation

CP generation

This parameter specifies the non-compatible CP


generation that is cancelled.
Compatible CP generations that have a counterpart on
MP cannot be cancelled via this parameter. Parameter
’GCS’ must be specified in this case to cancel the
generations on both sides.

Input format:
- 8 characters from the symbolic name character set.
- ?

Input values:
- The name of a non-compatible CP generation.
- ? to get a list of names for all non-compatible CP
generations that can be cancelled.

Exactly one of the three task parameter must be


specified.

GCS

Generation compatibility sign

This parameter specifies the pair of compatible


generations on CP and MP that are cancelled.
Non-compatible generations that exist on one side only
cannot be cancelled via this parameter. The generation
name must be specified in this case in parameter

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN GENCPMP- 1+


CAN GENCPMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

’CP generation’ for CP generations, respectively


parameter ’MP generation’ for MP generations.

Input format:
- Integer value between 1 and 9998.
- ?

Input values:
- The common GCS of a pair of compatible generations.
- ? to get a list of GCS for all compatible generation
pairs that can be cancelled.

Exactly one of the three task parameters must be


specified.

MP generation

MP generation

This parameter specifies the non-compatible MP


generation that is cancelled.
Compatible MP generations that have a counterpart on
CP cannot be cancelled via this parameter. Parameter
’GCS’ must be specified in this case to cancel the
generations on both sides.

Input format:
- 1..8 characters without space:
letters (also capitals), numbers, and the characters
! . $ % # + - _
- ?
This parameter is case-sensitive.

Input values:
- The name of a non-compatible MP generation.
- ? to get a list of names for all non-compatible MP
generations that can be cancelled.

Exactly one of the three task parameter must be


specified.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN GENCPMP- 2-


COPY GENCPMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Copy Generation on Coupled CP and MP

Copy Generation on Coupled CP and MP

This task copies the loaded CP and MP generations


in coupled CP-MP systems to safeguarding generations
on the system disks of CP and MP, respectively.
The created CP generation can be a BACKUP or
a GOLDEN generation.
The generation compatibility sign (GCS) of the
created CP and MP generations is set to a common
value to indicate that they are a compatible
generation pair.
The new GCS is defined automatically: the highest
valid GCS found on CP and MP is incremented by 1.
Furthermore, the validity flag of the new CP generation
is set to ’valid’, if it is not a GOLDEN generation.
For GOLDEN generations it is set to ’blocked’.
The open input log file is closed, and a new input log
file is created, because is necessary to change the
input log file when a backup copy of the complete
loaded generation is made.

Prerequisites:
- No invalid generation (GCS=9999) may exist on the
system disk of CP or MP before backup.
- Less than five MP generations may exist on the
MP system disk.
- Enough disk space must be available on the CP
and MP system disk.
- The loaded MP generation must have the highest
generation sequence number.

Notes:
- The prerequisites can be verified by the task
DISP GENCPMP. If the prerequisites are not met,
cancel generations by the task CAN GENCPMP,
or modify the generation sequence number by the
task MOD GENMP.
- This is a long-running task. An information message
is displayed, and the user has to confirm the
execution of the task.
- The task is performed in two phases:
1. Copying the generations
2. Setting the GCS and the validity flag
- If phase 1 fails, rollback is performed to restore the
situation as it was before. This rollback cancels
invalid generations (GCS=9999) on either side.
- If phase 2 fails, the GCS and the validity flag can be
set by the separate task MOD GENCPMP.
- The validity flag of GOLDEN CP generations must be
separately set to ’valid’ by the task MOD GEN after
the startup test. A non-valid or blocked generation
is not used for automatic fallbacks, but a manual
startup with blocked generations is always possible.
- This task can be used only to copy generations on
the system disks of CP and MP. There are separate
tasks to copy CP and MP generations to magneto-
optical disks: COPY GEN for CP generations,
COPY GENMP for MP generations.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 COPY GENCPMP : Backup type= ,New MP generation= 1
1 1
1 ,New input log file= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Backup type

Type of the new CP generation

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 COPY GENCPMP- 1+


COPY GENCPMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter specifies whether a BACKUP or GOLDEN


generation is created on CP.
- BACKUP: the safeguarding generation consists of
physical copies of all files of the loaded generation.
This type is used for routine savings.
- GOLDEN: the safeguarding generation is a backup
which must be tested with startup by the operator.

Input format:
- BACKUP or GOLDEN

Default: BACKUP

New MP generation

Name of the new MP generation

This parameter specifies the name of the new MP


generation.

Input format:
- 1..8 characters without space:
letters (also capitals), numbers, and the characters
! . $ % # + - _
- ?
This parameter is case-sensitive.

Input values:
- A new generation name that must end with a number,
e.g. DBXY_34.
- ? to get a proposal for the new MP generation name.
This displays the name that is automatically defined in
the default case.

Default:
The MP generation name is defined automatically: it is
derived from the generation name that ends with the
highest number. This number is incremented by 1.
Example: if DBXY_34 is the generation name with the
highest number, the new MP generation name is
DBXY_35.

Notes:
- The name of the new CP generation cannot be defined
by the user.

New input log file

Logical name of the new input log file

This parameter specifies the logical name of the new


input log file.
The logical name is the part of the full file name which
can be defined by the user, and which is common to all
related log files. For instance, it is the <LogicalName>
part of the full name LG.<LogicalName>.A0.MASTER of
a master log file.

Input format:
- 1..17 characters without space:
letters (also capitals), numbers, and the characters
! $ % & # + - _ ( ) , / ; < = > @ [ ] { } |
This parameter is case-sensitive.

Input values:
- A new log file name.

Default:
The logical name of the new input log file is the date
and time of its creation in the format YYMMDDhhmmss.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 COPY GENCPMP- 2-


DISP GENCPMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Generation on Coupled CP and MP

Display Generation on Coupled CP and MP

This task displays the list of generations in coupled


CP-MP systems. The listed CP and MP generations
can be located on the system disks or on magneto-
optical disks (MODs) of CP and MP, respectively.

Input:
- Display generations on CP and MP system disk:
Enter MDD into both task parameters (default).
- Display generations on a CP MOD only:
Enter the VSN of the MOD into parameter ’VSN’,
and leave parameter ’Device name’ empty.
- Display generations on a MP MOD only:
Enter the device name of the MOD into parameter
’Device name’, and leave parameter ’VSN’ empty.
- Display generations on a CP MOD and a MP MOD:
Enter the VSN and the device name of the MODs
into the corresponding task parameters.

Output:
The output table is divided into three main groups:

GCS: The generation compatibility sign is always


displayed.

CP GENERATIONS: Attributes of CP generations.


This group is present only when CP generations
are displayed. It contains columns for the following
attributes:
- Name: the name of the CP generation
- Creation Date: creation date and time of the CP
generation
- History: indicates the type of the generation
- Validity: the validity flag

MP GENERATIONS: Attributes of MP generations.


This group is present only when MP generations
are displayed. It contains columns for the following
attributes:
- Name: the name of the MP generation
- Creation Date: creation date and time of the
MP generation
- Seq: the generation sequence number
- BAP: the boot area position
- States: a combination of
administrative state: loc=locked, unl=unlocked
usage state: idl=idle, act=active, bus=busy
operational state: dis=disabled, ena=enabled

The output table is sorted according to CP output.


Compatible generations on CP and MP (equal GCS)
appear in the same line. MP generations without a
a counterpart on the CP are appended to the list.

The common generation compatibility sign (GCS) of


the loaded CP and MP generation is shown if
generations on the system disks are listed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP GENCPMP : Device name= ,VSN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Device name

Device name of MP disk

This parameter specifies the MP disk from which

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP GENCPMP- 1+


DISP GENCPMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

generations are listed.

Input format:
- MDD, MOD0 or MOD1
- ?

Input values:
- MDD to display generations on the MP system disk.
In this case parameter ’VSN’ must also be set
to MDD.
- The device name of a MP MOD (magneto-optical disk).
Valid device names are MOD0 and MOD1.
In this case parameter ’VSN’ must not be set
to MDD.
- ? to get all possible device names.
- Leave this parameter empty to display only generations
on the MP MOD specified by parameter ’Device name’.

Default: MDD

VSN

Volume serial number of CP disk

This parameter specifies the CP disk from which


generations are listed.

Input format:
- MDD
- 1..6 characters from the symbolic name character set.
- ?

Input values:
- MDD to display generations on the CP system disk.
In this case parameter ’Device name’ must also
be set to MDD.
- The VSN of a CP MOD (magneto-optical disk).
In this case parameter ’Device name’ must not
be set to MDD.
- ? to get all possible VSNs.
- Leave this parameter empty to display only generations
on the MP MOD specified by parameter ’Device name’.

Default: MDD

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP GENCPMP- 2-


MOD GENCPMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Generation on Coupled CP and MP

Modify Generation on Coupled CP and MP

This task assigns a common generation compatibility


sign (GCS) between 1 and 9998 to a CP and a MP
generation. This forms a compatible generation pair
in a coupled CP-MP system.
Furthermore, the validity flag of the CP generation is
set to ’valid’, if it is not a GOLDEN generation.
For GOLDEN generations it is set to ’blocked’.

Preconditions:
- Exactly one invalid generation (GCS=9999) must
exist on both the CP and the MP system disk. The
common GCS is assigned to these two invalid
generations.

Notes:
- A valid GCS (1..9998) assigned to one CP and one
MP generation indicates that these generations are
compatible.
- The GCS is 9999 if no counterpart is known for a
generation on the other side.
- It is possible that several invalid generations
(GCS=9999) exist on CP and MP, but normally there
should be only compatible generation pairs.
- This task can be used only to define compatible
generation pairs on the system disks of CP and MP.
It can neither modify a valid GCS, nor the GCS on
CP or MP only.
- The GCS can also be modified separately on CP
and MP by the tasks MOD GEN and MOD GCSMP,
respectively.
Caution: The separate modification of the GCS on
CP or MP may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!
- The validity flag of GOLDEN CP generations must be
separately set to ’valid’ by the task MOD GEN after
the startup test. A non-valid or blocked generation
is not used for automatic fallbacks, but a manual
startup with blocked generations is always possible.
- Other generation attributes can be modified
separately on CP and MP by the tasks MOD GEN
and MOD GENMP, respectively.
- The tasks MOD GEN, MOD GCSMP, and
MOD GENMP mentioned above can modify
attributes on system disk or magneto-optical disk.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD GENCPMP : GCS= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

GCS

New generation compatibility sign

This parameter specifies the new generation


compatibility sign (GCS) that is assigned to the CP
and MP generation to define them to be compatible.

Input format:
- Integer value between 1 and 9998.
- ?

Input values:
- A number between 1 and 9998 that is not assigned to
any other generation.
- ? to get a proposal for the new GCS. This displays
the GCS that is automatically assigned in the default

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GENCPMP- 1+


MOD GENCPMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

case.

Default:
The new GCS is defined automatically: the highest valid
GCS found on CP and MP is incremented by 1.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GENCPMP- 2-


BLD GENINSMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Build Generation First Install on MP

This task builds the loaded software


’Generation’ on the system disk during
first installation.
The system disk must be empty, i.e. labeled.
The ’Code’ portion is taken from the
loaded ’Generation’ which was loaded during
startUp from MOD.
The ’Data’ portion always taken from the loaded
’Generation’ and is added by a
database snapshot.

In an EWSD Innovation system the


’Generation compatibility sign (GCS)’ has to be supplied
with a reasonable value by means of task ’MOD GCSMP’.

Prerequisites:
- This task must not be called before the system reached
the syncronisation point 8 and the recovery
post-procesing is finished (all code files must be
closed).

Notes:
- This task is a long-running operation. The NE issues
begin-, progress- and end event reports.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 BLD GENINSMP : Generation= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Generation

This parameter specifies the name of


the loaded ’Generation’ to
be built on the system disk.
The ’Generation’ was loaded
during startup from MOD.
Input format: 1...8 characters from
the character set
without space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 BLD GENINSMP- 1-


CAN GENMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Generation on MP

This task cancels a software ’Generation’


on MP. The task deletes a fallback
’Generation’ on system disk (MDD) or on
the magneto-optical disk (MOD), depending on the input
parameter ’Device name’. The loaded
’Generation’ cannot be deleted.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN GENMP : Device name= ,Generation= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Device name

This parameter specifies the


destination device name, which can be
either system disk or magneto-optical
disk device.
Input values: MDD, MOD0, MOD1

Generation

This parameter specifies the name of


the ’Generation’ to be
canceled. This cannot be the
’Generation’ currently
loaded.
Input format: 1...8 characters from the
character set without
space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN GENMP- 1-


COPY GENMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Copy Generation on MP

This task copies a software ’Generation’


on MP. There are two functionalities:
1. Copy of the loaded (running)
’Generation’ on system disk (successful
only in a SSNC stand-alone configuration):
The task copies all ’Code’ and
’Data’ files into a new
’Generation’ on
’Boot area pos.’ one.
During a running backup copying the input log file
will be changed. The existing one is closed and a new
one will be created. The new input log file name can
be specified with the optional input parameter ’New
log file name’. If not specified, the default name of
the input log file is used.
2. Copy of a fallback ’Generation’ on MOD:
The task copies an existing fallback
’Generation’
(’Boot area pos.’ >= 1) from the system
disk (MDD) to a magneto-optical disk device (MOD). The
name of the new ’Generation’ on MOD is
the same as the name as the copied
’Generation’.

Prerequisites:
for 1 and 2:
- Less than five ’Generations’ exist
already on disk
- Enough disk space is available
for 1:
- Loaded (running) ’Generation’ should
have the highest ’Sequence no.’ of all
’Generations’ on the system disk in
order to ensure its uniqueness. In case it has not the
highest ’Sequence no.’, please modify it by
means of the task ’MOD GENMP’.

Notes:
- This is a long-running task. The NE issues
begin-, progress- and end event reports.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 COPY GENMP : Device name= [,Generation=] [,New generation=] 1
1 1
1 [,New input log file=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Device name

This parameter specifies the


destination device name: system disk
or magneto-optical disk device.
Input values: MDD, MOD0, MOD1

Generation

This parameter specifies the name of


the copied fallback
’Generation’; it is
relevant only if device = MOD0 or MOD1.
Input format: 1...8 characters from the
character set without
space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 COPY GENMP- 1+


COPY GENMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

New generation

This parameter specifies the name of


the new (backup)
’Generation’. It is
relevant only if device = MDD
Input format: 1...8 characters from the
character set without
space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

New input log file

This parameter specifies the user


defined part of the new input log
file name. The default file name
consists of the current system date
and time: YYMMDDHHMMSS;
Relevant only if device = MDD.
Input format:
name: 1...17 characters from the
character set
Input values: no restrictions

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 COPY GENMP- 2-


CR GENMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create Generation on MP

This task creates a software ’Generation’.


This is the first step in the System Upgrade/External
Restore task sequence. The next step after the successful
delivery of the ’Generation’ files is the
task ’VAL GENMP’.

Prerequisites:
- A valid Upgrade Control Table (UCT) File is required.
- A copy (backup) of the loaded ’Generation’
must have been done before creation of a new
’Generation’ is started during System
Upgrade.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR GENMP : New generation= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

New generation

This parameter specifies the name of


the new ’Generation’ to
be created.
Input format: 1...8 characters from the
character set without
space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GENMP- 1-
DISP GENMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Generation on MP

This task displays a software


’Generation’ on MP.
Depending on the input parameters, the task provides the
following functionalities:
1. Displays a list of all ’Generations’
with or without several attributes from system disk or
magneto-optical disk.
Relevant input parameters:
’Device name’, ’Attribute flag’
2. Displays one ’Generation’ with all
attributes from system disk or magneto-optical disk.
Relevant input parameters:
’Device name’, ’Generation’
3. Displays a list of all ’Code’ or
’Data’ files of a
’Generation’ with several attributes
from system disk or magneto-optical disk. Be aware
that there might be as many as hundred or more
’Data’ files which are part of a
’Generation’ !
Relevant input parameters:
’Device name’, ’Generation’, ’File type’
4. Displays one ’Code’ or
’Data’ file of a
’Generation’ with all attributes from
system disk or magneto-optical disk.
All input parameters are relevant:
’Device name’, ’Generation’, ’File type’, ’File’

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP GENMP : Device name= ,Attribute flag= [,Generation=] 1
1 1
1 [,File type=] [,File=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Device name

This parameter specifies the


destination device name which is
either system disk or magneto-optical
disk device. It is relevant for all 4
functionalities.
Input values: MDD, MOD0, MOD1

Attribute flag

This parameter specifies whether the list


of ’Generations’
on either system disk or magneto-optical
disk device is displayed with or without
generation attributes.
It is relevant only for functionality 1.
Input values: FALSE, TRUE

Generation

This parameter specifies the name of


the displayed ’Generation’.
It is relevant for functionalities 2,
3, 4.
Input format: 1...8 characters from
the character set
without space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP GENMP- 1+


DISP GENMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

File type

This parameter specifies whether


’Code’ or
’Data’ file(s) are
displayed. It is relevant for
functionalities 3 and 4.
Be aware that when choosing ’Data’,
several ’Data’ files might
be displayed !
Examples for ’Code’ files:
SY.MPULIB,
SY.AMXLIB
Examples for ’Data’ files:
DBMS.DA.002.00000,
DBMS.DA.002.00024

File

This parameter specifies the name of


the displayed ’Code’ or
’Data’ file. It is relevant
only for functionality 4.
Input format: 1...30 characters from
the character set
without space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP GENMP- 2-


INST GENMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Install Delivered Generation on MP

This task installs the newly created and validated software


’Generation’. This is the next
step in the System Upgrade task sequence after the task ’VAL
GENMP’ and is followed by the task ’UTIL GENMP’.
This action includes the following:
a. during System Upgrade:
- Prepares the newly created and validated
’Generation’ for activation.
- Loads new code to the peripheral unit (PCP) FEPROMs
while the PCP is still working for the switching
part with the old code in memory.
- Splits all MPs; thus canceling MP redundancy
- Activates the new software
’Generation’ in the nonswitching
part of the MPs.
- Transfers semipermanent data from the switching to
the nonswitching part of the MPs.
b. during External Restore :
- Prepares the newly created and validated
’Generation’ for activation.
- Deletes the Upgrade Control Table (UCT).
Afterwards, a load recovery can be started to load
the new ’Generation’ (e.g. by doing a
restore by task ’REST GENMP’).

Prerequisites:
- A valid Upgrade Control Table (UCT) file is required.
- The new ’Generation’ has been created
and validated.

Notes:
This task is a long-running operation. The NE issues
begin-, progress- and end event reports.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 INST GENMP : New generation= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

New generation

This parameter specifies the name of


the new ’Generation’ to
be installed.
Input format: 1...8 characters from the
character set without
space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 INST GENMP- 1-


MERGE GENMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Merge Generations on MP

This task builds a new fallback software


’Generation’ on the system disk of the MP.
A merge of the ’Data’ files
of one ’Generation’ and the
’Code’ files of another
’Generation’ to a new
’Generation’ is carried out. The
parameters ’Data generation’ and ’Code generation’
specify the ’Generations’ from which the
’Data’ and the ’Code’
portions are copied.
The ’Code’ portion can be selected from
any ’Generation’ without restrictions. The
’Data’ portion can be selected from any
’Generation’, except the loaded one.
This is a simple way to copy a
’Generation’ on an MOD back to the system
disk (even with the possibility of implicit renaming). No
LOADREC3 is executed.

In an EWSD Innovation system the


’Generation compatibility sign (GCS)’ has to be supplied
with a reasonable value by means of task ’MOD GCSMP’.

Notes:
- This is a long-running task. The NE issues
begin-, progress- and end event reports.
- In order to use this new ’Generation’,
it has to be restored by task ’REST GENMP’

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MERGE GENMP : New generation= ,Code device= ,Code generation= 1
1 1
1 ,Data device= ,Data generation= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

New generation

This parameter specifies the name of


the new ’Generation’to
be built.
Input format: 1...8 characters from
the character set
without space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

Code device

This parameter specifies the source of


the ’Code’ portion
’Generation’, which is
either the system disk or the
magneto-optical disk device.
Input values: MDD, MOD0, MOD1

Code generation

This parameter specifies the name of


the ’Code’ portion
source
’Generation’.
Input format: 1...8 characters from
the character set
without space

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GENMP- 1+


MERGE GENMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Input values: alphabetic characters


(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

Data device

This parameter specifies the source of


the ’Data’ portion
’Generation’, which is
either the system disk or the
magneto-optical disk device.
Input values: MDD, MOD0, MOD1

Data generation

This parameter specifies the name of


the ’Data’ portion source
’Generation’ (not the
loaded one).
Input format: 1...8 characters from
the character set
without space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GENMP- 2-


MOD GENMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Generation on MP

This task modifies one attribute of a software


’Generation’ on MP. The following
’Generation’ attributes can be modified:
1. ’Patch rev.’ of the loaded MP
’Generation’ on system disk
2. ’Admin. state’ of a fallback MP
’Generation’ (means not the loaded one)
on system disk or an archive
’Generation’ on magneto-optical disk.
3. ’Sequence no.’ of a MP
’Generation’ on system disk or an
archive ’Generation’ on magneto-optical
disk.

The ’Generation compatibility sign (GCS)’ of an MP


’Generation’ can be modified by means of
the task ’MOD GCSMP’, which is however not available in
an SSNC stand-alone system.

Notes:
- Only one ’Generation’ attribute can be
modified at a time.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD GENMP : Device name= [,Generation=] [,Patch revision=] 1
1 1
1 [,Admin. state=] [,Sequence number=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Device name

This parameter specifies the


destination device name, which is
either system disk or magneto-optical
disk device. It is not relevant for
the modification of the
’Patch rev.’.
Input values: MDD, MOD0, MOD1

Generation

This parameter specifies the name of


the modified
’Generation’; it is not
relevant for the modification of the
’Patch rev.’.
Input format: 1...8 characters from
the character set
without space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

Patch revision

This parameter identifies the revision


of the patch state. It is defined as a
unique number in the range of (0:999)
for a specific version.
The ’Patch rev.’ is
initialized during creation of a
’Generation’ with 0.
During backup copy of the loaded
’Generation’ it is
copied from the loaded to the backup
’Generation’. Usually

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GENMP- 1+


MOD GENMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

the ’Patch rev.’ has to


be set from the managing system when a
complete revision has been
incorporated successfully. This
attribute can be modified only for the
loaded ’Generation’,
which is determined within this task.
Input format: 0...999, range of
decimal numbers
Input values: no restrictions
Initial value: 0

Admin. state

This parameter specifies the


administrative state of a
’Generation’
This attribute cannot be modified for
the loaded
’Generation’.
Input values: Selection from :
’Unlocked’
’Locked’

Sequence number

This parameter specifies the serial


number of a
’Generation’. It is
defined during creation of a
’Generation’. During
system upgrade it is initialized with
0; during backup of the loaded
’Generation’ the
’Sequence no.’ of the backup
’Generation’ is copied
from the loaded
’Generation’ (before
the backup is performed) and the value
of the loaded
’Generation’ is
incremented by 1 after the backup is
completed.
Input format: 0...999, range of
decimal numbers
Input values: no restrictions
Initial value: 0
Notes:
The loaded ’Generation’
should have the highest value in
comparison to the other
’Generations’.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GENMP- 2-


REM GENMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Remove Generations on MP

This task finalizes the System Upgrade on MP. This step


follows after the task ’UTIL GENMP’ and is the last task in
the System Upgrade task sequence.
This task
- deletes all old ’Generations’
- resets upgrade specific flags and tasks.

Prerequisites:
- A valid Upgrade Control Table (UCT) file is required.
- The new ’Generation’ has been installed
and utilized.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REM GENMP ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REM GENMP- 1-


REST GENMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Restore Generation on MP

This task restores an MP ’Generation’ from


the system disk or the magneto-optical disk device (MOD).
The task provides 2 functionalities:
1. Restore and activation of a fallback
’Generation’ from the system disk.
2. Restore and activation of a archive
’Generation’ from magneto-optical disk
device (MOD). The ’Generation’ is
first copied from MOD onto the system disk before it
is activated.
The restored ’Generation’ is activated by
initiating a load recovery (LOADREC3).

Possible Effects:
- The restored fallback ’Generation’ from
system disk is activated by a load recovery (LOADREC3).

Notes:
- This is a long-running task. The NE issues the
following event reports:
begin- and progress event reports
restoreActiveNotification
- This task can be used in case the active generation was disabled
and can not be repaired during running operation.
This task can not be used in case of double disk outage or first installation;
therefore tasks REP DDISKOUT and BLD GENINSMP are available.
The system disk must NOT be labeled !

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REST GENMP : Device name= ,Generation= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Device name

This parameter specifies the source


device name, which is either system
disk or magneto-optical disk device.
Input values: MDD, MOD0, MOD1

Generation

This parameter specifies the name of


the ’Generation’ which
will be activated.
Input format: 1...8 characters from
the character set
without space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REST GENMP- 1-


UTIL GENMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Utilize Installed Generation on MP

This task causes utilization of the installed software


’Generation’. This is the next step in the
System Upgrade task sequence after the task ’INST GENMP’
and is followed by the task ’REM GENMP’.
This action includes the following:
- Transfers the switching function to those sides of
the split MP units with the new software version
load. All former switching MP units, i.e., those
with the old software version load, are reset. In
addition all peripheral units perform a soft reset
to activate the new software version.
- Merges the MP units; thus complete system
redundancy is re-established.

Prerequisites:
- A valid Upgrade Control Table (UCT) File is required.
- The new ’Generation’ has been installed.

Notes:
This task is a long-running operation. The NE issues
begin-, progress- and end event reports.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 UTIL GENMP : New generation= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

New generation

This parameter specifies the name of


the new ’Generation’ to
be utilized.
Input format: 1...8 characters from the
character set without
space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 UTIL GENMP- 1-


VAL GENMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Validate Delivered Generation on MP

This task validates the newly created


’Generation’, i.e. delivery
of a new ’Generation’ or build of the
’Generation’ files during System Upgrade or
External Restore has successfully completed. This task
follows after a ’Generation’ has been
created (tasks ’CR GENMP’ or ’BLD GENUPGMP’) and the
’Generation’ files are available.
The next step following validation in the System Upgrade /
External Restore task sequence is the task ’INST GENMP’.

Prerequisites:
- A valid Upgrade Control Table (UCT) File is required.
- The new ’Generation’ has been created
(tasks ’CR GENMP’ or ’BLD GENUPGMP’) and the
’Generation’ files are available.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 VAL GENMP : New generation= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

New generation

This parameter is the name of the new


’Generation’ to be
validated.
Input format: 1...8 characters from the
character set without
space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 VAL GENMP- 1-


BLD GENUPGMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Build Generation During Upgrade on MP

This task builds a software ’Generation’


on MP during System Upgrade from MOD. This is the first
step in the task sequence for System Upgrade from MOD.
This task is followed by task ’VAL GENMP’.
The ’Code’ portion of the new
’Generation’ is taken from any
’Generation’ on any MOD. The specification
of a ’Data’ portion is not allowed. The
’Data’ is added later on by online data
transfer from the old to the new
’Generation’ .

Prerequisites:
- A valid Upgrade Control Table (UCT) file is required.
- A copy (backup) of the loaded
’Generation’ must have been done before
build of a new ’Generation’ is started
during System Upgrade from MOD.

Notes:
- This task is a long-running operation. The NE issues
begin-, progress- and end event reports.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 BLD GENUPGMP : New generation= ,MOD name= ,Code generation= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

New generation

This parameter specifies the name of


the new ’Generation’to
be built.
Input format: 1...8 characters from
the character set
without space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

MOD name

This parameter specifies the device


name of the magneto-optical disk
device MOD from which the
’Code’ portion
source generation will be copied.
Input values: MOD0 or MOD1

Code generation

This parameter specifies the name of the


’Code’ portion source
generation.
Input format: 1...8 characters from
the character set
without space
Input values: alphabetic characters
(also capitals),
numbers and the
following characters:
! $ % # + - _ .

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 BLD GENUPGMP- 1-


REC GOS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RECORD GRADE OF SERVICE

This command activates the recording function for grade-of-service data


for the entire exchange.

Prerequisites:
- System time must be secure when the command is entered.

Notes:
- The name of the measurement file is displayed on the OMT
if disk output of traffic data is requested.
- Only one measurement job can be started.
- The traffic data are output to MDD file every 15 minutes within
the selected measurement intervals.
UNIT=OMT is not permissible
for the grade-of-service measurement.
At least 15 minutes elapse before the first data are output
with immediate start.
- The measurement can be stopped with STOP JOB, except
jobs with UNIT=MDD-DAILY.

This command starts a semipermanent job. It can be canceled with CAN JOB.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REC GOS : UNIT= [,BEG=] [,TER=] [,IV=] [,PER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

UNIT OUTPUT UNIT AND MODE

This parameter specifies the output unit and the mode of


output.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: OUTPUT UNIT
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
If this option is selected, a measurement file
is created and the traffic data are output to
this file. The start and the finish message
include the name of the file in which the
traffic data are available for postprocessing.

Notes :
- If a file is destroyed or cannot be extended,
an advisory is sent to the OMT.

This information unit specifies the output unit.

b: OUTPUT MODE
SINGLE SINGLE TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are output
to a single measurement file.
DAILY DAILY TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are output
to daily files. The measurement starts
immediately and has no defined end. Time
parameters are not permitted.
To secure the required space on disk, all 7
daily files are prepared and created at the
start of measurement.
A daily file is closed at the end of the day
and a new file for the next day is
automatically created, or the existing file is
replaced.
Daily files will be overwritten in the
following week on the same weekday.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC GOS- 1+


REC GOS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This information unit specifies the desired output


mode (daily file or single measurement file).
It is only permissible in connection with output
UNIT=MDD.

BEG BEGIN DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement begin date.

Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER
must be specified.
Exception: Time parameters cannot be specified for data
output in daily files.
- A maximum of four BEG dates in chronological order may
be linked with &. In the case of linked BEG dates, TER
is not permitted.
If no TER is selected, the measurement is active on the
specified BEG days only.
- The earliest possible begin date BEG is the day after
command input.
- The first BEG date must be within an interval of one
month starting from the current date.
- The other BEG dates must be within an interval of
one year starting from the current date.
- The measurement on the actual BEG day can be stopped
with STOP JOB. If the measurement is stopped on the
last BEG day, it will be finished.

Default: the begin of measurement is the current date.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

TER TERMINATION DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement termination date.

Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER
must be specified.
Exception: Time parameters may not be specified for data
output in daily files.
- Only one termination date may be entered.
The earliest possible termination date is the day after
command input.
- The measurement duration must not exceed one year.
- If no BEG parameter is entered, recording starts
immediately.

Default: the end of measurement is determined by the last


single day (BEG).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF TERMINATION DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC GOS- 2+


REC GOS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

c: DAY OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

IV INTERVAL TIME

This parameter indicates interval times of the measurement.

Notes:
- Interval times IV are only permitted if at least one
begin date BEG is selected.
- A maximum of 4 measurement intervals in chronological
order may be linked with &. Linked intervals have to be
at least 30 minutes apart except for measurements over
midnight.
- An interval may not include midnight, e.g. IV =
23-00-01-00 is not permitted.
A measurement over midnight requires the input of two
interval times, e.g. IV = 00-00-01-00&23-00-00-00.
- The measurement is active during the specified interval
times only.
- The measurement can be stopped during the actual interval
IV with STOP JOB. If the measurement is stopped
during the last interval IV, it will be finished.

Default: 24-hour measurement on the specified days

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: BEGIN HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: BEGIN MINUTE=
0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

c: TERMINATION HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

d: TERMINATION MINUTE=
0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

PER PERIODIC WEEKDAY

This parameter specifies the weekdays on which data


have to be recorded.

Notes:
- Input of weekdays is only permissible in
connection with a termination date (TER).
- Up to 6 of the values may be linked with &, except
the values NO, WO and HO which cannot be
linked with other values.

Default: measurement every day during the measurement


period

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

NO NO SPECIFIED PERIOD
Measurement every day
MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY
Days which are full working days

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC GOS- 3+


REC GOS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

HO HOLIDAY
Full national and international holidays are
included.
The full weekend day (the day marked EF
in the DISP WDCAT output mask) is included.
Half holidays are not included.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC GOS- 4-


REC GP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RECORD GROUP PROCESSOR

This command activates the recording function for the load data of the GP.

Prerequisites:
- System time must be secure when the command is entered.

Notes:
- The name of the measurement file is displayed on the OMT
if disk output of traffic data is requested.
- A maximum of together 8 jobs of REC GP and REC LTG may be
entered at the same time.
- The traffic data are output every 15 minutes within the
selected measurement intervals.
At least 15 minutes elapse before the first data are output
with immediate start.
- The measurement can be stopped with STOP JOB, except
jobs with UNIT=MDD-DAILY OR CYCLIC.

This command starts a semipermanent job. It can be canceled with CAN JOB.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REC GP : LTG= ,UNIT= [,BEG=] [,TER=] [,IV=] [,PER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP

This parameter specifies the number of the LTG for which traffic
data have to be recorded.

Prerequisites:
- Measurement of all LTG (LTG=X-X) is only possible if
output UNIT=MDD[SINGLE or DAILY].
- Measurement of LTGSETS (LTG=n-X) is only possible if
output UNIT=MDD[SINGLE or DAILY or CYCLIC] (n = 0 to 31).

Notes:
- A maximum of 16 single LTG may linked per command.
- The single LTG list will be automaticaly expanded if the
single LTG is a Master or Slave LTG.
* LTG = Master
all Slaves will be added
* LTG = Slave
the Master LTG and all other Slaves will be added.
- A maximum of 8 LTGSETS may linked per command.
- It is not possible to combine single LTG and LTGSETS
in one Measurement Job.
- The maximum number of LTGs which can be measured
simultaneously with either job REC LTG or REC GP
is limited depending on the configuration. It is not
possible to start more than one job with LTG=X-X.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

Dependent on the switching network hardware this unit


represents the time stage group (TSG for SNB) or the
switching network MULTIPLEXER (SNMUX for SND and
upper ones).

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC GP- 1+


REC GP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


1...63, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the GP number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

UNIT OUTPUT UNIT AND MODE

This parameter specifies the output unit and the mode of


output.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: OUTPUT UNIT
OMT OPERATION AND MAIN.TERMINAL
If this option is selected, data are output
to the OMT.
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
If this option is selected, a measurement file
is created and the traffic data are output to
this file. The start and the finish message
include the name of the file in which the
traffic data are available for postprocessing.

Notes :
- If a file is destroyed or cannot be extended,
an advisory is sent to the OMT.

This information unit specifies the output unit.

b: OUTPUT MODE
SINGLE SINGLE TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are output
to a single measurement file.
DAILY DAILY TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are output
to daily files. The measurement starts
immediately and has no defined end. Time
parameters are not permitted.
To secure the required space on disk, all 7
daily files are prepared and created at the
start of measurement.
A daily file is closed at the end of the day
and a new file for the next day is
automatically created, or the existing file is
replaced.
Daily files will be overwritten in the
following week on the same weekday.
CYCLIC CYCLIC TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
written into a cyclic measurement file. Time
parameters are not permitted for these
measurements.
If the cyclic file runs full, the newest data
will be lost. This occurs after a period of
two days.

This information unit specifies the desired output


mode (daily, single or cyclic measurement file).
It is only permissible in connection with output
UNIT=MDD.

BEG BEGIN DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement begin date.

Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER
must be specified.
Exception: Time parameters cannot be specified for data
output in daily or cyclic files.
- A maximum of four BEG dates in chronological order may

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC GP- 2+


REC GP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

be linked with &. In the case of linked BEG dates, TER


is not permitted.
If no TER is selected, the measurement is active on the
specified BEG days only.
- The earliest possible begin date BEG is the day after
command input.
- The first BEG date must be within an interval of one
month starting from the current date.
- The other BEG dates must be within an interval of
one year starting from the current date.
- The measurement on the actual BEG day can be stopped
with STOP JOB. If the measurement is stopped on the
last BEG day, it will be finished.

Default: the begin of measurement is the current date.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

TER TERMINATION DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement termination date.

Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER
must be specified.
Exception: Time parameters may not be specified for data
output in daily or cyclic files.
- Only one termination date may be entered.
The earliest possible termination date is the day after
command input.
- The measurement duration must not exceed one year.
- If no BEG parameter is entered, recording starts
immediately.

Default: the end of measurement is determined by the last


single day (BEG).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF TERMINATION DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

IV INTERVAL TIME

This parameter indicates interval times of the measurement.

Notes:
- Interval times IV are only permitted if at least one
begin date BEG is selected.
- A maximum of 4 measurement intervals in chronological
order may be linked with &. Linked intervals have to be
at least 30 minutes apart except for measurements over
midnight.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC GP- 3+


REC GP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- An interval may not include midnight, e.g. IV =


23-00-01-00 is not permitted.
A measurement over midnight requires the input of two
interval times, e.g. IV = 00-00-01-00&23-00-00-00.
- The measurement is active during the specified interval
times only.
- The measurement can be stopped during the actual interval
IV with STOP JOB. If the measurement is stopped
during the last interval IV, it will be finished.

Default: 24-hour measurement on the specified days

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: BEGIN HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: BEGIN MINUTE=
0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

c: TERMINATION HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

d: TERMINATION MINUTE=
0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

PER PERIODIC WEEKDAY

This parameter specifies the weekdays on which data


have to be recorded.

Notes:
- Input of weekdays is only permissible in
connection with a termination date (TER).
- Up to 6 of the values may be linked with &, except
the values NO, WO and HO which cannot be
linked with other values.

Default: measurement every day during the measurement


period

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

NO NO SPECIFIED PERIOD
Measurement every day
MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY
Days which are full working days
HO HOLIDAY
Full national and international holidays are
included.
The full weekend day (the day marked EF
in the DISP WDCAT output mask) is included.
Half holidays are not included.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC GP- 4-


CAN GPRSERV

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL GENERAL PACKET RADIO SERVICE

This command deletes a Packet Data Protocol (PDP) context


subscription record. The PDP context subscription record
contains the General Packet Radio Service (GPRS) subscription
data of a mobile subscriber.
The command DISP MSUB is used to display the stored
PDP context subscription records of a mobile subscriber.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN GPRSERV : MSIN= ,PDPREC= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

PDPREC PDP RECORD

This parameter specifies a Packet Data Protocol (PDP) context


subscription record.
Enter X to delete all PDP records of the selected subscriber.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

PDPREC1 PDP RECORD ONE


PDPREC2 PDP RECORD TWO
PDPREC3 PDP RECORD THREE
PDPREC4 PDP RECORD FOUR
PDPREC5 PDP RECORD FIVE
PDPREC6 PDP RECORD SIX
PDPREC7 PDP RECORD SEVEN
PDPREC8 PDP RECORD EIGHT
PDPREC9 PDP RECORD NINE
PDPREC10 PDP RECORD TEN
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN GPRSERV- 1-


ENTR GPRSERV

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER GENERAL PACKET RADIO SERVICE

This command defines a Packet Data Protocol (PDP) context


subscription record. The PDP context subscription record
contains the General Packet Radio Service (GPRS) subscription
data of a mobile subscriber. For each subscriber it is possible
to store up to 10 PDP context subscription records.
The command DISP MSUB is used to display the stored
PDP context subscription records of a mobile subscriber.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR GPRSERV : MSIN= ,PDPREC= ,PDPADR= ,QOSPROF= [,APN=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,APNAREA=] [,CHRG=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

PDPREC PDP CONTEXT SUBSCRIPT. RECORD

This parameter identifies a Packet Data Protocol (PDP)


context subscription record.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PDPREC1 PDP RECORD ONE


PDPREC2 PDP RECORD TWO
PDPREC3 PDP RECORD THREE
PDPREC4 PDP RECORD FOUR
PDPREC5 PDP RECORD FIVE
PDPREC6 PDP RECORD SIX
PDPREC7 PDP RECORD SEVEN
PDPREC8 PDP RECORD EIGHT
PDPREC9 PDP RECORD NINE
PDPREC10 PDP RECORD TEN

PDPADR PDP ADDRESSTYPE AND ADDRESS

This parameter specifies the Packet Data Protocol (PDP)


address type and address. If no address is entered, dynamic
addressing is used.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: ADDRESSTYPE
IPV4 IP VERSION 4 ADDRESS
X25 X.25 ADDRESS
PPP POINT TO POINT PROTOCOL

This information unit specifies the PDP address type.


Incompatibility:
- If the address type is set to PPP, then it is
not allowed to enter an address.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR GPRSERV- 1+


ENTR GPRSERV

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: ADDRESS=
1...15 characters from the
symbolic name character set

This information unit specifies the PDP address.


X.25 address: Max. 14 digit decimal number.
IPv4 address: The address has to be entered with dots in the
format XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX
(X= one digit decimal number)
Leading zeros need not be entered

QOSPROF QOS PROFILE NAME

This parameter specifies the Quality of Service


profile name.

Prerequisites:
- The quality of service profile must be created (CR QOSPROF).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

APN ACCESS POINT NAME

This parameter specifies the access point name.


If no access point name is entered, the default value
"*" is used as wildcard.

Notes:
- A mobile subscriber may have multiple subscription records for the
same PDP type and the same PDP address, but with different APNs.
For each subscriber there should be only one wild card APN at most
for each PDP address (PDPADR).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...62 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

Default: *

APNAREA ACCESS POINT NAME AREA

This parameter specifies the area in which the access point


name is valid.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

HPLMN HOME PLMN ONLY


ALLPLMN ALL PLMN

Default: HPLMN

CHRG CHARGING CHARACTERISTICS

This parameter specifies the charging characteristics.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

HOTBILL HOT BILLING


FLATRATE FLAT RATE
PREPAID PREPAID
NORMAL NORMAL

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR GPRSERV- 2-


CAN GSMBCIE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CAN GSM BEARER CAPABILITY INFO ELEMENT

This command deletes a GSM bearer capability information element.

Prerequisites:
- All mobile subscribers with reference to this GSM bearer capability
infomation element have to be deleted (CAN MSUB).

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN GSMBCIE : BCN= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

BCN BEARER CAPABILITY NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN GSMBCIE- 1-


CR GSMBCIE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CR GSM BEARER CAPABILITY INFO ELEMENT

This command creates a new GSM bearer capability information element.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR GSMBCIE : BCN= <,ITC= ,TRMODE= ,RACHRQ= ,STRUCT= 1
1 1
1 ,SIGACP= ,RATEAD= ,SYNCHR= ,USRRAT= ,DATABT= 1
1 1
1 ,STOPBT= ,PARITY= ,NICORX= ,NICOTX= ,INTRAT= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,MODEMT= ,CONNEL= ,FNUSRRAT= ,UIL2PR=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

BCN BEARER CAPABILITY NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ITC INFO. TRANSFER CAPABILITY

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SPEECH SPEECH
AUDIO 3.1 KHZ AUDIO EX PLMN
UDI UNRESTRICTED DIGITAL INFO.
FAX3 FACSIMILE GROUP 3
ASFAX3 ALTERNATE SPEECH/FAX GROUP 3
alternate speech/facsimile group 3
starting with speech

TRMODE TRANSFER MODE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CM CIRCUIT MODE
PM PACKET MODE

RACHRQ RADIO CHANNEL REQUIREMENTS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

HRCH HALF RATE CHANNEL


FRCH FULL RATE CHANNEL
DHRCH DUAL/HALF RATE CHANNEL PREF.
DFRCH DUAL/FULL RATE CHANNEL PREF.

STRUCT STRUCTURE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SDUI SERVICE DATA UNIT INTEGRITY


UNSTR UNSTRUCTURED

SIGACP SIGNALING ACCESS PROTOCOL

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GSMBCIE- 1+
CR GSMBCIE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

I440 I.440/450
X21 X.21
X28DPI X.28 DEDICATED PAD INDIV. NUI
X28DPU X.28 DEDICATED PAD UNIV. NUI
X28NDP X.28 NON DEDICATED PAD
X32 X.32

RATEAD RATE ADAPTION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NRA NO RATE ADAPTION


V110 V.110/X.30 RATE ADAPTION
X31 CCITT X.31 FLAG STUFFING
H223H245 RATE ADAPTION H.223 & H.245

SYNCHR SYNCHRONOUS / ASYNCHRONOUS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SYN SYNCHRONOUS
ASYN ASYNCHRONOUS

USRRAT USER RATE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

B300 0.3KBIT/S RECOM. X.1 AND V.110


B1200 1.2KBIT/S RECOM. X.1 AND V.110
B2400 2.4KBIT/S RECOM. X.1 AND V.110
B4800 4.8KBIT/S RECOM. X.1 AND V.110
B9600 9.6KBIT/S RECOM. X.1 AND V.110
B12000 12KBIT/S
B1200B75 1.2KBIT/75BIT/S V.23,X.1,V.110

DATABT NO.OF DATA BITS EX.PARITY BIT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BIT7 7 BITS
BIT8 8 BITS

STOPBT NUMBER OF STOP BITS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BIT1 1 BIT
BIT2 2 BITS

PARITY PARITY INFORMATION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ODD ODD
EVEN EVEN
NONE NONE
FT0 FORCED TO 0
FT1 FORCED TO 1

NICORX NETWORK INDEP.CLOCK ON RECEIPT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NIC IS NOT ALLOWED


Cannot accept data with network independent
clock (NIC). This means sender does not support
this optional procedure.
YES NIC IS ALLOWED
Can accept data with network independent
clock (NIC). This means sender supports this
optional procedure.

NICOTX NETWORK INDEP.CLOCK ON TRANSM.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GSMBCIE- 2+
CR GSMBCIE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NO NIC IS NOT REQUIRED


Requires not to send data with NIC.
YES NIC IS REQUIRED
Requires to send data with NIC.

INTRAT INTERMEDIATE RATE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NONE NONE
No intermediate rate.
KBS4 4 KBIT/S
KBS8 8 KBIT/S
KBS16 16 KBIT/S

MODEMT MODEM TYPE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NONE NONE
No modem type.
V21 V.21 MODEM
V22 V.22 MODEM
V22BIS V.22 BIS MODEM
V23 V.23 MODEM
V26TER V.26 TER MODEM
V32 V.32 MODEM
UNDEF UNDEFINED
Modem for undefined interface.
OUTB1 AUTOBAUDING TYPE 1
Autobauding type 1 (used only in conjunction
with "non transparent" connection element).

CONNEL CONNECTION ELEMENT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TR TRANSPARENT
NONTR NONTRANSPARENT (RLP)
BTR BOTH, TRANSPARENT PREFERRED
BNONTR BOTH, NONTRANSPARENT PREFERRED

FNUSRRAT FIXED NETWORK USER RATE

This parameter is only allowed for basic services


B20GENR, B30GENR, B40GENR.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NOTPRES NOT PRESENT


NONE NOT APPLICABLE
B9600 9.6KBIT/S RECOM. X.1,V.110
B14400 14.4KBIT/S RECOM. X.1,V.110
B19200 19.2KBIT/S RECOM. X.1,V.110
B28800 28.8KBIT/S RECOM. X.1,V.110
B38400 38.4KBIT/S RECOM. X.1,V.110
B48000 48KBIT/S RECOM. X.1,V.110
B56000 56KBIT/S RECOM. X.1,V.110
B64000 64KBIT/S BIT TRANSPARENT

UIL2PR USER INFO. LAYER 2 PROTOCOL

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NONE NONE
UIL2PR not present
X25 RECOMMENDATION X.25 LINK LEVEL
IA5 IA5
X75 X.75 LAYER 2 MODIFIED, TELETEX
VTX1 VIDEOTEX PROFILE 1
FAX3 FACSIMILE GROUP 3
VTX3 VIDEOTEX PROFILE 3

Default: NONE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GSMBCIE- 3-
DISP GSMBCIE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISP GSM BEARER CAPABILITY INFO ELEMENT

This command displays GSM bearer capability information elements.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP GSMBCIE : BCN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

BCN BEARER CAPABILITY NAME

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP GSMBCIE- 1-


MOD GSMBCIE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MOD GSM BEARER CAPABILITY INFO ELEMENT

This command modifies a GSM bearer capability information element.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD GSMBCIE : BCN= <,ITC= ,TRMODE= ,RACHRQ= ,STRUCT= 1
1 1
1 ,SIGACP= ,RATEAD= ,SYNCHR= ,USRRAT= ,DATABT= 1
1 1
1 ,STOPBT= ,PARITY= ,NICORX= ,NICOTX= ,INTRAT= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,MODEMT= ,CONNEL= ,FNUSRRAT= ,UIL2PR=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

BCN BEARER CAPABILITY NAME

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ITC INFO. TRANSFER CAPABILITY

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SPEECH SPEECH
AUDIO 3.1 KHZ AUDIO EX PLMN
UDI UNRESTRICTED DIGITAL INFO.
FAX3 FACSIMILE GROUP 3
ASFAX3 ALTERNATE SPEECH/FAX GROUP 3
alternate speech/facsimile group 3
starting with speech

TRMODE TRANSFER MODE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CM CIRCUIT MODE
PM PACKET MODE

RACHRQ RADIO CHANNEL REQUIREMENTS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

HRCH HALF RATE CHANNEL


FRCH FULL RATE CHANNEL
DHRCH DUAL/HALF RATE CHANNEL PREF.
DFRCH DUAL/FULL RATE CHANNEL PREF.

STRUCT STRUCTURE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SDUI SERVICE DATA UNIT INTEGRITY


UNSTR UNSTRUCTURED

SIGACP SIGNALING ACCESS PROTOCOL

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GSMBCIE- 1+


MOD GSMBCIE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

I440 I.440/450
X21 X.21
X28DPI X.28 DEDICATED PAD INDIV. NUI
X28DPU X.28 DEDICATED PAD UNIV. NUI
X28NDP X.28 NON DEDICATED PAD
X32 X.32

RATEAD RATE ADAPTION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NRA NO RATE ADAPTION


V110 V.110/X.30 RATE ADAPTION
X31 CCITT X.31 FLAG STUFFING
H223H245 RATE ADAPTION H.223 & H.245

SYNCHR SYNCHRONOUS / ASYNCHRONOUS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SYN SYNCHRONOUS
ASYN ASYNCHRONOUS

USRRAT USER RATE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

B300 0.3KBIT/S RECOM. X.1 AND V.110


B1200 1.2KBIT/S RECOM. X.1 AND V.110
B2400 2.4KBIT/S RECOM. X.1 AND V.110
B4800 4.8KBIT/S RECOM. X.1 AND V.110
B9600 9.6KBIT/S RECOM. X.1 AND V.110
B12000 12KBIT/S
B1200B75 1.2KBIT/75BIT/S V.23,X.1,V.110

DATABT NO.OF DATA BITS EX.PARITY BIT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BIT7 7 BITS
BIT8 8 BITS

STOPBT NUMBER OF STOP BITS

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BIT1 1 BIT
BIT2 2 BITS

PARITY PARITY INFORMATION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ODD ODD
EVEN EVEN
NONE NONE
FT0 FORCED TO 0
FT1 FORCED TO 1

NICORX NETWORK INDEP.CLOCK ON RECEIPT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NIC IS NOT ALLOWED


Cannot accept data with network independent
clock (NIC). This means sender does not support
this optional procedure.
YES NIC IS ALLOWED
Can accept data with network independend
clock (NIC). This means sender supports this
optional procedure.

NICOTX NETWORK INDEP.CLOCK ON TRANSM.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GSMBCIE- 2+


MOD GSMBCIE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NO NIC IS NOT REQUIRED


Requires not to send data with NIC.
YES NIC IS REQUIRED
Requires to send data with NIC.

INTRAT INTERMEDIATE RATE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NONE NONE
No intermediate rate.
KBS4 4 KBIT/S
KBS8 8 KBIT/S
KBS16 16 KBIT/S

MODEMT MODEM TYPE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NONE NONE
No modem type.
V21 V.21 MODEM
V22 V.22 MODEM
V22BIS V.22 BIS MODEM
V23 V.23 MODEM
V26TER V.26 TER MODEM
V32 V.32 MODEM
UNDEF UNDEFINED
Modem for undefined interface.
OUTB1 AUTOBAUDING TYPE 1
Autobauding type 1 (used only in conjunction
with "non transparent" connection element).

CONNEL CONNECTION ELEMENT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TR TRANSPARENT
NONTR NONTRANSPARENT (RLP)
BTR BOTH, TRANSPARENT PREFERRED
BNONTR BOTH, NONTRANSPARENT PREFERRED

FNUSRRAT FIXED NETWORK USER RATE

This parameter is only allowed for basic services


B20GENR, B30GENR, B40GENR.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NOTPRES NOT PRESENT


NONE NOT APPLICABLE
B9600 9.6KBIT/S RECOM. X.1,V.110
B14400 14.4KBIT/S RECOM. X.1,V.110
B19200 19.2KBIT/S RECOM. X.1,V.110
B28800 28.8KBIT/S RECOM. X.1,V.110
B38400 38.4KBIT/S RECOM. X.1,V.110
B48000 48KBIT/S RECOM. X.1,V.110
B56000 56KBIT/S RECOM. X.1,V.110
B64000 64KBIT/S BIT TRANSPARENT

UIL2PR USER INFO. LAYER 2 PROTOCOL

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NONE NONE
UIL2PR not present
X25 RECOMMENDATION X.25 LINK LEVEL
IA5 IA5
X75 X.75 LAYER 2 MODIFIED, TELETEX
VTX1 VIDEOTEX PROFILE 1
FAX3 FACSIMILE GROUP 3
VTX3 VIDEOTEX PROFILE 3

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GSMBCIE- 3-


CAN GTCGPACD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CAN GTT CALLING PARTY ADDR. CONV. DATA

This command cancels global title translation calling party address


conversion data.

Notes:
- The command will be rejected if:
- the translator identification does not exist
- no calling party address conversion data is entered
- a data inconsistency in the GTT database occurred.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN GTCGPACD : TRID= ,FNETW= ,TNETW= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FNETW FROM NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the originating network.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

TNETW TO NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the destinating network.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN GTCGPACD- 1-


DISP GTCGPACD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISP GTT CALLING PARTY ADDR. CONV. DATA

This command displays the global title translation calling party address
conversion data of the concerned tree(s).

The command is stoppable with the STOP DISP command.

Notes:
- When no data was found for the query, the message "NO (MORE) DATA FOR
DISPLAY AVAILABLE" will be displayed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP GTCGPACD : TRID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP GTCGPACD- 1-


ENTR GTCGPACD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER GTT CALLING PARTY ADDR. CONV. DATA

This command enters global title translation calling party address conversion
data for an existing digit tree in a gateway node.

Whenever a SCCP message is transferred to another network (in a gateway node),


it might be necessary to transform the calling party address (e.g. if we, as
gateway node, transfer a message from the national network to the international
network, we have to transform the national global title number to an
international number).

The calling party address depends on the following items:


- Translation type of the calling party address
- Numbering plan of the calling party address
- Nature of address of the calling party address
- The netwerk border to be crossed.

Prerequisites:

Notes:
- The command will be rejected if:
- the translator identification does not exist
- a data inconsistency in the GTT database occurred.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR GTCGPACD : TRID= ,FNETW= ,TNETW= [,TTID=] [,NP=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,NA=] [,DICON=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FNETW FROM NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the originating network.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

TNETW TO NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the destinating network.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

TTID TRANSLATION TYPE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the translation type identifier for the


modified global title of the calling party address.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR GTCGPACD- 1+


ENTR GTCGPACD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UNKNOWN TRANSLATION TYPE UNKNOWN


IMSI INTERNATIONAL MOBILE SUB. ID.
CCV CREDIT CARD VERIFICATION
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
INDD IN DIALED DIGITS
INCGPA IN CALLING PARTY ADDRESS
INPPDD IN PREFIX PLUS DIALED DIGITS
IEESS ISDN END-TO-END SUPPL. SERV.
ITCC INT. TELECOMM. CHARGE CARD
TT9 TRANSLATION TYPE 9
TT10 TRANSLATION TYPE 10
TT11 TRANSLATION TYPE 11
TT12 TRANSLATION TYPE 12
TT13 TRANSLATION TYPE 13
TT14 TRANSLATION TYPE 14
TT15 TRANSLATION TYPE 15
TT16 TRANSLATION TYPE 16
TT17 TRANSLATION TYPE 17
TT18 TRANSLATION TYPE 18
TT19 TRANSLATION TYPE 19
TT20 TRANSLATION TYPE 20
TT21 TRANSLATION TYPE 21
TT22 TRANSLATION TYPE 22
TT23 TRANSLATION TYPE 23
TT24 TRANSLATION TYPE 24
TT25 TRANSLATION TYPE 25
TT26 TRANSLATION TYPE 26
TT27 TRANSLATION TYPE 27
TT28 TRANSLATION TYPE 28
TT29 TRANSLATION TYPE 29
TT30 TRANSLATION TYPE 30
TT31 TRANSLATION TYPE 31

NP NUMBERING PLAN

This parameter specifies the new numbering plan for the modified global
title of the calling party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UNKNOWN NUMBERING PLAN UNKNOWN


ISDNTNP ISDN TELEPHONY NUMBERING PLAN
NP2 NUMBERING PLAN 2
DATANP DATA NUMBERING PLAN
TELEXNP TELEX NUMBERING PLAN
MMNP MARITIME MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
LMNP LAND MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
ISDNMNP ISDN MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
NP8 NUMBERING PLAN 8
NP9 NUMBERING PLAN 9
NP10 NUMBERING PLAN 10
NP11 NUMBERING PLAN 11
NP12 NUMBERING PLAN 12
NP13 NUMBERING PLAN 13
PNP PRIVATE NUMBERING PLAN
NP15 NUMBERING PLAN 15

NA NATURE OF ADDRESS INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the new nature of address for the modified
global title of the calling party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UNKNOWN NATURE OF ADDRESS UNKNOWN


SUBNO SUBSCRIBER NUMBER
NATUSE NATIONAL USE
NATNO NATIONAL SIGNIFICANT NUMBER
INTNO INTERNATIONAL NUMBER
NA5 NATURE OF ADDRESS 5
NA6 NATURE OF ADDRESS 6
NA7 NATURE OF ADDRESS 7
NA8 NATURE OF ADDRESS 8

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR GTCGPACD- 2+


ENTR GTCGPACD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NA9 NATURE OF ADDRESS 9


NA10 NATURE OF ADDRESS 10
NA11 NATURE OF ADDRESS 11
NA12 NATURE OF ADDRESS 12
NA13 NATURE OF ADDRESS 13
NA14 NATURE OF ADDRESS 14
NA15 NATURE OF ADDRESS 15

DICON DIGIT CONVERSION CODE

This parameter specifies how the existing global title digits are to be
modified. The following modifications can be made:
- replacement of digits
- insertion/append of digits
- removal of digits.

The modifications are specified in the form of a mask which consists


of control characters and digits.

Possible digit values : 0..9, *, #, A..F


Possible control characters : X, ., +, R and S

The control characters signify the following:


X : The corresponding digit value in the old code remains unchanged.
. : The corresponding digit value in the old code is omitted.
+ : The digit values following this control character are to be
inserted or to be appended in the corresponding position.
R : The digit values following this control character replace the
corresponding digit values in the old code.
S : The conversion is stopped : all digit values in the old code,
from the corresponding position on, are omitted.

e.g. GTDIG=004921
DICON=....+0032
The converted GT digits are 003221.

e.g. GTDIG=00492134
DICON=..R32XXS
The converted GT digits are 3221.

If the parameter is omitted, no digit conversion will take place.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...13 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR GTCGPACD- 3-


CAN GTCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. CODE POINT

This command cancels a global title translation code point.

Prerequisites:
- Associated global title translation destinations have to be cancelled
prior to the execution of this command.

Notes:
- The command will be rejected if:
- the translator identification does not exist
- the global title digit pattern does not exist
- there is still a destination assigned to this code point
- a data inconsistency in the GTT database occurred.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN GTCPT : TRID= ,GTDIG= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN GTCPT- 1-


CR GTCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. CODE POINT

This command creates a global title translation code point.


This code point contains the information required for global title translation
purposes.

This command should be executed prior to the global title translation desti-
nation commands.

Prerequisites:

Notes:
- The command will be rejected if:
- the translator identification does not exist
- the global digit pattern exists already
- the code point digits or a part of the code point digits already
exist, e.g. :
The code point with GTDIG = 1234 already exists.
An attempt to create a code point with GTDIG = 12 or
GTDIG = 123456 will be rejected.
- a GTT database table is saturated
- a data inconsistency in the GTT database occurred.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR GTCPT : TRID= ,GTDIG= [,DICON=] [,NP=] [,NA=] [,TTID=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,ND=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DICON DIGIT CONVERSION CODE

This parameter specifies how the existing global title digits are to be
modified. The following modifications can be made:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTCPT- 1+
CR GTCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- replacement of digits
- insertion of digits
- removal of digits.

The modifications are specified in the form of a mask which consists


of control characters and digits.

Possible digit values : 0..9, *, #, A..F


Possible control characters : X, ., +, R and S

The control characters signify the following:


X : The corresponding digit value in the old code remains unchanged.
. : The corresponding digit value in the old code is omitted.
+ : The digit values following this control character are to be
inserted or to be appended in the corresponding position.
R : The digit values following this control character replace the
corresponding digit values in the old code.
S : The conversion is stopped : all digit values in the old code,
from the corresponding position on, are omitted.

e.g. GTDIG=004921
DICON=....+0032
The converted GT digits are 003221.

e.g. GTDIG=004921
DICON=..R32XXS
The converted GT digits are 3221.

If the parameter is omitted, no digit conversion will take place.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...13 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NP NUMBERING PLAN

This parameter specifies the new numbering plan for the modified global
title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UNKNOWN NUMBERING PLAN UNKNOWN


ISDNTNP ISDN TELEPHONY NUMBERING PLAN
NP2 NUMBERING PLAN 2
DATANP DATA NUMBERING PLAN
TELEXNP TELEX NUMBERING PLAN
MMNP MARITIME MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
LMNP LAND MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
ISDNMNP ISDN MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
NP8 NUMBERING PLAN 8
NP9 NUMBERING PLAN 9
NP10 NUMBERING PLAN 10
NP11 NUMBERING PLAN 11
NP12 NUMBERING PLAN 12
NP13 NUMBERING PLAN 13
PNP PRIVATE NUMBERING PLAN
NP15 NUMBERING PLAN 15

NA NATURE OF ADDRESS INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the new nature of address for the modified
global title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UNKNOWN NATURE OF ADDRESS UNKNOWN


SUBNO SUBSCRIBER NUMBER
NATUSE RESERVED FOR NATIONAL USE
NATNO NATIONAL SIGNIFICANT NUMBER
INTNO INTERNATIONAL NUMBER
NA5 NATURE OF ADDRESS 5
NA6 NATURE OF ADDRESS 6
NA7 NATURE OF ADDRESS 7
NA8 NATURE OF ADDRESS 8
NA9 NATURE OF ADDRESS 9

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTCPT- 2+
CR GTCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NA10 NATURE OF ADDRESS 10


NA11 NATURE OF ADDRESS 11
NA12 NATURE OF ADDRESS 12
NA13 NATURE OF ADDRESS 13
NA14 NATURE OF ADDRESS 14
NA15 NATURE OF ADDRESS 15

TTID TRANSLATION TYPE IDENTIFICAT.

This parameter specifies the new translation type identification for


the modified global title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UNKNOWN TRANSLATION TYPE UNKNOWN


IMSI INTERNATIONAL MOBILE SUB. ID.
CCV CREDIT CARD VERIFICATION
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
INDD IN DIALED DIGITS
INCGPA IN CALLING PARTY ADDRESS
INPPDD IN PREFIX PLUS DIALED DIGITS
IEESS ISDN END-TO-END SUPPL. SERV.
ITCC INT. TELECOMM. CHARGE CARD
TT9 TRANSLATION TYPE 9
TT10 TRANSLATION TYPE 10
TT11 TRANSLATION TYPE 11
TT12 TRANSLATION TYPE 12
TT13 TRANSLATION TYPE 13
TT14 TRANSLATION TYPE 14
TT15 TRANSLATION TYPE 15
TT16 TRANSLATION TYPE 16
TT17 TRANSLATION TYPE 17
TT18 TRANSLATION TYPE 18
TT19 TRANSLATION TYPE 19
TT20 TRANSLATION TYPE 20
TT21 TRANSLATION TYPE 21
TT22 TRANSLATION TYPE 22
TT23 TRANSLATION TYPE 23
TT24 TRANSLATION TYPE 24
TT25 TRANSLATION TYPE 25
TT26 TRANSLATION TYPE 26
TT27 TRANSLATION TYPE 27
TT28 TRANSLATION TYPE 28
TT29 TRANSLATION TYPE 29
TT30 TRANSLATION TYPE 30
TT31 TRANSLATION TYPE 31

ND NETWORK DISCRIMINATOR

This parameter specifies if the global title addresses a national or


international subscriber and to which network it belongs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NATOWN NAT. SUB. & OWN NETWORK


NATFOR NAT. SUB. & FOREIGN NETWORK
INTFOR INT. SUB. & FOREIGN NETWORK

Default: NATOWN

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTCPT- 3-
DISP GTCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. CODE POINT

This command displays the global title translation code point.

If the GTDIG parameter is omitted, all the code point information of the
requested digit tree(s), identified by the translator identification, will be
displayed.

Notes:
- When no data was found for the query, the message "NO (MORE) DATA FOR
DISPLAY AVAILABLE" will be displayed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP GTCPT : TRID= [,GTDIG=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.
If the parameter is omitted, all the code points of the concerned
TRID will be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP GTCPT- 1-


MERGE GTCPT
INTERNAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MERGE GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. CODE POINT

This command merges a global title translation code point.

Parallel code points are code points that have all but their last digit
in common. If such code points ( and their associated destination
information ) exist, merging cancels those parallel code points (
and the associated destination ) and creates a new code point with a new
destination.
Compared with the parallel code points, the new code point has the
parallel code points’ digit combination, shortened by the last digit.
The digit combination of the new code point is given in the GTDIG
parameter.

The new code point can have one of the following destination types :
- LTG processor number in the own switch
- internal route, i.e. signaling point in the own area
- translator service group
- subsystem group
- retranslation in the own node.
The route parameter decides which optional parameter values should be entered.

Prerequisites:
- The global title translation digit tree must have been created.
- The global title translation code points to be merged must have been created.
- The global title translation destinations of the code points to be
merged, must have been created.
- The particular destination route ( e.g. a translator service group )
must have been created in the SCCP database.

Notes:
- The command will be rejected if:
- the translator identification does not exist
- no parallel code points exist
- one or more parallel code points do not have associated destination
information
- one or more parallel code points have associated destination
information that requires retranslation in the own node
- the particular destination route does not exist in the SCCP
database
- the new code point exists already
- a specific global title translation database table is saturated
- a data inconsistency in the GTT database occurred.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MERGE GTCPT - INTERNAL INTERNAL ROUTE


2. MERGE GTCPT - LTGNR LTG PROCESSOR NUMBER ROUTE
3. MERGE GTCPT - RETRANS RETRANSLATION ROUTE
4. MERGE GTCPT - SSG SUBSYSTEM GROUP ROUTE
5. MERGE GTCPT - TRLG TRANSLATOR GROUP ROUTE

1. Input format

INTERNAL ROUTE

This input format is used for creating a signaling point in the own area
as a global title translation destination for the new code point.

Prerequisites:
- The specified destination point code must have been created.
- The specified subsystem must have been created.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MERGE GTCPT : TRID= ,GTDIG= ,ROUTE= [,RTGP=] ,DPC= ,NI= 1
1 1
1 [,SSID=] [,DICON=] [,TTID=] [,NP=] [,NA=] 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 1+


MERGE GTCPT
INTERNAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,ND=] [,PPN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits of the new code point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTE ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the global title translation


destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTERNAL INTERNAL ROUTE

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences.


RTGP=CANGT indicates that the GT digits should be cancelled.
RTGP=PGTT indicates that another global title translation is
required in the next node.
RTGP=SPCINC indicates that the new called party address contains a
signaling point.

If the parameter is omitted, the following default value will be used :


- the global title will be kept ( then the DICON will be taken into
account )
- no global title translation is to be performed in the next node
- no signaling point is included in the new called party address.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CANGT CANCEL GLOBAL TITLE


SPCINC SIGNALING POINT CODE INCLUDED

DPC DESTINATION POINT CODE

Network Indicator = NAT0 Units = 4-3-4-3


Network Indicator = INAT0 Units = 3-8-3
Network Indicator = NAT1 Units = 4-3-4-3
Network Indicator = INAT1 Units = 3-8-3

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 2+


MERGE GTCPT
INTERNAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: DESTINATION POINT CODE UNIT1=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

b: DESTINATION POINT CODE UNIT2=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: DESTINATION POINT CODE UNIT3=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: DESTINATION POINT CODE UNIT4=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

NI NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the network concerned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

Default: INAT0

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFICATION

*FUTSS01:

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC ACCOUNT CARD CALLING


AWC AREA WIDE CENTREX
BSSAP BS SYSTEM APPLICATION PART
BSSMA BSSAP MAINTENANCE
CCC CREDIT CARD CALLING
DBC DEBIT CENTER
FPH FREEPHONE SERVICE
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01
FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
FUTSS11 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 11
FUTSS12 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 12
FUTSS13 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 13
FUTSS14 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 14
FUTSS15 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 15
FUTSS16 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 16
IGAP IRRIDIUM GATEWAY APPL. PART
IN IN APPLICATION IN SSP
IN2 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 3
IN4 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 4
IN5 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 5
ISS ISDN SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES
ISUP ISDN USER PART
MAP MOBILE APPLICATION PART
MAPAC MOBILE APPLICATION PART AC
MAPEIR MOBILE APPLICATION PART EIR
MAPHLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART HLR

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 3+


MERGE GTCPT
INTERNAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MAPMSC MOBILE APPLICATION PART MSC


MAPVLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART VLR
OMAP OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE ADM.
PN PERSONAL NUMBER
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TIS TELEINFO SERVICE
TSTUP TEST USER PART
TV TELEVOTING
UN UNIVERSAL NUMBER
UPT UNIVERSAL PERSONAL TELECOMM.
VPN VIRTUAL PRIVATE NETWORK

DICON DIGIT CONVERSION CODE

This parameter specifies how the existing global title digits are to be
modified. The following modifications can be made:
- replacement of digits
- insertion of digits
- removal of digits.

The modifications are specified in the form of a mask which consists


of control characters and digits.

Possible digit values : 0..9, *, #, A..F


Possible control characters : X, ., +, R and S

The control characters signify the following:


X : The corresponding digit value in the old code remains unchanged.
. : The corresponding digit value in the old code is omitted.
+ : The digit values following this control character are to be
inserted or to be appended in the corresponding position.
R : The digit values following this control character replace the
corresponding digit values in the old code.
S : The conversion is stopped : all digit values in the old code,
from the corresponding position on, are omitted.

e.g. GTDIG=004921
DICON=....+0032
The converted GT digits are 003221.

e.g. GTDIG=004921
DICON=..R32XXS
The converted GT digits are 3221.

If the parameter is omitted, no digit conversion will take place.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...13 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TTID TRANSLATION TYPE IDENTIFICAT.

This parameter specifies the new translation type identification for


the modified global title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CCV CREDIT CARD VERIFICATION


IEESS ISDN END-TO-END SUPPL. SERV.
IMSI INTERNATIONAL MOBILE SUB. ID.
INCGPA IN CALLING PARTY ADDRESS
INDD IN DIALED DIGITS
INPPDD IN PREFIX PLUS DIALED DIGITS
ITCC INT. TELECOMM. CHARGE CARD
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TT10 TRANSLATION TYPE 10
TT11 TRANSLATION TYPE 11
TT12 TRANSLATION TYPE 12
TT13 TRANSLATION TYPE 13
TT14 TRANSLATION TYPE 14
TT15 TRANSLATION TYPE 15
TT16 TRANSLATION TYPE 16
TT17 TRANSLATION TYPE 17
TT18 TRANSLATION TYPE 18
TT19 TRANSLATION TYPE 19
TT20 TRANSLATION TYPE 20

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 4+


MERGE GTCPT
INTERNAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TT21 TRANSLATION TYPE 21


TT22 TRANSLATION TYPE 22
TT23 TRANSLATION TYPE 23
TT24 TRANSLATION TYPE 24
TT25 TRANSLATION TYPE 25
TT26 TRANSLATION TYPE 26
TT27 TRANSLATION TYPE 27
TT28 TRANSLATION TYPE 28
TT29 TRANSLATION TYPE 29
TT30 TRANSLATION TYPE 30
TT31 TRANSLATION TYPE 31
TT9 TRANSLATION TYPE 9
UNKNOWN TRANSLATION TYPE UNKNOWN

NP NUMBERING PLAN

This parameter specifies the new numbering plan for the modified global
title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DATANP DATA NUMBERING PLAN


ISDNMNP ISDN MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
ISDNTNP ISDN TELEPHONY NUMBERING PLAN
LMNP LAND MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
MMNP MARITIME MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
NP10 NUMBERING PLAN 10
NP11 NUMBERING PLAN 11
NP12 NUMBERING PLAN 12
NP13 NUMBERING PLAN 13
NP15 NUMBERING PLAN 15
NP2 NUMBERING PLAN 2
NP8 NUMBERING PLAN 8
NP9 NUMBERING PLAN 9
PNP PRIVATE NUMBERING PLAN
TELEXNP TELEX NUMBERING PLAN
UNKNOWN NUMBERING PLAN UNKNOWN

NA NATURE OF ADDRESS

This parameter specifies the new nature of address for the modified
global title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTNO INTERNATIONAL NUMBER


NATNO NATIONAL SIGNIFICANT NUMBER
NATUSE RESERVED FOR NATIONAL USE
NA10 NATURE OF ADDRESS 10
NA11 NATURE OF ADDRESS 11
NA12 NATURE OF ADDRESS 12
NA13 NATURE OF ADDRESS 13
NA14 NATURE OF ADDRESS 14
NA15 NATURE OF ADDRESS 15
NA5 NATURE OF ADDRESS 5
NA6 NATURE OF ADDRESS 6
NA7 NATURE OF ADDRESS 7
NA8 NATURE OF ADDRESS 8
NA9 NATURE OF ADDRESS 9
SUBNO SUBSCRIBER NUMBER
UNKNOWN NATURE OF ADDRESS UNKNOWN

ND NETWORK DISCRIMINATOR

This parameter specifies if the global title addresses a national or


international subscriber and to which network it belongs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTFOR INT. SUB. & FOREIGN NETWORK


NATFOR NAT. SUB. & FOREIGN NETWORK
NATOWN NAT. SUB. & OWN NETWORK

Default: NATOWN

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 5+


MERGE GTCPT
INTERNAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PPN PORTABILITY PROCESSING NEEDED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
NO NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
Y PORTABILITY PROCESSING
YES PORTABILITY PROCESSING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 6+


MERGE GTCPT
LTGNR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

LTG PROCESSOR NUMBER ROUTE

This input format is used for creating a LTG processor number as a


global title translation destination for the new code point.

Prerequisites:
- The specified LTG has to exist. For this purpose, the CR LTG command has
to be executed prior to the MERGE GTCPT command.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MERGE GTCPT : TRID= ,GTDIG= ,ROUTE= [,RTGP=] ,LTGNR= ,NI= 1
1 1
1 [,SSID=] [,DICON=] [,TTID=] [,NP=] [,NA=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,ND=] [,PPN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits of the new code point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTE ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the global title translation


destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LTGNR LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences.


RTGP=CANGT indicates that the GT digits should be cancelled.
RTGP=PGTT indicates that another global title translation is
required in the next node.
RTGP=SPCINC indicates that the new called party address contains a
signaling point.

If the parameter is omitted, the following default value will be used :


- the global title will be kept ( then the DICON will be taken into

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 7+


MERGE GTCPT
LTGNR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

account )
- no global title translation is to be performed in the next node
- no signaling point is included in the new called party address.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CANGT CANCEL GLOBAL TITLE


PGTT PERFORM GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL.
SPCINC SIGNALING POINT CODE INCLUDED

LTGNR LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the LTG a message has to be relayed to by


the CP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

Dependent on the Switching Network Hardware this unit


represents the Time Stage Group (TSG for SNB) or the
Switching Network MULTIPLEXER (SNMUX for SND and upper ones)

Default: 0

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


0...63, range of decimal numbers

NI NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the network concerned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

Default: INAT0

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFICATION

*FUTSS01:

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC ACCOUNT CARD CALLING


AWC AREA WIDE CENTREX
BSSAP BS SYSTEM APPLICATION PART
BSSMA BSSAP MAINTENANCE
CCC CREDIT CARD CALLING
DBC DEBIT CENTER
FPH FREEPHONE SERVICE
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01
FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
FUTSS11 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 11
FUTSS12 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 12
FUTSS13 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 13
FUTSS14 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 14
FUTSS15 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 15
FUTSS16 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 16
IGAP IRRIDIUM GATEWAY APPL. PART

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 8+


MERGE GTCPT
LTGNR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

IN IN APPLICATION IN SSP
IN2 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 3
IN4 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 4
IN5 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 5
ISS ISDN SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES
ISUP ISDN USER PART
MAP MOBILE APPLICATION PART
MAPAC MOBILE APPLICATION PART AC
MAPEIR MOBILE APPLICATION PART EIR
MAPHLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART HLR
MAPMSC MOBILE APPLICATION PART MSC
MAPVLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART VLR
OMAP OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE ADM.
PN PERSONAL NUMBER
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TIS TELEINFO SERVICE
TSTUP TEST USER PART
TV TELEVOTING
UN UNIVERSAL NUMBER
UPT UNIVERSAL PERSONAL TELECOMM.
VPN VIRTUAL PRIVATE NETWORK

DICON DIGIT CONVERSION CODE

This parameter specifies how the existing global title digits are to be
modified. The following modifications can be made:
- replacement of digits
- insertion of digits
- removal of digits.

The modifications are specified in the form of a mask which consists


of control characters and digits.

Possible digit values : 0..9, *, #, A..F


Possible control characters : X, ., +, R and S

The control characters signify the following:


X : The corresponding digit value in the old code remains unchanged.
. : The corresponding digit value in the old code is omitted.
+ : The digit values following this control character are to be
inserted or to be appended in the corresponding position.
R : The digit values following this control character replace the
corresponding digit values in the old code.
S : The conversion is stopped : all digit values in the old code,
from the corresponding position on, are omitted.

e.g. GTDIG=004921
DICON=....+0032
The converted GT digits are 003221.

e.g. GTDIG=004921
DICON=..R32XXS
The converted GT digits are 3221.

If the parameter is omitted, no digit conversion will take place.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...13 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TTID TRANSLATION TYPE IDENTIFICAT.

This parameter specifies the new translation type identification for


the modified global title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CCV CREDIT CARD VERIFICATION


IEESS ISDN END-TO-END SUPPL. SERV.
IMSI INTERNATIONAL MOBILE SUB. ID.
INCGPA IN CALLING PARTY ADDRESS
INDD IN DIALED DIGITS
INPPDD IN PREFIX PLUS DIALED DIGITS
ITCC INT. TELECOMM. CHARGE CARD
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 9+


MERGE GTCPT
LTGNR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TT10 TRANSLATION TYPE 10


TT11 TRANSLATION TYPE 11
TT12 TRANSLATION TYPE 12
TT13 TRANSLATION TYPE 13
TT14 TRANSLATION TYPE 14
TT15 TRANSLATION TYPE 15
TT16 TRANSLATION TYPE 16
TT17 TRANSLATION TYPE 17
TT18 TRANSLATION TYPE 18
TT19 TRANSLATION TYPE 19
TT20 TRANSLATION TYPE 20
TT21 TRANSLATION TYPE 21
TT22 TRANSLATION TYPE 22
TT23 TRANSLATION TYPE 23
TT24 TRANSLATION TYPE 24
TT25 TRANSLATION TYPE 25
TT26 TRANSLATION TYPE 26
TT27 TRANSLATION TYPE 27
TT28 TRANSLATION TYPE 28
TT29 TRANSLATION TYPE 29
TT30 TRANSLATION TYPE 30
TT31 TRANSLATION TYPE 31
TT9 TRANSLATION TYPE 9
UNKNOWN TRANSLATION TYPE UNKNOWN

NP NUMBERING PLAN

This parameter specifies the new numbering plan for the modified global
title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DATANP DATA NUMBERING PLAN


ISDNMNP ISDN MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
ISDNTNP ISDN TELEPHONY NUMBERING PLAN
LMNP LAND MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
MMNP MARITIME MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
NP10 NUMBERING PLAN 10
NP11 NUMBERING PLAN 11
NP12 NUMBERING PLAN 12
NP13 NUMBERING PLAN 13
NP15 NUMBERING PLAN 15
NP2 NUMBERING PLAN 2
NP8 NUMBERING PLAN 8
NP9 NUMBERING PLAN 9
PNP PRIVATE NUMBERING PLAN
TELEXNP TELEX NUMBERING PLAN
UNKNOWN NUMBERING PLAN UNKNOWN

NA NATURE OF ADDRESS

This parameter specifies the new nature of address for the modified
global title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTNO INTERNATIONAL NUMBER


NATNO NATIONAL SIGNIFICANT NUMBER
NATUSE RESERVED FOR NATIONAL USE
NA10 NATURE OF ADDRESS 10
NA11 NATURE OF ADDRESS 11
NA12 NATURE OF ADDRESS 12
NA13 NATURE OF ADDRESS 13
NA14 NATURE OF ADDRESS 14
NA15 NATURE OF ADDRESS 15
NA5 NATURE OF ADDRESS 5
NA6 NATURE OF ADDRESS 6
NA7 NATURE OF ADDRESS 7
NA8 NATURE OF ADDRESS 8
NA9 NATURE OF ADDRESS 9
SUBNO SUBSCRIBER NUMBER
UNKNOWN NATURE OF ADDRESS UNKNOWN

ND NETWORK DISCRIMINATOR

This parameter specifies if the global title addresses a national or


international subscriber and to which network it belongs.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 10+


MERGE GTCPT
LTGNR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTFOR INT. SUB. & FOREIGN NETWORK


NATFOR NAT. SUB. & FOREIGN NETWORK
NATOWN NAT. SUB. & OWN NETWORK

Default: NATOWN

PPN PORTABILITY PROCESSING NEEDED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
NO NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
Y PORTABILITY PROCESSING
YES PORTABILITY PROCESSING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 11+


MERGE GTCPT
RETRANS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

RETRANSLATION ROUTE

This input format is used for creating a linked code point as a


global title translation destination for the new code point.

Prerequisites :
- The specified LTRID must have been created.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MERGE GTCPT : TRID= ,GTDIG= ,ROUTE= [,DICON=] [,NP=] [,NA=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,TTID=] [,ND=] ,LTRID= [,RDIG=] [,PPN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits of the new code point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTE ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the global title translation


destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

RETRANS RETRANSLATION IN OWN NODE

DICON DIGIT CONVERSION CODE

This parameter specifies how the existing global title digits are to be
modified. The following modifications can be made:
- replacement of digits
- insertion of digits
- removal of digits.

The modifications are specified in the form of a mask which consists


of control characters and digits.

Possible digit values : 0..9, *, #, A..F


Possible control characters : X, ., +, R and S

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 12+


MERGE GTCPT
RETRANS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The control characters signify the following:


X : The corresponding digit value in the old code remains unchanged.
. : The corresponding digit value in the old code is omitted.
+ : The digit values following this control character are to be
inserted or to be appended in the corresponding position.
R : The digit values following this control character replace the
corresponding digit values in the old code.
S : The conversion is stopped : all digit values in the old code,
from the corresponding position on, are omitted.

e.g. GTDIG=004921
DICON=....+0032
The converted GT digits are 003221.

e.g. GTDIG=004921
DICON=..R32XXS
The converted GT digits are 3221.

If the parameter is omitted, no digit conversion will take place.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...13 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NP NUMBERING PLAN

This parameter specifies the new numbering plan for the modified global
title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DATANP DATA NUMBERING PLAN


ISDNMNP ISDN MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
ISDNTNP ISDN TELEPHONY NUMBERING PLAN
LMNP LAND MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
MMNP MARITIME MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
NP10 NUMBERING PLAN 10
NP11 NUMBERING PLAN 11
NP12 NUMBERING PLAN 12
NP13 NUMBERING PLAN 13
NP15 NUMBERING PLAN 15
NP2 NUMBERING PLAN 2
NP8 NUMBERING PLAN 8
NP9 NUMBERING PLAN 9
PNP PRIVATE NUMBERING PLAN
TELEXNP TELEX NUMBERING PLAN
UNKNOWN NUMBERING PLAN UNKNOWN

NA NATURE OF ADDRESS

This parameter specifies the new nature of address for the modified
global title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTNO INTERNATIONAL NUMBER


NATNO NATIONAL SIGNIFICANT NUMBER
NATUSE RESERVED FOR NATIONAL USE
NA10 NATURE OF ADDRESS 10
NA11 NATURE OF ADDRESS 11
NA12 NATURE OF ADDRESS 12
NA13 NATURE OF ADDRESS 13
NA14 NATURE OF ADDRESS 14
NA15 NATURE OF ADDRESS 15
NA5 NATURE OF ADDRESS 5
NA6 NATURE OF ADDRESS 6
NA7 NATURE OF ADDRESS 7
NA8 NATURE OF ADDRESS 8
NA9 NATURE OF ADDRESS 9
SUBNO SUBSCRIBER NUMBER
UNKNOWN NATURE OF ADDRESS UNKNOWN

TTID TRANSLATION TYPE IDENTIFICAT.

This parameter specifies the new translation type identification for


the modified global title of the called party address.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 13+


MERGE GTCPT
RETRANS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CCV CREDIT CARD VERIFICATION


IEESS ISDN END-TO-END SUPPL. SERV.
IMSI INTERNATIONAL MOBILE SUB. ID.
INCGPA IN CALLING PARTY ADDRESS
INDD IN DIALED DIGITS
INPPDD IN PREFIX PLUS DIALED DIGITS
ITCC INT. TELECOMM. CHARGE CARD
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TT10 TRANSLATION TYPE 10
TT11 TRANSLATION TYPE 11
TT12 TRANSLATION TYPE 12
TT13 TRANSLATION TYPE 13
TT14 TRANSLATION TYPE 14
TT15 TRANSLATION TYPE 15
TT16 TRANSLATION TYPE 16
TT17 TRANSLATION TYPE 17
TT18 TRANSLATION TYPE 18
TT19 TRANSLATION TYPE 19
TT20 TRANSLATION TYPE 20
TT21 TRANSLATION TYPE 21
TT22 TRANSLATION TYPE 22
TT23 TRANSLATION TYPE 23
TT24 TRANSLATION TYPE 24
TT25 TRANSLATION TYPE 25
TT26 TRANSLATION TYPE 26
TT27 TRANSLATION TYPE 27
TT28 TRANSLATION TYPE 28
TT29 TRANSLATION TYPE 29
TT30 TRANSLATION TYPE 30
TT31 TRANSLATION TYPE 31
TT9 TRANSLATION TYPE 9
UNKNOWN TRANSLATION TYPE UNKNOWN

ND NETWORK DISCRIMINATOR

This parameter specifies if the global title addresses a national or


international subscriber and to which network it belongs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTFOR INT. SUB. & FOREIGN NETWORK


NATFOR NAT. SUB. & FOREIGN NETWORK
NATOWN NAT. SUB. & OWN NETWORK

Default: NATOWN

LTRID LINKED TRANSLATOR IDENTIF.

This parameter specifies the linked translator identification.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

RDIG RETRANSLATION DIGIT POSITION

This parameter specifies the first digit to be retranslated in the


own node.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24, range of decimal numbers

PPN PORTABILITY PROCESSING NEEDED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
NO NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
Y PORTABILITY PROCESSING
YES PORTABILITY PROCESSING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 14+


MERGE GTCPT
SSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

SUBSYSTEM GROUP ROUTE

This input format is used for creating a subsystem group as a


global title translation destination for the new code point.

Prerequisites:
- The subsystem group must have been created.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MERGE GTCPT : TRID= ,GTDIG= ,ROUTE= [,RTGP=] ,SSG= [,SSID=] 1
1 1
1 [,DICON=] [,TTID=] [,NP=] [,NA=] [,ND=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,PPN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits of the new code point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTE ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the global title translation


destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SSG SUBSYSTEM GROUP

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences.


RTGP=CANGT indicates that the GT digits should be cancelled.
RTGP=PGTT indicates that another global title translation is
required in the next node.
RTGP=SPCINC indicates that the new called party address contains a
signaling point.

If the parameter is omitted, the following default value will be used :


- the global title will be kept ( then the DICON will be taken into
account )

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 15+


MERGE GTCPT
SSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- no global title translation is to be performed in the next node


- no signaling point is included in the new called party address.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CANGT CANCEL GLOBAL TITLE


SPCINC SIGNALING POINT CODE INCLUDED

SSG SUBSYSTEM GROUP

This parameter specifies the subsystem group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFICATION

*FUTSS01:

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC ACCOUNT CARD CALLING


AWC AREA WIDE CENTREX
BSSAP BS SYSTEM APPLICATION PART
BSSMA BSSAP MAINTENANCE
CCC CREDIT CARD CALLING
DBC DEBIT CENTER
FPH FREEPHONE SERVICE
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01
FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
FUTSS11 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 11
FUTSS12 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 12
FUTSS13 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 13
FUTSS14 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 14
FUTSS15 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 15
FUTSS16 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 16
IGAP IRRIDIUM GATEWAY APPL. PART
IN IN APPLICATION IN SSP
IN2 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 3
IN4 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 4
IN5 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 5
ISS ISDN SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES
ISUP ISDN USER PART
MAP MOBILE APPLICATION PART
MAPAC MOBILE APPLICATION PART AC
MAPEIR MOBILE APPLICATION PART EIR
MAPHLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART HLR
MAPMSC MOBILE APPLICATION PART MSC
MAPVLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART VLR
OMAP OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE ADM.
PN PERSONAL NUMBER
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TIS TELEINFO SERVICE
TSTUP TEST USER PART
TV TELEVOTING
UN UNIVERSAL NUMBER
UPT UNIVERSAL PERSONAL TELECOMM.
VPN VIRTUAL PRIVATE NETWORK

DICON DIGIT CONVERSION CODE

This parameter specifies how the existing global title digits are to be
modified. The following modifications can be made:
- replacement of digits

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 16+


MERGE GTCPT
SSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- insertion of digits
- removal of digits.

The modifications are specified in the form of a mask which consists


of control characters and digits.

Possible digit values : 0..9, *, #, A..F


Possible control characters : X, ., +, R and S

The control characters signify the following:


X : The corresponding digit value in the old code remains unchanged.
. : The corresponding digit value in the old code is omitted.
+ : The digit values following this control character are to be
inserted or to be appended in the corresponding position.
R : The digit values following this control character replace the
corresponding digit values in the old code.
S : The conversion is stopped : all digit values in the old code,
from the corresponding position on, are omitted.

e.g. GTDIG=004921
DICON=....+0032
The converted GT digits are 003221.

e.g. GTDIG=004921
DICON=..R32XXS
The converted GT digits are 3221.

If the parameter is omitted, no digit conversion will take place.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...13 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TTID TRANSLATION TYPE IDENTIFICAT.

This parameter specifies the new translation type identification for


the modified global title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CCV CREDIT CARD VERIFICATION


IEESS ISDN END-TO-END SUPPL. SERV.
IMSI INTERNATIONAL MOBILE SUB. ID.
INCGPA IN CALLING PARTY ADDRESS
INDD IN DIALED DIGITS
INPPDD IN PREFIX PLUS DIALED DIGITS
ITCC INT. TELECOMM. CHARGE CARD
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TT10 TRANSLATION TYPE 10
TT11 TRANSLATION TYPE 11
TT12 TRANSLATION TYPE 12
TT13 TRANSLATION TYPE 13
TT14 TRANSLATION TYPE 14
TT15 TRANSLATION TYPE 15
TT16 TRANSLATION TYPE 16
TT17 TRANSLATION TYPE 17
TT18 TRANSLATION TYPE 18
TT19 TRANSLATION TYPE 19
TT20 TRANSLATION TYPE 20
TT21 TRANSLATION TYPE 21
TT22 TRANSLATION TYPE 22
TT23 TRANSLATION TYPE 23
TT24 TRANSLATION TYPE 24
TT25 TRANSLATION TYPE 25
TT26 TRANSLATION TYPE 26
TT27 TRANSLATION TYPE 27
TT28 TRANSLATION TYPE 28
TT29 TRANSLATION TYPE 29
TT30 TRANSLATION TYPE 30
TT31 TRANSLATION TYPE 31
TT9 TRANSLATION TYPE 9
UNKNOWN TRANSLATION TYPE UNKNOWN

NP NUMBERING PLAN

This parameter specifies the new numbering plan for the modified global

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 17+


MERGE GTCPT
SSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DATANP DATA NUMBERING PLAN


ISDNMNP ISDN MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
ISDNTNP ISDN TELEPHONY NUMBERING PLAN
LMNP LAND MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
MMNP MARITIME MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
NP10 NUMBERING PLAN 10
NP11 NUMBERING PLAN 11
NP12 NUMBERING PLAN 12
NP13 NUMBERING PLAN 13
NP15 NUMBERING PLAN 15
NP2 NUMBERING PLAN 2
NP8 NUMBERING PLAN 8
NP9 NUMBERING PLAN 9
PNP PRIVATE NUMBERING PLAN
TELEXNP TELEX NUMBERING PLAN
UNKNOWN NUMBERING PLAN UNKNOWN

NA NATURE OF ADDRESS

This parameter specifies the new nature of address for the modified
global title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTNO INTERNATIONAL NUMBER


NATNO NATIONAL SIGNIFICANT NUMBER
NATUSE RESERVED FOR NATIONAL USE
NA10 NATURE OF ADDRESS 10
NA11 NATURE OF ADDRESS 11
NA12 NATURE OF ADDRESS 12
NA13 NATURE OF ADDRESS 13
NA14 NATURE OF ADDRESS 14
NA15 NATURE OF ADDRESS 15
NA5 NATURE OF ADDRESS 5
NA6 NATURE OF ADDRESS 6
NA7 NATURE OF ADDRESS 7
NA8 NATURE OF ADDRESS 8
NA9 NATURE OF ADDRESS 9
SUBNO SUBSCRIBER NUMBER
UNKNOWN NATURE OF ADDRESS UNKNOWN

ND NETWORK DISCRIMINATOR

This parameter specifies if the global title addresses a national or


international subscriber and to which network it belongs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTFOR INT. SUB. & FOREIGN NETWORK


NATFOR NAT. SUB. & FOREIGN NETWORK
NATOWN NAT. SUB. & OWN NETWORK

Default: NATOWN

PPN PORTABILITY PROCESSING NEEDED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
NO NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
Y PORTABILITY PROCESSING
YES PORTABILITY PROCESSING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 18+


MERGE GTCPT
TRLG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

TRANSLATOR GROUP ROUTE

This input format is used for creating a translator service group as a


global title translation destination for the new code point.

Prerequisites:
- The translator service group must have been created.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MERGE GTCPT : TRID= ,GTDIG= ,ROUTE= [,RTGP=] ,TRLG= 1
1 1
1 [,SSID=] [,DICON=] [,TTID=] [,NP=] [,NA=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,ND=] [,PPN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits of the new code point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTE ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the global title translation


destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TRLG TRANSLATOR GROUP

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences.


RTGP=CANGT indicates that the GT digits should be cancelled.
RTGP=PGTT indicates that another global title translation is
required in the next node.
RTGP=SPCINC indicates that the new called party address contains a
signaling point.

If the parameter is omitted, the following default value will be used :


- the global title will be kept ( then the DICON will be taken into
account )

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 19+


MERGE GTCPT
TRLG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- no global title translation is to be performed in the next node


- no signaling point is included in the new called party address.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

PGTT PERFORM GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL.


SPCINC SIGNALING POINT CODE INCLUDED

TRLG TRANSLATOR SERVICE GROUP

This parameter specifies the translator service group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFICATION

*FUTSS01:

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC ACCOUNT CARD CALLING


AWC AREA WIDE CENTREX
BSSAP BS SYSTEM APPLICATION PART
BSSMA BSSAP MAINTENANCE
CCC CREDIT CARD CALLING
DBC DEBIT CENTER
FPH FREEPHONE SERVICE
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01
FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
FUTSS11 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 11
FUTSS12 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 12
FUTSS13 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 13
FUTSS14 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 14
FUTSS15 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 15
FUTSS16 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 16
IGAP IRRIDIUM GATEWAY APPL. PART
IN IN APPLICATION IN SSP
IN2 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 3
IN4 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 4
IN5 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 5
ISS ISDN SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES
ISUP ISDN USER PART
MAP MOBILE APPLICATION PART
MAPAC MOBILE APPLICATION PART AC
MAPEIR MOBILE APPLICATION PART EIR
MAPHLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART HLR
MAPMSC MOBILE APPLICATION PART MSC
MAPVLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART VLR
OMAP OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE ADM.
PN PERSONAL NUMBER
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TIS TELEINFO SERVICE
TSTUP TEST USER PART
TV TELEVOTING
UN UNIVERSAL NUMBER
UPT UNIVERSAL PERSONAL TELECOMM.
VPN VIRTUAL PRIVATE NETWORK

DICON DIGIT CONVERSION CODE

This parameter specifies how the existing global title digits are to be
modified. The following modifications can be made:
- replacement of digits

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 20+


MERGE GTCPT
TRLG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- insertion of digits
- removal of digits.

The modifications are specified in the form of a mask which consists


of control characters and digits.

Possible digit values : 0..9, *, #, A..F


Possible control characters : X, ., +, R and S

The control characters signify the following:


X : The corresponding digit value in the old code remains unchanged.
. : The corresponding digit value in the old code is omitted.
+ : The digit values following this control character are to be
inserted or to be appended in the corresponding position.
R : The digit values following this control character replace the
corresponding digit values in the old code.
S : The conversion is stopped : all digit values in the old code,
from the corresponding position on, are omitted.

e.g. GTDIG=004921
DICON=....+0032
The converted GT digits are 003221.

e.g. GTDIG=004921
DICON=..R32XXS
The converted GT digits are 3221.

If the parameter is omitted, no digit conversion will take place.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...13 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TTID TRANSLATION TYPE IDENTIFICAT.

This parameter specifies the new translation type identification for


the modified global title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CCV CREDIT CARD VERIFICATION


IEESS ISDN END-TO-END SUPPL. SERV.
IMSI INTERNATIONAL MOBILE SUB. ID.
INCGPA IN CALLING PARTY ADDRESS
INDD IN DIALED DIGITS
INPPDD IN PREFIX PLUS DIALED DIGITS
ITCC INT. TELECOMM. CHARGE CARD
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TT10 TRANSLATION TYPE 10
TT11 TRANSLATION TYPE 11
TT12 TRANSLATION TYPE 12
TT13 TRANSLATION TYPE 13
TT14 TRANSLATION TYPE 14
TT15 TRANSLATION TYPE 15
TT16 TRANSLATION TYPE 16
TT17 TRANSLATION TYPE 17
TT18 TRANSLATION TYPE 18
TT19 TRANSLATION TYPE 19
TT20 TRANSLATION TYPE 20
TT21 TRANSLATION TYPE 21
TT22 TRANSLATION TYPE 22
TT23 TRANSLATION TYPE 23
TT24 TRANSLATION TYPE 24
TT25 TRANSLATION TYPE 25
TT26 TRANSLATION TYPE 26
TT27 TRANSLATION TYPE 27
TT28 TRANSLATION TYPE 28
TT29 TRANSLATION TYPE 29
TT30 TRANSLATION TYPE 30
TT31 TRANSLATION TYPE 31
TT9 TRANSLATION TYPE 9
UNKNOWN TRANSLATION TYPE UNKNOWN

NP NUMBERING PLAN

This parameter specifies the new numbering plan for the modified global

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 21+


MERGE GTCPT
TRLG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DATANP DATA NUMBERING PLAN


ISDNMNP ISDN MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
ISDNTNP ISDN TELEPHONY NUMBERING PLAN
LMNP LAND MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
MMNP MARITIME MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
NP10 NUMBERING PLAN 10
NP11 NUMBERING PLAN 11
NP12 NUMBERING PLAN 12
NP13 NUMBERING PLAN 13
NP15 NUMBERING PLAN 15
NP2 NUMBERING PLAN 2
NP8 NUMBERING PLAN 8
NP9 NUMBERING PLAN 9
PNP PRIVATE NUMBERING PLAN
TELEXNP TELEX NUMBERING PLAN
UNKNOWN NUMBERING PLAN UNKNOWN

NA NATURE OF ADDRESS

This parameter specifies the new nature of address for the modified
global title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTNO INTERNATIONAL NUMBER


NATNO NATIONAL SIGNIFICANT NUMBER
NATUSE RESERVED FOR NATIONAL USE
NA10 NATURE OF ADDRESS 10
NA11 NATURE OF ADDRESS 11
NA12 NATURE OF ADDRESS 12
NA13 NATURE OF ADDRESS 13
NA14 NATURE OF ADDRESS 14
NA15 NATURE OF ADDRESS 15
NA5 NATURE OF ADDRESS 5
NA6 NATURE OF ADDRESS 6
NA7 NATURE OF ADDRESS 7
NA8 NATURE OF ADDRESS 8
NA9 NATURE OF ADDRESS 9
SUBNO SUBSCRIBER NUMBER
UNKNOWN NATURE OF ADDRESS UNKNOWN

ND NETWORK DISCRIMINATOR

This parameter specifies if the global title addresses a national or


international subscriber and to which network it belongs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTFOR INT. SUB. & FOREIGN NETWORK


NATFOR NAT. SUB. & FOREIGN NETWORK
NATOWN NAT. SUB. & OWN NETWORK

Default: NATOWN

PPN PORTABILITY PROCESSING NEEDED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
NO NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
Y PORTABILITY PROCESSING
YES PORTABILITY PROCESSING

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MERGE GTCPT- 22-


MOD GTCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. CODE POINT

This command modifies the global title translation code point.

Omitted parameters will not be taken into account, i.e. they keep their
current values.

Prerequisites:

Notes:
- The command will be rejected if:
- the translator identification does not exist
- the global title digit pattern does not exist
- a data inconsistency in the GTT database occurred.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD GTCPT : TRID= ,GTDIG= <,DICON= ,NP= ,NA= ,TTID= ,ND=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DICON DIGIT CONVERSION

This parameter specifies how the existing global title digits are to be
modified. The following modifications can be made:
- replacement of digits
- insertion of digits
- removal of digits.

The modifications are specified in the form of a mask which consists


of control characters and digits.

Possible digit values : 0..9, *, #, A..F


Possible control characters : X, ., +, R and S

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTCPT- 1+


MOD GTCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The control characters signify the following:


X : The corresponding digit value in the old code remains unchanged.
. : The corresponding digit value in the old code is omitted.
+ : The digit values following this control character are to beinserted
or to be appended in the corresponding position.
R : The digit values following this control character replace the
corresponding digit values in the old code.
S : The conversion is stopped : all digit values in the old code, from
the corresponding position on, are omitted.

e.g. GTDIG=004921
DICON=....+0032
The converted GT digits are 003221.

e.g. GTDIG=004921
DICON=..R32XXS
The converted GT digits are 3221.

If the parameter is omitted, no digit conversion will take place.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...13 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NP NUMBERING PLAN

This parameter specifies the new numbering plan for the modified global
title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UNKNOWN NUMBERING PLAN UNKNOWN


ISDNTNP ISDN TELEPHONY NUMBERING PLAN
NP2 NUMBERING PLAN 2
DATANP DATA NUMBERING PLAN
TELEXNP TELEX NUMBERING PLAN
MMNP MARITIME MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
LMNP LAND MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
ISDNMNP ISDN MOBILE NUMBERING PLAN
NP8 NUMBERING PLAN 8
NP9 NUMBERING PLAN 9
NP10 NUMBERING PLAN 10
NP11 NUMBERING PLAN 11
NP12 NUMBERING PLAN 12
NP13 NUMBERING PLAN 13
PNP PRIVATE NUMBERING PLAN
NP15 NUMBERING PLAN 15

NA NATURE OF ADDR. INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the new nature of address for the modified
global title of the called party address.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UNKNOWN NATURE OF ADDRESS UNKNOWN


SUBNO SUBSCRIBER NUMBER
NATUSE RESERVED FOR NATIONAL USE
NATNO NATIONAL SIGNIFICANT NUMBER
INTNO INTERNATIONAL NUMBER
NA5 NATURE OF ADDRESS 5
NA6 NATURE OF ADDRESS 6
NA7 NATURE OF ADDRESS 7
NA8 NATURE OF ADDRESS 8
NA9 NATURE OF ADDRESS 9
NA10 NATURE OF ADDRESS 10
NA11 NATURE OF ADDRESS 11
NA12 NATURE OF ADDRESS 12
NA13 NATURE OF ADDRESS 13
NA14 NATURE OF ADDRESS 14
NA15 NATURE OF ADDRESS 15

TTID TRANSLATION TYPE ID.

This parameter specifies the new translation type identification for


the modified global title of the called party address.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTCPT- 2+


MOD GTCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UNKNOWN TRANSLATION TYPE UNKNOWN


IMSI INTERNATIONAL MOBILE SUB. ID.
CCV CREDIT CARD VERIFICATION
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
INDD IN DIALED DIGITS
INCGPA IN CALLING PARTY ADDRESS
INPPDD IN PREFIX PLUS DIALED DIGITS
IEESS ISDN END-TO-END SUPPL. SERV.
ITCC INT. TELECOMM. CHARGE CARD
TT9 TRANSLATION TYPE 9
TT10 TRANSLATION TYPE 10
TT11 TRANSLATION TYPE 11
TT12 TRANSLATION TYPE 12
TT13 TRANSLATION TYPE 13
TT14 TRANSLATION TYPE 14
TT15 TRANSLATION TYPE 15
TT16 TRANSLATION TYPE 16
TT17 TRANSLATION TYPE 17
TT18 TRANSLATION TYPE 18
TT19 TRANSLATION TYPE 19
TT20 TRANSLATION TYPE 20
TT21 TRANSLATION TYPE 21
TT22 TRANSLATION TYPE 22
TT23 TRANSLATION TYPE 23
TT24 TRANSLATION TYPE 24
TT25 TRANSLATION TYPE 25
TT26 TRANSLATION TYPE 26
TT27 TRANSLATION TYPE 27
TT28 TRANSLATION TYPE 28
TT29 TRANSLATION TYPE 29
TT30 TRANSLATION TYPE 30
TT31 TRANSLATION TYPE 31

ND NETWORK DISCRIMINATOR

This parameter specifies the new network discriminator.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NATOWN NAT. SUB. & OWN NETWORK


NATFOR NAT. SUB. & FOREIGN NETWORK
INTFOR INT. SUB. & FOREIGN NETWORK

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTCPT- 3-


SPLIT GTCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SPLIT GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. CODE POINT

This command splits a global title translation code point.

Starting from an existing code point, NUM new global title code
points will be made. Compared to the old code point, the new code points
all have 1 different extra digit, ranging from 0 to ( NUM - 1 ).

All new code points get the same destination information as was
associated with the old code point.

The old code point - and its associated destination information - is


cancelled.

Prerequisites:
- The global title translation digit tree must be created.
- The global title translation code point to be split must be created.
- The codepoint associated global title translation destination
information must be created.

Notes:
- The command will be rejected if:
- the translator identification does not exist
- the global title digit pattern does not exist
- there is no destination assigned to this code point
- the destination assigned to this code point requires retranslation
in the own node
- a GTT database table is saturated
- a data inconsistency in the GTT database occurred.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 SPLIT GTCPT : TRID= ,GTDIG= [,NUM=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SPLIT GTCPT- 1+


SPLIT GTCPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NUM NUMBER OF NEW CODEPOINTS

This parameter specifies the number of new codepoints.


It denotes :
- how many ( NUM ) new code points will be created
- the range of the extra digit : 0 to (NUM-1).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

Default: 10

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SPLIT GTCPT- 2-


CAN GTDEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. DESTINATION

This command cancels a global title translation destination.

Notes:
- The command will be rejected if:
- the translator identification does not exist
- the global title digit pattern does not exist
- there is no destination assigned to this code point
- a data inconsistency in the GTT database occurred.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN GTDEST : TRID= ,GTDIG= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN GTDEST- 1-


CR GTDEST
INTERNAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. DESTINATION

This command creates a global title translation destination.


Six types of destinations are possible:
- LTG processor number in the own switch
- internal route, i.e. signaling point in the own area
- translator service group
- subsystem group
- retranslation in the own node.
The route parameter decides which optional parameter values should be entered.

Prerequisites:
- The global title translation digit tree must have been created.
- The global title translation code point must have been created.
- The particular objects the route is referring to must have been
created in the SCCP or GTT database.

Notes:
- The command will be rejected if:
- the translator identification does not exist
- the code point does not exist
- the required SCCP or GTT objects are not available
- a destination exists already for this codepoint
- a specific global title translation database table is saturated
- a data inconsistency in the GTT database occurred.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR GTDEST - INTERNAL INTERNAL ROUTE


2. CR GTDEST - LTGNR LTG PROCESSOR NUMBER ROUTE
3. CR GTDEST - RETRANS RETRANSLATION ROUTE
4. CR GTDEST - SSG SUBSYSTEM GROUP ROUTE
5. CR GTDEST - TRLG TRANSLATOR GROUP ROUTE

1. Input format

INTERNAL ROUTE

This input format is used for creating a signaling point in the own area
as a global title translation destination.

Prerequisites:
- The specified destination point code must have been created.
- The specified subsystem must have been created.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR GTDEST : TRID= ,GTDIG= ,ROUTE= [,RTGP=] ,DPC= ,NI= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,SSID=] [,PPN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTDEST- 1+
CR GTDEST
INTERNAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTE ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the global title translation


destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTERNAL INTERNAL ROUTE

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences.


RTGP=CANGT indicates that the GT digits should be cancelled.
RTGP=PGTT indicates that another global title translation is
required in the next node.
RTGP=SPCINC indicates that the new called party address contains a
signaling point.

If the parameter is omitted, the following default value will be used :


- the global title will be kept ( then the DICON will be taken into
account )
- no global title translation is to be performed in the next node
- no signaling point is included in the new called party address.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CANGT CANCEL GLOBAL TITLE


SPCINC SIGNALING POINT CODE INCLUDED

DPC DESTINATION POINT CODE

Network Indicator = NAT0 Units = 4-3-4-3


Network Indicator = INAT0 Units = 3-8-3
Network Indicator = NAT1 Units = 4-3-4-3
Network Indicator = INAT1 Units = 3-8-3

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: DESTINATION POINT CODE UNIT1=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

b: DESTINATION POINT CODE UNIT2=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: DESTINATION POINT CODE UNIT3=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: DESTINATION POINT CODE UNIT4=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTDEST- 2+
CR GTDEST
INTERNAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NI NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the network concerned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFICATION

*FUTSS01:

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC ACCOUNT CARD CALLING


AWC AREA WIDE CENTREX
BSSAP BS SYSTEM APPLICATION PART
BSSMA BSSAP MAINTENANCE
CCC CREDIT CARD CALLING
DBC DEBIT CENTER
FPH FREEPHONE SERVICE
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01
FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
FUTSS11 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 11
FUTSS12 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 12
FUTSS13 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 13
FUTSS14 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 14
FUTSS15 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 15
FUTSS16 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 16
IGAP IRRIDIUM GATEWAY APPL. PART
IN IN APPLICATION IN SSP
IN2 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 3
IN4 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 4
IN5 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 5
ISS ISDN SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES
ISUP ISDN USER PART
MAP MOBILE APPLICATION PART
MAPAC MOBILE APPLICATION PART AC
MAPEIR MOBILE APPLICATION PART EIR
MAPHLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART HLR
MAPMSC MOBILE APPLICATION PART MSC
MAPVLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART VLR
OMAP OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE ADM.
PN PERSONAL NUMBER
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TIS TELEINFO SERVICE
TSTUP TEST USER PART
TV TELEVOTING
UN UNIVERSAL NUMBER
UPT UNIVERSAL PERSONAL TELECOMM.
VPN VIRTUAL PRIVATE NETWORK

PPN PORTABILITY PROCESSING NEEDED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
NO NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
Y PORTABILITY PROCESSING
YES PORTABILITY PROCESSING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTDEST- 3+
CR GTDEST
LTGNR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

LTG PROCESSOR NUMBER ROUTE

This input format is used for creating a LTG processor number as a


global title translation destination.

Prerequisites:
- The specified LTG has to exist. For this purpose, the CR LTG command has
to be executed prior to the CR GTDEST command.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR GTDEST : TRID= ,GTDIG= ,ROUTE= [,RTGP=] ,LTGNR= ,NI= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,SSID=] [,PPN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTE ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the global title translation


destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LTGNR LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences.


RTGP=CANGT indicates that the GT digits should be cancelled.
RTGP=PGTT indicates that another global title translation is
required in the next node.
RTGP=SPCINC indicates that the new called party address contains a
signaling point.

If the parameter is omitted, the following default value will be used :


- the global title will be kept ( then the DICON will be taken into
account )

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTDEST- 4+
CR GTDEST
LTGNR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- no global title translation is to be performed in the next node


- no signaling point is included in the new called party address.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CANGT CANCEL GLOBAL TITLE


PGTT PERFORM GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL.
SPCINC SIGNALING POINT CODE INCLUDED

LTGNR LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the LTG a message has to be relayed to by


the CP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

Dependent on the Switching Network Hardware this unit


represents the Time Stage Group (TSG for SNB) or the
Switching Network MULTIPLEXER (SNMUX for SND and upper ones)

Default: 0

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


0...63, range of decimal numbers

NI NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the network concerned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFICATION

*FUTSS01:

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC ACCOUNT CARD CALLING


AWC AREA WIDE CENTREX
BSSAP BS SYSTEM APPLICATION PART
BSSMA BSSAP MAINTENANCE
CCC CREDIT CARD CALLING
DBC DEBIT CENTER
FPH FREEPHONE SERVICE
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01
FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
FUTSS11 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 11
FUTSS12 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 12
FUTSS13 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 13
FUTSS14 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 14
FUTSS15 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 15
FUTSS16 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 16
IGAP IRRIDIUM GATEWAY APPL. PART
IN IN APPLICATION IN SSP
IN2 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 3

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTDEST- 5+
CR GTDEST
LTGNR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

IN4 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 4


IN5 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 5
ISS ISDN SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES
ISUP ISDN USER PART
MAP MOBILE APPLICATION PART
MAPAC MOBILE APPLICATION PART AC
MAPEIR MOBILE APPLICATION PART EIR
MAPHLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART HLR
MAPMSC MOBILE APPLICATION PART MSC
MAPVLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART VLR
OMAP OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE ADM.
PN PERSONAL NUMBER
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TIS TELEINFO SERVICE
TSTUP TEST USER PART
TV TELEVOTING
UN UNIVERSAL NUMBER
UPT UNIVERSAL PERSONAL TELECOMM.
VPN VIRTUAL PRIVATE NETWORK

PPN PORTABILITY PROCESSING NEEDED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
NO NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
Y PORTABILITY PROCESSING
YES PORTABILITY PROCESSING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTDEST- 6+
CR GTDEST
RETRANS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

RETRANSLATION ROUTE

This input format is used for creating a linked code point.

Prerequisites :
- The specified LTRID must have been created.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR GTDEST : TRID= ,GTDIG= ,ROUTE= ,LTRID= [,RDIG=] [,PPN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTE ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the global title translation


destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

RETRANS RETRANSLATION IN OWN NODE

LTRID LINKED TRANSLATOR IDENTIF.

This parameter specifies the linked translator identification.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

RDIG RETRANSLATION DIGIT POSITION

This parameter specifies the first digit to be retranslated in the


own node.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTDEST- 7+
CR GTDEST
RETRANS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...24, range of decimal numbers

Default: 1

PPN PORTABILITY PROCESSING NEEDED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
NO NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
Y PORTABILITY PROCESSING
YES PORTABILITY PROCESSING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTDEST- 8+
CR GTDEST
SSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

SUBSYSTEM GROUP ROUTE

This input format is used for creating a subsystem group as a global title
translation destination.

Prerequisites:
- The subsystem group must have been created.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR GTDEST : TRID= ,GTDIG= ,ROUTE= [,RTGP=] ,SSG= [,SSID=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,PPN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTE ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the global title translation


destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SSG SUBSYSTEM GROUP

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences.


RTGP=CANGT indicates that the GT digits should be cancelled.
RTGP=PGTT indicates that another global title translation is
required in the next node.
RTGP=SPCINC indicates that the new called party address contains a
signaling point.

If the parameter is omitted, the following default value will be used :


- the global title will be kept ( then the DICON will be taken into
account )
- no global title translation is to be performed in the next node

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTDEST- 9+
CR GTDEST
SSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- no signaling point is included in the new called party address.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CANGT CANCEL GLOBAL TITLE


SPCINC SIGNALING POINT CODE INCLUDED

SSG SUBSYSTEM GROUP

This parameter specifies the subsystem group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFICATION

*FUTSS01:

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC ACCOUNT CARD CALLING


AWC AREA WIDE CENTREX
BSSAP BS SYSTEM APPLICATION PART
BSSMA BSSAP MAINTENANCE
CCC CREDIT CARD CALLING
DBC DEBIT CENTER
FPH FREEPHONE SERVICE
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01
FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
FUTSS11 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 11
FUTSS12 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 12
FUTSS13 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 13
FUTSS14 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 14
FUTSS15 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 15
FUTSS16 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 16
IGAP IRRIDIUM GATEWAY APPL. PART
IN IN APPLICATION IN SSP
IN2 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 3
IN4 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 4
IN5 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 5
ISS ISDN SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES
ISUP ISDN USER PART
MAP MOBILE APPLICATION PART
MAPAC MOBILE APPLICATION PART AC
MAPEIR MOBILE APPLICATION PART EIR
MAPHLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART HLR
MAPMSC MOBILE APPLICATION PART MSC
MAPVLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART VLR
OMAP OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE ADM.
PN PERSONAL NUMBER
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TIS TELEINFO SERVICE
TSTUP TEST USER PART
TV TELEVOTING
UN UNIVERSAL NUMBER
UPT UNIVERSAL PERSONAL TELECOMM.
VPN VIRTUAL PRIVATE NETWORK

PPN PORTABILITY PROCESSING NEEDED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
NO NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTDEST- 10+


CR GTDEST
SSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Y PORTABILITY PROCESSING
YES PORTABILITY PROCESSING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTDEST- 11+


CR GTDEST
TRLG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

TRANSLATOR GROUP ROUTE

This input format is used for creating a translator service group as


a global title translation destination.

Prerequisites:
- The translator service group must have been created.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR GTDEST : TRID= ,GTDIG= ,ROUTE= [,RTGP=] ,TRLG= [,SSID=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,PPN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTE ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the global title translation


destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TRLG TRANSLATOR GROUP

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences.


RTGP=CANGT indicates that the GT digits should be cancelled.
RTGP=PGTT indicates that another global title translation is
required in the next node.
RTGP=SPCINC indicates that the new called party address contains a
signaling point.

If the parameter is omitted, the following default value will be used :


- the global title will be kept ( then the DICON will be taken into
account )
- no global title translation is to be performed in the next node

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTDEST- 12+


CR GTDEST
TRLG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- no signaling point is included in the new called party address.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

PGTT PERFORM GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL.


SPCINC SIGNALING POINT CODE INCLUDED

TRLG TRANSLATOR SERVICE GROUP

This parameter specifies the translator service group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFICATION

*FUTSS01:

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC ACCOUNT CARD CALLING


AWC AREA WIDE CENTREX
BSSAP BS SYSTEM APPLICATION PART
BSSMA BSSAP MAINTENANCE
CCC CREDIT CARD CALLING
DBC DEBIT CENTER
FPH FREEPHONE SERVICE
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01
FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
FUTSS11 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 11
FUTSS12 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 12
FUTSS13 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 13
FUTSS14 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 14
FUTSS15 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 15
FUTSS16 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 16
IGAP IRRIDIUM GATEWAY APPL. PART
IN IN APPLICATION IN SSP
IN2 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 3
IN4 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 4
IN5 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 5
ISS ISDN SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES
ISUP ISDN USER PART
MAP MOBILE APPLICATION PART
MAPAC MOBILE APPLICATION PART AC
MAPEIR MOBILE APPLICATION PART EIR
MAPHLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART HLR
MAPMSC MOBILE APPLICATION PART MSC
MAPVLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART VLR
OMAP OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE ADM.
PN PERSONAL NUMBER
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TIS TELEINFO SERVICE
TSTUP TEST USER PART
TV TELEVOTING
UN UNIVERSAL NUMBER
UPT UNIVERSAL PERSONAL TELECOMM.
VPN VIRTUAL PRIVATE NETWORK

PPN PORTABILITY PROCESSING NEEDED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
NO NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTDEST- 13+


CR GTDEST
TRLG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Y PORTABILITY PROCESSING
YES PORTABILITY PROCESSING

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR GTDEST- 14-


DISP GTDEST

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. DESTINATION

This command displays the global title translation destination information.

If the GTDIG parameter is omitted, all the destination information of the


requested digit tree(s), identified by the translator identification, will be
displayed.

Notes:
- When no data was found for the query, the message "NO (MORE) DATA FOR
DISPLAY AVAILABLE" will be displayed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP GTDEST : TRID= [,GTDIG=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.
If the parameter is omitted, the associated destination information
of all codepoints of the concerned TRID will be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP GTDEST- 1-


MOD GTDEST
INTERNAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL. DESTINATION

This command modifies a global title translation destination.


Six types of destinations are possible ( see CR GTDEST ).

Parameters are treated as in the CR GTDEST command :


- all mandatory parameters have to be entered
- the default values as defined will be taken into account.

Prerequisites:
- The global title translation digit tree must have been created.
- The global title translation code point must have been created.
- A global title translation destination must have been created for
the code point.
- The particular objects the route is referring to must have been
created in the SCCP or GTT database.

Notes:
- The command will be rejected if:
- the translator identification does not exist
- the code point does not exist
- no destination exists for this codepoint
- the required SCCP or GTT objects are not available
- a specific global title translation database table is saturated
- a data inconsistency in the GTT database occurred.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD GTDEST - INTERNAL INTERNAL ROUTE


2. MOD GTDEST - LTGNR LTG PROCESSOR NUMBER ROUTE
3. MOD GTDEST - RETRANS RETRANSLATION ROUTE
4. MOD GTDEST - SSG SUBSYSTEM GROUP ROUTE
5. MOD GTDEST - TRLG TRANSLATOR GROUP ROUTE

1. Input format

INTERNAL ROUTE

This input format is used for modifying a signaling point in the own
area as a global title translation destination.

Prerequisites:
- The specified destination point code must have been created.
- The specified subsystem must have been created.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD GTDEST : TRID= ,GTDIG= ,ROUTE= [,RTGP=] [,CRTGP=] ,DPC= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,NI= [,SSID=] [,PPN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTDEST- 1+


MOD GTDEST
INTERNAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTE ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the global title translation


destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTERNAL INTERNAL ROUTE

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences.


RTGP=CANGT indicates that the GT digits should be cancelled.
RTGP=PGTT indicates that another global title translation is
required in the next node.
RTGP=SPCINC indicates that the new called party address contains a
signaling point.

Standard behaviour :
- the global title will be kept ( then the DICON will be taken into
account )
- no global title translation is to be performed in the next node
- no signaling point is included in the new called party address.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CANGT CANCEL GLOBAL TITLE


SPCINC SIGNALING POINT CODE INCLUDED

CRTGP CANCEL ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences which are to be set


to their default values before ( eventually ) taking into account the
RTGP parameter.

CRTGP=CANGT indicates that the global title will be kept.


CRTGP=PGTT indicates that no global title translation is
required in the next node.
CRTGP=SPCINC indicates that the new called party address does not
contain a signaling point.

If the parameter is omitted, it is not taken into account.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CANGT CANCEL GLOBAL TITLE


SPCINC SIGNALING POINT CODE INCLUDED

DPC DESTINATION POINT CODE

Network Indicator = NAT0 Units = 4-3-4-3


Network Indicator = INAT0 Units = 3-8-3
Network Indicator = NAT1 Units = 4-3-4-3
Network Indicator = INAT1 Units = 3-8-3

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTDEST- 2+


MOD GTDEST
INTERNAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: DESTINATION POINT CODE UNIT1=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

b: DESTINATION POINT CODE UNIT2=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: DESTINATION POINT CODE UNIT3=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: DESTINATION POINT CODE UNIT4=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

NI NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the network concerned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFICATION

*FUTSS01:

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC ACCOUNT CARD CALLING


AWC AREA WIDE CENTREX
BSSAP BS SYSTEM APPLICATION PART
BSSMA BSSAP MAINTENANCE
CCC CREDIT CARD CALLING
DBC DEBIT CENTER
FPH FREEPHONE SERVICE
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01
FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
FUTSS11 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 11
FUTSS12 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 12
FUTSS13 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 13
FUTSS14 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 14
FUTSS15 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 15
FUTSS16 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 16
IGAP IRRIDIUM GATEWAY APPL. PART
IN IN APPLICATION IN SSP
IN2 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 3
IN4 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 4
IN5 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 5
ISS ISDN SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES
ISUP ISDN USER PART
MAP MOBILE APPLICATION PART
MAPAC MOBILE APPLICATION PART AC
MAPEIR MOBILE APPLICATION PART EIR
MAPHLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART HLR
MAPMSC MOBILE APPLICATION PART MSC
MAPVLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART VLR
OMAP OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE ADM.
PN PERSONAL NUMBER
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTDEST- 3+


MOD GTDEST
INTERNAL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TIS TELEINFO SERVICE


TSTUP TEST USER PART
TV TELEVOTING
UN UNIVERSAL NUMBER
UPT UNIVERSAL PERSONAL TELECOMM.
VPN VIRTUAL PRIVATE NETWORK

PPN PORTABILITY PROCESSING NEEDED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
NO NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
Y PORTABILITY PROCESSING
YES PORTABILITY PROCESSING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTDEST- 4+


MOD GTDEST
LTGNR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

LTG PROCESSOR NUMBER ROUTE

This input format is used for modifying a LTG processor number


as a global title translation destination.

Prerequisites:
- The specified LTG has to exist. For this purpose, the CR LTG command has
to be executed prior to the MOD GTDEST command.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD GTDEST : TRID= ,GTDIG= ,ROUTE= [,RTGP=] [,CRTGP=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,LTGNR= ,NI= [,SSID=] [,PPN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTE ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the global title translation


destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LTGNR LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences.


RTGP=CANGT indicates that the GT digits should be cancelled.
RTGP=PGTT indicates that another global title translation is
required in the next node.
RTGP=SPCINC indicates that the new called party address contains a
signaling point.

Standard behaviour :
- the global title will be kept ( then the DICON will be taken into
account )

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTDEST- 5+


MOD GTDEST
LTGNR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- no global title translation is to be performed in the next node


- no signaling point is included in the new called party address.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CANGT CANCEL GLOBAL TITLE


PGTT PERFORM GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL.
SPCINC SIGNALING POINT CODE INCLUDED

CRTGP CANCEL ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences which are to be set


to their default values before ( eventually ) taking into account the
RTGP parameter.

CRTGP=CANGT indicates that the global title will be kept.


CRTGP=PGTT indicates that no global title translation is
required in the next node.
CRTGP=SPCINC indicates that the new called party address does not
contain a signaling point.

If the parameter is omitted, it is not taken into account.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CANGT CANCEL GLOBAL TITLE


PGTT PERFORM GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL.
SPCINC SIGNALING POINT CODE INCLUDED

LTGNR LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the LTG a message has to be relayed to by


the CP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LINE TRUNK GROUP SET=


0...31, range of decimal numbers

Dependent on the Switching Network Hardware this unit


represents the Time Stage Group (TSG for SNB) or the
Switching Network MULTIPLEXER (SNMUX for SND and upper ones)

b: LINE TRUNK GROUP NUMBER=


0...63, range of decimal numbers

NI NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the network concerned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFICATION

*FUTSS01:

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC ACCOUNT CARD CALLING


AWC AREA WIDE CENTREX
BSSAP BS SYSTEM APPLICATION PART
BSSMA BSSAP MAINTENANCE
CCC CREDIT CARD CALLING
DBC DEBIT CENTER
FPH FREEPHONE SERVICE
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTDEST- 6+


MOD GTDEST
LTGNR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02


FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
FUTSS11 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 11
FUTSS12 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 12
FUTSS13 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 13
FUTSS14 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 14
FUTSS15 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 15
FUTSS16 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 16
IGAP IRRIDIUM GATEWAY APPL. PART
IN IN APPLICATION IN SSP
IN2 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 3
IN4 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 4
IN5 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 5
ISS ISDN SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES
ISUP ISDN USER PART
MAP MOBILE APPLICATION PART
MAPAC MOBILE APPLICATION PART AC
MAPEIR MOBILE APPLICATION PART EIR
MAPHLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART HLR
MAPMSC MOBILE APPLICATION PART MSC
MAPVLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART VLR
OMAP OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE ADM.
PN PERSONAL NUMBER
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TIS TELEINFO SERVICE
TSTUP TEST USER PART
TV TELEVOTING
UN UNIVERSAL NUMBER
UPT UNIVERSAL PERSONAL TELECOMM.
VPN VIRTUAL PRIVATE NETWORK

PPN PORTABILITY PROCESSING NEEDED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
NO NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
Y PORTABILITY PROCESSING
YES PORTABILITY PROCESSING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTDEST- 7+


MOD GTDEST
RETRANS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

RETRANSLATION ROUTE

This format is used for creating a linked code point.

Prerequisites :
- The specified LTRID must have been created.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD GTDEST : TRID= ,GTDIG= ,ROUTE= ,LTRID= [,RDIG=] [,PPN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTE ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the global title translation


destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

RETRANS RETRANSLATION IN OWN NODE

LTRID LINKED TRANSLATOR IDENTIF.

This parameter specifies the linked translator identification.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

RDIG RETRANSLATION DIGIT POSITION

This parameter specifies the first digit to be retranslated in the


own node.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTDEST- 8+


MOD GTDEST
RETRANS
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...24, range of decimal numbers

PPN PORTABILITY PROCESSING NEEDED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
NO NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
Y PORTABILITY PROCESSING
YES PORTABILITY PROCESSING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTDEST- 9+


MOD GTDEST
SSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

SUBSYSTEM GROUP ROUTE

This input format is used for modifying a subsystem group as a global


title translation destination.

Prerequisites:
- The subsystem group must have been created.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD GTDEST : TRID= ,GTDIG= ,ROUTE= [,RTGP=] [,CRTGP=] ,SSG= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,SSID=] [,PPN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTE ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the global title translation


destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SSG SUBSYSTEM GROUP

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences.


RTGP=CANGT indicates that the GT digits should be cancelled.
RTGP=PGTT indicates that another global title translation is
required in the next node.
RTGP=SPCINC indicates that the new called party address contains a
signaling point.

Standard behaviour :
- the global title will be kept ( then the DICON will be taken into
account )
- no global title translation is to be performed in the next node

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTDEST- 10+


MOD GTDEST
SSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- no signaling point is included in the new called party address.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CANGT CANCEL GLOBAL TITLE


SPCINC SIGNALING POINT CODE INCLUDED

CRTGP CANCEL ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences which are to be set


to their default values before ( eventually ) taking into account the
RTGP parameter.

CRTGP=CANGT indicates that the global title will be kept.


CRTGP=PGTT indicates that no global title translation is
required in the next node.
CRTGP=SPCINC indicates that the new called party address does not
contain a signaling point.

If the parameter is omitted, it is not taken into account.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CANGT CANCEL GLOBAL TITLE


SPCINC SIGNALING POINT CODE INCLUDED

SSG SUBSYSTEM GROUP

This parameter specifies the subsystem group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFICATION

*FUTSS01:

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC ACCOUNT CARD CALLING


AWC AREA WIDE CENTREX
BSSAP BS SYSTEM APPLICATION PART
BSSMA BSSAP MAINTENANCE
CCC CREDIT CARD CALLING
DBC DEBIT CENTER
FPH FREEPHONE SERVICE
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01
FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
FUTSS11 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 11
FUTSS12 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 12
FUTSS13 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 13
FUTSS14 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 14
FUTSS15 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 15
FUTSS16 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 16
IGAP IRRIDIUM GATEWAY APPL. PART
IN IN APPLICATION IN SSP
IN2 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 3
IN4 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 4
IN5 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 5
ISS ISDN SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES
ISUP ISDN USER PART
MAP MOBILE APPLICATION PART
MAPAC MOBILE APPLICATION PART AC

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTDEST- 11+


MOD GTDEST
SSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MAPEIR MOBILE APPLICATION PART EIR


MAPHLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART HLR
MAPMSC MOBILE APPLICATION PART MSC
MAPVLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART VLR
OMAP OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE ADM.
PN PERSONAL NUMBER
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TIS TELEINFO SERVICE
TSTUP TEST USER PART
TV TELEVOTING
UN UNIVERSAL NUMBER
UPT UNIVERSAL PERSONAL TELECOMM.
VPN VIRTUAL PRIVATE NETWORK

PPN PORTABILITY PROCESSING NEEDED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
NO NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
Y PORTABILITY PROCESSING
YES PORTABILITY PROCESSING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTDEST- 12+


MOD GTDEST
TRLG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

TRANSLATOR GROUP ROUTE

This input format is used for modifying a translator service group as a


global title translation destination.

Prerequisites:
- The translator service group must have been created.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD GTDEST : TRID= ,GTDIG= ,ROUTE= [,RTGP=] [,CRTGP=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,TRLG= [,SSID=] [,PPN=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TRID TRANSLATOR IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the translator identification, which refers to


a certain digit tree.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the global title digits. Up to 24 global title


digits can be given.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: 8 GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ROUTE ROUTE TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the global title translation


destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TRLG TRANSLATOR GROUP

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences.


RTGP=CANGT indicates that the GT digits should be cancelled.
RTGP=PGTT indicates that another global title translation is
required in the next node.
RTGP=SPCINC indicates that the new called party address contains a
signaling point.

Standard behaviour :
- the global title will be kept ( then the DICON will be taken into
account )
- no global title translation is to be performed in the next node

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTDEST- 13+


MOD GTDEST
TRLG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- no signaling point is included in the new called party address.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

PGTT PERFORM GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL.


SPCINC SIGNALING POINT CODE INCLUDED

CRTGP CANCEL ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences which are to be set


to their default values before ( eventually ) taking into account the
RTGP parameter.

CRTGP=CANGT indicates that the global title will be kept.


CRTGP=PGTT indicates that no global title translation is
required in the next node.
CRTGP=SPCINC indicates that the new called party address does not
contain a signaling point.

If the parameter is omitted, it is not taken into account.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

PGTT PERFORM GLOBAL TITLE TRANSL.


SPCINC SIGNALING POINT CODE INCLUDED

TRLG TRANSLATOR SERVICE GROUP

This parameter specifies the translator service group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFICATION

*FUTSS01:

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC ACCOUNT CARD CALLING


AWC AREA WIDE CENTREX
BSSAP BS SYSTEM APPLICATION PART
BSSMA BSSAP MAINTENANCE
CCC CREDIT CARD CALLING
DBC DEBIT CENTER
FPH FREEPHONE SERVICE
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01
FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
FUTSS11 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 11
FUTSS12 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 12
FUTSS13 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 13
FUTSS14 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 14
FUTSS15 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 15
FUTSS16 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 16
IGAP IRRIDIUM GATEWAY APPL. PART
IN IN APPLICATION IN SSP
IN2 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 3
IN4 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 4
IN5 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 5
ISS ISDN SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICES
ISUP ISDN USER PART
MAP MOBILE APPLICATION PART
MAPAC MOBILE APPLICATION PART AC

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTDEST- 14+


MOD GTDEST
TRLG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MAPEIR MOBILE APPLICATION PART EIR


MAPHLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART HLR
MAPMSC MOBILE APPLICATION PART MSC
MAPVLR MOBILE APPLICATION PART VLR
OMAP OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE ADM.
PN PERSONAL NUMBER
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TIS TELEINFO SERVICE
TSTUP TEST USER PART
TV TELEVOTING
UN UNIVERSAL NUMBER
UPT UNIVERSAL PERSONAL TELECOMM.
VPN VIRTUAL PRIVATE NETWORK

PPN PORTABILITY PROCESSING NEEDED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
NO NO PORTABILITY PROCESSING
Y PORTABILITY PROCESSING
YES PORTABILITY PROCESSING

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD GTDEST- 15-


REC HLR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RECORD HOME LOCATION REGISTER DATA

This command records the home location register related data.

Prerequisites:
- System time must be secure when the command is entered.

Notes:
- Only 1 measurement job can be started.
- The measurement can be stopped with STOP JOB if the time
parameter values allow a continuation of the job.
- This command is only allowed for an HLR.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command starts a semipermanent job. It can be canceled with CAN JOB.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REC HLR : UNIT= [,BEG=] [,TER=] [,IV=] [,PER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

UNIT UNIT

This parameter specifies the output unit and the form of output.
Only one of the possible alternatives may be selected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: DEVICE
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
If this option is selected, a measurement file
is created and the received traffic data are
output to this file. After the parameter has
been accepted and at the end of the last
recording, an acknowledgement is output to
the OMT. It includes the name of the file in
which the traffic data are available for
postprocessing.
For postprocessing, the data must first be
copied to tape.

Notes:
- Identifier a covers both MDD and MOD.

This information unit specifies the output unit.

b: FILETYPE
SINGLE SINGLE FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
output to single measurement files.
DAILY DAILY FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
output to daily files. This is appropriate in
connection with continuous measurements which
start immediately and have no defined end.
To secure the required space on disk, all 7
daily files (MO...SU) are prepared and created
before the command is accepted.
Time parameters are not permissible for these
measurements.
A daily file is closed at the end of the day
and a new file for the next day is automatically
created on disk or the existing file is replaced.
In the second and subsequent weeks, the file
for the same day of the week is overwritten.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC HLR- 1+


REC HLR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CYCLIC CYCLIC FILE


If this option is selected, the data are
written into a cyclic measurement file.
Time parameters are not permitted for these
measurements.
If the cyclic file runs full the newest
data will be overwritten.
This occurs after a period of two days.

This information unit specifies the desired output form


(daily files , single measurement or cyclic fiel).

BEG BEGINNING DATE

This parameter specifies the measurement begin time.

Notes:
- The begin date BEG and/or the termination date TER must be
specified.
Exception : time parameters may not be specified for the data output
in daily and cyclic files.
- A maximum of four BEG dates (in ascending order) may be linked
with &. In case of linked BEG dates, TER is not permissible.
- The earliest possible begin date is the day after entry.
- It is not permissible to enter the command after 23:45 hours with a
begin date on the following day.
- The first measurement may not begin later than one month after the
current date. Subsequent measurements may not begin later than one
year after the current date.

Default: current date

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the year of the begin


date.

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the month of the begin


date.

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the day of the begin


date.

TER TERMINATING DATE

This parameter specifies the measurement termination date.

Notes:
- Only one termination date may be entered per command.
The earliest possible termination date is the day after entry.
- The measurement duration may not exceed one year.
- The begin date BEG and/or the termination date TER must
be specified.
Exception: time parameters may not be specified for data output
in daily and cyclic files.

Default: the end of the measurement is determined by the single day


measurement.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC HLR- 2+


REC HLR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the year in which


recording is to terminate.

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the month in which


recording is to terminate.

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the day on which


recording is to terminate.

IV INTERVAL TIME

This parameter specifies the measurement interval times.

Notes:
- A maximum of 4 measurement intervals may be linked with &.
- Interval times are only permissible in connection with a
begin date (BEG).

Incompatibilities:
- Intervals covering more than one day (e.g. 23-00-01-00).
- Intervals separated by a break of less than one hour.

Default: 24-hour measurement on the specified days.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: BEGIN HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the hour at which the


measurement interval begins.

b: BEGIN MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the minutes past the hour at


which the measurement interval begins.

c: END HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the hour at which the


measurement interval terminates.

d: END MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the minutes past the hour at


which the measurement interval terminates.

PER PERIODICAL WEEKDAY

This parameter specifies the weekdays on which data are to be


recorded.

Notes:
- The input of weekdays is only permissible in connection with
a termination date (TER).

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC HLR- 3+


REC HLR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Default: daily measurement during the measurement period.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC HLR- 4-


ACT HLRCHP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE HLR CHECKPOINT

This command blocks all HLR subscriber commands and starts the checkpointing
process. It is allowed only for Installation recovery mode. The command is
rejected if the checkpointing is already active. This command stores date and
time of the checkpointing activation.

This command is normally logged.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT HLRCHP ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT HLRCHP- 1-


DACT HLRCHP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE HLR CHECKPOINT

This command allows HLR commands again. Deactivation of HLR Checkpoint is


automatically executed at the end of Installation recovery or after finishing
HLR Split process.

This command is normally logged.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT HLRCHP ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT HLRCHP- 1-


DISP HLRCHP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY HLR CHECKPOINT

This command shows the current status (ALLOWED/BLOCKED), date and time
of start of the current checkpointing process for status = BLOCKED.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP HLRCHP ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP HLRCHP- 1-


CAN HLRID

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL HLR IDENTIFICATION

This command cancels Home Location Register identifications.

Prerequisites:
- All mobile subscribers created for this HLR identification
have to be deleted (CAN MSUB).

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN HLRID : HLRID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

HLRID HLR IDENTIFICATION

HLRID = a: 2 Digits

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...3 digit decimal number

The length is fixed and depends on project specific data.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN HLRID- 1-


CR HLRID

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE HLR IDENTIFICATION

This command creates valid Home Location Register identifications for


the mobile subscriber number IMSI.
This command has to be executed prior to the CR MSUB commands.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR HLRID : HLRID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

HLRID HOME LOCATION REGISTER ID.

HLRID = a: 2 Digits

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...3 digit decimal number

The length is fixed and depends on project specific data.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR HLRID- 1-
DISP HLRID

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY HLR IDENTIFICATION

This command displays all created HLR identifications with the number
of mobile subscribers created per HLR identification.
Also the total number of mobile subscribers created in the HLR is
displayed.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP HLRID ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP HLRID- 1-


ACT HLRUPD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE HOME LOCATION REGISTER UPDATE

This command activates a map message ’reset’ to a given VLR, a given


SGSN or to all internally known VLRs and SGSNs of the HLR-internal
address list, dependent on the given parameters. This list contains
all VLRs and SGSNs in whose area at least one subscriber of the HLR
is roaming. The VLR or SGSN which receives a ’reset’ message
will mark all subscribers associated with the HLR. After receiving a
subscriber request the VLR will send a ’location update’ message
and the SGSN will send a ’gprs location update’ message for the marked
subscriber in order to update the HLR.

After initiating the ’reset’ message(s), the addressing number(s)


and an information as to whether it was possible to send the message
to the VLR or the SGSN are displayed.

Sending a ’reset’ message can also be initiated by an ISTART2


recovery. In this case this command cannot be used before all
’reset’ messages have been sent.

If the ’reset’ messages are activated by a recovery, there will be no


display of the above described information.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT HLRUPD : VLRISD= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

VLRISD VLR INTERNAL ISDN NUMBER

This parameter specifies the internal ISDN number from a VLR or a


SGSN which is to update the HLR,
i.e. the VLR or SGSN to which a map message ’reset’ should be sent.
The second unit of the parameter determines if it is a VLR or a SGSN
which is addresssed.
VLRISD = isdn_number-VLR : VLR is addressed
VLRISD = isdn_number-SGSN : SGSN is addressed

If no second unit is entered a VLR will be addressed by default.

Note: If VLRISD=X is entered, map message ’reset’ will be sent


to all internally known VLRs and SGSNs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: VLR INTERNAL ISDN NUMBER=


1...16 digit decimal number

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: ENTITY INDICATOR
VLR VISITOR LOCATION REGISTER
SGSN SERVING GPRS SUPPORT NODE

Default: VLR

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT HLRUPD- 1-


DISP HLRUPD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY HOME LOCATION REGISTER UPDATE

The command displays the status of the HLR update, i.e. it displays
whether the HLR will be updated by the VLR(s) or the SGSN(s) caused by
map message(s) ’reset’.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP HLRUPD ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP HLRUPD- 1-


DISP HMSTAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY HEAP MANAGEMENT STATISTICS

This command outputs statistic tables.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP HMSTAT : DATA= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DATA DATA

This parameter specifies which table is to be output.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TIMCOUNT TIMER COUNTER


This parameter value outputs the time
administration statistic counter.
LOADSUB LOADED SUBSYSTEMS
This parameter value specifies the process
names of the loaded non-resident subsystems.
STATTAB STATISTIC TABLE
This parameter value outputs the statistic
table.
FREEBLOC FREE BLOCKS
This parameter value outputs the heap management
free blocks.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP HMSTAT- 1-


START HMSTAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

START HEAP MANAGEMENT STATISTICS

This command starts heap management statistics recording.


The table elements are initialized by setting them to zero,
except for the table element for the number of blocks, which
are set to the current number of free blocks.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 START HMSTAT ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 START HMSTAT- 1-


STOP HMSTAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

STOP HEAP MANAGEMENT STATISTICS

This command stops heap management statistics recording


in order to reduce the dynamic workload.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STOP HMSTAT ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STOP HMSTAT- 1-


CAN HOLIDAY

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL HOLIDAY

This command cancels one holiday.


The holiday can either be specified by DATE only or by DATE and
WDCAT.

Even if there are several entries for a date in the holiday table,
only one existing entry is canceled with each CAN HOLIDAY command.
If the date is to be canceled completely the command must be entered
several times.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN HOLIDAY : DATE= [,WDCAT=] [,FEAT=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DATE DATE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

Notes:
- X means fix holidays.
- The value 0 represents the year 2000.
- Dates in the past are not allowed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

WDCAT WEEKDAY CATEGORY

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL


HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL

FEAT FEATURE

This parameter specifies the charging feature of the calendar group for
which a holiday calendar is to be canceled.

For fix networks this parameter is optional, for mobile networks it can
be optional depending on the released features. As a default COMMON
will be taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

COMMON FIX NET CHARGING


MCHARGE MOBILE CHARGING

Default: COMMON

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN HOLIDAY- 1-


DISP HOLIDAY

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY HOLIDAY

This command displays holidays.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP HOLIDAY : [FEAT=] [,YEAR=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

FEAT FEATURE

This parameter specifies the charging feature of the calendar group for
which a holiday calendar is to be displayed.

For fix networks this parameter is optional, for mobile networks it can
be optional depending on the released features. As a default COMMON
will be taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

COMMON FIX NET CHARGING


MCHARGE MOBILE CHARGING

Default: COMMON

YEAR CALENDAR YEAR

This parameter specifies the year of the calendar group for


which a holiday calendar is to be displayed.

Notes:
- If "X" is entered for the year, a holiday calendar is displayed
which contains holiday dates fixed for every year (e.g.
Christmas). If the year is entered, a holiday calendar is
displayed which contains the specific holiday dates for that
year (e.g. Easter).
- Fixed holiday dates can also be displayed in the year specific
holiday calendars.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...99, range of decimal numbers

Notes:
- The value 0 represents the year 2000.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP HOLIDAY- 1-


ENTR HOLIDAY

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER HOLIDAY

This command enters holidays.

Prerequisites:
- The time must be secure.

Following types of holidays can be entered:


- 13 fixed international half holidays (category HH).
- 13 fixed international full holidays (category HO).
- 13 fixed national full holidays (category HN).
- 16 movable international full holidays per year (category HO)
for 30 years in advance.
- 16 movable national full holidays per year (category HN)
for 30 years in advance.

Notes:
- When <year> = X is entered, the date entered is interpreted as
a fixed holiday applicable for every year and the date does
not change from year to year.
- When <year> is entered, the date is interpreted as a movable
holiday only applicable in the specified year.
- Movable holidays must be specified each year and the date
changes from year to year.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR HOLIDAY : DATE= ,WDCAT= [,FEAT=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DATE DATE

Notes:
- Up to 16 parameter values can be linked with &.
- Dates in the past are not allowed.
- All linked parameters must be for same year.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

Notes:
- The value 0 represents the year 2000.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

WDCAT WEEKDAY CATEGORY

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

HH HALF HOLIDAY INTERNATIONAL


HO FULL HOLIDAY INTERNATIONAL

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR HOLIDAY- 1+


ENTR HOLIDAY

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

HN FULL HOLIDAY NATIONAL

FEAT FEATURE

This parameter specifies the charging feature of the calendar group for
which a holiday calendar is to be created.

For fix networks this parameter is optional, for mobile networks it can
be optional depending on the released features. As a default COMMON
will be taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

COMMON FIX NET CHARGING


MCHARGE MOBILE CHARGING

Default: COMMON

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR HOLIDAY- 2-


CAN HOPFEATIP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Hop Feature for IP

This task cancels one or more Hot Operation feature(s).

Notes:
When the parameter ’HOP buffer type’ is omitted, all created Hot Operation
features are cancelled.

This task is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN HOPFEATIP : [HOP buffer type=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

HOP buffer type

This parameter specifies the symbolic name of the buffer identification.


’HOP small buffer 1’ and ’HOP small buffer 2’ are buffers designed for
real-time applications.
’HOP large buffer 1’ and ’HOP large buffer 2’ are buffers designed for
near-real-time applications.
’Emergency Call Trace buffer’,’Imsi Trace buffer’ and ’Mobile Call
Record buffer’ are buffers
designed for the General Data Collection Service (GDCS).

Possible values:
- ’HOP small buffer 1’
- ’HOP small buffer 2’
- ’HOP large buffer 1’
- ’HOP large buffer 2’
- ’Emergency Call Trace buffer’
- ’Imsi Trace buffer’
- ’Mobile Call Record buffer’

Notes:
This parameter may be omitted in order to cancel all created Hot
Operation features.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN HOPFEATIP- 1-


CR HOPFEATIP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create Hop Feature for IP

This task creates a Hot Operation feature.


This feature enables the spontaneous transmission of data to a remote
destination. The transmission is done by
means of a proprietary protocol, denoted as HOP (Hot Operation Protocol).
The Hot Operation feature can be used for real-time applications, near-real-time
applications and
the General Data Collection Service (GDCS).
When using real-time Hot Operation, the data are sent within a few seconds;
near-real-time Hot Operation sends the
data within a few minutes.
Real-time and GDCS Hot Operation can be ’Usage-sensitive’ or
’Non-usage-sensitive’.

In case the Hot Operation is used for the General Data Collection Service (GDCS),
’Usage-sensitive’ Hot Operation
indicates that only data that has not been successfully transfered via the Hot
Operation Protocol will be stored
on the disk belonging to that data ( Files IA.ICMCR or IA.ICITR ), with an
indication of the unsuccesful transfer.
’Non-usage sensitive’ means that all data will be stored additionally on the disk
belonging to that data
( Files IA.ICMCR or IA.ICITR ), with an indication if the transfer has been
successful or unsuccessful.

In case of real-time Hot Operation, ’Usage-sensitive’ indicates that the remote


partner absolutely needs all data.
When the connection between the network node and the remote partner is
temporarily out of service, the generated
data are stored on a backup file on the network node. After the link is restored,
the backup file can be sent to
the remote partner with a manual request. Data which have been successfully sent
to the remote partner,
are not kept on the network node side.
For ’Non-usage-sensitive’ real-time Hot Operation, ticket data which could not be
sent immediately to the remote
partner (e.g. due to link outage), are marked as unsuccessful. Ticket data which
have been successfully sent
are marked as successful. The further treatment of both successfully and
unsuccessfully sent ticket data depends
on the setting of the ’Ticket Distributor’. The data are either stored on disk,
or sent via another, near-real-time
Hot Operation feature to another destination.

Near-real-time Hot Operation however is always ’Usage-sensitive’.

Prerequisites:
- The Hot Operation feature can only be successfully applied, when the
proprietary Hot Operation Protocol is also
implemented at the remote destination.
- In case the Hot Operation feature is used for real-time, ’Non-usage-sensitive’
applications,
the ’Ticket Distributor’ with parameter ’Ticket type’ equal to ’AMA’ and
the ’Ticket Distributor’ with parameter ’Ticket type’ equal to ’INA’
have to be created first with the Task ’CR TICKDISTR’

Remark:
_ In case of usage of the Hot Operation feature with General Data Collection
Servive (GDCS), only the following
parameters have any significance: ’HOP buffer type’, ’HOP application name’,
’Application id.’, ’Output timer’,
’Primary destination’ and ’HOP quality’.

This task is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR HOPFEATIP : HOP buffer type= ,HOP application name= 1
1 1
1 ,Application id.= ,Output timer= 1
1 1
1 ,Primary destination= [,Secondary destination=] 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR HOPFEATIP- 1+
CR HOPFEATIP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1 1
1 [,HOP quality=] [,File buffer id.=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

HOP buffer type

This parameter specifies the symbolic name of the buffer identification.


’HOP small buffer 1’ and ’HOP small buffer 2’ are buffers designed for
real-time applications.
’HOP large buffer 1’ and ’HOP large buffer 2’ are buffers designed for
near-real-time applications.
’Emergency Call Trace’,’Imsi Trace’ and ’Mobile Call Record’ are buffers
designed for
the General Data Collection Service (GDCS).

Possible values:
- ’HOP small buffer 1’
- ’HOP small buffer 2’
- ’HOP large buffer 1’
- ’HOP large buffer 2’
- ’Emergency Call Trace buffer’
- ’Imsi Trace buffer’
- ’Mobile Call Record buffer’

HOP application name

This parameter specifies the symbolic name of the Hot Operation feature.
This Hot Operation feature name can be
common to several applications. It can only be assigned once to a ’HOP
buffer type’.
The same symbolic name has to be used as in the corresponding MML
command on the CP side.

Input format:
1...25 characters:
A...Z, a...z, 0 ..9,
!, %, &, /, (, ), =, #, +, .,
_, -, ,, >, <, :, @, [, ], |, {, }, ;

Application id.

This parameter specifies a numeric value, which identifies the


application, using the Hot Operation feature.

Input format:
0...255, range of decimal numbers

Output timer

This parameter specifies the time period for the periodic saving of the
Hot Operation buffer to the remote
partner.
In case of real-time Hot Operation features (characterized by the use of
small buffers), the minimum value is 5 seconds.
In case of near-real-time Hot Operation features (characterized by the
use of large buffers), the minimum value
is 40 seconds.
In case the General Data Collection Service (GDCS) is used
(characterized by the use of the GDCS specific buffers),
the minimum value is 1 second.

Input format:
minutes: 0...15, range of decimal numbers
seconds: 0...59, range of decimal numbers

Primary destination

This parameter specifies the address of the Primary Destination. The


address can be indicated in IPV4 (Internet Protocol
Version 4) format, or in IPV6 (Internet Protocol Version 6) format.

Input format:
’IPV4 format’:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR HOPFEATIP- 2+
CR HOPFEATIP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

size: 4 numbers
of: 0...255, range of decimal numbers

Or

’IPV6 format’:
size: 8 numbers
of: 0...65535, range of decimal numbers

Restrictions:
’IPV4 format’ value (0.0.0.0) and ’IPV6 format’ value (0.0.0.0.0.0.0.0)
are not allowed.

In case that the General Data Collection Service (GDCS) is used, usage
of IPV4 address format is recommended.

Secondary destination

This parameter specifies the address of the Secondary Destination. The


address can be indicated in IPV4 (Internet Protocol
Version 4) format, or in IPV6 (Internet Protocol Version 6) format.
This parameter is not to be entered when using the General Data
Collection Service (GDCS).

Input format:
’IPV4 format’:
size: 4 numbers
of: 0...255, range of decimal numbers

Or

’IPV6 format’:
size: 8 numbers
of: 0...65535, range of decimal numbers

Restrictions:
’IPV4 format’ value (0.0.0.0) and ’IPV6 format’ value (0.0.0.0.0.0.0.0)
are not allowed.

HOP quality

This parameter is only relevant in case the Hot Operation feature is


used for real-time applications (characterized
by the use of small buffers) or for the General Data Collection service
(GDCS) (characterized by the use of the
GDCS specific buffers).
In case the Hot Operation is used for the General Data Collection
Service (GDCS), ’Usage-sensitive’ Hot Operation
indicates that only data that has not been successfully transfered via
the Hot Operation Protocol will be stored
on the disk belonging to that data ( Files IA.ICMCR or IA.ICITR ), with
an indication of the unsuccesful transfer.
’Non-usage sensitive’ means that all data offered to the HOP for
transfer will be stored additionally on the disk
belonging to that data ( Files IA.ICMCR or IA.ICITR ), with an
indication if the transfer has been successful or
unsuccessful.
In case of real-time Hot Operation, ’Usage-sensitive’ indicates that
the remote partner absolutely needs all data.
When the connection between the network node and the remote partner is
temporarily out of service, the generated
data are stored on a backup file on the network node. After the link is
restored, the backup file can be sent to
the remote partner with a manual request. Data which have been
successfully sent to the remote partner,
are not kept on the network node side.
For ’Non-usage-sensitive’ real-time Hot Operation, ticket data which
could not be sent immediately to the remote
partner (e.g. due to link outage), are marked as unsuccessful. Ticket
data which have been successfully sent
are marked as successful. The further treatment of both successfully and
unsuccessfully sent ticket data depends
on the setting of the ’Ticket Distributor’. The data are either stored
on disk, or sent via another, near-real-time
Hot Operation feature to another destination.
In case the Hot Operation feature is used for near-real-time
applications, the parameter ’HOP quality’ should

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR HOPFEATIP- 3+
CR HOPFEATIP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

be set on ’Usage-sensitive’. The data which are successfully sent to the


remote partner are not kept on the
network node side. The data which could not be sent immediately to the
remote partner are written into a file on the
network node, without a mark for successful or unsuccessful transfer.

Possible values:
- ’Usage-sensitive’
- ’Non-usage-sensitive’

File buffer id.

This parameter specifies the used buffer for the backup file.
This parameter is mandatory, in case the Hot Operation feature is used
for real-time applications and the parameter
’HOP quality’ is set on ’usage-sensitive’.
This parameter is not to be entered when using the General Data
Collection Service (GDCS).
The names of the SAMAR file are fixed for GDCS and depend on the chosen
HOP buffer type:
- ’Emergency Call Trace buffer’ = IA.ICMCR
- ’Imsi Trace buffer’ = IA.ICITR
- ’Mobile Call Record buffer’ = IA.ICMCR

Prerequisites:
The backup file must have a variable Record Format with a minimum Record
Size of 56 Kbyte.

Possible values:
- ’Buffer 1’
- ’Buffer 2’
- ’Buffer 3’
- ’Buffer 4’
- ’Buffer 5’
- ’Buffer 6’
- ’Buffer 7’

Restrictions:
The value ’No buffer’ is not allowed.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR HOPFEATIP- 4-
DISP HOPFEATIP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Hop Feature for IP

This task displays one or more Hot Operation feature(s).

Notes:
- When the parameter ’HOP buffer type’ is omitted, all created Hot Operation
features are displayed.
- In case of usage of the Hot Operation feature with General Data Collection
Servive (GDCS), only the following
parameters have any significance: ’HOP buffer type’, ’HOP application name’,
’Application id.’, ’Output timer’,
’Primary destination’ and ’HOP quality’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP HOPFEATIP : [HOP buffer type=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

HOP buffer type

This parameter specifies the symbolic name of the buffer identification.


’HOP small buffer 1’ and ’HOP small buffer 2’ are buffers designed for
real-time applications.
’HOP large buffer 1’ and ’HOP large buffer 2’ are buffers designed for
near-real-time applications.
’Emergency Call Trace’,’Imsi Trace’ and ’Mobile Call Record’ are buffers
designed for
the General Data Collection Service (GDCS).

Possible values:
- ’HOP small buffer 1’
- ’HOP small buffer 2’
- ’HOP large buffer 1’
- ’HOP large buffer 2’
- ’Emergency Call Trace’
- ’Imsi Trace’
- ’Mobile Call Record’

Notes:
This parameter may be omitted in order to display all created Hot
Operation features.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP HOPFEATIP- 1-


MOD HOPFEATIP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Hop Feature for IP

This task can modify the ’Output timer’ of a Hot Operation feature.

In case the Hot Operation feature is used with the General Data Collecting
Service (GDCS),
also the ’Primary destination’ and the ’HOP quality’ can be modified.

This task is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD HOPFEATIP : HOP buffer type= [,Output timer=] 1
1 1
1 [,Primary destination=] [,HOP quality=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

HOP buffer type

This parameter specifies the symbolic name of the buffer identification.


’HOP small buffer 1’ and ’HOP small buffer 2’ are buffers designed for
real-time applications.
’HOP large buffer 1’ and ’HOP large buffer 2’ are buffers designed for
near-real-time applications.
’Emergency Call Trace’,’Imsi Trace’ and ’Mobile Call Record’ are buffers
designed for
the General Data Collection Service (GDCS).

Possible values:
- ’HOP small buffer 1’
- ’HOP small buffer 2’
- ’HOP large buffer 1’
- ’HOP large buffer 2’
- ’Emergency Call Trace’
- ’Imsi Trace’
- ’Mobile Call Record’

Output timer

This parameter specifies the time period for the periodic saving of the
Hot Operation buffer to the remote
partner.
In case of real-time Hot Operation features (characterized by the use of
small buffers), the minimum value is 5 seconds.
In case of near-real-time Hot Operation features (characterized by the
use of large buffers), the minimum value
is 40 seconds.
In case the General Data Collection Service (GDCS) is used
(characterized by the use of the GDCS specific buffers),
the minimum value is 1 second.

Input format:
minutes: 0...15, range of decimal numbers
seconds: 0...59, range of decimal numbers

Primary destination

This parameter can only be entered in case the General Data Collection
Service (GDCS) is used.

This parameter specifies the address of the Primary Destination. The


address can be indicated in IPV4 (Internet Protocol
Version 4) format, or in IPV6 (Internet Protocol Version 6) format.

Input format:
’IPV4 format’:
size: 4 numbers
of: 0...255, range of decimal numbers

Or

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD HOPFEATIP- 1+


MOD HOPFEATIP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

’IPV6 format’:
size: 8 numbers
of: 0...65535, range of decimal numbers

Restrictions:
’IPV4 format’ value (0.0.0.0) and ’IPV6 format’ value (0.0.0.0.0.0.0.0)
are not allowed.

In case that the General Data Collection Service (GDCS) is used, usage
of IPV4 address format is recommended.

HOP quality

This parameter can only be entered in case the General Data Collection
Service (GDCS) is used.
For the General Data Collection Service (GDCS), ’Usage-sensitive’ Hot
Operation indicates that only data which have not been
transferred succesfully will be stored on disk. The data will be stored
with an indication of the unsuccessful transfer.
’Non-usage-sensitive’ means that all data is stored on disk with an
indication if the hot-operation transfer has been
successfull or unsuccessfull.

Possible values:
- ’Usage-sensitive’
- ’Non-usage-sensitive’

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD HOPFEATIP- 2-


DEF HWTPCOD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Define Hardware Code Tracepoint

This script defines a SWT hardware tracepoint.


You have to provide an ID name (max. 17 chars) and
the trace address itself (may consist of a single address
or up to four addresses, each address max. 72 chars).

You can provide the capsule of the trace address (8 chars).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DEF HWTPCOD : SWTid= [,SWTcps=] ,SWThwAddr= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SWTid

Name of ID (max. 17 chars)

SWTcps

Capsule of the trace address (8 chars)

SWThwAddr

may consist of a single address or up to four


addresses (each address max. 72 chars).

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DEF HWTPCOD- 1-


DEF HWTPDATA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Define Hardware Data Tracepoint

This script defines a SWT hardware data tracepoint.


You have to provide an ID name (max. 17 chars),
the data address itself (may consist of a single address
or up to four addresses, each address max. 72 chars),
the data access type (write/read & write),
and data access length (1 byte/2 bytes/4 bytes).

You can provide the capsule of the data address (8 chars)


and the Code Range of the traced address.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DEF HWTPDATA : SWTid= [,SWTcps=] ,SWThwaddr= ,SWThwtype= 1
1 1
1 ,SWThwlen= [,SWTcoderange=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SWTid

Name of ID (max. 17 chars)

SWTcps

Capsule of the trace address (8 chars)

SWThwaddr

May consist of a single address or up


to five address ranges (each address max. 72 chars)

SWThwtype

The HW tracepoint type can be Write or Read & write.

SWThwlen

The HW tracepoint length can be 1 byte, 2 bytes or 4 bytes.

SWTcoderange

The coderage of the tracepoint can be ID inside code range or


outside code range.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DEF HWTPDATA- 1-


CONT HWUPGMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Continue HW Upgrade on MP

This task is part of the HW Upgrade task sequence,


which differs from the regular System Upgrade task sequence only in this task.
This task continues the HW Upgrade on MP after it was interrupted
for the purpose of an MP exchange.

The task is to be entered:


a) during the task INST GENMP is running - on the non-switching side 1
b) during the task UTIL GENMP is running - on the switching side 0

Description:
The event report readyForMpExchangeOrContinue is issued when the system is
ready for MPU exchange. It indicates to the operator that one or several of
the MPUs may now be replaced. The operator afterwards continues
the HW Upgrade sequence by entering this task as described above.
MPU exchange: A red LED on the front panel of the MPU board
indicates which of the MP boards (one per pair, always on the same side,
either 0 or 1) are ready to be replaced.
The operator may change some of the units, or all of them.

The first side of MPUs can be replaced, when the event report
readyForMpExchangeOrContinue is received during the INST GENMP task.
The corresponding MPU boards of the other side of MPUs can be replaced,
when this event report is received during the UTIL GENMP task.

If replacement of the MPU-SA is required, the operator has to enter the


relevant office data and the HW indication flag in the MPU boot dialog.
As soon as the MPU-SA has reached active state (SP8 reached), the operator
again receives the event report readyforMpExchangeorContinue, meaning that now
this task can be entered to continue the HW- Upgrade sequence.

Prerequisites:
- A valid Upgrade Control Table (UCT) file is required.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONT HWUPGMP ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONT HWUPGMP- 1-


CAN IACOBJ
ANGRP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL IACHASTA OBJECT

This command cancels an IACHASTA object for a trunk group, a directory


number block, an announcement group, a private branch exchange,
a digital line unit, a V5 interface, a destination or a statistic index.

Notes:
For the canceling of an object, several cases can occur:

1/ There are other call processing elements (trunk groups, DN-blocks, etc.)
for the same object:
In this case, the IACHASTA object itself is not deleted. Only the connection
between the specified element and the object is canceled.

2/ No further elements exist for the object and the object does not participate
(i.e. as the origin, destination or destination classification) in an active
IACHASTA registration point. In this case, the object is immediately canceled.

3/ No further elements exist for the object but the object still participates
in an active registration point.
The command is rejected. All registration points for this object must be
canceled before the object itself can be canceled.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CAN IACOBJ - ANGRP ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP


2. CAN IACOBJ - DEST DESTINATION
3. CAN IACOBJ - DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT
4. CAN IACOBJ - DNBLOCK DIRECTORY NUMBER BLOCK
5. CAN IACOBJ - PBX PRIVATE BRANCH EXCHANGE
6. CAN IACOBJ - STAT STATISTIC INDEX
7. CAN IACOBJ - TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER
8. CAN IACOBJ - V5IF V5 INTERFACE

1. Input format

ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP

This input format cancels an IACHASTA object for a recorded


announcement group.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IACOBJ : OBJ= ,ANGRP= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA object name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANGRP ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP

This parameter specifies a recorded announcement group.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IACOBJ- 1+


CAN IACOBJ
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

DESTINATION

This input format cancels an IACHASTA object for a destination.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IACOBJ : OBJ= ,DEST= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA object name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies a destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IACOBJ- 2+


CAN IACOBJ
DLU
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This input format cancels an IACHASTA object for a digital line unit.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IACOBJ : OBJ= ,DLU= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA object name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This parameter specifies a digital line unit.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...2550, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IACOBJ- 3+


CAN IACOBJ
DNBLOCK
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

DIRECTORY NUMBER BLOCK

This input format cancels an IACHASTA object for a directory number block.
The parameter DN refers to the first directory number of the directory
number block.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IACOBJ : OBJ= ,LAC= ,DN= [,PBX=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA object name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies a local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies a directory number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PBX PRIVATE BRANCH EXCHANGE

This parameter refers to a private branch exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO (NO PBX)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IACOBJ- 4+


CAN IACOBJ
PBX
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

PRIVATE BRANCH EXCHANGE

This input format cancels an IACHASTA object for a private branch exchange.
The parameter DN refers to the pilot directory number of the private
branch exchange.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IACOBJ : OBJ= ,LAC= ,DN= ,PBX= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA object name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies a local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies a directory number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PBX PRIVATE BRANCH EXCHANGE

This parameter refers to a private branch exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

YES YES (PBX)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IACOBJ- 5+


CAN IACOBJ
STAT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

6. Input format

STATISTIC INDEX

This input format cancels an IACHASTA object for a statistic index


assigned to a zone point.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IACOBJ : OBJ= ,STAT= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA object name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

STAT STATISTIC INDEX

This parameter specifies a statistic index assigned to a zone point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...255, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IACOBJ- 6+


CAN IACOBJ
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

7. Input format

TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This input format cancels an IACHASTA object for a trunk group.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IACOBJ : OBJ= ,TGNO= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA object name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies a trunk group number.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IACOBJ- 7+


CAN IACOBJ
V5IF
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

8. Input format

V5 INTERFACE

This input format cancels an IACHASTA object for a V5 interface.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IACOBJ : OBJ= ,V5IF= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA object name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

V5IF V5 INTERFACE

This parameter specifies a V5 interface.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

6000...8999, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IACOBJ- 8-


CR IACOBJ
ANGRP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE IACHASTA OBJECT

This command creates an IACHASTA object for a trunk group, a directory


number block, an announcement group, a private branch exchange,
a digital line unit, a V5 interface, a destination or a statistic index.
This object can then be used as the origin or destination of an
IACHASTA registration point. The same object name can be used for
multiple call processing elements of the same or a different type.
Exception: objects created for a destination, with the additional
destination classification unit can only be used for multiple
call processing elements of the same kind, i.e. destinations.
If the object is created for a destination with the additional unit for
destination classification, then the object can additionally be used
for destination classification of an IACHASTA registration point.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR IACOBJ - ANGRP ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP


2. CR IACOBJ - DEST DESTINATION
3. CR IACOBJ - DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT
4. CR IACOBJ - DNBLOCK DIRECTORY NUMBER BLOCK
5. CR IACOBJ - PBX PRIVATE BRANCH EXCHANGE
6. CR IACOBJ - STAT STATISTIC INDEX
7. CR IACOBJ - TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER
8. CR IACOBJ - V5IF V5 INTERFACE

1. Input format

ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP

This input format creates an IACHASTA object for a recorded


announcement group.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR IACOBJ : OBJ= ,ANGRP= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA object name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ANGRP ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP

This parameter specifies a recorded announcement group.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IACOBJ- 1+
CR IACOBJ
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

DESTINATION

This input format creates an IACHASTA object for a destination.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR IACOBJ : OBJ= ,DEST= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA object name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies a destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: DESTINATION=
1...12 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

b: DESTINATION CLASSIFICATION
DESTCLSF DESTINATION CLASSIFICATION

This parameter unit specifies whether the object is created as


a destination classification object. If so, only destinations
can be assigned to it and it can be used for the creation of
registration points with destination classification.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IACOBJ- 2+
CR IACOBJ
DLU
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This input format creates an IACHASTA object for a digital line unit.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR IACOBJ : OBJ= ,DLU= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA object name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This parameter specifies a digital line unit.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...2550, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IACOBJ- 3+
CR IACOBJ
DNBLOCK
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

DIRECTORY NUMBER BLOCK

This input format creates an IACHASTA object for a directory number block.
The parameter DN refers to the first directory number of the directory
number block.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR IACOBJ : OBJ= ,LAC= ,DN= [,PBX=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA object name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies a local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies a directory number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PBX PRIVATE BRANCH EXCHANGE

This parameter refers to a private branch exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO (NO PBX)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IACOBJ- 4+
CR IACOBJ
PBX
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

PRIVATE BRANCH EXCHANGE

This input format creates an IACHASTA object for a private branch exchange.
The parameter DN refers to the pilot directory number of the private
branch exchange.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR IACOBJ : OBJ= ,LAC= ,DN= ,PBX= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA object name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies a local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies a directory number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PBX PRIVATE BRANCH EXCHANGE

This parameter refers to a private branch exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

YES YES (PBX)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IACOBJ- 5+
CR IACOBJ
STAT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

6. Input format

STATISTIC INDEX

This input format creates an IACHASTA object for a statistic index


assigned to a zone point.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR IACOBJ : OBJ= ,STAT= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA object name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

STAT STATISTIC INDEX

This parameter specifies a statistic index assigned to a zone point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...255, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IACOBJ- 6+
CR IACOBJ
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

7. Input format

TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This input format creates an IACHASTA object for a trunk group.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR IACOBJ : OBJ= ,TGNO= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA object name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies a trunk group number.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IACOBJ- 7+
CR IACOBJ
V5IF
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

8. Input format

V5 INTERFACE

This input format creates an IACHASTA object for a V5 interface.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR IACOBJ : OBJ= ,V5IF= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA object name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

V5IF V5 INTERFACE

This parameter specifies a V5 interface.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

6000...8999, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IACOBJ- 8-
DISP IACOBJ
ANGRP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IACHASTA OBJECT

This command displays IACHASTA objects. The output depends


on the input format used.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP IACOBJ - ANGRP ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP


2. DISP IACOBJ - DEST DESTINATION
3. DISP IACOBJ - DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT
4. DISP IACOBJ - DNBLOCK DIRECTORY NUMBER BLOCK
5. DISP IACOBJ - OBJ OBJECT
6. DISP IACOBJ - PBX PRIVATE BRANCH EXCHANGE
7. DISP IACOBJ - STAT STATISTIC INDEX
8. DISP IACOBJ - TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER
9. DISP IACOBJ - V5IF V5 INTERFACE

1. Input format

ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP

This input format displays the IACHASTA object of a recorded announcement


group.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACOBJ : ANGRP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ANGRP ANNOUNCEMENT GROUP

This parameter specifies a recorded announcement group.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACOBJ- 1+


DISP IACOBJ
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

DESTINATION

This input format displays the IACHASTA object of a destination.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACOBJ : DEST= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies a destination.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACOBJ- 2+


DISP IACOBJ
DLU
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This input format displays the IACHASTA object of a digital line unit.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACOBJ : DLU= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This parameter specifies a digital line unit.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...2550, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACOBJ- 3+


DISP IACOBJ
DNBLOCK
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

DIRECTORY NUMBER BLOCK

This input format displays the IACHASTA object of a directory number block.
The parameter DN refers to the first directory number of the directory
number block.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACOBJ : LAC= ,DN= [,PBX=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies a local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies a directory number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PBX PRIVATE BRANCH EXCHANGE

This parameter refers to a private branch exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO (NO PBX)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACOBJ- 4+


DISP IACOBJ
OBJ
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

OBJECT

When a specific IACHASTA object name is entered, this input format


displays all elements (trunk groups, directory number blocks, ...)
connected to that object.
When the value "X" is entered for parameter OBJ, an alphabetical
list of all existing IACHASTA objects (i.e. names) is displayed.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACOBJ : OBJ= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJ OBJECT

This parameter specifies an IACHASTA object name.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACOBJ- 5+


DISP IACOBJ
PBX
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

6. Input format

PRIVATE BRANCH EXCHANGE

This input format displays the IACHASTA object of a private branch exchange.
The parameter DN refers to the pilot directory number of the private
branch exchange.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACOBJ : LAC= ,DN= ,PBX= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies a local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies a directory number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PBX PRIVATE BRANCH EXCHANGE

This parameter refers to a private branch exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

YES YES (PBX)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACOBJ- 6+


DISP IACOBJ
STAT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

7. Input format

STATISTIC INDEX

This input format displays the IACHASTA object of a statistic index


assigned to a zone point.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACOBJ : STAT= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

STAT STATISTIC INDEX

This parameter specifies a statistic index assigned to a zone point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...255, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACOBJ- 7+


DISP IACOBJ
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

8. Input format

TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This input format displays the IACHASTA object of a trunk group.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACOBJ : TGNO= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies a trunk group number.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACOBJ- 8+


DISP IACOBJ
V5IF
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

9. Input format

V5 INTERFACE

This input format displays the IACHASTA object of a V5 interface.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACOBJ : V5IF= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

V5IF V5 INTERFACE

This parameter specifies a V5 interface.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

6000...8999, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACOBJ- 9-


ACT IACRG
AMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE IACHASTA REGISTRATION

This command activates an IACHASTA registration immediately or at the specified


date and time. The registration will be deactivated automatically if a
termination time is specified.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ACT IACRG - AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING


2. ACT IACRG - MET METERING REGISTRATION

1. Input format

AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING

This input format activates a ticketing registration.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT IACRG : OUT= [,BEG=] [,TER=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OUT OUTPUT TYPE

This parameter specifies the output type. When metering is chosen,


the call data are added on counters. When ticketing is chosen,
the call data are written in separate tickets.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING

BEG BEGIN DATE AND TIME

This parameter specifies the activation time for the registration.


If the parameter is omitted, the registration is activated
immediately.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

d: HOUR OF BEGIN TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

TER TERMINATION DATE AND TIME

This parameter specifies the deactivation date and time for


a registration. If the parameter is omitted, continuous
registration is activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IACRG- 1+


ACT IACRG
AMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a: YEAR OF TERMINATION DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

d: HOUR OF TERMINATION TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IACRG- 2+


ACT IACRG
MET
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

METERING REGISTRATION

This input format activates a metering registration.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT IACRG : OUT= ,RGPTTYPE= [,BEG=] [,TER=] [,FILEEXT=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OUT OUTPUT TYPE

This parameter specifies the output type. When metering is chosen,


the call data are added on counters. When ticketing is chosen,
the call data are written in separate tickets.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

MET METERING

RGPTTYPE REGISTRATION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the registration point type (single sided or


double sided or mixed single/double sided) for which the registration
is activated.
It must be identical to the value that was used for activation.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DOUBLE DOUBLE
MIXED MIXED
SINGLE SINGLE

BEG BEGIN DATE AND TIME

This parameter specifies the activation time for the registration.


If the parameter is omitted, the registration is activated
immediately.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

d: HOUR OF BEGIN TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

TER TERMINATION DATE AND TIME

This parameter specifies the deactivation date and time for


a registration. If the parameter is omitted, continuous
registration is activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: YEAR OF TERMINATION DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IACRG- 3+


ACT IACRG
MET
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: MONTH OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

d: HOUR OF TERMINATION TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

FILEEXT FILE EXTENSION

This parameter specifies the file extension. It offers the


possibility of labeling the account files made for the activated
meter registrations.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IACRG- 4-


DACT IACRG
AMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE IACHASTA REGISTRATION

This command deactivates an IACHASTA registration.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DACT IACRG - AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING


2. DACT IACRG - MET METERING REGISTRATION

1. Input format

AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING

This input format deactivates a ticketing registration.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DACT IACRG : OUT= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OUT OUTPUT TYPE

This parameter specifies the output type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT IACRG- 1+


DACT IACRG
MET
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

METERING REGISTRATION

This input format deactivates a metering registration.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DACT IACRG : OUT= ,RGPTTYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OUT OUTPUT TYPE

This parameter specifies the output type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

MET METERING

RGPTTYPE REGISTRATION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the registration point type (single sided or


double sided or mixed single/double sided) for which the registration
is deactivated. It must be identical to the value that was used for
activation.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DOUBLE DOUBLE
MIXED MIXED
SINGLE SINGLE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT IACRG- 2-


DISP IACRG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IACHASTA REGISTRATION

This command displays the status and characteristics of all activated


IACHASTA registrations.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACRG ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACRG- 1-


CAN IACRGPT
ANONYM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL IACHASTA REGISTRATION POINT

This command cancels an anonymous or named IACHASTA registration point


or removes an origin/destination/destination classification object
combination from a named registration point.

Notes:
For the canceling of a registration point, several cases can occur:

1/ There are other origin/destination/destination classification object


combinations created for the same named registration point.
In this case, the link with the named registration point is canceled,
the registration point itself is not deleted.

2/ No further origin/destination/destination classification object


combinations exist and no registration is active for the specified
registration point.
In this case, the registration point is immediately canceled.

3/ No further origin/destination/destination classification object


combinations exist and a registration is active for the specified
registration point.
In this case, the registration point is placed in an inactive status.
The registration point remains inactive until accounting (automatic or
forced by MML) for the registration has taken place. The registration
point is then canceled automatically.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CAN IACRGPT - ANONYM ANONYMOUS REGISTRATION POINT


2. CAN IACRGPT - RGPT NAMED REGISTRATION POINT

1. Input format

ANONYMOUS REGISTRATION POINT

This input format cancels an anonymous registration point.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IACRGPT : <OBJORIG= ,OBJDEST=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJORIG OBJECT ORIGIN

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA origin object for the definition
of the registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OBJDEST OBJECT DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA destination object for the


definition of the registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IACRGPT- 1+


CAN IACRGPT
RGPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

NAMED REGISTRATION POINT

This input format cancels a named registration point.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IACRGPT : <OBJORIG= ,OBJDEST=> [,DESTCLSF=] ,RGPT= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJORIG OBJECT ORIGIN

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA origin object for the definition
of the registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OBJDEST OBJECT DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA destination object for the


definition of the registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DESTCLSF DESTINATION CLASSIFICATION

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA destination classification


object for the definition of the registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

RGPT REGISTRATION POINT NAME

This parameter specifies the registration point name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IACRGPT- 2-


CR IACRGPT
AMAANON
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE IACHASTA REGISTRATION POINT

This command creates an IACHASTA registration point.


In general this means that an output type (AMA and/or metering)
is assigned to the specified combination of origin and/or
destination objects and eventually a destination classification
object.The specified combination can be a single registration point
(OBJORIG specified OR OBJDEST specified), which means that
only traffic is registered with IACHASTA, routed over the specified
object(s). The specified combination can also be a double registration
point (OBJORIG specified AND OBJDEST specified), which means
that only traffic is registered with IACHASTA, routed over the specified
origin object AND the specified destination object.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR IACRGPT - AMAANON IACAMA ANONYMOUS REGISTRATION POINT


2. CR IACRGPT - AMARGPT IACAMA NAMED REGISTRATION POINT
3. CR IACRGPT - METANON IACMET ANONYMOUS REGISTRATION POINT
4. CR IACRGPT - METRGPT IACMET NAMED REGISTRATION POINT

1. Input format

IACAMA ANONYMOUS REGISTRATION POINT

This input format creates an anonymous registration point


for ticketing.
This means that the point has no name of its own.
It is identified by the unique combination of origin
and/or destination object and output type.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR IACRGPT : <OBJORIG= ,OBJDEST=> ,OUT= [,SUCCONLY=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJORIG OBJECT ORIGIN

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA origin object for the definition
of the registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OBJDEST OBJECT DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA destination object for the


definition of the registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OUT OUTPUT TYPE

This parameter specifies the output type, i.e. whether call data must
be added to counters or written in a ticket.
This value must be compatible with the stored value if a registration
point with the same name already exists.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IACRGPT- 1+
CR IACRGPT
AMAANON
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SUCCONLY SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY

This parameter specifies that only successful


calls must be registered for IACAMA.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY


NO NO SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY
Y SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY
YES SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY

Default: NO

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IACRGPT- 2+
CR IACRGPT
AMARGPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

IACAMA NAMED REGISTRATION POINT

This input format creates a named registration point for ticketing.


This means that the point has its own name and that different
origin/destination/destination classification object combinations
with the same output type can be assigned to it.

Note: Any given origin/destination/destination classification


output type combination can only exist once in the system.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR IACRGPT : <OBJORIG= ,OBJDEST=> [,DESTCLSF=] [,SUCCONLY=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,OUT= ,RGPT= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJORIG OBJECT ORIGIN

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA origin object for the definition
of the registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OBJDEST OBJECT DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA destination object for the


definition of the registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DESTCLSF DESTINATION CLASSIFICATION

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA destination classification


object for the definition of the registration point.
Every other combination of origin- and/or destination objects
(standard objects) can be combined with a destination
classification object. In this case, a registration only takes
place, if these standard objects AND the destination
classification object are part of the connection.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SUCCONLY SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY

This parameter specifies that only successful


calls must be registered for IACAMA.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY


NO NO SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY
Y SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY
YES SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY

Default: NO

OUT OUTPUT TYPE

This parameter specifies the output type, i.e. whether call data must
be added to counters or written in a ticket.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IACRGPT- 3+
CR IACRGPT
AMARGPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This value must be compatible with the stored value if a registration


point with the same name already exists.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING

RGPT REGISTRATION POINT NAME

This parameter specifies the registration point name. When a


registration point name is specified, and the registration
point name already exists, the output type (AMA or MET) must
be the same as the registration point(s) available in the IACHASTA
registration point database under the same registration point name.
The kind of registration point(s) under the same registration point
name must also have the same point type (single-sided (only OBJORIG or
OBJDEST specified) or double-sided (both OBJORIG and OBJDEST
specified)).
When a named registration point is created with SUCCONLY=YES,
all subsequent additions of object combinations for this named
registration point have to be specified with SUCCONLY=YES too.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IACRGPT- 4+
CR IACRGPT
METANON
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

IACMET ANONYMOUS REGISTRATION POINT

This input format creates an anonymous registration point


for metering.
This means that the point has no name of its own.
It is identified by the unique combination of origin
and/or destination and output type.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR IACRGPT : <OBJORIG= ,OBJDEST=> ,OUT= ,SCHED= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJORIG OBJECT ORIGIN

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA origin object for the definition
of the registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OBJDEST OBJECT DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA destination object for the


definition of the registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OUT OUTPUT TYPE

This parameter specifies the output type, i.e. whether call data must
be added to counters or written in a ticket.
This value must be compatible with the stored value if a registration
point with the same name already exists.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

MET METERING

SCHED SCHEDULE

This parameter specifies the schedule that should be used for


the metering registration point to split up the call data
in different time groups.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IACRGPT- 5+
CR IACRGPT
METRGPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

IACMET NAMED REGISTRATION POINT

This input format creates a named registration point for metering.


This means that the point has its own name and that different
origin/destination/destination classification object combinations
with the same output type can be assigned to it.

Note: Any given origin/destination/destination classification


output type combination can only exist once in the system.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR IACRGPT : <OBJORIG= ,OBJDEST=> [,DESTCLSF=] ,OUT= ,RGPT= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,SCHED= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJORIG OBJECT ORIGIN

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA origin object for the definition
of the registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OBJDEST OBJECT DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA destination object for the


definition of the registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DESTCLSF DESTINATION CLASSIFICATION

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA destination classification


object for the definition of the registration point.
Every other combination of origin- and/or destination objects
(standard objects) can be combined with a destination
classification object. In this case, a registration only takes
place, if these standard objects AND the destination
classification object are part of the connection.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OUT OUTPUT TYPE

This parameter specifies the output type, i.e. whether call data must
be added to counters or written in a ticket.
This value must be compatible with the stored value if a registration
point with the same name already exists.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

MET METERING

RGPT REGISTRATION POINT NAME

This parameter specifies the registration point name. When a


registration point name is specified, and the registration
point name already exists, the output type (AMA or MET) must
be the same as the registration point(s) available in the IACHASTA

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IACRGPT- 6+
CR IACRGPT
METRGPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

registration point database under the same registration point name.


The kind of registration point(s) under the same registration point
name must also have the same point type (single-sided (only OBJORIG or
OBJDEST specified) or double-sided (both OBJORIG and OBJDEST
specified)).
When a named registration point is created with SUCCONLY=YES,
all subsequent additions of object combinations for this named
registration point have to be specified with SUCCONLY=YES too.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SCHED SCHEDULE

This parameter specifies the schedule that should be used for


the metering registration point to split up the call data
in different time groups.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IACRGPT- 7-
DISP IACRGPT
OBJDEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IACHASTA REGISTRATION POINT

This command displays IACHASTA registration points. The output depends


on the input format used.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP IACRGPT - OBJDEST SINGLE SIDED REGISTR. POINTS FOR OBJDEST


2. DISP IACRGPT - OBJORIG SINGLE SIDED REGISTR. POINTS FOR OBJORIG
3. DISP IACRGPT - OTHER OTHER REGISTRATION POINTS
4. DISP IACRGPT - RGPT NAMED REGISTRATION POINTS

1. Input format

SINGLE SIDED REGISTR. POINTS FOR OBJDEST

This input format displays the single sided registration points for the
specified destination object. The following table gives an overview of
the allowed parameter combinations and their results. Both named and
anonymous registration points are displayed with this input format.

OBJORIG OBJDEST DESTCLSF Result

- value value single sided registration points with


OBJDEST=value, DESTCLSF=value and no OBJORIG
- value - single sided registration points with
OBJDEST=value, no OBJORIG and no DESTCLSF
- value X single sided registration points with
OBJDEST=value, no OBJORIG and any DESTCLSF

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACRGPT : OBJDEST= [,DESTCLSF=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJDEST OBJECT DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA destination object.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DESTCLSF DESTINATION CLASSIFICATION

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA destination classification


object.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACRGPT- 1+


DISP IACRGPT
OBJORIG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

SINGLE SIDED REGISTR. POINTS FOR OBJORIG

This input format displays the single sided registration points for
the specified origin object. The following table gives an overview of
the allowed parameter combinations and their results. Both named and
anonymous registration points are displayed with this input format.

OBJORIG OBJDEST DESTCLSF Result

value - value single sided registration points with


OBJORIG=value, DESTCLSF=value and no OBJDEST
value - - single sided registration points with
OBJORIG=value, no OBJDEST and no DESTCLSF
value - X single sided registration points with
OBJORIG=value, no OBJDEST and any DESTCLSF

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACRGPT : OBJORIG= [,DESTCLSF=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJORIG OBJECT ORIGIN

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA origin object.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DESTCLSF DESTINATION CLASSIFICATION

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA destination classification


object.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACRGPT- 2+


DISP IACRGPT
OTHER
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

OTHER REGISTRATION POINTS

This input format displays the registration points for the specified
input parameters. The following table gives an overview of the allowed
parameter combinations and their results. Both named and anonymous
registration points are displayed with this input format.

OBJORIG OBJDEST DESTCLSF Result

value value value double sided registration points with


OBJORIG=value, OBJDEST=value and DESTCLSF=value
value value - double sided registration points with
OBJORIG=value, OBJDEST=value and no DESTCLSF
value value X double sided registration points with
OBJORIG=value, OBJDEST=value and any DESTCLSF
value X value registration points with OBJORIG=value,
DESTCLSF=value and any OBJDEST
value X - registration points with OBJORIG=value,
any OBJDEST and no DESTCLSF
value X X registration points with OBJORIG=value,
any OBJDEST and any DESTCLSF
X value value registration points with OBJDEST=value,
DESTCLSF=value and any OBJORIG
X value - registration points with OBJDEST=value,
any OBJORIG and no DESTCLSF
X value X registration points with OBJDEST=value,
any OBJORIG and any DESTCLSF
X X - ALL registration points
(any OBJORIG, any OBJDEST and ANY DESTCLSF)
X X X ALL registration points
(any OBJORIG, any OBJDEST and any DESTCLSF)

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACRGPT : OBJORIG= ,OBJDEST= [,DESTCLSF=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJORIG OBJECT ORIGIN

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA origin object.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OBJDEST OBJECT DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA destination object.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

DESTCLSF DESTINATION CLASSIFICATION

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA destination classification


object.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACRGPT- 3+


DISP IACRGPT
RGPT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

NAMED REGISTRATION POINTS

This input format displays named registration points.


When a name is specified, all the information of the registration
point is displayed. When the value "X" is entered, an
alphabetical list of all the named registration points is displayed.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACRGPT : RGPT= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RGPT REGISTRATION POINT NAME

This parameter specifies the registration point name.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACRGPT- 4-


MOD IACRGPT
ANAMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY IACHASTA REGISTRATION POINT

This command modifies the schedule that is to be used for the


specified IACHASTA metering registration point. Furthermore,
this command modifies if IACAMA tickets must be generated only
for successful calls or for unsuccessful calls too.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD IACRGPT - ANAMA ANONYMOUS REGISTRATION POINT FOR IACAMA


2. MOD IACRGPT - ANMET ANONYMOUS REGISTRATION POINT FOR IACMET
3. MOD IACRGPT - RGPTAMA NAMED REGISTRATION POINT FOR IACAMA
4. MOD IACRGPT - RGPTMET NAMED REGISTRATION POINT FOR IACMET

1. Input format

ANONYMOUS REGISTRATION POINT FOR IACAMA

This input format modifies the call type (successful


calls only or not) of an anonymous registration point
for IACAMA.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD IACRGPT : <OBJORIG= ,OBJDEST=> ,SUCCONLY= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJORIG OBJECT ORIGIN

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA origin object for the definition
of the modified registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OBJDEST OBJECT DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA destination object for the


definition of the modified registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SUCCONLY SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY

This parameter specifies that only successful


calls must be registered for IACAMA.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY


NO NO SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY
Y SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY
YES SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY

Default: NO

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IACRGPT- 1+


MOD IACRGPT
ANMET
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

ANONYMOUS REGISTRATION POINT FOR IACMET

This input format modifies the schedule of an anonymous registration point


for IACMET.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD IACRGPT : <OBJORIG= ,OBJDEST=> ,SCHED= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJORIG OBJECT ORIGIN

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA origin object for the definition
of the modified registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OBJDEST OBJECT DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the IACHASTA destination object for the


definition of the modified registration point.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SCHED SCHEDULE

This parameter specifies the schedule which becomes valid.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IACRGPT- 2+


MOD IACRGPT
RGPTAMA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

NAMED REGISTRATION POINT FOR IACAMA

This input format modifies the call type (successful calls


only or not) of a named registration point for IACAMA.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD IACRGPT : RGPT= ,SUCCONLY= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RGPT REGISTRATION POINT NAME

This parameter specifies the registration point name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SUCCONLY SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY

This parameter specifies that only successful


calls must be registered for IACAMA.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY


NO NO SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY
Y SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY
YES SUCCESSFUL CALLS ONLY

Default: NO

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IACRGPT- 3+


MOD IACRGPT
RGPTMET
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

NAMED REGISTRATION POINT FOR IACMET

This input format modifies the schedule of a named registration point


for IACMET.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD IACRGPT : RGPT= ,SCHED= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RGPT REGISTRATION POINT NAME

This parameter specifies the registration point name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SCHED SCHEDULE

This parameter specifies the schedule which becomes valid.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IACRGPT- 4-


DISP IACSCHED

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IACHASTA SCHEDULE

This command displays the specified IACHASTA schedule for metering registration.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACSCHED : SCHED= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCHED SCHEDULE

This parameter specifies the schedule.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACSCHED- 1-


MOD IACSCHED

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY IACHASTA SCHEDULE

This command modifies an IACHASTA schedule for metering registration.


The schedules contain sequences of valid time groups per weekday category.
This makes it possible to split the data collected for a registration
point across different time groups based on the time and weekday category.
In the default configuration, the schedules use time group 1 for all
weekday categories from 0 until 24 hours.
Using this command it is possible, for one schedule, to enter up to three
periods for one time group, for all weekday categories indicated.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD IACSCHED : SCHED= ,TIMGRP= ,TIME= [,WDCAT=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCHED SCHEDULE

This parameter specifies the schedule.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

TIMGRP TIME GROUP

This parameter specifies the time group for which the entered
periods are valid.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6, range of decimal numbers

TIME TIME

This parameter specifies the valid time periods (i.e. intervals)


for the time group. The specified time group then becomes valid
for the entered time interval.
Time periods can only be entered in whole 15-minute increments.
Up to 3 time intervals can be linked

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

a-b

a: HOUR (0..24)=
0...24, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTES (ONLY 00-15-30-45 ALLOWED)=


0...45, range of decimal numbers

WDCAT WEEKDAY CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the weekday category for which the


schedule is modified.
The priority assignment for the individual weekday
categories is as follows:

HO , HH > EF , EH > HN , WO

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IACSCHED- 1+


MOD IACSCHED

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

WO WORKDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY NATIONAL
EH WEEKEND HALF
EF WEEKEND FULL

Default: HO, HH, EF, EH, HN, WO

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IACSCHED- 2-


DISP IACSET

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IACHASTA SETTINGS

This command displays the current settings for IACHASTA meters.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACSET ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACSET- 1-


ENTR IACSET

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER IACHASTA SETTINGS

This command enters the settings for IACHASTA meters. These settings define
the meter layout (i.e. how large it must be), by specifying the number of
traffic distinction groups and the number of time groups that are used for
IACHASTA metering registration. Furthermore the counter behaviour of the
IACHASTA meters is defined with this command. It can be chosen between reset
counters (default) and cyclic counters.
The command overwrites the existing values with the entered parameter values.
The command is rejected when registration points with meters or active
registrations exist.
The command is also rejected when the new values are incompatible with the
existing traffic distinction groups and schedules as entered with the
MOD IACTRADI and MOD IACSCHED commands.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR IACSET : TIMGRPMX= ,TRAGRPMX= [,CYCLCNTR=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TIMGRPMX TIME GROUPS MAXIMUM

This parameter specifies the highest time group that


will be used in an IACHASTA metering schedule.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6, range of decimal numbers

TRAGRPMX TRAFFIC GROUPS MAXIMUM

This parameter specifies the highest traffic distinction


group that will be used for IACHASTA metering registration.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4, range of decimal numbers

CYCLCNTR CYCLIC COUNTERS

This parameter specifies if cyclic counters will be used


for IACHASTA metering registration.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO CYCLIC COUNTERS
YES CYCLIC COUNTERS
N NO CYCLIC COUNTERS
Y CYCLIC COUNTERS

Default: NO

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IACSET- 1-


DISP IACTRADI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IACHASTA TRAFFIC DISTINCTION

This command displays the IACHASTA traffic distinction criteria


for metering registration.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IACTRADI ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IACTRADI- 1-


MOD IACTRADI
CHRGTYPE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY IACHASTA TRAFFIC DISTINCTION

This command modifies the traffic distinction for the specified IACHASTA
meter registration point type. The traffic groups make it possible to split
the collected call data according to line category, transmission medium
requirement or charge type.
In the default situation, no distinction is made between traffic types.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD IACTRADI - CHRGTYPE CHARGE TYPE


2. MOD IACTRADI - LINECAT LINE CATEGORY
3. MOD IACTRADI - NONE NONE
4. MOD IACTRADI - TMR TRANSMISS. MEDIUM REQUIREMENT

1. Input format

CHARGE TYPE

This input format is entered when traffic distinction according to


charge type is required.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD IACTRADI : RGPTTYPE= ,DISTINCT= ,TRAGRP1= [,TRAGRP2=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RGPTTYPE REGISTRATION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the registration point type (single sided


or double sided) for which the traffic distinction groups are entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DOUBLE DOUBLE
SINGLE SINGLE

DISTINCT DISTINCTION

This parameter specifies the distinction criterion.

Notes:
If differentiation according to traffic distinction has already been
modified before, a reset is possible with parameter value NONE.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CHRGTYPE CHARGE TYPE


This parameter value refers to the charge type.

TRAGRP1 TRAFFIC GROUP 1

This parameter specifies the traffic group 1.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CHARGE CHARGE
NOCHARGE NO CHARGE

TRAGRP2 TRAFFIC GROUP 2

This parameter specifies the traffic group 2.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CHARGE CHARGE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IACTRADI- 1+


MOD IACTRADI
CHRGTYPE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NOCHARGE NO CHARGE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IACTRADI- 2+


MOD IACTRADI
LINECAT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

LINE CATEGORY

This input format is entered when traffic distinction according to


line category is required.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD IACTRADI : RGPTTYPE= ,DISTINCT= ,TRAGRP1= [,TRAGRP2= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,TRAGRP3=]] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RGPTTYPE REGISTRATION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the registration point type (single sided


or double sided) for which the traffic distinction groups are entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DOUBLE DOUBLE
SINGLE SINGLE

DISTINCT DISTINCTION

This parameter specifies the distinction criterion.

Notes:
If differentiation according to traffic distinction has already been
modified before, a reset is possible with parameter value NONE.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LINECAT LINE CATEGORY


This parameter value refers to the line category.

TRAGRP1 TRAFFIC GROUP 1

This parameter specifies the traffic group 1.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

COINBOX COINBOX
NORMAL NORMAL
OFFICE OFFICE

TRAGRP2 TRAFFIC GROUP 2

This parameter specifies the traffic group 2.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

COINBOX COINBOX
NORMAL NORMAL
OFFICE OFFICE

TRAGRP3 TRAFFIC GROUP 3

This parameter specifies the traffic group 3.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

COINBOX COINBOX
NORMAL NORMAL
OFFICE OFFICE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IACTRADI- 3+


MOD IACTRADI
NONE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

NONE

This input format is entered when no traffic distinction is required.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD IACTRADI : RGPTTYPE= ,DISTINCT= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RGPTTYPE REGISTRATION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the registration point type (single sided


or double sided) for which the traffic distinction groups are entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DOUBLE DOUBLE
SINGLE SINGLE

DISTINCT DISTINCTION

This parameter specifies the distinction criterion.

Notes:
If differentiation according to traffic distinction has already been
modified before, a reset is possible with parameter value NONE.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NONE NONE
This parameter refers to the default installation
(no traffic distinction criterion)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IACTRADI- 4+


MOD IACTRADI
TMR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

TRANSMISS. MEDIUM REQUIREMENT

This input format is entered when traffic distinction according to


transmission medium requirement is required.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD IACTRADI : RGPTTYPE= ,DISTINCT= ,TRAGRP1= [,TRAGRP2= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,TRAGRP3= [,TRAGRP4=]]] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

RGPTTYPE REGISTRATION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the registration point type (single sided


or double sided) for which the traffic distinction groups are entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DOUBLE DOUBLE
SINGLE SINGLE

DISTINCT DISTINCTION

This parameter specifies the distinction criterion.

Notes:
If differentiation according to traffic distinction has already been
modified before, a reset is possible with parameter value NONE.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TMR TRANSMISS. MEDIUM REQUIREMENT


This parameter value refers to the transmission
medium requirement.

TRAGRP1 TRAFFIC GROUP 1

This parameter specifies the traffic group 1.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

A3KHZ1 3.1KHZ AUDIO


KBIT64 64 KBIT/S UNRESTRICTED
KBIT64FB 64 KBIT/S FALL BACK CAPAB.
SPEECH SPEECH

TRAGRP2 TRAFFIC GROUP 2

This parameter specifies the traffic group 2.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

A3KHZ1 3.1KHZ AUDIO


KBIT64 64 KBIT/S UNRESTRICTED
KBIT64FB 64 KBIT/S FALL BACK CAPAB.
SPEECH SPEECH

TRAGRP3 TRAFFIC GROUP 3

This parameter specifies the traffic group 3.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

A3KHZ1 3.1KHZ AUDIO


KBIT64 64 KBIT/S UNRESTRICTED
KBIT64FB 64 KBIT/S FALL BACK CAPAB.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IACTRADI- 5+


MOD IACTRADI
TMR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SPEECH SPEECH

TRAGRP4 TRAFFIC GROUP 4

This parameter specifies the traffic group 4.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

A3KHZ1 3.1KHZ AUDIO


KBIT64 64 KBIT/S UNRESTRICTED
KBIT64FB 64 KBIT/S FALL BACK CAPAB.
SPEECH SPEECH

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IACTRADI- 6-


ACT IAFEAT
CDR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE INDIVIDUAL CALL DATA FEATURE

This command activates call data recording for the specified feature
type.

Prerequisites :
- The specified feature type must not yet be active (advisory and
command rejection).

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ACT IAFEAT - CDR COMMON CALL DETAIL RECORD


2. ACT IAFEAT - FIXFORM DISK FEATURES WITH FIXED RECORD FORMAT
3. ACT IAFEAT - HOPFEAT HOT OPERATION FEATURE
4. ACT IAFEAT - IOFEAT IMMEDIATE OUTPUT FEATURES
5. ACT IAFEAT - MP DISK FEATURES FOR MAIN PROCESSOR
6. ACT IAFEAT - NUMFILES DISK FEATURES WITH ONE OR TWO FILES
7. ACT IAFEAT - VARFORM DISK FEAT. WITH VARIABLE RECORD FORMAT

1. Input format

COMMON CALL DETAIL RECORD

This input format activates the CDR disk feature.

Note :
- The specified recording types (parameter REC) must not already be activated
via their corresponding feature type (parameter TYPE).
The following activations are mutually exclusive:

TYPE= TYPE= REC=


AMA and CDR, AMA;
IARA and CDR, IACAMA;
DNOB and CDR, DNOBS;
TRST and CDR, TRST;

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT IAFEAT : TYPE= ,REC= [,SIZE=] [,FILRECSZ=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE INDIV. CALL DATA FEATURE TYPE

This parameter specifies the individual call data feature type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CDR CALL DETAIL RECORDING

REC RECORDING TYPE

This parameter specifies the recording types to be activated


with the feature type CDR.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING


DNOBS DIRECTORY NUMBER OBSERVATION
IACAMA IACHASTA WITH AMA
TRST TRAFFIC STRUCTURE MEASUREMENT

SIZE DISK FILE SIZE IN PAM PAGES

This parameter specifies the size of the CP disk file in PAM pages.

Notes :
- The disk file must have a certain minimum size (advisory
with the required minimum disk size and command rejection).

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IAFEAT- 1+


ACT IAFEAT
CDR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- Determination of default values with reference to the


input of the parameter TYPE.
Parameter: TYPE SIZE
AMA 15000
ITR 40000
MOB 2000
MAL 100
OME 10000
TST 2500
TOB 2500
UAM 15000
ERS 90
PMOB 2000
DNOB 1000
MCR 15000
FIR 1000
IARA 15000
INA 15000
CDR 15000
LIR 600
- For TYPE=UAM, the maximum range is 747557

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...16777215, range of decimal numbers

FILRECSZ FILE RECORD SIZE

This value defines the length of one record of the cyclic file for
AMA, IARA, CDR or INA.
Such a file record contains several AMA/IARA/CDR/INA variable
records and possibly a filler record in order to fill up the file
record completely.
This parameter is not allowed in combination with the parameter
RECFORM = FIX1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2048,4096,8192, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IAFEAT- 2+


ACT IAFEAT
FIXFORM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

DISK FEATURES WITH FIXED RECORD FORMAT

This input format activates a disk feature with the fixed record format
defined by DT or project specific.

Prerequisites :
- The disk feature can only be activated if there is sufficient
storage capacity on the system disk (advisory and command rejection).
- If the disk file is not deleted before the disk feature is reactivated
and the previous activation was carried out with another record format,
the feature will not be activated (advisory and command rejection).
- If the disk file is not deleted before the disk feature is reactivated
with the same record format, the existing disk file with the same size
and contents is restored (advisory and command execution).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT IAFEAT : TYPE= ,RECFORM= [,SIZE=] [,FILRECSZ=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE INDIV. CALL DATA FEATURE TYPE

This parameter specifies the individual call data feature type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(AMA ) AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING


1IARA 1 INTERADMIN. REVENUE ACCOUNTING
*INA + INTELLIGENT NETWORK AMA

RECFORM RECORD FORMAT

This parameter specifies the fixed record format defined


by DT or project specific.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FIX1 FIXED FORMAT 1 (DT)


FIX2 FIXED FORMAT 2 (project spec.)

SIZE DISK FILE SIZE IN PAM PAGES

This parameter specifies the size of the CP disk file in PAM pages.

Notes :
- The disk file must have a certain minimum size (advisory
with the required minimum disk size and command rejection).
- Determination of default values with reference to the
input of the parameter TYPE.
Parameter: TYPE SIZE
AMA 15000
ITR 40000
MOB 2000
MAL 100
OME 10000
TST 2500
TOB 2500
UAM 15000
ERS 90
PMOB 2000
DNOB 1000
MCR 15000
FIR 1000
IARA 15000
INA 15000
CDR 15000
LIR 600
- For TYPE=UAM, the maximum range is 747557

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...16777215, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IAFEAT- 3+


ACT IAFEAT
FIXFORM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

FILRECSZ FILE RECORD SIZE

This value defines the length of one record of the cyclic file for
AMA, IARA, CDR or INA.
Such a file record contains several AMA/IARA/CDR/INA variable
records and possibly a filler record in order to fill up the file
record completely.
This parameter is not allowed in combination with the parameter
RECFORM = FIX1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2048,4096,8192, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IAFEAT- 4+


ACT IAFEAT
HOPFEAT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

HOT OPERATION FEATURE

This input format activates a feature type for output


via hot operation.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT IAFEAT : TYPE= ,HOPFEAT= [,REC=] [,FILEAR=] [,FILRECSZ=] 1
1 1
1 [,SIZE=] [,NUMFILES=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE INDIV. CALL DATA FEATURE TYPE

This parameter specifies the individual call data feature type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING


AMAI AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCT. IMMED.
CDR CALL DETAIL RECORDING
IARA INTERADMIN. REVENUE ACCOUNTING
INA INTELLIGENT NETWORK AMA
INAI INTELL. NETWORK AMA IMMEDIATE
MCR MOBILE SUBSC. CALL RECORDING
MCRI MOBILE SUBSC. CALL REC. IMMED.

HOPFEAT HOT OPERATION FEATURE NAME

This parameter specifies the symbolic name of the hot operation


feature. The same hot operation feature can be used for several
feature types.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...25 characters from the


symbolic name character set

REC RECORDING TYPE

This parameter specifies the recording types to be activated


with the feature type CDR.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING


DNOBS DIRECTORY NUMBER OBSERVATION
IACAMA IACHASTA WITH AMA
TRST TRAFFIC STRUCTURE MEASUREMENT

FILEAR FILE ARRAY ON MP

This parameter specifies the name of the SAM file array on the MP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...25 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FILRECSZ FILE RECORD SIZE

This value defines the length of one record of the cyclic file for
AMA, IARA, CDR or INA.
Such a file record contains several AMA/IARA/CDR/INA variable
records and possibly a filler record in order to fill up the file
record completely.
This parameter is not allowed in combination with the parameter
RECFORM = FIX1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IAFEAT- 5+


ACT IAFEAT
HOPFEAT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2048,4096,8192, range of decimal numbers

SIZE DISK FILE SIZE IN PAM PAGES

This parameter specifies the size of the CP disk file in PAM pages.

Notes :
- The disk file must have a certain minimum size (advisory
with the required minimum disk size and command rejection).
- Determination of default values with reference to the
input of the parameter TYPE.
Parameter: TYPE SIZE
AMA 15000
ITR 40000
MOB 2000
MAL 100
OME 10000
TST 2500
TOB 2500
UAM 15000
ERS 90
PMOB 2000
DNOB 1000
MCR 15000
FIR 1000
IARA 15000
INA 15000
CDR 15000
LIR 600
- For TYPE=UAM, the maximum range is 747557

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...16777215, range of decimal numbers

NUMFILES NUMBER OF FILES

This parameter specifies the number of files.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...2, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IAFEAT- 6+


ACT IAFEAT
IOFEAT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

IMMEDIATE OUTPUT FEATURES

This input format activates an immediate output feature.

Prerequisites :
- Immediate output features can only be activated if the APS
contains the relevant subsystems (advisory and command rejection).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT IAFEAT : TYPE= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE INDIV. CALL DATA FEATURE TYPE

This parameter specifies the individual call data feature type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(AMAI ) AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCT. IMMED.


1CTEI 1 CENTRAL TEST EQUIPMENT IMMED.
ZMALI Y MALICIOUS CALL TRACING IMMED.
1MCRI 1 MOBILE SUBSC. CALL REC. IMMED.
1MOBI 1 METER OBSERVATION IMMEDIATE
1OMEI 1 OBSERVED MOB. EQP. IMMEDIATE
*PMOBI + PREVENTIVE METER OBSERV. IMM.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IAFEAT- 7+


ACT IAFEAT
MP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

DISK FEATURES FOR MAIN PROCESSOR

This input format activates a disk feature for the main processor.

The types AMA, IARA, CDR, INA, MCR, ITR and LIR
are allowed. The other types are possibly subject to further
stipulations.

Prerequisites :
- The disk feature can only be activated if the main processor is
available.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT IAFEAT : TYPE= ,FILEAR= [,REC=] [,FILRECSZ=] [,RECFORM=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE INDIV. CALL DATA FEATURE TYPE

This parameter specifies the individual call data feature type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING


CDR CALL DETAIL RECORDING
IARA INTERADMIN. REVENUE ACCOUNTING
INA INTELLIGENT NETWORK AMA
ITR IMSI TRACE RECORDING
LIR LAWFUL INTERCEPT RECORDING
MCR MOBILE SUBSC. CALL RECORDING
UAM US AUTOMATIC MSG ACCOUNTING

FILEAR FILE ARRAY ON MP

This parameter specifies the name of the SAM file array on the MP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...25 characters from the


symbolic name character set

REC RECORDING TYPE

This parameter specifies the recording types to be activated


with the feature type CDR.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING


DNOBS DIRECTORY NUMBER OBSERVATION
IACAMA IACHASTA WITH AMA
TRST TRAFFIC STRUCTURE MEASUREMENT

FILRECSZ FILE RECORD SIZE

This value defines the length of one record of the cyclic file for
AMA, IARA, CDR or INA.
Such a file record contains several AMA/IARA/CDR/INA variable
records and possibly a filler record in order to fill up the file
record completely.
This parameter is not allowed in combination with the parameter
RECFORM = FIX1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2048,4096,8192, range of decimal numbers

RECFORM RECORD FORMAT

This parameter specifies the fixed record format defined


by DT or project specific.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IAFEAT- 8+


ACT IAFEAT
MP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FIX1 FIXED FORMAT 1 (DT)


FIX2 FIXED FORMAT 2 (project spec.)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IAFEAT- 9+


ACT IAFEAT
NUMFILES
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

6. Input format

DISK FEATURES WITH ONE OR TWO FILES

This input format activates a disk feature with the possibility to


provide one or two files.

Prerequisites :
- The disk feature can only be activated if there is sufficient
storage capacity on the system disk (advisory and command rejection).
- If the disk file(s) is (are) not deleted before the disk feature is
reactivated and the previous activation was carried out with another
record format, the feature will not be activated (advisory and command
rejection).
- If the disk file(s) is (are) not deleted before the disk feature is
reactivated with the same record format, the existing disk file(s)
with the same size and contents is (are) restored (advisory and
command execution).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT IAFEAT : TYPE= ,NUMFILES= [,REC=] [,SIZE=] [,RECFORM=] 1
1 1
1 [,FILRECSZ=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE INDIV. CALL DATA FEATURE TYPE

This parameter specifies the individual call data feature type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CDR CALL DETAIL RECORDING


IARA INTERADMIN. REVENUE ACCOUNTING

NUMFILES NUMBER OF FILES

This parameter specifies the number of files.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...2, range of decimal numbers

REC RECORDING TYPE

This parameter specifies the recording types to be activated


with the feature type CDR.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING


DNOBS DIRECTORY NUMBER OBSERVATION
IACAMA IACHASTA WITH AMA
TRST TRAFFIC STRUCTURE MEASUREMENT

SIZE DISK FILE SIZE IN PAM PAGES

This parameter specifies the size of the CP disk file in PAM pages.

Notes :
- The disk file must have a certain minimum size (advisory
with the required minimum disk size and command rejection).
- Determination of default values with reference to the
input of the parameter TYPE.
Parameter: TYPE SIZE
AMA 15000
ITR 40000
MOB 2000
MAL 100
OME 10000
TST 2500
TOB 2500
UAM 15000

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IAFEAT- 10+


ACT IAFEAT
NUMFILES
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ERS 90
PMOB 2000
DNOB 1000
MCR 15000
FIR 1000
IARA 15000
INA 15000
CDR 15000
LIR 600
- For TYPE=UAM, the maximum range is 747557

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...16777215, range of decimal numbers

RECFORM RECORD FORMAT

This parameter specifies the fixed record format defined


by DT or project specific.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FIX1 FIXED FORMAT 1 (DT)


FIX2 FIXED FORMAT 2 (project spec.)

FILRECSZ FILE RECORD SIZE

This value defines the length of one record of the cyclic file for
AMA, IARA, CDR or INA.
Such a file record contains several AMA/IARA/CDR/INA variable
records and possibly a filler record in order to fill up the file
record completely.
This parameter is not allowed in combination with the parameter
RECFORM = FIX1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2048,4096,8192, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IAFEAT- 11+


ACT IAFEAT
VARFORM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

7. Input format

DISK FEAT. WITH VARIABLE RECORD FORMAT

This input format activates a disk feature with a variable record format.

Prerequisites :
- The disk feature can only be activated if there is sufficient
storage capacity on the system disk (advisory and command rejection).
- If the disk file is not deleted before the disk feature is reactivated,
the existing disk file with the same size and contents is restored
(advisory and command execution).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT IAFEAT : TYPE= [,REC=] [,SIZE=] [,FILRECSZ=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE INDIV. CALL DATA FEATURE TYPE

This parameter specifies the individual call data feature type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(AMA ) AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING


1CDR 1 CALL DETAIL RECORDING
1DNOB 1 DIRECTORY NUMBER OBSERVATION
1ERS 1 ERROR STATISTICS
1FIR 1 FACILITY INPUT RECORDING
1IARA 1 INTERADMIN. REVENUE ACCOUNTING
1INA 1 INTELLIGENT NETWORK AMA
ZITR Y IMSI TRACE RECORDING
1LIR 1 LAWFUL INTERCEPT RECORDING
1MAL 1 MALICIOUS CALL TRACING
1MCR 1 MOBILE SUBSC. CALL RECORDING
1MOB 1 METER OBSERVATION
1OME 1 OBSERVED MOB. EQP. RECORDING
1PMOB 1 PREVENTIVE METER OBSERVATION
1TOB 1 TRAFFIC OBSERVATION
1TST 1 TRAFFIC STRUCT. MEASUREMENT
*UAM + US AUTOMATIC MSG ACCOUNTING

REC RECORDING TYPE

This parameter specifies the recording types to be activated


with the feature type CDR.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING


DNOBS DIRECTORY NUMBER OBSERVATION
IACAMA IACHASTA WITH AMA
TRST TRAFFIC STRUCTURE MEASUREMENT

SIZE DISK FILE SIZE IN PAM PAGES

This parameter specifies the size of the CP disk file in PAM pages.

Notes :
- The disk file must have a certain minimum size (advisory
with the required minimum disk size and command rejection).
- Determination of default values with reference to the
input of the parameter TYPE.
Parameter: TYPE SIZE
AMA 15000
ITR 40000
MOB 2000
MAL 100
OME 10000
TST 2500
TOB 2500
UAM 15000
ERS 90

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IAFEAT- 12+


ACT IAFEAT
VARFORM
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PMOB 2000
DNOB 1000
MCR 15000
FIR 1000
IARA 15000
INA 15000
CDR 15000
LIR 600
- For TYPE=UAM, the maximum range is 747557

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...16777215, range of decimal numbers

FILRECSZ FILE RECORD SIZE

This value defines the length of one record of the cyclic file for
AMA, IARA, CDR or INA.
Such a file record contains several AMA/IARA/CDR/INA variable
records and possibly a filler record in order to fill up the file
record completely.
This parameter is not allowed in combination with the parameter
RECFORM = FIX1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2048,4096,8192, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IAFEAT- 13-


CAN IAFEAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL INDIVIDUAL CALL DATA FEATURE

This command cancels the individual call data recording for the
specified feature type.
For feature types with disk file, the associated disk file is
retained, but the writing of new records is prevented.
Before the command is executed, all data of the specified type still
present in the CP buffer are automatically transferred to the
appropriate disk files. The file access permission is changed,
allowing the system operator to delete this file. Files named
IA.XXXXX may not be deleted until the file contents have been saved.

Notes :
- IA data type MOB may not be canceled unless all meter observation
requests for subscribers have been deactivated.
- This command should only be used in special cases, for instance
APS change, ODAGEN run or change of disk file size.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN IAFEAT : TYPE= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE INDIV. CALL DATA FEATURE TYPE

This parameter specifies the individual call data feature type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING


MCR MOBILE SUBSC. CALL RECORDING
IARA INTERADMIN. REVENUE ACCOUNTING
INA INTELLIGENT NETWORK AMA
CDR CALL DETAIL RECORDING
UAM US AUTOMATIC MSG ACCOUNTING
ITR IMSI TRACE RECORDING
LIR LAWFUL INTERCEPT RECORDING
MOB METER OBSERVATION
PMOB PREVENTIVE METER OBSERVATION
MAL MALICIOUS CALL TRACING
OME OBSERVED MOB. EQP. RECORDING
FIR FACILITY INPUT RECORDING
DNOB DIRECTORY NUMBER OBSERVATION
TOB TRAFFIC OBSERVATION
TST TRAFFIC STRUCT. MEASUREMENT
ERS ERROR STATISTICS
AMAI AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCT. IMMED.
MCRI MOBILE SUBSC. CALL REC. IMMED.
MOBI METER OBSERVATION IMMEDIATE
PMOBI PREVENTIVE METER OBSERV. IMM.
MALI MALICIOUS CALL TRACING IMMED.
OMEI OBSERVED MOB. EQP. IMMEDIATE
CTEI CENTRAL TEST EQUIPMENT IMMED.
INAI INTELLIGENT NETW. AMA IMMED.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IAFEAT- 1-


DISP IAFEAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY INDIVIDUAL CALL DATA FEATURES

This command displays the activated individual call data feature


types.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IAFEAT : [TYPE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE FEATURE TYPE

This parameter specifies the individual call data feature type.


When feature type is entered, all information upon the feature type
is displayed. When the the parameter is omitted, a list of all
activated feature types and their registration method is displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

AMA AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING


MCR MOBILE SUBSC. CALL RECORDING
IARA INTERADMIN. REVENUE ACCOUNTING
INA INTELLIGENT NETWORK AMA
CDR CALL DETAIL RECORDING
UAM US AUTOMATIC MSG ACCOUNTING
ITR IMSI TRACE RECORDING
LIR LAWFUL INTERCEPT RECORDING
MOB METER OBSERVATION
PMOB PREVENTIVE METER OBSERVATION
MAL MALICIOUS CALL TRACING
OME OBSERVED MOB. EQP. RECORDING
FIR FACILITY INPUT RECORDING
DNOB DIRECTORY NUMBER OBSERVATION
TOB TRAFFIC OBSERVATION
TST TRAFFIC STRUCT. MEASUREMENT
ERS ERROR STATISTICS
AMAI AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCT. IMMED.
MCRI MOBILE SUBSC. CALL REC. IMMED.
MOBI METER OBSERVATION IMMEDIATE
PMOBI PREVENTIVE METER OBSERV. IMM.
MALI MALICIOUS CALL TRACING IMMED.
OMEI OBSERVED MOB. EQP. IMMEDIATE
CTEI CENTRAL TEST EQUIPMENT IMMED.
INAI INTELL. NETWORK AMA IMMEDIATE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IAFEAT- 1-


MOD IAFEAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY INDIVIDUAL CALL DATA FEATURE

This command modifies the individual call data recording for


the specified feature type.

Prerequisites :
- The specified feature type must be active.
(advisory and command rejection)

This input format modifies the saving timer


for the specified feature type.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD IAFEAT : TYPE= ,SAVTIMER= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TYPE CALL DATA RECORDING TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of call data recording.

The types AMA, IARA, CDR, INA, MCR, ITR, LIR and OME are allowed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

(AMA ) AUTOMATIC MESSAGE ACCOUNTING


1CDR 1 CALL DETAIL RECORDING
1IARA 1 INTERADMIN. REVENUE ACCOUNTING
ZINA Y INTELLIGENT NETWORK AMA
1ITR 1 IMSI TRACE RECORDING
1LIR 1 LAWFUL INTERCEPT RECORDING
1MCR 1 MOBILE SUBSC. CALL RECORDING
*OME + OBSERVED MOB. EQP. RECORDING

SAVTIMER SAVING TIMER PERIOD IN MINUTES

This parameter specifies the time period for the


periodic saving of the buffer data to disk.
It can be entered and changed for activated recordings.

Notes :
- The default value is 0. When 0, periodic saving
to disk takes place every 2 minutes if the
amount of the buffer data is equal to the block size
(= 2K or 4K or 8K).
- When the value of SAVTIMER is not equal to 0,
saving of all the buffer data to disk takes place
periodically according to the entered value.
All data is guaranteed to be available on disk within
a maximum of (2 + SAVTIMER) minutes.

An incomplete block is filled up with zeros. Due to


the periodic saving, it is possible to have a high amount
of filled up zeros.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0,2,4...60, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IAFEAT- 1-


ACT IAOPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE INDIV. CALL DATA ADMIN. OPTIONS

This command is used to activate the generation and output to disk of


special optional record types and to block the buffering of
administrative records.
The special optional record types can only be generated for activated
IA features with disk output. They are used to evaluate the following
information:
- BRD = Recovery level and restoral time after a system failure
(breakdown)
- DTC = Date/time change due to error or change of summer/winter time
- OVF = Start and end time of buffer overflow and number of records lost
due to overflow
Storage of feature-specific call data records is suppressed if the buffer
input block is set. This acts as a safeguard against multiple billing of
special subscriber services.
The block must be set before the REGEN command file is processed and
then reset immediately after processing.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1SPREC= 1 1
1 ACT IAOPT : ZBLBUFR=Y ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SPREC SPECIAL OPTIONAL RECORD TYPE

This parameter specifies the special optional record types.


The activated optional special data records are not related
to data types TOB and UAM, consequently no administrative
data records are entered.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

DTC DATE TIME CHANGE


BRD BREAKDOWN
OVF OVERFLOW

BLBUFR BLOCKING OF BUFFER INPUTS

This parameter specifies the call data record type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ADMREC ADMINISTRATIVE RECORDS

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IAOPT- 1-


CAN IAOPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL INDIV. CALL DATA ADMIN. OPTIONS

This command is used to cancel the generation and output to disk of


special optional record types and to cancel the buffer input block
for individual call data administration records.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1SPREC= 1 1
1 CAN IAOPT : ZBLBUFR=Y ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SPREC SPECIAL OPTIONAL RECORD TYPE

This parameter specifies the special optional record types.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

DTC DATE TIME CHANGE


BRD BREAKDOWN
OVF OVERFLOW

BLBUFR BLOCKING OF BUFFER INPUTS

This parameter specifies the call data record type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ADMREC ADMINISTRATIVE RECORDS

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IAOPT- 1-


DISP IAOPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY INDIV. CALL DATA ADMIN. OPTIONS

This command displays the activated special optional record types and
states whether buffers are blocked.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IAOPT ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IAOPT- 1-


COPY IARACCT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

COPY IARACCOUNT

This command copies call data to a post processing file. Such a


saving is permitted both during time limited registration and during
continuous registration. It has to be performed whenever the registration
counters are expected to overflow. The command cannot be entered
immediately after a full hour, because at that time, the hourly saving
of the counters is executed, and the data to be saved are not static.
A new phase of the registration period begins after the saving, i.e.:
- All registration counters of the specified type are cleared.
- The values registered up to the end of the registration period are
stored in a new post processing file containing the save date in its
name.
- The job number of the registration job is not changed by saving.
The end time of the saved registration is the same as the start time
of the newly started registration.
- No registered data are lost when saving is initiated by this command.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 COPY IARACCT : MTYPE= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MTYPE MEASUREMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the measurement type, which is used for


separate registration jobs.
The choice of the meaning of the measurement types is free.
Nevertheless the database configuration (i.e. number of origin names
and destination names) leads to the following recommendation:
- IARSTAT1: Registration of international outgoing traffic.
- IARSTAT2: Registration of international incoming traffic.
- IARSTAT3: Registration of international transit traffic.
- IARSTAT4: Registration for statistical reasons.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IARSTAT1 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 1


IARSTAT2 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 2
IARSTAT3 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 3
IARSTAT4 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 4

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 COPY IARACCT- 1-


CAN IARCON

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL IARSTAT CONNEC.GROUP ASSIGNMENTS

This command cancels connection group assignments in the connection


group conversion table for combinations of connection types and
transmission medium requirement values, i.e. assignments of connection
groups to combinations of connection types and transmission medium
requirement values are deleted.
By cancelling a connection group assignment in the connection group
conversion table, calls with that specific combination of connection
type and transmission medium requirement value are no longer registered.

Notes:
- The command is rejected, when one or more of the specified assigments
don’t exist in the conversion table (see DISP IARCON command).

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IARCON : IARGRP= ,CONTYP= ,TMR= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IARGRP IARSTAT CONNECTION GROUP NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the connection group defined with
the command CR IARGRP.

Notes:
- A single X is not accepted for the input.
- Only alphanumerical characters are permitted for this parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CONTYP TYPES OF CONNECTION

This parameter specifies the connection types.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

AUTO AUTOMATIC CALL


This parameter value refers to automatic calls.
OSSP OSS PERSON TO PERSON
This parameter value refers to operator
assisted calls (person-person).
OSSS OSS STATION TO STATION
This parameter value refers to operator
assisted calls (station-station).
DAUT DISTANT OPERATOR AUTOMATIC
This parameter value refers to automatic calls
switched by the distant operator.
DOSP DISTANT OPERATOR PERSON/PERSON
This parameter value refers to long distance
operator assisted calls (person-person).
DOSS DIST.OPERATOR STATION/STATION
This parameter value refers to long distance
operator assisted calls (station-station).

TMR TRANSMISS. MEDIUM REQUIREMENT

This parameter specifies the transmission medium requirement values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARCON- 1+


CAN IARCON

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

of multiple values linked with &.

A3KHZ1 3.1 KHZ AUDIO


This parameter value refers to the transmission
medium requirement : 3.1 kHz audio (for voice or
voiceband data up to 9.6 kbit/s).
SPEECH SPEECH
This parameter value refers to the transmission
medium requirement : speech (for voice).
KBIT64 64 KBIT/S UNRESTRICTED
This parameter value refers to the transmission
medium requirement : 64 kbit/s unrestricted
(voice and/or high speed data).
KBIT64FB 64 KBIT/S FALLBACK CAPABILITY
This parameter value refers to the transmission
medium requirement : 64 kbit/s unrestricted
with fallback capability (voice and/or high
speed data).

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARCON- 2-


DISP IARCON

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IARSTAT CONNEC.GROUP ASSIGNMENTS

This command displays the complete connection group conversion table,


i.e. all assignments of connection groups to combinations of connection
types and transmission medium requirement values, entered with the
command ENTR IARCON are displayed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IARCON ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARCON- 1-


ENTR IARCON

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER IARSTAT CONNEC.GROUP ASSIGNMENTS

This command enters connection groups in the conversion table for


combinations of connection types and transmission medium requirement
values, i.e. an assignment of connection groups to combinations of
connection types and transmission medium requirement values is done.

Notes:
- The command is rejected when :
1. the assigment overlaps with previously entered assigments
(see DISP IARCON command);
2. the connection group does not exist (see DISP IARGRP command).
- From the parameters CONTYP and TMR, at least one should be entered.
- The specified connection group is entered in the conversion table for
all combinations of the entered parameter values.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR IARCON : IARGRP= <,CONTYP= ,TMR=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IARGRP IARSTAT CONNECTION GROUP NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the connection group defined with
the command CR IARGRP.

Notes:
- A single X is not accepted for the input.
- Only alphanumerical characters are permitted for this parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CONTYP TYPES OF CONNECTION

This parameter specifies the connection types.

Notes:
- When this parameter is omitted, the connection group is entered in
the conversation table for all possible connection types,
i.e. registration will be done independent of this parameter.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

AUTO AUTOMATIC CALL


This parameter value refers to automatic calls.
OSSP OSS PERSON TO PERSON
This parameter value refers to operator
assisted calls (person-person).
OSSS OSS STATION TO STATION
This parameter value refers to operator
assisted calls (station-station).
DAUT DISTANT OPERATOR AUTOMATIC
This parameter value refers to automatic calls
switched by the distant operator.
DOSP DISTANT OPERATOR PERSON/PERSON
This parameter value refers to long distance
operator assisted calls (person-person).
DOSS DIST.OPERATOR STATION/STATION
This parameter value refers to long distance
operator assisted calls (station-station).

Default: AUTO, OSSP, OSSS, DAUT, DOSP, DOSS

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IARCON- 1+


ENTR IARCON

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TMR TRANSMISS. MEDIUM REQUIREMENT

This parameter specifies the transmission medium requirement values.

Notes:
- When this parameter is omitted, the connection group is entered in
the conversion table for all possible transmission medium requirement
values, i.e. registration will be done independent of this parameter.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

A3KHZ1 3.1 KHZ AUDIO


This parameter value refers to the transmission
medium requirement : 3.1 kHz audio (for voice or
voiceband data up to 9.6 kbit/s).
SPEECH SPEECH
This parameter value refers to the transmission
medium requirement : speech (for voice).
KBIT64 64 KBIT/S UNRESTRICTED
This parameter value refers to the transmission
medium requirement : 64 kbit/s unrestricted
(voice and/or high speed data).
KBIT64FB 64 KBIT/S FALLBACK CAPABILITY
This parameter value refers to the transmission
medium requirement : 64 kbit/s unrestricted
with fallback capability (voice and/or high
speed data).

Default: A3KHZ1, SPEECH, KBIT64, KBIT64FB

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IARCON- 2-


DISP IARDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IARA STATISTICS DATA

This command displays the IARSTAT destination or origin names


for a measurement type and the associated state. It is also possible to
display the number of IARSTAT destination and origin names that
are free or in use for a measurement type.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,DNAME=11 1
1 DISP IARDAT : MTYPE= 1Z,ONAME=Y1 [,STATUS=] ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MTYPE MEASUREMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the measurement type, which is used for


separate registration jobs.
The choice of the meaning of the measurement types is free.
Nevertheless the database configuration (i.e. number of origin names
and destination names) leads to the following recommendation:
- IARSTAT1: Registration of international outgoing traffic.
- IARSTAT2: Registration of international incoming traffic.
- IARSTAT3: Registration of international transit traffic.
- IARSTAT4: Registration for statistical reasons.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IARSTAT1 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 1


IARSTAT2 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 2
IARSTAT3 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 3
IARSTAT4 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 4

DNAME DESTINATION NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT destination name.

Notes:
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

ONAME ORIGIN NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin name.

Notes:
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARDAT- 1+


DISP IARDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

STATUS STATUS

This parameter specifies the state of the IARSTAT name. If one of the
states is specified, only the names with this state are displayed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

INACT INACTIVE
While registration was active, the name is
removed from all objects to which it was
assigned, using the commands CAN IARNAME
or MOD IARNAME.
The name itself will be deleted after the
next saving of the IARSTAT counter data
to a post processing file.
ACT ACTIVE
The name was assigned to at least one object
using ENTR IARNAME/MOD IARNAME.
The name can additionally be assigned to other
objects.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARDAT- 2-


MOD IARDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY IARA STATISTICS DATA

This command modifies the IARSTAT origin or destination names.


The command is used for editorial changes of the names.
The assignment to the objects, as defined by the command ENTR IARNAME,
is not modified. The new name must not yet have been assigned for the
specified measurement type. The modification comes into effect immediately;
the system will no longer recognize the old name.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,DNAME=1 (;) 1
1 MOD IARDAT : MTYPE= Z,ONAME=Y Z Y 1
1 1 1 *!+ 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MTYPE MEASUREMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the measurement type, which is used for


separate registration jobs.
The choice of the meaning of the measurement types is free.
Nevertheless the database configuration (i.e. number of origin names
and destination names) leads to the following recommendation:
- IARSTAT1: Registration of international outgoing traffic.
- IARSTAT2: Registration of international incoming traffic.
- IARSTAT3: Registration of international transit traffic.
- IARSTAT4: Registration for statistical reasons.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IARSTAT1 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 1


IARSTAT2 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 2
IARSTAT3 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 3
IARSTAT4 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 4

DNAME DESTINATION NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT destination name.


Parameter values should be entered in the form:
first parameter unit <name:new>, then <name:old>.

Notes:
- Input of a single X is not accepted.

n/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

ONAME ORIGIN NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin name.


Parameter values should be entered in the form:
first parameter unit <name:new>, then <name:old>.

Notes:
- Input of a single X is not accepted.

n/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IARDAT- 1+


MOD IARDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IARDAT- 2-


DISP IARFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IARA MEASUREMENT FILE

This command displays an IARA meter measurement file list on OMT.


The file type depends on the chosen measurement method within the
mobile services switching center. The chosen measurement method
could be either IACHASTA with meters (IACMET) or IARSTAT with
meters (IARMET).
IACMET : CR.IR.rddds.fffff
IARMET : IR.Aryymmnn

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IARFILE : [MEASTYP=] [,STATUS=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MEASTYP MEASUREMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the measurement type of the data contained


by the file. A list of files containing this type of data are
displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALL ALL TYPES (IACMET/IARMET)


IARSTAT1 TYPE 1 (ONLY IARMET)
IARSTAT2 TYPE 2 (ONLY IARMET)
IARSTAT3 TYPE 3 (ONLY IARMET)
IARSTAT4 TYPE 4 (ONLY IARMET)

STATUS FILE STATUS

This parameter specifies the file status. All files with this
status are displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ALL ALL RESULT FILES


RUN RUNNING RESULT FILES
TER TERMINATED RESULT FILES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARFILE- 1-


CAN IARGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL IARSTAT CONNECTION GROUPS

This command cancels a previously installed connection group in


the connection group names table (see CR IARGRP command).

Notes:
- The command is not allowed when :
1. the connection group doesn’t exist (see DISP IARGRP command);
2. assigments for the specified connection group exist (,see
DISP IARCON command);
3. a registration is active (see DISP IARJOB command);
4. matrix points are still active (see DISP IARMPT command).

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IARGRP : IARGRP= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IARGRP IARSTAT CONNECTION GROUP NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the connection group.

Notes:
- A single X is not accepted for the input.
- Only alphanumeric characters are permitted for this parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARGRP- 1-


CR IARGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE IARSTAT CONNECTION GROUPS

This command installs a new connection group in the connection group


names table.

Notes:
- When the first CR IARGRP command for the actual APS is entered
before the commands CAN IARGRP resp. CAN IARCON are entered,
the default configuration of the connection group database is
overwritten. The names of the connection groups and their assignment
to combinations of connection types and transmission medium
requirements can then freely be chosen.
- When the commands CAN IARGRP resp. CAN IARCON are entered before
the command CR IARGRP, the default configuration is not overwritten
and the connection group is added to the existing groups. The default
configuration can then only be deleted by separate CAN IARGRP and
CAN IARCON commands.
- The command is rejected when :
1. the connection group already exists (see DISP IARGRP command);
2. the connection group names table is full (max. 7 connection groups
can be installed) (see DISP IARGRP command);
3. a registration is active (see DISP IARJOB command);
4. matrix points for counters are active (see DISP IARMPT command).

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR IARGRP : IARGRP= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IARGRP IARSTAT CONNECTION GROUP NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the connection group.

Notes:
- A single X is not accepted for the input.
- Only alphanumerical characters are permitted for this parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IARGRP- 1-
DISP IARGRP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IARSTAT CONNECTION GROUPS

This command displays the complete connection group names table,


i.e. all connection group names (max. 7) entered with the command
CR IARGRP are displayed.
When the CR IARGRP command has been entered earlier on, the
default configuration (connection group = connection type) is
displayed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IARGRP ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARGRP- 1-


DISP IARJOB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IARA STATISTICS JOB

This command displays the following information for all registration


jobs of all measurement types:
- begin- and end-time (in case of a time limited job)
- the post processing file name
- the job number
- the job state.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IARJOB ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARJOB- 1-


CAN IARMPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL IARSTAT MATRIX POINT

This command cancels a matrix point for the specified measurement type and
origin name / destination name combination. The matrix point is cancelled
for the counter method or for the ticket method. The command can be
used for one matrix point only.
When cancelling the matrix point, the following three cases can occur:
- For the specified measurement type a measurement job is active. The
matrix point immediately becomes inactive, so that no more call data are
added to the assigned measurement counters or no more tickets are generated.
The inactive status is necessary to hold the information needed for the
post processing file (in case of the counter method) or for the optional
data packages of already started calls (in case of the ticket method).
The matrix point remains in the inactive status until the next saving into
the associated post processing file or until the end of the measurement job.
The matrix point is then cancelled and (in case of the counter method)
the counters are made available to the pool of free counters.
- For the specified measurement type no measurement job is active.
The matrix point is cancelled immediately and (in case of the counter method)
the assigned measurement counters are immediately made available to the pool
of free counters.
- The specified origin name or the specified destination name is inactive.
The command is rejected, as there are either only matrix points which are
inactive or none at all.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IARMPT : MTYPE= ,DNAME= ,ONAME= <,CNTRS= ,TICKET=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MTYPE MEASUREMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the measurement type, which is used for


separate registration jobs.
The choice of the meaning of the measurement types is free.
Nevertheless the database configuration (i.e. number of origin names
and destination names) leads to the following recommendation:
- IARSTAT1: Registration of international outgoing traffic.
- IARSTAT2: Registration of international incoming traffic.
- IARSTAT3: Registration of international transit traffic.
- IARSTAT4: Registration for statistical reasons.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IARSTAT1 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 1


IARSTAT2 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 2
IARSTAT3 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 3
IARSTAT4 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 4

DNAME DESTINATION NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT destination name.

Notes:
- A single X is not accepted for the input.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARMPT- 1+


CAN IARMPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ONAME ORIGIN NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin name.

Notes:
- A single X is not accepted for the input.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

CNTRS IARA WITH COUNTERS

This parameter is used to deactivate the registration counters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO CANCEL NO IARA WITH COUNTERS


YES CANCEL IARA WITH COUNTERS

TICKET IARA WITH AMA TICKET

This parameter is used to deactivate the registration on


AMA-tickets.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO CANCEL NO IARA WITH AMA TICKET


YES CANCEL IARA WITH AMA TICKET

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARMPT- 2-


CR IARMPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE IARSTAT MATRIX POINT

This command creates a matrix point for the specified measurement type
and the specified origin name and destination name combination.
Depending on the further parameters, the counter method and/or the
ticket method are used for the registration of the call data for this
matrix point.

When the ticket method is chosen, for each call of the specified
origin name/destination name combination, an automatic message
accounting ticket is produced.

When the counter method is chosen, as many counters of the counter


pool, as there are connection groups to be measured separately, are
linked to the matrix point.

The matrix point is given the state ’active’ for counters and/or for
tickets.

Notes:
- Only one measurement type, one origin name and one destination/route
name may be specified at one time.
- The names must first be assigned to the objects, using the commands
ENTR IARNAME or MOD IARNAME.
- When the default connection group database is not used, i.e. when
separated registration pro transmission medium requirement is wanted,
the connection groups must first be created (command CR IARGRP) and
assigned to combinations of connection types and transmission medium
requirement values (command ENTR IARCON).
- When no registration is active for a measurement type, no call data
are registered for the matrix points of that particular measurement.
Activation of measurements is done with the command REC IARSTAT and
the activated measurements are displayed with the command
DISP IARJOB.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR IARMPT : MTYPE= ,DNAME= ,ONAME= [,CNTR1= [,CNTR2= 1
1 1
1 [,CNTR3= [,CNTR4= [,CNTR5= [,CNTR6= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,CNTR7=]]]]]]] [,TICKET=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MTYPE MEASUREMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the measurement type, which is used for


separate registration jobs.
The choice of the meaning of the measurement types is free.
Nevertheless the database configuration (i.e. number of origin names
and destination names) leads to the following recommendation:
- IARSTAT1: Registration of international outgoing traffic.
- IARSTAT2: Registration of international incoming traffic.
- IARSTAT3: Registration of international transit traffic.
- IARSTAT4: Registration for statistical reasons.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IARSTAT1 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 1


IARSTAT2 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 2
IARSTAT3 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 3
IARSTAT4 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 4

DNAME DESTINATION NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT destination name.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IARMPT- 1+
CR IARMPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Notes:
- A single X is not accepted for the input.
- Only alphanumeric characters are permitted for this parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

ONAME ORIGIN NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin name.

Notes:
- A single X is not accepted for the input.
- Only alphanumeric characters are permitted for this parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CNTR1 CONNECTION GROUPS COUNTER 1

This parameter enables the specified connection groups to be measured


separately or in any combination. When a connection group is assigned
to a particular counter, all call data for this matrix point and this
connection group are recorded in this counter. A maximum of 7 counters
can be used for one matrix point.

Notes:
- CAUTION: If a connection group is not specified in any counter,
call data for this connection group are not recorded.
- The parameter values are the previously defined connection groups
(see command CR IARGRP), eventually chained with &.
- The call data for the specified connection groups in one counter
are all added to the same measurement counter.
- It is also possible to enter the identifier ’ALL’ for parameter
CNTR1. The call data of all existing connection groups are
then added to one counter. In this case parameter CNTR2 to
parameter CNTR7 are not allowed.
- A single X is not accepted for the input.
- Only alphanumerical characters are permitted for this parameter.
- Multiple use of the same connection groups in different counter
parameters is not permitted.
- Parameters CNTR1 to CNTR7 may only be used in increasing
order.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CNTR2 CONNECTION GROUPS COUNTER 2

For parameter description, see parameter CNTR1.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CNTR3 CONNECTION GROUPS COUNTER 3

For parameter description, see parameter CNTR1.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CNTR4 CONNECTION GROUPS COUNTER 4

For parameter description, see parameter CNTR1.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IARMPT- 2+
CR IARMPT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CNTR5 CONNECTION GROUPS COUNTER 5

For parameter description, see parameter CNTR1.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CNTR6 CONNECTION GROUPS COUNTER 6

For parameter description, see parameter CNTR1.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CNTR7 CONNECTION GROUPS COUNTER 7

For parameter description, see parameter CNTR1.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...4 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TICKET IARSTAT WITH AMA TICKET

This parameter specifies whether automatic message accounting


tickets are wanted for call data of this matrix point or not.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NO NO IARSTAT WITH AMA TICKET


YES IARSTAT WITH AMA TICKET

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IARMPT- 3-
DISP IARMPT
MTYPE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IARSTAT MATRIX POINT

This command displays


1. when only the parameter MTYPE is entered:
- the number of used and free matrix points of the specified
measurement type;
- the number of used and free measurement counters in the common
counter pool for all four measurement types;
or
2. when all parameters are entered:
- the assignment of the connection groups to the counters for all
specified matrix points.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP IARMPT - MTYPE OVERVIEW PER MEASUREMENT TYPE


2. DISP IARMPT - OTHER SPECIFIC MATRIX POINT DISPLAY

1. Input format

OVERVIEW PER MEASUREMENT TYPE

This input format displays an overview of the free and


used matrix points for counters for the entered
measurement type and the number of free and used counters
of the whole counterpool.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IARMPT : MTYPE= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MTYPE MEASUREMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the measurement type, which is used for


separate registration jobs.
The choice of the meaning of the measurement types is free.
Nevertheless the database configuration (i.e. number of origin names
and destination names) leads to the following recommendation:
- IARSTAT1: Registration of international outgoing traffic.
- IARSTAT2: Registration of international incoming traffic.
- IARSTAT3: Registration of international transit traffic.
- IARSTAT4: Registration for statistical reasons.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IARSTAT1 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 1


IARSTAT2 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 2
IARSTAT3 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 3
IARSTAT4 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 4

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARMPT- 1+


DISP IARMPT
OTHER
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

SPECIFIC MATRIX POINT DISPLAY

This input format displays the status of the matrix point


for counters and AMA ticket and the connection groups
assigned to the registration counters.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IARMPT : MTYPE= ,DNAME= ,ONAME= <,CNTRS= ,TICKET=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MTYPE MEASUREMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the measurement type, which is used for


separate registration jobs.
The choice of the meaning of the measurement types is free.
Nevertheless the database configuration (i.e. number of origin names
and destination names) leads to the following recommendation:
- IARSTAT1: Registration of international outgoing traffic.
- IARSTAT2: Registration of international incoming traffic.
- IARSTAT3: Registration of international transit traffic.
- IARSTAT4: Registration for statistical reasons.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IARSTAT1 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 1


IARSTAT2 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 2
IARSTAT3 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 3
IARSTAT4 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 4

DNAME DESTINATION NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT destination name.

Notes:
- If the parameter is not specified, all associated parameter values
are accessed.
- A maximum of 10 individual names and/or intervals can be linked.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

ONAME ORIGIN NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin name.

Notes:
- If the parameter is not specified, all associated parameter values
are accessed.
- A maximum of 10 individual names and/or intervals can be linked.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARMPT- 2+


DISP IARMPT
OTHER
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CNTRS IARA WITH COUNTERS

This parameter specifies the counter status of the matrix points to be


displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT STATUS: ACTIVE


The matrix point is created with counters using
CR IARMPT.
INACT STATUS: INACTIVE
The matrix point was cancelled for counters using
CAN IARMPT, while registration was active.
It will retain this status until the next
time call data are saved in a post processing
file for the measurement type of the matrix point.
NOUSE STATUS: NOT USED
The matrix point is not created for counters
using CR IARMPT.

TICKET IARA WITH AMA TICKET

This parameter specifies the ticket status of the matrix points to be


displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT STATUS : ACTIVE


The matrix point is created for automatic
message accounting ticket using CR IARMPT.
INACT STATUS : INACTIVE
The matrix point was cancelled for automatic
message accounting ticket using the command
CAN IARMPT, while a registration was active.
It will retain this status until the end of the
registration or until the next saving of the
call data in post processing file for the
measurement type of the matrix point.
NOUSE STATUS : NOT USED
The matrix point is not created for automatic
message accounting ticket using CR IARMPT.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARMPT- 3-


CAN IARNAME
COUTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL IARA STATISTICS NAME

This command cancels IARSTAT origin or destination names in the IARSTAT


database for the entered object. i.e. an assignment of IARSTAT origin
or destination names to the entered object is deleted.

Notes:
- The IARSTAT names can be cancelled simultaneously for the four possible
measurement types.
- The deletion is immediately active.
- IARSTAT names cannot be assigned to test equipment, switchboards,
nailed-up connections (NUC) or local network trunk group.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CAN IARNAME - COUTYP CONFERENCE UNIT TYPE


2. CAN IARNAME - DEST DESTINATION
3. CAN IARNAME - LAC LOCAL AREA CODE
4. CAN IARNAME - LACOR LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING
5. CAN IARNAME - TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

1. Input format

CONFERENCE UNIT TYPE

This input format cancels IARSTAT origin or destination names


for a conference unit type.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IARNAME : COUTYP= ,DIR= ,NAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

COUTYP CONFERENCE UNIT TYPE

This parameter specifies the conference unit type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CONFL LARGE CONFERENCE


MEETME MEET ME
PHONMEET TELEPHONE MEETING

DIR DIRECTION

This parameter specifies the direction for which the entered IARSTAT
names are meant. i.e. the parameter specifies whether origin or
destination names are cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DEST DESTINATION
ORIG ORIGIN

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin or destination names for


the 4 IARSTAT measurement types. They are entered in the IARSTAT
database for a particular object, dependent on the other parameters
of the command.

Notes:
- Name: 1-2-3-4. If entry of a name is not desired for a
measurement type, either a 0 or the number sign # must be
entered.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARNAME- 1+


CAN IARNAME
COUTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

0 means: no name stored


# means: stored value is ignored
- The IARSTAT names can be new names or names already assigned
to other objects (grouping of registration).
- A name in INACTIVE cannot be used for new entries.
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: IARSTAT NAME 1=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

b: IARSTAT NAME 2=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

c: IARSTAT NAME 3=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

d: IARSTAT NAME 4=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARNAME- 2+


CAN IARNAME
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

DESTINATION

This input format cancels IARSTAT destination names for a


destination/route combination.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,RTNO=1 (;) 1
1 CAN IARNAME : DEST= Z,TGNO=Y ,NAME= Z Y 1
1 1 1 *!+ 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the destination area name.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

RTNO ROUTE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the position (route number) in the search


order of the route reference in the destination area data table.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin or destination names for


the 4 IARSTAT measurement types. They are entered in the IARSTAT
database for a particular object, dependent on the other parameters
of the command.

Notes:
- Name: 1-2-3-4. If entry of a name is not desired for a
measurement type, either a 0 or the number sign # must be
entered.
0 means: no name stored
# means: stored value is ignored
- The IARSTAT names can be new names or names already assigned
to other objects (grouping of registration).
- A name in INACTIVE cannot be used for new entries.
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARNAME- 3+


CAN IARNAME
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a: IARSTAT NAME 1=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

b: IARSTAT NAME 2=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

c: IARSTAT NAME 3=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

d: IARSTAT NAME 4=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARNAME- 4+


CAN IARNAME
LAC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

LOCAL AREA CODE

This input format cancels IARSTAT origin or destination names


for a local area code.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IARNAME : LAC= ,DIR= ,NAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DIR DIRECTION

This parameter specifies the direction for which the entered IARSTAT
names are meant. i.e. the parameter specifies whether origin or
destination names are cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DEST DESTINATION
ORIG ORIGIN

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin or destination names for


the 4 IARSTAT measurement types. They are entered in the IARSTAT
database for a particular object, dependent on the other parameters
of the command.

Notes:
- Name: 1-2-3-4. If entry of a name is not desired for a
measurement type, either a 0 or the number sign # must be
entered.
0 means: no name stored
# means: stored value is ignored
- The IARSTAT names can be new names or names already assigned
to other objects (grouping of registration).
- A name in INACTIVE cannot be used for new entries.
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: IARSTAT NAME 1=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

b: IARSTAT NAME 2=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

c: IARSTAT NAME 3=
1...6 characters from the

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARNAME- 5+


CAN IARNAME
LAC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

d: IARSTAT NAME 4=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARNAME- 6+


CAN IARNAME
LACOR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING

This input format cancels IARSTAT origin names for a


local area code originating.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IARNAME : LACOR= ,NAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LACOR LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING

This parameter specifies the local area code originating.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin or destination names for


the 4 IARSTAT measurement types. They are entered in the IARSTAT
database for a particular object, dependent on the other parameters
of the command.

Notes:
- Name: 1-2-3-4. If entry of a name is not desired for a
measurement type, either a 0 or the number sign # must be
entered.
0 means: no name stored
# means: stored value is ignored
- The IARSTAT names can be new names or names already assigned
to other objects (grouping of registration).
- A name in INACTIVE cannot be used for new entries.
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: IARSTAT NAME 1=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

b: IARSTAT NAME 2=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

c: IARSTAT NAME 3=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

d: IARSTAT NAME 4=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARNAME- 7+


CAN IARNAME
LACOR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARNAME- 8+


CAN IARNAME
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This input format cancels IARSTAT origin names for a


trunk group number.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IARNAME : TGNO= ,NAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin or destination names for


the 4 IARSTAT measurement types. They are entered in the IARSTAT
database for a particular object, dependent on the other parameters
of the command.

Notes:
- Name: 1-2-3-4. If entry of a name is not desired for a
measurement type, either a 0 or the number sign # must be
entered.
0 means: no name stored
# means: stored value is ignored
- The IARSTAT names can be new names or names already assigned
to other objects (grouping of registration).
- A name in INACTIVE cannot be used for new entries.
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: IARSTAT NAME 1=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

b: IARSTAT NAME 2=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

c: IARSTAT NAME 3=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARNAME- 9+


CAN IARNAME
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

d: IARSTAT NAME 4=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARNAME- 10-


DISP IARNAME
COUTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IARA STATISTICS NAME

This command displays IARSTAT origin or destination names in the IARSTAT


database for the entered objects, i.e. an assignment of IARSTAT origin
or destination names to the entered objects is displayed.

Notes:
- Only names in status ACTIVE are displayed.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP IARNAME - COUTYP CONFERENCE UNIT TYPE


2. DISP IARNAME - DEST DESTINATION
3. DISP IARNAME - LAC LOCAL AREA CODE
4. DISP IARNAME - LACOR LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING
5. DISP IARNAME - TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

1. Input format

CONFERENCE UNIT TYPE

This input format displays IARSTAT origin or destination names


for a conference unit type.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IARNAME : COUTYP= ,DIR= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

COUTYP CONFERENCE UNIT TYPE

This parameter specifies the conference unit type.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CONFL LARGE CONFERENCE


MEETME MEET ME
PHONMEET TELEPHONE MEETING
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

DIR DIRECTION

This parameter specifies whether the IARSTAT origin or


destination names are to be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DEST DESTINATION
ORIG ORIGIN

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARNAME- 1+


DISP IARNAME
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

DESTINATION

This input format displays IARSTAT destination names for a


destination.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,RTNO=11 1
1 DISP IARNAME : DEST= 1Z,TGNO=Y1 ; 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the destination area name.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

RTNO ROUTE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the position (route number) in the search


order of the route reference in the destination area data table.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARNAME- 2+


DISP IARNAME
LAC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

LOCAL AREA CODE

This input format displays IARSTAT origin or destination names


for a local area code.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IARNAME : LAC= ,DIR= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DIR DIRECTION

This parameter specifies whether the IARSTAT origin or


destination names are to be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DEST DESTINATION
ORIG ORIGIN

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARNAME- 3+


DISP IARNAME
LACOR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING

This input format displays IARSTAT origin names for a


local area code originating.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IARNAME : LACOR= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LACOR LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING

This parameter specifies the local area code originating.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARNAME- 4+


DISP IARNAME
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This input format displays IARSTAT origin names for a


trunk group number.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IARNAME : TGNO= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARNAME- 5-


ENTR IARNAME
COUTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER IARA STATISTICS NAME

This command enters IARSTAT origin or destination names in the IARSTAT


database for the entered object. i.e an assignment of IARSTAT origin
or destination names to the entered object is done.

Notes:
- The IARSTAT names can be entered simultaneously for the four possible
measurement types.
- The entry is immediately active.
- IARSTAT names cannot be assigned to test equipment, switchboards,
nailed-up connections (NUC) or local network trunk groups.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ENTR IARNAME - COUTYP CONFERENCE UNIT TYPE


2. ENTR IARNAME - DEST DESTINATION
3. ENTR IARNAME - LAC LOCAL AREA CODE
4. ENTR IARNAME - LACOR LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING
5. ENTR IARNAME - TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

1. Input format

CONFERENCE UNIT TYPE

This input format enters IARSTAT origin or destination names


for a conference unit type.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR IARNAME : COUTYP= ,DIR= ,NAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

COUTYP CONFERENCE UNIT TYPE

This parameter specifies the conference unit type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CONFL LARGE CONFERENCE


MEETME MEET ME
PHONMEET TELEPHONE MEETING

DIR DIRECTION TYPE

This parameter specifies the direction for which the entered IARSTAT
names are meant. i.e. the parameter specifies whether origin or
destination names are entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DEST DESTINATION
ORIG ORIGIN

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin or destination names for


the 4 IARSTAT measurement types. They are entered in the IARSTAT
database for a particular object, dependent on the other parameters
of the command.

Notes:
- Name: 1-2-3-4. If entry of a name is not desired for a
measurement type, either a 0 or the number sign # must be
entered.
0 means: no name stored
# means: stored value is ignored
- The IARSTAT names can be new names or names already assigned

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IARNAME- 1+


ENTR IARNAME
COUTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

to other objects (grouping of registration).


- A name in INACTIVE cannot be used for new entries.
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: IARSTAT NAME 1=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

b: IARSTAT NAME 2=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

c: IARSTAT NAME 3=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

d: IARSTAT NAME 4=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IARNAME- 2+


ENTR IARNAME
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

DESTINATION

This input format enters IARSTAT destination names for a


destination/route combination.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,RTNO=1 (;) 1
1 ENTR IARNAME : DEST= Z,TGNO=Y ,NAME= Z Y 1
1 1 1 *!+ 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the destination area name.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

RTNO ROUTE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the position (route number) in the search


order of the route reference in the destination area data table.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin or destination names for


the 4 IARSTAT measurement types. They are entered in the IARSTAT
database for a particular object, dependent on the other parameters
of the command.

Notes:
- Name: 1-2-3-4. If entry of a name is not desired for a
measurement type, either a 0 or the number sign # must be
entered.
0 means: no name stored
# means: stored value is ignored
- The IARSTAT names can be new names or names already assigned
to other objects (grouping of registration).
- A name in INACTIVE cannot be used for new entries.
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IARNAME- 3+


ENTR IARNAME
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a: IARSTAT NAME 1=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

b: IARSTAT NAME 2=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

c: IARSTAT NAME 3=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

d: IARSTAT NAME 4=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IARNAME- 4+


ENTR IARNAME
LAC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

LOCAL AREA CODE

This input format enters IARSTAT origin or destination names


for a local area code.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR IARNAME : LAC= ,DIR= ,NAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DIR DIRECTION TYPE

This parameter specifies the direction for which the entered IARSTAT
names are meant. i.e. the parameter specifies whether origin or
destination names are entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DEST DESTINATION
ORIG ORIGIN

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin or destination names for


the 4 IARSTAT measurement types. They are entered in the IARSTAT
database for a particular object, dependent on the other parameters
of the command.

Notes:
- Name: 1-2-3-4. If entry of a name is not desired for a
measurement type, either a 0 or the number sign # must be
entered.
0 means: no name stored
# means: stored value is ignored
- The IARSTAT names can be new names or names already assigned
to other objects (grouping of registration).
- A name in INACTIVE cannot be used for new entries.
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: IARSTAT NAME 1=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

b: IARSTAT NAME 2=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

c: IARSTAT NAME 3=
1...6 characters from the

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IARNAME- 5+


ENTR IARNAME
LAC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

d: IARSTAT NAME 4=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IARNAME- 6+


ENTR IARNAME
LACOR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING

This input format enters IARSTAT origin names for a local area
code originating.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR IARNAME : LACOR= ,NAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LACOR LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING

This parameter specifies the local area code originating.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin or destination names for


the 4 IARSTAT measurement types. They are entered in the IARSTAT
database for a particular object, dependent on the other parameters
of the command.

Notes:
- Name: 1-2-3-4. If entry of a name is not desired for a
measurement type, either a 0 or the number sign # must be
entered.
0 means: no name stored
# means: stored value is ignored
- The IARSTAT names can be new names or names already assigned
to other objects (grouping of registration).
- A name in INACTIVE cannot be used for new entries.
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: IARSTAT NAME 1=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

b: IARSTAT NAME 2=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

c: IARSTAT NAME 3=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

d: IARSTAT NAME 4=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IARNAME- 7+


ENTR IARNAME
LACOR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IARNAME- 8+


ENTR IARNAME
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This input format enters IARSTAT origin names for a trunk group
number.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR IARNAME : TGNO= ,NAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin or destination names for


the 4 IARSTAT measurement types. They are entered in the IARSTAT
database for a particular object, dependent on the other parameters
of the command.

Notes:
- Name: 1-2-3-4. If entry of a name is not desired for a
measurement type, either a 0 or the number sign # must be
entered.
0 means: no name stored
# means: stored value is ignored
- The IARSTAT names can be new names or names already assigned
to other objects (grouping of registration).
- A name in INACTIVE cannot be used for new entries.
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: IARSTAT NAME 1=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

b: IARSTAT NAME 2=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

c: IARSTAT NAME 3=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IARNAME- 9+


ENTR IARNAME
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

d: IARSTAT NAME 4=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IARNAME- 10-


MOD IARNAME
COUTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY IARA STATISTICS NAME

This command modifies IARSTAT origin or destination names in the


IARSTAT database for the entered object, i.e. an assignment of
IARSTAT origin or destination names to the entered object is changed.

Notes:
- The IARSTAT names can be changed simultaneously for the four possible
measurement types.
- The modification is immediately active.
- IARSTAT names cannot be assigned to test equipment, switchboards,
nailed-up connections (NUC) or local network trunk groups.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD IARNAME - COUTYP CONFERENCE UNIT TYPE


2. MOD IARNAME - DEST DESTINATION
3. MOD IARNAME - LAC LOCAL AREA CODE
4. MOD IARNAME - LACOR LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING
5. MOD IARNAME - TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

1. Input format

CONFERENCE UNIT TYPE

This input format modifies IARSTAT origin or destination names


for a conference unit type.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD IARNAME : COUTYP= ,DIR= ,NAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

COUTYP CONFERENCE UNIT TYPE

This parameter specifies the conference unit type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CONFL LARGE CONFERENCE


MEETME MEET ME
PHONMEET TELEPHONE MEETING

DIR DIRECTION

This parameter specifies the direction for which the entered IARSTAT
names are meant, i.e. the parameter specifies whether origin or
destination names are modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DEST DESTINATION
ORIG ORIGIN

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin or destination names for


the 4 IARSTAT measurement types. They are entered, modified or
cancelled in the IARSTAT database for a particular object,
dependent on the other parameters of the command.

Notes:
This parameter must be entered in the following form:

- Enter names : new1-new2-new3-new4/

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IARNAME- 1+


MOD IARNAME
COUTYP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Instead of newx, the sign # may be entered. In this


case, the value available in the memory must not be
considered.

- Cancel names : /old1-old2-old3-old4


Instead of oldx, the sign # may be entered. In this case,
the value available in the memory must not be considered.

- Modify names : new1-new2-new3-new4/old1-old2-old3-old4


Instead of newx or oldx, the sign 0 or # may be entered.
0 instead of newx means that the value in memory must be
cancelled.
When a new name is entered with newx, a 0 must be entered
instead of oldx.
For this registration, for wich no changes may take plays,
# must be entered instead of both newx and oldx.

Combinations without any sense are rejected.

- A name in INACTIVE cannot be used for new entries.


- If the maximum number of names is reached, modifying can
only be done by cancelling the old name and entering the
new name again.
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

n/o
n/
/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

a-b-c-d

a: IARSTAT NAME 1=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

b: IARSTAT NAME 2=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

c: IARSTAT NAME 3=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

d: IARSTAT NAME 4=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IARNAME- 2+


MOD IARNAME
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

DESTINATION

This input format modifies IARSTAT destination names for a


destination/route combination.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,RTNO=1 (;) 1
1 MOD IARNAME : DEST= Z,TGNO=Y ,NAME= Z Y 1
1 1 1 *!+ 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DEST DESTINATION

This parameter specifies the destination area name.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

RTNO ROUTE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the position (route number) in the search


order of the route reference in the destination area data table.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16, range of decimal numbers

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin or destination names for


the 4 IARSTAT measurement types. They are entered, modified or
cancelled in the IARSTAT database for a particular object,
dependent on the other parameters of the command.

Notes:
This parameter must be entered in the following form:

- Enter names : new1-new2-new3-new4/


Instead of newx, the sign # may be entered. In this
case, the value available in the memory must not be
considered.

- Cancel names : /old1-old2-old3-old4


Instead of oldx, the sign # may be entered. In this case,
the value available in the memory must not be considered.

- Modify names : new1-new2-new3-new4/old1-old2-old3-old4


Instead of newx or oldx, the sign 0 or # may be entered.
0 instead of newx means that the value in memory must be
cancelled.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IARNAME- 3+


MOD IARNAME
DEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

When a new name is entered with newx, a 0 must be entered


instead of oldx.
For this registration, for wich no changes may take plays,
# must be entered instead of both newx and oldx.

Combinations without any sense are rejected.

- A name in INACTIVE cannot be used for new entries.


- If the maximum number of names is reached, modifying can
only be done by cancelling the old name and entering the
new name again.
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

n/o
n/
/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

a-b-c-d

a: IARSTAT NAME 1=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

b: IARSTAT NAME 2=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

c: IARSTAT NAME 3=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

d: IARSTAT NAME 4=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IARNAME- 4+


MOD IARNAME
LAC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

LOCAL AREA CODE

This input format modifies IARSTAT origin or destination names


for a local area code.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD IARNAME : LAC= ,DIR= ,NAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DIR DIRECTION

This parameter specifies the direction for which the entered IARSTAT
names are meant, i.e. the parameter specifies whether origin or
destination names are modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DEST DESTINATION
ORIG ORIGIN

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin or destination names for


the 4 IARSTAT measurement types. They are entered, modified or
cancelled in the IARSTAT database for a particular object,
dependent on the other parameters of the command.

Notes:
This parameter must be entered in the following form:

- Enter names : new1-new2-new3-new4/


Instead of newx, the sign # may be entered. In this
case, the value available in the memory must not be
considered.

- Cancel names : /old1-old2-old3-old4


Instead of oldx, the sign # may be entered. In this case,
the value available in the memory must not be considered.

- Modify names : new1-new2-new3-new4/old1-old2-old3-old4


Instead of newx or oldx, the sign 0 or # may be entered.
0 instead of newx means that the value in memory must be
cancelled.
When a new name is entered with newx, a 0 must be entered
instead of oldx.
For this registration, for wich no changes may take plays,
# must be entered instead of both newx and oldx.

Combinations without any sense are rejected.

- A name in INACTIVE cannot be used for new entries.


- If the maximum number of names is reached, modifying can
only be done by cancelling the old name and entering the
new name again.
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

n/o
n/
/o

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IARNAME- 5+


MOD IARNAME
LAC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

n, o: new, old parameter value =

a-b-c-d

a: IARSTAT NAME 1=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

b: IARSTAT NAME 2=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

c: IARSTAT NAME 3=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

d: IARSTAT NAME 4=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IARNAME- 6+


MOD IARNAME
LACOR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING

This input format modifies IARSTAT origin names for a


local area code originating.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD IARNAME : LACOR= ,NAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LACOR LOCAL AREA CODE ORIGINATING

This parameter specifies the local area code originating.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin or destination names for


the 4 IARSTAT measurement types. They are entered, modified or
cancelled in the IARSTAT database for a particular object,
dependent on the other parameters of the command.

Notes:
This parameter must be entered in the following form:

- Enter names : new1-new2-new3-new4/


Instead of newx, the sign # may be entered. In this
case, the value available in the memory must not be
considered.

- Cancel names : /old1-old2-old3-old4


Instead of oldx, the sign # may be entered. In this case,
the value available in the memory must not be considered.

- Modify names : new1-new2-new3-new4/old1-old2-old3-old4


Instead of newx or oldx, the sign 0 or # may be entered.
0 instead of newx means that the value in memory must be
cancelled.
When a new name is entered with newx, a 0 must be entered
instead of oldx.
For this registration, for wich no changes may take plays,
# must be entered instead of both newx and oldx.

Combinations without any sense are rejected.

- A name in INACTIVE cannot be used for new entries.


- If the maximum number of names is reached, modifying can
only be done by cancelling the old name and entering the
new name again.
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

n/o
n/
/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

a-b-c-d

a: IARSTAT NAME 1=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IARNAME- 7+


MOD IARNAME
LACOR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: IARSTAT NAME 2=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

c: IARSTAT NAME 3=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

d: IARSTAT NAME 4=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IARNAME- 8+


MOD IARNAME
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This input format modifies IARSTAT origin names for a


trunk group number.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD IARNAME : TGNO= ,NAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.


This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

NAME NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin or destination names for


the 4 IARSTAT measurement types. They are entered, modified or
cancelled in the IARSTAT database for a particular object,
dependent on the other parameters of the command.

Notes:
This parameter must be entered in the following form:

- Enter names : new1-new2-new3-new4/


Instead of newx, the sign # may be entered. In this
case, the value available in the memory must not be
considered.

- Cancel names : /old1-old2-old3-old4


Instead of oldx, the sign # may be entered. In this case,
the value available in the memory must not be considered.

- Modify names : new1-new2-new3-new4/old1-old2-old3-old4


Instead of newx or oldx, the sign 0 or # may be entered.
0 instead of newx means that the value in memory must be
cancelled.
When a new name is entered with newx, a 0 must be entered
instead of oldx.
For this registration, for wich no changes may take plays,
# must be entered instead of both newx and oldx.

Combinations without any sense are rejected.

- A name in INACTIVE cannot be used for new entries.


- If the maximum number of names is reached, modifying can
only be done by cancelling the old name and entering the
new name again.
- This parameter allows only alphanumeric characters.

n/o
n/
/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

a-b-c-d

a: IARSTAT NAME 1=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IARNAME- 9+


MOD IARNAME
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The following characters are not permitted:


.

b: IARSTAT NAME 2=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

c: IARSTAT NAME 3=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

d: IARSTAT NAME 4=
1...6 characters from the
symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IARNAME- 10-


CAN IARSAVDA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL IARSTAT SAVING DATE

This command resets the time at which IARSTAT continuous


registrations are saved to the default values,
i.e. to the first day of the month at 0 a.m.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IARSAVDA Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARSAVDA- 1-


DISP IARSAVDA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IARSTAT SAVING DATE

This command displays hour and day for the automatic monthly saving
of the permanent IARSTAT measurements jobs in a post processing file.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP IARSAVDA Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARSAVDA- 1-


ENTR IARSAVDA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER IARSTAT SAVING DATE

This command enters a new time for the monthly automatic saving of
data of IARSTAT continuous registrations. The command is only
executed after a check has been made to ensure that no other time is
installed (except for the default: first day of the month at 0 a.m.).
If a time is already installed earlier on, it must first be reset
to the default value using the cancel command.
Automatic saving of data of continuous registration to a post processing
file is only carried out once a month. The user receives a message
acknowledging that the saving has been executed.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,DAYNUM=1 (;) 1
1 ENTR IARSAVDA : HOUR= Z,DAYTYP=Y Z Y 1
1 1 1 *!+ 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

HOUR HOUR OF DAILY SCHEDULED REPORT

This parameter specifies the hour at which the monthly


automatic saving of continuously registered data is
to take place.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...23, range of decimal numbers

DAYNUM DAY NUMBER OF SAVING DATE

This parameter specifies the day on which the automatic monthly


saving of the continuous registration is to be done. If the day of
the desired saving does not lie within the range, 1-28, entered
with this parameter, the parameter DAYTYP must be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...28, range of decimal numbers

DAYTYP DAY TYPE FOR SAVING DATE

This parameter specifies the ’type’ of day on which the monthly


automatic saving of continuously registered data is to take
place. It is only used in cases where the day number exceeds 28
(parameter DAYNUM).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

LAST LAST DAY


PREV PREVIOUS DAY
PREV2 DAY BEFORE PREVIOUS DAY

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IARSAVDA- 1-


DISP IARSTAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IARA STATISTICS

This command displays the IARSTAT counter data for a running or completed
registration job.
Only the registered data of origin and destination names which have
been combined to active matrix points are displayed.

Display of call data during a registration:


This is done by entering the measurement type parameter.
For time limited registrations, the displayed counters contain the call
data registered from the start of the registration until the last full hour;
i.e. the transient counters containing the values received during the
current hour are not included until the next full hour.
For a continuous registration job, the displayed counters contain the call
data registered from the last intermediate saving of the registration, until
the last full hour.
Remark: display is not possible during the saving of the transient counters
at the full hour.

Display of a post processing file:


The post processing file must be specified.
A display of the registered call data is only possible from the
unconverted file IR.Aryymmnn on disk. Copying the disk file to tape /
optical disk by TRANS FILE for post processing converts the data
into a format, which can no longer be displayed by DISP IARSTAT.
The disk file IR.Aryymmnn itself remains displayable.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1MTYPE=1 1
1 DISP IARSTAT : ZFILE= Y [,DNAME=] [,ONAME=] ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MTYPE MEASUREMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the measurement type, which is used for


separate registration jobs.
The choice of the meaning of the measurement types is free.
Nevertheless the database configuration (i.e. number of origin names
and destination names) leads to the following recommendation:
- IARSTAT1: Registration of international outgoing traffic.
- IARSTAT2: Registration of international incoming traffic.
- IARSTAT3: Registration of international transit traffic.
- IARSTAT4: Registration for statistical reasons.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IARSTAT1 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 1


IARSTAT2 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 2
IARSTAT3 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 3
IARSTAT4 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 4

FILE FILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of the post processing file on disk.
The name of the post processing file is structured as follows:
IR.Aryymmnn
with r = measurement type number (1...4)
yy = year (begin registration)
mm = month (begin registration)
nn = serial number (01...99) within a measurement type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARSTAT- 1+


DISP IARSTAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


+,*,%,#

DNAME DESTINATION NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT destination name.


If the parameter is omitted, all possible parameter values
are taken into account.

Notes:
- Up to 10 individual names and/or ranges can be linked.
- Linking with && covers the range of all names in
alphabetical order between the two specified names.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

ONAME ORIGIN NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin name.


If the parameter is omitted, all possible parameter values
are taken into account.

Notes:
- Up to 10 individual names and/or ranges can be linked.
- Linking with && covers the range of all names in
alphabetical order between the two specified names.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARSTAT- 2-


REC IARSTAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RECORD IARA STATISTICS

This command defines the start and end time of a registration job for
a measurement type. A post processing file for the saving of the recorded
call data for this measurement type is then created. When a post processing
file could not be created before the start time of the registration,
e.g. due to lack of space on disk, the registration will still be started.
Each full hour, the system will try to create the missing post processing
file.
The name of the post processing file is structured as follows:
IR.Aryymmnn
with r = measurement type number (1...4)
yy = year (begin registration)
mm = month (begin registration)
nn = serial number (01...99) within a measurement type

Notes:
The input parameters are checked for compliance with the following rules:
- A registration job can not be started earlier than the beginning of the
next hour or later than 31 days from now.
- The interval between start and end time may not be less than one hour
and may not exceed 35 days.
- Per measurement type, maximum 2 registration jobs can be installed.
Their time intervals may not overlap.

For time limited registrations, the registered data are saved on


post processing file at the end of the registration.
For long term registrations, a monthly saving on post processing file is
automatically executed. Without any input from the operator, this saving
takes place on the first day of each month at 0 a.m.
This saving time is changeable by the command ENTR IARSAVDA.
At the same time a new file is created to collect the data for the next month.
Furthermore it is always possible to start an intermediate saving by using
the command COPY IARACCT. In this case, also a new post processing
file is created.

The post processing file is created when REC IARSTAT is entered and it is
given write and delete protection. The name cannot be changed either. After
call data have been written to the file, the delete protection is cancelled.
Before transferring the post processing file from disk to magnetic tape /
optical disk, the IRCPP copying process must first be associated with
the command SET FGRPATT.
If the command is issued from a COFIP command file, the corresponding COFIP
parameters must be set to allow process messages to be output on the
printer terminal, otherwise all messages associated with the command are
suppressed.
If the command is started from a command file generated by REGEN, it is
possible that the begin time for a registration job has already been passed.
The job must then be re-entered manually with appropriate corrections
by the operating personnel.
If software errors occur during the saving of registered data to the
post processing file, registration is not interrupted, but changes to a new
status and can be stopped using the command CAN JOB. If software errors
occur again, call data may be lost, because the use of CAN JOB causes the
registration job to be stopped in all cases.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 REC IARSTAT : MTYPE= [,BEG=] [,TER=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MTYPE MEASUREMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the measurement type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IARSTAT1 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC IARSTAT- 1+


REC IARSTAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

IARSTAT2 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 2


IARSTAT3 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 3
IARSTAT4 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 4

BEG BEGIN DATE

This parameter defines the begin time for a registration job. If


the registration job is to start at the next hour on the hour,
it is not necessary to enter this parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

d: HOUR OF BEGIN TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

TER TERMINATION DATE

This parameter defines the termination time for a registration job.


If registration is to be continuous, it is not necessary to enter
this parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c-d

a: YEAR OF TERMINATION DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

d: HOUR OF TERMINATION TIME=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC IARSTAT- 2-


CAN IARTMPD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL IARSTAT TIME PERIOD

This command cancels an IARSTAT tariff switching time assigned to one


IARSTAT tariff zone. All other switching times remain effective.

Notes:
- When no weekday categories are specified, the tariff switching time is
cancelled for all possible weekday categories. This command is rejected,
when the tariff switching time does not exist for all weekday categories.
- When the last tariff switch of a tariff zone is cancelled, the call data
are added to the day counters.
- The command takes effect immediately.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IARTMPD : TZONE= ,TARIFF= ,TIME= [,WDCAT=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TZONE IARSTAT TARIFF ZONE

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT tariff zone, for which the
tariff switch is cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...99, range of decimal numbers

TARIFF IARSTAT TARIFF

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT tariff, to which will be switched.


Each tariff has its own counter. A tariff switch implies that the
registered data are added to another counter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DAY DAY TARIFF


EVE EVENING TARIFF
NIGHT NIGHT TARIFF

TIME TIME FOR TARIFF SWITCH

This parameter specifies the time for the tariff switch.


Tariff switches are only possible at the full hour.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
a decimal number

This parameter unit value must be zero (0), since tariff


switching times can only be entered for the full hour.

WDCAT WEEKDAY CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the weekday categories for the tariff switch.
When the parameter is omitted, the tariff switch is cancelled for all
possible weekday categories.
The priority assignment for the individual weekday
categories is as follows:

HO , HH > EF , EH > HN , WO

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARTMPD- 1+


CAN IARTMPD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

WO WORKDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL
EH HALF WEEKEND DAY
EF FULL WEEKEND DAY

Default: WO, HH, HO, HN, EH, EF

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARTMPD- 2-


CR IARTMPD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE IARSTAT TIME PERIOD

This command creates an IARSTAT tariff switching time for one IARSTAT
tariff zone. Up to 255 switching times can be created for the whole 99
tariff zones.

The following rules apply to the splitting of call data for a call that
extends on both sides of a tariff switching time:
- Holding times A-side and B-side and the conversation time are split
between the tariff counters before and after the switching time in
accordance with the actual time.
- The number of call attempts and calls answered are added to the
tariff counters valid after the tariff switching time.
- The switching times can be installed per weekday category. When no
weekday categories are specified, the tariff switching time is valid
for all possible weekday categories.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR IARTMPD : TZONE= ,TARIFF= ,TIME= [,WDCAT=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TZONE IARSTAT TARIFF ZONE

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT tariff zone, for which the
tariff switch is created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...99, range of decimal numbers

TARIFF IARSTAT TARIFF

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT tariff, to which will be switched.


Each tariff has its own counter. A tariff switch implies that the
registered data are added to another counter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DAY DAY TARIFF


EVE EVENING TARIFF
NIGHT NIGHT TARIFF

TIME TIME FOR TARIFF SWITCH

This parameter specifies the time for the tariff switch.


Tariff switches are only possible at the full hour.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
a decimal number

This parameter unit value must be zero (0), since tariff


switching times can only be entered for the full hour.

WDCAT WEEKDAY CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the weekday categories for the tariff switch.
When the parameter is omitted, the tariff switch is created for all
possible weekday categories.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IARTMPD- 1+
CR IARTMPD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The priority assignment for the individual weekday


categories is as follows:

HO , HH > EF , EH > HN , WO

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

WO WORKDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL
EH HALF WEEKEND DAY
EF FULL WEEKEND DAY

Default: WO, HH, HO, HN, EH, EF

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IARTMPD- 2-
DISP IARTMPD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IARA TIME PERIOD

This command displays the IARSTAT tariff switching times for


one or all IARSTAT tariff zones.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IARTMPD : TZONE= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TZONE TARIFF ZONE

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT tariff zone, to which a day


tariff, an evening tariff and a night tariff can be assigned.

Notes:
- Linking of tariff zones for output is not permitted.
- Input of a single X is permitted.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...99, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARTMPD- 1-


MOD IARTMPD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY IARSTAT TIME PERIOD

This command modifies, cancels or creates tariff switching times assigned


to one IARSTAT tariff zone.
This command combines the actions of commands CR IARTMPD and CAN IARTMPD.
To create or cancel switching times with this command, the conditions
described for the above mentioned commands apply without restriction.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD IARTMPD : TZONE= ,TARIFF= ,TIME= [,WDCAT=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TZONE IARSTAT TARIFF ZONE

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT tariff zone, for which the
tariff switch is modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...99, range of decimal numbers

TARIFF IARSTAT TARIFF

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT tariff, to which will be switched.


Each tariff has its own counter. A tariff switch implies that the
registered data are added to another counter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DAY DAY TARIFF


EVE EVENING TARIFF
NIGHT NIGHT TARIFF

TIME TIME FOR TARIFF SWITCH

This parameter specifies the time for the tariff switch.


Tariff switches are only possible at the full hour.

n/o
n/
/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

a-b

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
a decimal number

This parameter unit value must be zero (0), since tariff


switching times can only be entered for the full hour.

WDCAT WEEKDAY CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the weekday categories for the tariff switch.
When the parameter is omitted, the tariff switch is modified for all
possible weekday categories.
The priority assignment for the individual weekday
categories is as follows:

HO , HH > EF , EH > HN , WO

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IARTMPD- 1+


MOD IARTMPD

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

WO WORKDAY
HH HOLIDAY HALF INTERNATIONAL
HO HOLIDAY FULL INTERNATIONAL
HN HOLIDAY FULL NATIONAL
EH HALF WEEKEND DAY
EF FULL WEEKEND DAY

Default: WO, HH, HO, HN, EH, EF

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IARTMPD- 2-


CAN IARZONE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL IARA STATISTICS ZONE

This command cancels the assignment of one or more matrix points


to an IARSTAT tariff zone. The matrix points are identified by their
IARSTAT origin and destination names. The command takes immediate effect.
Caution:
If the tariff zone specified for one or more of the origin-destination
relations specified in the command is incorrect, the incorrectly specified
entry is not cancelled but all correct entries are cancelled. After the
assignment of an origin-destination relation to a tariff zone has
been cancelled, call data received are added to the day counters. If
destination names and/or origin names are specified for which no
matrix point has been created, the command is rejected (also if parameters
are linked with &). If, however, parameters are linked with &&, or X is
specified for origin and/or destination/route name, the assignment is
cancelled for those matrix points that are created.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IARZONE : MTYPE= ,TZONE= ,DNAME= ,ONAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MTYPE MEASUREMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the measurement type, which is used for


separate registration jobs.
The choice of the meaning of the measurement types is free.
Nevertheless the database configuration (i.e. number of origin names
and destination names) leads to the following recommendation:
- IARSTAT1: Registration of international outgoing traffic.
- IARSTAT2: Registration of international incoming traffic.
- IARSTAT3: Registration of international transit traffic.
- IARSTAT4: Registration for statistical reasons.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IARSTAT1 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 1


IARSTAT2 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 2
IARSTAT3 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 3
IARSTAT4 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 4

TZONE TARIFF ZONE

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT tariff zone.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...99, range of decimal numbers

DNAME DESTINATION NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT destination name.

Notes:
- Up to 10 individual names and/or ranges can be linked.
- Linking with && covers the range of all names in alphabetical order
between the two specified names.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARZONE- 1+


CAN IARZONE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

ONAME ORIGIN NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin name.

Notes:
- Up to 10 individual names and/or ranges can be linked.
- Linking with && covers the range of all names in alphabetical
order between the two specified names.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IARZONE- 2-


DISP IARZONE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IARA STATISTICS ZONE

This command displays the IARSTAT tariff zones assigned to one


or more matrix points. The matrix points are identified by their IARSTAT
origin and destination names. If no tariff zone is assigned to a matrix
point, a ’blank’ is output for the zone.

Notes: If origin and/or destination names are specified


for which no matrix point has been created, only the zones
assigned to created matrix points are displayed.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IARZONE : MTYPE= [,DNAME=] [,ONAME=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MTYPE MEASUREMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the measurement type, which is used for


separate registrations jobs.
The choice of the meaning of the measurement types is free.
Nevertheless the database configuration (i.e. number of origin names
and destination names) leads to the following recommendation:
- IARSTAT1: Registration of international outgoing traffic.
- IARSTAT2: Registration of international incoming traffic.
- IARSTAT3: Registration of international transit traffic.
- IARSTAT4: Registration for statistical reasons.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IARSTAT1 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 1


IARSTAT2 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 2
IARSTAT3 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 3
IARSTAT4 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 4

DNAME DESTINATION NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT destination name.


If the parameter is omitted, all associated parameter
values are adressed.

Notes:
- Up to 10 individual names and/or ranges can be linked.
- Linking with && covers the range of all names in
alphabetical order between the two specified names.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

ONAME ORIGIN NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin name.


If the parameter is omitted, all associated parameter
values are addressed.

Notes:
- Up to 10 individual names and/or ranges can be linked.
- Linking with && covers the range of all names in
alphabetical order between the two specified names.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARZONE- 1+


DISP IARZONE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IARZONE- 2-


ENTR IARZONE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER IARA STATISTICS ZONE

This command enters IARSTAT tariff zones to one or more matrix points for
counters. The matrix points are identified by their IARSTAT origin and
destination name.
The entered tariff zone applies immediately.
Caution: If a tariff zone has already been assigned to one of the IARSTAT
matrixpoints specified in the command, no part of the command
is executed.
If destination and/or origin names are specified for which no matrix
point has been created, the command is rejected (also if parameters
are linked with &). If, however, parameters are linked with &&, or X is
specified for origin and/or destination/route names, the tariff zone is
assigned to the created matrix points.
If the registered data for an origin-destination relation are not to be
split up in different tariffs, there is no need to use this command. The
registered data are then added to the day counters.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR IARZONE : MTYPE= ,TZONE= ,DNAME= ,ONAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MTYPE MEASUREMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the measurement type, which is used for


separate registration jobs.
The choice of the meaning of the measurement types is free.
Nevertheless the database configuration (i.e. number of origin names
and destination names) leads to the following recommendation:
- IARSTAT1: Registration of international outgoing traffic.
- IARSTAT2: Registration of international incoming traffic.
- IARSTAT3: Registration of international transit traffic.
- IARSTAT4: Registration for statistical reasons.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IARSTAT1 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 1


IARSTAT2 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 2
IARSTAT3 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 3
IARSTAT4 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 4

TZONE TARIFF ZONE

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT tariff zone.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...99, range of decimal numbers

DNAME DESTINATION NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT destination name.

Notes:
- Up to 10 individual names and/or ranges can be linked.
- Linking with && covers the range of all names in
alphabetical order between the two specified names.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IARZONE- 1+


ENTR IARZONE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

ONAME ORIGIN NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin name.

Notes:
- Up to 10 individual names and/or ranges can be linked.
- Linking with && covers the range of all names in alphabetical
order between the two specified names.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IARZONE- 2-


MOD IARZONE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY IARA STATISTICS ZONE

This command modifies the assignment of an IARSTAT tariff zone to one or


more matrix points. The matrix points are identified by their origin-
destination names. The new tariff zone applies immediately.
Caution:
If the old tariff zone specified in the command for one of the origin-
destination names is incorrect, then the entire command is not executed.
If destination and/or origin names are specified for which no
matrix point has been created, the command is rejected (also if parameters
are linked with &). If parameters are linked with &&, or X is specified for
origin and/or destination name, the modification is executed for the
created matrix points.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD IARZONE : MTYPE= ,TZONE= ,DNAME= ,ONAME= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MTYPE MEASUREMENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the measurement type, which is used for


separate registration jobs.
The choice of the meaning of the measurement types is free.
Nevertheless the database configuration (i.e. number of origin names
and destination names) leads to the following recommendation:
- IARSTAT1: Registration of international outgoing traffic.
- IARSTAT2: Registration of international incoming traffic.
- IARSTAT3: Registration of international transit traffic.
- IARSTAT4: Registration for statistical reasons.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IARSTAT1 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 1


IARSTAT2 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 2
IARSTAT3 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 3
IARSTAT4 IARSTAT MEASUREMENT TYPE 4

TZONE TARIFF ZONE

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT tariff zone. It may only


be entered in the form ’new/old’.

n/o

n, o: new, old parameter value =

1...99, range of decimal numbers

DNAME DESTINATION NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT destination name.

Notes:
- Up to 10 individual names and/or ranges can be linked.
- Linking with && covers the range of all names in
alphabetical order between the two specified names.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IARZONE- 1+


MOD IARZONE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

ONAME ORIGIN NAME

This parameter specifies the IARSTAT origin name.

Notes:
- Up to 10 individual names and/or ranges can be linked.
- Linking with && covers the range of all names in alphabetical
order between the two specified names.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

The following characters are not permitted:


.,+,*,%,#

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IARZONE- 2-


ACT IBFS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE INITIATOR BASED FILE SECURITY

This command is used to re-activate the Initiator based File


Security mechanism for all MML-Userids.

Note:
- When this command is entered then all MML-Userids that were
deactivated with the command DACT IBFS will be deleted from
the list of deactivated Userids.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT IBFS ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IBFS- 1-


DACT IBFS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE INITIATOR BASED FILE SECURITY

This command deactivates the Initiator based File Security method for up
to five MML-UserIds.
From this moment the File Security checks will not be done for the entered
MML-UserIds as long as the MP:OA&M is not available.

Note:
- On CP an InitiatorId is equal to a MML-UserId.
- The command may only be entered when the system is running in Innovation
together with a MP:OA&M.
- When the MP:OA&M is not available then the File Security checks will not
be done for the (previously) entered UserId(s).
- When the MP:OA&M is available then the File Security checks will be done
for all users and initiators and the deactivation for the entered
UserId(s) will be ignored.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT IBFS : USERID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

USERID USER IDENTIFICATION

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT IBFS- 1-


DISP IBFS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY INITIATOR BASED FILE SEC. STATUS

This command can be used to display the actual status of the


Initiator based File Security mechanism.
The status can be changed with the commands DACT IBFS and
ACT IBFS.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IBFS ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IBFS- 1-


STAT ILAYER1
DN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY STATUS OF LAYER 1 FOR ISDN PORTS

This command displays the saved status of the layer 1 activation


procedure.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing ISDN.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. STAT ILAYER1 - DN DIRECTORY NUMBER ORIENTED


2. STAT ILAYER1 - LC EQUIPMENT NUMBER ORIENTED

1. Input format

DIRECTORY NUMBER ORIENTED

Input format for directory-number-oriented output.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT ILAYER1 : [LAC=] ,DN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.


The parameter is mandatory in an exchange with multiple directory
number volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the subscriber.


Up to ten parameters can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT ILAYER1- 1+


STAT ILAYER1
LC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

EQUIPMENT NUMBER ORIENTED

Input format for equipment-number-oriented output.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT ILAYER1 : DLU= ,LC= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10,20,30...2550, range of decimal numbers

LC LINE CIRCUIT

This parameter specifies the circuit position in a DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b[-c]

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

c: CIRCUIT NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT ILAYER1- 2-


CAN IMEI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL INTERNAT. MOBILE EQUIPMENT ID.

This command deletes a single IMEI (International Mobile Equipment


Identity) or range of IMEI’s from one of the three lists (white, grey,
black) of the Equipment Identity Register (EIR) database.

Notes:
- An IMEI consists of 15 digits : TAC-FAC-SNR-SPA
with TAC : type approval code ( 6 digits ),
FAC : final assembly code ( 2 digits ),
SNR : serial number ( 6 digits ),
SPA : spare ( 1 digit ).
No input parameter is defined for the spare digit.

- A range of IMEI’s consists of IMEI’s with fixed TAC, fixed FAC


and consecutive SNR’s.

- A single IMEI can only be deleted from a list if it was previously


created as a single IMEI on that list.

- A range of IMEI’s can only be deleted from a list if exactly


the same range was previously created on that list.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if an equipment identification


register (EIR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IMEI : TAC= ,FAC= ,SNR= ,LIST= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TAC TYPE APPROVAL CODE

This parameter specifies the type approval code of the international


mobile equipment identity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

6 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

FAC FINAL ASSEMBLY CODE

This parameter specifies the type approval code of the international


mobile equipment identity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SNR SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the serial number of the international mobile


equipment identity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: SINGLE SNR OR LOWER BOUND OF SNR RANGE=


6 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

This information unit specifies either a


single serial number or the lower bound
of a range of serial numbers.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IMEI- 1+


CAN IMEI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: UPPER BOUND OF SNR RANGE=


6 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

This information unit specifies the upper


bound of a range of serial numbers.

LIST EQUIPMENT LIST

This parameter specifies the equipment list of the EIR database.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

WHITE WHITE EQUIPMENT LIST


BLACK BLACK EQUIPMENT LIST
GREY GREY EQUIPMENT LIST

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IMEI- 2-


CR IMEI
BLACK
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE INTERNAT. MOBILE EQUIPMENT ID.

This command creates a single IMEI (International Mobile Equipment)


Identity) or range of IMEI’s on one of the three lists (white, grey,
black) of the Equipment Identity Register (EIR) database.

If the IMEI or range of IMEI’s is created on the grey or black list,


the reason has to be specified.

Notes:
- An IMEI consists of 15 digits : TAC-FAC-SNR-SPA
with TAC : type approval code ( 6 digits ),
FAC : final assembly code ( 2 digits ),
SNR : serial number ( 6 digits ),
SPA : spare ( 1 digit ).
No input parameter is defined for the spare digit.

- A range of IMEI’s consists of IMEI’s with fixed TAC, fixed FAC


and consecutive SNR’s.

- A single IMEI can only be created on a list if it is not yet


present on that list.

- A range of IMEI’s can only be created on a list if none


of the specified IMEI’s is present on that list.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if an equipment identification


register (EIR) is installed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR IMEI - BLACK BLACK LIST


2. CR IMEI - GREY GREY LIST
3. CR IMEI - WHITE WHITE LIST

1. Input format

BLACK LIST

A single IMEI or range of IMEI’s is created on the black list for


the following reasons:
- the equipment is illegal,
- the equipment is stolen,
- the equipment is faulty,
- ... .

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR IMEI : TAC= ,FAC= ,SNR= ,LIST= ,REASON= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TAC TYPE APPROVAL CODE

This parameter specifies the type approval code of the international


mobile equipment identity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

6 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

FAC FINAL ASSEMBLY CODE

This parameter specifies the final assembly code of the international


mobile equipment identity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IMEI- 1+
CR IMEI
BLACK
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SNR SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the serial number of the international mobile


equipment identity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: SINGLE IMEI OR LOWER BOUND OF SNR RANGE=


6 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

This information unit specifies either a


single serial number or the lower bound
of a range of serial numbers.

b: UPPER BOUND OF SNR RANGE=


6 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

This information unit specifies the upper


bound of a range of serial numbers.

LIST EQUIPMENT LIST

This parameter specifies the equipment list of the EIR database.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BLACK BLACK EQUIPMENT LIST

REASON REASON FOR BEING ON EQ. LIST

This parameter specifies the reason for being on the grey or black
equipment list.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FLTEQ FAULTY EQUIPMENT


ILLEQ ILLEGAL EQUIPMENT
REBLEQ04 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 4
REBLEQ05 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 5
REBLEQ06 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 6
REBLEQ07 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 7
REBLEQ08 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 8
REBLEQ09 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 9
REBLEQ10 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 10
REBLEQ11 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 11
REBLEQ12 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 12
REBLEQ13 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 13
REBLEQ14 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 14
REBLEQ15 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 15
REBLEQ16 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 16
STOLENEQ STOLEN EQUIPMENT

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IMEI- 2+
CR IMEI
GREY
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

GREY LIST

A single IMEI or range of IMEI’s is created on the grey list for


the following reasons:
- the equipment is new,
- the equipment is possibly faulty,
- the equipment is possibly illegal,
- the equipment is temporarily approved,
- the equipment is traceable,
- the equipment is in test,
- ... .

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR IMEI : TAC= ,FAC= ,SNR= ,LIST= ,REASON= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TAC TYPE APPROVAL CODE

This parameter specifies the type approval code of the international


mobile equipment identity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

6 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

FAC FINAL ASSEMBLY CODE

This parameter specifies the final assembly code of the international


mobile equipment identity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SNR SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the serial number of the international mobile


equipment identity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: SINGLE IMEI OR LOWER BOUND OF SNR RANGE=


6 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

This information unit specifies either a


single serial number or the lower bound
of a range of serial numbers.

b: UPPER BOUND OF SNR RANGE=


6 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

This information unit specifies the upper


bound of a range of serial numbers.

LIST EQUIPMENT LIST

This parameter specifies the equipment list of the EIR database.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

GREY GREY EQUIPMENT LIST

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IMEI- 3+
CR IMEI
GREY
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

REASON REASON FOR BEING ON EQ. LIST

This parameter specifies the reason for being on the grey or black
equipment list.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NEWEQ NEW EQUIPMENT


POSFLTEQ POSSIBLY FAULTY EQUIPMENT
POSILLEQ POSSIBLY ILLEGAL EQUIPMENT
REGREQ07 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 7
REGREQ08 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 8
REGREQ09 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 9
REGREQ10 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 10
REGREQ11 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 11
REGREQ12 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 12
REGREQ13 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 13
REGREQ14 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 14
REGREQ15 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 15
REGREQ16 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 16
TEMAPEQ TEMPORARILY APPROVED EQUIPMENT
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT
TRACEQ TRACEABLE EQUIPMENT

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IMEI- 4+
CR IMEI
WHITE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

WHITE LIST

A single IMEI or range of IMEI’s is created on the white list when the
equipment is approved.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR IMEI : TAC= ,FAC= ,SNR= ,LIST= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TAC TYPE APPROVAL CODE

This parameter specifies the type approval code of the international


mobile equipment identity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

6 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

FAC FINAL ASSEMBLY CODE

This parameter specifies the final assembly code of the international


mobile equipment identity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SNR SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the serial number of the international mobile


equipment identity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: SINGLE IMEI OR LOWER BOUND OF SNR RANGE=


6 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

This information unit specifies either a


single serial number or the lower bound
of a range of serial numbers.

b: UPPER BOUND OF SNR RANGE=


6 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

This information unit specifies the upper


bound of a range of serial numbers.

LIST EQUIPMENT LIST

This parameter specifies the equipment list of the EIR database.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

WHITE WHITE EQUIPMENT LIST

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IMEI- 5-
DISP IMEI
TFSPEC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY INTERNAT. MOBILE EQUIPMENT ID.

This command displays information related to all single IMEI’s


(International Mobile Equipment Identity) and/or all ranges of
IMEI’s, which satisfy the input criteria.

Single IMEI’s and ranges of IMEI’s are displayed as they were


previously created.

Notes:
- An IMEI consists of 15 digits : TAC-FAC-SNR-SPA
with TAC : type approval code ( 6 digits ),
FAC : final assembly code ( 2 digits ),
SNR : serial number ( 6 digits ),
SPA : spare ( 1 digit ).
No input parameter is defined for the spare digit.

- The information related to a single IMEI will be displayed when


the single IMEI either equals the specified IMEI, or when it is
contained in the specified range of IMEI’s.

- The information related to a range of IMEI’s is displayed when this


range contains the specified IMEI, or when it contains at least
one IMEI of the specified range.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if an equipment identification


register (EIR) is installed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP IMEI - TFSPEC TAC AND FAC(’S) SPECIFIED


2. DISP IMEI - TFSSPEC TAC, FAC AND SNR(’S) SPECIFIED
3. DISP IMEI - TSPEC TAC(’S) SPECIFIED

1. Input format

TAC AND FAC(’S) SPECIFIED

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,LIST= 1 1
1 DISP IMEI : TAC= ,FAC= Z,REASON=Y ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TAC TYPE APPROVAL CODE

This parameter specifies the type approval code of the international


mobile equipment identity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

6 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

FAC FINAL ASSEMBLY CODE

This parameter specifies the final assembly code of the international


mobile equipment identity.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

2 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IMEI- 1+


DISP IMEI
TFSPEC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

LIST EQUIPMENT LIST

This parameter specifies the equipment list of the EIR database.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BLACK BLACK EQUIPMENT LIST


GREY GREY EQUIPMENT LIST
WHITE WHITE EQUIPMENT LIST
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

REASON REASON FOR BEING ON EQ. LIST

This parameter specifies the reason for being on the grey or black
equipment list.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FLTEQ FAULTY EQUIPMENT


ILLEQ ILLEGAL EQUIPMENT
NEWEQ NEW EQUIPMENT
POSFLTEQ POSSIBLY FAULTY EQUIPMENT
POSILLEQ POSSIBLY ILLEGAL EQUIPMENT
REBLEQ04 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 4
REBLEQ05 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 5
REBLEQ06 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 6
REBLEQ07 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 7
REBLEQ08 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 8
REBLEQ09 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 9
REBLEQ10 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 10
REBLEQ11 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 11
REBLEQ12 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 12
REBLEQ13 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 13
REBLEQ14 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 14
REBLEQ15 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 15
REBLEQ16 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 16
REGREQ07 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 7
REGREQ08 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 8
REGREQ09 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 9
REGREQ10 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 10
REGREQ11 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 11
REGREQ12 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 12
REGREQ13 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 13
REGREQ14 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 14
REGREQ15 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 15
REGREQ16 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 16
STOLENEQ STOLEN EQUIPMENT
TEMAPEQ TEMPORARILY APPROVED EQUIPMENT
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT
TRACEQ TRACEABLE EQUIPMENT

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IMEI- 2+


DISP IMEI
TFSSPEC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

TAC, FAC AND SNR(’S) SPECIFIED

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,LIST= 1 1
1 DISP IMEI : TAC= ,FAC= ,SNR= Z,REASON=Y ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TAC TYPE APPROVAL CODE

This parameter specifies the type approval code of the international


mobile equipment identity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

6 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

FAC FINAL ASSEMBLY CODE

This parameter specifies the final assembly code of the international


mobile equipment identity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SNR SERIAL NUMBER

This parameter specifies the serial number of the international mobile


equipment identity.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: SINGLE SNR OR LOWER BOUND OF SNR RANGE=


6 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

This information unit specifies either a


single serial number or the lower bound
of a range of serial numbers.

b: UPPER BOUND OF SNR RANGE=


6 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

This information unit specifies the upper


bound of a range of serial numbers.

LIST EQUIPMENT LIST

This parameter specifies the equipment list of the EIR database.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BLACK BLACK EQUIPMENT LIST


GREY GREY EQUIPMENT LIST
WHITE WHITE EQUIPMENT LIST
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

REASON REASON FOR BEING ON EQ. LIST

This parameter specifies the reason for being on the grey or black
equipment list.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IMEI- 3+


DISP IMEI
TFSSPEC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FLTEQ FAULTY EQUIPMENT


ILLEQ ILLEGAL EQUIPMENT
NEWEQ NEW EQUIPMENT
POSFLTEQ POSSIBLY FAULTY EQUIPMENT
POSILLEQ POSSIBLY ILLEGAL EQUIPMENT
REBLEQ04 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 4
REBLEQ05 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 5
REBLEQ06 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 6
REBLEQ07 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 7
REBLEQ08 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 8
REBLEQ09 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 9
REBLEQ10 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 10
REBLEQ11 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 11
REBLEQ12 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 12
REBLEQ13 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 13
REBLEQ14 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 14
REBLEQ15 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 15
REBLEQ16 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 16
REGREQ07 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 7
REGREQ08 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 8
REGREQ09 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 9
REGREQ10 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 10
REGREQ11 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 11
REGREQ12 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 12
REGREQ13 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 13
REGREQ14 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 14
REGREQ15 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 15
REGREQ16 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 16
STOLENEQ STOLEN EQUIPMENT
TEMAPEQ TEMPORARILY APPROVED EQUIPMENT
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT
TRACEQ TRACEABLE EQUIPMENT

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IMEI- 4+


DISP IMEI
TSPEC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

TAC(’S) SPECIFIED

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,LIST= 1 1
1 DISP IMEI : TAC= Z,REASON=Y ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TAC TYPE APPROVAL CODE

This parameter specifies the type approval code of the international


mobile equipment identity.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

6 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LIST EQUIPMENT LIST

This parameter specifies the equipment list of the EIR database.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BLACK BLACK EQUIPMENT LIST


GREY GREY EQUIPMENT LIST
WHITE WHITE EQUIPMENT LIST
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

REASON REASON FOR BEING ON EQ. LIST

This parameter specifies the reason for being on the grey or black
equipment list.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FLTEQ FAULTY EQUIPMENT


ILLEQ ILLEGAL EQUIPMENT
NEWEQ NEW EQUIPMENT
POSFLTEQ POSSIBLY FAULTY EQUIPMENT
POSILLEQ POSSIBLY ILLEGAL EQUIPMENT
REBLEQ04 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 4
REBLEQ05 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 5
REBLEQ06 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 6
REBLEQ07 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 7
REBLEQ08 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 8
REBLEQ09 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 9
REBLEQ10 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 10
REBLEQ11 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 11
REBLEQ12 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 12
REBLEQ13 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 13
REBLEQ14 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 14
REBLEQ15 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 15
REBLEQ16 REASON BLACK EQUIPMENT 16
REGREQ07 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 7
REGREQ08 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 8
REGREQ09 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 9
REGREQ10 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 10
REGREQ11 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 11
REGREQ12 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 12
REGREQ13 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 13
REGREQ14 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 14
REGREQ15 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 15
REGREQ16 REASON GREY EQUIPMENT 16
STOLENEQ STOLEN EQUIPMENT

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IMEI- 5+


DISP IMEI
TSPEC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TEMAPEQ TEMPORARILY APPROVED EQUIPMENT


TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT
TRACEQ TRACEABLE EQUIPMENT

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IMEI- 6-


ACT IMSITRAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE IMSI TRACING

This command activates the IMSI tracing for a subscriber.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT IMSITRAC : MSIN= ,REF= ,TYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

REF TRACE REFERENCE NUMBER

This parameter specifies a reference to a trace job.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...32767, range of decimal numbers

TYPE TRACE TYPE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CSMSNORM CALLS INCL. SMS NORMAL TRACE


CSMSPRIO CALLS INCL. SMS PRIORITY TRACE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IMSITRAC- 1-


DACT IMSITRAC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE IMSI TRACING

This command deactivates the IMSI tracing for a subscriber.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DACT IMSITRAC : MSIN= ,REF= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

MSIN MSUB IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

MSIN a: 10 Digits

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit decimal number

REF TRACE REFERENCE NUMBER

This parameter specifies a reference to a trace job.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...32767, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT IMSITRAC- 1-


CAN INAUTH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL IN AUTHORIZATION

This command removes the IN authorization for a subscriber identified


by its A-number id (ANI long form, ANI short form), B-number id (BNI)
or by a specific authentication code id (ACI).

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1ANI=1 1
1 1ANS=1 (;) 1
1 CAN INAUTH : ZACI=Y Z Y 1
1 1BNI=1 *!+ 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ANI A-NUMBER ID

This parameter specifies the A-number identification of the


subscriber for which the IN authorization must be removed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...24 digit decimal number

ANS A-NUMBER ID SHORT

This parameter specifies the A-number identification in short form


of the subscriber for which the IN authorization must be removed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...24 digit decimal number

ACI AUTHENTICATION CODE ID

This parameter specifies the authentication code (= personal


identification number) of the subscriber for which the IN
authorization must be removed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...24 digit decimal number

BNI B-NUMBER ID

This parameter specifies the B-number identification of the


subscriber for which the IN authorization must be removed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...24 digit decimal number

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INAUTH- 1-


CR INAUTH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE IN AUTHORIZATION

This command is used to give a subscriber identified by its number id


(ANI long form/ANS short form/BNI) or by a specific authentication
code id (ACI), the authorization to make use of an IN service specified
by the parameter PRID.

In case that the subscriber identified by ANI/ANS/BNI or ACI is a transit


exchange subscriber (TXS), this command is also used to identify the TXS
feature data.
Notice that TXS features are realized as "integrated service logic (ISL)
services".

Prerequisites:
- The trigger profile referenced by the parameter PRID must have been
created by the command CR INTRIG.
- The service class mark referenced by the parameter SCMID must have
been created by the command CR INSCM.
- For transit exchange subscribers, the TXS profile referenced by the
parameter TXSPROF must have been created by the command CR SUB (with
CAT=TXS).

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1ANI=1 1
1 1ANS=1 (;) 1
1 CR INAUTH : ZACI=Y [,PRID= ,SCMID=] [,TXSPROF=] Z Y 1
1 1BNI=1 *!+ 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ANI A-NUMBER ID

This parameter specifies the A-number identification of the


subscriber for which IN authorization is given.
At least TXSPROF or the combination of SCMID and PRID
must be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...24 digit decimal number

ANS A-NUMBER ID SHORT

This parameter specifies the A-number identification of the


subscriber for which IN authorization is given in a short form.
At least TXSPROF or the combination of SCMID and PRID
must be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...24 digit decimal number

ACI AUTHENTICATION CODE ID

This parameter specifies the authentication code (= personal


identification number) of the subscriber for which IN
authorization is given.
At least TXSPROF or the combination of SCMID and PRID
must be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...24 digit decimal number

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INAUTH- 1+
CR INAUTH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

BNI B-NUMBER ID

This parameter specifies the B-number identification of the


subscriber for which IN authorization is given.
Parameters PRID and SCMID are mandatory.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...24 digit decimal number

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile


which is used for the IN service for which authorization
is given.
This parameter is mandatory for BNI.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the corresponding IN


service class mark which is used for the triggering of the
subscriber calls.
This parameter is mandatory for BNI.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TXSPROF TXS PROFILE

This parameter specifies the virtual subscriber that contains


the TXS feature data.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LOCAL AREA CODE=


1...6 digit decimal number

b: DIRECTORY NUMBER=
1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INAUTH- 2-
DISP INAUTH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IN AUTHORIZATION

This command is used to display the IN authorization data of a subscriber


identified by its number id (ANI long form/ANS short form/BNI) or by
a specific authentication code id (ACI).

For transit exchange subscribers (TXS), this command can also be used to
display the corresponding TXS profile.

Prerequisites:
- The trigger profile referenced by the parameter PRID must have been created
by the command CR INTRIG.
- The service class mark referenced by the parameter SCMID must have been
created by the command CR INSCM.
- For transit exchange subscribers, the TXS profile referenced by the
parameter TXSPROF must have been created by the command CR SUB (with
CAT=TXS).

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1ANI=1 1
1 1ANS=1 1
1 DISP INAUTH : ZACI=Y [,PRID=] [,SCMID=] [,TXSPROF=] ; 1
1 1BNI=1 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ANI A-NUMBER ID

This parameter specifies the A-number identification of the


subscriber for which the IN authorization data must be displayed.

Note:
- The ANI can either be a partly defined number (starting digits) or
a complete number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit decimal number

ANS A-NUMBER ID

This parameter specifies the short form of A-number identification


of the subscriber for which the IN authorization data must be
displayed.

Note:
- The ANI can either be a partly defined number (starting digits) or
a complete number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit decimal number

ACI AUTHENTICATION CODE ID

This parameter specifies the authentication code (= personal


identification number) of the subscriber for which the IN

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INAUTH- 1+


DISP INAUTH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

authorization data must be displayed.

Note:
- The ACI can either be a partly defined number (starting digits) or
a complete number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit decimal number

BNI B-NUMBER ID

This parameter specifies the B-number identification of the


subscriber for which the IN authorization data must be displayed.

Note:
- The BNI can either be a partly defined number (starting digits) or
a complete number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...24 digit decimal number

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the IN trigger profile to be


used as a selection criterion for the display.
Only the IN authorization entries (ANI/ANS/ACI/BNI) with
the specified IN service will be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the IN service class mark to be


used as a selection criterion for the display.
Only the IN authorization entries (ANI/ANS/ACI/BNI) with
the specified IN service class mark will be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TXSPROF TXS PROFILE

This parameter specifies the TXS profile to be used as a selection


criterion for the display.
Only the IN authorization entries (ANI/ANS/ACI/BNI) with
the specified TXS profile will be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LOCAL AREA CODE=


1...6 digit decimal number

b: DIRECTORY NUMBER=
1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INAUTH- 2-


MOD INAUTH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY IN AUTHORIZATION

This command modifies the IN authorization data for a subscriber


identified by its number id (ANI long form/ANS short form/BNI)
or by a specific authentication code id (ACI).

Prerequisites:
- The new trigger profile referenced by the parameter PRID must have
been created by the command CR INTRIG.
- The new service class mark referenced by the parameter SCMID must have
been created by the command CR INSCM.
- For transit exchange subscribers, the new TXS profile referenced by
the parameter TXSPROF must have been created by the command CR SUB
(with CAT=TXS).

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1ANI=1 1
1 1ANS=1 1
1 MOD INAUTH : ZACI=Y <,PRID= ,SCMID= ,TXSPROF= ,CTXSPROF= 1
1 1BNI=1 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,CSCMID=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ANI A-NUMBER ID

This parameter specifies the A-number identification of the


subscriber for which the IN authorization data must be
modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...24 digit decimal number

ANS A-NUMBER ID

This parameter specifies the short form of A-number identification


of the subscriber for which the IN authorization data must be
modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...24 digit decimal number

ACI AUTHENTICATION CODE ID

This parameter specifies the authentication code (= personal


identification number) of the subscriber for which the IN
authorization data must be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...24 digit decimal number

BNI B-NUMBER ID

This parameter specifies the B-number identification of the


subscriber for which the IN authorization data must be
modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INAUTH- 1+


MOD INAUTH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2...24 digit decimal number

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the new trigger profile


which is used for the IN service for which authorization is
given.
When the PRID is newly added, the SCMID must also be entered.

Incompatibilities:
- Cannot be entered together with CSCMID.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the new corresponding IN


service class mark which is used for the triggering of the
subscriber calls.
When the SCMID is newly added, the PRID must also be entered.

Incompatibilities:
- Cannot be entered together with CSCMID.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TXSPROF TXS PROFILE

This parameter specifies the virtual subscriber that contains


the new TXS feature data.

Incompatibilities:
- CTXSPROF may not have been entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LOCAL AREA CODE=


1...6 digit decimal number

b: DIRECTORY NUMBER=
1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CTXSPROF CANCEL TXS PROFILE

This parameter specifies if the TXS profile must be removed for


the subscriber or not.

Incompatibilities:
- TXSPROF may not have been entered.
- for ANI or ACI only allowed when PRID and SCMID exist.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N TXS PROFILE REMAINS UNCHANGED


NO TXS PROFILE REMAINS UNCHANGED
Y CANCEL TXS PROFILE
YES CANCEL TXS PROFILE

Default: N

CSCMID CANCEL SCMID

When CSCMID is entered, the PRID is also cancelled.

Incompatibilities:
- Cannot be entered together with SCMID or PRID

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INAUTH- 2+


MOD INAUTH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- Cannot be entered together with BNI


- for ANI or ACI only allowed when TXSPROF exists.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N SCMID & PRID REMAIN UNCHANGED


NO SCMID & PRID REMAIN UNCHANGED
Y SCMID & PRID ARE CANCELLED
YES SCMID & PRID ARE CANCELLED

Default: N

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INAUTH- 3-


CAN INC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL INTERCEPT

This command cancels the data entered for the specified intercept identification
and applies an intercept tone coded in the GP if the intercept is accessed by
call processing.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN INC : INCEPT= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

INCEPT INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the intercept code for which the data are to
be canceled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION
ANNPDIAL ANN. PRIOR TO DIAL TONE
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
MWI MESSAGE WAITING INDICATION
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
OCUB OUTGOING CALLS BARRED IN CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
SCLSTO REJECT BY SCREENING LIST ORIG.
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
TXSCASU TXS CASUAL USER
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
OACSU D900 OFF AIR CALL SETUP
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
CREDLIMS CREDIT LIMIT SUPERVISION
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
CCBSMOB CALL COMPL. TO BUSY SUB. (NAT)
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
NOSERV SERVICE NOT AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
CHANGEDN CHANGED DIRECTORY NUMBER
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
UNOBDN DIRECTORY NUMBER UNOBTAINABLE
This value belongs to INTYP = TERM.
ICUB INCOMING CALLS BARRED IN CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
MOBSUBAB MOBILE SUBSCRIBER ABSENT
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
SCLSTT REJECT BY SCREENING LIST TERM.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
REJDIV REJECTION OF DIVERTED CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
ACREJ ANONYMOUS CALL REJECTION
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
BUSYNFEA BUSY NO FEATURE ANNOUNCEMENT
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
UNOBDE0 VACANT CODE
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE1 VACANT CODE NO OPERATOR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE2 VACANT CODE WITH OPERATOR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE3 NO WORKING EMERGENCY
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE4 PREFIX ONE NOT DIALED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE5 PREFIX ZERO NOT DIALED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INC- 1+


CAN INC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

UNOBDE6 PREFIX ONE IN ERROR


This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE7 PREFIX ZERO NOT ALLOWED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE8 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 08
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE9 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 09
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE10 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 10
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE11 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 11
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNALLROU UNALLOCATED ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
ILLDEST INCOMPATIBLE CALL DESTINATION
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE12 SCREENED INTERCEPT
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE13 PARTIAL DIAL
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
ANNARDN ANNOUNCEMENT AUTO RECALL DN
SWUPWEEK SHIFT WAKE UP WEEKLY
PINERR PIN INPUT ERROR
SCLIMACC SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT ACCEPT
SCLIMERR SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT ERROR
SCLIMINF SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT INFO
KONSUC KICK-OUT NUMBER SUCCESSFUL
KONUNSUC KICK-OUT NUMBER UNSUCCESSFUL
CCSOPR COLLECT CALL SCREENING OPR.
SVIOPR SERVICE INTERCEPTION OPERATOR
NOROUTE UNALLOCATED ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
NOALTROU NO ALTERNATE ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
ALLROUBA ALL ROUTES BARRED
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
ANIFLIST ANI FAILURE LIST
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
BLOCKLST BLOCKED BY LIST
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
BLKWINFO BLOCKING WITH INFORMATION
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
CALLREJ CALL REJECTED
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
CAUSE1 CAUSE 1
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
USNRESP NO USER RESPONDING
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
PROTERR PROTOCOL ERROR
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
SUSCI SERVICE USER FOR SCI
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
SUSCICTX SERVICE USER FOR SCI CTX
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
LOOPTMC LOOP TRUNK MONITORING CENTER
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
INI1TR6 IN INTERWORKING WITH 1TR6
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
FCOFFUI FCOFF USER INTERACTION
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
SUSVICCS SERVICE USER FOR SVI & CCS
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
LOOPCIDR LOOP CALL IDENTIFICATION REC.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
I1TR6IN INTERWORKING 1TR6 TO IN
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
ISUPLOOP ISUP LOOP
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
MOBMLOOP MOBILE MONITORING LOOP
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
CACNEXEC CAC NOT EXECUTING
CACNAUTH CAC NOT AUTHORIZED
BLOTRA0 BLOCKAGE TRAFFIC TYPE 0
RCFNRNET NO ROUTE TO SPEC NETWORK
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFPREEM PREEMPTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INC- 2+


CAN INC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RCFFACRJ FACILITY REJECTED


This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNCHAV NO CHANNEL AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFTMPFA TEMPORARY FAILURE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFSWEQC SWITCHING EQUIPMENT CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRCHNA REQUESTED CHANNEL NOT AVAIL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFPRBLO PRECEDENCE CALL BLOCKED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRUNAV RESOURCE UNAVAILABLE UNSPEC
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRFNSB REQ FACILITY NOT SUBSCRIBED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFBCNIM BC NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRFNIM REQ FAC NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFSVNIM SERVICE NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNMCUG USER NOT MEMBER OF CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFCTLEX CONV TIME LIMIT EXPIRED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRALOS RADIO LINK LOSS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFABSUB ABSENT SUBSCRIBER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFALNAN ALERTING NO ANSWER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB1 INVALID NUMBER FORMAT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB2 DIGITS NOT RECEIVED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB3 DIGIT TIMEOUT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRACON NO RADIO RESOURCE AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
PRIOQ PRIORITY QUEUEING
ANNQINFO ANN. OF QUEUE INFORMATION
SNA0 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 0
SNA1 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 1
SNA2 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 2
SNA3 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 3
SNA4 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 4
OVL1 OVERLOAD SITUATION 1
OVL2 OVERLOAD SITUATION 2
OVL3 OVERLOAD SITUATION 3
OVL4 OVERLOAD SITUATION 4
INV1 INVALID VOTE 1
INV2 INVALID VOTE 2
INANIF IN ANI FAILURE
IACB INTERNATIONAL AUTOM CALLBACK
ANN INTELLIGENT NETWORK ANNOUNCEM.
Unit b is required.
MOTFC1 CALL SETUP CONTROL 1
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC2 CALL SETUP CONTROL 2
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBIC ODB. OUTGOING INTERNAT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBIE ODB. OG. INT. CALLS EXC. HPLMN
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBPI ODB. OG. PREM. RATE INF. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBPE ODB. OG. PREM. RATE ENT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTADBAR MOB. ORIG. TRAF. ADMIN. BAR.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOTAIC MOB. ORIG. TRAF. ADMIN. INC.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC3 CALL SETUP CONTROL 3
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC4 CALL SETUP CONTROL 4
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INC- 3+


CAN INC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MOTFC5 CALL SETUP CONTROL 5


This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB1 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 1
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB2 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 2
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB3 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 3
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB4 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 4
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MTTABSUB MOB. TERM. TRAF. ABSENT SUB.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTNOPAG MOB. TERM. TRAF. NO PAG. RESP.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTSUBNC MOB. TERM. TRAF. SUB. NUM. CH.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTUNSUB MOB. TERM. TRAF. UNKNOWN SUB.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTADBAR MOB. TERM. TRAF. ADMIN. BAR.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTINDIA MOB. TERM. TRAF. INCOMP. DIAL.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
CFWUNCO CALL FORW. UNCONDITIONAL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNDUB CALL FORW. NET. DET. USER BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWUDUB CALL FORW. USER DET. USER BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNOREP CALL FORW. NO REPLY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNOPAG CALL FORW. NO PAGING RESPONSE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWRADCO CALL FORW. RADIO CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWVIOLA CALL FORW. FORWARD VIOLATION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWIMDET CALL FORW. IMSI DETACH
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBBUSY CALL BACK ON BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBNOREP CALL BACK ON NO REPLY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBNOPAG CALL BACK ON NO PAGING RESP
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBRADCO CALL BACK ON RADIO CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBIMDET CALL BACK ON IMSI DETACH
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
BAOC BARRING OF ALL OUTGOING CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOIC BARRING OF ALL OUT. INT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOCEXHP BAR. OF OUTG. CALLS EXC. HPLMN
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAIC BARRING OF ALL INCOMING CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
MOBQUEUE MOBILE CALL QUEUED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
SANNCW SERVICE ANNOUNCE. CALL WAITING
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
SANNCH SERVICE ANNOUNCEMENT CALL HOLD
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYINV MULTI PARTY INVOCATION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYEXT MULTI PARTY EXTENSION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYEALL MULTI PARTY EXTENSION ALL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYEIND MULTI PARTY EXTENSION INDIVID.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYHOLD MULTI PARTY ON HOLD
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MAPSYSFA SYSTEM FAILURE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPDATMI DATA MISSING
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INC- 4+


CAN INC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MAPUNDAT UNEXPECTED DATA VALUE


This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPFACNT FACILITY NOT SUPPORTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPUNSUB UNIDENTIFIED SUBSCRIBER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPBSNPR BS NOT PROVISIONED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPTSNPR TS NOT PROVISIONED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPRACON NO RADIO RESOURCE AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPCUGR CUG REJECT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPSNCUG SUBSCRIBER NOT MEMBER CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPIBCUG INCOMING CALLS BARRED CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPOBCUG OUTGOING CALLS BARRED CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC

b: ADDITIONAL NUMERIC VALUE=


0...250, range of decimal numbers

Compatibilities:
For ANN only value 1..127 is permitted.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INC- 5-


CR INC
IGNORE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE INTERCEPT

This command defines how a call is to be handled if call processing diverts it


to an intercept code.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR INC - IGNORE IGNORE INTERCEPT REASON


2. CR INC - NEWCB1NL NEW CODE B1 NUMBER NO LAC
3. CR INC - NEWCODE ANNOUNCEMENT VIA NEW CODE
4. CR INC - NEWDEST RESOURCES VIA DESTINATION
5. CR INC - TONE SUPPLY WITH A TONE

1. Input format

IGNORE INTERCEPT REASON

Input format for creating an intercept code which, when accessed, causes
the originally required connection to be set up after all.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR INC : INCEPT= ,INRES= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

INCEPT INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the intercept code for which data are to
be created.
This parameter is subdivided into functional blocks.
This subdivision is explained in parameter INTYP
of the command DISP INC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION
ACREJ ANONYMOUS CALL REJECTION
If an A-party has the feature CLIR (see CR SUB)
and the B-party has the feature ACTACREJ (see
CR SUB), the call will be rejected. The A-party
will be informed about this by the intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
ALLROUBA ALL ROUTES BARRED
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
ANIFLIST ANI FAILURE LIST
If an office-specific Whitelist or Blacklist
feature is active and the number of the A-party
is not available, the call will be rejected. The
A-party is informed about this with this
intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
ANN INTELLIGENT NETWORK ANNOUNCEM.
Unit b is required.
Sequencing is not allowed.
ANNARDN ANNOUNCEMENT AUTO RECALL DN
When a B-party has the automatic recall feature
and does not answer an incoming call or is busy,
the number of the A-party is stored by the system.
The B-party can initiate a recall by keying in
an access code. The B-party is informed by this
intercept about the stored A-party number.
ANNPDIAL ANN. PRIOR TO DIAL TONE
When going off hook, the A-party will get an
announcement before the dial tone is applied.
The intercept is used to address the announcement

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 1+
CR INC
IGNORE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

machine (UI-LTG).
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
ANNQINFO ANN. OF QUEUE INFORMATION
Sequencing is not allowed.
BAIC BARRING OF ALL INCOMING CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOC BARRING OF ALL OUTGOING CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOCEXHP BAR. OF OUTG. CALLS EXC. HPLMN
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOIC BARRING OF ALL OUT. INT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BLKWINFO BLOCKING WITH INFORMATION
An A party that has been blocked by "Hacker
Detection" will be informed by the intercept
that access is denied.
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
BLOCKLST BLOCKED BY LIST
Incoming calls are checked against an office-
specific Blacklist or Whitelist. If the A-party
number is in the Blacklist or missing in the
Whitelist, the call will be rejected. The A-party
is then informed about this via this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
BLOTRA0 BLOCKAGE TRAFFIC TYPE 0
BUSYNFEA BUSY NO FEATURE ANNOUNCEMENT
When the B-party is busy and the station is not
equipped for call-waiting or preemption, the
A-party is informed accordingly by the intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
CACNAUTH CAC NOT AUTHORIZED
If an A-party is not authorized to dial a carrier
access code, the call will be rejected. The system
reaction for the A-party is administered with this
intercept.
CACNEXEC CAC NOT EXECUTING
When an A-party dials a number with a carrier
access code, but access to the destination via
this carrier is not possible or allowed, either
the carrier access code for routing may be ignored
or the call may be rejected.
If the call is to be rejected, the appropriate
system reaction for A-party handling is
administered with this intercept.
CALLREJ CALL REJECTED
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
CAUSE1 CAUSE 1
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
CBBUSY CALL BACK ON BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBIMDET CALL BACK ON IMSI DETACH
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBNOPAG CALL BACK ON NO PAGING RESP
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBNOREP CALL BACK ON NO REPLY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBRADCO CALL BACK ON RADIO CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CCBSMOB CALL COMPL. TO BUSY SUB. (NAT)
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
CCSOPR COLLECT CALL SCREENING OPR.
This intercept is used to redirect a call from
the service user to a ACTCCS Operator (see
CR SUB). The intercept SUSVICCS must also be
created to enable addressing of the service user.
Sequencing is not allowed.
CFWIMDET CALL FORW. IMSI DETACH
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNDUB CALL FORW. NET. DET. USER BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNOPAG CALL FORW. NO PAGING RESPONSE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNOREP CALL FORW. NO REPLY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWRADCO CALL FORW. RADIO CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWUDUB CALL FORW. USER DET. USER BUSY

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 2+
CR INC
IGNORE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD


CFWUNCO CALL FORW. UNCONDITIONAL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWVIOLA CALL FORW. FORWARD VIOLATION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CHANGEDN CHANGED DIRECTORY NUMBER
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
Sequencing is not allowed.
CREDLIMS CREDIT LIMIT SUPERVISION
An A-party with the Credit Limit Supervision
feature who wants to set up a call, will first get
an announcement and afterwards the dialtone
depending on the status of his account. This
announcement can be a warning (credit limit almost
reached) or a blocking (credit limit reached)
announcement. This intercept is used to address
the announcement machine (UI-LTG).
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
FCOFFUI FCOFF USER INTERACTION
This intercept is used to redirect a call from
the service user to a UI-LTG for user interaction.
At least one of the intercepts SUSCI or SUSCICTX
must also be created to address the service user.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
IACB INTERNATIONAL AUTOM CALLBACK
Sequencing is not allowed.
ICUB INCOMING CALLS BARRED IN CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
ILLDEST INCOMPATIBLE CALL DESTINATION
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
INANIF IN ANI FAILURE
Sequencing is not allowed.
INI1TR6 IN INTERWORKING WITH 1TR6
If an IN call wants to reach a 1TR6-subscriber,
a SW-loop is required. This loop is addressed via
this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWCB1.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
INV1 INVALID VOTE 1
Sequencing is not allowed.
INV2 INVALID VOTE 2
Sequencing is not allowed.
ISUPLOOP ISUP LOOP
If ISUP is not recognized on the A-side the
ISUP HW loop will be initiated via this
intercept before the remote intercom number
is code processed.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWCB1.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
I1TR6IN INTERWORKING 1TR6 TO IN
As an 1TR6 subscriber is not able to handle IN, a
SW-loop is required. This loop is addressed via
this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should only be combined with
INRES=NEWCB1.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
KONSUC KICK-OUT NUMBER SUCCESSFUL
This intercept leads to an announcement after
storing of an undesirable A-party number to the
Kick-Out list was successful.
KONUNSUC KICK-OUT NUMBER UNSUCCESSFUL
This intercept leads to an announcement after
storing of an undesirable A-party number to the
Kick-Out list was not successful.
LOOPCIDR LOOP CALL IDENTIFICATION REC.
This intercept is used to address a loop-LTG for
the call identification recording feature (see
CR SUB). This feature enables the recording of

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 3+
CR INC
IGNORE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

malicious call data.


This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
LOOPTMC LOOP TRUNK MONITORING CENTER
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWDEST.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
MAPBSNPR BS NOT PROVISIONED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPCUGR CUG REJECT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPDATMI DATA MISSING
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPFACNT FACILITY NOT SUPPORTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPIBCUG INCOMING CALLS BARRED CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPOBCUG OUTGOING CALLS BARRED CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPRACON NO RADIO RESOURCE AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPSNCUG SUBSCRIBER NOT MEMBER CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPSYSFA SYSTEM FAILURE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPTSNPR TS NOT PROVISIONED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPUNDAT UNEXPECTED DATA VALUE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPUNSUB UNIDENTIFIED SUBSCRIBER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MOBMLOOP MOBILE MONITORING LOOP
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
MOBQUEUE MOBILE CALL QUEUED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MOTADBAR MOB. ORIG. TRAF. ADMIN. BAR.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC1 CALL SETUP CONTROL 1
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC2 CALL SETUP CONTROL 2
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC3 CALL SETUP CONTROL 3
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC4 CALL SETUP CONTROL 4
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC5 CALL SETUP CONTROL 5
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBIC ODB. OUTGOING INTERNAT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBIE ODB. OG. INT. CALLS EXC. HPLMN
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBPE ODB. OG. PREM. RATE ENT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBPI ODB. OG. PREM. RATE INF. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB1 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 1
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB2 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 2
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB3 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 3
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB4 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 4
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOTAIC MOB. ORIG. TRAF. ADMIN. INC.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MPTYEALL MULTI PARTY EXTENSION ALL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYEIND MULTI PARTY EXTENSION INDIVID.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYEXT MULTI PARTY EXTENSION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYHOLD MULTI PARTY ON HOLD

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 4+
CR INC
IGNORE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN


MPTYINV MULTI PARTY INVOCATION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MTTABSUB MOB. TERM. TRAF. ABSENT SUB.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTADBAR MOB. TERM. TRAF. ADMIN. BAR.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTINDIA MOB. TERM. TRAF. INCOMP. DIAL.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTNOPAG MOB. TERM. TRAF. NO PAG. RESP.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTSUBNC MOB. TERM. TRAF. SUB. NUM. CH.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTUNSUB MOB. TERM. TRAF. UNKNOWN SUB.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MWI MESSAGE WAITING INDICATION
If an A-party has the feature MWI (see CR SUB),
the A-party is informed by this intercept about
messages in the mailbox.
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
NOALTROU NO ALTERNATE ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
NOROUTE UNALLOCATED ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
NOSERV SERVICE NOT AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
OACSU D900 OFF AIR CALL SETUP
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
OCUB OUTGOING CALLS BARRED IN CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
OVL1 OVERLOAD SITUATION 1
Sequencing is not allowed.
OVL2 OVERLOAD SITUATION 2
Sequencing is not allowed.
OVL3 OVERLOAD SITUATION 3
Sequencing is not allowed.
OVL4 OVERLOAD SITUATION 4
Sequencing is not allowed.
PINERR PIN INPUT ERROR
This intercept is used to warn the subscriber
that the PIN Code entered is wrong.
PRIOQ PRIORITY QUEUEING
If a priority A-party wants to make a call and all
trunks are busy, the call will be queued in a
priority queue. The A-party is informed about this
by the intercept.
PROTERR PROTOCOL ERROR
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
RCFABSUB ABSENT SUBSCRIBER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFALNAN ALERTING NO ANSWER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFBCNIM BC NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFCTLEX CONV TIME LIMIT EXPIRED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFFACRJ FACILITY REJECTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNCHAV NO CHANNEL AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNMCUG USER NOT MEMBER OF CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNRNET NO ROUTE TO SPEC NETWORK
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFPRBLO PRECEDENCE CALL BLOCKED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFPREEM PREEMPTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRACON NO RADIO RESOURCE AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRALOS RADIO LINK LOSS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRCHNA REQUESTED CHANNEL NOT AVAIL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRFNIM REQ FAC NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRFNSB REQ FACILITY NOT SUBSCRIBED

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 5+
CR INC
IGNORE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC


RCFRUNAV RESOURCE UNAVAILABLE UNSPEC
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFSVNIM SERVICE NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFSWEQC SWITCHING EQUIPMENT CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFTMPFA TEMPORARY FAILURE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB1 INVALID NUMBER FORMAT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB2 DIGITS NOT RECEIVED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB3 DIGIT TIMEOUT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
REJDIV REJECTION OF DIVERTED CALLS
When a call is forwarded, the B2-party may have
the feature ACTRJDIV (see CR SUB), which means
that the B2-subscriber does not accept forwarded
calls. The A-party will be informed about this by
the intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
SANNCH SERVICE ANNOUNCEMENT CALL HOLD
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
SANNCW SERVICE ANNOUNCE. CALL WAITING
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
SCLIMACC SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT ACCEPT
This intercept leads to an announcement to
confirm that entry of the new subscriber
credit limit has been successful.
SCLIMERR SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT ERROR
This intercept leads to an announcement saying
that entry of the new subscriber credit limit
has failed.
SCLIMINF SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT INFO
This intercept leads to an announcement to inform
the subscriber about the current subscriber credit
limit.
SCLSTO REJECT BY SCREENING LIST ORIG.
If an A-party has the feature SCOACC (Selective
Call Acceptance) or SCOREJ (Selective Call
Rejection), an outgoing call is checked as to
whether the called number is in the Blacklist
or not present in the Whitelist. If so, the call
is rejected. The A-party is then informed
accordingly by this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
SCLSTT REJECT BY SCREENING LIST TERM.
If a B-party has the feature SCTACC (Selective
Call Acceptance) or SCTREJ (Selective Call
Rejection), an incoming call will be checked. If
the A-party number is in the Blacklist or not in
the Whitelist, the call will be rejected. The
A-party is then informed accordingly.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
SNA0 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 0
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA1 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 1
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA2 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 2
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA3 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 3
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA4 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 4
Sequencing is not allowed.
SUSCI SERVICE USER FOR SCI
For help on subscriber controlled input, this
intercept is used to redirect an ordinary
subscriber to the service user for SCI.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SUSCICTX SERVICE USER FOR SCI CTX
For help on subscriber controlled input, this
intercept is used to redirect a CENTREX subscriber
to the service user for SCI.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 6+
CR INC
IGNORE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SUSVICCS SERVICE USER FOR SVI & CCS


This intercept is used to redirect an A-party to
a service user if the B-party has the feature
SVI (SERVICE INTERCEPTION) or ACTCCS (COLLECT
CALL SCREENING) (see CR SUB).
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SVIOPR SERVICE INTERCEPTION OPERATOR
This intercept is used to redirect a call from
the service user to an SVI Operator (see CR SUB).
The intercept SUSVICCS must also be created to
enable addressing of the service user.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SWUPWEEK SHIFT WAKE UP WEEKLY
If no resources are available for the requested
time interval, the weekly wakeup request is
shifted to the previous interval. The subscriber
is informed about this by the intercept.
TXSCASU TXS CASUAL USER
If an A-party number is not in the IN
Authorization Database, this non-registered caller
is routed to an operator or to an announcement via
this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
UNALLROU UNALLOCATED ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE0 VACANT CODE
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE1 VACANT CODE NO OPERATOR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE10 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 10
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE11 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 11
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE12 SCREENED INTERCEPT
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE13 PARTIAL DIAL
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE2 VACANT CODE WITH OPERATOR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE3 NO WORKING EMERGENCY
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE4 PREFIX ONE NOT DIALED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE5 PREFIX ZERO NOT DIALED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE6 PREFIX ONE IN ERROR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE7 PREFIX ZERO NOT ALLOWED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE8 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 08
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE9 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 09
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDN DIRECTORY NUMBER UNOBTAINABLE
This value belongs to INTYP = TERM.

b: ADDITIONAL NUMERIC VALUE=


0...250, range of decimal numbers

Compatibilities:
For ANN only value 1..127 is permitted.

INRES INTERCEPT ADDITIONAL RESULT

This parameter specifies the response which is to be triggered when


the intercept code is accessed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IGNORE IGNORE REASON FOR TERMINATION

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 7+
CR INC
NEWCB1NL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

NEW CODE B1 NUMBER NO LAC

Input format to create an intercept code via which the digit translator is
re-accessed. Only the dialled number will be sent. (The Local Area Code will
not be appended to the number if it was not dialled by the subscriber.)
An intercept code of this type serves to access an announcement or an operator.

To hear an announcement the following actions (MML-commands) are necessary:


(For the complete command syntax see the corresponding CML.)

- Create a standard destination


CR DEST:DEST=<ANNOU1>,...
- Create an announcement group
CR ANGRP:TGNO=<A001>,...
- Create (an) announcement line(s)
CR ANLN:TGNO=<A001>,...
- Create a route to the announcement device
CR ROUTE:DEST=<ANNOU1>,TGNO=<A001>,...
- Create a code point
CR CPT:CODE=<123456789>,DEST=<ANNOU1>,...
- Create a zone point (for announcements that can be dialled directly too)
CR ZOPT:CODE=<123456789>,ZOCHA=NOPULSE,...
- Create an intercept
CR INC:INCEPT=<########>,INRES=NEWCB1NL,CODE=<123456789>;

To access an operator the following actions (MML-commands) are necessary:


(For the complete command syntax see the corresponding CML.)

- Create an intercept (with the common service group number)


CR INC:INCEPT=<########>,INRES=NEWCB1NL,CODE=<012345>;
- Create an intercept (with the calltype number)
CR INC:INCEPT=<########>,INRES=NEWCB1NL,CODE=<016789>;

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR INC : INCEPT= ,INRES= ,CODE= [,TONE=] [,SEQ=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

INCEPT INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the intercept code for which data are to
be created.
This parameter is subdivided into functional blocks.
This subdivision is explained in parameter INTYP
of the command DISP INC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION
ACREJ ANONYMOUS CALL REJECTION
If an A-party has the feature CLIR (see CR SUB)
and the B-party has the feature ACTACREJ (see
CR SUB), the call will be rejected. The A-party
will be informed about this by the intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
ALLROUBA ALL ROUTES BARRED
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
ANIFLIST ANI FAILURE LIST
If an office-specific Whitelist or Blacklist
feature is active and the number of the A-party
is not available, the call will be rejected. The
A-party is informed about this with this
intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
ANN INTELLIGENT NETWORK ANNOUNCEM.
Unit b is required.
Sequencing is not allowed.
ANNARDN ANNOUNCEMENT AUTO RECALL DN

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 8+
CR INC
NEWCB1NL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

When a B-party has the automatic recall feature


and does not answer an incoming call or is busy,
the number of the A-party is stored by the system.
The B-party can initiate a recall by keying in
an access code. The B-party is informed by this
intercept about the stored A-party number.
ANNPDIAL ANN. PRIOR TO DIAL TONE
When going off hook, the A-party will get an
announcement before the dial tone is applied.
The intercept is used to address the announcement
machine (UI-LTG).
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
ANNQINFO ANN. OF QUEUE INFORMATION
Sequencing is not allowed.
BAIC BARRING OF ALL INCOMING CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOC BARRING OF ALL OUTGOING CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOCEXHP BAR. OF OUTG. CALLS EXC. HPLMN
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOIC BARRING OF ALL OUT. INT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BLKWINFO BLOCKING WITH INFORMATION
An A party that has been blocked by "Hacker
Detection" will be informed by the intercept
that access is denied.
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
BLOCKLST BLOCKED BY LIST
Incoming calls are checked against an office-
specific Blacklist or Whitelist. If the A-party
number is in the Blacklist or missing in the
Whitelist, the call will be rejected. The A-party
is then informed about this via this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
BLOTRA0 BLOCKAGE TRAFFIC TYPE 0
BUSYNFEA BUSY NO FEATURE ANNOUNCEMENT
When the B-party is busy and the station is not
equipped for call-waiting or preemption, the
A-party is informed accordingly by the intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
CACNAUTH CAC NOT AUTHORIZED
If an A-party is not authorized to dial a carrier
access code, the call will be rejected. The system
reaction for the A-party is administered with this
intercept.
CACNEXEC CAC NOT EXECUTING
When an A-party dials a number with a carrier
access code, but access to the destination via
this carrier is not possible or allowed, either
the carrier access code for routing may be ignored
or the call may be rejected.
If the call is to be rejected, the appropriate
system reaction for A-party handling is
administered with this intercept.
CALLREJ CALL REJECTED
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
CAUSE1 CAUSE 1
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
CBBUSY CALL BACK ON BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBIMDET CALL BACK ON IMSI DETACH
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBNOPAG CALL BACK ON NO PAGING RESP
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBNOREP CALL BACK ON NO REPLY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBRADCO CALL BACK ON RADIO CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CCBSMOB CALL COMPL. TO BUSY SUB. (NAT)
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
CCSOPR COLLECT CALL SCREENING OPR.
This intercept is used to redirect a call from
the service user to a ACTCCS Operator (see
CR SUB). The intercept SUSVICCS must also be
created to enable addressing of the service user.
Sequencing is not allowed.
CFWIMDET CALL FORW. IMSI DETACH

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 9+
CR INC
NEWCB1NL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD


CFWNDUB CALL FORW. NET. DET. USER BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNOPAG CALL FORW. NO PAGING RESPONSE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNOREP CALL FORW. NO REPLY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWRADCO CALL FORW. RADIO CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWUDUB CALL FORW. USER DET. USER BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWUNCO CALL FORW. UNCONDITIONAL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWVIOLA CALL FORW. FORWARD VIOLATION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CHANGEDN CHANGED DIRECTORY NUMBER
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
Sequencing is not allowed.
CREDLIMS CREDIT LIMIT SUPERVISION
An A-party with the Credit Limit Supervision
feature who wants to set up a call, will first get
an announcement and afterwards the dialtone
depending on the status of his account. This
announcement can be a warning (credit limit almost
reached) or a blocking (credit limit reached)
announcement. This intercept is used to address
the announcement machine (UI-LTG).
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
FCOFFUI FCOFF USER INTERACTION
This intercept is used to redirect a call from
the service user to a UI-LTG for user interaction.
At least one of the intercepts SUSCI or SUSCICTX
must also be created to address the service user.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
IACB INTERNATIONAL AUTOM CALLBACK
Sequencing is not allowed.
ICUB INCOMING CALLS BARRED IN CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
ILLDEST INCOMPATIBLE CALL DESTINATION
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
INANIF IN ANI FAILURE
Sequencing is not allowed.
INI1TR6 IN INTERWORKING WITH 1TR6
If an IN call wants to reach a 1TR6-subscriber,
a SW-loop is required. This loop is addressed via
this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWCB1.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
INV1 INVALID VOTE 1
Sequencing is not allowed.
INV2 INVALID VOTE 2
Sequencing is not allowed.
ISUPLOOP ISUP LOOP
If ISUP is not recognized on the A-side the
ISUP HW loop will be initiated via this
intercept before the remote intercom number
is code processed.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWCB1.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
I1TR6IN INTERWORKING 1TR6 TO IN
As an 1TR6 subscriber is not able to handle IN, a
SW-loop is required. This loop is addressed via
this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should only be combined with
INRES=NEWCB1.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
KONSUC KICK-OUT NUMBER SUCCESSFUL
This intercept leads to an announcement after

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 10+


CR INC
NEWCB1NL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

storing of an undesirable A-party number to the


Kick-Out list was successful.
KONUNSUC KICK-OUT NUMBER UNSUCCESSFUL
This intercept leads to an announcement after
storing of an undesirable A-party number to the
Kick-Out list was not successful.
LOOPCIDR LOOP CALL IDENTIFICATION REC.
This intercept is used to address a loop-LTG for
the call identification recording feature (see
CR SUB). This feature enables the recording of
malicious call data.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
LOOPTMC LOOP TRUNK MONITORING CENTER
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWDEST.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
MAPBSNPR BS NOT PROVISIONED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPCUGR CUG REJECT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPDATMI DATA MISSING
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPFACNT FACILITY NOT SUPPORTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPIBCUG INCOMING CALLS BARRED CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPOBCUG OUTGOING CALLS BARRED CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPRACON NO RADIO RESOURCE AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPSNCUG SUBSCRIBER NOT MEMBER CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPSYSFA SYSTEM FAILURE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPTSNPR TS NOT PROVISIONED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPUNDAT UNEXPECTED DATA VALUE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPUNSUB UNIDENTIFIED SUBSCRIBER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MOBMLOOP MOBILE MONITORING LOOP
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
MOBQUEUE MOBILE CALL QUEUED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MOTADBAR MOB. ORIG. TRAF. ADMIN. BAR.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC1 CALL SETUP CONTROL 1
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC2 CALL SETUP CONTROL 2
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC3 CALL SETUP CONTROL 3
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC4 CALL SETUP CONTROL 4
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC5 CALL SETUP CONTROL 5
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBIC ODB. OUTGOING INTERNAT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBIE ODB. OG. INT. CALLS EXC. HPLMN
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBPE ODB. OG. PREM. RATE ENT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBPI ODB. OG. PREM. RATE INF. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB1 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 1
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB2 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 2
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB3 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 3
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB4 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 4

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 11+


CR INC
NEWCB1NL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.


MOTOTAIC MOB. ORIG. TRAF. ADMIN. INC.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MPTYEALL MULTI PARTY EXTENSION ALL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYEIND MULTI PARTY EXTENSION INDIVID.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYEXT MULTI PARTY EXTENSION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYHOLD MULTI PARTY ON HOLD
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYINV MULTI PARTY INVOCATION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MTTABSUB MOB. TERM. TRAF. ABSENT SUB.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTADBAR MOB. TERM. TRAF. ADMIN. BAR.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTINDIA MOB. TERM. TRAF. INCOMP. DIAL.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTNOPAG MOB. TERM. TRAF. NO PAG. RESP.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTSUBNC MOB. TERM. TRAF. SUB. NUM. CH.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTUNSUB MOB. TERM. TRAF. UNKNOWN SUB.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MWI MESSAGE WAITING INDICATION
If an A-party has the feature MWI (see CR SUB),
the A-party is informed by this intercept about
messages in the mailbox.
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
NOALTROU NO ALTERNATE ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
NOROUTE UNALLOCATED ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
NOSERV SERVICE NOT AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
OACSU D900 OFF AIR CALL SETUP
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
OCUB OUTGOING CALLS BARRED IN CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
OVL1 OVERLOAD SITUATION 1
Sequencing is not allowed.
OVL2 OVERLOAD SITUATION 2
Sequencing is not allowed.
OVL3 OVERLOAD SITUATION 3
Sequencing is not allowed.
OVL4 OVERLOAD SITUATION 4
Sequencing is not allowed.
PINERR PIN INPUT ERROR
This intercept is used to warn the subscriber
that the PIN Code entered is wrong.
PRIOQ PRIORITY QUEUEING
If a priority A-party wants to make a call and all
trunks are busy, the call will be queued in a
priority queue. The A-party is informed about this
by the intercept.
PROTERR PROTOCOL ERROR
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
RCFABSUB ABSENT SUBSCRIBER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFALNAN ALERTING NO ANSWER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFBCNIM BC NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFCTLEX CONV TIME LIMIT EXPIRED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFFACRJ FACILITY REJECTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNCHAV NO CHANNEL AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNMCUG USER NOT MEMBER OF CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNRNET NO ROUTE TO SPEC NETWORK
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFPRBLO PRECEDENCE CALL BLOCKED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFPREEM PREEMPTION

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 12+


CR INC
NEWCB1NL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC


RCFRACON NO RADIO RESOURCE AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRALOS RADIO LINK LOSS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRCHNA REQUESTED CHANNEL NOT AVAIL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRFNIM REQ FAC NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRFNSB REQ FACILITY NOT SUBSCRIBED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRUNAV RESOURCE UNAVAILABLE UNSPEC
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFSVNIM SERVICE NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFSWEQC SWITCHING EQUIPMENT CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFTMPFA TEMPORARY FAILURE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB1 INVALID NUMBER FORMAT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB2 DIGITS NOT RECEIVED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB3 DIGIT TIMEOUT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
REJDIV REJECTION OF DIVERTED CALLS
When a call is forwarded, the B2-party may have
the feature ACTRJDIV (see CR SUB), which means
that the B2-subscriber does not accept forwarded
calls. The A-party will be informed about this by
the intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
SANNCH SERVICE ANNOUNCEMENT CALL HOLD
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
SANNCW SERVICE ANNOUNCE. CALL WAITING
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
SCLIMACC SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT ACCEPT
This intercept leads to an announcement to
confirm that entry of the new subscriber
credit limit has been successful.
SCLIMERR SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT ERROR
This intercept leads to an announcement saying
that entry of the new subscriber credit limit
has failed.
SCLIMINF SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT INFO
This intercept leads to an announcement to inform
the subscriber about the current subscriber credit
limit.
SCLSTO REJECT BY SCREENING LIST ORIG.
If an A-party has the feature SCOACC (Selective
Call Acceptance) or SCOREJ (Selective Call
Rejection), an outgoing call is checked as to
whether the called number is in the Blacklist
or not present in the Whitelist. If so, the call
is rejected. The A-party is then informed
accordingly by this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
SCLSTT REJECT BY SCREENING LIST TERM.
If a B-party has the feature SCTACC (Selective
Call Acceptance) or SCTREJ (Selective Call
Rejection), an incoming call will be checked. If
the A-party number is in the Blacklist or not in
the Whitelist, the call will be rejected. The
A-party is then informed accordingly.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
SNA0 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 0
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA1 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 1
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA2 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 2
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA3 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 3
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA4 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 4
Sequencing is not allowed.
SUSCI SERVICE USER FOR SCI
For help on subscriber controlled input, this

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 13+


CR INC
NEWCB1NL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

intercept is used to redirect an ordinary


subscriber to the service user for SCI.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SUSCICTX SERVICE USER FOR SCI CTX
For help on subscriber controlled input, this
intercept is used to redirect a CENTREX subscriber
to the service user for SCI.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SUSVICCS SERVICE USER FOR SVI & CCS
This intercept is used to redirect an A-party to
a service user if the B-party has the feature
SVI (SERVICE INTERCEPTION) or ACTCCS (COLLECT
CALL SCREENING) (see CR SUB).
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SVIOPR SERVICE INTERCEPTION OPERATOR
This intercept is used to redirect a call from
the service user to an SVI Operator (see CR SUB).
The intercept SUSVICCS must also be created to
enable addressing of the service user.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SWUPWEEK SHIFT WAKE UP WEEKLY
If no resources are available for the requested
time interval, the weekly wakeup request is
shifted to the previous interval. The subscriber
is informed about this by the intercept.
TXSCASU TXS CASUAL USER
If an A-party number is not in the IN
Authorization Database, this non-registered caller
is routed to an operator or to an announcement via
this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
UNALLROU UNALLOCATED ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE0 VACANT CODE
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE1 VACANT CODE NO OPERATOR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE10 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 10
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE11 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 11
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE12 SCREENED INTERCEPT
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE13 PARTIAL DIAL
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE2 VACANT CODE WITH OPERATOR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE3 NO WORKING EMERGENCY
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE4 PREFIX ONE NOT DIALED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE5 PREFIX ZERO NOT DIALED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE6 PREFIX ONE IN ERROR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE7 PREFIX ZERO NOT ALLOWED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE8 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 08
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE9 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 09
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDN DIRECTORY NUMBER UNOBTAINABLE
This value belongs to INTYP = TERM.
USNRESP NO USER RESPONDING
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.

b: ADDITIONAL NUMERIC VALUE=


0...250, range of decimal numbers

Compatibilities:
For ANN only value 1..127 is permitted.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 14+


CR INC
NEWCB1NL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

INRES INTERCEPT ADDITIONAL RESULT

This parameter specifies the response which is to be triggered when


the intercept code is accessed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NEWCB1NL NEW CODE SEND B1 NUMBER NO LAC

CODE NEW CODE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: DIGITS FOR NEW CODE=


1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

This unit specifies the digit sequence to be used for


retranslation.

b: CATEGORY FOR NEW CODE


CATAC CATEGORY OF ACTUAL CONNECTION

This unit specifies the new class to be used for digit


translation. Translation with another class allows the
accessibility of a destination to be restricted
(e.g. in order to prevent the destination being dialed
directly).

Default: CATAC

TONE TONE AND TONE TIME DURATION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: TONE TYPE
ACKNTNEG ACKNOWLEDGEMENT TONE NEGATIVE
ACKNTPOS ACKNOWLEDGEMENT TONE POSITIVE
CONGTONE ALL TRUNKS BUSY TONE
DIALTONE DIAL TONE
This value is not allowed for SEQ=1.
If this value is entered, no further sequence is
allowed.
Unit b cannot be specified for this value.
INFOTONE SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE
NOTONE NO TONE
NUTONE NUMBER UNOBTAINABLE TONE
RNGTONE RINGING TONE
SUBBUSY SUBSCRIBER BUSY TONE

This unit specifies the tone which is to be applied if the


intercept code is accessed.
If the INRES parameter is also specified for the intercept
code, the tone is only applied if the response specified
by INRES (e.g. access an announcement) is not possible.

b: TONE TIME DURATION=


0...2047, range of decimal numbers

This parameter unit specifies how long (in seconds) the tone is
to be applied.
Value 0 means endless tone time duration.
Defaults:
ACKNTNEG = 120
ACKNTPOS = 24
CONGTONE = 30
INFOTONE = 0
NOTONE = 18
NUTONE = 30
RNGTONE = 24
SUBBUSY = 120

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 15+


CR INC
NEWCB1NL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SEQ SEQUENCE INDEX

This parameter specifies the position in which the response


created by this command is located if several responses are created
for one intercept code. This value must start with 1 and be entered
without gaps.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15, range of decimal numbers

Default: 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 16+


CR INC
NEWCODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

ANNOUNCEMENT VIA NEW CODE

Input format to create an intercept code via which the digit translator is
re-accessed. An intercept code of this type serves to access an announcement or
an operator.

To hear an announcement the following actions (MML-commands) are necessary:


(For the complete command syntax see the corresponding CML.)

- Create a standard destination


CR DEST:DEST=<ANNOU1>,...
- Create an announcement group
CR ANGRP:TGNO=<A001>,...
- Create (an) announcement line(s)
CR ANLN:TGNO=<A001>,...
- Create a route to the announcement device
CR ROUTE:DEST=<ANNOU1>,TGNO=<A001>,...
- Create a code point
CR CPT:CODE=<123456789>,DEST=<ANNOU1>,...
- Create a zone point (for announcements that can be dialled directly too)
CR ZOPT:CODE=<123456789>,ZOCHA=NOPULSE,...
- Create an intercept
CR INC:INCEPT=<########>,INRES=NEWCOD/NEWCB1,CODE=<123456789>;

To access an operator the following actions (MML-commands) are necessary:


(For the complete command syntax see the corresponding CML.)

- Create an intercept (with the common service group number)


CR INC:INCEPT=<########>,INRES=NEWCOD/NEWCB1,CODE=<012345>;
- Create an intercept (with the calltype number)
CR INC:INCEPT=<########>,INRES=NEWCOD/NEWCB1,CODE=<016789>;

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR INC : INCEPT= ,INRES= ,CODE= [,TONE=] [,SEQ=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

INCEPT INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the intercept code for which data are to
be created.
This parameter is subdivided into functional blocks.
This subdivision is explained in parameter INTYP
of the command DISP INC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION
ACREJ ANONYMOUS CALL REJECTION
If an A-party has the feature CLIR (see CR SUB)
and the B-party has the feature ACTACREJ (see
CR SUB), the call will be rejected. The A-party
will be informed about this by the intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
ALLROUBA ALL ROUTES BARRED
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
ANIFLIST ANI FAILURE LIST
If an office-specific Whitelist or Blacklist
feature is active and the number of the A-party
is not available, the call will be rejected. The
A-party is informed about this with this
intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
ANN INTELLIGENT NETWORK ANNOUNCEM.
Unit b is required.
Sequencing is not allowed.
ANNARDN ANNOUNCEMENT AUTO RECALL DN
When a B-party has the automatic recall feature

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 17+


CR INC
NEWCODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

and does not answer an incoming call or is busy,


the number of the A-party is stored by the system.
The B-party can initiate a recall by keying in
an access code. The B-party is informed by this
intercept about the stored A-party number.
ANNPDIAL ANN. PRIOR TO DIAL TONE
When going off hook, the A-party will get an
announcement before the dial tone is applied.
The intercept is used to address the announcement
machine (UI-LTG).
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
ANNQINFO ANN. OF QUEUE INFORMATION
Sequencing is not allowed.
BAIC BARRING OF ALL INCOMING CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOC BARRING OF ALL OUTGOING CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOCEXHP BAR. OF OUTG. CALLS EXC. HPLMN
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOIC BARRING OF ALL OUT. INT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BLKWINFO BLOCKING WITH INFORMATION
An A party that has been blocked by "Hacker
Detection" will be informed by the intercept
that access is denied.
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
BLOCKLST BLOCKED BY LIST
Incoming calls are checked against an office-
specific Blacklist or Whitelist. If the A-party
number is in the Blacklist or missing in the
Whitelist, the call will be rejected. The A-party
is then informed about this via this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
BLOTRA0 BLOCKAGE TRAFFIC TYPE 0
BUSYNFEA BUSY NO FEATURE ANNOUNCEMENT
When the B-party is busy and the station is not
equipped for call-waiting or preemption, the
A-party is informed accordingly by the intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
CACNAUTH CAC NOT AUTHORIZED
If an A-party is not authorized to dial a carrier
access code, the call will be rejected. The system
reaction for the A-party is administered with this
intercept.
CACNEXEC CAC NOT EXECUTING
When an A-party dials a number with a carrier
access code, but access to the destination via
this carrier is not possible or allowed, either
the carrier access code for routing may be ignored
or the call may be rejected.
If the call is to be rejected, the appropriate
system reaction for A-party handling is
administered with this intercept.
CALLREJ CALL REJECTED
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
CAUSE1 CAUSE 1
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
CBBUSY CALL BACK ON BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBIMDET CALL BACK ON IMSI DETACH
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBNOPAG CALL BACK ON NO PAGING RESP
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBNOREP CALL BACK ON NO REPLY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBRADCO CALL BACK ON RADIO CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CCBSMOB CALL COMPL. TO BUSY SUB. (NAT)
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
CCSOPR COLLECT CALL SCREENING OPR.
This intercept is used to redirect a call from
the service user to a ACTCCS Operator (see
CR SUB). The intercept SUSVICCS must also be
created to enable addressing of the service user.
Sequencing is not allowed.
CFWIMDET CALL FORW. IMSI DETACH
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 18+


CR INC
NEWCODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CFWNDUB CALL FORW. NET. DET. USER BUSY


This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNOPAG CALL FORW. NO PAGING RESPONSE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNOREP CALL FORW. NO REPLY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWRADCO CALL FORW. RADIO CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWUDUB CALL FORW. USER DET. USER BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWUNCO CALL FORW. UNCONDITIONAL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWVIOLA CALL FORW. FORWARD VIOLATION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CHANGEDN CHANGED DIRECTORY NUMBER
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
Sequencing is not allowed.
CREDLIMS CREDIT LIMIT SUPERVISION
An A-party with the Credit Limit Supervision
feature who wants to set up a call, will first get
an announcement and afterwards the dialtone
depending on the status of his account. This
announcement can be a warning (credit limit almost
reached) or a blocking (credit limit reached)
announcement. This intercept is used to address
the announcement machine (UI-LTG).
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
FCOFFUI FCOFF USER INTERACTION
This intercept is used to redirect a call from
the service user to a UI-LTG for user interaction.
At least one of the intercepts SUSCI or SUSCICTX
must also be created to address the service user.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
IACB INTERNATIONAL AUTOM CALLBACK
Sequencing is not allowed.
ICUB INCOMING CALLS BARRED IN CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
ILLDEST INCOMPATIBLE CALL DESTINATION
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
INANIF IN ANI FAILURE
Sequencing is not allowed.
INI1TR6 IN INTERWORKING WITH 1TR6
If an IN call wants to reach a 1TR6-subscriber,
a SW-loop is required. This loop is addressed via
this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWCB1.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
INV1 INVALID VOTE 1
Sequencing is not allowed.
INV2 INVALID VOTE 2
Sequencing is not allowed.
ISUPLOOP ISUP LOOP
If ISUP is not recognized on the A-side the
ISUP HW loop will be initiated via this
intercept before the remote intercom number
is code processed.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWCB1.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
I1TR6IN INTERWORKING 1TR6 TO IN
As an 1TR6 subscriber is not able to handle IN, a
SW-loop is required. This loop is addressed via
this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should only be combined with
INRES=NEWCB1.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
KONSUC KICK-OUT NUMBER SUCCESSFUL
This intercept leads to an announcement after
storing of an undesirable A-party number to the

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 19+


CR INC
NEWCODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Kick-Out list was successful.


KONUNSUC KICK-OUT NUMBER UNSUCCESSFUL
This intercept leads to an announcement after
storing of an undesirable A-party number to the
Kick-Out list was not successful.
LOOPCIDR LOOP CALL IDENTIFICATION REC.
This intercept is used to address a loop-LTG for
the call identification recording feature (see
CR SUB). This feature enables the recording of
malicious call data.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
LOOPTMC LOOP TRUNK MONITORING CENTER
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWDEST.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
MAPBSNPR BS NOT PROVISIONED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPCUGR CUG REJECT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPDATMI DATA MISSING
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPFACNT FACILITY NOT SUPPORTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPIBCUG INCOMING CALLS BARRED CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPOBCUG OUTGOING CALLS BARRED CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPRACON NO RADIO RESOURCE AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPSNCUG SUBSCRIBER NOT MEMBER CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPSYSFA SYSTEM FAILURE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPTSNPR TS NOT PROVISIONED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPUNDAT UNEXPECTED DATA VALUE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPUNSUB UNIDENTIFIED SUBSCRIBER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MOBMLOOP MOBILE MONITORING LOOP
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
MOBQUEUE MOBILE CALL QUEUED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MOTADBAR MOB. ORIG. TRAF. ADMIN. BAR.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC1 CALL SETUP CONTROL 1
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC2 CALL SETUP CONTROL 2
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC3 CALL SETUP CONTROL 3
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC4 CALL SETUP CONTROL 4
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC5 CALL SETUP CONTROL 5
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBIC ODB. OUTGOING INTERNAT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBIE ODB. OG. INT. CALLS EXC. HPLMN
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBPE ODB. OG. PREM. RATE ENT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBPI ODB. OG. PREM. RATE INF. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB1 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 1
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB2 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 2
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB3 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 3
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB4 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 4
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 20+


CR INC
NEWCODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MOTOTAIC MOB. ORIG. TRAF. ADMIN. INC.


This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MPTYEALL MULTI PARTY EXTENSION ALL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYEIND MULTI PARTY EXTENSION INDIVID.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYEXT MULTI PARTY EXTENSION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYHOLD MULTI PARTY ON HOLD
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYINV MULTI PARTY INVOCATION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MTTABSUB MOB. TERM. TRAF. ABSENT SUB.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTADBAR MOB. TERM. TRAF. ADMIN. BAR.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTINDIA MOB. TERM. TRAF. INCOMP. DIAL.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTNOPAG MOB. TERM. TRAF. NO PAG. RESP.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTSUBNC MOB. TERM. TRAF. SUB. NUM. CH.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTUNSUB MOB. TERM. TRAF. UNKNOWN SUB.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MWI MESSAGE WAITING INDICATION
If an A-party has the feature MWI (see CR SUB),
the A-party is informed by this intercept about
messages in the mailbox.
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
NOALTROU NO ALTERNATE ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
NOROUTE UNALLOCATED ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
NOSERV SERVICE NOT AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
OACSU D900 OFF AIR CALL SETUP
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
OCUB OUTGOING CALLS BARRED IN CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
OVL1 OVERLOAD SITUATION 1
Sequencing is not allowed.
OVL2 OVERLOAD SITUATION 2
Sequencing is not allowed.
OVL3 OVERLOAD SITUATION 3
Sequencing is not allowed.
OVL4 OVERLOAD SITUATION 4
Sequencing is not allowed.
PINERR PIN INPUT ERROR
This intercept is used to warn the subscriber
that the PIN Code entered is wrong.
PRIOQ PRIORITY QUEUEING
If a priority A-party wants to make a call and all
trunks are busy, the call will be queued in a
priority queue. The A-party is informed about this
by the intercept.
PROTERR PROTOCOL ERROR
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
RCFABSUB ABSENT SUBSCRIBER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFALNAN ALERTING NO ANSWER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFBCNIM BC NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFCTLEX CONV TIME LIMIT EXPIRED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFFACRJ FACILITY REJECTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNCHAV NO CHANNEL AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNMCUG USER NOT MEMBER OF CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNRNET NO ROUTE TO SPEC NETWORK
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFPRBLO PRECEDENCE CALL BLOCKED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFPREEM PREEMPTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 21+


CR INC
NEWCODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RCFRACON NO RADIO RESOURCE AVAILABLE


This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRALOS RADIO LINK LOSS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRCHNA REQUESTED CHANNEL NOT AVAIL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRFNIM REQ FAC NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRFNSB REQ FACILITY NOT SUBSCRIBED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRUNAV RESOURCE UNAVAILABLE UNSPEC
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFSVNIM SERVICE NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFSWEQC SWITCHING EQUIPMENT CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFTMPFA TEMPORARY FAILURE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB1 INVALID NUMBER FORMAT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB2 DIGITS NOT RECEIVED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB3 DIGIT TIMEOUT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
REJDIV REJECTION OF DIVERTED CALLS
When a call is forwarded, the B2-party may have
the feature ACTRJDIV (see CR SUB), which means
that the B2-subscriber does not accept forwarded
calls. The A-party will be informed about this by
the intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
SANNCH SERVICE ANNOUNCEMENT CALL HOLD
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
SANNCW SERVICE ANNOUNCE. CALL WAITING
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
SCLIMACC SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT ACCEPT
This intercept leads to an announcement to
confirm that entry of the new subscriber
credit limit has been successful.
SCLIMERR SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT ERROR
This intercept leads to an announcement saying
that entry of the new subscriber credit limit
has failed.
SCLIMINF SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT INFO
This intercept leads to an announcement to inform
the subscriber about the current subscriber credit
limit.
SCLSTO REJECT BY SCREENING LIST ORIG.
If an A-party has the feature SCOACC (Selective
Call Acceptance) or SCOREJ (Selective Call
Rejection), an outgoing call is checked as to
whether the called number is in the Blacklist
or not present in the Whitelist. If so, the call
is rejected. The A-party is then informed
accordingly by this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
SCLSTT REJECT BY SCREENING LIST TERM.
If a B-party has the feature SCTACC (Selective
Call Acceptance) or SCTREJ (Selective Call
Rejection), an incoming call will be checked. If
the A-party number is in the Blacklist or not in
the Whitelist, the call will be rejected. The
A-party is then informed accordingly.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
SNA0 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 0
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA1 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 1
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA2 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 2
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA3 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 3
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA4 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 4
Sequencing is not allowed.
SUSCI SERVICE USER FOR SCI
For help on subscriber controlled input, this
intercept is used to redirect an ordinary

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 22+


CR INC
NEWCODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

subscriber to the service user for SCI.


This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SUSCICTX SERVICE USER FOR SCI CTX
For help on subscriber controlled input, this
intercept is used to redirect a CENTREX subscriber
to the service user for SCI.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SUSVICCS SERVICE USER FOR SVI & CCS
This intercept is used to redirect an A-party to
a service user if the B-party has the feature
SVI (SERVICE INTERCEPTION) or ACTCCS (COLLECT
CALL SCREENING) (see CR SUB).
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SVIOPR SERVICE INTERCEPTION OPERATOR
This intercept is used to redirect a call from
the service user to an SVI Operator (see CR SUB).
The intercept SUSVICCS must also be created to
enable addressing of the service user.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SWUPWEEK SHIFT WAKE UP WEEKLY
If no resources are available for the requested
time interval, the weekly wakeup request is
shifted to the previous interval. The subscriber
is informed about this by the intercept.
TXSCASU TXS CASUAL USER
If an A-party number is not in the IN
Authorization Database, this non-registered caller
is routed to an operator or to an announcement via
this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
UNALLROU UNALLOCATED ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE0 VACANT CODE
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE1 VACANT CODE NO OPERATOR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE10 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 10
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE11 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 11
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE12 SCREENED INTERCEPT
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE13 PARTIAL DIAL
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE2 VACANT CODE WITH OPERATOR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE3 NO WORKING EMERGENCY
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE4 PREFIX ONE NOT DIALED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE5 PREFIX ZERO NOT DIALED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE6 PREFIX ONE IN ERROR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE7 PREFIX ZERO NOT ALLOWED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE8 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 08
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE9 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 09
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDN DIRECTORY NUMBER UNOBTAINABLE
This value belongs to INTYP = TERM.
USNRESP NO USER RESPONDING
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.

b: ADDITIONAL NUMERIC VALUE=


0...250, range of decimal numbers

Compatibilities:
For ANN only value 1..127 is permitted.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 23+


CR INC
NEWCODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

INRES INTERCEPT ADDITIONAL RESULT

This parameter specifies the response which is to be triggered when


the intercept code is accessed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NEWCB1 NEW CODE AND SEND B1 NUMBER


NEWCOD NEW CODE

CODE NEW CODE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: DIGITS FOR NEW CODE=


1...24 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

This unit specifies the digit sequence to be used for


retranslation.

b: CATEGORY FOR NEW CODE


CATAC CATEGORY OF ACTUAL CONNECTION

This unit specifies the new class to be used for digit


translation. Translation with another class allows the
accessibility of a destination to be restricted
(e.g. in order to prevent the destination being dialed
directly).

Default: CATAC

TONE TONE AND TONE TIME DURATION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: TONE TYPE
ACKNTNEG ACKNOWLEDGEMENT TONE NEGATIVE
ACKNTPOS ACKNOWLEDGEMENT TONE POSITIVE
CONGTONE ALL TRUNKS BUSY TONE
DIALTONE DIAL TONE
This value is not allowed for SEQ=1.
If this value is entered, no further sequence is
allowed.
Unit b cannot be specified for this value.
INFOTONE SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE
NOTONE NO TONE
NUTONE NUMBER UNOBTAINABLE TONE
RNGTONE RINGING TONE
SUBBUSY SUBSCRIBER BUSY TONE

This unit specifies the tone which is to be applied if the


intercept code is accessed.
If the INRES parameter is also specified for the intercept
code, the tone is only applied if the response specified
by INRES (e.g. access an announcement) is not possible.

b: TONE TIME DURATION=


0...2047, range of decimal numbers

This parameter unit specifies how long (in seconds) the tone is
to be applied.
Value 0 means endless tone time duration.
Defaults:
ACKNTNEG = 120
ACKNTPOS = 24
CONGTONE = 30
INFOTONE = 0
NOTONE = 18
NUTONE = 30
RNGTONE = 24

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 24+


CR INC
NEWCODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SUBBUSY = 120

SEQ SEQUENCE INDEX

This parameter specifies the position in which the response


created by this command is located if several responses are created
for one intercept code. This value must start with 1 and be entered
without gaps.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15, range of decimal numbers

Default: 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 25+


CR INC
NEWDEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

RESOURCES VIA DESTINATION

Input format for creating an intercept code reached via a destination area to
incorporate resources (e.g. pool echo suppressors) into the connection. An
intercept code of this type can also serve to access an announcement device.

To incorporate resources into the connection the following actions (MML-


commands) are necessary:
(For the complete command syntax see the corresponding CML.)

- Create a standard destination


CR DEST:DEST=<RESOU1>,...
- Create a trunk group
CR TGRP:TGNO=<RS001>,GCOS=ECDPGRP,...
- Create (a) trunk(s)
CR TRUNK:TGNO=<RS001>,...
- Create a route to the destination
CR ROUTE:DEST=<RESOU1>,TGNO=<RS001>,...
- Create an intercept
CR INC:INCEPT=<########>,INRES=NEWDEST,DEST=<RESOU1>;

To hear an announcement the following actions (MML-commands) are necessary:


(For the complete command syntax see the corresponding CML.)

- Create a standard destination


CR DEST:DEST=<ANNOU1>,...
- Create an announcement group
CR ANGRP:TGNO=<A001>,...
- Create (an) announcement line(s)
CR ANLN:TGNO=<A001>,...
- Create a route to the announcement device
CR ROUTE:DEST=<ANNOU1>,TGNO=<A001>,...
- Create an intercept
CR INC:INCEPT=<########>,INRES=NEWDEST,DEST=<ANNOU1>;

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR INC : INCEPT= ,INRES= ,DEST= [,TONE=] [,SEQ=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

INCEPT INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the intercept code for which data are to
be created.
This parameter is subdivided into functional blocks.
This subdivision is explained in parameter INTYP
of the command DISP INC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION
ACREJ ANONYMOUS CALL REJECTION
If an A-party has the feature CLIR (see CR SUB)
and the B-party has the feature ACTACREJ (see
CR SUB), the call will be rejected. The A-party
will be informed about this by the intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
ALLROUBA ALL ROUTES BARRED
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
ANIFLIST ANI FAILURE LIST
If an office-specific Whitelist or Blacklist
feature is active and the number of the A-party
is not available, the call will be rejected. The
A-party is informed about this with this
intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
ANN INTELLIGENT NETWORK ANNOUNCEM.
Unit b is required.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 26+


CR INC
NEWDEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Sequencing is not allowed.


ANNARDN ANNOUNCEMENT AUTO RECALL DN
When a B-party has the automatic recall feature
and does not answer an incoming call or is busy,
the number of the A-party is stored by the system.
The B-party can initiate a recall by keying in
an access code. The B-party is informed by this
intercept about the stored A-party number.
ANNPDIAL ANN. PRIOR TO DIAL TONE
When going off hook, the A-party will get an
announcement before the dial tone is applied.
The intercept is used to address the announcement
machine (UI-LTG).
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
ANNQINFO ANN. OF QUEUE INFORMATION
Sequencing is not allowed.
BAIC BARRING OF ALL INCOMING CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOC BARRING OF ALL OUTGOING CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOCEXHP BAR. OF OUTG. CALLS EXC. HPLMN
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOIC BARRING OF ALL OUT. INT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BLKWINFO BLOCKING WITH INFORMATION
An A party that has been blocked by "Hacker
Detection" will be informed by the intercept
that access is denied.
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
BLOCKLST BLOCKED BY LIST
Incoming calls are checked against an office-
specific Blacklist or Whitelist. If the A-party
number is in the Blacklist or missing in the
Whitelist, the call will be rejected. The A-party
is then informed about this via this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
BLOTRA0 BLOCKAGE TRAFFIC TYPE 0
BUSYNFEA BUSY NO FEATURE ANNOUNCEMENT
When the B-party is busy and the station is not
equipped for call-waiting or preemption, the
A-party is informed accordingly by the intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
CACNAUTH CAC NOT AUTHORIZED
If an A-party is not authorized to dial a carrier
access code, the call will be rejected. The system
reaction for the A-party is administered with this
intercept.
CACNEXEC CAC NOT EXECUTING
When an A-party dials a number with a carrier
access code, but access to the destination via
this carrier is not possible or allowed, either
the carrier access code for routing may be ignored
or the call may be rejected.
If the call is to be rejected, the appropriate
system reaction for A-party handling is
administered with this intercept.
CALLREJ CALL REJECTED
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
CAUSE1 CAUSE 1
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
CBBUSY CALL BACK ON BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBIMDET CALL BACK ON IMSI DETACH
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBNOPAG CALL BACK ON NO PAGING RESP
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBNOREP CALL BACK ON NO REPLY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBRADCO CALL BACK ON RADIO CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CCBSMOB CALL COMPL. TO BUSY SUB. (NAT)
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
CCSOPR COLLECT CALL SCREENING OPR.
This intercept is used to redirect a call from
the service user to a ACTCCS Operator (see
CR SUB). The intercept SUSVICCS must also be
created to enable addressing of the service user.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 27+


CR INC
NEWDEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Sequencing is not allowed.


CFWIMDET CALL FORW. IMSI DETACH
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNDUB CALL FORW. NET. DET. USER BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNOPAG CALL FORW. NO PAGING RESPONSE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNOREP CALL FORW. NO REPLY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWRADCO CALL FORW. RADIO CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWUDUB CALL FORW. USER DET. USER BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWUNCO CALL FORW. UNCONDITIONAL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWVIOLA CALL FORW. FORWARD VIOLATION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CHANGEDN CHANGED DIRECTORY NUMBER
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
Sequencing is not allowed.
CREDLIMS CREDIT LIMIT SUPERVISION
An A-party with the Credit Limit Supervision
feature who wants to set up a call, will first get
an announcement and afterwards the dialtone
depending on the status of his account. This
announcement can be a warning (credit limit almost
reached) or a blocking (credit limit reached)
announcement. This intercept is used to address
the announcement machine (UI-LTG).
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
FCOFFUI FCOFF USER INTERACTION
This intercept is used to redirect a call from
the service user to a UI-LTG for user interaction.
At least one of the intercepts SUSCI or SUSCICTX
must also be created to address the service user.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
IACB INTERNATIONAL AUTOM CALLBACK
Sequencing is not allowed.
ICUB INCOMING CALLS BARRED IN CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
ILLDEST INCOMPATIBLE CALL DESTINATION
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
INANIF IN ANI FAILURE
Sequencing is not allowed.
INI1TR6 IN INTERWORKING WITH 1TR6
If an IN call wants to reach a 1TR6-subscriber,
a SW-loop is required. This loop is addressed via
this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWCB1.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
INV1 INVALID VOTE 1
Sequencing is not allowed.
INV2 INVALID VOTE 2
Sequencing is not allowed.
ISUPLOOP ISUP LOOP
If ISUP is not recognized on the A-side the
ISUP HW loop will be initiated via this
intercept before the remote intercom number
is code processed.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWCB1.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
I1TR6IN INTERWORKING 1TR6 TO IN
As an 1TR6 subscriber is not able to handle IN, a
SW-loop is required. This loop is addressed via
this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should only be combined with
INRES=NEWCB1.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 28+


CR INC
NEWDEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

KONSUC KICK-OUT NUMBER SUCCESSFUL


This intercept leads to an announcement after
storing of an undesirable A-party number to the
Kick-Out list was successful.
KONUNSUC KICK-OUT NUMBER UNSUCCESSFUL
This intercept leads to an announcement after
storing of an undesirable A-party number to the
Kick-Out list was not successful.
LOOPCIDR LOOP CALL IDENTIFICATION REC.
This intercept is used to address a loop-LTG for
the call identification recording feature (see
CR SUB). This feature enables the recording of
malicious call data.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
LOOPTMC LOOP TRUNK MONITORING CENTER
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWDEST.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
MAPBSNPR BS NOT PROVISIONED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPCUGR CUG REJECT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPDATMI DATA MISSING
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPFACNT FACILITY NOT SUPPORTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPIBCUG INCOMING CALLS BARRED CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPOBCUG OUTGOING CALLS BARRED CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPRACON NO RADIO RESOURCE AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPSNCUG SUBSCRIBER NOT MEMBER CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPSYSFA SYSTEM FAILURE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPTSNPR TS NOT PROVISIONED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPUNDAT UNEXPECTED DATA VALUE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPUNSUB UNIDENTIFIED SUBSCRIBER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MOBMLOOP MOBILE MONITORING LOOP
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
MOBQUEUE MOBILE CALL QUEUED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MOTADBAR MOB. ORIG. TRAF. ADMIN. BAR.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC1 CALL SETUP CONTROL 1
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC2 CALL SETUP CONTROL 2
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC3 CALL SETUP CONTROL 3
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC4 CALL SETUP CONTROL 4
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC5 CALL SETUP CONTROL 5
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBIC ODB. OUTGOING INTERNAT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBIE ODB. OG. INT. CALLS EXC. HPLMN
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBPE ODB. OG. PREM. RATE ENT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBPI ODB. OG. PREM. RATE INF. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB1 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 1
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB2 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 2
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB3 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 3

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 29+


CR INC
NEWDEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.


MOTOSB4 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 4
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOTAIC MOB. ORIG. TRAF. ADMIN. INC.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MPTYEALL MULTI PARTY EXTENSION ALL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYEIND MULTI PARTY EXTENSION INDIVID.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYEXT MULTI PARTY EXTENSION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYHOLD MULTI PARTY ON HOLD
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYINV MULTI PARTY INVOCATION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MTTABSUB MOB. TERM. TRAF. ABSENT SUB.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTADBAR MOB. TERM. TRAF. ADMIN. BAR.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTINDIA MOB. TERM. TRAF. INCOMP. DIAL.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTNOPAG MOB. TERM. TRAF. NO PAG. RESP.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTSUBNC MOB. TERM. TRAF. SUB. NUM. CH.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTUNSUB MOB. TERM. TRAF. UNKNOWN SUB.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MWI MESSAGE WAITING INDICATION
If an A-party has the feature MWI (see CR SUB),
the A-party is informed by this intercept about
messages in the mailbox.
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
NOALTROU NO ALTERNATE ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
NOROUTE UNALLOCATED ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
NOSERV SERVICE NOT AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
OACSU D900 OFF AIR CALL SETUP
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
OCUB OUTGOING CALLS BARRED IN CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
OVL1 OVERLOAD SITUATION 1
Sequencing is not allowed.
OVL2 OVERLOAD SITUATION 2
Sequencing is not allowed.
OVL3 OVERLOAD SITUATION 3
Sequencing is not allowed.
OVL4 OVERLOAD SITUATION 4
Sequencing is not allowed.
PINERR PIN INPUT ERROR
This intercept is used to warn the subscriber
that the PIN Code entered is wrong.
PRIOQ PRIORITY QUEUEING
If a priority A-party wants to make a call and all
trunks are busy, the call will be queued in a
priority queue. The A-party is informed about this
by the intercept.
PROTERR PROTOCOL ERROR
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
RCFABSUB ABSENT SUBSCRIBER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFALNAN ALERTING NO ANSWER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFBCNIM BC NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFCTLEX CONV TIME LIMIT EXPIRED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFFACRJ FACILITY REJECTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNCHAV NO CHANNEL AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNMCUG USER NOT MEMBER OF CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNRNET NO ROUTE TO SPEC NETWORK
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFPRBLO PRECEDENCE CALL BLOCKED

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 30+


CR INC
NEWDEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC


RCFPREEM PREEMPTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRACON NO RADIO RESOURCE AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRALOS RADIO LINK LOSS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRCHNA REQUESTED CHANNEL NOT AVAIL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRFNIM REQ FAC NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRFNSB REQ FACILITY NOT SUBSCRIBED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRUNAV RESOURCE UNAVAILABLE UNSPEC
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFSVNIM SERVICE NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFSWEQC SWITCHING EQUIPMENT CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFTMPFA TEMPORARY FAILURE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB1 INVALID NUMBER FORMAT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB2 DIGITS NOT RECEIVED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB3 DIGIT TIMEOUT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
REJDIV REJECTION OF DIVERTED CALLS
When a call is forwarded, the B2-party may have
the feature ACTRJDIV (see CR SUB), which means
that the B2-subscriber does not accept forwarded
calls. The A-party will be informed about this by
the intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
SANNCH SERVICE ANNOUNCEMENT CALL HOLD
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
SANNCW SERVICE ANNOUNCE. CALL WAITING
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
SCLIMACC SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT ACCEPT
This intercept leads to an announcement to
confirm that entry of the new subscriber
credit limit has been successful.
SCLIMERR SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT ERROR
This intercept leads to an announcement saying
that entry of the new subscriber credit limit
has failed.
SCLIMINF SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT INFO
This intercept leads to an announcement to inform
the subscriber about the current subscriber credit
limit.
SCLSTO REJECT BY SCREENING LIST ORIG.
If an A-party has the feature SCOACC (Selective
Call Acceptance) or SCOREJ (Selective Call
Rejection), an outgoing call is checked as to
whether the called number is in the Blacklist
or not present in the Whitelist. If so, the call
is rejected. The A-party is then informed
accordingly by this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
SCLSTT REJECT BY SCREENING LIST TERM.
If a B-party has the feature SCTACC (Selective
Call Acceptance) or SCTREJ (Selective Call
Rejection), an incoming call will be checked. If
the A-party number is in the Blacklist or not in
the Whitelist, the call will be rejected. The
A-party is then informed accordingly.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
SNA0 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 0
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA1 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 1
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA2 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 2
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA3 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 3
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA4 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 4
Sequencing is not allowed.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 31+


CR INC
NEWDEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SUSCI SERVICE USER FOR SCI


For help on subscriber controlled input, this
intercept is used to redirect an ordinary
subscriber to the service user for SCI.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SUSCICTX SERVICE USER FOR SCI CTX
For help on subscriber controlled input, this
intercept is used to redirect a CENTREX subscriber
to the service user for SCI.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SUSVICCS SERVICE USER FOR SVI & CCS
This intercept is used to redirect an A-party to
a service user if the B-party has the feature
SVI (SERVICE INTERCEPTION) or ACTCCS (COLLECT
CALL SCREENING) (see CR SUB).
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SVIOPR SERVICE INTERCEPTION OPERATOR
This intercept is used to redirect a call from
the service user to an SVI Operator (see CR SUB).
The intercept SUSVICCS must also be created to
enable addressing of the service user.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SWUPWEEK SHIFT WAKE UP WEEKLY
If no resources are available for the requested
time interval, the weekly wakeup request is
shifted to the previous interval. The subscriber
is informed about this by the intercept.
TXSCASU TXS CASUAL USER
If an A-party number is not in the IN
Authorization Database, this non-registered caller
is routed to an operator or to an announcement via
this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
UNALLROU UNALLOCATED ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE0 VACANT CODE
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE1 VACANT CODE NO OPERATOR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE10 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 10
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE11 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 11
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE12 SCREENED INTERCEPT
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE13 PARTIAL DIAL
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE2 VACANT CODE WITH OPERATOR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE3 NO WORKING EMERGENCY
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE4 PREFIX ONE NOT DIALED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE5 PREFIX ZERO NOT DIALED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE6 PREFIX ONE IN ERROR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE7 PREFIX ZERO NOT ALLOWED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE8 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 08
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE9 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 09
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDN DIRECTORY NUMBER UNOBTAINABLE
This value belongs to INTYP = TERM.
USNRESP NO USER RESPONDING
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.

b: ADDITIONAL NUMERIC VALUE=


0...250, range of decimal numbers

Compatibilities:
For ANN only value 1..127 is permitted.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 32+


CR INC
NEWDEST
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

INRES INTERCEPT ADDITIONAL RESULT

This parameter specifies the response which is to be triggered when


the intercept code is accessed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NEWDEST NEW DESTINATION

DEST DESTINATION AREA NAME

This parameter specifies the destination area to be accessed by the


intercept code.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TONE TONE AND TONE TIME DURATION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: TONE TYPE
ACKNTNEG ACKNOWLEDGEMENT TONE NEGATIVE
ACKNTPOS ACKNOWLEDGEMENT TONE POSITIVE
CONGTONE ALL TRUNKS BUSY TONE
DIALTONE DIAL TONE
This value is not allowed for SEQ=1.
If this value is entered, no further sequence is
allowed.
Unit b cannot be specified for this value.
INFOTONE SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE
NOTONE NO TONE
NUTONE NUMBER UNOBTAINABLE TONE
RNGTONE RINGING TONE
SUBBUSY SUBSCRIBER BUSY TONE

This unit specifies the tone which is to be applied if the


intercept code is accessed.
If the INRES parameter is also specified for the intercept
code, the tone is only applied if the response specified
by INRES (e.g. access an announcement) is not possible.

b: TONE TIME DURATION=


0...2047, range of decimal numbers

This parameter unit specifies how long (in seconds) the tone is
to be applied.
Value 0 means endless tone time duration.
Defaults:
ACKNTNEG = 120
ACKNTPOS = 24
CONGTONE = 30
INFOTONE = 0
NOTONE = 18
NUTONE = 30
RNGTONE = 24
SUBBUSY = 120

SEQ SEQUENCE INDEX

This parameter specifies the position in which the response


created by this command is located if several responses are created
for one intercept code. This value must start with 1 and be entered
without gaps.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15, range of decimal numbers

Default: 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 33+


CR INC
TONE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

SUPPLY WITH A TONE

Input format to create an intercept code via which an intercept tone is


accessed.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR INC : INCEPT= ,TONE= [,SEQ=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

INCEPT INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the intercept code for which data are to
be created.
This parameter is subdivided into functional blocks.
This subdivision is explained in parameter INTYP
of the command DISP INC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION
ACREJ ANONYMOUS CALL REJECTION
If an A-party has the feature CLIR (see CR SUB)
and the B-party has the feature ACTACREJ (see
CR SUB), the call will be rejected. The A-party
will be informed about this by the intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
ALLROUBA ALL ROUTES BARRED
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
ANIFLIST ANI FAILURE LIST
If an office-specific Whitelist or Blacklist
feature is active and the number of the A-party
is not available, the call will be rejected. The
A-party is informed about this with this
intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
ANN INTELLIGENT NETWORK ANNOUNCEM.
Unit b is required.
Sequencing is not allowed.
ANNARDN ANNOUNCEMENT AUTO RECALL DN
When a B-party has the automatic recall feature
and does not answer an incoming call or is busy,
the number of the A-party is stored by the system.
The B-party can initiate a recall by keying in
an access code. The B-party is informed by this
intercept about the stored A-party number.
ANNPDIAL ANN. PRIOR TO DIAL TONE
When going off hook, the A-party will get an
announcement before the dial tone is applied.
The intercept is used to address the announcement
machine (UI-LTG).
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
ANNQINFO ANN. OF QUEUE INFORMATION
Sequencing is not allowed.
BAIC BARRING OF ALL INCOMING CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOC BARRING OF ALL OUTGOING CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOCEXHP BAR. OF OUTG. CALLS EXC. HPLMN
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOIC BARRING OF ALL OUT. INT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BLKWINFO BLOCKING WITH INFORMATION
An A party that has been blocked by "Hacker
Detection" will be informed by the intercept
that access is denied.
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
BLOCKLST BLOCKED BY LIST

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 34+


CR INC
TONE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Incoming calls are checked against an office-


specific Blacklist or Whitelist. If the A-party
number is in the Blacklist or missing in the
Whitelist, the call will be rejected. The A-party
is then informed about this via this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
BLOTRA0 BLOCKAGE TRAFFIC TYPE 0
BUSYNFEA BUSY NO FEATURE ANNOUNCEMENT
When the B-party is busy and the station is not
equipped for call-waiting or preemption, the
A-party is informed accordingly by the intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
CACNAUTH CAC NOT AUTHORIZED
If an A-party is not authorized to dial a carrier
access code, the call will be rejected. The system
reaction for the A-party is administered with this
intercept.
CACNEXEC CAC NOT EXECUTING
When an A-party dials a number with a carrier
access code, but access to the destination via
this carrier is not possible or allowed, either
the carrier access code for routing may be ignored
or the call may be rejected.
If the call is to be rejected, the appropriate
system reaction for A-party handling is
administered with this intercept.
CALLREJ CALL REJECTED
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
CAUSE1 CAUSE 1
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
CBBUSY CALL BACK ON BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBIMDET CALL BACK ON IMSI DETACH
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBNOPAG CALL BACK ON NO PAGING RESP
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBNOREP CALL BACK ON NO REPLY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBRADCO CALL BACK ON RADIO CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CCBSMOB CALL COMPL. TO BUSY SUB. (NAT)
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
CCSOPR COLLECT CALL SCREENING OPR.
This intercept is used to redirect a call from
the service user to a ACTCCS Operator (see
CR SUB). The intercept SUSVICCS must also be
created to enable addressing of the service user.
Sequencing is not allowed.
CFWIMDET CALL FORW. IMSI DETACH
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNDUB CALL FORW. NET. DET. USER BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNOPAG CALL FORW. NO PAGING RESPONSE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNOREP CALL FORW. NO REPLY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWRADCO CALL FORW. RADIO CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWUDUB CALL FORW. USER DET. USER BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWUNCO CALL FORW. UNCONDITIONAL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWVIOLA CALL FORW. FORWARD VIOLATION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CHANGEDN CHANGED DIRECTORY NUMBER
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
Sequencing is not allowed.
CREDLIMS CREDIT LIMIT SUPERVISION
An A-party with the Credit Limit Supervision
feature who wants to set up a call, will first get
an announcement and afterwards the dialtone
depending on the status of his account. This
announcement can be a warning (credit limit almost
reached) or a blocking (credit limit reached)
announcement. This intercept is used to address
the announcement machine (UI-LTG).
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 35+


CR INC
TONE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

FCOFFUI FCOFF USER INTERACTION


This intercept is used to redirect a call from
the service user to a UI-LTG for user interaction.
At least one of the intercepts SUSCI or SUSCICTX
must also be created to address the service user.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
IACB INTERNATIONAL AUTOM CALLBACK
Sequencing is not allowed.
ICUB INCOMING CALLS BARRED IN CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
ILLDEST INCOMPATIBLE CALL DESTINATION
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
INANIF IN ANI FAILURE
Sequencing is not allowed.
INI1TR6 IN INTERWORKING WITH 1TR6
If an IN call wants to reach a 1TR6-subscriber,
a SW-loop is required. This loop is addressed via
this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWCB1.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
INV1 INVALID VOTE 1
Sequencing is not allowed.
INV2 INVALID VOTE 2
Sequencing is not allowed.
ISUPLOOP ISUP LOOP
If ISUP is not recognized on the A-side the
ISUP HW loop will be initiated via this
intercept before the remote intercom number
is code processed.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWCB1.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
I1TR6IN INTERWORKING 1TR6 TO IN
As an 1TR6 subscriber is not able to handle IN, a
SW-loop is required. This loop is addressed via
this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should only be combined with
INRES=NEWCB1.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
KONSUC KICK-OUT NUMBER SUCCESSFUL
This intercept leads to an announcement after
storing of an undesirable A-party number to the
Kick-Out list was successful.
KONUNSUC KICK-OUT NUMBER UNSUCCESSFUL
This intercept leads to an announcement after
storing of an undesirable A-party number to the
Kick-Out list was not successful.
LOOPCIDR LOOP CALL IDENTIFICATION REC.
This intercept is used to address a loop-LTG for
the call identification recording feature (see
CR SUB). This feature enables the recording of
malicious call data.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
LOOPTMC LOOP TRUNK MONITORING CENTER
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWDEST.
This value should not be combined with TONE.
Sequencing is not allowed.
MAPBSNPR BS NOT PROVISIONED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPCUGR CUG REJECT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPDATMI DATA MISSING
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPFACNT FACILITY NOT SUPPORTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPIBCUG INCOMING CALLS BARRED CUG

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 36+


CR INC
TONE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC


MAPOBCUG OUTGOING CALLS BARRED CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPRACON NO RADIO RESOURCE AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPSNCUG SUBSCRIBER NOT MEMBER CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPSYSFA SYSTEM FAILURE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPTSNPR TS NOT PROVISIONED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPUNDAT UNEXPECTED DATA VALUE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPUNSUB UNIDENTIFIED SUBSCRIBER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MOBMLOOP MOBILE MONITORING LOOP
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
This value should be combined only with
INRES=NEWDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
MOBQUEUE MOBILE CALL QUEUED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MOTADBAR MOB. ORIG. TRAF. ADMIN. BAR.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC1 CALL SETUP CONTROL 1
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC2 CALL SETUP CONTROL 2
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC3 CALL SETUP CONTROL 3
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC4 CALL SETUP CONTROL 4
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC5 CALL SETUP CONTROL 5
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBIC ODB. OUTGOING INTERNAT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBIE ODB. OG. INT. CALLS EXC. HPLMN
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBPE ODB. OG. PREM. RATE ENT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBPI ODB. OG. PREM. RATE INF. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB1 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 1
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB2 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 2
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB3 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 3
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB4 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 4
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOTAIC MOB. ORIG. TRAF. ADMIN. INC.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MPTYEALL MULTI PARTY EXTENSION ALL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYEIND MULTI PARTY EXTENSION INDIVID.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYEXT MULTI PARTY EXTENSION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYHOLD MULTI PARTY ON HOLD
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYINV MULTI PARTY INVOCATION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MTTABSUB MOB. TERM. TRAF. ABSENT SUB.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTADBAR MOB. TERM. TRAF. ADMIN. BAR.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTINDIA MOB. TERM. TRAF. INCOMP. DIAL.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTNOPAG MOB. TERM. TRAF. NO PAG. RESP.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTSUBNC MOB. TERM. TRAF. SUB. NUM. CH.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTUNSUB MOB. TERM. TRAF. UNKNOWN SUB.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MWI MESSAGE WAITING INDICATION
If an A-party has the feature MWI (see CR SUB),
the A-party is informed by this intercept about

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 37+


CR INC
TONE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

messages in the mailbox.


This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
NOALTROU NO ALTERNATE ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
NOROUTE UNALLOCATED ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
NOSERV SERVICE NOT AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
OACSU D900 OFF AIR CALL SETUP
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
OCUB OUTGOING CALLS BARRED IN CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
OVL1 OVERLOAD SITUATION 1
Sequencing is not allowed.
OVL2 OVERLOAD SITUATION 2
Sequencing is not allowed.
OVL3 OVERLOAD SITUATION 3
Sequencing is not allowed.
OVL4 OVERLOAD SITUATION 4
Sequencing is not allowed.
PINERR PIN INPUT ERROR
This intercept is used to warn the subscriber
that the PIN Code entered is wrong.
PRIOQ PRIORITY QUEUEING
If a priority A-party wants to make a call and all
trunks are busy, the call will be queued in a
priority queue. The A-party is informed about this
by the intercept.
PROTERR PROTOCOL ERROR
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
RCFABSUB ABSENT SUBSCRIBER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFALNAN ALERTING NO ANSWER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFBCNIM BC NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFCTLEX CONV TIME LIMIT EXPIRED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFFACRJ FACILITY REJECTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNCHAV NO CHANNEL AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNMCUG USER NOT MEMBER OF CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNRNET NO ROUTE TO SPEC NETWORK
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFPRBLO PRECEDENCE CALL BLOCKED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFPREEM PREEMPTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRACON NO RADIO RESOURCE AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRALOS RADIO LINK LOSS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRCHNA REQUESTED CHANNEL NOT AVAIL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRFNIM REQ FAC NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRFNSB REQ FACILITY NOT SUBSCRIBED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRUNAV RESOURCE UNAVAILABLE UNSPEC
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFSVNIM SERVICE NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFSWEQC SWITCHING EQUIPMENT CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFTMPFA TEMPORARY FAILURE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB1 INVALID NUMBER FORMAT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB2 DIGITS NOT RECEIVED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB3 DIGIT TIMEOUT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
REJDIV REJECTION OF DIVERTED CALLS
When a call is forwarded, the B2-party may have
the feature ACTRJDIV (see CR SUB), which means

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 38+


CR INC
TONE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

that the B2-subscriber does not accept forwarded


calls. The A-party will be informed about this by
the intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
SANNCH SERVICE ANNOUNCEMENT CALL HOLD
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
SANNCW SERVICE ANNOUNCE. CALL WAITING
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
SCLIMACC SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT ACCEPT
This intercept leads to an announcement to
confirm that entry of the new subscriber
credit limit has been successful.
SCLIMERR SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT ERROR
This intercept leads to an announcement saying
that entry of the new subscriber credit limit
has failed.
SCLIMINF SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT INFO
This intercept leads to an announcement to inform
the subscriber about the current subscriber credit
limit.
SCLSTO REJECT BY SCREENING LIST ORIG.
If an A-party has the feature SCOACC (Selective
Call Acceptance) or SCOREJ (Selective Call
Rejection), an outgoing call is checked as to
whether the called number is in the Blacklist
or not present in the Whitelist. If so, the call
is rejected. The A-party is then informed
accordingly by this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
SCLSTT REJECT BY SCREENING LIST TERM.
If a B-party has the feature SCTACC (Selective
Call Acceptance) or SCTREJ (Selective Call
Rejection), an incoming call will be checked. If
the A-party number is in the Blacklist or not in
the Whitelist, the call will be rejected. The
A-party is then informed accordingly.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
SNA0 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 0
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA1 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 1
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA2 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 2
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA3 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 3
Sequencing is not allowed.
SNA4 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 4
Sequencing is not allowed.
SUSCI SERVICE USER FOR SCI
For help on subscriber controlled input, this
intercept is used to redirect an ordinary
subscriber to the service user for SCI.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SUSCICTX SERVICE USER FOR SCI CTX
For help on subscriber controlled input, this
intercept is used to redirect a CENTREX subscriber
to the service user for SCI.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SUSVICCS SERVICE USER FOR SVI & CCS
This intercept is used to redirect an A-party to
a service user if the B-party has the feature
SVI (SERVICE INTERCEPTION) or ACTCCS (COLLECT
CALL SCREENING) (see CR SUB).
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SVIOPR SERVICE INTERCEPTION OPERATOR
This intercept is used to redirect a call from
the service user to an SVI Operator (see CR SUB).
The intercept SUSVICCS must also be created to
enable addressing of the service user.
Sequencing is not allowed.
SWUPWEEK SHIFT WAKE UP WEEKLY
If no resources are available for the requested
time interval, the weekly wakeup request is
shifted to the previous interval. The subscriber
is informed about this by the intercept.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 39+


CR INC
TONE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TXSCASU TXS CASUAL USER


If an A-party number is not in the IN
Authorization Database, this non-registered caller
is routed to an operator or to an announcement via
this intercept.
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
UNALLROU UNALLOCATED ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE0 VACANT CODE
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE1 VACANT CODE NO OPERATOR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE10 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 10
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE11 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 11
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE12 SCREENED INTERCEPT
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE13 PARTIAL DIAL
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE2 VACANT CODE WITH OPERATOR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE3 NO WORKING EMERGENCY
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE4 PREFIX ONE NOT DIALED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE5 PREFIX ZERO NOT DIALED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE6 PREFIX ONE IN ERROR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE7 PREFIX ZERO NOT ALLOWED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE8 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 08
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE9 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 09
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDN DIRECTORY NUMBER UNOBTAINABLE
This value belongs to INTYP = TERM.
USNRESP NO USER RESPONDING
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.

b: ADDITIONAL NUMERIC VALUE=


0...250, range of decimal numbers

Compatibilities:
For ANN only value 1..127 is permitted.

TONE TONE AND TONE TIME DURATION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: TONE TYPE
ACKNTNEG ACKNOWLEDGEMENT TONE NEGATIVE
ACKNTPOS ACKNOWLEDGEMENT TONE POSITIVE
CONGTONE ALL TRUNKS BUSY TONE
DIALTONE DIAL TONE
This value is not allowed for SEQ=1.
If this value is entered, no further sequence is
allowed.
Unit b cannot be specified for this value.
INFOTONE SPECIAL INFORMATION TONE
NOTONE NO TONE
NUTONE NUMBER UNOBTAINABLE TONE
RNGTONE RINGING TONE
SUBBUSY SUBSCRIBER BUSY TONE

This unit specifies the tone which is to be applied if the


intercept code is accessed.
If the INRES parameter is also specified for the intercept
code, the tone is only applied if the response specified
by INRES (e.g. access an announcement) is not possible.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 40+


CR INC
TONE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: TONE TIME DURATION=


0...2047, range of decimal numbers

This parameter unit specifies how long (in seconds) the tone is
to be applied.
Value 0 means endless tone time duration.
Defaults:
ACKNTNEG = 120
ACKNTPOS = 24
CONGTONE = 30
INFOTONE = 0
NOTONE = 18
NUTONE = 30
RNGTONE = 24
SUBBUSY = 120

SEQ SEQUENCE INDEX

This parameter specifies the position in which the response


created by this command is located if several responses are created
for one intercept code. This value must start with 1 and be entered
without gaps.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15, range of decimal numbers

Default: 1

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INC- 41-


DISP INC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY INTERCEPT

This command displays the created data for the specified intercept code.

This command allows multiple starts.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP INC : <INCEPT= ,INTYP=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

INCEPT INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the intercept code for which the data are
to be displayed.
Up to 34 intercept identifiers may be linked.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: INTERCEPT IDENTIFICATION
ANNPDIAL ANN. PRIOR TO DIAL TONE
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
MWI MESSAGE WAITING INDICATION
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
OCUB OUTGOING CALLS BARRED IN CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
SCLSTO REJECT BY SCREENING LIST ORIG.
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
TXSCASU TXS CASUAL USER
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
OACSU D900 OFF AIR CALL SETUP
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
CREDLIMS CREDIT LIMIT SUPERVISION
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
CCBSMOB CALL COMPL. TO BUSY SUB. (NAT)
This value belongs to INTYP=ORIG.
NOSERV SERVICE NOT AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
CHANGEDN CHANGED DIRECTORY NUMBER
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
UNOBDN DIRECTORY NUMBER UNOBTAINABLE
This value belongs to INTYP = TERM.
ICUB INCOMING CALLS BARRED IN CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
SCLSTT REJECT BY SCREENING LIST TERM.
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
REJDIV REJECTION OF DIVERTED CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
ACREJ ANONYMOUS CALL REJECTION
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
BUSYNFEA BUSY NO FEATURE ANNOUNCEMENT
This value belongs to INTYP=TERM.
UNOBDE0 VACANT CODE
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE1 VACANT CODE NO OPERATOR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE2 VACANT CODE WITH OPERATOR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE3 NO WORKING EMERGENCY
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE4 PREFIX ONE NOT DIALED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE5 PREFIX ZERO NOT DIALED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE6 PREFIX ONE IN ERROR
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE7 PREFIX ZERO NOT ALLOWED
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INC- 1+


DISP INC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

UNOBDE8 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 08


This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE9 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 09
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE10 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 10
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE11 UNOBTAINABLE DESTINATION 11
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNALLROU UNALLOCATED ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
ILLDEST INCOMPATIBLE CALL DESTINATION
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
UNOBDE13 PARTIAL DIAL
This value belongs to INTYP=DIZO.
ANNARDN ANNOUNCEMENT AUTO RECALL DN
SWUPWEEK SHIFT WAKE UP WEEKLY
PINERR PIN INPUT ERROR
SCLIMACC SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT ACCEPT
SCLIMERR SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT ERROR
SCLIMINF SUBSCRIBER CREDIT LIMIT INFO
KONSUC KICK-OUT NUMBER SUCCESSFUL
KONUNSUC KICK-OUT NUMBER UNSUCCESSFUL
CCSOPR COLLECT CALL SCREENING OPR.
SVIOPR SERVICE INTERCEPTION OPERATOR
NOROUTE UNALLOCATED ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
NOALTROU NO ALTERNATE ROUTE
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
ALLROUBA ALL ROUTES BARRED
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
ANIFLIST ANI FAILURE LIST
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
BLOCKLST BLOCKED BY LIST
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
BLKWINFO BLOCKING WITH INFORMATION
This value belongs to INTYP=ROUTING.
CALLREJ CALL REJECTED
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
CAUSE1 CAUSE 1
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
USNRESP NO USER RESPONDING
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
PROTERR PROTOCOL ERROR
This value belongs to INTYP=BASICAUS.
SUSCI SERVICE USER FOR SCI
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
SUSCICTX SERVICE USER FOR SCI CTX
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
LOOPTMC LOOP TRUNK MONITORING CENTER
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
INI1TR6 IN INTERWORKING WITH 1TR6
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
FCOFFUI FCOFF USER INTERACTION
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
SUSVICCS SERVICE USER FOR SVI & CCS
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
LOOPCIDR LOOP CALL IDENTIFICATION REC.
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
I1TR6IN INTERWORKING 1TR6 TO IN
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
ISUPLOOP ISUP LOOP
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
MOBMLOOP MOBILE MONITORING LOOP
This value belongs to INTYP=COMDEST.
CACNEXEC CAC NOT EXECUTING
CACNAUTH CAC NOT AUTHORIZED
BLOTRA0 BLOCKAGE TRAFFIC TYPE 0
RCFNRNET NO ROUTE TO SPEC NETWORK
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFPREEM PREEMPTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFFACRJ FACILITY REJECTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNCHAV NO CHANNEL AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFTMPFA TEMPORARY FAILURE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INC- 2+


DISP INC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RCFSWEQC SWITCHING EQUIPMENT CONGESTION


This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRCHNA REQUESTED CHANNEL NOT AVAIL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFPRBLO PRECEDENCE CALL BLOCKED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRUNAV RESOURCE UNAVAILABLE UNSPEC
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRFNSB REQ FACILITY NOT SUBSCRIBED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFBCNIM BC NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRFNIM REQ FAC NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFSVNIM SERVICE NOT IMPLEMENTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFNMCUG USER NOT MEMBER OF CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFCTLEX CONV TIME LIMIT EXPIRED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRALOS RADIO LINK LOSS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFABSUB ABSENT SUBSCRIBER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB1 INVALID NUMBER FORMAT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB2 DIGITS NOT RECEIVED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFUNOB3 DIGIT TIMEOUT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
RCFRACON NO RADIO RESOURCE AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBRCFC
PRIOQ PRIORITY QUEUEING
ANNQINFO ANN. OF QUEUE INFORMATION
SNA0 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 0
SNA1 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 1
SNA2 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 2
SNA3 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 3
SNA4 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 4
OVL1 OVERLOAD SITUATION 1
OVL2 OVERLOAD SITUATION 2
OVL3 OVERLOAD SITUATION 3
OVL4 OVERLOAD SITUATION 4
INV1 INVALID VOTE 1
INV2 INVALID VOTE 2
INANIF IN ANI FAILURE
IACB INTERNATIONAL AUTOM CALLBACK
ANN INTELLIGENT NETWORK ANNOUNCEM.
Unit b is required.
MOTFC1 CALL SETUP CONTROL 1
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC2 CALL SETUP CONTROL 2
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBIC ODB. OUTGOING INTERNAT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBIE ODB. OG. INT. CALLS EXC. HPLMN
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBPI ODB. OG. PREM. RATE INF. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTODBPE ODB. OG. PREM. RATE ENT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTADBAR MOB. ORIG. TRAF. ADMIN. BAR.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOTAIC MOB. ORIG. TRAF. ADMIN. INC.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC3 CALL SETUP CONTROL 3
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC4 CALL SETUP CONTROL 4
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTFC5 CALL SETUP CONTROL 5
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB1 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 1
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB2 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 2
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MOTOSB3 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 3
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INC- 3+


DISP INC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MOTOSB4 OPERATOR SPEC BARRING 4


This value belongs to INTYP=MOBORIG.
MTTABSUB MOB. TERM. TRAF. ABSENT SUB.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTNOPAG MOB. TERM. TRAF. NO PAG. RESP.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTSUBNC MOB. TERM. TRAF. SUB. NUM. CH.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTUNSUB MOB. TERM. TRAF. UNKNOWN SUB.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTADBAR MOB. TERM. TRAF. ADMIN. BAR.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
MTTINDIA MOB. TERM. TRAF. INCOMP. DIAL.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBTERM.
CFWUNCO CALL FORW. UNCONDITIONAL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNDUB CALL FORW. NET. DET. USER BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWUDUB CALL FORW. USER DET. USER BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNOREP CALL FORW. NO REPLY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWNOPAG CALL FORW. NO PAGING RESPONSE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWRADCO CALL FORW. RADIO CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWVIOLA CALL FORW. FORWARD VIOLATION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CFWIMDET CALL FORW. IMSI DETACH
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBBUSY CALL BACK ON BUSY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBNOREP CALL BACK ON NO REPLY
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBNOPAG CALL BACK ON NO PAGING RESP
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBRADCO CALL BACK ON RADIO CONGESTION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
CBIMDET CALL BACK ON IMSI DETACH
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCFWD
BAOC BARRING OF ALL OUTGOING CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOIC BARRING OF ALL OUT. INT. CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAOCEXHP BAR. OF OUTG. CALLS EXC. HPLMN
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
BAIC BARRING OF ALL INCOMING CALLS
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBCRES
MOBQUEUE MOBILE CALL QUEUED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
SANNCW SERVICE ANNOUNCE. CALL WAITING
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
SANNCH SERVICE ANNOUNCEMENT CALL HOLD
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYINV MULTI PARTY INVOCATION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYEXT MULTI PARTY EXTENSION
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYEALL MULTI PARTY EXTENSION ALL
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYEIND MULTI PARTY EXTENSION INDIVID.
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MPTYHOLD MULTI PARTY ON HOLD
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBSANN
MAPSYSFA SYSTEM FAILURE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPDATMI DATA MISSING
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPUNDAT UNEXPECTED DATA VALUE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPFACNT FACILITY NOT SUPPORTED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPUNSUB UNIDENTIFIED SUBSCRIBER
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPBSNPR BS NOT PROVISIONED
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INC- 4+


DISP INC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MAPTSNPR TS NOT PROVISIONED


This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPRACON NO RADIO RESOURCE AVAILABLE
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPCUGR CUG REJECT
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPSNCUG SUBSCRIBER NOT MEMBER CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPIBCUG INCOMING CALLS BARRED CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC
MAPOBCUG OUTGOING CALLS BARRED CUG
This value belongs to INTYP=MOBMAPC

b: ADDITIONAL NUMERIC VALUE=


0...250, range of decimal numbers

Compatibilities:
For ANN only value 1..127 is permitted.

INTYP INTERCEPT TYPE

This parameter restricts data display to the specified intercept type.


An intercept type contains all intercept codes which are accessed for
similar reasons.
For example, if the DIZO intercept type is specified, the data are
displayed for all created intercept codes that are accessed if call set
up fails because of problems in digit translation or zoning.
This parameter is only allowed with INCEPT=X.
Division of intercept codes into groups:
ORIG:
ANNPDIAL
MWI
OCUB
SCLSTO
TXSCASU
OACSU
CREDLIMS
CCBSMOB
TERM:
NOSERV
CHANGEDN
UNOBDN
ICUB
SCLSTT
REJDIV
ACREJ
BUSYNFEA
DIZO:
UNOBDE0
UNOBDE1
UNOBDE2
UNOBDE3
UNOBDE4
UNOBDE5
UNOBDE6
UNOBDE7
UNOBDE8
UNOBDE9
UNOBDE10
UNOBDE11
UNALLROU
ILLDEST
UNOBDE13
ANNARDN
SWUPWEEK
PINERR
SCLIMACC
SCLIMERR
SCLIMINF
KONSUC
KONUNSUC
CCSOPR
SVIOPR
ROUTING:
NOROUTE
NOALTROU

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INC- 5+


DISP INC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ALLROUBA
ANIFLIST
BLOCKLST
BLKWINFO
BASICAUS:
CALLREJ
CAUSE1
USNRESP
PROTERR
COMDEST:
SUSCI
SUSCICTX
LOOPTMC
INI1TR6
FCOFFUI
SUSVICCS
LOOPCIDR
I1TR6IN
ISUPLOOP
MOBMLOOP
CACNEXEC
CACNAUTH
BLOTRA0
MOBRCFC:
RCFNRNET
RCFPREEM
RCFFACRJ
RCFNCHAV
RCFTMPFA
RCFSWEQC
RCFRCHNA
RCFPRBLO
RCFRUNAV
RCFRFNSB
RCFBCNIM
RCFRFNIM
RCFSVNIM
RCFNMCUG
RCFCTLEX
RCFRALOS
RCFABSUB
RCFUNOB1
RCFUNOB2
RCFUNOB3
RCFRACON
PRIOQ
ANNQINFO
SNA0
SNA1
SNA2
SNA3
SNA4
OVL1
OVL2
OVL3
OVL4
INV1
INV2
INANIF
IACB
ANN
MOBORIG:
MOTFC1
MOTFC2
MOTODBIC
MOTODBIE
MOTODBPI
MOTODBPE
MOTADBAR
MOTOTAIC
MOTFC3
MOTFC4
MOTFC5
MOTOSB1
MOTOSB2
MOTOSB3
MOTOSB4

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INC- 6+


DISP INC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MOBTERM:
MTTABSUB
MTTNOPAG
MTTSUBNC
MTTUNSUB
MTTADBAR
MTTINDIA
MOBCFWD:
CFWUNCO
CFWNDUB
CFWUDUB
CFWNOREP
CFWNOPAG
CFWRADCO
CFWVIOLA
CFWIMDET
CBBUSY
CBNOREP
CBNOPAG
CBRADCO
CBIMDET
MOBCRES:
BAOC
BAOIC
BAOCEXHP
BAIC
MOBSANN:
MOBQUEUE
SANNCW
SANNCH
MPTYINV
MPTYEXT
MPTYEALL
MPTYEIND
MPTYHOLD
MOBMAPC:
MAPSYSFA
MAPDATMI
MAPUNDAT
MAPFACNT
MAPUNSUB
MAPBSNPR
MAPTSNPR
MAPRACON
MAPCUGR
MAPSNCUG
MAPIBCUG
MAPOBCUG
Up to 34 intercept types may be linked.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ORIG ORIGINATING TRAFFIC


TERM TERMINATING TRAFFIC
DIZO DIGIT TRANSLATION ZONING
ROUTING ROUTING
BASICAUS BACKWARD SIGNALED CAUSES
COMDEST COMMON DESTINATIONS
MOBRCFC MOBILE RCF ADD CAUSES
MOBORIG MOBILE ORIGINATING TRAFFIC
MOBTERM MOBILE TERMINATING TRAFFIC
MOBCFWD MOBILE CALL FORWARDING
MOBCRES MOBILE CALL RESTRICTION
MOBSANN MOBILE SERVICE ANNOUNCEMENT
MOBMAPC MOBILE MAP ADD CAUSES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INC- 7-


DISP INDIC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY INDICATION STATUS

This command displays all functional units out of service, all blocked
trunks and all catastrophe conditions. The status information appears
as a continuous message.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP INDIC : [OBJECT=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

OBJECT INDICATION OBJECT

This parameter specifies the object for an indication.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

LTG LINE TRUNK GROUP


DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT
SN SWITCHING NETWORK
MB MESSAGE BUFFER
CLOCK CENTRAL CLOCK GENERATOR
CCS COMMON CHANNEL SIGNALING
SIGLBL SIGNALING LINK BLOCKED
SYP SYSTEM PANEL
CU CENTRAL UNITS
TGBL TRUNK GROUP BLOCKED
CAT1 CATASTROPHE CONDITION 1
CAT2 CATASTROPHE CONDITION 2
TOLLCAT TOLL CATASTROPHE
ALDSUP ALARM DISPLAY SUPPRESSION
ATMF ATM FABRIC

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INDIC- 1-


DISP INEXDATA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISP INTELL.NETWORK EXCHANGE DATA

This command displays specific data of the home exchange concerning Intelligent
Network services.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP INEXDATA ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INEXDATA- 1-


ENTR INEXDATA

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTR INTELL.NETWORK EXCHANGE DATA

This command creates exchange specific data concerning the Intelligent Network
service execution on the home exchange.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR INEXDATA : <LAC= ,TDDIG= ,LCCODE=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code of the Service Switching
Point in the Intelligent Network.
If it will be used as zoning destination, the command CR ZOPT has to
be entered with the local area code specified in the CODE parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

TDDIG TRAFFIC DISCRIMINATION DIGITS

This parameter specifies the traffic discrimination digits that will


be used for all Intelligent Network application protocols for which
Service Filtering may be executed in the update mode (e.g. protocol
type SINAP1). It has to be specified in order to complete the vote
directory number given in the Update operation. In the corresponding
ENTR INSLDAT command the traffic discrimination digits are part of
the vote directory number.

Default: 01.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2 digit decimal number

LCCODE LEG CONTROLLER CODE

This parameter specifies the code for the selection of a Leg


Controller LTG. The code must be created with command CR CPT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR INEXDATA- 1-


CAN INI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Initiator

This task cancels an ’Initiator’.


The required input parameters for an unique ’Initiator’ selection are:
1) ’Initiator AET’ or alternativly ’Initiator name’
2) and ’Password type’

Note:
’Cancel Initiator’ removes the specified ’Initiator’ from the Q3 authentication
database and does not cancel an existing association.

The operation will be not executed, if no further (unrestricted) system access


possible.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN INI : [Initiator AET=] [,Initiator name=] ,Password type= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Initiator AET

This parameter specifies an remote Initiator (OS


application) by the application entity title (AET).

Dependencies:

This parameter must not be entered, if ’Initiator name’


is specified.

Input format: {nn nn nn ... }

Initiator name

This parameter defines the unique initiator name within


the specified password type.

This parameter must not be entered, if ’Initiator AET’


is specified.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

Password type

This mandatory parameter is used for an unique ’Initiator’


selection and specifies the type of password mechanism.

Input values:

’Replay protected PW’ : Initiator with a replay


protected password
’Simple PW’ : Initiator with a simple password
’No PW’ : Initiator without a password

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INI- 1-


CR INI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create Initiator

This task creates an ’Initiator’, at Q3 Authentication function with the specified


password type.
Possible password types are the "Simple PW" and the "Replay protected PW"
for simple or replay-protected authentication and type "No PW" (without password)
which supports only an identification.

Each ’Initiator’ must be specified by its AET (application entity title), except
one "Simple PW" Initiator can be defined without an AET specification.
This Initiator is then called ’Default "Simple PW" Initiator’, which allows all
unknown Initiators system access via the specified (default) simple password.

Further it is possible to define time dependencies and restrict the system access
of
each ’Initiator’ by following scheduling parameters:
- duration: defines a ’Start Time’ and ’Stop Time’ and/or
- daily scheduling: time intervals for all days of the week or
- weekly scheduling: time intervals per individual days of the week.

The parameter ’Availability status’ indicates if a ’Initiator’ with scheduling


parameters is available (’On’) or not (’Off’). The output "-" indicates that no
scheduling parameter was entered.

Note:
- The parameters for daily scheduling and weekly scheduling exclude one another.
- The scheduling paramters must be selected when the initiator is created. If not,
then it is not possible to add scheduling parameters later by ’MOD INI’.

If no scheduling parameters created then the ’Initiator’ is permanent valid and


can get system access every time.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR INI : [Initiator AET=] [,Initiator name=] ,Password type= 1
1 1
1 [,Password=] [,Verify password=] [,Accept time range=] 1
1 1
1 [,Start time=] [,Stop time=] [,Daily intervals=] 1
1 1
1 [,Weekly intervals=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Initiator AET

This parameter specifies an remote Initiator (OS


application) by the application entity title (AET).
This parameter is mandatory, except one "Simple PW"
’Initiator’ can be defined without an AET entry to allow
all unknown ’Initiators’ system access via the specified
(default) simple password.

Input format: {nn nn nn ... }

Initiator name

This parameter defines the unique initiator name within


the specified password type.

If this optional parameter is not specified, the system


generates automatically a name:

’AUTHNULLnnnn’ : for initiators without passwords


("No PW") types
’AUTHRPPWnnnn’ : for "Replay protected PW" initiators,
’AUTHSIPWnnnn’ : for "Simple PW" initiators.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

Password type

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INI- 1+
CR INI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This mandatory parameter defines the type of password


mechanism. It specifies if the ’Initiator’ should
be identified without a password or if it should be
authenticated by a simple or by a replay-protected
password.

Input values:

’Replay protected PW’ : Initiator with a replay


protected password
’Simple PW’ : Initiator with a simple password
’No PW’ : Initiator without a password

Password

This parameter specifies the password.

Prerequisites:

The password should contain at least a letter, a digit


and a special character and the password length should
be between 4 (minimum) and 24 (maximum) characters.

Input format: String (4-24 characters).

Verify password

Please enter password string again.

Input format: String (4-24 characters).

Accept time range

This parameter is only used for ’Initiators’ with


’Password type’ "Replay protected PW" to specify
the ’accept time range’.
This means the maximum time interval between generating
the authentication value at the ’Initiator’ and receiving
it at the responder.
If the parameter is not specified for an "replay
protected PW" Initiator then the default value of
5 minutes will be used.

Input format: hh:mm:ss (String )


hh hour (00..23),
mm minute (00..59),
ss second (00..59).

Start time

This parameter defines the ’Start time’ at which the


’Initiator’ gets system access.
If only the ’Start time’ is set the ’Stop time’ will be
set automatically to ’Continuous’.
The time value is rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.

Input format: standard date and time values.

Default value: actual system time


will be set if this parameter is omitted
but ’Stop time’ is set.

Stop time

This parameter defines the ’Stop time’ at which the


’Initiator’ loses system access.
If only the ’Stop time’ is set the ’Start time’ will be
set automatically to the actual system time of the switch.

Input format: option ’Continuous’


option ’Specific’ : standard date and
time values
Default value: option ’Continuous’
will be set if this parameter is omitted
but ’Start time’ is set.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INI- 2+
CR INI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Daily intervals

This parameter selects daily scheduling. Up to 6 time


intervals can be specified within the ’Initiator’ gets
system access.
If this parameter is entered the parameter for weekly
scheduling must not be entered.
The time values are rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.
Overlapping intervals are combined to one interval.

Input format : hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

Default: whole day.

Weekly intervals

This parameter selects weekly scheduling. Up to 6 time


intervals can be defined for each day of the week.
The system access will be denied on days of the week not
selected and on days with 0 intervals set. At least one
day with one interval must be selected.
If this parameter is entered the parameter for daily
scheduling must not be entered.
The time values are rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.
Overlapping intervals are combined to one interval.

Input format: hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval for one day)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

Default: selects all days of the week without any time


restriction. Inactive days must be disabled from
the default value.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INI- 3-
DISP INI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Initiator

This task is used to display the attributes of one or more ’Initiators’.


The following selection is possible:

- Output of one ’Initiator’:


--> Please enter 1) ’Initiator AET’ or ’Initiator name’
and 2) ’Password type’.

- Output of all ’Initiators’:


--> No input necessarry.

- Idividual selections:
--> You can do selection by
1) ’Initiator AET’ or ’Initiator name’ or ’Name substring’
and/or
2) ’Password type’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP INI : [Initiator AET=] [,Initiator name=] [,Name substring=] 1
1 1
1 [,Password type=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Initiator AET

This parameter specifies an remote Initiator (OS


application) by the application entity title (AET).

Dependencies:

This parameter must not be entered, if ’Initiator name’


or ’Name substring’ is specified.

Input format: {nn nn nn ... }

Initiator name

This parameter selects a initiator by a name string.

Dependencies:

This parameter must not be entered, if ’Initiator AET’


or ’Name Substring’ is specified.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

Name substring

This parameter specifies a pattern (Substring) for the


’Initiator name’. Only ’Initiators’ which name contains
this Substring at any position will be displayed.

Dependencies:

This parameter must not be entered, if ’Initiator AET’


or ’Initiator name’ is specified.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

Password type

This parameter selects Initiators by a specific password


type. If the parameter is omitted then all Initiators,
otherwise only the Initiators with the specified ’Password
type’ will be displayed.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INI- 1+


DISP INI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Input values:

’Replay protected PW’ : Initiators with a replay


protected password
’Simple PW’ : Initiators with a simple password
’No PW’ : Initiators without a password

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INI- 2-


MOD INI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Initiator

This task modifies the authentication parameters of an existing ’Initiator’.

The following parameters are used for an unique ’Initiator’ selection and
can not be changed:
1) ’Initiator AET’ or alternativly ’Initiator name’ and
2) ’Password type’.

Following parameters are changeable:


- ’Password’,
- ’Accept time range’
- ’Scheduling data’

Note: A creation of new scheduling parameters is not possible. Only


scheduling paramters selected when the initiator was created can
be modified in the following way:
- duration: replace ’Start Time’ and/or ’Stop Time’,
- daily scheduling: replace daily intervals,
- weekly scheduling: replace time intervals of single days of the week.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD INI : [Initiator AET=] [,Initiator name=] ,Password type= 1
1 1
1 [,Password=] [,Verify password=] [,Accept time range=] 1
1 1
1 [,Start time=] [,Stop time=] [,Daily intervals=] 1
1 1
1 [,Weekly intervals=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Initiator AET

This parameter specifies an remote Initiator (OS


application) by the application entity title (AET).

Dependencies:

This parameter must not be entered, if ’Initiator name’


is specified.

Input format: {nn nn nn ... }

Initiator name

This parameter defines the unique initiator name within


the specified password type.

This parameter must not be entered, if the ’Initiator AET’


is specified.

Input format: String (1-12 characters)

Password type

This mandatory parameter is used for an unique ’Initiator’


selection and specifies the type of password mechanism.

Input values:

’Replay protected PW’ : Initiator with a replay


protected password
’Simple PW’ : Initiator with a simple password
’No PW’ : Initiator without a password

Password

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INI- 1+


MOD INI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter defines the new password value.

Prerequisites:

The password should contain at least a letter, a digit


and a special character and the password length should
be between 4 (minimum) and 24 (maximum) characters.

Input format: String (4-24 characters).

Verify password

Please enter new password string again.

Input format: String (4-24 characters).

Accept time range

This parameter is only used for ’Initiators’ with


’Password type’ "Replay protected PW" to specify
the ’accept time range’.
This means the maximum time interval between generating
the authentication value at the ’Initiator’ and receiving
it at the responder.

Input format: hh:mm:ss (String )


hh hour (00..23),
mm minute (00..59),
ss second (00..59).

Start time

This parameter replaces the ’Start time’ at which the


’Initiator’ gets system access.
The parameter can be replaced only if a ’Start time’ or
’Stop time’ was entered, when the ’Initiator’ was created.

Input format: standard date and time values.

Stop time

This parameter replaces the ’Stop time’ at which the


’Initiator’ loses system access.
The parameter can be replaced only, if a ’Start time’ or
’Stop time’ was entered, when the ’Initiator’ was created.

Input format: option ’Continuous’


option ’Specific’ : standard date and
time values

Default value: option ’Continuous’

Daily intervals

This parameter replaces the ’Daily intervals’ (up to 6)


within the ’Initiator’ gets system access.
The parameter can be entered only, if ’Daily intervals’
were entered when the ’Initiator’ was created.
The time values are rounded up to a multiple of 5 minutes.
Overlapping intervals are combined to one interval.

Input format : hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

Weekly intervals

This parameter replaces the ’Weekly intervals’ within


the ’Initiator’ gets system access.
Only days of the week selected in the parameter are
replaced. The intervals of the days not selected will
not be changed.
Enter 0 intervals to disable the whole day. At least
one day with one interval must be active in the resultant
’Weekly intervals’; otherwise the parameter is rejected.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INI- 2+


MOD INI

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Input format : hh:mm-hh:mm (one interval for one day)


hh hour (00 - 23)
mm minute (00 - 59)
Use 00:00-00:00 to select the whole day

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INI- 3-


CAN INOVLCO

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL IN OVERLOAD CONTROL DATA

This command removes the Congestion Control data.

Note:
Some guidelines have to be taken into account using the following
parameters:

- using CLGPTY : SKEY is mandatory,


LOCNO and CLDPTY are incompatible,
- using LOCNO : SKEY is mandatory,
CLGPTY and CLDPTY are incompatible,
- using CLDPTY : CLGPTY and LOCNO are incompatible.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN INOVLCO : <CLDPTY= ,CLGPTY= ,LOCNO= ,SKEY=> [,CTRLTYPE=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CLDPTY CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the called party number for


which the Congestion Control data will be removed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...22 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the calling party number for


which the Congestion Control data will be removed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...22 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LOCNO LOCATION NUMBER

This parameter specifies the location number for


which the Congestion Control data will be removed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SKEY SERVICE KEY

This parameter specifies the service key for which


Congestion Control data have to be removed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

CTRLTYPE CONTROL TYPE

This parameter specifies the originator of the Congestion


Control data, which have to be deleted.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INOVLCO- 1+


CAN INOVLCO

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SSPOP SSP OPERATOR


SCPOP SCP OPERATOR
SCPAUT SCP AUTOMATIC

Default: SSPOP

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INOVLCO- 2-


DISP INOVLCO

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IN OVERLOAD CONTROL DATA

This command displays data concerning specified or all Intelligent Network


Congestion Control data. These data can be the parameters or the statistics
about Congestion Control. It is also possible to distinguish between SCP
originated or operator originated Congestion Control data.

Note:
Some guidelines have to be taken into account using the following
parameters:

- using CLGPTY : SKEY is mandatory,


LOCNO and CLDPTY are incompatible,
- using LOCNO : SKEY is mandatory,
CLGPTY and CLDPTY are incompatible,
- using CLDPTY : CLGPTY and LOCNO are incompatible.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP INOVLCO : <CLDPTY= ,CLGPTY= ,LOCNO= ,SKEY=> [,FORMAT=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,CTRLTYPE=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CLDPTY CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the called party number for which


Congestion Control data have to be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...22 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the calling party number for which


Congestion Control data have to be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...22 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LOCNO LOCATION NUMBER

This parameter specifies the location number for which


Congestion Control data have to be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SKEY SERVICE KEY

This parameter specifies the service key for which


Congestion Control data have to be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INOVLCO- 1+


DISP INOVLCO

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

FORMAT FORMAT

This parameter specifies the kind of data which has to be displayed:


- PA has to be used for the selection of control data for a
specified SKEY, CLDPTY, CLGPTY or LOCNO.
- ST has to be used for the selection of SKEY, CLDPTY,
CLGPTY or LOCNO specific statistic data.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PA DISPLAY CONTROL PARAMETERS


ST DISPLAY CONTROL STATISTICS

This parameter determines whether to display statistics


or the parameters of Congestion Control.

Default: PA

CTRLTYPE CONTROL TYPE

This parameter specifies the originator of the Congestion


Control data, which have to be displayed.
If no value is entered the data of all origins will be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SSPOP SSP OPERATOR


SCPOP SCP OPERATOR
SCPAUT SCP AUTOMATIC

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INOVLCO- 2-


ENTR INOVLCO

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER IN OVERLOAD CONTROL DATA

This command enters the control data to prevent the SCP


from overload. This will be done for a control criterion,
i.e. either for a given service key SKEY, called party
number CLDPTY, calling party number CLGPTY or location
number LOCNO. The maximal number of controlled and allowed
requests to the SCP concerning the control criterion is
specified by the parameter BURST. The decrease value
DECVAL is expected to be the number of requests answered in
the decrease time DECTIME.

Prerequisites:

- a service key must have been created with the command


CR INTRIG.

Note:
Some guidelines have to be taken into account using the following
parameters:

- using CLGPTY : SKEY is mandatory,


LOCNO and CLDPTY are incompatible,
- using LOCNO : SKEY is mandatory,
CLGPTY and CLDPTY are incompatible,
- using CLDPTY : CLGPTY and LOCNO are incompatible.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR INOVLCO : CODURA= ,BURST= ,DECVAL= <,SKEY= ,CLDPTY= 1
1 1
1 ,CLGPTY= ,LOCNO=> [,DECTIME=] [,RELCA=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,TREAT=] [,DURA=] [,ANNCYC=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODURA CONTROL DURATION

This parameter specifies the control duration in seconds.


A value greater than 86400 means an infinite duration.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...99999, range of decimal numbers

BURST BURST OF ALL. SIMUL. CALLS

This parameter specifies the maximal number of controlled and


simultaneous allowed requests to the SCP concerning the
control criterion.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...65535, range of decimal numbers

DECVAL DECREASE VALUE

This parameter specifies the decrease value.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...65535, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR INOVLCO- 1+


ENTR INOVLCO

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SKEY SERVICE KEY

This parameter is used to specify the control criterion, i.e.


the IN service for which overload control data will be
entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

CLDPTY CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter is used to specify the control criterion, i.e.


the called party number for which overload control data will be
entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...22 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter is used to specify the control criterion, i.e.


the calling party number for which overload control data will be
entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...22 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LOCNO LOCATION NUMBER

This parameter is used to specify the control criterion, i.e.


the location number for which overload control data will be
entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DECTIME DECREASE TIME

This parameter specifies the decrease time in milliseconds.


There is a different handling for the decrease time
between Callgapping for ETSI and BELLCORE-IN:
ETSI:
A value greater than 60000 means an infinite decrease time.
Incompatibilities:
- if BURST greater than 0,
this parameter value must not be greater than 60000
BELLCORE:
A value greater than 300000 is blocked.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...999999, range of decimal numbers

Default: 100

RELCA RELEASE CAUSE

This parameter specifies the release cause, which will be used


to control the call release and intercept treatment. It is related
to the announcement determined by the TREAT parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LOCATION
USER USER
PRL PRIV. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR INOVLCO- 2+


ENTR INOVLCO

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PUL PUB. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER


TRN TRANSIT NETWORK
PUR PUB. NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
PRR PRIV.NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
INTN INTERNATIONAL NETWORK
IWP BEYOND AN INTERWORKING POINT

Default: PUL

b: CAUSE VALUE=
0...127, range of decimal numbers

Default: 42

TREAT CALL TREATMENT

This parameter specifies the intercept code for blocked IN calls.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: ANNOUNCEMENT IDENTIFICATION
TONE SCP TONE
ANN SCP ANNOUNCEMENT

Default: TONE

b: ADDITIONAL NUMERIC VALUE=


1...126, range of decimal numbers

Compatibilities:
- For TONE identifier this value is of range (1..31).

Default: 4

DURA ANNOUNCEMENT / TONE DURATION

This parameter specifies the time limitation of the entered tone or


announcement. It is related to the tone / announcement determined
by the TREAT parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...255, range of decimal numbers

Default: 40

ANNCYC ANNOUNCEMENT CYCLES

This parameter specifies the number of cycles of the entered


announcement. It is related to the announcement determined by the
TREAT parameter.

Incompatibilities:
- if TREAT = TONE, this parameter is not allowed

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7, range of decimal numbers

Default: 1

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR INOVLCO- 3-


RSET INPLOG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Reset Input Log Function

This task resets the Input Log Function. The log files
are closed (Master, Q3 binary and text file, and, in
where applicable, an MML log file). This procedure may
take longer than expected, as already started data base
changes must all be finished. The user defined part of
the log file names which was entered with ’Log file
name’, and a separate message with the fully specified
file name of the Master file, are returned to the user.
Use FTP to save the files belonging to the currently
closed master file , or have them executed by the Log
Executor (relevant file names are contained in the
Master file). If, however the Input Log Function is
already reset, a message is displayed but no other
information is returned.
This task does not mean just interrupting the logging
procedure, it generally resets the whole function. I.e.
it is not possible to continue with logging using the
same log files.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 RSET INPLOG ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RSET INPLOG- 1-


SET INPLOG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Set Input Log Function

This task activates the Input Log Function to log


database changes. New log files are created. These are
the Master, Q3 binary and text file, and, where
applicable, an MML log file. The input parameter
’Log file name’ specifies the user defined part of
the log file names. This means that if this part is
’TEST’, files with the following file names are created:
\LG.TEST.A0.MASTER, \LG.TEST.A1.Q3B, \LG.TEST.A1.Q3T
(and \LG.TEST.A1.MML). Additionally the ’Swap file size’
can be specified to limit the log file sizes so that
they fit on a single MOD. When reaching the limit,
the old log files are closed and new ones are created
with an incremented ’Extension’ part (A1..A9, B1..B9,
..Z1..Z9). The ’Log file name’ that has actually been
used and the current ’Swap file size’ are returned
to the user

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 SET INPLOG : [Log file name=] [,Swap file size=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Log file name

This parameter specifies the user defined part of the


log file names. File names are structured as follows:
\LG.<user def. part>.<’Extension’>.<type>. ’Extension’
and type are automatically filled in. File names must
be unique, i.e. user parts that are currently used on
disk, are not allowed to be used.
Input format: String of 1..17 characters valid in file
names. The following characters are allowed
’A’,’B’,’C’,’D’,’E’,’F’,’G’,’H’,’I’,’J’,’K’,’L’,’M’,
’N’,’O’,’P’,’Q’,’R’,’S’,’T’,’U’,’V’,’W’,’X’,’Y’,’Z’,
’a’,’b’,’c’,’d’,’e’,’f’,’g’,’h’,’i’,’j’,’k’,’l’,’m’,
’n’,’o’,’p’,’q’,’r’,’s’,’t’,’u’,’v’,’w’,’x’,’y’,’z’,
’0’,’1’,’2’,’3’,’4’,’5’,’6’,’7’,’8’,’9’,
’!’,’$’,’%’,’&’,’#’,’+’,’-’,’_’,’(’,’)’,’,’,’/’,
’;’,’<’,’=’,’>’,’@’,’[’,’]’,’{’,’}’,’|’.
Default value: current date and time as string.

Swap file size

This parameter specifies a threshold limit in bytes. If


the sum of the sizes of the two (three) log files (not
counting the master file) reaches this value, the log
files are automatically closed, and new ones with an
incremented ’Extension’ are created. The master log
file is not replaced but new references to the new log
files will be appended.
If an out-of-range value is specified, it will be
automatically corrected to the nearest limit without
error indication. If not specified, the value used
previously is kept, or, if not appropriate, a default
value (20000 kB) is used internally.
Input format: Range 1000..10000 kB.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 SET INPLOG- 1-


STAT INPLOG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Status of Input Log Function

This task displays the status of the Input Log


Function. After successful execution the following
attributes are displayed:
’Log file name’: user part of the currently used
log file names;
’Extension’: index part of the file names;
’Administrative state’: indicates whether ILG is active
or not;
’Operational state’: indicates whether ILG is
functioning properly;
’Procedural status’: if filled in, it indicates a
temporary condition. Value ’Initialising’ means being
activated, ’Terminating’ means being reset (running
jobs are awaited, new jobs are rejected. Log files
are not yet closed);
’Swap file size’ : threshold limit size for internal
file swapping;
’Reason for error’: additional information if
Operational state is disabled;
’Blocked state’ : indicates a database lock initiated
by Software Management

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT INPLOG ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT INPLOG- 1-


ACT INPLOGEX

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Activate Input Log Execution

This task starts the incorporation of Input Log files.


One master file can be incorporated by this task.
A ’Start number’ both for Q3 requests and
MML commands saved in input logging files and a ’Stop
number’ can be specified. The ’Device name’ is to specify
where the logging files are available. If the execution is to
start at the first Q3 entry in the master, you do not
need to specify a ’Start Q3 number’ and similary, if
the execution is to start at the first MML entry in the master,
you do not need to specify a ’Start MML number’. If
the execution is to stop at the last entry, no
’Stop number’ needs to be specified.
The response will idicate, whether the execution was sucessful. If
the requested files could not be executed completely, then the
following error protocol files will be created:

(in the following file names the double backslashes are only simple,
but the script language does not allow simple backslash)

\LG.<File name>.LEXERR.nnn : a list of all problems,


which are occured during
the log execution,
\LG.<File name>.LEXLMR.nnn : a copy of \NET.RESULT file,
if a Layer Management config
file could not be incorporated,
LG.LEXOUT.nnn : (located on the CP disc!)
The error responses of MML
applications.

You can stop the Input Log Execution by the task ’Deactivate
Input Log Execution’ and request the status of Input Log Execution
by the task ’Display Status of Input Log Execution’.
Do not start this task before your previous ’Activate
Input Log Execution’ task has finished. No multiple start allowed.
WARNING: Execution of this task may take a long time!

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT INPLOGEX : Device name= ,File name= [,Start MML number=] 1
1 1
1 [,Start Q3 number=] [,Stop number=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Device name

This parameter defines the


name of device, where the
input logging files stored.

Input format: SYS, MOD0, MOD1.

File name

This parameter defines the name


of the master file to be executed.

Input format: String (1-17 characters)


valid in file names.

Start MML number

This parameter specifies, at which


sequence number the execution of MML
commandos in the master file is to
begin.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT INPLOGEX- 1+


ACT INPLOGEX

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

If the execution is to start at the


first entry in the file, no sequence
number needs to be specified.

Input format : Integer

Start Q3 number

This parameter specifies, at which


sequence number the execution of Q3
requests in the master file is to
begin.
If execution is to start at the first
entry in the file, no sequence number
needs to be specified.

Input format : Integer

Stop number

This parameter specifies, at which


sequence number the execution is to
finish.
If the execution is to stop at the last
entry in the file, no sequence number
has to be specified.

Input format : Integer

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT INPLOGEX- 2-


DACT INPLOGEX

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Deactivate Input Log Execution

This task deactivates Input Log Execution.


The task displays the following information: confirmation
about termination, the file name and the sequence number of the
MML command, SCI counter, Q3 request or Q3 linked request
which was incorporated last.
After a stop the execution is to start at the first entry,
which was not incorporated yet. If the excution stopped at a
Q3 linked entry or at an SCI, then it is to decide, whether
the Q3T or the MML file has to be edited.
No deactivation is possible, if the Input Log Execution was not
activated before.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT INPLOGEX ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT INPLOGEX- 1-


STAT INPLOGEX

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Status of Input Log Execution

Purpose of this task is to display the status of Input Log


Execution.
The task displays the following information: status of the
Input Log Execution (running or not running), the currently
used file name, the sequence number of the
MML command, SCI counter, Q3 request or Q3 linked request
which was incorporated last.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT INPLOGEX ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT INPLOGEX- 1-


CAN INPLOGFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Input Log File

Cancel Input Log File

This task cancels (deletes) input log files on the MP.


It can be used for SSNC standalone and also for
coupled CP-MP systems, because in coupled systems
log files are located on the MP side only.
Log files can be cancelled on the MP system disk or
on a magneto-optical MP disk (MOD).
All log files of a swap extension are always cancelled
together. The swap extensions that should be
cancelled must be specified in parameter
’Swap extensions’.

Output:
The output of this task shows:
- Files that are successfully cancelled.
- Files that are not cancelled because of an error.
- Files that are not closed, which cannot be cancelled
for this reason.
- Swap extensions specified in the input string which
do not exist.
Only those categories which are not empty are shown in
the output.
The entities listed in the output are swap extensions and
the master log file, which is represented by the logical
log file name.

Notes:
- Only closed log files can be cancelled. The master
log file can only be cancelled when all its log files
are closed.
- A confirmation is requested before the log files are
cancelled.
- When one log file of a swap extension cannot be
cancelled, the task tries to cancel remaining log files
of the swap extension. The output string will indicate
that this swap extension was not successfully
cancelled.
- If the master log file is not cancelled itself, it is
modified: All references to successfully and not
successfully cancelled swap extensions are
removed. This is necessary, because a problem
would arise if the MP could not find cancelled
log files that are still listed in the master log file. Not
successfully cancelled swap extensions are also removed
from the master, because some of their log files
could have been cancelled.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN INPLOGFILE : Swap extensions= ,Device name= ,Log file name= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Swap extensions

Swap extensions to be cancelled

This parameter specifies the entities that are cancelled.


Possible entities are swap extensions and the master
log file.

Input format:
- String without any restriction of length.
- ?

Input values:
- A blank-delimited string of entities, e.g.
"InputLog1 .A1 .A2 .A3". The logical log file name
("InputLog1" in this example) represents the master

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INPLOGFILE- 1+


CAN INPLOGFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

log file. Specified swap extensions that are not defined


in the master log file are ignored.
- ? to get such a string containing all entities that can
be cancelled, i.e. all closed swap extensions and the
logical log file name (representing the master log file;
all swap extension must be closed to cancel the
master log file). The string can be used as input to
this parameter.

This parameter must be specified, except when ? is entered


to one of the other two parameters.

Device name

Device name of MP disk

This parameter specifies the MP system disk or


MP MOD (magneto-optical disk) from which the log files
are cancelled.

Input format:
- MDD, MOD0 or MOD1
- ?

Input values:
- MDD to cancel log files on the MP system disk.
- The device name of a MP MOD. Valid device names
are MOD0 and MOD1.
- ? to get the names of all available MP disks.

Default: MDD

Log file name

Logical log file name

This parameter specifies the logical name of the log


files that are cancelled.
The logical name is the part of the full file name which
can be defined by the user, and which is common to all
related log files. For instance, it is the <LogicalName>
part of the full name LG.<LogicalName>.A0.MASTER of
a master log file.
The log files must be located on the MP system disk, if
parameter ’Device name’ is MDD, or on the MP MOD
specified by parameter ’Device name’.

Input format:
- 1..17 characters without space:
letters (also capitals), numbers, and the characters
! $ % & # + - _ ( ) , / ; < = > @ [ ] { } |
- ?
This parameter is case-sensitive.

Input values:
- An existing logical log file name.
- ? to get a list of all logical log file names on the
specified MP device.

This parameter must be specified, except when ? is entered


to parameter ’Device name’.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INPLOGFILE- 2-


COPY INPLOGFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Copy Input Log File

Copy Input Log File

This task copies input log files from the MP system


disk to a MP MOD (magneto-optical disk).
It can be used for SSNC standalone and also for
coupled CP-MP systems, because in coupled systems
log files are located on the MP side only.
It is possible to copy all closed log files mentioned in
the master log file, or to specify particular swap
extensions that are copied.
All log files of a swap extension are always copied
together.
The master log file is always copied.

Output:
The output of this task shows:
- Files that are successfully copied.
- Files that are not copied because of an error,
e.g. if the destination disk is full.
- Files that are not closed, which cannot be copied
for this reason.
- Swap extensions specified in the input string which
do not exist.
Only those categories which are not empty are shown in
the output.
The entities listed in the output are swap extensions and
the master log file, which is represented by the logical
log file name.
If parameter ’Swap extensions’ is empty, all closed swap
extensions are copied and appear in the output.

Preconditions:
- There must be enough free disk space on the
destination MOD. The available disk space is
checked before a swap extension is copied. If there
is not enough space for all the log files of the swap
extension, these log files are not copied. The output
indicates that this swap extension is not copied.
Further swap extensions are copied if there is
enough disk space available for them. In the same
way, the master input log file is copied only if there
is enough free disk space for it. It is the last file
that is copied.

Possible Effects:
- It is not checked if log files have already been copied
to the destination disk before. Log files on the
destination disk are overwritten without a warning
message.
- When one log file of a swap extension cannot be
copied, the whole swap extension is not copied. All
its remaining log files found on the destination disk
are cancelled. The output indicates that this
swap extension is not successfully copied.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 COPY INPLOGFILE : Swap extensions= ,Device name= ,Log file name= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Swap extensions

Swap extensions to be copied

This parameter specifies the swap extensions that are


copied.
The master log file is always copied.

Input format:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 COPY INPLOGFILE- 1+


COPY INPLOGFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- String without any restriction of length.


- ?

Input values:
- A blank-delimited string of swap extensions, e.g.
".A1 .A2 .A3". Specified swap extensions that are
not defined in the master log file are ignored.
- ? to get such a string containing all swap extensions
that can be copied, i.e. all closed swap extensions.
The string can be used as input to this parameter.

Default:
All closed swap extensions are copied.

Device name

Device name of MP MOD

This parameter specifies the magneto-optical MP disk


(MOD) to which the log files are copied.

Input format:
- MOD0 or MOD1
- ?

Input values:
- The device name of a MP MOD. Valid device names
are MOD0 and MOD1.
- ? to get the names of all available MP MODs.

This parameter must be specified, except when ? is entered


to one of the other two parameters.

Log file name

Logical log file name

This parameter specifies the logical name of the log


files that are copied.
The logical name is the part of the full file name which
can be defined by the user, and which is common to all
related log files. For instance, it is the <LogicalName>
part of the full name LG.<LogicalName>.A0.MASTER of
a master log file.
The log files must be located on the MP system disk.

Input format:
- 1..17 characters without space:
letters (also capitals), numbers, and the characters
! $ % & # + - _ ( ) , / ; < = > @ [ ] { } |
- ?
This parameter is case-sensitive.

Input values:
- An existing logical log file name.
- ? to get a list of all logical log file names on the
MP system disk.

This parameter must be specified, except when ? is entered


to parameter ’Device name’.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 COPY INPLOGFILE- 2-


MOD INPLOGFILE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Input Log Files

This task changes active log files created by the Input


Log Function. The old log files are closed (Master, Q3
binary and text file, and, where applicable, an MML log
file). This procedure may take longer than expected, as
already started data base changes must all be finished.
After finishing this task, the user defined part of the
old log file names and a separate message with the fully
specified file name of the old Master file are returned
to the user. Use FTP to save the files belonging to the
currently closed master file, or have them executed by
the Log Executor (relevant file names are contained in
the Master file). Then the new log files (similar to the
closed ones: new Master, Q3 binary and text file, and,
where applicable, an MML log file), specified by input
parameters are created. The input parameter New log file
name specifies the user defined part of the new log file
names. This means that if this part is specified as
’TEST’, files with the following file names are created:
\LG.TEST.A0.MASTER, \LG.TEST.A1.Q3B, \LG.TEST.A1.Q3T
(and \LG.TEST.A1.MML). Additionally the ’Swap file size’
can be modified which limits the log file sizes so that
they fit on a single MOD. The new log file name that has
actually been used and the current ’Swap file size’ are
also returned to the user

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD INPLOGFILE : [New log file name=] [,Swap file size=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

New log file name

This parameter specifies the user defined part of log


file names. File names are structured as follows:
\LG.<user def. Part>.<’Extension’>.<type>. ’Extension’
and type are automatically filled in. File names must
be unique, i.e. user parts that are currently used on
disk, are not allowed to be used.
Input format: String of 1..17 characters valid in file
names. The following characters are allowed
’A’,’B’,’C’,’D’,’E’,’F’,’G’,’H’,’I’,’J’,’K’,’L’,’M’,
’N’,’O’,’P’,’Q’,’R’,’S’,’T’,’U’,’V’,’W’,’X’,’Y’,’Z’,
’a’,’b’,’c’,’d’,’e’,’f’,’g’,’h’,’i’,’j’,’k’,’l’,’m’,
’n’,’o’,’p’,’q’,’r’,’s’,’t’,’u’,’v’,’w’,’x’,’y’,’z’,
’0’,’1’,’2’,’3’,’4’,’5’,’6’,’7’,’8’,’9’,
’!’,’$’,’%’,’&’,’#’,’+’,’-’,’_’,’(’,’)’,’,’,’/’,
’;’,’<’,’=’,’>’,’@’,’[’,’]’,’{’,’}’,’|’.
Default value: current date and time as string.

Swap file size

This parameter specifies a threshold limit in bytes.


If the sum of the sizes of the two (three) log files
(not counting the master file) reaches this value,
the log files are automatically closed, and new ones
with an incremented ’Extension’ are created. The
master log file is not replaced but new references to
the new log files will be appended.
If an out-of-range value is specified, it will be
automatically corrected to the nearest limit without
error indication. If not specified, the value used
previously is kept.
Input format: Range 1000..10000 kB.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INPLOGFILE- 1-


CAN INSCM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CAN IN SERVICE CLASS MARK

This command removes an IN service class mark.

Prerequisites:
- No IN service class mark reference (assigned with the MML command
CR INSCMREF) and no IN authorization (assigned with the MML command
CR INAUTH) may exist which refer to this IN service class.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN INSCM : SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be removed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INSCM- 1-


CR INSCM
TDP1
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE IN SERVICE CLASS MARK

This command creates an INSCM that is used for the installation


of trigger detection points (TDP) of several types.
The following types of trigger detection points can be controlled
with IN service class marks:

TDP1 - Originating Attempt Authorized:


This trigger is detected in the A-side seizure processing when the
off-hook for a certain object is detected.

TDP2 - Collected Information:


This trigger is detected when the A-side wants to setup a call and
a specified number of digits is collected.

TDP3 - Analyzed Information:


This trigger is detected during the IN specific analysis of the
called party number, the calling party number or its category.

TDP4 - Route Select Failure:


This trigger is detected when the indication was received that no
route to the required destination can be found.

TDP5 - Originating Busy:


This trigger is detected when the originating call party receives
an indication of user busy from the terminating call party.

TDP6 - Originating No Answer:


This trigger is detected in the A-side processing when the B-side
does not answer and the no-answer timer is expired.

TDP5O6 - Combines TDP5 and TDP6.

TDP12 - Terminating Attempt Authorized:


This trigger is detected in the B-side seizure processing when the
the call setup to a certain object was detected.

TDP13 - Terminating Busy:


This trigger is detected in the B-side seizure processing when the
B-party is busy.

TDP14 - Terminating No Answer:


This trigger is detected in the B-side seizure processing when the
B-side does not answer and the no-answer timer is expired.

TDP13O14 - Combines TDP13 and TDP14.

Precondition for the use of a trigger detection point is the creation


and the activation of an INSCM reference (respectively by the CR INSCMREF
and ACT INSCMREF command) or the creation of an IN authorization
(by means of the command CR INAUTH)

Prerequisites:
- The trigger profile referenced by the parameter PRID has to
be created by command CR INTRIG.
- SSF type must be NORMAL.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR INSCM - TDP1 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 1


2. CR INSCM - TDP12 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 12
3. CR INSCM - TDP13 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13
4. CR INSCM - TDP13O14 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13O14
5. CR INSCM - TDP14 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 14
6. CR INSCM - TDP2 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 2
7. CR INSCM - TDP3 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 3
8. CR INSCM - TDP4 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 4
9. CR INSCM - TDP5 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5
10. CR INSCM - TDP5O6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5O6
11. CR INSCM - TDP6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 6

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 1+
CR INSCM
TDP1
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 1

Creation of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP1.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR INSCM : SCMID= ,TYPE= ,PRID= [,PREFIX=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP1 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 1

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 2+
CR INSCM
TDP12
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 12

Creation of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP12.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR INSCM : SCMID= ,TYPE= ,PRID= [,PREFIX=] [,COLDIG=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,CLDPTY=] [,NCLDPTY=] [,CLGPTY=] [,PROP=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP12 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 12

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

COLDIG COLLECT DIGITS

This parameter specifies the number of called party digits to be


collected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...14, range of decimal numbers

CLDPTY CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of a dialled


digit combination.
- Either it can be used to detect an IN service request for destination
numbers starting with the entered digits.
- Or it can be used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service
request for a destination number if the complete number is entered as

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 3+
CR INSCM
TDP12
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

B-number in the IN-authorization database (see CR INAUTH).


In this case only a single parameter value equal to "*" must be
administered.

Compatibilities:
If used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service request
for a destination number when the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database following rules are
valid :
- only allowed for TDP12.
- the parameter PRID must not be entered.
- the parameter NCLDPTY may be entered. Numbers entered with this
parameter are not triggered.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NCLDPTY NOT CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of


a NOT dialled digit combination. It is used to detect an
IN service request for destination numbers NOT starting
with the entered digits.

Compatibities:
- CLDPTY=*. See parameter CLDPTY for more information.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter
must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PROP PROPERTY

This parameter specifies the SCM properties.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

<CNAM > CALLING NAME NOT PRESENT


< > This parameter value specifies an extra trigger
< > condition. It is used to detect an IN service
< > request depending on the unavailability of the
< > calling name.
<PROP3 > PROPERTY 3
<PROP4 > PROPERTY 4
<PROP5 > PROPERTY 5
<PROP6 > PROPERTY 6
<PROP7 > PROPERTY 7
<PROP8 > PROPERTY 8
<PROP9 > PROPERTY 9

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 4+
CR INSCM
TDP13
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13

Creation of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP13.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR INSCM : SCMID= ,TYPE= ,PRID= [,PREFIX=] [,CLGPTY=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,RELCA=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP13 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter
must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 5+
CR INSCM
TDP13
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RELCA RELEASE CAUSE

This parameter specifies the release cause, which will be used


to trigger IN depending on the call release.
It can be entered for the trigger types TDP4, TDP5, TDP5O6, TDP13
or TDP13O14.

Notes:
- Up to 3 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: CAUSE VALUE=
0...127, range of decimal numbers

b: LOCATION
INTN INTERNATIONAL NETWORK
IWP BEYOND AN INTERWORKING POINT
PRL PRIV. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PRR PRIV.NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
PUL PUB. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PUR PUB. NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
TRN TRANSIT NETWORK
USER USER

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 6+
CR INSCM
TDP13O14
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13O14

Creation of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP13O14.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR INSCM : SCMID= ,TYPE= ,PRID= [,PREFIX=] ,NOANST= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,CLGPTY=] [,RELCA=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP13O14 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13O14

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NOANST NO ANSWER TIME

This parameter specifies the value of the NO-ANSWER timer


for TDP6, TDP5O6, TDP14 or TDP13O14

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...60, range of decimal numbers

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 7+
CR INSCM
TDP13O14
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

RELCA RELEASE CAUSE

This parameter specifies the release cause, which will be used


to trigger IN depending on the call release.
It can be entered for the trigger types TDP4, TDP5, TDP5O6, TDP13
or TDP13O14.

Notes:
- Up to 3 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: CAUSE VALUE=
0...127, range of decimal numbers

b: LOCATION
INTN INTERNATIONAL NETWORK
IWP BEYOND AN INTERWORKING POINT
PRL PRIV. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PRR PRIV.NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
PUL PUB. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PUR PUB. NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
TRN TRANSIT NETWORK
USER USER

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 8+
CR INSCM
TDP14
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 14

Creation of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP14.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR INSCM : SCMID= ,TYPE= ,PRID= [,PREFIX=] ,NOANST= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,CLGPTY=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP14 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 14

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NOANST NO ANSWER TIME

This parameter specifies the value of the NO-ANSWER timer


for TDP6, TDP5O6, TDP14 or TDP13O14

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...60, range of decimal numbers

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 9+
CR INSCM
TDP14
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 10+


CR INSCM
TDP2
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

6. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 2

Creation of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP2.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR INSCM : SCMID= ,TYPE= ,PRID= [,PREFIX=] ,COLDIG= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,ESCAPE=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP2 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 2

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

COLDIG COLLECT DIGITS

This parameter specifies the number of called party digits to be


collected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...14, range of decimal numbers

ESCAPE ESCAPE CODE

This parameter specifies the escape code to be used in case


of TDP2 for the setup of a normal non-IN call.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...2 digit decimal number

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 11+


CR INSCM
TDP3
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

7. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 3

Creation of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP3.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR INSCM : SCMID= ,TYPE= [,PRID=] [,PREFIX=] [,COLDIG=] 1
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,CLDPTY= 11 (;) 1
1 1Z,NCLDPTY=Y1 [,CLGPTY=] [,CAT=] [,NCAT=] [,PROP=] Z Y 1
1 11 11 *!+ 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP3 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 3

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

COLDIG COLLECT DIGITS

This parameter specifies the number of called party digits to be


collected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...14, range of decimal numbers

CLDPTY CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of a dialled


digit combination.
- Either it can be used to detect an IN service request for destination
numbers starting with the entered digits.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 12+


CR INSCM
TDP3
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- Or it can be used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service


request for a destination number if the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database (see CR INAUTH).
In this case only a single parameter value equal to "*" must be
administered.

Compatibilities:
If used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service request
for a destination number when the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database following rules are
valid :
- only allowed for TDP12.
- the parameter PRID must not be entered.
- the parameter NCLDPTY may be entered. Numbers entered with this
parameter are not triggered.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NCLDPTY NOT CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of


a NOT dialled digit combination. It is used to detect an
IN service request for destination numbers NOT starting
with the entered digits.

Compatibities:
- CLDPTY=*. See parameter CLDPTY for more information.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter
must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CAT CALLING PARTY CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the category of calling party. It is


used to restrict the IN-triggering to a specific category of
calling parties.

Notes:
- This parameter has the opposite effect as NCAT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 13+


CR INSCM
TDP3
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CAT15 CATEGORY 15
COINB COIN BOX
DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
OPOSINAT OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the category of the calling party.

NCAT NOT CALLING PARTY CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the category of calling party. It is used


to restrict the IN-triggering to calling parties which are NOT of
the entered category.

Notes:
- This parameter has the opposite effect as a.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15
COINB COIN BOX
DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
OPOSINAT OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the category of the calling party.

PROP PROPERTY

This parameter specifies the SCM properties.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ETRIND EVALUATE RETRIGGER INDICATION


This parameter value specifies that the retrigger
indication "IN Triggering Inhibited After Connect"
delivered by the IN service logic will be
evaluated.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 14+


CR INSCM
TDP4
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

8. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 4

Creation of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP4.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR INSCM : SCMID= ,TYPE= ,PRID= [,PREFIX=] [,COLDIG=] 1
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,CLDPTY= 11 (;) 1
1 1Z,NCLDPTY=Y1 [,CLGPTY=] [,RELCA=] Z Y 1
1 11 11 *!+ 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP4 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 4

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

COLDIG COLLECT DIGITS

This parameter specifies the number of called party digits to be


collected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...14, range of decimal numbers

CLDPTY CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of a dialled


digit combination.
- Either it can be used to detect an IN service request for destination
numbers starting with the entered digits.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 15+


CR INSCM
TDP4
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- Or it can be used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service


request for a destination number if the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database (see CR INAUTH).
In this case only a single parameter value equal to "*" must be
administered.

Compatibilities:
If used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service request
for a destination number when the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database following rules are
valid :
- only allowed for TDP12.
- the parameter PRID must not be entered.
- the parameter NCLDPTY may be entered. Numbers entered with this
parameter are not triggered.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NCLDPTY NOT CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of


a NOT dialled digit combination. It is used to detect an
IN service request for destination numbers NOT starting
with the entered digits.

Compatibities:
- CLDPTY=*. See parameter CLDPTY for more information.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter
must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

RELCA RELEASE CAUSE

This parameter specifies the release cause, which will be used


to trigger IN depending on the call release.
It can be entered for the trigger types TDP4, TDP5, TDP5O6, TDP13
or TDP13O14.

Notes:
- Up to 3 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: CAUSE VALUE=
0...127, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 16+


CR INSCM
TDP4
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: LOCATION
INTN INTERNATIONAL NETWORK
IWP BEYOND AN INTERWORKING POINT
PRL PRIV. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PRR PRIV.NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
PUL PUB. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PUR PUB. NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
TRN TRANSIT NETWORK
USER USER

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 17+


CR INSCM
TDP5
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

9. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5

Creation of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP5.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,CLDPTY= 11 1
1 CR INSCM : SCMID= ,TYPE= ,PRID= [,PREFIX=] 1Z,NCLDPTY=Y1 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,CLGPTY=] [,RELCA=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP5 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLDPTY CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of a dialled


digit combination.
- Either it can be used to detect an IN service request for destination
numbers starting with the entered digits.
- Or it can be used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service
request for a destination number if the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database (see CR INAUTH).
In this case only a single parameter value equal to "*" must be
administered.

Compatibilities:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 18+


CR INSCM
TDP5
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

If used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service request


for a destination number when the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database following rules are
valid :
- only allowed for TDP12.
- the parameter PRID must not be entered.
- the parameter NCLDPTY may be entered. Numbers entered with this
parameter are not triggered.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NCLDPTY NOT CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of


a NOT dialled digit combination. It is used to detect an
IN service request for destination numbers NOT starting
with the entered digits.

Compatibities:
- CLDPTY=*. See parameter CLDPTY for more information.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter
must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

RELCA RELEASE CAUSE

This parameter specifies the release cause, which will be used


to trigger IN depending on the call release.
It can be entered for the trigger types TDP4, TDP5, TDP5O6, TDP13
or TDP13O14.

Notes:
- Up to 3 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: CAUSE VALUE=
0...127, range of decimal numbers

b: LOCATION
INTN INTERNATIONAL NETWORK
IWP BEYOND AN INTERWORKING POINT
PRL PRIV. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PRR PRIV.NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
PUL PUB. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 19+


CR INSCM
TDP5
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PUR PUB. NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER


TRN TRANSIT NETWORK
USER USER

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 20+


CR INSCM
TDP5O6
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

10. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5O6

Creation of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP5O6.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR INSCM : SCMID= ,TYPE= ,PRID= [,PREFIX=] ,NOANST= 1
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,CLDPTY= 11 (;) 1
1 1Z,NCLDPTY=Y1 [,CLGPTY=] [,RELCA=] Z Y 1
1 11 11 *!+ 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP5O6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5O6

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NOANST NO ANSWER TIME

This parameter specifies the value of the NO-ANSWER timer


for TDP6, TDP5O6, TDP14 or TDP13O14

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...60, range of decimal numbers

CLDPTY CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of a dialled


digit combination.
- Either it can be used to detect an IN service request for destination
numbers starting with the entered digits.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 21+


CR INSCM
TDP5O6
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- Or it can be used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service


request for a destination number if the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database (see CR INAUTH).
In this case only a single parameter value equal to "*" must be
administered.

Compatibilities:
If used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service request
for a destination number when the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database following rules are
valid :
- only allowed for TDP12.
- the parameter PRID must not be entered.
- the parameter NCLDPTY may be entered. Numbers entered with this
parameter are not triggered.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NCLDPTY NOT CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of


a NOT dialled digit combination. It is used to detect an
IN service request for destination numbers NOT starting
with the entered digits.

Compatibities:
- CLDPTY=*. See parameter CLDPTY for more information.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter
must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

RELCA RELEASE CAUSE

This parameter specifies the release cause, which will be used


to trigger IN depending on the call release.
It can be entered for the trigger types TDP4, TDP5, TDP5O6, TDP13
or TDP13O14.

Notes:
- Up to 3 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: CAUSE VALUE=
0...127, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 22+


CR INSCM
TDP5O6
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: LOCATION
INTN INTERNATIONAL NETWORK
IWP BEYOND AN INTERWORKING POINT
PRL PRIV. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PRR PRIV.NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
PUL PUB. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PUR PUB. NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
TRN TRANSIT NETWORK
USER USER

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 23+


CR INSCM
TDP6
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

11. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 6

Creation of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP6.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR INSCM : SCMID= ,TYPE= ,PRID= [,PREFIX=] ,NOANST= 1
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,CLDPTY= 11 (;) 1
1 1Z,NCLDPTY=Y1 [,CLGPTY=] Z Y 1
1 11 11 *!+ 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 6

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NOANST NO ANSWER TIME

This parameter specifies the value of the NO-ANSWER timer


for TDP6, TDP5O6, TDP14 or TDP13O14

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...60, range of decimal numbers

CLDPTY CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of a dialled


digit combination.
- Either it can be used to detect an IN service request for destination
numbers starting with the entered digits.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 24+


CR INSCM
TDP6
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- Or it can be used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service


request for a destination number if the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database (see CR INAUTH).
In this case only a single parameter value equal to "*" must be
administered.

Compatibilities:
If used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service request
for a destination number when the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database following rules are
valid :
- only allowed for TDP12.
- the parameter PRID must not be entered.
- the parameter NCLDPTY may be entered. Numbers entered with this
parameter are not triggered.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NCLDPTY NOT CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of


a NOT dialled digit combination. It is used to detect an
IN service request for destination numbers NOT starting
with the entered digits.

Compatibities:
- CLDPTY=*. See parameter CLDPTY for more information.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter
must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCM- 25-


DISP INSCM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISP IN SERVICE CLASS MARK

This command displays the data concerning a specified or all


IN service class marks.
Depending on the TYPE parameter only service class marks of
special type will be displayed.
Depending on the PRID parameter only service class mark using
this profile identifier will be displayed.
Depending on the FORMAT parameter specific data of the service
class mark related to the trigger condition or trigger profile
will be displayed.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP INSCM : SCMID= [,TYPE=] [,PRID=] [,FORMAT=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


for which the IN service class mark shall be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP1 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 1


TDP2 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 2
TDP3 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 3
TDP4 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 4
TDP5 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5
TDP6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 6
TDP12 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 12
TDP13 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13
TDP14 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 14
TDP13O14 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13O14
TDP5O6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5O6

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


for which the IN service class mark shall be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FORMAT FORMAT SELECTION FOR DISPLAY

This parameter specifies the kind of data which has to be displayed


for an Service Class Mark:
- PA has to be used to display the specific trigger conditions.
- CT has to be used to display the profile identification of the SCM.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INSCM- 1+


DISP INSCM

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PA PARAMETERS TRIGGER CONDITIONS


CT CALL TREATMENT

Default: PA

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INSCM- 2-


MOD INSCM
TDP1
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY IN SERVICE CLASS MARK

This command modifies an IN service class mark that is used for


the triggering at the following trigger detection points:

TDP1 - Originating Attempt Authorized:


This trigger is detected in the A-side seizure processing when the
off-hook for a certain object was detected.

TDP2 - Collected Information:


This trigger is detected when the A-side wants to setup a call and
a specified number of digits was collected.

TDP3 - Analyzed Information:


This trigger is detected during the IN specific analysis of the
called party number, the calling party number or its category.

TDP4 - Route Select Failure:


This trigger is detected when the indication was received that no
route to the required destination can be found.

TDP5 - Originating Busy:


This trigger is detected when the originating call party receives
an indication of user busy from the terminating call party.

TDP6 - Originating No Answer:


This trigger is detected in the A-side processing when the B-side
does not answer and the no-answer timer is expired.

TDP5O6 - Combines TDP5 and TDP6.

TDP12 - Terminating Attempt Authorized:


This trigger is detected in the B-side seizure processing when the
the call setup to a certain object was detected.

TDP13 - Terminating Busy:


This trigger is detected in the B-side seizure processing when the
B-party is busy.

TDP14 - Terminating No Answer:


This trigger is detected in the B-side seizure processing when the
B-side does not answer and the no-answer timer is expired.

TDP13O14 - Combines TDP13 and TDP14.

Notes:
- The type of service class mark must not be changed.
- The MOD command allows to overwrite existing parameter values.
- Removal of trigger conditions is only allowed for an escape code.

Prerequisites:
- The trigger profile referenced by the parameter PRID has to
be created by command CR INTRIG.
- SSF type must be NORMAL.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD INSCM - TDP1 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 1


2. MOD INSCM - TDP12 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 12
3. MOD INSCM - TDP13 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13
4. MOD INSCM - TDP13O14 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13O14
5. MOD INSCM - TDP14 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 14
6. MOD INSCM - TDP2 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 2
7. MOD INSCM - TDP3 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 3
8. MOD INSCM - TDP4 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 4.
9. MOD INSCM - TDP5 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5.
10. MOD INSCM - TDP5O6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5O6
11. MOD INSCM - TDP6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 6

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 1+


MOD INSCM
TDP1
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 1

Modification of a service class mark for a trigger detection point


of type TDP1.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD INSCM : SCMID= <,PRID= ,PREFIX= ,CPREFIX=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX DIGITS

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CPREFIX CANCEL PREFIX

This parameter specifies if the prefix digits have to be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED


NO PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED
Y CANCEL PREFIX
YES CANCEL PREFIX

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 2+


MOD INSCM
TDP12
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 12

Modification of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP12.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD INSCM : SCMID= <,PRID= ,PREFIX= ,CPREFIX= ,COLDIG= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,CLDPTY= ,NCLDPTY= ,CLGPTY= ,PROP= ,CPROP=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX DIGITS

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CPREFIX CANCEL PREFIX

This parameter specifies if the prefix digits have to be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED


NO PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED
Y CANCEL PREFIX
YES CANCEL PREFIX

COLDIG COLLECT DIGITS

This parameter specifies the number of called party digits to be


collected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...14, range of decimal numbers

CLDPTY CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of a dialled


digit combination.
- Either it can be used to detect an IN service request for destination
numbers starting with the entered digits.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 3+


MOD INSCM
TDP12
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- Or it can be used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service


request for a destination number if the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database (see CR INAUTH).
In this case only a single parameter value equal to "*" must be
administered.

Compatibilities:
If used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service request
for a destination number when the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database following rules are
valid :
- only allowed for TDP12.
- the parameter PRID must not be entered.
- the parameter NCLDPTY may be entered. Numbers entered with this
parameter are not triggered.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NCLDPTY NOT CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of


a NOT dialled digit combination. It is used to detect an
IN service request for destination numbers NOT starting
with the entered digits.

Compatibities:
- CLDPTY=*. See parameter CLDPTY for more information.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter
must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PROP PROPERTY

This parameter specifies the SCM properties to be


added to the already existing values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

<CNAM > CALLING NAME NOT PRESENT


< > This parameter value specifies an extra trigger
< > condition. It is used to detect an IN service
< > request depending on the unavailability of the
< > calling name.
<PROP3 > PROPERTY 3
<PROP4 > PROPERTY 4
<PROP5 > PROPERTY 5
<PROP6 > PROPERTY 6
<PROP7 > PROPERTY 7

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 4+


MOD INSCM
TDP12
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

<PROP8 > PROPERTY 8


<PROP9 > PROPERTY 9

CPROP CANCEL SCM PROPERTY

This parameter specifies the SCM properties to be


canceled from the already existing values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

<CNAM > CALLING NAME NOT PRESENT


< > This parameter value specifies an extra trigger
< > condition. It is used to detect an IN service
< > request depending on the unavailability of the
< > calling name.
<PROP3 > PROPERTY 3
<PROP4 > PROPERTY 4
<PROP5 > PROPERTY 5
<PROP6 > PROPERTY 6
<PROP7 > PROPERTY 7
<PROP8 > PROPERTY 8
<PROP9 > PROPERTY 9

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 5+


MOD INSCM
TDP13
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13

Modification of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP13.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD INSCM : SCMID= <,PRID= ,PREFIX= ,CPREFIX= ,CLGPTY= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,RELCA=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX DIGITS

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CPREFIX CANCEL PREFIX

This parameter specifies if the prefix digits have to be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED


NO PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED
Y CANCEL PREFIX
YES CANCEL PREFIX

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter
must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 6+


MOD INSCM
TDP13
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RELCA RELEASE CAUSE

This parameter specifies the release cause, which will be used


to trigger IN depending on the call release.
It can be entered for the trigger types TDP4, TDP5, TDP5O6, TDP13
or TDP13O14.

Notes:
- Up to 3 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: CAUSE VALUE=
0...127, range of decimal numbers

b: LOCATION
INTN INTERNATIONAL NETWORK
IWP BEYOND AN INTERWORKING POINT
PRL PRIV. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PRR PRIV.NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
PUL PUB. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PUR PUB. NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
TRN TRANSIT NETWORK
USER USER

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 7+


MOD INSCM
TDP13O14
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13O14

Modification of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP13O14.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD INSCM : SCMID= <,PRID= ,PREFIX= ,CPREFIX=> ,NOANST= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 <,CLGPTY= ,RELCA=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX DIGITS

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CPREFIX CANCEL PREFIX

This parameter specifies if the prefix digits have to be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED


NO PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED
Y CANCEL PREFIX
YES CANCEL PREFIX

NOANST NO ANSWER TIME

This parameter specifies the value of the NO-ANSWER timer


for TDP6, TDP5O6, TDP14 or TDP13O14

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...60, range of decimal numbers

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 8+


MOD INSCM
TDP13O14
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter
must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

RELCA RELEASE CAUSE

This parameter specifies the release cause, which will be used


to trigger IN depending on the call release.
It can be entered for the trigger types TDP4, TDP5, TDP5O6, TDP13
or TDP13O14.

Notes:
- Up to 3 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: CAUSE VALUE=
0...127, range of decimal numbers

b: LOCATION
INTN INTERNATIONAL NETWORK
IWP BEYOND AN INTERWORKING POINT
PRL PRIV. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PRR PRIV.NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
PUL PUB. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PUR PUB. NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
TRN TRANSIT NETWORK
USER USER

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 9+


MOD INSCM
TDP14
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 14

Modification of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP14.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD INSCM : SCMID= <,PRID= ,PREFIX= ,CPREFIX=> ,NOANST= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 <,CLGPTY=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX DIGITS

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CPREFIX CANCEL PREFIX

This parameter specifies if the prefix digits have to be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED


NO PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED
Y CANCEL PREFIX
YES CANCEL PREFIX

NOANST NO ANSWER TIME

This parameter specifies the value of the NO-ANSWER timer


for TDP6, TDP5O6, TDP14 or TDP13O14

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...60, range of decimal numbers

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 10+


MOD INSCM
TDP14
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter
must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 11+


MOD INSCM
TDP2
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

6. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 2

Modification of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP2.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD INSCM : SCMID= <,PRID= ,PREFIX= ,CPREFIX= ,COLDIG= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,ESCAPE= ,CESCAPE=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX DIGITS

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CPREFIX CANCEL PREFIX

This parameter specifies if the prefix digits have to be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED


NO PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED
Y CANCEL PREFIX
YES CANCEL PREFIX

COLDIG COLLECT DIGITS

This parameter specifies the number of called party digits to be


collected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...14, range of decimal numbers

ESCAPE ESCAPE CODE

This parameter specifies the modified escape code to be used in case


of TDP2 for the setup of a normal non-IN call.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 12+


MOD INSCM
TDP2
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...2 digit decimal number

CESCAPE CANCEL ESCAPE CODE

This parameter specifies if the escape code has to be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N ESCAPE CODE REMAINS UNCHANGED


NO ESCAPE CODE REMAINS UNCHANGED
Y CANCEL ESCAPE CODE
YES CANCEL ESCAPE CODE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 13+


MOD INSCM
TDP3
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

7. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 3

Modification of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP3.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD INSCM : SCMID= <,PRID= ,PREFIX= ,CPREFIX= ,COLDIG= 1
1 1
1 ,CLDPTY= ,NCLDPTY= ,CLGPTY= ,CAT= ,NCAT= ,PROP= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,CPROP=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX DIGITS

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CPREFIX CANCEL PREFIX

This parameter specifies if the prefix digits have to be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED


NO PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED
Y CANCEL PREFIX
YES CANCEL PREFIX

COLDIG COLLECT DIGITS

This parameter specifies the number of called party digits to be


collected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...14, range of decimal numbers

CLDPTY CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of a dialled


digit combination.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 14+


MOD INSCM
TDP3
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- Either it can be used to detect an IN service request for destination


numbers starting with the entered digits.
- Or it can be used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service
request for a destination number if the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database (see CR INAUTH).
In this case only a single parameter value equal to "*" must be
administered.

Compatibilities:
If used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service request
for a destination number when the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database following rules are
valid :
- only allowed for TDP12.
- the parameter PRID must not be entered.
- the parameter NCLDPTY may be entered. Numbers entered with this
parameter are not triggered.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NCLDPTY NOT CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of


a NOT dialled digit combination. It is used to detect an
IN service request for destination numbers NOT starting
with the entered digits.

Compatibities:
- CLDPTY=*. See parameter CLDPTY for more information.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter
must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CAT CALLING PARTY CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the category of calling party. It is


used to restrict the IN-triggering to a specific category of
calling parties.

Notes:
- This parameter has the opposite effect as NCAT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 15+


MOD INSCM
TDP3
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

fixed mobile subscriber


CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15
COINB COIN BOX
DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
OPOSINAT OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the category of the calling party.

NCAT NOT CALLING PARTY CATEGORY

This parameter specifies the category of calling party. It is used


to restrict the IN-triggering to calling parties which are NOT of
the entered category.

Notes:
- This parameter has the opposite effect as CAT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15
COINB COIN BOX
DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
OPOSINAT OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the category of the calling party.

PROP PROPERTY

This parameter specifies the SCM properties to be


added to the already existing values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ETRIND EVALUATE RETRIGGER INDICATION


This parameter value specifies that the retrigger
indication "IN Triggering Inhibited After Connect"
delivered by the IN service logic will be
evaluated.

CPROP CANCEL SCM PROPERTY

This parameter specifies the SCM properties to be


canceled from the already existing values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ETRIND EVALUATE RETRIGGER INDICATION


This parameter value specifies that the retrigger
indication "IN Triggering Inhibited After Connect"
delivered by the IN service logic will be
evaluated.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 16+


MOD INSCM
TDP4
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

8. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 4.

Modification of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP4.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD INSCM : SCMID= <,PRID= ,PREFIX= ,CPREFIX= ,COLDIG= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,CLDPTY= ,NCLDPTY= ,CLGPTY= ,RELCA=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX DIGITS

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CPREFIX CANCEL PREFIX

This parameter specifies if the prefix digits have to be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED


NO PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED
Y CANCEL PREFIX
YES CANCEL PREFIX

COLDIG COLLECT DIGITS

This parameter specifies the number of called party digits to be


collected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...14, range of decimal numbers

CLDPTY CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of a dialled


digit combination.
- Either it can be used to detect an IN service request for destination
numbers starting with the entered digits.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 17+


MOD INSCM
TDP4
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- Or it can be used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service


request for a destination number if the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database (see CR INAUTH).
In this case only a single parameter value equal to "*" must be
administered.

Compatibilities:
If used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service request
for a destination number when the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database following rules are
valid :
- only allowed for TDP12.
- the parameter PRID must not be entered.
- the parameter NCLDPTY may be entered. Numbers entered with this
parameter are not triggered.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NCLDPTY NOT CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of


a NOT dialled digit combination. It is used to detect an
IN service request for destination numbers NOT starting
with the entered digits.

Compatibities:
- CLDPTY=*. See parameter CLDPTY for more information.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter
must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

RELCA RELEASE CAUSE

This parameter specifies the release cause, which will be used


to trigger IN depending on the call release.
It can be entered for the trigger types TDP4, TDP5, TDP5O6, TDP13
or TDP13O14.

Notes:
- Up to 3 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: CAUSE VALUE=
0...127, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 18+


MOD INSCM
TDP4
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: LOCATION
INTN INTERNATIONAL NETWORK
IWP BEYOND AN INTERWORKING POINT
PRL PRIV. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PRR PRIV.NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
PUL PUB. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PUR PUB. NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
TRN TRANSIT NETWORK
USER USER

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 19+


MOD INSCM
TDP5
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

9. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5.

Modification of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP5.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD INSCM : SCMID= <,PRID= ,PREFIX= ,CPREFIX= ,CLDPTY= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,NCLDPTY= ,CLGPTY= ,RELCA=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX DIGITS

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CPREFIX CANCEL PREFIX

This parameter specifies if the prefix digits have to be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED


NO PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED
Y CANCEL PREFIX
YES CANCEL PREFIX

CLDPTY CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of a dialled


digit combination.
- Either it can be used to detect an IN service request for destination
numbers starting with the entered digits.
- Or it can be used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service
request for a destination number if the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database (see CR INAUTH).
In this case only a single parameter value equal to "*" must be
administered.

Compatibilities:
If used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service request
for a destination number when the complete number is entered as

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 20+


MOD INSCM
TDP5
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

B-number in the IN-authorization database following rules are


valid :
- only allowed for TDP12.
- the parameter PRID must not be entered.
- the parameter NCLDPTY may be entered. Numbers entered with this
parameter are not triggered.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NCLDPTY NOT CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of


a NOT dialled digit combination. It is used to detect an
IN service request for destination numbers NOT starting
with the entered digits.

Compatibities:
- CLDPTY=*. See parameter CLDPTY for more information.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter
must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

RELCA RELEASE CAUSE

This parameter specifies the release cause, which will be used


to trigger IN depending on the call release.
It can be entered for the trigger types TDP4, TDP5, TDP5O6, TDP13
or TDP13O14.

Notes:
- Up to 3 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: CAUSE VALUE=
0...127, range of decimal numbers

b: LOCATION
INTN INTERNATIONAL NETWORK
IWP BEYOND AN INTERWORKING POINT
PRL PRIV. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PRR PRIV.NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
PUL PUB. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PUR PUB. NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
TRN TRANSIT NETWORK

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 21+


MOD INSCM
TDP5
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

USER USER

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 22+


MOD INSCM
TDP5O6
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

10. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5O6

Modification of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP5O6.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD INSCM : SCMID= <,PRID= ,PREFIX= ,CPREFIX=> ,NOANST= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 <,CLDPTY= ,NCLDPTY= ,CLGPTY= ,RELCA=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX DIGITS

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CPREFIX CANCEL PREFIX

This parameter specifies if the prefix digits have to be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED


NO PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED
Y CANCEL PREFIX
YES CANCEL PREFIX

NOANST NO ANSWER TIME

This parameter specifies the value of the NO-ANSWER timer


for TDP6, TDP5O6, TDP14 or TDP13O14

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...60, range of decimal numbers

CLDPTY CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of a dialled


digit combination.
- Either it can be used to detect an IN service request for destination
numbers starting with the entered digits.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 23+


MOD INSCM
TDP5O6
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- Or it can be used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service


request for a destination number if the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database (see CR INAUTH).
In this case only a single parameter value equal to "*" must be
administered.

Compatibilities:
If used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service request
for a destination number when the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database following rules are
valid :
- only allowed for TDP12.
- the parameter PRID must not be entered.
- the parameter NCLDPTY may be entered. Numbers entered with this
parameter are not triggered.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NCLDPTY NOT CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of


a NOT dialled digit combination. It is used to detect an
IN service request for destination numbers NOT starting
with the entered digits.

Compatibities:
- CLDPTY=*. See parameter CLDPTY for more information.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter
must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

RELCA RELEASE CAUSE

This parameter specifies the release cause, which will be used


to trigger IN depending on the call release.
It can be entered for the trigger types TDP4, TDP5, TDP5O6, TDP13
or TDP13O14.

Notes:
- Up to 3 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: CAUSE VALUE=
0...127, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 24+


MOD INSCM
TDP5O6
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: LOCATION
INTN INTERNATIONAL NETWORK
IWP BEYOND AN INTERWORKING POINT
PRL PRIV. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PRR PRIV.NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
PUL PUB. NETW. SERVING LOCAL USER
PUR PUB. NETW. SERVING REMOTE USER
TRN TRANSIT NETWORK
USER USER

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 25+


MOD INSCM
TDP6
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

11. Input format

TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 6

Modification of a service class mark for a trigger detection point of


type TDP6.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD INSCM : SCMID= <,PRID= ,PREFIX= ,CPREFIX=> ,NOANST= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 <,CLDPTY= ,NCLDPTY= ,CLGPTY=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the service class mark


to be modified.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile,


the data of which has to be used when the trigger was
detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

PREFIX PREFIX DIGITS

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be set in front


of the called party number when the dialogue to the SCP has to
be started.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CPREFIX CANCEL PREFIX

This parameter specifies if the prefix digits have to be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED


NO PREFIX REMAINS UNCHANGED
Y CANCEL PREFIX
YES CANCEL PREFIX

NOANST NO ANSWER TIME

This parameter specifies the value of the NO-ANSWER timer


for TDP6, TDP5O6, TDP14 or TDP13O14

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...60, range of decimal numbers

CLDPTY CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of a dialled


digit combination.
- Either it can be used to detect an IN service request for destination
numbers starting with the entered digits.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 26+


MOD INSCM
TDP6
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- Or it can be used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service


request for a destination number if the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database (see CR INAUTH).
In this case only a single parameter value equal to "*" must be
administered.

Compatibilities:
If used for terminating triggers to detect an IN service request
for a destination number when the complete number is entered as
B-number in the IN-authorization database following rules are
valid :
- only allowed for TDP12.
- the parameter PRID must not be entered.
- the parameter NCLDPTY may be entered. Numbers entered with this
parameter are not triggered.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

NCLDPTY NOT CALLED PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition of


a NOT dialled digit combination. It is used to detect an
IN service request for destination numbers NOT starting
with the entered digits.

Compatibities:
- CLDPTY=*. See parameter CLDPTY for more information.

This parameter can have up to 3 parameter values linked together


with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the extra trigger condition for a


calling party number. It is used to detect an IN service request
depending on the origin of a call.

Notes:
- For txs (transit exchange subscribers) features this parameter
must be equal "*". In this case PRID may not be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...10 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCM- 27-


ACT INSCMREF
CODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE IN SERVICE CLASS MARK REFERENCE

This command activates an IN service class mark assigned to a subscriber,


PBX, a PBX line, a trunk group, a CENTREX group, a common service group,
a call type or a digit code.

Prerequisites :
- The corresponding INSCMREF must have been created with the command
CR INSCMREF.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ACT INSCMREF - CODE IN SCM REFERENCE FOR DIGIT COMBINATION


2. ACT INSCMREF - CTORCSG IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CALL TYPE OR CSGRP
3. ACT INSCMREF - CXGACODE IN SCM REF. FOR CENTREX GROUP AND CODE
4. ACT INSCMREF - CXGRP IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CENTREX GROUP
5. ACT INSCMREF - PBXLN IN SCM REFERENCE FOR PBX LINE
6. ACT INSCMREF - SUBORPBX IN SCM REFERENCE FOR SUB OR PBX
7. ACT INSCMREF - TGNO IN SCM REFERENCE FOR TRUNK GROUP

1. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR DIGIT COMBINATION

Activate an IN service class mark already assigned to


a digit combination (code).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT INSCMREF : CODE= [,ORIG1=] ,TYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION CODE

This parameter specifies the digit combination (code).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code for which the


destination digits are evaluated.
Only decimal numbers, range 0..3839, and the hexadecimal number’DEF’
may be entered.

This hexadecimal number ’DEF’ identifies the "default ORIG1".


This value represents all ORIG1 values that are not explicitely
entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP3 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 3


TDP4 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 4

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT INSCMREF- 1+


ACT INSCMREF
CODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TDP5 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5


TDP5O6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5O6
TDP6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 6

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT INSCMREF- 2+


ACT INSCMREF
CTORCSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CALL TYPE OR CSGRP

Activate an IN service class mark already assigned to a call type or


a common service group.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT INSCMREF : [LAC=] ,DN= ,TYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the addressed


object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP12 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 12

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT INSCMREF- 3+


ACT INSCMREF
CXGACODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

IN SCM REF. FOR CENTREX GROUP AND CODE

Activate an IN service class mark already assigned


to a CENTREX group and code.

Incompatibilities :

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT INSCMREF : CXGRP= ,CODE= ,TYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CXGRP CENTREX GROUP

This parameter specifies a number that identifies the CENTREX group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION CODE

This parameter specifies the digit combination (code).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP3 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 3

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT INSCMREF- 4+


ACT INSCMREF
CXGRP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CENTREX GROUP

Activate an IN service class mark already assigned to a CENTREX group.

Incompatibilities :

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT INSCMREF : CXGRP= ,TYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CXGRP CENTREX GROUP

This parameter specifies a number that identifies the CENTREX group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP12 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 12


TDP2 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 2

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT INSCMREF- 5+


ACT INSCMREF
PBXLN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR PBX LINE

Activate an IN Service Class Mark already assigned to a PBX line.

Incompatibilities :

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT INSCMREF : [LAC=] ,DN= ,LNO= [,OPMODE=] ,TYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the addressed


object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number of the PBX line.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

OPMODE OPERATING MODE

This parameter specifies the operating mode of the PBX line.


Incoming lines are lines coming to the switch from the PBX.
Outgoing lines are lines going from the switch to the PBX.

Notes:
- Input is mandatory if several OPMODE values are assigned
to the PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ABW ANALOG BOTHWAY


AIC ANALOG INCOMING
AOG ANALOG OUTGOING
IBW ISDN BOTHWAY
IIC ISDN INCOMING
IOG ISDN OUTGOING

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP1 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 1


TDP12 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 12
TDP13 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13
TDP13O14 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13O14

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT INSCMREF- 6+


ACT INSCMREF
PBXLN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TDP14 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 14


TDP2 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 2
TDP3 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 3
TDP4 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 4
TDP5 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5
TDP5O6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5O6
TDP6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 6

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT INSCMREF- 7+


ACT INSCMREF
SUBORPBX
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

6. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR SUB OR PBX

Activate an IN Service Class Mark already assigned to a subscriber or a PBX.

Incompatibilities :

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT INSCMREF : [LAC=] ,DN= ,TYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the addressed


object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP1 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 1


TDP12 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 12
TDP13 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13
TDP13O14 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13O14
TDP14 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 14
TDP2 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 2
TDP3 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 3
TDP4 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 4
TDP5 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5
TDP5O6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5O6
TDP6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 6

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT INSCMREF- 8+


ACT INSCMREF
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

7. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR TRUNK GROUP

Activate an IN service class mark already assigned to a trunk group.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT INSCMREF : TGNO= ,TYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be realized with this IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP1 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 1


TDP2 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 2
TDP3 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 3
TDP4 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 4
TDP5 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5
TDP5O6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5O6
TDP6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 6

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT INSCMREF- 9-


CAN INSCMREF
CODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL IN SERVICE CLASS MARK REFERENCE

This command cancels the assignment of an IN service class mark reference


to a subscriber, a PBX, a PBX line, a trunk group, a CENTREX group, a
call type, a common service group or a digit code.

Notes :
- The SCMREF must be deactivated before it may be cancelled.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CAN INSCMREF - CODE IN SCM REFERENCE FOR DIGIT COMBINATION


2. CAN INSCMREF - CTORCSG IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CALL TYPE OR CSGRP
3. CAN INSCMREF - CXGACODE IN SCM REF. FOR CENTREX GROUP AND CODE
4. CAN INSCMREF - CXGRP IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CENTREX GROUP
5. CAN INSCMREF - PBXLN IN SCM REFERENCE FOR PBX LINE
6. CAN INSCMREF - SUBORPBX IN SCM REFERENCE FOR SUB OR PBX
7. CAN INSCMREF - TGNO IN SCM REFERENCE FOR TRUNK GROUP

1. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR DIGIT COMBINATION

Cancellation of an IN service class mark reference to a digit combination


(for office based IN-triggering).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN INSCMREF : CODE= [,ORIG1=] ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION CODE

This parameter specifies the digit combination (code).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code for which the


destination digits are evaluated.
Only decimal numbers, range 0..3839, and the hexadecimal number’DEF’
may be entered.

This hexadecimal number ’DEF’ identifies the "default ORIG1".


This value represents all ORIG1 values that are not explicitely
entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the IN service class mark


whose reference with subscriber, PBX, PBXLN, a trunk group or a
digit code must be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INSCMREF- 1+


CAN INSCMREF
CTORCSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CALL TYPE OR CSGRP

Cancellation of an IN service class mark reference assigned to a call type


or a common service group.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN INSCMREF : [LAC=] ,DN= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the addressed


object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the IN service class mark


whose reference with subscriber, PBX, PBXLN, a trunk group or a
digit code must be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INSCMREF- 2+


CAN INSCMREF
CXGACODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

IN SCM REF. FOR CENTREX GROUP AND CODE

Cancellation of an IN service class mark reference assigned


to a CENTREX group and code.

Incompatibilities :

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN INSCMREF : CXGRP= ,CODE= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CXGRP CENTREX GROUP

This parameter specifies a number that identifies the CENTREX group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION CODE

This parameter specifies the digit combination (code).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the IN service class mark


whose reference with subscriber, PBX, PBXLN, a trunk group or a
digit code must be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INSCMREF- 3+


CAN INSCMREF
CXGRP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CENTREX GROUP

Cancellation of an IN service class mark reference assigned to a CENTREX group.

Incompatibilities :

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN INSCMREF : CXGRP= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CXGRP CENTREX GROUP

This parameter specifies a number that identifies the CENTREX group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the IN service class mark


whose reference with subscriber, PBX, PBXLN, a trunk group or a
digit code must be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INSCMREF- 4+


CAN INSCMREF
PBXLN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR PBX LINE

Cancellation of an IN service class mark reference assignment to a PBX line.

Incompatibilities :

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN INSCMREF : [LAC=] ,DN= [,OPMODE=] ,LNO= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the addressed


object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

OPMODE OPERATING MODE

This parameter specifies the operating mode of the PBX line.


Incoming lines are lines coming to the switch from the PBX.
Outgoing lines are lines going from the switch to the PBX.

Notes:
- Input is mandatory if several OPMODE values are assigned
to the PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ABW ANALOG BOTHWAY


AIC ANALOG INCOMING
AOG ANALOG OUTGOING
IBW ISDN BOTHWAY
IIC ISDN INCOMING
IOG ISDN OUTGOING

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number of the PBX line.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the IN service class mark


whose reference with subscriber, PBX, PBXLN, a trunk group or a
digit code must be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INSCMREF- 5+


CAN INSCMREF
SUBORPBX
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

6. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR SUB OR PBX

Cancellation of an IN service class mark reference assignment to


a subscriber or a PBX.

Incompatibilities :

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN INSCMREF : [LAC=] ,DN= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the addressed


object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the IN service class mark


whose reference with subscriber, PBX, PBXLN, a trunk group or a
digit code must be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INSCMREF- 6+


CAN INSCMREF
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

7. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR TRUNK GROUP

Cancellation of an IN service class mark reference to a trunk group


(for trunk group based IN-triggering).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN INSCMREF : TGNO= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the IN service class mark


whose reference with subscriber, PBX, PBXLN, a trunk group or a
digit code must be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INSCMREF- 7-


CR INSCMREF
CODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE IN SERVICE CLASS MARK REFERENCE

This command assigns an IN service class mark to a subscriber, PBX,


PBX line, a trunkgroup, a CENTREX group, a call type, a common service
group or a digit code.

Prerequisites :
- The INSCM specified in parameter SCMID must have been created
with command CR INSCM.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR INSCMREF - CODE IN SCM REFERENCE FOR DIGIT COMBINATION


2. CR INSCMREF - CTORCSG IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CALL TYPE OR CSGRP
3. CR INSCMREF - CXGACODE IN SCM REF. FOR CENTREX GROUP AND CODE
4. CR INSCMREF - CXGRP IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CENTREX GROUP
5. CR INSCMREF - PBXLN IN SCM REFERENCE FOR PBX LINE
6. CR INSCMREF - SUBORPBX IN SCM REFERENCE FOR SUB OR PBX
7. CR INSCMREF - TGNO IN SCM REFERENCE FOR TRUNK GROUP

1. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR DIGIT COMBINATION

Assignment of an IN service class mark to a digit combination (for office based


IN-triggering).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR INSCMREF : CODE= [,ORIG1=] ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION CODE

This parameter specifies the digit combination (code) to


which the IN service class mark is assigned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code for which the


destination digits are evaluated.
Only decimal numbers, range 0..3839, and the hexadecimal number’DEF’
may be entered.

This hexadecimal number ’DEF’ identifies the "default ORIG1".


This value represents all ORIG1 values that are not explicitely
entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the IN service class mark


to be assigned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCMREF- 1+
CR INSCMREF
CODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCMREF- 2+
CR INSCMREF
CTORCSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CALL TYPE OR CSGRP

Assignment of an IN service class mark to a call type or a common service group.

Prerequisites :

Incompatibilities :
- An INSCM may only be assigned to CENTREX common service groups or
to call types for a CENTREX common service groups.
- Only INSCMs of type TDP12 can be assigned.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR INSCMREF : [LAC=] ,DN= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the addressed


object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the IN service class mark


to be assigned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCMREF- 3+
CR INSCMREF
CXGACODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

IN SCM REF. FOR CENTREX GROUP AND CODE

Assignment of an IN service class mark to a CENTREX group and code.

Prerequisites :

Incompatibilities :
- Only INSCMs of type TDP3 can be assigned.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR INSCMREF : CXGRP= ,CODE= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CXGRP CENTREX GROUP

This parameter specifies a number that identifies the CENTREX group


to which the IN service class mark is assigned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION CODE

This parameter specifies the digit combination (code) to


which the IN service class mark is assigned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the IN service class mark


to be assigned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCMREF- 4+
CR INSCMREF
CXGRP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CENTREX GROUP

Assignment of an IN service class mark to a CENTREX group.

Prerequisites :

Incompatibilities :

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR INSCMREF : CXGRP= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CXGRP CENTREX GROUP

This parameter specifies a number that identifies the CENTREX group


to which the IN service class mark is assigned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the IN service class mark


to be assigned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCMREF- 5+
CR INSCMREF
PBXLN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR PBX LINE

Assignment of an IN service class mark to a PBX line.

Prerequisites:
- The parameters LAC, DN, OPMODE and LNO must address a PBX line
previously created with command CR PBXLN.
- Terminating IN service class marks may only be assigned to PBX lines with
COS = DCANORM.

Incompatibilities :
- Originating INSCMs of different types must not be assigned to the
same object simultaneously.
- To assign an originating INSCM to a PBX line, no reference to an
originating INSCM must already exist for the PBX line and no
reference to an INSCM of incompatible TYPE must exist for the
belonging PBX.
- To assign a terminating INSCM to a PBX line, no terminating INSCM must
already be assigned to the PBX line.
- INSCMs are incompatible with:
- OPMODE = IIC1TR6
= IBW1TR6
= IOG1TR6
- Originating INSCMs are incompatible with
OPMODE = IOG
= AOG.
- Terminating INSCMs are incompatible with
OPMODE = IIC
= AIC.
- INSCMs of type TDP1 may not be assigned to a PBX line if the line itself
or the PBX is assigned :
TRARSTR = TRACLACT
= TRACLMOD.

Notes:
- In case an IN service class mark is also assigned to the PBX, the IN service
class mark assigned to the PBX line will take precedence.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR INSCMREF : [LAC=] ,DN= [,OPMODE=] ,LNO= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the addressed


object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

OPMODE OPERATING MODE

This parameter specifies the operating mode of the PBX line.


Incoming lines are lines coming to the switch from the PBX.
Outgoing lines are lines going from the switch to the PBX.

Notes:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCMREF- 6+
CR INSCMREF
PBXLN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- Input is mandatory if several OPMODE values are assigned


to the PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ABW ANALOG BOTHWAY


AIC ANALOG INCOMING
AOG ANALOG OUTGOING
IBW ISDN BOTHWAY
IIC ISDN INCOMING
IOG ISDN OUTGOING

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number of the PBX line.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the IN service class mark


to be assigned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCMREF- 7+
CR INSCMREF
SUBORPBX
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

6. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR SUB OR PBX

Assignment of an IN service class mark to a subscriber or a PBX.

Prerequisites :
- The parameters LAC, DN must address a subscriber or a PBX
previously created respectively with commands CR SUB or CR PBX.
- Originating INSCMs may only be assigned to a PBX having at least
one of the following OPMODEs : IIC, AIC, IBW, ABW.
- Terminating INSCMs may only be assigned to a PBX having at least
one of the following OPMODEs: IOG, AOG, IBW, ABW.

Incompatibilities :
- Originating INSCMs of different types must not be assigned to the
same object simultaneously.
- To assign an originating INSCM to a subscriber, no reference to
an originating INSCM must already exist for the subscriber.
- To assign an originating INSCM to a PBX, no reference to an
originating INSCM must already exist for the PBX and no reference
to an INSCM of incompatible TYPE must exist for the PBX lines
belonging to that PBX.
- To assign a terminating INSCM to a subscriber or a PBX, no terminating
INSCM must already be assigned to the subscriber or PBX.
- INSCMs may not be assigned to:
- subscribers with CAT = COINB1
= COINB2
= COINB3
= TPLRNG
= TPLTIP
= TESTNO
= IDSB
= ECS
= ECSP
- subscribers with LNATT = ISDN1TR6
- PBX with TYPE = FRAMEHD
= PHI
- PBX with OPMODE = IIC1TR6
= IBW1TR6
= IOG1TR6
- Originating INSCMs may not be assigned subscribers with CAT = VIRTSUB.
- Terminating INSCMs, except of type TDP12, may not be assigned to CENTREX
users.
- INSCMs of type TDP1 may not be assigned to subscribers with :
TRARSTR = TRACLACT
= TRACLMOD.
- INSCMs of type TDP1 may not be assigned to a PBX if the PBX itself or
one of its lines is assigned :
TRARSTR = TRACLACT
= TRACLMOD.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR INSCMREF : [LAC=] ,DN= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the addressed


object.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCMREF- 8+
CR INSCMREF
SUBORPBX
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the IN service class mark


to be assigned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCMREF- 9+
CR INSCMREF
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

7. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR TRUNK GROUP

Assignment of an IN service class mark to a trunk group (for trunk group


based IN-triggering).

Prerequisites :
- The parameter TGNO must address a trunk group, previously created with
the command CR TGRP.

Incompatibilities :
- INSCMs of different types must not be assigned to the same object
simultaneously.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR INSCMREF : TGNO= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number to which the


IN service class mark is assigned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the IN service class mark


to be assigned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INSCMREF- 10-


DACT INSCMREF
CODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE IN SERVICE CLASS MARK REF.

This command deactivates an IN service class mark previously activated.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DACT INSCMREF- CODE IN SCM REFERENCE FOR DIGIT CODE


2. DACT INSCMREF- CTORCSG IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CALL TYPE OR CSGRP
3. DACT INSCMREF- CXGACODE IN SCM REF. FOR CENTREX GROUP AND CODE
4. DACT INSCMREF- CXGRP IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CENTREX GROUP
5. DACT INSCMREF- PBXLN IN SCM REFERENCE FOR PBX LINE
6. DACT INSCMREF- SUBORPBX IN SCM REFERENCE FOR SUB OR PBX
7. DACT INSCMREF- TGNO IN SCM REFERENCE FOR TRUNK GROUP

1. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR DIGIT CODE

Deactivate an IN service class mark already assigned


to a digit combination (code).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DACT INSCMREF : CODE= [,ORIG1=] ,TYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION CODE

This parameter specifies the digit combination (code).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code for which the


destination digits are evaluated.
Only decimal numbers, range 0..3839, and the hexadecimal number’DEF’
may be entered.

This hexadecimal number ’DEF’ identifies the "default ORIG1".


This value represents all ORIG1 values that are not explicitely
entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be deactivated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP3 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 3


TDP4 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 4
TDP5 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5
TDP5O6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5O6
TDP6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 6

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT INSCMREF- 1+


DACT INSCMREF
CTORCSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CALL TYPE OR CSGRP

Deactivate an IN service class mark already assigned to a call type or


a common service group.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DACT INSCMREF : [LAC=] ,DN= ,TYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the addressed


object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be deactivated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP12 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 12

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT INSCMREF- 2+


DACT INSCMREF
CXGACODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

IN SCM REF. FOR CENTREX GROUP AND CODE

Deactivate an IN service class mark already assigned


to a CENTREX group and code.

Incompatibilities :

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DACT INSCMREF : CXGRP= ,CODE= ,TYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CXGRP CENTREX GROUP

This parameter specifies a number that identifies the CENTREX group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION CODE

This parameter specifies the digit combination (code).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be deactivated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP3 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 3

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT INSCMREF- 3+


DACT INSCMREF
CXGRP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CENTREX GROUP

Deactivate an IN service class mark already assigned to a CENTREX group.

Incompatibilities :

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DACT INSCMREF : CXGRP= ,TYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CXGRP CENTREX GROUP

This parameter specifies a number that identifies the CENTREX group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be deactivated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP12 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 12


TDP2 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 2

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT INSCMREF- 4+


DACT INSCMREF
PBXLN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR PBX LINE

Deactivate an IN Service Class Mark already assigned to a PBX line.

Incompatibilities :

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DACT INSCMREF : [LAC=] ,DN= ,LNO= [,OPMODE=] ,TYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the addressed


object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number of the PBX line.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

OPMODE OPERATING MODE

This parameter specifies the operating mode of the PBX line.


Incoming lines are lines coming to the switch from the PBX.
Outgoing lines are lines going from the switch to the PBX.

Notes:
- Input is mandatory if several OPMODE values are assigned
to the PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ABW ANALOG BOTHWAY


AIC ANALOG INCOMING
AOG ANALOG OUTGOING
IBW ISDN BOTHWAY
IIC ISDN INCOMING
IOG ISDN OUTGOING

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be deactivated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP1 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 1


TDP12 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 12
TDP13 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13
TDP13O14 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13O14
TDP14 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 14

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT INSCMREF- 5+


DACT INSCMREF
PBXLN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TDP2 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 2


TDP3 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 3
TDP4 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 4
TDP5 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5
TDP5O6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5O6
TDP6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 6

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT INSCMREF- 6+


DACT INSCMREF
SUBORPBX
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

6. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR SUB OR PBX

Deactivate an IN Service Class Mark already assigned to a subscriber or a PBX.

Incompatibilities :

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DACT INSCMREF : [LAC=] ,DN= ,TYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the addressed


object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be deactivated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP1 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 1


TDP12 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 12
TDP13 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13
TDP13O14 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 13O14
TDP14 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 14
TDP2 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 2
TDP3 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 3
TDP4 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 4
TDP5 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5
TDP5O6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5O6
TDP6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 6

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT INSCMREF- 7+


DACT INSCMREF
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

7. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR TRUNK GROUP

Deactivate an IN service class mark already assigned to a trunk group.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DACT INSCMREF : TGNO= ,TYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TYPE TRIGGER DETECTION POINT TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of trigger detection point


to be deactivated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

TDP1 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 1


TDP2 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 2
TDP3 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 3
TDP4 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 4
TDP5 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5
TDP5O6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 5O6
TDP6 TRIGGER DETECTION POINT 6

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT INSCMREF- 8-


DISP INSCMREF
CODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IN SERVICE CLASS MARK REFERENCE

This command displays references of subscribers, PBXs, PBX lines, trunk


groups, CENTREX groups, call types, common service groups and digit
codes to IN service class marks.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP INSCMREF- CODE IN SCM REFERENCE FOR DIGIT COMBINATION


2. DISP INSCMREF- CXGACODE IN SCM REF. FOR CENTREX GROUP AND CODE
3. DISP INSCMREF- CXGRP IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CENTREX GROUP
4. DISP INSCMREF- DN IN SCM REFERENCE ASSIOCIATED TO DN
5. DISP INSCMREF- TGNO IN SCM REFERENCE FOR TRUNK GROUP

1. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR DIGIT COMBINATION

Displays references of digit combinations (codes) to IN service class marks.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP INSCMREF : CODE= [,ORIG1=] [,SCMID=] [,STATUS=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION CODE

This parameter specifies the digit combination (code).

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code for which the


destination digits are evaluated.
Only decimal numbers, range 0..3839, and the hexadecimal number’DEF’
may be entered.

This hexadecimal number ’DEF’ identifies the "default ORIG1".


This value represents all ORIG1 values that are not explicitely
entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of an IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

STATUS ACTIVITY STATUS

This parameter specifies the status of the Intelligent Network


service whose data has to be displayed.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INSCMREF- 1+


DISP INSCMREF
CODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT SERVICE IS ACTIVE


INACT SERVICE IS NOT ACTIVE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INSCMREF- 2+


DISP INSCMREF
CXGACODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

IN SCM REF. FOR CENTREX GROUP AND CODE

Displays references of CENTREX groups and code to IN service class marks.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP INSCMREF : CXGRP= ,CODE= [,SCMID=] [,STATUS=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CXGRP CENTREX GROUP

This parameter specifies a number that identifies the CENTREX group.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION CODE

This parameter specifies the digit combination (code).

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of an IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

STATUS ACTIVITY STATUS

This parameter specifies the status of the Intelligent Network


service whose data has to be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT SERVICE IS ACTIVE


INACT SERVICE IS NOT ACTIVE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INSCMREF- 3+


DISP INSCMREF
CXGRP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CENTREX GROUP

Displays references of CENTREX groups to IN service class marks.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP INSCMREF : CXGRP= [,SCMID=] [,STATUS=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CXGRP CENTREX GROUP

This parameter specifies a number that identifies the CENTREX group.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of an IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

STATUS ACTIVITY STATUS

This parameter specifies the status of the Intelligent Network


service whose data has to be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT SERVICE IS ACTIVE


INACT SERVICE IS NOT ACTIVE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INSCMREF- 4+


DISP INSCMREF
DN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE ASSIOCIATED TO DN

Displays references of subscribers, PBXs, PBX lines, call types or


common service groups to IN service class marks.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP INSCMREF : [LAC=] ,DN= [,OTPTYPE=] [,LNO=] [,OPMODE=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,SCMID=] [,STATUS=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number.

Notes:
- If LAC=X is entered, DN=X has to be entered, too.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

OTPTYPE ORIG./TERM. PARTY TYPE

This parameter specifies the type for orginating or terminating


party.

Notes:
- If it is not entered, all types of originating or terminating
party are displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CSGRP COMMON SERVICE GROUP


CTYPE CALL TYPE
PBX PBX
PBXLN PBX LINE
SUB SUBSCRIBER

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number of the PBX line.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

OPMODE OPERATING MODE

This parameter specifies the operating mode of the PBX line.


Incoming lines are lines coming to the switch from the PBX.
Outgoing lines are lines going from the switch to the PBX.

Notes:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INSCMREF- 5+


DISP INSCMREF
DN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- Input is mandatory if several OPMODE values are assigned


to the PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ABW ANALOG BOTHWAY


AIC ANALOG INCOMING
AOG ANALOG OUTGOING
IBW ISDN BOTHWAY
IIC ISDN INCOMING
IOG ISDN OUTGOING

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of an IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

STATUS ACTIVITY STATUS

This parameter specifies the status of the Intelligent Network


service whose data has to be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT SERVICE IS ACTIVE


INACT SERVICE IS NOT ACTIVE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INSCMREF- 6+


DISP INSCMREF
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR TRUNK GROUP

Displays references of trunk groups to IN service class marks.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP INSCMREF : TGNO= [,SCMID=] [,STATUS=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of an IN service class mark.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

STATUS ACTIVITY STATUS

This parameter specifies the status of the Intelligent Network


service whose data has to be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT SERVICE IS ACTIVE


INACT SERVICE IS NOT ACTIVE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INSCMREF- 7-


MOD INSCMREF
CODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY IN SERVICE CLASS MARK REFERENCE

This command permits to replace an IN service class mark assigned to a


subscriber, a PBX, a PBX line, a trunk group, a CENTREX group, a call type,
a common service group or a digit code by another IN service class mark.

Prerequisites :
- The IN service class mark specified in parameter SCMID must have been
created with command CR INSCM.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD INSCMREF - CODE IN SCM REFERENCE FOR DIGIT COMBINATION


2. MOD INSCMREF - CTORCSG IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CALL TYPE OR CSGRP
3. MOD INSCMREF - CXGACODE IN SCM REF. FOR CENTREX GROUP AND CODE
4. MOD INSCMREF - CXGRP IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CENTREX GROUP
5. MOD INSCMREF - PBXLN IN SCM REFERENCE FOR PBX LINE
6. MOD INSCMREF - SUBORPBX IN SCM REFERENCE FOR SUB OR PBX
7. MOD INSCMREF - TGNO IN SCM REFERENCE FOR TRUNK GROUP

1. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR DIGIT COMBINATION

Replacement of an IN service class mark assigned to a digit combination


(for office based IN-triggering).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD INSCMREF : CODE= [,ORIG1=] ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION CODE

This parameter specifies the digit combination (code).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ORIG1 ORIGINATING MARK 1

This parameter specifies the originating code for which the


destination digits are evaluated.
Only decimal numbers, range 0..3839, and the hexadecimal number’DEF’
may be entered.

This hexadecimal number ’DEF’ identifies the "default ORIG1".


This value represents all ORIG1 values that are not explicitely
entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the new INSCM


to be assigned.

Compatibilities:
- The INSCM must be of the same TYPE as the old INSCM.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCMREF- 1+


MOD INSCMREF
CODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCMREF- 2+


MOD INSCMREF
CTORCSG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CALL TYPE OR CSGRP

Replacement of an IN service class mark assigned to a call type or


a common service group.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD INSCMREF : [LAC=] ,DN= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the addressed


object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the new INSCM


to be assigned.

Compatibilities:
- The INSCM must be of the same TYPE as the old INSCM.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCMREF- 3+


MOD INSCMREF
CXGACODE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

IN SCM REF. FOR CENTREX GROUP AND CODE

Replacement of an IN service class mark assigned to a CENTREX group and code.

Incompatibilities :
- Only INSCMs of type TDP3 can be assigned.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD INSCMREF : CXGRP= ,CODE= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CXGRP CENTREX GROUP

This parameter specifies a number that identifies the CENTREX group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

CODE DIGIT COMBINATION CODE

This parameter specifies the digit combination (code).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the new INSCM


to be assigned.

Compatibilities:
- The INSCM must be of the same TYPE as the old INSCM.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCMREF- 4+


MOD INSCMREF
CXGRP
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR CENTREX GROUP

Replacement of an IN service class mark assigned to a CENTREX group.

Incompatibilities :

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD INSCMREF : CXGRP= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

CXGRP CENTREX GROUP

This parameter specifies a number that identifies the CENTREX group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...4 digit decimal number

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the new INSCM


to be assigned.

Compatibilities:
- The INSCM must be of the same TYPE as the old INSCM.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCMREF- 5+


MOD INSCMREF
PBXLN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR PBX LINE

Replacement of the IN service class mark assigned to a PBX line.

Incompatibilities :

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD INSCMREF : [LAC=] ,DN= [,OPMODE=] ,LNO= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the addressed


object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

OPMODE OPERATING MODE

This parameter specifies the operating mode of the PBX line.


Incoming lines are lines coming to the switch from the PBX.
Outgoing lines are lines going from the switch to the PBX.

Notes:
- Input is mandatory if several OPMODE values are assigned
to the PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ABW ANALOG BOTHWAY


AIC ANALOG INCOMING
AOG ANALOG OUTGOING
IBW ISDN BOTHWAY
IIC ISDN INCOMING
IOG ISDN OUTGOING

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the line number of the PBX line.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the new INSCM


to be assigned.

Compatibilities:
- The INSCM must be of the same TYPE as the old INSCM.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCMREF- 6+


MOD INSCMREF
SUBORPBX
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

6. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR SUB OR PBX

Replacement of the IN service class mark assigned to a subscriber


or a PBX.

Incompatibilities :

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD INSCMREF : [LAC=] ,DN= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the addressed


object.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the new INSCM


to be assigned.

Compatibilities:
- The INSCM must be of the same TYPE as the old INSCM.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCMREF- 7+


MOD INSCMREF
TGNO
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

7. Input format

IN SCM REFERENCE FOR TRUNK GROUP

Replacement of an IN service class mark assigned to a trunk group


(for trunk group based IN-triggering).

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD INSCMREF : TGNO= ,SCMID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

TGNO TRUNK GROUP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the trunk group number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SCMID SERVICE CLASS MARK IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the new INSCM


to be assigned.

Compatibilities:
- The INSCM must be of the same TYPE as the old INSCM.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INSCMREF- 8-


ACT INSLDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACT INTELL.NETWORK SERVICE LOGIC DATA

This command will be used for the activation of the service with the
feature Service Filtering for the specified Intelligent Network subscriber
which was deactivated by the operator before.

Prerequisites:
- The subscriber activated by the partner Service Control Point has been
deactivated by the DACT INSLDAT command.

Notes:
- Generally the activation of the subscriber will be done by the Service
Control Point.
- At this activation the counter for valid votes will not be reset.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) X( )= 1
1 1VOTEDN=1 11,CLGPTY=11 (;) 1
1 ACT INSLDAT : ZSKEY= Y 1Z,LOCNO= Y1 Z Y 1
1 1 1 11 11 *!+ 1
1 * + >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

VOTEDN VOTE DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number for which Service


Filtering has to be executed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SKEY SERVICE KEY

This parameter specifies the Intelligent Network service for which


Service Filtering has to be executed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the calling party


in case of origin dependent counting.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...22 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LOCNO LOCATION NUMBER

This parameter specifies the location number


in case of origin dependent counting.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT INSLDAT- 1-


CAN INSLDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CAN INTELL.NETWORK SERVICE LOGIC DATA

This command removes the service logic data that are necessary for the
feature Service Filtering of an Intelligent Network vote directory
number.

Prerequisites:
- The status of Service Filtering for the specified vote directory
number has to be inactive.

Notes:
- Generally Service Filtering will be deactivated by an administration
message from the partner Service Control Point. If it is not able to
send this message, the DACT INSLDAT command may be used.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) X( )= 1
1 1VOTEDN=1 11,CLGPTY=11 (;) 1
1 CAN INSLDAT : ZSKEY= Y 1Z,LOCNO= Y1 Z Y 1
1 1 1 11 11 *!+ 1
1 * + >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

VOTEDN VOTE DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number for which Service


Filtering has to be executed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SKEY SERVICE KEY

This parameter specifies the Intelligent Network service for which


Service Filtering has to be executed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the calling party


in case of origin dependent counting.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...22 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LOCNO LOCATION NUMBER

This parameter specifies the location number


in case of origin dependent counting.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INSLDAT- 1-


DACT INSLDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DACT INTELL.NETWORK SERVICE LOGIC DATA

This command deactivates the feature Service Filtering of an Intelligent


Network service subscriber. Generally Service Filtering will be deactivated
by an administration message from the partner Service Control Point or a timer.
If it is not able to send such a message, this command may be used. It can be
used in case of canceling an element, if the Service Control Point is not able
to do it.

Prerequisites:
- The status of Service Filtering for the specified subscriber identifier
has to be active.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) X( )= 1
1 1VOTEDN=1 11,CLGPTY=11 (;) 1
1 DACT INSLDAT : ZSKEY= Y 1Z,LOCNO= Y1 Z Y 1
1 1 1 11 11 *!+ 1
1 * + >* +W 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

VOTEDN VOTE DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number for which Service


Filtering has to be executed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SKEY SERVICE KEY

This parameter specifies the Intelligent Network service for which


Service Filtering has to be executed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the calling party


in case of origin dependent counting.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...22 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LOCNO LOCATION NUMBER

This parameter specifies the location number


in case of origin dependent counting.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT INSLDAT- 1-


DISP INSLDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISP INTELL.NETWORK SERVICE LOGIC DATA

This command displays data concerning specified or all Intelligent Network


numbers for the feature Service Filtering. In order to select a vote
directory number (possibly in connection with an origin)
also the protocol type has to be entered. Depending on the FORMAT
parameter specific data for the control of Service Filtering related to a
vote directory number, for the treatment of filtered calls, a SCP address
description or specific statistics (counter) will be displayed. A further
choice can be reached by means of the parameters STATUS, SKEY and
MODE to select all active or inactive Service Filtering entities, all
entities related to a service or all entities related to a control mode,
respectively.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,CLGPTY=11 1
1 DISP INSLDAT : <VOTEDN= ,SKEY=> 1Z,LOCNO= Y1 [,PROT=] 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,FORMAT=] [,STATUS=] [,MODE=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

VOTEDN VOTE DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number for which Service


Filtering has to be executed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SKEY SERVICE KEY

This parameter specifies the Intelligent Network service for which


Service Filtering entities have to be displayed:
Notice:
- If SKEY and VOTEDN are entered all Service Filtering entities
with the specified SKEY and VOTEDN will be displayed.
- If the SKEY is entered without the VOTEDN, only these Service
Filtering entities will be displayed, which have the specified
SKEY as filter criteria.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the calling party


in case of origin dependent counting.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...22 digit hexadecimal number where B is

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INSLDAT- 1+


DISP INSLDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LOCNO LOCATION NUMBER

This parameter specifies the location number


in case of origin dependent counting.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PROT PROTOCOL TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the Intelligent


Network application protocol the service execution is
based on.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SINAP1 SIEMENS INAP 1


CS1 CS1 CONFORM INAP
CS2 CS2 CONFORM INAP
PROT4 PROTOCOL TYPE 4

FORMAT FORMAT SELECTION FOR DISPLAY

This parameter specifies the kind of data which has to be displayed


for an Intelligent Network service subscriber on the own exchange:
- PA has to be used for the selection of control data for the
specified directory number.
- CT has to be used for the selection of information about the
treatment of filtered calls.
- AD has to be used for the selection of an address description
of the partner Service Control Point.
- ST has to be used for the selection of directory number
specific statistic data (counter).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PA DISPLAY CONTROL PARAMETER


CT DISPLAY CALL TREATMENT
AD ADDRESS DESCRIPTION
ST STATUS OF COUNTER

Default: PA

STATUS STATUS OF SUBSCRIBER

This parameter specifies the state of the Service Filtering entities


which are selected to display. Omitting this parameter the active
and inactive entities are displayed. If a vote directory number is
specified, the STATUS parameter should be omitted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INACT INACTIVE SUBSCRIBER


ACT ACTIVE SUBSCRIBER

MODE CONTROL MODE

This parameter specifies the mode of Service Filtering control


to be selected for the display.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UP UPDATE CONTROLLED
TI TIME CONTROLLED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INSLDAT- 2-


ENTR INSLDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTR INTELL.NETWORK SERVICE LOGIC DATA

This command will be used for the regeneration of Service Filtering


feature data for Intelligent Network subscriber. The execution of
this command includes the activation of the feature Service Filtering
for this subscriber. All counters assigned to the subscriber entities
(the subscriber with VOTEDN and all with SELCODES entered
consecutive numbered directory numbers). In case of expired TERDATE
and TERTIME, the subscriber will be canceled.
Entering this command not for the purpose of data regeneration but for
the creation, modification or cancelation purpose, a conflict for the
partner Service Control Point could be caused.

Prerequisites:
1. General:
- There must be created a trigger profile for the SKEY by the command
CR INTRIG.
- The Service Filtering subscribers and all consecutive numbers
must belong to the same by CR CPT created Code Point.
The Code Points which are relevant for Service Filtering subscribers
may not contain the optional parameters LAC, MFCAT, ZDIG or
ROUTYP.

2. In case of a CCNC configuration:

Notes:
- The specified data correspond to the data sent by the Service Control
Point.
- If MODE = TI, all counters are sent to the Service Control Point
in case of modification or cancellation.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,CLGPTY=11 1
1 ENTR INSLDAT : [VOTEDN=] ,SKEY= 1Z,LOCNO= Y1 [,CHARIND=] 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
1 ,TREAT= [,PROT=] [,ACNSEL=] [,SELCODES=] 1
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,PRECVAL=1 1
1 [,SCLENGTH=] [,MODE=] Z,INTERV= Y [,BEGDATE= 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 ,BEGTIME=] [,CODURA=] [,TERDATE= ,TERTIME=] 1
1 1
1 [,RELCA=] [,DURA=] [,ANNCYC=] [,RTGP=] 1
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,NETIND= 1 1
1 Z,NETNAME=Y [,TTID= ,NA= ,NP= ,GTDIG=] 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,DPC=] [,SSID=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR INSLDAT- 1+


ENTR INSLDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Input parameter

VOTEDN VOTE DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number for which Service


Filtering has to be executed.

Notes:
- If PROT = SINAP1 this parameter does not contain the
selection code digits. Otherwise the directory number contains
the first selection code.
- The last two digits have to be entered as decimal
numbers

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

SKEY SERVICE KEY

This parameter specifies the Intelligent Network service


to be installed on the home exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

CLGPTY CALLING PARTY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the calling party


in case of origin dependent counting.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...22 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LOCNO LOCATION NUMBER

This parameter specifies the location number


in case of origin dependent counting.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CHARIND CHARGE INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the kind of charging for calls to all IN


numbers, assigned to this subscriber.
A not entered parameter will be interpreted as invalid charging
indicator.
Note:
- Up to two parameter values can be linked with &.
The parameter values PLSATT and PLSSUP can be
entered together.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b]

a: CHARGE INDICATOR
NOCHAR NOT TO BE CHARGED
ZONE CHARGED BY ZONE
NOACTR NO SPECIFIC ACTION REQUIRED
PLSATT PULSE CALL ATTEMPT TARIFF
Compatibilities:
- PLSSUP
PLSSUP PULSE SET-UP TARIFF AT ANSWER
Compatibilities:
- PLSATT

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR INSLDAT- 2+


ENTR INSLDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: ZONE NUMBER / TARIFF=


0...511, range of decimal numbers

Compatibilities:
- If CHARIND = ZONE, PLSATT or PLSSUP this parameter value
is mandatory.

TREAT CALL TREATMENT

This parameter specifies the intercept code to confirm a counted call


for a valid selection code while executing Service Filtering.

Compatibilities:
- For TONE identifier the b is of range (1..31).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: TONE/ANNOUNCEMENT IDENTIFICATION
TONE SCP TONE
Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1
ANN SCP ANNOUNCEMENT

b: ADDITIONAL NUMERIC VALUE=


0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

PROT PROTOCOL TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the Intelligent


Network application protocol the service execution is
based on.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SINAP1 SIEMENS INAP 1


CS1 CS1 CONFORM INAP
CS2 CS2 CONFORM INAP
PROT4 PROTOCOL TYPE 4

Default: CS1

ACNSEL APPLIC. CONTEXT NAME SELECTOR

ACNSEL=3 : SINAP5M
ACNSEL=5 : SINAP5M+
ACNSEL=6 : SINAP5M++
ACNSEL=7 : 163TR78
ACNSEL=8 : TINAP2001
ACNSEL=10: CAP Version 1
ACNSEL=11: CAP Version 2
ACNSEL=12: CAP Version 3
ACNSEL=13: CAP Version 3 SMS-MO
ACNSEL=14: SINAP7M
ACNSEL=15: SINAP7M+
ACNSEL=20: SINAP6NP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...31, range of decimal numbers

SELCODES LIMIT OF SELECTION CODES

This parameter specifies the number of selection codes that will be


created for the subscriber.

Compatibilities:
- Only in case of whitebook SCCP 100 selection codes will be
supported. If bluebook SCCP is used in the network, the number
of selection codes is limited to 30.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...100, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR INSLDAT- 3+


ENTR INSLDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Default: 1

SCLENGTH SELECTION CODE LENGTH

This parameter specifies the number of digits, specifying the


selection codes for a service filtering entity.

Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...2, range of decimal numbers

MODE CONTROL MODE

This parameter specifies the mode of Service Filtering control


to be selected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UP UPDATE CONTROLLED
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
TI TIME CONTROLLED
Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

Default: TI

PRECVAL PRECOUNT VALUE

This parameter specifies the number of calls for valid selection codes
that have to be counted until a request to the partner Service Control
Point has to be initiated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

INTERV PRECOUNT INTERVAL

This parameter specifies the time interval in seconds during which the
calls with valid selection code have to be counted. After expiration
a request to the partner Service Control Point has to be initiated.

Incompatibilities:
- If PROT = SINAP1 this parameter is not allowed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3600, range of decimal numbers

BEGDATE BEGIN DATE

This parameter specifies the begin date of Service Filtering for


an entity.

Prerequisites:
- MODE = TI.

Default: current date

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR INSLDAT- 4+


ENTR INSLDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

BEGTIME BEGIN TIME

This parameter specifies the begin time of Service Filtering for


an entity.

Prerequisites:
- MODE = TI.

Default: current time

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b[-c]

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECONDS=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

CODURA CONTROL DURATION

This parameter specifies the time (in seconds) service filtering


will be performed for this entity after the BEGDATE / BEGTIME.

Prerequisites:
- MODE = TI .

Incompatibilities:
- If no value was entered, the TERDATE and TERTIME has to be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...86400, range of decimal numbers

TERDATE TERMINATING DATE

This parameter specifies the stop date of Service Filtering for


an entity.

Prerequisites:
- MODE = TI.
In this case either CODURA or this parameter has to be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

TERTIME TERMINATING TIME

This parameter specifies the stop time of Service Filtering for


an entity.

Prerequisites:
- MODE = TI.
In this case either CODURA or this parameter has to be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR INSLDAT- 5+


ENTR INSLDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a-b[-c]

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECONDS=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

RELCA RELEASE CAUSE

This parameter specifies the release cause, which will be used


to control the call release and intercept treatment.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: LOCATION
USER USER
PRL PRIVATE NETWORK LOCAL USER
PUL PUBLIC NETWORK LOCAL USER
TRN TRANSIT NETWORK
PUR PUBLIC NETWORK REMOTE USER
PRR PRIVATE NETWORK REMOTE USER
INTN INTERNATIONAL NETWORK
IWP BEYOND AN INTERWORKING POINT

Default: PUL

b: CAUSE VALUE=
0...127, range of decimal numbers

Default: 31

DURA TONE/ANNOUNCEMENT DURATION

This parameter specifies the time limitation (in seconds) of the


entered tone or announcement.

Compatibilities:
- If the PROT = SINAP1 this parameter is mandatory.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...255, range of decimal numbers

Default: 40

ANNCYC NUMBER OF ANNOUNCEMENT CYCLES

This parameter specifies the number of cycles of the entered


announcement . It is related to the announcement determined by the
TREAT parameter.

Compatibilities:
- If PROT = SINAP1 this parameter is mandatory.

Incompatibilities:
- TREAT = TONE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...7, range of decimal numbers

Default: 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR INSLDAT- 6+


ENTR INSLDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences for the


delivery of a Signalling Connection Control Part message
to the Service Control Point.

Incompatibilities:
- MODE = UP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SPC ROUTE BY SPC AND SSN


GT ROUTE BY GT

Default: SPC

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the network of the


Service Switching Point.

Incompatibilities:
- MODE = UP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NET 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NET 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NET 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NET 1

NETNAME NETWORK NAME

This parameter identifies the signalling network in which


the destination point is existing by its name. This parameter
is mandatory if the feature multiple networks is activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

TTID TRANSLATION TYPE ID.

This parameter specifies the translation type identifier


of the global title.

Incompatibilities:
- MODE = UP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UNKNOWN TRANSLATION TYPE UNKNOWN


IMSI INTERNATIONAL MOBILE SUB. ID.
CCV CREDIT CARD VERIFICATION
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
IEESS ISDN END-TO-END SUPPL. SERV.
ITCC INT. TELECOMM. CHARGE CARD
TT9 TRANSLATION TYPE 9
TT10 TRANSLATION TYPE 10
TT11 TRANSLATION TYPE 11
TT12 TRANSLATION TYPE 12
TT13 TRANSLATION TYPE 13
TT14 TRANSLATION TYPE 14
TT15 TRANSLATION TYPE 15

NA NATURE OF ADDRESS

This parameter specifies the nature of address of the global title.

Incompatibilities:
- MODE = UP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UNKNOWN NATURE OF ADDRESS UNKNOWN

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR INSLDAT- 7+


ENTR INSLDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SUBNO SUBSCRIBER NUMBER


NATUSE RESERVED FOR NATIONAL USE
NATNO NATIONAL SIGNIFICANT NUMBER
INTNO INTERNATIONAL NUMBER
NA5 NATURE OF ADDRESS 5
NA6 NATURE OF ADDRESS 6
NA7 NATURE OF ADDRESS 7
NA8 NATURE OF ADDRESS 8
NA9 NATURE OF ADDRESS 9
NA10 NATURE OF ADDRESS 10
NA11 NATURE OF ADDRESS 11
NA12 NATURE OF ADDRESS 12
NA13 NATURE OF ADDRESS 13
NA14 NATURE OF ADDRESS 14
NA15 NATURE OF ADDRESS 15

NP NUMBERING PLAN

This parameter specifies the numbering plan of the global title.

Incompatibilities:
- MODE = UP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

UNKNOWN NUMB. PLAN UNKNOWN


ISDNTNP ISDN TELEPHONY NUMB. PLAN
NP2 NUMBERING PLAN 2
DATANP DATA NUMBERING PLAN
TELEXNP TELEX NUMBERING PLAN
MMNP MARITIME MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
LMNP LAND MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
ISDNMNP ISDN MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
NP8 NUMBERING PLAN 8
NP9 NUMBERING PLAN 9
NP10 NUMBERING PLAN 10
NP11 NUMBERING PLAN 11
NP12 NUMBERING PLAN 12
NP13 NUMBERING PLAN 13
PNP PRIVATE NUMBERING PLAN
NP15 NUMBERING PLAN 15

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the digits of the global title. The digits can
be input in a structured format.

Incompatibilities:
- MODE = UP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: GT DIGITS FIRST PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: GT DIGITS SECOND PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: GT DIGITS THIRD PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

DPC DESTINATION POINT CODE

Network Indicator = NAT0 Units = 4-3-4-3


Network Indicator = INAT0 Units = 3-8-3
Network Indicator = NAT1 Units = 4-3-4-3
Network Indicator = INAT1 Units = 3-8-3

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR INSLDAT- 8+


ENTR INSLDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: DESTINATION POINT CODE - UNIT 1=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

b: DESTINATION POINT CODE - UNIT 2=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: DESTINATION POINT CODE - UNIT 3=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: DESTINATION POINT CODE - UNIT 4=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the subsystem identifier of the service


specific application part on the partner Service Control Point.

Incompatibilities:
- MODE = UP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

IN2 IN APPLICATION 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION 3
IN4 IN APPLICATION 4
If a destination point code which specifies an
EWSD node is entered together with this subsystem
identifier then the LNP (local number portability)
server function on that EWSD node is addressed.
IN5 IN APPLICATION 5
If a destination point code which specifies the
own EWSD node is entered together with this
subsystem identifier then the internal SCF on the
own node is addressed.
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01
FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR INSLDAT- 9-


END INSTALL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

END INSTALLATION RECOVERY

This command terminates the installation phase.


As a result of this command, normal handling of software faults via SW error
treatment and recovery action groups is possible.

Notes:
During the installation phase software faults cause a processor stop.

This command is only permitted when an exchange is first being put into service.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 END INSTALL ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 END INSTALL- 1-


REC INSTAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RECORD INTELLIGENT NETWORK STATISTIC

This command starts the recording of IN statistic measurement.


To store the data on disk a measurement file will be created and
the name of the file will be displayed at the OMT. A maximum of
2 commands can be entered.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REC INSTAT : UNIT= [,BEG=] [,TER=] [,IV=] [,PER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

UNIT OUTPUT UNIT AND MODE

This parameter specifies the output unit and the form of output.
Only one of the possible alternatives may be selected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: OUTPUT UNIT
OMT OPERATION AND MAIN.TERMINAL
If this option is selected, data are output
every 15 minutes throughout the specified
measurement period.
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
If this option is selected, a measurement file
is created and the received traffic data are
output to this file. After the parameter has
been accepted and at the end of the last
recording, an acknowledgement is output to
the OMT. It includes the name of the file in
which the traffic data are available for
postprocessing.
For postprocessing, the data must first
be copied to a removable medium.

This information unit specifies the output unit.

b: OUTPUT MODE
SINGLE SINGLE TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
output to single measurement files.
If a file is destroyed or cannot be extended, an
advisory is output to the OMT.
DAILY DAILY TRAFFIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
output to day files. This is appropriate in
connection with continuous measurements which
start immediately and have no defined end.
To secure the required space on disk, all 7 daily
files (MO...SU) are prepared and created before
the command is accepted.
At least 15 minutes elapse before the first data
are output. Time parameters are not permissible
for these measurements.
A day file is closed at the end of the day and a
new file for the next day is automatically created
on the disk, or the existing file is replaced.
In the second and subsequent weeks, the
file for the same day of the week is
overwritten.

This information unit specifies the desired output form

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC INSTAT- 1+


REC INSTAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

(day file or single measurement file).


It is only permissible in connection with output unit = MDD.

BEG BEGIN DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement begin time.

Notes:
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER must be
specified.
Exception: Time parameters may not be specified for the data output
in day files.
- A maximum of four BEG dates may be linked with &. In case of
linked BEG dates, TER is not permissible.
- The earliest possible begin date BEG is the day after
command entry.

Default: current date

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF BEGIN DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF BEGIN DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

TER TERMINATION DATE

This parameter indicates the measurement time termination date.

Notes:
- Only one termination date may be entered per command.
The earliest possible termination date is the day after command
entry.
- Throughout the specified recording period, the measurement data
are called down every 15 minutes and output on the relevant output
device.
- The measurement duration may not exceed one year.
- Either the begin date BEG or the termination date TER must be
specified.
Exception: Time parameters may not be specified for the data output
in day files.

Default: the end of measurement is determined by the single day


measurement.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR OF TERMINATION DATE=


0...99, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY OF TERMINATION DATE=


1...31, range of decimal numbers

IV INTERVAL TIME

This parameter indicates the daily measurement interval times.

Notes:
- A maximum of 4 measurement intervals may be linked with &.
- Interval times are only permissible in connection with a begin date

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC INSTAT- 2+


REC INSTAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

(BEG).

Default: 24-hour measurement on the specified days

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: HOUR OF BEGIN DATE=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE OF BEGIN DATE=


0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

c: HOUR OF TERMINATION DATE=


0...23, range of decimal numbers

d: MINUTE OF TERMINATION DATE=


0,15,30,45, range of decimal numbers

PER PERIODIC WEEKDAY

This parameter specifies the weekdays on which data are to be recorded.

Notes:
- Up to 6 weekdays (MO..SU) may be linked with &.
The categories of weekdays (NO, WO, HO) may be entered alone.
- The input of weekdays is only permissible in connection with a
termination date (TER).
- If the value HO is selected all sundays, ’national’ holidays
and ’international’ holidays will be measured.
- The parameter values NO, HO and WO are not usable in
combination with other parameter values.
- Exception: Time parameter may not be specified for the data
output in daily files.

Default: daily measurement during the measurement period.


No input means measurement on all days.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

NO EVERY DAY
MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY
HO HOLIDAY

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC INSTAT- 3-


ENTR INSTGEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER INSTALLATION GENERATION

This command creates an initial installation generation as part of the


initial installation of an application program system (APS) in a
switching processor.

A differentiation must be made between initial installation of an APS and


re-installation of a previously active APS and the associated files. For
this purpose, commands UPD GEN, COPY GEN, TRANS SYFILE and ENTR GEN
as well as auxiliary commands such as MOD GEN, CAN GEN, ACT FIXPOINT
and DACT FIXPOINT can be used.

Another differentiation must be made between the initial installation of an


APS and database extension for this APS. Once the initial installation
procedure has been performed, database extension is possible. For this
purpose, the commands MOD DBSIZE and DISP DBSIZE are used.

For creating the initial installation generation, the system files read in
from tape/optical disk are combined to form a file generation. The name of
the generation to be created is taken from the Tasklib. File SY.SEMILIB
(semipermanent database) is extracted from the Tasklib. File SY.SIMP is
extracted from file SY.PSW.T098, provided the latter exists. All these
starting files (production system files) are delivered as non-generation
files by the manufacturer on tape/optical disk. Only in course of
ENTR INSTGEN they are assigned to the generation to be introduced. The
loadlibs are attached and connected and update is activated.

If no files or not all of the files required for creating the initial
installation are specified, the disk is searched for the missing production
system files. Only those files that conform to the conventions for system
files and, of these, only the first file found in each case are used.

A precondition for creating the initial installation generation is that


the complete production system files exist (at least one PSW Lib must exist)
and that they do not belong to different APSs.

The specified file name need not be in accordance with the name conventions
for EWSD system files; if required, the name of the file is automatically
changed to a file name that is in accordance with the EWSD conventions,
when the file is introduced in the initial installation generation.

The name of the initial installation generation is formed as follows:

|---------------|
| ff kk 00 00 |
|---------------|

The command is rejected if a generation exists already.


For information about the generation concept see the command description
for COPY GEN.

This command is only permitted when an exchange is first being put into service.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR INSTGEN : [LIB=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIB LIBRARY

This parameter specifies a library in the SSP LIB113D format. Only


TASKLIB, SEMILIB, LOADLIB.LA, LOADLIB.MA, LOADLIB.CA type files and
PSW libraries are accepted. The parameter can be used in the
continuation mode, i.e. several libraries can be specified one after
the other. If the library name is not a system file name, it will be
renamed.

This parameter is used to specify the system files that are to be


incorporated in the installation generation. The specified file must

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR INSTGEN- 1+


ENTR INSTGEN

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

be without generation,i.e., it must be a production system file read


in from the production tape/optical disk. Accordingly, it is not
permissible to specify a CP-Semilib or Simp-Semilib; these are not
automatically created from the production Tasklib until the initial
installation generation is created. In continuation mode, some or
all production files can be specified one after the other.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...17 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR INSTGEN- 2-


CAN INTCELL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL INTERNAL CELL

This command cancels an internal cell within the mobile services


switching center area (MSC area).

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN INTCELL : LACOD= ,CI= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LACOD LOCATION AREA CODE

LACOD a: 0..65535

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...65535, range of decimal numbers

CI CELL IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the geographical area in which a single


base station supplies the radio resources. A cell is the smallest
addressable unit of a radio area from point of view of the MSC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...65535, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INTCELL- 1-


CR INTCELL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE INTERNAL CELL

This command creates an internal cell within the mobile services


switching center area (MSC area).

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR INTCELL : LACOD= ,CI= ,BSCSPC= ,NETIND= ,RC= ,LMN= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,LCSCAP=] [,GAD=] [,ORIG2=] [,LOCNO=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LACOD LOCATION AREA CODE

LACOD a: 0..65535

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...65535, range of decimal numbers

CI CELL IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the geographical area in which a single


base station supplies the radio resources. A cell is the smallest
addressable unit of a radio area from point of view of the MSC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...65535, range of decimal numbers

BSCSPC BASE STATION CONTROLLER SPC

BSCSPC a: = 1..15
b: = 1..7
c: = 1..15
d: = 1..7

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: SIGNALING POINT CODE UNIT1=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

b: SIGNALING POINT CODE UNIT2=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: SIGNALING POINT CODE UNIT3=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: SIGNALING POINT CODE UNIT4=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the network concerned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTCELL- 1+
CR INTCELL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1


NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

RC RADIO CONTROLLER

This parameter specifies the type of the radio system.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

BSC GSM BASE STATION CONTROLLER


RNC UMTS RADIO NETWORK CONTROLLER

LMN LOCATION MARK NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the emergency center


to which emergency calls are routed.
If the Hex-digit ’F’ is used in the location mark number, this digit
will be replaced by the dialed digits.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...16 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

LCSCAP LOCATION SERVICES CAPABILITY

This parameter specifies the type of location services (LCS)


which the radio network controller (RNC) supports. It only
applies if the radio controller is an RNC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NONE NO LOCATION SERVICES


GEOGRAPH GEOGRAPHIC LOCATION
SAI SERVICE AREA IDENTIFICATION

Default: NONE

GAD GEOGRAPHICAL AREA DESCRIPTION

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: LATITUDE=
1...6 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: LONGITUDE=
1...6 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: UNCERTAINTY CODE=
1...2 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

The following values are allowed:


- 01...7F, range of hexadecimal numbers

ORIG2 ORIGINATING MARK 2

This parameter specifies the originating mark of a call.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...252, range of decimal numbers

LOCNO LOCATION NUMB ORIG FOR IN APPL

This parameter specifies the geographic area for IN services.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit decimal number

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTCELL- 2-
DISP INTCELL
BSCAREA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY INTERNAL CELL

This command displays data of created internal cells of a mobile


services switching center area (MSC area).

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP INTCELL - BSCAREA BSC AREA DATA


2. DISP INTCELL - CELL CELL DATA
3. DISP INTCELL - LOCAREA LOCATION AREA DATA
4. DISP INTCELL - ORIGMARK ORIGIN CLASS DATA

1. Input format

BSC AREA DATA

This input format displays information of a specified BSC or RNC area.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP INTCELL : BSCSPC= ,NETIND= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

BSCSPC BASE STATION CONTROLLER SPC

BSCSPC a: = 1..15
b: = 1..7
c: = 1..15
d: = 1..7

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: SIGNALING POINT CODE UNIT1=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

b: SIGNALING POINT CODE UNIT2=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: SIGNALING POINT CODE UNIT3=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: SIGNALING POINT CODE UNIT4=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the network type concerned.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NETWORK 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NETWORK 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NETWORK 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INTCELL- 1+


DISP INTCELL
CELL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

CELL DATA

This input format displays information of a specified cell.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP INTCELL : LACOD= ,CI= [,DATAKD=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LACOD LOCATION AREA CODE

LACOD a: 0..65535

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...65535, range of decimal numbers

CI CELL IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the geographical area in which a single


base station supplies the radio resources. A cell is the smallest
addressable unit of a radio area from point of view of the MSC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...65535, range of decimal numbers

DATAKD DATA KIND

This parameter specifies the kind of data to be displayed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

GENRDATA GENERAL DATA


INDATA INTELLIGENT NETWORK DATA
LCSDATA LOCATION SERVICES DATA

Default: GENRDATA

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INTCELL- 2+


DISP INTCELL
LOCAREA
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

LOCATION AREA DATA

This input format displays information of a specified location area


or all location area codes depending on value of LACOD.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP INTCELL : LACOD= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LACOD LOCATION AREA CODE

LACOD a: 0..65535

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...65535, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INTCELL- 3+


DISP INTCELL
ORIGMARK
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

ORIGIN CLASS DATA

This input format displays cells assigned to mobile charging zones.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP INTCELL : ORIG2= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ORIG2 ORIGINATING MARK 2

This parameter specifies the originating mark of a call.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...252, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INTCELL- 4-


MOD INTCELL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY INTERNAL CELL

This command modifies assigned data of an internal cell.

Notes:
- Only one of the optional parameters may be entered at one time.
Exceptions are mentioned in the parameter description.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted if a mobile services switching


center/visitor location register (MSC/VLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD INTCELL : LACOD= ,CI= <,NLACOD= ,NCI= ,NORIG2= ,NLOCNO= 1
1 1
1 ,CLOCNO= ,NLCSCAP= ,NGAD= ,CGAD=> ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LACOD LOCATION AREA CODE

LACOD a: 0..65535

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...65535, range of decimal numbers

CI CELL IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the geographical area in which a single


base station supplies the radio resources. A cell is the smallest
addressable unit of a radio area from point of view of the MSC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...65535, range of decimal numbers

NLACOD NEW LOCATION AREA CODE

NLACOD a: 0..65535

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...65535, range of decimal numbers

NCI NEW CELL IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the new geographical area in which a single


base station supplies the radio resources. A cell is the smallest
addressable unit of a radio area from point of view of the MSC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...65535, range of decimal numbers

NORIG2 NEW ORIGINATING MARK 2

This parameter specifies the new originating mark of a call.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...252, range of decimal numbers

NLOCNO NEW LOC NUMB ORIG FOR IN APPL

This parameter specifies the new geographic area for IN services.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit decimal number

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTCELL- 1+


MOD INTCELL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CLOCNO CAN LOC NUMB ORIG FOR IN APPL

This parameter specifies the existing geographic area for IN services


to be deleted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...15 digit decimal number

NLCSCAP NEW LOCATION SERV. CAPABILITY

This parameter specifies the new type of location services (LCS) which
the radio network controller (RNC) supports. It only applies if the
radio controller is an RNC.

Compatibilities:
- If you enter NLCSCAP=SAI, the parameter NGAD can also be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NONE NO LOCATION SERVICES


GEOGRAPH GEOGRAPHIC LOCATION
SAI SERVICE AREA IDENTIFICATION

Default: NONE

NGAD NEW GEOGR. AREA DESCRIPTION

This parameter specifies the new geographical area description.

Compatibilities:
- Can be entered with parameter a=SAI.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: LATITUDE=
1...6 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: LONGITUDE=
1...6 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: UNCERTAINTY CODE=
1...2 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

CGAD CANCEL GEOGR. AREA DESCRIPTION

This parameter specifies the existing geographical area description


to be deleted.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: LATITUDE=
1...6 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: LONGITUDE=
1...6 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: UNCERTAINTY CODE=
1...2 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTCELL- 2-


REC INTCELL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RECORD INTERNAL CELL

This command records the internal cell related data or the handover
traffic flow structure data depending on the entered STOP JOB.

Prerequisites:
- System time must be secure when the command is entered.

Notes:
- The measurement can be stopped with DTYPE if the time
parameter values allow a continuation of the job.
- Only the measurement of internal cells is allowed.
- This command is only allowed for an MSC.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command starts a semipermanent job. It can be canceled with CAN JOB.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REC INTCELL : UNIT= ,DTYPE= [,INTCELL=] [,BEG=] [,TER=] 1
1 1
1 [,IV=] [,PER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

UNIT UNIT

This parameter specifies the output unit and the form of output.
Only one of the possible alternatives may be selected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: DEVICE
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
If this option is selected, a measurement file
is created and the received traffic data are
output to this file. After the parameter has
been accepted and at the end of the last
recording, an acknowledgement is output to
the OMT. It includes the name of the file in
which the traffic data are available for
postprocessing.
For postprocessing, the data must first be
copied to tape.

Notes:
- Identifier a covers both MDD and MOD.

This information unit specifies the output unit.

b: FILETYPE
SINGLE SINGLE FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
output to single measurement files.
DAILY DAILY FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
output to daily files. This is appropriate in
connection with continuous measurements which
start immediately and have no defined end.
To secure the required space on disk, all 7
daily files (MO...SU) are prepared and created
before the command is accepted.
Time parameters are not permissible for these
measurements.
A daily file is closed at the end of the day
and a new file for the next day is automatically
created on disk or the existing file is replaced.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC INTCELL- 1+


REC INTCELL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

In the second and subsequent weeks, the file


for the same day of the week is overwritten.
CYCLIC CYCLIC FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
written into a cyclic measurement file.
Time parameters are not permitted for these
measurements.
If the cyclic file runs full the newest
data will be lost.
This occurs after a period of two days.

This information unit specifies the desired output form


(daily files, single or cyclic measurement files).

DTYPE DATATYPE

This parameter specifies the kind of data that is to be measured.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTCREL INTERNAL CELL RELATED MEAS


HOTRFS HANDOVER TRAFFIC FLOW STRUCT

INTCELL INTERNAL CELL IDENTIFICATION

This parameter specifies the internal cell.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: LOCATION AREA CODE=


1...65535, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the


location area code.

b: CELL IDENTIFICATION=
0...65535, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the


cell identification.

BEG BEGINNING DATE

This parameter specifies the measurement begin time.

Notes:
- The begin date BEG and/or the termination date TER must be
specified.
Exception : time parameters may not be specified for the data output
in daily and cyclic files.
- A maximum of four BEG dates (in ascending order) may be linked
with &. In case of linked BEG dates, TER is not permissible.
- The earliest possible begin date is the day after entry.
- It is not permissible to enter the command after 23:45 hours with a
begin date on the following day.
- The first measurement may not begin later than one month after the
current date. Subsequent measurements may not begin later than one
year after the current date.

Default: current date

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the year of the begin


date.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC INTCELL- 2+


REC INTCELL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the month of the begin


date.

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the day of the begin


date.

TER TERMINATING DATE

This parameter specifies the measurement termination date.

Notes:
- Only one termination date may be entered per command.
The earliest possible termination date is the day after entry.
- The measurement duration may not exceed one year.
- The begin date BEG and/or the termination date TER must
be specified.
Exception: time parameters may not be specified for data output
in daily and cyclic files.

Default: the end of the measurement is determined by the single day


measurement.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the year in which


recording is to terminate.

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the month in which


recording is to terminate.

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the day on which


recording is to terminate.

IV INTERVAL TIME

This parameter specifies the measurement interval times.

Notes:
- A maximum of 4 measurement intervals may be linked with &.
- Interval times are only permissible in connection with a
begin date (BEG).

Incompatibilities:
- Intervals covering more than one day (e.g. 23-00-01-00).
- Intervals separated by a break of less than one hour.

Default: 24-hour measurement on the specified days.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: BEGIN HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC INTCELL- 3+


REC INTCELL

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This information unit specifies the hour at which the


measurement interval begins.

b: BEGIN MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the minutes past the hour at


which the measurement interval begins.

Notes:
- Possible values : 0, 15, 30 and 45.

c: END HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the hour at which the


measurement interval terminates.

d: END MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the minutes past the hour at


which the measurement interval terminates.

Notes:
- Possible values : 0, 15, 30 and 45.

PER PERIODICAL WEEKDAY

This parameter specifies the days of the week on which


recording is to take place.

Notes:
- The input of weekdays is only permissible in connection with
a termination date (TER).

Default: daily measurement during the measurement period.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC INTCELL- 4-


ACT INTRIG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACT INTELL.NETWORK TRIGGER PROFILE

This command activates an already created Intelligent Network service.


Precondition for the use of this service is the creation of specific
code points by means of CR CPT, of specific zone points by means of
CR ZOPT, or of line triggers by the commands CR INSCM, CR INSCMREF
and ACT INSCMREF.
For the use of CAMEL profiles no other preconditions exist.

Prerequisites:
- A trigger profile for the specified profile identifier must exist.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ACT INTRIG : PRID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile the


Intelligent Network service of which has to be activated on
the home exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT INTRIG- 1-


CAN INTRIG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CAN INTELL.NETWORK TRIGGER PROFILE

This command removes an Intelligent Network service.

Prerequisites:
- The service has to be in inactive status.
- For this trigger profile no related Service Filtering data administered
by a partner SCP or per MML by command ENTR INSLDAT must exist.
- No IN Service Class Marks administered by command CR INSCM and
referring to this trigger profile must exist.
- No specific code or zone points for this trigger profile must exist.
- The USSD COUNTER of this trigger profile must be zero.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN INTRIG : PRID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile


to be removed from the home exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN INTRIG- 1-


CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CR INTELL.NETWORK TRIGGER PROFILE

This command creates a trigger profile which is used to install an


Intelligent Network (IN) service on an exchange.
Precondition for the use of this service is the creation of IN
specific code points by means of CR CPT, of specific zone points
by means of CR ZOPT or of line trunk group specific or office
based triggers by the commands CR INSCM, CR INSCMREF
and ACT INSCMREF.
For administration of CAMEL profiles no preconditions exists.
The service has to be activated by ACT INTRIG.

Prerequisites:
1. General:
- The intercept identifier values specified by the parameters DACTINC,
OVLINC and INVINC must have been created by the command CR INC.
- For a zone number specified by the parameter CHGINF a tariff has to be
entered by command ENTR TAR.
- No trigger table entry with CAMEL = YES and the same service key,
the same SCP address and the same CSITYPE must exist.

2. In the case of an CCNC configuration:

3. In the case of an SSNC configuration:


- Equivalent preconditions as mentioned for the CCNC configuration are valid.
These conditions cannot be checked by the system since they are
administrated by means of Q3 tasks instead of MML commands.

Compatibilities:
- The parameter OVLINC and INVINC may only be entered for protocol
type SINAP1.
- Only special property values (PROP24..PROP39) of parameter
GENPROP may be specified for SSFTYPE=ASST.

Incompatibilities:
- A global title must not be entered together with a DPC.
- For SSFTYPE=ASST the parameters SKEY, TRAT, INCAT, RELEASE,
CHGINF, CHGPROF, OVLINC, INVINC and EODRAN must not be entered.
- In case of parameter CAMEL = NO only USSDPRID = NONE is allowed.
- In case of parameter CAMEL = NO only CDPAPFX = NONE is allowed.
- In case of parameter CAMEL = NO no CSITYPE must be entered.
- No trigger table entry with CAMEL = YES and the same service key,
the same SCP address and the same CSITYPE must exist.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR INTRIG - GT PROFILE WITH LOGICAL SCP ADDRESSING


2. CR INTRIG - SPC PROFILE WITH PHYSICAL SCP ADDRESSING

1. Input format

PROFILE WITH LOGICAL SCP ADDRESSING

This input format is to be used to create a trigger profile with


a SCP address consisting of a global title and any combination of
a translator service group and a subsystem identifier.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,NETIND= 1 1
1 CR INTRIG : PRID= Z,NETNAME=Y ,RTGP= ,TTID= [,NP= ,NA=] 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 1+
CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1 1
1 X( )= 1
1 11,GTDIG= 11 1
1 1Z,PREFIX=Y1 [,ORTTID= ,ORSSID= ,ORNP= ,ORNA= 1
1 11 11 1
1 >* +W 1
1 1
1 ,ORGTDIG=] [,PROT=] [,ACNSEL=] [,SSFTYPE=] 1
1 1
1 [,SKEY=] [,CAMEL=] [,CSITYPE=] [,USSDPRID=] 1
1 1
1 [,IPAVAIL=] [,IPSSPCA=] [,CDPAPFX=] [,CGAC=] 1
1 1
1 [,TRLG=] [,SSID=] [,SSPGT=] [,TRAT=] [,INCAT=] 1
1 1
1 [,GENPROP=] [,MOBPROP=] [,EODRAN=] [,IWRULE=] 1
1 1
1 [,RELEASE=] [,CHGINF=] [,CHGPROF=] [,DACTINC=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,SSFTIMER=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile for the
installation of an Intelligent Network service on the home exchange.
Since the service logic may be distributed on several Service Control
Points, for one service different trigger profiles may be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the network of the SSP.


The value corresponding to this indicator is used in the network
indicator field of the message signalling units sent between two
exchanges.
This parameter is mandatory in a configuration with CCNC;
in a configuration with SSNC this parameter is only mandatory when
the feature "multiple networks" is not activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NET 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NET 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NET 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NET 1

NETNAME NETWORK NAME

This parameter identifies the signaling network in which


the destination point is existing by its name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences for the


delivery of a SCCP message to the SCP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

GT ROUTE BY GT

Default: SPC

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 2+
CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TTID TRANSLATION TYPE ID.

This parameter specifies the translation type identifier of the global


title.
If it was specified with INPPDD the parameter PREFIX has to
be entered instead of the parameter GTDIG. If it was specified
with INCGPA or INDD the parameters GTDIG, PREFIX, NP and
NA must not be entered. The corresponding values will be determined
from the calling party address or the called party address,
respectively.
For all other values of this parameter GTDIG, NP and NA must
be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CCV CREDIT CARD VERIFICATION


IEESS ISDN END-TO-END SUPPL. SERV.
IMSI INTERNATIONAL MOBILE SUB. ID.
INCGPA IN CALLING PARTY ADDRESS
Incompatibilities:
- PREFIX, GTDIG, NP and NA.
INDD IN DIALED DIGITS
Incompatibilities:
- PREFIX, GTDIG, NP and NA.
INPPDD IN PREFIX PLUS DIALED DIGITS
Compatibilities:
- PREFIX.
ITCC INT. TELECOMM. CHARGE CARD
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TT10 TRANSLATION TYPE 10
TT11 TRANSLATION TYPE 11
TT12 TRANSLATION TYPE 12
TT13 TRANSLATION TYPE 13
TT14 TRANSLATION TYPE 14
TT15 TRANSLATION TYPE 15
TT9 TRANSLATION TYPE 9
UNKNOWN TRANSLATION TYPE UNKNOWN

NP NUMBERING PLAN

This parameter specifies the numbering plan of the global title.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DATANP DATA NUMBERING PLAN


ISDNMNP ISDN MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
ISDNTNP ISDN TELEPHONY NUMB. PLAN
LMNP LAND MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
MMNP MARITIME MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
NP10 NUMBERING PLAN 10
NP11 NUMBERING PLAN 11
NP12 NUMBERING PLAN 12
NP13 NUMBERING PLAN 13
NP15 NUMBERING PLAN 15
NP2 NUMBERING PLAN 2
NP8 NUMBERING PLAN 8
NP9 NUMBERING PLAN 9
PNP PRIVATE NUMBERING PLAN
TELEXNP TELEX NUMBERING PLAN
UNKNOWN NUMB. PLAN UNKNOWN

NA NATURE OF ADDRESS

This parameter specifies the nature of address of the global title.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTNO INTERNATIONAL NUMBER


NATNO NATIONAL SIGNIFICANT NUMBER
NATUSE RESERVED FOR NATIONAL USE
NA10 NATURE OF ADDRESS 10
NA11 NATURE OF ADDRESS 11
NA12 NATURE OF ADDRESS 12
NA13 NATURE OF ADDRESS 13
NA14 NATURE OF ADDRESS 14
NA15 NATURE OF ADDRESS 15
NA5 NATURE OF ADDRESS 5

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 3+
CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NA6 NATURE OF ADDRESS 6


NA7 NATURE OF ADDRESS 7
NA8 NATURE OF ADDRESS 8
NA9 NATURE OF ADDRESS 9
SUBNO SUBSCRIBER NUMBER
UNKNOWN NATURE OF ADDRESS UNKNOWN

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the digits of the global title. The digits can
be input in a structured format.
For IN triggering with CSI only 16 digits are evaluated.
For CAMEL profiles it is possible to enter the SCP address partly.
For example, only a few trigger profiles are necessary for roaming
subscribers if created this way.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: GT DIGITS FIRST PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: GT DIGITS SECOND PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: GT DIGITS THIRD PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PREFIX PREFIX DIGITS

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be used to assemble a


global title dynamically together with the digit information of the
called party number. This means that the global title is composed of
the prefix digits and the address signals of the called party number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...3 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

ORTTID ORIG. TRANSLATION TYPE ID.

This parameter specifies the translation type identifier of the global


title of the SSP.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CCV CREDIT CARD VERIFICATION


IEESS ISDN END-TO-END SUPPL. SERV.
IMSI INTERNATIONAL MOBILE SUB. ID.
ITCC INT. TELECOMM. CHARGE CARD
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TT10 TRANSLATION TYPE 10
TT11 TRANSLATION TYPE 11
TT12 TRANSLATION TYPE 12
TT13 TRANSLATION TYPE 13
TT14 TRANSLATION TYPE 14
TT15 TRANSLATION TYPE 15
TT9 TRANSLATION TYPE 9
UNKNOWN TRANSLATION TYPE UNKNOWN

ORSSID ORIGINATOR SUBSYSTEM ID.

This parameter specifies the subsystem identifier of the IN application


part on the SSP as part of the calling party address.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 4+
CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01


FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
IN IN APPLICATION IN SSP
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
IN2 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 3
IN4 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 4
IN5 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 5

ORNP ORIGINATOR NUMBERING PLAN

This parameter specifies the numbering plan of the global title


of the SSP.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DATANP DATA NUMBERING PLAN


ISDNMNP ISDN MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
ISDNTNP ISDN TELEPHONY NUMB. PLAN
LMNP LAND MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
MMNP MARITIME MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
NP10 NUMBERING PLAN 10
NP11 NUMBERING PLAN 11
NP12 NUMBERING PLAN 12
NP13 NUMBERING PLAN 13
NP15 NUMBERING PLAN 15
NP2 NUMBERING PLAN 2
NP8 NUMBERING PLAN 8
NP9 NUMBERING PLAN 9
PNP PRIVATE NUMBERING PLAN
TELEXNP TELEX NUMBERING PLAN
UNKNOWN NUMB. PLAN UNKNOWN

ORNA ORIGINATOR NATURE OF ADDRESS

This parameter specifies the nature of address of the global title


of the SSP.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTNO INTERNATIONAL NUMBER


NATNO NATIONAL SIGNIFICANT NUMBER
NATUSE RESERVED FOR NATIONAL USE
NA10 NATURE OF ADDRESS 10
NA11 NATURE OF ADDRESS 11
NA12 NATURE OF ADDRESS 12
NA13 NATURE OF ADDRESS 13
NA14 NATURE OF ADDRESS 14
NA15 NATURE OF ADDRESS 15
NA5 NATURE OF ADDRESS 5
NA6 NATURE OF ADDRESS 6
NA7 NATURE OF ADDRESS 7
NA8 NATURE OF ADDRESS 8
NA9 NATURE OF ADDRESS 9
SUBNO SUBSCRIBER NUMBER
UNKNOWN NATURE OF ADDRESS UNKNOWN

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 5+
CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ORGTDIG ORIG. GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the digits of the global title in the calling
party address of the SSP. The digits can be input in a structured
format.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: GT DIGITS FIRST PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: GT DIGITS SECOND PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: GT DIGITS THIRD PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PROT PROTOCOL TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the Intelligent Network


application protocol the service execution is based on.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CS1 CS1 CONFORM INAP


CS2 CS2 CONFORM INAP
PROT4 PROTOCOL TYPE 4
SINAP1 SIEMENS INAP 1
Compatibilities:
- SKEY = 1..8.

Default: CS1

ACNSEL APPLIC. CONTEXT NAME SELECTOR

ACNSEL=3 : SINAP5M
ACNSEL=5 : SINAP5M+
ACNSEL=6 : SINAP5M++
ACNSEL=7 : 163TR78
ACNSEL=8 : TINAP2001
ACNSEL=10: CAP Version 1
ACNSEL=11: CAP Version 2
ACNSEL=12: CAP Version 3
ACNSEL=13: CAP Version 3 SMS-MO
ACNSEL=14: SINAP7M
ACNSEL=15: SINAP7M+
ACNSEL=20: SINAP6NP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...31, range of decimal numbers

SSFTYPE SERVICE SWITCHING FUNCT. TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of Service Switching


Function for which the trigger profile was created. If an
IN trigger was detected the SSF can act as initiating
(normal) or assisting SSF.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ASST ASSISTING
BU2CUSF BEARER UNRELATED TO CUSF
BU2SSF BEARER UNRELATED TO SSF

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 6+
CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

NORM NORMAL

Default: NORM

SKEY SERVICE KEY

This parameter specifies the Intelligent Network service to be


installed on the home exchange. The same service key may occur in
different trigger profiles.

Notes:
The SKEY=0 is used as master key in case of Call Gap. So, if a
trigger profile is entered with SKEY=0 it is not possible to gap
service requests with this service key individually.

Compatibilities:
- SKEY = 1..8 if PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

CAMEL CAMEL TRIGGERING

This parameter indicates whether the profile


can be used for triggering with CSI.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO CSI-TRIGGERING
NO NO CSI-TRIGGERING
Y CSI-TRIGGERING POSSIBLE
YES CSI-TRIGGERING POSSIBLE

Default: NO

CSITYPE CSI TYPE

This parameter specifies for which kind of CSI


the trigger profile can be used. It is used
to distinguish between two CAMEL trigger profiles
with the same service key and SCP address.
Up to 5 parameter values can be linked with &.

Notes:
- ALLCSI must not be linked with another CSI.
- In case of default service key or default SCP
address only CSITYPE = ALLCSI is allowed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ALLCSI ALL CSI TYPES


DCSI DIALLED SERVICE CSI
OCSI ORIGINATING CSI
SMSCSI SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE CSI
TCSI TERMINATING CSI
VTCSI VMSC TERMINATING CSI

Default: ALLCSI

USSDPRID USSD PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter points to another trigger table


element which must be used for USSD calltype.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

Input NONE for USSDPRID means no USSDPRID.

Default: NONE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 7+
CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

IPAVAIL IP AVAILABLE

This parameter indicates whether Intelligent


Peripherie (IP) capabilities are available and
are to be transfered to the SCP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO IP CAPABILITIES AVAILABLE
NO NO IP CAPABILITIES AVAILABLE
Y IP CAPABILITIES AVAILABLE
YES IP CAPABILITIES AVAILABLE

Default: NO

IPSSPCA IPSSP CAPABILITIES

This parameter indicates the IP capabilities of the SSP.


Up to 7 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

GENVA GEN. OF VOICE ANN. FROM TEXT


Generation of voice announcements from text
is supported.
IPRAD IP ROUTING ADDRESS SUPPORTED
IP Routing Address is supported.
RES1 RESERVED1
Reserved for future enhancements 1.
RES2 RESERVED2
Reserved for future enhancements 2.
VOICEBA VOICEBACK SUPPORTED
VoiceBack is supported.
VOICESPR VOICE INF. WITH SPEECH RECOGN.
VoiceInformation is supported via speech
recognition.
VOICEVR VOICE INF. WITH VOICE RECOGN.
VoiceInformation is supported via voice
recognition.

CDPAPFX CALLED PARTY ADDRESS PREFIX

This parameter specifies the digits to be


prefixed to the called party address before
the address is sent to SCP or used
for re-routing.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

Input NONE for CDPAPFX means no CDPAPFX.

CGAC CALL GAP ACCEPTANCE

This parameter specifies whether an operation call gap


from the SCP is accepted or not.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACCG ACCEPT OPERATION CALL GAP


ACSCFID ACCEPT CG WITH SCFID ONLY
CGRES CALL GAP RESERVED
Reserved for future enhancements.
IGNCG IGNORE OPERATION CALL GAP

Default: ACCG

TRLG TRANSLATOR SERVICE GROUP

This parameter specifies a translator service group which performs


the global title translation if the translation is not executed in
the SSP.

Prerequisites:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 8+
CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

- In the case of a CCNC configuration the translator service group


must have been created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFIER

*FUTSS01:

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC ACCOUNT CARD CALLING


Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
AWC AREA WIDE CENTREX
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
CCC CREDIT CARD CALLING
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
FPH FREEPHONE SERVICE
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01
FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
INMP1 IN APPLICATION 1 ON MP
If a destination point code which specifies a
node containing a SSNC-based Number Portability
Server is entered together with this subsystem
identifier then the LNP (local number portability)
server function on that node (Stand-alone STP or
with EWSD as host) is addressed.
INMP2 IN APPLICATION 2 ON MP
INMP3 IN APPLICATION 3 ON MP
INMP4 IN APPLICATION 4 ON MP
INMP5 IN APPLICATION 5 ON MP
IN2 IN APPLICATION 2
Used for CAP protocols.
IN3 IN APPLICATION 3
Used for national INAP protocols.
IN4 IN APPLICATION 4
Used for number portability.
IN5 IN APPLICATION 5
PN PERSONAL NUMBER
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
TIS TELEINFO SERVICE
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
TV TELEVOTING
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
UN UNIVERSAL NUMBER
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
UPT UNIV PERSONAL TELECOMMUNICAT
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
VPN VIRTUAL PRIVATE NETWORKS
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

SSPGT SSP GT REQUIRED

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 9+
CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N SSP GLOBAL TITLE NOT REQUIRED


NO SSP GLOBAL TITLE NOT REQUIRED
Y SSP GLOBAL TITLE REQUIRED
YES SSP GLOBAL TITLE REQUIRED

Default: NO

TRAT TRAFFIC TYPE

This parameter specifies a traffic type assigned to the Intelligent


Network service in the trigger profile. The traffic type is
evaluated after detection of an IN trigger.

Default: NOBLOCK.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

INCAT IN CATEGORY

This parameter specifies branch categories for the digit translation.

Compatibilities:
- GENPROP=UINCAT.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15
COINB COIN BOX
DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
OPOSINAT OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the category for which the destination is


addressed.

GENPROP GENERAL PROPERTIES

This parameter specifies the general properties related to


the Intelligent Network service execution.
Up to 40 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

XADPBIN = ABBREV. DIALLING PROC. BY IN


1CLIREQ 1 CALLING LINE ID. REQUESTED
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1CONINH 1 CONGESTION CONTROL INHIBITED
1DPINH 1 DETECTION POINTS INHIBITED
1 1 The activation of internal detection points is
1 1 not allowed for the current service key. This
1 1 property is only relevant for the execution of
1 1 special services, e.g. international calls.
1 1
1 1 Incompatibilities:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 10+


CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1ENACPH 1 ENABLE CALL PARTY HANDLING
1EODREQ 1 END OF DIALLING REQUESTED
1FTALLOW 1 FEATURE TRANSPARENCY ALLOWED
1FTRINH 1 FURTHER TRIGGERING INHIBITED
1 1 Notes:
1 1 - For the protocol type SINAP1 this value
1 1 is set automatically.
1MCIHLD 1 MCI HOLD REQUESTED
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1MCIPRE 1 MALIC. CALL ID. PREP. REQ.
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1MHNCLI 1 MCI HOLD IF NO CLI AVAILABLE
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1ONLCHG 1 ONLINE CHARGING
1PASSBA 1 PASS B PTY CHARGE MSG TO A PTY
1PCNCHG 1 PER CONNECTION CHARGING
1PROP18 1 PROPERTY 18
1 1 PPS Indication. It is evaluated to realize the
1 1 follwowing functionality:
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile indicates a PPS.
1 1 FALSE: In case of interworking between PPS and
1 1 CFNRc (detected after 2nd HLR
1 1 interrogation)
1 1 the T-CSI dialogue will be terminated.
1PROP19 1 PROPERTY 19
1 1 Changing from T-BCSM to O-BCSM
1 1 TRUE: Changing the BCSM is allowed.
1 1 FALSE: Changing the BCSM is not allowed.
1PROP20 1 PROPERTY 20
1 1 Identification of the trigger profile TDP12-
1 1 related profile. PROP20 is necessary to
1 1 distinguish between "Basic IN Services" and "IN
1 1 User subscribt Services" because both are triggert
1 1 via digit analysis.
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile corresponds to an user
1 1 subscribed IN-MTC service, i.e. TDP12 is
1 1 send in the OP:IDP to the SCP (mapping of
1 1 TDP3 to TDP12).
1 1 FALSE: else
1PROP21 1 PROPERTY 21
1 1 Cross phase compatibility between MAP- and CAP-
1 1 interface
1 1 TRUE: The protocol version is determined
1 1 according to the CAMEL phase supported on
1 1 the MAP interface.
1 1 FALSE: the protocol version is determined by the
1 1 ACN selector (parameter ACNSEL).
1PROP22 1 PROPERTY 22
1 1 Fall Back to Basic SMS MO
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile is used for SMS MO
1 1 and MOC.
1 1 FALSE: The trigger profile used for MOC only.
1PROP23 1 PROPERTY 23
1 1
1 1 Usage of CdPA or SMSC-address in Op:I_DP for SMS
1 1 MO
1 1 TRUE: the InitialDP for SMS MO contains the SMSC-
1 1 address as Called Party Address.
1 1 FALSE: the InitialDP for SMS MO contains the SMS
1 1 receiver address as Called Party Address.
1 1 (This property to be used with only if
1 1 PROP22 together)
1PROP24 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 24
1 1 Control of ticket generation
1 1 TRUE: Tickets should not be generated.
1 1 FALSE: Tickets should be generated.
1PROP25 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 25
1 1 Prefixing of CdPA with CAC digits
1 1 TRUE: The digits received from A-side GP shall be
1 1 Prefixed with the received CAC (if any) and
1 1 the appropiate prefix for CAC dialing
1 1 FALSE: The digits received from A-side GP are send
1 1 unchanged in the C:IN_DATA to the BSSAP

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 11+


CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1PROP26 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 26


1 1 Using of default zoning
1 1 TRUE: The ZONDA is called with the received
1 1 Digits to determine the charging zone or a
1 1 No charge indication (but not to overwrite
1 1 The AMA parameter)
1 1 False: The default zone from trigger profile
1 1 Is set in the CPB as local zoning result or
1 1 Chargefree indication is evaluated.
1PROP27 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 27
1 1
1 1 Interworking IN/CAMEL with CF
1 1 True: The interworking of CF with IN/CAMEL is
1 1 Allowed.
1 1 False: The interworking of CF with IN/CAMEL is
1 1 Not allowed.
1 1 The network provider can support the interworking
1 1 of CF with IN MOC service by setting General
1 1 Property 27 in the trigger profile of the IN MOC
1 1 service.
1PROP28 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 28
1 1 Fallback from CAP Ph3, CAP PH2 to CAP Ph1
1 1 TRUE: The AC negotioation on the CAP interface is
1 1 supported.
1 1 FALSE: AC negotiation on the CAP interface is not
1 1 possible.
1PROP29 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 29
1 1 Identification of the trigger profile as TDP2-
1 1 related profile
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile corresponds to an user
1 1 subscribt IN-MOC service, i.e TDP2 is send
1 1 in the OP:IDP to the SCP
1 1 FALSE: else
1 1 PROP29 is necessary for Overlay networks as it is
1 1 not possible to distinguish between "Basic IN-
1 1 Services" and "IN User Subscribed Services".
1PROP30 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 30
1 1 GSM-BC or ISDN-BC in Op:I_DP
1 1 TRUE: The ISUP Bearer Capability (BC) is used in
1 1 Op:Initial_DP.
1 1 FALSE: The GSM BC is used.
1PROP31 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 31
1 1 Ticket control by suppression of ticket generation
1 1 TRUE: The SCP is allowed to suppress ticket
1 1 generation by sending "SuppressCITicket" in
1 1 The OP:SendChargingInfo
1 1 FALSE: else
1PROP32 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 32
1 1 CAMEL Overlay. Possibility to to administrate a
1 1 prefix with MML CR INTRIG parameter CDAPRFX.
1 1 TRUE: (and CDPAPFX not empty) IN handling is
1 1 stopped, CAMEL relevant data is reset and a
1 1 digit anlaysis with the prefixed Called
1 1 Party Number is started
1 1 FALSE: Continiue normal IN handling
1PROP33 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 33
1 1 Mapping of Calling Party Number
1 1 True: Mapping of Calling Party Number from INAP
1 1 OP:CONNECT to Calling Party Number ISUP o/g
1 1 IAM (only valid for ISUP-LTG)
1 1 False: Mapping of Calling Party Number from INAP
1 1 OP:CONNECT to Generic Number (additional
1 1 Calling number) in ISUP o/g IAM
1PROP34 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 34
1 1 CAC Handling for Prepaid Subscribers
1 1 (see PROP35)
1PROP35 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 35
1 1 CAC Handling for Prepaid Subscribers
1 1 PROP34 False and PROP35 False: If CAC is dialed
1 1 Call is released
1 1 PROP34 True and PROP35 False: CAC will be ignored
1 1 For routing
1 1 PROP34 False and PROP35 True: Call will be
1 1 Rerouted via
1 1 Carrier network
1 1 PROP34 True and PROP35 True: PROP35 has priority
1PROP36 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 36

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 12+


CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1 1 Suppression of DAS Announcement for PNS and


1 1 SNP/NTS
1 1 TRUE: PNS or SNP/NTS is active
1 1 FALSE: PNS or SNP/NTS is not active
1PROP37 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 37
1 1 Supply of Location Number
1 1 True: Supply the Location Number from ATD
1 1 False: Supply the Location Number from VLR number
1PROP38 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 38
1 1 Other Party Long_Number in MOC Record
1 1 True: Write "rerouted number" (from SCP) as other
1 1 party long number in MOC Record
1 1 False: Write "dialled number" as other party long
1 1 number in MOC Record
1PROP39 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 39
1RCNCLI 1 REL. CALL IF NO CLI RETRIEVED
1 1 Prerequisites:
1 1 - The intercept identifier INANIF must have
1 1 been created by the command CR INC.
1 1
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1SFINH 1 SERVICE FILTERING INHIBITED
>UINCAT W USE IN CATEGORY
Compatibilities:
- INCAT must be specified.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

MOBPROP MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTIES

This parameter specifies the mobile specific properties


related to the Intelligent Network service execution.
It is divided into common properties (0-23) and
project properties (24-31).
Up to 32 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CFCPPPS CHARGE FREE CALL PHASE FOR PPS


This property is intended Prepaid
Services (PPS). Setting of this property will
inform the SCP, that the actual call phase has
lasted 0 seconds. This means that the call phase
in question is held free of charge.
This behaviour is available for SINAP and CAP
protocol.
TRUE - Actual call phase is held free of charge
FALSE - Actual call phase is not held free of charg
DEFCOMZO DEFAULT COMMON ZONING
If this property is set, zoning with
new digits from SCP is performed for
CAP protocol.
ENHACAP3 ENHANCED TDP3 HANDL. FOR CAP3
Allow ApplyCharging, CallInformationRequest and
RequestReportBCSM. The Camel Ph3 standard
3GPP 23.078 does not allow the operations
ApplyCharging, CallInformationRequest and
RequestReportBCSM for IN-dialogues triggered via
a D-CSI or N-CSI (TriggerDetectionPoint TDP3).
I.e. after reception of a Connect or a Continue
or ContinueWithArgument operation from the
SCP, D-CSI or N-CSI dialogue has to be closed.
Our SSP shall allow the usage of the above
mentioned operations also on a D-CSI or N-CSI
dialogue. Whether these operations are allowed or
not, shall be controllable with this Trigger
Profile Property. This property is checked
only if the CAP Ph3 protocol is used in case of
D-CSI or N-CSI triggered IN dialogues.
TRUE - allow operations
FALSE - inhibit operations
INPASS IN PARALLEL TO MOC ASSIGNMENT
If this property is set, the channel
assignment for MOC and IN-Dialogue are set up in

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 13+


CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

parallel.
MPROP08 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 8
MPROP09 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 9
MPROP10 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 10
MPROP11 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 11
MPROP12 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 12
MPROP13 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 13
MPROP14 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 14
MPROP15 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 15
MPROP16 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 16
MPROP17 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 17
MPROP18 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 18
MPROP19 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 19
MPROP20 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 20
MPROP21 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 21
MPROP22 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 22
MPROP23 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 23
NOEXTPAR NO EXT PARAM SENT BY SSP
If this property is set, the SSP sends
INAP-operations without Extension Parameters.
Notes:
- This property has no influence on Extension
Parameters sent by the SCP.
- If this property is not set, SCCP segmentation
has to be switched on.
PPROP00 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 0
SDDPFC Interworking, supply LOCNO from SCP-Address
in case of MOC:
True: Copy SCP-Address of SDDPFC Interface.
False: Don’t copy.
PPROP01 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 1
PPROP02 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 2
PPROP03 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 3
PPROP04 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 4
PPROP05 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 5
PPROP06 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 6
PPROP07 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 7
SCPNSMSC SEND CLD PTY NO AND SMSC ADDR
The SSP provides the SMS Service Center Address
and Called Party Address for SMS MO Trigger
Feature with CAP Phase 1 to the SCP.
GENPROP = PROP23 determines, which parameters
are used to transmit the addresses.
SUPACMSG SUPPRESS ANSWER/CONNECT MSG
If this property is set, any ANSWER/CONNECT
message for that call section to Calling Party
will be suppressed.
Prerequisites:
- SCP (CAP or SINAP7M+ prot) has to send in OP:CTR
OP:ETC the BothwayThroughConnectIndicator (BTCI)
= NOT_REQUIRED. BTCI is an subparameter of
SIITwo (ServiceInteractionIndicator 2).
SUPCHART SUPPRESS CHARGING TICKET
If this property is set, MOC/CF Charging Ticket
will be suppressed.
Prerequisites:
- SCP (CAP or SINAP7M+ prot) has to send in OP:CTR
OP:ETC the BothwayThroughConnectIndicator (BTCI)
= NOT_REQUIRED. BTCI is an subparameter of
SIITwo (ServiceInteractionIndicator 2).

EODRAN END OF DIALLING RANGE

This parameter specifies a minimal number of dialled digits


and a maximal number of dialled digits to have a general
end of dialling condition.
This parameter is evaluated only if GENPROP=EODREQ is set.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: MIN=
0...28, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 14+


CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: MAX=
0...28, range of decimal numbers

Default: 28

IWRULE INTERWORKING RULE

This parameter is used to control the interworking of IN


with basic network features. The first unit addresses the set
of default values for the Service Interaction Indicator (SII)
to be applied if the SCP did not send any. The second unit
specifies the interaction level which is applied for the
control of the SIIs influence on this interworking
(project specific).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: SERVICE INTERACTION INDICATOR INDEX=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

b: INTERACTION LEVEL=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

RELEASE RELEASE REQUIRED INDICATOR

This parameter specifies a value to decide whether an Intelligent


Network call has to be released in the case that a protocol
abnormality occurs.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N RELEASE NOT REQUIRED


NO RELEASE NOT REQUIRED
Y RELEASE REQUIRED
YES RELEASE REQUIRED

Default: YES

CHGINF DEFAULT CHARGING INFORMATION

This parameter specifies the charging information in case no


information about how to charge an Intelligent Network call
was sent by the partner SCP.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: CHARGE INFORMATION
NOCHAR NO CHARGE
NOINTV NO INTERVENTION BY IN
REJECT REJECT THE CALL
ZONE CHARGE BY ZONE
unit b is required

Default: NOINTV

b: ZONE NUMBER=
0...511, range of decimal numbers

Compatibilities:
- ZONE is entered for the first unit.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 15+


CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CHGPROF CHARGING PROFILE

This parameter specifies the charging profile that is applied


when an IN service request was detected with an originating
line trigger.
The charging profile determines the billing registration
method and - in the case of metering - the subscriber charge
counters CNTR1 .. CNTR5.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PROF0 PROFILE 0
No billing registration.
PROF1 PROFILE 1
Automatic Message Accounting.
PROF10 PROFILE 10
Metering on charge counters 1&5.
PROF11 PROFILE 11
Metering on charge counters 2&3.
PROF12 PROFILE 12
Metering on charge counters 2&4.
PROF13 PROFILE 13
Metering on charge counters 2&5.
PROF14 PROFILE 14
Metering on charge counters 3&4.
PROF15 PROFILE 15
Metering on charge counters 3&5.
PROF16 PROFILE 16
Metering on charge counters 4&5.
PROF17 PROFILE 17
Metering on charge counters 1&2&3.
PROF18 PROFILE 18
Metering on charge counters 1&2&4.
PROF19 PROFILE 19
Metering on charge counters 1&2&5.
PROF2 PROFILE 2
Metering on charge counter 1.
PROF20 PROFILE 20
Metering on charge counters 1&3&4.
PROF21 PROFILE 21
Metering on charge counters 1&3&5.
PROF22 PROFILE 22
Metering on charge counters 1&4&5.
PROF23 PROFILE 23
Metering on charge counters 2&3&4.
PROF24 PROFILE 24
Metering on charge counters 2&3&5.
PROF25 PROFILE 25
Metering on charge counters 2&4&5.
PROF26 PROFILE 26
Metering on charge counters 3&4&5.
PROF27 PROFILE 27
Metering on charge counters 1&2&3&4.
PROF28 PROFILE 28
Metering on charge counters 1&2&3&5.
PROF29 PROFILE 29
Metering on charge counters 1&2&4&5.
PROF3 PROFILE 3
Metering on charge counter 2.
PROF30 PROFILE 30
Metering on charge counters 1&3&4&5.
PROF31 PROFILE 31
Metering on charge counters 2&3&4&5.
PROF32 PROFILE 32
Metering on charge counters 1&2&3&4&5.
PROF4 PROFILE 4
Metering on charge counter 3.
PROF5 PROFILE 5
Metering on charge counter 4.
PROF6 PROFILE 6
Metering on charge counter 5.
PROF7 PROFILE 7
Metering on charge counters 1&2.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 16+


CR INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PROF8 PROFILE 8
Metering on charge counters 1&3.
PROF9 PROFILE 9
Metering on charge counters 1&4.

DACTINC DEACTIV. SERV. INTERCEPT ID.

This parameter specifies the intercept code selected in case the


Intelligent Network service is in status inactive.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SNA0 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 0


SNA1 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 1
SNA2 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 2
SNA3 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 3
SNA4 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 4

Default: SNA0

SSFTIMER SSF TIMER

This parameter specifies the time, in which the answer


from SCP/SCF is expected in steps of 100ms.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...255, range of decimal numbers

Default: 100

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 17+


CR INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

PROFILE WITH PHYSICAL SCP ADDRESSING

This input format is to be used to create a trigger profile with


a SCP address consisting of a destination point code and a
subsystem identifier.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,NETIND= 1 1
1 CR INTRIG : PRID= Z,NETNAME=Y [,RTGP=] ,SSID= ,DPC= 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 [,ORTTID= ,ORSSID= ,ORNP= ,ORNA= ,ORGTDIG=] 1
1 1
1 [,PROT=] [,ACNSEL=] [,SSFTYPE=] [,SKEY=] 1
1 1
1 [,IPAVAIL=] [,IPSSPCA=] [,CGAC=] [,SSPGT=] 1
1 1
1 [,TRAT=] [,INCAT=] [,GENPROP=] [,MOBPROP=] 1
1 1
1 [,EODRAN=] [,IWRULE=] [,RELEASE=] [,CHGINF=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,CHGPROF=] [,DACTINC=] [,SSFTIMER=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile for the
installation of an Intelligent Network service on the home exchange.
Since the service logic may be distributed on several Service Control
Points, for one service different trigger profiles may be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the network of the SSP.


The value corresponding to this indicator is used in the network
indicator field of the message signalling units sent between two
exchanges.
This parameter is mandatory in a configuration with CCNC;
in a configuration with SSNC this parameter is only mandatory when
the feature "multiple networks" is not activated.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NET 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NET 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NET 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NET 1

NETNAME NETWORK NAME

This parameter identifies the signaling network in which


the destination point is existing by its name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences for the


delivery of a SCCP message to the SCP.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 18+


CR INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SPC ROUTE BY SPC AND SSN

Default: SPC

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFIER

*FUTSS01:

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC ACCOUNT CARD CALLING


Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
AWC AREA WIDE CENTREX
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
CCC CREDIT CARD CALLING
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
FPH FREEPHONE SERVICE
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01
FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
INMP1 IN APPLICATION 1 ON MP
If a destination point code which specifies a
node containing a SSNC-based Number Portability
Server is entered together with this subsystem
identifier then the LNP (local number portability)
server function on that node (Stand-alone STP or
with EWSD as host) is addressed.
INMP2 IN APPLICATION 2 ON MP
INMP3 IN APPLICATION 3 ON MP
INMP4 IN APPLICATION 4 ON MP
INMP5 IN APPLICATION 5 ON MP
IN2 IN APPLICATION 2
Used for CAP protocols.
IN3 IN APPLICATION 3
Used for national INAP protocols.
IN4 IN APPLICATION 4
Used for number portability.
IN5 IN APPLICATION 5
PN PERSONAL NUMBER
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
TIS TELEINFO SERVICE
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
TV TELEVOTING
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
UN UNIVERSAL NUMBER
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
UPT UNIV PERSONAL TELECOMMUNICAT
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
VPN VIRTUAL PRIVATE NETWORKS
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

DPC DESTINATION POINT CODE

Network Indicator = NAT0 Units = 4-3-4-3


Network Indicator = INAT0 Units = 3-8-3

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 19+


CR INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Network Indicator = NAT1 Units = 4-3-4-3


Network Indicator = INAT1 Units = 3-8-3

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: DESTINATION POINT CODE - UNIT 1=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

b: DESTINATION POINT CODE - UNIT 2=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: DESTINATION POINT CODE - UNIT 3=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: DESTINATION POINT CODE - UNIT 4=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

ORTTID ORIG. TRANSLATION TYPE ID.

This parameter specifies the translation type identifier of the global


title of the SSP.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CCV CREDIT CARD VERIFICATION


IEESS ISDN END-TO-END SUPPL. SERV.
IMSI INTERNATIONAL MOBILE SUB. ID.
ITCC INT. TELECOMM. CHARGE CARD
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TT10 TRANSLATION TYPE 10
TT11 TRANSLATION TYPE 11
TT12 TRANSLATION TYPE 12
TT13 TRANSLATION TYPE 13
TT14 TRANSLATION TYPE 14
TT15 TRANSLATION TYPE 15
TT9 TRANSLATION TYPE 9
UNKNOWN TRANSLATION TYPE UNKNOWN

ORSSID ORIGINATOR SUBSYSTEM ID.

This parameter specifies the subsystem identifier of the IN application


part on the SSP as part of the calling party address.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01


FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
IN IN APPLICATION IN SSP
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
IN2 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 3
IN4 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 4
IN5 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 5

ORNP ORIGINATOR NUMBERING PLAN

This parameter specifies the numbering plan of the global title

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 20+


CR INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

of the SSP.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DATANP DATA NUMBERING PLAN


ISDNMNP ISDN MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
ISDNTNP ISDN TELEPHONY NUMB. PLAN
LMNP LAND MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
MMNP MARITIME MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
NP10 NUMBERING PLAN 10
NP11 NUMBERING PLAN 11
NP12 NUMBERING PLAN 12
NP13 NUMBERING PLAN 13
NP15 NUMBERING PLAN 15
NP2 NUMBERING PLAN 2
NP8 NUMBERING PLAN 8
NP9 NUMBERING PLAN 9
PNP PRIVATE NUMBERING PLAN
TELEXNP TELEX NUMBERING PLAN
UNKNOWN NUMB. PLAN UNKNOWN

ORNA ORIGINATOR NATURE OF ADDRESS

This parameter specifies the nature of address of the global title


of the SSP.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTNO INTERNATIONAL NUMBER


NATNO NATIONAL SIGNIFICANT NUMBER
NATUSE RESERVED FOR NATIONAL USE
NA10 NATURE OF ADDRESS 10
NA11 NATURE OF ADDRESS 11
NA12 NATURE OF ADDRESS 12
NA13 NATURE OF ADDRESS 13
NA14 NATURE OF ADDRESS 14
NA15 NATURE OF ADDRESS 15
NA5 NATURE OF ADDRESS 5
NA6 NATURE OF ADDRESS 6
NA7 NATURE OF ADDRESS 7
NA8 NATURE OF ADDRESS 8
NA9 NATURE OF ADDRESS 9
SUBNO SUBSCRIBER NUMBER
UNKNOWN NATURE OF ADDRESS UNKNOWN

ORGTDIG ORIG. GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the digits of the global title in the calling
party address of the SSP. The digits can be input in a structured
format.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: GT DIGITS FIRST PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: GT DIGITS SECOND PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: GT DIGITS THIRD PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 21+


CR INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PROT PROTOCOL TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the Intelligent Network


application protocol the service execution is based on.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CS1 CS1 CONFORM INAP


CS2 CS2 CONFORM INAP
PROT4 PROTOCOL TYPE 4
SINAP1 SIEMENS INAP 1
Compatibilities:
- SKEY = 1..8.

Default: CS1

ACNSEL APPLIC. CONTEXT NAME SELECTOR

ACNSEL=3 : SINAP5M
ACNSEL=5 : SINAP5M+
ACNSEL=6 : SINAP5M++
ACNSEL=7 : 163TR78
ACNSEL=8 : TINAP2001
ACNSEL=10: CAP Version 1
ACNSEL=11: CAP Version 2
ACNSEL=12: CAP Version 3
ACNSEL=13: CAP Version 3 SMS-MO
ACNSEL=14: SINAP7M
ACNSEL=15: SINAP7M+
ACNSEL=20: SINAP6NP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...31, range of decimal numbers

SSFTYPE SERVICE SWITCHING FUNCT. TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of Service Switching


Function for which the trigger profile was created. If an
IN trigger was detected the SSF can act as initiating
(normal) or assisting SSF.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ASST ASSISTING
BU2CUSF BEARER UNRELATED TO CUSF
BU2SSF BEARER UNRELATED TO SSF
NORM NORMAL

Default: NORM

SKEY SERVICE KEY

This parameter specifies the Intelligent Network service to be


installed on the home exchange. The same service key may occur in
different trigger profiles.

Notes:
The SKEY=0 is used as master key in case of Call Gap. So, if a
trigger profile is entered with SKEY=0 it is not possible to gap
service requests with this service key individually.

Compatibilities:
- SKEY = 1..8 if PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

IPAVAIL IP AVAILABLE

This parameter indicates whether Intelligent


Peripherie (IP) capabilities are available and

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 22+


CR INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

are to be transfered to the SCP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO IP CAPABILITIES AVAILABLE
NO NO IP CAPABILITIES AVAILABLE
Y IP CAPABILITIES AVAILABLE
YES IP CAPABILITIES AVAILABLE

Default: NO

IPSSPCA IPSSP CAPABILITIES

This parameter indicates the IP capabilities of the SSP.


Up to 7 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

GENVA GEN. OF VOICE ANN. FROM TEXT


Generation of voice announcements from text
is supported.
IPRAD IP ROUTING ADDRESS SUPPORTED
IP Routing Address is supported.
RES1 RESERVED1
Reserved for future enhancements 1.
RES2 RESERVED2
Reserved for future enhancements 2.
VOICEBA VOICEBACK SUPPORTED
VoiceBack is supported.
VOICESPR VOICE INF. WITH SPEECH RECOGN.
VoiceInformation is supported via speech
recognition.
VOICEVR VOICE INF. WITH VOICE RECOGN.
VoiceInformation is supported via voice
recognition.

CGAC CALL GAP ACCEPTANCE

This parameter specifies whether an operation call gap


from the SCP is accepted or not.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACCG ACCEPT OPERATION CALL GAP


ACSCFID ACCEPT CG WITH SCFID ONLY
CGRES CALL GAP RESERVED
Reserved for future enhancements.
IGNCG IGNORE OPERATION CALL GAP

Default: ACCG

SSPGT SSP GT REQUIRED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N SSP GLOBAL TITLE NOT REQUIRED


NO SSP GLOBAL TITLE NOT REQUIRED
Y SSP GLOBAL TITLE REQUIRED
YES SSP GLOBAL TITLE REQUIRED

Default: NO

TRAT TRAFFIC TYPE

This parameter specifies a traffic type assigned to the Intelligent


Network service in the trigger profile. The traffic type is
evaluated after detection of an IN trigger.

Default: NOBLOCK.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 23+


CR INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

INCAT IN CATEGORY

This parameter specifies branch categories for the digit translation.

Compatibilities:
- GENPROP=UINCAT.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15
COINB COIN BOX
DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
OPOSINAT OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the category for which the destination is


addressed.

GENPROP GENERAL PROPERTIES

This parameter specifies the general properties related to


the Intelligent Network service execution.
Up to 40 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

XADPBIN = ABBREV. DIALLING PROC. BY IN


1CLIREQ 1 CALLING LINE ID. REQUESTED
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1CONINH 1 CONGESTION CONTROL INHIBITED
1DPINH 1 DETECTION POINTS INHIBITED
1 1 The activation of internal detection points is
1 1 not allowed for the current service key. This
1 1 property is only relevant for the execution of
1 1 special services, e.g. international calls.
1 1
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1ENACPH 1 ENABLE CALL PARTY HANDLING
1EODREQ 1 END OF DIALLING REQUESTED
1FTALLOW 1 FEATURE TRANSPARENCY ALLOWED
1FTRINH 1 FURTHER TRIGGERING INHIBITED
1 1 Notes:
1 1 - For the protocol type SINAP1 this value
1 1 is set automatically.
1MCIHLD 1 MCI HOLD REQUESTED
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1MCIPRE 1 MALIC. CALL ID. PREP. REQ.
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1MHNCLI 1 MCI HOLD IF NO CLI AVAILABLE
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1ONLCHG 1 ONLINE CHARGING
1PASSBA 1 PASS B PTY CHARGE MSG TO A PTY
1PCNCHG 1 PER CONNECTION CHARGING
1PROP18 1 PROPERTY 18
1 1 PPS Indication. It is evaluated to realize the

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 24+


CR INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1 1 follwowing functionality:
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile indicates a PPS.
1 1 FALSE: In case of interworking between PPS and
1 1 CFNRc (detected after 2nd HLR
1 1 interrogation)
1 1 the T-CSI dialogue will be terminated.
1PROP19 1 PROPERTY 19
1 1 Changing from T-BCSM to O-BCSM
1 1 TRUE: Changing the BCSM is allowed.
1 1 FALSE: Changing the BCSM is not allowed.
1PROP20 1 PROPERTY 20
1 1 Identification of the trigger profile TDP12-
1 1 related profile. PROP20 is necessary to
1 1 distinguish between "Basic IN Services" and "IN
1 1 User subscribt Services" because both are triggert
1 1 via digit analysis.
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile corresponds to an user
1 1 subscribed IN-MTC service, i.e. TDP12 is
1 1 send in the OP:IDP to the SCP (mapping of
1 1 TDP3 to TDP12).
1 1 FALSE: else
1PROP21 1 PROPERTY 21
1 1 Cross phase compatibility between MAP- and CAP-
1 1 interface
1 1 TRUE: The protocol version is determined
1 1 according to the CAMEL phase supported on
1 1 the MAP interface.
1 1 FALSE: the protocol version is determined by the
1 1 ACN selector (parameter ACNSEL).
1PROP22 1 PROPERTY 22
1 1 Fall Back to Basic SMS MO
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile is used for SMS MO
1 1 and MOC.
1 1 FALSE: The trigger profile used for MOC only.
1PROP23 1 PROPERTY 23
1 1
1 1 Usage of CdPA or SMSC-address in Op:I_DP for SMS
1 1 MO
1 1 TRUE: the InitialDP for SMS MO contains the SMSC-
1 1 address as Called Party Address.
1 1 FALSE: the InitialDP for SMS MO contains the SMS
1 1 receiver address as Called Party Address.
1 1 (This property to be used with only if
1 1 PROP22 together)
1PROP24 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 24
1 1 Control of ticket generation
1 1 TRUE: Tickets should not be generated.
1 1 FALSE: Tickets should be generated.
1PROP25 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 25
1 1 Prefixing of CdPA with CAC digits
1 1 TRUE: The digits received from A-side GP shall be
1 1 Prefixed with the received CAC (if any) and
1 1 the appropiate prefix for CAC dialing
1 1 FALSE: The digits received from A-side GP are send
1 1 unchanged in the C:IN_DATA to the BSSAP
1PROP26 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 26
1 1 Using of default zoning
1 1 TRUE: The ZONDA is called with the received
1 1 Digits to determine the charging zone or a
1 1 No charge indication (but not to overwrite
1 1 The AMA parameter)
1 1 False: The default zone from trigger profile
1 1 Is set in the CPB as local zoning result or
1 1 Chargefree indication is evaluated.
1PROP27 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 27
1 1
1 1 Interworking IN/CAMEL with CF
1 1 True: The interworking of CF with IN/CAMEL is
1 1 Allowed.
1 1 False: The interworking of CF with IN/CAMEL is
1 1 Not allowed.
1 1 The network provider can support the interworking
1 1 of CF with IN MOC service by setting General
1 1 Property 27 in the trigger profile of the IN MOC
1 1 service.
1PROP28 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 28
1 1 Fallback from CAP Ph3, CAP PH2 to CAP Ph1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 25+


CR INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1 1 TRUE: The AC negotioation on the CAP interface is


1 1 supported.
1 1 FALSE: AC negotiation on the CAP interface is not
1 1 possible.
1PROP29 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 29
1 1 Identification of the trigger profile as TDP2-
1 1 related profile
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile corresponds to an user
1 1 subscribt IN-MOC service, i.e TDP2 is send
1 1 in the OP:IDP to the SCP
1 1 FALSE: else
1 1 PROP29 is necessary for Overlay networks as it is
1 1 not possible to distinguish between "Basic IN-
1 1 Services" and "IN User Subscribed Services".
1PROP30 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 30
1 1 GSM-BC or ISDN-BC in Op:I_DP
1 1 TRUE: The ISUP Bearer Capability (BC) is used in
1 1 Op:Initial_DP.
1 1 FALSE: The GSM BC is used.
1PROP31 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 31
1 1 Ticket control by suppression of ticket generation
1 1 TRUE: The SCP is allowed to suppress ticket
1 1 generation by sending "SuppressCITicket" in
1 1 The OP:SendChargingInfo
1 1 FALSE: else
1PROP32 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 32
1 1 CAMEL Overlay. Possibility to to administrate a
1 1 prefix with MML CR INTRIG parameter CDAPRFX.
1 1 TRUE: (and CDPAPFX not empty) IN handling is
1 1 stopped, CAMEL relevant data is reset and a
1 1 digit anlaysis with the prefixed Called
1 1 Party Number is started
1 1 FALSE: Continiue normal IN handling
1PROP33 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 33
1 1 Mapping of Calling Party Number
1 1 True: Mapping of Calling Party Number from INAP
1 1 OP:CONNECT to Calling Party Number ISUP o/g
1 1 IAM (only valid for ISUP-LTG)
1 1 False: Mapping of Calling Party Number from INAP
1 1 OP:CONNECT to Generic Number (additional
1 1 Calling number) in ISUP o/g IAM
1PROP34 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 34
1 1 CAC Handling for Prepaid Subscribers
1 1 (see PROP35)
1PROP35 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 35
1 1 CAC Handling for Prepaid Subscribers
1 1 PROP34 False and PROP35 False: If CAC is dialed
1 1 Call is released
1 1 PROP34 True and PROP35 False: CAC will be ignored
1 1 For routing
1 1 PROP34 False and PROP35 True: Call will be
1 1 Rerouted via
1 1 Carrier network
1 1 PROP34 True and PROP35 True: PROP35 has priority
1PROP36 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 36
1 1 Suppression of DAS Announcement for PNS and
1 1 SNP/NTS
1 1 TRUE: PNS or SNP/NTS is active
1 1 FALSE: PNS or SNP/NTS is not active
1PROP37 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 37
1 1 Supply of Location Number
1 1 True: Supply the Location Number from ATD
1 1 False: Supply the Location Number from VLR number
1PROP38 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 38
1 1 Other Party Long_Number in MOC Record
1 1 True: Write "rerouted number" (from SCP) as other
1 1 party long number in MOC Record
1 1 False: Write "dialled number" as other party long
1 1 number in MOC Record
1PROP39 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 39
1RCNCLI 1 REL. CALL IF NO CLI RETRIEVED
1 1 Prerequisites:
1 1 - The intercept identifier INANIF must have
1 1 been created by the command CR INC.
1 1
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 26+


CR INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1SFINH 1 SERVICE FILTERING INHIBITED


>UINCAT W USE IN CATEGORY
Compatibilities:
- INCAT must be specified.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

MOBPROP MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTIES

This parameter specifies the mobile specific properties


related to the Intelligent Network service execution.
It is divided into common properties (0-23) and
project properties (24-31).
Up to 32 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CFCPPPS CHARGE FREE CALL PHASE FOR PPS


This property is intended Prepaid
Services (PPS). Setting of this property will
inform the SCP, that the actual call phase has
lasted 0 seconds. This means that the call phase
in question is held free of charge.
This behaviour is available for SINAP and CAP
protocol.
TRUE - Actual call phase is held free of charge
FALSE - Actual call phase is not held free of charg
DEFCOMZO DEFAULT COMMON ZONING
If this property is set, zoning with
new digits from SCP is performed for
CAP protocol.
ENHACAP3 ENHANCED TDP3 HANDL. FOR CAP3
Allow ApplyCharging, CallInformationRequest and
RequestReportBCSM. The Camel Ph3 standard
3GPP 23.078 does not allow the operations
ApplyCharging, CallInformationRequest and
RequestReportBCSM for IN-dialogues triggered via
a D-CSI or N-CSI (TriggerDetectionPoint TDP3).
I.e. after reception of a Connect or a Continue
or ContinueWithArgument operation from the
SCP, D-CSI or N-CSI dialogue has to be closed.
Our SSP shall allow the usage of the above
mentioned operations also on a D-CSI or N-CSI
dialogue. Whether these operations are allowed or
not, shall be controllable with this Trigger
Profile Property. This property is checked
only if the CAP Ph3 protocol is used in case of
D-CSI or N-CSI triggered IN dialogues.
TRUE - allow operations
FALSE - inhibit operations
INPASS IN PARALLEL TO MOC ASSIGNMENT
If this property is set, the channel
assignment for MOC and IN-Dialogue are set up in
parallel.
MPROP08 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 8
MPROP09 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 9
MPROP10 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 10
MPROP11 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 11
MPROP12 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 12
MPROP13 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 13
MPROP14 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 14
MPROP15 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 15
MPROP16 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 16
MPROP17 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 17
MPROP18 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 18
MPROP19 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 19
MPROP20 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 20
MPROP21 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 21
MPROP22 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 22
MPROP23 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 23
NOEXTPAR NO EXT PARAM SENT BY SSP
If this property is set, the SSP sends
INAP-operations without Extension Parameters.
Notes:
- This property has no influence on Extension

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 27+


CR INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Parameters sent by the SCP.


- If this property is not set, SCCP segmentation
has to be switched on.
PPROP00 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 0
SDDPFC Interworking, supply LOCNO from SCP-Address
in case of MOC:
True: Copy SCP-Address of SDDPFC Interface.
False: Don’t copy.
PPROP01 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 1
PPROP02 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 2
PPROP03 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 3
PPROP04 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 4
PPROP05 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 5
PPROP06 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 6
PPROP07 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 7
SCPNSMSC SEND CLD PTY NO AND SMSC ADDR
The SSP provides the SMS Service Center Address
and Called Party Address for SMS MO Trigger
Feature with CAP Phase 1 to the SCP.
GENPROP = PROP23 determines, which parameters
are used to transmit the addresses.
SUPACMSG SUPPRESS ANSWER/CONNECT MSG
If this property is set, any ANSWER/CONNECT
message for that call section to Calling Party
will be suppressed.
Prerequisites:
- SCP (CAP or SINAP7M+ prot) has to send in OP:CTR
OP:ETC the BothwayThroughConnectIndicator (BTCI)
= NOT_REQUIRED. BTCI is an subparameter of
SIITwo (ServiceInteractionIndicator 2).
SUPCHART SUPPRESS CHARGING TICKET
If this property is set, MOC/CF Charging Ticket
will be suppressed.
Prerequisites:
- SCP (CAP or SINAP7M+ prot) has to send in OP:CTR
OP:ETC the BothwayThroughConnectIndicator (BTCI)
= NOT_REQUIRED. BTCI is an subparameter of
SIITwo (ServiceInteractionIndicator 2).

EODRAN END OF DIALLING RANGE

This parameter specifies a minimal number of dialled digits


and a maximal number of dialled digits to have a general
end of dialling condition.
This parameter is evaluated only if GENPROP=EODREQ is set.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: MIN=
0...28, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

b: MAX=
0...28, range of decimal numbers

Default: 28

IWRULE INTERWORKING RULE

This parameter is used to control the interworking of IN


with basic network features. The first unit addresses the set
of default values for the Service Interaction Indicator (SII)
to be applied if the SCP did not send any. The second unit
specifies the interaction level which is applied for the
control of the SIIs influence on this interworking
(project specific).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: SERVICE INTERACTION INDICATOR INDEX=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 28+


CR INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Default: 0

b: INTERACTION LEVEL=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

RELEASE RELEASE REQUIRED INDICATOR

This parameter specifies a value to decide whether an Intelligent


Network call has to be released in the case that a protocol
abnormality occurs.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N RELEASE NOT REQUIRED


NO RELEASE NOT REQUIRED
Y RELEASE REQUIRED
YES RELEASE REQUIRED

Default: YES

CHGINF DEFAULT CHARGING INFORMATION

This parameter specifies the charging information in case no


information about how to charge an Intelligent Network call
was sent by the partner SCP.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: CHARGE INFORMATION
NOCHAR NO CHARGE
NOINTV NO INTERVENTION BY IN
REJECT REJECT THE CALL
ZONE CHARGE BY ZONE
unit b is required

Default: NOINTV

b: ZONE NUMBER=
0...511, range of decimal numbers

Compatibilities:
- ZONE is entered for the first unit.

CHGPROF CHARGING PROFILE

This parameter specifies the charging profile that is applied


when an IN service request was detected with an originating
line trigger.
The charging profile determines the billing registration
method and - in the case of metering - the subscriber charge
counters CNTR1 .. CNTR5.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PROF0 PROFILE 0
No billing registration.
PROF1 PROFILE 1
Automatic Message Accounting.
PROF10 PROFILE 10
Metering on charge counters 1&5.
PROF11 PROFILE 11

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 29+


CR INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Metering on charge counters 2&3.


PROF12 PROFILE 12
Metering on charge counters 2&4.
PROF13 PROFILE 13
Metering on charge counters 2&5.
PROF14 PROFILE 14
Metering on charge counters 3&4.
PROF15 PROFILE 15
Metering on charge counters 3&5.
PROF16 PROFILE 16
Metering on charge counters 4&5.
PROF17 PROFILE 17
Metering on charge counters 1&2&3.
PROF18 PROFILE 18
Metering on charge counters 1&2&4.
PROF19 PROFILE 19
Metering on charge counters 1&2&5.
PROF2 PROFILE 2
Metering on charge counter 1.
PROF20 PROFILE 20
Metering on charge counters 1&3&4.
PROF21 PROFILE 21
Metering on charge counters 1&3&5.
PROF22 PROFILE 22
Metering on charge counters 1&4&5.
PROF23 PROFILE 23
Metering on charge counters 2&3&4.
PROF24 PROFILE 24
Metering on charge counters 2&3&5.
PROF25 PROFILE 25
Metering on charge counters 2&4&5.
PROF26 PROFILE 26
Metering on charge counters 3&4&5.
PROF27 PROFILE 27
Metering on charge counters 1&2&3&4.
PROF28 PROFILE 28
Metering on charge counters 1&2&3&5.
PROF29 PROFILE 29
Metering on charge counters 1&2&4&5.
PROF3 PROFILE 3
Metering on charge counter 2.
PROF30 PROFILE 30
Metering on charge counters 1&3&4&5.
PROF31 PROFILE 31
Metering on charge counters 2&3&4&5.
PROF32 PROFILE 32
Metering on charge counters 1&2&3&4&5.
PROF4 PROFILE 4
Metering on charge counter 3.
PROF5 PROFILE 5
Metering on charge counter 4.
PROF6 PROFILE 6
Metering on charge counter 5.
PROF7 PROFILE 7
Metering on charge counters 1&2.
PROF8 PROFILE 8
Metering on charge counters 1&3.
PROF9 PROFILE 9
Metering on charge counters 1&4.

DACTINC DEACTIV. SERV. INTERCEPT ID.

This parameter specifies the intercept code selected in case the


Intelligent Network service is in status inactive.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SNA0 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 0


SNA1 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 1
SNA2 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 2
SNA3 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 3
SNA4 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 4

Default: SNA0

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 30+


CR INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SSFTIMER SSF TIMER

This parameter specifies the time, in which the answer


from SCP/SCF is expected in steps of 100ms.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...255, range of decimal numbers

Default: 100

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR INTRIG- 31-


DACT INTRIG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DACT INTELL.NETWORK TRIGGER PROFILE

This command deactivates an Intelligent Network service.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DACT INTRIG : PRID= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile the


Intelligent Network service of which has to be deactivated
on the home exchange.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT INTRIG- 1-


DISP INTRIG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISP INTELL.NETWORK TRIGGER PROFILE

This command displays data concerning specified or all Intelligent Network


trigger profiles. Depending on the FORMAT parameter the data for the
installation of a service, a description of the address of the partner
Service Control Point and, if available in the IN application, the own
address or, for PROT = SINAP1 service specific statistics will be
displayed. A further choice can be reached by the parameters STATUS
to select all active or inactive services, SKEY to select all profiles
related to the specified service key and PROT to select a single protocol
type, respectively.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP INTRIG : PRID= [,FORMAT=] [,SKEY=] [,PROT=] [,SSFTYPE=] 1
1 1
1 [,STATUS=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile to be


displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

FORMAT FORMAT SELECTION

This parameter specifies the kind of data which is displayed


for an Intelligent Network service on the own exchange:
- PA is used for the selection of installation data,
- CT is used for the selection of call treatment data,
- AD is used for the selection of address description data,
- ST is used for the selection of service specific statistics.
Only data of trigger profiles with protocol type SINAP1 and a
service key in the range of 1 to 8 will be displayed,
- MS is used for the selection of mobile specific data.
- CA is used for the selection of CAMEL specific data.

Compatibilities:
- If FORMAT = ST only a profile identifier may be specified. The
service key and the SCP address available in the trigger profile will
be used to select the service specific statistic. If any Service Con-
trol Point concerning the selected service is addressed by a global
title no address may be specified in the corresponding output mask.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PA TRIGGER PROFILE PARAMETER


CT DISPLAY CALL TREATMENT
Incompatibilities:
- SSFTYPE = ASST.
AD SCP AND SSP ADDRESSES
ST STATISTICS OF INTELL.NETWORK
Incompatibilities:
- The parameters PROT, STATUS and SKEY must not
be specified.
MS MOBILE SPECIFIC DATA
CA CAMEL SPECIFIC DATA

Default: PA

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INTRIG- 1+


DISP INTRIG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SKEY SERVICE KEY

This parameter specifies the Intelligent Network service to be


displayed.

Incompatibilities:
- The SKEY parameter must not be entered if FORMAT = ST.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

PROT PROTOCOL TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the Intelligent Network


application protocol the service execution is based on.

Incompatibilities:
- The PROT parameter must not be entered if FORMAT = ST.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SINAP1 SIEMENS INAP 1


Compatibilities:
- SKEY = 1..8.
CS1 CS1 CONFORM INAP
CS2 CS2 CONFORM INAP
PROT4 PROTOCOL TYPE 4

SSFTYPE SERVICE SWITCHING FUNCT. TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of Service Switching


Function for which the trigger profile was created. If an
IN trigger was detected the SSF can act as initiating
(normal) or assisting SSF.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NORM NORMAL
ASST ASSISTING
Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

STATUS ACTIVITY STATUS

This parameter specifies the status of the Intelligent Network


service the data of which has to be displayed.

Incompatibilities:
- The STATUS parameter must not be entered if FORMAT = ST.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INACT SERVICE IS NOT ACTIVE


ACT SERVICE IS ACTIVE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP INTRIG- 2-


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MOD INTELL.NETWORK TRIGGER PROFILE

This command modifies the trigger profile data of an Intelligent


Network service on an exchange, independent of the status of the
service. All parameters except the profile identifier and the
SSF type may be changed.

If the network indicator will be modified, a complete SCP address and - if


already available - the SSP address also has to be entered for Non-CAMEL
profiles. If the routing preferences for the SCP or the SSP address will be
modified, i.e. if a physical address has to be replaced by a logical or
vice versa, then the new address has to be entered completely.
In case the translation type identifier of the SCP address shall be
modified, then also a complete address including routing preferences has
to be specified.
If the translator service group of the SCP address shall be omitted, then a
complete address including routing preferences has to be entered.
Furthermore single parameter values of an already existing logical or
physical address (e.g. the global title digits or the
destination point code) may be modified.
If the protocol type will be changed from SINAP1 to another protocol type
the overload and invalid vote intercept id in the data base will be ignored.
If the protocol type will be changed from another protocol type to SINAP1,
then the overload resp. the invalid vote intercept id have to be entered.
The subsystem identifier has to be changed accordingly. In addition the
parameter GENPROP = FTRINH is set automatically.
For administration of CAMEL profiles no preconditions exists.

Prerequisites:
1. General:
- If the protocol type will be changed Service Filtering entities must not
exist for this trigger profile.
- For a zone number specified by the parameter CHGINF a tariff has to be
entered by command ENTR TAR.
- The intercept identifier values specified by the parameters DACTINC,
OVLINC and INVINC must have been created by the command CR INC.
- If GENPROP = SFINH will be entered Service Filtering entities must
not exist for this trigger profile.
- No trigger table entry with CAMEL = YES and the same service key,
the same SCP address and the same CSITYPE must exist.

2. In case of an CCNC configuration:

3. In the case of an SSNC configuration:


- Equivalent preconditions as mentioned for the CCNC configuration are valid.
These conditions cannot be checked by the system since they are
administrated by means of Q3 tasks instead of MML commands.

Compatibilities:
- The parameters OVLINC and INVINC may only be entered for protocol
type SINAP1.
- Only special property values (PROP24..PROP39) of parameter
GENPROP may be specified for SSFTYPE=ASST.

Incompatibilities:
- A global title must not be entered together with a DPC.
- For SSFTYPE=ASST the parameters TRAT, INCAT, RELEASE,
CHGINF, CHGPROF, OVLINC, INVINC and EODRAN must not be entered.
- In case of parameter CAMEL = NO only USSDPRID = NONE is allowed.
- In case of parameter CAMEL = NO only CDPAPFX = NONE is allowed.
- In case of parameter CAMEL = NO no CSITYPE must be entered.
- No trigger table entry with CAMEL = YES and the same service key,
the same SCP address and the same CSITYPE must exist.

This command is normally logged.

This command is only permitted for an exchange providing IN.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD INTRIG - GT PROFILE WITH LOGICAL SCP ADDRESSING


2. MOD INTRIG - SPC PROFILE WITH PHYSICAL SCP ADDRESSING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 1+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1. Input format

PROFILE WITH LOGICAL SCP ADDRESSING

This input format has to be used to modify a trigger profile with


a SCP address consisting of a global title and any combination of
a translator service group and a subsystem identifier.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD INTRIG : PRID= <,SKEY= ,NETIND= ,NETNAME= ,RTGP= 1
1 1
1 ,CAMEL=> [,CSITYPE=] [,CCSITYPE=] <,USSDPRID= 1
1 1
1 ,IPAVAIL= ,IPSSPCA= ,CIPSSPCA= ,CDPAPFX=> 1
1 1
1 [,CGAC=] <,TTID= ,NP= ,NA= ,GTDIG= ,PREFIX= 1
1 1
1 ,TRLG= ,SSID= ,PROT= ,ACNSEL= ,SSPGT= ,ORTTID= 1
1 1
1 ,ORSSID= ,ORNP= ,ORNA= ,ORGTDIG= ,TRAT= 1
1 1
1 ,INCAT=> [,GENPROP=] [,CGENPROP=] [,MOBPROP=] 1
1 1
1 [,CMOBPROP=] <,EODRAN= ,IWRULE= ,RELEASE= 1
1 1
1 ,CHGINF= ,CHGPROF= ,CCHGPROF= ,DACTINC= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,SSFTIMER=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile to be


modified. Since the service logic may be distributed on several
Service Control Points, for one service different trigger
profiles may be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SKEY SERVICE KEY

This parameter specifies the Intelligent Network service to be


installed on the home exchange. The same service key may occur in
different trigger profiles.

Notes:
The SKEY=0 is used as master key in case of Call Gap. So, if a
trigger profile is entered with SKEY=0 it is not possible to gap
service requests with this service key individually.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the network of the SSP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NET 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NET 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NET 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NET 1

NETNAME NETWORK NAME

This parameter identifies the signaling network in which

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 2+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

the destination point is existing by its name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences for the


delivery of a SCCP message to the SCP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

GT ROUTE BY GT

CAMEL CAMEL TRIGGERING

This parameter indicates whether the profile


can be used for triggering by CSI.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO CSI-TRIGGERING
NO NO CSI-TRIGGERING
Y CSI-TRIGGERING POSSIBLE
YES CSI-TRIGGERING POSSIBLE

Default: NO

CSITYPE CSI TYPE

This parameter adds CSI-Types for which the trigger profile


could be used to the already existing values. CSITYPE is
used to distinguish between two CAMEL trigger profiles with
the same service key and SCP address.
Up to 5 parameter values can be linked with &.

Notes:
- ALLCSI cannot be linked with another CSI.
- Adding parameter values deletes an existing CSITYPE = ALLCSI
- Adding ALLCSI deletes existing parameter values.
- In case of default service key or default SCP address only
CSITYPE = ALLCSI is allowed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ALLCSI ALL CSI TYPES


DCSI DIALLED SERVICE CSI
OCSI ORIGINATING CSI
SMSCSI SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE CSI
TCSI TERMINATING CSI
VTCSI VMSC TERMINATING CSI

CCSITYPE CANCELED CSI TYPE

This parameter cancels CSI-Types for which the trigger


profile could be used from the already existing parameter
values. Up to 5 parameter values can be linked with &.

Notes:
- If all existing parameter values are canceled then
CSITYPE = ALLCSI will be assigned to the CAMEL trigger
profile (DEFAULT value).

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ALLCSI ALL CSI TYPES


DCSI DIALLED SERVICE CSI
OCSI ORIGINATING CSI
SMSCSI SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE CSI
TCSI TERMINATING CSI
VTCSI VMSC TERMINATING CSI

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 3+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

USSDPRID USSD PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter points to another trigger table


element which must be used for USSD calltype.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

Input NONE for USSDPRID means no USSDPRID.

IPAVAIL IP AVAILABLE

This parameter indicates whether Intelligent


Peripherie (IP) capabilities are available and
are to be transfered to the SCP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO IP CAPABILITIES AVAILABLE
NO NO IP CAPABILITIES AVAILABLE
Y IP CAPABILITIES AVAILABLE
YES IP CAPABILITIES AVAILABLE

Default: NO

IPSSPCA IPSSP CAPABILITIES

This parameter indicates the IP capabilities of the SSP


to be added to the already existing values.
Up to 7 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

GENVA GEN. OF VOICE ANN. FROM TEXT


Generation of voice announcements from text
is supported.
IPRAD IP ROUTING ADDRESS SUPPORTED
IP Routing Address is supported.
RES1 RESERVED1
Reserved for future enhancements 1.
RES2 RESERVED2
Reserved for future enhancements 2.
VOICEBA VOICEBACK SUPPORTED
VoiceBack is supported.
VOICESPR VOICE INF. WITH SPEECH RECOGN.
VoiceInformation is supported via speech
recognition.
VOICEVR VOICE INF. WITH VOICE RECOGN.
VoiceInformation is supported via voice
recognition.

CIPSSPCA CANCELED IPSSP CAPABILITIES

This parameter specifies the IP capabilities of the SSP


to be canceled from the existing trigger profile.
Up to 7 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

GENVA GEN. OF VOICE ANN. FROM TEXT


Generation of voice announcements from text
is canceled.
IPRAD IP ROUTING ADDRESS CANCELED
IP Routing Address is canceled.
RES1 RESERVED1
Reserved for future enhancements 1.
RES2 RESERVED2
Reserved for future enhancements 2.
VOICEBA VOICEBACK CANCELED
VoiceBack is canceled.
VOICESPR VOICE INF. WITH SPEECH RECOGN.
VoiceInformation is canceled via speech
recognition.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 4+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

VOICEVR VOICE INF. WITH VOICE RECOGN.


VoiceInformation is canceled via voice
recognition.

CDPAPFX CALLED PARTY ADDRESS PREFIX

This parameter specifies the digits to be


prefixed to the called party address before
the address is sent to SCP or used
for re-routing.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

Input NONE for CDPAPFX means no CDPAPFX.

CGAC CALL GAP ACCEPTANCE

This parameter specifies whether an operation call gap


from the SCP is accepted or not.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACCG ACCEPT OPERATION CALL GAP


ACSCFID ACCEPT CG WITH SCFID ONLY
CGRES CALL GAP RESERVED
Reserved for future enhancements.
IGNCG IGNORE OPERATION CALL GAP

TTID TRANSLATION TYPE ID.

This parameter specifies the translation type identifier of the global


title.
If it was specified with INPPDD the parameter PREFIX has to
be entered instead of the parameter GTDIG. If it was specified with
INCGPA or INDD the parameters GTDIG, PREFIX, NP and NA
must not be entered. The corresponding values will be determined from
the calling party address or the called party address, respectively.
For all other values of this parameter GTDIG, NP and NA
must be entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CCV CREDIT CARD VERIFICATION


IEESS ISDN END-TO-END SUPPL. SERV.
IMSI INTERNATIONAL MOBILE SUB. ID.
INCGPA IN CALLING PARTY ADDRESS
Incompatibilities:
- PREFIX, GTDIG, NP and NA.
INDD IN DIALED DIGITS
Incompatibilities:
- PREFIX, GTDIG, NP and NA.
INPPDD IN PREFIX PLUS DIALED DIGITS
Compatibilities:
- PREFIX.
ITCC INT. TELECOMM. CHARGE CARD
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TT10 TRANSLATION TYPE 10
TT11 TRANSLATION TYPE 11
TT12 TRANSLATION TYPE 12
TT13 TRANSLATION TYPE 13
TT14 TRANSLATION TYPE 14
TT15 TRANSLATION TYPE 15
TT9 TRANSLATION TYPE 9
UNKNOWN TRANSLATION TYPE UNKNOWN

NP NUMBERING PLAN

This parameter specifies the numbering plan of the global title.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DATANP DATA NUMBERING PLAN


ISDNMNP ISDN MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
ISDNTNP ISDN TELEPHONY NUMB. PLAN

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 5+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

LMNP LAND MOBILE NUMB. PLAN


MMNP MARITIME MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
NP10 NUMBERING PLAN 10
NP11 NUMBERING PLAN 11
NP12 NUMBERING PLAN 12
NP13 NUMBERING PLAN 13
NP15 NUMBERING PLAN 15
NP2 NUMBERING PLAN 2
NP8 NUMBERING PLAN 8
NP9 NUMBERING PLAN 9
PNP PRIVATE NUMBERING PLAN
TELEXNP TELEX NUMBERING PLAN
UNKNOWN NUMB. PLAN UNKNOWN

NA NATURE OF ADDRESS

This parameter specifies the nature of address of the global title.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTNO INTERNATIONAL NUMBER


NATNO NATIONAL SIGNIFICANT NUMBER
NATUSE RESERVED FOR NATIONAL USE
NA10 NATURE OF ADDRESS 10
NA11 NATURE OF ADDRESS 11
NA12 NATURE OF ADDRESS 12
NA13 NATURE OF ADDRESS 13
NA14 NATURE OF ADDRESS 14
NA15 NATURE OF ADDRESS 15
NA5 NATURE OF ADDRESS 5
NA6 NATURE OF ADDRESS 6
NA7 NATURE OF ADDRESS 7
NA8 NATURE OF ADDRESS 8
NA9 NATURE OF ADDRESS 9
SUBNO SUBSCRIBER NUMBER
UNKNOWN NATURE OF ADDRESS UNKNOWN

GTDIG GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the digits of the global title. The digits can
be input in a structured format.
For IN triggering with CSI only 16 digits are evaluated.
For CAMEL profiles it is possible to enter the SCP address partly.
For example, only a few trigger profiles are necessary for roaming
subscribers if created this way.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: GT DIGITS FIRST PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: GT DIGITS SECOND PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: GT DIGITS THIRD PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PREFIX PREFIX DIGITS

This parameter specifies the prefix digits to be used to assemble a


global title dynamically together with the digit information of the
called party number. This means that the global title is composed of
the prefix digits and the address information of the called party
number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...3 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 6+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TRLG TRANSLATOR SERVICE GROUP

This parameter specifies a translator service group which performs


the global title translation if the translation is not executed in
the SSP.

Prerequisites:
- In the case of a CCNC configuration the translator service group
must have been created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFIER

*FUTSS01:

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC ACCOUNT CARD CALLING


Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
AWC AREA WIDE CENTREX
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
CCC CREDIT CARD CALLING
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
FPH FREEPHONE SERVICE
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01
FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
INMP1 IN APPLICATION 1 ON MP
If a destination point code which specifies a
node containing a SSNC-based Number Portability
Server is entered together with this subsystem
identifier then the LNP (local number portability)
server function on that node (Stand-alone STP or
with EWSD as host) is addressed.
INMP2 IN APPLICATION 2 ON MP
INMP3 IN APPLICATION 3 ON MP
INMP4 IN APPLICATION 4 ON MP
INMP5 IN APPLICATION 5 ON MP
IN2 IN APPLICATION 2
Used for CAP protocols.
IN3 IN APPLICATION 3
Used for national INAP protocols.
IN4 IN APPLICATION 4
Used for number portability.
IN5 IN APPLICATION 5
PN PERSONAL NUMBER
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
TIS TELEINFO SERVICE
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
TV TELEVOTING
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
UN UNIVERSAL NUMBER
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
UPT UNIV PERSONAL TELECOMMUNICAT
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 7+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

VPN VIRTUAL PRIVATE NETWORKS


Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

PROT PROTOCOL TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the Intelligent Network


application protocol the service execution is based on.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CS1 CS1 CONFORM INAP


CS2 CS2 CONFORM INAP
PROT4 PROTOCOL TYPE 4
SINAP1 SIEMENS INAP 1
Compatibilities:
- SKEY = 1..8.

ACNSEL APPLIC. CONTEXT NAME SELECTOR

ACNSEL=3 : SINAP5M
ACNSEL=5 : SINAP5M+
ACNSEL=6 : SINAP5M++
ACNSEL=7 : 163TR78
ACNSEL=8 : TINAP2001
ACNSEL=10: CAP Version 1
ACNSEL=11: CAP Version 2
ACNSEL=12: CAP Version 3
ACNSEL=13: CAP Version 3 SMS-MO
ACNSEL=14: SINAP7M
ACNSEL=15: SINAP7M+
ACNSEL=20: SINAP6NP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...31, range of decimal numbers

SSPGT SSP GT REQUIRED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N SSP GLOBAL TITLE NOT REQUIRED


NO SSP GLOBAL TITLE NOT REQUIRED
Y SSP GLOBAL TITLE REQUIRED
YES SSP GLOBAL TITLE REQUIRED

ORTTID ORIG. TRANSLATION TYPE ID.

This parameter specifies the translation type identifier of the


global title of the SSP.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CCV CREDIT CARD VERIFICATION


IEESS ISDN END-TO-END SUPPL. SERV.
IMSI INTERNATIONAL MOBILE SUB. ID.
ITCC INT. TELECOMM. CHARGE CARD
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TT10 TRANSLATION TYPE 10
TT11 TRANSLATION TYPE 11
TT12 TRANSLATION TYPE 12
TT13 TRANSLATION TYPE 13
TT14 TRANSLATION TYPE 14
TT15 TRANSLATION TYPE 15
TT9 TRANSLATION TYPE 9
UNKNOWN TRANSLATION TYPE UNKNOWN

ORSSID ORIGINATOR SUBSYSTEM ID.

This parameter specifies the subsystem identifier of the IN application


part on the SSP as part of the calling party address. It depends on the
entered protocol type.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 8+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01


FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
IN IN APPLICATION IN SSP
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
IN2 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 3
IN4 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 4
IN5 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 5

ORNP ORIGINATOR NUMBERING PLAN

This parameter specifies the numbering plan of the global


title of the SSP.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DATANP DATA NUMBERING PLAN


ISDNMNP ISDN MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
ISDNTNP ISDN TELEPHONY NUMB. PLAN
LMNP LAND MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
MMNP MARITIME MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
NP10 NUMBERING PLAN 10
NP11 NUMBERING PLAN 11
NP12 NUMBERING PLAN 12
NP13 NUMBERING PLAN 13
NP15 NUMBERING PLAN 15
NP2 NUMBERING PLAN 2
NP8 NUMBERING PLAN 8
NP9 NUMBERING PLAN 9
PNP PRIVATE NUMBERING PLAN
TELEXNP TELEX NUMBERING PLAN
UNKNOWN NUMB. PLAN UNKNOWN

ORNA ORIGINATOR NATURE OF ADDRESS

This parameter specifies the nature of address of the global


title of the SSP.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTNO INTERNATIONAL NUMBER


NATNO NATIONAL SIGNIFICANT NUMBER
NATUSE RESERVED FOR NATIONAL USE
NA10 NATURE OF ADDRESS 10
NA11 NATURE OF ADDRESS 11
NA12 NATURE OF ADDRESS 12
NA13 NATURE OF ADDRESS 13
NA14 NATURE OF ADDRESS 14
NA15 NATURE OF ADDRESS 15
NA5 NATURE OF ADDRESS 5
NA6 NATURE OF ADDRESS 6
NA7 NATURE OF ADDRESS 7
NA8 NATURE OF ADDRESS 8
NA9 NATURE OF ADDRESS 9
SUBNO SUBSCRIBER NUMBER
UNKNOWN NATURE OF ADDRESS UNKNOWN

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 9+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ORGTDIG ORIG. GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the digits of the global title in the calling
party address of the SSP. The digits can be input in a structured
format.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: GT DIGITS FIRST PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: GT DIGITS SECOND PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: GT DIGITS THIRD PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TRAT TRAFFIC TYPE

This parameter specifies a traffic type assigned to the Intelligent


Network service in the trigger profile. The traffic type is
evaluated after detection of an IN trigger.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

INCAT IN CATEGORY

This parameter specifies branch categories for the digit translation.

Compatibilities:
- GENPROP=UINCAT.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15
COINB COIN BOX
DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
OPOSINAT OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the category for which the destination is


addressed.

GENPROP GENERAL PROPERTIES

This parameter specifies the general properties related to the


Intelligent Network service execution to be added to the already
existing values.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 10+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Up to 40 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

XADPBIN = ABBREV. DIALLING PROC. BY IN


1CLIREQ 1 CALLING LINE ID. REQUESTED
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1CONINH 1 CONGESTION CONTROL INHIBITED
1DPINH 1 DETECTION POINTS INHIBITED
1 1 The activation of internal detection points is
1 1 not allowed for the current service key. This
1 1 property is only relevant for the execution of
1 1 special services, e.g. international calls.
1 1
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1ENACPH 1 ENABLE CALL PARTY HANDLING
1EODREQ 1 END OF DIALLING REQUESTED
1FTALLOW 1 FEATURE TRANSPARENCY ALLOWED
1FTRINH 1 FURTHER TRIGGERING INHIBITED
1 1 Notes:
1 1 - For the protocol type SINAP1 this value
1 1 is set automatically.
1MCIHLD 1 MCI HOLD REQUESTED
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1MCIPRE 1 MALIC. CALL ID. PREP. REQ.
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1MHNCLI 1 MCI HOLD IF NO CLI AVAILABLE
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1ONLCHG 1 ONLINE CHARGING
1PASSBA 1 PASS B PTY CHARGE MSG TO A PTY
1PCNCHG 1 PER CONNECTION CHARGING
1PROP18 1 PROPERTY 18
1 1 PPS Indication. It is evaluated to realize the
1 1 follwowing functionality:
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile indicates a PPS.
1 1 FALSE: In case of interworking between PPS and
1 1 CFNRc (detected after 2nd HLR
1 1 interrogation)
1 1 the T-CSI dialogue will be terminated.
1PROP19 1 PROPERTY 19
1 1 Changing from T-BCSM to O-BCSM
1 1 TRUE: Changing the BCSM is allowed.
1 1 FALSE: Changing the BCSM is not allowed.
1PROP20 1 PROPERTY 20
1 1 Identification of the trigger profile TDP12-
1 1 related profile. PROP20 is necessary to
1 1 distinguish between "Basic IN Services" and "IN
1 1 User subscribt Services" because both are triggert
1 1 via digit analysis.
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile corresponds to an user
1 1 subscribed IN-MTC service, i.e. TDP12 is
1 1 send in the OP:IDP to the SCP (mapping of
1 1 TDP3 to TDP12).
1 1 FALSE: else
1PROP21 1 PROPERTY 21
1 1 Cross phase compatibility between MAP- and CAP-
1 1 interface
1 1 TRUE: The protocol version is determined
1 1 according to the CAMEL phase supported on
1 1 the MAP interface.
1 1 FALSE: the protocol version is determined by the
1 1 ACN selector (parameter ACNSEL).
1PROP22 1 PROPERTY 22
1 1 Fall Back to Basic SMS MO
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile is used for SMS MO
1 1 and MOC.
1 1 FALSE: The trigger profile used for MOC only.
1PROP23 1 PROPERTY 23
1 1
1 1 Usage of CdPA or SMSC-address in Op:I_DP for SMS
1 1 MO

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 11+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1 1 TRUE: the InitialDP for SMS MO contains the SMSC-


1 1 address as Called Party Address.
1 1 FALSE: the InitialDP for SMS MO contains the SMS
1 1 receiver address as Called Party Address.
1 1 (This property to be used with only if
1 1 PROP22 together)
1PROP24 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 24
1 1 Control of ticket generation
1 1 TRUE: Tickets should not be generated.
1 1 FALSE: Tickets should be generated.
1PROP25 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 25
1 1 Prefixing of CdPA with CAC digits
1 1 TRUE: The digits received from A-side GP shall be
1 1 Prefixed with the received CAC (if any) and
1 1 the appropiate prefix for CAC dialing
1 1 FALSE: The digits received from A-side GP are send
1 1 unchanged in the C:IN_DATA to the BSSAP
1PROP26 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 26
1 1 Using of default zoning
1 1 TRUE: The ZONDA is called with the received
1 1 Digits to determine the charging zone or a
1 1 No charge indication (but not to overwrite
1 1 The AMA parameter)
1 1 False: The default zone from trigger profile
1 1 Is set in the CPB as local zoning result or
1 1 Chargefree indication is evaluated.
1PROP27 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 27
1 1
1 1 Interworking IN/CAMEL with CF
1 1 True: The interworking of CF with IN/CAMEL is
1 1 Allowed.
1 1 False: The interworking of CF with IN/CAMEL is
1 1 Not allowed.
1 1 The network provider can support the interworking
1 1 of CF with IN MOC service by setting General
1 1 Property 27 in the trigger profile of the IN MOC
1 1 service.
1PROP28 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 28
1 1 Fallback from CAP Ph3, CAP PH2 to CAP Ph1
1 1 TRUE: The AC negotioation on the CAP interface is
1 1 supported.
1 1 FALSE: AC negotiation on the CAP interface is not
1 1 possible.
1PROP29 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 29
1 1 Identification of the trigger profile as TDP2-
1 1 related profile
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile corresponds to an user
1 1 subscribt IN-MOC service, i.e TDP2 is send
1 1 in the OP:IDP to the SCP
1 1 FALSE: else
1 1 PROP29 is necessary for Overlay networks as it is
1 1 not possible to distinguish between "Basic IN-
1 1 Services" and "IN User Subscribed Services".
1PROP30 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 30
1 1 GSM-BC or ISDN-BC in Op:I_DP
1 1 TRUE: The ISUP Bearer Capability (BC) is used in
1 1 Op:Initial_DP.
1 1 FALSE: The GSM BC is used.
1PROP31 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 31
1 1 Ticket control by suppression of ticket generation
1 1 TRUE: The SCP is allowed to suppress ticket
1 1 generation by sending "SuppressCITicket" in
1 1 The OP:SendChargingInfo
1 1 FALSE: else
1PROP32 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 32
1 1 CAMEL Overlay. Possibility to to administrate a
1 1 prefix with MML CR INTRIG parameter CDAPRFX.
1 1 TRUE: (and CDPAPFX not empty) IN handling is
1 1 stopped, CAMEL relevant data is reset and a
1 1 digit anlaysis with the prefixed Called
1 1 Party Number is started
1 1 FALSE: Continiue normal IN handling
1PROP33 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 33
1 1 Mapping of Calling Party Number
1 1 True: Mapping of Calling Party Number from INAP
1 1 OP:CONNECT to Calling Party Number ISUP o/g
1 1 IAM (only valid for ISUP-LTG)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 12+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1 1 False: Mapping of Calling Party Number from INAP


1 1 OP:CONNECT to Generic Number (additional
1 1 Calling number) in ISUP o/g IAM
1PROP34 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 34
1 1 CAC Handling for Prepaid Subscribers
1 1 (see PROP35)
1PROP35 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 35
1 1 CAC Handling for Prepaid Subscribers
1 1 PROP34 False and PROP35 False: If CAC is dialed
1 1 Call is released
1 1 PROP34 True and PROP35 False: CAC will be ignored
1 1 For routing
1 1 PROP34 False and PROP35 True: Call will be
1 1 Rerouted via
1 1 Carrier network
1 1 PROP34 True and PROP35 True: PROP35 has priority
1PROP36 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 36
1 1 Suppression of DAS Announcement for PNS and
1 1 SNP/NTS
1 1 TRUE: PNS or SNP/NTS is active
1 1 FALSE: PNS or SNP/NTS is not active
1PROP37 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 37
1 1 Supply of Location Number
1 1 True: Supply the Location Number from ATD
1 1 False: Supply the Location Number from VLR number
1PROP38 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 38
1 1 Other Party Long_Number in MOC Record
1 1 True: Write "rerouted number" (from SCP) as other
1 1 party long number in MOC Record
1 1 False: Write "dialled number" as other party long
1 1 number in MOC Record
1PROP39 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 39
1RCNCLI 1 REL. CALL IF NO CLI RETRIEVED
1 1 Prerequisites:
1 1 - The intercept identifier INANIF must have
1 1 been created by the command CR INC.
1 1
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1SFINH 1 SERVICE FILTERING INHIBITED
>UINCAT W USE IN CATEGORY
Compatibilities:
- INCAT must be specified.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

CGENPROP CANCELED GENERAL PROPERTIES

This parameter specifies the general properties related to the


Intelligent Network service execution to be canceled from the
existing trigger profile.
Up to 40 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

XADPBIN = ABBREV. DIALLING PROC. BY IN


1CLIREQ 1 CALLING LINE ID. REQUESTED
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1CONINH 1 CONGESTION CONTROL INHIBITED
1DPINH 1 DETECTION POINTS INHIBITED
1 1 The activation of internal detection points is
1 1 not allowed for the current service key. This
1 1 property is only relevant for the execution of
1 1 special services, e.g. international calls.
1 1
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1ENACPH 1 ENABLE CALL PARTY HANDLING
1EODREQ 1 END OF DIALLING REQUESTED
1FTALLOW 1 FEATURE TRANSPARENCY ALLOWED
1FTRINH 1 FURTHER TRIGGERING INHIBITED
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - FTRINH = FTRINH.
1MCIHLD 1 MCI HOLD REQUESTED

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 13+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1MCIPRE 1 MALIC. CALL ID. PREP. REQ.
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1MHNCLI 1 MCI HOLD IF NO CLI AVAILABLE
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1ONLCHG 1 ONLINE CHARGING
1PASSBA 1 PASS B PTY CHARGE MSG TO A PTY
1PCNCHG 1 PER CONNECTION CHARGING
1PROP18 1 PROPERTY 18
1 1 PPS Indication. It is evaluated to realize the
1 1 follwowing functionality:
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile indicates a PPS.
1 1 FALSE: In case of interworking between PPS and
1 1 CFNRc (detected after 2nd HLR
1 1 interrogation)
1 1 the T-CSI dialogue will be terminated.
1PROP19 1 PROPERTY 19
1 1 Changing from T-BCSM to O-BCSM
1 1 TRUE: Changing the BCSM is allowed.
1 1 FALSE: Changing the BCSM is not allowed.
1PROP20 1 PROPERTY 20
1 1 Identification of the trigger profile TDP12-
1 1 related profile. PROP20 is necessary to
1 1 distinguish between "Basic IN Services" and "IN
1 1 User subscribt Services" because both are triggert
1 1 via digit analysis.
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile corresponds to an user
1 1 subscribed IN-MTC service, i.e. TDP12 is
1 1 send in the OP:IDP to the SCP (mapping of
1 1 TDP3 to TDP12).
1 1 FALSE: else
1PROP21 1 PROPERTY 21
1 1 Cross phase compatibility between MAP- and CAP-
1 1 interface
1 1 TRUE: The protocol version is determined
1 1 according to the CAMEL phase supported on
1 1 the MAP interface.
1 1 FALSE: the protocol version is determined by the
1 1 ACN selector (parameter ACNSEL).
1PROP22 1 PROPERTY 22
1 1 Fall Back to Basic SMS MO
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile is used for SMS MO
1 1 and MOC.
1 1 FALSE: The trigger profile used for MOC only.
1PROP23 1 PROPERTY 23
1 1
1 1 Usage of CdPA or SMSC-address in Op:I_DP for SMS
1 1 MO
1 1 TRUE: the InitialDP for SMS MO contains the SMSC-
1 1 address as Called Party Address.
1 1 FALSE: the InitialDP for SMS MO contains the SMS
1 1 receiver address as Called Party Address.
1 1 (This property to be used with only if
1 1 PROP22 together)
1PROP24 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 24
1 1 Control of ticket generation
1 1 TRUE: Tickets should not be generated.
1 1 FALSE: Tickets should be generated.
1PROP25 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 25
1 1 Prefixing of CdPA with CAC digits
1 1 TRUE: The digits received from A-side GP shall be
1 1 Prefixed with the received CAC (if any) and
1 1 the appropiate prefix for CAC dialing
1 1 FALSE: The digits received from A-side GP are send
1 1 unchanged in the C:IN_DATA to the BSSAP
1PROP26 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 26
1 1 Using of default zoning
1 1 TRUE: The ZONDA is called with the received
1 1 Digits to determine the charging zone or a
1 1 No charge indication (but not to overwrite
1 1 The AMA parameter)
1 1 False: The default zone from trigger profile
1 1 Is set in the CPB as local zoning result or
1 1 Chargefree indication is evaluated.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 14+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1PROP27 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 27


1 1
1 1 Interworking IN/CAMEL with CF
1 1 True: The interworking of CF with IN/CAMEL is
1 1 Allowed.
1 1 False: The interworking of CF with IN/CAMEL is
1 1 Not allowed.
1 1 The network provider can support the interworking
1 1 of CF with IN MOC service by setting General
1 1 Property 27 in the trigger profile of the IN MOC
1 1 service.
1PROP28 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 28
1 1 Fallback from CAP Ph3, CAP PH2 to CAP Ph1
1 1 TRUE: The AC negotioation on the CAP interface is
1 1 supported.
1 1 FALSE: AC negotiation on the CAP interface is not
1 1 possible.
1PROP29 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 29
1 1 Identification of the trigger profile as TDP2-
1 1 related profile
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile corresponds to an user
1 1 subscribt IN-MOC service, i.e TDP2 is send
1 1 in the OP:IDP to the SCP
1 1 FALSE: else
1 1 PROP29 is necessary for Overlay networks as it is
1 1 not possible to distinguish between "Basic IN-
1 1 Services" and "IN User Subscribed Services".
1PROP30 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 30
1 1 GSM-BC or ISDN-BC in Op:I_DP
1 1 TRUE: The ISUP Bearer Capability (BC) is used in
1 1 Op:Initial_DP.
1 1 FALSE: The GSM BC is used.
1PROP31 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 31
1 1 Ticket control by suppression of ticket generation
1 1 TRUE: The SCP is allowed to suppress ticket
1 1 generation by sending "SuppressCITicket" in
1 1 The OP:SendChargingInfo
1 1 FALSE: else
1PROP32 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 32
1 1 CAMEL Overlay. Possibility to to administrate a
1 1 prefix with MML CR INTRIG parameter CDAPRFX.
1 1 TRUE: (and CDPAPFX not empty) IN handling is
1 1 stopped, CAMEL relevant data is reset and a
1 1 digit anlaysis with the prefixed Called
1 1 Party Number is started
1 1 FALSE: Continiue normal IN handling
1PROP33 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 33
1 1 Mapping of Calling Party Number
1 1 True: Mapping of Calling Party Number from INAP
1 1 OP:CONNECT to Calling Party Number ISUP o/g
1 1 IAM (only valid for ISUP-LTG)
1 1 False: Mapping of Calling Party Number from INAP
1 1 OP:CONNECT to Generic Number (additional
1 1 Calling number) in ISUP o/g IAM
1PROP34 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 34
1 1 CAC Handling for Prepaid Subscribers
1 1 (see PROP35)
1PROP35 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 35
1 1 CAC Handling for Prepaid Subscribers
1 1 PROP34 False and PROP35 False: If CAC is dialed
1 1 Call is released
1 1 PROP34 True and PROP35 False: CAC will be ignored
1 1 For routing
1 1 PROP34 False and PROP35 True: Call will be
1 1 Rerouted via
1 1 Carrier network
1 1 PROP34 True and PROP35 True: PROP35 has priority
1PROP36 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 36
1 1 Suppression of DAS Announcement for PNS and
1 1 SNP/NTS
1 1 TRUE: PNS or SNP/NTS is active
1 1 FALSE: PNS or SNP/NTS is not active
1PROP37 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 37
1 1 Supply of Location Number
1 1 True: Supply the Location Number from ATD
1 1 False: Supply the Location Number from VLR number
1PROP38 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 38

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 15+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1 1 Other Party Long_Number in MOC Record


1 1 True: Write "rerouted number" (from SCP) as other
1 1 party long number in MOC Record
1 1 False: Write "dialled number" as other party long
1 1 number in MOC Record
1PROP39 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 39
1RCNCLI 1 REL. CALL IF NO CLI RETRIEVED
1 1 Prerequisites:
1 1 - The intercept identifier INANIF must have
1 1 been created by the command CR INC.
1 1
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1SFINH 1 SERVICE FILTERING INHIBITED
>UINCAT W USE IN CATEGORY
Notes:
- If this value is specified the parameter UINCAT
will be initialized.

MOBPROP MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTIES

This parameter specifies the mobile specific properties


related to the Intelligent Network service execution
to be added to the already existing values.
It is divided into common properties (0-23) and
project properties (24-31).
Up to 32 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CFCPPPS CHARGE FREE CALL PHASE FOR PPS


This property is intended Prepaid
Services (PPS). Setting of this property will
inform the SCP, that the actual call phase has
lasted 0 seconds. This means that the call phase
in question is held free of charge.
This behaviour is available for SINAP and CAP
protocol.
TRUE - Actual call phase is held free of charge
FALSE - Actual call phase is not held free of charg
DEFCOMZO DEFAULT COMMON ZONING
If this property is set, zoning with
new digits from SCP is performed for
CAP protocol.
ENHACAP3 ENHANCED TDP3 HANDL. FOR CAP3
Allow ApplyCharging, CallInformationRequest and
RequestReportBCSM. The Camel Ph3 standard
3GPP 23.078 does not allow the operations
ApplyCharging, CallInformationRequest and
RequestReportBCSM for IN-dialogues triggered via
a D-CSI or N-CSI (TriggerDetectionPoint TDP3).
I.e. after reception of a Connect or a Continue
or ContinueWithArgument operation from the
SCP, D-CSI or N-CSI dialogue has to be closed.
Our SSP shall allow the usage of the above
mentioned operations also on a D-CSI or N-CSI
dialogue. Whether these operations are allowed or
not, shall be controllable with this Trigger
Profile Property. This property is checked
only if the CAP Ph3 protocol is used in case of
D-CSI or N-CSI triggered IN dialogues.
TRUE - allow operations
FALSE - inhibit operations
INPASS IN PARALLEL TO MOC ASSIGNMENT
If this property is set, the channel
assignment for MOC and IN-Dialogue are set up in
parallel.
MPROP08 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 8
MPROP09 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 9
MPROP10 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 10
MPROP11 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 11
MPROP12 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 12
MPROP13 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 13
MPROP14 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 14
MPROP15 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 15
MPROP16 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 16

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 16+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MPROP17 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 17


MPROP18 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 18
MPROP19 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 19
MPROP20 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 20
MPROP21 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 21
MPROP22 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 22
MPROP23 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 23
NOEXTPAR NO EXT PARAM SENT BY SSP
If this property is set, the SSP sends
INAP-operations without Extension Parameters.
Notes:
- This property has no influence on Extension
Parameters sent by the SCP.
- If this property is not set, SCCP segmentation
has to be switched on.
PPROP00 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 0
SDDPFC Interworking, supply LOCNO from SCP-Address
in case of MOC:
True: Copy SCP-Address of SDDPFC Interface.
False: Don’t copy.
PPROP01 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 1
PPROP02 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 2
PPROP03 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 3
PPROP04 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 4
PPROP05 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 5
PPROP06 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 6
PPROP07 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 7
SCPNSMSC SEND CLD PTY NO AND SMSC ADDR
The SSP provides the SMS Service Center Address
and Called Party Address for SMS MO Trigger
Feature with CAP Phase 1 to the SCP.
GENPROP = PROP23 determines, which parameters
are used to transmit the addresses.
SUPACMSG SUPPRESS ANSWER/CONNECT MSG
If this property is set, any ANSWER/CONNECT
message for that call section to Calling Party
will be suppressed.
Prerequisites:
- SCP (CAP or SINAP7M+ prot) has to send in OP:CTR
OP:ETC the BothwayThroughConnectIndicator (BTCI)
= NOT_REQUIRED. BTCI is an subparameter of
SIITwo (ServiceInteractionIndicator 2).
SUPCHART SUPPRESS CHARGING TICKET
If this property is set, MOC/CF Charging Ticket
will be suppressed.
Prerequisites:
- SCP (CAP or SINAP7M+ prot) has to send in OP:CTR
OP:ETC the BothwayThroughConnectIndicator (BTCI)
= NOT_REQUIRED. BTCI is an subparameter of
SIITwo (ServiceInteractionIndicator 2).

CMOBPROP CANCEL MOBSPECIFIC PROPERTIES

This parameter specifies the mobile specific properties


related to the Intelligent Network service execution
to be canceled from the already existing values.
It is divided into common properties (0-23)
and project properties (24-31).
Up to 32 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CFCPPPS CHARGE FREE CALL PHASE FOR PPS


This property is intended Prepaid
Services (PPS). Setting of this property will
inform the SCP, that the actual call phase has
lasted 0 seconds. This means that the call phase
in question is held free of charge.
This behaviour is available for SINAP and CAP
protocol.
TRUE - Actual call phase is held free of charge
FALSE - Actual call phase is not held free of charg
DEFCOMZO DEFAULT COMMON ZONING
If this property is set, zoning with
new digits from SCP is performed for
CAP protocol.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 17+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENHACAP3 ENHANCED TDP3 HANDL. FOR CAP3


Allow ApplyCharging, CallInformationRequest and
RequestReportBCSM. The Camel Ph3 standard
3GPP 23.078 does not allow the operations
ApplyCharging, CallInformationRequest and
RequestReportBCSM for IN-dialogues triggered via
a D-CSI or N-CSI (TriggerDetectionPoint TDP3).
I.e. after reception of a Connect or a Continue
or ContinueWithArgument operation from the
SCP, D-CSI or N-CSI dialogue has to be closed.
Our SSP shall allow the usage of the above
mentioned operations also on a D-CSI or N-CSI
dialogue. Whether these operations are allowed or
not, shall be controllable with this Trigger
Profile Property. This property is checked
only if the CAP Ph3 protocol is used in case of
D-CSI or N-CSI triggered IN dialogues.
TRUE - allow operations
FALSE - inhibit operations
INPASS IN PARALLEL TO MOC ASSIGNMENT
If this property is set, the channel
assignment for MOC and IN-Dialogue are set up in
parallel.
MPROP08 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 8
MPROP09 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 9
MPROP10 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 10
MPROP11 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 11
MPROP12 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 12
MPROP13 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 13
MPROP14 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 14
MPROP15 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 15
MPROP16 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 16
MPROP17 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 17
MPROP18 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 18
MPROP19 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 19
MPROP20 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 20
MPROP21 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 21
MPROP22 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 22
MPROP23 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 23
NOEXTPAR NO EXT PARAM SENT BY SSP
If this property is set, the SSP sends
INAP-operations without Extension Parameters.
Notes:
- This property has no influence on Extension
Parameters sent by the SCP.
- If this property is not set, SCCP segmentation
has to be switched on.
PPROP00 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 0
SDDPFC Interworking, supply LOCNO from SCP-Address
in case of MOC:
True: Copy SCP-Address of SDDPFC Interface.
False: Don’t copy.
PPROP01 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 1
PPROP02 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 2
PPROP03 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 3
PPROP04 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 4
PPROP05 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 5
PPROP06 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 6
PPROP07 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 7
SCPNSMSC SEND CLD PTY NO AND SMSC ADDR
The SSP provides the SMS Service Center Address
and Called Party Address for SMS MO Trigger
Feature with CAP Phase 1 to the SCP.
GENPROP = PROP23 determines, which parameters
are used to transmit the addresses.
SUPACMSG SUPPRESS ANSWER/CONNECT MSG
If this property is set, any ANSWER/CONNECT
message for that call section to Calling Party
will be suppressed.
Prerequisites:
- SCP (CAP or SINAP7M+ prot) has to send in OP:CTR
OP:ETC the BothwayThroughConnectIndicator (BTCI)
= NOT_REQUIRED. BTCI is an subparameter of
SIITwo (ServiceInteractionIndicator 2).
SUPCHART SUPPRESS CHARGING TICKET
If this property is set, MOC/CF Charging Ticket
will be suppressed.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 18+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Prerequisites:
- SCP (CAP or SINAP7M+ prot) has to send in OP:CTR
OP:ETC the BothwayThroughConnectIndicator (BTCI)
= NOT_REQUIRED. BTCI is an subparameter of
SIITwo (ServiceInteractionIndicator 2).

EODRAN END OF DIALLING RANGE

This parameter specifies a minimal number of dialled digits


and a maximal number of dialled digits to have a general
end of dialling condition.
This parameter is evaluated only if GENPROP=EODREQ is set.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: MIN=
0...28, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

b: MAX=
0...28, range of decimal numbers

Default: 28

IWRULE INTERWORKING RULE

This parameter is used to control the interworking of IN


with basic network features. The first unit addresses the set
of default values for the Service Interaction Indicator (SII)
to be applied if the SCP did not send any. The second unit
specifies the interaction level which is applied for the
control of the SIIs influence on this interworking
(project specific).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: SERVICE INTERACTION INDICATOR INDEX=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

b: INTERACTION LEVEL=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

RELEASE RELEASE REQUIRED INDICATOR

This parameter specifies a value to decide whether an Intelligent


Network call has to be released in the case that a protocol
abnormality occurs.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N RELEASE NOT REQUIRED


NO RELEASE NOT REQUIRED
Y RELEASE REQUIRED
YES RELEASE REQUIRED

CHGINF DEFAULT CHARGING INFORMATION

This parameter specifies the charging information in case no


information about how to charge an Intelligent Network call
was sent by the partner SCP.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 19+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: CHARGE INFORMATION
NOCHAR NO CHARGE
NOINTV NO INTERVENTION BY IN
REJECT REJECT THE CALL
ZONE CHARGE BY ZONE
unit b is required

b: ZONE NUMBER=
0...511, range of decimal numbers

Compatibilities:
- ZONE is entered for the first unit.

CHGPROF CHARGING PROFILE

This parameter specifies the charging profile that is applied


when an IN service request was detected with an originating
line trigger.
The charging profile determines the billing registration
method and - in the case of metering - the subscriber charge
counters CNTR1 .. CNTR5.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PROF0 PROFILE 0
No billing registration.
PROF1 PROFILE 1
Automatic Message Accounting.
PROF10 PROFILE 10
Metering on charge counters 1&5.
PROF11 PROFILE 11
Metering on charge counters 2&3.
PROF12 PROFILE 12
Metering on charge counters 2&4.
PROF13 PROFILE 13
Metering on charge counters 2&5.
PROF14 PROFILE 14
Metering on charge counters 3&4.
PROF15 PROFILE 15
Metering on charge counters 3&5.
PROF16 PROFILE 16
Metering on charge counters 4&5.
PROF17 PROFILE 17
Metering on charge counters 1&2&3.
PROF18 PROFILE 18
Metering on charge counters 1&2&4.
PROF19 PROFILE 19
Metering on charge counters 1&2&5.
PROF2 PROFILE 2
Metering on charge counter 1.
PROF20 PROFILE 20
Metering on charge counters 1&3&4.
PROF21 PROFILE 21
Metering on charge counters 1&3&5.
PROF22 PROFILE 22
Metering on charge counters 1&4&5.
PROF23 PROFILE 23
Metering on charge counters 2&3&4.
PROF24 PROFILE 24
Metering on charge counters 2&3&5.
PROF25 PROFILE 25
Metering on charge counters 2&4&5.
PROF26 PROFILE 26
Metering on charge counters 3&4&5.
PROF27 PROFILE 27
Metering on charge counters 1&2&3&4.
PROF28 PROFILE 28
Metering on charge counters 1&2&3&5.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 20+


MOD INTRIG
GT
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PROF29 PROFILE 29
Metering on charge counters 1&2&4&5.
PROF3 PROFILE 3
Metering on charge counter 2.
PROF30 PROFILE 30
Metering on charge counters 1&3&4&5.
PROF31 PROFILE 31
Metering on charge counters 2&3&4&5.
PROF32 PROFILE 32
Metering on charge counters 1&2&3&4&5.
PROF4 PROFILE 4
Metering on charge counter 3.
PROF5 PROFILE 5
Metering on charge counter 4.
PROF6 PROFILE 6
Metering on charge counter 5.
PROF7 PROFILE 7
Metering on charge counters 1&2.
PROF8 PROFILE 8
Metering on charge counters 1&3.
PROF9 PROFILE 9
Metering on charge counters 1&4.

CCHGPROF CANCEL CHARGING PROFILE

This parameter specifies if the charging profile shall be


cancelled.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N PROFILE REMAINS UNCHANGED


NO PROFILE REMAINS UNCHANGED
Y CANCEL PROFILE
YES CANCEL PROFILE

DACTINC DEACTIV. SERV. INTERCEPT ID.

This parameter specifies the intercept code selected in case the


Intelligent Network service is in status inactive.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SNA0 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 0


SNA1 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 1
SNA2 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 2
SNA3 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 3
SNA4 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 4

SSFTIMER SSF TIMER

This parameter specifies the time, in which the answer


from SCP/SCF is expected, in steps of 100ms.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...255, range of decimal numbers

Default: 100

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 21+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

PROFILE WITH PHYSICAL SCP ADDRESSING

This input format is to be used to modify a trigger profile with


a SCP address consisting of a destination point code and a
subsystem identifier.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD INTRIG : PRID= <,NETIND= ,NETNAME= ,RTGP= ,DPC= 1
1 1
1 ,IPAVAIL= ,IPSSPCA= ,CIPSSPCA=> [,CGAC=] <,SKEY= 1
1 1
1 ,SSID= ,PROT= ,ACNSEL= ,SSPGT= ,ORTTID= 1
1 1
1 ,ORSSID= ,ORNP= ,ORNA= ,ORGTDIG= ,TRAT= 1
1 1
1 ,INCAT=> [,GENPROP=] [,CGENPROP=] [,MOBPROP=] 1
1 1
1 [,CMOBPROP=] <,EODRAN= ,IWRULE= ,RELEASE= 1
1 1
1 ,CHGINF= ,CHGPROF= ,CCHGPROF= ,DACTINC= 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ,SSFTIMER=> Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PRID PROFILE IDENTIFIER

This parameter specifies the name of the trigger profile to be


modified. Since the service logic may be distributed on several
Service Control Points, for one service different trigger
profiles may be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...6 characters from the


symbolic name character set

NETIND NETWORK INDICATOR

This parameter specifies the network of the SSP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INAT0 INTERNATIONAL NET 0


INAT1 INTERNATIONAL NET 1
NAT0 NATIONAL NET 0
NAT1 NATIONAL NET 1

NETNAME NETWORK NAME

This parameter identifies the signaling network in which


the destination point is existing by its name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

RTGP ROUTING PREFERENCES

This parameter specifies the routing preferences for the


delivery of a SCCP message to the SCP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SPC ROUTE BY SPC AND SSN

DPC DESTINATION POINT CODE

Network Indicator = NAT0 Units = 4-3-4-3

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 22+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Network Indicator = INAT0 Units = 3-8-3


Network Indicator = NAT1 Units = 4-3-4-3
Network Indicator = INAT1 Units = 3-8-3

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: DESTINATION POINT CODE - UNIT 1=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

b: DESTINATION POINT CODE - UNIT 2=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

c: DESTINATION POINT CODE - UNIT 3=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

d: DESTINATION POINT CODE - UNIT 4=


0...16383, range of decimal numbers

IPAVAIL IP AVAILABLE

This parameter indicates whether Intelligent


Peripherie (IP) capabilities are available and
are to be transfered to the SCP.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO IP CAPABILITIES AVAILABLE
NO NO IP CAPABILITIES AVAILABLE
Y IP CAPABILITIES AVAILABLE
YES IP CAPABILITIES AVAILABLE

Default: NO

IPSSPCA IPSSP CAPABILITIES

This parameter indicates the IP capabilities of the SSP


to be added to the already existing values.
Up to 7 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

GENVA GEN. OF VOICE ANN. FROM TEXT


Generation of voice announcements from text
is supported.
IPRAD IP ROUTING ADDRESS SUPPORTED
IP Routing Address is supported.
RES1 RESERVED1
Reserved for future enhancements 1.
RES2 RESERVED2
Reserved for future enhancements 2.
VOICEBA VOICEBACK SUPPORTED
VoiceBack is supported.
VOICESPR VOICE INF. WITH SPEECH RECOGN.
VoiceInformation is supported via speech
recognition.
VOICEVR VOICE INF. WITH VOICE RECOGN.
VoiceInformation is supported via voice
recognition.

CIPSSPCA CANCELED IPSSP CAPABILITIES

This parameter specifies the IP capabilities of the SSP


to be canceled from the existing trigger profile.
Up to 7 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

GENVA GEN. OF VOICE ANN. FROM TEXT


Generation of voice announcements from text
is canceled.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 23+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

IPRAD IP ROUTING ADDRESS CANCELED


IP Routing Address is canceled.
RES1 RESERVED1
Reserved for future enhancements 1.
RES2 RESERVED2
Reserved for future enhancements 2.
VOICEBA VOICEBACK CANCELED
VoiceBack is canceled.
VOICESPR VOICE INF. WITH SPEECH RECOGN.
VoiceInformation is canceled via speech
recognition.
VOICEVR VOICE INF. WITH VOICE RECOGN.
VoiceInformation is canceled via voice
recognition.

CGAC CALL GAP ACCEPTANCE

This parameter specifies whether an operation call gap


from the SCP is accepted or not.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACCG ACCEPT OPERATION CALL GAP


ACSCFID ACCEPT CG WITH SCFID ONLY
CGRES CALL GAP RESERVED
Reserved for future enhancements.
IGNCG IGNORE OPERATION CALL GAP

SKEY SERVICE KEY

This parameter specifies the Intelligent Network service to be


installed on the home exchange. The same service key may occur in
different trigger profiles.

Notes:
The SKEY=0 is used as master key in case of Call Gap. So, if a
trigger profile is entered with SKEY=0 it is not possible to gap
service requests with this service key individually.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

SSID SUBSYSTEM IDENTIFIER

*FUTSS01:

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACC ACCOUNT CARD CALLING


Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
AWC AREA WIDE CENTREX
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
CCC CREDIT CARD CALLING
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
FPH FREEPHONE SERVICE
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01
FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
INMP1 IN APPLICATION 1 ON MP
If a destination point code which specifies a
node containing a SSNC-based Number Portability
Server is entered together with this subsystem
identifier then the LNP (local number portability)

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 24+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

server function on that node (Stand-alone STP or


with EWSD as host) is addressed.
INMP2 IN APPLICATION 2 ON MP
INMP3 IN APPLICATION 3 ON MP
INMP4 IN APPLICATION 4 ON MP
INMP5 IN APPLICATION 5 ON MP
IN2 IN APPLICATION 2
Used for CAP protocols.
IN3 IN APPLICATION 3
Used for national INAP protocols.
IN4 IN APPLICATION 4
Used for number portability.
IN5 IN APPLICATION 5
PN PERSONAL NUMBER
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
TIS TELEINFO SERVICE
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
TV TELEVOTING
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
UN UNIVERSAL NUMBER
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
UPT UNIV PERSONAL TELECOMMUNICAT
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
VPN VIRTUAL PRIVATE NETWORKS
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

PROT PROTOCOL TYPE

This parameter specifies the type of the Intelligent Network


application protocol the service execution is based on.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CS1 CS1 CONFORM INAP


CS2 CS2 CONFORM INAP
PROT4 PROTOCOL TYPE 4
SINAP1 SIEMENS INAP 1
Compatibilities:
- SKEY = 1..8.

ACNSEL APPLIC. CONTEXT NAME SELECTOR

ACNSEL=3 : SINAP5M
ACNSEL=5 : SINAP5M+
ACNSEL=6 : SINAP5M++
ACNSEL=7 : 163TR78
ACNSEL=8 : TINAP2001
ACNSEL=10: CAP Version 1
ACNSEL=11: CAP Version 2
ACNSEL=12: CAP Version 3
ACNSEL=13: CAP Version 3 SMS-MO
ACNSEL=14: SINAP7M
ACNSEL=15: SINAP7M+
ACNSEL=20: SINAP6NP

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...31, range of decimal numbers

SSPGT SSP GT REQUIRED

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N SSP GLOBAL TITLE NOT REQUIRED


NO SSP GLOBAL TITLE NOT REQUIRED
Y SSP GLOBAL TITLE REQUIRED
YES SSP GLOBAL TITLE REQUIRED

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 25+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ORTTID ORIG. TRANSLATION TYPE ID.

This parameter specifies the translation type identifier of the


global title of the SSP.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CCV CREDIT CARD VERIFICATION


IEESS ISDN END-TO-END SUPPL. SERV.
IMSI INTERNATIONAL MOBILE SUB. ID.
ITCC INT. TELECOMM. CHARGE CARD
SMS SHORT MESSAGE SERVICE
TT10 TRANSLATION TYPE 10
TT11 TRANSLATION TYPE 11
TT12 TRANSLATION TYPE 12
TT13 TRANSLATION TYPE 13
TT14 TRANSLATION TYPE 14
TT15 TRANSLATION TYPE 15
TT9 TRANSLATION TYPE 9
UNKNOWN TRANSLATION TYPE UNKNOWN

ORSSID ORIGINATOR SUBSYSTEM ID.

This parameter specifies the subsystem identifier of the IN application


part on the SSP as part of the calling party address. It depends on the
entered protocol type.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

FUTSS01 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 01


FUTSS02 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 02
FUTSS03 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 03
FUTSS04 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 04
FUTSS05 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 05
FUTSS06 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 06
FUTSS07 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 07
FUTSS08 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 08
FUTSS09 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 09
FUTSS10 FUTURE SUBSYSTEM 10
IN IN APPLICATION IN SSP
Compatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.
IN2 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 2
IN3 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 3
IN4 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 4
IN5 IN APPLICATION IN SSP 5

ORNP ORIGINATOR NUMBERING PLAN

This parameter specifies the numbering plan of the global


title of the SSP.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DATANP DATA NUMBERING PLAN


ISDNMNP ISDN MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
ISDNTNP ISDN TELEPHONY NUMB. PLAN
LMNP LAND MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
MMNP MARITIME MOBILE NUMB. PLAN
NP10 NUMBERING PLAN 10
NP11 NUMBERING PLAN 11
NP12 NUMBERING PLAN 12
NP13 NUMBERING PLAN 13
NP15 NUMBERING PLAN 15
NP2 NUMBERING PLAN 2
NP8 NUMBERING PLAN 8
NP9 NUMBERING PLAN 9
PNP PRIVATE NUMBERING PLAN

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 26+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TELEXNP TELEX NUMBERING PLAN


UNKNOWN NUMB. PLAN UNKNOWN

ORNA ORIGINATOR NATURE OF ADDRESS

This parameter specifies the nature of address of the global


title of the SSP.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

INTNO INTERNATIONAL NUMBER


NATNO NATIONAL SIGNIFICANT NUMBER
NATUSE RESERVED FOR NATIONAL USE
NA10 NATURE OF ADDRESS 10
NA11 NATURE OF ADDRESS 11
NA12 NATURE OF ADDRESS 12
NA13 NATURE OF ADDRESS 13
NA14 NATURE OF ADDRESS 14
NA15 NATURE OF ADDRESS 15
NA5 NATURE OF ADDRESS 5
NA6 NATURE OF ADDRESS 6
NA7 NATURE OF ADDRESS 7
NA8 NATURE OF ADDRESS 8
NA9 NATURE OF ADDRESS 9
SUBNO SUBSCRIBER NUMBER
UNKNOWN NATURE OF ADDRESS UNKNOWN

ORGTDIG ORIG. GLOBAL TITLE DIGITS

This parameter specifies the digits of the global title in the calling
party address of the SSP. The digits can be input in a structured
format.

Compatibilities:
- SSPGT = YES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b[-c]]

a: GT DIGITS FIRST PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

b: GT DIGITS SECOND PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

c: GT DIGITS THIRD PART=


1...8 digit hexadecimal number where B is
interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

TRAT TRAFFIC TYPE

This parameter specifies a traffic type assigned to the Intelligent


Network service in the trigger profile. The traffic type is
evaluated after detection of an IN trigger.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...7 characters from the


symbolic name character set

INCAT IN CATEGORY

This parameter specifies branch categories for the digit translation.

Compatibilities:
- GENPROP=UINCAT.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 27+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CAT11 CATEGORY 11
own mobile subscriber
CAT12 CATEGORY 12
foreign mobile subscriber
CAT13 CATEGORY 13
fixed mobile subscriber
CAT14 CATEGORY 14
CAT15 CATEGORY 15
COINB COIN BOX
DATAINAT DATA XMISSION INTERNATIONAL
DATRANS DATA XMISSION NATIONAL
OPOS OPERATOR’S POSITION
OPOSINAT OPERATOR’S POS. INTERNATIONAL
SUBINAT ORDINARY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBORD ORDINARY SUBSCRIBER
SUBPINAT PRIORITY SUB INTERNATIONAL
SUBPRIOR PRIORITY SUBSCRIBER
TESTEQ TEST EQUIPMENT

This unit specifies the category for which the destination is


addressed.

GENPROP GENERAL PROPERTIES

This parameter specifies the general properties related to the


Intelligent Network service execution to be added to the already
existing values.
Up to 40 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

XADPBIN = ABBREV. DIALLING PROC. BY IN


1CLIREQ 1 CALLING LINE ID. REQUESTED
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1CONINH 1 CONGESTION CONTROL INHIBITED
1DPINH 1 DETECTION POINTS INHIBITED
1 1 The activation of internal detection points is
1 1 not allowed for the current service key. This
1 1 property is only relevant for the execution of
1 1 special services, e.g. international calls.
1 1
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1ENACPH 1 ENABLE CALL PARTY HANDLING
1EODREQ 1 END OF DIALLING REQUESTED
1FTALLOW 1 FEATURE TRANSPARENCY ALLOWED
1FTRINH 1 FURTHER TRIGGERING INHIBITED
1 1 Notes:
1 1 - For the protocol type SINAP1 this value
1 1 is set automatically.
1MCIHLD 1 MCI HOLD REQUESTED
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1MCIPRE 1 MALIC. CALL ID. PREP. REQ.
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1MHNCLI 1 MCI HOLD IF NO CLI AVAILABLE
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1ONLCHG 1 ONLINE CHARGING
1PASSBA 1 PASS B PTY CHARGE MSG TO A PTY
1PCNCHG 1 PER CONNECTION CHARGING
1PROP18 1 PROPERTY 18
1 1 PPS Indication. It is evaluated to realize the
1 1 follwowing functionality:
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile indicates a PPS.
1 1 FALSE: In case of interworking between PPS and
1 1 CFNRc (detected after 2nd HLR
1 1 interrogation)
1 1 the T-CSI dialogue will be terminated.
1PROP19 1 PROPERTY 19
1 1 Changing from T-BCSM to O-BCSM

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 28+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1 1 TRUE: Changing the BCSM is allowed.


1 1 FALSE: Changing the BCSM is not allowed.
1PROP20 1 PROPERTY 20
1 1 Identification of the trigger profile TDP12-
1 1 related profile. PROP20 is necessary to
1 1 distinguish between "Basic IN Services" and "IN
1 1 User subscribt Services" because both are triggert
1 1 via digit analysis.
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile corresponds to an user
1 1 subscribed IN-MTC service, i.e. TDP12 is
1 1 send in the OP:IDP to the SCP (mapping of
1 1 TDP3 to TDP12).
1 1 FALSE: else
1PROP21 1 PROPERTY 21
1 1 Cross phase compatibility between MAP- and CAP-
1 1 interface
1 1 TRUE: The protocol version is determined
1 1 according to the CAMEL phase supported on
1 1 the MAP interface.
1 1 FALSE: the protocol version is determined by the
1 1 ACN selector (parameter ACNSEL).
1PROP22 1 PROPERTY 22
1 1 Fall Back to Basic SMS MO
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile is used for SMS MO
1 1 and MOC.
1 1 FALSE: The trigger profile used for MOC only.
1PROP23 1 PROPERTY 23
1 1
1 1 Usage of CdPA or SMSC-address in Op:I_DP for SMS
1 1 MO
1 1 TRUE: the InitialDP for SMS MO contains the SMSC-
1 1 address as Called Party Address.
1 1 FALSE: the InitialDP for SMS MO contains the SMS
1 1 receiver address as Called Party Address.
1 1 (This property to be used with only if
1 1 PROP22 together)
1PROP24 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 24
1 1 Control of ticket generation
1 1 TRUE: Tickets should not be generated.
1 1 FALSE: Tickets should be generated.
1PROP25 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 25
1 1 Prefixing of CdPA with CAC digits
1 1 TRUE: The digits received from A-side GP shall be
1 1 Prefixed with the received CAC (if any) and
1 1 the appropiate prefix for CAC dialing
1 1 FALSE: The digits received from A-side GP are send
1 1 unchanged in the C:IN_DATA to the BSSAP
1PROP26 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 26
1 1 Using of default zoning
1 1 TRUE: The ZONDA is called with the received
1 1 Digits to determine the charging zone or a
1 1 No charge indication (but not to overwrite
1 1 The AMA parameter)
1 1 False: The default zone from trigger profile
1 1 Is set in the CPB as local zoning result or
1 1 Chargefree indication is evaluated.
1PROP27 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 27
1 1
1 1 Interworking IN/CAMEL with CF
1 1 True: The interworking of CF with IN/CAMEL is
1 1 Allowed.
1 1 False: The interworking of CF with IN/CAMEL is
1 1 Not allowed.
1 1 The network provider can support the interworking
1 1 of CF with IN MOC service by setting General
1 1 Property 27 in the trigger profile of the IN MOC
1 1 service.
1PROP28 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 28
1 1 Fallback from CAP Ph3, CAP PH2 to CAP Ph1
1 1 TRUE: The AC negotioation on the CAP interface is
1 1 supported.
1 1 FALSE: AC negotiation on the CAP interface is not
1 1 possible.
1PROP29 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 29
1 1 Identification of the trigger profile as TDP2-
1 1 related profile
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile corresponds to an user

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 29+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1 1 subscribt IN-MOC service, i.e TDP2 is send


1 1 in the OP:IDP to the SCP
1 1 FALSE: else
1 1 PROP29 is necessary for Overlay networks as it is
1 1 not possible to distinguish between "Basic IN-
1 1 Services" and "IN User Subscribed Services".
1PROP30 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 30
1 1 GSM-BC or ISDN-BC in Op:I_DP
1 1 TRUE: The ISUP Bearer Capability (BC) is used in
1 1 Op:Initial_DP.
1 1 FALSE: The GSM BC is used.
1PROP31 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 31
1 1 Ticket control by suppression of ticket generation
1 1 TRUE: The SCP is allowed to suppress ticket
1 1 generation by sending "SuppressCITicket" in
1 1 The OP:SendChargingInfo
1 1 FALSE: else
1PROP32 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 32
1 1 CAMEL Overlay. Possibility to to administrate a
1 1 prefix with MML CR INTRIG parameter CDAPRFX.
1 1 TRUE: (and CDPAPFX not empty) IN handling is
1 1 stopped, CAMEL relevant data is reset and a
1 1 digit anlaysis with the prefixed Called
1 1 Party Number is started
1 1 FALSE: Continiue normal IN handling
1PROP33 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 33
1 1 Mapping of Calling Party Number
1 1 True: Mapping of Calling Party Number from INAP
1 1 OP:CONNECT to Calling Party Number ISUP o/g
1 1 IAM (only valid for ISUP-LTG)
1 1 False: Mapping of Calling Party Number from INAP
1 1 OP:CONNECT to Generic Number (additional
1 1 Calling number) in ISUP o/g IAM
1PROP34 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 34
1 1 CAC Handling for Prepaid Subscribers
1 1 (see PROP35)
1PROP35 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 35
1 1 CAC Handling for Prepaid Subscribers
1 1 PROP34 False and PROP35 False: If CAC is dialed
1 1 Call is released
1 1 PROP34 True and PROP35 False: CAC will be ignored
1 1 For routing
1 1 PROP34 False and PROP35 True: Call will be
1 1 Rerouted via
1 1 Carrier network
1 1 PROP34 True and PROP35 True: PROP35 has priority
1PROP36 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 36
1 1 Suppression of DAS Announcement for PNS and
1 1 SNP/NTS
1 1 TRUE: PNS or SNP/NTS is active
1 1 FALSE: PNS or SNP/NTS is not active
1PROP37 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 37
1 1 Supply of Location Number
1 1 True: Supply the Location Number from ATD
1 1 False: Supply the Location Number from VLR number
1PROP38 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 38
1 1 Other Party Long_Number in MOC Record
1 1 True: Write "rerouted number" (from SCP) as other
1 1 party long number in MOC Record
1 1 False: Write "dialled number" as other party long
1 1 number in MOC Record
1PROP39 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 39
1RCNCLI 1 REL. CALL IF NO CLI RETRIEVED
1 1 Prerequisites:
1 1 - The intercept identifier INANIF must have
1 1 been created by the command CR INC.
1 1
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1SFINH 1 SERVICE FILTERING INHIBITED
>UINCAT W USE IN CATEGORY
Compatibilities:
- INCAT must be specified.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 30+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CGENPROP CANCELED GENERAL PROPERTIES

This parameter specifies the general properties related to the


Intelligent Network service execution to be canceled from the
existing trigger profile.
Up to 40 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

XADPBIN = ABBREV. DIALLING PROC. BY IN


1CLIREQ 1 CALLING LINE ID. REQUESTED
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1CONINH 1 CONGESTION CONTROL INHIBITED
1DPINH 1 DETECTION POINTS INHIBITED
1 1 The activation of internal detection points is
1 1 not allowed for the current service key. This
1 1 property is only relevant for the execution of
1 1 special services, e.g. international calls.
1 1
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1ENACPH 1 ENABLE CALL PARTY HANDLING
1EODREQ 1 END OF DIALLING REQUESTED
1FTALLOW 1 FEATURE TRANSPARENCY ALLOWED
1FTRINH 1 FURTHER TRIGGERING INHIBITED
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - FTRINH = FTRINH.
1MCIHLD 1 MCI HOLD REQUESTED
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1MCIPRE 1 MALIC. CALL ID. PREP. REQ.
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1MHNCLI 1 MCI HOLD IF NO CLI AVAILABLE
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1ONLCHG 1 ONLINE CHARGING
1PASSBA 1 PASS B PTY CHARGE MSG TO A PTY
1PCNCHG 1 PER CONNECTION CHARGING
1PROP18 1 PROPERTY 18
1 1 PPS Indication. It is evaluated to realize the
1 1 follwowing functionality:
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile indicates a PPS.
1 1 FALSE: In case of interworking between PPS and
1 1 CFNRc (detected after 2nd HLR
1 1 interrogation)
1 1 the T-CSI dialogue will be terminated.
1PROP19 1 PROPERTY 19
1 1 Changing from T-BCSM to O-BCSM
1 1 TRUE: Changing the BCSM is allowed.
1 1 FALSE: Changing the BCSM is not allowed.
1PROP20 1 PROPERTY 20
1 1 Identification of the trigger profile TDP12-
1 1 related profile. PROP20 is necessary to
1 1 distinguish between "Basic IN Services" and "IN
1 1 User subscribt Services" because both are triggert
1 1 via digit analysis.
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile corresponds to an user
1 1 subscribed IN-MTC service, i.e. TDP12 is
1 1 send in the OP:IDP to the SCP (mapping of
1 1 TDP3 to TDP12).
1 1 FALSE: else
1PROP21 1 PROPERTY 21
1 1 Cross phase compatibility between MAP- and CAP-
1 1 interface
1 1 TRUE: The protocol version is determined
1 1 according to the CAMEL phase supported on
1 1 the MAP interface.
1 1 FALSE: the protocol version is determined by the
1 1 ACN selector (parameter ACNSEL).
1PROP22 1 PROPERTY 22
1 1 Fall Back to Basic SMS MO
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile is used for SMS MO
1 1 and MOC.
1 1 FALSE: The trigger profile used for MOC only.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 31+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1PROP23 1 PROPERTY 23
1 1
1 1 Usage of CdPA or SMSC-address in Op:I_DP for SMS
1 1 MO
1 1 TRUE: the InitialDP for SMS MO contains the SMSC-
1 1 address as Called Party Address.
1 1 FALSE: the InitialDP for SMS MO contains the SMS
1 1 receiver address as Called Party Address.
1 1 (This property to be used with only if
1 1 PROP22 together)
1PROP24 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 24
1 1 Control of ticket generation
1 1 TRUE: Tickets should not be generated.
1 1 FALSE: Tickets should be generated.
1PROP25 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 25
1 1 Prefixing of CdPA with CAC digits
1 1 TRUE: The digits received from A-side GP shall be
1 1 Prefixed with the received CAC (if any) and
1 1 the appropiate prefix for CAC dialing
1 1 FALSE: The digits received from A-side GP are send
1 1 unchanged in the C:IN_DATA to the BSSAP
1PROP26 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 26
1 1 Using of default zoning
1 1 TRUE: The ZONDA is called with the received
1 1 Digits to determine the charging zone or a
1 1 No charge indication (but not to overwrite
1 1 The AMA parameter)
1 1 False: The default zone from trigger profile
1 1 Is set in the CPB as local zoning result or
1 1 Chargefree indication is evaluated.
1PROP27 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 27
1 1
1 1 Interworking IN/CAMEL with CF
1 1 True: The interworking of CF with IN/CAMEL is
1 1 Allowed.
1 1 False: The interworking of CF with IN/CAMEL is
1 1 Not allowed.
1 1 The network provider can support the interworking
1 1 of CF with IN MOC service by setting General
1 1 Property 27 in the trigger profile of the IN MOC
1 1 service.
1PROP28 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 28
1 1 Fallback from CAP Ph3, CAP PH2 to CAP Ph1
1 1 TRUE: The AC negotioation on the CAP interface is
1 1 supported.
1 1 FALSE: AC negotiation on the CAP interface is not
1 1 possible.
1PROP29 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 29
1 1 Identification of the trigger profile as TDP2-
1 1 related profile
1 1 TRUE: The trigger profile corresponds to an user
1 1 subscribt IN-MOC service, i.e TDP2 is send
1 1 in the OP:IDP to the SCP
1 1 FALSE: else
1 1 PROP29 is necessary for Overlay networks as it is
1 1 not possible to distinguish between "Basic IN-
1 1 Services" and "IN User Subscribed Services".
1PROP30 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 30
1 1 GSM-BC or ISDN-BC in Op:I_DP
1 1 TRUE: The ISUP Bearer Capability (BC) is used in
1 1 Op:Initial_DP.
1 1 FALSE: The GSM BC is used.
1PROP31 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 31
1 1 Ticket control by suppression of ticket generation
1 1 TRUE: The SCP is allowed to suppress ticket
1 1 generation by sending "SuppressCITicket" in
1 1 The OP:SendChargingInfo
1 1 FALSE: else
1PROP32 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 32
1 1 CAMEL Overlay. Possibility to to administrate a
1 1 prefix with MML CR INTRIG parameter CDAPRFX.
1 1 TRUE: (and CDPAPFX not empty) IN handling is
1 1 stopped, CAMEL relevant data is reset and a
1 1 digit anlaysis with the prefixed Called
1 1 Party Number is started
1 1 FALSE: Continiue normal IN handling
1PROP33 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 33

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 32+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1 1 Mapping of Calling Party Number


1 1 True: Mapping of Calling Party Number from INAP
1 1 OP:CONNECT to Calling Party Number ISUP o/g
1 1 IAM (only valid for ISUP-LTG)
1 1 False: Mapping of Calling Party Number from INAP
1 1 OP:CONNECT to Generic Number (additional
1 1 Calling number) in ISUP o/g IAM
1PROP34 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 34
1 1 CAC Handling for Prepaid Subscribers
1 1 (see PROP35)
1PROP35 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 35
1 1 CAC Handling for Prepaid Subscribers
1 1 PROP34 False and PROP35 False: If CAC is dialed
1 1 Call is released
1 1 PROP34 True and PROP35 False: CAC will be ignored
1 1 For routing
1 1 PROP34 False and PROP35 True: Call will be
1 1 Rerouted via
1 1 Carrier network
1 1 PROP34 True and PROP35 True: PROP35 has priority
1PROP36 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 36
1 1 Suppression of DAS Announcement for PNS and
1 1 SNP/NTS
1 1 TRUE: PNS or SNP/NTS is active
1 1 FALSE: PNS or SNP/NTS is not active
1PROP37 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 37
1 1 Supply of Location Number
1 1 True: Supply the Location Number from ATD
1 1 False: Supply the Location Number from VLR number
1PROP38 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 38
1 1 Other Party Long_Number in MOC Record
1 1 True: Write "rerouted number" (from SCP) as other
1 1 party long number in MOC Record
1 1 False: Write "dialled number" as other party long
1 1 number in MOC Record
1PROP39 1 SPECIAL PROPERTY 39
1RCNCLI 1 REL. CALL IF NO CLI RETRIEVED
1 1 Prerequisites:
1 1 - The intercept identifier INANIF must have
1 1 been created by the command CR INC.
1 1
1 1 Incompatibilities:
1 1 - PROT = SINAP1.
1SFINH 1 SERVICE FILTERING INHIBITED
>UINCAT W USE IN CATEGORY
Notes:
- If this value is specified the parameter UINCAT
will be initialized.

MOBPROP MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTIES

This parameter specifies the mobile specific properties


related to the Intelligent Network service execution
to be added to the already existing values.
It is divided into common properties (0-23) and
project properties (24-31).
Up to 32 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CFCPPPS CHARGE FREE CALL PHASE FOR PPS


This property is intended Prepaid
Services (PPS). Setting of this property will
inform the SCP, that the actual call phase has
lasted 0 seconds. This means that the call phase
in question is held free of charge.
This behaviour is available for SINAP and CAP
protocol.
TRUE - Actual call phase is held free of charge
FALSE - Actual call phase is not held free of charg
DEFCOMZO DEFAULT COMMON ZONING
If this property is set, zoning with
new digits from SCP is performed for
CAP protocol.
ENHACAP3 ENHANCED TDP3 HANDL. FOR CAP3
Allow ApplyCharging, CallInformationRequest and

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 33+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RequestReportBCSM. The Camel Ph3 standard


3GPP 23.078 does not allow the operations
ApplyCharging, CallInformationRequest and
RequestReportBCSM for IN-dialogues triggered via
a D-CSI or N-CSI (TriggerDetectionPoint TDP3).
I.e. after reception of a Connect or a Continue
or ContinueWithArgument operation from the
SCP, D-CSI or N-CSI dialogue has to be closed.
Our SSP shall allow the usage of the above
mentioned operations also on a D-CSI or N-CSI
dialogue. Whether these operations are allowed or
not, shall be controllable with this Trigger
Profile Property. This property is checked
only if the CAP Ph3 protocol is used in case of
D-CSI or N-CSI triggered IN dialogues.
TRUE - allow operations
FALSE - inhibit operations
INPASS IN PARALLEL TO MOC ASSIGNMENT
If this property is set, the channel
assignment for MOC and IN-Dialogue are set up in
parallel.
MPROP08 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 8
MPROP09 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 9
MPROP10 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 10
MPROP11 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 11
MPROP12 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 12
MPROP13 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 13
MPROP14 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 14
MPROP15 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 15
MPROP16 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 16
MPROP17 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 17
MPROP18 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 18
MPROP19 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 19
MPROP20 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 20
MPROP21 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 21
MPROP22 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 22
MPROP23 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 23
NOEXTPAR NO EXT PARAM SENT BY SSP
If this property is set, the SSP sends
INAP-operations without Extension Parameters.
Notes:
- This property has no influence on Extension
Parameters sent by the SCP.
- If this property is not set, SCCP segmentation
has to be switched on.
PPROP00 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 0
SDDPFC Interworking, supply LOCNO from SCP-Address
in case of MOC:
True: Copy SCP-Address of SDDPFC Interface.
False: Don’t copy.
PPROP01 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 1
PPROP02 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 2
PPROP03 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 3
PPROP04 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 4
PPROP05 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 5
PPROP06 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 6
PPROP07 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 7
SCPNSMSC SEND CLD PTY NO AND SMSC ADDR
The SSP provides the SMS Service Center Address
and Called Party Address for SMS MO Trigger
Feature with CAP Phase 1 to the SCP.
GENPROP = PROP23 determines, which parameters
are used to transmit the addresses.
SUPACMSG SUPPRESS ANSWER/CONNECT MSG
If this property is set, any ANSWER/CONNECT
message for that call section to Calling Party
will be suppressed.
Prerequisites:
- SCP (CAP or SINAP7M+ prot) has to send in OP:CTR
OP:ETC the BothwayThroughConnectIndicator (BTCI)
= NOT_REQUIRED. BTCI is an subparameter of
SIITwo (ServiceInteractionIndicator 2).
SUPCHART SUPPRESS CHARGING TICKET
If this property is set, MOC/CF Charging Ticket
will be suppressed.
Prerequisites:
- SCP (CAP or SINAP7M+ prot) has to send in OP:CTR

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 34+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

OP:ETC the BothwayThroughConnectIndicator (BTCI)


= NOT_REQUIRED. BTCI is an subparameter of
SIITwo (ServiceInteractionIndicator 2).

CMOBPROP CANCEL MOBSPECIFIC PROPERTIES

This parameter specifies the mobile specific properties


related to the Intelligent Network service execution
to be canceled from the already existing values.
It is divided into common properties (0-23)
and project properties (24-31).
Up to 32 parameter values can be linked with &.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

CFCPPPS CHARGE FREE CALL PHASE FOR PPS


This property is intended Prepaid
Services (PPS). Setting of this property will
inform the SCP, that the actual call phase has
lasted 0 seconds. This means that the call phase
in question is held free of charge.
This behaviour is available for SINAP and CAP
protocol.
TRUE - Actual call phase is held free of charge
FALSE - Actual call phase is not held free of charg
DEFCOMZO DEFAULT COMMON ZONING
If this property is set, zoning with
new digits from SCP is performed for
CAP protocol.
ENHACAP3 ENHANCED TDP3 HANDL. FOR CAP3
Allow ApplyCharging, CallInformationRequest and
RequestReportBCSM. The Camel Ph3 standard
3GPP 23.078 does not allow the operations
ApplyCharging, CallInformationRequest and
RequestReportBCSM for IN-dialogues triggered via
a D-CSI or N-CSI (TriggerDetectionPoint TDP3).
I.e. after reception of a Connect or a Continue
or ContinueWithArgument operation from the
SCP, D-CSI or N-CSI dialogue has to be closed.
Our SSP shall allow the usage of the above
mentioned operations also on a D-CSI or N-CSI
dialogue. Whether these operations are allowed or
not, shall be controllable with this Trigger
Profile Property. This property is checked
only if the CAP Ph3 protocol is used in case of
D-CSI or N-CSI triggered IN dialogues.
TRUE - allow operations
FALSE - inhibit operations
INPASS IN PARALLEL TO MOC ASSIGNMENT
If this property is set, the channel
assignment for MOC and IN-Dialogue are set up in
parallel.
MPROP08 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 8
MPROP09 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 9
MPROP10 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 10
MPROP11 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 11
MPROP12 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 12
MPROP13 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 13
MPROP14 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 14
MPROP15 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 15
MPROP16 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 16
MPROP17 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 17
MPROP18 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 18
MPROP19 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 19
MPROP20 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 20
MPROP21 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 21
MPROP22 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 22
MPROP23 MOBILE SPECIFIC PROPERTY 23
NOEXTPAR NO EXT PARAM SENT BY SSP
If this property is set, the SSP sends
INAP-operations without Extension Parameters.
Notes:
- This property has no influence on Extension
Parameters sent by the SCP.
- If this property is not set, SCCP segmentation
has to be switched on.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 35+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PPROP00 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 0


SDDPFC Interworking, supply LOCNO from SCP-Address
in case of MOC:
True: Copy SCP-Address of SDDPFC Interface.
False: Don’t copy.
PPROP01 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 1
PPROP02 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 2
PPROP03 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 3
PPROP04 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 4
PPROP05 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 5
PPROP06 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 6
PPROP07 MOBILE PROJECT PROPERTY 7
SCPNSMSC SEND CLD PTY NO AND SMSC ADDR
The SSP provides the SMS Service Center Address
and Called Party Address for SMS MO Trigger
Feature with CAP Phase 1 to the SCP.
GENPROP = PROP23 determines, which parameters
are used to transmit the addresses.
SUPACMSG SUPPRESS ANSWER/CONNECT MSG
If this property is set, any ANSWER/CONNECT
message for that call section to Calling Party
will be suppressed.
Prerequisites:
- SCP (CAP or SINAP7M+ prot) has to send in OP:CTR
OP:ETC the BothwayThroughConnectIndicator (BTCI)
= NOT_REQUIRED. BTCI is an subparameter of
SIITwo (ServiceInteractionIndicator 2).
SUPCHART SUPPRESS CHARGING TICKET
If this property is set, MOC/CF Charging Ticket
will be suppressed.
Prerequisites:
- SCP (CAP or SINAP7M+ prot) has to send in OP:CTR
OP:ETC the BothwayThroughConnectIndicator (BTCI)
= NOT_REQUIRED. BTCI is an subparameter of
SIITwo (ServiceInteractionIndicator 2).

EODRAN END OF DIALLING RANGE

This parameter specifies a minimal number of dialled digits


and a maximal number of dialled digits to have a general
end of dialling condition.
This parameter is evaluated only if GENPROP=EODREQ is set.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: MIN=
0...28, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

b: MAX=
0...28, range of decimal numbers

Default: 28

IWRULE INTERWORKING RULE

This parameter is used to control the interworking of IN


with basic network features. The first unit addresses the set
of default values for the Service Interaction Indicator (SII)
to be applied if the SCP did not send any. The second unit
specifies the interaction level which is applied for the
control of the SIIs influence on this interworking
(project specific).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: SERVICE INTERACTION INDICATOR INDEX=


0...7, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 36+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: INTERACTION LEVEL=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

Default: 0

RELEASE RELEASE REQUIRED INDICATOR

This parameter specifies a value to decide whether an Intelligent


Network call has to be released in the case that a protocol
abnormality occurs.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N RELEASE NOT REQUIRED


NO RELEASE NOT REQUIRED
Y RELEASE REQUIRED
YES RELEASE REQUIRED

CHGINF DEFAULT CHARGING INFORMATION

This parameter specifies the charging information in case no


information about how to charge an Intelligent Network call
was sent by the partner SCP.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: CHARGE INFORMATION
NOCHAR NO CHARGE
NOINTV NO INTERVENTION BY IN
REJECT REJECT THE CALL
ZONE CHARGE BY ZONE
unit b is required

b: ZONE NUMBER=
0...511, range of decimal numbers

Compatibilities:
- ZONE is entered for the first unit.

CHGPROF CHARGING PROFILE

This parameter specifies the charging profile that is applied


when an IN service request was detected with an originating
line trigger.
The charging profile determines the billing registration
method and - in the case of metering - the subscriber charge
counters CNTR1 .. CNTR5.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PROF0 PROFILE 0
No billing registration.
PROF1 PROFILE 1
Automatic Message Accounting.
PROF10 PROFILE 10
Metering on charge counters 1&5.
PROF11 PROFILE 11
Metering on charge counters 2&3.
PROF12 PROFILE 12
Metering on charge counters 2&4.
PROF13 PROFILE 13
Metering on charge counters 2&5.
PROF14 PROFILE 14
Metering on charge counters 3&4.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 37+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PROF15 PROFILE 15
Metering on charge counters 3&5.
PROF16 PROFILE 16
Metering on charge counters 4&5.
PROF17 PROFILE 17
Metering on charge counters 1&2&3.
PROF18 PROFILE 18
Metering on charge counters 1&2&4.
PROF19 PROFILE 19
Metering on charge counters 1&2&5.
PROF2 PROFILE 2
Metering on charge counter 1.
PROF20 PROFILE 20
Metering on charge counters 1&3&4.
PROF21 PROFILE 21
Metering on charge counters 1&3&5.
PROF22 PROFILE 22
Metering on charge counters 1&4&5.
PROF23 PROFILE 23
Metering on charge counters 2&3&4.
PROF24 PROFILE 24
Metering on charge counters 2&3&5.
PROF25 PROFILE 25
Metering on charge counters 2&4&5.
PROF26 PROFILE 26
Metering on charge counters 3&4&5.
PROF27 PROFILE 27
Metering on charge counters 1&2&3&4.
PROF28 PROFILE 28
Metering on charge counters 1&2&3&5.
PROF29 PROFILE 29
Metering on charge counters 1&2&4&5.
PROF3 PROFILE 3
Metering on charge counter 2.
PROF30 PROFILE 30
Metering on charge counters 1&3&4&5.
PROF31 PROFILE 31
Metering on charge counters 2&3&4&5.
PROF32 PROFILE 32
Metering on charge counters 1&2&3&4&5.
PROF4 PROFILE 4
Metering on charge counter 3.
PROF5 PROFILE 5
Metering on charge counter 4.
PROF6 PROFILE 6
Metering on charge counter 5.
PROF7 PROFILE 7
Metering on charge counters 1&2.
PROF8 PROFILE 8
Metering on charge counters 1&3.
PROF9 PROFILE 9
Metering on charge counters 1&4.

CCHGPROF CANCEL CHARGING PROFILE

This parameter specifies if the charging profile shall be


cancelled.

Incompatibilities:
- PROT = SINAP1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N PROFILE REMAINS UNCHANGED


NO PROFILE REMAINS UNCHANGED
Y CANCEL PROFILE
YES CANCEL PROFILE

DACTINC DEACTIV. SERV. INTERCEPT ID.

This parameter specifies the intercept code selected in case the


Intelligent Network service is in status inactive.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

SNA0 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 0


SNA1 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 1

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 38+


MOD INTRIG
SPC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

SNA2 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 2


SNA3 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 3
SNA4 SERVICE NOT ACTIVE 4

SSFTIMER SSF TIMER

This parameter specifies the time, in which the answer


from SCP/SCF is expected, in steps of 100ms.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...255, range of decimal numbers

Default: 100

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD INTRIG- 39-


TEST IO

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TEST INPUT/OUTPUT SYSTEM

This command tests all input/output processors and O&M equipment


which are active.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 TEST IO : [SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST IO- 1-


CAN IOC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER

This command cancels the input/output controllers IOC-2 and IOC-3.


Prerequisites:
- Both input/output controllers must be PLA.
- All input/output processors must be cancelled first.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN IOC : IOC= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOC INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER

This parameter specifies one of the input/output controllers to be


cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...3, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IOC- 1-


CONF IOC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER

This command configures an input/output controller.

Notes:
- The configuration from ACT to MBL and the configuration from
MBL or UNA to ACT is considered dangerous.
A dialog mask is output. The operating personnel must decide by
entering ’+’ or ’-’ whether the command should be executed.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF IOC : IOC= ,OST= [,DIAG=] [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOC INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER NUMBER

This parameter specifies the input/output controller to be


configured.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

OST OPERATING STATE

This parameter specifies the target operating state.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED
PLA PLANNED

DIAG DIAGNOSIS

This parameter allows diagnosis of the input/output controller


before configuring it from MBL or UNA to ACT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N CONFIGURE WITHOUT DIAGNOSIS


NO CONFIGURE WITHOUT DIAGNOSIS
Y CONFIGURE WITH DIAGNOSIS
YES CONFIGURE WITH DIAGNOSIS

Default: YES

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF IOC- 1-


CR IOC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER

This command creates a second pair of input/output controllers (IOC-2/3).

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR IOC : IOC= ,PBI= ,IOCR= ,PBIR= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOC INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER

This parameter specifies the input/output controller to be created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...3, range of decimal numbers

PBI PHYSICAL BUS INTERFACE NUMBER

This parameter specifies the physical bus interface number of the


input/output controller.
Notes:
- The physical bus interface number depends on the mounting location
of the input/output controller specified by parameter IOC.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...15, range of decimal numbers

IOCR REDUNDANT IOC

This parameter specifies the redundant input/output controller to be


created.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

2...3, range of decimal numbers

PBIR PBI OF REDUNDANT IOC

This parameter specifies the physical bus interface number of the


redundant input/output processor.
Notes:
- The physical bus interface number depends on the mounting location of
the redundant input/output controller specified by parameter IOCR.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...15, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IOC- 1-
DIAG IOC
DIAG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSE INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER

This command initiates single, repeated or permanent diagnostic runs


for an input/output controller.

Prerequisites:
- The input/output controller must be MBL.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DIAG IOC - DIAG SINGLE DIAGNOSIS


2. DIAG IOC - REPDIAG REPEATED DIAGNOSIS

1. Input format

SINGLE DIAGNOSIS

This input initiates a single diagnosis for an input/output controller.


The diagnosis includes a BCMY interface test.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG IOC : IOC= [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOC INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER NUMBER

This parameter specifies the input/output controller to be diagnosed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG IOC- 1+


DIAG IOC
REPDIAG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

REPEATED DIAGNOSIS

This input initiates a repeated or permanent diagnosis for an


input/output controller. The diagnosis does not include a BCMY
interface test.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG IOC : IOC= ,REP= [,INT=] [,STATCS=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOC INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER NUMBER

This parameter specifies the input/output controller to be diagnosed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

REP REPEAT

Valid values are :


2...65535 for repeated diagnosis
PERM for permanent diagnosis with unlimited number
of runs (termination with command STOP JOB)

This parameter specifies the number of diagnostic runs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

INT INTERRUPT DIAGNOSTIC CYCLE

This parameter specifies that a repeated or permanent diagnosis is


interrupted as soon as a fault is detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N CONTINUE IN CASE OF FAULT


NO CONTINUE IN CASE OF FAULT
Y TERMINATE IN CASE OF FAULT
YES TERMINATE IN CASE OF FAULT

Default: NO

STATCS OUTPUT OF STATISTICS

This parameter specifies the interval between statistic outputs


in minutes.

Notes:
- Statistic output can also be requested with the DISP DIAGSTAT
command.

Standard Behavior: no statistic output

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...60, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG IOC- 2-


DISP IOC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER

This command displays all input/output processors attached


to the input/output controller and their associated bus
connection numbers.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IOC : IOC= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOC INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IOC- 1-


TEST IOC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TEST INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER

This command tests an input/output controller.

Prerequisites:
-

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 TEST IOC : [IOC=] [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOC INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER NUMBER

This parameter specifies the input/output controller to be tested.

Notes:
- If the optional unit parameter is omitted, all active input/output
processors are tested.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST IOC- 1-


CAN IOP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This command cancels an input/output processor.

Prerequisites:
-
- All devices on this input/output processor must be cancelled.

Notes:
- IOPUNI-0/1 with the initial loading devices can neither
be created nor cancelled.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN IOP : IOP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOP INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the input/output processor to be cancelled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: IOP TYPE
IOPSCDV IOP FOR OMT/CSC
IOPSCDX IOP FOR CSC
IOPMTD IOP FOR MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE
IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT
IOPMB IOP FOR MESSAGE BUFFER
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES
IOPAUC IOP FOR AUTHENTICATION CENTER

b: IOP NUMBER=
0...43, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IOP- 1-


CONF IOP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This command configures an input/output processor.

Prerequisites:
- The input/output processor must have been created.
- Load file SY.PSW.Tnnn (nnn = load type) must exist
on disk if IOPLAU or IOPUNI is to be entered subsequently.

Notes:
-
A dialog mask is output. The operating personnel must decide by
entering ’+’ or ’-’ whether the command should be executed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF IOP : IOP= ,OST= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOP INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the type and number of the processor


to be configured.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: IOP TYPE
IOPSCDV IOP FOR OMT/CSC
IOPSCDX IOP FOR CSC
IOPMDD IOP FOR MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
IOPMTD IOP FOR MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE
IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT
IOPMB IOP FOR MESSAGE BUFFER
IOPTA IOP FOR TIMER AND ALARM
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES
IOPAUC IOP FOR AUTHENTICATION CENTER

b: IOP NUMBER=
0...43, range of decimal numbers

OST OPERATING STATE

This parameter specifies the target operating state of the input/output


processor.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED
PLA PLANNED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF IOP- 1-


CR IOP
IOPAUC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This command creates a new input/output processor.

This command is normally logged.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR IOP - IOPAUC CREATE IOPAUC


2. CR IOP - IOPLAU CREATE IOPLAU
3. CR IOP - IOPMB CREATE IOPMB
4. CR IOP - IOPUNI CREATE IOPUNI
5. CR IOP - SPEC CREATE IOPMTD,IOPSCDV,IOPSCDX

1. Input format

CREATE IOPAUC

This input creates an input/output processor for


an Authentication Center.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR IOP : IOC= ,BIOC= ,IOP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOC INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER NUMBER

This parameter specifies the input/output controller number


associated with the input/output processor.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

BIOC IOC BUS CONNECTION NUMBER

This parameter assigns the input/output processor to the bus


connection number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

IOP INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the input/output processor connected


to the input/output controller.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: IOP TYPE
IOPAUC IOP FOR AUTHENTICATION CENTER

b: IOP NUMBER=
0,1,2...11, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IOP- 1+
CR IOP
IOPLAU
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

CREATE IOPLAU

This input creates an input/output processor for a link


adaption unit

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR IOP : IOC= ,BIOC= ,IOP= ,IOPR= ,BIOCR= [,LOADTP=] 1
1 1
1 [,LDPRTY=] [,EAI=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOC INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER NUMBER

This parameter specifies the input/output controller number


associated with the input/output processor.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

BIOC IOC BUS CONNECTION NUMBER

This parameter assigns the input/output processor to the bus


connection number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

IOP INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the input/output processor connected


to the input/output controller.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: IOP TYPE
IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT

b: IOP NUMBER=
0,1,2...11, range of decimal numbers

IOPR REDUNDANT IOP

This parameter specifies the number of the redundant input/output


processor for a redundant input/output processor.

Notes:
- This input/output processor must be connected to the redundant
input/output controller specified by the IOC parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: TYPE OF REDUNDANT IOP


IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT

b: NUMBER OF REDUNDANT IOP=


0,1,2...11, range of decimal numbers

BIOCR REDUNDANT B:IOC CONNECTION NO.

This parameter assigns the redundant input/output processor


to the bus connection number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IOP- 2+
CR IOP
IOPLAU
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

0...15, range of decimal numbers

LOADTP LOAD TYPE

This parameter defines the load file name.

Notes:
- The file name ’SY.PSW.TNNN’ is derived from load type ’NNN’.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

100,101,102...120, range of decimal numbers

Default: 100

LDPRTY LOAD PRIORITY

This parameter specifies the load priority.

Notes:
- The load priority specifies the moment during system recovery
(initial start with reloading of the LTGs) at which the IOPLAU
is loaded.
The loading of a high priority IOPLAU delays the start of call
processing.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

HIGH HIGH LOAD PRIORITY


Loading of high priority IOPLAUs
before or during loading of LTGs.
LOW LOW LOAD PRIORITY
Loading of low priority IOPLAUs
after loading of LTGs and start of
call processing.

Default: LOW

EAI EMERGENCY ACTION INTERFACE

This Parameter assigns the functionality "Emergency Action Interface"


to an input/output processor.
Notes:
- Only one pair of IOPLAU can have the EAI ability.
- The IOP for EAI can only be created at the B:IOC number 11
(parameter BIOC) of IOC-0/1.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N NO EAI FUNCTIONALITY
NO NO EAI FUNCTIONALITY
Y EAI FUNCTIONALITY
YES EAI FUNCTIONALITY

Default: NO

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IOP- 3+
CR IOP
IOPMB
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

CREATE IOPMB

This input creates an input/output processor


for a message buffer.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR IOP : IOC= ,BIOC= ,IOP= ,SUBST= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOC INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER NUMBER

This parameter specifies the input/output controller number


associated with the input/output processor.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

BIOC IOC BUS CONNECTION NUMBER

This parameter assigns the input/output processor to the bus


connection number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

IOP INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the input/output processor connected


to the input/output controller.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: IOP TYPE
IOPMB IOP FOR MESSAGE BUFFER

b: IOP NUMBER=
0,1,2...43, range of decimal numbers

SUBST SUBSTITUTE FOR IOP MSG BUFFER

This parameter specifies the substitute input/output processor


for the message buffer.

Notes:
- This parameter must only be specified in connection with this
processor type.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: IOP TYPE
IOPMB IOP FOR MESSAGE BUFFER

b: IOP NUMBER=
0,1,2...43, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IOP- 4+
CR IOP
IOPUNI
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

4. Input format

CREATE IOPUNI

This input creates an input/output processor unified for O&M devices.

Notes:
- IOPUNI-0/1 with the initial loading devices can neither be
created nor be cancelled.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR IOP : IOC= ,BIOC= ,IOP= [,LOADTP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOC INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER NUMBER

This parameter specifies the input/output controller number


associated with the input/output processor.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

BIOC IOC BUS CONNECTION NUMBER

This parameter assigns the input/output processor to the bus


connection number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

IOP INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the input/output processor connected


to the input/output controller.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: IOP TYPE
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES

b: IOP NUMBER=
2,3,4...7, range of decimal numbers

LOADTP LOAD TYPE

This parameter defines the load file name.

Notes:
- The file name ’SY.PSW.TNNN’ is derived from load type ’NNN’.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

121,122,123...140, range of decimal numbers

Default: 121

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IOP- 5+
CR IOP
SPEC
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

5. Input format

CREATE IOPMTD,IOPSCDV,IOPSCDX

This input creates an input/output processor for:


- an OMT/operator terminal
- an operator terminal
- a MTD

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR IOP : IOC= ,BIOC= ,IOP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOC INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER NUMBER

This parameter specifies the input/output controller number


associated with the input/output processor.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

BIOC IOC BUS CONNECTION NUMBER

This parameter assigns the input/output processor to the bus


connection number.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...15, range of decimal numbers

IOP INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the input/output processor connected


to the input/output controller.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: IOP TYPE
IOPMTD IOP FOR MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE
IOPSCDV IOP FOR OMT/CSC
IOPSCDX IOP FOR CSC

b: IOP NUMBER=
0,1,2...5, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IOP- 6-
DIAG IOP
DIAG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSE INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This command initiates single, repeated or permanent diagnostic runs


for an input/output processor.

Prerequisites:

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DIAG IOP - DIAG SINGLE DIAGNOSIS


2. DIAG IOP - REPDIAG REPEATED DIAGNOSIS

1. Input format

SINGLE DIAGNOSIS

This input initiates a single diagnosis for an input/output processor.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG IOP : IOP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOP INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the input/output processor to be diagnosed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: IOP TYPE
IOPAUC IOP FOR AUTHENTICATION CENTER
IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT
IOPMB IOP FOR MESSAGE BUFFER
IOPMDD IOP FOR MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
IOPMTD IOP FOR MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE
Prerequisites:
- An initialized tape with a file protection ring
must be inserted in the magnetic tape device.
IOPSCDV IOP FOR OMT/CSC
IOPSCDX IOP FOR CSC
IOPTA IOP FOR TIMER AND ALARM
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES

b: IOP NUMBER=
0...43, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG IOP- 1+


DIAG IOP
REPDIAG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

REPEATED DIAGNOSIS

This input initiates a repeated or permanent diagnosis for an


input/output processor.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG IOP : IOP= ,REP= [,INT=] [,STATCS=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOP INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the input/output processor to be diagnosed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: IOP TYPE
IOPAUC IOP FOR AUTHENTICATION CENTER
IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT
IOPMB IOP FOR MESSAGE BUFFER
IOPMDD IOP FOR MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
IOPMTD IOP FOR MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE
Prerequisites:
- An initialized tape with a file protection ring
must be inserted in the magnetic tape device.
IOPSCDV IOP FOR OMT/CSC
IOPSCDX IOP FOR CSC
IOPTA IOP FOR TIMER AND ALARM
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES

b: IOP NUMBER=
0...43, range of decimal numbers

REP REPEAT

Valid values are :


2...65535 for repeated diagnosis
PERM for permanent diagnosis with unlimited number
of runs (termination with command STOP JOB)

This parameter specifies the number of diagnostic runs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

INT INTERRUPT DIAGNOSTIC CYCLE

This parameter specifies that a repeated or permanent diagnosis is


interrupted as soon as a fault is detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N CONTINUE IN CASE OF FAULT


NO CONTINUE IN CASE OF FAULT
Y TERMINATE IN CASE OF FAULT
YES TERMINATE IN CASE OF FAULT

Default: NO

STATCS OUTPUT OF STATISTICS

This parameter specifies the interval between statistic outputs


in minutes.

Notes:
- If the parameter is omitted there is no statistic output.
- Statistic output can also be requested with the DISP DIAGSTAT

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG IOP- 2+


DIAG IOP
REPDIAG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

command.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...60, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG IOP- 3-


DISP IOP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This command displays the operating state of the specified input/output


processor, the associated input/output controller, the connection number on
the B:IOC, the connected devices and the redundant partner for an IOPMB.
Additional information for IOPLAU: number and operating state of the
link adaption unit, load type and load priority of the IOPLAU and
the number of the redundant input/output processor.
Additional information for IOPUNI: load type and information whether
system or init part of the flash memory is used. During normal operation
code of system part is used. Code of init part is used during hardware
recovery of CP (basic input/output function) or in case of a missing or
destroyed system part.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IOP : IOP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOP INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the input/output processor.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: IOP TYPE
IOPSCDV IOP FOR OMT/CSC
IOPSCDX IOP FOR CSC
IOPMDD IOP FOR MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
IOPMTD IOP FOR MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE
IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT
IOPMB IOP FOR MESSAGE BUFFER
IOPTA IOP FOR TIMER AND ALARM
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES
IOPAUC IOP FOR AUTHENTICATION CENTER

b: IOP NUMBER=
0...43, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IOP- 1-


TEST IOP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TEST INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This command tests one or all input/output processors of one


type.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 TEST IOP : IOP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOP INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSOR

This parameter specifies the input/output processor to be tested.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: IOP TYPE
IOPSCDV IOP FOR OMT/CSC
IOPSCDX IOP FOR CSC
IOPMDD IOP FOR MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
IOPMTD IOP FOR MAGNETIC TAPE DEVICE
IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT
IOPMB IOP FOR MESSAGE BUFFER
IOPTA IOP FOR TIMER AND ALARM
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES
IOPAUC IOP FOR AUTHENTICATION CENTER

b: IOP NUMBER=
0...43, range of decimal numbers

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST IOP- 1-


CONF IOPG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE IOP GROUP

This command configures the input/output processor group belonging to


the specified input/output controller.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF IOPG : IOC= ,OST= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOC INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

OST OPERATING STATE

This parameter specifies the target operating state of the input/output


processor group.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF IOPG- 1-


DIAG IOPG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSE IOP GROUP

This command initiates diagnosis of the input/output processor group


belonging to the specified input/output controller.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG IOPG : IOC= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOC INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG IOPG- 1-


TEST IOPG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TEST IOP GROUP

This command tests an input/output processor group on the specified


input/output controller. All active input/output processors are tested.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 TEST IOPG : IOC= [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IOC INPUT/OUTPUT CONTROLLER NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...3, range of decimal numbers

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST IOPG- 1-


DMP IOPIMDMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DUMP IOP MEMORY IMMEDIATE DUMP

This command supplies a consistent display of memory contents of IOP


platforms or of the corresponding load library on system disk.

If UNIT = DISK is entered, the specified address range to be


dumped will be read from load library.
To dump contents of a platform’s memory, select the appropriate
platform using parameter PLF.

You can specify up to five different address ranges to be dumped.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1PLF= 1 1
1 DMP IOPIMDMP : ZUNIT=Y ,ADDR= [,LENGTH=] [,FORMAT=] ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the IOP platform.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES
IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: IOP NUMBER=
0...43, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the platform number.

UNIT SYSTEM UNIT

This parameter specifies the system unit.


If disk is selected a linear dump of the content of the IOP loadlib
at the specified address range will be performed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

DISK REQUEST READ FROM DISK

ADDR LIST OF ADDRESS RANGES

This parameter defines the address (range) of the memory


content to be dumped.
For dumping a linear memory content, 2 ways of specifying
the address limits of the dump can be used:
either an address range is entered with ADDR,
or, if only the start address is given, you have to specify
the length of the dump using parameter LENGTH.

Following inputs are possible:

- Address is specified relative to a module begin, i.e capsule,


SPU, and module name are entered (8 characters each), plus a

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP IOPIMDMP- 1+


DMP IOPIMDMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

distance within the module


e.g.: ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE0C_0006" or
ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE0C_0006+H’23F"
Offsets are hexadecimal numbers preceded by the letter "H" and a
single quote.
The module version number (underline and 4 digits) may be
omitted.
Notes:
module names have to be entered always in combination with
the corresponding SPU names.

- A symbolic address can be specified by using a symbol name (i.e.


the name of a granted object, length 8 characters):
e.g.: ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE0C_0006.SYMBOLA0+H’12A4"

- Address ranges must be specified by entering the start address


and the upper limit, separated by "&&".
e.g.: ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE0C.SYMBOLA0"&&
"SPU00A0A.MODULE0C.SYMBOLA0+H’F4"

The capsule name has to be entered with the start address only and
must be omitted with the upper limit of the address range.

The upper limit of an address range may be specified in


relation to the lower limit in the following way:
e.g.: ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE0C+H’AF"&&"+H’21"
shorthand for
ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE0C+H’AF"&&
"SPU00A0A.MODULE0C+H’CF"
The second address is interpreted as number of bytes to be dumped if
it begins with the character plus ("+").

- Symbolic addresses can be specified by using labels. A label is


preceded by the letter "L" and a single quote:
e.g.: ADDR="CAPSCA0A.L’LABELBEG+H’476EBF"

- Symbolic address by using the value of an exported symbol (8


characters) as an additional offset:

e.g.: ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE1C_2401.SYMBOLA0
+SPU00A0A.MODULE2P_0101.CONST000" or
ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE1C
+SPU00A0A.MODULE2P.CONST000+H’0FF4"

If both module names are identical, the second one may be


omitted.
e.g.: ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE1C_2401.SYMBOLA0+.CONST000"
instead of
ADDR="CAPSCA0A.SPU00A0A.MODULE1C_2401.SYMBOL
+SPU00A0A.MODULE1C_2401.CONST000".

- Absolute address within capsule in hexadecimal form:


e.g.: ADDR="CAPSCA0A+H’2A476EBF"&&"+H’28"

- Absolute address within a load module in hexadecimal form:


e.g.: ADDR="LDMOD00X+H’10ED04D0"&&"+H’28"

Up to 5 different address ranges may be entered, concatenated by "&".

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

LENGTH LENGTH OF DUMP ELEMENT

This parameter provides the length of a single chained


element of a linked list, or, in case of a linear dump,
the number of bytes which shall be dumped if only a start
address is entered.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...2147483647, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP IOPIMDMP- 2+


DMP IOPIMDMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

FORMAT FORMAT OF OUTPUT

This parameter specifies the format type of the output.


If HEX is chosen an output in hexadecimal form will be
produced, in case of ASCII the output will contain ASCII
characters additionally to the hex output.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

HEX HEXADECIMAL OUTPUT


SYMBOL SYMBOLIC OUTPUT
ASCII ASCII OUTPUT

Default: ASCII

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DMP IOPIMDMP- 3-


ACT IOPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE IOP PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can activate one or more Permanent


Patches in the memory of those platforms indicated under parameter
PLF. Successful execution of the command results in execution
of the atomic action AM (Activate in Memory) in
parallel on all respective platforms in operation.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT IOPPRPCH : ID= [,PLF=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

PLF LIST OF PLATFORMS

This parameter specifies the IOP platform where a Permanent


Patch is to be processed.
If the parameter is omitted the command concerns all
platforms in operation.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES
IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: IOP NUMBER=
0...43, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the IOP number.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IOPPRPCH- 1-


CAN IOPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL IOP PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can cancel one or more Permanent


Patches on disk implicitly deactivating them in the memory on all
platforms in operation. Successful execution of the command
results in execution of the atomic actions DUD
(Deupdate on Disk), DAM (Deactivate in Memory) and CD (Cancel
on Disk).

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN IOPPRPCH : ID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IOPPRPCH- 1-


DACT IOPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE IOP PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can deactivate one or more Permanent


Patches in the memory of those platforms indicated under parameter
PLF. Successful execution of the command results in execution
of the atomic actions DUD (Deupdate on Disk) and
DAM (Deactivate in Memory) in parallel on all respective
platforms in operation.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT IOPPRPCH : ID= [,PLF=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

PLF LIST OF PLATFORMS

This parameter specifies the IOP platform where a Permanent


Patch is to be processed.
If the parameter is omitted the command concerns all
platforms in operation.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES
IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: IOP NUMBER=
0...43, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the IOP number.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT IOPPRPCH- 1-


DISP IOPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IOP PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can display patch data kept in the
patch administration on disk and patch states concerning
Permanent Patches for all platform(s) in operation specified
by parameter PLF.
The patch selection can be performed either by patch identifier(s)
using parameter ID or by logical address ranges affected by
the patches, using parameter ADDR.
In case of using parameter ADDR, the filling levels of the
Patch Area and the Patch Administration are displayed
additionally.
If ID = X is entered, parameter LIB is also required.
To limit the list of patch IDs, it is possible to specify
combinations of following parameters:
BEGDATE, BEGTIME, ENDDATE, ENDTIME and PATSTATE

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1ID= 1 1
1 DISP IOPPRPCH : ZADDR=Y [,PLF=] [,LIB=] [,BEGDATE=] 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 [,BEGTIME=] [,ENDDATE=] [,ENDTIME=] 1
1 1
1 [,PATSTATE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.
It is also possible to use wildcard signs (*) or (?) as part
of the patchname. In this case all patches found within the
specified capsule and fulfilling the wildcard criteria will
be displayed.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname" or
ID="capsname.*" or
ID="capsname.A?CD*EF"

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

10...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

ADDR LIST OF ADDRESS RANGES

This parameter represents an interval in which the search


for patches will be performed. An address can be specified
either in hexadecimal form as an offset from capsule begin or
symbolically.

e.g.: ADDR="capname.address"&&"address" or
ADDR="capname.address"&&"+distance"

where address may have one of the following


structures:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IOPPRPCH- 1+


DISP IOPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

"spuname.modname+offset+distance", or
"spuname.modname.symbol+offset+distance", or
"label+offset+distance", or
"offset+distance", where

capname <text string> = 8 char.,


label L’<text string> = 8 char.,
spuname <text string> = 8 char.,
modname <text string> = 8 char. (or 13 if the
version is included),
symbol <text string> <= 8 char.,
offset <hexadecimal string> <= 8 hex signs,
distance disitem+disitem ..+disitem..,
disitem spuname.modname.symbol or offset

The end address of an interval may be omitted. If it is


omitted in the case of capsule or module the entire address
range of the unit is scanned. If it is omitted in the case of
symbol or offset the search range is that byte only.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

PLF LIST OF PLATFORMS

This parameter specifies the IOP platform where a Permanent


Patch is to be processed.
If the parameter is omitted the command concerns all
platforms in operation.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES
IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: IOP NUMBER=
0...43, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the IOP number.

LIB LIBRARY NAME

This parameter represents the name of the library associated


with the platform to be patched.
If the parameter is omitted, the library specified via
parameter ID is taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

BEGDATE BEGIN DATE

This parameter specifies the begin date of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGTIME,
ENDDATE and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter BEGDATE: 2000:01:01

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IOPPRPCH- 2+


DISP IOPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a: YEAR=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

BEGTIME BEGIN TIME

This parameter specifies the begin time of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
ENDDATE and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter BEGTIME: 00:00:00

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECOND=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

ENDDATE END DATE

This parameter specifies the end date of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
BEGTIME and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter ENDDATE: actual date

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

ENDTIME END TIME

This parameter specifies the end time of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
BEGTIME and ENDDATE.
Default value of parameter ENDTIME: 23:59:59

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IOPPRPCH- 3+


DISP IOPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECOND=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

PATSTATE PATCH STATE

This parameter is used to limit the list of patch IDs


displayed to those patches having the entered PATSTATE.
If this parameter is omitted, every patch will be displayed
regardless of its state in the system.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

NOTENTER NEITHER ENTERING NOR ENTERED


HIT HIT
ENTRG ENTERING
ENTRD ENTERED
NOTUPD OTHER THAN UPDATED
PARTACT PARTLY ACTIVE
ACT ACTIVE
UPD UPDATED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IOPPRPCH- 4-


ENTR IOPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER IOP PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can enter a Permanent Patch into the
patch administration on disk. Successful execution of the
command results in execution of the atomic action ED (Enter on
Disk).
With each ENTR IOPPRPCH command one of the four different
subpatch types can be entered:

- Insert Rucksack Subpatches using parameter INSRADDR


- Replace Subpatches using parameter REPADDR
- Insert Procedure Subpatches using parameter INSPREF
- Insert Variable Subpatches using parameter INSVREF

The subpatch types can be entered in the form of subpatches


belonging to a specified Patch ID. Under one specified Patch ID
subpatches of different types can be inserted into the
system.
For each subpatch of a patch a new ENTR IOPPRPCH command is
necessary.
The completeness of the subpatches is indicated by means of
parameter SUBPCHNO.
All Subpatches with the exception of Insert Variable can be
entered in subpatch parts for each part using an individual
ENTR IOPPRPCH command. All subpatch parts except Insert
Procedure Subpatches are referred to the same patch address.
The concatenation of those subpatch parts is supported by
means of parameter SUBPPART.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,INSRADDR=1 1
1 1,REPADDR= 1 1
1 ENTR IOPPRPCH : ID= Z,INSPREF= Y [,SUBPPART=] [,NEWCNT= 1
1 1,INSVREF= 1 1
1 1,SUBPCHNO=1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 [,OLDCNT=]] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID PATCH IDENTIFIER

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name. Whenever a subpatch or
subpatch part is entered for a certain patch the identifier
must be identical.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

INSRADDR INSERT RUCKSACK SUBPATCH ADDR.

This parameter provides the insert rucksack subpatch


address. The address format is an interval within the
module boundaries in the form of begin address and end
address (linked by &&) whereby the latter may be given as a
distance relative to the begin address. At the begin address
the instruction is replaced by a branch instruction for jumping
to the respective rucksack. The end address serves as
continuation address from which the program will continue
after the rucksack code has been executed.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IOPPRPCH- 1+


ENTR IOPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The old instruction (6 Byte), overwritten by the branch


instruction, is at user’s own risk to add to the rucksack
or not.
An address can be specified either in hexadecimal form as an
offset from capsule begin or symbolically.

e.g.: INSRADDR="spuname.modname.symbol+distance" or
INSRADDR="offset+distance" or
INSRADDR="label+distance",

&&"spuname.modname.symbol+distance" or
&&"label+distance" or
&&"+offset" ,where

label L’<text string> = 8 char.,


spuname <text string> = 8 char.,
modname <text string> = 8 char. (or 13 if the
version is included),
symbol <text string> <= 8 char.,
offset H’<hexadecimal string> <= 8 hex signs,
distance disitem+disitem ..+disitem..,
disitem spuname.modname.symbol or offset

The given address is valid for the capsule denoted within


parameter ID.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

REPADDR REPLACE SUBPATCH ADDRESS

This parameter provides the replace subpatch address. The


address format is a replacement address, where address can
be specified in the same way as described for the first part
of INSRADDR.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

INSPREF INSERT PROCED. SUBPATCH REFER.

This parameter provides the insert procedure subpatch


reference as a mnemonic including the number <n> of the
insert procedure.
The inserted procedure is only visible within the defining
patch. The number <n> serves to address the inserted
procedure within other subpatches of the defining patch.

e.g.: INSPREF="IP’5"

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...6 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

INSVREF INSERT VARIAB. SUBPATCH REFER.

This parameter provides the insert variable subpatch


reference as a mnemonic including the number <n> of the
insert variable and the length of the variable in bytes.
The inserted variable is only visible within the defining
patch.

e.g.: INSVREF="IV’5"-50

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: "INSERT VARIABLE" SUBPATCH REFERENCE=


4...6 characters from the
text string character set, enclosed in "

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IOPPRPCH- 2+


ENTR IOPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This unit serves to address the inserted variable


within other subpatches of the defining patch.

b: LENGTH OF INSERT VARIABLE IN BYTES=


1...4096, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the length of the variable to be


declared.

SUBPCHNO TOTAL NUMBER OF SUBPATCHES

This parameter represents the total number of subpatches


belonging to a Patch ID. A patch must be closed by a final
ENTR IOPPRPCH command with the parameters ID and
SUBPCHNO, whereby the latter one corresponds to the number
of patches, entered under the same ID.
This command causes the transition of the patch state from
ENTRG to ENTRD.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...59, range of decimal numbers

SUBPPART ACTUAL NUMBER OF SUBPATCH PART

This parameter characterizes a part of a subpatch. A subpatch


of a Permanent Patch may, for some reason, have more than one
part in the case of Insert Rucksack Subpatch, Permanent
Replace Subpatch, or Insert Procedure Subpatch.

e.g.: SUBPPART="partcounter-lastsign"

The partcounter denotes the subpatch part sequence number


and serves as concatenation controller.
The lastsign denotes either the last or not last part of a
subpatch.

If SUBPPART is omitted, e.g., typical proceeding in case


of a short subpatch consisting of only one part, the default
value 1-LAST is assumed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a[-b]

a: ACTUAL NUMBER OF SUBPATCH PART TO BE ENTERED=


1...999, range of decimal numbers

This unit denotes the subpatch part sequence number.

b: INDICATOR THAT LAST PART OF SUBPATCH IS ENTERED


NOTLAST NOT LAST SUBPATCH PART
LAST LAST SUBPATCH PART

This unit denotes either last or not last part.

NEWCNT NEW CONTENT OF SUBPATCH

This parameter represents the new instruction code to be


executed instead of the old instruction code which may be
represented by parameter OLDCNT.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

OLDCNT OLD CONTENT AT SUBPATCH LOCAT.

This parameter represents the old instruction code to be


checked for security reasons.
Must not be used for Insert Variable or Insert Procedure
subpatches.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IOPPRPCH- 3+


ENTR IOPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IOPPRPCH- 4-


UPD IOPPRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

UPDATE IOP PERMANENT PATCH

With this command you can update one or more Permanent


Patches on disk, whereby they are implicitly activated in
memory on all active platforms. Successful execution of the
command results in execution of the atomic actions
AM (Activate in Memory) and UD (Update on Disk).

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 UPD IOPPRPCH : ID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 UPD IOPPRPCH- 1-


ACT IOPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ACTIVATE IOP TRANSIENT PATCH

With this command you can activate one or more Transient


Patches in the memory on one platform. Successful execution of
the command results in execution of the atomic action
AM (Activate in Memory) on the respective platform in
operation.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT IOPTRPCH : PLF= ,ID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the IOP platform where a Transient


Patch is to be processed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES
IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: IOP NUMBER=
0...43, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the IOP number.

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT IOPTRPCH- 1-


CAN IOPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL IOP TRANSIENT PATCH

With this command you can cancel one or more Transient


Patches in the memory on one platform by implicitly
deactivating them in the memory on this platform.
Successful execution of the command results in execution of
the atomic actions DAM (Deactivate in Memory) and CM (Cancel
in Memory) on the respective platform in operation.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN IOPTRPCH : PLF= ,ID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the IOP platform where a Transient


Patch is to be processed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES
IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: IOP NUMBER=
0...43, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the IOP number.

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IOPTRPCH- 1-


DACT IOPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DEACTIVATE IOP TRANSIENT PATCH

With this command you can deactivate one or more Transient


Patches in the memory on one platform. Successful execution of
the command results in execution of the atomic action
DAM (Deactivate in Memory) on the respective platform in
operation.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DACT IOPTRPCH : PLF= ,ID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the IOP platform where a Transient


Patch is to be processed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES
IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: IOP NUMBER=
0...43, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the IOP number.

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DACT IOPTRPCH- 1-


DISP IOPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IOP TRANSIENT PATCH

With this command you can display patch data kept in the
patch administration on the individual platform and patch
states concerning Transient Patches for a specified platform in
operation.
The patch selection can be performed either by patch identifier(s)
using parameter ID or by logical address ranges affected by
the patches, using parameter ADDR.
In case of using parameter ADDR, the filling levels of the
Patch Area and the Patch Administration are displayed
additionally.
If ID = X is entered, parameter LIB is also required.
To limit the list of patch IDs, it is possible to specify
combinations of following parameters:
BEGDATE, BEGTIME, ENDDATE, ENDTIME and PATSTATE

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,ID= 1 1
1 DISP IOPTRPCH : PLF= Z,ADDR=Y [,LIB=] [,BEGDATE=] [,BEGTIME=] 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
1 [,ENDDATE=] [,ENDTIME=] [,PATSTATE=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the IOP platform where a Transient


Patch is to be processed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES
IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: IOP NUMBER=
0...43, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the IOP number.

ID LIST OF PATCH IDENTIFIERS

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name.
It is also possible to use wildcard signs (*) or (?) as part
of the patchname. In this case all patches found within the
specified capsule and fulfilling the wildcard criteria will
be displayed.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname" or
ID="capsname.*" or
ID="capsname.A?CD*EF"

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IOPTRPCH- 1+


DISP IOPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

10...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

ADDR LIST OF ADDRESS RANGES

This parameter represents an interval in which the search


for patches will be performed. An address can be specified
either in hexadecimal form as an offset from capsule begin or
symbolically.

e.g.: ADDR="capname.address"&&"address" or
ADDR="capname.address"&&"+distance"

where address may have one of the following


structures:

"spuname.modname+offset+distance", or
"spuname.modname.symbol+offset+distance", or
"label+offset+distance", or
"offset+distance", where

capname <text string> = 8 char.,


label L’<text string> = 8 char.,
spuname <text string> = 8 char.,
modname <text string> = 8 char. (or 13 if the
version is included),
symbol <text string> <= 8 char.,
offset <hexadecimal string> <= 8 hex signs,
distance disitem+disitem ..+disitem..,
disitem spuname.modname.symbol or offset

The end address of an interval may be omitted. If it is


omitted in the case of capsule or module the entire address
range of the unit is scanned. If it is omitted in the case of
symbol or offset the search range is that byte only.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.
Multiple values and/or ranges can be linked with &.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

LIB LIBRARY NAME

This parameter represents the name of the library associated


with the platform to be patched.
If the parameter is omitted, the library specified via
parameter ID is taken.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...32 characters from the


symbolic name character set

BEGDATE BEGIN DATE

This parameter specifies the begin date of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGTIME,
ENDDATE and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter BEGDATE: 2000:01:01

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IOPTRPCH- 2+


DISP IOPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

BEGTIME BEGIN TIME

This parameter specifies the begin time of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
ENDDATE and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter BEGTIME: 00:00:00

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECOND=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

ENDDATE END DATE

This parameter specifies the end date of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
BEGTIME and ENDTIME.
Default value of parameter ENDDATE: actual date

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...9999, range of decimal numbers

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

ENDTIME END TIME

This parameter specifies the end time of the display interval,


i.e., the time period for which patch data are to be displayed.
Notes:
- This parameter can be used in combination with BEGDATE,
BEGTIME and ENDDATE.
Default value of parameter ENDTIME: 23:59:59

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

a: HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

b: MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

c: SECOND=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IOPTRPCH- 3+


DISP IOPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

PATSTATE PATCH STATE

This parameter is used to limit the list of patch IDs


displayed to those patches having the entered PATSTATE.
If this parameter is omitted, every patch will be displayed
regardless of its state in the system.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ENTRG ENTERING
ENTRD ENTERED
ACT ACTIVE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IOPTRPCH- 4-


ENTR IOPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER IOP TRANSIENT PATCH

With this command you can enter a Transient Patch into the
patch administration on a platform.
Successful execution of the command results in execution
of the atomic action EM (Enter into Memory) on the
respective platform in operation.
With each ENTR IOPTRPCH command the subpatch type Replace
Subpatch can be entered by using parameter REPADDR.

The completeness of the subpatches is indicated by means of


parameter SUBPCHNO. For each subpatch of a patch a new
ENTR IOPTRPCH command is necessary.

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ( ) 1
1 1,REPADDR= 1 1
1 ENTR IOPTRPCH : PLF= ,ID= Z,SUBPCHNO=Y [,NEWCNT= [,OLDCNT=]] ; 1
1 1 1 1
1 * + 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PLF PLATFORM NAME

This parameter specifies the IOP platform where a Transient


Patch is to be processed.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: PLATFORM TYPE
IOPUNI IOP UNIFIED FOR O&M DEVICES
IOPLAU IOP FOR LINK ADAPTION UNIT

This unit specifies the platform type.

b: IOP NUMBER=
0...43, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the IOP number.

ID PATCH IDENTIFIER

This parameter serves for the unambiguous identification of


an individual patch at the switch. It is defined by the
capsule name and a patch name. Whenever a subpatch is
entered for a certain patch the identifier must be
identical.

e.g.: ID="capsname.patchname"

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

11...25 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

REPADDR REPLACE SUBPATCH ADDRESS

This parameter provides the replace subpatch address. The


address format is a replacement address.

e.g.: REPADDR="spuname.modname.symbol+distance" or
REPADDR="offset+distance" or
REPADDR="label+distance",

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IOPTRPCH- 1+


ENTR IOPTRPCH

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

label L’<text string> = 8 char.,


spuname <text string> = 8 char.,
modname <text string> = 8 char. (or 13 if the
version is included),
symbol <text string> <= 8 char.,
offset H’<hexadecimal string> <= 8 hex signs,
distance disitem+disitem ..+disitem..,
disitem spuname.modname.symbol or offset

The given address is valid for the capsule denoted within


parameter ID.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

SUBPCHNO TOTAL NUMBER OF SUBPATCHES

This parameter represents the total number of subpatches


belonging to a Patch ID. A patch must be closed by a final
ENTR IOPTRPCH command with the parameters ID and
SUBPCHNO, whereby the latter one corresponds to the number
of patches, entered under the same ID.
This command causes the transition of the patch state from
ENTRG to ENTRD.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...118, range of decimal numbers

NEWCNT NEW CONTENT OF SUBPATCH

This parameter represents the new instruction code to be


executed instead of the old instruction code which may be
represented by parameter OLDCNT.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

OLDCNT OLD CONTENT AT SUBPATCH LOCAT.

This parameter represents the old instruction code to be


checked for security reasons.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...72 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR IOPTRPCH- 2-


CAN IPADR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL AN IP-ADDRESS

This command cancels an IP-address which has been created


by CR IPADR

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN IPADR : ADRNAM= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ADRNAM ADDRESS NAME

This parameter specifies the symbolic name of an IP-address.

Note:
- The first three characters must be ’IPA’.
Any characters can be chosen for the rest of the name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IPADR- 1-


CR IPADR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE AN IP-ADDRESS

This command creates a new IP-address.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR IPADR : ADRNAM= [,IPADR=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ADRNAM ADDRESS NAME

This parameter specifies the symbolic name of an IP-address.

Note:
- The first three characters must be ’IPA’.
Any characters can be chosen for the rest of the name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

IPADR ADDRESS VALUE

This parameter specifies the value of the remote IP-address.

Note:
- The parameter IPADR is defined in that way that either an
IPv4 or an IPv6 value can be entered.
- An IPv4 address has four units : V1-V2-V3-V4, where each
Vx (x=1..4) is defined as a range of 0..255. Always all
four units must be entered.
- For an IPv6 address only the first unit can be entered.
- An IPv6 address consist of 8 components with the following
format : V1&V2&V3&V4&V5&V6&V7&V8 where each Vx (x=1..8) is
defined as a range of 0..FFFF. Always all eight components
must be entered.
- In case of a local IP address no IPADR can be entered.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: ADDRESS VALUE1=
1...4 characters from the
symbolic name character set

b: ADDRESS VALUE2=
0...255, range of decimal numbers

c: ADDRESS VALUE3=
0...255, range of decimal numbers

d: ADDRESS VALUE4=
0...255, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IPADR- 1-
DISP IPADR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY IP-ADDRESSES

This command displays information about one or all defined


IP-address(es).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IPADR : ADRNAM= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ADRNAM ADDRESS NAME

This parameter specifies the symbolic name of an IP-address.

Note:
- If ’x’ is entered the information of all IP-addresses is
displayed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IPADR- 1-


MOD IPADR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY IP-ADDRESS

This command modifies a remote IP-address which has been created


by CR IPADR.

Note:
- A local IP-address cannot be modified.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD IPADR : ADRNAM= ,OIPADR= ,NIPADR= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

ADRNAM ADDRESS NAME

This parameter specifies the symbolic name of an IP-address.

Note:
- The first three characters must be ’IPA’.
Any characters can be chosen for the rest of the name.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

OIPADR OLD ADDRESS VALUE

This parameter specifies the old value of the remote IP-address.

Notes:
- The parameter OIPADR allows a value of format IPv4 or IPv6.
- An IPv4 address has four units : V1-V2-V3-V4, where each
Vx (x=1..4) is defined as a range of 0..255. Always all
four units must be entered.
- For an IPv6 address only the first unit can be entered.
- An IPv6 address consist of 8 components with the following
format : V1&V2&V3&V4&V5&V6&V7&V8 where each Vx (x=1..8) is
defined as a range of 0..FFFF. Always all eight components
must be entered.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: OLD ADDRESS VALUE1=


1...4 characters from the
symbolic name character set

b: OLD ADDRESS VALUE2=


0...255, range of decimal numbers

c: OLD ADDRESS VALUE3=


0...255, range of decimal numbers

d: OLD ADDRESS VALUE4=


0...255, range of decimal numbers

NIPADR NEW ADDRESS VALUE

This parameter specifies the new value of the remote IP-address.

Note:
- The parameter NIPADR allows a value of format IPv4 or IPv6.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IPADR- 1+


MOD IPADR

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c[-d]]]

a: NEW ADDRESS VALUE1=


1...4 characters from the
symbolic name character set

b: NEW ADDRESS VALUE2=


0...255, range of decimal numbers

c: NEW ADDRESS VALUE3=


0...255, range of decimal numbers

d: NEW ADDRESS VALUE4=


0...255, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IPADR- 2-


CAN IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT

This command cancels an Interworking Equipment.

Prerequisites:
- An Interworking Equipment must be allocated at the specified location.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN IWE : DLU= ,MOD= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This parameter specifies the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...2553, range of decimal numbers

MOD MODULE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the number of the DLU shelf.

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the module number in the DLU shelf.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IWE- 1-


CR IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT

This command creates an Interworking Equipment.

Prerequisites:
- The module must be created (see CR DLUMOD).
- No Interworking Equipment has been created at this location yet.

Compatibilities:
- Up to 500 Interworking Equipments can be created.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR IWE : DLU= ,MOD= ,CONNTYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This parameter specifies the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...2553, range of decimal numbers

MOD MODULE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the number of the DLU shelf.

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the module number in the DLU shelf.

CONNTYPE CONNECTION TYPE

This parameter specifies the set of connection types


which are supported by the Interworking Equipment.

Compatibilities:
- For the module type IWEA only the following
connection types are allowed:
ATA03
ATA12
ATA24
ATA48
ATA96
ANA03
ANA12
ANA24
ANA48
ANA96
DTA03
DTA12
DTA24
DTA48
DTA96
DNA03
DNA12
DNA24

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IWE- 1+
CR IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DNA48
DNA96
F3T24
F3T48
F3T96

- For the module type IWEB only the following


connection types are allowed:
ATA03
ATA12
ATA1275
ATA24
ATA48
ATA96
ANA03
ANA12
ANA1275
ANA24
ANA48
ANA96
DTA03
DTA12
DTA24
DTA48
DTA96
DNA03
DNA12
DNA24
DNA48
DNA96
F3T24
F3T48
F3T96

- For the module type IWEC only the following


connection types are allowed:

ATA03
ATA12
ATA1275
ATA24
ATA48
ATA96
ANA03
ANA12
ANA1275
ANA24
ANA48
ANA96
ANS12
ANS24
ANS48
ANS96
ANA03A
ANA12A
ANA24A
ANA48A
ANA96A
DTA03
DTA12
DTA24
DTA48
DTA96
DNA03
DNA12
DNA24
DNA48
DNA96
DNS12
DNS24
DNS48
DNS96
F3T24
F3T48
F3T96

- For the module type IWED only the following

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IWE- 2+
CR IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

connection types are allowed:

ATA03
ATA12
ATA1275
ATA24
ATA48
ATA96
ANA03
ANA12
ANA1275
ANA24
ANA48
ANA96
ANS12
ANS24
ANS48
ANS96
ANA03A
ANA12A
ANA24A
ANA48A
ANA96A
DTA03
DTA12
DTA24
DTA48
DTA96
DNA03
DNA12
DNA24
DNA48
DNA96
DNS12
DNS24
DNS48
DNS96
F3T24
F3T48
F3T96

- For the module type IWEE only the following


connection types are allowed:

AAH2
ATA03
ATA12
ATA1275
ATA24
ATA48
ATA96
ANA03
ANA12
ANA1275
ANA24
ANA48
ANA96
ANS12
ANS24
ANS48
ANS96
ANA03A
ANA12A
ANA24A
ANA48A
ANA96A
DAH2
DTA03
DTA12
DTA24
DTA48
DTA96
DNA03
DNA12
DNA24
DNA48
DNA96

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IWE- 3+
CR IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DNS12
DNS24
DNS48
DNS96
F3T24
F3T48
F3T96

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ATA03 ANALOG TRANSP ASYNC 300 BIT/S


ATA12 ANALOG TRANSP ASYNC 1200 BIT/S
ATA1275 ANALOG TRANS ASY 1200/75 BIT/S
ATA24 ANALOG TRANSP ASYNC 2400 BIT/S
ATA48 ANALOG TRANSP ASYNC 4800 BIT/S
ATA96 ANALOG TRANSP ASYNC 9600 BIT/S
ANA03 ANALOG NONTRA ASYNC 300 BIT/S
ANA12 ANALOG NONTRA ASYNC 1200 BIT/S
ANA1275 ANALOG NONTR ASY 1200/75 BIT/S
ANA24 ANALOG NONTRA ASYNC 2400 BIT/S
ANA48 ANALOG NONTRA ASYNC 4800 BIT/S
ANA96 ANALOG NONTRA ASYNC 9600 BIT/S
ANS12 ANALOG NONTRA SYNCH 1200 BIT/S
ANS24 ANALOG NONTRA SYNCH 2400 BIT/S
ANS48 ANALOG NONTRA SYNCH 4800 BIT/S
ANS96 ANALOG NONTRA SYNCH 9600 BIT/S
ANA03A ANA 300 BIT/S AUTOBAUD TYPE 1
ANA12A ANA 1200 BIT/S AUTOBAUD TYPE 1
ANA24A ANA 2400 BIT/S AUTOBAUD TYPE 1
ANA48A ANA 4800 BIT/S AUTOBAUD TYPE 1
ANA96A ANA 9600 BIT/S AUTOBAUD TYPE 1
DTA03 DIGITA TRANSP ASYNC 300 BIT/S
DTA12 DIGITA TRANSP ASYNC 1200 BIT/S
DTA24 DIGITA TRANSP ASYNC 2400 BIT/S
DTA48 DIGITA TRANSP ASYNC 4800 BIT/S
DTA96 DIGITA TRANSP ASYNC 9600 BIT/S
DNA03 DIGITA NONTRA ASYNC 300 BIT/S
DNA12 DIGITA NONTRA ASYNC 1200 BIT/S
DNA24 DIGITA NONTRA ASYNC 2400 BIT/S
DNA48 DIGITA NONTRA ASYNC 4800 BIT/S
DNA96 DIGITA NONTRA ASYNC 9600 BIT/S
DNS12 DIGITA NONTRA SYNCH 1200 BIT/S
DNS24 DIGITA NONTRA SYNCH 2400 BIT/S
DNS48 DIGITA NONTRA SYNCH 4800 BIT/S
DNS96 DIGITA NONTRA SYNCH 9600 BIT/S
F3T24 FAX GROUP 3 TRANSP 2400 BIT/S
F3T48 FAX GROUP 3 TRANSP 4800 BIT/S
F3T96 FAX GROUP 3 TRANSP 9600 BIT/S
AAH2 ANALOG ASYNC HSCSD 2 TCH
DAH2 DIGITAL ASYNC HSCSD 2 TCH
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IWE- 4-
DISP IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT

This command displays one or more Interworking Equipments.

Prerequisites:
- If the command is entered to display only one IWE, then an
Interworking Equipment must be allocated at the specified location.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP IWE : DLU= ,MOD= [,CONNTYPE=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This parameter specifies the DLU.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

10...2553, range of decimal numbers

MOD MODULE

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the number of the DLU shelf.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the module number in the DLU shelf.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

CONNTYPE CONNECTION TYPE

This parameter specifies a set of connection types. Only the


IWEs with at least one of the specified connection types will be
displayed.
If the connection type is not entered, then all IWEs in the
specified range are displayed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ATA03 ANALOG TRANSP ASYNC 300 BIT/S


ATA12 ANALOG TRANSP ASYNC 1200 BIT/S
ATA1275 ANALOG TRANS ASY 1200/75 BIT/S
ATA24 ANALOG TRANSP ASYNC 2400 BIT/S
ATA48 ANALOG TRANSP ASYNC 4800 BIT/S
ATA96 ANALOG TRANSP ASYNC 9600 BIT/S

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IWE- 1+


DISP IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ANA03 ANALOG NONTRA ASYNC 300 BIT/S


ANA12 ANALOG NONTRA ASYNC 1200 BIT/S
ANA1275 ANALOG NONTR ASY 1200/75 BIT/S
ANA24 ANALOG NONTRA ASYNC 2400 BIT/S
ANA48 ANALOG NONTRA ASYNC 4800 BIT/S
ANA96 ANALOG NONTRA ASYNC 9600 BIT/S
ANS12 ANALOG NONTRA SYNCH 1200 BIT/S
ANS24 ANALOG NONTRA SYNCH 2400 BIT/S
ANS48 ANALOG NONTRA SYNCH 4800 BIT/S
ANS96 ANALOG NONTRA SYNCH 9600 BIT/S
ANA03A ANA 300 BIT/S AUTOBAUD TYPE 1
ANA12A ANA 1200 BIT/S AUTOBAUD TYPE 1
ANA24A ANA 2400 BIT/S AUTOBAUD TYPE 1
ANA48A ANA 4800 BIT/S AUTOBAUD TYPE 1
ANA96A ANA 9600 BIT/S AUTOBAUD TYPE 1
DTA03 DIGITA TRANSP ASYNC 300 BIT/S
DTA12 DIGITA TRANSP ASYNC 1200 BIT/S
DTA24 DIGITA TRANSP ASYNC 2400 BIT/S
DTA48 DIGITA TRANSP ASYNC 4800 BIT/S
DTA96 DIGITA TRANSP ASYNC 9600 BIT/S
DNA03 DIGITA NONTRA ASYNC 300 BIT/S
DNA12 DIGITA NONTRA ASYNC 1200 BIT/S
DNA24 DIGITA NONTRA ASYNC 2400 BIT/S
DNA48 DIGITA NONTRA ASYNC 4800 BIT/S
DNA96 DIGITA NONTRA ASYNC 9600 BIT/S
DNS12 DIGITA NONTRA SYNCH 1200 BIT/S
DNS24 DIGITA NONTRA SYNCH 2400 BIT/S
DNS48 DIGITA NONTRA SYNCH 4800 BIT/S
DNS96 DIGITA NONTRA SYNCH 9600 BIT/S
F3T24 FAX GROUP 3 TRANSP 2400 BIT/S
F3T48 FAX GROUP 3 TRANSP 4800 BIT/S
F3T96 FAX GROUP 3 TRANSP 9600 BIT/S
AAH2 ANALOG ASYNC HSCSD 2 TCH
DAH2 DIGITAL ASYNC HSCSD 2 TCH

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IWE- 2-


MOD IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT

This command modifies an Interworking Equipment.

Prerequisites:
- An Interworking Equipment must be allocated at the specified location.

This command is normally logged.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD IWE : DLU= ,MOD= ,CONNTYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This parameter specifies the DLU.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...2553, range of decimal numbers

MOD MODULE

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the number of the DLU shelf.

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the module number in the DLU shelf.

CONNTYPE CONNECTION TYPE

This parameter specifies the set of connection types


which are supported by the Interworking Equipment.

Compatibilities:
- For the module type IWEA only the following
connection types are allowed:
ATA03
ATA12
ATA24
ATA48
ATA96
ANA03
ANA12
ANA24
ANA48
ANA96
DTA03
DTA12
DTA24
DTA48
DTA96
DNA03
DNA12
DNA24
DNA48
DNA96
F3T24
F3T48

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IWE- 1+


MOD IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

F3T96

- For the module type IWEB only the following


connection types are allowed:
ATA03
ATA12
ATA1275
ATA24
ATA48
ATA96
ANA03
ANA12
ANA1275
ANA24
ANA48
ANA96
DTA03
DTA12
DTA24
DTA48
DTA96
DNA03
DNA12
DNA24
DNA48
DNA96
F3T24
F3T48
F3T96

- For the module type IWEC only the following


connection types are allowed:

ATA03
ATA12
ATA1275
ATA24
ATA48
ATA96
ANA03
ANA12
ANA1275
ANA24
ANA48
ANA96
ANS12
ANS24
ANS48
ANS96
ANA03A
ANA12A
ANA24A
ANA48A
ANA96A
DTA03
DTA12
DTA24
DTA48
DTA96
DNA03
DNA12
DNA24
DNA48
DNA96
DNS12
DNS24
DNS48
DNS96
F3T24
F3T48
F3T96

- For the module type IWED only the following


connection types are allowed:

ATA03
ATA12

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IWE- 2+


MOD IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ATA1275
ATA24
ATA48
ATA96
ANA03
ANA12
ANA1275
ANA24
ANA48
ANA96
ANS12
ANS24
ANS48
ANS96
ANA03A
ANA12A
ANA24A
ANA48A
ANA96A
DTA03
DTA12
DTA24
DTA48
DTA96
DNA03
DNA12
DNA24
DNA48
DNA96
DNS12
DNS24
DNS48
DNS96
F3T24
F3T48
F3T96

- For the module type IWEE only the following


connection types are allowed:

AAH2
ATA03
ATA12
ATA1275
ATA24
ATA48
ATA96
ANA03
ANA12
ANA1275
ANA24
ANA48
ANA96
ANS12
ANS24
ANS48
ANS96
ANA03A
ANA12A
ANA24A
ANA48A
ANA96A
DAH2
DTA03
DTA12
DTA24
DTA48
DTA96
DNA03
DNA12
DNA24
DNA48
DNA96
DNS12
DNS24
DNS48
DNS96

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IWE- 3+


MOD IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

F3T24
F3T48
F3T96

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ATA03 ANALOG TRANSP ASYNC 300 BIT/S


ATA12 ANALOG TRANSP ASYNC 1200 BIT/S
ATA1275 ANALOG TRANS ASY 1200/75 BIT/S
ATA24 ANALOG TRANSP ASYNC 2400 BIT/S
ATA48 ANALOG TRANSP ASYNC 4800 BIT/S
ATA96 ANALOG TRANSP ASYNC 9600 BIT/S
ANA03 ANALOG NONTRA ASYNC 300 BIT/S
ANA12 ANALOG NONTRA ASYNC 1200 BIT/S
ANA1275 ANALOG NONTR ASY 1200/75 BIT/S
ANA24 ANALOG NONTRA ASYNC 2400 BIT/S
ANA48 ANALOG NONTRA ASYNC 4800 BIT/S
ANA96 ANALOG NONTRA ASYNC 9600 BIT/S
ANS12 ANALOG NONTRA SYNCH 1200 BIT/S
ANS24 ANALOG NONTRA SYNCH 2400 BIT/S
ANS48 ANALOG NONTRA SYNCH 4800 BIT/S
ANS96 ANALOG NONTRA SYNCH 9600 BIT/S
ANA03A ANA 300 BIT/S AUTOBAUD TYPE 1
ANA12A ANA 1200 BIT/S AUTOBAUD TYPE 1
ANA24A ANA 2400 BIT/S AUTOBAUD TYPE 1
ANA48A ANA 4800 BIT/S AUTOBAUD TYPE 1
ANA96A ANA 9600 BIT/S AUTOBAUD TYPE 1
DTA03 DIGITA TRANSP ASYNC 300 BIT/S
DTA12 DIGITA TRANSP ASYNC 1200 BIT/S
DTA24 DIGITA TRANSP ASYNC 2400 BIT/S
DTA48 DIGITA TRANSP ASYNC 4800 BIT/S
DTA96 DIGITA TRANSP ASYNC 9600 BIT/S
DNA03 DIGITA NONTRA ASYNC 300 BIT/S
DNA12 DIGITA NONTRA ASYNC 1200 BIT/S
DNA24 DIGITA NONTRA ASYNC 2400 BIT/S
DNA48 DIGITA NONTRA ASYNC 4800 BIT/S
DNA96 DIGITA NONTRA ASYNC 9600 BIT/S
DNS12 DIGITA NONTRA SYNCH 1200 BIT/S
DNS24 DIGITA NONTRA SYNCH 2400 BIT/S
DNS48 DIGITA NONTRA SYNCH 4800 BIT/S
DNS96 DIGITA NONTRA SYNCH 9600 BIT/S
F3T24 FAX GROUP 3 TRANSP 2400 BIT/S
F3T48 FAX GROUP 3 TRANSP 4800 BIT/S
F3T96 FAX GROUP 3 TRANSP 9600 BIT/S
AAH2 ANALOG ASYNC HSCSD 2 TCH
DAH2 DIGITAL ASYNC HSCSD 2 TCH
X ENTIRE RANGE OF PARAM. VALUES

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IWE- 4-


REC IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

RECORD INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT FUNCTION

This command records the interworking equipment function related data.

Prerequisites:
- System time must be secure when the command is entered.

Notes:
- Only 1 measurement job can be started.
- The measurement can be stopped with STOP JOB if the time
parameter values allow a continuation of the job.
- This command is only allowed for an MSC.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command starts a semipermanent job. It can be canceled with CAN JOB.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 REC IWE : UNIT= [,BEG=] [,TER=] [,IV=] [,PER=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

UNIT UNIT

This parameter specifies the output unit and the form of output.
Only one of the possible alternatives may be selected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b

a: DEVICE
MDD MAGNETIC DISK DEVICE
If this option is selected, a measurement file
is created and the received traffic data are
output to this file. After the parameter has
been accepted and at the end of the last
recording, an acknowledgement is output to
the OMT. It includes the name of the file in
which the traffic data are available for
postprocessing.
For postprocessing, the data must first be
copied to tape.

Notes:
- Identifier a covers both MDD and MOD.

This information unit specifies the output unit.

b: FILETYPE
SINGLE SINGLE FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
output to single measurement files.
DAILY DAILY FILE
If this option is selected, the data are
output to daily files. This is appropriate in
connection with continuous measurements which
start immediately and have no defined end.
To secure the required space on disk, all 7
daily files (MO...SU) are prepared and created
before the command is accepted.
Time parameters are not permissible for these
measurements.
A daily file is closed at the end of the day
and a new file for the next day is automatically
created on disk or the existing file is replaced.
In the second and subsequent weeks, the file
for the same day of the week is overwritten.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC IWE- 1+


REC IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CYCLIC CYCLIC FILE


If this option is selected, the data are
written into a cyclic measurement file.
Time parameters are not permitted for these
measurements.
If the cyclic file runs full the newest
data will be lost.
This occurs after a period of two days.

This information unit specifies the desired output form


(daily files, single or cyclic measurement files).

BEG BEGINNING DATE

This parameter specifies the measurement begin time.

Notes:
- The begin date BEG and/or the termination date TER must be
specified.
Exception : time parameters may not be specified for the data output
in daily and cyclic files.
- A maximum of four BEG dates (in ascending order) may be linked
with &. In case of linked BEG dates, TER is not permissible.
- The earliest possible begin date is the day after entry.
- It is not permissible to enter the command after 23:45 hours with a
begin date on the following day.
- The first measurement may not begin later than one month after the
current date. Subsequent measurements may not begin later than one
year after the current date.

Default: current date

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the year of the begin


date.

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the month of the begin


date.

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the day of the begin


date.

TER TERMINATING DATE

This parameter specifies the measurement termination date.

Notes:
- Only one termination date may be entered per command.
The earliest possible termination date is the day after entry.
- The measurement duration may not exceed one year.
- The begin date BEG and/or the termination date TER must
be specified.
Exception: time parameters may not be specified for data output
in daily and cyclic files.

Default: the end of the measurement is determined by the single day


measurement.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

a-b-c

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC IWE- 2+


REC IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

a: YEAR=
0...99, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the year in which


recording is to terminate.

b: MONTH=
1...12, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the month in which


recording is to terminate.

c: DAY=
1...31, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the day on which


recording is to terminate.

IV INTERVAL TIME

This parameter specifies the measurement interval times.

Notes:
- A maximum of 4 measurement intervals may be linked with &.
- Interval times are only permissible in connection with a
begin date (BEG).

Incompatibilities:
- Intervals covering more than one day (e.g. 23-00-01-00).
- Intervals separated by a break of less than one hour.

Default: 24-hour measurement on the specified days.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a-b-c-d

a: BEGIN HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the hour at which the


measurement interval begins.

b: BEGIN MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the minutes past the hour at


which the measurement interval begins.

Notes:
- Possible values : 0, 15, 30 and 45.

c: END HOUR=
0...23, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the hour at which the


measurement interval terminates.

d: END MINUTE=
0...59, range of decimal numbers

This information unit specifies the minutes past the hour at


which the measurement interval terminates.

Notes:
- Possible values : 0, 15, 30 and 45.

PER PERIODICAL WEEKDAY

This parameter specifies the days of the week on which

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC IWE- 3+


REC IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

recording is to take place.

Notes:
- The input of weekdays is only permissible in connection with
a termination date (TER).

Default: daily measurement during the measurement period.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

MO MONDAY
TU TUESDAY
WE WEDNESDAY
TH THURSDAY
FR FRIDAY
SA SATURDAY
SU SUNDAY
WO WORKDAY

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 REC IWE- 4-


STAT IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY STATUS OF INTERWORKING EQUIPMENT

This command displays the transient data (individual for each port)
for one/several Interworking Equipments.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT IWE : DLU= ,MOD= [,STATUS=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

DLU DIGITAL LINE UNIT

This parameter specifies the DLU.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

10...2553, range of decimal numbers

MOD MODULE

This parameter specifies the mounting location of the DLU module.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

a-b

a: SHELF NUMBER=
0...7, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the number of the DLU shelf.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

b: MODULE NUMBER=
0...15, range of decimal numbers

This unit specifies the module number in the DLU shelf.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of


unit values.

STATUS STATE OF IWE

This parameter specifies the transient status of an Interworking


Equipment.
Default value of this parameter is X.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

BUSY BUSY
IDLE IDLE STATUS
AUD AUDIT CHECK RUNNING
AUIDL AUDIT IDLE LIST FLAG
BBAC BLOCKED BACKWARD
BPRM BLOCKED PERMANENT
BPCN BLOCKING PREPARED CANCEL
DLUX DLU SWITCH X-WAY
DLUY DLU SWITCH Y-WAY
DLUF DLU SWITCH FREE WAY
NDLU NOT ACCESSIBLE DLU

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT IWE- 1+


STAT IWE

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MBLM MAINTENANCE BLOCKED MODULE


CBLM CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED MODULE
NXSYS NOT ACCESSIBLE X-SYS
NXWAY NOT ACCESSIBLE X-WAY
CBLXS CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED X-SYS
NYSYS NOT ACCESSIBLE Y-SYS
NYWAY NOT ACCESSIBLE Y-WAY
CBLYS CONDITIONALLY BLOCKED Y-SYS

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT IWE- 2-


CAN IWPSS7

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Interworking Point for SS7

This task cancels an interworking point IWP.

Prerequisites:
- the IWP must not be used by a Signaling data link

Inputparameter :
- IWP ID
This parameter identifies the interworking point (IWP).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN IWPSS7 : IWP ID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IWP ID

This parameter identifies the interworking point (IWP).

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN IWPSS7- 1-


CR IWPSS7

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create Interworking Point for SS7

This task creates an interworking point IWP which can be used by a


Signaling data link to connect to a narrowband port.
It returns the IWP ID as a reference to the IWP.

The IWP consists of the objects


- Interworking point
- Interworking point VC
This object represents the VC level of an endpoint of a
narrowband connection in the ATM Layer.
This object is responsible for generating Comm. alarm
notifications if
- a buffer overflow or underflow occurs
- a VC-AIS or VC-RDI failure is detected
In case of VC-AIS or VC-RDI failure the value of the Probable cause
parameter is set to AIS or Far end receiver failure, respectively.

Prerequisites:
- the LIC port object must exist, either LICPRTE1 or LICPRTDS1
- the LIC port must be configured for STM traffic
- the LIC port must not be already assigned to another IWP

Inputparamter :
- LIC
This parameter specifies the LIC.
- LIC port
This parameter specifies the LIC port beginning with 1.
- Time slot
This Parameter specifies the time slot TS, with which the IWP will be
connected.
Possible values are 1..31 for E1 and 1..24 for DS1.
- IWP ID
This parameter identifies the interworking point (IWP).
If it is omitted, a value will be chosen by the node.
- Admin. state
This parameter may be used to inhibit (lock) and allow (unlock)
the flow of cells through the IWP.
- Alarm profile MP
This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ for a unit.
The ’Alarm Profile MP’ contains the Probable cause values.
For each Probable cause an alarm priority is assigned.
On the MP the following standardised ’Alarm Profile MP’s
are available:

ALSUPP:
The alarm priority of all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is suppressed.

WARNING:
This is no alarm, but a warning. The alarm priority of all
Probable cause values indicates a warning.

MINNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is of minor importance and will not escalate.

MINESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is minor,
if the service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
In case the service is affected the priority will escalate to
critical.

MAJNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate.

MAJESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate, if the
service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
If service is affected, the priority will escalate to critical.

CRITICAL:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is critical,
i.e. service is affected.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IWPSS7- 1+
CR IWPSS7

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Outputparameters :
- IWP ID
- LIC
- LIC port
- Time Slot
- Admin. state
- Operational state
- Alarm status
- Current problem list
- Alarm profile MP

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR IWPSS7 : LIC= ,LIC port= ,Time Slot= [,IWP ID=] 1
1 1
1 ,Admin. state= ,Alarm profile MP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter specifies the LIC.

LIC port

This parameter specifies the LIC port beginning with 1.

Time Slot

This Parameter specifies the time slot TS, with which the IWP will be
connected.

Input format :
1..31 for E1, range of decimal numbers
1..24 for DS1, range of decimal numbers

IWP ID

This parameter identifies the interworking point (IWP).


If it is omitted, a value will be chosen by the node.

Admin. state

This parameter may be used to inhibit (lock) and allow (unlock)


the flow of cells through the IWP.

Alarm profile MP

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ for a unit.


The ’Alarm Profile MP’ contains the Probable cause values.
For each Probable cause an alarm priority is assigned.
On the MP the following standardised ’Alarm Profile MP’s
are available:

ALSUPP:
The alarm priority of all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is suppressed.

WARNING:
This is no alarm, but a warning. The alarm priority of all
Probable cause values indicates a warning.

MINNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is of minor importance and will not escalate.

MINESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is minor,
if the service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
In case the service is affected the priority will escalate to
critical.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IWPSS7- 2+
CR IWPSS7

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MAJNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate.

MAJESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate, if the
service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
If service is affected, the priority will escalate to critical.

CRITICAL:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is critical,
i.e. service is affected.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR IWPSS7- 3-
DISP IWPSS7

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Interworking Point for SS7

This task displays one specified or all interworking points IWP of the
Managed element R1.
If the IWP is specified by the IWP ID, all parameters of this IWP will be
displayed.
Otherwise a list of all IWP will be displayed.

Inputparameter :
- IWP ID
This parameter identifies the interworking point (IWP).

Outputparameter :
for a single IWP
- IWP ID
- LIC
- LIC port
- Time Slot
- Admin. state
This parameter may be used to inhibit (lock) and allow (unlock)
the flow of cells through the IWP.
- Operational state
This parameter describes the operability of a resource.
It is read-only and can have one of the following values:
’Disabled’ The resource is totally inoperable and unable to provide
service to the user(s).
’Enabled’ The resource is partially or fully operable and
available for use.
- Alarm status
- Current problem list
- Alarm profile MP
This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ for a unit.
The ’Alarm Profile MP’ contains the Probable cause values.
For each Probable cause an alarm priority is assigned.
On the MP the following standardised ’Alarm Profile MP’s
are available:

ALSUPP:
The alarm priority of all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is suppressed.

WARNING:
This is no alarm, but a warning. The alarm priority of all
Probable cause values indicates a warning.

MINNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is of minor importance and will not escalate.

MINESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is minor,
if the service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
In case the service is affected the priority will escalate to
critical.

MAJNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate.

MAJESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate, if the
service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
If service is affected, the priority will escalate to critical.

CRITICAL:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is critical,
i.e. service is affected.

for a list of IWP


- IWP ID
- LIC
- LIC port
- Time Slot
- Admin. state
- Operational state
- Alarm status

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IWPSS7- 1+


DISP IWPSS7

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP IWPSS7 : [IWP ID=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IWP ID

This parameter identifies the interworking point (IWP).


If it is omitted, all interworking points will be displayed.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP IWPSS7- 2-


MOD IWPSS7

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Interworking Point for SS7

This Task modifies an interworking point IWP.

Prerequisites:
A IWP shall not be administratively locked if it
is referenced by a Signaling data link object which is not
administratively locked.

Inputparameter :
- IWP ID
This parameter identifies the interworking point (IWP).
- Admin. state
This parameter may be used to inhibit (lock) and allow (unlock)
the flow of cells through the IWP.
- Alarm profile MP
This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ for a unit.
The ’Alarm Profile MP’ contains the Probable cause values.
For each Probable cause an alarm priority is assigned.
On the MP the following standardised ’Alarm Profile MP’s
are available:

ALSUPP:
The alarm priority of all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is suppressed.

WARNING:
This is no alarm, but a warning. The alarm priority of all
Probable cause values indicates a warning.

MINNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is of minor importance and will not escalate.

MINESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is minor,
if the service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
In case the service is affected the priority will escalate to
critical.

MAJNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate.

MAJESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate, if the
service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
If service is affected, the priority will escalate to critical.

CRITICAL:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is critical,
i.e. service is affected.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD IWPSS7 : IWP ID= [,Admin. state=] [,Alarm profile MP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

IWP ID

This parameter identifies the interworking point (IWP).

Admin. state

This parameter may be used to inhibit (lock) and allow (unlock)


the flow of cells through the IWP.

Alarm profile MP

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IWPSS7- 1+


MOD IWPSS7

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ for a unit.


The ’Alarm Profile MP’ contains the Probable cause values.
For each Probable cause an alarm priority is assigned.
On the MP the following standardised ’Alarm Profile MP’s
are available:

ALSUPP:
The alarm priority of all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is suppressed.

WARNING:
This is no alarm, but a warning. The alarm priority of all
Probable cause values indicates a warning.

MINNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is of minor importance and will not escalate.

MINESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is minor,
if the service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
In case the service is affected the priority will escalate to
critical.

MAJNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate.

MAJESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate, if the
service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
If service is affected, the priority will escalate to critical.

CRITICAL:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is critical,
i.e. service is affected.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD IWPSS7- 2-


CAN JOB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL JOB

This command cancels semipermanent jobs. Timer jobs scheduled


for predetermined times can be cancelled. Time jobs which are
running must first be stopped before they can be cancelled.

Notes:
- This command may not be entered from command files.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN JOB : JN= ,CMDCOD= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

JN JOB NUMBER

This parameter specifies the job number assigned to a job.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...9999, range of decimal numbers

CMDCOD COMMAND CODE

This parameter specifies the command code of the job to be canceled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN JOB- 1-


CONT JOB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONTINUE JOB

This command reactivates user processes which were started by commands


with the attribute CONTINUE.

Prerequisite:
- This command may not be entered from command files.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONT JOB : JN= [,STEP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

JN JOB NUMBER

This parameter specifies the job number assigned to a job.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...9999, range of decimal numbers

STEP STEP NUMBER

This parameter specifies the logical step up to which the job


should be processed.

Note:
With some processes this parameter is mandatory.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...998, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONT JOB- 1-


DISP JOB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY JOB

This command displays job data for one job or all jobs.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP JOB : [JN=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

JN JOB NUMBER

This parameter specifies the job number assigned to a job.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP JOB- 1-


STOP JOB

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

STOP JOB

This command stops transient jobs or part-jobs which have the command
attribute STOP.

Notes:
- This command may not be entered from command files.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STOP JOB : JN= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

JN JOB NUMBER

This parameter specifies the job number assigned to a job.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

10...9999, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STOP JOB- 1-


DISP JOSITDAT

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY JOSIT DATA

This command displays internal tracer data specified by the parameter


SELECT.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP JOSITDAT : [SELECT=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

SELECT SELECTION

This parameter determines the displayed tracer data.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

X ALL AVAILABLE SS DATA


COLLECT PARAM VALUES OF LAST ACTOSITRA
Parameter values of the last ACT OSITRAC command.
TSTATE ACTUAL TRACER STATUS

Default: X

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP JOSITDAT- 1-


DISP JOSITDATMP

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display OSI Tracer State MP

This task displays the state and activation parameter of the specified
OSI Tracer.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP JOSITDATMP : Tracer selection= ,MP ID= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

Tracer selection

The OSI Tracer consists of five independant trace


utilities. This parameter specifies the Tracer of
which the state and activation parameter are to be
output.

Possible selections:
- ’FTP’ (Layer ’L7F’, ’X’)
- ’OSI’ (Layers ’L4’, ’L5’, ’L6’, ’L7A’, ’L7C’,
’L7MO’, ’L7NE’, ’L7Q’, ’L7R’, ’X’)
- ’TCP’ (Layers ’L3IP’, ’L4TC’, ’X’)
- ’PRH’ (Layers ’UDP’ , ’SCTP’, ’M3UA’, ’X’)
- ’OAMD’ (Layers ’HOP’, ’X’)

MP ID

This parameter defines the number of the


hardware platform (MP), where the tracer is started.
Format: (1..128 decimal integers)

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP JOSITDATMP- 1-


CAN KEYWORD
PBXLN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL KEYWORD

This command cancels keyword-specific data for a subscriber, a PBX line, a PBX
or a Subscriber Profile.

Notes:
- If applicable an AMA-ticket can be generated.
- If applicable an FIR-ticket can be generated.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted for a local exchange.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CAN KEYWORD - PBXLN KEY F. ANALOG/ISDN PBXLN


2. CAN KEYWORD - PROFILE KEY F. SUBSCRIBER PROFILES
3. CAN KEYWORD - SUBPBX KEY F. ANALOG/ISDN SUB/PBX

1. Input format

KEY F. ANALOG/ISDN PBXLN

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN KEYWORD : [LAC=] ,DN= [,OPMODE=] ,LNO= [,PURPOSE=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the subscriber,


PBX-line or PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

OPMODE OPERATING MODE

This parameter specifies the operating mode of a PBX line.


It is administered with the commands CR PBX / MOD PBX /
CR PBXLN.

Notes:
- This parameter is ommissible if only one OPMODE exists for the
chosen PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

XABW = ANALOG BOTHWAY


1AIC 1 ANALOG INCOMING
1IBW 1 ISDN BOTHWAY
1IBW1TR6 1 ISDN BOTHWAY 1TR6 PROTOCOL
1IIC 1 ISDN INCOMING
>IIC1TR6 W ISDN INCOMING 1TR6 PROTOCOL

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN KEYWORD- 1+


CAN KEYWORD
PBXLN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

PURPOSE PURPOSE OF CANCELING

This parameter specifies the keyword-specific data which should


be cancelled.

Notes:
- If this parameter is not entered, then KEY, INTKEY and
KEYPRF will be cancelled.
- If this parameter is entered, then the according keyword-speicifc
data will be cancelled.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

XINTKEY = INTERNET KEYWORD


1KEY 1 KEYWORD
>KEYPRF W KEYWORD PROFILE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN KEYWORD- 2+


CAN KEYWORD
PROFILE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

KEY F. SUBSCRIBER PROFILES

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN KEYWORD : PRFID= [,PURPOSE=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PRFID PROFILE IDENTIFICATION

Specifies the profile identification (see command CR SUBPRFID),


for which a keyword should be canceled.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...200, range of decimal numbers

PURPOSE PURPOSE OF CANCELING

This parameter specifies the keyword-specific data which should


be cancelled.

Notes:
- If this parameter is not entered, then KEY, INTKEY and
KEYPRF will be cancelled.
- If this parameter is entered, then the according keyword-speicifc
data will be cancelled.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

XKEY = KEYWORD
>KEYPRF W KEYWORD PROFILE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN KEYWORD- 3+


CAN KEYWORD
SUBPBX
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

KEY F. ANALOG/ISDN SUB/PBX

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN KEYWORD : [LAC=] ,DN= [,PURPOSE=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the subscriber,


PBX-line or PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

PURPOSE PURPOSE OF CANCELING

This parameter specifies the keyword-specific data which should


be cancelled.

Notes:
- If this parameter is not entered, then KEY, INTKEY and
KEYPRF will be cancelled.
- If this parameter is entered, then the according keyword-speicifc
data will be cancelled.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

XINTKEY = INTERNET KEYWORD


1KEY 1 KEYWORD
>KEYPRF W KEYWORD PROFILE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN KEYWORD- 4-


DISP KEYWORD
PROFILE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY KEYWORD

This command displays keyword-specific data of a subscriber, a PBX line, a


PBX or a subscriber profile.

Keyword-specific data may be displayed for:


- a single subscriber,
- a single PBX line,
- a single PBX,
- a single subscriber profile,
- a range of directory numbers,
- a range of subscriber profiles,
- all directory numbers in an exchange,
- all subscriber profiles in an exchange.

Keyword-specific data include:


- the normal keyword
- information, if the normal keyword is a security keyword or not
- information about the existence of an internet keyword
- the keyword profile

Notes:
- The Parameter KEY will not be displayed if it is a security keyword.
- An information will be given, if an Internet Keyword is existing but the
Internet Keyword itself will not be displayed.
- A selective display is possible with input of DN=X (or interval) or
PRFID=X (or interval) and parameter KEYPRF.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted for a local exchange.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DISP KEYWORD - PROFILE KEY F. SUBSCRIBER PROFILES


2. DISP KEYWORD - SUBPBXLN KEY F. ANALOG/ISDN SUB/PBX/PBXLN

1. Input format

KEY F. SUBSCRIBER PROFILES

Input format for display of keyword specific data for Subscriber Profiles.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP KEYWORD : PRFID= [,KEYPRF=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PRFID PROFILE IDENTIFICATION

Specifies the profile identification (see command CR SUBPRFID),


for which data should be displayed.

Notes:
- Together with parameter KEYPRF only the input of PRFID=X
is allowed.

Incompatibilities:
- LAC
- OPMODE
- LNO

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP KEYWORD- 1+


DISP KEYWORD
PROFILE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...200, range of decimal numbers

KEYPRF KEYWORD PROFILE

Specifies the keyword profile identification, which should be


searched for.

Prerequisites:
- Input of DN=X (or interval) or PRFID=X (or interval).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

X(PRF1 )= KEYWORD PROFILE 1


11PRF10 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 10
11PRF11 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 11
11PRF12 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 12
11PRF13 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 13
11PRF14 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 14
11PRF15 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 15
1ZPRF16 Y1 KEYWORD PROFILE 16
11PRF2 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 2
11PRF3 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 3
11PRF4 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 4
11PRF5 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 5
11PRF6 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 6
11PRF7 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 7
11PRF8 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 8
>*PRF9 +W KEYWORD PROFILE 9

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP KEYWORD- 2+


DISP KEYWORD
SUBPBXLN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

KEY F. ANALOG/ISDN SUB/PBX/PBXLN

Input format for display of keyword specific data for Subscriber, PBX
or PBX Lines.

Notes:
- If data for a specific PBX Line should be displayed, then parameter
LNO has to be entered too.
- If DN=X (or interval) is entered, then the keyword data for all
existing objects (resp. all existing objects within this interval)
are displayed.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 DISP KEYWORD : [LAC=] ,DN= [,OPMODE=] [,LNO=] [,KEYPRF=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.
- If LAC=X is entered, DN=X has to be entered, too.
- Together with parameter KEYPRF only the input of LAC=X is
allowed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the


subscriber/PBX-line/PBX.

Notes:
- If LAC=X is entered, DN=X has to be entered, too.
- Together with parameter KEYPRF only the input of DN=X or
a DN-interval is allowed.

If X is entered, it represents the entire range of parameter values.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


a value-range by linking two values with &&.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

OPMODE OPERATING MODE

This parameter specifies the operating mode of a PBX line.


It is administered with the commands CR PBX and MOD PBX.

Notes:
- Keyword and Keyword Profile are not allowed for IOG,
AOG and IOG1TR6 lines.
- If OPMODE is specified, LNO must be entered too.
- This parameter is ommissible if only one OPMODE exists for the
chosen PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

XABW = ANALOG BOTHWAY


1AIC 1 ANALOG INCOMING
1IBW 1 ISDN BOTHWAY
1IBW1TR6 1 ISDN BOTHWAY 1TR6 PROTOCOL
1IIC 1 ISDN INCOMING

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP KEYWORD- 3+


DISP KEYWORD
SUBPBXLN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

>IIC1TR6 W ISDN INCOMING 1TR6 PROTOCOL

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

KEYPRF KEYWORD PROFILE

Specifies the keyword profile identification, which should be


searched for.

Prerequisites:
- Input of DN=X (or interval) or PRFID=X (or interval).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

X(PRF1 )= KEYWORD PROFILE 1


11PRF10 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 10
11PRF11 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 11
11PRF12 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 12
11PRF13 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 13
11PRF14 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 14
11PRF15 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 15
1ZPRF16 Y1 KEYWORD PROFILE 16
11PRF2 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 2
11PRF3 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 3
11PRF4 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 4
11PRF5 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 5
11PRF6 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 6
11PRF7 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 7
11PRF8 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 8
>*PRF9 +W KEYWORD PROFILE 9

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP KEYWORD- 4-


ENTR KEYWORD
PBXLN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

ENTER KEYWORD

This command enters a keyword for


- a subscriber (categories main station,ISDN basic access, ISDN digital
switch board, two party line, coinbox and cordless terminal mobility)
- a PBX line (bothway or incoming to the switch; categories main station,
ISDN basic access, B-channel of ISDN primary access fixed and cordless
terminal mobility)
- a PBX
- a Subscriber Profile
via parameter KEY.
For some subscriber classes of service administered via SCI
(subscriber controled input) a keyword is mandatory.
Only Subscribers with security keyword are allowed to modify keyword per SCI.

This command enters an internet keyword for


- a subscriber (categories main station,ISDN basic access, ISDN digital
switch board, two party line, coinbox and cordless terminal mobility)
- a PBX line (bothway or incoming to the switch; categories main station,
ISDN basic access, B-channel of ISDN primary access fixed and cordless
terminal mobility)
- a PBX
(for TYPE = PBX, MLHG, PASLAVE, SHG, PBXDDINO, PA,
or no special PBX-TYPE)
via parameter INTKEY.

This command enters a keyword profile for


- a subscriber (categories main station,ISDN basic access, ISDN digital
switch board, two party line, coinbox and cordless terminal mobility)
- a PBX line (bothway or incoming to the switch; categories main station,
ISDN basic access, B-channel of ISDN primary access fixed and cordless
terminal mobility)
- a PBX
- a Subscriber Profile
via parameter KEYPRF.

Notes:
- A secure Keyword is stored and logged in coded form.
- An Internet Keyword and a not secure keyword is stored and logged in uncoded
form.
- If applicable an AMA-ticket can be generated except for an Internet Keyword.
- If applicable a FIR-ticket can be generated except for an Internet Keyword.
- If no Keyword is entered, a default value may be set (for detailed
description about setting of default values see parameter KEY and
INTKEY, for the default Keyword and Internet Keyword see command
DISP CALLPOPT).

This command allows multiple starts.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. ENTR KEYWORD - PBXLN KEY F. ANALOG/ISDN PBXLN


2. ENTR KEYWORD - PROFILE KEY F. SUBSCRIBER PROFILES
3. ENTR KEYWORD - SUBPBX KEY F. ANALOG/ISDN SUB/PBX

1. Input format

KEY F. ANALOG/ISDN PBXLN

Input format for assigning a keyword, internet keyword or keyword profile to a


PBX line.

Notes:
- If parameter SECURE is not entered, then NO will be set as default
if a keyword is entered.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR KEYWORD : [LAC=] ,DN= [,OPMODE=] ,LNO= [,KEY=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,SECURE=] [,INTKEY=] [,KEYPRF=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR KEYWORD- 1+


ENTR KEYWORD
PBXLN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the


subscriber/PBX.

Notes:
- For PBX-lines the pilot directory number of the
relevant PBX must be entered within this parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

OPMODE OPERATING MODE

This parameter specifies the operating mode of a PBX line.


It is administered with the commands CR PBX / MOD PBX /
CR PBXLN.

Notes:
- Keyword is not allowed for IOG, AOG and IOG1TR6 lines.
- This parameter is ommissible if only one OPMODE exists for the
chosen PBX.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

XABW = ANALOG BOTHWAY


1AIC 1 ANALOG INCOMING
1IBW 1 ISDN BOTHWAY
1IBW1TR6 1 ISDN BOTHWAY 1TR6 PROTOCOL
1IIC 1 ISDN INCOMING
>IIC1TR6 W ISDN INCOMING 1TR6 PROTOCOL

LNO LINE NUMBER

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...9999, range of decimal numbers

KEY KEYWORD

Notes:
- If no keyword is entered, a default value will be set
except when parameter INTKEY or KEYPRF is entered and
parameter SECURE is not entered.
(see command DISP CALLPOPT)
- If the keyword (personal identification number) specified during
SCI does not correspond to the keyword stored for the subscriber
then SCI is rejected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...12 digit decimal number

SECURE SECURITY KEYWORD

A security keyword may be modified by SCI. A normal keyword


may not be modified by SCI.

Notes:
- A security keyword can not be displayed.
- A security keyword is logged in enciphered format.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR KEYWORD- 2+


ENTR KEYWORD
PBXLN
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

X(N )= NORMAL KEYWORD


1ZNO Y1 NORMAL KEYWORD
11Y 11 SECURITY KEYWORD
>*YES +W SECURITY KEYWORD

INTKEY INTERNET KEYWORD

Keyword used for Internet sessions.

Notes:
- If none of the parameters INTKEY, KEY, KEYPRF
or SECURE is entered, then a default keyword for KEY and
INTKEY will be set.
(see command DISP CALLPOPT)
- If parameter INTKEY is not entered and parameter KEY and/or
parameter SECURE and/or parameter KEYPRF is entered, then no
default value for INTKEY will be set.
- If the parameters KEY is not entered and parameter INTKEY is
entered, then a default value for KEY will only be set, when
parameter SECURE is entered too.
- If the internet keyword specified during login into an internet
session does not correspond to the internet keyword stored for the
subscriber then login is rejected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...12 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

KEYPRF KEYWORD PROFILE

Specifies the keyword profile identification, which should be


assigned. The keyword profile includes a set of features. For using
these features the input of a keyword is mandatory.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

X(PRF1 )= KEYWORD PROFILE 1


11PRF10 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 10
11PRF11 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 11
11PRF12 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 12
11PRF13 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 13
11PRF14 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 14
11PRF15 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 15
1ZPRF16 Y1 KEYWORD PROFILE 16
11PRF2 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 2
11PRF3 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 3
11PRF4 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 4
11PRF5 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 5
11PRF6 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 6
11PRF7 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 7
11PRF8 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 8
>*PRF9 +W KEYWORD PROFILE 9

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR KEYWORD- 3+


ENTR KEYWORD
PROFILE
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

KEY F. SUBSCRIBER PROFILES

Input format for assigning a keyword or a keyword profile to a subscriber


profile.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 ENTR KEYWORD : PRFID= [,SECURE=] [,KEYPRF=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

PRFID PROFILE IDENTIFICATION

Specifies the profile identification (see command CR SUBPRFID),


for which a keyword and/or a keyword profile should be entered.

Notes:
- The specified profile has to be an existing CREATE-profile.
- For entering a keword for subscriber profiles SECURE=YES
has to be entered without input of parameter KEY, so that the
default keyword will be written.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...200, range of decimal numbers

SECURE SECURITY KEYWORD

A security keyword may be modified by SCI. A normal keyword


may not be modified by SCI.

Notes:
- A security keyword can not be displayed.
- A security keyword is logged in enciphered format.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

X(Y )= SECURITY KEYWORD


>*YES +W SECURITY KEYWORD

KEYPRF KEYWORD PROFILE

Specifies the keyword profile identification, which should be


assigned. The keyword profile includes a set of features. For using
these features the input of a keyword is mandatory.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

X(PRF1 )= KEYWORD PROFILE 1


11PRF10 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 10
11PRF11 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 11
11PRF12 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 12
11PRF13 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 13
11PRF14 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 14
11PRF15 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 15
1ZPRF16 Y1 KEYWORD PROFILE 16
11PRF2 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 2
11PRF3 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 3
11PRF4 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 4
11PRF5 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 5
11PRF6 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 6
11PRF7 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 7
11PRF8 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 8
>*PRF9 +W KEYWORD PROFILE 9

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR KEYWORD- 4+


ENTR KEYWORD
SUBPBX
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

KEY F. ANALOG/ISDN SUB/PBX

Input format for assigning a keyword, internet keyword or keyword profile to a


subscriber or a PBX.

Notes:
- If parameter SECURE is not entered, then NO will be set as default,
if a keyword is entered.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ENTR KEYWORD : [LAC=] ,DN= [,KEY=] [,SECURE=] [,INTKEY=] 1
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 [,KEYPRF=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAC LOCAL AREA CODE

This parameter specifies the local area code.

Notes:
- Input is mandatory for an exchange with multiple DN volume.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...6 digit decimal number

DN DIRECTORY NUMBER

This parameter specifies the directory number of the


subscriber/PBX.

Notes:
- For PBX-lines the pilot directory number of the
relevant PBX must be entered within this parameter.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...12 digit hexadecimal number where B is


interchangeable with * and C is interchangeable with #

KEY KEYWORD

Notes:
- If no keyword is entered, a default value will be set
except when parameter INTKEY or KEYPRF is entered and
parameter SECURE is not entered.
(see command DISP CALLPOPT)
- If the keyword (personal identification number) specified during
SCI does not correspond to the keyword stored for the subscriber
then SCI is rejected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...12 digit decimal number

SECURE SECURITY KEYWORD

A security keyword may be modified by SCI. A normal keyword


may not be modified by SCI.

Notes:
- A security keyword can not be displayed.
- A security keyword is logged in enciphered format.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

X(N )= NORMAL KEYWORD


1ZNO Y1 NORMAL KEYWORD
11Y 11 SECURITY KEYWORD

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR KEYWORD- 5+


ENTR KEYWORD
SUBPBX
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

>*YES +W SECURITY KEYWORD

INTKEY INTERNET KEYWORD

Keyword used for Internet sessions.

Notes:
- If none of the parameters INTKEY, KEY, KEYPRF
or SECURE is entered, then a default keyword for KEY and
INTKEY will be set.
(see command DISP CALLPOPT)
- If parameter INTKEY is not entered and parameter KEY and/or
parameter SECURE and/or parameter KEYPRF is entered, then no
default value for INTKEY will be set.
- If the parameters KEY is not entered and parameter INTKEY is
entered, then a default value for KEY will only be set, when
parameter SECURE is entered too.
- If the internet keyword specified during login into an internet
session does not correspond to the internet keyword stored for the
subscriber then login is rejected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

4...12 characters from the


text string character set, enclosed in "

KEYPRF KEYWORD PROFILE

Specifies the keyword profile identification, which should be


assigned. The keyword profile includes a set of features. For using
these features the input of a keyword is mandatory.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

X(PRF1 )= KEYWORD PROFILE 1


11PRF10 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 10
11PRF11 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 11
11PRF12 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 12
11PRF13 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 13
11PRF14 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 14
11PRF15 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 15
1ZPRF16 Y1 KEYWORD PROFILE 16
11PRF2 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 2
11PRF3 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 3
11PRF4 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 4
11PRF5 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 5
11PRF6 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 6
11PRF7 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 7
11PRF8 11 KEYWORD PROFILE 8
>*PRF9 +W KEYWORD PROFILE 9

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ENTR KEYWORD- 6-


ACT L1LNKUPG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Activate L1 Link Upgrade

This task starts the upgrade for Signaling link

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 ACT L1LNKUPG ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

none

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 ACT L1LNKUPG- 1-


CONF LAU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CONFIGURE LINK ADAPTION UNIT

This command configures a LAU.


The LAU is activated without test.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF LAU : LAU= ,OST= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAU LINK ADAPTION UNIT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...11, range of decimal numbers

OST OPERATING STATUS

This parameter specifies the target operating state.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ACT ACTIVE
MBL MAINTENANCE BLOCKED
Because of its influence on the X25LINKs,
configuration of a LAU from ACT to MBL is
considered as dangerous. A dialog mask is output.
The operating personnel must decide, by entering
’+’ or ’-’, whether the command should
be executed.
PLA PLANNED

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF LAU- 1-


DIAG LAU
DIAG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DIAGNOSE LINK ADAPTION UNIT

This command initiates single, repeated or permanent diagnostic runs


for a link adaption unit.

Prerequisites:
- The link adaption unit must be MBL.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. DIAG LAU - DIAG SINGLE DIAGNOSIS


2. DIAG LAU - REPDIAG REPEATED DIAGNOSIS

1. Input format

SINGLE DIAGNOSIS

This input initiates a single diagnosis for a link adaption unit.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG LAU : LAU= [,SUP=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAU LINK ADAPTION UNIT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...11, range of decimal numbers

SUP SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES


NO DISPLAY PROGRESS MESSAGES
Y SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES
YES SUPPRESS PROGRESS MESSAGES

Default: YES

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG LAU- 1+


DIAG LAU
REPDIAG
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

REPEATED DIAGNOSIS

This input initiates a repeated or permanent diagnosis for a link


adaption unit.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG LAU : LAU= ,REP= [,INT=] [,STATCS=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAU LINK ADAPTION UNIT

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...11, range of decimal numbers

REP REPEAT

Valid values are :


2...65535 for repeated diagnosis
PERM for permanent diagnosis with unlimited number
of runs (termination with command STOP JOB)

This parameter specifies the number of diagnostic runs.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...5 characters from the


symbolic name character set

INT INTERRUPTION

This parameter specifies that a repeated or permanent diagnosis is


interrupted as soon as a fault is detected.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

N CONTINUE IN CASE OF FAULT


NO CONTINUE IN CASE OF FAULT
Y TERMINATE IN CASE OF FAULT
YES TERMINATE IN CASE OF FAULT

Default: NO

STATCS OUTPUT OF STATISTICS

This parameter specifies the interval between


statistic outputs in minutes.

Notes:
- Statistic output can also be requested with the
DISP DIAGSTAT command.

Standard Behavior: no statistic output

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...60, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG LAU- 2-


TEST LAU

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

TEST LINK ADAPTION UNIT

This command tests LAUs. The interface to the IOPLAU


is tested, and also X25LINK specific HW parts of the LAU
in case a X25LINK is not ACT.

Prerequisite:
- The units which are to be tested must be ACT.
- The IOP must be active.

Caution: The execution of this command may compromise the regular operation of
the exchange!

This command is provided for use only by


Non-Standard Maintenance (NM) personnel.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 TEST LAU : [LAU=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LAU LINK ADAPTION UNIT

This parameter specifies the link adaption unit to be tested.

Note:
- If the optional unit parameter is omitted, all active
link adaption units are tested.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

0...11, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 TEST LAU- 1-


CAN LCS
CREL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CANCEL LOCATION SERVICES

This command deletes Location Services Profile data in the HLR.


If only parameter LCS is entered then the entire profile is deleted.
If the parameters CLNT, GMLC or CLNTYPE are entered, the corresponding
entries are deleted from the profile.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CAN LCS - CREL CALL RELATED CLASS


2. CAN LCS - CUNREL CALL UNRELATED CLASS
3. CAN LCS - PLMNOPR PLMNOPR OPERATOR CLASS

1. Input format

CALL RELATED CLASS

This input format is used to delete an LCS profile for the call related class.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN LCS : LCS= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LCS LOCATION SERVICES PROFILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of an LCS Profile.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN LCS- 1+


CAN LCS
CUNREL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

CALL UNRELATED CLASS

This input format is used to delete an LCS profile for the call unrelated class
or to delete a CLNT or GMLC from such a profile.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN LCS : LCS= [,CLNT=] [,GMLC=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LCS LOCATION SERVICES PROFILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of an LCS Profile.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CLNT CLIENT

This parameter specifies the address of an LCS Client


to be deleted from the LCS profile.
This is the global title address according to E.164.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...15 digit decimal number

GMLC GMLC ADDRESS

This parameter specifies the address of a GMLC to


be deleted from the LCS profile.
This is the global title address according to E.164.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...15 digit decimal number

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN LCS- 2+


CAN LCS
PLMNOPR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

PLMNOPR OPERATOR CLASS

This input format is used to delete an LCS profile for the PLMN operator class
or to delete a CLNTYPE from such a profile.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CAN LCS : LCS= [,CLNTYPE=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LCS LOCATION SERVICES PROFILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of an LCS Profile.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

CLNTYPE CLIENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the PLMN Client types to


be deleted from the LCS profile.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ANONYM ANONYMOUS LOCATION INFO


BRDCAST BROADCASTING LOCATION REL.INFO
OMHPLMN O&M LCS CLIENT IN HPLMN
OMVPLMN O&M LCS CLIENT IN VPLMN
TMSUBS TARGET MS SUBSCRIBED SERVICE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN LCS- 3-


CR LCS
CREL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

CREATE LOCATION SERVICES

This command creates a new Location Services Profile.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. CR LCS - CREL CALL RELATED CLASS


2. CR LCS - CUNREL CALL UNRELATED CLASS
3. CR LCS - PLMNOPR PLMN OPERATOR CLASS

1. Input format

CALL RELATED CLASS

This input format is used to create an LCS Profile for the call related class.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR LCS : LCS= ,SSV= ,NTF= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LCS LOCATION SERVICES PROFILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of an LCS Profile.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSV SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICE

This parameter specifies a supplementary service for the


Location Services Profile (LCS).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CREL CALL RELATED CLASS

NTF NOTIFICATION TO MS USER

This parameter specifies the notification to the MS user.


For the call unrelated class the client-specific NTF of parameter
CLNT overrides this general NTF.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ANORSP ALLOWED IF NO RESPONSE


AWONOT ALLOWED WITHOUT NOTIFICATION
For the call unrelated class this value means
"positioning not allowed".
AWTNOT ALLOWED WITH NOTIFICATION
NONRSP RESTRICTED IF NO RESPONSE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR LCS- 1+
CR LCS
CUNREL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

CALL UNRELATED CLASS

This input format is used to create an LCS Profile for the call unrelated class.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR LCS : LCS= ,SSV= [,CLNT=] [,GMLC=] [,NTF=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LCS LOCATION SERVICES PROFILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of an LCS Profile.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSV SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICE

This parameter specifies a supplementary service for the


Location Services Profile (LCS).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CUNREL CALL UNRELATED CLASS

CLNT CLIENT

This parameter specifies the address of an LCS Client,


a notification to MS user and a GMLC restriction.
This is the global title address according to E.164.
The maximum number of entries is 5.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c]]

a: LCS CLIENT ADDRESS=


1...15 digit decimal number

b: NOTIFICATION TO MS USER
ANORSP ALLOWED IF NO RESPONSE
AWONOT ALLOWED WITHOUT NOTIFICATION
AWTNOT ALLOWED WITH NOTIFICATION
NONRSP RESTRICTED IF NO RESPONSE

Default: AWONOT

c: GMLC RESTRICTION
AGMLC ANY GMLC IN ANY COUNTRY
HGMLC ANY GMLC IN THE HOME COUNTRY
IGMLC IDENTIFIED GMLC ONLY

Default: AGMLC

GMLC GMLC ADDRESS

This parameter specifies the address of a GMLC.


If c is entered as GMLC restriction in parameter
CLNT, at least one address must be entered.
This is the global title address according to E.164.
The maximum number of entries is 5.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR LCS- 2+
CR LCS
CUNREL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

1...15 digit decimal number

NTF NOTIFICATION TO MS USER

This parameter specifies the notification to the MS user.


For the call unrelated class the client-specific NTF of parameter
CLNT overrides this general NTF.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ANORSP ALLOWED IF NO RESPONSE


AWONOT ALLOWED WITHOUT NOTIFICATION
For the call unrelated class this value means
"positioning not allowed".
AWTNOT ALLOWED WITH NOTIFICATION
NONRSP RESTRICTED IF NO RESPONSE

Default: AWONOT

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR LCS- 3+
CR LCS
PLMNOPR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

PLMN OPERATOR CLASS

This input format is used to create an LCS Profile for the PLMN operator class.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 CR LCS : LCS= ,SSV= ,CLNTYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LCS LOCATION SERVICES PROFILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of an LCS Profile.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSV SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICE

This parameter specifies a supplementary service for the


Location Services Profile (LCS).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PLMNOPR PLMN OPERATOR CLASS

CLNTYPE CLIENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the PLMN Client types.


The maximum number of entries is 5.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ANONYM ANONYMOUS LOCATION INFO


BRDCAST BROADCASTING LOCATION REL.INFO
OMHPLMN O&M LCS CLIENT IN HPLMN
OMVPLMN O&M LCS CLIENT IN VPLMN
TMSUBS TARGET MS SUBSCRIBED SERVICE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR LCS- 4-
DISP LCS

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

DISPLAY LOCATION SERVICES

This command displays information on LCS Profiles.

This command may start a long-running job. It can be stopped with STOP JOB: JN=
<job number>.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP LCS : [LCS=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LCS LOCATION SERVICES PROFILE NAME

This parameter specifies the names of the LCS Profiles to be displayed.


A list of up to 10 profile names may be entered. If the parameter is
omitted, all profiles will be displayed.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP LCS- 1-


MOD LCS
CREL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

MODIFY LOCATION SERVICES

This command modifies a Location Services Profile in the HLR.

This command is normally logged.

This command allows multiple starts.

This command is only permitted if a home location register


(HLR) is installed.

THIS COMMAND HAS FOLLOWING INPUT FORMATS :

1. MOD LCS - CREL CALL RELATED CLASS


2. MOD LCS - CUNREL CALL UNRELATED CLASS
3. MOD LCS - PLMNOPR PLMN OPERATOR CLASS

1. Input format

CALL RELATED CLASS

This input format is used to modify an LCS Profile for the call related class.
Only parameter NTF can be modified.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD LCS : LCS= ,SSV= ,NTF= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LCS LOCATION SERVICES PROFILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of an LCS Profile.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSV SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICE

This parameter specifies a supplementary service for the


Location Services Profile (LCS).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CREL CALL RELATED CLASS

NTF NOTIFICATION TO MS USER

This parameter specifies the notification to the MS user.


For the call unrelated class the client-specific NTF of parameter
CLNT overrides this general NTF.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ANORSP ALLOWED IF NO RESPONSE


AWONOT ALLOWED WITHOUT NOTIFICATION
For the call unrelated class this value means
"positioning not allowed".
AWTNOT ALLOWED WITH NOTIFICATION
NONRSP RESTRICTED IF NO RESPONSE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD LCS- 1+


MOD LCS
CUNREL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

2. Input format

CALL UNRELATED CLASS

This input format is used to modify an LCS Profile for the call unrelated class.
For the parameter CLNT the values for NTF and GMLC restriction of an existing
client address can be modified. A new client can be added.
For the parameter GMLC values can be added.
The parameter NTF can be modified.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD LCS : LCS= ,SSV= [,CLNT=] [,GMLC=] [,NTF=] Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LCS LOCATION SERVICES PROFILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of an LCS Profile.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSV SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICE

This parameter specifies a supplementary service for the


Location Services Profile (LCS).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

CUNREL CALL UNRELATED CLASS

CLNT CLIENT

This parameter specifies the address of an LCS Client,


a notification to MS user and a GMLC restriction.
This is the global title address according to E.164.
The maximum number of entries is 5.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

a[-b[-c]]

a: LCS CLIENT ADDRESS=


1...15 digit decimal number

b: NOTIFICATION TO MS USER
ANORSP ALLOWED IF NO RESPONSE
AWONOT ALLOWED WITHOUT NOTIFICATION
AWTNOT ALLOWED WITH NOTIFICATION
NONRSP RESTRICTED IF NO RESPONSE

Default: AWONOT

c: GMLC RESTRICTION
AGMLC ANY GMLC IN ANY COUNTRY
HGMLC ANY GMLC IN THE HOME COUNTRY
IGMLC IDENTIFIED GMLC ONLY

Default: AGMLC

GMLC GMLC ADDRESS

This parameter specifies the address of a GMLC.


This is the global title address according to E.164.
If IGMLC is entered as GMLC restriction in parameter
CLNT, at least one address must be entered.
The maximum number of entries is 5.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD LCS- 2+


MOD LCS
CUNREL
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

1...15 digit decimal number

NTF NOTIFICATION TO MS USER

This parameter specifies the notification to the MS user.


For the call unrelated class the client-specific NTF of parameter
CLNT overrides this general NTF.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

ANORSP ALLOWED IF NO RESPONSE


AWONOT ALLOWED WITHOUT NOTIFICATION
For the call unrelated class this value means
"positioning not allowed".
AWTNOT ALLOWED WITH NOTIFICATION
NONRSP RESTRICTED IF NO RESPONSE

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD LCS- 3+


MOD LCS
PLMNOPR
KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

3. Input format

PLMN OPERATOR CLASS

This input format is used to modify an LCS Profile for the PLMN operator class.
The entered values of CLNTYPE will be added to the existing values.

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 (;) 1
1 MOD LCS : LCS= ,SSV= ,CLNTYPE= Z Y 1
1 *!+ 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LCS LOCATION SERVICES PROFILE NAME

This parameter specifies the name of an LCS Profile.

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

1...8 characters from the


symbolic name character set

SSV SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICE

This parameter specifies a supplementary service for the


Location Services Profile (LCS).

This parameter only accepts a single value entry.

PLMNOPR PLMN OPERATOR CLASS

CLNTYPE CLIENT TYPE

This parameter specifies the PLMN Client types.


The maximum number of entries is 5.

This parameter allows entry of a single value, or


of multiple values linked with &.

ANONYM ANONYMOUS LOCATION INFO


BRDCAST BROADCASTING LOCATION REL.INFO
OMHPLMN O&M LCS CLIENT IN HPLMN
OMVPLMN O&M LCS CLIENT IN VPLMN
TMSUBS TARGET MS SUBSCRIBED SERVICE

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD LCS- 4-


CAN LIC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Line Interface Card

This task deletes one ]LIC] of the platform 190.


To delete ]LIC] of the platform 140 use local craft terminal (LCT).
Prerequisite:
- In case of deleting a ]LIC] in a ]LIC red. group] following must be regarded:
The working ]LIC] must be deleted first. Then the redundant ]LIC] must be
deleted.

+ ------------------------------ +
! redundant ]LIC’| working ]LIC] !
! (]Pitch]) | (]Pitch]) !
+ ------------------------------ +
! 115 | 103 !
! 139 | 127 !
! 163 | 151 !
! 187 | 175 !
! 303 | 291 !
! 327 | 315 !
! 351 | 339 !
! 375 | 363 !
+ ------------------------------ +

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN LIC : LIC= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter is the number of an existing ]LIC].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...1024.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN LIC- 1-


CONF LIC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Configure Line Interface Card

This task configures a ]LIC] of the platform 190.


To configure ]LIC] of the platform 140 use local craft terminal (LCT).
There is a choice between the ]Admin. state] ]locked], ]unlocked],
]reserved] and ]underRepair].
If the input of ]Admin. state] is ]locked] then ]Hazard check]
can be performed. Performing the ]Hazard check] means that in case
a hazard is detected, the configuration will not be executed and actual
effects are displayed in the output table. Not performing the ]Hazard check]
means that the configuration will be executed always and detected hazards
are displayed in the output table.
Notes:
- If ]Admin. state] is not ]locked] the input parameter ]Hazard check]
is not used.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CONF LIC : LIC= ,Hazard check= ,Admin. state= [,Load information=] ;1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter is the number of an existing ]LIC].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...1024.

Hazard check

If this parameter is ’Yes’, ]Hazard check] is started at


the deactivation of a unit.

Admin. state

This parameter is used to select the kind of configuration.

Load information

This parameter specifies if the code portion should be loaded by force


or only if necessary.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CONF LIC- 1-


CR LIC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create Line Interface Card

This task is used to create a ]LIC] of the platform 190.


To create ]LIC] of the platform 140 use local craft terminal (LCT).
Prerequisites:
- A ]Shelf] must exist.
- An ]AMX] in this ]Shelf] must exist.
- A ]LIC red. group] must exist.
- In one ]LIC red. group] the same ]Signal mode] must exist.
- In case of creating a ]LIC] in a ]LIC red. group] following must be regarded:
The redundant ]LIC] must be created first. Then the working ]LIC] must be
created.

+--------------------------------+
! redundant ]LIC’| working ]LIC] !
! (]Pitch]) | (]Pitch]) !
+--------------------------------+
! 115 | 103 !
! 139 | 127 !
! 163 | 151 !
! 187 | 175 !
! 303 | 291 !
! 327 | 315 !
! 351 | 339 !
! 375 | 363 !
+--------------------------------+

Following combinations are allowed:

+------------------------------------------------------+
! ]Board type] | ]Signal mode] | ]Load type] !
+------------------------------------------------------+
! ]LIC2A / LIC2a-P] | ]E1] | ]CLIC0011] !
! ]LIC1-5A] | ]DS1] | ]CLIC0011] !
! ]LIC34A] | ]E3] | ]CLIC0021] !
! ]LIC34A-P] | ]E3] | ]CLIC0181] !
! ]LIC45A] | ]DS3] | ]CLIC0031] !
! ]LIC155A] | ]STM-1] | ]CLIC0041] !
! ]LIC155D-P] | ]STM-1] | ]CLIC0141] !
! ]LIC155B] | ]STM-1] | ]CLIC0041] !
! ]LIC155E-P] | ]STM-1] | ]CLIC0141] !
! ]LIC155C] | ]STM1] | ]CLIC0041] !
! ]LIC155F-P] | ]STM-1] | ]CLIC0141] !
! ]LICTSC2A-P] | ]E1] | ]CLIC0161] !
! ]A2SC] | ] ] | ]CLIC0171] !
+------------------------------------------------------+

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR LIC : LIC= ,Signal mode= ,Board type= ,Rack= ,Shelf= 1
1 1
1 ,Pitch= [,Load type=] ,Alarm profile MP= 1
1 1
1 [,LIC red. group=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter is the number of a ]LIC].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...1024.

Signal mode

This parameter specifies the ]Signal mode] of a ]LIC].

Board type

This parameter describes the type of the board.

Rack

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR LIC- 1+
CR LIC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter is the name of an existing ]Rack].


Allowed values are symbolic names of exactly 8 characters.

Shelf

This parameter is the number of an existing ]Shelf].

Pitch

This parameter is the number of a ]Pitch].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...400.

Load type

This parameter is used to specify the ]Load type] of the ]LIC] to be


created.
The allowed values are CLIC0011, CLIC0021, CLIC0181, CLIC0031, CLIC0141,
CLIC0111, CLIC0161, CLIC0171.
+--------------------------------+
! ]Load type] | ]Board type] !
+--------------------------------+
! ]CLIC0011] | ]LIC2A / LIC2a-P]!
! ]CLIC0011] | ]LIC1-5A] !
! ]CLIC0021] | ]LIC34A] !
! ]CLIC0181] | ]LIC34A-P] !
! ]CLIC0031] | ]LIC45A] !
! ]CLIC0041] | ]LIC155A] !
! ]CLIC0141] | ]LIC155D-P] !
! ]CLIC0041] | ]LIC155B] !
! ]CLIC0041] | !
! ]CLIC0141] | ]LIC155E-P] !
! ]CLIC0141] | !
! ]CLIC0041] | ]LIC155C] !
! ]CLIC0041] | !
! ]CLIC0141] | ]LIC155F-P] !
! ]CLIC0141] | !
! ]CLIC0111] | ]LICTSC2A] !
! ]CLIC0161] | ]LICTSC2A-P] !
! ]CLIC0171] | ]A2SC] !
+--------------------------------+

Alarm profile MP

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ to the managed


unit to control its alarming behavior.

The ’Alarm Profile MP’ is used to determine the priority of


an alarm, depending on its ’Probable cause’ (see Q3-standards
X.721, M.3100 etc.) and the detected service impact.

Input format:
Selection from:
generally applicable ’Alarm Profile MPs’ available on MP:
- ’ALSUPP’: Alarm suppression
Alarm is negligible and therefore suppressed.
No alarm processing will be performed.
- ’WARNING’: Warning
Alarm constitutes a situation to which attention
is drawn. For all ’Probable cause’ values the
alarm priority ’Warning’ will be used.
- ’MINNOESC’: Minor with no escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MINESC’: Minor with escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’MAJNOESC’: Major with no escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MAJESC’: Major with escalation

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR LIC- 2+
CR LIC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Alarm is of major importance, with escalation.


For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’CRITICAL’: Critical
Alarm indicates a critical system condition.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Critical’ will be used.
or a user-defined one:
- ’own name’, Input: 1...8 characters from printable character set
Use task ’DISP ALPROFMP’ to get an overview of the
existing ’Alarm Profile MPs’.

Standard behavior:
If no ’Alarm Profile MP’ is specified in a create task, a reasonable
default value, depending on the managed object class, is selected by
the system.

LIC red. group

This parameter specifies an existing ]LIC red. group].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...512.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR LIC- 3-
DIAG LIC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Diagnose Line Interface Card

This task starts diagnosis of a ]LIC] of the platform 190.


To diagnose ]LIC] of the platform 140 use local craft terminal (LCT).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DIAG LIC : LIC= ,Kind of diagnosis= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter is the number of an existing ]LIC].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...1024.

Kind of diagnosis

This parameter specifies the kind of diagnosis.


Following values are allowed:

]Self diagnosis]:
Base test for the unit.
It checks the availability and the workability of
the components .
Resets unit and becomes ]Self diagnosis].
No further tests are performed.

]Quick diagnosis]:
Performs a more comprehensive test than ]Self
diagnosis].
It includes all diagnosis tests without long
running
tests.
It must include testing of those hardware parts
which
are tested during normal operation.

]Complete diagnosis]:
This option performs full testing of all the
object functions, including tests which take a
long time
to complete such as memory tests.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DIAG LIC- 1-


DISP LIC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display Line Interface Card

This task displays one or all ]LICs] of the platform 190. The input parameter is
the number
identifying a ]LIC]. If there is no input of the ]LIC] then the output
will be all ]LICs] of the platform 190 within the system.
To display ]LICs] of the platform 140 use local craft terminal (LCT).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP LIC : [LIC=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter is the number of an existing ]LIC].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...1024.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP LIC- 1-


MOD LIC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify Line Interface Card

This task changes the value of the ]Alarm profile MP] of the
]LIC] of the platform 190.
To modify ]LIC] of the platform 140 use local craft terminal (LCT).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD LIC : LIC= ,Alarm profile MP= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter is the number of an existing ]LIC].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...1024.

Alarm profile MP

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ to the managed


unit to control its alarming behavior.

The ’Alarm Profile MP’ is used to determine the priority of


an alarm, depending on its ’Probable cause’ (see Q3-standards
X.721, M.3100 etc.) and the detected service impact.

Input format:
Selection from:
generally applicable ’Alarm Profile MPs’ available on MP:
- ’ALSUPP’: Alarm suppression
Alarm is negligible and therefore suppressed.
No alarm processing will be performed.
- ’WARNING’: Warning
Alarm constitutes a situation to which attention
is drawn. For all ’Probable cause’ values the
alarm priority ’Warning’ will be used.
- ’MINNOESC’: Minor with no escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MINESC’: Minor with escalation
Alarm is of minor importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Minor’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’MAJNOESC’: Major with no escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with no escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used. If service is degraded, no
alarm escalation will be performed.
- ’MAJESC’: Major with escalation
Alarm is of major importance, with escalation.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Major’ will be used if no service impact is
detected. If service is degraded, the alarm
priority will escalate to ’Critical’.
- ’CRITICAL’: Critical
Alarm indicates a critical system condition.
For all ’Probable cause’ values the alarm priority
’Critical’ will be used.
or a user-defined one:
- ’own name’, Input: 1...8 characters from printable character set
Use task ’DISP ALPROFMP’ to get an overview of the
existing ’Alarm Profile MPs’.

Standard behavior:
If no ’Alarm Profile MP’ is specified in a create task, a reasonable
default value, depending on the managed object class, is selected by
the system.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD LIC- 1+


MOD LIC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD LIC- 2-


RECOV LIC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Recover Line Interface Card

This task recovers a ]LIC] of the platform 190.


To recover ]LIC] of the platform 140 use local craft terminal (LCT).
Allowed parameters for recovery of the ]LIC] are:

+---------------------------------------------------------------------+
! ]Scope] ]Depth] ]Measures] !
+---------------------------------------------------------------------+
!LOADREC2: ]Platform] ]Cold start] ]Loading of code and data] !
+---------------------------------------------------------------------+

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 RECOV LIC : LIC= ,Scope= ,Depth= ,Measures= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter is the number of an existing ]LIC].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...1024.

Scope

This parameter specifies that only the adressed platform is recovered.

Depth

This parameter specifies that the recovery is a coldstart recovery.

Measures

This parameter specifies that code and data are reloaded.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 RECOV LIC- 1-


STAT LIC

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

STAT Line Interface Card

This task displays the state of one or all ]LICs] of the platform 190.
The input parameter is the number identifying a ]LIC].
If there is no input then the output will be the states of all
]LICs] of the platform 190 within the system.
To display state of ]LICs] of the platform 140 use local craft terminal (LCT).

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 STAT LIC : [LIC=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter is the number of an existing ]LIC].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...1024.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 STAT LIC- 1-


CAN LICPRTDS1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel LIC Port of Type DS1

This task cancels a ’LIC port’ of type DS1 (’LICPRTDS1’).

Prerequisites:
No ATM layer objects may exist for the given ’LICPRTDS1’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN LICPRTDS1 : LIC= ,LIC port= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter specifies the ’LIC’.

Input format:
1..32767, range of decimal numbers

LIC port

This parameter specifies the ’LIC port’.

Input format:
1..8, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN LICPRTDS1- 1-


CR LICPRTDS1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create LIC Port of Type DS1

This task creates a ’LIC port’ of type DS1 (’LICPRTDS1’).

ATTENTION :
If the script can not finish execution ( e.g. connection between
Net Manager and node is broken ) then use the following procedure :
- First use ’CAN LICPRTDS1’ and then try to create this ’LICPRTDS1’
again.

The ’LICPRTDS1’ consists of the objects


- ’DS1 line TTP’
This managed object represents a termination point where the
digital DS1 signal (1.544 Mbps) is originated and terminated.
A ’Comm. alarm’ notification shall be emitted if a
’Loss of signal’ (’LOS’) condition is detected. The ’Probable cause’
parameter of the notification shall indicate ’LOS’.
- ’DS1 CTP’
This managed object represents a termination point where the
DS1 link connection is originated and terminated.
- ’DS1 path TTP’
This managed object represents a termination point where the
DS1 frame path trail is terminated, i.e.,the DS1 path overhead
is generated and added to the outgoing signal,
and is removed from the incoming signal and processed.
A ’Comm. alarm’ notification shall be emitted if
- a ’Loss of Frame’ (’LOF’)
- a DS1 path ’Alarm Indication Signal’ (’AIS’)
condition is detected.
- ’DS0 time slot’ (24 instances, only for ’Traffic type’ ’STM’)
This managed object represents a termination point where the DS0 link
connection is terminated.
- ’TC adaptor’ (only for ’Traffic type’ ’ATM’)
This object represents a point in the managed system where the
adaptation of the ATM Layer to the underlying physical infrastructure
(e.g., SDH or PDH transport network) takes place.

Prerequisites:
- ’LIC’ must exist.
- ’LIC’ must support DS1.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR LICPRTDS1 : LIC= ,LIC port= [,Redundant LIC=] ,Traffic type= 1
1 1
1 ,Admin. state= ,Alarm profile MP= ,Timing source= 1
1 1
1 ,Line build out= ,DS1 line code= ,DS1 frame format= 1
1 1
1 ,DS1 data link= ,RAI format= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter specifies the ’LIC’.

Input format:
1..32767, range of decimal numbers

LIC port

This parameter specifies the ’LIC port’.

Input format:
1..8, range of decimal numbers

Redundant LIC

This parameter specifies the ’LIC’ number of the redundant ’LIC’.


This parameter is mandatory if the active ’LIC’ is configured
for 1+1 board redundancy, otherwise it must be empty.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR LICPRTDS1- 1+
CR LICPRTDS1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Input format:
1..32767, range of decimal numbers

Traffic type

This parameter determines the type of traffic on the physical interface.

Input format:
Selection from:
’ATM’ broadband
’STM’ narrowband, access to timeslots

Admin. state

This parameter describes the administration of a resource.

Input format:
Selection from:
’Locked’ The resource is administratively prohibited from
performing services for its users.
’Unlocked’ The resource is administratively permitted to perform
services for its users. This is independent of its
inherent operability.

Alarm profile MP

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ for a unit.


The ’Alarm Profile MP’ contains the Probable cause values.
For each Probable cause an alarm priority is assigned.
On the MP the following standardised ’Alarm Profile MP’s
are available:

ALSUPP:
The alarm priority of all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is suppressed.

WARNING:
This is no alarm, but a warning. The alarm priority of all
Probable cause values indicates a warning.

MINNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is of minor importance and will not escalate.

MINESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is minor,
if the service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
In case the service is affected the priority will escalate to
critical.

MAJNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate.

MAJESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate, if the
service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
If service is affected, the priority will escalate to critical.

CRITICAL:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is critical,
i.e. service is affected.

Timing source

This parameter selects the clock source for the transmitted


line signal. This is only valid for non-ATM traffic.

Input format:
Selection from:
’System time’ the internal clock from the ACCG is used.
’Loop’ the incoming line clock is used.

Line build out

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR LICPRTDS1- 2+
CR LICPRTDS1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter is used to indicate the line build out setting (i.e.
equalization setting) of
the transmission line at the line termination.

Input format:
Selection from:
1 0..35 m
2 25..65 m
3 55..95 m
4 85..125 m
5 115..155 m
6 145..185 m
7 175..210 m
length for a PULB 22AWG cable.

DS1 line code

This parameter selects the DS1 line code.

Input format:
Selection from:
’AMI’ Alternate Mark Inversion (bipolar) without zero code
suppression.
’AMIZCS’ Alternate Mark Inversion (bipolar) with zero code
suppression.
’B8ZS’ Alternate Mark Inversion (bipolar) with 8-zero
substitution.

Compatibilities:
For ’Traffic type’ = ’ATM’ the only possible value is ’B8ZS’.

DS1 frame format

This parameter identifies the DS1 frame format.

Input format:
Selection from:
’SF’ Superframe format
’ESF’ Extended superframe format

Compatibilities:
For ’Traffic type’ = ’ATM’ the only possible value is ’ESF’.

DS1 data link

This parameter specifies whether the DS1 data link is enabled or not.

Input format:
Selection from:
’TRUE’ enabled
’FALSE’ disabled

Compatibilities:
If the interface is used as clock source, only the value TRUE is
possible.

RAI format

This parameter defines the ’Remote Alarm Indication’ (’RAI’) format.

Input format:
Selection from:
’TRUE’ set bit 2 to 0 in every channel.
’FALSE’ set FS bit of frame 12.

Compatibilities:
For ’Traffic type’ = ’ATM’ the only possible value is ’TRUE’.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR LICPRTDS1- 3-
DISP LICPRTDS1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display LIC Port of Type DS1

This task displays one specific ’LIC port’ of type DS1 (’LICPRTDS1’), all
’LICPRTDS1’ of a given ’LIC’
or all ’LICPRTDS1’ which meet the filter condition.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP LICPRTDS1 : [LIC=] [,LIC port=] [,DS1 line TTP ID=] 1
1 1
1 [,DS1 path TTP ID=] [,Admin. state=] 1
1 1
1 [,Operational state=] [,Traffic type=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter specifies the ’LIC’.


If this parameter is ommitted, all ’LICPRTDS1’ which meet the filter
condition are displayed.

Input format:
1..32767, range of decimal numbers

LIC port

This parameter specifies the ’LIC port’.


If this parameter is ommitted, all ’LICPRTDS1’ of the ’LIC’ are
displayed.

Input format:
1..8, range of decimal numbers

DS1 line TTP ID

This parameter specifies a component of the ’LICPRTDS1’ which can emit


alarms.
It can be used as an alternate key for the ’LICPRTDS1’ instead of the
parameters
’LIC’ and ’LIC port’.
If ’LIC’ is assigned, ’DS1 line TTP ID’ will be ignored.

DS1 path TTP ID

This parameter specifies a component of the ’LICPRTDS1’ which can emit


alarms.
It can be used as an alternate key for the ’LICPRTDS1’ instead of the
parameters
’LIC’ and ’LIC port’.
If ’LIC’ or ’DS1 line TTP ID’ are assigned, ’DS1 path TTP ID’
will be ignored.

Admin. state

This parameter specifies the ’Admin. state’ for the filter condition.
If ’LIC’, ’DS1 line TTP ID’ or ’DS1 path TTP ID’ are assigned,
’Admin. state’ will be ignored.

Input format:
Selection from:
’Locked’ The resource is administratively prohibited from
performing services for its users.
’Unlocked’ The resource is administratively permitted to perform
services for its users. This is independent of its
inherent operability.

Operational state

This parameter specifies the ’Operational state’ for the filter


condition.
If ’LIC’, ’DS1 line TTP ID’ or ’DS1 path TTP ID’ are assigned,

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP LICPRTDS1- 1+


DISP LICPRTDS1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

’Operational state’ will be ignored.

Input format:
Selection from:
’Disabled’ The resource is totally inoperable and unable to provide
service to the user(s).
’Enabled’ The resource is partially or fully operable and
available for use.

Traffic type

This parameter specifies the ’Traffic type’ for the filter condition.
If ’LIC’, ’DS1 line TTP ID’ or ’DS1 path TTP ID’ are assigned,
’Traffic type’ will be ignored.

Input format:
Selection from:
’ATM’ broadband
’STM’ narrowband, access to timeslots

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP LICPRTDS1- 2-


MOD LICPRTDS1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify LIC Port of Type DS1

This task modifies a ’LIC port’ of type DS1 (’LICPRTDS1’).

Possible Effects:
If the ’Admin. state’ is ’unlocked’, it will temporarily be ’locked’
during the modify operation. This will cause a service interruption.
Changing the line coding or the framing format is a service-affecting
operation.
If the ’Admin. state’ is set to ’locked’, the port is disabled.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD LICPRTDS1 : LIC= ,LIC port= [,Admin. state=] 1
1 1
1 [,Alarm profile MP=] [,Timing source=] 1
1 1
1 [,Line build out=] [,DS1 line code=] 1
1 1
1 [,DS1 frame format=] [,DS1 data link=] [,RAI format=] ;1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter specifies the ’LIC’.

Input format:
1..32767, range of decimal numbers

LIC port

This parameter specifies the ’LIC port’.

Input format:
1..8, range of decimal numbers

Admin. state

This parameter describes the administration of a resource.

Input format:
Selection from:
’Locked’ The resource is administratively prohibited from
performing services for its users.
’Unlocked’ The resource is administratively permitted to perform
services for its users. This is independent of its
inherent operability.

Alarm profile MP

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ for a unit.


The ’Alarm Profile MP’ contains the Probable cause values.
For each Probable cause an alarm priority is assigned.
On the MP the following standardised ’Alarm Profile MP’s
are available:

ALSUPP:
The alarm priority of all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is suppressed.

WARNING:
This is no alarm, but a warning. The alarm priority of all
Probable cause values indicates a warning.

MINNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is of minor importance and will not escalate.

MINESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is minor,
if the service of the alarmed unit is not affected.

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD LICPRTDS1- 1+


MOD LICPRTDS1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

In case the service is affected the priority will escalate to


critical.

MAJNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate.

MAJESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate, if the
service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
If service is affected, the priority will escalate to critical.

CRITICAL:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is critical,
i.e. service is affected.

Timing source

This parameter selects the clock source for the transmitted


line signal. This is only valid for non-ATM traffic.

Input format:
Selection from:
’System time’ the internal clock from the ACCG is used.
’Loop’ the incoming line clock is used.

Line build out

This parameter is used to indicate the line build out setting (i.e.
equalization setting) of
the transmission line at the line termination.

Input format:
Selection from:
1 0..35 m
2 25..65 m
3 55..95 m
4 85..125 m
5 115..155 m
6 145..185 m
7 175..210 m
length for a PULB 22AWG cable.

DS1 line code

This parameter selects the DS1 line code.

Input format:
Selection from:
’AMI’ Alternate Mark Inversion (bipolar) without zero code
suppression.
’AMIZCS’ Alternate Mark Inversion (bipolar) with zero code
suppression.
’B8ZS’ Alternate Mark Inversion (bipolar) with 8-zero
substitution.

Compatibilities:
For ’Traffic type’ = ’ATM’ the only possible value is ’B8ZS’.

DS1 frame format

This parameter identifies the DS1 frame format.

Input format:
Selection from:
’SF’ Superframe format
’ESF’ Extended superframe format

Compatibilities:
For ’Traffic type’ = ’ATM’ the only possible value is ’ESF’.

DS1 data link

This parameter specifies whether the DS1 data link is enabled or not.

Input format:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD LICPRTDS1- 2+


MOD LICPRTDS1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Selection from:
’TRUE’ enabled
’FALSE’ disabled

Compatibilities:
If the interface is used as clock source, only the value TRUE is
possible.

RAI format

This parameter defines the ’Remote Alarm Indication’ (’RAI’) format.

Input format:
Selection from:
’TRUE’ set bit 2 to 0 in every channel.
’FALSE’ set FS bit of frame 12.

Compatibilities:
For ’Traffic type’ = ’ATM’ the only possible value is ’TRUE’.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD LICPRTDS1- 3-


CAN LICPRTE1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel LIC Port of Type E1

This task cancels a ’LIC port’ of type E1 (’LICPRTE1’).

Prerequisites:
No ATM layer objects may exist for the given ’LICPRTE1’.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN LICPRTE1 : LIC= ,LIC port= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter specifies the ’LIC’.

Input format:
1..32767, range of decimal numbers

LIC port

This parameter specifies the ’LIC port’.

Input format:
1..8, range of decimal numbers

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN LICPRTE1- 1-


CR LICPRTE1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Create LIC Port of Type E1

This task creates a ’LIC port’ of type E1 (’LICPRTE1’).

ATTENTION :
If the script can not finish execution ( e.g. connection between
Net Manager and node is broken ) then use the following procedure :
- First use ’CAN LICPRTE1’ and then try to create this ’LICPRTE1’
again.

The ’LICPRTE1’ consists of the objects


- ’PPI TTP’
This managed object class represents the point where the internal
logic level and the timing is converted into a line signal,
and the incoming interface signal is converted into an internal logic
level and the timing is recovered from the line signal.
A ’Comm. alarm’ notification shall be issued if a
’Loss of signal’ (’LOS’) is detected. The ’Probable cause’
parameter of the notification shall indicate ’LOS’.
The ’Operational state’ is ’Disabled’ if a ’LOS’ is detected
- ’E1 alarm TTP’
This object class originates and terminates a PDH hierarchy trail.
This object class includes the ’AIS’ monitoring function.
A ’Comm. alarm’ notification shall be issued if
- a ’Loss of Frame’ (’LOF’)
- a ’Far end receiver failure’ (’FERF’)
- an ’Alarm Indication Signal’ (’AIS’)
is detected.
The ’Operational state’ is ’Disabled’ when a ’LOF’, FERF’ or
’AIS’ is detected.
- ’E0 time slot’ (31 instances, only for ’Traffic type’ ’STM’)
An instance of this object class originates and terminates a 64 kbit/s
connection.
- ’TC adaptor’ (only for ’Traffic type’ ’ATM’)
This object represents a point in the managed system where the
adaptation of the ATM Layer to the underlying physical infrastructure
takes place.

Prerequisites:
- ’LIC’ must exist.
- ’LIC’ must support E1.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CR LICPRTE1 : LIC= ,LIC port= [,Redundant LIC=] ,Traffic type= 1
1 1
1 ,Admin. state= ,Alarm profile MP= ,Timing source= 1
1 1
1 ,E-bit= ,E-bit polarity= ,National bit= 1
1 1
1 ,E1 frame format= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter specifies the ’LIC’.

Input format:
1..32767, range of decimal numbers

LIC port

This parameter specifies the ’LIC port’.

Input format:
1..8, range of decimal numbers

Redundant LIC

This parameter specifies the ’LIC’ number of the redundant ’LIC’.


This parameter is mandatory if the active ’LIC’ is configured

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR LICPRTE1- 1+
CR LICPRTE1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

for 1+1 board redundancy, otherwise it must be empty.

Input format:
1..32767, range of decimal numbers

Traffic type

This parameter determines the type of traffic on the physical interface.

Input format:
Selection from:
’ATM’ broadband
’STM’ narrowband, access to timeslots

Admin. state

This parameter describes the administration of a resource.

Input format:
Selection from:
’Locked’ The resource is administratively prohibited from
performing services for its users.
’Unlocked’ The resource is administratively permitted to perform
services for its users. This is independent of its
inherent operability.

Alarm profile MP

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ for a unit.


The ’Alarm Profile MP’ contains the Probable cause values.
For each Probable cause an alarm priority is assigned.
On the MP the following standardised ’Alarm Profile MP’s
are available:

ALSUPP:
The alarm priority of all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is suppressed.

WARNING:
This is no alarm, but a warning. The alarm priority of all
Probable cause values indicates a warning.

MINNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is of minor importance and will not escalate.

MINESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is minor,
if the service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
In case the service is affected the priority will escalate to
critical.

MAJNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate.

MAJESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate, if the
service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
If service is affected, the priority will escalate to critical.

CRITICAL:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is critical,
i.e. service is affected.

Timing source

This parameter selects the clock source for the transmitted


line signal. This is only valid for non-ATM traffic.

Input format:
Selection from:
’System time’ the internal clock from the ACCG is used.
’Loop’ the incoming line clock is used.

E-bit

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR LICPRTE1- 2+
CR LICPRTE1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

This parameter enables or disables the evaluation of the E-bit


in the E1 CRC multiframe.

Input format:
Selection from:
’TRUE’ the E-bit is enabled
’FALSE’ the E-bit is disabled

E-bit polarity

This parameter sets the expected E-bit polarity for an accepted


multiframe.

Input format:
Selection from:
’TRUE’ error free submultiframe: E-bit=1 (according to ITU-T
G704)
’FALSE’ error free submultiframe: E-bit=0 (according to M.3604)

National bit

This parameter determines whether default pattern or national


bit default pattern is sent.

Input format:
Selection from:
’TRUE’ national bit default pattern
’FALSE’ default pattern

E1 frame format

This parameter identifies the ’E1 frame format’.

Input format:
Selection from:
’Double’ used for older systems
’CRC’

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CR LICPRTE1- 3-
DISP LICPRTE1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Display LIC Port of Type E1

This task displays one specific ’LIC port’ of type E1 (’LICPRTE1’),


all ’LICPRTE1’ of a given ’LIC’ or all ’LICPRTE1’ which meet the filter condition.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 DISP LICPRTE1 : [LIC=] [,LIC port=] [,PPI TTP ID=] [,Admin. state=] 1
1 1
1 [,Operational state=] [,Traffic type=] ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter specifies the ’LIC’.


If this parameter is ommitted, all ’LICPRTE1’ which meet the filter
condition are displayed.

Input format:
1..32767, range of decimal numbers

LIC port

This parameter specifies the ’LIC port’.


If this parameter is ommitted, all ’LICPRTE1’ of the ’LIC’ are displayed.
If ’LIC’ is not assigned, ’LIC port’ will be ignored.

Input format:
1..8, range of decimal numbers

PPI TTP ID

This parameter specifies a component of the ’LICPRTE1’ which can emit


alarms.
It can be used as an alternative key for the ’LICPRTE1’ instead of the
parameters
’LIC’ and ’LIC port’.
If ’LIC’ is assigned, ’PPI TTP ID’ will be ignored.

Admin. state

This parameter specifies the ’Admin. state’ for the filter condition.
If ’LIC’ or ’PPI TTP ID’ are assigned,
’Admin. state’ will be ignored.

Input format:
Selection from:
’Locked’ The resource is administratively prohibited from
performing services for its users.
’Unlocked’ The resource is administratively permitted to perform
services for its users. This is independent of its
inherent operability.

Operational state

This parameter specifies the ’Operational state’ for the filter


condition.
If ’LIC’ or ’PPI TTP ID’ are assigned,
’Operational state’ will be ignored.

Input format:
Selection from:
’Disabled’ The resource is totally inoperable and unable to provide
service to the user(s).
’Enabled’ The resource is partially or fully operable and
available for use.

Traffic type

This parameter specifies the ’Traffic type’ for the filter condition.
If ’LIC’ or ’PPI TTP ID’ are assigned,

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP LICPRTE1- 1+


DISP LICPRTE1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

’Traffic type’ will be ignored.

Input format:
Selection from:
’ATM’ broadband
’STM’ narrowband, access to timeslots

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 DISP LICPRTE1- 2-


MOD LICPRTE1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Modify LIC Port of Type E1

This task modifies a ’LIC port’ of type E1.

Possible Effects:
If the ’Admin. state’ is ’unlocked’, it will temporarily be ’locked’
during the modify operation. This will cause a service interruption.
If the ’Admin. state’ is set to ’locked’, the port is disabled.

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 MOD LICPRTE1 : LIC= ,LIC port= [,Admin. state=] 1
1 1
1 [,Alarm profile MP=] [,E1 frame format=] [,E-bit=] 1
1 1
1 [,E-bit polarity=] [,National bit=] [,Timing source=] ;1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC

This parameter specifies the ’LIC’.

Input format:
1..32767, range of decimal numbers

LIC port

This parameter specifies the ’LIC port’.

Input format:
1..8, range of decimal numbers

Admin. state

This parameter describes the administration of a resource.

Input format:
Selection from:
’Locked’ The resource is administratively prohibited from
performing services for its users.
’Unlocked’ The resource is administratively permitted to perform
services for its users. This is independent of its
inherent operability.

Alarm profile MP

This parameter relates an ’Alarm Profile MP’ for a unit.


The ’Alarm Profile MP’ contains the Probable cause values.
For each Probable cause an alarm priority is assigned.
On the MP the following standardised ’Alarm Profile MP’s
are available:

ALSUPP:
The alarm priority of all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is suppressed.

WARNING:
This is no alarm, but a warning. The alarm priority of all
Probable cause values indicates a warning.

MINNOESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates
that the alarm is of minor importance and will not escalate.

MINESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is minor,
if the service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
In case the service is affected the priority will escalate to
critical.

MAJNOESC:

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD LICPRTE1- 1+


MOD LICPRTE1

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate.

MAJESC:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values indicates that
the alarm is of major importance but will not escalate, if the
service of the alarmed unit is not affected.
If service is affected, the priority will escalate to critical.

CRITICAL:
The alarm priority for all Probable cause values is critical,
i.e. service is affected.

E1 frame format

This parameter identifies the ’E1 frame format’.

Input format:
Selection from:
’Double’ used for older systems
’CRC’

E-bit

This parameter enables or disables the evaluation of the E-bit


in the E1 CRC multiframe.

Input format:
Selection from:
’TRUE’ the E-bit is enabled
’FALSE’ the E-bit is disabled

E-bit polarity

This parameter sets the expected E-bit polarity for an accepted


multiframe.

Input format:
Selection from:
’TRUE’ error free submultiframe: E-bit=1 (according to ITU-T
G704)
’FALSE’ error free submultiframe: E-bit=0 (according to M.3604)

National bit

This parameter determines whether default pattern or national


bit default pattern is sent.

Input format:
Selection from:
’TRUE’ national bit default pattern
’FALSE’ default pattern

Timing source

This parameter selects the clock source for the transmitted


line signal. This is only valid for non-ATM traffic.

Input format:
Selection from:
’System time’ the internal clock from the ACCG is used.
’Loop’ the incoming line clock is used.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 MOD LICPRTE1- 2-


CAN LICREDG

KKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKKK

Cancel Line Interface Card Red. Group

This task deletes a ]LIC red. group].


Prerequisites:
- No ]LIC] exists in this ]LIC red. group].

Input format

XBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBB=
1 1
1 CAN LICREDG : LIC red. group= ; 1
1 1
>BBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBBW

Input parameter

LIC red. group

This parameter is the number of an existing ]LIC red. group].


The allowed range of decimal numbers is 1...512.

E N D

P30305-V6000-A866-01-7619 CAN LICREDG- 1-

Vous aimerez peut-être aussi